3-3 1/2 Page apa style paper on being in a DBT support group

profileWwjdalloverme1
Handbook_of_Health_Social_Work-1.pdf

fmatter.indd iifmatter.indd ii 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

Praise for Handbook of Health Social Work, Second Edition

“The major strength is the organization and comprehensive content of the book. This is a book that can serve as a reference book in any social worker’s library, regardless of whether they are practic- ing in a health-care setting. There are no other books on this topic that are as comprehensive in scope as the Handbook of Health Social Work, Second Edition.”

— Deborah Collinsworth, LAPSW, NSW-C, Director of Nephrology Social Work Services, Dialysis Clinics, Inc., West Tennessee

“I’m quite impressed by the comprehensive nature of this revision. It’s the enduring kind of text that serves an immediate purpose for social work instruction while also providing a reference for future practice. This is a book that you’ll want to keep on your shelf.”

— Kevin Lindamood, Vice President for External Affairs at Health Care for the Homeless, Adjunct Professor of Health Policy at the University of Maryland SSW

“Sarah Gehlert and Teri Browne have thoughtfully covered the topics. The readers of this book will be empowered to deal with the daily challenges. It’s simple but far reaching, a rich knowledge bank of social workers’ interventions, and will benefi t even policy makers in planning strategies to improve patients’ quality of life.”

— Sujata Mohan Rajapurkar, PhD, Medical Social Worker and Transplant Coordinator, Muljibhai Patel Urological Hospital, Gujarat, India

“The book’s strengths include the high quality of writing and the expertise of its contributors. It covers the fi eld of health social work in signifi cant depth and is sure to leave readers well informed.”

— Mary Sormanti, PhD, MSW, Associate Professor of Professional Practice, Columbia University School of Social Work

“Quite simply, this is the defi nitive volume for Health and Social Work. The fi rst edition was well- executed, well-written, and comprehensive. In this second edition, Gehlert and Browne and their expert contributors have confi dently managed to keep pace with current theory and empirical re- search across a wide range of subject matter that will be of interest to practitioners, educators, and researchers.”

— Michael Vaughn, PhD, Assistant Professor, School of Social Work, School of Public Health, and Department of Public Policy Studies, Saint Louis University

fmatter.indd ifmatter.indd i 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

fmatter.indd iifmatter.indd ii 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

HANDBOOK OF HEALTH SOCIAL WORK

SECOND EDITION

Edited by

SARAH GEHLERT and TERI BROWNE

John Wiley & Sons, Inc.

fmatter.indd iiifmatter.indd iii 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

This book is printed on acid-free paper. o

Copyright © 2012 by John Wiley & Sons, Inc. All rights reserved.

Published by John Wiley & Sons, Inc., Hoboken, New Jersey. Published simultaneously in Canada.

No part of this publication may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system, or transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, scanning, or otherwise, except as permitted under Section 107 or 108 of the 1976 United States Copyright Act, without either the prior written permission of the Publisher, or authorization through payment of the appropriate per-copy fee to the Copyright Clearance Center, Inc., 222 Rosewood Drive, Danvers, MA 01923, (978) 750-8400, fax (978) 646-8600, or on the Web at www.copyright.com. Requests to the Publisher for permission should be addressed to the Permissions Department, John Wiley & Sons, Inc., 111 River Street, Hoboken, NJ 07030, (201) 748-6011, fax (201) 748-6008.

Limit of Liability/Disclaimer of Warranty: While the publisher and author have used their best efforts in preparing this book, they make no representations or warranties with respect to the accuracy or completeness of the contents of this book and specifi cally disclaim any implied warranties of merchantability or fi tness for a particular purpose. No warranty may be created or extended by sales representatives or written sales materials. The advice and strategies contained herein may not be suitable for your situation. You should consult with a professional where appropriate. Neither the publisher nor author shall be liable for any loss of profi t or any other commercial damages, including but not limited to special, incidental, consequential, or other damages.

This publication is designed to provide accurate and authoritative information in regard to the subject matter covered. It is sold with the understanding that the publisher is not engaged in rendering professional services. If legal, accounting, medical, psychological or any other expert assistance is required, the services of a competent professional person should be sought.

Designations used by companies to distinguish their products are often claimed as trademarks. In all instances where John Wiley & Sons, Inc. is aware of a claim, the product names appear in initial capital or all capital letters. Readers, however, should contact the appropriate companies for more complete information regarding trademarks and registration.

For general information on our other products and services, please contact our Customer Care Department within the U.S. at (800) 762-2974, outside the United States at (317) 572-3993 or fax (317) 572-4002.

Wiley also publishes its books in a variety of electronic formats. Some content that appears in print may not be available in electronic books. For more information about Wiley products, visit our Web site at www.wiley.com.

Library of Congress Cataloging-in-Publication Data:

Handbook of health social work / edited by Sarah Gehlert and Teri Browne. — 2nd ed. p. cm. Includes bibliographical references and index. ISBNs 978-0-470-64365-5; 978-1-118-11589-3; 978-1-118-11591-6; 978-118-11590-9 1. Medical social work—Handbooks, manuals, etc. I. Gehlert, Sarah, 1948- II. Browne, Teri. HV687.A2H36 2012 362.1‘0425—dc22 2011010997

Printed in the United States of America

10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1

fmatter.indd ivfmatter.indd iv 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

v

Contents

Foreword viii Suzanne Heurtin-Roberts

Acknowledgments x

List of Contributors xi

Introduction xiii

PART I FOUNDATIONS OF SOCIAL WORK IN HEALTH CARE 1

1 ⏐ Conceptual Underpinnings of Social Work in Health Care 3 Sarah Gehlert

2 ⏐ Social Work Roles and Health-Care Settings 20 Teri Browne

3 ⏐ Ethics and Social Work in Health Care 41 Jared Sparks

4 ⏐ Public Health and Social Work 64 Marjorie R. Sable, Deborah R. Schild, and J. Aaron Hipp

5 ⏐ Health Policy and Social Work 100 Julie S. Darnell and Edward F. Lawlor

6 ⏐ Theories of Health Behavior 125 Sarah Gehlert and Sarah E. Bollinger

fmatter.indd vfmatter.indd v 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

vi Contents

PART II HEALTH SOCIAL WORK PRACTICE: A SPECTRUM OF CRITICAL CONSIDERATIONS 141

7 ⏐ Community and Health 143 Christopher Masi

8 ⏐ Physical and Mental Health: Interactions, Assessment, and Interventions 164 Malitta Engstrom

9 ⏐ Social Work Practice and Disability Issues 219 Rebecca Brashler

10 ⏐ Communication in Health Care 237 Sarah Gehlert

11 ⏐ Religion, Spirituality, Health, and Social Work 263 Terry A. Wolfer

12 ⏐ Developing a Shared Understanding: When Medical Patients Use Complementary and Alternative Approaches 291 Penny B. Block

13 ⏐ Families, Health, and Illness 318 John S. Rolland

14 ⏐ Human Sexual Health 343 Les Gallo-Silver and David S. Bimbi

PART III HEALTH SOCIAL WORK: SELECTED AREAS OF PRACTICE 371

15 ⏐ Social Work With Children and Adolescents With Medical Conditions 373 Nancy Boyd Webb and Rose A. Bartone

16 ⏐ Social Work With Older Adults in Health-Care Settings 392 Sadhna Diwan, Shantha Balaswamy, and Sang E. Lee

17 ⏐ Substance Use Problems in Health Social Work Practice 426 Malitta Engstrom, Colleen A. Mahoney, and Jeanne C. Marsh

fmatter.indd vifmatter.indd vi 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

Contents vii

18 ⏐ Nephrology Social Work 468 Teri Browne

19 ⏐ Oncology Social Work 498 Daniel S. Gardner and Allison Werner-Lin

20 ⏐ Adherence and Mental Health Issues in Chronic Disease: Diabetes, Heart Disease, and HIV/AIDS 526 Wendy Auslander and Stacey Freedenthal

21 ⏐ Social Work and Genetics 557 Allison Werner-Lin and Kate Reed

22 ⏐ Pain Management and Palliative Care 590 Terry Altilio, Shirley Otis-Green, Susan Hedlund, and Iris Cohen Fineberg

23 ⏐ End-of-Life Care 627 Yvette Colón

Afterword 643 Candyce S. Berger

About the Editors 649

Author Index 651

Subject Index 677

fmatter.indd viifmatter.indd vii 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

Foreword

It is both an exciting and a challenging time to be a social worker in the fi eld of health. A diversity of roles is available for social work- ers. Areas of practice and opportunities for inter- and transdisciplinary collaborations are unprecedented in the history of the profession. Social workers along with other professionals are on the cutting edge of new health-relevant programs and practices, with social workers frequently in top leadership roles in these ef- forts. To note just a very few examples, social workers are providing genetic counseling and mental health treatment, coordinating hospice and palliative care, working with communities to develop better access to cancer care and clini- cal trials, advocating for and writing improved health-relevant policies, developing health pro- grams and practices, and conducting research that provides an evidence base for effective practice in social work and other professions.

A number of events and trends have come to bear on this blossoming of social work in health. The Patient Protection and Affordable Care Act of 2010 (PPACA), itself the result of decades of advocacy and study on the part of many, including social workers, will radically change the context in which health care is de- livered in the United States. This change will require profound and unsurpassed expertise in complex systems and their relationships to users of health care that is the domain of so- cial workers. Effective implementation of the PPACA will require social work expertise at all levels, from front-line practitioner to policy maker and executive.

The evidence-based practice movement in social work and other health professions also has been integral to the rising importance of social work in health. From fi rst-level, or T1, translation of research fi ndings to cultural and community tailoring and dissemination and diffusion, social work has a principal role to play in getting health knowledge and knowl- edge-based practice to the populations that most can use it. Indeed, social work has been and will continue to be a key source of research producing such knowledge. As the profession is focused on improving people’s well-being through practice that targets interrelationships among systems and people, social work re- search is of great consequence for knowledge production on which to base health-care re- form and other efforts to improve health care in the United States. Thanks to the concerted and strategic efforts of academic social work and professional social work organizations, health social work research is growing and be- ginning to fl ourish.

The growth of the social determinants per- spective on health has fostered a crucial place for social work in health. As a profession, so- cial work has long understood the importance of multiple life dimensions and experiences as they affect human well-being across the life cycle and has built its practice on such a per- spective. As other health professions catch up in this area, social work’s contributions can be very infl uential in helping to prevent reinven- tion of the wheel in both health care and dis- ease prevention.

viii

fmatter.indd viiifmatter.indd viii 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

Foreword ix

I have noted just a few of the phenomena leading to social work’s rich contributions to health and great potential for even more. As a postdoctoral fellow in applied anthropology, I once worked in a hospital setting on a geriatric consult team. Repeatedly I went to social work staff for information and advice. Indeed, my team (which included physicians, a nurse, and a pharmacologist) held to the mantra of “go ask a social worker, they know everything!” The breadth and depth of social work exper- tise in health is refl ected in and supported by the material in the current work.

This volume is a crucial addition to the libraries of seasoned practitioners as well as an essential foundation for fl edgling social workers ready to enter health as a practice and research area. Both editors are respected leaders in the fi eld of health and social work with an abundance of experience, knowledge, and passion for their work. They have brought together a multiplicity of impressive contribu- tors, all authorities in their respective areas, who share their knowledge and wisdom. The Handbook’s contributors address multiple theoretical foundations, models, issues, and dilemmas for the social worker in health.

Included are descriptions of skill sets and other expertise needed for direct practice clinicians, community workers, planners, policy makers, researchers, advocates, and administrators. The volume covers practice and research areas ranging from chronic disorders to infectious disease, from physical to mental disorders, and all the gray areas in between.

However, the book is not simply a how-to manual. Rather, it assesses the current state of the fi eld while suggesting important new directions and developments for the future of social work in health. The ideas in this vol- ume suggest that, perhaps, there is some truth to the sentiment that “social workers know everything.” Certainly they know a great deal about working to improve health and about what will be needed in the future to improve the nation’s health. At a time of great change in the United States in regard to facilitating the production of better health for populations and individuals, a ny social worker engaged in this area would be well advised to have this out- standing resource at hand.

Suzanne Heurtin-Roberts Bethesda, Maryland

fmatter.indd ixfmatter.indd ix 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

Acknowledgments

The preparation of the second edition of this Handbook involved the efforts of a number of people. First and foremost was Jerrod Live- oak, a very talented young man who again helped us organize and edit the Handbook. We could not have done it without his as- sistance. Rachel Livsey and Kara Borbely of John Wiley & Sons’ behavioral science divi- sion were supportive throughout the process. We join them in mourning the loss of Lisa Gebo, a gifted member of the John Wiley & Sons team who worked with us on the fi rst edition and lost her life to breast can- cer on June 14, 2010. We also would like to thank these colleagues who reviewed the

book and provided valuable feedback: Gary Rosenberg, Mount Sinai School of Medicine; Mary Sormanti, Columbia University; Judy Howe, Mount Sinai School of Medicine; Kevin Lindamood, University of Maryland; Deborah Collinsworth, Union University; and Michael Vaughn, St. Louis University. The 36 contributors to the Handbook, some of whom were friends and others known to us only by reputation prior to the collabora- tion, worked hard and were patient with this revision. Finally, we would like to thank our spouses, Roy Wilson and Lyle Browne, who were always willing to listen to our ideas and to provide feedback and support.

x

fmatter.indd xfmatter.indd x 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

xi

List of Contributors

Terry Altilio, MSW, ACSW Beth Israel Medical Center New York, New York

Wendy Auslander, PhD Washington University St. Louis, Missouri

Shantha Balaswamy, PhD Ohio State University Columbus, Ohio

Rose A. Bartone, MSW, LCSW-R New York Medical College Valhalla, New York

Candyce S. Berger, PhD Stony Brook University Stony Brook, New York

David S. Bimbi, PhD LaGuardia Community College Long Island City, New York

Penny B. Block, PhD Block Center for Integrative Cancer Care Evanston, Illinois

Sarah E. Bollinger, MSW, LCSW Washington University St. Louis, Missouri

Rebecca Brashler, MSW, LCSW Rehabilitation Institute of Chicago Chicago, Illinois

Teri Browne, PhD University of South Carolina Columbia, South Carolina

Yvette Colón, PhD, ACSW, BCD American Pain Foundation Baltimore, Maryland

Julie S. Darnell, PhD University of Illinois at Chicago Chicago, Illinois

Sadhna Diwan, PhD San Jose State University San Jose, California

Malitta Engstrom, PhD University of Chicago Chicago, Illinois

Iris Cohen Fineberg, PhD Lancaster University Lancaster, United Kingdom

Stacey Freedenthal, PhD University of Denver Denver, Colorado

Les Gallo-Silver, MSW, ACSW, CSW-R LaGuardia Community College Long Island City, New York

Daniel S. Gardner, PhD New York University New York, New York

Sarah Gehlert, PhD Washington University St. Louis, Missouri

Susan Hedlund, MSW, LCSW Hospice of Washington County Portland, Oregon

fmatter.indd xifmatter.indd xi 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

xii List of Contributors

Suzanne Heurtin-Roberts, PhD, MSW United States Department of Health and

Human Services Bethesda, Maryland

J. Aaron Hipp, PhD Washington University St. Louis, Missouri

Edward F. Lawlor, PhD Washington University St. Louis, Missouri

Sang E. Lee, PhD San Jose State University San Jose, California

Colleen A. Mahoney, PhD University of Wisconsin Madison, Wisconsin

Jeanne C. Marsh, PhD University of Chicago Chicago, Illinois

Christopher Masi, MD, PhD University of Chicago Chicago, Illinois

Shirley Otis-Green, MSW, ACSW, LCSW City of Hope National Medical Center Duarte, California

Kate Reed, MPH, ScM National Coalition for Health Professional

Education in Genetics Lutherville, Maryland

John S. Rolland, MD Chicago Center for Family Health Chicago, Illinois

Marjorie R. Sable, DrPH University of Missouri Columbia, Missouri

Deborah R. Schild, PhD Public Health Social Worker Ann Arbor, Michigan

Jared Sparks, PhD Ozark Guidance Springdale, Arkansas

Nancy Boyd Webb, DSW, LICSW, RPT-S Fordham University (retired) New York, New York

Allison Werner-Lin, PhD New York University New York, New York

Terry A. Wolfer, PhD University of South Carolina Columbia, South Carolina

fmatter.indd xiifmatter.indd xii 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

xiii

Introduction

In a faculty meeting a few years ago, a col- league from another profession referred to the “lower-level skills” of social workers in health care. She distinguished these skills from the “higher-level skills” of social workers in men- tal health settings. I addressed her comment by citing the broad array of information that social workers in health care must possess and be able to access quickly in order to assess cli- ent situations and devise optimal plans in the limited time available to them in health-care settings. I characterized the process as highly challenging, requiring skills at least as well developed as those of social workers in other arenas. This exchange between my colleague and me made me realize two things. First of all, health social work is not well understood by those working in other subfi elds of social work and other disciplines. Second, it would behoove health social work scholars to better defi ne and represent the subfi eld.

As health care becomes increasingly more complex, social workers have much to know. We have yet to fully understand what the Pa- tient Protection and Affordable Care Act that was enacted in March 2010 means for the health of the nation or what it means for so- cial work practice and research. We do know that current federal approaches to addressing complicated health conditions like HIV/AIDS and cancer argue strongly for simultaneous attention to factors operating at the social, psychological, and biological levels (see, e.g., Warnecke et al., 2008). As members of health- care teams that take these approaches, social

workers must possess suffi cient knowledge at the social, psychological, and biological lev- els to converse productively with other team members and to work in concert with them constructively. In addition, to be effective, so- cial workers must be aware of how these fac- tors operate with individuals, families, groups, communities, and societies. This awareness is best accomplished by engaging community stakeholders at many levels in research.

The Handbook of Health Social Work was developed to prepare students to work in the current health-care environment in which providers from a number of disciplines work more closely together than was ever the case in the past. Health care in the United States has moved from being multidisciplinary to being interdisciplinary, with the ultimate goal of being transdisciplinary. In multidisci- plinary environments, professionals from dif- ferent disciplines work on the same projects but speak their own languages, view health care through their own disciplinary lens, and often share knowledge with one another after the fact. Interdisciplinary teams interact more closely, but each discipline continues to op- erate within its own boundaries. Because an interdisciplinary approach almost never pro- vides a broad enough view of health-care conditions to capture their inherent complexi- ties, transdisciplinary teamwork has become the exemplar. Here health-care professionals work so closely together that they must de- velop a shared language and pool the best of their separate disciplinary theories. Absent this

fmatter.indd xiiifmatter.indd xiii 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

xiv Introduction

new, more interdependent approach, the team is reminiscent of the old cartoon of a roomful of blindfolded people touching different parts of an elephant, with each describing the beast based only on the part that she is touching. One might base his description on the trunk, another on the ears, and a third on the tail. To address complex health conditions like HIV/ AIDS effectively, we must recognize the el- ephant in the room.

In 2009, my coeditor, Teri Browne, and I were asked by John Wiley & Sons if we would be interested in revising the Handbook. A good deal has changed on both the national and in- ternational fronts in the 4 years since the fi rst edition was published. The mapping of the human genome in 2004 continues to change how we view and approach the treatment of disease. Our ability to treat some disorders has increased markedly. Over the four years be- tween the fi rst and second editions, increasing numbers of people lost their health-care cov- erage. Although health-care reform holds the potential to ensure that citizens have cover- age, this is not true for those who are undocu- mented immigrants, and exactly how reform will impact the nation’s steadily increasing health disparities remains a question.

These changes will continue, and require a great deal of fl exibility on the part of health so- cial workers. As was the case with the fi rst edi- tion of the Handbook of Health Social Work, the second edition considers social workers in health care to be active problem solvers who must draw from a variety of germane bodies of information to address the issues and prob- lems faced by individuals, families, groups, communities, and societies. We believe that this approach allows fl exibility and thus posi- tions health social workers to deal optimally with a changing health-care environment. The authors and layout of the second edition re- fl ect this approach. Learning exercises at the end of each chapter are designed to stimulate discussion and help readers process the infor- mation provided and consider it analytically. The book’s chapters are sandwiched between a foreword by Suzanne Heurtin-Roberts and an afterword by Candyce Berger, both of whom

have broken ground as social work leaders in health-care practice and research and done much to raise the profi le of the profession.

The book is divided into three sections. Part I, Foundations of Social Work in Health Care, provides information that we consider basic and central to the operations of social workers in health care. In Chapter 1, “Conceptual Un- derpinnings of Social Work in Health Care,” Sarah Gehlert again discusses the principles that underlie the development of social work in health care and follows its course through time to discover any changes in principles and activities that may have occurred. Chapter 2, “Social Work Roles and Health-Care Set- tings,” by Teri Browne, carefully outlines the wide array of roles performed by social work- ers in health-care settings today. After provid- ing a framework for ethical decision making, Chapter 3, “Ethics and Social Work in Health Care,” by Jared Sparks, again considers some key issues confronting social workers in health care in a variety of arenas, from practice with individuals to policy development. All three chapters take into account the unique chal- lenges facing health care in the United States.

Public health social work recently was named as one of the top 50 professions by U.S. News & World Report, and training programs that combine the two continue to grow. Be- cause of this, and because social work has for a long time played an integral role in the pub- lic health of the United States and other parts of the world, Chapter 4, titled “Public Health and Social Work,” is an essential component of the Handbook, to orient readers to the pub- lic health perspective. J. Aaron Hipp, a com- munity psychologist who works in a school of public health, joined health social workers Marjorie R. Sable and Deborah R. Schild in revising the chapter. The chapter introduces readers to the concepts of primary, secondary, and tertiary health care and considers health from a wider lens than is often used, including global patterns of health and disease. Chapter 5, “Health Policy and Social Work,” written by Julie S. Darnell and Edward F. Lawlor, is almost totally revised from the fi rst edition. It presents basic information on the interplay

fmatter.indd xivfmatter.indd xiv 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

Introduction xv

among clinical, administrative, and policy is- sues in health care. Although it is beyond the scope of this book to cover all possible health policies and considerations, an overview of the most pertinent policies and issues is pro- vided. The authors address the likely sequelae of health care reform. Chapter 6, “Theories of Health Behavior,” by Sarah Gehlert and Sarah E. Bollinger, outlines fi ve key theories and meth- ods that can help guide social work practice and research in health care. Empirical evidence for their use in certain situations is provided.

Part II is titled Health Social Work Prac- tice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations. Although cases and questions confronted by social workers in health care vary widely, certain critical issues should always be con- sidered. The eight chapters in this part repre- sent critical issues that should be considered in approaching cases or pursuing the answers to health-care questions, even though in time they may not prove to be germane to those cases or questions. Failing to consider issues such as religion, sexuality, or substance use may lead to incomplete understandings of cases or consideration of health-care ques- tions. It was only after considering health beliefs, for instance, that Matsunaga and col- leagues (1996) were able to understand why native Hawaiian women did not participate in breast cancer screening despite their high rates of breast cancer.

Because individuals and families do not operate independently but rather as parts of communities, an overview of the relationships between health and community factors is in- cluded in Part II. In Chapter 7, “Community and Health,” Christopher Masi again reviews signifi cant evidence-based data and provides information about how knowledge about com- munity factors can be accessed and included in social work activities in health care. The complex interplay of physical and mental health is addressed in Chapter 8, “Physical and Mental Health: Interactions, Assessment, and Interventions.” The chapter, again prepared by Malitta Engstrom, carefully outlines how to assess for mental health concerns and re- views a variety of interventions. In Chapter 9,

“Social Work Practice and Disability Issues,” Rebecca Brashler again carefully frames so- cial work practice with individuals and groups with disabilities and provides suggestions for practice. Because communication is central to the effective provision of heath care as it changes through time, the revised chapter titled “Communication in Health Care” is in- cluded as Chapter 10 in Part II of this Hand- book. The chapter provides a basic framework for understanding the dynamics of health-care communication; reviews interventions for im- proving communication; considers the effect of culture, gender, race, and other salient factors on patient and provider communication; and provides guidelines for the use of interpreters. It also addresses the dynamics of health-care teams and social workers’ positions on teams.

In Chapter 11, “Religion, Spirituality, Health, and Social Work,” author Terry A. Wolfer, who is new to the Handbook, reviews the ways in which religion and spirituality af- fect health and individual and group responses to health care. Ways of incorporating religious and spiritual considerations into practice and policy are reviewed. Complementary and al- ternative treatments are reviewed in Chapter 12, “Developing a Shared Understanding: When Medical Patients Use Complementary and Alternative Approaches.” Author Penny B. Block provides information on the extent of al- ternative and complementary treatments in the United States and reasons for their use. She reviews a number of treatments and their his- tories and addresses the importance for social workers of being familiar with complementary and alternative techniques. Chapter 13, “Fami- lies, Health, and Illness,” again written by John S. Rolland, presents a framework for under- standing the interplay between family struc- ture and dynamics and health and addresses its implications for social work practice and policy in health care. Chapter 14, “Human Sexual Health,” addresses the relationship be- tween sexuality and health and discusses ways to incorporate sexual and other intimate con- siderations into practice and policy. Authors Les Gallo-Silver and David S. Bimbi make the point that sexual and other intimate issues are

fmatter.indd xvfmatter.indd xv 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

xvi Introduction

more likely to be faced by social workers in health care than in other areas of practice.

Part III, Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice, contains nine chapters by social workers with extensive practice and academic experience. Selecting the areas to include was diffi cult, and the list is not meant to be exhaus- tive. Our aim was to present a range of examples of good social work practice in suffi cient detail to provide a reasonable overview of social work practice in health care. The second edition of the Handbook includes a new chapter devoted to health social work practice with young pa- tients: Chapter 15, “Social Work With Children and Adolescents With Medical Conditions,” by seasoned authors Nancy Boyd Webb and Rose A. Bartone. Chapter 16, “Social Work With Older Adults in Health-Care Settings,” outlines the issues central to practice with older adults and the challenges faced by social workers. Sang E. Lee joins Sadhna Diwan and Shantha Balaswamy as an author of the revised chap- ter. Because substance use is widespread today and can negatively affect health and response to treatment, it is important that social workers consider the topic in practice and policy. The revised Chapter 17, titled “Substance Use Prob- lems in Health Social Work Practice,” again written by Malitta Engstrom, Colleen A. Mahoney, and Jeanne C. Marsh, carefully out- lines the importance of considering substance use and abuse and provides guidelines for in- corporation into practice and policy.

After providing background on end-stage renal disease and its psychosocial sequelae, in Chapter 18, “Nephrology Social Work,” Teri Browne reviews evidence-based social work interventions, policies and programs, and resources and organizations available to ne- phrology social workers. In Chapter 19, “On- cology Social Work,” Daniel S. Gardner joins Allison Werner-Lin as an author in the revised chapter. The chapter reviews psychosocial is- sues faced by patients with cancer and their families. Practice considerations are outlined and suggestions for interventions provided.

Issues of chronic illness are addressed by Wendy Auslander and Stacey Freedenthal in the revised and retitled Chapter 20, “Adher-

ence and Mental Health Issues in Chronic Disease: Diabetes, Heart Disease, and HIV/ AIDS.” Chronic conditions present a number of unique challenges to social workers, such as how to improve adherence to treatment recommendations. The authors outline these challenges and make suggestions for practice. Chapter 21, “Social Work and Genetics,” has been revised in light of myriad advances in our understanding of genetics and health that have occurred in the last several years. Kate Reed, from the National Coalition for Health Pro- fessional Education in Genetics, joins Allison Werner-Lin as an author of the chapter, which considers the role of social workers in helping patients and families learn and make decisions about genetic testing and cope with its results.

The management of pain in acute and chronic illness increasingly has become the domain of social workers in health care. Chapter 22, “Pain Management and Palliative Care,” orients readers to the effect of pain on behavior and functioning and reviews roles for social workers in pain management and palliative care teams. Terry Altilio, Shirley Otis-Green, Susan Hedlund, and Iris Cohen Fineberg are authors of the chapter. Finally, Chapter 23, “End-of-Life Care,” again by Yvette Colón, discusses how social workers can assist patients and families in dealing with these end-of-life issues effectively.

Our aim in preparing the Handbook of Health Social Work has been to provide a source of information that would help social workers to be active problem solvers rather than followers of routines and existing proto- cols. The book enables social work students to learn the foundations of practice and policy in health care (Part I), critical considerations in implementing practice and policy (Part II), and the ways in which social work is practiced in a number of arenas and with a number of health conditions (Part III).

We hope that the book will continue to be useful in professional education, allowing those already in practice to learn about issues such as pain management and alternative and comple- mentary medicine that they might not have been exposed to while in school or had the opportunity

fmatter.indd xvifmatter.indd xvi 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

Introduction xvii

to learn after graduation. It also is a valuable source of information on evidence-based prac- tice in a variety of areas of health care.

Social workers in health care today face a number of challenges, some new and some that have always been with the profession. We hope that readers will use the 23 chapters of the Handbook of Health Social Work as a set of tools to help them better address the health-care needs of the individuals, families, groups, com- munities, and societies with whom they work.

Sarah Gehlert St. Louis, Missouri

Teri Browne Columbia, South Carolina

REFERENCES

Matsunaga, D. S., Enos, R., Gotay, C. C., Banner, R. O., DeCambra, H., Hammond, O. W., . . . Tsark, J. (1996). Participatory research in a native Hawaiian community: The Wai’anae Cancer Research Project. Cancer, 78, 1582–1586.

Warnecke, R. B., Oh, A., Breen, N., Gehlert, S., Lurie, N., Rebbeck, T., . . . Patmios, G. (2008). Approaching health disparities from a population perspective: The NIH Centers for Population Health and Health Disparities. American Journal of Public Health, 98, 1608–1615.

fmatter.indd xviifmatter.indd xvii 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

fmatter.indd xviiifmatter.indd xviii 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

PART I

Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

JWBT514_ch01.indd 1JWBT514_ch01.indd 1 9/21/11 7:41 PM9/21/11 7:41 PM

JWBT514_ch01.indd 2JWBT514_ch01.indd 2 9/21/11 7:41 PM9/21/11 7:41 PM

3

1

Conceptual Underpinnings of Social Work in Health Care

SARAH GEHLERT

The writing of the fi rst edition of this text co- incided with the centennial of the hiring of the fi rst medical social worker in the United States, Garnet Pelton, who began working at Massachusetts General Hospital in 1905. The writing of the second edition fi ve years later comes at another key point for health social work, namely the passage of the Patient Protec- tion and Affordable Care Act in March 2010, which will radically increase health insurance coverage for U.S. citizens over the next de- cade. It seems an appropriate time to consider the history of social work in health care and to assess the degree to which the vision of its founders has been met in its fi rst 100 years. Ida Cannon (1952), the second social worker hired at Massachusetts General Hospital, whose ten- ure lasted for 40 years, wrote: “[B]asically, so- cial work, wherever and whenever practiced at its best, is a constantly changing activity, gradually building up guiding principles from accumulated knowledge yet changing in tech- niques. Attitudes change, too, in response to shifting social philosophies” (p. 9). How, if at all, have the guiding principles of social work in health care changed over the century?

This chapter focuses on the development of the profession from its roots in the 19th cen- tury to the present. This longitudinal examina- tion of the profession’s principles and activities should allow for a more complete and accurate view of the progression of principles through time than could have been achieved by sam- pling at points in time determined by historical events, such as the enactment of major health- care policies.

Chapter Objectives • Discuss the historical underpinnings of the

founding of the fi rst hospital social work department in the United States.

• Describe the forces and personalities responsible for the establishment of the fi rst hospital social work department in the United States.

• Determine how the guiding principles of social work in health care have changed from the time of the founding of the fi rst hospital social work department to the present time.

• Determine how the techniques and approaches of social work in health care have changed from the time of the founding of the fi rst hospital social work department to the present time.

Frequent references to other chapters in this book capture the current conceptual frame- work of social work in health care.

HISTORICAL FOUNDATION OF SOCIAL WORK IN HEALTH CARE

Social work in health care owes it origins to changes in (a) the demographics of the U.S. population during the 19th and early 20th cen- turies; (b) attitudes about how the sick should be treated, including where treatment should occur; and (c) attitudes toward the role of so- cial and psychological factors in health. These three closely related phenomena set the stage

JWBT514_ch01.indd 3JWBT514_ch01.indd 3 9/21/11 7:41 PM9/21/11 7:41 PM

4 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

for the emergence of the fi eld of social work in health care.

A number of events that began in the mid- 1800s led to massive numbers of people im- migrating to the United States. In all, 35 to 40 million Europeans immigrated between 1820 and 1924. The Gold Rush, which began in California in 1849, and the Homestead Act of 1862 added to the attractiveness of immi- gration (Rosenberg, 1967).

About 5.5 million Germans immigrated to the United States between 1816 and 1914 for economic and political reasons. Over 800,000 arrived in the 7-year period between 1866 and 1873, during the rule of Otto von Bismarck. The Potato Famine in Ireland in the 1840s re- sulted in the immigration of 2 million people during that decade and almost a million more in the next decade. Between 1820 and 1990, over 5 million Italians immigrated to the United States, mostly for economic reasons, with peak years between 1901 and 1920. A major infl ux of Polish immigrants occurred be- tween 1870 and 1913. Those arriving prior to 1890 came largely for economic reasons; those after came largely for economic and political reasons. Polish immigration peaked again in 1921, a year in which over half a million Pol- ish immigrants arrived in the United States. Two million Jews left Russia and Eastern Eu- ropean countries between 1880 and 1913 and traveled to the United States.

The United States struggled to adapt to the challenge of immigration. The Ellis Island Im- migration Station opened in 1892 to process the large number of immigrants entering the country. By 1907, over 1 million people per year were passing through Ellis Island. The massive waves of immigration presented new health-care challenges, especially in the north- eastern cities, where most of the new arrivals settled. Rosenberg (1967) wrote that 723,587 persons resided in New York City in 1865, 90% on the southern half of Manhattan Island alone. Over two thirds of the city’s popula- tion at the time lived in tenements. Accidents were common, sanitation was primitive, and food supplies were in poor condition by the time they reached the city. One in 5 infants in

New York City died prior to their fi rst birth- day, compared to 1 in 6 in London (Rosenberg, 1967). Adding to the challenge, the vast ma- jority of immigrants had very limited or no English language skills and lived in poverty. Immigrants brought with them a wide range of health-care beliefs and practices that differed from those predominant in the United States at the time.

In the late 1600s and early 1700s, people who were sick were cared for at home. A few hastily erected structures were built to house persons with contagious diseases dur- ing epidemics (O’Conner, 1976, p. 62). These structures operated in larger cities and were fi rst seen before the Revolutionary War. As the U.S. population grew, communities de- veloped almshouses to care for people who were physically or mentally ill, aged and ill, orphaned, or vagrant. Unlike the structures erected during epidemics, almshouses were built to operate continuously. The fi rst alms- house, which was founded in 1713 in Phila- delphia by William Penn, was open only to Quakers. A second almshouse was opened to the public in Philadelphia in 1728 with mon- ies obtained from the Provincial Assembly by the Philadelphia Overseers of the Poor. Other large cities followed, with New York open- ing the Poor House of the City of New York (later named Bellevue Hospital) in 1736 and New Orleans opening Saint John’s Hospital in 1737 (Commission on Hospital Care, 1947). Although called a hospital, Saint John’s was classifi ed as an almshouse because it primar- ily served people living in poverty who had nowhere else to go.

By the mid-1700s, people who became ill in almshouses were separated from other in- habitants. At fi rst they were housed on sepa- rate fl oors, in separate departments, or in other buildings of the almshouse. When these units increased in size, they branched off to form public hospitals independent of almshouses. Hospitals eventually became popular among persons of means, who for the fi rst time pre- ferred to be treated for illness by specialists outside the home and were willing to pay for the service.

JWBT514_ch01.indd 4JWBT514_ch01.indd 4 9/21/11 7:41 PM9/21/11 7:41 PM

Conceptual Underpinnings of Social Work in Health Care 5

A number of voluntary hospitals were es- tablished between 1751 and 1840 with various combinations of public and private funds and patients’ fees (O’Conner, 1976). The fi rst vol- untary hospital was founded in Philadelphia in 1751 with subscriptions gathered by Benjamin Franklin and Dr. Thomas Bond and funds from the Provincial General Assembly of Philadel- phia. The New York Hospital began admitting patients in 1791 and the Massachusetts Gen- eral Hospital in 1821. In 1817, the Quakers opened the fi rst mental hospital, which began admitting anyone needing care for mental ill- ness in 1834.

A third type of medical establishment, the dispensary, began to appear in the late 1700s. Dispensaries were independent of hospitals and fi nanced by bequests and voluntary sub- scriptions. Their original purpose was to dis- pense medications to ambulatory patients. In time, however, dispensaries hired physicians to visit patients in their homes. The fi rst four dispensaries were established in Philadelphia in 1786 (exclusively for Quakers), New York in 1795, Boston in 1796, and Baltimore in 1801.

19th-Century Efforts Toward Public Health Reform

The last half of the 19th century saw efforts to reform hospitals and dispensaries, many of which were led by women physicians. Dr. Elizabeth Blackwell, unable to fi nd em- ployment in hospitals because of her gender, established a dispensary for women and chil- dren in New York’s East Side in 1853. The East Side had seen a massive infl ux of immigrants from Europe and was becoming increasingly crowded. Blackwell’s dispensary provided home visits and by 1857 had secured a few hospital beds for its patients. The dispensary, which later became the New York Infi rmary for Women and Children, provided home visits to 334 African American and White American patients in 1865 (Cannon, 1952). The follow- ing year, Dr. Rebecca Cole, an African Ameri- can physician, was hired as a “sanitary visitor.” When visiting families, Cole discussed topics

such as hygiene and how to select and cook food and addressed issues of education and em- ployment. In 1890, Mrs. Robert Hoe provided funds to the New York Infi rmary for Women and Children to employ a full-time home visitor to work under the direction of Dr. Annie Daniels. Daniels kept records of family size, income, and living expenses in the manner of social workers of the time, such as Jane Addams, who founded Hull House in Chicago in 1889.

The fi rst medical resident to work with Dr. Blackwell in New York, Marie Zakrzewska, moved to Boston and in 1859 became the fi rst professor of obstetrics and gynecology at the New England Female Medical College. Dr. Zakrzewska established a dispensary and 10-bed ward in Boston in 1862, the New Eng- land Hospital for Women and Children. It was the fi rst hospital in Boston and the second in the United States (after the New York Dispen- sary for Women and Children) to be run by women physicians and surgeons. As had the New York Dispensary for Women and Chil- dren, the New England Hospital for Women and Children featured home visiting, with increased attention to social conditions. For many years, home visits were part of the edu- cation of nurses and physicians in training.

In 1890, Dr. Henry Dwight Chapin, a pe- diatrician who lectured at the New York Post- graduate Hospital and the Women’s Medical College of the New York Infi rmary for Women and Children, established a program in which volunteers visited the homes of ill children to report on conditions and to ensure that medi- cal instructions had been understood and im- plemented. In 1894, he appointed a woman physician to do the job but soon replaced her with a nurse. Chapin’s efforts led to a foster- care home for ill and convalescing children whose parents were unable to care for them adequately (Romanofsky, 1976). He founded the Speedwell Society in 1902 to encourage foster care. The Speedwell Society would have ties to the social work departments later estab- lished in New York hospitals.

A close partnership between the Johns Hopkins Hospital and Baltimore’s Charity Organization Society at the turn of the 20th

JWBT514_ch01.indd 5JWBT514_ch01.indd 5 9/21/11 7:41 PM9/21/11 7:41 PM

6 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

century served as a breeding ground for ideas about how to merge social work and medi- cine. Four people involved in these discus- sions were instrumental to the establishment of formal social work services in hospitals. Mary Richmond, Mary Wilcox Glenn, Jeffrey Brackett, and Dr. John Glenn, who became the director of the Russell Sage Foundation, were actively involved in the application of social work to medicine.

Hospital Almoners in London

The fi rst social worker, called a hospital almoner, was hired by the Royal Free Hospital in London in 1895. This occurred when the Royal Free Hospital came together with the London Charity Organization Society through Charles Loch. Loch was a very religious man who had served in the Secretarial Depart- ment of the Royal College of Surgeons for three years. He was appointed secretary of the London Charity Organization in 1875 and brought with him a strong interest in the so- cial aspects of health. While a member of the Medical Committee of the Charity Organiza- tion Society, Loch addressed a growing con- cern that patients might be misrepresenting their situations to receive free care. In 1874, the Royal Free Hospital asked the Charity Organization Society to screen patients to de- termine how many were indeed poor. They found only 36% to be truly eligible for ser- vices. Loch thought that individuals request- ing care should be screened by “a competent person of education and refi nement who could consider the position and circumstances of the patients” (Cannon, 1952, p. 13). Loch fought for many years to have an almoner appointed. He addressed the Provident Medical Associa- tion in 1885 and was called to testify before a committee of the House of Lords in 1891. In 1895, Mary Stewart was hired to be the fi rst social almoner at the Royal Free Hospital. Prior to assuming the position, Stewart had worked for many years for the London Char- ity Organization Society. She was stationed at its entrance because her principal function at the hospital was to review applications for

admission to the hospital’s dispensary and ac- cept those that were deemed suitable for care. Her secondary duties were to refer patients for services and determine who should be served at dispensaries (Cannon, 1952).

Stewart was given 3 months of initial fund- ing by the London Charity Organization So- ciety. Although by all accounts her work was considered productive, the Charity Organiza- tion Society refused to renew her contract until the Royal Free Hospital agreed to pay at least part of her salary. Ultimately, two of the hospi- tal’s physicians agreed to pay half of Stewart’s salary for a year, and the Charity Organization Society covered the other half. From that point on, social almoners were part of hospitals in England. By 1905, seven other hospitals had hired almoners.

In 1906, the Hospital Almoners’ Council (later the Institute of Hospital Almoners) took over the training of almoners. The Institute for Hospital Almoners was responsible for the ex- pansion of the almoner’s repertoire to include functions such as prevention of illness. The fi rst years of its operation saw the develop- ment of classes for prospective fathers, a hos- tel for young women with socially transmitted diseases, and other programs (Cannon, 1952).

First Social Service Department in the United States

Garnet Pelton began work as a social worker in the dispensary of the Massachusetts Gen- eral Hospital 10 years after Mary Stewart was fi rst hired to work at the Royal Free Hospital in London. Ida Cannon, who replaced Pelton after she became ill six months into her ten- ure and who held the position for 40 years, described “a special bond of fellowship be- tween the English almoners and the medical social workers of our country” (Cannon, 1952, p. 20). She also described her own 1907 visit with Anne Cummins, an almoner at London’s St. Thomas Hospital.

Garnet Pelton, Ida Cannon, and Dr. Richard Cabot were central to the establishment of the social work department at Massachusetts Gen- eral Hospital. Relatively little has been written

JWBT514_ch01.indd 6JWBT514_ch01.indd 6 9/21/11 7:41 PM9/21/11 7:41 PM

Conceptual Underpinnings of Social Work in Health Care 7

about Pelton or her short tenure at the hospi- tal. Cannon (1952) briefl y described Pelton’s nurse’s training at Massachusetts General Hospital and her contribution to the Denison House Settlement. While at the settlement, she brought Syrian immigrants from her South End Boston neighborhood to the hospital for treatment. Pelton was hired by Cabot to work at Massachusetts General Hospital and began on October 2, 1905. She worked from a desk located in a corner of the corridor of the outpa- tient clinic at Massachusetts General Hospital and resigned after six months when she devel- oped tuberculosis. The poor received treatment for tuberculosis in the outpatient department because they could not afford sanitarium treat- ment. There is some question about whether Pelton contracted tuberculosis through her work in the outpatient department. At any rate, Cabot arranged for her treatment at Saranac Lake, New York, and later at Asheville, North Carolina.

Pelton was succeeded by Ida Cannon, who published two books and several reports on medical social work and about whom a fair amount of biographical information is avail- able. Cannon was born in Milwaukee into a family of means. She was trained as a nurse at the City and County Hospital of St. Paul and worked as a nurse for 2 years. She then stud- ied sociology at the University of Minnesota, where she heard a lecture by Jane Addams and became interested in social work. She worked as a visiting nurse for the St. Paul Associated Charities for three years prior to enrolling in Simmons College of Social Work. Cannon met Richard Cabot through her older brother, a Harvard-educated physiologist, as Cabot was organizing social services at Massachusetts Hospital. She was hired to replace Pelton in 1906, began working full time after graduat- ing from Simmons College in 1907, and was named the fi rst chief of the Social Service De- partment in 1914. She retired from Massachu- setts General Hospital in 1945.

Dr. Richard Cabot was an especially pro- lifi c writer and has himself been the subject of scholarship over the years (see, e.g., Dodds, 1993; O’Brien, 1985). Cabot was a Harvard-

educated physician who had a great deal to do with the establishment of social work and other helping professions in U.S. hospitals. He was active professionally from the 1890s through most of the 1930s, a time when pro- fessions were being defi ned (see, e.g., Flexner, 1910) and medicine was the standard for what it meant to be professional.

Cabot’s paternal grandfather, Samuel (1784 to 1863), made his fortune in trading after fi rst going to sea at 19 years of age. Samuel Cabot married Eliza Perkins, daughter of Boston’s most successful trader, and eventually took over his father-in-law’s fi rm. He is described as a practical man who believed primarily in action and hard work and favored commerce over culture (Evison, 1995).

Cabot’s father, James (1821 to 1903), stud- ied philosophy in Europe, trained as a lawyer, taught philosophy at Harvard, and was a bi- ographer and friend of Ralph Waldo Emerson. He considered himself a transcendentalist, holding that, “the transcendental included whatever lay beyond the stock notions and traditional beliefs to which adherence was ex- pected because they were accepted by sensible persons” (Cabot, 1887, p. 249). The transcen- dentalists questioned much of the commer- cialism of their parents’ generation and were particularly critical of slavery. The Civil War, which began when James Elliott Cabot was 40 years old, was waged in part due to the sentiments of this generation. Cabot’s mother, Elizabeth, bore most of the responsibility of raising the couple’s seven sons and shared with her husband the transcendentalist’s ques- tioning of stock notions and traditional beliefs. Elizabeth Cabot said of women: “[I]t seems to me that very few of us have enough mental occupation. We ought to have some intellec- tual life apart from the problems of educa- tion and housekeeping or even the interests of society” (Cabot, 1869, p. 45). O’Brien de- scribes Elizabeth Cabot as “warmly maternal and deeply religious” and “tirelessly philan- thropic” (O’Brien, 1985, p. 536).

The Civil War demoralized the nation and spawned a new conservatism and materialism. The publication of The Origin of the Species by

JWBT514_ch01.indd 7JWBT514_ch01.indd 7 9/21/11 7:41 PM9/21/11 7:41 PM

8 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

Charles Darwin in 1859 (1936), which brought an appreciation of the scientifi c method, and growing concern about the number of immi- grants arriving in the country added to a shift to realism from the idealism of James Elliott Cabot’s generation. In the wave of social Dar- winism that ensued, charity was seen as naive and potentially harmful to its recipients. It was into this posttranscendentalist atmosphere that Richard Cabot was born in 1868.

The tension between his generation and that of his parents shaped Richard Cabot’s vision. He took a radical centrist position based in philo- sophical pragmatism, taking two opposing views, and helped to locate a middle ground between them. Rather than considering either side as right or wrong, he held that a greater truth could emerge through creating a dialogue between the two sides. Throughout his career, Cabot saw himself as an interpreter or translator, able to fi nd the middle ground between extremes.

Cabot fi rst studied philosophy at Harvard and then switched to medicine. He rejected philosophers who observed rather than acted and for that reason was drawn to the philoso- phy of John Dewey. Evison (1995), a Cabot biographer, writes: “[A]ction drew him; Jane Addams and Teddy Roosevelt appealed to him because they did something” (p. 30). Cabot held that knowledge was gained through prob- lem solving, even when hypotheses were not supported. Like Addams before him, he be- lieved that people can learn from failure.

Cabot’s senior thesis used epidemiologic methods to examine the effi cacy of Christian Science healing (Dodds, 1993). By the time he had completed medical school in 1892, the germ theory of the 1870s and 1880s had taken hold, and the roles of technology and labora- tory analysis had gained in salience. Cabot initially followed the trend by completing postgraduate training in laboratory research and a Dalton Research Fellowship in hematol- ogy. He turned down an appointment as the fi rst bacteriologist at Massachusetts General Hospital and in 1898, four years after com- pleting his fellowship, accepted a much less prestigious appointment in the outpatient de- partment.

Patients were treated in the outpatient de- partment at Massachusetts General Hospital rather than in the wards when their cases were considered uninteresting or hopeless (Evison, 1995). Because no treatment existed for condi- tions such as tuberculosis, typhus, and diabe- tes, patients with these conditions usually were treated in the outpatient department, especially if they were poor. Medicines prescribed were largely analgesic. (Antibiotics were not devel- oped until the 1940s.) Many patients were im- migrants who presented with language barriers and infectious diseases such as typhus. Add- ing to the bleakness of the situation was the depression of 1893, the worst that had been experienced to that date.

Cabot described the speed with which physicians saw patients when he fi rst arrived in the outpatient department: Referred to by some physicians as “running off the clinic” (Evison, 1995, p. 183), a physician pulled a bell to signal a patient to enter the room. The physician would shout his questions while the patient was still moving and have a prescrip- tion written by the time the patient arrived at his desk. He would then pull the bell for the next patient.

Cabot began to see that social and mental problems often underlaid physical problems and that purely physical affl ictions were rare (Cabot, 1915). He held that it was not possible to restore patients to health without consid- ering what he called the nonsomatic factors, such as living conditions. He described one case in this way:

One morning as I was working in the out- patient department, I had a series of knotty human problems come before me . . . that morning I happened to wake to the fact that the series of people that came to me had pretty much wasted their time. I had fi rst of all to deal with a case of diabetes. That is a disease in which medicine can accomplish practically nothing, but in which diet can accomplish a great deal. We had worked out very minutely a diet that should be given such patients. We had it printed upon slips which were made up in pads so that we could tear off a slip from one of these pads and give the patient the best

JWBT514_ch01.indd 8JWBT514_ch01.indd 8 9/21/11 7:41 PM9/21/11 7:41 PM

Conceptual Underpinnings of Social Work in Health Care 9

that was known about diabetes in short com- pass. I remember tearing off a slip from this pad and handing it to the patient, feel- ing satisfaction that we had all these ready so that the patient need not remember any- thing. . . . The woman to whom it had been given did not seem satisfi ed. I asked her what was the matter. . . . She looked it over and among the things that she could eat she saw asparagus, Brussels sprouts, and one or two other things, and she called my attention to the fact that there was no possibility of her buying these things. We had, in other words, asked her to do things that she could by no possibility do. (Cabot, 1911, pp. 308–309)

Cabot’s exposure to social work came fi rst from his relationship with Jane Addams. In 1887, he took a course at Harvard entitled “Ethi- cal Theories and Social Reform” from Francis Greenwood Peabody. Many who took the course went on to work for the Boston Children’s Aid Society, as did Cabot when he became a director there in 1896. It was there that he was exposed to the case conference approach.

Cabot viewed the relationship between medicine and social work from his radical cen- trist perspective. He thought that each profes- sion possessed the element that the other most needed. For medicine, this was empiricism, and for social work, it was breadth. Cabot thought physicians’ enthusiastic acceptance of empiricism had made them far too narrow in scope, ignoring social and psychological fac- tors in health. Social workers possessed the breadth that physicians lacked but relied too heavily on good intentions. They needed to become more scientifi c and systematic to en- sure that their methods were effective and to develop a theoretical base for their work. Each profession could gain from association with the other.

Cabot set about reforming the treatment process in the outpatient clinic. He hired Garnet Pelton to fulfi ll three functions: (1) to critique while helping to socialize medicine, (2) to act as a translator between the physi- cian and patient and family, and (3) to provide information on social and mental factors. Cabot described the critical role by saying

[S]he will not be there primarily as a critic, but nevertheless she will be far better than the average critic because she will be part of the institution and will be criticism from the inside, which I think is always the most valuable kind. (Cabot, 1912, pp. 51–52)

Pelton kept records of every case, which were used for instruction and to identify trends that would be published in regular reports. Prior to Pelton, no records of patient visits to the out- patient department were kept at Massachusetts Hospital.

Cabot viewed social workers as translators of medical information to patients and families in a way that they could understand. He said,

[T]he social worker . . . can reassure patients as to the kind of things that are being done and are going to be done with them. There is no one else who explains; there is no other person in the hospital whose chief business is to explain things. (Cabot, 1912, p. 50)

Cabot also saw social workers as trans- lators of information about patients and families to physicians. Social work’s role in providing social and psychological informa- tion to physicians is described in a quote from Ida Cannon:

While she must have an understanding of the patient’s physical condition, the physical condition is only one aspect of the patient to which she must take account. As the physi- cian sees the disease organ not isolated but as possibly affecting the whole body, so the hospital social worker sees the patient not merely as an isolated, unfortunate person occupying a hospital bed, but as a member belonging to a family or community group that is altered because of his ill health. Physi- cian and nurse seek to strengthen the general physical state of the patient so that he can combat his disease. The social worker seeks to remove those obstacles, either in the pa- tient’s surroundings or in his mental attitude, that interfere with successful treatment, thus freeing the patient to aid in his own recovery. (Cannon, 1923, pp. 14–15)

Cabot thought that social work could best fulfi ll this role because nurses had “lost their claim

JWBT514_ch01.indd 9JWBT514_ch01.indd 9 9/21/11 7:41 PM9/21/11 7:41 PM

10 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

to be a profession by allowing themselves to become mere implementers of doctor’s or- ders” (Evison, 1995, p. 220). He defi ned social work’s expertise as diagnosis and “treatment of character in diffi culties,” which he saw as encompassing expertise in mental health.

The hospital did not initially support Pelton’s hiring, so Cabot paid her salary with his own funds. To convince the hospital’s su- perintendent, Frederic Washburn, that Pelton was a good addition, Cabot set about docu- menting that her hiring was cost effective. He calculated that the hospital had spent $120 on a baby with gastrointestinal problems whose mother brought her to the hospital on four oc- casions over a short period of time because the family was unable to provide the nutrients prescribed for her. Cabot did not want admin- istrators to view social work’s primary role as preventing misuse of hospital services but in- stead to save money by helping to make treat- ment more effective. He viewed medical social workers as distinct from hospital almoners.

Ida Cannon took over for Garnet Pelton in 1906 when Pelton went to Saranac Lake, New York, to receive treatment for pulmonary tu- berculosis. Cannon was named the fi rst chief of social work in 1914. She shared status with the chief of surgery and the chief of medicine. Cannon developed training programs for so- cial workers at Massachusetts General Hos- pital, including medical education. Cannon hired Harriett Bartlett to be the fi rst educa- tional director in the Social Work Department. Other programs begun during her tenure in- cluded a low-cost lunch counter for patients and staff; a committee to investigate the social correlates of tuberculosis, which produced the fi rst comprehensive analysis of tuberculosis in the United States; interdisciplinary medical rounds with social workers; and clay model- ing classes for psychiatric patients. Cannon and Cabot together developed systems for evaluating the effectiveness of social work in- terventions and included this information in medical records.

Cannon did not take the same radical views of hospital social work that were espoused by Pelton and Cabot, with whom she clashed

often during their fi rst years of working to- gether. Cannon thought social workers should accommodate hospital mechanisms rather than being critics or reformers of medicine, as Cabot had advocated. Nevertheless, the two worked together until Cabot accepted a commission of major in the Medical Reserve Corps in 1917 during World War I. He re- turned to the outpatient department of Massa- chusetts General Hospital in 1918, but he then left to chair Harvard’s Department of Social Ethics in 1919. Shortly before he left the hos- pital, its board of directors voted to make the Social Service Department a permanent part of the hospital and to cover the full cost of its functioning. Prior to that, Cabot had covered the cost of up to 13 social workers with his personal funds.

Ida Cannon was named director of the new Social Work Department in 1919. By the time she retired from Massachusetts General Hos- pital in 1945, the hospital employed 31 social workers. Several former social workers at Mas- sachusetts General Hospital went on to direct departments in other hospitals, such as Mary Antoinette Cannon (the University Hospital of Philadelphia) and Ruth T. Boretti (Strong Me- morial Hospital of the University of Rochester School of Medicine and Dentistry).

GROWTH OF HOSPITAL SOCIAL WORK DEPARTMENTS

In 1961, Bartlett described the course of so- cial work in health care as spiraling, “in which periods of uncertainty and fl uidity alternated with those of clarity and control” (p. 15). She said that in its fi rst 30 years, growth was lin- ear as social work spread from one hospital to another. Methods were simple because social work in hospitals “almost alone carried the re- sponsibility for bringing the social viewpoint into the hospital.”

The success achieved at Massachusetts General Hospital eventually drew the attention of the American Hospital Association and the American Medical Association. Johns Hopkins

JWBT514_ch01.indd 10JWBT514_ch01.indd 10 9/21/11 7:41 PM9/21/11 7:41 PM

Conceptual Underpinnings of Social Work in Health Care 11

Hospital hired Helen B. Pendleton, who had worked with the Charity Organization Society as its fi rst social worker in 1907. As had been the case with Garnet Pelton at Massachusetts General Hospital, Pendleton remained on the job for only a few months. The position re- mained vacant for four months, then she was replaced by a graduate nurse. At Johns Hop- kins, social workers initially were housed in a room that was also used for storing surgical supplies. They were not allowed on the wards, which were controlled by nurses (Nacman, 1990). Social workers, however, controlled access to medical records by physicians and nurses and had to approve all free medical care and prescriptions for medicine that was to last longer than one week (Brogen, 1964). The de- partment prospered, as had the department at Massachusetts General Hospital, and by 1931 had a staff of 31.

Garnet Pelton completed a survey of so- cial service in hospitals in the United States in 1911 at the behest of John M. Glenn, the fi rst director of the Russell Sage Foundation and a strong proponent of social work in health care. She was able to locate 44 social service departments in 14 cities, 17 of which were in New York City alone. These departments pro- vided a range of services, all focused on the provision of assistance to the patient (Cannon, 1952).

New York City, which housed nearly 40% of the country’s hospital social service depart- ments, organized the fi eld’s fi rst conference in 1912, which was called the New York Confer- ence on Hospital Social Work. The conference was held regularly between 1912 and 1933. A quarterly report entitled Hospital Social Service documented conference fi ndings and highlighted the progress of various hospital so- cial service departments.

By 1913, 200 U.S. hospitals had social workers. Ruth Emerson, who left Massachu- setts General Hospital in 1918, established the social service department at the University of Chicago. Edith M. Baker, who left Massachu- setts General Hospital in 1923, established the social service department at Washington Uni- versity in St. Louis.

PROFESSIONALIZATION OF THE FIELD

The fi rst training course in medical social work was held in 1912. Cannon (1932) wrote that the growth of such courses was slow and lacked coordination until 1918, when the American Association of Hospital Social Workers was established in Kansas City. The association, which employed an educational secretary, had a twofold purpose: to foster and coordinate the training of social workers in hospitals and to enhance communication between schools of social work and practitioners. Although the American Association of Hospital Social Workers was the fi rst national organization of social workers in health care, it was preceded by local organizations in St. Louis, Boston, Philadelphia, Milwaukee, and New York. Mary A. Stites, the author of History of the Ameri- can Association of Medical Social Workers (1955) says that prior to the establishment of the American Association of Hospital Social Workers, medical social workers in health care for some time had congregated at meetings of the National Conference of Social Work (for- mally called the National Conference of Chari- ties and Corrections). The burning question at the fi rst meeting of the American Association of Hospital Social Workers in 1918 was whether the group should orient more closely with so- cial work or medicine. Eight of the 30 women who signed the association’s fi rst constitution were graduate nurses.

The American Association of Hospital So- cial Workers published a study of 1,000 cases from 60 hospital social work departments in 1928. According to the report:

The social worker’s major contributions to medical care, gauged by frequency of perfor- mance, are: (1) the securing of information to enable an adequate understanding of the general health problem of the patient; (2) in- terpretation of the patient’s health problem to himself, his family and community welfare agencies; and (3) the mobilizing of measures for the relief of the patient and his associates. Briefl y then, the basic practices of hospital

JWBT514_ch01.indd 11JWBT514_ch01.indd 11 9/21/11 7:41 PM9/21/11 7:41 PM

12 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

social work exhibited in the study under con- sideration can be described as discovery of the relevant social factors in the health prob- lems of particular patients and infl uencing these factors in such ways as to further the patient’s medical care. (p. 28)

This description does not differ appreciably from the way that hospital social work was conceptualized by Cannon and Cabot at Mas- sachusetts General Hospital.

A survey of schools of social work pub- lished in 1929 (Cannon, 1932) listed 10 schools that offered formal courses in medical social work and 18 that were in the process of plan- ning medical social work curriculum:

1. Washington University

2. University of Chicago

3. New York School of Social Work

4. Tulane University

5. University of Indiana

6. University of Missouri

7. Simmons College

8. Western Reserve University

9. Pennsylvania School of Social and Health Work

10. National Catholic School of Social Work

In all, medical social work was considered to be graduate-level work. A second survey that year was sent to social service department heads in hospitals asking them to query their workers about their training and experience. Of the 596 respondents, 70% had taken at least one course in general social work, and 48% of those had received a diploma or certifi cate between 1899 and 1930. Interestingly, 38% of respondents had completed at least one course in nursing, and 86% of those had received a certifi cate or diploma in nursing. The survey listed six activities of medical social workers:

1. Medical social case management

2. Securing data

3. Health teaching

4. Follow-up

5. Adjustment of rates

6. Medical extension of transfer to convales- cent home, public health agency, or medical institution

In 1954, the year before the American As- sociation of Medical Social Workers merged with six other specialty organizations to form the National Association of Social Work- ers, 2,500 people attended its annual meet- ing. The American Association of Medical Social Workers was the largest of all social work membership organizations. The current major specialty organization for social work- ers in health care on the national level, the Society for Leadership in Health Care, boasts 700 members (Society for Social Work Lead- ership in Health Care, 2011, January 2). This organization, which changed its name from the Society for Social Work Administrators in Health Care in the 1990s and is affi liated with the American Hospital Association, was founded in 1965. Other current national or- ganizations include the American Network of Home Health Care Social Workers, the Asso- ciation of Oncology Social Work, the Council of Nephrology Social Workers, the National Association of Perinatal Social Workers, and the Society for Transplant Social Workers.

DEFINING MEDICAL SOCIAL WORK

By 1934, the American Association of Medi- cal Social Workers (the American Associa- tion of Hospital Social Workers changed its name that year) published a report prepared by Harriet Bartlett. The report defi ned medical social work as a specifi c form of social case work that focuses on the relationship between disease and social maladjustment. Bartlett wrote, “[I]t is an important part of the social worker’s function to concern herself with the social problems arising directly out of the na- ture of the medical treatment. In this way, she facilitates and extends the medical treatment” (p. 99). Emphasis was placed on surmounting social impediments to health, “providing some occupation or experience for the person jolted

JWBT514_ch01.indd 12JWBT514_ch01.indd 12 9/21/11 7:41 PM9/21/11 7:41 PM

Conceptual Underpinnings of Social Work in Health Care 13

out of his regular plan of life by chronic dis- ease, to offset what he has lost and to make him feel that he has still a useful place in the world” (p. 99).

The 1934 report highlighted a series of problems as requiring particular attention. They were: (a) the integration of psychologi- cal concepts, defi ned in part as needing to know more about human motivation in gen- eral and in relation to illness; (b) problems of functional and mental disease, specifi cally the need to integrate the study of the organism with that of the personality; and (c) problems of methods of thinking, which had to do with balancing the study of personality with a con- sideration of the person in his social situation.

This competition for attention between personality and social environment gained salience with the advent of psychiatry and psychoanalysis in the United States. Although popular in Europe in the 1880s and 1890s, mental treatment in hospitals did not take hold in the United States at fi rst. Courses in psycho- therapy began appearing in medical schools in 1907, and Freud made his fi rst tour of the United States two years later.

The emergence of psychiatry and psycho- analysis into medicine had two major effects on social work in health care. First, psychia- try’s emergence into medicine is tied to the appearance of other professionals in hospi- tals, such as psychologists and social scien- tists. Their presence meant that the social and mental domains of health were no longer ex- clusive to social work and that medical social work for the fi rst time had signifi cant competi- tion for a role in health care.

A second effect of psychiatry’s emergence into medicine was the impact of psychoana- lytic theory on how social workers in health care approached cases, namely, from a more person-centered perspective. The confusion between a focus on personality and on social environment remained after psychiatric social work separated from medical social work. The separation often is attributed to 1919, when Smith College developed a course for psy- chiatric aides attached to the U.S. Army dur- ing World War I (Grinker, MacGregor, Selan,

Klein, & Kohrman, 1961), although the Psy- chiatric Social Service Department was not established at Massachusetts General Hospital until 1930. Mary Jarrett (1919), the associate director of the Smith College Training School for Social Work, argued for a more psychiatric approach to case work in her address to the Conference of Social Work in 1919:

One by-product of the psychiatric point of view in social case work is worth consid- eration in these days of overworked social workers, that is, the greater ease in work that it gives the social worker. The strain of dealing with unknown quantities is perhaps the greatest cause of fatigue in our work. . . . More exact knowledge of personalities with which we are dealing not only saves the worker worry and strain but also releases energy which can be applied to treatment. . . . Another result is that impatience is almost entirely eliminated. No time is wasted upon annoyance or indignation with the uncoop- erative housewife, the persistent liar, the re- peatedly delinquent girl. . . . I know of social workers who looked with suspicion upon the careful preliminary study of personal- ity, because they feared that all the worker’s interest might go into the analysis, and that treatment might be neglected. I believe that fear has been something of a bugaboo in so- cial work. (p. 592)

The implication of Jarrett’s address is that a focus on personality allows the social worker to get at the client’s problem with ease, thus saving time for treatment.

Another possible source of social work’s at- traction to psychoanalytic theory was Abraham Flexner’s 1915 address to the National Con- ference of Charities and Corrections, in which he said that social work was not a profession. Flexner defi ned professions as: (a) involving essentially intellectual operations, (b) having large individual responsibility, (c) deriving their raw material from science and learning, (d) working up their material to a practical and defi nite end, (e) possessing educationally communicable techniques, (f) tending to self- organization, and (g) becoming increasingly altruistic in motivation. He said that although

JWBT514_ch01.indd 13JWBT514_ch01.indd 13 9/21/11 7:41 PM9/21/11 7:41 PM

14 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

social work had a professional spirit, it failed to meet all of the criteria for a profession be- cause its members did not have a great deal of individual responsibility and lacked a written body of knowledge and educationally com- municable techniques. Flexner’s address had a profound effect on the fi eld. Some social workers viewed medicine as a model profes- sion and an intrapersonal approach as more professional than one focused on social and environmental factors.

Nacman (1990) notes that, by the 1940s, psychosocial information was increasingly being used by medical social workers to make medical diagnoses and treatment plans. This was in contrast to its use, in Ida Cannon’s words, “to remove those obstacles, either in the patient’s surroundings or in his mental attitude, that interfere with success- ful treatment, thus freeing the patient to aid in his own recovery” (1923, pp. 14–15). The work of Helen Harris Perlman countered the tendency to use information primarily to make medical diagnoses and plans by em- phasizing social science concepts over psy- choanalytic ones and refocusing on society and environment. A focus on environment was reinforced in the 1950s by the commu- nity mental health and public health move- ments (see Chapter 4 of this text) and the civil rights movement of the 1960s.

SOCIAL WORK IN HEALTH CARE: BEYOND THE HOSPITAL

After World War II and the passage of the Social Security Act, social work in health care began to branch out from its hospital base. Social work programs were established in the U.S. Army and Navy and the Veter- ans Administration. The advent in the mid- 1960s of Medicare and Medicaid, and titles XVIII and XIX of the Social Security Act, provided coverage for people who might otherwise not have been treated. These two programs further increased the need for so- cial work services.

The number of social workers in health care increased with the variety of work settings. Between 1960 and 1970, the number of social workers in health care nearly doubled (Bracht, 1974). By 1971, social workers were employed in a wide range of settings. A Medicare report from that year reported 11,576 social workers in 6,935 participating hospitals, 2,759 in 4,829 extended-care facilities, and 316 social workers in 2,410 home health agencies (U.S. Department of Health, Education, and Welfare, 1976). Social workers also could be found in state and local health departments and in federal agencies, such as the Department of Defense. Social workers entered new health-care arenas, such as preven- tive and emergency services. Techniques were added to the social work repertoire to address these new settings and arenas. Interventions ap- peared based on behavior, cognitive, family sys- tems, crisis, and group work theories. Because health costs were growing at an alarming rate, the federal government began to institute mea- sures to control costs. In 1967, utilization review measures were enacted that required Medicare providers to demonstrate that care was neces- sary and that its costs were reasonable. In 1972, Congress enacted the Peer Standards Review Act, which required the peer review of medical billing to ensure that services had been utilized appropriately.

Neither utilization review nor peer stan- dards review proved as effective as was hoped. Another attempt to control costs took its cues from a long history of prepaid health-care ar- rangements provided to workers around the country, the fi rst of which was a rural farm- ers’ cooperative in Elk City, Oklahoma, in 1929. The best known of these arrangements was the Kaiser Permanente Health Plan. In 1973, the Health Maintenance Organization (HMO) Act was passed by the Nixon admin- istration. The act authorized $375 million in federal grants to develop HMOs. Initially, em- ployers saw HMOs as a less expensive way of providing insurance to their employees. In recent years, state governments have used managed care in their Medicaid programs. By 1993, 70% of Americans with health insurance were enrolled in some form of managed care.

JWBT514_ch01.indd 14JWBT514_ch01.indd 14 9/21/11 7:41 PM9/21/11 7:41 PM

Conceptual Underpinnings of Social Work in Health Care 15

Cornelius (1994) distills the perils of managed care for social workers by saying that

the social worker becomes an agent of man- aged care and agrees to serve the public within the corporate guidelines and not nec- essarily according to the assessed needs of the client. . . . If the social worker practices outside the protocols, . . . the client is denied coverage and the social worker is denied re- imbursement; money becomes the carrot and the stick. (p. 52)

Another major cost containment effort had a profound effect on hospital care. The pro- spective payment system, based on a set of 500 diagnostic-related groups (DRGs), each with its own specifi c payment rate, was instituted in 1983 to replace traditional retrospective re- imbursement for hospital care. The rates were developed based on the nature of the illness, accepted treatment procedures, whether the hospital was a teaching facility, local wage scales, and the hospital’s location (Reamer, 1985, p. 86). This standardization was in- tended to provide an incentive for hospitals to become more effi cient.

Under DRGs, patients entered the hospital sicker and left sooner (Dobrof, 1991). This impacted hospital social work services in two major ways:

1. Hospitalization was seen as a failure of the system, and every effort was made to avoid it; thus, those who were admitted were quite ill.

2. Because hospitals were paid a specifi ed rate, it was in their best interests to keep stays as short as possible. Because patients entered more ill and stayed for a shorter time, less comprehensive care could be pro- vided in hospitals.

Although there is debate about the extent to which social workers were cut from hospitals (see, e.g., Coulton, 1988), many social work forces in hospitals were downsized or recon- fi gured during this period. Some were merged with other departments, others self-governed, and, in other cases, social workers and other

professionals were organized by service rather than by department.

It is clear that hospital social workers found less opportunity to spend time with patients because patients were there for less time, and much of the social worker’s time was taken by helping to prepare sicker patients and their families for recuperation at home or in other facilities, such as extended-care facilities. Do- brof (1991) describes “hospital-based social workers confronting larger caseloads of sicker patients with increased need for home care ser- vices or placement in nursing homes” (p. 44).

Both HMOs and DRGs affected how so- cial workers in health care practiced. HMOs restricted social workers’ ability to practice based on their own assessment of needs. DRGs limited the time that social workers in hospi- tals had to work with patients and forced an emphasis on discharge planning. This limited social workers’ ability to perform in the man- ner outlined by its founders, such as Bartlett, “to concern herself with the social problems arising directly out of the nature of medical treatment” (1934, p. 99), or Cannon, “to re- move those obstacles . . . that interfere with suc- cessful treatment” (1923, pp. 14–15).

New techniques have been developed in response to time limits on treatment. Task- centered case work (Reid & Epstein, 1972) emphasizes the goals of treatment, and a num- ber of brief treatment techniques have been developed (see, e.g., Mailick, 1990). Social workers have helped to adapt intervention the- ories for use in health settings, such as stress inoculation from cognitive theory (see, e.g., Blythe & Erdahl, 1986).

Claiborne and Vandenburgh (2001) defi ne a new role for social workers as disease manag- ers. As patients live longer with disease con- ditions or survive conditions once considered fatal, such as cancer, issues of quality of life arise. Survivors of cancer, previously expect- ing to die, need assistance with learning how to live. Those with long-term health conditions, such as rheumatoid arthritis, require guidance on how to live a full life with their condition. As a rule, disease management entails “a team of professionals that integrates and coordinates

JWBT514_ch01.indd 15JWBT514_ch01.indd 15 9/21/11 7:41 PM9/21/11 7:41 PM

16 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

care across an array of services to maintain op- timal patient functioning and quality of life” (Claiborne & Vandenburgh, 2001, p. 220). These teams often operate across facilities. Claiborne and Vandenburgh see social work- ers as key members of disease management teams due to their ability to work across health systems and managed care settings. Chapters 8 and 20 of this text discuss mental health issues in chronic illness.

The Patient Protection and Affordable Care Act (PPACA), which was enacted in March 2010, represents a radical change in how health- care services are constructed and delivered. Al- though its course and impact are yet to be seen, Darnell and Lawlor (in Chapter 5 of this text) argue that the PPACA will change the land- scape of health social work practice for the fore- seeable future and heighten its importance, for a number of reasons. Although the PPACA in- cludes provisions to extend insurance coverage, for example, it falls short of universal coverage. Darnell and Lawlor estimate that 23 million people will remain uninsured in 2019, includ- ing undocumented immigrants, who except for emergency situations are excluded from Medicaid coverage. Health social workers will be important advocates for those who remain uninsured. Also, despite improved affordabil- ity of insurance coverage, the coordination of care will remain a challenge (Gorin, Gehlert, & Washington, 2010). Health social workers will play a crucial role in connecting patients to ap- propriate services and maintaining the safety net for those who do not qualify for services.

CHANGES IN TECHNIQUE AND APPROACH THROUGH TIME

The settings in which social work is practiced in health care have changed through time. From 1905 until 1930, medical social work- ers practiced almost entirely in hospitals. Har- riet Bartlett (1957) described the course of change during that period as linear, with the number of social service departments increas- ing steadily and their claim to the social and

mental domains largely unchallenged by other disciplines. With the advent of psychotherapy, however, professionals such as psychologists and other social scientists began to work in hospitals, and for the fi rst time social workers had to compete for roles.

The period of linear growth was followed by an expansion into previously unimagined settings. Federally imposed cost containment, beginning in the late 1960s, posed challenges to social workers in health care and forced a great deal of fl exibility and creativity. In some respects, competition with other disciplines that social work experienced in its most recent 70 years in health care, and its failure to defi ne a niche that was exclusively its own since that time (see, e.g., Lister, 1980), prepared social workers to remain viable in a changing health- care environment. They have adapted well to these changing environments.

How do the visions of Ida Cannon and Rich- ard Cabot hold in the current health environ- ment in which social workers practice? At a time when the changing demographics pose prob- lems of communication in health care, Cabot’s idea of social worker as translator or interpreter seems modern and as salient today as it was in 1905. In 2000, 1 in 10 U.S. residents, over 28.4 million people, was born outside the country (Lollock, 2001). These fi gures do not include an estimated 10.9 million undocumented immi- grants (Camarota & Jensenius, 2009).

The current 10% of U.S. residents who were born outside the country compares to a high of 15% between 1890 and 1910, the years during which Mary Stewart was hired in Lon- don and Garnet Pelton and Ida Cannon were hired in Boston. The percentage born outside the country in 2000 is higher than it was for the decades that immediately preceded 2000. According to U.S. Census Bureau records, 7% of the population was born outside the United States in the 1950s, 5% in the 1970s, and 8% in the 1990s (Lollock, 2001).

As outlined in Chapter 10 of this text, com- munication is the key to the provision of ef- fective health care. Clinical encounters are more problematic when providers and patients are from different racial or ethnic groups or

JWBT514_ch01.indd 16JWBT514_ch01.indd 16 9/21/11 7:41 PM9/21/11 7:41 PM

Conceptual Underpinnings of Social Work in Health Care 17

different socioeconomic statuses. A report by the Institute of Medicine (2002) implicated physician behavior in health disparities in the United States, and researchers (see, e.g., Johnson, Roter, Powe, & Cooper, 2004) have noted different communication patterns among White American physicians when they are dealing with African American versus White American patients. It is unlikely, however, that these biases are limited to physicians. Al- though empirical studies to date have centered on the behavior of physicians as the time that providers are able to spend with patients de- creases, the opportunity for mental shortcuts that can lead to bias increases (Burgess, Fu, & von Ryn, 1990). Clearly, the translator or in- terpreter role fi rst defi ned by Richard Cabot in 1905 remains important in health care today. Likewise, the idea that social workers are in the best position among professionals in health care to interpret information from patients and families to providers and to interpret and ex- plain information from providers to patients and families holds true.

Cannon’s dictum that the social worker see the patient “as a member belonging to a family or community group that is altered because of his ill health” (1923, p. 15) also seems ger- mane to the current challenge of disease man- agement. Cannon was writing at a time prior to the development of treatment advances, such as antibiotics, chemotherapy, and radiation therapy, when patients did not live for long pe- riods of time with chronic health conditions. Her words seem even more salient today when a growing number of patients face living with chronic conditions.

Cabot’s belief that social workers should become more scientifi c and systematic was evidenced with the advent of research in so- cial work in the late 1960s and early 1970s. He and Cannon would be heartened by the success of evidence-based practice and the active in- corporation of research in social work practice in health care. Social workers with health-care backgrounds now head research teams and serve as program directors and other key posi- tions at the National Institutes of Health and other federal agencies.

Although they initially disagreed about the role of social workers as critics or agents of socialization within hospitals, both Cabot and Cannon doubtless would be impressed by the growing number of social workers who serve as administrators of hospitals and health-care agencies and institutions across the United States.

Ida Cannon’s statement that social work, when practiced at its best, “is a constantly changing activity, gradually building up guid- ing principles from accumulated knowledge yet changing in techniques” (1923, p. 9), still holds true. Social work in health care has been through a great deal in 100 years and has weathered seemingly insurmountable chal- lenges through time. As noted by Darnell and Lawlor in Chapter 5 of this text, health social workers now face a role as policy implemen- tors and advocates for the health-care delivery systems changes that come from the 2010 Pa- tient Protection and Affordable Care Act. De- spite these never-ending challenges, however, the guiding principles of social work in health care remain in force and are as strong today as they were in 1905.

SUGGESTED LEARNING EXERCISES

Learning Exercise 1.1

The people involved in establishing the fi rst Social Service Department at Massachusetts General Hospital (Ida Cannon, Garnet Pelton, and Richard Cabot) were all White Americans and came from families without fi nancial dif- fi culties. Cabot was from a very privileged background. Cannon’s father was a railroad administrator in Minnesota. That Pelton was able to obtain nurses’ training at the turn of the century suggests that she had means. The sub- sequent century of social work’s involvement in health care has seen the inclusion of many people from a number of racial, ethnic, and socioeconomic backgrounds. In small groups, indicate how you think the diverse nature of the health social work today might infl uence

JWBT514_ch01.indd 17JWBT514_ch01.indd 17 9/21/11 7:41 PM9/21/11 7:41 PM

18 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

the professions’ ability to advocate for the 23 million people whom Darnell and Lawlor (see Chapter 5 of this text) estimate will re- main uninsured in 2019, despite the passage of the 2010 Patient Protection and Affordable Care Act.

Learning Exercise 1.2

The fi rst hospital almoner in England (Mary Stewart) and the fi rst hospital social worker in the United States (Garnet Pelton) were women whose hiring was championed by men with in- fl uence in medicine (Charles Loch and Rich- ard Cabot). Who should be credited for the development of social work in health care? To what extent do you think that the development of social work in health care is attributable to the vision of Loch and Cabot? Were Loch and Cabot necessary catalysts for the development of social work in hospitals rather than its pio- neers? In other words, to what extent to you think that the vision and actions of women like Pelton and Cannon contributed to the devel- opment of health social work? What does this all say about gender roles and relationships in the United States and within the profession of social work?

Learning Exercise 1.3

Despite improvements in our ability to treat serious disease and improvements in the af- fordability of health insurance, health dis- parities by race, ethnicity, and socioeconomic status in the United States have continued to rise. Do you think that the enactment of the Patient Protection and Affordability Act will (1) decrease health disparities or (2) do you think that, while it will decrease the number of people who are at risk for adverse health outcomes, it will widen the gap between those who do and do not have access to adequate and appropriate health care, and thus increase dis- parities? Divide into two groups and develop arguments for each position. How might health social work help to ameliorate health dispari- ties in the United States?

REFERENCES

American Association of Hospital Social Workers. (1928). Medical social case records submitted in the 1927 case competition of the American Association of Hospital Social Workers. Chicago, IL: University of Chicago Press.

Bartlett, H. M. (1934). Medi cal social work: A study of current aims and methods in medical social case work. Chicago, IL: American Association of Medical Social Workers.

Bartlett, H. M. (1957). Fifty years of social work in the medical setting: Past signifi cance/future outlook. New York, NY: National Association of Social Workers.

Bartlett, H. M. (1961). Analyzing social work practice. Silver Spring, MD: National Association of Social Workers.

Blythe, B. J., & Erdahl, J. C. (1986). Using stress inoculation to prepare a patient for open-heart surgery. Health & Social Work, 11, 265–274.

Bracht, N. (1974). Health care: The largest human service system. Social Work, 19, 532–542.

Brogen, M. S. (1964). Johns Hopkins Hospital Department of Social Service, 1907–1931. Social Service Review, 38, 88–98.

Burgess, D. J., Fu, S. S., & von Ryn, M. (1990). Why do providers contribute to disparities and what can be done about it? Journal of General Internal Medicine, 19, 1154–1159.

Cabot, E. D. (1869, December 8). Letters of Elizabeth Cabot, Boston: Vol. 2. From Mrs. Twistleton’s death to the beginning of her son Edward’s illness, 1862 to 1885. Retrieved from http://ocp.hul.harvard.edu/ww

Cabot, J. E. (1887). A memoir of Ralph Waldo Emerson. Boston, MA: Houghton Miffl in.

Cabot, R. C. (1911). Social service work in hospitals. Chicago Medical Recorder, 33, 307–321.

Cabot, R. C. (1912). Humanizing the hospitals. In S. Breckenridge (Ed.), The child in the city (pp. 41–52). Chicago, IL: Chicago School of Civics and Philanthropy.

Cabot, R. C. (1915). Social service and the art of healing. New York, NY: Moffat, Yard and Company.

Camarota, S. A, & Jensenius, K. (2009). A shifting tide: Recent trends in the illegal immigrant population. Retrieved from Center for Immigration Studies Web site: http://www.cis.org/IllegalImmigration ShiftingTide

Cannon, I. M. (1923). Social work in hospitals: A contribution to progressive medicine. New York, NY: Russell Sage.

Cannon, I. M. (1932). Report on the subcommittee on medical social service. In White House Conference on Child Health and Protection (Eds.), Hospitals and child care: Section 1. Medical service (pp. 131–272). New York, NY: Century.

JWBT514_ch01.indd 18JWBT514_ch01.indd 18 9/21/11 7:41 PM9/21/11 7:41 PM

Conceptual Underpinnings of Social Work in Health Care 19

Cannon, I. M. (1952). On the social frontier of medicine. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.

Claiborne, N., & Vandenburgh, H. (2001). Social workers’ role in disease management. Health & Social Work, 26, 217–225.

Commission on Hospital Care. (1947). Hospital care in the United States. New York, NY: Commonwealth Fund.

Cornelius, D. S. (1994). Managed care and social work: Constructing a context and a response. Social Work in Health Care, 20, 47–63.

Coulton, C. (1988). Prospective payment requires increased attention to quality of post hospital care. Social Work in Health Care, 13, 19–30.

Darwin, C. (1936). The origin of species by means of natural selection: Or, the preservation of favored races in the struggle for life and the descent of man and selection in relation to sex. New York, NY: Modern Library. (Originally published 1859)

Dobrof, J. (1991). DRGs and the social workers role in discharge planning. Social Work in Health Care, 16, 37–54.

Dodds, T. A. (1993). Richard Cabot: Medical reformer during the Progressive Era (1890–1920). Annals of Internal Medicine, 119, 417–422.

Evison, I. S. (1995). Pragmatism and idealism in the professions: The case of Richard Clarke Cabot, 1869– 1935 (Unpublished doctoral dissertation). University of Chicago, IL.

Flexner, A. (1910). Medical education in the United States and Canada: A report to the Carnegie Foundation for the Advancement of Teaching. New York, NY: Carnegie Foundation for the Advancement of Teaching.

Flexner, A. (1915). Is social work a profession? Paper presented at the meeting of the National Conference of Charities and Corrections, Baltimore, MD.

Gorin, S. H., Gehlert, S. J., & Washington, T. A. (2010). Health care reform and health disparities: Implications for social workers. Health & Social Work, 35(4), 243– 247.

Grinker, R. MacGregor, H., Selan, K., Klein, A., & Kohrman, J. (1961). Early years of psychiatric social work. Social Service Review, 35, 111–126.

Institute of Medicine. (2002). Unequal treatment: What healthcare providers need to know about racial and ethnic disparities in health care. Washington, DC: National Academy Press.

Jarrett, M. C. (1919). The psychiatric thread running through all social case work. Proceedings of the

National Conference of Social Work. Chicago, IL: University of Chicago Press.

Johnson, R. L., Roter, D., Powe, N. R., & Cooper, L. A. (2004). Patient race/ethnicity and quality of patient- physician communication during medical visits. American Journal of Public Health, 94, 2084–2090.

Lister, L. (1980). Role expectations of social workers and other health professionals. Health & Social Work, 5, 41–49.

Lollock, L. (2001). The foreign born population of the United States: March 2000. Current Population Reports (pp. 20–534). Washington, DC: U.S. Census Bureau.

Mailick, M. D. (1990). Short-term treatment of depression in physically-ill hospital patients. In K. W. Davidson & S. S. Clarke (Eds.), Social work in health care: Handbook for practice (pp. 401–413). New York, NY: Haworth Press.

Nacman, M. (1990). Social work in health settings: A historical review. In K. W. Davidson & S. S. Clarke (Eds.), Social work in health care: Handbook for practice (pp. 7–37). New York, NY: Haworth Press.

O’Brien, L. (1985). “A bold plunge into the sea of values”: The career of Dr. Richard Cabot. New England Quarterly, 58, 533–553.

O’Conner, R. (1976). American hospitals: The fi rst 200 years. Journal of the American Hospital Association, 50, 62–72.

Reamer, F. G. (1985). Facing up to the challenge of DRGs. Health & Social Work, 10, 85–94.

Reid, W. J., & Epstein, L. (1972). Task-centered casework. New York, NY: Columbia University Press.

Romanofsky, P. (1976). Infant mortality: Dr. Henry Dwight Chapin and the Speedwell Society 1890– 1920. Journal of the Medical Society of New Jersey, 73, 33–38.

Rosenberg, C. E. (1967). The practice of medicine in New York a century ago. Bulletin of the History of Medicine, 41, 223–253.

Society for Social Work Leadership in Health Care. (2011, January 2). About SSWLHC. Retrieved from http:// www.sswlhc.org/

Stites, M. A. (1955). History of the American Association of Medical Social Workers. Washington, DC: American Association of Medical Social Workers.

U.S. Department of Health, Education, and Welfare. (1976). Medicare, 1971: Participating providers. Offi ce of Research and Statistics (Social Security Administration Publication No. SSA 76-11706). Washington, DC: U.S. Government Printing Offi ce.

JWBT514_ch01.indd 19JWBT514_ch01.indd 19 9/21/11 7:41 PM9/21/11 7:41 PM

20

2

Social Work Roles and Health- Care Settings

TERI BROWNE

Necessarily, the role of health social workers through time has changed to accommodate federal, state, and local policy changes; trends in health and disease; and the changing roles of other health-care professionals. As discussed in Chapter 1, however, the basic function of social work remains, and social workers’ roles today refl ect their responsibility for treating the whole person by taking a biopsychosocial approach to outreach, assessment, interven- tion, and care.

Health social workers operate in a variety of environments and assume numerous roles in the design, delivery, and evaluation of care. Social workers facilitate linkages across orga- nizational systems and professions to improve health care for both individuals and popula- tions. This occurs in myriad settings, in a num- ber of different ways, and with various levels of transdisciplinary collaboration. Health so- cial workers need to be aware of these factors to most effectively provide services to individ- uals and communities.

Chapter Objectives • Describe a biopsychosocial approach to

health care and the professionals who deliver it.

• Defi ne the role of the social worker on the health-care team.

• Outline the tasks of health social workers related to the delivery and design of health care.

• Discuss professional issues and challenges related to teamwork and recommendations for effective collaboration.

SOCIAL WORK’S BIOPSYCHOSOCIAL APPROACH TO HEALTH CARE

Increasingly, the recommended approach for health-care service delivery today is biopsy- chosocial. Proposed by Engel in 1977, the biopsychosocial model addresses the biologi- cal, social, environmental, psychological, and behavioral aspects of illness. This model ex- pands the traditional medical model of health care that focuses primarily on the biological causes of disease. The biopsychosocial model considers the nonmedical determinants of disease in collaboration with the purely bio- logical components. For example, a biopsy- chosocial model of health service takes into account patients’ ability to purchase recom- mended medicine for diabetes when creating a treatment plan for patients rather than focusing only on laboratory results and physical status, as a medical-model approach would do. Lin- dau, Laumann, Levinson, and Waite’s (2003) interactive biopsychosocial model expands Engel’s model to include general health status

Note: The author would like to thank her Uni- versity of South Carolina College of Social Work research assistants, Sonya Davis-Kennedy, Les- ley Jacobs, Olivia Jones, Derrick Jordan, Cassidy Shaver, Valerie Stiling, Felix Weston, and Jennifer Worthington, for reviewing this chapter and making suggestions for added content.

JWBT514_ch02.indd 20JWBT514_ch02.indd 20 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Social Work Roles and Health-Care Settings 21

rather than illness alone and consideration of the important role of social networks and cultural contexts in health. For the purposes of this chapter, the term biopsychosocial is used to indicate an approach to health service deliv- ery that addresses the psychological and social aspects of health and treatment that includes behavioral and environmental factors.

Intervention that considers biopsychosocial issues related to health requires the use of a transdisciplinary team of professionals to ad- dress medical problems and concerns in a va- riety of settings. In addition to social workers, professionals may include physicians, physi- cian assistants, and residents; nurses and nurse practitioners; dietitians; psychologists; patient care technicians; nurse and home health aides; physical, occupational, and speech therapists; administrators; chaplains; and pharmacists. In- dividual patients and members of their social support network are also increasingly recog- nized as critically important members of trans- disciplinary teams (McWilliam, 2009).

Limits of the Medical Approach: Psychosocial Issues Related to Health

Before the introduction of Engel’s biopsycho- social model, Nason and Delbanco (1976) rec- ommended that providers of medical services attend to patients’ psychosocial issues and advocated for the inclusion of social workers on health-care teams. Health social workers directly address the social, behavioral, and emotional concerns of individuals and their social support network as well as develop and administer policies and programs and conduct research that are attuned to the psychosocial needs of individuals.

On an individual level, people may not be able to understand illness and recommended treatment because of developmental disabili- ties; low literacy levels; or language, hearing, or vision barriers. Many medical conditions and treatments are very complex, and social workers may be required to explain these is- sues to patients and their families. Socio- economic disadvantage can greatly impact a patient’s ability to receive medical care. If

she lacks adequate health insurance, transpor- tation to medical appointments, prescription coverage, or money to buy nutritional supple- ments and special dietary products, her health may be compromised. Patients may need myriad services from a number of agencies, such as meal delivery, homemaker services, or physical therapy. Arranging and coordi- nating community services can be confusing or overwhelming for patients, especially for those with additional social, psychological, or medical burdens. Environmental factors also directly impact individuals’ social function- ing and health status (see Chapters 4 and 7 for models of how environmental factors infl uence health and functioning).

Emotional problems can be caused by and result from health problems (see Chapter 8). After a major medical procedure such as open heart surgery, a patient’s anxiety may increase (Ben-Zur, Rappaport, Ammar, & Uretzky, 2000). Among people with cardiovascular dis- ease, untreated depression has been found to increase the risk of a heart attack (Monster, Johnsen, Olsen, McLaughlin, & Sorenson, 2004). A person who is depressed may be less motivated to follow up with medical appoint- ments. If he is not coping well with his diag- nosis and treatment regimen, he may do less well physically (Livneh, 2000). Effective cop- ing, enhanced self-effi cacy, and optimism have been associated with enhanced quality of life in people with chronic illnesses (Rose, Fliege, Hildebrandt, Schirop, & Klapp, 2002).

Patients’ social support networks can in- fl uence their health status signifi cantly. As discussed in Chapter 13, families can provide important support and assistance during times of health crisis, or they can represent barriers to optimal care. For example, the husband of a breast cancer patient who does not support the doctor’s recommendation for a double mastectomy may confound and even further harm the patient’s health status by causing her to become reluctant to have the necessary sur- gery. Family structure and the availability of social support impacts the health of patients across their life course (Thompson, Auslander, & White, 2001).

JWBT514_ch02.indd 21JWBT514_ch02.indd 21 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

22 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

Conversely, illness may exacerbate exist- ing psychosocial problems; for example, a woman in a troubled marriage who becomes ill may lose her primary social support when her partner leaves because he cannot cope with the stress of her illness and its treatment. This may leave her with no transportation to medi- cal appointments in addition to coping with is- sues related to role adjustment and loss, both of which can negatively impact her health.

If a child has supportive family members to help him with the challenges of medical prob- lems and hospitalizations, he will likely fare better than a child who does not. Likewise, a woman recovering from heart surgery who has neighbors or family to help with household chores and child care may recuperate better and be more likely to attend weekly cardiac rehabilitation appointments than someone who has no help. Psychosocial issues like these, which occur outside hospitals and doctors’ of- fi ces, greatly infl uence individuals’ abilities to maintain their health.

Many individuals who seek medical care also have what Rehr (1982) refers to as “social illnesses and problems.” These illnesses and problems are psychosocial rather than bio- logical in nature, such as child or elder abuse, violence (including sexual assault and fam- ily violence), substance use, other harmful behaviors such as “cutting” or bulimia, and suicide attempts. All are factors that require social work attention and intervention to im- prove biopsychosocial status and, consequen- tially, health status. For example, Sormanti and Shibusawa (2008) found that 5.5% of women ages 50 to 64 years seen at emergency depart- ments and primary care clinics were victims of intimate partner violence. This and other fi ndings suggest a need for social workers in medical settings to intervene with patients who are burdened with these “social illnesses and problems” in addition to medical illnesses.

The current health-care environment in the United States (see Chapter 5) emphasizes cost containment through shorter hospital stays, briefer medical interventions, and the provi- sion of fewer comprehensive services with fewer personnel. For example, decades ago,

individuals may have spent a number of weeks in a hospital recuperating from hip replace- ment or liver transplant surgery. Many surgical procedures that were once done on an inpatient basis are now performed in outpatient, same- day facilities. Lengthy hospital stays are now the exception rather than the rule because of fi xed reimbursement for medical procedures, and an individual who has a hip replaced or receives a liver transplant may be discharged from the hospital a few days after her surgery.

The trend toward shorter hospital stays and greater reliance on outpatient care may exacer- bate patient psychosocial problems. Bateman and Whitaker (2002) assert that social workers are needed in medical settings to address in- creased home care needs in part because they can provide discharge planning that links pa- tients to necessary home health services. The authors also suggest that social workers should play a greater role in primary care settings, ad- dressing medical issues on a preventive level to decrease morbidity and the need for hospi- talization. (See Box 2.1.)

Related to an emphasis on medical cost containment is an increase in community health programs. Aimed at preventing illness or health issues, programs that confront issues such as prenatal care and cancer screening em- ploy social workers in their orchestration and day-to-day functioning.

Health Settings and the Social Worker’s Place Within Them

Direct health services are provided in various settings and include public and private hospi- tals, outpatient clinics, neighborhood health centers, ambulatory surgery centers, physi- cian’s offi ces, mobile care units, skilled nurs- ing facilities, military settings, correctional facilities, schools, and health maintenance or- ganizations. Care may be provided in centers devoted to specifi c diseases, such as kidney failure (dialysis centers), cancer (chemother- apy clinics), and human immunodefi ciency virus (HIV)/acquired immunodefi ciency syn- drome (AIDS) (community health clinics), or in multipurpose organizations that address

JWBT514_ch02.indd 22JWBT514_ch02.indd 22 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Social Work Roles and Health-Care Settings 23

local, state, and federal agencies; community organizations; government offi ces; or schools and research institutions. Health is considered across the life course in micro- and macrolevel settings, from prenatal and infant care to older adult and end-of-life care.

Health is a critical practice area for all so- cial workers, both on clinical levels and macro levels, and social workers play an important role in each of these care settings. U.S. News & World Report (2010) ranked medical and pub- lic health social work as one of their 50 best careers of 2011. In 2010, 22% of all social workers were employed as medical and pub- lic health social workers, and it is projected that between 2008 and 2018 the number of health social workers in the United States will increase by 22% (U.S. Department of Labor, 2010).

Regulatory standards for social work in health care vary by state in the United States, with each state having a different set of li- censing rules for social workers. Health orga- nizations also differ in how they recommend and regulate the inclusion of social workers on health-care teams. As noted in Chapter 1, social workers have been involved in medical settings for over a century and are essential to the implementation of biopsychosocial models of health service delivery.

Empirical evidence indicates that ap- proaches to health care that include social workers and nurses in addition to physicians result in better patient outcomes than ap- proaches involving physicians alone; such evidence also suggests that social worker and nurse interventions are less costly. For example, Sommers, Marton, Barbaccia, and Randolph (2000) conducted an experimen- tal research study on the effectiveness of an interdisciplinary team model in the provision of primary care. In this study, the interven- tion group received care from a primary care physician, registered nurse, and social worker while the control group received care from the primary care physician alone. The researchers found that the group cared for by the multi- disciplinary team experienced signifi cantly lower rates of hospitalization and hospital

Box 2.1 Health Social Work Profi le

Mildred Williamson, MSW, PhD, is the director of programs and research for the Ambulatory and Community Health Network of the Cook County Bureau of Health Services in Chicago, IL. In this capacity, she creates health programs based on the community’s needs. She previously was the administrator of the Woodlawn Health Center in Chicago and the Women and Children HIV Program at the Cook County Hospital. Williamson is a recipient of many local, state, federal, and private foundation grants for health research. She has served as a member of the Centers for Disease Control and Prevention’s Advisory Council on HIV/AIDS Prevention and Care and is on the boards of directors of two Chicago HIV-related organizations: Vision House and the Families’ and Children’s AIDS Network. Williamson currently serves on the board of the AIDS Alliance for Children, Youth, and Families, a national organization of HIV family- and youth-centered care providers, advocates, and consumers that she helped found in 1994. She served as president of the organization’s board from 1997 to 2001.

numerous health issues. For example, Rock and Cooper (2000) describe possible social work activities in a primary care clinic. These activities include patient assessment; screen- ing and treatment for alcoholism, depression, and anxiety; case management; cognitive- behavioral therapy to improve patient self- management of the treatment regimes; and bereavement counseling.

Other practice settings might specifi cally treat acute medical needs (including outpa- tient services or services provided on an ad hoc basis) or chronic medical needs where pa- tients are admitted and receive services for a period of time. Indirect health services, such as program and policy planning and health programming, may be overseen by profes- sionals working on transdisciplinary teams via

JWBT514_ch02.indd 23JWBT514_ch02.indd 23 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

24 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

readmission, fewer follow-up physician visits, and increased participation in social activities. They estimated that the interdisciplinary ap- proach saved at least $90 per patient (includ- ing the cost of the additional personnel), not including the savings from fewer physician visits.

Additional research supports the notion that social work services are needed by patients in health-care settings. McGuire, Bikson, and Blue-Howells (2005) distributed self-adminis- tered surveys to 684 patients receiving primary care services at four Veterans Affairs clinics. These surveys were completed anonymously and offered to every patient seen at the clin- ics during data collection. They measured pa- tients’ psychosocial needs such as fi nancial assistance, housing, and counseling. Almost two-thirds of patients reported experiencing psychosocial barriers. Sixty-three percent re- ported fi nancial problems, and 62% reported personal stress. More than one third (38%) of the patients had problems such as unemploy- ment, poor transportation, and relationship issues. About a quarter of the patients were homeless (28%) or needed home health care (21%). Only 15% of those surveyed reported experiencing no psychosocial barriers to fol- lowing primary care recommendations, and most of the patients (74%) had more than one social problem.

SOCIAL WORKER’S ROLE ON HEALTH TEAMS

Social workers are essential to the delivery and design of optimal health care. Social work- ers contribute via direct clinical contact with patients and their families as well as through roles in macrolevel settings. They work on health teams comprised of direct patient-care professionals and as administrators oversee- ing program planning and implementation. Health social work tasks are congruent with the goals of the profession of social work and include helping clients problem solve and cope with life stressors; linking individuals with resources, services, and opportunities;

promoting effective and humane service sys- tems; and developing and improving social policy (Gambrill, 1997).

Hands-On Practice: Social Workers as Part of Health-Care Delivery

A wide variety of health social work tasks exist in direct patient-care settings. These in- clude interventions with patients and members of their social support networks, collabora- tions with members of transdisciplinary teams, coordination of services within the community and entitlement agencies, advocacy with gov- ernmental bodies for patient needs, and super- vision or administration in health facilities. Activities of the health social worker in direct patient-care settings include careful assess- ment of patient situations and the design and implementation of interventions.

Health Social Work Assessment

Social workers conduct an evaluation of the strengths and needs of individuals and mem- bers of their social support network as part of a social work assessment to identify assets and potential barriers to care. These efforts are specifi c to practice settings and infl uenced by organizational or regulatory requirements and the type of services offered by the organiza- tion. For example, a hospital may have a stan- dard social work assessment tool used in all departments. Oncology social workers may use a standardized tool that is specifi c to the needs of cancer patients, whereas rehabilita- tion social workers likely will use a different type of assessment tool. Such assessment tools are not limited to disease, and social workers also help health-care teams assess psychologi- cal and social issues, such as domestic violence (Danis, 2003) and socioeconomic barriers to the attainment of quality health care, among other issues.

Health Social Work Intervention

Based on a careful assessment of needs, social workers provide assistance and develop and implement interventions to address identifi ed needs. This process may include explaining

JWBT514_ch02.indd 24JWBT514_ch02.indd 24 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Social Work Roles and Health-Care Settings 25

the disease and its treatment to patients in a manner that is sensitive to their literacy levels; developmental stages; and language, visual, or hearing barriers. Facilitating communica- tion between providers and patients is a key health social work role further discussed in Chapter 10. (See Box 2.2.)

Social workers are familiar with the eligi- bility requirements of local and federal entitle- ment programs and can help patients and their families access and learn more about these re- sources. Social workers are the health profes- sionals who possess “the knowledge necessary to assess social services needs [and] to secure and coordinate community-based services” (Berkman, 1996, p. 545). Health social work- ers can help patients gain needed resources by providing case management services that refer and link patients and their families to services and other resources.

Furthermore, health social work has a dual focus of enhancing social institutions’ responses to human needs and enhancing the

Box 2.2 Health Social Work Profi le

Kay Ammon, MSW, LCSW, QSW, is a social worker in the intensive care nursery at Santa Clara Valley Medical Center in San Jose, CA. Working with critically ill infants and their families, Ammon orients families to the nursery, which is highly technical and can be overwhelming, and discusses its policies and procedures. Ammon provides emotional support, grief counseling, coping with guilt and anxiety, end-of-life care and information, referral, and linkages to resources for ill children and their families. As a Spanish-speaking health-care provider working with many Hispanic families, she considers herself a “key link” between families and the health- care team. She translates sophisticated medical communications for patients’ families and coordinates family care conferences. She helps families understand complex medical terminology and discharge recommendations.

social functioning of individuals (Dhooper, 1994). Health social workers use their clini- cal skills to help patients and their families cope with illness and treatment recommenda- tions. Many diagnoses, such as amyotrophic lateral sclerosis (ALS; also called Lou Geh- rig’s disease), are very diffi cult for patients to accept. ALS is a progressive neuromuscular disease that is very debilitating and ultimately fatal. A person given an ALS diagnosis may be depressed, angry, and fearful. A health so- cial worker is trained to provide counseling to assist the patient cope with his diagnosis, provide grief counseling for the losses that he will experience as a result of his disease, and encourage him to follow up with medical care to maximize his quality of life.

In addition, recommended treatment regi- mens can be diffi cult for patients to follow. A teenage boy diagnosed with diabetes may fi nd that the need to test his blood glucose lev- els several times a day, self-administer insu- lin shots while at school, and avoid sugar is very cumbersome. He may choose to not fol- low medical advice because it confl icts with his preferred lifestyle. A health social worker can help him by empathizing with the intru- siveness of the diabetic treatment regime, pro- viding supportive counseling, and helping him fi nd ways to cope with the diffi cult aspects of his treatment regimen. She also may col- laborate with the school nurse to explore the possibility of the boy testing his blood glucose level and self-administering insulin in her of- fi ce. This would afford him greater privacy than if he were to use a public space. Another lifestyle intervention might include the social worker discussing with the boy’s parents the types of food or refreshments served at home or at parties to ensure that these foods con- form to his diet. Some children and adoles- cents face stigma or misunderstanding about their illness from their peers and classmates, and in this case the social worker might offer a class presentation to educate the patient’s peers about his disease and dispel any myths or misinformation about diabetes that they may possess, making them more familiar with the disease and demystifying the boy’s unique

JWBT514_ch02.indd 25JWBT514_ch02.indd 25 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

26 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

diet requirements and need for insulin injec- tions during the school day.

For older adults, social workers in health care are able to provide couples and family counseling. A couple grieving over the death of their newborn daughter may see the hos- pital social worker for grief counseling. The social worker may work with an entire fam- ily to discuss their adjustment after a father’s leg amputation. Likewise, interventions re- lated to end-of-life care often require family conferences and intervention using a range of theory- and evidence-based intervention strat- egies. Health social workers often run sup- port groups for patients and their families to provide education and support on a variety of health issues.

Health social workers may see patients re- ferred by other professionals. Patients may be referred because of psychosocial issues that represent a barrier to effective treatment. For example, a hospital social worker may not see all patients who come to the emergency room but will be called to assess and provide services to victims of sexual assault or family violence or refer these victims to appropriate services. A social worker employed in a pri- mary care setting may be asked to work only with patients and families who have identifi ed psychosocial needs, such as problems coping with vision loss that preclude follow-up with recommended referrals or a lack of insurance to pay for needed medications. Likewise, a so- cial worker employed by a hospital emergency department may be asked to work with a pa- tient who comes to the department frequently for what essentially are primary-care needs. The referral might be to assess barriers to re- ceiving and using preventive care and refer the patient for community services.

Conversely, some social workers see every patient who passes through their particular setting. For instance, transplant social work- ers evaluate the psychosocial issues that af- fect every patient in need of a transplant. The goal of the evaluation is to help the team decide if the patient should be accepted into the program. The social worker addresses the psychosocial issues that might interfere with a

successful transplant and that must be resolved before a patient is scheduled for transplant sur- gery. Case management services are provided by social workers to patients while they are being worked up for transplant. Such services include referrals for community resources, fi - nancial counseling, and family and caregiver preparation and education for their posttrans- plant caregiving roles.

A common phenomenon in health social work practice is having patients, their families, and community members actively participate on health teams or act as advisors to programs and research. Underlying this trend is the idea that patients have a voice equal to that of pro- fessionals in their health-care planning and health research. The Center for Interdisciplinary Health Disparities Research at the University of Chicago, led by Sarah Gehlert, PhD, MSW, is part of a multisite federal program to develop centers for the study of population health and health disparities. Each project includes com- munity members as stakeholders along with scientifi c investigators with specialties in the biological, social, and psychological aspects of health. Gehlert’s team conducted 49 intensive focus groups with 503 community residents to determine community beliefs, concerns, and attitudes about breast cancer and its treat- ment. Social workers in clinical, administrative, and research roles are instrumental in help- ing health-care teams incorporate community members and consumers in planning and serve as advocates for them throughout the process.

On a health-care team or in an administra- tive role, social workers ensure that the social context of health is addressed in patient care and program planning. Miller and Rehr (1983) refer to social workers in health care as media- tors between the health-care system and con- sumers. This work also involves advocating at the systems level for improvements in the delivery of care.

Social Work as Part of the Design of Health Care

The profession of social work has a dual focus on enhancing the social functioning of

JWBT514_ch02.indd 26JWBT514_ch02.indd 26 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Social Work Roles and Health-Care Settings 27

individuals and the responses of social insti- tutions to human needs (Dhooper, 1994). A wide variety of health social work tasks exist in nondirect patient-care settings, such as community, university-based, and government agencies. These tasks might include public health social work, policy development, pro- gram planning, community education and screening, or research. In these macrolevel settings, social workers collaborate with other professionals and with policy makers, elected offi cials, and university faculty, administra- tors, and community members.

Health social workers design and imple- ment community health programs and initia- tives. For example, a social worker may work on a team that is planning a program to im- prove prenatal care. The social worker must then ensure that psychosocial barriers to pre- natal care, such as a lack of child care at a prenatal clinic, are addressed as part of the ini- tiative. Social workers also may provide edu- cation to individuals, groups, and communities on different health issues. Health social work- ers are involved in preventive services, such as health screening and immunizations. They can help identify individuals in need of services and providing linkages to such services via outreach programs. (See Box 2.3.)

At an even broader level, many social work- ers are involved in research that directly and indirectly infl uences policy, community and public health, and clinical practice. Routinely health social workers perform quality assur- ance and outcome measurement on the ser- vices they provide to track psychosocial issues and the impact of social work intervention on alleviating these issues. Social workers also perform research at the community or univer- sity level with individuals and communities, or as it relates to health-care issues in general.

For example, Caroline Jennette, MSW, is a social work research specialist at the Uni- versity of North Carolina Kidney Center. The mission of the Kidney Center is to reduce the burden of chronic kidney disease through research, clinical care, and community out- reach. Jennette maintains a variety of roles in her position, including study coordination,

community education, and conducting re- search on health policy and state policy diffu- sion. She also acts as the legislative liaison for the Kidney Center and keeps her colleagues current on policy issues affecting the nephrol- ogy community and patient access to care. Jennette coordinates a large research registry of patients with glomerular disease and en- sures that investigators abide by the rules gov- erning ethical practice of research with human subjects. She is a member of the American So- ciety of Nephrology’s KidneyNews editorial

Box 2.3 Health Social Work Profi le

Rose Popovich, MSW, LCSW, is the 2001 recipient of the Ida M. Cannon Award for Distinguished Leadership from the Society for Social Work Leadership in Health Care. She is the executive director of the performance improvement program for Community Health Network in Indianapolis, IN. The network consists of fi ve acute care hospitals, outpatient surgery centers, a home care agency, a rehabilitation center, integrated physician services, a family medicine residency, outpatient clinics in schools, wellness services for employers, as well as other services. Her team applies the methodologies of performance improvement to a variety of issues confronting the system from throughput to electronic order entry, patient falls, frequent emergency room patient visitors, physician credentialing processes—anything and everything, both administrative and clinical. Popovich says that her social work background is essential to the creation of the community health program she oversees in that it helps her to better understand the needs of the population served. Her social work background also was essential to understand and assess customer needs, helping teams defi ne their goals and metrics and facilitating the change process.

JWBT514_ch02.indd 27JWBT514_ch02.indd 27 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

28 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

board, of which she is a regular contributor of policy articles. A typical day for Jennette may include consulting with an investigator on a research project, scanning for policies in sessions pertaining to kidney disease, editing patient education materials, going over in- formed consent with a participant for inclu- sion in a research registry, and working on an independent research project.

Social workers have an active voice in large funding organizations such as the Na- tional Institutes of Health (NIH) and make sure that psychosocially relevant research is conducted. Many social work scholars have received funding from the NIH for health research, and social work research has been made a priority at NIH. In 2003, NIH cre- ated a social work research working group to promote NIH-funded social work research (see http://obssr.od.nih.gov/pdf/SWR_Report .pdf for more details). Since then, several NIH institutes have promoted social work research funding and conducted an NIH sum- mer training course on topics of interest to social workers and others (such as genet- ics and community-based participatory re- search). Organizations such as the Society for Social Work Research and the Social Work Policy Institute provide information and re- sources for social workers who are interested in health research.

SURVEY OF SOCIAL WORK PROFESSIONALS

Social workers’ roles are diverse and aspire to achieve total patient health as well as to pro- vide community and public service to bring about positive health status on a larger scale. Social workers entering the fi eld today have innumerable opportunities to affect the qual- ity of individual patients’ lives, the health of myriad communities, and the fi eld in general. To illustrate the many and varied responsibili- ties and opportunities with which social work- ers are faced as they prepare to enter the fi eld today, consider actual professionals currently contributing to the fi eld.

Case Management and Patient Advocacy

In her former role as a hospital social worker at MedCenter One Health Systems in Bismarck, ND, Jennifer Schlinger, MSW, LCSW, primar- ily worked in the rehabilitation department, collaborating daily with physicians, physical and occupational therapists, dietitians, nurses, and other professionals. Although most of her patients were adults, she occasionally worked with pediatric patients and provided services to all individuals who were admitted to the reha- bilitation department. Patient stays are limited to 6 weeks while patients receive medical treatment and are assisted with recuperation surgery or medical crises. Schlinger performed case management activities on a daily basis, helping patients plan their discharge and ar- range follow-up care. This was particularly challenging for patients living in rural areas of the state in which no local home health or other health-care services are available. Sch- linger spent a great deal of time advocating for patients, especially those on Medicaid who are burdened with an annual 30-day limit for rehabilitation services. Schlinger helped pa- tients obtain entitlements, access community resources, and create and nurture social sup- port systems. She acted as a liaison between patients and the medical team as well as com- munity organizations. Schlinger currently works as a civilian social worker/case manager with the North Dakota Army National Guard. She works with soldiers to ensure that they are medically ready to deploy and meet retention standards. She serves as a liaison between the soldier and the state medical detachment phy- sicians and the soldier’s unit.

Health social workers also may serve as supervisors in their practice settings by pro- viding clinical supervision, or they may hold a position as a liaison between the department of social work and the administration of the agency or organization for which they work.

Sharon Mass, PhD, MSW, is the director of case management and palliative care at Cedars- Sinai Medical Center in Los Angeles. In this position she oversees a cross-disciplinary

JWBT514_ch02.indd 28JWBT514_ch02.indd 28 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Social Work Roles and Health-Care Settings 29

group of over 120 staff members (50 social workers, 35 nurse case managers, 8 home care coordinators, 3 physicians, 2 advanced prac- tice nurses, 6 administrative support staff, and other per diem staff). She is president-elect of the American Case Management Associa- tion, an organization of 3,000 nurses and so- cial workers who provide case management in acute-care hospital settings. She is a founding member of the board of directors of the Ameri- can Case Management Association. Mass has published in the areas of case management and end-of-life care. She is an adjunct professor at the School of Social Work at the University of Southern California and has received many awards for her work in social work in health care. Mass attends daily administrative and medical staff meetings about health-care deliv- ery in which she advocates for patients from the social work and case management services departments. She provides supervision for so- cial work licensure and guides social workers’ professional development at the hospital. She also is active in committees on patients’ rights and is a member of the institutional review board.

Assessment of Need: The First Step of Care

Some social workers in health care see all patients in the clinical settings in which they work. Jeff Harder, MSW, LICSW, is a trans- plant social worker at the University of Wash- ington Medical Center in Seattle. In his work with the kidney and pancreas transplant pro- gram, Harder conducts psychosocial evalua- tions on all patients referred for a kidney or pancreas transplant. Harder assists patients and their caregivers with fi nding needed re- sources, such as local housing for follow-up outpatient care after transplant, if necessary. He provides counseling, education on what to expect after a transplant, and discharge plan- ning. Harder assists patients and their families with coping, information, referrals, assessment of further needs, and vocational rehabilitation. He continues to assist patients who previously received transplants when they lose insurance

coverage or have questions about returning to work.

Needs-Based Care: Assisting the Client in Need

Some health social workers see only those pa- tients in their health-care setting who require their services. In addition, other health social workers may work on a freelance basis. For example, Mary Raymer, MSW, ACSW, is a psychiatric social worker and licensed mar- riage and family therapist who has worked with terminally ill patients and their families for 25 years. An early hospice leader, she was the social work section leader for the National Hospice and Palliative Care Organization and is one of the originators of the Social Work End-of-Life Education Project. She has her own private practice and specializes in com- plicated grief reactions, stress, and terminal illness. The majority of her practice involves counseling individuals and families who are coping with grief.

Public Health Social Work

Marvin R. Hutchinson, MSW, LISWAP, CP, is the recently retired director of public health social work for the South Carolina Department of Health. He participated regularly in legisla- tive, policy, and program meetings (ensuring a psychosocial emphasis to the proceedings) and oversaw the public health social work program. His staff included regional public health social work directors and state program public health social work consultants with whom he worked to develop new initiatives for more than 225 master’s-level public health social workers. These social workers are employed in clinical, community, and management positions across the state in programs such as maternal health, child health, family planning, tuberculosis treatment, school health, children’s rehabilita- tive services, AIDS, and home health services. Hutchinson taught at the College of Social Work of the University of South Carolina. He directed violence and suicide prevention initia- tives and oversaw the MSW/master’s in public

JWBT514_ch02.indd 29JWBT514_ch02.indd 29 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

30 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

health internship program. He presented work- shops and papers to interagency staff as well as to audiences at state, regional, national, and international conferences. In addition, Hutchinson serves on national-level commit- tees (representing the Association of State and Territorial Public Health Social Workers, the National Council on Aging, the Public Health Foundation, and the National Association of Social Workers) and legislative committees re- garding issues such as school health, violence, systems, and integration. He received recog- nition from the Surgeon General for public health services and is the 2005 South Carolina NASW Social Worker of the Year.

Multilevel Intervention: Diversifying Responsibility

Social workers can intervene both on an in- dividual and a systems level in health care. Patricia Ann Gibson, MSW, ACSW, is direc- tor of the Comprehensive Epilepsy Program at the Wake Forest University School of Medi- cine in North Carolina. She is involved in nu- merous organizations, including the American Epilepsy Society, the Epilepsy Foundation, the International Bureau of Epilepsy, and Interna- tional Epilepsy Congress. Gibson also is on the professional advisory board of the National Tuberous Sclerosis Alliance and has authored numerous publications for patients and profes- sionals. In 1976, she developed and continues to run a nationwide telephone information line for epilepsy. She speaks with patients and their families about their concerns. After learning of parents’ inability to afford their children’s medicine, she spent 8 years developing an epilepsy medication fund for the state of North Carolina and supplements this fund with a va- riety of fundraising efforts (including a chili cook-off, yard sales, and offering snacks at her offi ce for donations). Gibson sees patients for education as well as individual, family, and group counseling. Much of her time is spent speaking and conducting workshops, confer- ences, and symposia. These include educa- tion on epilepsy for primary and secondary schools, parents, physicians, nurses, medical

students, hospitals, and community organi- zations. She also organizes several national conferences, such as Advances in the Man- agement of Epilepsy, the Pediatric Neurology Symposium, and the International Conference on Epilepsy Care. In these trainings, she pres- ents a transdisciplinary approach to the treat- ment of epilepsy.

John Q. Gowan, MSW, is the coordinator of consumer relations and community de- velopment for the End-Stage Renal Disease (ESRD) Network 7 of Florida and is another example of a health social worker involved in direct patient- and community-level service. A major part of his job is organizing and present- ing workshops for dialysis unit staff members about challenging patient situations and in- creasing staff sensitivity to patient needs. At the ESRD Network, Gowan also provides as- sistance to renal patients and their families, as- sists with rehabilitation promotion for ESRD patients, and facilitates the state’s Patient Ad- visory Committee, which addresses dialysis patient concerns and encourages patient in- volvement in their care.

Administration and Social Work in the Design of Health Care

Social workers play an important role in the design of health-care delivery through admin- istrative roles in clinical settings, overseeing both social workers and other professionals. Polly Jones, MSW, MSM, LCSW, CPHQ, is the director of clinical excellence for Ascen- sion Health in Burlington, IN. She is respon- sible for the coordination of accreditation activities for the more than 70 Ascension hospitals, including educational initiatives, individual consultations, and quality im- provement activities, and for facilitating the Joint Commission on Accreditation of Health Care Organizations system survey each year. She also oversees programming and projects for all of the hospitals. In these capacities, she advocates for the social work profession by encouraging social work involvement in activ- ities, programs, and teams at a local level. On a daily basis, she travels to different hospitals

JWBT514_ch02.indd 30JWBT514_ch02.indd 30 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Social Work Roles and Health-Care Settings 31

across the country to work with transdisci- plinary teams on various projects. As a project manager, she facilitates team interaction and promotes improved patient outcomes. She re- ports that her social work training is invaluable as it relates to knowledge of group dynamics, change theory, and how systems work. Jones frequently publishes and speaks about various topics related to health social work and was the 2005 president of the Society of Social Work Leadership in Healthcare. As president of this organization, she networked with social work leaders across the country to provide ed- ucation, advocacy, and other support to social workers in myriad health-care settings.

Filling the Health-Care Void: Social Work’s Myriad Responsibilities

Social workers sometimes have health-care– specifi c responsibilities. Others, however, are responsible for a variety of roles within the setting in which they work. Douglas Kirk, MSSW, LCSW, for example, is the program director for mental health intensive case man- agement at the Veterans Hospital in Madison, WI. He works with veterans at the hospital who require intensive mental health case man- agement. In describing his various tasks in this role, Kirk stated:

On any one day, I might be in with a client in a medical examination for hepatitis, help- ing both the physician understand the patient (not all doctors have patience for the men- tally ill) and the patient to understand the doctor. I might then be on the phone with the district attorney [DA] advocating for proba- tion rather than jail, helping the DA under- stand that jail may be counterproductive for this mentally ill person or explaining to the group home how to care for the edema in this man’s legs. Later that day, I might be show- ing someone else how to operate a washing machine and observing him to see if the re- cent increase in medication has resulted in any side effects. While doing the wash, we might discuss how to cope with his voices. Afterward, we may rework his budget to re- fl ect his wish to have more money for fun

on the weekends. Later that day, I might be meeting with the family of a patient who are trying their best but instead are enabling the patient to be stuck and not move forward. I help them see that their son has skills and strengths and is more than his mental illness. I might take that patient to the store to teach him how to shop more independently and eat more nutritiously. Earlier I cleaned diarrhea off the fl oor for a dehydrated person who lives alone, hugged another who is having a particularly lonely day, and spent time with a very psychotic person who has exercised his right to decline medication but is suffering as a result. (personal communication, March 25, 2005)

In treating each individual case, Kirk is faced with an unusual collection of responsi- bilities that fall under his area of expertise as a health social worker. In this role, he must work multilaterally in order to provide the best care for his patients, addressing microlevel needs for one patient and macrolevel issues in order to ensure that another is treated appropriately and in his or her best interest.

Dawn Romano, MSW, LMSW, LCSW, is a clinical social work supervisor at Chil- dren’s Mercy Hospitals and Clinics in Kan- sas City, MO. She is another example of a social worker who performs a multitude of tasks. Her daily clinical responsibilities in- clude crisis intervention, child abuse and neglect assessment, and trauma counseling to patients and families. As a supervisor, she oversees the hospital’s social workers, pro- viding child abuse orientation and clinical supervision. She serves on a variety of com- mittees, including the trauma and domestic violence committees. The majority of her work centers on child abuse and neglect as- sessments, and she meets with children and families to complete psychosocial assess- ments for child abuse and neglect. Work- ing closely with her team, she completes hotline reports and works with the child protection services agencies to assess the immediate safety of children. She advises law enforcement offi cials on the reporting and investigation of child abuse and neglect,

JWBT514_ch02.indd 31JWBT514_ch02.indd 31 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

32 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

provides support and education to families, and connects families to community sup- port services. She provides case manage- ment services and is a part of the trauma and hospital emergency response teams. She is the social worker representative on a team including a chaplain and nursing supervisor that provides crisis intervention, education, emotional support, and grief counseling to families whose children have been injured in motor vehicle accidents, shootings, drown- ings, falls, suicides, and other tragedies.

COLLABORATING WITH OTHER PROFESSIONALS

In the various health settings described, social workers are called on to collaborate with other health-care professionals. Social workers may work on teams that are multidisciplinary (each professional works autonomously with little interaction), interdisciplinary (professionals interact with one another to provide services but maintain clear professional boundaries dictated by distinct terminology and interven- tive preferences), or, ideally, transdisciplinary (close collaboration among the professionals, including sharing a common language and ap- proach to programming and intervention plan- ning).

The level of collaboration within a team is specifi c to individual health settings and their norms and practices. At one end of the spec- trum, collaborating with other professionals might occur indirectly. For example, physi- cians may read social work notes in a patient’s chart yet never discuss the patient’s care di- rectly with the social worker. Social workers may be employed at health settings on a per diem or consultant basis and not be active members of teams. At the other extreme, pro- fessionals may work directly with one another on a daily basis, confer frequently about pa- tient issues, visit patients as a team, and make all care planning decisions based on group meetings and group feedback, with all mem- bers having an equal voice in the process.

Challenges to Professional Collaboration

Professional collaboration can be challenging in a health setting. Even if the team interacts frequently, professionals may not have equal voices in the care planning process, profes- sional roles may not be clear, and professional perspectives and ethics may clash. The execu- tion of team collaboration varies signifi cantly. At care planning meetings, the social worker may be a passive observer and not encouraged to participate unless necessary. Alternatively, social workers may organize and run such meetings.

Workplace change represents a signifi cant challenge to health social workers. Health-care provision increasingly is focused on reducing costs and decreasing hospital stays. Profes- sional departments, including counseling ser- vices and community education, have been reduced in size or eliminated (Sulman, Savage, & Way, 2001). Another challenge to health so- cial work is the co-opting by other professions of tasks that historically have fallen under the rubric of social work. This is notably true in case management, with nurses and other profes- sionals performing case management activities. Hospital social work departments are being re- placed by nurse-led case management depart- ments, and nursing professionals increasingly are supervising health social workers (Alveo, 2001; Globerman, White, & McDonald, 2003). In a study of discharge planners, Holliman, Dziegielewski, and Teare (2003) found that nurse case managers are paid more than so- cial work case managers. The authors found that private hospitals were more likely to hire nurses as discharge planners, although federal and state hospitals were more likely to hire so- cial workers as discharge planners.

Collaboration may be hampered by am- biguity of roles and tasks, and different dis- ciplines may not understand one another’s lexicon and procedures. Health professionals have unique training, education, and perspec- tives toward practice. Physicians, nurses, and social workers (along with the other members of the transdisciplinary team) view and frame

JWBT514_ch02.indd 32JWBT514_ch02.indd 32 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Social Work Roles and Health-Care Settings 33

patient problems and their solutions to those problems through separate lenses. Carlton (1984) wrote: “[S]ocial work is a profession whose purpose, logic, and underlying ratio- nale differ from those of other professions” (p. xiii). Rolland (1994) asserts:

Clinicians from different disciplines bring their own assets and liabilities to the interac- tion of family and illness and disability. Phy- sicians and nurses have a surplus of technical medical information. They can have trouble seeing the psychosocial forest through the technological lens they need to use to help the patient medically. And if they can switch lenses, often they have trouble deciding which trees in the medical forest are psycho- socially important. They may have diffi culty taking the 1,001 facts about diabetes and dis- tilling from them the essence of the psycho- social meaning of the disorder. (pp. 20–21)

Social workers are both trained and ethically obligated to advocate for their patients. This may lead to interprofessional strain because other professionals may be annoyed by patient and family behavior that does not fi t neatly with the policies and procedures of health-care agen- cies or institutions. Physicians and nurses may get frustrated with the parents of an infant in an intensive care nursery who visit only late at night. They may view the parents as negligent because they do not spend the entire day with the ill child and awaken the baby when they do visit. While empathizing with the staff’s need to cope with visitation beyond the “normal” visiting hours, the social worker can inform the team about the parents’ work schedules that preclude daytime visits. The social worker also can advocate for these parents, pointing out that despite working during the day, the parents visit every day, spending several hours with the in- fant, and are indeed very devoted parents. So- cial work advocacy also can play a role when issues arise regarding nontraditional families. In situations in which the medical team does not view a same-sex partner as legitimate, so- cial workers can advocate for inclusion of such partners in care planning.

Health Social Work Recommendations

Many recommendations can be made to maxi- mize health team collaboration. Professional differences in health settings can be reframed as assets rather than liabilities. A biopsycho- social model of health requires the perspec- tives of a number of professionals to most effectively deliver health services. In terms of training transdisciplinary health profession- als, Headrick and Khaleel (2008) suggest that students should be offered a curriculum that integrates theory and practice content from each discipline and that students should have interprofessional learning and training op- portunities. An example of a transdisciplinary education model is the Institute for Healthcare Improvement’s Open School, which offers students from social work, medicine, nurs- ing, pharmacy, physical therapy, public health, dentistry, and other schools transdisciplinary learning opportunities online and at chapter meetings across the country (see www.ihi.org/ ihi for more details).

Cowles (2003, p. 21) lists specifi c objec- tives that are essential to maximal team col- laboration:

• Role clarity and fl exibility

• Mutual respect and trust

• Consensus on group norms, values, com- mitment, and purpose

• An egalitarian attitude; a sense of equal im- portance

• A sense of group bond and interdependence rather than autonomy

• Open communication and sharing

• Flexible leadership and decision making; shared power

• Flexible membership composition based on case needs

• A stable core membership

• A sense of both group and professional identity

• Ability to negotiate and reach consensus

• Goal focus and goal clarity

• Record keeping of meetings

JWBT514_ch02.indd 33JWBT514_ch02.indd 33 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

34 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

• Attention to both the task and maintenance functions of the team

• A systems perspective

Health social workers need to remember that clients do not normally present to the health-care system for social work services specifi cally; rather, they present with medical needs that have psychosocial components. As such, it is the social worker’s responsibility to be familiar with the biological aspects of the biopsychosocial care model. Social workers should enhance their understanding of medical issues and terminology so that they are knowl- edgeable when talking to patients and their families and can participate fully on health- care teams.

Bronstein (2003) suggests a model of trans- disciplinary collaboration grounded in the frameworks of collaboration theory, role the- ory, and ecological systems theory. Bronstein’s model proposes that transdisciplinary teams should include interdependence of the individ- ual team members, newly created professional activities, fl exibility, collective ownership of goals, and process refl ection. In this model, interdependence refers to frequent communi- cation, interaction, and mutual respect among team members. Newly created professional activities represent collaborative opportunities that take advantage of team members’ indi- vidual expertise to achieve team outcomes that would be diffi cult to accomplish if team mem- bers worked alone.

Health social workers can support and re- inforce other team members’ roles rather than engage in turf wars and provide staff education on psychosocial issues to other team mem- bers (Nason & Delbanco, 1976). Globerman, White, Mullings, and Davies (2003) recom- mend that social workers minimize role con- fl ict with other members of the health team by proactively defi ning and promoting their unique roles and tasks, continuously updating their knowledge base related to the relevant practice area, and acknowledging the exper- tise of other professionals. They also advise that social workers evaluate and track the im- pact of their services. Doing this allows social

workers to identify areas in which they spe- cialize, establish a niche on the team, and show the effectiveness of their unique contribution to health care. Social workers should play an active role on quality assurance or continuous quality improvement committees.

As Kayser, Hansen, and Groves (1995) state:

[T]o obtain resources and the commitment from hospital administrations to provide comprehensive services, social work depart- ments need to continually collect the data that substantiates that they are the profes- sionals best trained for such responsibilities and can deliver the services in the most cost- effective manner. (p. 498)

This is particularly true in the era of managed care, for which medical spending is limited and cost containment is mandated by health organizations (Segal, 2002). If social work- ers can show that they reduce medical costs by reducing hospital stays, increasing patient satisfaction and quality of life, and reducing morbidity and mortality, they can maintain their presence in health organizations. Social workers also need to equip themselves with the skills to intervene effectively with patients on a short-term or ad hoc basis.

Simmons (1989) reviewed the fi scal advan- tage of social work services in health-care set- tings and noted that social workers conserve institutional resources in several ways. They link patients with insurance and resources and thus increase reimbursement, reduce hospital stays through effective discharge planning and linkages to outpatient resources, increase ser- vice provision through outreach and program planning and mediating confl icts between pa- tients and providers, enhance revenue through the creation of new programs and services, and improve the productivity of the medical team by participating in employee assistance pro- grams that support team members.

Health social workers also must advocate for themselves as active members of health teams. Lee (2002) and Globerman (1999) recommend that health social workers cre- ate literature that informs other professionals and consumers about the role of health social

JWBT514_ch02.indd 34JWBT514_ch02.indd 34 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Social Work Roles and Health-Care Settings 35

workers, provide team training about the social work activities and roles, provide evidence of the effectiveness of social work services, and be visible parts of health settings by vol- unteering to be part of task forces and com- mittees. Social workers must document their interventions with patients and their families. Brief, quickly completed forms may suffi ce to achieve this aim if social workers are burdened by large caseloads and time constraints.

Changes in health-care delivery and or- ganizational constraints affect all members of the health team. Just as they help cli- ents cope with illness, its treatment, and the changes that illness entails, social workers can use those skills to help the health-care team adapt to hospital and program restruc- turing (Globerman, 1999). Social workers can provide professional support to their colleagues when they face challenging pa- tient situations, such as when patients die (Roberts, 1989). These efforts allow health social workers to help minimize role confl ict with other team members as well as demon- strate that social work is effective.

TREATING THE WHOLE PERSON: SOCIAL WORK’S PRIMARY ROLE

Health social workers fi ll various roles, work in myriad settings, and perform a broad collec- tion of tasks on the clinical and administrative levels. Social work fulfi lls a critical function in the biopsychosocial approach to health care. As Romano (1981) wrote:

[S]ocial work occupies a unique position in that it has its feet in health and mental health, its hands in the social sciences, its viscera in clinical intervention skills, and its head and heart in a commitment to the issues of the quality of life of disabled persons in society. (p. 15)

Although fi scal, organizational, and profes- sional challenges exist in providing health services that fully incorporate the biologi- cal, social, and psychological determinants

of health, social work is a vital component to health teams to explain and signifi cantly affect the complex pathways through which variables at different levels infl uence health (Keefl er, Duder, & Lechman, 2001).

SUGGESTED LEARNING EXERCISES

Learning Exercise 2.1

As a group, compile a list of questions to ask a health social worker based on what you learned in this chapter. You may want to ask about the social worker’s role or roles, tasks, and ethical challenges as well as if the social worker is part of an transdisciplinary health-care team. Find a health social worker in your commu- nity and arrange an individual interview, using the list of questions your group creates for this exercise. Be sure that your group interviews social workers working in a variety of health- care settings, including those who work with individuals and families and those who work on a community level or in a research institu- tion. Either by an oral presentation or a written synopsis, report back to the group the informa- tion that you obtain.

Learning Exercise 2.2

Using the profi les of health social workers throughout this chapter and information that your group gathers from the interviews in Ex- ercise 2.1, compare and contrast the different roles in health-care settings. What is it exactly that health social workers do? How are the roles in different settings similar? How are they different? What types of transdisciplinary teams and ethical challenges do different so- cial workers encounter? What are the differ- ences and similarities between clinical health social workers and those who work in an ad- ministrative or policy-level capacity?

Learning Exercise 2.3

Using information from this chapter and the interviews from Learning Exercise 2.1, discuss the differences between social workers and the

JWBT514_ch02.indd 35JWBT514_ch02.indd 35 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

36 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

other members of the health-care team. What are some fundamental differences? What does social work uniquely bring to the care of pa- tients? What are differences in the codes of ethics of different professions? How can these differences manifest themselves in health set- tings at various levels? What are some ex- amples of professional challenges or clashes? How can social workers collaborate most ef- fectively with other professionals on a team-, agency-, and policy-level setting? How might you as a health social worker make a case for why social work, social services, case manage- ment, or patient education is your domain and not that of another discipline? (You also may incorporate content from Chapter 1 and so- cial work history course(s) in answering these questions.)

Learning Exercise 2.4

Richard is a 38-year-old, married African American male who previously was diagnosed with type 1 diabetes. Recently, Richard was diagnosed with kidney failure. He is married with three children, ages 5, 10, and 12, and just started a job as an electrician. Richard is an only child and has limited social support network members. Although his wife is an ac- tive member of a Baptist church, Richard does not consider himself to be religious and does not attend church services with his family. He is the sole income provider for his family. Be- cause Richard is in a probationary period for his new job, he will not qualify for employee group health insurance for two more months and thus cannot miss a day of work without risking termination. Richard’s health problems and new job have caused him a signifi cant amount of stress and increased marital discord. This is exacerbated by long work days and fre- quent overtime work. Richard’s acute kidney failure condition has progressed to the point at which he will have to start dialysis, and he has been referred to a kidney transplant program for an evaluation by the transdisciplinary team that includes a transplant social worker. The team will interview Richard and determine if he is a candidate for a kidney transplant.

As mentioned in this chapter, psychosocial barriers can impact whether a patient will be considered for a transplant. Considering the biopsychosocial approach, identify factors that the transplant social worker may consider when assessing Richard. If possible, role-play a screening assessment of Richard with another member of your group. (This can be done by several dyads of group members.) Discuss as a group what items should be included in this social work assessment and why. Should the social worker recommend that Richard receive a kidney transplant, based on his biopsycho- social assessment? What are the benefi ts of a transdisciplinary approach in the kidney trans- plant center?

Learning Exercise 2.5

Using information from this and other chapters in this book, pick a setting that may employ a health social worker. Create a brochure or hand- out for clients or customers of that setting that describes the role of the social worker in that organization. Be sure to include information about the different services and tasks that the social worker is responsible for in that setting.

SUGGESTED RESOURCES

The National Association of Social Work (www.socialworkers.org) has numerous re- sources for health social work, including a health specialty practice section, social work summits that include health social work or- ganizations, continuing education modules (available online) regarding social work and various health-care settings (such as oncology and end of life), and social work clinical indi- cators for various health settings.

Additional Resources for Social Workers American Case Management Association—

www.acmaweb.org The goal of the American Case

Management Association is to pro- vide the highest quality professional developmental services such as mentor- ing, resource information, educational

JWBT514_ch02.indd 36JWBT514_ch02.indd 36 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Social Work Roles and Health-Care Settings 37

forums, and new opportunities for net- working.

American Lung Association—www.lungusa .org

The American Lung Association is the leading organization working to save lives by preventing lung disease and im- proving lung health through education, advocacy, and research. The main goals of the organization are to stop tobacco use and tobacco-related lung disease, improve the air we breathe, and reduce the burden of lung disease on patients and their families.

American Network of Home Health Care Social Workers—www.homehealth socialwork.org

This network is a professional asso- ciation organized for the benefi t of so- cial workers in health-care settings. Its Web site has an abundance of resources related to health-care issues.

American Public Health Association— www.apha.org

The American Public Health Asso- ciation is made up of and represents a diverse group of health professionals and others who are concerned about their health or the health of their com- munities. The association aims to protect families and communities from prevent- able, serious health threats and to ensure accessible education within the commu- nity regarding health services and dis- ease prevention.

Association of Oncology Social Work— www.aosw.org

The Association of Oncology Social Work (AOSW) is a not-for-profi t organi- zation geared toward improving the psy- chosocial services of clients with cancer and their families. AOSW strives to im- prove services through education, advo- cacy, networking, research, and resource development.

Association of Pediatric Oncology Social Workers—www.aposw.org

The mission of the Association of Pediatric Oncology Social Workers is to

enhance pediatric psychosocial oncol- ogy care through clinical social work practice, advocacy, research, education, and program development. Some of their goals include advocating for both na- tional and international policies that will improve the lives of children with cancer and their families as well as promote the ethical standards of social workers work- ing in pediatric oncology.

Association of State and Territorial Public Health Social Workers—www.astho.org

The Association of State and Ter- ritorial Public Health Social Workers is a not-for-profi t organization that repre- sents the public health agencies of the United States, U.S. territories, the Dis- trict of Columbia, and its own public health employees. The agency’s main focus is to create and infl uence sound public health policies as well as ensure excellence in state-based public health practice.

Council of Nephrology Social Work— www.kidney.org/professionals/CNSW/ index.cfm

The Council of Nephrology Social Work works within the National Kidney Foundation as a professional member- ship council while also networking with other agencies, the government, and pri- vate groups. Its purpose is to aid patients and their families with the various psy- chosocial stressors of kidney disease and to support federal regulations governing standards of nephrology social work practice.

Council on Social Work Education—www .cswe.org

The Council on Social Work Educa- tion is a partnership of educational and professional institutions, social welfare agencies, and individual members. It is the only recognized accrediting agency for social work education in the country.

Epilepsy Foundation—www.epilepsyfound ation.org

The Epilepsy Foundation is a voluntary agency dedicated solely to the welfare of

JWBT514_ch02.indd 37JWBT514_ch02.indd 37 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

38 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

patients and their families with epilepsy. The agency strives to ensure that people with seizures are able to engage in all life experiences, to improve how people with epilepsy are viewed within society, and to promote research.

National Association of Children’s Hos- pitals and Related Institutions—www .childrenshospitals.net

The National Association of Chil- dren’s Hospitals and Related Institu- tions is a not-for-profi t agency made up of children’s hospitals, large pediatric units in medical centers, and related health systems. This agency is a voice for health-care systems and ensures chil- dren’s access to services and hospitals’ ability to provide services that are needed by children.

National Association of Perinatal Social Workers—www.napsw.org

This organization provides support and a forum to communicate for perina- tal social workers and the unique situa- tions in which they work, sharing knowl- edge as well as ensuring excellence in social work practice regarding families and individuals during pregnancy and the fi rst year of life.

National Hospice and Palliative Care Organization—www.nhpco.org

This organization is dedicated to en- hancing end-of-life care and expanding access to hospice care with the goal of profoundly improving quality of life for people dying in the United States and their families.

National Multiple Sclerosis Society— www.nationalmssociety.org

The National Multiple Sclerosis Society helps individuals throughout the nation fi ght the challenges associ- ated with living with multiple sclero- sis (MS). The society funds research to prevent, treat, and cure MS and provides advocacy and education for communities as well as services for individuals and their families dealing with MS.

Social Work Policy Institute—www .socialworkpolicy.org

The Social Work Policy Institute is a think tank created under the National Association of Social Workers (NASW). Their main ideals are to strengthen social work’s voice in public policy, to educate policy makers through the collection and disbursement on the effectiveness of social work, and to create a forum to discuss issues in health care and social service delivery.

Society for Social Work Leadership in Health Care—www.sswlhc.org

This organization is committed to pro- moting the universal availability, acces- sibility, coordination, and effectiveness of health care in regard to the psychosocial components of health and illness.

Society for Transplant Social Workers— www.transplantsocialworker.org/index .cfm

This organization is dedicated to pro- moting and ensuring ethical social work practice and encourage research and publication on psychosocial issues re- lated to transplants.

Veterans Health Administration—www1 .va.gov/health

The Veterans Health Administration serves the needs of U.S. veterans by pro- viding primary care, specialized care, and related medical and social support services.

INTERNATIONAL SOCIAL WORK ORGANIZATIONS

International Federation of Social Work- ers—www.ifsw.org

The International Federation of So- cial Workers is a worldwide organization striving for social justice, human rights, and social development through the growth of social workers, ethical prac- tices, and the international cooperation and communication of social workers and their professional organizations.

JWBT514_ch02.indd 38JWBT514_ch02.indd 38 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Social Work Roles and Health-Care Settings 39

The countries listed have Web sites for their national social work organizations.

Asian and Pacifi c Association for Social Work Education—www.apaswe.info

Australian Association of Social Workers— www.aasw.asn.au

Austria—www.sozialarbeit.at Brazilian Congress of Social Workers—

www.cfess.org.br/_ingles/home.php British Association of Social Workers—

www.basw.co.uk Canadian Association of Social Workers—

www.casw-acts.ca Danish Association of Social Workers—

www.socialrdg.dk Finland Union of Professional Social Work-

ers—www.talentia.fi France Association of Social Workers—

www.anas.fr Ghana Association of Social Workers—

www.gasow.org Hellenic Association of Social Workers—

www.skle.gr Hong Kong Social Workers Association—

www.hkswa.org.hk/chi Icelandic Association of Social Workers—

www.felagsradgjof.is India: National Association of Profes-

sional Social Workers in India—www .napswionline.org

Irish Association of Social Workers—www .iasw.ie

Israel Association of Social Workers— www.socialwork.org.il

Italy—www.assnas.it Japanese Association of Psychiatric Social

Workers—www.japsw.or.jp Japanese Association of Social Workers—

www.jasw.jp Korea Association of Social Workers—

www.welfare.net/site/global/globalEng .jsp

Kyrgyz Republic: Association of Social Workers of the Kyrgyz Republic—http:// asw.gratis.kg

Luxembourg—www.anasig.lu New Zealand: Aotearoa New Zealand As-

sociation of Social Workers—http:// anzasw.org.nz

Portugal—www.apross.pt Romanian Association for the Promotion of

Social Work—www.fnasr.ro Singapore Association of Social Workers—

www.sasw.org.sg Spain—www.cgtrabajosocial.es Sri Lanka Association of Professional So-

cial Workers—www.slapsw.org/index .html

Sweden—www.akademssr.se Swedish Union of Local Government

Offi cers—www.sktf.se/Default.aspx Switzerland—www.avenirsocial.ch Social Workers’ Association of Thailand—

www.nontapum.com Uruguay—www.adasu.org/menu.htm

REFERENCES

Alveo, G. (2001). Change in social work service in the VA system. Continuum, 21(1), 8–14.

Bateman, N., & Whitaker, T. (2002). The employment outlook for social workers. National Association of Social Workers Intersections in Practice, 1, 7–9.

Ben-Zur, H., Rappaport, B., Ammar, R., & Uretzky, G. (2000). Coping strategies, life style changes, and pessimism after open-heart surgery. Health & Social Work, 25(3), 201–209.

Berkman, B. (1996). The emerging health-care world: Implications for social work practice and education. Social Work, 41(5), 541–551.

Bronstein, L. (2003). A model for interdisciplinary collaboration. Social Work, 48(3), 297–306.

Carlton, T. O. (1984). Clinical social work in health settings. New York, NY: Springer.

Cowles, L. A. (2003). Social work in the health fi eld: A care perspective. Binghamton, NY: Haworth Press.

Danis, F. S. (2003). The criminalization of domestic violence: What social workers need to know. Social Work, 48(3), 237–246.

Dhooper, S. (1994). Social work and transplantation of human organs. Westport, CT: Praeger.

Engel, G. L. (1977). The need for a new medical model: A challenge for biomedicine. Science, 196(4286), 129–136.

Gambrill, E. D. (1997). Social work practice: A critical thinker’s guide. New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Globerman, J. (1999). Hospital restructuring: Positioning social work to manage change. Social Work in Health Care, 28(4), 13–30.

JWBT514_ch02.indd 39JWBT514_ch02.indd 39 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

40 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

Globerman, J., White, J., & McDonald, G. (2003). Social work in restructuring hospitals: Program management fi ve years later. Health & Social Work, 27(4), 274–283.

Globerman, J., White, J. J., Mullings, D., & Davies, J. M. (2003). Thriving in program management environments: The case of social work in hospitals. Social Work in Health Care, 38(2), 1–18.

Headrick, L. A., & Khaleel, N. I. (2008). Getting it right: Educating professionals to work together in improving health and health care. Journal of Interprofessional Care, 22(4), 364–374.

Holliman, D., Dziegielewski, S. F., & Teare, R. (2003). Differences and similiarites between social work and nurse discharge planners. Health & Social Work, 28(4), 224–231.

Kayser, K., Hansen, P., & Groves, A. (1995). Evaluating social work practice in a medical setting: How do we meet the challenges of a rapidly changing system? Research on Social Work Practice, 5(4), 485–500.

Keefl er, J., Duder, S., & Lechman, C. (2001). Predicting length of stay in an acute care hospital: The role of psychosocial problems. Social Work in Health Care, 33(2), 1–16.

Lee, J. S. (2002). Social work services in home health care: Challenges for the new prospective payment system era. Social Work in Health Care, 35(3), 23–36.

Lindau, S. T., Laumann, E. O., Levinson, W., & Waite, L. J. (2003). Synthesis of scientifi c disciplines in pursuit of health: The interactive biopsychosocial model. Perspectives in Biology and Medicine, 46(3, Suppl.), S74–S86.

Livneh, H. (2000). Psychosocial adaptation to cancer: The role of coping strategies. Journal of Rehabilitation, 66(2), 40–49.

McGuire, J., Bikson, K., & Blue-Howells, J. (2005). How many social workers are needed in primary care? A patient-based needs assessment example. Health & Social Work, 30(4), 305–313.

McWilliam, W. (2009). Patients, persons or partners? Involving those with chronic disease in their care. Chronic Illness, 5(4), 277–292.

Miller, M. S., & Rehr, H. (1983). Social work issues in health care. Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice-Hall.

Monster, T. B., Johnsen, S. P., Olsen, M. L., McLaughlin, J. K., & Sorenson, H. T. (2004). Antidepressants and risk of fi rst-time hospitalization of myocardial infarction: A population-based case-control study. American Journal of Medicine, 117, 732–737.

Nason, F., & Delbanco, T. (1976). Soft services: A major, cost-effective component of primary medical care. Social Work in Health Care, 1(3), 297–308.

Rehr, H. (1982). Social work and medicine at Mount Sinai: Then and now. In H. Rehr (Ed.), Milestones in social work and medicine (pp. 2–59). New York, NY: Prodist.

Roberts, C. S. (1989). Confl icting professional values in social work and medicine. Health & Social Work, 14, 211–218.

Rock, B. D., & Cooper, M. (2000). Social work in primary care. Social Work in Health Care, 31(1), 1–17.

Rolland, J. S. (1994). Families, illness, and disability: An integrative treatment model. New York, NY: Basic Books.

Romano, M. (1981). Social worker’s role in rehabilitation: A review of the literature. In J. Brown, B. Kirlin, & S. Watt (Eds.), Rehabilitation services and the social work role: Challenge for change (pp. 13–21). Baltimore, MD: Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.

Rose, M., Fliege, H., Hildebrandt, M., Schirop, T., & Klapp, B. F. (2002). The network of psychological variables in patients with diabetes and their importance for quality of life and metabolic control. Diabetes Care, 25(1), 35–42.

Segal, S. P. (2002). Introduction: Pt. 3. Social Work in Health Care, 35(1/2), 351–358.

Simmons, W. J. (1989). Benefi ts of social work in hospitals. In B. S. Vourlekis & C. G. Leukefeld (Eds.), Making our case: A resource book of selected materials for social workers in health care (pp. 36–39). Silver Spring, MD: National Association of Social Workers.

Sommers, L. S., Marton, K. I., Barbaccia, J. C., & Randolph, J. (2000). Physician, nurse, and social worker collaboration in primary care for chronically ill seniors. Archives of Internal Medicine, 160(12), 1825–1833.

Sulman, J., Savage, D., & Way, S. (2001). Retooling social work practice for high volume, short stay. Social Work in Health Care, 34(3/4), 315–332.

Sormanti, M., & Shibusawa, T. (2008). Intimate partner violence among midlife and older women: A descriptive analysis of women seeking medical services. Health & Social Work, 33(1), 33–41.

Thompson, S. J., Auslander, W. F., & White, N. H. (2001). Infl uence of family structure on health among youths with diabetes. Health & Social Work, 26(1), 7–14.

U.S. Department of Labor. (2010). Occupational outlook handbook 2010–2011 Edition: Social Workers. Retrieved from www.bls.gov/oco/pdf/ocos060.pdf.

U.S. News & World Report. (2010). The 50 best careers of 2011. Retrieved from http://money.usnews.com/ money/careers/articles/2010/12/06/the-50-best- careers-of-2011.html.

JWBT514_ch02.indd 40JWBT514_ch02.indd 40 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

41

3

Ethics and Social Work in Health Care

JARED SPARKS

If this is the best of all possible worlds, what are the others like?

—Voltaire, 1759

When confronted with the harsh reality of illness and suffering that existed in the 18th century, the French author and philosopher Voltaire expressed his feelings of incredulity that such conditions were tolerated. Even now, as the tools of science and technology have ad- vanced society’s understanding of biology and the human condition, humankind continues to feel a sense of astonishment and vulnerability in the face of unresolved modern health-care issues and ethical dilemmas.

Today lives are increasingly infl uenced by human invention even prior to conception through genetic counseling and intervention. As a person progresses through each devel- opmental stage of life, choices must be made regarding available health options. These can be especially diffi cult at the end of life.

The purpose of this chapter is to facilitate discussion and understanding of health social work ethics in a changing health-care environ- ment. Toward this end, some of the philosophi- cal foundations of ethics are reviewed and the history of social work ethics is discussed, as are decision making, theoretical frameworks, and other special topics.

Chapter Objectives • Discuss the development of social work

ethics, medical ethics, and bioethics within a historical and cultural context.

• Defi ne ethical terminology and theory as these relate to the social work code of ethics.

• Outline decision-making models and theo- retical applications as they relate to social work ethics in health care.

• Discuss particular ethical issues related to dual relationships, managed care, and re- search ethics.

• Outline ethical challenges in the 21st cen- tury and beyond.

OVERVIEW OF ETHICAL ISSUES IN SOCIAL WORK

Within each chapter of this book and the con- comitant practice areas in social work reside compelling ethical issues and questions. Social workers play an important role in addressing these issues and answering these questions. In health social work, practitioners inform pa- tients of their treatment and discharge options, advocate for patients within a transdisciplinary team, serve on ethics committees, and shape policy. These experiences provide a unique and valuable opportunity to gain both a micro- and macro-level perspective of health social work ethics. The ability to articulate a position clearly and effect change depends on understanding the ethical issues involved. Today more than at any time in history social workers must have a

JWBT514_ch03.indd 41JWBT514_ch03.indd 41 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

42 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

working knowledge of ethical dilemmas in health care and how health social work ethics may be employed to address these dilemmas.

Social workers and other health-care pro- fessionals may prefer to think of themselves discretely as completely homogeneous groups, each profession holding a unique value system and set of beliefs. All social workers may have an idea of what health social work ethics con- stitute and suggest. In reality, however, not everyone shares the same concept of exactly what that may be. The 18th-century French author Diderot described an appreciation of differences in understanding from person to person in his work D’Alembert’s Dream.

For the obvious reason that no two of us are exactly alike, we never understand exactly and are never exactly understood. There is always an element of “more or less”—our speech falls short of the real sensation or overshoots it. We realize how much variety there is in people’s opinions, and “there is a thousand times more that we don’t notice and fortunately cannot no- tice” (Diderot, 1769/1976, p. 222).

Diderot reveals some unease in considering the possibility of understanding exactly how someone else experiences or interprets a cer- tain phenomenon. It does seem fortunate that individuals experience life differently. In the study of health social work ethics, consensus may be reached fairly easily. That will not al- ways be the case, and care should be taken to respect different opinions.

Throughout the course of a career, most so- cial workers encounter situations for which no completely desirable solutions can be found, because each alternative has its own set of un- desirable outcomes. Proctor, Morrow-Howell, and Lott (1993) further defi ne ethical dilem- mas as situations “when a social worker can- not adhere to professional values or when adhering to one ethic requires behaving coun- ter to another” (p. 166).

Reamer (1987, pp. 801–809) identifi ed eight areas of importance when considering ethical dilemmas in social work: (1) confi - dentiality and privileged communication; (2) truthfulness; (3) paternalism and self-determi- nation; (4) laws, policies, and regulation; (5)

whistle-blowing; (6) distributing limited re- sources; (7) personal and professional values; and (8) ethical decision making. Some of these topics are discussed throughout this chapter.

In contemplating ethical dilemmas, the point of ethical discourse is not necessarily to arrive at an immutably “right” solution. Value lies in thoughtful review and discussion. Through the process of ethics discourse, a more complete understanding may be reached, and alternative courses of action may appear; if not, there may be at the very least an appreciation that what- ever decision was reached was the result of in- formed and thoughtful consideration rather than the singular expressed preference of a party in- volved in the patient’s care.

Ethics codes provide some direct guidance for practice. Lowenberg and Dolgoff (1996) identifi ed four other purposes of codes of ethics:

1. Protect the public.

2. Protect the profession. (Self-regulation is a hallmark of a profession and ideally more effective than governmental involvement.)

3. Prevent internal strife.

4. Protect practitioners from lawsuits. (The ra- tionale for why a specifi c course of action was taken provides some defense against lawsuits.)

Before we discuss individual cases in which some of the purposes of codes of ethics may be made clear, we review the philosophic founda- tion of social work ethics. This review should not be considered comprehensive. You are en- couraged to read on your own in this area to develop a more complete understanding and to prepare yourself to use the code of ethics in your social work practice.

ETHICS TERMINOLOGY AND THEORY

Most social workers do not have formal train- ing in philosophy as it relates to ethics. Sepa- rate classes in professional ethics seldom are

JWBT514_ch03.indd 42JWBT514_ch03.indd 42 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Ethics and Social Work in Health Care 43

present in a social work curriculum. In prac- tice, many social workers will fi nd that their state social work boards require ongoing ethics education as a condition of licensure. Formal training and continuing education help develop ethical thought and practice in the profession. However, regardless of how little or how much of an ethics background social workers have, when in practice, they frequently engage in ethical discourse.

A basic understanding of terminology helps clarify thought and decision making in eth- ics. The National Association of Social Work (NASW) code of ethics provides some useful content. In an effort to supplement this content, special attention is paid in this chapter to vocab- ulary in the form of defi nition and distinction. Words like values, morals, and even ethics often are used interchangeably, yet their distinctions are important to social work practice.

Values

A discussion of values is fundamental to the study of professional ethics. Although they have specifi c meaning as they relate to social work ethics, values exist in personal, profes- sional, and societal contexts. Confusion may arise from explanations of this notion because a multitude of defi nitions for the term values exists depending on the branch of philosophy or social theorist making reference to it. Fur- thermore, the term values has been co-opted by a variety of political infl uences, each claim- ing to have a more correct grasp of what values are. Nonetheless, through all this contention, values have specifi c and signifi cant meaning in a code of ethics.

The word value is derived from the Latin word valere, which means “be worthy, be strong” (Angeles, 1992). The Harper Col- lins Dictionary of Philosophy defi nes value as “worth; the quality of a thing that makes it desirable, desired, useful, or an object of in- terest,” as well as “of excellence; that which is esteemed, prized or regarded highly, or as a good.” As value relates to human behavior, Rokeach (1973) provided this defi nition: “an enduring belief that a specifi c mode or end

state of existence is personally or socially pref- erable to an opposite or converse mode or end state of existence” (p. 23). Values serve as ide- als of what is right. Within professions, values constitute what is unique and good that sets one profession apart from others.

As a profession, social work holds these core values: service, social justice, dignity and worth of the person, importance of human re- lationships, integrity, and competence (NASW, 2000). According to Reamer (1995), “Social work is among the most value-based of all professions” (p. 3).

Before attempting to identify, understand, and comment on ethical dilemmas, health social workers should examine their personal values. Each person has personal values that have been shaped by family, friends, culture, and prior life experiences. These personal values infl uence how dilemmas are viewed and whether a prac- titioner accepts the profession’s core values. Understanding differences in individual value bases has special relevance as practitioners in- teract with patients operating from value posi- tions different from their own. Hodge (2003) underscored this in an article providing data to suggest that the values of master’s level social workers “were more to the left of working and middle class clients” (p. 107).

Morals

Morals is a term derived from the Latin word moralis, meaning custom, manners, or char- acter. Morals have been defi ned as consisting of “principles or rules of conduct which de- fi ne standards for right behavior” (Lowenberg & Dolgoff, 1996, p. 22). Morals encompass widely accepted notions of right and wrong. Although morals are not necessarily outlined in the NASW Code of Ethics, they do shape how social workers develop professional and personal values.

Laws

Laws also has been defi ned in different ways. Some defi nitions point to concerns with pro- tection from abuses of power by authorities

JWBT514_ch03.indd 43JWBT514_ch03.indd 43 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

44 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

as well as individuals. Other defi nitions refer more to social control and welfare, and still others emphasize more consideration of social justice.

Laws, ethics, and values all have unique meanings. Simply passing legislation does not change individuals’ deep-seated beliefs and ideas regarding a particular issue. For exam- ple, passing laws proscribing assisted suicide will not change people’s personal perspectives. Simply attending to the law does not protect social workers from behaving in a profession- ally unethical way. When laws are passed that are unjust, social workers have an obligation to work through the courts to address social injustice. For example, NASW is active in ad- dressing legislation affecting health-care is- sues such as prescription drug coverage.

Principles and Standards

Principles in a code of ethics may be thought of as a stage in the formation of values. In their own right, principles can serve as an ideal, of sorts. Principles inform social work practice (Reamer, 1995) and offer a reference point for the development of even more spe- cifi c standards. Standards in a code of ethics specifi cally outline how social workers should conduct themselves.

Ethics

Ethics is a term derived from the Greek word ethos, which means a person’s character or disposition (Angeles, 1992). There are several ways of defi ning ethics. For the purposes of this chapter, ethics will be divided into three branches: metaethics, normative ethics, and applied ethics.

Metaethics

Metaethics asks the questions “What does something really mean?” or “What does it re- ally mean to be ‘good’ or ‘bad’?” The term metaethics refers to the study of the “methods, language, logical structure, and reasoning used to arrive at and justify moral decisions and knowledge” (Angeles, 1992, p. 183).

Normative Ethics

In contrast to metaethics, normative ethics is concerned with identifi cation of the morals, values, principles, or standards that might be relevant in addressing a dilemma. In developing a normative ethical response to such a situation, several values and principles might be relevant. The NASW 2000 Code of Ethics wisely re- fl ects that there are situations in which values, standards, and principles confl ict. In these situ- ations, two reasonable and informed practitio- ners may disagree on what constitutes an ethical response to a clinical situation.

Applied Ethics

Applied ethics is a third branch of ethics and is concerned with the application of normative ethics (a relevant set of morals, values, princi- ples, and standards) to specifi c situations. This would be the stage at which decisions actually are made. Social workers should consider if the ethical standard regarding legal obliga- tions supersedes the principles of autonomy and self-determination or if they feel that they should act to have the law changed.

Ethics can be defi ned within each of the three contexts—metaethics, normative ethics, and applied ethics. That is, ethics can be con- sidered: (a) a branch of philosophy interested in value-based reasoning and human conduct; (b) a framework of morals, values, principles, and standards; or (c) the actual decision-making process derived from that specifi c framework. As it relates to social work in health care, Joseph and Conrad (1989) provide a defi nition of ethical behavior as “social workers’ profes- sional behaviors in relation to biomedical ethi- cal choices” (p. 23). The next section provides a discussion of ethical issues related to a topic that health social workers may encounter re- lated to end-of-life care.

End-of-Life Care

The right-to-die debate resurfaced in 2005 with the case of Terri Schiavo, whose husband had her feeding tube and hydration removed against her parents’ wishes. This case provides

JWBT514_ch03.indd 44JWBT514_ch03.indd 44 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Ethics and Social Work in Health Care 45

an example of just how divisive ethical dilem- mas can become. Schiavo’s case was not the fi rst to capture national attention. Two other women, Karen Quinlan and Nancy Cruzan, similarly faced the court’s involvement in their right-to-die cases. Both women suffered brain damage and never regained consciousness to the point that they were able to verbalize their wishes. Karen Quinlan’s breathing tube ulti- mately was removed, but she lived another 10 years. Nancy Cruzan’s parents won a lengthy court battle to have her feeding and hydra- tion stopped. Cruzan died two weeks after her feeding tube was removed. Both Quinlan and Cruzan died in the 1980s. Amid even more controversy, Schiavo died on March 31, 2005, 13 days after her feeding tube was removed. These cases all refl ect fundamental moral, ethical, and religious differences in this coun- try. They also point to a strong need for health social workers to be attentive to their patients’ wishes and advocate for completing advance directive documents specifying such wishes.

When responding to challenging situations such as the ones just described, the practitioner should fi rst examine his or her own values as they relate to the wishes of the patient. A social worker’s values may differ from the patient’s and interfere with the ability to engage in a meaningful discussion. In a study of 110 hos- pice social workers, Csikai (2004) found that among the least discussed issues in hospice care were those of euthanasia and thoughts of suicide by a patient even though 34% of the social workers had been approached by their patients about assisted death. Under no circumstance should the social worker fail to address the patient’s concerns. In situations in which a social worker’s values confl ict with those of a patient, it may be necessary to refer the patient to a colleague.

One of the fi rst responses to a patient who is requesting to die should be a careful screening for depression and a review of any other possi- ble health treatment modalities. It may be that after careful consideration and review of op- tions the patient will still wish to die. However, it also may be that he would like reassurance from his family that he will be cared for and

will not be a burden or abandoned (Csikai, 1999). The patient also might be concerned about what options his life could hold. After these issues are addressed adequately, the pa- tient might not continue to wish for euthanasia or assisted death.

Metaethics may be relevant in situations in which social workers believe that suicide is wrong. Questions considered in metaethi- cal analysis include why it is wrong and if it is wrong in all situations. The defi nition of suicide infl uences any subsequent conversa- tion. Metaethics would be involved in under- standing whether suicide is wrong in the case of a suffering patient. Metaethics also would be concerned with questions about what sui- cide is. Is it suicide when it is physician as- sisted—that is, a doctor gives a competent patient the medications or other means to end his life? Is suicide somehow different from ac- tive voluntary euthanasia when a physician in- jects a competent patient who requests a lethal amount of an opiate-based painkiller? Is forgo- ing recommended medical treatment suicide?

In contrast to metaethics, normative ethics is concerned with the identifi cation of the mor- als, values, principles, or standards that might be relevant in addressing a dilemma. A nor- mative ethics dilemma may be whether one should support assisted death or euthanasia. Normative ethics also is concerned with as- sembling a framework out of those identifi ed morals, values, principles, and standards that could be used in contemplating a specifi c in- stance of assisted death or euthanasia.

From a medical standpoint, the principles of benefi cence and nonmalfeasance apply. The principle of benefi cence basically instructs the practitioners to “do good.” The principle of nonmalfeasance instructs the practitioner to “do no harm.” From the social work code, the value in question could be dignity and worth of the person. The principles of autonomy and self-determination also seem to have bearing. However, the ethical standard of commit- ment to clients takes into account that social workers may have legal obligations falling into the realm of standards that would preclude fa- cilitating euthanasia or assisted death. Also

JWBT514_ch03.indd 45JWBT514_ch03.indd 45 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

46 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

relevant would be evaluating whether patient autonomy supersedes preserving life in such a case.

A variety of broad philosophical theories exists within an ethics code to inform and in- fl uence decision making. Both social work and medicine have been infl uenced by a number of philosophies over the years. Modern medi- cine as a profession owes more to the positiv- ist model than does social work. Positivism is the notion that reality exists, is based on fi xed laws, and is thus understandable (Guba, 1990). Science in this framework is the mechanism by which we can determine what constitutes this reality and ultimately manipulate it in our interest. This thought came about during the Enlightenment period in the late 17th and throughout the 18th centuries, when the world was being viewed more in the context of a clockwork universe that was ultimately under- standable and subject to our control (Spurlin, 1984).

At times health social work may be seen as a profession struggling to emulate the positiv- istic approaches that have led medicine to its present status in society. However, it would be diffi cult to argue that social work has not paid heed to a constructivist model. In contrast to a clockwork universe, constructivism proposes that society is not “a system, a mechanism, or an organism” (Parton, 2003, p. 5) but rather a symbolic construct relying on collaboration between the observer and observed, together creating a novel and fl uid meaning.

As it relates to social work in health care, constructivism asks that a practitioner step outside the imposed work environments (in thought) and engage his patient on her own terms in order to develop a more thorough un- derstanding of the patient, what she is experi- encing, and what she would desire. The social work injunction to “start where the patient is” and not where the social worker is or where the social worker wants the patient to be would be a step in the right direction toward con- structivism. Social workers may better provide relevant services if they understand the mean- ing imposed by a patient on her disease and the available treatments.

BASIC NORMATIVE THEORIES

Some ethics theories are more concerned with outcomes of actions. Others are more con- cerned with identifying principles, standards, and rules that can guide behavior before any action is taken. Hence, most normative ethical theory falls into the category of deontological or teleontological.

Deontological and Teleontological Theories

Deontological theory places primacy on the ethical value, standard, or principle in deter- mining the correct action without consider- ation of the outcome. For example, with the principle of confi dentiality, deontological the- ory would dictate that a social worker should under no circumstances violate the principle.

Teleontological theory is more concerned with the outcome of a particular action than with values, principles, or standards. The word teleontological comes from the Greek word telos, which means “end or goal” (Angeles, 1992, p. 369). For example, a teleontological consideration of confi dentiality would be more concerned with what would happen if this con- fi dentiality were violated.

Deontology and teleontology often clash, as do the values, principles, and standards of an ethical code. One example of this is the 1976 case of Tarasoff v. Board of Regents of the University of California (Kagle & Kopels, 1994). In this case, a patient informed his psy- chologist at the University of California that he was having homicidal ideations with Ta- tiana Tarasoff as the target. The patient even went so far as to inform his psychologist of his plans. The psychologist contacted the cam- pus police, who detained the patient for a brief time and later released him with a warning not to go near Tarasoff.

Later, the psychologist’s supervisors told him to destroy his case notes surrounding this incident, which by law is illegal and by the NASW standards would be a clear violation of the principles surrounding client records,

JWBT514_ch03.indd 46JWBT514_ch03.indd 46 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Ethics and Social Work in Health Care 47

deception, and fraud. Several months later, the patient murdered Tatiana. Tarasoff’s par- ents ultimately successfully sued the univer- sity. The California Supreme Court indicated that the university had a duty to protect, which superseded the patient’s privacy and confi dentiality.

This controversy falls within the realm of “duty to protect” or “duty to warn.” The de- ontological consideration in this case would be to attend to the ethical standard of con- fi dentiality regardless of the outcome. This consideration obviously falls apart when the outcome seems much more harmful than the violation of confi dentiality, as was affi rmed by the court. A teleontological consideration to protect the intended victim ultimately may have more of a positive benefi t in the sense that a life is saved.

In addition to framing ethical dilemmas via teleontological and deontological perspectives, other concepts such as utilitarianism, Kantian ethics, ethics of care, and virtue ethics can be applied in health social work.

Utilitarianism

Utilitarianism was strongly infl uenced by Brit- ish philosophers Jeremy Bentham and John Stuart Mills. This theory is premised on the principle of utility. Utility is the doctrine that a person ought to do that which brings about the greatest happiness to the greatest number of people or to the community as a whole. The determination of right or wrong is teleonto- logical in utilitarianism.

Utilitarianism has two main divisions: act and rule. Act utilitarianism focuses exclusively on the outcome. A classic example would be the experiments conducted by the Nazis dur- ing World War II. This “research” violated a host of ethical considerations and resulted in the torture and death of many. The question an act utilitarian might pose would be: “Could the research have some utility in providing us- able data?” The act utilitarian might insist that the data be made available to provide insight into certain human conditions, treatments, or diseases because there might be value in these data.

Rule utilitarianism, however, defers to es- tablished standards within an ethical frame- work to make the decision of what produces the most good. Research ethics has informed consent as a cornerstone for its foundation. This was clearly violated by the Nazi experi- ments. With regard to these experiments, a rule utilitarian would suggest that the use of these data might generate more harm than good by setting a precedent for using data obtained unethically.

Ethics of Duty (Kantian Ethics)

In contrast to most utilitarian thought, espe- cially act utilitarianism, stands ethics of duty. This concept was espoused by the German philosopher Immanuel Kant, who felt that the outcome of an act was not relevant to deter- mining whether it was right or wrong. Kant believed that actions were right only if they were consistent with a particular standard, fi t- ting within a categorical imperative. One way of determining what a categorical imperative was would be to pose the question “Would everyone benefi t if everyone participated in a particular act?”

Kant believed that there were basically two types of duties: perfect and imperfect. Perfect duties are duties of omission, or clear duties of things one should not do, such as steal, lie, or kill. These duties are primarily “black and white” in terms of conduct. Imperfect duties are not as clearly defi ned. They are duties of commission, such as be a good person. These duties are more diffi cult to identify because they are diffi cult to clearly extrapolate in every instance.

Ethics of Care

Gilligan’s (1982) study of morality and pur- ported differences in male and female moral reasoning brought Kant’s arguments to a new audience. She believed that there were differ- ences, but they were not necessarily indicative of moral superiority. Gilligan held that females attended more to the ethics of care than the ethics of rights and justice. The ethics of care dictates that a more constructivist approach might be taken in speaking to patients and

JWBT514_ch03.indd 47JWBT514_ch03.indd 47 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

48 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

their families. Carse (1991) identifi ed seven applications of care ethics in health settings:

1. A shift from principle-ism and institutional rules and emphasis on a more responsive relationship with the patient

2. An emphasis on self-awareness as a part of understanding others

3. Placing value on ethical discourse and not focusing exclusively on outcomes

4. A review of gender-based differences in health care

5. An emphasis on the nature and dynamics of relationships as particularly important in ethical deliberation

6. Acknowledgment of the reality of moral ambivalence

7. Consideration of what traits or virtues one should develop to further competence in ethical decision making.

Virtue Ethics

Virtue is a translation of the Greek word arete, which means “excellence” (Lacey, 1996). Both ethics of care and virtue ethics have been referred to as “theories without principles” be- cause they do not arise from specifi c principles (Munson, 2000). Although the ethics of care theory may use principles during application, virtue ethics may rely on principles even less. Virtue ethics refers to the positive attributes of a particular type of person. Carse (1991) con- sidered virtue ethics valuable in the sense that contemplating a virtue may result in a better- developed sense of professional self as it re- lates to others.

Virtue ethics may be problematic. For in- stance, ideas about what attributes a virtuous doctor must possess may vary from person to person. They might include patience, empathy, and intelligence. It may be more diffi cult to come up with an agreed-on defi nition of what attributes a virtuous social worker might have, especially as it relates to particular practice areas, even within health social work. For ex- ample, a hospital-based social worker in a case management department might be perceived

as virtuous because she is able to contain costs by discharging patients quickly. Another hos- pital-based social worker may be perceived as virtuous because he advocates for longer hos- pitalizations for his psychiatric patients.

DEVELOPMENT OF MEDICAL ETHICS, SOCIAL WORK ETHICS, AND BIOETHICS

Medical Ethics

If anyone conceal more than a single lunatic without a license, he becomes liable to a penalty of fi ve hundred pounds.

—Percival, 1803

Western medical ethics can be traced to 477 bce and the Oath of Hippocrates. How- ever, Thomas Percival’s 1803 code of ethics will serve as the starting point of this review. Although the language and perspective of this code may seem antiquated, as evidenced in the preceding passage, it intimates modern dilem- mas. For example, licensing and credentialing of health-care institutions and practitioners continue to be relevant today.

Percival was a physician in England during the late 18th and early 19th centuries. In addition to being a physician, he was a writer of morality stories for the middle class. People sought his help resolving disputes at the local Manchester Hospital. He was also familiar with larger soci- etal forces causing unrest in England, namely the introduction of spinning mills, the English slave trade, and treatment of the poor (Baker, Porter, & Porter, 1993). Much of his aware- ness of larger societal concerns can be seen in his 243-page Medical Ethics (Percival, 1803), which was progressive and thorough. Unfor- tunately, the publication has been criticized as more involved with professional etiquette than professional ethics. This criticism seems to miss the mark because topics covered are cogent even by today’s standards and include abortion, rape, medical malpractice, and the purpose of charity. To be fair, the codes of both

JWBT514_ch03.indd 48JWBT514_ch03.indd 48 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Ethics and Social Work in Health Care 49

medicine and social work have components of trade etiquette as well as more value-based considerations. Percival’s code eventually ap- peared in America in the early 1800s in a much abridged version of the original and infl uenced the American Medical Association’s (AMA) fi rst code of ethics in 1847.

Social Work Ethics

Abraham Flexner (1915) may have provided some impetus for the fi eld of social work de- veloping a unique code of ethics by posing the question of whether social work was, in fact, a profession. Flexner was one of the most in- fl uential fi gures of his day in medical educa- tion, and he imposed many changes in how education was conceptualized and delivered (Bonner, 2002). Flexner also commented on the profession of social work in his 1915 ar- ticle, “Is Social Work a Profession?” published by the New York School of Philanthropy. In this article, he outlined the necessary criteria for a profession. According to Flexner, social work had not yet met all the criteria of a pro- fession, but he posited that in some ways it was closer to doing so than law and medicine. One of the most important requirements of a profession, according to Flexner (1915), was that it should have “spirit” or values:

In so far as accepted professions are pros- ecuted at a mercenary or selfi sh level, law and medicine are no better than trades. . . . In the long run, the fi rst, main and indispensable cri- terion of a profession will be the possession of a professional spirit, and that test social work may, if with will, fully satisfy. (p. 24)

The social work community began a conversa- tion about ethics shortly after Flexner’s report. Reamer (1998) identifi ed four distinct periods of development for the social work code of ethics: the morality period, the values period, the ethical theory and decision-making period, and the ethical standards and risk management period (p. 488).

The morality period for social work oc- curred in the late 19th century and lasted until

the 1950s. Individuals receiving care from so- cial workers often were viewed as defective in some way. In the early 20th century, social workers began to attend more to social justice concerns. External infl uences of society, such as poverty, disease, and educational opportu- nities, were appreciated. The settlement house movement refl ected this concern with attempts to provide newcomers to the United States with some basic skills and understanding of how to better integrate into their new country.

Mary Richmond has been credited with drafting an early social work code of ethics in the 1920s (Reamer, 1987). This was during what was likely the beginning of the end of the morality period. During this time, articles were written on the need for social work eth- ics, and in 1923, the American Association for Organizing Family Social Work (AAOFSW) began work on a code of ethics (Lowenberg & Dolgoff, 1996). The American Association of Social Workers adopted a formal code of ethics in 1947, 100 years after the AMA’s code was adopted (Reamer, 1999). AAOFSW merged with others to form the National Association of Social Workers (NASW) in 1955. NASW published its fi rst code of ethics in 1960, con- sisting of a set of 15 “I” statements, such as “I respect the privacy of the people I serve.” Shortly after the interest in settlement houses declined, social work focused more on devel- oping a domain-specifi c knowledge base and area of practice that would set it apart from other professions. In the 1940s and 1950s, so- cial work moved into the values period (lasting until the 1980s), during which there continued to be a shift away from focusing on the cli- ent’s morality to identifying ethical standards and guidelines.

In social work, the 1980s ushered in the ethi- cal theory and decision-making period. In both the medical and social work communities, this period was largely infl uenced by conferences and center and commission work in develop- ing a normative ethical response to bioethical dilemmas. Lowenberg and Dolgoff (1996) and Reamer (1995) wrote about the importance of ethical theory and decision-making models in resolving health-care and social justice issues.

JWBT514_ch03.indd 49JWBT514_ch03.indd 49 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

50 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

Malpractice concerns as well as the introduc- tion of managed care also helped direct ethics in this period.

Social work ethics is now in a period of ethical standards and risk management, ac- cording to Reamer (1998). The 1990s through the beginning of the 21st century have seen a number of increasingly public scandals. Com- panies have been caught engaging in ethi- cally unsound accounting practices that have impacted thousands. The Catholic Church has been beset as inappropriate sexual rela- tionships have been made public. Also, as a consequence of some new homeland security initiatives, concern regarding confi dentiality and privacy has increased. Social work has a role in treating and advocating for the victims of abuses by powerful organizations. Clearly understanding the ethical principles involved allows practitioners to more easily identify and address misconduct.

At the time of publication of this book, over 20 countries have developed codes of ethics for social work to address challenges at mul- tiple levels of practice. For example, torture and terrorism, both increasingly a part of our global awareness, are mentioned specifi cally in the principles of the 2004 International Fed- eration of Social Work Code of Ethics (www .ifsw.org/f38000032.html).

Recent abuses of power by large corpora- tions, institutions, and the government suggest an ongoing need to set clearer standards for social work practice in more ethically unam- biguous situations, such as when social work- ers enter into dual relationships with patients. Because standards for behavior in ethically challenging situations may prove elusive, so- cial workers need to continue to update their knowledge base and learn decision-making skills that will protect their clients against harm and themselves against litigation. As a consequence of a litigious society and chal- lenging practice environments, many social work ethics experts agree that all social work- ers should purchase malpractice insurance. The touchstone for guiding practice, however, remains the latest code of ethics. The revised 1999 NASW Code of Ethics clearly articulates

social work’s mission and values base. This code is the best developed and refi ned to date and refl ects an increasing sophistication in so- cial work theory and practice.

Bioethics

During the late 1940s and early 1950s, there were signifi cant advances in medical technol- ogy (Jonsen, 1998). In 1949, the polio vac- cine was discovered. In 1950, antihypertensive medications were discovered. In 1952, an- tipsychotic medications for the treatment of schizophrenia were developed. Medical ethics at that time echoed a sense of accomplishment and security that the profession was respected. In what may have been medicine’s self-satis- faction, thoughtful review and analysis of ethi- cal dilemmas may not have seemed necessary.

This self-assuredness waned in the 1960s as biotechnology ushered in unforeseen diffi cul- ties. Albert Jonsen (1998) traces the birth of bioethics to the point in time at which technol- ogy made hemodialysis available on a chronic basis with the development of the Scribner shunt, which allowed for external access to the bloodstream. This marked the fi rst time that a terminal illness—end-stage renal disease— moved from 100% fatal to 100% treatable by mechanical means. The ethics relevance of this was the subsequent development of di- alysis selection committees. These commit- tees had to make decisions regarding what nonmedical criteria should be used in deter- mining who lives and who dies, which called into question individual social worth and what this constitutes. On the social front, the 1960s and 1970s were a period of growth in aware- ness and activism. The Nixon administration’s Watergate scandal and the unpopular Vietnam War together brought ethics and social justice concerns to the public consciousness. Biotech- nological realities and consequent real-life di- lemmas presented the public with seemingly impossible ethical situations.

The 1960s also bore witness to conferences in the United States and other countries that addressed bioethical issues. These conferences acknowledged and reviewed dilemmas in areas

JWBT514_ch03.indd 50JWBT514_ch03.indd 50 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Ethics and Social Work in Health Care 51

such as genetics, eugenics, and transplantation. In addition to dialysis, heart transplantation became a feasible intervention. The discus- sion at the conferences ultimately resulted in the generation of scholarly papers on ethics. As these collections began to develop and sev- eral bioethics centers appeared to house these collections, further bioethical conversations developed. Some of these centers were the Hastings Center, the Kennedy Institute of Eth- ics at Georgetown, and the Society for Health and Human Values.

As bioethics centers were developing, the bioethical conversation moved to the realm of government. The Mondale Hearings of 1968, for example, raised important questions about end-of-life issues, behavior control, and ex- perimentation with human participants. Ulti- mately the hearings gave birth to the National Bioethics Commission that exists today. The 2003 Commission was made up of 17 indi- viduals appointed by the president. These in- dividuals include scientists, doctors, ethicists, social scientists, lawyers, and theologians. The purpose of this committee is to advise the pres- ident and help shape policy.

As discussed in the research ethics section that follows, the Tuskegee story fi rst appeared in the media in July 1972. Peter Bruxton, who had training as a social worker, was essen- tial in exposing this story. He learned of the study from colleagues after he was hired to work with patients who had venereal disease. He attempted to work within the system to intervene by contacting superiors. Ultimately he became a “whistle-blower” and went to the press in 1972 to expose the study (Jones, 1981). Partly in response to the public outrage, the Commission for the Protection of Human Subjects of Biomedical and Behavioral Re- search was established in 1974. As its name suggests, the commission’s imperative was to develop guidelines for protecting participants in research. This commission was one of the fi rst governmental bodies to consider ethics and develop recommendations for policy and legislation. The Commission for the Protec- tion of Human Subjects of Biomedical and Be- havioral Research consisted of 12 individuals

from science, law, ethics, and the public. Its mandate was to publish guidelines for medi- cal research, an example of which is the 1975 Recommendations on Research with the Fetus (National Commission for the Protection of Human Subjects of Biomedical and Behav- ioral Research, 1975). Several other important documents followed: the 1976 report Research Involving Prisoners (National Commission for the Protection of Human Subjects of Biomedi- cal and Behavioral Research, 1976) and in 1979 the Report and Recommendations on In- stitutional Review Boards (National Commis- sion for the Protection of Human Subjects of Biomedical and Behavioral Research, 1979). Finally in 1979, the National Commission is- sued the Belmont report in an effort to fulfi ll its mandate to identify basic ethical principles that could guide research. Albert Jonsen, who served on the commission, later wrote:

As a commissioner I participated in the for- mulation of that [Belmont] Report. Today, I am skeptical of its status as serious ethical analysis. I suspect that it is in effect a prod- uct of American Moralism prompted by the desire of congressmen and of the public to see the chaotic world of biomedical research reduced to order by clear and unambiguous principle. (Jonsen, 1991, p. 125)

His commentary on the commission he was part of foreshadows the diffi culty to fi nd clear guidelines in right-to-die cases. Following the Belmont Report, the President’s Commission for the Study of Ethical Problems in Medicine and Biomedical and Behavioral Research was established in 1979. This commission had a broader mandate than the National Commis- sion for the Protection of Human Subjects. It addressed topics such as how death should be defi ned. One of the important documents to come out of this commission was Deciding to Forego Life-Sustaining Treatment, which suggested that a competent patient should have priority over others in decision mak- ing (President’s Commission for the Study of Ethical Problems in Medicine and Biomedi- cal and Behavioral Research, 1983). Before

JWBT514_ch03.indd 51JWBT514_ch03.indd 51 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

52 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

disbanding in 1983, the commission recom- mended that ethics committees should have a role in dilemmas involving life-or-death care and reviewed the concept of durable power of attorney. These committees are appointed to fulfi ll a specifi c mandate and are appointed for a specifi c period of time.

The Los Alamos National Laboratory, Law- rence Livermore National Laboratory, and Department of Energy Laboratories began producing DNA clone libraries of single chro- mosomes in 1983, marking the beginning of a process that ultimately would result in the mapping of the human genome. The Human Genome Project began in 1990, and by April 2003, the human genome had been mapped.

The National Bioethics Advisory Commis- sion (1996–2001) and the President’s Council on Bioethics (2001–2009) have both had to address the implications of human genome re- search. In addition to the governmental over- sight in the form of commissions, the Human Genome Project also developed its own ethics program. This is the world’s largest bioethics program, and it is a model for other programs throughout the world. Beginning in 2010, President Obama directed the Presidential Commission for the Study of Bioethical Issues to examine issues surrounding biosynthetic technology. This technology goes beyond the genetic manipulation of existing systems and proposes to create new systems entirely, namely those not found in nature.

DECISION-MAKING MODELS

Social workers routinely make key deci- sions in a variety of settings. One of the most visible settings for social work deci- sion making is on health-care policy and eth- ics committees. Social work presence may have changed somewhat with the advent of managed care, but organizations historically have felt that social work input is essential (Mulvey, 1997). As these decisions become more transparent and subject to scrutiny, it becomes increasingly important to make them in an orderly and informed fashion.

This is in contrast to what Goldmeier (1984, p. 46) believes was in the recent past a “ten- dency to resolve ethical dilemmas on a case- by-case basis without systematic grounding in ethical principles.”

Developing a sound ethical decision can be a daunting task, and currently a variety of models exist to help guide decision mak- ing. These models assume various geometric shapes—some square, some triangular, some two-dimensional, others three-dimensional. It is not the appearance of the model, however, that is important. Rather, it is the number of elements and complexity of ties that is impor- tant. Sound decision making involves consid- eration of a variety of factors and variables and not necessarily in a formulaic or linear fashion. For an informed decision to be made, the practitioner must be aware of many factors, such as:

• Personal values and collegial, institutional, and societal infl uences

• Ethical theory and decision-making models

• Social work theory, research, and practice standards

• Social work ethical codes, as well as other professional codes

• Relevant agency policy

• Federal and state laws and other regulations

• Impact on patients and, in some cases, impact on practitioner (as in whistle-blowing)

Identifying and attending to all of these factors is challenging. For example, Mattison (2000) refl ects that identifying specifi cally what social work practice standards are may be somewhat diffi cult because a standard of prac- tice often is not well defi ned. Also, most social workers in health care do not work in isolation. Rather, they are part of larger transdisciplinary teams. In considering institutional infl uences, the relationships with and perspectives of oth- ers on the health-care team have a signifi cant impact on the contribution social workers have in ethical decision making (Landau, 2000).

After the social worker has developed un- derstanding of the dilemma, he or she should

JWBT514_ch03.indd 52JWBT514_ch03.indd 52 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Ethics and Social Work in Health Care 53

fi rst look to the social work code of ethics to identify values, principles, and standards that may be relevant in resolving the prob- lem. In addition to the areas identifi ed pre- viously, there should be an added effort to identify sources of feedback. These may be colleagues, agency committees, local state boards of social work examiners, profes- sional social work organizations including NASW, or legal counsel.

Models of decision making often share components. They may differ at times in some fundamental areas, such as how principles are ordered hierarchically. In this sense, mod- els may represent different schools of thought in much the same way that models of treat- ment in health care vary and treatment theories differ from one another. Netting, Kettner, and McMurtry (1993), Murdach (1995), Lowen- berg and Dolgoff (1996), Jonsen, Seigler, and Winslade (1997), and Mattison (2000), all review different models and decision-making approaches relevant to health social work practice.

According to Netting and colleagues (1993, pp. 411–412), the steps to decision making are:

1. Recognize the problem.

2. Investigate the variables.

3. Get feedback from others.

4. Appraise the values that apply to the dilemma.

5. Evaluate the dilemma.

6. Identify and think about possible alternatives.

7. Weigh the pros and cons of each alternative.

8. Make your decision.

Part of the diffi culty in completing the last task in the list, actually making the decision, is weighing one principle against another or even rank-ordering a series of principles (such as freedom over well-being). Reamer (1990) proposes comparing principles to one another and deciding which one is more im- portant. For example, “an individual’s right to freedom takes precedence over his or her own right to well-being” (Reamer, 1990,

p. 63). In the case of a patient’s decision to continue to engage in self-destructive behav- iors, however, this ordering would allow a person with alcoholism to continue to drink. In considering other principles, Reamer does make provision for an attempt at intervention to determine “voluntariness and informed choice” as well as preventing harm to oth- ers (p. 63). However, in this example, the ontological considerations of freedom su- persede the teleontological considerations, such as impact on family, friends, and work as well as long-term health consequences, such as cirrhosis. In other words, protecting individual freedom may be seen as a more important principle than forcing someone to live a healthy lifestyle.

Lowenberg and Dolgoff (1996, p. 414) pro- pose a rank-ordering of principles from which an individual should be able to:

• Exist with basic needs.

• Receive treatment that is fair and equal.

• Have free choice and freedom.

• Have injury that is minimal or nonexistent.

• Cultivate a good quality of life.

• Secure privacy and confi dentiality.

• Understand the truth.

• Receive available information.

SPECIAL TOPICS RELATED TO HEALTH SOCIAL WORK ETHICS

Dual Relationship

Dual relationship continues to be an area of challenges for many social workers. Dual re- lationship in health social work practice may be loosely defi ned as a type of violation of the practitioner and patient relationship. In- junctions against dual relationships in health care have been in evidence since the time of Hippocrates. “Whatever houses I may visit, I will come for the benefi t of the sick, remain- ing free of all intentional injustice, of all mis- chief and in particular of sexual relations with

JWBT514_ch03.indd 53JWBT514_ch03.indd 53 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

54 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

both female and male persons, be they free or slaves” (Hippocratic Oath, 400 bce).

In a 2009 study, Boland-Prom surveyed 27 state social work regulatory boards and exam- ined 874 complaints that resulted in actions. The most frequently occurring complaint con- cerned inappropriate dual relationships. After another examination of NASW code viola- tions, Strom-Gottfried (2000) found most to be boundary violations in dual relationships. The most frequently occurring violations were sexual relationships and nonsexual dual rela- tionships.

Current defi nitions of dual relationships are varied. Craig (1991) describes them as “am- biguous relationships in which the goals and boundaries are tailored to meet the needs of the counselor” (p. 49). Hill and Mamalakis (2001) defi ne dual relationships as “any con- current or sequential relationship between a therapist and client that is distinct from the therapeutic relationship” (p. 200).

Early work on the topic of dual relationships focused on absolute contraindications in dual relationships, such as a practitioner having sex with a client. However, a variety of nonsexual dual relationships exist. Recently the paradigm has shifted to consideration of when dual rela- tionships are appropriate. Reamer (2003) has divided dual relationships into those that are boundary crossings and those that are bound- ary violations.

Boundary crossings may not be inap- propriate in all cases but remain controver- sial. One example might be a hospital social worker serving on a fundraising board with a current or former patient. The appropriate- ness of this situation greatly depends on the social worker’s ability to make appropriate judgments in what could potentially become an ethically compromising environment. Some would caution social workers to avoid these potentially dangerous and libelous situ- ations completely.

We could argue, however, that failing to collaborate with the patient would result in more harm than good for him. Health social workers may be cautioned not to engage in dual relationships with patients no matter

what the situation. This certainly seems an outdated and perhaps alarmist position that might place patients at greater risk if it jeop- ardized potential collaborations between so- cial workers and patients. Threatening the ability to collaborate on boards or planning committees, for example, might mean that so- cial workers and patients would not engage in dialogues to establish the needs of end-stage renal patients.

How would one go about ordering princi- ples and standards in this instance? Does the “slippery slope” argument have the fi nal say in whether to proscribe potentially benefi cial interactions? The slippery slope metaphor is a very prominent argument in the fi eld of ethics. It is also called the “thin edge of the wedge” or “wedge” argument (Pence, 2004, p. 111). According to Pence, these arguments are most prominent at the beginning of end-of-life ethi- cal dilemmas. Although colloquial in com- mon parlance, the term does speak to some important considerations, such as conceptual or empirical trajectories. Would allowing dual relationships to occur in this area result in an ongoing reduction of standards in more clearly defi ned inappropriate relationships (concep- tual)? Is there something about human nature that ultimately will take advantage of these situations (empirical)?

Lazarus (1994) would respond by saying that “one of the worst professional violations is that of permitting current risk management principles to take precedence over humane in- terventions” (p. 260). This is not a new idea. Miller and Rollnick (1991) and Carl Rogers (1959) all support the idea that relationships account for much of the changes that occur in treatment. Current literature echoes this sentiment by providing evidence to support a relationship between the quality of rapport between provider and client and outcome. These “clinical encounters and relationships may even be perceived by clients as more like ‘friendships’” (Green et al., 2008, p. 9).

The careful consideration of the appropri- ateness of potential dual relationships is es- pecially relevant to rural social workers who may encounter multiple dual relationships. In

JWBT514_ch03.indd 54JWBT514_ch03.indd 54 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Ethics and Social Work in Health Care 55

response to the misleading information pro- vided by continuing education providers, the author of this chapter contacted by phone the Louisiana State Board of Social Work Exam- iners, NASW, and the Council of Nephrol- ogy Social Workers for input. In addition, the NASW Code of Ethics was consulted for guid- ance. No board expressly prohibited all dual relationships. However, it was suggested by the state board that guidelines be developed to address this issue.

Boundary violations, alternatively, are clearly inappropriate. These involve “exploit- ative, manipulative, deceptive, or coercive” actions (Reamer, 2003, p. 122). The 2000 NASW Code of Ethics proscribes social work- ers’ engagement “in dual or multiple relation- ships with clients or former clients in which there is a great risk of exploitation or potential harm to the client” (Standard 1.06).

Clear dangers are inherent in the example of a social worker serving on a board or com- mittee with a patient. If the social worker was not sensitive to the dynamics of the situation, the board role could devolve, and several un- toward outcomes could be possible. For in- stance, the relationship could devolve into a more collegial or friendship-type relationship (and even possibly a sexual relationship), or the patient might feel he has more access to the social worker and attempt to use this time to address more clinical concerns. This access to the health-care provider beyond the provider- patient relationship may become increasingly problematic as social workers are responsible for more and more patients with less time to provide clinical services.

The issue of confi dentiality could pose a problem if the social worker was not careful. For example, one scenario that conceivably could cause problems might be if the patient was sick and other board members asked the social worker about specifi cs of his illness. The social worker could abuse power in the relationship to stifl e the patient’s voice on the board or in the patient’s health-care environ- ment. Furthermore, the social worker and pa- tient could manipulate decisions and available resources for economic or other gain.

Another potential danger is possible serv- ing on boards with patients. In applying utili- tarianism to this example, it becomes apparent that both courses of action may be defensible. Act utilitarian thought and care ethics may dic- tate that the potential benefi ts take precedence over the risks. Rule utilitarianism or Kantian ethics might suggest that more harm would be done to the profession if these rules were not maintained.

Arguments for considering dual relation- ships in light of the service provided also may be relevant. For example, Hardinia (2004) points out that direct clinical social work prac- tice is substantively different from community social work. With this in mind, some would argue that collaboration takes on more of an ethical imperative in community work than it does in clinical work. Does this hold true for social work in health care? Strom-Gottfried (2003) provides data to suggest that private practitioners have a higher rate of ethical vio- lations than do social workers in agencies. This was measured by reviewing 894 of 901 eth- ics complaints fi led with NASW for the time period 1986 to 1997. More work should be undertaken to determine why this is the case, because the study questions how the data were gathered. One possible explanation would be that there is more oversight and thus fewer opportunities for violation in agency settings, such as hospital social work, compared with private practice. Another explanation might be that the nature of the client-social worker re- lationship is different in nonpsychotherapeutic settings and therefore lends itself less easily to abuse.

When inappropriate dual relationships do occur, they may have less to do with the nature of the relationship and more with intrapsychic features of the practitioner. Schoener (1995) suggests that clinicians who engage in sexual or other inappropriate relationships with cli- ents may have underlying mood or personality disorders. In addition, Simon (1999) identifi ed the egregious occurrence of impairment (as may occur in substance use) and incompetence as possible triggers of inappropriate dual rela- tionships.

JWBT514_ch03.indd 55JWBT514_ch03.indd 55 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

56 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

Managed Care and Whistle-Blowing

As discussed in Chapter 5 of this book, man- aged care has changed the dynamics of health- care provision in the United States dramatically. Neuman (2000) describes the new environ- ment as one with decreased reimbursement for health-care providers, decentralization of services, a decrease in staff credentialing and expertise, and the emergence of standards of care. These conditions increase the possibility that ethical violations will occur.

Possible abuses that might occur more fre- quently in a managed care environment in- clude the exaggeration of patient symptoms in order to ensure or increase reimbursement. This exaggeration may be well intentioned from the practitioner’s perspective. It may as- sume the form of changing diagnoses from an adjustment disorder to a more severe psychiat- ric illness in order to secure or extend needed treatment in a psychiatric hospital. Employees may be encouraged to seek treatment from in- network providers. These providers, especially in health care, also may be the patient’s col- leagues, vendors, or own clients. This places an employee in a potential dual relationship with the provider.

Historically managed care has threatened informed consent through facilities’ use of nondisclosure, or gag, clauses. These gag clauses prevented social workers or other prac- titioners from discussing the limits of services available as mandated by third-party payers or of discussing other available options beyond those offered by a particular managed care organization (Strom-Gottfried, 1998). Social work, specifi cally through NASW, was one of the fi rst professions to address specifi cally the ethics involved in informed consent as it re- lates to nondisclosure clauses.

Confi dentiality also may be more threatened in a health-care environment that relies on out- sourcing services. The availability of electronic data and transfer of data from one facility to another may pose an ethical risk. However, this may be more a function of technology than managed care specifi cally. With the vast amount of data available electronically, this information

has become a target of computer hackers and other criminals. There have been recent cases where criminals have accessed personal credit information of tens of thousands of individu- als. It is not inconceivable for this to happen to personal health information. Personal health information in the wrong hands could affect a person’s employment potential, fi nances, and interpersonal relationships.

Practitioners in managed care and other health-care environments may witness un- ethical practices. One decision is whether to inform authorities of these practices. Whistle- blowing refers to the act of notifying authori- ties of harmful deviation from standards of care or unethical practices within an organiza- tion. From a micro-level perspective, this may take the form of notifying superiors of a col- league’s malpractice in terms of violations of the NASW Code of Ethics, law, or agency poli- cies. From a macro-level perspective, this may involve a practitioner notifying people outside the agency of problems within the agency. Al- though the best policy generally is to follow a chain of command within an agency, this may not provide the appropriate results. For exam- ple, retaliation is a real concern in a corporate work environment.

If the identifi ed problem is with the policies made by the management, and these have been brought to the attention of the management with no effect, it may be necessary to pursue other options outside the company. For example, in the past, whistle-blowers have accessed local media and the American Civil Liberties Union. However, Reamer (1999, p. 162) recommends that, before notifying authorities within or out- side an agency of ethical violations, a practitio- ner should take time to consider the:

• Severity of harm and misconduct involved

• Quality of evidence of wrongdoing

• Effect of the decision on colleagues and agency

• Viability of alternative courses of action

It may be important to realize that no agency is perfect, and employees cannot be functional

JWBT514_ch03.indd 56JWBT514_ch03.indd 56 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Ethics and Social Work in Health Care 57

if they whistle-blow every time they encounter a problem. If a social worker comes across a problem with a colleague or an agency, there should be an effort to directly address the colleague or follow the chain of command. Careful documentation of the event and the efforts taken by the social worker to resolve the problem should be made.

The NASW Code of Ethics includes sev- eral references to situations in which report- ing violations might be appropriate. However, lock-step or formulaic responses to this type of dilemma, as in all other ethical dilemmas, may prove incomplete. Decision making during the reporting process should be made in a refl ec- tive and orderly fashion, and documented. For any claim to be taken seriously, documentation must be provided. Documentation also serves to protect the social worker, especially if a court becomes involved.

Consideration should be made to what ef- fect any accusations by the reporter might have. The accusations could ruin the reputa- tion of a coworker or undermine the mission of an agency. As a consequence, clients could be harmed if there is an interruption or end to services. Finally, great care should be taken to consider other options. There are some governmental guidelines protecting people who report possible wrongdoing, but they are placed at great risk from the beginning. This may result in damage to their reputation. Still, when it is clear that there is harm to others, all reasonable efforts should be taken to remedy the situation.

SOCIAL WORK RESEARCH ETHICS

The ethics of social science are situation ethics.

—Humphreys, 1975, p. 170

This quote from Humphreys can be seen as morally ambiguous. Fortunately, safeguards exist today that protect ethical analysis from devolving into an argument used to justify a desired protocol (Lacey, 1996). For example,

all universities and health-care facilities should have their own institutional review boards (IRBs) that provide some safeguard against potentially harmful research and ensure that research does not exploit human participants. IRBs ensure that there is informed consent, confi dentiality consideration, policies regard- ing data storage, and other safeguards.

Unfortunately, problems occur even with these safeguards in place. While conducting research, social workers may deviate from ethical practice for a variety of reasons. One of the most seductive motives may be that the researcher believes the benefi t from the results or knowledge accrued by bending rules for re- search on human subjects or other deviations from research protocols outweigh any harm done to participants. Deviations from ethically sound research, regardless of how seemingly innocuous or, conversely, compelling, can have serious consequences to the researcher, participants, and society at large. Within the realm of research, the areas of most impor- tance are:

• Voluntary participation or consent

• No harm to participants or nonmalfeasance

• Anonymity and confi dentiality

• Deception

• Analysis and reporting

• Justice and benefi cence

Many people trace the development of re- search ethics to the Nuremburg Code. Follow- ing World War II, in 1946, the United States, France, the United Kingdom, and Russia par- ticipated in an eight-month trial in which 16 German physicians were convicted of crimes against humanity. These physicians had par- ticipated in research on prisoners without their consent, often infl icting great pain and death. Some of this wartime research in Nazi Ger- many involved shooting prisoners to study wounds and purposefully injecting prisoners with live viruses to study disease.

The Nuremberg Code was developed in response to these violations. Attention to vol- untary consent was at the center of the Code

JWBT514_ch03.indd 57JWBT514_ch03.indd 57 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

58 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

(Trials of War Criminals Before the Nurem- berg Military Tribunals Under Control Coun- cil Law 10, 1950). In all, the Nuremberg Code identifi ed 10 principles designed to protect research participants. This was a great step forward in research ethics, but its principles have not always been followed. In a sense, the publication of the Nuremberg Code marks the beginning of a cyclical phenomenon in which a crisis involving research occurs, a response is made in the form of legislation addressing the crisis, and the conditions preceding the cri- sis eventually reappear.

The United States was not immune from this phenomenon. In 1929, the U.S. Public Health Service with the local departments of health of Mississippi, Tennessee, Georgia, Alabama, North Carolina, and Virginia were involved in what is called the Tuskegee Study, the aim of which was to control syphilis. In 1932, syphi- lis treatment was withheld from approximately 400 African American men in Macon County, GA. The fact that African American men were used exclusively was refl ective of the racist at- titudes of the time. The ensuing study spanned some 40 years, despite the fact that penicillin became available to treat syphilis in the 1940s (Jones, 1981). The study was made public in the 1970s as an example of misuse of research on human subjects. In 1997, President Clin- ton made a formal public apology to the sur- viving participants of the study, and in 1999, the National Center for Bioethics and Health Care was established at Tuskegee University. Recently, Susan Reverby uncovered additional information about syphilis experiments that were sponsored by the U.S. government (Mc- Neil, 2010).

In 2010, Secretary of State Hillary Rodham Clinton and Health and Human Services Sec- retary Kathleen Sebelius made a public apol- ogy to the government of Guatemala related to the actions of the U.S. Public Health Service from 1946 to 1948. Seven hundred Guatema- lan prisoners were purposefully infected with syphilis using prostitutes, direct exposure to the virus, and spinal injection.

A common theme in both the Nazi atrocities and the Tuskegee and Guatemalan studies is

the use of vulnerable populations, which often consist of the disenfranchised, minorities, and women. In all these cases, one of the primary violations of research ethics was in the lack of voluntary participation. The Guatemalan pris- oners were a vulnerable population by virtue of being incarcerated. By today’s standards, prisoners are considered a vulnerable popula- tion and require full IRB deliberation before any study is sanctioned. Many of the Guatema- lan prisoners also had mental illnesses.

Informed consent also may be related to privacy concerns as outlined in the discussion of Henrietta Lacks (see Box 3.1). Cells labeled with her name were disseminated throughout the world without her understanding that she was providing tissue for research.

Millgram’s obedience study provides an- other example of violation of the “no harm to participants” principle (Miller, 1986). Mill- gram conducted this study in the early 1960s. He was researching the phenomenon of obe- dience. For this study, he recruited partici- pants via a newspaper advertisement. He then instructed the participants to assume the role of a teacher who would infl ict punishment through an electric shock to a learner. An actor assumed the role of the learner and had an electrode strapped to his arm. The teacher was instructed to give the learner a shock with each incorrect response. The teacher was then in- structed to increase the voltage incrementally. The actor would respond to each shock.

Disturbingly, the teachers continued to administer the shocks even when the voltage meter indicated that the shocks registered in the dangerous and severe range. Throughout this experiment, the teachers appeared to suf- fer psychological trauma while administer- ing the shocks, yet they continued to follow Millgram’s commands. A common criticism of Millgram is that he relied on the ends to justify the means, or attended to only teleonto- logical considerations. This experiment did re- veal valuable information. It has been viewed by some as shedding light on why people were able to commit violent acts while under the di- rection of an authority, such as in Nazi Ger- many. However, his study still is considered

JWBT514_ch03.indd 58JWBT514_ch03.indd 58 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Ethics and Social Work in Health Care 59

Box 3.1 Henrietta Lacks and the First Immortal Cell Line

As health-care professionals, we often assume that we have a good understanding of the ethical issues revolving around informed consent, especially as it relates to medical procedures and research. Is that always the case? Are you aware of what happens to your blood or tissue when it is drawn or biopsied for diagnostic purposes? You might be surprised. General consent forms, in addition to consent for the tests, often contain a brief provision for saving a sample for research. Over the years, this and other collection consents have resulted in the storage of tissue from over 307 million samples from 178 million people (Eiseman & Haga, 1999) in the United States alone.

In her 2010 book The Immortal Life of Henrietta Lacks, Rebecca Skloot brings awareness to the issues revolving around informed consent and stored tissue samples by focusing her attention on the woman who generated the fi rst immortal cell line. Henrietta Lacks was an African American woman who, at age 30, was diagnosed with an especially aggressive form of cervical cancer. She was treated at Johns Hopkins in 1951. In April of that year, after she signed a basic consent form that did not mention donating a sample, tissue was scraped from

her cervix and sent to the hospital lab. The radium procedure used to treat her was then administered. She died that October. Since then, Lack’s cells have been used all over the world in research ranging from Parkinson’s disease to the fl u, and they continue to be used today.

Enough of her cells have been grown to weigh “50 million metric tons . . . wrap around the earth at least three times, spanning more than 350 million feet” (Skloot, 2010, p. 2). They are commonly referred to as HeLa cells. In 2000, around the time of the fi rst cloning of a mammal, Christine Borland, a Scottish artist, drew from this Lack’s legacy by displaying a microscope examining HeLa cells and the magnifi ed image of those cells. The work was titled HeLa HOT to refl ect the “hot topic” of genetic research and was part of a larger exhibit commenting on the ambiguities and sometimes dehumanizing impact of genetic research.

The Health Insurance Portability and Accountability Act of 1996 would no longer allow the name of the donor of a tissue sample to be widely known. It does little to mitigate the effects of HeLa research and notoriety on Lack’s family, a family who has benefi ted little from the immense amount of money generated by discoveries made using the HeLa cell line.

an egregious violation of research ethics for a variety of reasons, including the possible long- term psychological trauma to the participants.

Project Camelot was an attempt by the U.S. government in the 1950s to investigate how governments were overthrown and re-formed in Latin America (Horowitz, 1967). The under- lying intent was to gain information that would allow some control over how governments in volatile political climates developed. This type of research has clear problems. Although this example may come from macro-level practice, it serves to illuminate the misuse of research in politics. This type of research immediately calls into question justice and benefi cence.

It also speaks to a clouded purpose of the re- search. The danger that health social workers should remember from this is that the true nature of research is not always apparent. Health social workers involved in their own and institutional research endeavors are wise to refl ect carefully on the previously discussed research considerations. Many social workers, especially those working in teaching hospi- tals, either will be approached to participate in research or will have patients who are in research studies. Learning the funding source and the premise behind the research will help social workers assess its value to the patients and better inform them.

JWBT514_ch03.indd 59JWBT514_ch03.indd 59 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

60 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

ETHICAL CHALLENGES IN THE 21ST CENTURY

As is apparent in some of the examples in this chapter, ethical challenges evolve in ways that at once demand and escape satisfying solu- tions. In the 21st century and beyond, ethical dialogue is inexorably tied to science. Health social work has an obligation to provide a voice to individuals and to existing culture as sciences provide an ever broadening array of ethically ambiguous choices. Health social workers providing direct care to patients, serv- ing on ethics committees, shaping policy, and acting in the legislative arena must all have the ability to redirect attention to ethical and in- terpersonal considerations. From a micro-level to a macro-level perspective, this will be chal- lenging because new health-care dilemmas have profound societal meaning.

Compelling health dilemmas have the po- tential to draw reasonable discourse and action away from the issue at hand. These dilemmas may be used as rallying cries for agendas far re- moved from the welfare of the patient. An inad- equate and depersonalizing health-care industry further threatens ethical care in this country. Health social workers can effect change, how- ever. By remaining grounded in an understand- ing of the profession’s mission, values, and ethics, health social workers have the ability to avoid losing focus. With a clear sense of pur- pose, health social workers can help redirect health care to an ethical best fi t with patients.

SUGGESTED LEARNING EXERCISES

Learning Exercise 3.1

Heather recently completed the requirements for her social work license. She was hired by a hospital’s psychosocial rehabilitation cen- ter as its program coordinator. This program provides services to patients with a serious mental illness (SMI). With her social work license, Heather can now provide individual and group therapy and bill third-party payers,

such as Medicare and Medicaid. She also can supervise paraprofessionals who provide psy- chosocial rehabilitation day services to pa- tients. These services are defi ned by her state Medicaid manual but encompass a broad array of needs, including social-skill development and community integration. One of Heather’s new roles is to plan, supervise, and sign off on all of these services as the mental health professional. This is appropriate and required by Medicaid.

Within her fi rst week, Heather learns that the most popular rehabilitation day program is taking clients to a casino. Usually two to four paraprofessionals accompany the clients to the casino. Clients spend the day there, and some gamble. They interact with community mem- bers, eat, and often see a show. The point of the program as it was explained to Heather was to promote social skills in a natural environment. As a new MSW graduate, Heather remembers that community-based social learning is essen- tial for the SMI population. Clients who have cognitive defi cits from a mental illness have a better chance of learning skills in a natural set- ting. This all makes perfect sense to Heather, but something about this whole situation both- ers her.

What should Heather be concerned about, if anything? If Medicaid only considers active interventions as billable services, is it ethical to bill Medicaid to take clients to a casino? How should she go about fi nding some direc- tion in this situation? What can Heather do in this situation?

Learning Exercise 3.2

Sam was a transplant candidate at liver trans- plant center where you are employed. His liver disease is due to hepatitis C virus and polysub- stance dependence. About a year ago, Sam was denied a transplant because of medical contra- indications and ongoing alcohol abuse. He was advised to lose weight and stop drinking before he would be reconsidered for transplant. Sam is well known regionally for his art and poetry, but he is best known for his charisma and over- the-top lifestyle. Several employees at the liver

JWBT514_ch03.indd 60JWBT514_ch03.indd 60 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Ethics and Social Work in Health Care 61

transplant center are fond of him. Sam brings paintings to the center every month or so, and the staff hang them in the waiting room.

Sam’s health continues to deteriorate, but he tells everyone that he just knows that he will get a transplant soon. Sam’s family and fans take some comfort in this information. As a social worker on this transplant team, your role has been to conduct a psychosocial evalu- ation and provide education and counseling. When it was clear that he was not going to en- gage in treatment with you or at your center, you made attempts to refer Sam elsewhere for counseling and then hospice care. He refused both. Multiple relational and ethical issues are involved in this scenario. What is the implicit message or messages that Sam is sending by gifting his paintings to the center? What is the message the offi ce manager is sending back to Sam by accepting them? How is this impacting his care? More important, what is your role in his care now?

Learning Exercise 3.3

Kimberly has been a very effective spokes- person working as a social worker for a local hospice. She also is known for her good thera- peutic work with patients. A local producer has heard lots of positive things about the hos- pice and has approached Kimberly with the idea of a documentary series to increase pub- lic awareness and support. They would fi lm in the hospice and interview friends and family members in the community. This would all be tastefully done with the informed consent of patients and families.

Kimberly is familiar with this type of media. She has seen similar reality shows with prisoners, pregnant teens, hoarding, substance dependence and abuse, and mental disorders. There is even a local broadcast of drug court. Sometimes licensed therapists, including so- cial workers, take part in these shows, and the actual treatment is recorded and broadcast. Kimberly realizes that this presents privacy is- sues but decides that, with a thorough review of the potential risks and benefi ts in the con- sent process, the clients can make informed

decisions. She also thinks it is inappropriate and infantilizing to assume that people make these choices for themselves. She also believes that there will be broader benefi ts to society.

Even though reality shows have become the norm, they present numerous ethical chal- lenges. In this example, what are the risks and benefi ts to the clients? Is a documentary on hospice any different from broadcasting a local drug court? How would the informed consent be impacted if the drug court participants were given the choice of prison or televised drug court? Are prisoners and people with serious mental illnesses vulnerable populations that warrant special consideration in the consent- ing process for television broadcasts? Is spe- cial consideration for informed consent just an issue for research? How does incentivizing participation by offering to pay for treatment impact the informed consent process?

SUGGESTED RESOURCES

The Genome Project—http://genomics.energy .gov/

This is a gateway site for the project. The Hastings Center—www.thehasting

scenter.org The center is a nonpartisan research

institution dedicated in part to bioethics. Human Genome Project Information Ethi-

cal Legal and Social Issues—www.ornl .gov/sci/techresources/Human_Genome/ elsi/elsi.shtml

International Federation of Social Workers Ethics in Social Work Statement of Prin- ciples—www.ifsw.org/p38000324.html

This site includes links to approxi- mately 20 countries with national codes of social work ethics.

National Association of Social Workers Of- fi ce of Ethics and Professional Review— www.socialworkers.org/nasw/ethics/ default.asp

National Institutes of Health Bioethics resources and links—http://bioethics .od.nih.gov

JWBT514_ch03.indd 61JWBT514_ch03.indd 61 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

62 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

Presidential Commission for the Study of Bioethical Issues—www.bioethics.gov

The Rand Corporation—www.rand.org/ This not-for-profi t organization con-

ducts research in numerous areas includ- ing health and health care.

Tuskegee University National Center for Bioethics in Research & Health Care— www.tuskegee.edu/Global/category .asp?C=35026&nav=menu200_14

REFERENCES

Angeles, P. (1992). The Harper Collins dictionary of philosophy (2nd ed.). New York, NY: HarperCollins.

Baker, R., Porter, R., & Porter, D. (Eds.). (1993). The codifi cation of medical morality (Vols. 1–2). Boston, MA: Kluwer Academic.

Boland-Prom, K. (2009). Results from a national study of social workers sanctioned by state licensing boards. Social Work, 54(4), 351–360.

Bonner, T. (2002). Iconoclast: Abraham Flexner and a life in learning. Baltimore, MD: Johns Hopkins University Press.

Carse, A. (1991). The voice of care: Implications for bioethical education. Journal of Medicine and Philosophy, 16, 5–28.

Craig, J. (1991). Preventing dual relationships in pastoral counseling. Counseling and Values, 36, 49–54.

Csikai, E. (1999). Euthanasia and assisted suicide: Issues for social work practice. Journal of Gerontological Social Work, 31(3/4), 49–63.

Csikai, E. (2004). Social workers’ participation in the resolution of ethical dilemmas in hospice care. Health & Social Work, 29(1), 67–76.

Diderot, D. (1976). Rameau’s Nephew and D’Alembert’s Dream. New York, NY: Penguin. (Original work published 1769.)

Eiseman, E., & Haga, S. (1999). Handbook of human tissue sources: A national resource of human tissue samples [Electronic version]. Rand Corporation. Retrieved from www.rand.org/pubs/monograph_reports/MR954.

Flexner, A. (1915). Is social work a profession? Studies in Social Work, 4, 1–24.

Gilligan, C. (1982). In a different voice. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.

Goldmeier, J. (1984). Ethical styles and ethical decisions in health settings. Social Work in Health Care, 10(1), 45–60.

Green C., Polen, M., Janoff, S., Castelton, D., Wisdom, J., Vuckovic, N., . . . Oken, S. L.(2008). Understanding how clinician-patient relationships and relational continuity of care affect recovery from serious

mental illness: STARS study results. Psychiatric Rehabilitation Journal, 32(1), 9–22.

Guba, E. (1990). The paradigm dialogue. Newbury Park, CA: Sage.

Hardinia, D. (2004). Guidelines for ethical practice in community organization. Social Work, 49(4), 595–604.

Hill, M., & Mamalakis, P. (2001). Family therapists and religious communities: Negotiating dual relationships. Family Relations, 50, 199–208.

Hodge, D. (2003). Value differences between social workers and members of the working and middle classes. Social Work, 48(1), 107–119.

Horowitz, I. (1967). The rise and fall of project Camelot. Cambridge, MA: Massachusetts Institute of Technology.

Humphreys, L. (1975). Tearoom trade: Impersonal sex in public places. Hawthorne, NY: Aldine Transaction.

Jones, J. (1981). Bad blood: The Tuskegee syphilis experiment. New York, NY: Free Press.

Jonsen, A. (1991). American moralism and the origin of bioethics in the United States. Journal of Medicine and Philosophy, 16, 113–130.

Jonsen, A. (1998). The birth of bioethics. Oxford, UK: Oxford University Press.

Jonsen, A., Seigler, M., & Winslade, W. (1997). Clinical ethics (5th ed.). New York, NY: McGraw-Hill.

Joseph, M., & Conrad, A. (1989). Social work infl uence on interdisciplinary ethical decision making in health care settings. Health & Social Work, 2, 22–30.

Kagle, J., & Kopels, S. (1994). Confi dentiality after Tarasoff. Health & Social Work, 19(3), 217–222.

Lacey, H. (1996). Philosophy of science and ethics. Ethics, 2(2), 111–120.

Landau, R. (2000). Ethical dilemmas in general hospitals: Social workers’ contribution to ethical decision making. Social Work in Health Care, 32(2), 75–92.

Lazarus, A. (1994). How certain boundaries and ethics diminish therapeutic effectiveness. Ethics and Beha- vior, 4, 255–261.

Lowenberg, F., & Dolgoff, R. (1996). Ethical decisions for social work practice (5th ed.). Itasca, IL: Peacock Press.

Mattison, M. (2000). Ethical decision making: The person in the process. Social Work, 45(3), 201–212.

Miller, A. (1986). The obedience experiments: A case study of controversy in social science. New York, NY: Praeger.

Miller, W., & Rollnick, S. (1991). Motivational interviewing: preparing people to change addictive behavior. New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Mulvey, B. (1997). Synopsis of a practical guide: Guidelines for ethics committees. Journal of Florida Medical Association, 84(8), 506–509.

Munson, R. (2000). Intervention and refl ection: Basic issues in medical ethics (6th ed.). Belmont, CA: Wadsworth/Thompson Learning.

JWBT514_ch03.indd 62JWBT514_ch03.indd 62 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Ethics and Social Work in Health Care 63

Murdach, A. (1995). Decision making situations in health care. Health & Social Work, 20(3), 187–191.

National Association of Social Workers. (2000). Code of ethics of the National Association of Social Workers. Washington, DC: NASW Press.

National Commission for the Protection of Human Subjects of Biomedical and Behavioral Research. (1975). Report and recommendations: Research on the fetus. Washington, DC: U.S. Department of Health, Education, and Welfare.

National Commission for the Protection of Human Subjects of Biomedical and Behavioral Research. (1976). Report and recommendations: Research involving prisoners. Washington, DC: U.S. Government Printing Offi ce.

National Commission for the Protection of Human Subjects of Biomedical and Behavioral Research. (1979). Report and Recommendations on Institutional Review Boards. Washington, DC: U.S. Government Printing Offi ce.

Netting, F., Kettner, P., & McMurty, S. (1993). Social work macro practice (3rd ed.). Needham Heights, MA: Allyn & Bacon.

Neuman, K. (2000). Understanding organizational re- engineering in health care. Social Work in Health Care, 31(1), 19–33.

Parton, N. (2003). Rethinking professional practice: The contributions of social constructionism and the feminist ethics of care. British Journal of Social Work, 33(1), 1–16.

Pence, G. (2004). Classic cases in medical ethics (4th ed.). New York, NY: McGraw-Hill.

Percival, T. (1803). Medical ethics. Manchester, UK: S. Russel.

President’s Commission for the Study of Ethical Problems in Medicine and Biomedical and Behavioral Research. (1983). Deciding to forego life-sustaining treatment. Washington, DC: U.S. Government Printing Offi ce.

Proctor, E., Morrow-Howell, N., & Lott, C. (1993). Classifi cation and correlates of ethical dilemmas in hospital social work. Social Work, 38(2), 166–176.

Reamer, F. (1987). Values and ethics. In Encyclopedia of social work (18th ed., pp. 801–809). Silver Spring, MD: National Association of Social Workers.

Reamer, F. (1990). Ethical dilemmas in social service (3rd ed.). New York, NY: Columbia University Press.

Reamer, F. (1995). Social work values and ethics. New York, NY: Columbia University Press.

Reamer, F. (1998). The evolution of social work ethics. Social Work, 43(6), 488–497.

Reamer, F. (1999). Social work values and ethics (2nd ed.). New York, NY: Columbia University Press.

Reamer, F. (2003). Boundary issues in social work: Managing dual relationships. Social Work, 48(1), 121–133.

Rogers, C. (1959). A theory of therapy, personality, and interpersonal relationships as developed in client centered framework. In S. Koch (Ed.), Psychology: the study of a science: Vol. 3. Formulations of the person and the social context (pp. 184–256). New York, NY: McGraw-Hill.

Rokeach, M. (1973). The nature of human values. New York, NY: Free Press.

Schoener, G. (1995). Assessment of professionals who have engaged in boundary violations. Psychiatric Annals, 25, 95–99.

Simon, R. (1999). The natural history of therapist sexual misconduct identifi cation and prevention. Forensic Psychiatry, 22, 31–47.

Skloot, R. (2010). The immortal life of Henrietta Lacks. New York, NY: Crown.

Spurlin, P. (1984). The French enlightenment in America. Athens, GA: University of Georgia Press.

Strom-Gottfried, K. (1998). Informed consent meets managed care. Health & Social Work, 23(1), 25–33.

Strom-Gottfried, K. (2000). Ensuring ethical practice: An examination of NASW code violations, 1986–1997. Social Work, 45(3), 251–261.

Strom-Gottfried, K. (2003). Understanding adjudication: Origins, targets, and outcomes of ethics complaints. Social Work, 48(1), 85–94.

Trials of War Criminal Before the Nuremberg Military Tribunals Under Control Council Law 10 (1950). Superintendent of Documents. Washington, DC: U.S. Government Printing Offi ce.

Voltaire, F. (1759). Candide (Rev. ed., 2003; L. Walsh, trans.). New York, NY: Barnes & Noble Classics.

JWBT514_ch03.indd 63JWBT514_ch03.indd 63 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

64

4

Public Health and Social Work

MARJORIE R. SABLE, DEBORAH R. SCHILD, AND J. AARON HIPP

In his seminal 1920 piece “The Untilled Fields of Public Health,” Charles-Edward Amory Winslow, professor of public health at the Yale School of Medicine from 1915 to 1945, de- fi ned public health as:

the science and the art of preventing disease, prolonging life, and promoting physical health and effi ciency through organized community efforts for the sanitation of the environment, the control of community infections, the education of the individual in principles of personal hygiene, the organiza- tion of medical and nursing services for the early diagnosis and preventive treatment of disease, and the development of the social machinery which will ensure to every indi- vidual in the community a standard of living adequate for the maintenance of health. (In- stitute of Medicine [IOM], 1988, p. 39)

The core functions of public health agen- cies at all levels of government are assessment, policy development, and assurance (IOM, 1988; Schneider, 2000). Assessment refers to the regular collection, analysis, and sharing of information about health conditions, risks, and resources in a community. Policy development uses assessment data to develop local and state health and social welfare policies and to direct resources toward those policies. Assurance fo- cuses on the availability of necessary health services throughout the community. It includes maintaining the ability of both public health agencies and private providers to manage day- to-day operations as well as the capacity to respond to critical situations and emergencies.

Public health is a fi eld of practice with a spe- cifi c orientation and framework for the various

professionals who work within the public health arena. The professionals include both clinical practitioners, such as clinical social workers, nurses, health educators, occupational health and safety professionals, and physicians and nonclinical professionals, such as epidemiolo- gists, administrators, and policy makers.

Social workers are well prepared to work within public health and with other public health professionals because they share many of the same values, theories, and practice meth- ods. Shared values include a commitment to enhance social, economic, and environmen- tal justice and a focus on eliminating dispari- ties between and among various populations. Furthermore, social work and public health interventions primarily focus on oppressed, vul- nerable, and at-risk groups (Wilkinson, Rounds, & Copeland, 2002). Theoretical approaches to develop interventions are, in social work, the ecological approach of person in environment (Germain, 1984; Germain & Gitterman, 1980; Kondrat, 2008) and, in public health, social epi- demiology (Berkman & Kawachi, 2000; Oakes & Kaufman, 2006). Each is unique, but both rely on an understanding of how social systems relate to health status.

Social workers who work in public health serve as members of transdisciplinary teams, share many of the same skills as their col- leagues, and participate in public health inter- ventions. The unique approach that public health social workers bring to public health practice is grounded in social work theory, especially the person-in-environment approach to practice. The practice methods particular to social work- ers—family centered, community based, cultur- ally competent, coordinated care—have been

JWBT514_ch04.indd 64JWBT514_ch04.indd 64 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Public Health and Social Work 65

integrated into public health practice and ad- opted by various other providers of public health services (Bishop & Arango, 1997).

This chapter explores public health social work fi rst by examining its history and then by exploring its intersection with social work practice, current practices, research, and future directions.

Chapter Objectives • Review the history of public health social

work and introduce Healthy People 2020, the U.S. national public health goals and objectives.

• Discuss shared values and common ap- proaches in public health and social work practice.

• Describe levels of practice and components of prevention.

• Review public health interventions for health promotion and disease prevention.

• Identify emerging issues for public health social work practice and research.

HISTORY OF PUBLIC HEALTH SOCIAL WORK

An early public health intervention in the United States was an immunization campaign to prevent smallpox (World Health Organiza- tion [WHO], 1998). Public health interven- tions occurred before the modern era, but the combination of increasing sophistication in the medical sciences and the efforts of so- cial reformers helped establish modern public health. The roots of the modern institution of public health in the United States are almost indistinguishable from the roots of social work itself. Social reformers established settlement houses, proposed legislation, and succeeded in establishing programs that had far-reaching impacts on the health status of Americans.

The efforts of early social reformers led to the development of settlement houses and even- tually to the establishment of the Children’s Bureau in the U.S. Department of Health and Human Services (DHHS) (Gordon, 1994). The Children’s Bureau campaign to investigate and

reduce infant mortality provided the impetus for the passage of the Maternity and Infancy Protection Act, also known as the Sheppard- Towner Act of 1921 (Margolis, Cole, & Kotch, 2005). The Sheppard-Towner Act was the pre- cursor to Title V of the Social Security Act of 1935, which established the role of the federal government in providing and regulating mater- nal and child health services, crippled children’s services, and child welfare services (Gordon, 1994; Margolis et al., 2005). Title V, also re- ferred to as the Maternal and Child Health Services Block Grant, is administered by the Maternal and Child Health Bureau (MCHB) in DHHS. More information about the history and programs of Title V can be found on the MCHB Web site (http://mchb.hrsa.gov).

Although public health social work had its roots in maternal and child health, the prac- tice of public health social work has expanded into a number of areas (see Box 4.1). These in- clude participation in transdisciplinary teams working on such issues as pandemic infl uenza, physical activity and obesity, tobacco cessa- tion, human traffi cking, and disaster prepared- ness for both natural and man-made disasters.

Settlement Houses and Social Reform Movements

In the late 1890s, residents of settlement houses worked to improve the health of the

Box 4.1 Brief Defi nition of Public Health Social Work

A public health social worker is a graduate- prepared social worker whose primary practice fulfi lls core public health func- tions within a public or private agency. Although it includes all of the 10 essential public health functions, public health social work practice focuses on interventions to strengthen communities, families, and indi- viduals to promote health, well-being, and functioning and minimize disability and institutionalization.

Source: Adapted from Public Health Social Work Standards and Competencies (2005).

JWBT514_ch04.indd 65JWBT514_ch04.indd 65 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

66 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

communities in which they lived. For exam- ple, Jane Addams, a cofounder of Hull House in Chicago, ran for and was elected to be the public sanitarian in her ward. She worked to establish rubbish removal, clean water, and sewage management. At Hull House and at the Henry Street Settlement in New York, founded by Lillian Wald (1887–1940), resi- dents taught hygiene and other health-pro- moting behaviors to the community (Gordon, 1994). These social reform movements, which provided one of the foundations for the social work profession, served to inspire areas within public health such as community health, pub- lic health nursing, occupational health, and environmental health.

One resident of Addams’ Hull House was Alice Hamilton, a professor at the Woman’s Medical School of Northwestern University. While a professor of pathology and living at the Hull House, Hamilton became interested in the working conditions and occupational exposures of low-income residents. Her work

in industrial hygiene led to the creation of the Occupational Disease Commission of Illinois and her position as the fi rst female professor at Harvard University. Hamilton was a pioneer in the emerging fi eld of toxicology.

Healthy People 2020

Beginning in 1980 and continuing through each subsequent decade, DHHS has developed successive sets of national health promotion and disease prevention goals and objectives, the most recent of which is Healthy People 2020. The goals of Healthy People 2020 are to (a) eliminate preventable disease, disabil- ity, injury, and premature death; (b) achieve health equity, eliminate disparities, and im- prove the health of all groups; (c) create social and physical environments that promote good health for all; and (d) promote healthy devel- opment and healthy behaviors across every stage of the life cycle (Healthy People 2020, n.d. a). Figure 4.1 displays the Action Model

Innate individual traits: age, sex,

race, and biological

factors

Interventions

Determinants of Health

Assessment, Monitoring, Evaluation, and Dissemination

Action Model to Achieve Healthy People 2020 Overarching Goals

• Policies • Programs • Information

Outcomes • Behavioral outcomes • Specific risk factors, diseases, and conditions • Injuries • Well-being and health- related Quality of Life • Health equity

Across life course

Ind ivid

ual behavior

So ci

al, fa

mil y, an

d community networks

Liv ing

and working conditions

Bro ad s

ocial, e conomic, cultural, health, and environm

ental conditions and policies at the glob al, n

atio

na l, s

ta te

, a nd

lo ca

l l ev

el s

Figure 4.1 Action Model to Achieve Healthy People 2020 Overarching Goals (Healthy People 2020, n.d. a.).

JWBT514_ch04.indd 66JWBT514_ch04.indd 66 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Public Health and Social Work 67

to Achieve Healthy People 2020 Overarching Goals (Healthy People 2020, Phase I Report). The objectives for meeting these goals are di- vided into a broad spectrum of 38 topic areas. These objectives can be accessed through the Healthy People 2020 (n.d. b) home page (www.healthypeople.gov/hp2020).

The goals and objectives of Healthy People 2020 are guidelines for policy and prevention strategies. Many if not most of the topic areas and their objectives are arenas in which pub- lic health social workers practice and provide unique expertise to the development and im- plementation of public health prevention poli- cies and programs.

Although it is widely accepted that social factors are major determinants of health, the current Healthy People 2020 initiative has

only proposed social determinants of health as an objective area. As of this writing, any- one can create an online profi le and propose a social determinant of health objective. With- out set objectives, social objectives to reduce the number of children in poverty, reduce the number of children who go to bed hungry, and decrease the number of people who are un- employed are missing from the nation’s pub- lic health objectives, yet all are recognized as social determinants of health care. Examples of current social determinant–associated objectives are provided in Box 4.2. As the primary providers of psychosocial interven- tions, public health social workers should take the lead in advocating for inclusion of social objectives in subsequent versions of Healthy People.

Box 4.2 Example Healthy People 2020 Objectives Associated With Social Determinants of Health

Access to Health Services • Increase the proportion of people with

health insurance. • Reduce the proportion of individuals

who experience diffi culties or delays in obtaining necessary medical care, dental care, or prescription medicines.

Adolescent Health • Increase educational achievement of

adolescents and young adults. • Increase the percentage of adolescents

who are connected to a parent or other positive adult caregiver.

Early and Middle Childhood • Decrease the percentage of children who

have poor-quality sleep. • Increase the proportion of children who

are ready for school in all fi ve domains of healthy development.

Educational and Community-Based Programs • Increase high school completion. • Increase the proportion of elementary,

middle, and senior high schools that

provide comprehensive school health education to prevent health problems in these areas: unintentional injury; violence; suicide; tobacco use and addiction; alcohol or other drug use; unintended pregnancy, human immunodefi ciency virus (HIV)/acquired immunodefi ciency syndrome (AIDS), and sexually transmitted disease infection; unhealthy dietary patterns; and inadequate physical activity.

Environmental Health • Reduce the proportion of occupied

housing units that have moderate or severe structural problems.

• Increase the proportion of the population in the U.S.–Mexico border region that has adequate drinking water and sanitation facilities.

Family Planning • Increase the proportion of females at

risk of unintended pregnancy who used contraception at most recent sexual intercourse.

• Increase the proportion of adolescents who received formal instruction on reproductive health topics before they were 18 years old.

JWBT514_ch04.indd 67JWBT514_ch04.indd 67 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

68 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

INTERSECTION OF SOCIAL WORK AND PUBLIC HEALTH

As discussed in the introduction to this chapter, public health provides a specifi c orientation and framework for the various professionals who practice within the public health arena. Public health social workers fi ll many different posi- tions, including: case managers; health educa- tors; program planners and evaluators; grant writers; administrators and program directors at the federal, regional, state, and local levels; and executive directors of not-for-profi t agencies. Social workers now work in a variety of areas that once would have been considered the pur- view of public health, such as wellness, obesity prevention, physical activity, and smoking ces- sation (Curry et al., 2007; Lawrence, Hazlett, & Hightower, 2010; Leung et al., 2007; Thomas, Supiano, Chasco, McGowan, & Beer, 2009) The public health arena has expanded to defi ne issues important to social work, such as domes- tic violence and sexual assault, as signifi cant public health problems (Kimerling et al., 2010; Saftlas et al., 2010; Silverman et al., 2010).

Beginning in 1996, a group of public health social workers convened to develop a useful defi nition of public health social work. They debated whether public health social workers are defi ned by training, job, or a combination of both. What, they asked, are the common attributes of the person and the job? The de- bate led to a brief and a longer defi nition and a philosophy for public health social work. The defi nitions, philosophy, and model prac- tice standards and core competencies can be found online at http://oce.sph.unc.edu/cetac/ phswcompetencies_may05.pdf

Social work practice in public health dif- fers from clinical social work practice in two distinct ways:

1. Public health social work practice emphasizes health promotion, protection from environ- mental harms, and disease prevention.

2. Public health social work practice targets populations rather than individuals and groups (Watkins, 1985).

Social workers bring to public health practice skills, such as community assessment, and social work values, such as the promotion of social jus- tice, a focus on the most vulnerable populations, recognition for the need of cultural competence, and sensitivity to race and ethnicity. For example, public health social workers understand the need to tailor interventions to specifi c populations. Interventions developed for White, middle-class populations may not be effective with lower-in- come, minority populations.

The need for tailoring interventions to spe- cifi c populations has been supported by several researchers (Chin, Walters, Cook, & Huang, 2007; Green & Glasgow, 2006; Klesges, Dzewaltowski, & Glasgow, 2008). Chin and colleagues noted that few interventions work at the population level (are generalizable) and that interventions must be culturally tailored to work with each social, cultural, or racial/ ethnic group. Green and Glasgow developed review criteria to assess the external validity and potential generalizability of interventions. Elements of the criteria include descriptions of representativeness of participants and set- tings, extent of program adaptation and im- plementation of intervention content, and maintenance of intervention effects and long- term sustainability of programs. Klesges and colleagues applied the Green and Glasgow model to review the external validity of child- hood obesity prevention studies. They found that there remains a need for researchers to include external validity measures in their studies. They specifi cally identify three main criteria: “(1) representativeness of participants at the child, setting, and staff levels; (2) ro- bustness of intervention effects across differ- ent subgroups, delivery staff, and conditions; and (3) replicability of results across settings and under different contexts” (Klesges et al., 2008, p. 222).

Epidemiology and the Determinants of Health

The foundation of public health research is epidemiology, the study of the distribution and determinants of disease in populations. Public

JWBT514_ch04.indd 68JWBT514_ch04.indd 68 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Public Health and Social Work 69

health uses evidence-based interventions— those that are developed and verifi ed through research—to control and prevent epidemics and disease outbreaks.

A focus of epidemiological studies has been to examine the determinants of health and well-being. As stated in Healthy People 2020:

[H]ealth determinants are the range of per- sonal, social, economic, and environmental factors that determine the health status of in- dividuals or populations. They are embedded in our social and physical environments. So- cial determinants include family, community, income, education, sex, race/ethnicity, geo- graphic location, and access to health care, among others. Determinants in the physical environments include our natural and built environments. (n.d. a)

Lung cancer is a useful example to dem- onstrate the interactions of health determi- nants. Biologically, lung cancer is caused by a manifestation of malignant cells. Some in- dividuals may have a genetic predisposition to developing cancer, but other, nonbiologic causes of lung cancer exist. The most impor- tant additional determinant of lung cancer is the behavior of an individual. Cigarette smok- ing is the leading cause of lung cancer and is associated with 87% of cases (National Can- cer Institute [NCI], n.d). Secondhand smoke, or passive smoking, is an example of a physi- cal environmental cause of lung cancer. Bars where smoking is accepted and where people often socialize are another physical environ- ment that leads to lung cancer. Although not as powerful a factor in the development of lung cancer as smoking, exposures to indoor and outdoor airborne toxins, such as ash, dust, asbestos, and particulate matter, represent an- other cause.

These latter correlates with lung cancer also are associated with social determinants of health. In developing nations, it is common for women to cook over open stoves, using wood- or dung-fueled fi res. The women and their young children have direct exposure three times per day, as meals are prepared. Likewise,

asbestos has been linked causally to mesothe- lioma, a specifi c type of lung cancer. Asbestos is any of several silicate minerals mined for their fl ame-retardant and insulating properties. Many people in developed nations have been exposed during building renovations involv- ing old insulation. Asbestos has been linked to some of the lung conditions currently being experienced by fi rst responders to the World Trade Center on September 11, 2001. In de- veloping nations, the mining of these silicate minerals continues, usually by impoverished workers using little or no airway protection.

Lung cancer rates, like those of many dis- eases, vary by race and socioeconomic status (SES). In the United States, lung cancer rates in the African American community are higher for both males and females compared with the White American community (NCI, 2010). The rate ratios for both men and women were higher among those with less than a high school edu- cation than for those with a college education (3.01 and 2.02, respectively), and incidence rates were 1.7 times higher among those with incomes below $12,500 than for those with incomes above $50,000 (Clegg et al., 2009). A number of social factors promote smoking. When smoking is acceptable in one’s peer group, the social environment promotes that activity (Lakon, Hipp, & Timberlake, 2010). An example of a social factor is the placement of bright and colorful cigarette advertisements at children’s eye level in stores, thus enticing the next generation to become smokers (Havi- land & Sember, 2004). Public health efforts were effective in eliminating the use of mar- keting strategies directed at children, such as cartoons in advertising (Schooler, Feighery, & Flora, 1996).

Two overarching determinants of health are the macrolevel issues of policies and interven- tions and access to quality health care. Public health policies address health promotion and disease prevention. Some prevention policies to discourage tobacco use include smoke-free buildings and federal, state, and local laws that prohibit tobacco use where people work, espe- cially in airplanes and restaurants. In addition to reducing smoking behavior, these types of

JWBT514_ch04.indd 69JWBT514_ch04.indd 69 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

70 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

restrictions also are designed to protect em- ployees from constant exposure to secondhand smoke.

Access to care is especially important be- cause the later that cancer is diagnosed, the worse its prognosis. Access to diagnosis and treatment is limited not only by lack of health insurance but also by other social and environ- mental factors. Although the passage of the Patient Protection and Affordable Care Act (PPACA) in March 2010 requires that every- one have insurance by 2014, it does little to address other issues of access to care (Kaiser Family Foundation, 2010). System and insti- tutional barriers limit access to health care especially for lower-income and minority families (Dai, 2010). System barriers include inadequate capacity to serve the populations, and institutional barriers include problems in the organization and delivery of care. Some system factors for lower-income people are the limited numbers of health-care providers serving inner cities and rural areas and limited safety-net clinics for those who lack insurance. Clinic hours held only during the workday are an institutional barrier. Another institutional barrier is the lack of accommodation to com- munication needs of non-English speakers. Research on disparities in access to health care based on race, ethnicity, and language for those who are insured has shown that Span- ish speakers are less likely to get health care than their English-speaking peers. These fi nd- ings are consistent for physician visits, mental health services, mammograms, and infl uenza vaccinations (Fiscella, Franks, Doescher, & Saver, 2002; Weech-Maldonado et al., 2003). Many facilities have few interpreters, and pro- viders sometimes rely on family members, often children, to translate.

COMMON VALUES

Two values shared by social work and public health are the elimination of health disparities and the promotion of social, economic, and environmental justice. Health disparities exist

between and among populations defi ned by race or ethnicity, gender and gender identifi - cation, SES, education, employment or insur- ance status, disability status, and geography. Disparities also are found in screening, inci- dence, mortality, survivorship, and treatment (Gehlert, Mininger, Sohmer, & Berg, 2008).

Elimination of Health Disparities

At the request of Congress in 1999, IOM con- vened a panel of experts to examine the ex- tent to which racial and ethnic minority health disparities are attributable to disparities in health-care services. Their report, Unequal Treatment, found a consistent body of research demonstrating minority disparities in health care. Minorities were less likely than White American patients to receive appropriate care for heart disease, such as cardiac medications and bypass surgery, but more likely to receive less desirable medical procedures, such as lower limb amputations for diabetes (Smed- ley, Stith, & Nelson, 2003). Keefe (2010) dis- cusses racial and ethnic health-care disparities in seven health categories or conditions from a public health social work perspective: heart disease and stroke; cancer; HIV/AIDS; respi- ratory diseases; diabetes; maternal, infant, and child health; and mental health and mental disorders. For further information on social inequalities and health, please see the Public Broadcasting Series Unnatural Causes (www .pbs.org/unnaturalcauses/index.htm).

The overall health of an individual and the population is determined by a wide array of factors—from broad social economic, cultural, health, and environmental factors to individual behaviors. Interventions such as policies, pro- grams, and health interventions work across the life course and the social-individual envi- ronments to infl uence outcomes. Urie Bron- fenbrenner’s ecological systems theory (1979), a precursor to both person-in-environment and social epidemiology, outlines the infl uence of systems from the individual level (micro) to the cultural level (macro) with the inclusion of life course (chronosystem).

JWBT514_ch04.indd 70JWBT514_ch04.indd 70 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Public Health and Social Work 71

In addition to health inequalities related to race and ethnicity, it has long been known that health disparities are related to SES; the lower a person’s SES, the more likely that person is to have poor health. Recent research by Strin- ghini and colleagues (2010) found that health behaviors can account for some but not all of the SES effect. However, poor health behav- iors related to diet, physical activity, and al- cohol consumption are thought to be partially related to environmental stressors, which may be aggravated by low SES (Dunn, 2010). Health inequalities also are place based, as outlined in reference to access to care. Spatial infl uence also is captured in proximity and ac- cess to healthy environments, not just places of care. Mitchell and Popham (2008) found income-associated health inequalities in Eng- land but report that proximity to green spaces (i.e., parks) moderates this association. The

incidence rate ratio of all-cause mortality and circulatory disease, on average, decreased the closer one lived to green space. This decrease was slight for those of high income but was quite steep for those in the lower quartile of income (see Figure 4.2).

Racially based health disparities are particu- larly apparent when examining three important maternal and child health status indicators: in- fant mortality (IM), low birth weight (LBW), and maternal mortality. IM is one of the leading indicators used to measure a country’s health. Although the overall U.S. rate of IM dropped to 6.75 per 1,000 live births in 2007, this rate is still short of the Healthy People 2010 ob- jective of reducing IM to 4.5 per 1,000 (Xu, Kochanek, Murphy, & Tejada-Vera, 2010). The 2008 IM rate places the United States 33rd among nations monitored by the United Nations Populations Division (United Nations

Figure 4.2 Exposure to Green Space Mediates the Effect of Income on All-Cause and Circulatory Disease Mortality

Source: From Mitchell and Popham (2008).

2.2 All-cause mortalityA

In ci

de nc

e ra

te ra

tio

2.0

1.8

1.6

1.4

1.2

1.0

Income group 2 Income group 3 Income group 4

2.6 Deaths from circulatory diseaseB

In ci

de nc

e ra

te ra

tio

2.4

2.2

2.0

1.6

1.8

1.4

1.2

1.0 Group 1 (least) Group 2 Group 3

Exposure to green space Group 4 Group 5 (most)

JWBT514_ch04.indd 71JWBT514_ch04.indd 71 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

72 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

Department of Economic and Social Affairs, Population Division, 2007). The IM rate was 2.4 times greater in African American than in White American infants in 2007 (Mathews & MacDorman, 2010). LBW—the second lead- ing cause of IM—rose to 8.3% in 2007, the highest level reported in the United States for four decades. LBW rates for non-Hispanic Af- rican Americans was 14.0%, nearly double the rate for non-Hispanic White Americans (7.3%) in 2006 (Martin et al., 2009). Maternal mortal- ity for African American women was 26.5 per 100,000 live births, 2.7 times greater than the rate for White women (10.0 per 100,000) (Xu et al., 2010).

Place-based health disparities are also prevalent and often are tied to racial and socio- economic status. Food deserts—neighborhoods with limited access to healthy food—have been identifi ed in many low-income communities of color across the United States (Walker, Keane, & Burke, 2010). Disparities have been identi- fi ed in the proximity and access to parks and natural open space for recreation, psychological restoration, and social health (Floyd, Taylor, & Whitt-Glover, 2009; Hartig, 2008). Place also is tied to inequalities in the prevalence and main- tenance of chronic diseases including diabetes (Schootman et al., 2010), cancer (Freedman, Grafova, & Rogowski, 2011), HIV/AIDS and cardiovascular diseases (Nazmi, Diez Roux, Ranjit, Seeman, & Jenny, 2010).

Recognizing the vast health inequities across the world, WHO established the Com- mission on Social Determinants of Health (CSDH) in 2005. CSDH fi nds that health dis- parities are a matter of social justice and are created not only by policy but also by unequal distributions of power and wealth. In their fi nal report, CSDH offers three principles of action to close the gaps in health:

1) Improve the conditions of daily life—the circumstances in which people are born, grow, live, work, and age. 2) Tackle the in- equitable distribution of power, money, and resources—the structural drivers of those conditions of daily life—globally, nationally, and locally. 3) Measure the problem, evaluate

action, expand the knowledge base, develop a workforce that is trained in the social de- terminants of health, and raise public aware- ness about the social determinants of health. (CSDH, 2008, p. 2)

Promotion of Social, Economic, and Environmental Justice

Some current U.S. policies and inaccessibility to quality health services lead to social, eco- nomic, and environmental injustice. Social, economic, and environmental inequalities are determinants of disparities in health status. Thus, social work and public health both aim to promote changes that will lead to a more just society.

Social and physical environments that exist in poor neighborhoods, such as those in the inner city, contribute to adverse health outcomes. For example, the lack of job op- portunities creates a situation in which a neigh- borhood may tolerate sales of illegal drugs in order to bring in suffi cient income to support families. Drug sales in a community lead to addiction and its sequelae, such as illegal ac- tivities that lead to violent behavior, morbidity, and mortality.

A number of social factors, including the ubiquitous stressors of prejudice and poverty, also can lead to poor health status. Krieger (2003, 2005) has been conducting research on racism and health status for many years. She characterizes racism as one of the key fac- tors in establishing health status and identifi es fi ve pathways through which racism can harm health. These include: (1) economic and social deprivation; (2) exposure to toxins; (3) so- cially infl icted trauma; (4) targeted marketing of products harmful to health, such as alcohol, tobacco, and illicit drugs; and (5) inadequate or degrading medical care. In various studies, Krieger and her colleagues have shown the effects of perceived racism on differences in LBW and IM rates between African Ameri- can and White American women (Mustillo et al., 2004) and how racism plays into police violence (Cooper, Moore, Gruskin, & Krieger, 2004). Other groups, such as minority religions

JWBT514_ch04.indd 72JWBT514_ch04.indd 72 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Public Health and Social Work 73

and those with different gender expression and identifi cation (i.e., the lesbian, gay, bisexual, and transgendered [LGBT] community), also are oppressed and particularly vulnerable to system and institutional barriers to primary and secondary care.

Social epidemiology has been used as a tool to explain disparities within racial and ethnic groups. A study among middle-class African American women in Chicago found that birth outcomes were better for those living in pre- dominantly African American census tracks compared with those living in racially mixed areas. The researchers concluded that “the posi- tive effects of a better socioeconomic context may be countered for minority women by the ad- verse effects of racism or racial stigma” (Pickett, Collins, Masi, & Wilkinson, 2005, p. 2229).

Another example of a socially created health condition is obesity. The National Nutrition and Health Survey (NHANES) tracks the rates of overweight, obese, and extremely obese (mea- sured using Body Mass Index [BMI], calculated as the ratio of kilograms/meter2) in American

adults (Ogden & Carroll, 2010b). The preva- lence of overweight (BMI = 25.0–29.9) in adults 20 years and older has remained stable at about 34% since 1960. The prevalence of obesity (BMI ≥ 30) and extreme obesity (BMI ≥ 40) have more than doubled during the same time frame. In the 1960 to 1962 National Health Study, 13.4% of adults were obese; in the 2007– 2008 NHANES, 34.3% were. Extreme obesity has risen in prevalence from 0.9% in 1960–1962 to 6% in 2007–2008.

Disparities in the prevalence of obesity occur by race/ethnicity and gender (Ogden & Carroll, 2010b). In the 2007–2008 NHANES, prevalence was highest for non-Hispanic Black women (49.6%) and Hispanic women (45.1%) and lowest for non-Hispanic White men (31.9%). Clusters of obesity also is re- vealed geographically. The American South, especially the deep South and southern Appa- lachia, have the highest rates of adult obesity. Although the rates have increased over the past 20 years, the distribution of obesity remains mostly the same (see Figure 4.3).

1999

Obesity Trends* Among U.S. Adults BRFSS, 1990, 1999, 2009

(*BMI ≥ 30, or about 30 lbs. overweight for 5’4” person)

2009

1990

NoData <10% 10%–14% 15%–19% 20% –24% 25% –29% 30%≥

Figure 4.3 Spatial Distribution of Obesity Across the United States Source: Adapted from Centers for Disease Control and Prevention (2010). Data for fi gure was derived from Behavioral Risk Factor Surveillance System, CDC.

JWBT514_ch04.indd 73JWBT514_ch04.indd 73 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

74 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

Childhood obesity is a special concern of U.S. fi rst lady Michelle Obama. (Obesity in children is defi ned as BMI greater than or equal to sex- and age-specifi c 95th percentile from the 2000 CDC growth charts [Ogden & Carroll, 2010a].) NHANES has measured obesity in three age groups of children since the 1970s. The 1971–1974 NHANES reported the prevalence of obesity in children ages 2 to 5 years to be 5.0%; in children 6 to 11 years, 4.0%; and in children 12 to 19 years, 6.1%. The prevalence in the 2007–2008 NHANES dou- bled for the youngest children (10.4%), grew nearly fi ve times for children 6 to 11 years old (19.6%), and tripled for children 12 to 19 years old (18.1%). Similar to adults, adolescents (12–19 years old) exhibit inequalities in the distribution of obesity by race, ethnicity, and gender. The prevalence of obesity among non- Hispanic African American girls and Mexican American boys are highest (29.2% and 26.8%, respectively). The prevalence is lowest among non-Hispanic White girls (14.5%) and boys (16.7%) (Ogden & Carroll, 2010a).

Larger restaurant portions, fast food, and lack of exercise are some causes for the in- creased size of Americans. Busy work sched- ules limit parents’ time to prepare healthy meals, leaving them to rely on high-fat cafete- ria offerings for lunch (Eliadis, 2006). Time is spent on video games or watching televi- sion rather than on exercise. Cecil-Karb and Grogan-Kaylor (2009) studied the effects of parents’ perceptions of neighborhood safety on children’s BMI. They found a signifi - cant association between perceptions of poor neighborhood safety and BMI. This associa- tion was mediated by television watching. An- other factor associated with increased time indoors is the suburbanization and driving culture throughout most of the United States. Many social and policy practices and decisions enacted in the fi rst half of the 20th century have led to the urban–suburban dichotomy witnessed today in many cities.

As automobiles became more ubiquitous and vehicle traffi c increased in city centers, the number of pedestrian–vehicle accidents increased along with other sequelae. Families

began moving to the suburbs so that children would have more room to play outdoors, away from city traffi c (Frank, Engelke, & Schmid, 2003). At the same time, the practice of redlin- ing became acceptable. Redlining is the pro- cess by which lending institutions (generally for home mortgages) demarcate areas of cities to raise and lower interest rates and discrimi- nate in loan dealings based on characteristics such as ethnicity or income (Gee, 2008). Over decades, such processes drained the city-center tax base and left downtowns with low-income, predominately minority residents while the suburbs became majority Caucasian and middle income. The residents leaving urban centers for the suburbs took with them their tax base. Cities were left with limited fi nancial resources to support schools, parks, and pub- lic services. In turn, more people moved away from urban centers, creating a phenomenon that is only now being halted.

However, 70 years removed from the be- ginning of this exodus, families in the suburbs are suffering from a lack of physical activity. Suburban families now are forced to commute many miles by automobile for long periods, re- stricting active transportation, such as walking or bicycle riding. Time spent in the car is not replaced with play or physical activity when families return home. Meanwhile, downtowns across the United States are making efforts to revitalize with walkability as a core principle of regeneration. Cities are passing Complete Streets bills and ordinances that require streets to be multipurpose, including mixed-income residences, commercial space, and retail. The infrastructure of streets also is changing, with better-designed crosswalks and bike lanes and wider sidewalks (Frank et al., 2003).

Public health social workers can contrib- ute to the development of public policies, such as making neighborhoods safe and in- viting, by helping to determine the social and economic forces that encourage overweight and obesity. As cities work to reclaim their downtowns, many are turning to trendy loft districts to attract middle-income, and blue- collar workers. Unfortunately, this process is more akin to gentrifi cation than mixed-income

JWBT514_ch04.indd 74JWBT514_ch04.indd 74 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Public Health and Social Work 75

development. Wealthy developers are purchas- ing inexpensive buildings and developing a former low-income area for middle- to high- income residents with little consideration for the current residents. Low-income residents are forced to relocate, often away from social service providers proximate to their old neigh- borhoods. Cities usually benefi t fi nancially from gentrifi cation because of the increase in tax base and “clean” downtown neighbor- hoods. However, the process continues to seg- regate along racial and socioeconomic lines (for more, see Slater, 2006).

Public health social workers have suc- cessfully advocated changes in public policy to improve the health status indicators in the population, particularly for the disadvantaged, such as the Medicaid expansions under the Omnibus Budget Reconciliation Act of 1989. This and the expanded State Children’s Health Insurance Program (SCHIP), established as an optional program for states in 1997, are examples of policies that promote social and economic justice. In February 2009, the SCHIP program was reauthorized, and as of June 30, 2010, all states and territories and the District of Columbia had implemented SCHIP (Centers for Medicare and Medicaid Services, 2010).

Changing the distribution of fi nancial re- sources and promoting socially just actions would reduce the disparities in health status of vulnerable populations (McGinnis, William- Russo, & Knickman, 2002). Unfortunately, these attempts have not all been success- ful. The Medicaid expansion policies of the 1980s, which were intended to reduce health disparities by increasing access to care for low-income pregnant women, failed to reduce the disparity in birth outcomes between Af- rican American and White American women (Martin et al., 2009; Mathews & MacDorman, 2010; Xu et al., 2010).

The social work profession is strongly in favor of the need to achieve economic justice. The Delegate Assembly of the National As- sociation of Social Workers (NASW) meets every three years to develop and publish the public and professional policy statements for

the association. A prominent policy position that has been included and updated by NASW is for the development of public policies that promote economic justice. NASW (2009) continues to advocate on the issues of poverty and access to health care for all. To achieve a socially and economically just society will require changes in American social values, but it is a worthy goal of both public health and social work.

COMMON METHODOLOGIES FOR PRACTICE

Sound social work and public health interven- tions and policy are evidence based. To arrive at evidence-based practices, both fi elds rely on strong research and evaluation of programs and policies. One common approach used by social work and public health is the commu- nity assessment. Public health also uses social epidemiology for program planning and evalu- ation. Epidemiological methods used in public health also could be used by social workers in developing interventions at all levels of prac- tice. Another tool is a geographic information system (GIS), a software-based tool used in social work and public health practice and re- search to map spatial correlations, discrimina- tions, and to identify areas of need.

Mussolino (2005) analyzed the NHANES I to provide evidence of a prospective asso- ciation between depression and hip fracture. Interventions that target depression in elderly people theoretically may impact the contribu- tion of hip fracture to morbidity and mortality. This is an example of how public health so- cial work intervention might improve a public health outcome. Another example is based on data collected from the National Hospital Am- bulatory Medical Care Survey, which estab- lished the home as the predominant location of injury for U.S. children. The researchers recommend interventions targeting the home environment to reduce the morbidity and mor- tality from unintentional injury in U.S. chil- dren (Phelan, Khoury, Kalkwarf, & Lanphear, 2005).

JWBT514_ch04.indd 75JWBT514_ch04.indd 75 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

76 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

Community Assessment

Community assessment is a method of iden- tifying the strengths and weaknesses in a de- fi ned community. Members of the community are involved in designing, implementing, and analyzing the information gathered from as- sessments. Other assessments are initiated by public authorities in response to legal mandate and may or may not involve community mem- bers. In either case, the assessments help to defi ne problems and gaps in services so that the community and professionals can advocate for improvements to existing programs and for new policies and programs.

Comprehensive community assessments use various methods to obtain data for analy- sis. These methods include community sur- veys, health impact assessments (see Box 4.3), interviews with community leaders, and town hall meetings. Data collection may be from vital records of births and deaths, hospital dis- charge information, and other data from public health and social service agencies.

Because of their training, social workers are well prepared to conduct community assess- ments. Public health social workers contrib- ute to public health assessments and in doing so provide insights regarding the social con- text of health and disease. Public health social workers collaborate with other public health professionals to apply social understanding to interventions that are developed in response to community assessment (Wilkinson et al., 2002). For example, they participate in child death review teams to provide the person-in-en- vironment perspective. Community assessment is also crucial to the development of culturally competent social marketing strategies. A study that explored factors linking at-risk African Americans with health-promotion programs found that, contrary to common perception, the use of the African American church and the use of a high-profi le person to deliver a mes- sage actually may be counterproductive to ef- forts to motivate people to use health prevention programs (Icard, Bourjolly, & Siddiqui, 2003). This fi nding is an example of how research should guide evidence-based practice.

Box 4.3 Health Impact Assessments

Health impact assessments (HIA) were fi rst established in Europe in the late 1990s. The National Health Service of the United Kingdom defi nes an HIA as a

developing approach that can help to identify and consider the potential—or actual—health impacts of a proposal on a population. Its primary output is a set of evidence-based recommendations geared to informing the decision-making process. These recommendations aim to highlight practical ways to enhance the positive aspects of a proposal, and to remove or minimise any negative impacts on health, wellbeing and health inequalities that may arise or exist. (Taylor & Quigley, 2002, p. 2)

Colleagues of the authors recently completed an HIA in St. Louis, MO. The core team consisted of two researchers from the school of medicine, one from the design and visual arts school, three from social work, and one from public health, in addition to one community partner. The steering committee consisted of eight stakeholders from the local community, either residents or local practitioners from schools, religious organizations, municipalities, or nongovernmental organizations. Finally, there were groups of consultants, students, community surveyors, and an advisory team, most of whom were associated with social work and/or public health. The team worked together to identify a series of recommendations offered to a redevelopment effort in a low-income community of color.

Social Epidemiology

Social epidemiology—the study of the impact of social factors on the distribution of health and illness in a population—examines the role of social variables on other known and ac- cepted biological and behavioral factors that shape the health status of a community (Oakes

JWBT514_ch04.indd 76JWBT514_ch04.indd 76 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Public Health and Social Work 77

& Kaufman, 2006). Social epidemiology is a research method that uses mostly quantitative data to identify social determinants of health and health outcomes. For example, Lynch and Kaplan (2000) have conducted numerous studies to better understand the impact of so- cioeconomic position on health. Using the fi nd- ings from their and others’ studies, they have developed a theoretical model to explain these effects. This model uses a life-course perspec- tive and takes into account a broad range of conditions and statuses, and it discusses the variation in measures of socioeconomic posi- tion. This variation demonstrates the challenges of conducting social epidemiologic studies. For example, Krieger and her colleagues have studied the effects of racism on health (Krieger, 2005; Krieger, Chen, Waterman, Rehkopf, & Subramanian, 2003). To do so, they had to de- velop a measure of perceived racism, which, although used by others, still is not universally accepted because the experience of racial dis- crimination can be thought of as subjective, and thus the measure might not work the same way in all settings. Others have examined race and health of children and found important associa- tions (Flores, Olson, & Tomany-Korman, 2005).

Some social epidemiologists use qualita- tive as well as quantitative data. An exam- ple is the Fetal and Infant Mortality Review (FIMR), sponsored and monitored by MCHB (Hutchins, Grason, & Handler, 2004; Koontz, Buckley, & Ruderman, 2004). FIMRs are con- ducted at the community level after a fetal or infant death that cannot be attributed to a med- ical cause—for example, sudden infant death syndrome (SIDS). The purpose of an FIMR is to gather medical and social information that can be used to enhance the health and well- being of women, infants, and families. That information then can be used to improve com- munity resources and service delivery systems to reduce additional fetal and infant deaths. FIMRs are conducted by examining medical care data, autopsies, and assessments, often completed by social workers, of the social en- vironment of the pregnant woman and the in- fant. Attention is given to housing, number of adults and children in the household, and other

family resources. The data are reviewed by transdisciplinary technical advisory commit- tees that, in addition to physicians and nurses, may include clinical social workers and com- munity volunteers. Public health social work- ers contribute to these reviews by interpreting the social contexts in which deaths occur.

Geographic Information Systems

GISs allow for the spatial analysis of distri- butions, trends, services, clusters, and so on. Through a system of data management and software, a person can utilize a GIS to map information on scales from a neighborhood to worldwide. These skills are taught to students in many universities. For example, in a joint social work and public health course at Washington University in St. Louis that is built around a community-based teaching model, students work with community agencies in need of spa- tial analysis. Past analyses have included mar- ket research to analyze where donations most often come from and where agencies might better market their organizations to obtain additional donations and funds. Two recent projects mapped neighborhood assets, crimes, and empty lots to identify the best locales for service expansion. Another project mapped the percentage of students receiving free and reduced-price lunches across a city against the location of summertime meal providers and local soup kitchens (see Figure 4.4). This proj- ect allowed the agency to identify communities within the city that have a high proportion of children who receive free and reduced-priced lunch who also live in areas with limited access to summertime and weekend food services. This spatial analysis identifi ed neighborhoods for the expansion of food provisions.

Community assessment, social epidemiol- ogy, and GISs are tools that clearly identify the social and physical environmental factors in the determination of health status and dis- crimination in a community. With the informa- tion gleaned from using these methods, public health social workers and other public health professionals can work together toward the goal of improving the quality of life of the public.

JWBT514_ch04.indd 77JWBT514_ch04.indd 77 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

78 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

LEVELS OF PRACTICE AND COMPONENTS OF PREVENTION

At the micro, or direct-practice, level, public health social workers implement public health interventions using clinical social work skills or provide social work services as part of a larger public health program. At the mezzo, or indirect- practice level, public health social workers de- velop, implement, and administer public health programs. At the macro level, public health social workers contribute their knowledge of psychosocial and cultural issues to the develop- ment of public health interventions. They also are involved in surveillance and evaluation of programs that serve low-income and vulnerable populations. Public health social workers are en- gaged in the policy-making arena in conjunction with other public health professionals.

Much of public health practice takes place at the macro level. Social work and public health

administrators at the macro level of practice use community-based assessments to develop interventions. Public health practitioners may use nonclinical social work interventions, such as job programs and health-care reform, to change the social environment. Public health practitioners, including public health social workers, conduct theoretical and intervention research in order to advance a shared commit- ment to evidence-based practice.

Components of Prevention

Disease prevention is divided into three levels: primary, secondary, and tertiary (Schneider, 2000). Primary prevention is intended to pro- tect us from injury and disease. Examples in- clude the Back-to-Sleep national campaign for the prevention of SIDS, immunizations against childhood and other diseases, and automobile restraints and airbags. Another primary pre- vention is the imposition of large taxes on

Iowa

Missouri

Arkansas Kentucky

Tennessee

Springfield

St. Louis

Chicago

Illinois

Indiana

St. Louis City County Children Receiving Food Baskets by OFS (Avg. for Jan. through Dec.) Compared to Children in Poverty by Census Track, 2009

Operation Food Search OFS Partner Agencies

Children Receiving Food Baskets Kernel Density: Avg. for Jan. – Dec.

High Density

Low Density Children in Poverty Number

less than – 50 51 – 100 101 – 200 201 – 500 501 and greater

Data obtained from the U.S. Census 2000 and Operation Food Search Map Created Hyunil Kim and Cecilia A. Zappa

Chesterfield

Meramec

Lafayette

Queeny

Missouri River

Bonhomme Jefferson

Illinois

Clayton Hadley

University

Normandy

Norwood

Fergoson HallsFerry

St. Ferdinand

Spanish Lake

Lewis and Clark

Florissant Northwest

Airport

Midland

Creve Coeur Maryland Heights

MissouriMissouriMissouri

Gravois

St. Louis County St. Louis City

Tensson Ferry

Oakville

Lemay Concord

Location

Figure 4.4 GIS Map Showing the Number of Children Living in Poverty per Census Track and the Number of Children Receiving Food Baskets From Community-Based Agencies

Source: Reproduced courtesy of Operation Food Search, St. Louis, MO, and MSW students Hyunil Kim and Cecilia Zappa.

JWBT514_ch04.indd 78JWBT514_ch04.indd 78 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Public Health and Social Work 79

tobacco to limit its use by increasing the cost of cigarettes and other tobacco products.

Secondary prevention is the early diagnosis and treatment of disease and seeks to reverse or retard a disease process from progressing. Examples are Pap smears, mammograms, and prostate-specifi c antigen tests to identify malig- nant or premalignant states and intervene to ef- fect a cure or slow the progression of the illness.

Tertiary prevention includes those actions taken to minimize the effects of a disease and prevent further disability. Periodic eye exams to detect and treat diabetic retinopathy are a type of tertiary prevention because they pre- vent disability deriving from diabetes although they do not treat the primary disease.

TYPES OF PUBLIC HEALTH SOCIAL WORK INTERVENTIONS

The intersection of the three levels of social work practice with the three levels of prevention is displayed in Figure 4.5. The public health crisis of HIV is used to illustrate public health

social work interventions within the familiar framework of micro, mezzo, and macro levels of practice and components of prevention.

Primary Prevention of HIV at the Micro, Mezzo, and Macro Levels

The roles of public health social workers in the primary prevention of HIV at the micro level include condom distribution in clinics, counsel- ing women living with HIV about their health and family planning, and participating in needle exchange programs. At the mezzo level, public health social workers administer community- based programs for safe needle exchange and condom distribution. Needle exchange has been a controversial primary prevention intervention for HIV, and public health social workers who advo- cate for federal, state, and local policy to permit this intervention are working at the macro level.

Secondary Prevention of HIV at the Micro, Mezzo, and Macro Levels

Outreach and early intervention services are particularly important to meet the needs of

Mic ro

Mez zo

Mac ro

Components of Prevention

Levels of Practice

Public Health Social Work Model of Practice

Types of Intervention

Knowledge SkillsValues

Condom distribution

and sexuality education

Community-based needle exchange

and condom distribution programs

Advocacy for primary prevention program

establishment and funding

Counseling and testing

Community-based programs for

people with HIV

Advocacy for better policies to increase early detection and

treatment of HIV

Systematic mode of adherence counseling for HAART

Cross-program coordination for

local agency efforts

Advocacy for funding program

such as Ryan White

Sec ond

ary Prim

ary Tert

iary

Figure 4.5 Components of Prevention and Levels of Practice

JWBT514_ch04.indd 79JWBT514_ch04.indd 79 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

80 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

people living with HIV who are not receiv- ing care. Many public health social workers work in hospitals, local health departments, and community-based programs that provide counseling and testing for HIV. The Posi- tive Start program in Missouri provides an interface between the community HIV/AIDS agency and the Department of Corrections. It targets inmates living with HIV who are sched- uled to be released (personal communication, Cale Mitchell, executive director, Rain Central Missouri, July 20, 2010). This mezzo program creates a connection to clients by providing re- ferrals for case management after release and educates them about prevention when they re- join society. Public health social workers who fi ght discriminatory policies targeting people with HIV, such as in employment and housing, are working at the macro level.

Tertiary Prevention of HIV at the Micro, Mezzo, and Macro Levels

Examples of tertiary prevention at the micro level include direct-service case management for medical services, securing resources to enhance health outcomes (supportive services such as housing and food vouchers), and mak- ing referrals and providing payment assistance for visits to infectious disease specialists or HIV-focused physicians. Mezzo-level public health social workers administer programs that help people living with HIV obtain and maintain stable and high-quality housing, for example. Public health social workers oper- ating in the research and policy arenas to ad- vance improved programs for people living with HIV are working at the macro level for tertiary prevention.

PUBLIC HEALTH SOCIAL WORK PRACTICE TODAY

Public health social work practice today is a growing fi eld. There are social workers work- ing in public health at all levels of practice and with all components of prevention. The prac- tice settings for public health social workers

refl ect the partnership between public health and social work.

Practice Settings

Public health social workers do not practice in isolation. Their practice, often on transdis- ciplinary teams, takes place in host settings that are usually public but also may be private. Public settings include federal public health agencies as well as state and local health de- partments. At all three levels of government, public health social workers work in various policy-making and program positions. In ad- dition, public health social work practice is primarily at the population level. For example, public health social workers work side by side with public health environmental specialists to ensure that safe housing is available to a community of elders. They work with public health nurses, physicians, and epidemiologists to develop, implement, and evaluate programs that serve all ages in the population. They coordinate home visiting programs targeting pregnant women at high risk for poor birth outcomes.

Federal-level public health social workers work in national and regional offi ces. They create and administer regulations for policy implementation and manage and provide over- sight for grants, such as the MCHB grant and Special Projects of Regional and National Signifi cance and other federal grants. Some public health social workers provide training, and others conduct and use research to inform evidence-based interventions. Federal public health social workers act as liaisons to state programs funded by block grants.

Public health social workers are found in a variety of state-administered, federally funded programs, such as the Title V Children with Special Health Care Needs program. They work as the intermediaries between state and local health departments and other public health agencies in managing federal pass- through dollars. Public health social workers provide management oversight for the pro- grams and train managers to comply with fed- eral mandates. Public health social workers at

JWBT514_ch04.indd 80JWBT514_ch04.indd 80 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Public Health and Social Work 81

the federal and state levels also provide expert testimony and advocate for public health pro- grams when Congress and state legislatures develop policy and budgets that will affect the public’s health.

Local health departments are the work- horses within the public health system, and programs generally associated with these agencies are the maternal and child health programs (family planning, prenatal care, well-child care, immunizations), disease sur- veillance and treatment programs (tubercu- losis control, sexually transmitted infections, West Nile virus, pandemic infl uenza such as H1N1), and environmental protection pro- grams (restaurant inspection, vermin control, air quality, milk safety, veterinary-borne dis- ease). In addition, vital statistics (birth and death certifi cates) often are housed within local health departments.

At the local level, in public health depart- ments as well as in private nonprofi t agencies, public health social workers develop and im- plement programs and provide direct service. Some examples of direct practice are case management for specifi c populations, home visiting, immigrant health services, HIV/AIDS counseling and testing, outreach to elderly people for blood pressure screening and other health services, and family planning and other reproductive health care. Public health social workers also work in community and migrant primary care centers.

Private settings in which public health so- cial workers are employed usually are located in not-for-profi t agencies, such as Planned Parenthood, domestic violence shelters, AIDS organizations, and established agencies, such as the YMCA/YWCA. Public health social work practice in private settings usually does not differ from practice in the public sector. Private agencies often are created to provide services that are limited or prohibited by government regulations, such as counseling clients about abortion. Some programs that operate in the private sector are supported by public funds and must comply with govern- ment regulations that apply to the services they provide. Although the practice settings

remain standard, the areas of concern for pub- lic health social workers shift as social and economic conditions change and as diseases emerge.

Both public and private development agen- cies offer another example of practice settings for public health social work. The U.S. Agency for International Development (USAID; www .usaid.gov) is a federal government agency that “supports long-term and equitable economic growth and advances U.S. foreign policy objec- tives by supporting economic growth, agricul- ture, and trade; global health; and democracy, confl ict prevention, and humanitarian assis- tance.” Both for-profi t (e.g., Development Al- ternatives, Inc.) and not-for-profi t (e.g., Hope International, Response To Intervention, Cen- ter for Agricultural Bioscience International) private agencies also work in international development to advance social, economic, and environmental justice.

PREPARING TO BE A PUBLIC HEALTH SOCIAL WORKER

There are various ways to prepare to be a pub- lic health social worker. Although many public health social workers do not have formal pub- lic health education or public health degrees, in applicants for these positions, employers look for sound social work knowledge as it re- lates to public health practice. Typically pub- lic health social workers are trained on the job and learn through continuing education and participation in regional and national meetings of public health social workers. The annual meetings of the American Public Health As- sociation (APHA) and the Association of State and Territorial Public Health Social Workers (ASTPHSW) are examples of learning and networking opportunities for public health so- cial workers.

Increasingly, social work students who plan on practicing in public health enroll in one of the existing dual or joint master’s in social work/master’s in public health (MSW/ MPH) programs. These programs are grow- ing in size and number. Courses completed in

JWBT514_ch04.indd 81JWBT514_ch04.indd 81 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

82 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

one degree fulfi ll requirements in the second, allowing students to meet all requirements with a reduced credit load. In some schools, practica and internships also are identifi ed that meet the practice requirements of both social work and public health, affording the student experience in interdisciplinary or transdisciplinary work. Each university and each of the schools of social work and public health has unique programs and admissions processes.

For social work master’s students who are considering public health practice but are not at a school where a dual-degree program is of- fered, there are many other ways to prepare. Some schools offer social work concentra- tions in pertinent areas, such as health, mental health, and gerontology, which may include some public health content. If there is a public health school, department, or program at the university or college, students can take courses in that program as electives. If there is no public health program, there may be one at a nearby institution. Faculty members with pub- lic health training can supervise independent study. Students can work with fi eld placement offi ces to fi nd a practicum experience in a pub- lic health agency. Students are welcomed at public health social work meetings and events, often at reduced rates.

Certain areas of knowledge and resources are particularly valuable. At the federal level, the primary agency related to public health social work practice is DHHS. Key agen- cies in DHHS are the Health Resources Ser- vices Administration (HRSA), the National Institutes of Health, the Centers for Disease Control and Prevention, the Administration of Children Youth and Families, and the Sub- stance Abuse and Mental Health Services Administration. MCHB and the Offi ce of the Surgeon General are located within HRSA. Each of these agencies publishes documents and reports with essential information about public health. They also sponsor research to develop new knowledge and test interven- tions related to the public’s health. Two other important federal programs within the De- partment of Agriculture are Women, Infants,

and Children and the Supplemental Nutrition Assistance Program (SNAP; formerly the Food Stamp Program).

The federal, state, and local public health programs all relate to one another, usually in regard to the fl ow of funds. How federal regu- lations affect state health departments and how state and local health departments interact is critical knowledge for public health social workers.

As professionals, public health social workers are expected to keep current with changes in the fi eld. Important resources for public health social workers are, as men- tioned, APHA (including the Social Work section) and ASTPHSW. Furthermore, there are numerous texts, federal publications (such as Healthy People 2020 and Morbidity and Mortality Weekly Report), and journals that will help inform public health social work- ers. Some of the important journals are the American Journal of Public Health, Health & Social Work, Social Work in Health Care, Social Work in Public Health, Maternal and Child Health Journal, Public Health Reports, and Health Affairs.

EMERGING ISSUES FOR PUBLIC HEALTH SOCIAL WORK

Global Issues of Disaster Preparedness, Terrorism, Climate Change, Oppression, and Social Justice

Terrorism, disasters, war, disease, climate change, and social justice will shape the focus of much public health social work practice during the coming years. The attacks on the World Trade Center and the Pentagon on September 11, 2001, stimulated awareness among Americans of both the reality of do- mestic terrorism and the plights of oppressed people in other parts of the world. The domes- tic terrorism threat increasingly is an area of practice for public health social workers who are active members of disaster preparedness and response teams (see Box 4.4).

JWBT514_ch04.indd 82JWBT514_ch04.indd 82 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Public Health and Social Work 83

Box 4.4 Disaster Preparedness and Response Teams: New Orleans Rebuilding

In fall 2005, the city of New Orleans suffered a trifecta of disasters: the winds and rain of Hurricane Katrina, the failure of the protective levee system, and the pressures of another storm, Hurricane Rita. The loss of life, home, and livelihood was unprecedented in American history, and images from the disasters exposed the harsh realities of poverty and vulnerability endemic in urban America.

With skills in population-focused intervention, perspective of social systems, and knowledge of individual assessments of well-being, public health social workers have played critical roles in the rebuilding and recovery of New Orleans and its citizenry. Looking back at the disasters for lessons and improvements, public health social workers have assisted in developing disaster plans and coordination agreements at civic, community, and agency levels. This assistance includes the creation of services that are sensitive to the unique needs of the city’s most vulnerable groups in regard to transportation and shelter provisions. In addition to these activities focused on equipping the community for future challenges, public health social workers are active in recovery and resilience

as communities work to repair the social fabric torn away by the trauma and struggle associated with loss and displacement. Public health social workers participate in recovery and rebuilding in diverse roles, including:

• Assisting in civic engagement activities that refl ect on the lessons of the disaster and give voice to the displaced

• Advocating for homeowners and workers to be protected from environmental exposures during cleanup

• Coordinating safe housing and resources for those returning home

• Addressing needs within social service systems as population numbers and composition changes

• Supporting the development of community clinics and facilitating primary health-care providers for residents

The many roles of public health social workers in New Orleans illustrate the demand for professionals with these skills and the valuable contributions they can make.

Source: Courtesy of Holly Scheib, PhD, MSW, MPH, Director of International Programming, Tulane School of Social Work, New Orleans, LA.

Disaster Preparedness and Response

Public health social workers have increasingly played a role in disaster preparedness and re- sponse. Disasters are “emergencies of a sever- ity and magnitude resulting in deaths, injuries, illness, and/or property damage that cannot be effectively managed by the application of routine procedures or resources” (Landesman, 2005, p. 1). Rounds and colleagues describe three types of disasters: natural, technological, and complex (Rounds, Caye, Ross-Sheriff, Bailey, & Anderson, 2005; Rounds, Caye, Walsh, Vaughn, & Anderson, 2008). Natural disasters include acts of nature, such as fl oods, hurricanes, tornados, volcanic eruptions, earth- quakes, and landslides. Some technological

disasters are machinery or equipment malfunc- tions, including factory explosions, nuclear power plant failures, chemical spills, and air- plane failures. Examples of complex disasters are catastrophic events of intentional human strategy, including acts of terrorism and war. Emerging diseases, such as pandemic infl u- enza, also can constitute disasters requiring public health social work intervention.

Hurricane Katrina and the ensuing fl ood in New Orleans (August 2005) represent both a natural and technological disaster. The hur- ricane itself was disastrous in areas such as Biloxi, MS, yet produced minimal damage in New Orleans. The lack of infrastructure and failure to repair a levee there, however, re- sulted in massive fl ooding in the Ninth Ward,

JWBT514_ch04.indd 83JWBT514_ch04.indd 83 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

84 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

a lower-income, mostly African American section of the city. Inadequate disaster plan- ning for fl ooding exemplifi es how disasters can disproportionately affect oppressed pop- ulations, because people without cars have limited ability to evacuate. The aftereffects of hurricanes and fl ooding include disloca- tion, separation from families, lack of medi- cal and mental health care, and disruption of education for children. Similarly, the British Petroleum oil spill of 2010 not only led to eco- logical disaster but produced physical, mental, and economic health consequences for many of the residents of the Gulf Coast affected by Hurricane Katrina.

Public health social workers have de- veloped detailed practice guidelines and educational training modules for disas- ter preparedness, reaction, and response. Landesman’s 2005 text, Public Health Man- agement of Disasters: The Practice Guide (2nd ed.), provides a broad overview of types of disasters and the role of public health in agency and community planning, assessment, and response. For example, in her chapter on mental health strategies, she reviews the psy- chological and emotional impact of disasters, such as posttraumatic stress disorder, and provides strategies for response. Landesman identifi es three public health roles:

1. Help restore the psychological and social functioning of individuals and the community.

2. Reduce the occurrence and severity of ad- verse mental health outcomes due to expo- sure and technological disasters through prevention, assessment, and response.

3. Help speed recovery and prevent long-term problems by providing information about normal reactions to disaster-related stress and how to handle these reactions.

Disaster Preparedness for Public Health Social Workers is a two-part online educa- tional training module. Part I focuses on natu- ral disasters (Rounds et al., 2005), and Part II focuses on bioterrorism (Rounds et al., 2008).

Terrorism and Climate Change

In their 2009 article “Psychology in an Age of Ecological Crisis,” Stokols and colleagues outline the myriad ecological changes humans currently face. The authors discuss global threats to personal and societal well-being, in- cluding terrorism and climate change. There is a disconnect and latent fear between the two seemingly unrelated challenges. A feeling of helplessness has led some terror researchers to coin the term pretraumatic stress syndrome (Sinclair & LoCicero, 2010) and to study helplessness depression (Berry, Bowen, & Kjellstrom, 2010).

According to environmental psychology, “people ideally strive to achieve optimal en- vironments or those that maximize the fulfi ll- ment of their needs and the accomplishment of their goals and plans” (Stokols et al., 2009, p. 187). In other words, humans strive for op- timal environments for our own well-being. Achieving such environments becomes ex- traordinarily diffi cult when environments are harmed or people are constantly afraid of the threat of such harm. Public health social work- ers are uniquely positioned to meet the chal- lenges delineated by Stokols and colleagues.

New conceptualizations of human response to ecological, social, and technological change are needed, particularly those that

• Address the links between local and global events.

• Encompass collective as well as individual efforts to cope with impending threats.

• Incorporate an extended rather than narrow time perspective.

GLOBAL ISSUES OF OPPRESSION AND SOCIAL JUSTICE

Oppression

Internationally, particularly in West Asia and the Middle East, the health of women and children has been highly compromised by war,

JWBT514_ch04.indd 84JWBT514_ch04.indd 84 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Public Health and Social Work 85

isolation due to religious rules, and political policies of western governments. Growing numbers of public health social workers will be needed as members of international teams to improve the health of refugees and residents in foreign nations. Foci of their work will be in the maternal and child health arena to improve women’s overall and reproductive health, psy- chological capacity to deal with posttraumatic stress disorder, and prevent and protect com- munities from the effects of poverty and the aftermath of war and terrorism.

In the United States, HIV/AIDS is now being treated as a chronic disease. The abil- ity of the United States and other industrial- ized nations to achieve this state is due to the wealth that supports provision of antiretroviral drugs to people living with HIV. In develop- ing countries, expensive drugs are beyond the reach not only of HIV/AIDS populations but also of governments with very limited mon- etary resources.

In sub-Saharan Africa, the epidemic of HIV/AIDS affects up to 25% of the popula- tion in some countries. Social and economic consequences of the disease can be addressed by public health social workers. In response to the President’s Emergency Plan for AIDS Re- lief (PEPFAR), which was proposed in 2003, Congress enacted the U.S. Leadership Against HIV/AIDS, Tuberculosis, and Malaria Act of 2003 (PL 108–25). PEPFAR was reauthorized on July 30, 2008. The new act (H.R. 5501, the Tom Lantos and Henry J. Hyde United States Global Leadership against HIV/AIDS, Tuber- culosis, and Malaria Reauthorization Act of 2008) was signed into law, authorizing up to $48 billion over the following fi ve years to combat global HIV/AIDS, tuberculosis, and malaria. The three goals of PEPFAR are to: (1) support treatment for 2 million HIV-infected individuals; (2) support prevention of 7 mil- lion infections; and (3) support care for 10 million infected and affected by HIV/AIDS, including orphans and vulnerable children (U.S. President’s Emergency Plan for AIDS Relief, n.d.). Interventions to meet these three goals are within the scope of public health social work practice. U.S. social workers can

participate on international transdisciplinary teams to address these goals.

Another issue of oppression at global and national levels is human traffi cking (see Box 4.5). Human traffi cking has been described as a form of modern-day slavery. Although largely hidden, it is widespread throughout the United States. Traffi cking can take the form of forced prostitution; forced labor situations such as domestic servants, nannies, sweatshop workers, janitors, restaurant workers, migrant farm workers, fi shery workers, hotel or tour- ist industry workers, and beggars (U.S. De- partment of Health and Human Services [US DHHS], 2008a).

According to United Nations Offi ce on Drugs and Crime (UNODC), the United States is one of the highest “countries of destina- tion” for human traffi cking victims globally (UNODC, 2006), with estimates of 18,000 to 20,000 human beings traffi cked into and through the United States every year (US DHHS, 2008b). Although the exact number of people affected globally is unknown, the United Nations (2009/2010) estimates that some 2.5 million people throughout the world at any given time are the victims of human traffi cking.

Public health social workers on the front- line can play supportive roles by helping to identify victims and by providing after-care services, such as rehabilitation and reintegra- tion (Hokenstad, 2010; Salett, 2006). These might include services in housing, health care, addictions treatment, immigration, food, income, employment, and legal services. So- cial workers also can play a preventive role by educating potential victims, educating law enforcement personnel about the issue, and ad- vocating for the protection of this vulnerable population. Community partnerships and sup- port networks are critical for addressing and overcoming the social exclusion of these vic- tims (Hokenstad, 2010; Salett, 2006).

An example of such a partnership is the Central Missouri Stop Human Traffi cking Coalition, a multisector coalition made up of members of the community and representa- tives from different organizations, including

JWBT514_ch04.indd 85JWBT514_ch04.indd 85 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

86 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

Box 4.5 Human Traffi cking

Three cases on identifying human traffi cking from the Family Violence Prevention Fund (2007) are presented in this box. As you read each case, ask yourself: Is this traffi cking? If so, what is it for (sex or labor or both)? Here are some traffi cking red-fl ag questions to ask about potential traffi cking victims:

• How did they get here? • What happened once they got here? • Was there fraud or coercion? • What were their real or perceived choices? • Who is in control? • Can they leave? • Are they or their families threatened

(real or perceived)? • Who has their documents or other things

that matter to them?

Joyce, a woman from the Philippines, attended a dance school that is sponsored by the Philippine government for overseas workers. She has received her “certifi cation” and signed up with a broker to be an entertainer in Seattle. Upon her arrival, she learned that her debt for “school and transport into the United States” is $4,000. To ensure that she pays off the broker, she is required to stay at a home that the broker owns. She owes $500 per month in rent to live there and is not allowed to leave alone. She also is required to dance at the broker’s club, where she is paid $100 a week; her rent and food is deducted from this amount. Her debt keeps mounting, and she feels she will never be able to pay it back. She is told that she could earn more money at the club by performing sexual acts with customers. She does not have any immigration documents. She agrees to work performing sexual acts at the club to “pay back her debt” to her employer and to send money home to her family.

Nadia was interested in coming to the United States and thought she could go to school as well as work and make money to support her family back home. She was approached by a prominent businessman in her community and told that he could get her into the United States to work. The businessman ran a mail-order bride business. He placed Nadia’s picture in his catalog and explained to Nadia that she could come to the United States, marry an American, and have all her dreams come true. Tom has picked Nadia out of a catalog to possibly be his wife. Tom gets a fi ancée visa for Nadia and brings her into the United States. After she gets here, Nadia is too busy taking care of the house and Tom’s children from a previous marriage to go to school. Nadia works 16 hours a day to keep the house clean and Tom and the kids fed. Tom has Nadia’s visa in his safe deposit box.

Carlos lived in Mexico and wanted to come to the United States to work. He paid a coyote (smuggler) to be brought into the country. Once he crossed the border, he was taken to a safe house where a contractor picked him up with others staying there and transported him to an apple farm in Washington State where he was to work. Carlos was told that the cost of being smuggled into the United States and transported to the farm was $2,500. After he arrived at the farm, Carlos understood that he could not leave and that he would be beaten if he attempted to do so. Carlos was paid for his work, but rent and food costs were subtracted. Carlos was moved to other farms throughout the West Coast depending on the season. He never felt he could leave the farms where he lived.

Source: Adapted from the Family Violence Prevention Fund, 2007.

JWBT514_ch04.indd 86JWBT514_ch04.indd 86 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Public Health and Social Work 87

social service providers, local and federal law enforcement, faith-based organizations, stu- dents, educators, health-care providers, and others. Its goal is to eradicate traffi cking and provide supports for individuals through ac- tivities such as

• Building a collaborative network of health and social service providers, law enforce- ment agencies, and nongovernmental orga- nizations that can provide direct services for victims of human traffi cking

• Providing training for professionals in health care, social service, and law en- forcement agencies regarding identifying and appropriately responding to victims of human traffi cking

• Conducting community awareness and edu- cation events about the issue of human traf- fi cking; raising funds for incidental victim needs that cannot be provided by existing social service or health-care agencies

• Providing assistance to community groups, service providers, educators, and govern- mental agencies who request information, training, or other assistance regarding human traffi cking

Although the coalition does not provide direct services, the network established through its partnering agencies also can assist with in- vestigation and protection, temporary emer- gency shelter, counseling and trauma therapy, and immigration consulting (personal com- munication, Deborah Hume, University of Missouri Masters in Public Health Program, August 12, 2010).

Social Justice

Access to Health Care

Since the passage of the PPACA of 2010, there is the potential that universal access (via reforms in health insurance) to health care may be achieved in 2014. Until universal ac- cess to health care is achieved in the United States, public health social workers will re- main active in efforts to bring comprehensive,

high-quality, and affordable health care to all. Social workers must help to defi ne compre- hensive care as including primary and second- ary prevention as well as psychosocial health assessments and interventions. Furthermore, public health social workers can continue to advocate for public policies that contribute to the improvement the nation’s health, for example, through antipoverty programs, jobs programs, environmental health programs, and education.

Under our current health-care delivery sys- tem, the poor and elderly people will continue to rely on publicly fi nanced programs: Medic- aid, SCHIP, and Medicare. Public health social workers will be involved in the evaluation of these programs to propose and advocate for changes that refl ect the social work values of social and economic justice.

SCHIP and Medicaid cover children ages 0 to 21 years. Other than pregnant women and certain low-income and groups with dis- abilities, people between the ages of 21 and 65 have no access to publicly funded health insur- ance. When the PPACA is fully implemented, the state-based exchanges will provide an op- portunity for these groups to obtain affordable health insurance (Kaiser Family Foundation, 2010).

Local and global environmental justice is an important component of social justice (see Box 4.6). In Robert Bullard’s seminal book, Dumping in Dixie: Race, Class, and Environ- mental Quality (1990), the author outlines the important connections among social justice, the civil rights movement, and environmen- talism. Bullard uses examples from across the United States, especially the South, of companies that locate waste and polluting fa- cilities disproportionately in low-income and/ or minority communities. The U.S. Environ- mental Protection Agency (U.S. EPA; 2010) defi nes environmental justice as the “fair treat- ment and meaningful involvement of all peo- ple regardless of race, color, national origin, or income with respect to the development, implementation, and enforcement of environ- mental laws, regulations, and policies” (www .epa.gov/environmentaljustice/).

JWBT514_ch04.indd 87JWBT514_ch04.indd 87 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

88 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

A broad range of environmental justice is- sues and champions exist within the United States. In the Bronx in New York City, Majora Carter won a 2009 MacArthur “genius grant” fellowship for her work as founder and direc- tor of Sustainable South Bronx. The organiza- tion worked to keep a solid waste management plant out of the community and has expanded parks, bike paths, and healthy food options throughout the community. In Los Angeles, numerous efforts support low-income minori- ties, especially those living near the Port of Los Angeles. Residents living near the port are disparately exposed to diesel fumes from ships entering the port and transfer trucks and trains carrying goods from the port. Half a dozen oil refi neries also are located there. The ZIP

code around the port has a population of over 50,000 residents: 85% are Hispanic; 6% are over the age of 25 who have college degree; and 27% live below the federal poverty line. Organizations like Communities for a Better Environment are working to advance poli- cies such as restricting idling times of transfer trucks, better notifi cation about refi nery fl are events, and expanding public transportation for area residents.

Globally, electronic waste, or e-waste, has become a signifi cant issue. Developed and developing countries dispose of bil- lions of electronic devices per year. In 2005, the EPA estimated that over 300 million electronic devices were removed from homes in the United States alone, representing

Box 4.6 Public Health Social Work and the Benefi t Model

It is easy for social work and public health students, professionals, and researchers to focus on defi cit models, but one also can work and research from a benefi t model. Health promotion and nature contact is one area in particular. Natural public open space is receiving growing attention as a saluto- genic resource for psychological, physical, and social health. Natural environments elicit improvements in mood and concentra- tion, outpace entertainment and built urban environments in perceived psychological and attention restoration quality, increase social interactions and social capital, and correlate with self-reported health. Proxim- ity and access to open space is reported to decrease blood pressure and increase walk- ing and physical activity levels.

Restorative environments are places that afford visitors the opportunity to recover from stress and otherwise renew personal adaptive resources needed to meet the de- mands of everyday life, such as the ability to focus attention. In our daily lives, each of us uses a variety of psychological and physi- cal facilities. As demands on these facilities

compound across a time frame, need for psychological and physical restoration in- creases. If restoration does not occur, fatigue may become symptomatic.

During the 1970s and 1980s, Yi-Fu Tuan and E. O. Wilson described human evolu- tionary and innate response to geographic, topographic (Tuan), and biologic (Wilson) en- vironmental attributes. Roger Ulrich followed with reported expedited recovery time in hospital patients with a natural view out their window and articulated the psychophysiologi- cal stress recovery theory. In the late 1980s, Rachel and Stephen Kaplan introduced the term restorative environments and the Atten- tion Restoration Theory (ART)—that to be restored, we must be away from the stressor and be fascinated by our new environment, and the environment have suffi cient scope and compatibility to our needs. More recently, the quality of life and psychosocial benefi ts of parks and open space have been highlighted. These studies have led to increased restorative environment research. This is an opportune time for public health social workers to help in translating the research to practice via “pre- scriptions” for clients to experience outdoor and natural settings.

JWBT514_ch04.indd 88JWBT514_ch04.indd 88 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Public Health and Social Work 89

approximately 2 million tons of e-waste (U.S. EPA, 2008). Electronic devices, including cell phones, MP3 players, laptops, and televisions, are produced with metals such as lead, silver, zinc, and mercury, all of which can leach into groundwater when disposed of improperly (Lincoln, Ogunseitan, Shapiro, & Saphores, 2007). Because properly disposing of or recy- cling e-waste is costly, much of it is shipped to developing nations where workers dismantle e-waste in poor working conditions for only a few dollars per day. The workers are directly exposed to the heavy metals within the elec- tronics, and their families and communities are exposed to the waste through local water- ways and the burning of remaining equipment (Nnorom & Osibanjo, 2008).

Mental Health Services

The fi rst Surgeon General’s Report on Mental Health was issued in 1999 (U.S. DHHS, 1999). This report is important, as is emphasized in Chapter 8 in this volume, because it acknowl- edges the association between mental and physical health. It describes the toll of mental illness on the population and states that men- tal health programs in the United States are founded on a public health population-based model. Furthermore, the report highlights the issue of disparities in treatment based on culture, race, gender, and fi nancial access. Finally, the report identifi es stigma associ- ated with mental illness as a major obstacle. In suggesting courses of action to the public health and medical communities, the Surgeon General’s Report mentions facilitating entry into the mental health system. In recognition of the links between mind and body, the report identifi es primary care providers as one route of entry to mental health services.

Clinical social workers deliver more men- tal health care than do any other professionals. Public health social workers have the potential to develop and contribute to population-level interventions to address the concerns cited in the Surgeon General’s Report, such as allevia- tion of stigma and of barriers to care and dis- parities in diagnosis and treatment.

Research

Evidence-based interventions and sound pub- lic policy result from well-planned and ex- ecuted research. As more public health social workers become involved in research, such as that described in this chapter, the importance of including social, behavioral, and environ- mental factors as determinants of health will become more apparent.

Public health social workers are increasingly engaged in community-based participatory re- search (CBPR). CBPR is defi ned by the Agency for Healthcare Research and Quality (AHRQ) as “a collaborative process involving research- ers and community representatives; it engages community members, employs local knowledge in the understanding of health problems and the design of interventions, and invests community members in the processes and products of re- search” (2010, p. 1). CBPR is especially useful in populations that often are reluctant to engage in conventional research (minority, low income, rural, and central city) because of their use in previous, sometimes unethical, studies (e.g. Tuskegee study.)

Three additional factors support the use of participatory research to improve the health of disadvantaged communities.

First, local community knowledge increases our understanding of the complex interac- tions among economic, social, and behav- ioral factors that contribute to disparities and, therefore, should inform the design of inter- ventions aimed at reducing these disparities. In addition, there is a gap between the knowl- edge produced in research and practiced in these communities. Finally, members of these communities are increasingly reluctant to participate in research and are organizing to monitor and/or prevent such activities. (AHRQ, 2010, p. 1)

Examples of CBPR include projects aimed at: increasing the availability of high-quality food in inner-city neighborhoods; the environmental factors that contribute to childhood asthma; and the relationships among SES, physical environ- ment, and heart disease (AHRQ, 2010, p. 1).

JWBT514_ch04.indd 89JWBT514_ch04.indd 89 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

90 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

Another path to ameliorating health dispari- ties is clinical and translational science (CTS). The emergence of CTS has many implications for public health social work research and in- terventions. The goal of translational science is to translate basic research fi ndings into clini- cal practice and population-based interven- tions (Brekke, Ell, & Palinkas, 2007; Ruth & Sisco, 2008). Clinical and translational science is framed in at least four translational phases. T1 refers to fi rst knowledge developed through laboratory bench research; T2 refers to taking this bench research to the bedside for clinical trials; T3 is applying these fi ndings in clini- cal practice; and T4 involves applications of knowledge at the community and population level (Kon, 2008; Tufts CTSI, 2010). Social workers are critical to the success of the T3 and T4 phases through their individual clinical practices and by developing and implementing community-level interventions. CTS is trans- disciplinary in nature. Professionals in CTS range from bench scientists, to clinical provid- ers, to population-based workers. Social work- ers work at both the clinical and societal levels (Gehlert et al., 2010).

The direction from T1 to T4 CTS (bottom- up research) assumes that laboratory bench science is the beginning of studying health disparities. Gehlert and colleagues (2008; Gehlert, Mininger, & Cipriano-Steffens, 2011) suggest that rather than bottom-up research, studies of health disparities should examine the impacts of social and environmental fac- tors on behavioral and hereditary components of health outcomes (top down). This approach examines the infl uence of upstream (T3 and T4) determinants, such as social environment, SES, and discrimination, on individual behav- ior, health status, and disease. If we know the effects of upstream determinants and how they vary by population, we are better positioned to develop T4 interventions (Gehlert et al., 2008).

Gehlert and colleagues (2008) conducted studies of African American women newly diagnosed with breast cancer using the top- down approach. They examined various up- stream determinants, such as neighborhood environments, social isolation, depression, and

perceived loneliness. They found signifi cant associations among these factors to demon- strate a pathway from the community effects to inside the nucleus of the cell. Social environ- ments create isolation and depression. These emotional states alter the stress-hormone re- sponse. When stress-hormone receptors are activated, farther downstream biochemical pathways known to increase tumor cell sur- vival are activated. This research demonstrates the important contributions that social workers can make to the transdisciplinary team, both in understanding health determinants and in developing appropriate societal interventions to ameliorate downstream effects on the bio- logical level.

Public health social work involvement in clinical and translational research that assesses psychosocial determinants can lead to more comprehensive and culturally competent in- terventions to address public health problems. Emerging areas for CTS research may include disparities in obesity and tobacco use. For ex- ample, the biological effects are well known, but associations with upstream factors warrant further study to establish population-based in- terventions (Gehlert et al., 2008).

Additional emerging research methods at the nexus of social work and public health in- clude GIS, system dynamics, and social net- work analysis. GIS was discussed earlier as a practice method, but it is also very much a research method (see Figure 4.4). Social work and public health both use GIS. As outlined by Hillier (2007), GIS strengthens social work by (a) continuing and improving social surveys, (b) providing a geographic framework for the study and understanding of human behavior, (c) spatially locating needs and assets within a community, (d) mapping and improving the delivery of social services, and (e) emphasiz- ing social justice through the empowerment of disenfranchised communities. The ben- efi ts of GIS to public health mirror those of social work by (a) strengthening epidemio- logical methods, (b) providing a geographic framework for the study of human disease and health, (c) spatially locating needs and assets within a community, (d) mapping and

JWBT514_ch04.indd 90JWBT514_ch04.indd 90 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Public Health and Social Work 91

improving the delivery of public health inter- ventions and programs, and (e) highlighting disproportionate exposures to environmental agents (environmental justice).

Most of today’s public health social work challenges are complex and dynamic in terms of understanding and working toward im- provements and eventual prevention. For ex- ample, how does posttraumatic stress disorder affect soldiers returning from the Iraq or Af- ghanistan wars? Potential negative effects are associated with psychological, physical, and social health. Friends and families may pro- vide support or may be a source of additional stress. System dynamics (SD) is a method- ological approach that assists in understanding complex systems over time. SD uses a system of internal and external feedback loops, fl ows, and outputs (see Figure 4.6). SD computer software allows researchers to set and change feedback loops, stocks, and fl ows and to run models to determine potential reactions and outcomes. Delayed effects and time series can be built in as well. Specifi c to public health social work, SD allows for the modeling of

individual, community, and organizational as- sets, needs, vulnerabilities, preventive efforts, responses, complications, and potential out- comes. Most important to SD are the feedback loops within and between these categories. For additional information, see Homer and Hirsch (2006) and Hirsch, Levine, and Miller (2007).

Social network analysis (SNA) uses a series of nodes and ties to build a three-dimensional structure of social networks. Nodes can be in- dividuals, organizations, or policies, and ties are the connections between nodes (see Fig- ure 4.7). SNA allows for the understanding of how and why certain ties are made and how information is or is not shared across ties and between nodes.

Christakis and Fowler (2007), in a promi- nent SNA article published in the New England Journal of Medicine, reviewed over 12,000 in- dividuals who participated in the Framingham Heart Study to determine whether obesity is “contagious.” The authors found that an indi- vidual’s chance of becoming obese increased by 57% if the person had an obese friend, and 40% if the person had an obese sibling. Spousal

Population net inflow

Population not at risk

Risk onset

Risk reduction

Population at risk

Disease incidence

Disease cure and recovery

Complications (urgent episodes)

Population with disease

Disease related deaths

Urgent careInjury and violence death rate

Risk managementAdverse behaviors and

living conditions

Disease management

As an example, adverse behaviors and living conditions can result in individuals within the population not at risk to become at risk while improvements in behaviors and living conditions can have the effect of moving individuals from at risk to not at risk.

Figure 4.6 System Dynamics Example Showing the Population as Not at Risk, at Risk, or With Disease

Source: Homer, Hirsch, and Milstein, 2007.

JWBT514_ch04.indd 91JWBT514_ch04.indd 91 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

92 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

infl uence was slightly less strong, although still signifi cant, at 37%. Lakon and colleagues (2010) used SNA to show that both individual and neighborhood ties (multilevel modeling) affected the smoking behaviors of teenagers. Luke and colleagues (Leischow et al., 2010; Luke & Harris, 2007) describe network-and organization-level SNA. Tobacco control and efforts to reduce the numbers of cigarette smok- ers require a coordinated effort. Luke and Har- ris use SNA to show the coordination and lack thereof between agencies under the guidance of DHHS. Repeat surveys and gaps in services across government agencies can greatly reduce effi ciency in preventive efforts.

IMPACT OF PUBLIC HEALTH SOCIAL WORK

This chapter addressed only a sample of the issues, practice settings, and interventions encountered by public health social workers. Other issues that public health social workers

address include: services for immigrants and refugees; health care for men and women not related to reproduction; and inner-city and rural concerns, such as safety, crowding, and social and physical isolation, all of which im- pact the ability of these populations to achieve the maximum potential health status.

Although medical social workers work with patients and their families to adapt to sudden and severe illness or trauma, public health so- cial workers operate at the population level promoting primary prevention interventions to address the causes of these health prob- lems. Public health social workers contribute their expertise grounded in the person-in- environment orientation (Kondrat, 2008) to incorporate responses to behavioral, social, and physical environmental determinants of health in public health interventions.

The problems will change over time, but well-prepared public health social workers will be ready to take on new challenges. The new generation of public health social workers will carry on the traditions of the founders of

Figure 4.7 Network of Relationships Among Individuals Working on Tobacco Control at the Department of Health and Human Services

Source: Adapted from Leischow et al., 2010.

JWBT514_ch04.indd 92JWBT514_ch04.indd 92 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Public Health and Social Work 93

social work who created settlement houses and worked to improve environmental conditions, develop economic reforms, and protect chil- dren, all of which contributed to the improve- ment of the public’s health. Their work laid the foundation of federal programs for children and families and gave direction for the future of our profession.

SUGGESTED LEARNING EXERCISES

Learning Exercise 4.1

The purpose of this exercise is to apply your understanding of the determinants of health to a public health problem and discuss the role of public health social work in addressing the problem.

Your class will be divided into small groups and each assigned one of 38 focus areas from Healthy People 2020 (found on the Healthy People Web site) at one class session. Be- tween classes, your homework assignment is to gather data about the area and prepare a fact sheet for your classmates. In the next class ses- sion, each group will meet to identify deter- minants of the health problem in the various domains identifi ed in Figure 4.1 and how they interact.

After identifying the determinants, your group will explore the roles of public health social workers in promoting health and pre- venting the public health problem and then present your understanding to the class. The presentation must identify issues of diversity and disparities in the distribution, treatment, and prognosis of the illness at the core of the problem. In addition, you should be prepared to present on issues of social and economic justice associated with the health concern.

Learning Exercise 4.2

Review the cases in Box 4.5. Discuss whether you would classify these cases as human traf- fi cking. Discuss ways in which a transdisci- plinary team can address the issues identifi ed

in these cases. What would be the role of a public health social worker in each case?

Learning Exercise 4.3

The purpose of this exercise is to explore pri- mary, secondary, and tertiary levels of preven- tion that can be applied to an intervention for a public health problem.

In this activity, you will be assigned to play a role on a committee that has gathered to address a public health problem in your community. The professionals on the com- mittee, in addition to a public health social worker, may include a physician; an epidemi- ologist; a public health nurse; and/or a pub- lic offi cial, such as a prosecuting attorney, a city council member, or a law enforcement offi cer. The committee will meet and use data that were provided to you by your instructor to collaborate in the design of interventions at the three levels of prevention and then to decide which intervention will best serve the community.

Possible topics:

• Perinatal substance abuse

• Teen pregnancy

• Sudden increase in the number of syphilis cases

• Motor vehicle accidents involving adoles- cents and alcohol

• Rise in suicide rate

• Rise in childhood obesity

• Asthma in a minority population

• Domestic violence

• Human traffi cking

• Dental caries

Learning Exercise 4.4

In this chapter, we discussed three emerging methods at the nexus of social work and pub- lic health: geographic information systems, system dynamics, and social network analy- sis. These methods rely on mapping, feed- back loops, and social ties, respectively. We

JWBT514_ch04.indd 93JWBT514_ch04.indd 93 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

94 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

also outlined community-based participatory research (CBPR), in which researchers and community partners work in collaboration to overcome public health social work chal- lenges. For this exercise, think of a way that CBPR can be utilized to map, develop system feedback loops, and determine social ties. What practice and research questions would you answer using this mixed methodology?

APPENDIX 4.1: GLOSSARY

Assessment Collection, analysis, and sharing of data about health conditions, risks, and resources in a community.

Assurance Monitoring the availability of health services in a community.

Epidemiology Study of distribution and determinants of disease in populations.

Evidence-based practice Interventions that are based on theory that is supported by empirical research.

Fetal and Infant Mortality Review (FIMR) Review conducted to gather medical and social information after a fetal or infant death.

Healthy People 2020 Public health goals and objectives for the United States as set by the U.S. Department of Health and Human Services.

Infant mortality (IM) Death prior to an infant’s fi rst birthday; one of the leading indicators used worldwide to measure a country’s health.

Low birth weight (LBW) Weight of less than 2,500 grams, or about 5.5 pounds, at birth; a cause of infant mortality and, thus, one of the leading indicators used worldwide to measure a country’s health.

Policy development Use of assessment data to develop local and state health and social welfare policies and to direct resources toward those policies.

Population-based intervention Intervention focused on health promotion/disease prevention

in populations rather than on the treatment of individuals.

Prevention, primary Promotion of health and prevention of disease or trauma before it occurs.

Prevention, secondary Early diagnosis and treatment of disease.

Prevention, tertiary Action taken to minimize the effects of a disease and prevent further disability.

Social epidemiology Study of the impact of social factors on the distribution of health and illness in a population.

Title V of the Social Security Act of 1935 Provides for maternal and child health programs that are delivered by states through a block grant mechanism; Title V programs are administered by the Maternal and Child Health Bureau of the Health Services and Resources Administration (HRSA) of the U.S. Department of Health and Human Services.

APPENDIX 4.2: PUBLIC HEALTH SOCIAL WORK STANDARDS AND COMPETENCIES

Public health social workers address health from a broad perspective that includes physi- cal, social, emotional, and spiritual well-being throughout the continuum of the life cycle. They address health issues by identifying and imple- menting strategies and interventions that ad- dress pivotal times of transition from one phase of individual development to another. Public health social work ensures the competency of its practice to address the issues of public health effectively through a core body of knowledge, philosophy, code of ethics, and standards.

Public health social work employs a range of strategies to implement essential public health functions in a measurable fashion as specifi ed in the Public Health Social Work Standards and Competencies (2005). These are available online at http://oce.sph.unc.edu/ cetac/phswcompetencies_may05.pdf/.

JWBT514_ch04.indd 94JWBT514_ch04.indd 94 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Public Health and Social Work 95

REFERENCES

Agency for Healthcare Research and Quality. (2010). Community-based participatory research. Retrieved from www.ahrq.gov/about/cpcr/cbpr/cbpr1.htm

Berkman, L. F., & Kawachi, I. (Eds.). (2000). Social epidemiology. New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Berry, H., Bowen, K., & Kjellstrom, T. (2010). Climate change and mental health: A causal pathways framework. International Journal of Public Health, 55(2), 123–132.

Bishop, K. K., & Arango, P. (1997). Creating the context: Family-centered, community-based, culturally-sensitive partnerships. In K. K. Bishop, M. S. Taylor, & P. Arango (Eds.), Partnerships at work: Lessons learned from programs and practices of families, professionals and communities (pp. 11–15). Burlington: University of Vermont, Department of Social Work.

Brekke, J. S., Ell, K., & Palinkas, L. A. (2007). Translational science at the National Institute of Mental Health: Can social work take its rightful place? Research on Social Work Practice, 17, 123–133.

Bronfenbrenner, U. (1979). The Ecology of Human Development: Experiments by Nature and Design. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.

Bullard, R. D. 1990. Dumping in Dixie: Race, class, and environmental quality. Boulder, CO: Westview.

Cecil-Karb, R., & Grogan-Kaylor, A. (2009). Childhood body mass index in community context: Neighborhood safety, television viewing, and growth trajectories of BMI. Health & Social Work, 34, 169–177.

Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. (2010). Obesity trends among U.S. adults. Retrieved from www.cdc.gov/obesity/data/trends.html

Centers for Medicare and Medicaid Services. (2010). Low cost health insurance for families & children. Overview. Retrieved from www.cms.gov/ LowCostHealthInsFamChild

Chin, M. H., Walters, A. E., Cook, S. C., & Huang, E. S. (2007). Interventions to reduce racial and ethnic disparities in health care. Medical Care Research Review, 64(5; Suppl.), 7S–28S.

Christakis, N. A., & Fowler, J. H. (2007). The spread of obesity in a large social network over 32 years. New England Journal of Medicine, 357(4), 370–379.

Clegg, L. X., Reichman, M. E., Miller, B. A., Hankey, B. F., Singh, G. K., Lin, Y. D., . . . Edwards, B. K. (2009). Impact of socioeconomic status on cancer incidence and stage at diagnosis: Selected fi ndings from the surveillance, epidemiology, and end results: National Longitudinal Mortality Study. Cancer Causes Control, 20(4), 417–435.

Commission on Social Determinants of Health. (2008). Closing the gap in a generation: Final Report of the Commission on Social Determinants of Health. Geneva, World Health Organization.

Retrieved from http://whqlibdoc.who. int/ publications/2008/9789241563703_eng.pdf

Cooper, H., Moore, L., Gruskin, S., & Krieger, N. (2004). Characterizing perceived police violence: Implications for public health. American Journal of Public Health, 94, 1109–1118.

Curry, S. J., Emery, S., Sporer, A. K., Mermelstein, R., Flay, B. R., Berbaum, M., . . . Wells, H. (2007). A national survey of tobacco cessation programs for youths. American Journal of Public Health, 97, 171–177.

Dai, D. (2010). Black residential segregation, disparities in spatial access to health care facilities, and late-stage breast cancer diagnosis in metropolitan Detroit. Health & Place, 16(5), 1038–1052.

Dunn, J. R. (2010). Health behavior vs. the stress of low socioeconomic status and health outcomes. JAMA, 303, 1199–1200.

Eliadis, E. E. (2006). The role of social work in the childhood obesity epidemic. Social Work, 51, 86–88.

Family Violence Prevention Fund. (2007). Collaborating to help traffi cking survivors: Emerging issues and practice pointers. San Francisco, CA: Author.

Fiscella, K., Franks, P., Doescher, M. P., & Saver, B. G. (2002). Disparities in health care by race, ethnicity, and language among the insured: Findings from a national sample. In T. A. LaVeist (Ed.), Race, ethnicity, and health: A public health reader (pp. 198–209). San Francisco, CA: Jossey-Bass.

Flores, G., Olson, L., & Tomany-Korman, S. C. (2005). Racial and ethnic disparities in early childhood health and health care. Pediatrics, 115e, 183–193.

Floyd, M. F., Taylor, W. C., & Whitt-Glover, M. (2009). Measurement of park and recreation environments that support physical activity in low-income communities of color: Highlights of challenges and recommendations. American Journal of Preventive Medicine, 36(4), S156–S160.

Frank, L., Engelke, P., & Schmid, T. (2003). Health and community design: The impact of the built environment on physical activity. Washington, DC: Island Press.

Freedman, V. A., Grafova, I. B., & Rogowski, J. (2011). Neighborhoods and chronic disease onset in later life. American Journal of Public Health. 101(1), 79–86.

Gee, G. C. (2008). A multilevel analysis of the relationship between institutional and individual racial discrimination and health status. American Journal of Public Health, 98(Suppl. 1), S48–S56.

Gehlert, S., Mininger, C., & Cipriano-Steffens, T. M. (2011). Placing biology in breast cancer research. In D. Takeuchi (Ed.), Expanding the boundaries of place. New York, NY: Springer.

Gehlert, S., Mininger, C., Sohmer, D., & Berg, K. (2008). (Not so) gently down the stream: Choosing targets to ameliorate health disparities. Health & Social Work, 33, 163–167.

Gehlert, S., Murray, A., Sohmer, D., McClintock, M., Conzen, S., & Olopade, O. (2010). The importance

JWBT514_ch04.indd 95JWBT514_ch04.indd 95 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

96 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

of transdisciplinary collaborations for understanding and resolving health disparities. Social Work in Public Health, 25, 408–422.

Gehlert, S., Sohmer, D., Sacks, T., Mininger, C., McClintock, M., & Olopade, O. (2008). Targeting health disparities: A model linking upstream determinants to downstream interventions. Health Affairs, 27, 339–349.

Germain, C. B. (1984). Social work practice in health care: An ecological perspective. New York, NY: Free Press.

Germain, C., & Gitterman, A. (1980). The life model of social work practice. New York, NY: Columbia University Press.

Gordon, L. (1994). Pitied but not entitled: Single mothers and the history of welfare. New York, NY: Free Press.

Green, L. W., & Glasgow, R. E. (2006). Evaluating the relevance, generalization, and applicability of research. Issues in external validation and translation methodology. Evaluation and the Health Professions, 29, 126–153.

Hartig, T. (2008). Green space, psychological restoration, and health inequality. Lancet, 372, 1614–1615.

Haviland, L., & Sember, R. (2004). [Cover description]. American Journal of Public Health, 94, 163.

Healthy People 2020. (n.d. a). Phase I report. Recommendations for the framework and format of Healthy People 2020. Retrieved from www. healthypeople.gov/HP2020/advisory/PhaseI/PhaseI.pdf

Healthy People 2020. (n.d. b). Home page. Retrieved from www.healthypeople.gov/Default.htm

Hillier, A. E. (2007). Why social work needs mapping. Journal of Social Work Education, 43(2), 205–221.

Hirsch, G. B., Levine, R., & Miller, R. (2007). Using system dynamics modeling to understand the impact of social change initiatives. American Journal of Community Psychology, 39(3), 239–253.

Hokenstad, M. S. (2010). Human traffi cking brief. 2010 Joint World Conference on Social Work and Social Development. International Council on Social Welfare. Retrieved from www.icsw.org/doc/2010 _JointWorldConf_Agenda_ICSW_HumanTraffi cking .pdf

Homer, J. B., & Hirsch, G. B. (2006). Systems dynamics modeling for public health: Background and opportunities. American Journal of Public Health, 96(3), 452–458.

Homer, J., Hirsch, G., & Milstein. B. (2007). Chronic illness in a complex health economy: The perils and promises of downstream and upstream reforms. System Dynamics Review, 23(2/3), 313–343.

Hutchins, E., Grason, H., & Handler, A. (2004). FIMR and other mortality reviews public health tools for strengthening maternal and child health systems in communities: Where do we need to go next? Maternal and Child Health Journal, 8, 259–268.

Icard, L. D., Bourjolly, J. N., & Siddiqui, N. (2003). Designing social marketing strategies to increase African Americans’ access to health promotion programs. Health & Social Work, 28, 214–223.

Institute of Medicine Committee for the Study of the Future of Public Health. (1988). The future of public health. Washington, DC: National Academy Press.

Kaiser Family Foundation. (2010). Summary of the new health reform law. Focus on Health Reform. Retrieved from www.kff. org/healthreform/upload/8061.pdf

Keefe, R. H. (2010). Health disparities: A primer for public health social workers. Social Work in Public Health, 25, 237–257.

Kimerling, R., Street, A. E., Pavao, J., Smith, M. W., Cronkite, R. C., Holmes, T. H., & Frayne, S. M. (2010). Military-related sexual trauma among Veterans Health Administration patients returning from Afghanistan and Iraq. American Journal of Public Health, 100, 1409–1412.

Klesges, L. M., Dzewaltowski, D. A., & Glasgow, R. E. (2008). Review of external validity reporting in childhood obesity prevention research. American Journal of Preventive Medicine, 38, 216–223.

Koontz, A. M., Buckley, K. A., & Ruderman, M. (2004). The evolution of fetal and infant mortality review as a public health strategy. Maternal and Child Health Journal, 8, 195–203.

Kon, A. A. (2008). The Clinical and Translational Science Award (CTSA) Consortium and the translational research model. American Journal of Bioethics, 8, 1–3.

Kondrat, M. E. (2008). Person-in-environment. In T. Mizrahi & L. E. Davis (Eds.), Encyclopedia of Social Work (20th ed., vol. 3, pp. 348–354). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Krieger, N. (2003). Does racism harm health? Did child abuse exist before 1962? On explicit questions, critical science, and current controversies: An ecosocial perspective. American Journal of Public Health, 93, 194–199.

Krieger, N. (2005). Race, genetics, and health disparities. Stormy weather: Race, gene expression, and the science of health disparities. American Journal of Public Health, 95, 2155–2160.

Krieger, N., Chen, J. T., Waterman, P. D., Rehkopf, D. H., & Subramanian, S. V. (2003). Race/ethnicity, gender, and monitoring socioeconomic gradients in health: A comparison of area-based socioeconomic measures—The Public Health Disparities Geocoding Project. American Journal of Public Health, 93, 1655–1671.

Lakon, C. M., Hipp, J. R., & Timberlake, D. S. (2010). The social context of adolescent smoking: A systems perspective. American Journal of Public Health, 100(7), 1218–1228.

Landesman, L. Y. (2005). Public health management of disasters: The practice guide (2nd ed.). Washington, DC: American Public Health Association.

JWBT514_ch04.indd 96JWBT514_ch04.indd 96 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Public Health and Social Work 97

Lawrence, S., Hazlett, R., & Hightower, P. (2010). Understanding and acting on the growing childhood and adolescent weight crisis: A role for social work. Health & Social Work, 35 147–153.

Leischow S., Luke D. A., Mueller N. B., Harris J. K., Ponder P., Marcus S., & Clark P. (2010). Mapping U.S. government tobacco control leadership: Networked for success? Nicotine & Tobacco Research, 12(9), 888–894.

Leung, G. M., Chan, S. S. C., Johnston, J. M., Chan, S. K. K., Woo, P. P. S., Chi, I., & Lam, T-H. (2007). Effectiveness of an elderly smoking cessation counseling training program for social workers. CHEST, 131, 1157–1165.

Lincoln, J. D., Ogunseitan, O. A., Shapiro, A. A., & Saphores, J.-D. M. (2007). Leaching assessments of hazardous materials in cellular telephones. Environmental Science & Technology, 41(7), 2572– 2578.

Luke, D. A., & Harris, J. K. (2007). Network analysis in public health: History, methods, and applications. Annual Review of Public Health, 28(1), 69–93.

Lynch, J., & Kaplan, G. (2000). Socioeconomic position. In L. F. Berkman & I. Kawachi (Eds.), Social epidemiology (pp. 13–35). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Margolis, L. H., Cole, G. P., & Kotch, J. B. (2005). Historical foundations of maternal and child health. In J. B. Kotch (Ed.), Maternal and child health: Programs, problems and policy in public health (2nd ed., pp. 23–55). Gaithersburg, MD: Aspen.

Martin, J. A., Hamilton, B. E., Sutton, P. D., Ventura, S. J., Menacker, F., Kirmeyer, S., . . . Mathews, T. J. (2009). Births: Final data for 2006. National Vital Statistics Reports, 57(7). Retrieved from www.cdc.gov/nchs/ data/nvsr/nvsr57/nvsr57_07.pdf

Mathews, T. J., & MacDorman, M. F. (2010). Infant mortality statistics from the 2006 period linked birth/ infant death data set. National Vital Statistics Reports, 58(17), 1–32.

McGinnis, J. M., Williams-Russo, P., & Knickman, J. R. (2002). The case for more active policy attention to health promotion. Health Affairs, 21, 78–93.

Mitchell, R., & Popham, F. (2008). Effect of exposure to natural environment on health inequalities: an observational population study. Lancet, 372, 1655– 1660.

Mussolino, M. E. (2005). Depression and hip fracture risk: The NHANES I epidemiologic follow-up study. Public Health Reports, 120(1), 71–75.

Mustillo, S., Krieger, N., Gunderson, E. P., Sidney, S., McCreath, H., & Kiefe, C. I. (2004). Self-reported experiences of racial discrimination and Black-White differences in preterm and low-birthweight deliveries: The CARDIA Study. American Journal of Public Health, 94, 2125–2131.

National Association of Social Workers. (2009). Social work speaks (10th ed.). Washington, DC: Author.

National Cancer Institute. (2010). A snapshot of lung cancer. Retrieved from www.cancer.gov/aboutnci/ servingpeople/snapshots/lung.pdf

National Cancer Institute. (n.d.). SEER Cancer Statistics Review, 1995–2007. Retrieved from http://seer.cancer. gov/csr/1975_2007/results_merged/topic_mor_trends .pdf

Nazmi, A., Diez Roux, A., Ranjit, N., Seeman, T. E., & Jenny, N. S. (2010). Cross-sectional and longitudinal associations of neighborhood characteristics with infl ammatory markers: Findings from the Multi- Ethnic Study of Atherosclerosis. Health & Place, 16(6), 1104–1112.

Nnorom, I. C., & Osibanjo, O. (2008). Overview of electronic waste (e-waste) management practices and legislations, and their poor applications in the developing countries. Resources, Conservation and Recycling, 52(6), 843–858.

Oakes, J. M., & Kaufman, J. S. (2006). Introduction: Advancing methods in social epidemiology. In J. M. Oakes & J. S. Kaufman (Eds.), Methods in social epidemiology (pp. 3–20). San Francisco, CA: Jossey- Bass.

Ogden, C. L., & Carroll, M. (June 2010a). Prevalence of obesity in children and adolescents: United States, trends 1963–1965 through 2007–2008. National Center for Health Statistics. Retrieved from www.cdc. gov/nchs/data/hestat/obesity_child_07_08/obesity _child_07_08.pdf

Ogden, C. L., & Carroll, M. (June 2010b). Prevalence of overweight, obesity and extreme obesity among adults: United States, trends 1976–1980 through 2007–2008. National Center for Health Statistics. Retrieved from www.cdc.gov/NCHS/data/hestat/ obesity_adult_07_08/obesity_adult_07_08.pdf

Phelan, K. J., Khoury, J., Kalkwarf, H., & Lanphear, B. (2005). Residential injuries in United States children and adolescents. Public Health Reports, 120(1), 63–70.

Pickett, K. E., Collins, J. W., Masi, C. M., & Wilkinson, R. G. (2005). The effects of racial density and income incongruity on pregnancy outcomes. Social Science & Medicine, 60, 2229–2238.

President’s emergency plan for AIDS relief. (n.d.). Retrieved from http://southafrica.usembassy.gov/wwwhaids.html

Public Health Social Work Standards and Competencies. (2005). Retrieved from http://oce.sph.unc.edu/cetac/ phswcompetencies_may05.pdf

Rounds, K., Caye, J., Ross-Sheriff, T., Bailey, D., & Anderson, J. (2005). Disaster preparedness planning for public health social workers. Part I: Natural Disasters. Produced by the MCH Public Health Social Work Leadership Training Program & The Behavioral Healthcare Resource Program, Jordan Institute for Families, School of Social Work, University of North Carolina at Chapel Hill. Retrieved from http:// behavioralhealthcareinstitute.org/kathleen2/index.htm

Rounds, K., Caye, J., Walsh, T., Vaughn, J., & Anderson, J. (2008). Disaster preparedness planning for public

JWBT514_ch04.indd 97JWBT514_ch04.indd 97 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

98 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

health social workers. Part II: Bioterrorism. Produced by the MCH Public Health Social Work Leadership Training Program & The Behavioral Healthcare Resource Program, Jordan Institute for Families, School of Social Work, and the NC Center for Disaster Preparedness, Institute of Public Health, University of North Carolina at Chapel Hill. Retrieved from http:// behavioralhealthcareinstitute.org/kathleenB/index.htm

Ruth, B. J., & Sisco, S. (2008). Public health. In T. Mizrahi & L. E. Davis (Eds.), Encyclopedia of social work (20th ed., vol. 3, pp. 476–483). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Saftlas, A. F., Wallis, A. B., Shochet, T., Harland, K. K., Dickey, P., & Peek-Asa, C. (2010). Prevalence of intimate partner violence among an abortion population. American Journal of Public Health, 100, 1412–1415.

Salett, E. (2006). Human traffi cking and modern day slavery. National Association of Social Workers Practice Update. Washington, DC: NASW Offi ce of Human Rights and International Affairs.

Schneider, M.-J. (2000). Introduction to public health. Gaithersburg, MD: Aspen.

Schooler, C., Feighery, E., & Flora, J. A. (1996). Seventh graders’ self-reported exposure to cigarette marketing and its relationship to their smoking behavior. American Journal of Public Health, 86, 1216–1221.

Schootman, M., Andresen, E., Wolinsky, F., Miller, J. P., Yan, Y., & Miller, D. (2010). Neighborhood conditions, diabetes, and risk of lower-body functional limitations among middle-aged African Americans: A cohort study. BMC Public Health, 10(1), 283.

Silverman, J. G., Decker, M. R., McCauley, H. L., Gupta, J., Miller, E., Raj, A., & Goldberg, A. B. (2010). Male perpetration of intimate partner violence and involvement in abortions and abortion-related confl ict. American Journal of Public Health, 100, 1415–1417.

Sinclair, S. J., & LoCicero, A. (2010). Assessing the ongoing psychological impact of terrorism. In L. Baer & M. A. Blais (Eds.), Handbook of clinical rating scales and assessment in psychiatry and mental health (pp. 271–285). New York, NY: Humana Press.

Slater, T. (2006). The eviction of critical perspectives from gentrifi cation research. International Journal of Urban and Regional Research, 30(4), 737–757.

Smedley, B. D., Stith, A. Y., & Nelson, A. R. (Eds.). (2003). Unequal treatment: Confronting racial and ethnic disparities in health care. Washington, DC: Institute of Medicine, Committee on Understanding and Eliminating Racial and Ethnic Disparities in Health Care.

Stokols, D., Runnerstrum, M. G., Misra, S., & Hipp, J. A. (2009). Psychology in an age of ecological crisis: From personal angst to collective action. American Psychologist, 64(3), 181–193.

Stringhini, S., Sabia, S., Shipley, M., Brunner, E., Nabi, H., Kivimaki, M., & Singh-Manoux, A. (2010). Association of socioeconomic position with health behaviors and mortality. JAMA, 303, 1159–1166.

Taylor, L., & Quigley, R. (2002). Health Impact Assessment: A review of reviews. London, UK: Health Development Agency.

Thomas, L. A., Supiano, K. P., Chasco, E. E., McGowan, J., & Beer, M. C. (2009). Smoking cessation for seniors: A program that works. Clinical Gerontologist, 21, 118–125.

Tufts CTSI. (2010). What is translational science? Retrieved from www.tuftsctsi. org/About-Us/What-is- Translational-Science.aspx?c=129239448128972191

United Nations Department of Economic and Social Affairs, Population Division (2007). World population prospects: The 2006 revision, highlights, Working Paper No. ESA/P/WP. 202. Retrieved from www.un .org/esa/population/publications/wpp2006/WPP2006 _Highlights_rev.pdf

United Nations Offi ce on Drugs and Crime (2006). Traffi cking in persons: Global patterns. Vienna, Austria: Author. Retrieved from www.unodc.org/documents/ human-traffi cking/HT-globalpatterns-en.pdf

U.S. Department of Health and Human Services. (1999). Mental health: A report of the surgeon general— Executive summary. Rockville, MD: Author.

U.S. Department of Health and Human Services. (2008a). Identifying and interacting with victims of human traffi cking. DHHS: Administration for Children & Families, Campaign to Rescue and Restore Victims of Human Traffi cking. Retrieved from www.acf.hhs .gov/traffi cking/campaign_kits/tool_kit_health/identify _victims.html

U.S. Department of Health and Human Services. (2008b). Look beneath the surface: Role of law enforcement offi cers in identifying and helping victims of human traffi cking (PowerPoint presentation). Washington, DC: DHHS Administration for Children & Families, Campaign to Rescue and Restore Victims of Human Traffi cking. Retrieved from www.acf.hhs.gov/ traffi cking/campaign_kits/index.html

U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. (2008). Fact sheet: Management of electronic waste in the United States. Washington, DC: Author.

U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. (2010). Envi- ronmental justice. Retrieved from www.epa.gov/ environmentaljustice/

United States President’s Emergency Plan for AIDS Relief. (n.d.) About PEPFAR. Retrieved from www .pepfar.gov/about/index.htm

Walker, R. E., Keane, C. R., & Burke, J. G. (2010). Disparities and access to healthy food in the United States: A review of food desserts literature. Health & Place, 16(5), 876–884. doi: 10.1016/j .healthplace.2010.04

Watkins, E. L. (1985, June). The conceptual base for public health social work. In A. Gitterman, R. B. Black, & F. Stein (Eds.), Public health social work in maternal and child health: A forward plan (pp. 17–33). Proceedings of the Working Conference of the Public Health Social Work Advisory Committee for the Bureau of

JWBT514_ch04.indd 98JWBT514_ch04.indd 98 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Public Health and Social Work 99

Health Care Delivery and Assistance, Rockville, MD: Division of Maternal and Child Health.

Weech-Maldonado, R., Morales, L. S., Elliott, M., Spritzer, K., Marshall, G., & Hays, R. D. (2003). Race/ ethnicity, language, and patients’ assessments of care in Medicaid managed care. Health Services Research 38, 789–808.

Wilkinson, D. S., Rounds, K. A., & Copeland, V. C. (2002). Infusing public health content into foundation and advanced social work courses. Journal of Teaching in Social Work, 22(3/4), 139–154.

World Health Organization. (1998). Smallpox eradication: A global fi rst. Retrieved from www.who.int/archives/ who50/en/smallpox.htm.

Xu, J. Q., Kochanek, K. D., Murphy, S. L., Tejada-Vera, B. (2010). Deaths: Final data for 2007. National Vital Statistics Reports Web Release, 58(19). Hyattsville, MD: National Center for Health Statistics. Retrieved from www.cdc.gov/NCHS/data/nvsr/nvsr58/nvsr58_19 .pdf

JWBT514_ch04.indd 99JWBT514_ch04.indd 99 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

100

5

Health Policy and Social Work

JULIE S. DARNELL AND EDWARD F. LAWLOR

Health policy refers to actions taken by gov- ernment or the private sector to achieve a specifi c health-care goal. One such action is the Patient Protection and Affordable Care Act (PPACA), enacted in March 2010, which changed the landscape for health and social work practice for the foreseeable future. As it is implemented over the next 10 years, the legislation will signifi cantly increase health insurance coverage and reset the philosophy, organization, and fi nancing of care. The chal- lenge for social workers in this environment is to know both the fundamentals of the current health-care systems and the changes resulting from the new law and their trajectory.

As practitioners in various settings, social workers assist clients in obtaining and navi- gating federal and state health programs with complex eligibility rules and application pro- cedures, directly provide publicly supported health services, and disseminate informa- tion to individuals and groups about numer- ous aspects of health care. As advocates for poor, disadvantaged, and disenfranchised in- dividuals and families, social workers act to infl uence health policies and legislation that enhance the welfare of at-risk and vulnerable populations and improve existing health-care delivery systems. As policy makers work- ing in local, state, or federal agencies, social workers formulate health policies and admin- ister health programs. These roles—far from being made obsolete by health reform—take on heightened importance in the reformed en- vironment. The success of health reform will depend on its provisions remaining intact, the newly insured gaining access to insurance cov- erage, and people’s ability to obtain needed

health-care services, regardless of their insur- ance status. For social workers to be effective in the new post–health-care-reform era, they must possess a thorough understanding of the law, which fi rst requires a strong command of the broader health-care policy environment that the law amends.

This chapter provides an overall frame- work for understanding health policy that is essential to successful direct practice, advo- cacy, and policy making. The framework in- cludes exposure to the key overall concerns of health policy—access, costs, quality, and accountability—as well as an introduction in the key organizational, fi nance, and payment structures in health care. We then provide an introduction to the structure and key issues in Medicare, Medicaid, and the State Children’s Health Insurance Program (SCHIP), the three main public insurance programs. We highlight the implications of health reform for future policy and practice. Due to space consider- ations, we focus on federal health policy ac- tions. For readers who are interested in state health policy issues, some additional resources are listed at the end of this chapter. With this background, we review the history of com- prehensive health reform and its ultimate pas- sage in 2010. Finally, the chapter raises a set of policy issues and provides a number of key resources for ongoing involvement for social workers interested in understanding and infl u- encing health policy.

Chapter Objectives • Provide a framework—access, cost, qual-

ity, accountability—for assessing all health policy initiatives.

JWBT514_ch05.indd 100JWBT514_ch05.indd 100 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Health Policy and Social Work 101

• Describe the basic organization, fi nancing, and payment structures of health care.

• Describe the key components of Medicare, Medicaid, and SCHIP.

• Briefl y describe the history and content of health-care reform.

• Identify key long-term health policy issues and professional roles for social workers.

FRAMEWORK FOR UNDERSTANDING HEALTH POLICY

Anyone wishing to understand the U.S. health system is immediately confronted by a di- chotomy: Massive amounts of spending occur against a backdrop of resource scarcity. Al- though the U.S. health-care system represents one of the largest economies in the world in its own right, health policy exists in a context of relative scarcity of resources. This is evident in much of the public debate: Although the coun- try spends over $2.5 trillion on health services, it is a truism in public discourse that we are not “spending enough” on mental health, research, Medicaid nursing home reimbursement, and other worthy causes. Because medical knowl- edge and technology are constantly producing fantastic new possibilities for intervention and treatment, the overarching challenge of health policy is to allocate resources toward care that is effective and cost worthy.

In this environment of tremendous spend- ing and resource scarcity, clinicians, managers, and policy makers face four general problems of health policy: access, costs, quality, and ac- countability.

Access refers to the “actual use of personal health services and everything that facilitates or impedes their use” (Andersen & Davidson, 2001, p. 3). Measures of access provide sig- nals of the fairness or social justice of health systems, indicators of its effi ciency or effec- tiveness, and important signposts for policy attention. Access is not just health insurance coverage but includes all of the practical and even cultural determinants—such as transpor- tation and cultural competence of providers—

that infl uence whether individuals are able to obtain needed services in a timely fashion.

Costs of health care represent the oppor- tunities forgone in the national economy as a result of devoting resources to health care. Re- sources allocated to health services mean that they are not available for their best alternative use, whether that consists of wages and sal- ary, investments in things such as education or plant and equipment, or for other forms of consumption. In the United States, we are concerned not only about the level of health- care costs—such as per-capita spending, or the share of gross domestic product—but also the rate of growth of health-care expenditures. The problem of cost containment is endemic in health care and the preoccupation of employ- ers who share in the costs of insurance, gov- ernments who fi nance public programs, and individuals who bear signifi cant out-of-pocket costs for medical expenses such as prescrip- tion drug coverage.

Quality of health care can refer to structural, process, or outcome dimensions of health-care delivery. Structural dimensions of health- care quality include the facilities, technology, workforce, and other observable “inputs” into care. In the early history of accreditation of health-care organizations, for example, sur- veyors focused on life safety and hygienic aspects of providers as the most salient mea- sures of quality. As health-care organizations became more sophisticated and standardized, quality improvement focuses on processes of care and, more recently, on outcomes (Lawlor & Raube, 1995).

Accountability of health care refers to the assurance that health care is clinically effec- tive, prudently delivered, and serving the best interests of patients and payers. Examples of accountability measures in health policy in- clude recent efforts to provide a patients’ bill of rights, the administrative efforts to reduce fraud and abuse, legal efforts to reform medi- cal malpractice litigation, and quality mea- sures to promote better outcomes and process in hospitals (Chassin et al., 2010).

Virtually all health policy endeavors can be understood as responding to access, cost,

JWBT514_ch05.indd 101JWBT514_ch05.indd 101 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

102 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

quality, or accountability concerns in health care. Efforts to change insurance coverage are motivated largely by access concerns; efforts to increase the cost sharing (such as copay- ments and deductibles) are driven by cost con- tainment concerns; efforts to reduce medical errors in hospitals are a form of quality ini- tiative; and legislation to reform medical mal- practice is a form of accountability change in the health system.

HEALTH SERVICES ORGANIZATION

The American approach to health-care delivery is an especially complicated mixture of public, nonprofi t, and for-profi t entities. To conceptu- alize all of the moving parts, it is helpful to separate out the organizations, fi nance and payment, and regulatory components of the system. In its organization, the health-care sys- tem is a complicated web of government, non- profi t, and for-profi t organizations that interact in a mix of public and private relationships.

Government is responsible for a signifi cant portion of health-care fi nance (appropriating and distributing money, primarily through taxes, that goes into the system); regulating ac- cess, cost, and quality; and actually producing health services in hospitals, clinics, prisons, and other settings.

The nonprofi t sector in health care is ex- tremely varied and includes: organizations such as BlueCross BlueShield; academic cen- ters that carry out research and train physicians, nurses, social workers, and other personnel; foundations that fund research and health ser- vices; and nonprofi t hospitals and clinics that provide health-care services directly.

The for-profi t (otherwise known as the pro- prietary or investor-owned) sector has varying emphasis in the system, depending on the in- dustry or sector. The pharmaceutical industry is almost entirely for-profi t, the nursing home industry is roughly 66% for-profi t, and the hospital industry is only 14% for-profi t.

To understand health-care politics and policy, it is important to recognize that, taken

together, these sectors add up to a large in- dustry: from pharmaceutical manufacturers, to suppliers of medical devices and durable goods, to architects, to ambulances, to con- sultants, to social workers. All of these actors are both politically and economically invested in health policy. Social workers need to ap- preciate that in addition to access and quality of clinical care—the usual priority of profes- sionals working in the system—health care is a political economy in its own right. Its power and vested interests add up to a $2.5 trillion industry. This power was most visibly on dis- play when health reform legislation was being debated and when interests such as the phar- maceutical industry, the insurance industry, or hospitals see their control and markets being threatened. However, this political economy is an ongoing force in health care, affecting the politics and decisions at every level of policy making, from local planning, to federal pay- ment policy for hospitals and physicians.

Finance and Payment

Social workers, whether in clinical, policy, management, or advocacy roles, need to un- derstand the relationship of fi nance, payment systems, providers, and actual provision of health services. Table 5.1 illustrates the basic elements of this framework for understanding the fl ow of dollars through the health system. Financing arrangements gather up dollars through taxes in the public sector or insur- ance premiums in the private sector. These dollars are then paid out in various payment systems that carry their own incentives for cost savings, preventive care, or other policy goals. For example, Diagnosis Related Groups (DRGs) are the payment method that Medi- care uses to reimburse hospitals for inpatient care. In payment systems, the dollars typically fl ow to particular provider types, whether they are ambulances, physicians, hospitals, health maintenance organizations (HMOs), or any of the hundreds of other provider types. Fi- nally, payments that go to particular provid- ers are calibrated for each individual service. For example, physicians often are paid on the

JWBT514_ch05.indd 102JWBT514_ch05.indd 102 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Health Policy and Social Work 103

Table 5.1 Examples of Finance, Payment, Provider, Service Relationships

Finance Payment Systems Providers Service

Payroll tax Diagnosis-related groups Hospitals All inpatient expenses

Employer/employee premiums

Capitation Managed care organization All covered health services, including prescription drugs

Federal and state (Medicaid) tax revenues

Fee for service Physicians Offi ce visits

Out-of-pocket expenditures

Fee for service Dentist Procedure

basis of a fee schedule that sets the specifi c amount based on cost, risk, or other criteria for payment.

Finance

Health services are fi nanced via a complicated patchwork of out-of-pocket expenditures, em- ployer and employee payments to insurers and other private intermediaries, and tax revenues that fl ow to public programs and public pro- viders, such as the Veterans Administration or county public hospitals.

Tax revenues fl ow into the health-care sys- tem through a number of routes. The most important sources of public funds for health services are payroll tax contributions and gen- eral revenue receipts for Medicare. Payroll tax contributions are deposited in a Medicare Part A Trust Fund for Hospital Insurance. Gen- eral revenue contributions are combined with premiums (75% general revenues, 25% Part B premiums) to fi nance physicians’ services, home health, and other nonhospital expenses in Medicare. A combination of federal and state tax revenues fi nance Medicaid. The exact contribution of federal and state sources varies from state to state depending on a formula but averages about 50/50.

The federal government fi nances a variety of other health services and programs through appropriations in the federal budget. Ex- amples include veterans’ services, payments to Federally Qualifi ed Health Centers (under the Health Resources and Services Adminis- tration), HIV and AIDS services (under the

Centers for Disease Control and Prevention), and Indian Health Services (under the Bu- reau of Indian Affairs). States fund a variety of health programs and providers as well as provide a signifi cant amount of direct health services through state hospitals, state schools, and departments of correction. Cities and counties are responsible for funding a variety of health services ranging from school health to public hospitals and clinics.

A considerable amount of health care is provided without obvious sources of payment, either as charity care (provided as in-kind ser- vices) or by writing off bad debt. The most in- teresting form of unfunded health care is free care provided by individual providers, such as physicians who provide care in their of- fi ces without payment, or organizations, such as free clinics. This care, offi cially known as uncompensated or charity care, is a signifi cant although often unaccounted for component of the health system. For some providers, such as inner-city teaching hospitals, charity care can be a signifi cant proportion of overall care and must be supported by subsidies, fundraising, or other sources.

Monies that are paid by employers and employees to health insurance plans, usually in the form of premiums for health coverage, account for about 36% of all health-care reve- nues. Indeed, 60% of Americans receive health insurance through their employers (DeNavas- Walt, Proctor, & Mills, 2004). Employees are charged amounts that may refl ect characteris- tics of their group (either their demographics

JWBT514_ch05.indd 103JWBT514_ch05.indd 103 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

104 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

or their cost and experience in using health services), the generosity of coverage, and the degree to which their employer wishes to dis- tribute the burden differently among higher- or lower-compensated employees. Thus, the premiums that individuals pay for health in- surance coverage vary widely across fi rms, occupations, and geography. Small fi rms with an expensive record of health-care costs and little ability or desire to subsidize coverage can face prohibitively high costs of coverage for workers.

Out-of-pocket expenditures usually are given to providers in the form of copayments or deductibles. Copayments require individu- als to share in the costs of a service, such as a physician visit or a prescription drug order, in order to make the user sensitive to the price or cost of that service. Deductibles also create a kind of price sensitivity to the use of health services and typically apply to the fi rst dollars of service use, such as the fi rst day or days of a hospitalization. A large body of economic re- search, most notably the RAND Health Insur- ance Experiments, documents the reductions in the costs and use of care when patients are charged even small copayments or deduct- ibles (Newhouse & the Insurance Experiment Group, 1993).

These kinds of fi nancial disincentives to use health services can discourage needed or ap- propriate care. The rise of “consumer-directed health care” has been accompanied by an in- crease in the use of copayments, deductibles, limits, and other features of health insurance coverage that are designed to reduce costs and force patients to be prudent users of services. At the extreme, new plan types known as Medical Savings Accounts (MSAs) combine high deductibles, catastrophic coverage, and favorable tax treatment to encourage consum- ers to make very calculated choices about their use of medical resources. Because consumers may get to keep and roll over any savings that may accrue when they do not spend out-of- pocket dollars for health services, policy mak- ers believe they will be much more careful and prudent about decisions to use resources. Critics of the MSAs worry that relatively

healthy enrollees will select these plans, leav- ing other insurance pools with sicker and more costly enrollees and, ultimately, much higher premiums.

Payment

In general, payment systems can be designed as prospective or retrospective, cost based or risk based. A prospective payment system es- tablishes the amount to be paid in advance, leaving the provider to assume the fi nancial risk if a patient costs more than the predeter- mined amount. A cost-based system attempts to reimburse providers for the actual resource use in an episode of care. The disadvantage of cost-based systems is that they fail to provide incentives for providers to be effi cient; when they began, cost-based systems such as in Medicare came to be known as “blank check Medicare.” Risk-based systems push the costs (or risks) of health services back to providers, and this gives them powerful incentives to be effi cient.

The most famous prospective payment sys- tem, and the one most consequential for social workers, is the Medicare Prospective Payment System (PPS), originally introduced in 1983. The unit of payment for the Medicare PPS was the diagnosis-related group, defi ned by the codes from the ninth edition of the Inter- national Statistical Classifi cation of Diseases and Related Health Problems applied to the patient’s condition or diagnosis at discharge. Hospitals were paid a fi xed, prospectively determined amount based on the resource intensity of a particular diagnosis. This fi xed prospective payment is a powerful example of a risk-based system. For example, a hip frac- ture would be classifi ed into a particular DRG category, “DRG 210 hip and femur procedure except major joint, without comorbidities or complications.” The hospital would be paid a fi xed amount based on the DRG weight for that case, which has a mean length of stay of 4.5 days.

In general, if the hospital treated the patient quickly and at low cost, it could retain the margin it earned on this episode of care; if the patient had a long and costly hospital stay, the

JWBT514_ch05.indd 104JWBT514_ch05.indd 104 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Health Policy and Social Work 105

hospital could lose considerable money on that particular patient. The theory of this payment system is that, with large numbers of patients, the winners and losers would net out, resulting in a small operating margin for the hospital. The incentives in this system are for hospitals to treat patients quickly and effi ciently.

For social workers, the introduction of PPS resulted in a tremendous emphasis on dis- charge planning because quick and effective discharge was the key to reduced lengths of stay, especially reductions in what hospital managers termed “administratively necessary days,” the time it took to fi nd an appropriate subacute setting, such as a skilled nursing facility to provide the next incidence of care for the patient. Because of the economic im- portance of discharge planning, this activity became the dominant task and even a profes- sional identity for hospital social workers. In many hospitals, hospital social workers be- came discharge planners.

Prospective payment systems can take many forms. Typically, managed care organi- zations pay providers for taking care of per- sons for a year-long term (thus the expression per person per year), for bundles or packages of services (such as for a package of cardiac care services: preoperative, surgical, postop- erative), or for treating certain diagnoses.

Retrospective payment systems, as the term suggests, pay for services after they have been delivered, on the basis of either costs or a fee schedule. The principal difference from pro- spective systems is that in retrospective sys- tems, the risk for more or less costly cases is shifted away from the provider. Until the mid-1980s, the widespread use of retrospec- tive cost-based payment systems, sometimes referred to as “blank check medicine,” was implicated in rapidly increasing health-care costs. Providers had no incentives to limit costs; rather, the more costly services they provided, the more they were paid.

Managed care organizations typically rely on versions of risk-based payment systems that force the insurer or provider to assume some degree of fi nancial risk or responsibil- ity for the costs of covering enrollees. HMOs

were based on a model of prepaid health care, known as capitation, in which plans were paid a single payment per person per year (known as a capitation payment), irrespective of the ill- nesses or cost experience of that individual en- rollee. The theory of these payments was that through the laws of large numbers, variations in the costs of illness experience of enrollees would smooth out. If the capitation payment was close to the average costs of covering this population, the managed care provider would have a strong incentive to control costs. Critics of these models charged that HMOs engaged in selection behavior, picking the healthiest enrollees for their plans, or engaged in treat- ment practices that restricted needed services or disadvantaged vulnerable patients.

As experience with and criticism of par- ticular payment systems build, inevitably there are movements to refi ne and improve such systems. Examples of refi nement would include the adoption of so-called partial capi- tation models (that attempt to blend fairness with the incentive effects of capitation), the extension of outlier payments in DRGs (to take account of extremely costly cases), and the application of sophisticated payment mod- els to new provider types (such as the adoption of prospective payment in long-term specialty hospitals). As these payment systems become more fi ne-tuned, the overall complexity of the system escalates.

KEY FEDERAL HEALTH PROGRAMS: MEDICARE, MEDICAID, AND SCHIP

Social workers in the fi eld of health care un- doubtedly will encounter Medicare and Med- icaid, two federal health insurance programs enacted into law in 1965. Together, Medicare and Medicaid cover 1 in 3 Americans, or 107 million benefi ciaries. The newest pub- lic insurance program, the State Children’s Health Insurance Program, enacted in 1997, covered 5 million children in 2009 (Smith, Roberts, et al. 2010). Medicare, Medicaid, and SCHIP account for over one third of national

JWBT514_ch05.indd 105JWBT514_ch05.indd 105 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

106 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

health spending and three fourths of all pub- lic spending—costing 770 billion in 2007 (Centers for Medicare and Medicaid Services [CMS], 2010).

In an era of increasingly complex and changing rules in federal health programs, knowledge about federal health policies and expertise in eligibility have become requisite skills for social workers to effectively connect clients with available resources and advocate for improvements in programs. Social work- ers are poised to help clients overcome persis- tent barriers to coverage that result from lack of knowledge or misinformation about public health programs.

Medicare

Medicare is a federal health insurance pro- gram that covered 47 million people in 2010, of whom 37.5 million are people age 65 and older and 8 million are people under age 65 with disabilities (Kaiser Family Foundation, 2010). Medicare’s history is rich and conse- quential—eligibility, payment systems, public support, and the model of acute care delivery that guides most of Medicare’s coverage are the products of overt political choices over its history (Lawlor, 2003). Medicare has four parts: A, B, C, and D.

Part A covers inpatient hospital, skilled nursing facility, hospice, and some home health-care services. People who are eligible to receive Social Security payments receive Part A automatically when they reach age 65. It is fi nanced primarily by a mandatory 1.45% payroll tax paid by employees and matched by employers. In 2010, benefi ciaries admitted to a hospital paid a $1,100 deductible for the fi rst 60 days; thereafter, benefi ciaries paid ad- ditional amounts per day for an inpatient stay.

Part B covers services offered by physi- cians and other providers (including clinical social workers); outpatient hospital services; some home health care; laboratory tests, X- rays, and other radiology services; physical and occupational therapy and speech pathol- ogy services; and medical equipment and supplies for home use. Part B is voluntary,

although 93% of people eligible for Part A elect Part B coverage (CMS, 2004h). Part B is fi nanced by benefi ciary premiums, which are set by law at 25% of the cost of Part B ben- efi ts, and general revenues from the U.S. Trea- sury. In 2010, the monthly premium for Part B coverage was $110.50. Benefi ciaries also are required to meet an annual Part B deductible ($155 in 2010) and pay 20% coinsurance for most Part B services.

Added as part of the Balanced Bud- get Act of 1997, Part C (originally called Medicare+Choice and later renamed Medicare Advantage) provides benefi ciaries the option to enroll in managed care plans. Medicare Ad- vantage plans enrolled 11 million benefi ciaries in 2010 (CMS, 2010), despite three decades of effort and expectations that the Medicare en- rollment in managed care would dominate the program (CMS, 2004e; Lawlor, 2003).

Added under the Medicare Prescription Drug, Improvement, and Modernization Act of 2003, Part D provides a voluntary prescrip- tion drug benefi t. Part D is fi nanced jointly by a benefi ciary premium (25.5%) and gen- eral revenues (74.5%) from the U.S. Treasury. Low-income benefi ciaries receive additional subsidies for coverage. Part D has had rapid uptake, now covering 28 million benefi ciaries and accounting for 11% of Medicare benefi t expenditures. A controversial element of Part D coverage, addressed in the 2010 PPACA, was a gap in prescription drug coverage, known as the donut hole.

Medicare benefi ciaries can elect to par- ticipate in Part D prescription drug cover- age by paying a premium. Once on the plan, benefi ciaries must pay the fi rst $310 of drug expenses (the deductible) before any cover- age is provided. After the deductible is met, Medicare will pay 75% up to the point at which a benefi ciary has incurred $2,831 of drug expenses. Over the next $3,609 of drug expenses—the so-called donut hole—Medi- care Part D provides no additional coverage. When a benefi ciary has incurred $6,440 of prescription drug expenses, catastrophic cov- erage kicks in, covering 95% of any addi- tional expenses. Provisions in the PPACA will

JWBT514_ch05.indd 106JWBT514_ch05.indd 106 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Health Policy and Social Work 107

reduce this out-of-pocket burden in the donut hole gradually, covering different proportions of brand name and generic expenses, until the law is fully phased in by 2020.

Although most Medicare benefi ciaries are elderly people, Medicare essentially does not pay for the cost of long-term care. Medicaid, discussed next, is the major public program that pays for long-term care in a nursing home.

PPACA made a number of substantial changes in Medicare fi nancing, coverage, and payment policy (Kaiser Family Founda- tion, 2010). A number of provider payments, especially payments for Medicare Advantage Plans, were reduced over time to limit overall Medicare cost growth. Overall, the package of Medicare spending cuts, taking account of additional spending in the law, is expected to reduce Medicare expenditures by a net of $428 billion between 2010 and 2019. A number of changes in the payroll tax fi nancing, employer tax deductions, premium levels, and fees on prescription drug providers also will increase fi nancing for Medicare over time. The PPACA also establishes a variety of innovations in delivery systems for benefi ciaries, increased prevention services, reductions in fraud and abuse, and an independent advisory board for the program.

Medicaid

Medicaid is a means-tested health insurance entitlement program fi nanced jointly by the federal government and the states. The pro- gram is a substantial player in the overall U.S. health-care system, accounting for approxi- mately 16% of all health-care spending. (Med- icaid is an especially large player in long-term care, accounting for 41% of all nursing home spending.) Medicaid covers nearly 60 million people, of whom 29 million are low-income children, 15 million are low-income adults, 8 million are elderly people, and 9 million are disabled people. Among those covered, Med- icaid provides long-term care assistance to over 1 million nursing home residents and 2.8 million community-based residents (Kaiser Family Foundation, 2010).

Within broad federal guidelines, states es- tablish their own eligibility criteria, determine the scope of covered services, establish pay- ment rates, and administer the program. Con- sequently, the Medicaid program varies widely across states. Federal Medicaid law requires that states cover individuals who fall within certain categories, including people who meet the requirements of the Aid to Families with Dependent Children (AFDC). Although the Personal Responsibility and Work Opportunity Reconciliation Act of 1996 (PRWORA) re- placed the open-ended entitlement to cash as- sistance, AFDC, with time-limited Temporary Assistance for Needy Families (TANF), states are not required to provide Medicaid coverage to TANF recipients. Only people who would have been eligible for AFDC under the AFDC requirements in effect on July 16, 1996, are guaranteed Medicaid coverage: pregnant women and children under age 6 with family income at or below 133% of the federal pov- erty level; children under age 19 who were born on or after September 30, 1983, and have family income at or below the federal poverty level; Supplemental Security Income (SSI) re- cipients in most states; recipients of adoption or foster care assistance under Title IV; and certain low-income Medicare benefi ciaries. States have the option to extend coverage to groups beyond federal minimum standards.

Starting in 2014, PPACA expands Medicaid coverage to all individuals and families with incomes below 133% of the poverty line. Chil- dren in families with incomes below 133% of the poverty line who formerly were covered by SCHIP would then transition to Medicaid coverage. The effect of this coverage rule will vary tremendously from state to state; states that have had relatively low eligibility levels will experience dramatic increases in Medicaid coverage. All together, it is estimated that the Medicaid provisions in PPACA will increase coverage in the program by 15.9 million peo- ple (Holahan & Headen, Kaiser Commission on Medicaid and the Uninsured, 2010). These 16 million represent half of the 32 million people who are anticipated to become newly insured under health reform.

JWBT514_ch05.indd 107JWBT514_ch05.indd 107 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

108 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

Federal Medicaid law also requires that states provide certain basic services, includ- ing inpatient and outpatient hospital services; physician, midwife, and nurse practitioner services; family planning services and sup- plies; prenatal care; vaccines for children; early and periodic screening; diagnosis and treatment (EPSDT) for children under age 21; laboratory and X-ray services; rural health clinic services; federally qualifi ed health center services; home health care; and nurs- ing home care. States have the option to ex- pand the scope of services to provide certain optional services, such as prescription drugs, transportation services, optometrist services and eyeglasses, prosthetic devices, home and community-based care, and rehabilitation and physical therapy services.

Medicaid enrollment in managed care plans has increased steadily over the past decade, now accounting for 71% of all enrollees receiving health-care coverage. Medicaid-managed care programs have been the source of both innova- tion and controversy, especially in states with high penetration of managed care. The most innovative Medicaid-managed care programs have developed care management programs, creative outreach to assure timely and preven- tive care, quality standards, and increased reli- ance on evidence-based medicine. The latest generation of Medicaid innovation has been the development of medical home models that establish a continuing primary care point of service and coverage, increased patient educa- tion, and coordination of care across multiple health providers and social services (Rosenthal et al., 2010). The controversy over Medicaid- managed care has arisen where: predatory or exploitive marketing practices have occurred; service delivery systems or availability of phy- sicians have been inadequate, either in certain places or for particular vulnerable populations; or quality of care has been poor.

Medicaid expenditures are spent dispro- portionately on elderly and disabled people. Although elderly and disabled people com- prised 25% of the benefi ciaries in 2007, they consumed 77% of Medicaid spending. As in other health insurance pools, a relatively

small proportion of Medicaid participants account for a large share of spending: In 2004, 5% of enrollees accounted for more than half of all spending. Moreover, more than 40% of all Medicaid spending is attrib- utable to people who receive both Medicare and Medicaid, known as dual eligibles (see Figure 5.1; Kaiser Commission on Medic- aid and the Uninsured, 2004). Dual eligibles may receive full Medicaid benefi ts plus as- sistance with Medicare cost sharing or may receive only assistance with paying Medicare premium and copayments. Dual eligibles are arguably among the most vulnerable Medi- care benefi ciaries, because they are poorer, sicker, and more likely to be members of a minority group than other Medicare benefi cia- ries. They experience higher rates of chronic disease, are more likely to suffer from mental disorders and Alzheimer’s disease, are more likely to receive assistance with instrumental activities of daily living, and are more likely to be unable to walk without assistance than other Medicare benefi ciaries (Kasper, Elias, & Lyons, 2004). Because of their multiple, complex needs, dual eligibles require services and supports that often fall outside Medicare’s scope of services.

Medicare benefi ciaries who are dually eli- gible for Medicaid often do not know about Medicaid or do not think they are eligible for it. It is estimated that between 41.5% and 47.9% of Medicare benefi ciaries who are eligible for payment of cost-sharing expenses under the so-called Medicare buy-in program are not re- ceiving assistance (Families USA Foundation,

Medicare Medicaid “Dual

eligibles”

Figure 5.1

JWBT514_ch05.indd 108JWBT514_ch05.indd 108 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Health Policy and Social Work 109

1998). Social workers who advise clients about available programs can play a crucial role in remedying this problem (Ozminkowski, Aizer, & Smith, 1997). By informing clients about the Medicare buy-in options, social workers can help their eligible Medicare clients save thousands of dollars per year.

Social workers also routinely work with populations who are ineligible for public pro- grams. Notably, because Medicaid historically has relied on categorical eligibility, nearly half of the poor have not qualifi ed for Medicaid. As described, this fact will change in 2014 (or sooner at state option), when all nonelderly adults under 133% of the poverty level will qualify for Medicaid. Until then, nondisabled adults without children and poor parents in states with eligibility below the federal pov- erty level will continue to be ineligible for Medicaid. In addition, neither Medicare nor Medicaid pays for health services received by undocumented immigrants, with the excep- tion of labor and delivery, which is covered by Medicaid. Moreover, legal immigrants’ access to Medicaid was restricted as a result of changes adopted in the PRWORA. Be- fore PRWORA, Medicaid eligibility was the same for citizens and noncitizens. PRWORA imposed a fi ve-year ban on Medicaid eligi- bility for new legal immigrants entering the United States after August 1996. Furthermore, PRWORA required the inclusion of the in- come of an immigrant’s sponsors in determin- ing an immigrant’s eligibility for Medicaid, effectively excluding many immigrants from Medicaid (Kaiser Commission on Medicaid and the Uninsured, 2003). The PPACA does not change legal and illegal immigrants’ eligi- bility for Medicaid. Numerous studies (Capps et al., 2002; Fix & Zimmerman, 1998; Maloy, Darnell, Kenney, & Cyprien, 2000) have cited fear of deportation and confusion about eli- gibility as barriers to enrollment of eligible immigrants into Medicaid. During this time of transition to full implementation of health reform, social workers will have an important role to play in educating their clients about the changes in Medicaid eligibility, assessing their clients’ eligibility for Medicaid, and encouraging

those who are eligible to enroll in the program. The failure of immigration reform and legis- lation restoring immigrants’ access to public benefi ts suggest a policy advocacy area where social workers can become involved.

State Children’s Health Insurance Program

The State Children’s Health Insurance Program is a federally funded and state-administered health insurance program for children up to 200% (or higher) of the federal poverty level. (States that already had extended coverage to children to levels at, near, or above 200% of poverty when the new law was enacted could further extend coverage up to 50 percentage points above whatever limits were in place in March 1997.) States that elect to participate in the program are entitled to higher federal contributions for every state dollar spent on child health programs. In designing their child health programs, states have the option to ex- tend Medicaid coverage, create a separate pro- gram, or fashion some combination of the two. Unlike Medicaid, SCHIP is not an open-ended entitlement but a capped entitlement; states, not children, are entitled to assistance (Rosen- baum, Johnson, Sonosky, Markus, & DeGraw, 1998). Moreover, the law caps federal fi nan- cial contributions to states at an annual aggre- gate level. Nearly $40 billion in federal funds were made available to states between 1998 and 2007 with an average allocation of $4 bil- lion per year (Dubay, Hill, & Kenney, 2002). SCHIP originated in the Balanced Budget Act of 1997 and was reauthorized through 2013 under the Children’s Health Insurance Pro- gram Reauthorization Act of 2009 (CHIPRA). When the CHIPRA reauthorization expires, the PPACA will extend authorization to 2015 but also requires states to hold the line on eli- gibility rules as of March 2010, when the law was enacted. PPACA also expands the funding available to states through an increase in the federal match rate.

All states (and the District of Columbia [DC]) participate in the SCHIP program. Of these, 12 states (including DC) expanded their

JWBT514_ch05.indd 109JWBT514_ch05.indd 109 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

110 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

existing Medicaid programs, 18 states created new state child health programs, and 21 states adopted some combination (CMS, 2004g). States that choose to implement a separate child health program have the fl exibility to adopt more limited benefi t packages than the state’s Medicaid program, impose cost sharing at signifi cantly higher levels than in Medicaid, and cap enrollment.

In this environment of dramatic change for Medicaid and SCHIP, social workers can help individuals and organizations make the tran- sition by educating clients about their cover- age options and the requirements to maintain coverage. Indeed, social workers employed in hospitals, ambulatory clinics, schools, and social service agencies have been conduct- ing application assistance and outreach since SCHIP’s enactment.

The combination of health reform and state fi scal crises present an interesting challenge for the maintenance or increase of Medicaid and SCHIP coverage until 2014 (Kaiser Commission on Medicaid and the Uninsured, August 2010). The recession simultaneously reduced state revenues and increased state social service and health-care demands. Stimulus support under the American Recovery and Reinvestment Act provided fi scal relief to states in 2010. Under reform, states have signifi cant responsibilities to upgrade information technology, create coordi- nation between new health insurance exchanges and Medicaid, and pilot numerous delivery sys- tem reforms and long-term care innovations. This interim period before health reform is fully implemented will produce an interesting con- test between the federal government seeking to maintain states’ level of effort and Medicaid coverage and the states facing dramatic fi scal crises brought on by the recession.

HEALTH-CARE REFORM: HISTORY AND CULMINATION

Enactment of the PPACA was the culmination of almost a century of political struggle and incremental steps toward universal coverage and access. A brief historical review of such

failed efforts is instructive, because it points to the differences in approaches and raises issues that are likely to be revisited again.

Support for national health insurance dates back nearly a century. President Theodore Roosevelt, in his unsuccessful reelection bid against Woodrow Wilson in 1912, endorsed health insurance for all Americans (Davis, 2001; Kronenfeld & NetLibrary, 2002; Starr, 1982). The fi rst national health insurance re- form model bill was proposed in 1915 by the American Association for Labor Legislation (AALL), a group of social progressives. The AALL’s model bill provided medical coverage to lower-paid workers and their dependents. It was fi nanced by a tax on wages paid by em- ployees, employers, and the states. Its eventual defeat is attributed to opposition from special interests (physicians, labor, and business) and America’s entry into World War I (Starr, 1982).

At this point, the movement for universal health insurance stalled. Notably, President Franklin Roosevelt omitted national health insurance in his proposed Social Security bill because of concern that opposition would jeopardize the entire proposal (Kronenfeld & NetLibrary, 2002). Momentum for univer- sal health insurance coverage did not emerge again until the 1940s. Introduced in 1943 in the U.S. Congress by Senators Robert Wagner and James Murray and Representative John Dingell, the Wagner-Murray-Dingell bill was the fi rst congressionally sponsored bill to pro- vide mandatory national health insurance. The bill sought to provide physician and hospital care to employees and retirees under the So- cial Security system. It included an employer mandate system of fi nance in which employers and employees contributed to a national trust fund that reimbursed providers (Bodenheimer & Grumbach, 2002; Starr, 1982). Amid op- position from organized medicine, Congress never voted on the bill (American Historical Association, n.d.). In 1945, President Truman endorsed a similar bill, becoming the fi rst president to send a national health insurance bill to Congress. Physicians and other health- care interests opposed the health-care bill and federal agencies opposed the plan or bestowed

JWBT514_ch05.indd 110JWBT514_ch05.indd 110 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Health Policy and Social Work 111

only lukewarm support (Starr, 1982). Ulti- mately, only one component of the bill, the Hospital Survey and Construction Act (known as the Hill-Burton Act), was signed into law.

Despite the defeat of the Wagner-Murray- Dingell bill, it set the stage some 20 years later for the enactment of Medicare in 1965 (discussed in detail earlier). In an era in which fewer than 15% of the elderly popula- tion had health insurance, Congress adopted the Wagner-Murray-Dingell approach but re- stricted it to people age 65 and older. As with the original Wagner-Murray-Dingell bill, insur- ance is compulsory and is fi nanced (in part) by a payroll tax. A companion program, Medicaid (also described earlier), enacted in 1965, ad- opted a very different model, with coverage provided only to certain groups of low-income people and fi nanced by general federal and state taxes (Bodenheimer & Grumbach, 2002).

In 1970, Senator Edward Kennedy and Representative Martha Griffi ths introduced a universal health insurance plan that went farther than either the AALL legislation or the Wagner-Murray-Dingell bill. A single- payer plan, the Kennedy-Griffi ths proposal provided a national health insurance system administered by the federal government. It was fi nanced by employment taxes (payroll and self-employment) and by general tax rev- enues. Like its predecessors, the bill could not overcome opposition from organized interests (Bodenheimer & Grumbach, 2002).

As an alternative to the Kennedy-Griffi ths bill, President Nixon proposed a national health insurance plan that was administered privately (not by the government). His pro- posal imposed an employer mandate for those with 25 or more employees (Bodenheimer & Grumbach, 2002; Davis, 2001) and proposed public plans that would replace and improve on Medicare and Medicaid (Davis, 2001). With its focus on the private sector, the Nixon proposal marked a clear departure from ear- lier proposals that relied on government fi - nancing (Bodenheimer & Grumbach, 2002). Its defeat is attributed to lack of public will (Bodenheimer & Grumbach, 2002) and politi- cal scandal (Plissner, 2001).

President Carter supported a comprehen- sive program of national health insurance dur- ing his successful bid for the presidency, but skyrocketing infl ation rates detracted attention from national health reform (Kronenfeld & NetLibrary, 2002).

A congressionally mandated commission, the Bipartisan Commission on Comprehensive Health Care (called the Pepper Commission after its fi rst chairman, Congressman Claude Pepper, who served until his death), in 1990 recommended a pay-or-play approach to em- ployer coverage. Interest in comprehensive health reform legislation accelerated following the commission’s recommendations (Mueller, 1993). Senator Mitchell later adopted the pay- or-play model in bipartisan legislation (Davis, 2001). The legislation required employers to either provide a health plan for their employ- ees or pay into a state insurance fund. A com- parison of these major types of health-care re- form approaches is found in Table 5.2.

President Bill Clinton pushed strongly for comprehensive health-care reform in what culminated as the Health Security Act legisla- tion introduced in Congress in 1993. The leg- islation assured universal coverage through an “individual mandate,” which required citizens and legal residents to purchase standardized comprehensive insurance coverage through a regional alliance, a state-established interme- diary that contracted with health insurance plans. The legislation created an “employer mandate”; universal coverage was fi nanced principally by mandatory contributions from employers (roughly 80%). Emphasizing indi- vidual responsibility, the legislation also re- quired contributions from employees (roughly 20%). (Persons who were not in the workforce were entitled to income-related subsidies to purchase coverage through the alliance.) Fed- eral subsidies supplemented contributions made by many fi rms and individuals. The Medicare program remained in place and was expanded to include prescription drug cover- age. Medicaid coverage was supplanted by the alliance plans, with the exception of nonacute care for cash-assistance recipients who en- rolled in health plans through the alliance but

JWBT514_ch05.indd 111JWBT514_ch05.indd 111 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

112 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

retained Medicaid coverage (Fuchs & Merlis, 1993).

The defeat of the Clinton plan in 1994 is at- tributable to numerous factors. Commentators ascribe failure to the political process and, in particular, to misguided leadership (Johnson & Broder, 1996), political naivete (Brown, 1996), failure of public deliberation (Heclo, 1995), a narrow base of presidential political support (Heclo, 1995), insuffi cient attention to timing (Hamburg & Ballin, 1995; Johnson & Broder, 1996), failure to sell the plan to the public (Blendon, Brodie, & Benson, 1995), opposi- tion from special interests that had a stake in the status quo (Judis, 1995; Oberlander, 2003), and the structure of U.S. political institutions (Oberlander, 2003). Its defeat also is attributed to the size and complexity of the legislation it- self (Johnson & Broder, 1996; Starr, 1995) and to antistatist values (Jimenez, 1997; Johnson & Broder, 1996; Oberlander, 2003; Skocpol, 1995).

The specifi cs of the Obama Health Plan grew out of a set of campaign commitments, a political strategy, and a variety of compro- mises necessary to reconcile House and Senate differences. A complex and bipartisan reform in the State of Massachusetts in 2006 set the stage for a proposal that built on a require- ment for private health insurance coverage, with a variety of subsidies and Medicaid ex- pansions to cover low- and moderate-income populations. The Massachusetts experiment had demonstrated that it was possible to

assuage the many concerns of providers, ad- vocates, and insurers in implementing reform and, by 2009, only 2.7% of the population were uninsured.

The political strategy that Obama pursued deliberately did not replicate the process of the Clinton plan. The administration provided relatively little guidance in the early phases of policy development, instead relying on congressional process and committees to ne- gotiate the key provisions. Further, the admin- istration worked to bring the various special interest groups “inside the tent” in the negotia- tions, to try to avoid the fi erce opposition to reform that had been engendered by the Clin- ton approach. At crucial political moments in the evolution of the Obama plan, the Pharma- ceutical Manufacturers Association (PhRMA), the insurance industry, hospitals, doctors, and other key special interests, and stakeholders publicly and visibly supported the reform. In each case, however, serious concessions and compromises had been made to win their support. Critics on the left suggested that the emerging legislation did not represent a signif- icant and bold transformation of the system— such as a single-payer approach. Critics on the right argued that the proposed legislation, especially its mandate for individual coverage, represented a major incursion into individual liberties and structurally a major takeover of health services by the government.

After a surprising Republican Senate vic- tory in Massachusetts (ironically an election

Table 5.2 Comparison of Major Types of Health Care Reform Approaches

Type of Reform Mandatory/Voluntary Brief Description

Single payer Mandatory Single government-run insurance organization collects health-care fees and reimburses providers.

Employer mandate Mandatory Employers are required to contribute to the cost of health-care coverage for employees and dependents.

Vouchers/tax credits Voluntary Individuals purchase health insurance with the assistance of government subsidies.

Medical savings accounts Voluntary Individuals save money in tax-exempt accounts that they can use to pay medical expenses.

Individual mandate Mandatory Employees are required to purchase insurance.

JWBT514_ch05.indd 112JWBT514_ch05.indd 112 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Health Policy and Social Work 113

to fi ll the seat of long-term reform champion Edward (Ted) Kennedy), the political calcu- lus of health-care reform shifted still again in 2010. Through a complicated set of legislative maneuvers, the House version of the legisla- tion was adopted without change by the Senate (avoiding the need to go through Conference Committee and renegotiate with the House), and further changes were adopted in the con- text of a subsequent large-scale budget recon- ciliation bill, the Health Care and Education Reconciliation Act of 2010.

KEY FEATURES OF HEALTH REFORM

In addition to changes in Medicare and Med- icaid just described, PPACA makes signifi cant changes in overall insurance coverage and reg- ulation, affordability, quality, long-term care coverage, workforce development, and health promotion and prevention.

Under the new law, most individuals will be required to demonstrate health insurance provided through their employer, Medicaid, SCHIP, or Medicare, or to purchase health- care coverage through newly formed health in- surance exchanges. (Individuals subject to the mandate and who do not have insurance cov- erage will be required to pay a penalty based on their income.) Larger employers with more than 50 employees must provide coverage for their workforce or pay an assessment that is calibrated to the number of employees partici- pating in the publicly available options.

Individuals and families with incomes below 133% of the poverty line will be cov- ered by Medicaid. Individuals and families with incomes between 133% and 400% of the poverty line and who do not receive coverage from their employers or public programs are eligible for premium subsidies to make cover- age affordable. These premium subsidies will be applied to insurance coverage available through new state health insurance exchanges, which will function like marketplaces where individuals and families can purchase stan- dardized health insurance plans. Low-income

individuals are also eligible for cost-sharing subsidies.

The new law contains numerous provisions to regulate insurance coverage and protect con- sumers. These provisions protect individuals with preexisting conditions, regulate the rates and underwriting practices that determine eli- gibility and premiums, require certain forms of information and customer service (such as call centers), and control marketing practices.

Although the new law emphasizes primary care delivery as an important solution to the costs, access, quality, and accountability prob- lems in health care, it is well known that there are huge shortages in primary care physicians, nurses, and allied health professionals, includ- ing social workers. PPACA allocates an addi- tional $11 billion to the federal health center program over the next fi ve years. These new monies are in addition to the annual discre- tionary funding ($2.2 billion in 2010). PPACA also increases reimbursement for primary care “evaluation and management” services, pro- vides additional funding and regulates slots for primary care training, and provides additional loan forgiveness and incentives for physicians to practice primary care in underserved areas. PPACA also provides extensive funding and incentives to increase the pipeline of nurses who will enter primary care, including provi- sions to support nurse-managed primary care clinics.

Numerous provisions of the new law are directed at encouraging prevention and health promotion. Some of these provisions, such as reimbursement for preventive visits in Medi- care, encourage more health promotion in the health-care delivery system. Some provisions are directed at increasing wellness programs sponsored by employers. Still a third arm of the legislation funds public health program- ming for obesity, infectious diseases, and other preventable conditions in community settings.

Long-term care coverage will be provided to participants who sign up for voluntary insur- ance under the Community Living Assistance Services and Supports program. Although many of the details of this program are yet to be determined, individuals will be eligible to

JWBT514_ch05.indd 113JWBT514_ch05.indd 113 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

114 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

contribute to a plan that provides a certain dol- lar coverage for in-home or community-based long-term care expenses. After contributing through payroll deductions for at least fi ve years (the “vesting” period), individuals will be eligible for up to $50 per day for the social and long-term care supports necessary to keep them in the community. The law also makes numer- ous Medicaid changes designed to encourage more community-based long-term care op- tions, making it easier for states to innovate in home and community-based services as well as provide incentives and coverage for attendants and other community-based supports for ben- efi ciaries who are aged and disabled.

POLICY ISSUES FOR SOCIAL WORK

The PPACA shifts the orientation of health in- surance and health policy to a more preventive and primary care mode. Now enacted, the law shifts much of the implementation challenge to the states. States will have responsibility to implement health exchanges and restructure their delivery systems to respond to signifi cant new low- and middle-income populations who now have insurance coverage. This new model will put particular stressors on the delivery systems that exist in medically underserved areas (with already existing shortages of pro- viders) as well as rural areas. Social workers can play important roles as policy implemen- tors and advocates as these delivery system changes take place. It will be important to work collaboratively with primary care, nurs- ing, public health, and social service organi- zations and providers in shaping the delivery systems required for successful implementa- tion of reform.

In addition to the fi nancing and delivery system issues that surround Medicare, Med- icaid, and national health reform, social work has particular interests in the alleviation of health disparities, the future of the so-called health safety net, as well as the revitalization and replenishment of social work professional roles in health care.

Uninsured

The PPACA shifts attention away from the un- insured, who will no longer be in the policy spotlight. The individual mandate to purchase insurance is a key provision in PPACA, but it is essential to recognize that the PPACA falls short of achieving universal insurance. At full implementation in 2019, it is estimated that 23 million people will be uninsured. The pool of uninsured will be composed of individuals who are excluded from coverage expansions, those who opt out of coverage, and those who are left without coverage although they are eligible. This number represents 8% of the total U.S. nonelderly residents, when includ- ing those residing unlawfully; excluding the undocumented, the uninsured share is 5% of all nonelderly residents. Until 2019, the num- ber of nonelderly people who are uninsured is predicted to hover around 50 million through 2013 and then is expected to decrease to 31 million in 2014, the year when a number of coverage expansions take effect. After 2014, the number of uninsured continues to decline but never falls below 20 million.

People who remain uninsured will fall into two categories: exempt from the penalty and not exempt. Several groups of people are ex- empt from the penalty associated with failing to purchase health insurance coverage. These include: undocumented immigrants, individu- als who are unable to fi nd affordable health insurance coverage (i.e., health insurance premium exceeds 8% of income), individuals who claim a (yet undefi ned) hardship exemp- tion, people who are without health insurance coverage for less than three months, people whose gross income is below the threshold for fi ling a federal income tax return, mem- bers of American Indian/Alaska Native tribes, members of recognized religious groups that embrace teachings opposed to the acceptance of the benefi ts of insurance, and incarcerated individuals.

The Congressional Budget Offi ce (CBO) has estimated that of the approximately 21 million people who are projected to be unin- sured in 2016, approximately 4 million will

JWBT514_ch05.indd 114JWBT514_ch05.indd 114 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Health Policy and Social Work 115

pay a penalty for failing to purchase insurance coverage (CBO, 2010). Of these 3.9 million, 1 million uninsured individuals who pay the pen- alty have low incomes; specifi cally, 400,000 people are estimated to have income below the poverty line and 600,000 are estimated to have income between 100% and 200% of the poverty line. An additional 1.5 million unin- sured individuals who pay the penalty have moderate incomes between 200% to 300% of the poverty line (.8 million) or between 300% to 400% of the poverty line (.7 million). The majority of uninsured who are subject to the penalty are projected to have incomes of 400% or more (2.4 million).

The CBO estimates do not include a com- plete itemization of the 23 million uninsured. But it is known that the largest share of the uninsured will be undocumented immigrants. Undocumented people are prohibited from purchasing insurance through the new ex- changes and are ineligible for Medicaid cov- erage except for emergency medical services. People who are in the country unlawfully may be covered by an employer-sponsored health plan or purchase insurance from companies of- fering their products outside of the state-based insurance exchanges. They are estimated to number 8 million and to account for about one third of the uninsured in 2019.

The next largest group of uninsured will be individuals who are eligible for—but do not enroll in—Medicaid. Although the new law extends coverage to individuals who are under age 65 and have income up to 133% of the poverty level, it is well documented that not all eligible individuals actually obtain Medicaid coverage. There is considerable state variation in the rate of participation in Medicaid among eligible individuals. The General Account- ability Offi ce (GAO) has documented that between 56% and 64% of eligible nonelderly adults enroll (GAO, 2005).

The phenomenon of eligible people not enrolling in public programs is not new. A previous study (Holahan, Cook, & Dubay, 2007) estimated that a quarter of the unin- sured in 2004 were eligible for public pro- grams but not enrolled in them. Davidoff,

Garrett, and Yemane (2001) conducted a study of Medicaid-eligible adults who are not enrolled and found that, compared with Medicaid enrollees, Medicaid-eligible-but- not-enrolled individuals are less likely to have chronic illnesses and are in better overall health. Despite their better health, however, Medicaid-eligible-but-not-enrolled adults still face substantial access barriers and, as a result, use fewer services. Com- pared with their Medicaid benefi ciary coun- terparts, Medicaid-eligible-but-not-enrolled adults are more likely to be older, married, White or Hispanic, an immigrant, working full time, and have incomes between 50% and 100% of the poverty line (Davidoff et al., 2001). It is important for social workers to understand who has fallen through the Med- icaid cracks in the past, because adults who share these characteristics also might be sus- ceptible to failing to enroll in Medicaid in the post–health reform era.

Because of its 2006 adoption of compre- hensive health reform legislation, Massachu- setts foreshadows likely successes and failures that the country may experience as it rolls out a similar plan. The people who remain unin- sured in Massachusetts are: male, young (age 18–26), and single; Hispanic; a noncitizen; and an adult with limited English profi ciency or living in a household in which there is an adult unable to speak English; an adult who lacks a high school education; below 150% of the poverty line; and residing in a metropolitan area (Long, Phader, & Lynch, 2010). Further, it is reported that 42% of the uninsured adults in Massachusetts have income below 150% of the poverty line, an amount that makes them eligible for a full premium subsidy (Long et al., 2010). Thus, while affordability will be one important factor in predicting participa- tion in health insurance coverage, it is by no means the only important factor. Cultural char- acteristics and language, such as inability to communicate well in English, low literacy, and noncitizenship, appear to make people espe- cially vulnerable to being uninsured. As social workers routinely help people apply for public benefi ts and for subsidized coverage through

JWBT514_ch05.indd 115JWBT514_ch05.indd 115 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

116 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

the state-based exchanges, it will be important for them to target outreach and enrollment as- sistance to these at-risk populations.

Health Disparities

Wide disparities in access, costs, quality, and outcomes exist across groups in their health- care use, quality, and outcomes. The most vis- ible examples have been differences in infant mortality, low birth weight, and adverse birth outcomes by race. African Americans experi- ence infant mortality rates double those of White Americans. This differential has been stubbornly consistent, even as infant mortality rates have dropped precipitously over the past four decades. Prostate cancer rates are 60% higher for African American men as compared to White American men. African Americans experience signifi cantly higher rates (and higher death rates) from cardiovascular dis- ease and stroke, diabetes, and HIV/AIDS as well as other major categories of disease and mortality. Other ethnic and racial groups also exhibit high rates of morbidity and mortality that are apparently not well addressed by the public health or health delivery system. For example, obesity and diabetes present at high rates in the American Indian/Alaskan Native population, the Mexican American population, and the Pacifi c Islander/Asian American popu- lation.

Racial and ethnic disparities have long been known to health services researchers and pol- icy makers but more recently have become a matter of signifi cant policy concern. A major impetus for national policy attention to ra- cial and ethnic disparities was the Institute of Medicine (IOM) report, Unequal Treatment: Confronting Racial and Ethnic Disparities in Healthcare (Smedley, Stith, Nelson, & U.S. Institute of Medicine, Committee on Under- standing and Eliminating Racial and Ethnic Disparities in Health Care, 2002). The IOM re- port documented signifi cant differences in use and quality of health services—test, sophis- tication of treatment, and so on—even when insurance and income were controlled. The report was controversial, because it identifi ed

discrimination in medical practice as a sig- nifi cant factor over and above the traditional access factors and operation of the delivery system. More specifi cally, the report focused on stereotyping and prejudice by clinical pro- viders, whether conscious or unconscious.

The federal government, as well as numer- ous health foundations, has identifi ed racial and ethnic disparities as a major initiative for funding, clinical and services attention, and research. Congress now requires an annual re- port, prepared by the Agency for Healthcare Research and Quality on issues in address- ing disparities across a variety of vulnerable groups: the low-income population, racial and ethnic minorities, women, children, elderly people, and individuals with special or chronic health-care needs. The issues are complex and involve interactions among underlying social circumstances, health behaviors, and health services delivery.

Health-Care Safety Net

Because so many individuals and families have experienced access problems due to fi nancial and nonfi nancial barriers, the delivery of care by public and nonprofi t organizations that pro- vide care for free or on the basis of ability to pay is a critical issue (Smedley et al., 2002). These so-called safety net providers include public hospitals and clinics, federally qualifi ed health centers (FQHCs), specialty providers (such as reproductive health centers), and free clinics that rely principally on volunteer con- tributions. Signifi cant amounts of care also are provided by hospitals, physicians, and clinics in the form of free or subsidized care. Particu- lar services, such as emergency room care or burn care, are provided disproportionately to uninsured patients because of poverty, short- comings of the primary or public health sys- tems, or regulatory requirements.

Historically, these providers have relied heavily on: grants from federal, state, and local sources; Medicaid and FQHC reim- bursements; and private philanthropy. In the short run, before health reform is phased in, these sources are under stress in most states,

JWBT514_ch05.indd 116JWBT514_ch05.indd 116 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Health Policy and Social Work 117

and none has been able to keep up with the real costs of delivering health services. In the longer run, many urban centers will need to address planning, governance, and coordina- tion of the safety net providers as health re- form is implemented. The PPACA provides substantial new funding for community health centers—$11 billion over fi ve years—with the expectation that these critical pieces of the safety net will implement some of the vision of community-based primary care as well as respond to the needs of uncovered individuals, such as undocumented workers, through the transition of reform.

Rural safety net providers have faced even greater challenges as the combined effects of technology growth, diffi culties in recruiting and retaining physicians and allied health per- sonnel, and payment policies have conspired against the efforts of rural areas to maintain small hospitals and access to primary care (Ormond, Wallin, & Goldenson, 2000). It is diffi cult to achieve the effi ciencies and technologies of care demanded in modern medicine with the relatively small number of patients who, by defi nition, are present in rural hospitals and clinics. Doctors looking for colleagues, wanting to refer to specialists, or looking for access to sophisticated equipment or facilities naturally will practice in more urban settings. The fact that many rural areas have disproportionately high numbers of un- insured and low-income residents means that providers face a kind of triple jeopardy: a poor payer environment, disadvantaged and often high-risk patients, and high unit costs.

Both Medicare and Medicaid have pro- moted policies to support rural providers and physicians, and providers have endeavored to respond with mergers, affi liations, and the use of new technologies, such as telemedicine. The plight of the rural safety net, however, continues to be a major area of policy concern.

Patient-Centered Medical Home

Although it originated in 1967 as a strategy to care for children with special care needs, in recent years the medical home concept has

evolved into a broadly accepted and widely tested model to deliver high-quality primary care for anyone. Although there is no standard defi nition of a medical home, most concur that its essential components are a personal pri- mary care physician, enhanced access to care, care coordination, team-based care, a whole- person orientation, and a focus on quality and safety.

The patient-centered medical home model has been tested in a variety of ways and set- tings. Dozens of public and private dem- onstration programs exist, of which the American Academy of Pediatrics, one of the physician specialty groups responsible for the model’s creation, maintains a listing (www .medicalhomeinfo.org). The model also has received widespread acceptance. The National Committee on Quality Assurance has devel- oped three levels of Medical Home recogni- tion for health-care practices. The American Medical Association House of Delegates adopted the “Joint Principles of the Patient- Centered Medical Home,” which were devel- oped by four physician specialty groups. The new health reform law authorizes continued experimentation with the medical home model. Specifi cally, the PPACA authorizes states to implement a “Health Home” for Medicaid enrollees with chronic conditions or serious mental health conditions. The PPACA also specifi es the patient-centered medical home as one of the models to test for “high-need” benefi ciaries under the newly created Center for Medicare and Medicaid Innovation within the CMS.

Social workers’ expertise in connecting clients to appropriate services and resources makes them especially well suited to play a role in care coordination activities. With train- ing and experience in case management, social workers are adept at each of the care manage- ment processes: identifying needs and devel- oping, implementing, and evaluating the care plan. Arguably, care coordination is one of the most important components of a medical home because it can reduce costs and improve quality of care (McAllister, Presler, & Cooley, 2007). Nevertheless, some evidence suggests

JWBT514_ch05.indd 117JWBT514_ch05.indd 117 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

118 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

that a majority of practices have not adopted care coordination activities (Goldberg & Kuzel, 2009). This fi nding suggests a need for social workers to underscore the importance of care coordination activities and to step in to provide this service.

The profession of social work draws on theories of human behavior and social sys- tems in order to change and improve the lives of people and society. Embracing the person-in-environment perspective, social workers have special insight into the medi- cal home whole-person orientation. When considering the whole person, social work- ers consider the client’s physical, emotional, and spiritual attributes in the context of each of her surroundings—her family, commu- nity, and society. As health-care practices begin to implement medical home models, social workers can bring to the table much understanding about the whole person and can help to ensure that this component of the model is fully realized and adopted. Social workers also have at their disposal a client- centered, fi eld-tested tool, the aptly named person-in-environment system, for classi- fying problems. This system is intended to yield a better understanding of the problems that clients are experiencing so that more ef- fective interventions can be designed.

Social Work Professional Role

Virtually absent from the policy discussions of health reform or more narrow considerations of state Medicaid policy or urban health- care delivery is the role of social work as a profession in the health-care system. Profes- sional roles for social workers have changed dramatically in recent years, in part as a re- sult of policy changes. The implementation of the Medicare Prospective Payment System, for example, fundamentally changed the re- sponsibilities for medical social workers to an emphasis on discharge planning. The pri- ority for hospitals was to shorten lengths of inpatient stays. With that priority, an emphasis emerged to fi nd placements and make arrange- ments for expedited discharge. Social workers,

with knowledge of community resources, abil- ity to work with families, and interdisciplin- ary orientation, became the default solution to this institutional need. Unfortunately, the status of medical social work and the breadth of responsibilities that medical social workers enjoyed in hospitals devolved as social work increasingly became identifi ed simply with “discharge planning.”

With the aging of the population, the grow- ing primacy of chronic conditions such as dia- betes and asthma, and the shift to new forms of community health-care delivery, the social work profession has the opportunity to defi ne and advocate for new roles in practice. Efforts under way by the National Institute of Health’s National Cancer Institute, CMS, the Health Resources and Services Administration, the American Cancer Society, and other local hos- pitals and clinics to use “patient navigation” to assist families and vulnerable patients in nego- tiating clinical, service, and social aspects of cancer care and chronic disease treatment rep- resent important areas for role defi nition (or loss of role defi nition) for social work in health care (Darnell, 2007). Key to reinvigorating the social work professional role in health services delivery will be advocacy in policy: making sure that criteria, payment, and management designate social work as the professional pro- vider of choice.

As advocates and proponents of social jus- tice, social workers also have a role in arguing for sound and compassionate policy responses to disparities in and lack of access to health care. At a state level, social workers have been an important voice and source of analysis for Medicaid and SCHIP coverage and reimburse- ment policy. At a local level, especially in the absence of universal coverage, social workers play an important policy and political role in the maintenance of the so-called health-care safety net: public and nonprofi t providers that serve low income, uninsured, or underinsured patients. At each of these levels of advocacy, substantive knowledge of programs and policy is essential. One source of political capital that social workers bring to legislative, administra- tive, and regulatory decisions is their expertise

JWBT514_ch05.indd 118JWBT514_ch05.indd 118 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Health Policy and Social Work 119

in the workings of programs such as Medicare and Medicaid as well as their understanding of the real-life effects of these programs on vul- nerable populations and communities.

CONCLUSION

Health policy in the United States attempts to address systemic problems of access, costs, quality, and accountability. With the enact- ment of PPACA, the dominant policy con- cerns about the system will shift from access to costs and quality. Although the architects of health reform assert that it will lead to substantial overall cost controls (Orszag & Emanuel, 2010), others believe that the leg- islation did not deal with the fundamental drivers of cost, such as escalating technol- ogy, delivery system discipline, and insur- ance. Looked at more carefully, the problem of costs is not simply the level of health-care costs in the United States but rather a concern about the value or benefi t that these services produce. As the government and private pay- ers for health care have attempted to gain control over health-care expenditures, more and more policy attention has been paid to ensuring the quality and accountability of the system. Health policy will be increasingly preoccupied with outcomes, information, and incentives for quality care.

The key policy levers for affecting the size and scope of health services are fi nanc- ing arrangements (such as taxes and insurance premiums), payment arrangements (such as DRGs or managed care capitation payments), and information sources about quality and ef- fi ciency of services.

Although access cost, quality, and account- ability concerns are the primary issues for policy analysis and reform, all legislative and regulatory actions in the health system take place within the context of huge political and economic interests. The recent history of re- form was dominated by large interests, such as the insurance and pharmaceutical industries, shaping public perceptions and congressional behavior.

The next phase of reform shifts to the states, where the implementation of health ex- changes, Medicaid and SCHIP coverage, de- livery system reforms, health prevention and promotion, and workforce development will determine the ultimate success of PPACA. The largest transition will be the movement of uninsured and underinsured populations to a coverage model where they will be expected to select and participate in traditional insur- ance or Medicaid coverage and will be steered toward mainstream providers and services. Supporting and advocating for vulnerable populations during this transition will be a key role for social workers.

The two large policy arenas for social work in health care will continue to be the Medicare and Medicaid programs. In Medicare, the ad- dition of prescription drug coverage and the evolution to more competitive and “consumer- driven” approaches to health plan choice and coverage will be important frontiers for social work advocacy and practice. Medicaid is fac- ing threats to coverage and fi nancing, particu- larly during the transition to reform in 2014, when eligibility for Medicaid shifts to 133% of the poverty line across the country. During this interim period, states face a kind of policy scissors: On one side, their economic down- turn is straining resources and forcing cuts in programs, while on the other side, the ramp-up of reform is creating expectations and require- ments for maintenance and expansion of cov- erage. The vigilance and advocacy of social workers will be especially important during this transitional period.

Social workers will need to be savvy about these health policy changes in their own prac- tice, in professional roles that attempt to for- mulate or implement health policy, and in promoting broader advocacy for health-care reform. The implementation of health reform, rapidly escalating costs, the aging of the pop- ulation, and increasing pressures to control public spending will continue to place health care at the top of the national policy agenda, providing important opportunities for social workers to exercise their vital professional, ad- vocacy, and leadership roles.

JWBT514_ch05.indd 119JWBT514_ch05.indd 119 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

120 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

SUGGESTED LEARNING EXERCISES

Learning Exercise 5.1

Identify the eligibility criteria for Medicaid for a low-income person with a disability in your state. Is the person eligible for other health insurance coverage besides Medicare? Under what circumstances would the individual be dually eligible for Medicare and Medicaid? What other programs would you explore? What prescription drug coverage is available to this individual? What safety net providers are available to provide health-care coverage? What gaps in service do you anticipate?

Learning Exercise 5.2

Propose a new professional role for social workers motivated by health reform. Provide a one-paragraph job description of this role. How would you advocate the benefi ts and rationale of this role to senior policy leader- ship at the CMS? How would you propose this role be fi nanced and reimbursed? How would this role relate to that of other professionals— physicians, health-care administrators, nurses, and so on—in the health system?

Learning Exercise 5.3

Identify the single most compelling policy problem for social workers to address in health care. Is it disparities in access or outcomes? Is it the cultural competence of providers? Is it the erosion of Medicaid coverage in states? What strategies and approaches would you propose for social work to infl uence the path of health policy formulation?

SUGGESTED RESOURCES

More detailed presentations of program data, policy analysis, and eligibility rules can be found in government documents, foundation reports, Web resources, and journals. Social workers with ongoing interests in health policy

should familiarize themselves with the overall government program structure and resource commitment to health services. The most com- prehensive guide to government entitlement programs (especially Medicare and Medicaid), the Green Book, is published periodically by the U.S. House Ways and Means Commit- tee and is also available on the Web at www .gpoaccess.gov/wmprints/green/index.html

Social workers interested in gaining a deeper understanding of Medicare and Medicaid should be familiar with the federal program’s documents, especially “Medicare and You,” available through the CMS at www.cms.gov

Ongoing policy issues in Medicare and Medicaid as well as specifi c topics in mi- nority health, HIV/AIDS, and access for the uninsured are thoroughly covered by the Kai- ser Family Foundation and its extensive Web resources. More information can be found at www.kff.org

Key journals with which social workers interested in health policy should be familiar include Health Affairs, Health Care Financing Review, and Social Work and Health.

A comprehensive glossary of health-care terminology has been published as the 2004 edition of AcademyHealth Glossary of Terms Commonly Used in Health Care, and can be found at www.academyhealth.org

APPENDIX 5.1: TIMELINE OF KEY FEDERAL HEALTH POLICY ACTIONS SINCE THE NEW DEAL

2000s 2010 Patient Protection and Affordable

Care Act, the Health Care & Education Reconciliation Act.

2003 Medicare Prescription Drug Improve- ment and Modernization Act of 2003.

2001 Federal health centers program ex- panded under presidential initiative.

2000 Breast and Cervical Cancer Preven- tion and Treatment Act of 2000 permit- ted states to provide Medicaid to certain women diagnosed with breast or cervical

JWBT514_ch05.indd 120JWBT514_ch05.indd 120 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Health Policy and Social Work 121

cancer, regardless of their income or re- sources.

1990s 1999 Ticket to Work and Work Incentives

Improvement Act of 1999 expanded the availability of Medicare and Medicaid for certain disabled benefi ciaries who return to work.

1997 Balanced Budget Act of 1997 estab- lished the State Children’s Health Insur- ance Program (SCHIP) and created the Medicare. Choice program.

1996 Health Insurance Portability and Accountability Act (HIPAA); Personal Responsibility and Work Opportunity Reconciliation Act of 1996; Mental Health Parity Act of 1996.

1994 Clinton health plan defeated. 1993 Health Security Act (Clinton Health

Reform Plan) introduced in Congress; Family and Medical Leave Act of 1993.

1990 Americans with Disabilities Act (ADA); Ryan White Comprehensive AIDS Resources Emergency Act.

1980s 1989 Omnibus Budget Reconciliation

Act of 1989; Medicare Catastrophic Coverage Act repealed.

1988 Medicare Catastrophic Coverage Act of 1988 provided coverage for cata- strophic illness and prescription drugs.

1987 Omnibus Budget Reconciliation Act of 1987 expanded Medicaid eligibil- ity for pregnant women and children and established the resource-based relative value scale for reimbursing physicians under Medicare; Stewart B. McKinney Homeless Assistance Act.

1986 Omnibus Budget Reconciliation Act of 1986; Omnibus Health Act.

1985 Emergency Defi cit Reduction and Balanced Budget Act; Consolidated Omnibus Budget Reconciliation Act.

1984 Defi cit Reduction Act of 1984 (DEFRA) required states to extend Medicaid coverage to children born after September 30, 1983, up to age 5

in families meeting Aid to Families with Dependent Children (AFDC) standards; Child Abuse Amendments established treatment and reporting guidelines for severely disabled newborns.

1983 Social Security Amendments estab- lished the Medicare prospective payment system (PPS), including the Diagnosis Related Groups (DRGs) scale for reim- bursing inpatient services for Medicare and Medicaid patients.

1982 Tax Equity and Fiscal Responsibil- ity Act of 1982 (TEFRA).

1981 Omnibus Budget Reconciliation Act of 1981.

1980 Omnibus Budget Reconciliation Act of 1980.

1970s 1979 Surgeon General report, Healthy

People, laid foundation for national pre- vention agenda.

1977 Departments of Labor and Health, Education, and Welfare Appropria- tions Act for FY 1977 created the Hyde Amendment, which prohibited federal Medicaid payments for abortions, with certain exceptions.

1973 Health Maintenance Organization (HMO) Act.

1972 Social Security Amendments of 1972 established the Supplemental Se- curity Income (SSI) program, created Professional Standards Review Organi- zations (PSROs), extended Medicaid eli- gibility to certain people with disabilities receiving SSI, and extended Medicare eligibility to people with end-stage renal disease (ESRD); National School Lunch and Child Nutrition Amendments estab- lished the Women, Infants, and Children (WIC) program.

1960s 1967 Social Security Amendments of 1967

enacted the Early and Periodic Screen- ing Diagnosis and Treatment (EPSDT) benefi t under Medicaid; Mental Health Amendments of 1967.

JWBT514_ch05.indd 121JWBT514_ch05.indd 121 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

122 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

1965 Social Security Amendments of 1965 created Medicare and Medicaid.

1960 Social Security Amendments of 1960.

1950s 1950 National Science Foundation Act of

1950.

1940s 1946 Hospital Survey and Construction

Act (Hill-Burton Act) provided federal grants and loans to build hospitals; Na- tional Mental Health Act.

1944 Public Health Service Act of 1944. 1943 Emergency Maternal and Infant

Care Program provided maternity care and infants for wives and children of service members.

1930s 1935 Social Security Act of 1935 passed

including Title V, Maternal and Child Health.

Sources: Adapted from Healthcare Reform in America: A Reference Handbook, by J. J. Kronenfeld and M. R. Kronenfeld, 2004, Santa Barbara, CA: ABC-CLIO; Appendix 1: Medicaid Legislative History—1965–2000, by Henry J. Kaiser Family Foundation, n.d., retrieved from http://www.kff.org/medicaid/ loader.cfm?url=/commonspot/security/getfile .cfm&PageID=14255; Breast and Cervical Cancer Prevention and Treatment, by Centers for Medicare and Medicaid Services, 2004a, retrieved from http://www.cms.hhs.gov/bccpt/ default.asp; CMS History Page Quiz, by Centers for Medicare and Medicaid Services, 2004b, retrieved from http://www.cms.hhs.gov/about/ history/quiz/answers.asp; The Mental Health Parity Act, by Centers for Medicare and Med- icaid Services, 2004f, from http://www.cms.hhs .gov/hipaa/hipaa1/content/mhpa.asp/.

REFERENCES

American Historical Association. (n.d.). Has a national health program been put before Congress? Retrieved from http://www.historians.org/Projects/GIroundtable/ Health/Health4htm

Andersen, R. M., & Davidson, P. L. (2001). Improving access to care in America: Individual and contextual indicators. In R. M. Andersen, T. H. Rice, & F. Kominski (Eds.), Changing the U.S. health care system: Key issues in health services policy and management (pp. 3–30). San Francisco, CA: Jossey-Bass.

Blendon, R. J., Brodie, M., & Benson, J. (1995). What happened to Americans’ support for the Clinton health plan? Health Affairs, 14(2), 7–23.

Bodenheimer, T., & Grumbach, K. (2002). Understanding health policy: A clinical approach (3rd ed.). New York, NY: Lange Medical Books/McGraw-Hill.

Brown, L. D. (1996). The politics of Medicare and health reform, then and now. Health Care Financing Review, 18(2), 163–168.

Capps, R., Ku, L., Fix, M. E., Furgiuele, C., Passel, J. S., Ranchand, R., . . . Perez-Lopez, D. (2002). How are immigrants faring after welfare reform? Preliminary evidence from Los Angeles and New York City fi nal report. Washington, DC: Urban Institute.

Centers for Medicare and Medicaid Services. (2004b). CMS history page quiz. Retrieved from http://www .cms.hhs.gov/about/history/quiz/answers.asp

Centers for Medicare and Medicaid Services. (2004e). Medicare: A brief summary. Retrieved from http:// www.cms.hhs.gov/publication/overview-medicare- medicaid/default3.asp

Centers for Medicare and Medicaid Services. (2004g). State children’s health insurance program: Plan activity as of October 5, 2004. Retrieved from http://63.241.27.79/schip/chip-map.pdf

Centers for Medicare and Medicaid Services. (2004h). Trends by state by quarter report. Retrieved from http://www.cms.hhs.gov/healthplans/statistics/trends/ default.asp

Centers for Medicare and Medicaid Services. (2010). Brief summaries of Medicare and Medicaid. Retrieved from https://www.cms.gov/MedicareProgramRatesStats/ downloads/MedicareMedicaidSummaries2010.pdf

Chassin, M. R., Leob, J. M., Schmaltz, S. P., & Wachter, R. M. (2010). Accountability measures—Using measurement to promote quality  improvement. New England Journal of Medicine, 363(7), 683–688.

Congressional Budget Offi ce (CBO). (2010). Payments of penalties for being uninsured under the patient protection and affordable care Act. Retrieved from: http://www.cbo.gov/ftpdocs/113xx/doc11379 /Individual_Mandate_Penalties-04-30.pdf

Darnell, J.S. (2007). Patient navigation: a call to action. Social Work, 52(1), 81–84.

Davidoff, A. J., Garrett, B., & Yemane, A. (2001). Medicaid-eligible adults who are not enrolled: Who are they and do they get the care they need? Retrieved from http://www.urban.org/publications/310378.html

Davis, K. (2001). Universal coverage in the United States: Lessons from experience of the twentieth century. New York, NY: Commonwealth Fund.

JWBT514_ch05.indd 122JWBT514_ch05.indd 122 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Health Policy and Social Work 123

DeNavas-Walt, C., Proctor, B. D., & Mills, R. J. (2004). Income, poverty, and health insurance coverage in the United States, 2003. Washington, DC: U.S. Census Bureau.

Dubay, L., Hill, I., & Kenney, G. (2002). Five things everyone should know about SCHIP. Washington, DC: Urban Institute.

Families USA Foundation. (1998). Shortchanged: Billions withheld from Medicare benefi ciaries. Washington, DC: Families USA Foundation.

Fix, M. E., & Zimmerman, W. (1998). Refusing a helping hand. Washington, DC: Urban Institute.

Fuchs, B. C., & Merlis, M. (1993). Health care reform: President Clinton’s Health Security Act. Washington, DC: Congressional Research Service, Library of Congress.

General Accountability Offi ce. (2005). Medicaid: States’ efforts to maximize federal reimbursements highlight need for improved federal oversight. Retrieved from http://www.gao.gov/products/GAO-05-836T

Goldberg, D. G., & Kuzel, A. J. (2009). Elements of the patient-centered medical home in family practices in Virginia. Annals of Family Medicine, 7, 301–308.

Hamburg, R. S., & Ballin, S. D. (1995). Politics of the demise of healthcare reform. Circulation, 91(1), 8–9.

Heclo, H. (1995). The Clinton health plan: Historical perspective. Health Affairs, 14(1), 86–98.

Henry J. Kaiser Family Foundation. (n.d.). Appendix 1: Medicaid legislative history—1965–2000. Retrieved from www.kff.org/medicaid/loader.cfm?url=/commonspot /security/getfi le.cfm&PageID=14255

Holahan, J., Cook, A., & Dubay, L. (2007). Characteristics of the uninsured: Who is eligible for public coverage and who needs help affording coverage? Washington DC: The Kaiser Commission on Medicaid and the Uninsured.

Holahan, J., Headen, I., & Kaiser Commission on Medicaid and the Uninsured. (2010). Medicaid coverage and spending in health reform: National and state‐by‐state results for adults at or below 133% FPL. Retrieved from http://www.kff.org/healthreform /upload/Medicaid-Coverage-and-Spending-in-Health -Reform-National-and-State-By-State-Results-for -Adults-at-or-Below-133-FPL.pdf

Jimenez, M.A. (1997, March). Concepts of health and national health care policy: A view from American history. Social Service Review, 34–50.

Johnson, H. B., & Broder, D. S. (1996). The system: The American way of politics at the breaking point (1st ed.). Boston, MA: Little, Brown.

Judis, J.B. (1995). Abandoned surgery: Business and the failure of health care reform. American Prospect, 21, 65–74.

Kaiser Commission on Medicaid and the Uninsured. (2003). Immigrants’ health care coverage and access. Washington, DC: Author.

Kaiser Commission on Medicaid and the Uninsured. (2004). The Medicaid program at a glance. Washington, DC: Author.

Kaiser Commission on Medicaid and the Uninsured. (August 2010). State Medicaid Agencies prepare for health care reform while continuing to face challenges from the recession. Washington, DC: Author.

Kaiser Family Foundation. (2010). Medicare Chartbook: 2010. Retrieved from http://www.kff.org/medicare /8103.cfm

Kasper, J., Elias, R., & Lyons, B. (2004). Dual eligibles: Medicaid’s role in fi lling Medicare’s gaps. Washington, DC: Kaiser Commission on Medicaid and the Uninsured.

Kronenfeld, J. J., & NetLibrary Inc. (2002). Health care policy issues and trends. Retrieved from http://www .netLibrary.com/urlapi.asp?action=summary&v=1&bo okid=85899

Lawlor, E. F. (2003). Redesigning the Medicare contract: Politics, markets, and agency. Chicago, IL: University of Chicago Press.

Lawlor, E. F., & Raube, K. (1995). Social interventions and outcomes in medical effectiveness research. Social Service Review, 69(3), 383–404.

Long, S. K., Phadera, L., & Lynch, V. (2010). Massachusetts health reform in 2008: Who are the remaining uninsured adults? Retrieved from http://www.rwjf.org/fi les /research/67248.MassReform2008UninsuredBrief.pdf

Maloy, K. A., Darnell, J., Kenney, K. A., & Cyprien, S. (2000). Effects of the 1996 welfare and immigration reform laws on the ability and willingness of immigrants to access Medicaid and health care services (Vol. 1). Washington, DC: Center for Health Services Research and Policy, The George Washington University School of Public Health and Health Services.

McAllister, J. W., Presler, E., & Cooley W. C. (2007). Practice-based care coordination: A medical home essential. Pediatrics, 120(3), 723–33.

Mueller, K. J. (1993). Health care policy in the United States. Lincoln: University of Nebraska Press.

Newhouse, J. P., & the Insurance Experiment Group. (1993). Free for all? Lessons from the Rand Health Insurance experiments. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.

Oberlander, J. (2003). The politics of health reform: Why do bad things happen to good plans? Health Affairs, 22(5), W391–W404.

Ormond, B. A., Wallin, S., & Goldenson, S. M. (2000). Supporting the rural health care safety net. Washington, DC: Urban Institute.

Orszag, P. R., & Emanuel, E. J. (2010). Health care reform and cost control. New England Journal of Medicine, 363, 601–603.

Ozminkowski, R. J., Aizer, A., & Smith, G. (1997). The value and use of the qualifi ed Medicare benefi ciary program: Early evidence from Tennessee. Health & Social Work, 22(1), 12–19.

Plissner, M. (2001). A health-care bill fantasy. Retrieved from http://www.slate.com/id/1007796

JWBT514_ch05.indd 123JWBT514_ch05.indd 123 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

124 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

Rosenbaum, S., Johnson, K., Sonosky, C., Markus, A., & DeGraw, C. (1998). The children’s hour: The State Children’s Health Insurance Program. Health Affairs, 17(1), 75–89.

Rosenthal, M. B., Beckman, H. B., Forrest, D. D., Huang, E. S., Landon, B. E., & Lewis, S. (2010). Will the patient- centered medical home improve effi ciency and reduce costs of care? A measurement and research agenda. Medical Care Research & Review, 67(4), 476–484.

Skocpol, T. (1995). The rise and resounding demise of the Clinton plan. Health Affairs, 14(1), 66–85.

Smedley, B. D., Stith, A. Y., Nelson, A. R., & U.S. Institute of Medicine, Committee on Understanding and

Eliminating Racial and Ethnic Disparities in Health Care. (2002). Unequal treatment: Confronting racial and ethnic disparities in health care. Washington, DC: National Academy Press.

Smith, V., Roberts, D., Marks, C., & Rousseau, D. (2010). CHIP enrollment: June 2008 data snapshot. Washington, DC: Kaiser Commission on Medicaid and the Uninsured.

Starr, P. (1982). The social transformation of American medicine. New York, NY: Basic Books.

Starr, P. (1995). What went wrong with health reform. American Prospect, 20, 20–31.

JWBT514_ch05.indd 124JWBT514_ch05.indd 124 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

125

6

Theories of Health Behavior

SARAH GEHLERT AND SARAH E. BOLLINGER

Theories of health behavior have the potential to order the panoply of constructs with which health social workers are faced and provide a conceptual framework that assists in un- derstanding why people behave as they do in terms of their health. These theories provide direction for the helping process and structure for research. They allow us to unite practice and research by providing a shared language for discussing clinical realities.

A review of the 15 health social work model syllabi selected in 1999 by jury in conjunction with the Council on Social Work Education (Copeland, Jackson, Jarman-Rohde, Rosen, & Stone, 1999) revealed a paucity of items related directly to health behavior theory. This is indeed the case, although leading social work textbooks for years have emphasized the importance of theory in social work practice and research. Hep- worth, Rooney, Rooney, Strom-Gottfried, and Larsen (2010), for example, believe that social work theory is essential both in understanding clients’ situations and in providing appropriate interventions. The authors write, “[T]hroughout our professional history, social workers have drawn selectively on theories to help understand circumstances and guide intervention” (p. 18). It is clear that theory is integral to myriad aspects of the social work profession, which only serves to underscore the unsettling lack of health behavior theory available through social work curriculum.

We could say that social workers in health care make ample use of theory, if our defi nition of practice theory were limited exclusively to orienting theories, such as cognitive, behavioral, group, or family systems. Social work interven- tions are based on orienting theories, most of which come from the fi eld of psychology.

Sheafor and Horejsi (2006) say that “most prac- tice theories are rooted in one or more orienting theories” and give the example of “psychosocial therapy, which is based primarily on psycho- dynamic theory and ego psychology” (p. 51). Social workers in health care have used orient- ing theories amply and creatively, such as in the adaptation of cognitive and behavioral theories to produce stress inoculation (Blythe & Erdahl, 1986), a technique for preparing patients for diffi cult medical procedures.

This chapter argues, however, for a different category of theories that are equally important to practice: theories of health behavior. Al- though orienting theories and theories of health behavior are related, they differ in two ways.

1. Orienting theories can be seen as narrower than theories of health behavior because they focus on the origin and treatment of human problems rather than the full constellation of human behavior. Theories of health behavior are germane to all behaviors, not just those that are problematic. They might be used to consider why people protect their health through exercise and regular physician visits, for example.

2. Theories of health behavior, while con- sidering all types of behavior, restrict themselves to the arena of health. Ori- enting theories, however, are concerned with problematic behavior in many areas, including health, education, employment, and marriage.

This chapter contends that adding theories of health behavior to our defi nition of practice theory provides valuable tools for social work

JWBT514_ch06.indd 125JWBT514_ch06.indd 125 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

126 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

practice and research in health care. After a brief discussion of the uses of theory in so- cial work, a select group of theories of health behavior are introduced and reviewed. Each is discussed in terms of its past uses in health practice and research, its strengths and limita- tions, and empirical evidence of its ability to explain health behavior.

Chapter Objectives • Defi ne theory in general and theories of

health behavior in particular. • Distinguish theories of health behavior

from orienting theories. • Discuss ways in which theories of health

behavior could be used to advance social work practice in health care.

• Discuss ways in which theories of health behavior could be used to advance social work research in health care.

• Describe the Health Belief Model, its limi- tations, and the empirical evidence for its use.

• Describe the Theory of Reasoned Action, its limitations, and the empirical evidence for its use.

• Describe how the Theory of Planned Action extends the Theory of Reasoned Action and the empirical evidence for its use.

• Describe the Social Action Theory, its limi- tations, and the empirical evidence for its use.

• Describe the Behavioral Model of Health Services Use, its limitations, and the em- pirical evidence for its use.

• Distinguish among the fi ve theories in terms of their limitations and empirical evidence available for their use.

• Describe the Transtheoretical Model and how it might contribute to social work prac- tice and research.

USE OF THEORY IN SOCIAL WORK PRACTICE AND RESEARCH

Kerlinger (1986) defi nes the word theory as “a set of interrelated constructs, defi nitions, and propositions that present a systematic view

of phenomena by specifying relations among variables, with the purpose of explaining and predicting the phenomena” (p. 9). He defi nes the word constructs as concepts that have been “deliberately and consciously invented for a special scientifi c purpose” (p. 27). Constructs such as well-being, self-esteem, and aggres- sion are widely used in social work. By virtue of their ability to propose relationships among constructs, theories provide order in what oth- erwise might be an overwhelming confusion of abstract ideas. This order is especially im- portant in social work, in which abstract, less perceptible constructs, such as aggression and self-esteem, are considered instead of the dis- crete, directly measurable subjects of inquiry of the natural sciences (e.g., molecular weight, temperature). Theory helps to order the array of constructs with which social workers are faced, providing a conceptual framework that assists in understanding client problems and, in doing so, provides directions for proceeding with the helping process.

Theory not only provides order for what is going on with any one client situation or with clients of the same social worker but also al- lows us to compare across practice situations and settings. In this way, we gain a shared un- derstanding of the dynamics of certain constel- lations of behavior within the fi eld. In addition, theory allows us to unite the arenas of research and practice by providing a shared language for discussing clinical realities.

Understanding how constructs relate to one another in the present allows us to predict how they are likely to operate in the future and, thus, to plan interventions. Glanz, Rimer, and Viswanath (2008) write, “A health educator without theory is like a mechanic or a tech- nician, whereas the professional who under- stands theory and research comprehends the ‘why’ and can design and craft well-tailored interventions” (pp. 25–26). The knowledge that a certain action, covert or overt, likely will lead to another action makes it possible to intervene to promote behaviors that will have desired outcomes and decrease the likeli- hood of undesired outcomes. If we know, for instance, that people who understand their risk for acquiring a disease will be more likely to

JWBT514_ch06.indd 126JWBT514_ch06.indd 126 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Theories of Health Behavior 127

engage in preventive behaviors, interventions can be developed to focus on conveying risk.

Theories and skills are natural partners in social work practice. As the time allotted to as- sess and treat client problems decreases, tools that facilitate assessment and the development of effective treatment approaches increase in value. Theory represents the accumulation of knowledge about human behavior that is necessary to inform our use of skills. Rely- ing on theories to help construct interventions increases the likelihood that they will be suc- cessful. If successful interventions are imple- mented as soon as possible after problems are noted, the hopelessness that results from mul- tiple treatment failures can be avoided.

An example of how theory provides guid- ance for practice comes from an empirical study of adults with epilepsy. Adults with epilepsy experience high rates of psychoso- cial problems, such as a suicide rate 5 times higher than that of the population as a whole for all types of seizures combined and 25 times higher for seizures that originate in the tempo- ral limbic system of the brain (Hauser & Hes- dorffer, 1990; Robertson, 1997). In attempting to understand the etiology of these psychoso- cial problems so that effective interventions could be designed and implemented, Gehlert (1994, 1996) hypothesized that some people with epilepsy generalized their lack of physical control, as represented by epileptic seizures, to the social realm, causing them to have very low expectations that any of their behavioral efforts would result in foreseeable outcomes. The basis for this hypothesis was that repeated disruptions in the action-to-outcome sequence, such as when a young girl wants to succeed in school yet cannot because her parents are unable to provide her with clothing and books, led to a learned helpless state accompanied by high rates of depression and other psycho- social problems. Attribution theory (Abramson, Seligman, & Teasdale, 1978; Kelley, 1967; Weiner, 1985), which predicts depression for people who attribute negative events in their lives, such as not being able to get or keep a job, to their own doing, and positive events, such as being given a compliment, to outside infl uences (e.g., other people, fate, luck), was

helpful in making sense of how constructs such as seizure control and psychosocial prob- lems fi t together.

Although not a theory of health behavior per se attribution theory (Abramson et al., 1978; Heider, 1958; Kelley, 1967) has been used widely to explain behavior. The theory holds that people, when faced with a world over which they have little control, attempt to im- pose control by offering explanations or causes for what happens to them. Illness is an example of a situation over which people have little con- trol, and therefore it elicits causal explanations.

Abramson and colleagues (1978) speak of three dimensions of causal attributions: (1) internality versus externality, or whether the cause is due to the person or to other persons or circumstances; (2) globality versus specifi city, or whether the same explanations are used for a variety of factors or are specifi c to one or a few factors; and (3) stability versus instability, which has to do with whether a factor is long lasting or transient. Pessimistic attributional style is said to occur when people make stable, global, internal attributions for bad events.

Attributions, the dimensions of which are measured using either the Attributional Style Questionnaire (Peterson et al., 1982) or the Content Analysis of Verbatim Explanations technique (Peterson, Bettes, & Seligman, 1985), are useful in explaining health behav- ior. Peterson, Seligman, and Vaillant (1988) divided 99 graduates of the 1942 to 1944 classes of Harvard University into those with optimistic and pessimistic attributional styles and followed their physical health at 5-year intervals for 30 years. They found pessimistic attributional style to predict poor health at ages 45 to 60 years, even when controlling for men- tal and physical health at age 25 years. The authors proposed that people with pessimis- tic attributional styles might tend to become passive in the face of illness, be less able to solve problems, and have fewer supportive so- cial networks to buffer against stress. Negative attributional style has been associated with eating disorders in women (Morrison, Waller, & Lawson, 2006) and poorer outcomes among people with multiple sclerosis (Kneebone & Dunmore, 2004).

JWBT514_ch06.indd 127JWBT514_ch06.indd 127 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

128 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

In the example of epilepsy, understanding how a key cognitive component of learned helplessness, termed negative attributional style, developed in people with epilepsy helped to determine both a point and a target of intervention. For example, people with epi- lepsy are faced with multiple messages from others that they are not as effi cacious as other people. Even the most benign actions of oth- ers, such as assistance during a seizure, convey subtle messages of ineffectiveness and lack of control that, when internalized over the years by people with epilepsy, lead to negative at- tributional style. A small-group intervention in which individuals with epilepsy are helped to identify when negative thoughts are likely to occur, stop the thoughts, and substitute more realistic appraisals has proved effective in de- creasing negative attributional style and de- pression (Gehlert, 1995).

THEORETICAL APPROACHES BASED ON RATIONAL CHOICE

The fi rst theories of health behavior to be con- sidered hold that human behavior stems from rational, logical thought processes. People make health choices largely based on consideration of the costs and benefi ts of various actions. The two major versions are the Health Belief Model and the Theory of Reasoned Action. The The- ory of Planned Behavior (Ajzen, 1991; Ajzen & Madden, 1986) is an extension of the Theory of Reasoned Action and not a theory in itself.

Health Belief Model

The Health Belief Model (Hochbaum, 1958; Rosenstock, 1960, 1966, 1974) was devel- oped originally to explain why people failed to participate in health screening for tubercu- losis despite accommodations such as mobile vans that came into their neighborhoods. The model posits two major components of health behavior: threat and outcome expectations (see Table 6.1). Threat involves perceived sus- ceptibility to an ill-health condition and the

perceived seriousness of that condition. In the case of risk for acquiring AIDS, for example, threat would entail believing that one is suscep- tible to acquiring AIDS and that it is as serious as the medical community portrays it to be.

Outcome expectations are the perceived benefi ts of a specifi ed action, such as using condoms to prevent the transmission of HIV, and the perceived barriers to taking that ac- tion. The benefi t of taking action to reduce the risk of acquiring AIDS might be staying alive, whereas barriers might be the cost of buying condoms or fear that one will be rejected after asking a partner to use them.

The Health Belief Model has been used with a variety of health behaviors and conditions. These include medication adherence among psychiatric outpatients (Kelly, Mamon, & Scott, 1987), obtaining infl uenza vaccination by indi- viduals at high risk for acquiring life-threatening complications of infl uenza (Larson, Bergman, Heidrich, Alvin, & Schneeweiss, 1982), screen- ing behaviors for breast and cervical cancer (In- gledue, Cottrell, & Bernard, 2004; Ko, Sadler, Ryujin, & Dong, 2003; Tanner-Smith & Brown, 2010), and adherence by lower-socioeconomic- status mothers to weight-loss regimens for their obese children (Becker, Maiman, Kirscht, Haef- ner, & Drachman, 1977).

Empirical evidence supports the ability of the Health Belief Model to predict health outcomes. Becker and colleagues (1977) were able to explain 39% of the variance in dietary adherence using the Health Belief Model’s components in multiple regression analysis. This means that when components of the model, such as perceived susceptibility, were measured in a group of people whose dietary adherence was also measured, the model’s

Table 6.1 Major Elements of the Health Belief Model

I. Perceived Threat A. Perceived susceptibility B. Perceived severity

II. Outcome Expectations A. Perceived benefi ts B. Perceived costs

III. Expectations of Self-Effi cacy

JWBT514_ch06.indd 128JWBT514_ch06.indd 128 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Theories of Health Behavior 129

components were relatively important to un- derstanding dietary adherence. Although other factors must be considered to fully explain what determines dietary adherence, the Health Belief Model adds signifi cantly to our ability to understand the phenomenon.

Janz and Becker (1984) published a meta- analysis of 18 prospective and 28 retrospec- tive applications of the Health Belief Model completed during the fi rst 30 years of its use. The ability of each component of the model to predict health outcomes, such as adopting health preventive behaviors, was calculated by dividing the number of positive, statisti- cally signifi cant fi ndings for a component by the number of studies for which signifi cant re- sults were obtained. Perceived threat was the most and perceived costs the least signifi cant predictor of outcomes, with perceived suscep- tibility and perceived benefi ts intermediate between the two. This fi nding suggests that the perceived impediments to engaging in a behavior to improve health (whether they are

real or not), such as fear of losing one’s hair from radiation therapy for cancer, are more signifi cant than other factors (e.g., perceptions of severity, susceptibility, and benefi t) in de- termining whether a person will engage in the behavior. Perceived severity is the least signifi - cant factor in determining behavior.

Theory of Reasoned Action

The Theory of Reasoned Action (Fishbein, 1967; Fishbein & Ajzen, 1975) extends the Health Belief Model to include the infl uences of signifi cant others in the environment on in- dividual health behavior. The theory assumes that behavior is determined immediately by be- havioral intention (see Figure 6.1). Behavioral intention is, in turn, determined by a person’s attitude toward the behavior and the infl u- ence of signifi cant others in the environment, or social norm. Attitude toward the behavior consists of two things: (1) an individual’s belief that if a behavior is performed, a given outcome

Behavioral Beliefs

Evaluation of Attitude Behavioral Toward Outcomes Behavior

Normative Beliefs

Subjective Behavioral Behavior Motivation Norm Intention to Comply

Control Beliefs Perceived

Behavioral Perceived Control Power

Figure 6.1 Combined Theory of Reasoned Action (TRA) and Theory of Planned Behavior (TPB)

Components shared by the TRA and TBP are shown in regular type. Those unique to the TPB are shown in bold type.

JWBT514_ch06.indd 129JWBT514_ch06.indd 129 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

130 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

will accrue, and (2) how important the indi- vidual considers the outcome to be.

Social norm comprises beliefs about what valued others will think about one’s perform- ing a behavior coupled with the individual’s motivation to comply with their opinions. For example, a practitioner might consider a young woman’s perceptions of what her boyfriend, closest friend, mother, and physician would think about her having an abortion and her motivation to comply with their opinions in at- tempting to understand or predict her behavior.

The Theory of Reasoned Action has been applied to many health behaviors and condi- tions, including substance abuse (Beck, 1981), weight loss (Sejwacz, Ajzen, & Fishbein, 1980), and hypertension (Norman, Marconi, Schezel, Schechter, & Stolley, 1985). Because it includes others who hold infl uence over the individual, the Theory of Reasoned Action has been widely used in studies of the health behavior of adolescents, often in the area of contraception decision making (Albarracín, Johnson, Fishbein, & Muellerleile, 2001; Baker, 1988), abortion (Smetana & Adler, 1986), and AIDS risk behavior (Jemmott, Jem- mott, & Fong, 1992). Baker was able to predict 36% of the variance in intention to use con- doms with steady partners and 8% with new or infrequent partners by taking into account atti- tudes toward condom use and subjective norm among patients in a sexually transmitted dis- ease clinic. Jemmott and colleagues designed an intervention for African American adoles- cent males that emphasized knowledge, atti- tudes, and skill building based on the Theory of Reasoned Action to decrease intentions to engage in AIDS risk behavior and the behavior itself. Adolescents who received the interven- tion reported signifi cantly fewer occasions of coitus, fewer partners, more frequent condom use, and a lower incidence of heterosexual anal intercourse than did adolescents in the control condition. A recent meta-analysis conducted by Cooke and French (2008) also found that the Theory of Reasoned Action was able to successfully predict participation in a variety of screening behaviors, such as for breast and colorectal cancer and prenatal screening.

Theory of Planned Behavior

Ajzen and Madden (1986; Ajzen, 1991) ex- tended the Theory of Reasoned Action to in- clude perceived control over behavior. Their idea was that intention alone could not predict behavior if the behavior was one over which the individual did not have complete control (see Figure 6.1). Perceived behavioral control is assumed to refl ect past problems encoun- tered in behavioral performance. That is, if a person has been unsuccessful in engaging in a behavior in the past, such as losing weight, and thus has demonstrated poor control over the behavior, it is less likely that he will be able to maintain the behavior no matter how strong his intentions.

The Theory of Planned Behavior has been widely used to predict behaviors as diverse as the administration of opioids for pain relief by nurses (Edwards et al., 2001), cervical cancer screening (Sheeran & Orbell, 2000), and fi ght- ing by adolescents (Jemmott, Jemmott, Hines, & Fong, 2001). In a review of studies in which behavior was predicted via intentions alone, as in the Theory of Reasoned Action, and in com- bination with perceived behavioral control, as in the Theory of Planned Behavior, behaviors that required more volitional control and with which the individual had negative experiences in the past, such as losing weight and getting high grades, were better predicted by the com- bination of intentions and perceived behavioral control than by intentions alone (Ajzen, 1991). A meta-analysis of 96 studies found that the Theory of Planned Behavior predicted con- dom use less accurately than did the Theory of Reasoned Action (Albarracín et al., 2001). A meta-analysis of 185 studies using the Theory of Planned Behavior prior to the end of 1997 found the theory to account on average for 27% of the variance in health behavior (Ar- mitage & Conner, 2001). In addition, fi ndings of the previously mentioned meta-analysis by Cooke and French (2008), which considered the Theory of Planned Behavior in addition to the Theory of Reasoned Action, were consis- tent with analyses of the Theory of Planned Behavior, except that perceived behavioral

JWBT514_ch06.indd 130JWBT514_ch06.indd 130 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Theories of Health Behavior 131

control did not contribute signifi cantly to be- havior.

THEORETICAL APPROACHES BASED ON SOCIAL NETWORKS

The impetus for approaches based on social networks came from critiques that rational choice approaches did not adequately take into account environmental infl uences on be- havior. The Health Belief Model is entirely in- trapersonal, and even the Theory of Reasoned Action and Theory of Planned Behavior fail to acknowledge infl uences on health behav- ior outside the individual’s immediate envi- ronment. Missing is an appreciation for the infl uences of social networks and structures on health behavior. In a second category of theoretical approaches—approaches based on social networks—the emphasis shifts from in- dividual mental events to social relationships, recognizing the social nature of individuals (Tilly, 1984). This shift in emphasis helps to avoid another criticism of approaches based on rational choice—namely, that they ignore the infl uence of culture on health behavior.

If we conceptualize health decisions made by individuals as the centermost of three con- centric circles, approaches based on social net- works add two adjacent bands or layers (see Figure 6.2). The middle layer comprises social networks and the outer layer the larger social system, which includes governmental and eco- nomic entities and forces. Two approaches that consider the middle and outer layers of infl u- ences on health behavior are Social Action The- ory (Ewalt, 1991) and the Behavioral Model of Health Services Use (Andersen, 1968, 1995).

Social Action Theory

Social Action Theory (Ewalt, 1991) represents a marriage of psychological and public health models and principles. The prevailing model in public health is a three-way interaction among host, agent, and environment. Whereas approaches based on rational choice are con-

cerned exclusively with the host, Social Action Theory encourages a social-contextual analysis of personal change by suggesting pathways by which social and other environmental factors infl uence cognitive processes. The model con- tains three dimensions: (1) self-regulation as a desired action state, (2) a system of interre- lated change mechanisms, and (3) larger envi- ronmental systems that contextually determine how personal change mechanisms operate (see Box 6.1; Ewalt, 1991, p. 932). Individuals’ de- sired states are infl uenced by what is necessary to achieve goals, such as social infl uence, per- sonal safety, material resources, and intimacy (Ewalt, 1991, p. 936).

The health routines and habits that ensue are entwined with those of others, and how these relationships develop has the potential to either promote or inhibit the goals of indi- viduals or the prescriptions of health provid- ers. Recommended change in diet for a child with diabetes, for example, would require a parent to shop for and prepare different foods or serve two separate meals to the fam- ily. Health decisions, therefore, are viewed as being embedded in the social network. Although the Theory of Reasoned Action views social networks as infl uences on health behavior, Social Action Theory considers them to be mechanisms of action. Other peo- ple are viewed as active players rather than as outside infl uences on behavior and are thus inside the lens of inquiry.

Social Action Theory holds that social ties strongly infl uence the success of attempts to alter behavioral routines, such as lowering dietary fat, increasing physical activity, or en- gaging in less risky sexual practices. Failure to adhere to health-enhancing regimens has been linked to confl icts that arise when fam- ily members’ routines are disrupted (Oldridge, 1982). This fi nding provides guidance for the choice, development, and targeting of inter- ventions, often by specifying when and how signifi cant others should be included in the treatment process.

Because Social Action Theory is a fairly new approach, its applications have been fewer. McCree (1997) found high relationship

JWBT514_ch06.indd 131JWBT514_ch06.indd 131 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

132 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

Box 6.1 Social Action Theory

Infl uences on Health Behavior • Personal level (health habits, personal

projects, action states, motivation) • Social level (social and biological

contexts, social interdependence, social interaction processes, action linkages)

• Societal level (organizational structures at the level of government; economic, educational, and health-care systems; laws; policies)

Societal Behavioral Model of Health

Services Use

Social Social Action Theory

Intrapersonal Health Belief Model

Theory of Reasoned Action

Theory of Planned Behavior

Figure 6.2 Concentric Circles Representing the Three Layers of Infl uence on Health Behavior, With Theories and Models Superimposed

The Behavioral Model of Health Services Use is on a stippled background. Social Action Theory is on a dotted background. The Health Belief Model, Theory of Reasoned Action, and Theory of Planned Behavior are on a clear background.

closeness, favorable attitudes toward condom use, high self-esteem, and a secure attachment style to best predict condom use among a sam- ple of African American women. This fi nding suggests interventions focused on increasing self-effi cacy, improving sexual responsibility, and creating more favorable attitudes toward condom use among women and their sexual partners. Social Action Theory also has been applied successfully to the promotion of more healthful behavior and well-being after heart attacks (Ewalt & Fitzgerald, 1995).

JWBT514_ch06.indd 132JWBT514_ch06.indd 132 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Theories of Health Behavior 133

BEHAVIORAL MODEL OF HEALTH SERVICES USE

The Behavioral Model of Health Services Use has gone through three phases since its devel- opment in the 1960s (Andersen, 1968, 1995) and fairly recently underwent another major revision—the Behavioral Model for Vulnera- ble Populations (Gelberg, Andersen, & Leake, 2000). The model differs somewhat from the approaches outlined previously in its empha- sis on health services use and the outcomes of health behavior. Originating in medical sociol- ogy, it considers a bigger picture of the infl u- ences on health behavior, such as aspects of the health-care system.

The original model (Andersen, 1968) di- vided determinants of health service use into three groups of variables: predisposing, enabling, and need. Predisposing variables were ones such as demographic factors and health beliefs and attitudes that infl uenced an individual’s use of health services. Enabling factors included insurance coverage, social

support, and family income. Need variables usually included perceived and objectively de- termined health problems. The model’s second phase in the 1970s (see, e.g., Aday & Ander- sen, 1974) saw predisposing, enabling, and need variables subsumed under the category of population characteristics and the addition of a category of variables, the health-care sys- tem, which included policy and resources and organization of the health-care system. Con- sumer satisfaction was included as an outcome of the use of health services. Phase 3 of the model, in the 1980s and 1990s, brought the addition of the external environment to an ex- panded category of determinants of health be- havior (see Figure 6.3). Use of health services was no longer the end point of the model but was subsumed, with personal health practice, under a new category titled health behavior. The outcomes of health behavior became the model’s new end point, which was made up of perceived and evaluated health status and consumer satisfaction (Andersen, Davidson, & Ganz, 1994).

Health Outcome

Population

Characteristics

Personal Health

Practices

Perceived Health

Status

Health Care

System

Use of Health

Services

Evaluated Health

Status

Primary Determinants of Behavior Health Behavior

Figure 6.3 Components of Phase 3 of the Behavioral Model of Health Services Use.

Source: From “Revisiting the Behavioral Model and Access to Medical Care: Does It Matter?” by R. Andersen, 1995, Journal of Health and Social Behavior, 36, 7. Copyright © 1995 by SAGE. Reprinted with permission.

JWBT514_ch06.indd 133JWBT514_ch06.indd 133 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

134 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

Empirical support for the Behavioral Model of Health Services Use has been strong. Andersen and Aday (1978) used the model to understand levels of health services use of a probability sample of 7,787 noninstitutional- ized people in the United States. These authors were able to explain 22% of the variance in physician visits using (a) age, race, and educa- tion of the head of household as predisposing variables; (b) family income, physician visit insurance, number of physicians per 1,000 in population, and if a particular physician was seen as enabling variables; and (c) perceived health and number of illness symptoms in the prior year as need variables. Level of illness and age were related most strongly to the num- ber of physician visits. The most signifi cant policy-related variable was having a regular source of care.

The Behavioral Model for Vulnerable Pop- ulations (Gelberg et al., 2000) is an especially valuable tool for the fi eld of social work be- cause of its focus on the health services use of disadvantaged people. Adding residential history, mental health, substance abuse, vic- timization history, and competing needs to the original model increased the model’s effi - cacy with vulnerable people in a longitudinal study of homeless individuals (Gelberg et al., 2000).

TRANSTHEORETICAL MODEL: STAGES OF CHANGE

Although not itself a theory of health be- havior, the Transtheoretical Model (TTM) (DiClemente & Prochaska, 1982; Prochaska, 1984) adds a dimension to existing theories, namely the readiness of individuals to make proposed changes in health behavior. Six stages of change are considered: precontem- plation, contemplation, preparation, action, maintenance, and termination (Prochaska, Redding, & Evers, 2008).

The Transtheoretical Model incorporates both intrapersonal and social components of health behaviors and includes vari- ous processes of change in its approach to

understanding and changing health behavior. These processes include consciousness rais- ing, the use of dramatic relief, and utiliza- tion of helping relationships. Change is seen as ongoing and incremental rather than static or occurring at one fi xed point in time. This concept adds to the social worker’s abil- ity to intervene to change behavior by vir- tue of respecting “where the client is” and understanding the client within the context of a larger social environment and an ongo- ing process of change. The Transtheoretical Model has been used with a vast array of health behaviors, including smoking cessa- tion (Dijkstra, Conijm, & DeVries, 2006), stress management (Evers et al., 2006), and condom use (Redding, Morokoff, Rossi, & Meier, 2007).

DISCUSSION

In the early years of the 20th century, Richard Cabot, the Massachusetts physician who helped found the fi rst hospital social work de- partment, urged social workers to build a solid theoretical basis for their profession (Evison, 1995). The profession of social work may have overlooked this advice, focusing on maintain- ing a respected profi le in medicine instead. Building its own theoretical base is an enor- mous undertaking that arguably is too much to ask of health social work. Employing well- founded theoretical approaches from other disciplines, then, represents a reasonable and prudent compromise with which Cabot likely would have been satisfi ed.

The theoretical approaches reviewed in this chapter are all relatively sound empiri- cally. They differ more in scope than in con- tent. Approaches based on rational choice focus on the center of a model consisting of three concentric circles, with social networks and relationships forming the middle, and so- cietal level infl uences forming the outer lay- ers (see Figure 6.2). Although they take into consideration only a part of what we know to infl uence health behavior, they have util- ity for understanding that layer well. Whereas

JWBT514_ch06.indd 134JWBT514_ch06.indd 134 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Theories of Health Behavior 135

some have criticized these approaches for fo- cusing on the intrapersonal, it can be argued that, in certain situations, focusing on smaller constellations of behavior can be useful clini- cally. To gain an understanding of what goes on within an individual in decision making, a smaller framework, such as that provided by the Health Belief Model, could, for example, be very useful.

Since approaches based on rational choice focus largely on the individual, it is important that the social worker does not engage in the fundamental attribution error (i.e., overlooking environmental causes of the behavior of oth- ers) or victim blaming but instead embeds this microcosm of behavior within the larger arena of environmental infl uences on behavior.

A major strength of Social Action Theory is that it considers in detail infl uences on be- havior from an individual’s social network (the middle of our three concentric circles of in- fl uence). This focus provides a useful tool for pinpointing how others in the environment are facilitating or impeding the efforts of patients and providers to implement health behavior change. The Behavioral Model of Health Ser- vices Use extends our analytic lens to include several systems levels (e.g., the health-care system). The principal disadvantage of ap- proaches based on social networks is that their inclusiveness renders them more cumbersome to implement in practice and research.

Behavioral theory is a powerful tool that allows us to apply existing knowledge of in- ternal and external determinants of health be- havior to the clinical situations with which we are faced. The Health Belief Model offers in- sight into individual’s health decision making. The Theory of Reasoned Action extends that insight to include anticipated opinions of val- ued others. The Theory of Planned Behavior increases the power of the Theory of Reasoned Action when the behavior in question requires a great deal of volition, such as in weight loss or smoking cessation. Social Action Theory is particularly useful when the behavior (rather than opinions) of others is a factor in an in- dividual’s behavior change. The Behavioral Model of Health Services Use, by virtue of its

taking into consideration infl uences at various systems levels, provides assistance in health planning. Taken together, this set of theories and models is a resource that can heighten the ability of health social workers to suc- ceed in an increasingly demanding health-care environment.

SUGGESTED LEARNING EXERCISE

The purpose of this assignment is to apply one of the theories of health behavior discussed in this chapter to a specifi c health issue or problem. Students should choose one of the three listed vignettes and use it as a tool for analyzing one theory discussed in the chapter. Students should explain the health behavior from the vignette in detail as it relates to the chosen theory and justify why the theory was chosen over others. What features or elements of the theory add to its ability to explain the health behavior described in the specifi c vi- gnette and would help a health social worker intervene optimally?

In this assignment, students should fi rst in- clude a brief outline of the theory and of the issue or problem as it affects the chosen case. Students should write succinctly, with enough detail to assess their understanding of the the- ory and the issue or problem. Next, students should explain in detail how well the theory fi ts the case chosen. Are all of the salient ele- ments of the case covered by the theory? Does the theory allow for a better understanding of the client’s behavior? If not, why not? This should be the crux of the assignment. Last, students should address the implications for social work practice of using the theory to un- derstand behavior surrounding the health issue or problem.

Learning Exercise 6.1

A 42-year-old White male who moved to Se- attle from Texas one year ago is a patient in the cardiac care unit of your hospital. He was admitted after a second myocardial infarction

JWBT514_ch06.indd 135JWBT514_ch06.indd 135 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

136 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

(MI), which occurred within a month of a pre- vious MI. Notes from his prior admission in- dicate that the patient works as an investigator for the state liquor board. He is married for the second time and lives with his unemployed wife and 15-year-old stepson. They reside with a distant relative and were in the process of moving into a rented house when the second MI occurred. He has one biological child, who lives with his fi rst wife in Texas. His father died suddenly of an MI at 55 years of age, without making it to the hospital. You note that the patient is a stocky man, moderately over- weight, and a heavy smoker.

During his fi rst admission to the hospital, nurses’ notes indicate that the patient pre- sented in an angry manner to the health-care team, threatening to sign out of the hospital and mumbling and interrupting the nurse dur- ing cardiac class. He was fairly impulsive, defensive, and, according to the chart notes, very physically active before the MI. When threatening to sign out of the hospital during the hospitalization, he said he was “too young to have a heart attack . . . . I can’t work, I can’t smoke, I can’t eat what I want. . . . I don’t care if I die. . . . This hospitalization has placed my family in fi nancial danger. We’re supposed to move. . . . I need to help them.” At the time of his second admission to the hospital, you note that the patient seems to have tested the limits at home. He now says that he needs to return to Texas, and he has not followed up with the interdisciplinary team’s recommendation from his fi rst hospitalization.

Learning Exercise 6.2

A middle-age, African American woman with a history of breast cancer in her family fi nds a suspicious lump in her breast. Upon inter- view, she relates to you that her mother died from breast cancer at a young age and that she is familiar with breast cancer, although she says that her family never talked much about the illness when she was growing up. You gather from the interview that she works two jobs, which require her to work many long, late hours. As a single mother with a

busy and changing schedule, she has diffi - culty fi nding time to see a doctor and says that she is “just so frustrated by it all.” You ask her about the reasons for her frustration, and she says that she recently had a lapse in health insurance because she has been unable to afford the monthly premium. The bills and rent payment have been backing up, and she is having diffi culty providing for her family’s basic needs. This additional stressor is more than she can deal with at this time.

Understanding her lapse in health insurance and restricted fi nancial situation, you recom- mend the free health clinic that offers cancer screening to women with low incomes. She says that although she is familiar with this clinic, it is diffi cult to reach from her apart- ment. The woman says that she must take two buses and wait for her bus transfer in an ex- tremely unsafe neighborhood in order to get there. In addition, she tells you that she has gone to this particular clinic a couple of times in the past when she lacked health insurance and was disheartened by the lack of consis- tency in her care. Even when she was able to make the trip across the city to see a doctor, she was never able to see the same physician twice, and explaining her situation multiple times was wearisome. You sense her frustra- tion at the societal barriers that are restricting her ability to follow up with her health con- cerns. She decides to ignore the lump and hope that it will just go away so that she can con- tinue working to pay the bills and care for her young daughter.

Learning Exercise 6.3

An elderly widow struggles with hyperten- sion, diabetes, and arthritis, and lives alone in a second-fl oor apartment. She frequently fi nds herself in need of assistance around the house as her chronic illnesses become pro- gressively worse, and she is having diffi culty knowing how to manage these tasks alone. It is now diffi cult to climb the stairs up to the apartment, and she often feels nervous about falling while getting into the bathtub; how- ever, she tells you that she is unsure of what to

JWBT514_ch06.indd 136JWBT514_ch06.indd 136 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Theories of Health Behavior 137

do about this situation. She is very indecisive about spending money on home health care, and she does not know where to turn to access these resources. The events coordinator at the local senior center informs you that the wom- an’s husband died about a year ago, and she seems to be having trouble making decisions on her own. The woman did everything with her spouse and says that she relied heavily on him to help her know what to do. The woman’s husband paid all of the bills, maintained the fi - nances, and drove her to her routine doctor ap- pointments, but now that he is gone, she rarely keeps these appointments and has trouble fi ll- ing her prescriptions.

The woman tells you that her two adult chil- dren live out of town, and although she speaks to them on the phone almost every week, they seem to be very busy. The woman expresses her desire to talk with them more frequently, but they are full-time professionals with young families of their own and rarely return her mul- tiple calls. From her description, it seems that she calls her children multiple times a day and that they have begun to avoid most of these calls assuming that she is being overly needy. The woman tells you during a home visit that since the death of her husband, she has found a lot of solace in attending church. She speaks to the pastor regularly and appears to look to him for guidance on many issues. She states that he has a lot of wisdom and that she hopes to talk to him more about some of her concerns.

REFERENCES

Abramson, L. Y., Seligman, M. E. P., & Teasdale, J. D. (1978). Learned helplessness in humans: Critique and reformulation. Journal of Abnormal Psychology, 87, 49–74.

Aday, L. A., & Andersen, R. M. (1974). A framework for the study of access to medical care. Health Services Research, 9, 208–220.

Ajzen, I. (1991). The theory of planned behavior. Organizational Behavior and Human Decision Processes, 50, 179–211.

Ajzen, I., & Madden, T. J. (1986). Prediction of goal- oriented behavior: Attitudes, intentions, and perceived behavioral control. Journal of Experimental Social Psychology, 22, 453–474.

Albarracín, D., Johnson, B. T., Fishbein, M., & Muellerleile, P. A. (2001). Theories of reasoned action and planned behavior as models of condom use: A meta-analysis. Psychological Bulletin, 127, 142–161.

Andersen, R. (1968). Behavioral model of families’ use of health services (Research Series No. 25). Chicago, IL: Center for Health Administration Studies, University of Chicago.

Andersen, R. (1995). Revisiting the behavioral model and access to medical care: Does it matter? Journal of Health and Social Behavior, 36, 1–10.

Andersen, R., & Aday, L. A. (1978). Access to medical care in the United States: Realized and potential. Medical Care, 16, 533–546.

Andersen, R. M., Davidson, P., & Ganz, P. (1994). Symbiotic relationships of quality of life, health services research, and other health research. Quality of Life Research, 3, 365–371.

Armitage, C. J., & Conner, M. (2001). Effi cacy of the theory of planned behavior: A meta-analytic review. British Journal of Social Psychology, 40, 471–499.

Baker, S. A. (1988). An application of the Fishbein model for predicting behavioral intentions to use condoms in a sexually transmitted disease clinic population (Unpublished doctoral dissertation). University of Washington.

Beck, K. (1981). Driving under the infl uence of alcohol: Relationships of attitudes and beliefs in a college population. American Journal of Drug and Alcohol Abuse, 8, 377–388.

Becker, M. H., Maiman, L. A., Kirscht, J. P., Haefner, D. P., & Drachman, R. H. (1977). The health belief model and prediction of dietary compliance: A fi eld experiment. Journal of Health and Social Behavior, 18, 348–366.

Blythe, B. J., & Erdahl, J. C. (1986). Using stress inoculation to prepare a patient for open-heart surgery. Health & Social Work, 11, 265–274.

Cooke, R., & French, D. P. (2008). How well do the theory of reasoned action and theory of planned behavior predict intentions and attendance at screening programmes? A meta-analysis. Psychology and Health, 23(7), 745–765.

Copeland, V. C., Jackson, V., Jarman-Rohde, L., Rosen, A. J., & Stone, G. (Eds.). (1999). Approaches to health care in social work: A compendium of model syllabi. Alexandria, VA: Council on Social Work Education.

DiClemente, C. C., & Prochaska, J. O. (1982). Self change and therapy change of smoking behavior. A comparison of processes of change in cessation and maintenance. Addictive Behavior, 7, 133–142.

Dijkstra, A., Conijm, B., & DeVries, H. (2006). A match- mismatch test of a stage model of behavioral change in tobacco smoking. Addiction, 101, 1035–1043.

Edwards, H. E., Nash, R. E., Najman, J. M., Yates, P. M., Fentiman, B. J., Dewar, A., . . . Skerman, H. M. (2001).

JWBT514_ch06.indd 137JWBT514_ch06.indd 137 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

138 Foundations of Social Work in Health Care

Determinants of nurses’ intention to administer opioids for pain relief. Nursing Health Science, 3, 149–159.

Evers K. E., Prochaska, J. O., Johnson, J. L., Mauriello, L. M., Padula, J. A., & Prochaska, J. M. (2006). A randomized clinical trial of a population- and transtheoretical model-based stress-management intervention. Health Psychology, 25(4), 521–529.

Evison, I. S. (1995). Pragmatism and idealism in the professions: The case of Richard Clarke Cabot (Unpublished doctoral dissertation). University of Chicago, IL.

Ewalt, C. K. (1991). Social action theory for a public health psychology. American Psychologist, 46, 931–946.

Ewalt, C. K., & Fitzgerald, S. T. (1995). Changing behaviour and promoting well-being after heart attack: A social action theory approach. Irish Journal of Psychology, 15, 219–241.

Fishbein, M. (1967). Attitude and the prediction of behavior. In M. Fishbein (Ed.), Readings in attitude theory and measurement (pp. 477–492). New York, NY: Wiley.

Fishbein, M., & Ajzen, I. (1975). Belief, attitude, intention, and behavior: An introduction to theory and research. Reading, MA: Addison-Wesley.

Gehlert, S. (1994). Perceptions of control in adults with epilepsy. Epilepsia, 35, 81–88.

Gehlert, S. (1995). Cognitive restructuring for psychosocial problems in epilepsy. Epilepsia, 36(Suppl. 3), S190.

Gehlert, S. (1996). Attributional style and locus of control in adults with epilepsy. Journal of Health Psychology, 1, 469–477.

Gelberg, L., Andersen, R. M., & Leake, B. D. (2000). The behavioral model for vulnerable populations: Application to medical care use and outcomes for homeless people. Health Services Research, 34, 1273– 1302.

Glanz, K., Rimer, B. K., & Viswanath, K. (2008). Theory, research, and practice in health education. In K. Glanz, B. K. Rimer, & K. Viswanath (Eds.), Health behavior and health education: Theory research and practice (pp. 21-40). San Francisco, CA: Jossey-Bass.

Hauser, W. A., & Hesdorffer, D. C. (1990). Epilepsy: Frequency, causes and consequences. New York, NY: Demos.

Heider, F. (1958). The psychology of interpersonal relations. New York, NY: Wiley.

Hepworth, D. H., Rooney, R. H., Rooney, G. D., Strom- Gottfried, K., & Larsen, J. A. (2010). Direct social work practice: Theory and skills (2nd ed.). Pacifi c Grove, CA: Brooks/Cole.

Hochbaum, G. M. (1958). Public participation in medical screening programs: A sociopsychological study (Public Health Service Publication No. 572). Washington, DC: U.S. Department of Health and Human Services, United States Public Health Service.

Ingledue, K., Cottrell, R., & Bernard, A. (2004). College women’s knowledge, perceptions, and preventive

behaviors regarding human papillomavirus infection and cervical cancer. American Journal of Health Studies, 19, 28–34.

Janz, N., & Becker, M. (1984). The health belief model: A decade later. Health Education Quarterly, 11, 1–47.

Jemmott, J. B., III, Jemmott, L. S., & Fong, G. T. (1992). Reductions in HIV risk-associated sexual behaviors among Black male adolescents: Effects of an AIDS prevention intervention. American Journal of Public Health, 82, 372–377.

Jemmott, J. B., III, Jemmott, L. S., Hines, P. M., & Fong, G. T. (2001). The theory of planned behavior as a model of intentions for fi ghting among African American and Latino adolescents. Journal of Maternal and Child Health, 5, 253–263.

Kelley, H. H. (1967). Attribution in social psychology. Nebraska Symposium of Motivation (Vol. 15, pp. 192– 238). Lincoln: University of Nebraska Press.

Kelly, G. R., Mamon, J. A., & Scott, J. E. (1987). Utility of the health belief model in examining medication compliance among psychiatric outpatients. Social Science and Medicine, 11, 1205–1211.

Kerlinger, F. N. (1986). Foundations of behavioral research. New York, NY: Holt, Rinehart and Winston.

Kneebone, I. I., & Dunmore, E. (2004). Attributional style and symptoms of depression in persons with multiple sclerosis. International Journal of Behavior Medicine, 11(2), 110–115.

Ko, C. M., Sadler, G. R., Ryujin, L., & Dong, A. (2003). Fillipina American women’s breast cancer knowledge, attitudes, and screening behaviors. BMC Public Health, 3(27), 1–6.

Larson, E. B., Bergman, J., Heidrich, F., Alvin, B. L., & Schneeweiss, R. (1982). Do postcard reminders improve infl uenza vaccination compliance? Medical Care, 20, 639–648.

McCree, D. H. (1997). The effect of social interdependence on condom use self-effi cacy in a college population of African-American females. Dissertation Abstract International, 58(4-B), 2106 (UMI No. AAM9730752).

Morrison, T., Waller, G., & Lawson, R. (2006). Attributional style in the eating disorders. Journal of Nervous and Mental Disease, 194(4), 303–305.

Norman, S. A., Marconi, K. M., Schezel, G. W., Schechter, C. F., & Stolley, P. D. (1985). Beliefs, social normative infl uences and compliance with antihypertensive medication. American Journal of Preventive Health, 1, 10–17.

Oldridge, N. B. (1982). Compliance and exercise in primary prevention of coronary heart disease: A review. Preventive Medicine, 11, 56–70.

Peterson, C., Bettes, B. A., & Seligman, M. E. P. (1985). Depressive symptoms and unprompted causal attributions: Content analysis. Behaviour Research and Therapy, 23, 379–382.

Peterson, C., Seligman, M. E. P., & Vaillant, G. E. (1988). Pessimistic explanatory style is a risk factor for

JWBT514_ch06.indd 138JWBT514_ch06.indd 138 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Theories of Health Behavior 139

physical illness: A thirty-fi ve-year longitudinal study. Journal of Personality and Social Psychology, 55, 23–27.

Peterson, C., Semmel, A., von Baeyer, C., Abramson, L. Y., Metalsky, G. I., & Selgiman, M. E. P. (1982). The attributional style questionnaire. Cognitive Therapy and Research, 6, 287–300.

Prochaska, J. O. (1984). Systems of psychotherapy: A transtheoretical analysis (2nd ed.). Pacifi c Grove, CA: Brooks-Cole.

Prochaska, J. O., Redding, C. A., & Evers, K. E. (2008). The transtheoretical model and stages of change. In K. Glanz, B. K. Rimer, & K. Viswanath (Eds.), Health behavior and health education: Theory research and practice (pp. 21–40). San Francisco, CA: Jossey-Bass.

Redding, C. A., Morokoff, P. J., Rossi, J. S., & Meier, K. S. (2007). A TTM-tailored condom use intervention for at-risk women and men. In T. Edgar, S. M. Noar, & V. Freimuth (Eds.), Communication Perspectives on HIV/AIDS for the 21st Century (pp. 423–428). Hillsdale, NJ: Erlbaum.

Robertson, M. M. (1997). Suicide, parasuicide, and epilepsy. In J. Engel & T. A. Pedley (Eds.), Epilepsy: A comprehensive textbook (pp. 2141–2151). Philadelphia, PA: Lippincott-Raven.

Rosenstock, I. M. (1960). What research in motivation suggests for public health. American Journal of Public Health, 50, 295–301.

Rosenstock, I. M. (1966). How people use health services. Milbank Memorial Fund Quarterly, 44, 94–124.

Rosenstock, I. M. (1974). Historical origins of the health belief model. Health Education Monographs, 2, 328– 335.

Sejwacz, D., Ajzen, I., & Fishbein, M. (1980). Predicting and understanding weight loss. In I. Ajzen & M. Fishbein (Eds.), Understanding attitudes and predicting behavior (pp. 102–112). Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice-Hall.

Sheafor, B. W., & Horejsi, C. (2006). Techniques and Guidelines for Social Work Practice. Boston, MA: Allyn & Bacon.

Sheeran, P., & Orbell, S. (2000). Using implementation intentions to increase attendance for cervical cancer screening. Health Psychology, 19, 283–289.

Smetana, J., & Adler, M. (1986). Understanding the abortion decision: A test of Fishbein’s value expectancy model. Journal of Population, 2, 338–357.

Tanner-Smith, E. E., & Brown, T. N. (2010). Evaluating the health belief model: A critical review of studies predicting mammographic and pap screening. Social Theory & Health, 8(1), 95–125.

Tilly, C. (1984). Big structures, large processes, huge comparisons. New York, NY: Russell Sage.

Weiner, B. (1985). “Spontaneous” causal thinking. Psychological Bulletin, 97, 74–84.

JWBT514_ch06.indd 139JWBT514_ch06.indd 139 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

JWBT514_ch06.indd 140JWBT514_ch06.indd 140 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

PART II

Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

JWBT514_ch07.indd 141JWBT514_ch07.indd 141 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

JWBT514_ch07.indd 142JWBT514_ch07.indd 142 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

143

7

Community and Health

CHRISTOPHER MASI

Beginning at gestation and continuing through adulthood, day-to-day social and environmen- tal experiences have important positive and negative health effects. The pathways of infl u- ence are several and include the effects of air, water, and food quality as well as exposure to physical, social, and psychological stressors. Access to and quality of medical care also affect the onset and course of disease. It has been estimated that, in fi rst-world countries, shortfalls in medical care account for 10% of early mortality, adverse social circumstances account for 15%, and environmental expo- sure accounts for 5%. Behavioral patterns and genetic predisposition may account for as much as 40% and 30% of early mortality, respectively (McGinnis, Williams-Russo, & Knickman, 2002). Not surprisingly, each of these factors, including genetic predisposition, can be strongly infl uenced by the resources and characteristics of a community. As counselors, coordinators, and advocates, social workers have unique opportunities to maximize the positive and minimize the negative effects of communities on health.

This chapter reviews the ways in which communities affect health and addresses sev- eral questions, including the extent to which neighborhoods differ with respect to ethnic composition and resources that are important to health. The chapter discusses the distinction between contextual and compositional neigh- borhood features and addresses the relationship between community characteristics and each of the major domains of health determinants. In some cases, the connection between the so- cial/physical environment and health is obvi- ous. In other cases, the pathways of infl uence

are less straightforward and are explained in greater detail. This chapter uses a life-course model to demonstrate the potential effects of the social and physical environment on each stage of the life cycle. Finally, implications of the neighborhood–health connection for social work practice are discussed.

Chapter Objectives • Document key differences in community

characteristics. • Illustrate ethnicity- and income-related

health disparities. • Defi ne social determinants of health. • Review the distinction between contextual

and compositional community features. • Demonstrate pathways through which com-

munity characteristics infl uence health. • Describe the effects of homelessness on

health. • Identify community effects on health

throughout the life course. • Describe community-based participatory

research. • Outline the implications of the relationship

between neighborhood quality and health for social work practice in health-care settings.

COMPOSITION OF U.S. NEIGHBORHOODS

Neighborhood characteristics in the United States, whether urban or rural, vary widely in terms of ethnic makeup and income. This is due to many factors, including resources, per- sonal preferences, and discrimination. With some exceptions, individuals tend to live near

JWBT514_ch07.indd 143JWBT514_ch07.indd 143 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

144 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

those in similar economic circumstances, while individuals of a particular ethnicity or cultural background often prefer to live near others of similar ethnicity or culture. Residency pat- terns also are infl uenced by discrimination in realty and lending practices. In the United States, these practices have limited the hous- ing opportunities of many groups and resulted in neighborhood differences that do not refl ect the wishes or best interests of all populations.

Although it is not always apparent, racial segregation still is practiced in the United States. In 2000, the typical White American person lived in a neighborhood that was 80.2% White, 6.7% African American, 7.0% Hispanic, and 3.9% Asian. In contrast, the typical African American person lived in a neighborhood that was 51.4% African Ameri- can, 33% White, 11.4% Hispanic, and 3.3% Asian. The average Hispanic person lived in a neighborhood that was 45.5% Hispanic, 36.5% White, 10.8% African American, and 5.9% Asian. The typical Asian person lived in a neighborhood that was 17.9% Asian, 54% White, 9.2% African American, and 17.4% Hispanic (Mumford Center, 2001).

The fi ve U.S. cities with the highest de- gree of Black–White segregation are Detroit, Milwaukee, New York, Chicago, and Newark (Mumford Center, 2001). Each city has an Index of Dissimilarity of 80 or greater, meaning that 80% of either group would have to move to different census tracts for the two groups to become equally distributed throughout each city. Although segregation has declined over the past 20 years, the slow rate of change sug- gests it will take another 40 years before the level of Black–White segregation in the United States declines to the level of Hispanic–White segregation (Mumford Center, 2001).

Economic and school segregation are also prevalent in the United States. According to the 2000 U.S. census, 3.5 million people live in neighborhoods with poverty concentrations of 40% or greater (Orr et al., 2003). In pub- lic schools attended by the average African American student, 38.3% of the students are poor, whereas in schools attended by the aver- age Hispanic student, 44% of the students are

poor. In contrast, in public schools attended by the average White American student, only 19.6% of the students are poor (Orfi eld, 2001).

Unfortunately, there is evidence that public school segregation is increasing in the United States. In 1980, 62.9% of African American students attended schools with minority en- rollment over 50%. In 1998, this fi gure had risen to 70.2%, while more than one-third of African American students attended schools with minority enrollment of 90% to 100%. School segregation also has increased for Hispanic students. Between 1968 and 1998, the proportion of Hispanic students who at- tended schools with minority enrollments of 90% to 100% increased from 23.1% to 36.6% (Orfi eld, 2001).

Employment discrimination is another source of neighborhood disparity. In the United States, communities with high proportions of minority residents often have higher unem- ployment rates and lower average incomes. Among Chicago’s 77 community areas, un- employment rates in the most economically depressed areas varied from 25.8% to 33.5% in 2000. In these communities, the propor- tion of African American residents varied from 85.5% to 97.8%, and median household income was $17,209. The fi ve Chicago com- munity areas with the lowest unemployment rates (2.8%–3.4%) had populations that were 79.4% to 93.3% White, and the median house- hold income was $56,455 (Kouvelis, Harper, & Thomas, 2003).

Although diversity is part of the fabric of the United States, diversity between neighbor- hoods is often greater than diversity within them. Segregation and unequal distribution of resources, in the form of housing quality, green space for exercise, health-care access, and food quality all have important health ramifi cations.

Does Health Differ by Income and Race or Ethnicity?

Income-related health disparities have been noted for several centuries. Reference to the relationship between health and wealth can

JWBT514_ch07.indd 144JWBT514_ch07.indd 144 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Community and Health 145

be found in ancient Chinese and Greek texts (Krieger, 2001; Porter, 1997). In the early 20th century, Chapin (1924) found that the annual death rate among nontaxpayers was over twice that of taxpayers in Providence, RI. More re- cently, health outcome differences by income have been documented in the United States, the United Kingdom, and throughout the world.

According to a 2007 U.S. survey of 23,393 adults, poor health continues to affect lower- income individuals to a greater extent than those with higher incomes (Pleis & Lucas, 2009). Among those with household incomes below the federal poverty line, 29.5% reported having hypertension and 4.2% reported having had a stroke. In contrast, only 21.9% and 1.9% of those with incomes greater than or equal to 200% of the poverty threshold reported having hypertension or stroke, respectively. The rates of diabetes and kidney disease were 12.2% and 2.6% among the poor and 6.6% and 1.1% among the not poor, respectively. Obesity among those with incomes of less than $35,000 was also more prevalent (28.9%) compared with those who had incomes of $100,000 or more (19.8%) (Pleis & Lucas, 2009).

Differences in health behaviors and ac- cess to care may contribute to differences in income-related disease prevalence. In 2007, 26.8% of those with annual incomes less than $35,000 smoked while 12.4% of those with annual incomes of $100,000 or more did so (Pleis & Lucas, 2009). Of those with incomes of $100,000 or more, 92.2% had a usual place of care while 77.4% of those with incomes less than $35,000 reported a usual place of care (Pleis & Lucas, 2009).

Both disease prevalence and access to care vary by ethnicity. According to the National Health Interview Survey (Pleis & Lucas, 2009), the prevalence of obesity (defi ned as a body mass index greater than or equal to 30) was 35.1% among African Americans, 27.5% among Hispanics, and 25.4% among White Americans. The prevalences of hypertension and stroke were 22.2% and 2.2% among White Americans, 31.7% and 3.7% among African Americans, and 20.6% and 2.5% among His- panic Americans, respectively, while the rates

of diabetes and kidney disease were 6.8% and 1.4% among White Americans, 12.3% and 2.5% among African Americans, and 11.1% and 1.8% among Hispanic Americans, re- spectively. Among White respondents, 84.5% reported a usual place of care. This percent- age was slightly higher for African Americans (85.5%) and lower for Hispanic Americans (74.4%) (Pleis & Lucas, 2009).

Given the strong relationship between ethnicity and illness, it is not surprising that ethnicity is related to both life expectancy and mortality. In 2006, the life expectancy at birth was 73.2 years for African Ameri- can infants and 78.2 years for white infants. Contributing to this difference in life expec- tancy are differences in infant death and death due to chronic disease. For deaths of infants younger than 1 year, the rate per 100,000 was lower among White infants (576.0) compared to African American (1,303.1) and Hispanic infants (590.6) in 2006. For cause-specifi c mortality, the age-adjusted Black:White ratio was 1.3 for diseases of the heart, 1.2 for ma- lignant neoplasms, 1.5 for cerebrovascular disease, 2.1 for diabetes mellitus, and 2.7 for hypertensive disease. The overall age-adjusted death rate (per 100,000) was higher among African Americans (982.0) compared to White Americans (764.4) and Hispanic Americans (564.0) in 2006 (Heron et al., 2009).

When considering the ways in which in- come and race are related to illness and mor- tality, some links are more obvious than others. Health behaviors, including diet and access to care, mediate this relationship to some extent. Less well understood is the mechanism by which psychological distress also may medi- ate income- and ethnicity-related differences in health outcomes. In the 2007 National Health Interview Survey (Pleis & Lucas, 2009), those with household incomes less than $35,000 reported higher rates of psychological distress compared with those with incomes of $100,000 or greater in these areas: feeling sad all or most of the time (5.7% versus 0.7%), feeling hopeless all or most of the time (4.3% versus 0.5%), feeling worthless all or most of the time (3.8% versus 0.4%), or reporting

JWBT514_ch07.indd 145JWBT514_ch07.indd 145 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

146 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

everything is an effort all or most of the time (9.0% versus 1.7%). Ethnic differences also existed in some of these domains. Feeling sad all or most of the time was higher among African American people (3.7%) compared to White people (2.6%). Reporting everything is an effort all or most of the time was also more common among African American respon- dents (6.8%) compared to White respondents (4.4%) (Pleis & Lucas, 2009).

There is some evidence that education may modify the relationship between income/ ethnicity and health. Specifi cally, those with higher education, regardless of income or ethnicity, tend to have lower mortality rates compared with those who have less educa- tion. In 2006, the age-adjusted mortality rate (per 100,000) among those with fewer than 12 years of education was 528.8. Among those with 13 or more years of education, the rate was 200.0 (Heron et al., 2009). The effect of education on health is not completely under- stood, but it appears to operate through such important mediators as health behaviors, ac- cess to care, place of residence, and ability to cope with stressful situations.

Low income and low educational attain- ment are also risk factors for homelessness, which is associated with poor health, includ- ing higher rates of human immunodefi ciency virus (HIV), tuberculosis, hypertension, dia- betes, substance abuse, and trauma. Homeless individuals also are more likely to experi- ence complications from chronic diseases (Sadowski, Kee, VanderWeele, & Buchanan, 2009). These phenomena are due to several factors, including increased exposure to ad- verse environmental conditions, reduced ac- cess to regular medical care, prioritizing food and shelter above medical concerns, and ex- posure to violence (Sadowski et al., 2009). Not surprisingly, minority populations have higher rates of homelessness compared to White Americans, thereby contributing to ra- cial disparities in health. A recent survey of homeless shelters in 16 cities found that 47% of residents were African American, a pro- portion higher than in the general population (United States Conference of Mayors, 2007).

Research clearly demonstrates that health dif- fers by income, race, and ethnicity.

How Are Neighborhood Effects Identifi ed?

Given the myriad factors that affect health, it is not surprising that particular neighborhood features, including health-care resources, the presence of green space for exercise, availabil- ity of healthy foods, quality of housing, norms and values, and crime all have been associated with health outcomes. But how important are these factors when compared to individual characteristics, such as genetic predisposi- tion and health behaviors? That is, what are the relative health effects of contextual (i.e., neighborhood-level) characteristics compared with compositional (i.e., individual-level) characteristics? Contextual features include neighborhood norms and values, number of parks, quality of schools, and amount of crime in a given neighborhood. Compositional fea- tures include individual ethnicity, income, education, and health behaviors. One way to distinguish contextual from compositional ef- fects is by performing multilevel analysis, a statistical approach that categorizes data by level (e.g., individual, classroom, school) and assesses the relative effect of each level on the outcome. If two communities differ in terms of an important health outcome, such as infant mortality, a key question addressed by multi- level analysis would be: Is the difference in in- fant mortality due to contextual factors (such as community health care resources or qual- ity of community drinking water), or does the difference exist because mothers in these two communities are different in important ways (i.e., income, smoking behavior)? When con- textual effects are found, it suggests that there is something about a community or neighbor- hood (e.g., contaminated drinking water) that exerts an effect on the outcome (e.g., cancer incidence) over and above the effects related to individual characteristics.

In the absence of obvious culprits, such as contaminated drinking water, multilevel analysis cannot always separate individual

JWBT514_ch07.indd 146JWBT514_ch07.indd 146 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Community and Health 147

from community-level effects. For example, multilevel studies have demonstrated signifi - cant contextual effects on a variety of health outcomes, but the strength of these effects often is diminished when multiple individual characteristics are considered (Pickett & Pearl, 2001). This fact suggests that either the contex- tual effect is weak or the relationship between the contextual feature and the health outcome is mediated by one or more individual charac- teristics, such as diet or tobacco use. Although not negating neighborhood effects, their me- diation by health behaviors makes contextual effects more diffi cult to identify.

Another way to distinguish contextual from compositional effects is to perform an experi- ment in which individuals living in a commu- nity are randomly assigned to either remain in the community or move to a new community with different characteristics. If both groups are similar with respect to individual char- acteristics at the beginning of the study, then postintervention interviews and analyses per- mit an assessment of the contextual effects on health. Such studies are diffi cult to perform be- cause of fi nancial and ethical constraints, but experiments of this type are occasionally un- dertaken. One example is the Moving to Oppor- tunity (MTO) for Fair Housing Demonstration Program. Conducted by the U.S. Department of Housing and Urban Development, MTO is a randomized social experiment designed to assess the effects of moving out of poor neigh- borhoods. Families with very low incomes with children younger than 18 years living in public housing or private assisted housing in poor neighborhoods of fi ve cities—Baltimore, Boston, Chicago, Los Angeles, and New York City—were eligible. Between 1994 and 1998, eligible families were randomly assigned to one of three groups: the experimental group, the Section 8 group, or the control group. Indi- viduals in the experimental group were offered housing vouchers that could be used only in low-poverty areas. This group also received assistance fi nding and leasing units. In addi- tion, to retain their vouchers, families were re- quired to stay in their new neighborhoods for at least one year. Those in the Section 8 group

were offered housing vouchers with no restric- tions on where the vouchers could be used and no assistance fi nding or leasing units. Con- trol group members were not offered hous- ing vouchers; they continued to live in public housing or receive project-based housing as- sistance (Orr et al., 2003).

In 2002, nearly 8,900 participating adults and children were contacted to assess follow- up status in several domains, including physical and mental health, child educational achieve- ment, youth delinquency and risky behavior, and adult and youth employment and earnings. On average, individuals in the experimental and Section 8 groups reported signifi cant in- creases in their perceptions of safety and sub- stantial decreases in their risk of observing or being a victim of a crime. Compared with the control group, the intervention group also re- ported less diffi culty getting police to respond to their calls and large reductions in the pres- ence of abandoned buildings, public alcohol consumption, litter, trash, and graffi ti.

Adult health differences noted on follow- up included signifi cant reductions in the prev- alence of obesity, psychological distress, and depression among the experimental but not the Section 8 group compared with the control group. Calmness and peacefulness were re- portedly signifi cantly increased in the experi- mental group. Among girls age 12 to 19 years, researchers noted reductions in psychological distress and generalized anxiety disorder in the experimental group compared with the control group. Among girls age 15 to 19 years, those in the experimental group were signifi cantly less likely to use marijuana or smoke ciga- rettes compared with the control group (Orr et al., 2003).

MTO is important in that it assessed the relationship among neighborhood characteris- tics, health, and health behaviors. Because of randomization, those in the intervention group were not different from those in the control group. Therefore, differences noted in health and health behaviors were due to contextual factors, not individual differences. These re- sults provide evidence that neighborhood features, including neighborhood wealth, can

JWBT514_ch07.indd 147JWBT514_ch07.indd 147 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

148 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

affect health independent of individual char- acteristics. In this case, greater availability of police and decreased exposure to crime and delinquency appear to have had a positive im- pact on psychological well-being.

MECHANISMS BY WHICH COMMUNITIES INFLUENCE HEALTH

An individual’s social circumstances and physical environment represent two ways communities can infl uence health. Social cir- cumstances include neighborhood educational level, employment, income disparities, pov- erty, crime, and social cohesion. A community in which social relationships are easy to make and maintain is likely to be a healthier environ- ment than a community in which residents are afraid to venture from their homes because of concerns about crime. A study from the United Kingdom found that individuals who recently had a heart attack and who had a confi dant or intimate partner were about half as likely to die or have a further cardiac event compared with similar patients without a confi dant or partner (Dickens et al., 2004).

Number and type of social relationships also depend on neighborhood norms and ex- pectations. Laumann, Ellingson, Mahay, Paik, and Youm (2004) recently documented this in four Chicago communities: one predominantly African American community on the South Side, one Mexican American community on the West Side, one mixed but predominantly Puerto Rican community on the Northwest Side, and one primarily White community on the North Side with large heterosexual and homosexual populations. Each neighborhood had distinct opportunities, or “markets,” for social relationships, some more supportive of relational or committed encounters and others more amenable to transactional (i.e., relatively uncommitted and often short term) relationships. In this study, market type was infl uenced by the neighborhood’s economy as well as the ethnicity and sexual orientation of its residents. For example, family, friends, and

church played an important role in forming committed relationships in Hispanic commu- nities. In contrast, the transactional market in the North Side community was important for gay men but not for lesbians, who preferred the relational market.

Physical environment refers to sanitation; quality of housing, food, and water; and ex- posure to environmental toxins and pathogens. Public health and safety programs often moni- tor these environmental characteristics. Statis- tics regarding life expectancy and causes of death indicate that environmental problems pose less of a risk in developed countries com- pared with third-world countries. For example, the life expectancy of an infant born in 2006 in the United States is 80.2 years for females and 75.1 years for males, and the leading causes of death are heart disease (26%), cancer (23.1%), and stroke (5.7%) (Heron et al., 2009). The remaining causes, including chronic lung dis- ease, accidents, diabetes, and infections, each account for fewer than 10% of deaths, and only a very small percentage of deaths are di- rectly attributable to environmental conditions.

In contrast, the most common causes of childhood mortality in developing countries are related to communicable diseases. These in- clude pneumonia, diarrheal diseases, malaria, measles, and HIV/AIDS (acquired immune de- fi ciency disease) (World Health Organization [WHO], 2008). In 2009, the estimated life ex- pectancy at birth was 62 years for females and 59 years for males. That year it was estimated that 80% of Haitians lived in poverty and the per capita gross domestic product (GDP) was $1,300. By comparison, the estimated poverty rate in the United States that year was 12% and the per capita GDP was $46,400. In 2000, the freshwater withdrawal rate per capita was 116 cubic meters per year in Haiti compared with 1,600 cubic meters per year in the United States (Central Intelligence Agency, 2010). Lack of potable water and inadequate sewage disposal are risk factors for infections such as hepatitis A, typhoid, and cholera; poor housing conditions and overcrowding are risk factors for airborne diseases, including infl uenza and tuberculosis. In Haiti, there were 299 cases of

JWBT514_ch07.indd 148JWBT514_ch07.indd 148 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Community and Health 149

tuberculosis per 100,000 in 2006 compared with 4 cases per 100,000 in the United States that year (WHO, 2008).

It is important to remember that the rela- tionship between national wealth and public health infrastructure is not always positive or linear. Living conditions and environmen- tal quality also refl ect national priorities and the relative amount of resources dedicated to public health programs. A comparison of the United States and Cuba is illustrative. Despite having a per capita GDP that is less than one- quarter that of the United States ($9,700 ver- sus $46,400 in 2009), Cuban health statistics compare favorably. In Cuba, female life ex- pectancy at birth is 79.85 years, and male life expectancy at birth is 75.19 years. At nine cases of tuberculosis per 100,000 per year, the Cuban tuberculosis rate is much closer to that of the United States than of Haiti. In fact, low-income communities in the United States with high numbers of immigrants have tuber- culosis rates that exceed the Cuban rate. The tuberculosis rate among foreign-born U.S. res- idents was 18.6 per 100,000 in 2009 (Centers for Disease Control and Prevention, 2010). Despite fewer resources per capita, Cuba has developed a public health system that con- trols many of the environmentally associated diseases that plague third-world countries and continue to affl ict low-income communities in the United States.

Although immunization against disease and separating drinking water from waste water continue to be important strategies in fi rst- world countries, these countries have increas- ingly embraced the medical model of health care, which focuses on treatment of disease after it is established. Although this model has led to tremendous advances in surgery and medicine, the recent epidemics of obe- sity, hypertension, cardiovascular disease, and osteoarthritis in wealthy nations suggest that the pendulum may have swung too far away from disease prevention and toward disease intervention (Masi & Gehlert, 2009). Not only does the medical model deemphasize disease prevention, but treatment of disease after it is established is extremely expensive. Cuba often

is cited as an example of the health success that can be attained through public health prac- tices. In 2006, the United States spent over $2 trillion on health care, or roughly $6,714 per person. In comparison, Cuba spent approxi- mately $363 per person on health care and had health outcomes that were similar, if not better, than those in the United States (WHO, 2010).

The public health approach is effective not only because it controls infectious diseases but also because it addresses many of the social determinants of health. Shortfalls in medical care account for approximately 10% of early mortality, and adverse social circumstances and environmental exposures account for 15% and 5% of premature mortality, respectively, in fi rst-world countries (McGinnis et al., 2002). In third-world countries, access to and qual- ity of medical care as well as social circum- stances and environmental exposures likely play much greater roles in early mortality. WHO refers to these factors as social deter- minants of health and defi nes them as access to high-quality health care, education, and housing as well as opportunities for social and economic fl ourishing (Commission on the So- cial Determinants of Health [CSDH], 2008). According to the CSDH, reduced access to these factors is due to a “toxic combination of poor social policies and programmes, un- fair economic arrangements, and bad politics” (p. 1). Social determinants of health thus ex- plain a major part of health inequities between and within countries. In its 2008 report, the CSDH delineates the political steps that are needed to address the social determinants of health and improve health in developing na- tions. Although this report does not mention neighborhood factors specifi cally, it is easy to imagine that new policies regarding health- care access and quality, education, and hous- ing ultimately would be implemented and have effects at the community level.

Despite the nation’s fi rst-world status and emphasis on the medical model, some experts in the United States are beginning to advocate for changes in education, housing, and em- ployment policies as ways to improve national health (Schoeni, House, Kaplan, & Pollack,

JWBT514_ch07.indd 149JWBT514_ch07.indd 149 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

150 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

2008). To an increasing number of policy mak- ers, it is apparent that whether a person exer- cises, eats a balanced diet, smokes, or engages in high-risk sexual practices is often a func- tion of a neighborhood’s social, economic, and physical environment. For example, studies have shown that adults are more likely to exer- cise in their neighborhood if they perceive it to be safe (Wilbur, Chandler, Dancy, & Lee, 2003) or if they have access to parks, trails, and other areas conducive to physical activity (Huston, Evenson, Bors, & Gizlice, 2003). Other stud- ies have found that healthy foods, such as fruits and vegetables, are less available (Mooney, 1990; Morland, Wing, & Diez Roux, 2002) and more expensive (Sooman, MacIntyre, & Anderson, 1993) in poor neighborhoods com- pared with wealthy neighborhoods. Obesity has been linked to increased portion sizes and consumption of high-fat foods, such as those served at fast-food restaurants. One study of restaurant density found that people living in the poorest socioeconomic status category had 2.5 times the exposure to fast-food restaurants compared with those living in the wealthiest category (Reidpath, Burns, Garrard, Mahoney, & Townsend, 2001). In the United States, low-income individuals are exposed to more outdoor tobacco advertising than individuals with higher income (Hackbarth, Silvestri, & Cosper, 1995; Stoddard, Johnson, Sussman, Dent, & Boley-Cruz, 1998).

In addition, patterns of social relationships and sexual practices are tied to the economy and culture of the community. Laumann and colleagues (2004) found that residents of higher-income communities tend to meet their partners at school or work and form longer- term relationships more frequently than residents of lower-income communities. In contrast, residents of low-income communi- ties are more likely to be in polygamous or short-term, transactional relationships. The links among poverty, prostitution, and sexu- ally transmitted disease are well established and add to the disease burden of low-income communities (Edlund & Korn, 2002; Girard, 2000; Satz, 2003).

Access to medical care often refl ects the re- sources and provider practices within particu- lar communities. Newer tests and procedures may be available in urban areas long before they become standard practice in rural com- munities. For example, a recent study of U.S. patients with cardiac arrest found that sur- vival differed markedly by location of arrest. The survival rate was 9% in rural areas, 14% in suburban areas, and 23% in urban sites. These differences were attributed to several factors related to the communities, including medical response time, transport time, resus- citative skill, and type of medical intervention (Vukmir, 2004). In a comparison of diabetes care in urban versus rural clinics in Alabama, Andrus, Kelley, Murphey, and Herndon (2004) found that rural patients were less likely to be at their goals for glycosylated hemoglobin (a measure of blood glucose control), cholesterol level, and blood pressure. Compared with their counterparts at urban clinics, these patients also were less likely to receive screening and preventive services, such as eye examinations, urinary protein screening, aspirin therapy, and vaccinations. In Mexico, the mortality rate from cervical cancer is 3 times higher in rural areas than it is in urban areas. In the rural state of Chiapas, the cervical cancer mortality relative risk was 10.99 times that of the risk in Mexico City. This difference has been at- tributed to lack of formal education and insuf- fi cient access to medical care (Palacio-Mejia, Rangel-Gomez, Hernandez-Avila, & Lazcano- Ponce, 2003).

Type and quality of care also differ mark- edly across urban settings in the United States. Studies of so-called small-area variations in care were pioneered by Dr. Jack Wenn- berg at Dartmouth in the 1980s. Since that time, the Dartmouth group has documented regional variations in Medicare spending, use of cancer screening tests, physician adherence to national health-care guide- lines, and frequency of surgical procedures (McAndrew-Cooper, Wennberg, & Center for the Evaluative Clinical Sciences Staff,1999). For example, regional rates of mammography

JWBT514_ch07.indd 150JWBT514_ch07.indd 150 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Community and Health 151

screening in the United States vary from 12.5% to over 50%, with women in the north- eastern United States, Florida, and Michigan being more likely to receive mammography than women elsewhere. Annual screening for colorectal cancer also varies by geogra- phy, from 2.4% among Medicare enrollees in Terre Haute, IN, to 22.2% in Takoma Park, MD. In general, compliance with national colorectal cancer screening is higher in the East and South compared with the Midwest and West in the United States. Medicare en- rollees in some areas of the country are also more likely to undergo coronary angiography and carotid endarterectomy than in others. A signifi cant proportion of these procedures are performed unnecessarily. The Dartmouth group has shown that use of medical care re- sources often refl ects capacity (i.e., number of physicians, number of hospital beds) more than need for care. The causes of these small- area variations are numerous and likely re- fl ect the effects of prominent physicians who infl uence local practice through lectures and consultation (Wennberg et al., 1997).

There is growing evidence that societal fac- tors also can infl uence the onset and course of several diseases, including type 2 diabetes mellitus, cancer, and cardiovascular disease. For example, obesity leads to insulin resis- tance, which is a signifi cant trigger for type 2 diabetes mellitus. As the prevalence of obesity has increased in the United States, so too has the prevalence of diabetes. During the period from 1988 to 1994, 24.5% of U.S. adults were obese. By the period from 1999 to 2004, this proportion had increased to 32.1% (Lopez- Jimenez et al., 2009). Between 1988 to 2004, the percentage of adults in a national survey who reported being diagnosed with diabetes increased from 8.2% to 9.6% (Lopez-Jimenez et al., 2009). This study also revealed that dia- betes rates vary by state in the United States. In the period from 2003 to 2006, the rate was 11.4% and 27.7% among those age 30 to 59 years and 60 years and older, respectively, in Mississippi and 6.5% and 19.3% among the same age groups, respectively, in Montana

(Danaei, Friedman, Oza, Murray, & Ezzati, 2009). The increasing prevalence of obesity appears to have several causes, including the decrease in cost of food as a percentage of in- come, a shift toward higher-calorie diets, and a decrease in physical activity (Philipson & Posner, 2003). State-to-state variation in cost of food, dietary patterns, and physical activity likely contribute to state differences in obesity and diabetes prevalence.

Not only can community resources affect diet and disease onset among adults, these same factors can affect disease onset in sub- sequent generations. For example, fetuses of diabetic mothers appear to be at higher risk of developing diabetes as adults. In a study of Pima Indians, the children of women with type 2 diabetes were more obese and had a higher rate of diabetes (50%) compared with the chil- dren of women who developed diabetes after the pregnancy (8.6%) (Pettitt, Nelson, Saad, Bennett, & Knowler, 1993). These fi ndings suggest that predisposition to disease can be modifi ed in utero by maternal diet and blood glucose control. This modifi cation has been labeled fuel-mediated teratogenesis (Freinkel, 1980).

The “thrifty gene” hypothesis contends that higher rates of obesity and diabetes among ethnic minorities, including Pima Indians and African American populations in the United States and Aborigines in Australia, arise from a genetic predisposition to energy storage in abdominal fat in these populations. In times of famine or when diets consist of low-fat foods that are not nutrient dense, such a trait con- fers survival advantage. However, when food is plentiful (as in modern United States and Australia) and diets are high in carbohydrates and fats, effi cient energy storage becomes a li- ability and leads to obesity. Although there is evidence for this theory, it is unclear whether a thrifty gene infl uences health outcomes among ethnic minorities to the same extent as other important factors, such as the dietary and psychological changes that can occur with discrimination and economic marginalization (McDermott, 1998).

JWBT514_ch07.indd 151JWBT514_ch07.indd 151 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

152 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

COMMUNITY EFFECTS AND THE LIFE COURSE

The community effects described can impact individual health at any or all stages of the life course, including gestation, childhood, adoles- cence, adulthood, and end of life. Interest in community effects on health has spurred inter- est in health geography and area analysis of epidemiological data. Examples of studies that analyze the relationship between neighbor- hood or community characteristics and health outcomes at each stage of life are presented next.

Gestation

Because maternal health is a strong predictor of fetal and infant health, many investigators have examined the relationship between the social experience of pregnant women and the health of their newborns. In a study of 176 U.S. cities with a population of 50,000 or more, LaVeist (1989) found that mortality among African American infants was positively as- sociated with the city’s index of segregation. The mean morality rate in this study was 19.31 per 1,000 live births among African American infants and 11.09 per 1,000 live births among White infants. In cities with the lowest level of segregation, mortality among African Ameri- can infants was almost 5% below the mean for all African American infants; in cities with the highest index of segregation, the rate was almost 3% above the overall mean. LaVeist suggested that higher African American in- fant mortality rates in highly segregated cities refl ect older housing stock, higher levels of stress and environmental toxins, and reduced levels of city and medical care services in minority communities. According to LaVeist, these effects are ameliorated as the level of ethnic integration increases.

The notion that ambient stressors can ad- versely affect pregnancy outcomes is supported by several studies. In Santiago, Chile, women living in high-violence neighborhoods in 1985 and 1986 were 5 times more likely to expe- rience pregnancy complications (including

gestational hypertension, fetal growth retarda- tion, and miscarriage) compared with women living in less violent neighborhoods (Zapata, Rebolledo, Atalah, Newman, & King, 1992). Collins and colleagues (1998) found the odds ratio of very low birth weight (less than 3.3 pounds) was 1.7 to 3.2 for African American mothers in Chicago who rated their neighbor- hoods unfavorably in terms of police protec- tion, protection of property, personal safety, friendliness, delivery of municipal services, cleanliness, quietness, and schools compared with controls. Using multilevel statistical tech- niques, which account for maternal as well as neighborhood characteristics, another study found mean birth weight decreased among African American infants as the neighborhood level of economic disadvantage increased (Buka, Brennan, Rich-Edwards, Raudenbush, & Earls, 2003). Maternal factors considered in this study were number of times a woman has given birth, prenatal care, education, age, mar- ital status, and smoking history. Neighborhood disadvantage refl ected an aggregate measure of the proportion of residents in a neighbor- hood who lived below the poverty line, were on public assistance, or were unemployed. A similar multilevel analysis found a signifi - cant inverse association between birth weight and census-tract violent crime among African American, White, and Hispanic populations (Masi, Hawkley, Piotrowski, & Pickett, 2007).

The links between maternal psychological stress, preterm delivery (less than 37 weeks’ gestation), and low birth weight (less than 5.5 pounds) are not well understood. We do know, however, that maternal stress can lead to increased fetal cortisol, a stress hormone that stimulates placental corticotropin-re- leasing hormone (Chrousos, Torpy, & Gold, 1998; Norwitz, Robinson, & Callis, 1999). Corticotropin-releasing hormone has been labeled a “placental clock” because eleva- tions of this hormone appear to be crucial to the initiation of labor (McLean et al., 1995). Preterm delivery is the primary determinant of low birth weight, and both are risk factors for health problems later in life. Approxi- mately three quarters of neonatal mortality

JWBT514_ch07.indd 152JWBT514_ch07.indd 152 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Community and Health 153

and almost one half of long-term neurologi- cal impairment in children have been linked to preterm birth (Alexander, 1998). In a series of studies, Barker (1998) found evidence that low birth weight is a risk factor for coronary ar- tery disease, stroke, diabetes, and hypertension later in life. These studies and others point to the importance of maternal health, including psychological well-being, to the health of off- spring during infancy and later in life.

Childhood

Positive and negative childhood experiences can have both immediate and long-term health effects. These experiences usually refl ect the child’s care environment as well as neighbor- hood characteristics. Effects on health can be direct, involving physiologic pathways, or indirect, involving long-term health be- haviors. Using a retrospective cohort design, Rauh, Parker, and Garfi nkel (2003) found that third-grade reading scores in the New York City public schools were signifi cantly related to both individual- and community-level pre- dictors. At the individual level, male gender, low birth weight, unmarried mother, and low maternal education predicted lower reading scores. Controlling for individual-level risk, lower reading scores were signifi cantly asso- ciated with concentrated community poverty, defi ned as more than 40% of families in the community living below the federally defi ned poverty level. Research suggests that pre- school educational interventions lead to im- proved subsequent educational attainment and avoidance of high-risk health behaviors later in life (Heckman & Masterov, 2007).

Childhood exposure to lead dust is strongly associated with housing materials, which itself is related to the date of housing construction and neighborhood resources. Using National Health and Nutrition Examination Survey data from 1988 to 1994, Bernard and McGeehin (2003) found blood lead levels (BLL) were greater than or equal to 5 micrograms per deciliter (mcg/dL) in 42.5% of children liv- ing in housing built before 1946 but in only 14.1% of children living in housing built after

1973. In this study, non-Hispanic Black chil- dren were 3 times more likely to have BLL greater than or equal to 5 mcg/dL compared with non-Hispanic White children. Cognitive changes associated with lead toxicity include a decrease in IQ, distractibility, poor organi- zational skills, and hyperactivity. The effects of lead toxicity among children appear to be irreversible and may contribute to adverse be- haviors, including delinquency and teen preg- nancy (Bellinger, 2004).

Childhood maltreatment, including neglect, physical abuse, and sexual abuse, also appear to be related to community social organiza- tion. Coulton, Korbin, Su, and Chow (1995) found that the highest risk of maltreatment occurred among children who lived in neigh- borhoods characterized by poverty, high num- bers of children per adult resident, population turnover, and concentration of female-headed households. The psychological and physiolog- ical effects of childhood maltreatment can be long lasting. In a study of 49 women age 18 to 45 years, Heim, Newport, and colleagues (2000) found that women with a history of childhood abuse demonstrated increased pi- tuitary-adrenal and autonomic responses to stress compared with controls. Stress-related peak levels of adrenocorticotropic hormone (ACTH) were 6 times higher among women with a history of childhood abuse and current major depression compared with age-matched controls. Dysregulation of the hypothalamic- pituitary-adrenal (HPA) axis has been associ- ated with several diseases in adults, including chronic fatigue syndrome, fi bromyalgia, rheu- matoid arthritis, and asthma (Heim, Ehlert, & Hellhammer, 2000). Developmental neuro- biologists currently are examining pathways through which childhood stress and trauma infl uence brain development and function later in life (Teicher, Anderson, Polcari, Anderson, & Navalta, 2002).

Adolescence

Several studies have found positive associa- tions among neighborhood socioeconomic status and adolescent educational attainment

JWBT514_ch07.indd 153JWBT514_ch07.indd 153 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

154 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

(including years of schooling completed), probability of completing high school, and likelihood of attending college (Leventhal & Brooks-Gunn, 2000). Depending on the study, neighborhood socioeconomic status comprises one or more of these commu- nity characteristics: percentage of college- educated residents, percentage of residents living below poverty, percentage of mana- gerial/professional residents, high school dropout rate, levels of female family head- ship, and female employment. Coulton and Pandey (1992) found that teen birth and ju- venile delinquency rates were higher among adolescents living in Cleveland census tracts in which more than 40% of the population lived below the poverty threshold.

An evaluation of a scattered-site public housing program in Yonkers, NY, revealed that youths who remained in low-income neighborhoods were more likely to have used marijuana in the prior year and show signs of problem drinking in the previous month com- pared with adolescents who moved to middle- income neighborhoods (Briggs, 1997). In the National Survey of Adolescent Males, a high rate of neighborhood unemployment was asso- ciated with impregnating someone and father- ing a child (Ku, Sonenstein, & Pleck, 1993).

Mediation of the relationship between neighborhood characteristics and adolescent behaviors likely involves several pathways. In a review of this literature, Jencks and Mayer (1990) described fi ve conceptual models or pathways of infl uence, each emphasizing a different neighborhood construct: institutional resources, collective socialization, contagion or epidemic effects, competition, and relative deprivation. In their study of 877 Los Ange- les adolescents, Aneshensel and Sucoff (1996) found evidence for some of these effects. In this study, youth in low-socioeconomic-status (SES) neighborhoods perceived greater ambi- ent crime, violence, drug use, and graffi ti com- pared with youth living in neighborhoods with high SES. This effect was independent of in- dividual SES, and the perception of neighbor- hood hazard was associated with symptoms of depression, anxiety, oppositional defi ant

disorder, and conduct disorder. These results suggest that neighborhood characteristics can have important effects on adolescent physical health and social behavior.

Adulthood

Several dimensions of the neighborhood envi- ronment have been linked to illness and mor- tality among adults. These dimensions include crime rates, ratio of homeowners to renters, percentage of residents receiving public assis- tance, index of segregation, percentage of un- employment, percentage of households headed by women, income, education, collective ef- fi cacy, and housing value. As with studies of children and adolescents, the central ques- tion is whether neighborhoods truly infl uence health outcomes or if differences in health simply are due to differences in the residents’ age, race/ethnicity, and health behaviors. In other words, do contextual effects exist above and beyond the compositional associations with health? As mentioned, one way to address this question is to perform multilevel analysis, which simultaneously accounts for individual- and neighborhood-level variables.

One of the earliest studies demonstrating a contextual, or area, effect examined mortal- ity over a 9-year period in Alameda County, CA (Haan, Kaplan, & Camacho, 1987). From the 1,811 study participants, data were ob- tained regarding baseline health conditions, socioeconomic factors, health practices, social networks, and psychological factors. The re- searchers also noted if the participants lived in a designated poverty area. Analysis revealed the age-, sex-, and race-adjusted relative risk of mortality was 1.71 times higher among those living in poverty areas compared with those living in nonpoverty areas. The addition of baseline health conditions and other indi- vidual characteristics to the analysis lowered the relative risk of mortality slightly, but it remained signifi cantly higher among poverty- area residents. The authors speculated that ad- verse health outcomes in poverty areas were mediated by higher crime rates, poorer hous- ing, lack of transportation, higher levels of

JWBT514_ch07.indd 154JWBT514_ch07.indd 154 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Community and Health 155

environmental contaminants, or a combination of these factors.

In another study, individual- and family- level information from the 1986 national Americans’ Changing Lives study was linked to 1980 census information to assess the rela- tive effects of personal and neighborhood characteristics on three health outcomes: num- ber of chronic conditions experienced in the previous year, level of functional limitation, and self-rated health (Robert, 1998). The indi- vidual-level indicators were age, race, gender, and education, and the family-level indicators were income and level of assets. At the com- munity level, four indicators were included: percentage of households receiving public assistance, percentage of families with an in- come of $30,000 or more, percentage of adult unemployment, and a composite index of the three.

Initial bivariate analysis indicated that edu- cation and family income were more highly correlated with all three measures of health compared with the community-level variables. Controlling for individual-level and family- level SES, the percentage of households re- ceiving public assistance had an independent association with self-rated health. In addi- tion, percentage of families earning $30,000 or more, percentage of adult unemployment, and a composite economic disadvantage index each had associations with several chronic conditions when individual- and family-level SES were controlled. Robert (1998) concluded that while individual-level variables are stron- ger predictors of health, community-level in- dicators appear to have signifi cant associations with health.

LeClere, Rogers, and Peters (1998) used multilevel analysis to assess neighborhood ef- fects on female heart disease mortality. Data from the National Health Interview Survey (1986–1990) were linked to death certifi cate information from the National Death Index and the 1990 U.S. census at the census tract level. Individual-level information from the National Health Interview Survey included age, race, body mass index, preexisting con- ditions, income, education, marital status,

and employment status. Census information included percentage of families in the census tract headed by women, percentage of persons in the census tract who were Black, median family income, percentage of households who received public assistance, and unemployment rate.

For both White Americans and African Americans, heart disease rates were higher in the poorest census tracts. Adjusting for indi- vidual-level characteristics in the multilevel model, this study found that women living in communities where more than one quarter of the families were headed by women were more likely to die of heart disease compared with women who lived in neighborhoods with fewer female-headed households. The authors hypothesized that neighborhoods with high proportions of female-headed households may be associated with increased fi nancial, physi- cal, and emotional stress. Stress and other psychosocial risk factors may contribute to heart disease either directly, through accel- eration of the atherosclerotic process, or in- directly, through adverse coping behaviors, such as smoking, increased caloric intake, or increased alcohol intake (Williams, Barefoot, & Schneiderman, 2003).

These studies provide evidence that the neighborhood environment exerts an effect on health independent of individual characteris- tics. However, as more individual character- istics are included in multilevel models, the neighborhood effects on health seem to dimin- ish. In addition, some neighborhood effects may be more deleterious than others. Among the studies reviewed, the most commonly cited culprits are poor housing quality, exposure to toxins, and psychological stress.

End of Life

Among older individuals, the intensity of medical care received at the end of life var- ies by community. McAndrew-Cooper and colleagues (1999) used 1995–1996 Medicare billing information to compare frequency and types of care delivered to older adults in the last six months of life. They found that end-of-life

JWBT514_ch07.indd 155JWBT514_ch07.indd 155 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

156 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

issues “are resolved in ways that depend on where the patient happens to live, not on the patient’s preferences or the power of care to extend life” (p. 42). For example, in some communities, the chance of being hospitalized at the time of death was 20%; in other com- munities, this proportion was 50%. During the last 6 months of life, the chance of spending a week or more in an intensive care unit also varied by community, ranging from less than 4% to over 20% of patients. The number of physicians who care for patients in the last 6 months of life, also called “intensity of care,” varies by community. In some areas, 30% of patients were seen by 10 or more physicians, whereas in other areas, fewer than 3% received care from this number. Interestingly, variations in intensity of care refl ected amount of health- care resources more than underlying levels of illness in the community. Also, variations in intensity of care did not predict improved outcomes. That is, mortality rates among older sick individuals were not lower in communi- ties providing more intensive medical care.

McAndrew-Cooper and colleagues (1999) acknowledged that while mortality was not associated with intensity of care, increased spending and services at the end of life may be associated with improved comfort measures and quality of death. Comfort measures are ob- viously desirable, but do most people want to be in an intensive care unit at the end of life? A study of patients with life-threatening illnesses indicated that 82% would prefer to die at home rather than in the hospital if they were told by their physician they had “very little time to live” (SUPPORT Principal Investigators, 1995). Given the results of these studies, it appears that some communities are better at allocating re- sources and addressing the needs and wishes of gravely ill Medicare recipients than others.

IMPLICATIONS FOR SOCIAL WORK PRACTICE

The studies reviewed in this chapter sug- gest that neighborhoods can infl uence health positively by providing access to high-quality

medical care, healthy foods, and green space for exercise as well as by minimizing expo- sure to crime, toxins, and infectious disease. Neighborhoods also can negatively infl uence health through poor housing stock, exposure to chemical and biological pathogens, decreased access to medical care, promotion of adverse health behaviors, and ambient psychological stressors. These effects raise important ques- tions for social work practice. For example, from a social work perspective, is it more ef- fi cient to help individuals improve their living situation on a case-by-case basis or through community-wide interventions? If a neigh- borhood is physically or psychologically unhealthy, does it make more sense to help individuals move out of the neighborhood or to advocate community change? The answers to these questions are refl ected in the diversity of strategies currently used by social workers. That is, some social workers address prob- lems at the individual level, others work for change at the community level, and still others do both. Neighborhood improvement is a slow process and often requires political, adminis- trative, and community organizing abilities. Providing services to individuals also requires administrative ability as well as knowledge of resources and persistence. Both community- and individual-level development strategies are essential, and both should be supported to a greater extent by public policy.

MacIntyre, MacIver, and Sooman (1993) believe neighborhood improvement has re- ceived short shrift in the policy arena. They argue that unhealthy behaviors and many dis- eases arise from adverse environments and that improvements in the physical and social environment can lead to improved health be- haviors and health. Instead of encouraging working-class populations to act more like middle-class populations, MacIntyre and col- leagues believe that public policy should foster the transformation of working-class neighbor- hoods into middle-class neighborhoods.

However, garnering support for investment in low-income communities is time consuming and often is viewed as a low priority by private and public institutions. Even when support is

JWBT514_ch07.indd 156JWBT514_ch07.indd 156 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Community and Health 157

obtained and a plan is in place for community improvement, several pitfalls must be avoided. One of them is the population displacement that can occur with gentrifi cation. For exam- ple, a $150 million project to build 550 new single-family homes in Chicago’s economi- cally depressed Englewood neighborhood was opposed by some working-class and senior residents who were concerned that rent and property tax increases would force them out. Although about 20% of the proposed homes were set aside for low-income families, local residents were concerned that overall hous- ing costs would be too high (Olivo, 2004). These concerns turned out to be valid, as the low-income units were designed for families earning up to 100% of the Chicago Area Median Family Income, which was $72,400 in 2008. At that time, the median family income in Englewood was $34,902, effectively making the low-income units inaccessible to the aver- age Englewood community resident (Develop- ing Government Accountability to the People Network, 2008). This example demonstrates that although neighborhood improvement can be benefi cial for many, the unintended conse- quences for low- and fi xed-income residents must be considered.

Helping individuals or families fi nd hous- ing in healthy environments is an important service provided by many social workers. In some cases, such assistance can mean the dif- ference between health and illness or even life and death. But relocation also has pitfalls. Moving to a new neighborhood can lead to dis- ruption of social networks and loss of support systems. Minorities or individuals with lower incomes also may feel stressed in high-income neighborhoods, especially if there is little eth- nic or economic diversity. Analyzing 11 years of data from Alameda County, CA, Yen and Kaplan (1999) found that low-income individ- uals living in a neighborhood with high SES had signifi cantly higher mortality rates com- pared with low-income individuals living in neighborhoods with low SES. The authors hy- pothesize that differential access to resources and psychological stress contributed to this disparity. The implication for social workers

and other service providers is that relocation is not without cost, and every effort should be made to help individuals access services and develop support networks in their new com- munities.

An additional cost of relocation can be incurred by those who remain in impover- ished communities. Typically, individuals who leave economically depressed neighborhoods are either employed or have higher levels of education and job skills. Out-migration of human capital means that those who remain have fewer community resources and fewer successful role models (Wilson, 1996). This can result in further community deterioration, including loss of educational and health-care services and exacerbation of health problems among those left behind.

This problem is mitigated partially if all members of a community leave or are relo- cated. For example, the Chicago Housing Au- thority recently relocated all residents of the Robert Taylor Homes (a series of 28 high-rise public housing buildings on Chicago’s South Side) to subsidized housing throughout the city. The subsidized housing includes mixed- income units being constructed on the site of the former Robert Taylor Homes. In contrast to neighborhoods that have suffered from out- migration of social capital, this program will result in the evolution of an impoverished area into a middle-class community. However, it will occur at the expense of near complete turnover of neighborhood residents and the disruption of many family and social network ties.

Neighborhood change in the other direc- tion (from middle class to working class) also can occur when economic and ethnic inte- gration occurs too rapidly. The early history of Chicago’s Englewood neighborhood is an example. In the fi rst half of the 20th century, Englewood was a popular destination for Ger- man, Swedish, and Irish immigrants pursu- ing the American dream of home ownership. When African American residents moved to Englewood to pursue the same dream in the 1960s and 1970s, “White fl ight” ensued, and the population decreased from 90,000 in 1960

JWBT514_ch07.indd 157JWBT514_ch07.indd 157 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

158 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

to 40,000 in 2000 (Kouvelis et al., 2003). Ma- jority exodus when a tipping point is reached is a common problem and presents a recurring challenge for politicians and community plan- ners. How can neighborhoods be integrated without inducing rapid turnover and without incurring property tax and rent increases that overburden low-income residents? In her study of the history of integration, Cashin (2004) notes that rapid neighborhood turnover is less likely to occur when the minority percentage does not exceed a certain proportion or when three or more ethnic groups coexist, none more dominant than the other. Although integration control is not always necessary, many commu- nities closely monitor the status and effects of integration. Some have done so to enhance in- tegration while others have done so to discour- age it. Working at planning and administrative levels, social workers can monitor and help infl uence patterns of integration in their own communities. They also can help families and individuals negotiate the often arcane rules of subsidized housing and ensure that new resi- dents have access to community resources.

Another strategy to improve neighborhoods is through Empowerment Zones—economic development programs begun during the Clin- ton administration. Through this initiative, urban Empowerment Zones (EZs) and Enter- prise Communities receive federal tax credits and Block Grants to design and fund economic development, housing, job training, and social programs (Dixon, 2000). Since 1993, this program has had several successes, including the creation of new businesses, job-training programs, and new or rehabilitated housing for homeless persons. However, a perception exists that ineffective oversight and improper handling of funds have limited the success of this program (McDavid, 1998). Many com- munity residents report that EZ funds have not reached the street level, where they are needed most (Dixon, 2000). In collaboration with administrators and community leaders, social workers can help ensure that EZ jobs and resources reach the street level and pro- vide resources to small business owners, entre- preneurs, and job seekers. All citizens should take an interest in taxpayer-funded programs

such as the EZ initiative. Social workers have the training and skills to monitor and deploy them as originally designed.

A recent report indicates that approximately 3.5 million Americans are likely to experience homelessness in a given year (National Coali- tion for Homelessness, 2009). As a result, 860 cities and counties have enacted 10-year plans to end homelessness, and 49 states have cre- ated Interagency Councils on Homelessness (Interagency Council on Homelessness, 2009). Social workers can play important roles in re- ducing the adverse health effects of homeless- ness, as demonstrated by two recent studies. In the fi rst, homeless individuals treated in emer- gency rooms were randomized to long-term housing and social worker–directed case man- agement versus usual care, which consisted of standard discharge planning (Sadowski et al., 2009). After 18 months, individuals in long- term housing had fewer emergency depart- ment visits, fewer hospitalizations, and fewer days spent in the hospital. In a similar study of homeless emergency room patients with HIV, a higher proportion of individuals who entered long-term housing and received social worker–directed case management were alive at one year compared with the usual care group, who received standard discharge planning (Buchanan, Kee, Sadowski, Garcia, 2009).

Using progressive taxation policies, many nations in Europe have had success in pursuing economic parity. These policies have enhanced social security and reduced income-related health differences. Published in 1998, Britain’s Acheson report on health disparities recom- mends specifi c steps to reduce these disparities further, including increased cash and services to poor women, expectant mothers, children, and elderly people. Additional resources for schools and job training programs as well as improved housing for the poor are also recom- mended (Acheson, 1998). In the United States, many politicians decry the “offshoring” of jobs to low-wage locales and have called for tax incentives to retain American jobs. Some of these efforts refl ect increasing recognition of the growing disparities in employment, income, and community resources in the United States. Whether this rhetoric refl ects an appreciation of

JWBT514_ch07.indd 158JWBT514_ch07.indd 158 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Community and Health 159

the link between neighborhood characteristics and health remains to be seen, but efforts in this direction have gained momentum in other coun- tries and some argue that they also should be supported in the United States.

Social workers can play a key role in advo- cating economic reform and directing commu- nity improvement. As professionals who work on the front lines, social workers observe fi rst- hand the effects of unemployment, low wages, and lack of health insurance. Inability to afford housing, strained family relationships, and de- ferred treatment for illnesses are just a few of the outcomes social workers encounter on a daily basis. Recognizing the need for systemic change, social workers often lead the way in bringing attention to resource-poor communi- ties. This attention can occur in many ways, including through community-based partici- patory research (CBPR). CBPR is a powerful tool for initiating change because it identifi es community resources, needs, and solutions, with community stakeholders who are experi- encing problems. Developed over the past two decades, the key features of CBPR are that it:

• Recognizes a community as a unit of identity

• Builds on strengths and resources within the community

• Facilitates collaborative, equitable involve- ment of all partners in all phases of the re- search

• Integrates knowledge and action for mutual benefi t of all partners

• Promotes a collaborative and empowering process that attends to social inequalities

• Involves a cyclical and iterative process

• Addresses health from both positive and ecological perspectives

• Disseminates fi ndings and knowledge gained to all partners

• Involves a long-term commitment by all partners (Israel, Schulz, Parker, & Becker, 2001)

Recent studies have used CBPR to raise awareness of the importance of community characteristics to health outcomes, including the built environment and health (Redwood

et al., 2010), health-care resources and breast cancer treatment (Masi & Gehlert, 2009), and the role of tribal customs in promoting health and preventing substance abuse (Thomas, Donovan, Sigo, Austin, & Marlatt, 2009). Other ways in which social workers can advo- cate reform and enhance community capacity include testifying before city and state legis- latures, writing editorials in local newspapers, highlighting defi cient city services, and form- ing community-based service organizations.

A large volume of evidence indicates that individual health is infl uenced by community characteristics and resources. Because so many communities face economic and resource chal- lenges, the opportunities for social workers to have a signifi cant impact are enormous. This impact can occur at the individual level as well as at the community and national levels. What- ever strategy is chosen, those who strive to im- prove the social and physical environment of others can be assured that such efforts will have long-lasting and signifi cant health benefi ts.

SUGGESTED LEARNING EXERCISES

Learning Exercise 7.1

Identify the characteristics of a local neighbor- hood that appear to have the most important effects on the health of its residents.

Learning Exercise 7.2

List the physical, social, and health-care needs of individuals who live in an economically de- pressed community.

Learning Exercise 7.3

Compare and contrast the advantages and dis- advantages of the public health and medical models of health care.

Learning Exercise 7.4

List the advantages of community-based par- ticipatory research in identifying community resources, needs, and solutions.

JWBT514_ch07.indd 159JWBT514_ch07.indd 159 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

160 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

Learning Exercise 7.5

Describe the potential impact of education, employment, housing, and food policy on health outcomes in the United States.

SUGGESTED RESOURCES

Berkman, L. F., & Kawachi, I. (Eds.). (2000). Social epidemiology. New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Commission on the Social Determinants of Health. (2008). Closing the gap in a gen- eration: Health equity through action on the social determinants of health. Geneva, Switzerland: World Health Organization.

Diez Roux, A. V. (2001). Investigating neighborhood and area effects on health. American Journal of Public Health, 91, 1783–1789.

Ellen, I. G., Mijanovich, T., & Dillman, K. (2001). Neighborhood effects on health: Exploring the links and assessing the evi- dence. Journal of Urban Affairs, 23(3/4), 391–408.

Schoeni, R. F., House, J. S., Kaplan, G. A., & Pollack, H. (Eds.). (2008). Making Americans healthier: Social and economic policy as health policy. New York, NY: Russell Sage.

World Health Organization: http://www .who.int/en/

REFERENCES

Acheson, D. (1998). Independent inquiry into inequalities in health report. London, UK: Her Majesty’s Stationery Offi ce.

Alexander, G. R. (1998). Preterm birth: Etiology, mechanisms, and prevention. Prenatal and Neonatal Medicine, 3, 3–9.

Andrus, M. R., Kelley, K. W., Murphey, L. M., & Herndon, K. C. (2004). A comparison of diabetes care in rural and urban medical clinics in Alabama. Journal of Community Health, 29(1), 29–44.

Aneshensel, C. S., & Sucoff, C. A. (1996). The neighborhood context of adolescent mental health. Journal of Health and Social Behavior, 37(4), 293–310.

Barker, D. (1998). Mothers, babies and health in later life. London, UK: Churchill Livingstone.

Bellinger, D. C. (2004). Lead. Pediatrics, 113(4), 1016– 1022.

Bernard, S. M., & McGeehin, M. A. (2003). Prevalence of blood lead levels >5 mu g/dL among U.S. children 1 to 5 years of age and socioeconomic and demographic factors associated with blood lead levels of 5 to 10 mu g/dL. Third National Health and Nutrition Examination Survey, 1988–1994. Pediatrics, 112(6), 1308–1313.

Briggs, X. S. (Ed.). (1997). Yonkers revisited: The early impacts of scattered-site public housing on families and neighborhoods. New York, NY: Teachers College.

Buchanan, D., Kee, R., Sadowski, L. S., & Garcia, D. (2009). The health impact of supportive housing for HIV-positive homeless patients: A randomized controlled trial. American Journal of Public Health, 99, S675–S680.

Buka, S. L., Brennan, R. T., Rich-Edwards, J. W., Raudenbush, S. W., & Earls, F. (2003). Neighborhood support and the birth weight of urban infants. American Journal of Epidemiology, 157(1), 1–8.

Cashin, S. (2004). The failures of integration: How race and class are undermining the American dream. New York, NY: Public Affairs.

Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. (2010). Decrease in reported tuberculosis cases—United States, 2009. Morbidity and Mortality Weekly Report, 59(10), 289–294.

Central Intelligence Agency. (2010). The world factbook. Washington, DC: Offi ce of Public Affairs.

Chapin, C. (1924). Deaths among taxpayers and non- taxpayers in Providence, RI, 1865. American Journal of Public Health, 9, 647–651.

Chrousos, G. P., Torpy, D. J., & Gold, P. W. (1998). Interactions between the hypothalamic-pituitary- adrenal axis and the female reproductive system: Clinical implications. Annals of Internal Medicine, 129, 229–240.

Collins, J. W., David, R. J., Symons, R., Hadler, A., Wall, S., & Andes, S. (1998). African-American mothers’ perception of their residential environment, stressful life events, and very low birthweight. Epidemiology, 9(3), 286–289.

Commission on the Social Determinants of Health. (2008). Closing the gap in a generation: Health equity through action on the social determinants of health. Geneva, Switzerland: World Health Organization.

Coulton, C. J., Korbin, J. E., Su, M., & Chow, J. (1995). Community level factors and child maltreatment rates. Child Development, 66, 1262–1276.

Coulton, C. K., & Pandey, S. (1992). Geographic concentration of poverty and risk to children in urban neighborhoods. American Behavioral Scientist, 35(3), 238–257.

Danaei, G., Friedman, A. B., Oza, S., Murray, C. J. L., & Ezzati, M. (2009). Diabetes prevalence and diagnosis in US states: Analysis of health surveys. Population Health Metrics, 7(16), 1–13.

JWBT514_ch07.indd 160JWBT514_ch07.indd 160 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Community and Health 161

Developing Government Accountability to the People Network. (2008). Local implementation: Chicago, Illinois: Response to the periodic report of the United States to the United Nations Committee on the Elimination of Racial Discrimination. Chicago, IL: Author.

Dickens, C. M., McGowan, L., Percival, C., Douglas, J., Tomenson, B., Cotter, L., . . . Creed, F. H. (2004). Lack of a close confi dant, but not depression, predicts further cardiac events after myocardial infarction. Heart, 90, 518–522.

Dixon, J. (2000, January 17). Residents in Detroit’s empowerment zone see no progress in 5 years. Detroit Free Press. Retrieved from www.freep.com/news /locway/dzone17_20000117.htm

Edlund, L., & Korn, E. (2002). A theory of prostitution. Journal of the Political Economy, 110(1), 181–214.

Freinkel, N. (1980). Of pregnancy and progeny. Diabetes, 29, 1023–1035.

Girard, M. (2000). Emerging infectious diseases. Medicine Sciences, 16(8/9), 883–891.

Haan, M., Kaplan, G. A., & Camacho, T. (1987). Poverty and health: Prospective evidence from the Alameda County Study. American Journal of Epidemiology, 125(6), 989–998.

Hackbarth, D. P., Silvestri, B., & Cosper, W. (1995). Tobacco and alcohol billboards in 50 Chicago neighborhoods: Market segmentation to sell dangerous products to the poor. Journal of Public Health Policy, 16, 213–230.

Heckman, J. J., & Masterov, D. V. (2007). The productivity argument for investing in young children. Review of Agricultural Economics, 29(3), 446–493.

Heim, C., Ehlert, U., & Hellhammer, D. H. (2000). The potential role of hypocortisolism in the pathophysiology of stress-related bodily disorders. Psychoneuroendocrinology, 25, 1–25.

Heim, C., Newport, D. J., Heit, S., Graham, Y. P., Wilcox, M., Bonsall, R., . . . Nemeroff, C. B. (2000). Pituitary- adrenal and autonomic responses to stress in women after sexual and physical abuse in childhood. JAMA, 284(5), 592–597.

Heron, M., Hoyert, D. L., Murphy, S. L., Xu, J., Kochanek, K. D., & Tejada-Vera, B. (2009). Deaths: Final data for 2006. National Vital Statistics Reports, 57(14), 1–135.

Huston, S. L., Evenson, K. R., Bors, P., & Gizlice, Z. (2003). Neighborhood environment, access to places for activity, and leisure-time physical activity in a diverse North Carolina population. American Journal of Health Promotion, 18(1), 58–69.

Interagency Council on Homelessness. (2009). Home page. Retrieved from www.ich.gov

Israel, B.A., Schulz, A.J., Parker, E.A., & Becker, A.B. (2001). Community-based participatory research: Policy recommendations for promoting a partnership approach in health research. Education for Health, 14, 182–197.

Jencks, C., & Mayer, S. (1990). The social consequences of growing up in a poor neighborhood. In L. E. Lynn & M. F. H. McGeary (Eds.), Inner-city poverty in the United States (pp. 111–186). Washington, DC: National Academy Press.

Kouvelis, A., Harper, D. M., & Thomas, S. (2003). Community area health inventory, 1989–1999. Chicago, IL: Chicago Department of Public Health.

Krieger, N. (2001). Theories for social epidemiology in the twenty-fi rst century: An ecosocial perspective. International Journal of Epidemiology, 30(4), 668–677.

Ku, L., Sonenstein, F. L., & Pleck, J. H. (1993). Neighborhood, family, and work: Infl uences on the premarital behaviors of adolescent males. Social Forces, 72, 479–503.

Laumann, E. O., Ellingson, S., Mahay, J., Paik, A., & Youm, Y. (Eds.). (2004). The sexual organization of the city. Chicago, IL: University of Chicago Press.

LaVeist, T. A. (1989). Linking residential segregation to the infant mortality race disparity in U.S. cities. Social Science Review, 73(2), 90–94.

LeClere, F. B., Rogers, R. G., & Peters, K. (1998). Neighborhood social context and racial differences in women’s heart disease mortality. Journal of Health and Social Behavior, 39, 91–107.

Leventhal, T., & Brooks-Gunn, J. (2000). The neighborhoods they live in: The effects of neighborhood residence on child and adolescent outcomes. Psychological Bulletin, 126(2), 309–337.

Lopez-Jimenez, F., Batsis, J. A., Roger, V. L., Brekke, L., Ting, H. H., & Somers, V. K. (2009). Trends in 10-year predicted risk of cardiovascular disease in the United States, 1976–2004. Circulation: Cardiovascular Quality and Outcomes, 2, 443–450.

MacIntyre, S., MacIver, S., & Sooman, A. (1993). Area, class and health: Should we be focusing on places or people? Journal of Social Policy, 22(2), 213–234.

Masi, C. M., & Gehlert, S. (2009). Perceptions of breast cancer treatment among African American women and men: Implications for interventions. Journal of General Internal Medicine, 24(3), 408–414.

Masi, C. M., Hawkley, L. C., Piotrowski, Z. H., & Pickett, K. E. (2007). Neighborhood economic disadvantage, violent crime, group density, and pregnancy outcomes in a diverse, urban population. Social Science & Medicine, 65, 2440–2457.

McAndrew-Cooper, M., Wennberg, J. E., & Center for the Evaluative Clinical Sciences Staff. (1999). The Dartmouth Atlas of Health Care 1999. Chicago, IL: American Hospital Association.

McDavid, N. L. (1998, October). HUD auditing empower- ment zone. Chicago Reporter. Retrieved from http:// www.chicagoreporter.com/index.php/c/Inside_Stories /d/HUD_Auditing_Empowerment_Zone

McDermott, R. (1998). Ethics, epidemiology and the thrifty gene: Biological determinism as a health hazard. Social Science and Medicine, 47(9), 1189–1195.

JWBT514_ch07.indd 161JWBT514_ch07.indd 161 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

162 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

McGinnis, J. M., Williams-Russo, P., & Knickman, J. R. (2002). The case for more active policy attention to health promotion. Health Affairs, 21(2), 78–93.

McLean, M., Bisits, A., Davies, J., Woods, R., Lowry, P., & Smith, R. (1995). A placental clock controlling the length of human pregnancy. Nature Medicine, 1(5), 460–463.

Mooney, C. (1990). Cost and availability of healthy food choices in a London health district. Journal of Human Nutrition and Dietetics, 3, 111–120.

Morland, K., Wing, S., & Diez Roux, A. (2002). The contextual effect of the local food environment on residents’ diets: The Atherosclerosis Risk in Communities Study. American Journal of Public Health, 92, 1761–1768.

Mumford Center. (2001). Ethnic diversity grows, neighborhood integration lags behind. Retrieved from www.albany.edu/mumford/census

National Coalition for Homelessness. (2009). How many people experience homelessness? Retrieved from www.nationalhomeless.org/factsheets/How_Many .html

Norwitz, E. R., Robinson, J. N., & Callis, J. R. G. (1999). The control of labor. New England Journal of Medicine, 341(1), 660–666.

Olivo, A. (2004, May 6). Englewood rebirth plan brings hope and anxiety. Chicago Tribune, p. 1, 32.

Orfi eld, G. (2001). Schools more separate: Consequences of a decade of resegregation. The Civil Rights Project, Harvard University. Retrieved from www .civilrightsproject.ucla.edu/research/k-12-education /integration-and-diversity/schools-more-separate -consequences-of-a-decade-of-resegregation/?search term=resegregation

Orr, L., Feins, J. D., Jacob, R., Beecroft, E., Sanbonmatsu, L., Katz, L. F., . . . Kling, J. R. (2003). Moving to opportunity for fair housing demonstration: Interim impacts evaluation. Retrieved from www.huduser.org /Publications/pdf/MTOFullReport.pdf

Palacio-Mejia, L. S., Rangel-Gomez, G., Hernandez- Avila, M., & Lazcano-Ponce, E. (2003). Cervical cancer, a disease of poverty: Mortality differences between urban and rural areas in Mexico. Salud Publica De Mexico, 45(Suppl. 3), S315–S325.

Pettitt, D. J., Nelson, R. G., Saad, M. F., Bennett, P. H., & Knowler, W. C. (1993). Diabetes and obesity in the offspring of Pima Indian women with diabetes during pregnancy. Diabetes Care, 16, 482–486.

Philipson, T. J., & Posner, R. A. (2003). The long-run growth in obesity as a function of technological change. Perspectives in Biology and Medicine, 46(Suppl. 3), S87–S107.

Pickett, K., & Pearl, M. (2001). Multilevel analyses of neighborhood socioeconomic context and health outcomes: A critical review. Journal of Epidemiology and Community Health, 55, 111–122.

Pleis, J. R., & Lucas, J. W. (2009). Summary health statistics for U.S. adults: National Health Interview Survey, 2007. Washington, DC: National Center for Health Statistics.

Porter, N. (1997). The greatest benefi t to mankind: A medical history of humanity. New York, NY: Norton.

Rauh, V. A., Parker, F. L., & Garfi nkel, R. S. (2003). Biological, social, and community infl uences on third- grade reading levels of minority head start children: A multilevel approach. Journal of Community Psychology, 31(3), 255–278.

Redwood, Y., Schulz, A. J., Israel, B. A., Yoshihama, M., Wang, C., & Kreuter, M. (2010). Social, economic, and political processes that create built environment inequities: Perspectives from urban African Americans in Atlanta. Family & Community Health, 33(1), 53–67.

Reidpath, D. D., Burns, C., Garrard, J., Mahoney, M., & Townsend, M. (2001). An ecological study of the relationship between social and environmental determinants of obesity. Health and Place, 8, 141–145.

Robert, S. A. (1998). Community-level socioeconomic status effects on adult health. Journal of Health and Social Behavior, 139, 18–37.

Sadowski, L. S., Kee, R. A., VanderWeele, T. J., & Buchanan, D. (2009). Effect of housing and case management on emergency department visits and hospitalizations among chronically ill homeless adults: A randomized trial. JAMA, 301(17), 1771–1778.

Satz, D. (2003). Child labor: A normative perspective. World Bank Economic Review, 17(2), 297–309.

Schoeni, R. F., House, J. S., Kaplan, G. A., & Pollack, H. (Eds.). (2008). Making Americans healthier: Social and economic policy as health policy. New York, NY: Russell Sage.

Sooman, A., MacIntyre, S., & Anderson, A. (1993). Scotland’s health: A more diffi cult challenge for some? The price and availability of healthy foods in socially contrasting localities in the West of Scotland. Health Bulletin, 51, 276–284.

Stoddard, J. L., Johnson, C. A., Sussman, S., Dent, C., & Boley-Cruz, T. (1998). Tailoring outdoor tobacco advertising to minorities in Los Angeles County. Journal of Health Communication, 3, 137–146.

SUPPORT Principal Investigators. (1995). A controlled trial to improve care for seriously ill hospitalized patients. JAMA, 274, 1591–1598.

Teicher, M. H., Anderson, S. L., Polcari, A., Anderson, C. M., & Navalta, C. P. (2002). Developmental neurobiology of childhood stress and trauma. Psychiatric Clinics of North America, 25(2), 397–426.

Thomas, L. R., Donovan, D. M., Sigo, R. L. W., Austin, L., & Marlatt, G. A. (2009). The community pulling together: A tribal-university partnership project to reduce substance abuse and promote good health in a reservation tribal community. Journal of Ethnicity in Substance Abuse, 8(3), 1–13.

JWBT514_ch07.indd 162JWBT514_ch07.indd 162 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Community and Health 163

United States Conference of Mayors. (2007). A status report on hunger and homelessness in America’s cities: A 23-city survey. Washington, DC: Author.

Vukmir, R. B. (2004). The infl uence of urban, suburban, or rural locale on survival from refractory prehospital cardiac arrest. American Journal of Emergency Medicine, 22(2), 90–93.

Wennberg, D. E., Dickens, J. D., Biener, L., Fowler, F. J., Soule, D. N., & Keller, R. B. (1997). Do physicians do what they say? The inclination to test and its association with coronary angiography rates. Journal of General Internal Medicine, 12, 172–176.

Wilbur, J., Chandler, P. J., Dancy, B., & Lee, H. (2003). Correlates of physical activity in urban Midwestern African-American women. American Journal of Preventive Medicine, 25(2), 45–52.

Williams, R. B., Barefoot, J. C., & Schneiderman, N. (2003). Psychosocial risk factors for cardiovascular

disease: More than one culprit at work. JAMA, 290(16), 2190–2192.

Wilson, W. J. (1996). When work disappears: The world of the new urban poor. New York, NY: Random House.

World Health Organization. (2008). World health statistics 2008. Geneva, Switzerland: Author.

World Health Organization (2010). Countries. Retrieved from http://who.int/countries

Yen, I. H., & Kaplan, G. A. (1999). Neighborhood social environmental and risk of death: Multilevel evidence from the Alameda County Study. American Journal of Epidemiology, 149, 898–907.

Zapata, B. C., Rebolledo, A., Atalah, E., Newman, B., & King, M. (1992). The infl uence of social and political violence on the risk of pregnancy complications. American Journal of Public Health, 82, 685–690.

JWBT514_ch07.indd 163JWBT514_ch07.indd 163 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

164

8

Physical and Mental Health: Interactions, Assessment, and Interventions

MALITTA ENGSTROM

Interactions between physical and mental health are among the most complex issues that are brought to social workers in health-care settings. The complexity stems from the dy- namic mind–body relationship; the numerous possible combinations of physical and mental health conditions; differentiation of psychologi- cal reactions to physical illness; psychological effects of physical conditions and treatments and psychiatric disorders; intervention during mental health crises; and provision of ongo- ing intervention to support physical and mental well-being. While considering these issues, the social worker formulates assessments and of- fers interventions that refl ect the unique family and ecological contexts of people in their envi- ronments. With particular focus on differential assessment, this chapter provides guidance for social workers navigating these complexities.

It is important to recognize the limitations inherent in using the terms physical health and mental health (U.S. Department of Health and Human Services [DHHS], 1999, p. 5). This lan- guage implies a false division of these related el- ements of overall health (Angell, 2002; DHHS, 1999; Kerson, 2002). In fact, these two elements are not only interrelated but also exert mutual infl uences on each other (Rolland, 1994). Rec- ognizing this mutual infl uence and the ongoing emergence of knowledge about the mind–body connection, this chapter uses these terms for both illustrative purposes and toward the goal of developing knowledge with adequate specifi c- ity so that practitioners can engage effectively

in evidence-based assessment and intervention (Angell, 2002; Williams, 1998).

Chapter Objectives • Provide a framework for considering

the intersections of health, psychosocial well-being, and ecological factors (e.g., race, ethnicity, cultural background, gen- der, socioeconomic status, age, sexual orientation, family relationships, social support).

• Offer guidance for differential assessment of psychological reactions to physical ill- ness, psychological symptoms associated with physical illness or treatment, and clini- cal mood and anxiety disorders.

• Provide a conceptual overview and clinical tools for the assessment of suicide risk and for intervention in this area.

• Highlight general intervention strategies to support overall health, coping, and well- being and targeted intervention strategies to assist people experiencing psychologi- cal distress associated with depression and anxiety disorders in health-care settings.

PSYCHOSOCIAL CONDITIONS AND INCREASED RISK FOR ILLNESS

Stress

Psychological distress, including stress, anger, hostility, depression, and anxiety, is associated

JWBT514_ch08.indd 164JWBT514_ch08.indd 164 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Physical and Mental Health: Interactions, Assessment, and Interventions 165

with numerous negative health outcomes across a wide range of illnesses (Institute of Medicine [IOM], 2001). The role of stress in particular has been well documented in its relationship to risk for numerous health prob- lems, including cardiovascular disease, cancer, autoimmune and infl ammatory disorders, and wound healing. Although stress and its effects on physiology can be benefi cial and enable a person to respond to a threat—to “fi ght or fl ee” (IOM, 2001)—an individual will experience allostatic load when faced with chronic expo- sure to undefi ned stress that is unresolved and thus perpetuates the stress response. Allostatic load refers to the cumulative physiological toll of repeated responses to stress (McEwen & Stellar, 1993). Allostatic load also can occur when the stress response fails to activate (McEwen, 1998; McEwen & Gianaros, 2010). Allostasis involves the body’s physiological re- sponses to stressors to foster adaptation to chal- lenge and to maintain homeostasis (Sterling & Eyer, 1988). However, as the body continues to engage in allostasis, allostatic load results and can contribute disease (McEwen, 1998; McEwen & Stellar, 1993). Allostatic load is infl uenced not only by chronic stress but also by behavioral factors, including substance use, physical activity, sleep, and diet; individual temperament; and genetics and developmental variations (IOM, 2001; McEwen, 1998).

There are two primary ways to consider the relationship between stress and health: through a biological pathway and through behavior. Through a biological pathway, stress directly infl uences the body’s physiology. Responding to stress releases hormones that infl uence the central nervous, cardiovascular, and immune systems (IOM, 2001). Exposure to chronic stress in particular negatively infl uences the immune system (Segerstrom & Miller, 2004). The concept of allostatic load—the cumulative physiological cost of responding to stress— provides a compelling framework for under- standing ways in which responding to stress affects well-being, in general, and perpetuates health disparities, in particular (McEwen & Gianaros, 2010). Coping with stress may lead to behaviors, such as eating a higher-fat diet,

smoking cigarettes, and reducing exercise, all of which increase the risk for illness (Ng & Jeffrey, 2003). Through both physiology and behavior, stress intersects with health. In ad- dition, the psychosocial and physical demands of illness may increase stress and warrant in- tervention to address biological and behavioral effects on overall health.

Popular notions of stress may discount its impact on well-being, as refl ected in such statements as “He’s just stressed out.” How- ever, a growing body of science suggests that being stressed out, particularly if one repeat- edly experiences stress, has far-reaching im- plications for physical health (McEwen & Gianaros, 2010). Social workers in health-care settings are well positioned to help people who are experiencing psychological stress. Such intervention may be critical to support- ing physical and mental health. One powerful framework for guiding intervention in this area is Lazarus and Folkman’s (1984) model of stress, appraisal, and coping. This model and its implications for physical and mental health are further discussed in the “Psychosocial In- tervention Strategies in Health-Care Settings” section of this chapter.

Social Relationships

Social networks, support, integration, and capital also have strong implications for physi- cal and mental health (IOM, 2001; McGinnis, Williams-Russo, & Knickman, 2002). The term social networks generally refers to the composition of a person’s social relationships (e.g., number of people, types of relationships, relationships among the people in a social network); social support generally refers to a person’s sense of feeling warmly regarded and respected or to the type of support available (e.g., emotional support, material assistance, instrumental or practical support) (Cobb, 1976; House & Kahn, 1985; IOM, 2001). So- cial integration can be conceptualized as the number of intimate relationships a person has with both individuals (including family and friends) and groups (including voluntary and religious organizations) as well as a person’s

JWBT514_ch08.indd 165JWBT514_ch08.indd 165 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

166 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

sense of having multiple social roles and com- munal connections with others (IOM, 2001; McEwen & Gianaros, 2010). Social capital re- fl ects a societal conceptualization of its mem- bers’ integration. Measures of social capital can include reported trust among people and degree of civic participation. Greater social integration is associated with a host of health outcomes, including improved quality of life, reduced mortality, fewer suicides, and less crime (IOM, 2001). Furthermore, enhancing social integration may be particularly helpful in reducing the long-term physiological costs of repeatedly responding to stress (McEwen & Gianaros, 2010).

Social ties and support are far reaching in their power to strengthen health. They sup- port survival in infancy, buffer stress in life transitions, increase one’s ability to fi ght off a cold, reduce advancement of carotid ath- erosclerosis, slow the decline of immune functioning in persons with human immu- nodefi ciency virus (HIV), and contribute to lower levels of allostatic load. Alternatively, isolation, loss, confl ict within relationships, and the potential for disease transmission are aspects of social ties that can negatively affect physical and mental health (IOM, 2001). For social workers in health-care settings, these fi ndings highlight the importance of explor- ing available social support, augmenting it when needed, enhancing interactions among social network members as indicated, and facilitating social integration. In addition, social workers can play an important role in preventing disease transmission between so- cial network members through education and counseling efforts.

PHYSICAL ILLNESS AND THE ROLE OF MENTAL HEALTH

Among people who are experiencing physical illness, mental health can play an important role in physical outcomes across the life span. For example, among adolescents, depression, low-self-esteem, and parent–child confl ict can infl uence nonadherence to oncology regi-

mens (Kennard et al., 2004). Among adults who have experienced myocardial infarction, depression, state anxiety, and psychologi- cal distress can increased the risk of 5-year cardiac-related mortality (Frasure-Smith & Lesperance, 2003). Among older women with cancer, depression can lower the likelihood of receiving appropriate treatment and increase the risk of death (Goodwin, Zhang, & Ostir, 2004). In addition, treating depression can reduce intensity of pain and disability asso- ciated with osteoarthritis among older adults (Lin et al., 2003).

The next example of research among women living with HIV is provided to illustrate the relationship between mental and physical health, to consider possible pathways through which mental and physical health interact, and to consider implications for social work practice. In this study, Ickovics and colleagues (2001) found that women with chronic depres- sion were twice as likely to die as women with limited or no depressive symptoms. In addi- tion, when controlling for sociodemographic background, clinical status, and substance use, chronic depression predicted decline in CD4 cell counts among women in the study. Al- though the causal mechanisms in this relation- ship remain unclear, the authors propose four possible explanations:

1. The previously established impact of de- pression on morbidity and mortality via changes in neuroendocrine and immuno- logical functioning may have an interaction effect with the medical illness (see also Cohen & Herbert, 1996; Kemeny et al., 1994; Miller, Cohen, & Herbert, 1999).

2. Depression may contribute to engagement in risk behaviors, such as alcohol and to- bacco use, and to disengagement in health care, which may negatively infl uence health status.

3. The negative impact of depression on medi- cation adherence among people living with HIV may contribute to declines in health.

4. Although protease inhibitors have been shown to be associated with reductions in

JWBT514_ch08.indd 166JWBT514_ch08.indd 166 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Physical and Mental Health: Interactions, Assessment, and Interventions 167

symptoms of depression, fewer than half the women in the study received highly ac- tive antiretroviral therapy for HIV (Ickovics et al., 2001; Low-Beer et al., 2000). With suboptimal treatment experiences, women may have reduced access to both the physi- cal and the mental health gains associated with protease inhibitor treatment.

This example of the relationship between depression and mortality among women liv- ing with HIV underscores both the relevance of mental health in physical health outcomes and the complexity of possible pathways be- tween mental and physical health. Although medical intervention to address physical ill- ness may be the priority among the health-care team, mental health assessment and interven- tion is likely to be closely linked with physi- cal health outcomes. In terms of social work practice, this linkage highlights the critical role of assessing psychosocial conditions, including mental health and risk behaviors, and formulat- ing interventions that can support individuals’ overall health.

ASSESSING PSYCHOSOCIAL CONDITIONS IN HEALTH- CARE SETTINGS

Accurate assessment is at the heart of effec- tive social work intervention. As described by Meyer (1993), assessment involves “the think- ing process that seeks out the meaning of case situations, puts the particulars of the case in some order, and leads to appropriate interven- tions” (p. 2). In addition, the assessment is a relationship-building process with clients. The effort to identify the client’s presenting con- cern, factors that contribute to it, resources that can alleviate it, and how to address it is ide- ally a collaborative endeavor (Berlin & Marsh, 1993). As the social worker seeks to under- stand the client in his situation, her expression of interest and empathy and her engagement with the client as a respected collaborator can facilitate a positive helping relationship. Such

an alliance is an important component of ef- fective services (Horvath, 1995).

In health-care settings, social workers are likely to encounter people with a range of mental health experiences. Some people may be experiencing mild psychological distress and may benefi t from psychoeducation re- garding their physical conditions and support- ive counseling to enhance coping and stress management. Others may be experiencing severe psychological distress and may ben- efi t from intensive psychosocial interventions, including psychotherapy and psychopharma- cology (DHHS, 1999; IOM, 2001). The pro- cess through which a social worker or other professional considers the nature of a client’s mental health issues and their infl uencing fac- tors is called differential assessment. When the process is intended to identify a psychiat- ric diagnostic category, it is called differential diagnosis (American Psychiatric Association, 2000). This chapter uses the term differential assessment to refl ect a comprehensive focus that extends beyond diagnostic consider- ations. To guide differential assessment and thus appropriate intervention, this discussion covers several intersecting domains, includ- ing ecological factors, mental health symp- toms, physical conditions, medications, and substance use. Figure 8.1 illustrates various domains related to mental health symptoms; Figure 8.2 provides a more real-world depic- tion of the complex intersections among each of these domains.

Ecological Factors: Macrosystems, Exosystems, and Mesosystems

Although conceptualizations of the connec- tions between the person and the environment have varied, social workers have a long- standing history of recognizing the importance of a person-in-environment perspective (Berlin & Marsh, 1993; Germain & Gitterman, 1980; Hollis, 1939; Jordan & Franklin, 1995; Kondrat, 2002; Perlman, 1957; Richmond, 1917). Eco- logical systems theory (Bronfenbrenner, 1977, 1979, 1989) provides a lens through which

JWBT514_ch08.indd 167JWBT514_ch08.indd 167 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

168 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

Health Conditions

Ecological Factors*

Medications/ Medical

Treatment

Substance Use

Mental Health Symptoms

Co-Occurring Psychiatric Disorder(s)

Figure 8.2 Mental Health Symptoms

*For example, race, ethnicity, cultural background, SES, employment status, sexual orientation, spiritual background, family, social support, gender, and age.

Mental Health

Symptoms

Health Conditions

Ecological Factors*

Medications/ Medical

Treatment

Co-Occurring Psychiatric Disorder(s)

Substance Use

Figure 8.1 Domains Related to Mental Health Symptoms

*For example, race, ethnicity, cultural background, SES, employment status, sexual orientation, spiritual background, family, social support, gender, and age.

JWBT514_ch08.indd 168JWBT514_ch08.indd 168 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Physical and Mental Health: Interactions, Assessment, and Interventions 169

to employ this perspective in considering the transactional intersections of ecological fac- tors and physical and mental health. According to ecological systems theory, each individual experiences life within a unique intersecting web of systems. These intersecting systems can include the microsystem (i.e., individual activity, roles, physical and mental health status) and then broaden to the mesosystem (i.e., relationships with family, signifi cant oth- ers, peers), then to the exosystem (i.e., work, neighborhood, community), and fi nally to the macrosystem (i.e., culture and dominant pat- terned processes that inform numerous con- fi gurations, including politics, government, education, and law). Through this perspective, one can consider the relationships between physical and mental health within the context of relationships with signifi cant others and peers; interactions with community, school, work, or unemployment; and connections to broader cultural frameworks and governmen- tal institutions.

The importance of this perspective is not only its consistency with social work practice, which recognizes that individuals and their en- vironments exist in dynamic, mutually infl u- encing interaction (Kondrat, 2002), but also in the conclusion reached by the seminal report from the IOM (2001) that focuses on the in- teractions among biology, behavior, and social infl uences. After reviewing evidence gath- ered across numerous disciplines, the report concludes:

[H]ealth and behavior are infl uenced by fac- tors at multiple levels, including biological, psychological, and social. Interventions that involve only the person—for example, using self-control or willpower—are unlikely to change long-term behavior unless other fac- tors, such as family relationships, work situ- ation, or social norms, happen to be aligned to support a change. (p. 27)

To formulate an accurate assessment that will lead the social worker in the direction of ef- fective intervention, multisystemic infl uences need to be considered. Lack of attention to

the various components of an ecologically in- formed assessment may lead the social worker to focus excessively on either individual char- acteristics or environmental factors and result in faulty explanations regarding how to be most helpful (Berlin & Marsh, 1993).

A dispositional bias that focuses exces- sively on individual-level explanations of presenting problems is a common assessment error (Berlin & Marsh, 1993; Gambrill, 2006); however, complex social, political, and eco- nomic systems infl uence health behaviors and access to health-supporting resources (IOM, 2001). Effective assessment requires deliber- ate attention to multisystemic considerations. The ecological framework provides an effi - cient way to consider the numerous systems with which individuals interact and their mu- tual infl uence with physical and mental health.

This overview of an ecological approach to assessment begins with the macrosystem and concludes with in-depth attention to aspects of the microsystems of physical and mental health. This sequence of assessments acknowl- edges that complex, multisystemic factors in- fl uence physical and mental health. Beginning with the macrosystem places social and en- vironmental considerations in the foreground of the assessment and intervention processes. The critical importance of culturally compe- tent services and the growing body of evidence regarding health disparities based on race and socioeconomic background further support starting at the macrosystem and proceeding to exo-, meso-, and microlevel components of the assessment.

Macrosystems

Beginning with the broadest level, the macro- system, McGoldrick (1982) states that neither physical nor mental health problems can be assessed appropriately without understanding “the frame of reference of the person seek- ing help” (p. 6). A person’s cultural context informs this frame of reference and infl u- ences how she will identify and label prob- lems (McGoldrick, 1982). In addition, cultural infl uences may shape the experience and

JWBT514_ch08.indd 169JWBT514_ch08.indd 169 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

170 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

communication of pain, expected or desired treatment, understanding of illness causes, coping styles, and perspectives regarding whom to turn to for help (e.g., primary care physician, mental health provider, traditional healer, clergy) (DHHS, 2001a; McGoldrick, 1982). In the context of assessing and inter- vening to address mental health in health-care settings, these considerations become particu- larly salient in several ways.

The ways in which symptoms are expe- rienced and described will intersect with the social worker’s understanding of what is the matter and how to help (Berlin & Marsh, 1993; McGoldrick, 1982). Generalized statements re- garding culture and cultural norms, values, and expectations run the risk of conveying stereo- typed information that may obscure individual differences and experiences and may over- look diversity within a culture (Yellow Bird, Fong, Galindo, Nowicki, & Freeman, 1996); however, such information, when provided and used appropriately, can broaden the social worker’s cultural knowledge base and inform efforts to reach a shared understanding of the client’s experiences (Kerson, 2002). With this caveat in mind, somatization—the expression of feelings of distress through physical symp- toms—refl ects an important intersection be- tween culture and physical and mental health (DHHS, 2001a). Powerful infl uences are likely to contribute to somatization across cultural groups, including the culture’s understanding of the connection between mind and body, culturally accepted ways of expressing dis- tress, and culturally informed stigma regarding mental illness (DHHS, 2001a). For example, a limited body of research suggests that, among people who are American Indian and Alaska Native, there is not a clear distinction between mind and body, and it is likely that such people express distress in both somatic and psycho- logical terms (DHHS, 2001a). Among several Asian cultures, mental illness carries signifi - cant stigma; the weight of this stigma may infl uence the likelihood of people from Asian backgrounds expressing psychological dis- tress in physical symptoms (DHHS, 2001a). Cultural perspectives regarding the connection

between mind and body also may infl uence this likelihood (Lin & Cheung, 1999); how- ever, when asked explicitly about mental health, research suggests that Asian clients will report symptoms in psychological terms (DHHS, 2001a; Lin & Cheung, 1999).

Common examples of somatization among people who are Puerto Rican, Mexican, and White include stomach-related problems, chest pain, and palpitations. Among people in Africa and South Asia, somatization may involve sen- sations of “burning hands and feet,” “worms in the head,” or “ants crawling under the skin.” Among some Asian groups, somatization may involve blurred vision, dizziness, and vertigo (DHHS, 2001a, p. 11). In terms of social work practice in health-care settings, the possible somatization of psychological distress under- scores the importance of routine screening for mental health concerns.

To provide culturally competent assess- ment and intervention, it is critical that social workers become informed about their own and their clients’ cultural beliefs about experiences of physical and mental health (DHHS, 2001a; Pinderhughes, 1989; Rolland, 1994). Such competence is vital to recognize and support normative coping in the midst of physical or mental illness and to avoid misassessment of physical and mental health symptoms (Lin & Cheung, 1999). The next paragraphs discuss some strategies to assist social workers with increasing their cultural competence in ad- dressing mental health in health-care settings.

Becoming more mindful of one’s own cul- tural beliefs about physical and mental health may enhance self-awareness and capacity to engage in culturally competent assessment and intervention (Pinderhughes, 1989; Rolland, 1994). Social workers should consider spe- cifi c ways in which their cultural background infl uences their values regarding expressions of distress and mental and physical illness. One particularly signifi cant domain in the as- sessment of mental health pertains to cultural expectations regarding expression of emotion. To what degree does a person’s cultural back- ground encourage open expression of emotion or limit its direct expression? Social workers’

JWBT514_ch08.indd 170JWBT514_ch08.indd 170 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Physical and Mental Health: Interactions, Assessment, and Interventions 171

own beliefs about expected displays of emotion are likely to infl uence the lens through which they assess client experiences. For example, a social worker whose cultural background en- courages direct expression of emotion may view a person who is reserved in emotional expression as having a problematic restricted range of affect, when, in fact, the behavior is consistent with the person’s cultural context and does not refl ect a problem in emotional expres- sion. Awareness of this lens can foster refl ec- tion regarding culturally informed assessment and the recognition that “cultural differences are not deviances” (Pinderhughes, 1989, p. 17). Additional salient domains for social workers to consider include their own culturally informed expectations regarding how people respond to physical pain and values regarding mental ill- ness and psychological distress.

Exploring clients’ cultural identity with them can explain implications of culture in their presenting concerns and service prefer- ences, including culturally informed ways of expressing distress and preferred types of help. Furthermore, explorations of culture, immigra- tion, and acculturation contribute salient infor- mation to ecologically informed assessments (American Psychiatric Association, 2000).

Becoming better informed about the cul- tures of the people social workers serve and about evidence-based interventions that are culturally relevant to them can be important avenues to enhancing intervention effective- ness (Carlton-LaNey, 1999; DHHS, 2001a; Pinderhughes, 1989).

As outlined in Chapter 10 of this book, ex- ploring clients’ beliefs about their illnesses, their desired outcomes, and their service preferences may be facilitated by using these questions (Kleinman, Eisenberg, & Good, 1978, p. 256):

What do you think has caused your problem?

Why do you think it started when it did? What do you think your sickness does to

you? How does it work? How severe is your sickness? Will it have

a short or long course?

What kind of treatment do you think you should receive?

What are the most important results you hope to receive from this treatment?

What are the chief problems your sickness has caused for you?

What do you fear most about your sickness?

Becoming better attuned to issues of com- monality and difference, including race, eth- nicity, culture, socioeconomic status (SES), gender, sexual orientation, age, physical abil- ity, and power, between the social worker and the clients served may facilitate addressing these elements within the helping relationship (American Psychiatric Association, 1994; Pin- derhughes, 1989).

Actively considering clients’ spiritual be- liefs can contribute to the provision of cul- turally competent services. As described by Kerson (2002), spiritual beliefs and health beliefs often are intertwined and warrant at- tention that is comparable to other cultural be- liefs. Walsh (2004) further describes the role of prayer, meditation, and faith in numerous positive health outcomes, including reduced stress, decreased blood pressure and cortisol levels, improved management of chronic pain, reduced problems with alcohol or other drugs, and reduced depression. Walsh also asserts, “Over 350 studies point to religion as the for- gotten factor in physical and mental health” (p. 198). Beliefs may provide a powerful source of cognitive assistance to people who are experiencing physical and mental health diffi culties. They may facilitate a sense of co- herence, meaning, and control (Walsh, 2004).

In addition to supporting a worldview that facilitates meaning, Musick, Traphagan, Koenig, and Larson (2000) provide three fur- ther pathways through which religion may positively infl uence health: (1) supporting positive health behaviors (e.g., healthier diets, reduced drinking and smoking, increased physical activity); (2) fostering social integra- tion and support (e.g., shared beliefs, larger social network, opportunities for conversation, learning, support); and (3) providing comfort

JWBT514_ch08.indd 171JWBT514_ch08.indd 171 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

172 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

(e.g., emotional and instrumental support, re- ligious rituals for assistance in diffi cult times, source of hope and coping). Spirituality and religion may be important resources, but as- sessment should be sensitive to these topics as potential sources of confl icted or nega- tive feelings (Gotterer, 2001). Open-ended inquiry that is sensitive to a diversity of ex- periences and that elicits the client’s unique experiences can be a useful starting point for active consideration of spiritual beliefs. Chapter 11 of this book may help in address- ing these issues further; the chapter provides additional detail regarding ways in which culture intersects with health, including ways in which bodily sensations are recognized as symptoms of illness.

Although cultural competence facilitates the recognition of strengths of cultural infl uences and coping in the midst of health challenges (McGoldrick, 1982), the infl uences of race- related health disparities are particularly salient in the context of physical and mental health. An ecologically informed assessment requires contextual knowledge of these disparities and their implications for effective services. The extent of race-related disparities in physical and mental health is staggering. For example, in comparison to their White counterparts, people who are African American are more than twice as likely to experience infant mor- tality and to give birth to a low-weight infant; they also have considerably higher prevalence of tuberculosis, greater exposure to unhealthy air, and considerably higher death rates associ- ated with heart disease, stroke, all cancers, and homicide (Keppel, Pearcy, & Wagener, 2002; Weir et al., 2003). Although African American people have lower rates of major depression and alcohol dependence than their White coun- terparts, they are likely to experience more se- vere, persistent symptoms and to receive less treatment (Grant, 1997; D. R. Williams et al., 2007; D. R. Williams, Mohammed, Leavell, & Collins, 2010). Furthermore, in addition to increased risk of dying from cardiovascu- lar disease, people who are African American experience increased risk of burden associated with the condition than do people who are

White (Hahn, Heath, & Chang, 1998; Offi ce of Minority Health, Centers for Disease Control and Prevention [CDC], n.d.; Parmley, 2001). Although epidemiological studies indicate in- creased prevalence of cardiovascular-disease risk factors among people who are African American (e.g., physical inactivity, being over- weight, hypertension, diabetes mellitus) (Hahn et al., 1998), it is also important to consider the ways in which such disparities are shaped by structural inequities that infl uence access to health care and to resources that support health, including safe living, working, and ex- ercising environments and healthy dietary op- tions (Keppel et al., 2002; Winkleby, Kraemer, Ahn, & Varady, 1998; Wyatt et al., 2003; also see Chapter 7 in this book). In addition, al- though race and socioeconomic inequalities intersect and additional research is needed to identify the ways in which they (along with gender) infl uence health, several studies indi- cate that race-related health disparities persist even when controlling for socioeconomic fac- tors (for discussion, see Williams et al., 2010).

Racial discrimination is another salient macrolevel consideration related to physical and mental health disparities (Krieger, 2003; D. R. Williams, Neighbors, & Jackson, 2003). A large body of research conducted across di- verse cultural groups indicates that discrimi- nation is associated with health problems and, in particular, with mental health problems (D. R. Williams et al., 2003; D. R. Williams & Mohammed, 2009; Yoo, Gee, & Takeuchi, 2009); however, the mechanisms through which discrimination infl uences health are still being explored (Krieger, 2003; D. R. Williams et al., 2003; D. R. Williams & Mohammed, 2009). One conceptualization of this relation- ship suggests that experiencing discrimination is a source of stress that can negatively infl u- ence health through physiological pathways and through behaviors that increase illness risk (D. R. Williams et al., 2003; D. R. Williams & Mohammed, 2009).

Building on this conceptualization are examinations of the mediating role of cop- ing in the relationship between discrimina- tion and health (Noh & Kaspar, 2003). As

JWBT514_ch08.indd 172JWBT514_ch08.indd 172 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Physical and Mental Health: Interactions, Assessment, and Interventions 173

described by Noh and Kaspar, this body of research considers differences in health based on whether people exposed to discrimination employ emotion-focused coping or problem- focused coping. Emotion-focused coping gen- erally includes cognitions that aim to reduce distress, including minimization, avoidance, distancing, and fi nding positive elements of negative circumstances (Lazarus & Folkman, 1984). Problem-focused coping generally in- volves steps to solve a problem, including specifying the problem, considering potential solutions, evaluating strengths and limitations of potential solutions, choosing a solution, and taking action (Lazarus & Folkman, 1984). There have been divergent fi ndings regarding the health effects of emotion- and problem- focused coping among members of diverse culture and gender groups. Noh and Kaspar (2003) assert that the effectiveness of coping is likely shaped by the nature of the stressor and the individual’s resources, social context, cul- tural background, and degree of acculturation.

Another conceptualization of the possible mechanisms through which discrimination negatively affects health comes from the work of Krieger (2003). She argues that the infl u- ence of racism on health should be examined through research on these issues: “(1) eco- nomic and social deprivation; (2) toxic sub- stances and hazardous conditions; (3) socially infl icted trauma . . . ; (4) targeted marketing of commodities that can harm health, such as junk food and psychoactive substances . . . ; and (5) inadequate or degrading medical care” (p. 196). Although Krieger recognizes the role of individual- and community-level coping and action to counter discrimination, these fi ve potential pathways underscore systemic and multilevel infl uences of racism on health. This body of knowledge is evolving, but im- plications for social work practice include attention to individual coping strategies to manage stress and support health and systemic factors that negatively infl uence physical and mental health. Additional considerations on how to support psychological well-being and coping when experiencing serious illness are addressed in the “Psychosocial Intervention

Strategies in Health-Care Settings” section of this chapter.

Exosystems

Exosystem issues regarding SES, including income, education, and employment, are also likely to intersect with microlevel physical and mental health issues. In fact, as described by McGinnis and colleagues (2002), “for the population as a whole, the most consistent pre- dictor of the likelihood of death in any given year is level of education; persons ages 45 to 64 in the highest levels of education have death rates 2.5 times lower than those in the lowest level” (p. 81). Individual poverty and societal inequality of income distribution also negatively affect mortality among people with lower incomes (McGinnis et al., 2002). In ad- dition to mortality risks associated with lower SES is an increased risk of mental health prob- lems (DHHS, 1999; Siefert, Bowman, Hefl in, Danziger, & Williams, 2000). Comparisons between people in the extremes of SES sug- gest that annual prevalence of mental disorders among people at the lower end are approxi- mately twice that of those at the higher end (World Health Organization [WHO], 2001).

The increased prevalence of mental health problems among people with lower SES has been explained in two primary ways. The fi rst explanation is that the increased risk of acute and chronic stressors among people living in poverty may contribute to their increased risk of mental health problems (Siefert et al., 2000). This explanation is referred to as so- cial causation, in which social circumstances have a causal link with mental health prob- lems. The second explanation, referred to as social selection, argues that mental health problems cause people to move downward in SES (Dohrenwend et al., 1992; Saraceno & Barbui, 1997). Social causation appears most relevant for women experiencing depression and for men experiencing antisocial personal- ity and substance use disorders while social selection appears most relevant among those experiencing schizophrenia (Dohrenwend et al., 1992; Siefert et al., 2000). Among children, recent research suggests that social causation

JWBT514_ch08.indd 173JWBT514_ch08.indd 173 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

174 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

may be most relevant for young people ex- periencing oppositional or conduct disorders and that parental monitoring mediates this re- lationship, such that changing poverty level is associated with increased parental monitor- ing, which in turn is associated with decreased mental health symptoms (Costello, Compton, Keller, & Angold, 2003). This study did not fi nd that social causation was as relevant for symptoms of anxiety and depression among the participants.

SES also is associated with the course of mental health problems. Numerous factors may infl uence this relationship, including ob- stacles related to accessing care, lack of health insurance, and lack of culturally and linguisti- cally appropriate services (WHO, 2001). For social workers addressing mental health issues in health-care settings, the increased risk of physical and mental health problems among people with lower SES underscores the impor- tance of designing and delivering services to reach this population.

Research on stress and coronary artery dis- ease provides an example of the specifi c ways

CASE EXAMPLE

Joseph is a 52-year-old, heterosexual, single man of Italian American ancestry who has worked in various construction positions for the past 20 years. Although Joseph earns enough money to pay most of his monthly bills, his employer does not provide health insurance, and his income exceeds the eligibility criteria for Medicaid. Joseph recently presented in the emergency room reporting chest pains and shortness of breath, which ultimately were diagnosed as symptoms of myocardial infarction. Upon consultation with the health-care team, Joseph was encouraged to begin a medication regimen and urged to reduce his work hours, to reduce the stress in his life, and to improve his eating habits because he generally relied on low-cost, high-fat takeout for lunch and dinner. Upon discharge from the hospital, Joseph agreed to follow the health-care

team’s recommendations and enrolled in the hospital’s stress management program.

Within two weeks of beginning the stress management program, Joseph reports that his bills are accumulating due to his efforts to work fewer hours and that he has just received a hefty bill for his hospital services in addition to expensive prescribed medications. Joseph reports that he feels better since reducing his work hours and attending the stress management program but fears he will be unable to pay his bills and might lose his house if he does not return to his prior work schedule. He also says that he thinks returning to work might reduce his general level of stress, because much of it originates with fi nancial pressures and pressure from his boss to work longer days. Joseph fears his boss might replace him with another worker who can maintain the demanding hours.

in which SES intersects with mental and phys- ical health. Krantz and colleagues (2000) dis- cuss factors that may contribute to the inverse relationship between SES and cardiac morbid- ity and mortality, including limited access to health care, increased prevalence of risks (e.g., smoking, high blood pressure), inadequate nu- trition, and social and environmental stress. The hypothetical case example below illus- trates this point in regard to implications for social work practice.

As this case depicts, supporting Joseph’s physical and mental well-being involves consideration not only of individual coping and stress management strategies but also of broader systems, including employment and socioeconomic resources. Furthermore, as the case depicts, the relationship between socioeconomic resources and health can be a bidirectional one (Adler & Stewart, 2010; Kawachi, Adler, & Dow, 2010).

Mesosystems

Attention to clients’ family and social contexts refl ects the mesosystem from an ecological

JWBT514_ch08.indd 174JWBT514_ch08.indd 174 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Physical and Mental Health: Interactions, Assessment, and Interventions 175

perspective. Numerous empirical studies sup- port the vital role of family and social support in physical and mental health outcomes (for ex- amples, see Allgšwer, Wardle, & Steptoe, 2001; Bagner, Fernandez, & Eyberg, 2004; DiMatteo, 2004a; McFarlane et al., 1995; for reviews, see Campbell, 2003; Weihs, Fisher, & Baird, 2002). When considering issues of physical and mental health in the context of family and social relationships, it is important to pay at- tention to the meaning, diversity, and strengths of these relationships. In her discussion of the course of psychotherapeutic intervention with a lesbian woman struggling with infertility, Brown (1991) writes, “[D]uring the process of infertility treatments and fertility testing, Carla [the client] always had to anticipate having to explain to yet another person where her hus- band wasn’t and who Susan [her partner] was” (p. 25). Such anticipation of a heterosexist bias is likely to fuel a client’s emotional disengage- ment from the health-care team and unlikely to facilitate effective intervention to support the mesolevel intimate relationships in the client’s life. To support clients in their intimate relation- ships and to support their physical and mental health, information gathering should proceed with open-ended, inclusive questions that do not presume particular responses.

In addition and as previously described, it is likely that macrosystemic issues such as homophobia may interact with microsystem physical and mental health conditions. Brown (1991) describes this complexity in relation to dominant cultural expectations of women to be wives and mothers. Women who are lesbian and struggling with infertility may confront complex issues regarding their identity in this dominant cultural context. These intersecting cultural and personal experiences may create “diffi culties both in valuing herself and being valued by others, diffi culties that may be dis- tressing enough to merit psychotherapeutic intervention” (Brown, 1991, p. 15). In Chap- ter 13 of this book, Rolland discusses relation- ships among individuals, families, and health and ways in which social workers can inter- vene to foster coping and positive health out- comes among families in health-care settings.

Informed by relational theory, the research of Kayser and Sormanti (2002a) suggests that women’s psychosocial response to cancer is likely to be infl uenced by close connections with others and that these connections are in- terwoven with women’s sense of identity. In addition, their research suggests that experi- encing cancer may infl uence identity by affect- ing the ways in which women who are mothers alter their priorities (Kayser & Sormanti, 2002b). For example, women in this study de- scribed: enjoying their families and their lives with greater intensity; learning about their identities apart from their functions as work- ers, partners, and mothers; fi nding deep per- sonal strength and self-effi cacy; experiencing greater empathy and authenticity in their rela- tionships; and examining the balance between caring for self and others.

Interventions to help people experiencing changes in their sense of identity and to support their social relationships as they face illness are important aspects of the social worker’s role in health-care settings. Such interventions are likely to have important implications for posi- tive health outcomes. In fact, social isolation is said to increase the risk of mortality by 2 to 5 times compared with the presence of rela- tionships with family, friends, and community (McGinnis et al., 2002). Given that a number of mental health conditions may contribute to social withdrawal and social isolation (Ameri- can Psychiatric Association, 2000), individuals experiencing concurrent physical and mental health conditions may be a particularly vulner- able group. As part of a comprehensive assess- ment, social workers should explore clients’ social support, including attention to compo- sition and size of the person’s social network, types of social support available, positive and negative components of available support, and strengths and obstacles to engaging with others and sharing support.

Microsystems

Bearing in mind the complex intersections between the multiple systems in the ecologi- cal framework, this discussion now turns to

JWBT514_ch08.indd 175JWBT514_ch08.indd 175 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

176 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

microsystems of physical and mental health. Given the high prevalence of depression and anxiety disorders across all age groups and their increased prevalence among people ex- periencing chronic illnesses, they will be the primary focus of this discussion of assessment and intervention. It should be noted that al- though this discussion focuses on depression and anxiety disorders as discrete conditions, they frequently co-occur with each other and with other psychiatric and substance use disor- ders. There is growing recognition of these con- current conditions, the challenges associated with them, and the importance of integrated

treatment to assist people experiencing them (American Academy of Child and Adolescent Psychiatry [AACAP], 2010; Campbell et al., 2007; Center for Substance Abuse Treatment [CSAT], 2005, 2009; Engstrom, El-Bassel, Go, & Gilbert, 2008; Engstrom, Shibusawa, El-Bassel, & Gilbert, 2011; National Institute of Mental Health [NIMH], 2008). Implica- tions for assessment and intervention with children experiencing co-occurring conduct disorder and health conditions are discussed in Box 8.1. Further information that focuses entirely on children and older adults can be found in Chapters 15 and 16 of this book.

Box 8.1 Intersections Between Disruptive Disorders and Health Conditions: Assisting Parents and Children

Each year approximately 1 out of 10 children is likely to experience a disruptive disorder, such as attention-defi cit/hyperactivity disorder, conduct disorder, or oppositional defi ant disorder (DHHS, 1999; Shaffer et al., 1996). The symptoms associated with disruptive disorders, including signifi cant diffi culties following directions, limited tolerance for frustration, impulsive behavior, and opposition to authority fi gures, pose particular challenges for children who are experiencing co-occurring health conditions. In addition, children’s ability to benefi t from health-care services may be limited by their diffi culties following through with adult requests to adhere to medical recommendations (e.g., diet, medicine, other treatment) and to avoid behaviors that worsen illness or interfere with treatment (e.g., engaging in restricted activities, removing bandages, moving around during exams or treatment) (Bagner et al., 2004; Matthews, Spieth, & Christophersen, 1995). Although the study presented here focuses on a child experiencing a disruptive disorder and bladder cancer, it likely has relevance for those experiencing other conditions commonly seen among children in health-care settings, including asthma, diabetes, and epilepsy.

Based on a case study of a 4-year- old boy, “Robert Smith,” experiencing oppositional defi ant disorder and bladder cancer, Bagner and colleagues (2004) suggest that parent–child interaction therapy (PCIT) holds promise as an effective intervention to address co-occurring disruptive behavior and persistent physical illness. On referral for psychological services, Robert was screaming, yelling, and hitting during medical visits. His behavioral diffi culties were exacerbated when he began chemotherapy. In one instance, he swung the bag fi lled with his chemotherapy over his head, resulting in its spilling on his mother and one of the nurses.

The two phases of PCIT include an initial focus on child-directed interaction (CDI) that aims to enhance the relationship between the parent and child, the degree of positive parental communication with the child, and the child’s social skills through play therapy. In the CDI phase, parents are guided to use nondirective skills outlined by the acronym PRIDE: praise for the child, refl ection of the child’s statements, imitation of the child’s play, description of the child’s behavior, and enthusiasm in the play (Bagner et al., 2004, p. 3). Parents are coached during this phase to employ PRIDE skills while ignoring negative behaviors and avoiding criticism,

JWBT514_ch08.indd 176JWBT514_ch08.indd 176 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Physical and Mental Health: Interactions, Assessment, and Interventions 177

questions, and commands directed toward the child. The second phase focuses on parent-directed interaction. Similar to behavioral intervention, this phase aims to enhance parenting skills in these domains: expectations of their children, limit-setting ability, and consistent discipline.

After 12 sessions of PCIT, Robert displayed numerous clinically signifi cant improvements in his behavior as measured by the Child Behavior Checklist and the Eyberg Child Behavior Inventory, and his behavior was no longer consistent with a diagnosis of oppositional defi ant disorder. Robert’s behavioral gains transferred to medical visits, as noted by his physician and social worker, who described increased adherence and an absence of aggression in his behavior. In

addition, Ms. Smith experienced clinically signifi cant reduction in her parenting stress.

Although this case example presents but one illustration of the effectiveness of PCIT with a child experiencing co-occurring oppositional defi ant disorder and a serious health condition, its effi cacy with several other populations of children experiencing disruptive behaviors and disorders (Brestan & Eyberg, 1998; Eisenstadt, Eyberg, McNeil, Newcomb, & Funderburk, 1993; Hood & Eyberg, 2003; McNeil, Eyberg, Eisenstadt, Newcomb, & Funderburk, 1991; Nixon, Sweeney, Erickson, & Touyz, 2003; Schuhmann, Foote, Eyberg, Boggs, & Algina, 1998) further suggests that PCIT may be useful for clinicians, parents, and children to address such co-occurring health issues.

Prevalence

According to the Surgeon General’s Report on Mental Health, each year approximately 1 in 5 people of all ages is likely to experi- ence psychiatric symptoms that meet crite- ria for a diagnosable mental health condition (DHHS, 1999). Anxiety disorders, which can include posttraumatic stress disorder, simple phobia, social phobia, agoraphobia, generalized anxiety disorder, panic disorder, and obsessive-compulsive disorder, have the highest annual prevalence among children (ages 9–17 years, 13%), adults (ages 18–54 years, 16.4%), and older adults (over age 55 years, 11.4%) (DHHS, 1999). Among chil- dren, disruptive disorders follow in annual prevalence, with an estimated 10.3% of children meeting diagnostic criteria and ex- periencing mild global impairment (DHHS, 1999). Annual prevalence of mood disor- ders, which can include major depressive episode, unipolar major depression, dysthy- mia, and bipolar disorder, is estimated to be 6.2% among children, 7.1% among adults, and 4.4% among older adults (DHHS, 1999). Psychiatric and substance use disor- ders often are described and classifi ed based on the diagnostic criteria of the Diagnostic

and Statistical Manual of Mental Disorders, Fourth Edition, Text Revision (DSM-IV-TR) (American Psychiatric Association, 2000), as described in Box 8.2.

Among people with serious and persistent illnesses, prevalence rates of mental health conditions that meet DSM-IV-TR diagnos- tic criteria are likely to be elevated (Aben et al., 2003; American Psychiatric Associa- tion, 2000; Bing et al., 2001). For example, among a large, representative sample of adults engaged in HIV-related medical care, prevalence of psychiatric disorders was 47.9%, which is higher than twice the preva- lence among community participants (Bing et al., 2001; DHHS, 1999). Among people living with HIV, major depression and dys- thymia were the most common conditions, and 21% experienced both conditions; gen- eralized anxiety disorders and panic attacks followed in prevalence (Bing et al., 2001). Prevalence estimates of depressive symp- toms and major depression among people experiencing cancer vary considerably— between 1% and 42% (Patrick et al., 2003). Prevalence estimates of anxiety disorders also encompass a broad range, 10% to 30%, based on large-scale research that employed

JWBT514_ch08.indd 177JWBT514_ch08.indd 177 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

178 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

Box 8.2 DSM and Multiaxial Assessment

A commonly used method for describing and classifying the types of mental health symptoms a person is experiencing, along with additional information regarding other health conditions, environmental stressors, and their overall functioning, is the multiaxial assessment contained in the Diagnostic and Statistical Manual of Mental Disorders, Fourth Edition, Text Revision (DSM-IV-TR) (American Psychiatric Association, 2000). Although there are numerous critiques of the DSM-IV-TR (Kirk & Kutchins, 1992; Mechanic, 1999; Saleebey, 2002; Wakefi eld, 1999), its wide usage as a classifi cation and communication system in physical and mental health settings supports developing familiarity with it (Kerson, 2002; Williams, 1998). Components of the DSM-IV multiaxial assessment tool are introduced here. More detailed information and the most recent text revisions of the DSM-IV can be found in the DSM-IV-TR. A comprehensive revision of the DSM currently is under way. The Diagnostic and Statistical Manual of Mental Disorders: Fifth Edition (DSM-5) is expected to be published in May 2013.

The DSM-IV multiaxial assessment (American Psychiatric Association, 1994, 2000) generally focuses on describing and communicating the problems people are experiencing; however, social workers have a commitment to recognize and to build on people’s strengths (Saleebey, 2002). In multiaxial assessment, it is important to be attuned to, to recognize, and to formulate interventions that build on clients’ strengths. No matter how dire a situation may be, people have strengths that have fueled their perseverance and survival to the point at which they come into contact with the social worker. Actively refl ecting on and engaging people’s strengths, which may include their knowledge, capacities, and resources, are arguably central components of clients “achieving their goals and visions and . . . [having] a better quality of life on

their terms” (Saleebey, 2002, pp. 1–2). Developing a specifi c notation regarding client strengths may provide a useful tool for active consideration of and engagement with clients’ strengths as part of the multiaxial assessment.

According to the DSM-IV-TR, multiaxial assessment includes these domains:

• Axis I—Clinical Disorders Other Disorders That May Be a Focus of Clinical Attention

• Axis II—Personality Disorders, Mental Retardation

• Axis III—General Medical Conditions • Axis IV—Psychosocial and Environmental

Problems • Axis V—Global Assessment of

Functioning (American Psychiatric Association, 1994, p. 25; American Psychiatric Association, 2000, p. 27)

This discussion of the differential assessment of physical and mental health focuses primarily on Axis I, Clinical Disorders, such as major depressive episode or generalized anxiety disorder; Axis III, General Medical Conditions, such as cardiovascular disease or HIV; and Axis IV, Psychosocial and Environmental Problems, such as homelessness, long- standing poverty, or recent loss. Because social workers have specialized training in addressing the interactions between people and their environments, they are likely to have particular ability to address issues related to Axis IV; however, it is worth noting that in addition to this expertise, estimates suggest that there are more social workers in the psychotherapy workforce (192,814) than psychologists (73,018), psychiatrists (33,486), and psychiatric nurses (15,330) combined (Center for Mental Health Services, 2001; Insel, 2004). As described throughout this chapter, social workers’ attention to the interface between the person and environment is an important aspect of

JWBT514_ch08.indd 178JWBT514_ch08.indd 178 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Physical and Mental Health: Interactions, Assessment, and Interventions 179

standardized interviews and diagnostic cri- teria (Stark et al., 2002). Methodological limitations likely contribute to these wide ranges; however, the National Institutes of Health’s State-of-the-Science Panel (Patrick et al., 2003) states that “the most common symptoms of cancer and treatments for cancer are pain, depression, and fatigue” (p. 110). Among people experiencing stroke or myocardial infarction, new cases of de- pression were identifi ed in 38.7% and 28.4% of a group of people receiving care in the Netherlands; when adjusted for age, sex, and degree of disability, the rates of depression were comparable (Aben et al., 2003).

It is also important to consider trauma in the context of health and comprehensive assessment. Lifetime exposure to trauma— including exposure to seeing someone being seriously injured or killed; a fi re, fl ood, or nat- ural disaster; a life-threatening accident; com- bat; physical attacks; and sexual assaults—is estimated to occur among 61% of men and 51% of women in the United States (Kessler, Sonnega, Bromet, Hughes, & Nelson, 1995); however, in the current context of post-9/11 experiences, a global war on terror, and home- land security alerts within the United States, perceived risk or threat to one’s safety and related psychological sequelae may be more

both differential assessment and intervention in mental and physical health; however, the ability to understand and to intervene to address these complex co-occurring issues also requires substantive background and training in additional psychotherapeutic interventions, some of which are discussed in the “Psychosocial Intervention Strategies in Health-Care Settings” section of this chapter.

Axis II identifi es personality disorders and mental retardation. There are 10 specifi c personality disorders: paranoid personality disorder, schizoid personality disorder, schizotypal personality disorder, antisocial personality disorder, borderline personality disorder, histrionic personality disorder, narcissistic personality disorder, avoidant personality disorder, dependent personality disorder, and obsessive-compulsive personality disorder. Personality disorders that do not meet diagnostic criteria for any of the 10 types identifi ed are categorized as personality disorder not otherwise specifi ed (NOS). People with a personality disorder generally experience “an enduring pattern of inner experience and behavior that deviates markedly from the expectations of the individual’s culture, is pervasive and infl exible, has an onset in adolescence or early adulthood, is stable over time, and leads to distress or impairment” (American

Psychiatric Association, 2000, p. 685). As with the clinical disorders recorded on Axis I, the DSM-IV-TR includes specifi c diagnostic criteria for each of the personality disorders.

Axis V includes the Global Assessment of Functioning (GAF) scale, which refl ects the clinician’s assessment of the client’s overall functioning in psychological, social, and occupational domains. The GAF does not consider the infl uence of physical and environmental conditions. The GAF is a constructed continuum in which functioning associated with mental health is ranked on a scale of 1 to 100 (a ranking of 0 indicates inadequate information). A GAF rating of 10 is associated with “persistent danger of severely hurting self or others”; a GAF rating of 50 is associated with “serious symptoms (e.g., suicidal ideation, severe obsessional rituals, frequent shoplifting) or any serious impairment in social, occupational, or school functioning (e.g., no friends, unable to keep a job)”; and a GAF rating of 91 is associated with “superior functioning in a wide range of activities” (American Psychiatric Association, 2000, p. 34). Detailed information and guidance regarding how to formulate a GAF rating can be found in the DSM-IV-TR (American Psychiatric Association, 2000).

JWBT514_ch08.indd 179JWBT514_ch08.indd 179 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

180 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

prevalent than earlier estimates (Susser, Herman, & Aaron, 2002). Estimates from 1995 suggest that approximately 5.0% of men and 10.4% of women ages 18 to 54 years ex- perience psychological effects of trauma that meet the diagnostic criteria for posttraumatic stress disorder (PTSD), a type of anxiety dis- order, in their lifetime (American Psychiatric Association, 2000; Kessler et al., 1995).

In the context of U.S. involvement in cur- rent military confl icts, the risk of PTSD and other mental health concerns among military members and veterans is particularly salient. Recent estimates indicate that among veter- ans who served in Operation Iraqi Freedom or Operation Enduring Freedom and sought services at the Veterans Administration (VA), 25% met diagnostic criteria for a mental health condition. In addition, 13% of men and 11% of women in the study met diagnostic criteria for PTSD. Veterans younger than 40 years, es- pecially those ages 18 to 25 years, are more likely to experience PTSD and other mental health conditions when compared with those older than 40 years (Seal, Bertenthal, Miner, Sen, & Marmar, 2007).

In addition to risks associated with their military service, female veterans’ experi- ences may be complicated by exposure to sexual harassment and assault within the military. Among a nationally representative sample of 3,632 female veterans seeking care at the VA, an estimated 55% experienced sexual harassment and 23% experienced sexual assault in the military (Skinner et al., 2000). These experiences are associated with increased risk for PTSD, problematic sub- stance use, other mental health concerns, health problems, and employment diffi culties (Skinner et al., 2000; Surís, Lind, Kashner, Borman, & Petty, 2004).

Despite the signifi cant mental health needs of many veterans, active military members, and their families, stigma, concerns regard- ing professional ramifi cations, and inadequate funding limit the availability and use of mental health services (Department of Defense Task Force on Mental Health, 2007; Hoge et al., 2004; DHHS, 2001a). A recent report by the

Department of Defense Task Force on Men- tal Health calls for strategies to strengthen re- silience, to reach military members and their families across a continuum of care, and to reduce stigma by ensuring that mental health care is an integrated component of military ser- vice. Give an Hour, an organization committed to linking current military personnel and their families with free mental health services, is a resource that addresses some of these calls to action (www.giveanhour.org). Additional information regarding assessing and respond- ing to veterans’ and family members’ mental health needs can be found online through the National Center for PTSD (www.ptsd.va.gov /index.asp).

The connections between trauma and health are numerous.

1. Preexisting trauma exposure and its psychological sequelae are likely to interact with experiences of physical illness.

2. People may be seeking medical care as a direct result of a traumatic experience, such as a motor vehicle accident, sexual assault, or other physical attack.

3. Consistent with the traumatic events identifi ed in the DSM-IV-TR as potential precipitants of PTSD (American Psychiatric Association, 2000), Mundy and Baum (2004) underscore the utility of broadening the defi nition of trauma to include some medical conditions such as myocardial infarctions, which may be considered traumatic events because they represent a serious threat to a person’s life.

4. Research regarding PTSD and health- care usage suggests signifi cantly elevated rates of medically related hospitalization, visits to the emergency department, and visits to a medical provider among people experiencing PTSD (Stein, McQuaid, Pedrelli, Lenox, & McCahill, 2000).

Given the high prevalence of exposure to trau- matic events, their powerful intersection with individual health and medical care, and the

JWBT514_ch08.indd 180JWBT514_ch08.indd 180 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Physical and Mental Health: Interactions, Assessment, and Interventions 181

potential for people to experience clinically signifi cant symptoms of posttraumatic stress, even if they do not meet DSM-IV-TR diagnos- tic criteria for PTSD (American Psychiatric Association, 2000), this chapter includes dis- cussion of posttraumatic stress in health-care settings.

Detection

Several factors contribute the importance of routine mental health screening in health-care settings:

• The high prevalence of depression and anx- iety in the general population and among people with serious and persistent physical illnesses

• The signifi cant number of people, particu- larly people from racial and ethnic minority backgrounds, who seek mental health-care solely through primary care services

• The high prevalence (30%–50%) of people experiencing psychiatric disorders who go undetected in usual primary care

• The potential negative impact of psychiat- ric disorders on health outcomes (DHHS, 2001a; Lecrubier, 2004; Pignone et al., 2002; Regier et al., 1993)

Depression and anxiety can be expressed in health-care settings in a variety of ways. For example, a father may comment to a so- cial worker or other health-care provider that his teenage son “does not seem to be him- self.” The father might say that his son has been short-tempered lately, is sleeping more than usual, has experienced a decline in his grades, and has lost interest in social activi- ties that formerly interested him. The father has attempted to offer him incentives to im- prove his academic performance and to en- courage him to spend time with friends to no avail. Another individual may describe feeling fatigued, having sore muscles, and experienc- ing diffi culty falling asleep but attribute these symptoms to recent stress at work. As part of conducting a comprehensive assessment, the social worker would recognize that depression among children and adolescents may present

as irritability (American Psychiatric Associa- tion, 2000), and that symptoms of anxiety that are attributed to normalized conditions, such as stress at work, may not be detected ac- curately (Culpeper, 2003; Kessler, Lloyd, & Lewis, 1999). Equipped with the knowledge that detection of mood and anxiety disorders requires the consideration of atypical presen- tation of symptoms or behaviors, the social worker would understand that further assess- ment would be warranted for both individuals.

In health-care settings, depression and anxiety also may be expressed through fre- quent medical visits (more than fi ve per year) and through physical changes, such as weight gain or loss or sleeping problems (Institute for Clinical Systems Improvement, 2002). Anxi- ety in particular may be expressed through medically unexplained physical symptoms, such as chest pain, gastrointestinal problems, headache, or dizziness (Culpeper, 2003; Insti- tute for Clinical Systems Improvement, 2002). Physical concerns, rather than explicit con- cerns about anxiety, are expressed frequently by people experiencing panic disorders (Insti- tute for Clinical Systems Improvement, 2002). Although it is important not to invalidate an individual’s physical symptoms, recognizing that such symptoms may have a relationship with mental health concerns and, as discussed, may refl ect culturally informed somatization of distress can provide avenues to appropri- ate intervention and relief. However, some medical conditions, including coronary in- suffi ciency, chronic obstructive pulmonary disease, pancreatic tumor, hypoparathyroid- ism, pheochromocytoma, pulmonary emboli, certain cases of coronary artery disease, and certain epilepsies, may be eclipsed by symp- toms of anxiety and would warrant assess- ment by a physician. Culpeper suggests that if a person older than 35 years previously in good health does not have a history of prior anxiety symptoms, and describes new onset of anxiety, evaluation for possible medical condi- tions should be pursued. Such medical evalua- tion also would be indicated (a) when a client presents with symptoms of anxiety without a personal or family history of anxiety; (b) in

JWBT514_ch08.indd 181JWBT514_ch08.indd 181 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

182 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

the absence of a stressful life event; and po- tentially (c) when a client describes a high level of concern about the feelings of anxiety, which may suggest the presence of a physical condition rather than a mental health condi- tion. Social workers are well situated to refer clients for appropriate physical care and to further explore mental health issues that may manifest as physical symptoms. In addition to asking open-ended questions about the client’s mood, coping strategies, and daily function- ing, screening instruments and a formal mental status exam are two structured ways in which social workers can explore mental health in health-care settings.

Screening Instruments

Screening instruments, which identify men- tal health symptoms warranting additional assessment, may facilitate the detection of mood, anxiety, and trauma-related disorders in health-care settings. Such instruments can in- clude standardized scales with numerous items or just a few questions. They often are used in health-care settings in which certain psychoso- cial responses are seen frequently and in which their early detection is thought important for the achievement of optimal outcomes of care.

According to the U.S. Preventive Services Task Force (USPSTF; 2009), these screening questions may identify the majority of adults experiencing depression with effectiveness that is comparable to detailed instruments (p. 760):

• Over the last two weeks, have you felt down, depressed, or hopeless?

• Have you felt little interest or pleasure in doing things?

Positive responses to these questions suggest that additional assessment of depression and concurrent concerns (e.g., substance use prob- lems, other psychological distress) should be conducted to inform appropriate intervention (USPSTF, 2009).

Screening for specifi c anxiety disorders may be facilitated by the next questions proposed

by Levinson and Engel (1997). Each question aims to screen for a particular anxiety disorder. A positive response to any of these questions warrants further assessment of anxiety and of its impact on the individual’s daily life (Insti- tute for Clinical Systems Improvement, 2002, pp. 2–3).

• Would you describe yourself as a nervous person? Do you feel nervous or tense? (Generalized Anxiety Disorder)

• Have you ever had a sudden attack of rapid heartbeat or rush of intense fear, anxiety, or nervousness? (Panic Disorder)

• Have you ever avoided important activities because you were afraid you would have a sudden attack like the one I just asked you about? (Agoraphobia)

• Some people have strong fears of being watched or evaluated by others. For example, some people do not want to eat, speak, or write in front of people because they fear em- barrassing themselves. Is anything like this a problem for you? (Social Phobia)

• Some people have strong fears, or phobias, about heights, fl ying, bugs, or snakes. Do you have any phobias? (specifi c phobia)

• Some people are bothered by intrusive, silly, unpleasant, or horrible thoughts that keep repeating over and over. For example, some people have repeated thoughts of hurting someone they love even though they don’t want to; that a loved one has been seriously hurt; that they will yell obscenities in pub- lic; or that they are contaminated by germs. Has anything like this troubled you? (Ob- session)

• Some people are bothered by doing some- thing over and over. They can’t resist the urge, even when they try. They might wash their hands every few minutes or repeatedly check to see that the stove is off or the door is locked or count things excessively. Has anything like this been a problem for you? (Compulsion)

• Have you ever seen or experienced a trau- matic event when you thought your life

JWBT514_ch08.indd 182JWBT514_ch08.indd 182 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Physical and Mental Health: Interactions, Assessment, and Interventions 183

was in danger? Have you ever seen some- one else in grave danger? What happened? (Acute Stress and Posttraumatic Stress Dis- orders).

PTSD is associated with several health conditions, including hypertension, athero- sclerotic heart disease, chronic pain, and vul- nerability to infections; frequently involves increased health-care utilization; and often goes undetected. The National Center for PTSD (2010) suggests taking steps to identify and assist people experiencing PTSD. Detec- tion of this “hidden diagnosis,” as described by Lecrubier (2004), can be facilitated with a four-item screening instrument, the Primary Care PSTD Screen (Prins et al., 2004). The yes-no, self-reported screening questions can be completed via paper and pencil by the client and are (www.ptsd.va.gov/professional/pages/ assessments/pc-ptsd.asp):

In your life, have you ever had any experi- ence that was so frightening, horrible, or up- setting that, in the past month, you

1. Have had nightmares about it or thought about it when you did not want to?

2. Tried hard not to think about it or went out of your way to avoid situations that reminded you of it?

3. Were you constantly on guard, watchful, or easily startled?

4. Felt numb or detached from others, activi- ties, or your surroundings?

In primary care settings, positive responses to two of these screening questions would war- rant further assessment for PTSD (Prins et al., 2004). The National Center for PTSD pro- vides detailed information regarding proceed- ing with further assessment and intervention (www.ptsd.va.gov/index.asp).

Substance misuse is a serious health con- cern that often co-occurs with mental health problems (CSAT, 2005) and complicates other health issues. Chapter 17 provides detailed discussion of screening, assessment, and interventions with which to assist people ex- periencing substance use problems.

Formal Mental Status Exam

The mental status exam is a systematic, sem- istructured method for gathering informa- tion about and describing a person’s mental health status at the current time. It includes observation and inquiry to assess a person’s mental status and frequently involves a writ- ten summary of the examination. Unlike a biopsychosocial assessment, the mental sta- tus exam does not explore comprehensive elements of the person in her environment and her history but focuses primarily on her mental status at the present time. In addi- tion, the mental status exam involves not only eliciting the client’s perspective but also actively drawing on and incorporating the social worker’s observations (Lukas, 1993). Finally, although it is not a diagnos- tic tool, the mental status exam may alert the social worker to mental health problems that warrant further assessment (Trzepacz & Baker, 1993).

The mental status exam addresses these domains: appearance, attitude, and activity (sometimes simply referred to as appearance and behavior); mood and affect; speech and language; thought processes, thought con- tent, and perception; cognition; and insight and judgment (Trzepacz & Baker, 1993). A mental status exam may be conducted as a discrete assessment or as part of a clinical in- terview. For example, when a social worker begins talking with an older adult client, the client may describe recent diffi culties with remembering to take his medication and a recent event in which he forgot where he parked his car at the grocery store and wan- dered around the parking lot for an hour. His description would be a cue to pursue explo- ration of his cognitive capacities and of his memory, in particular. Especially when a client introduces an area that is worthy of further exploration through a mental status exam, it can be useful to follow up empa- thetically with the client, explain the nature of the questions you will ask, and proceed with the exam. This sort of follow-up con- veys both attentiveness to the client and your

JWBT514_ch08.indd 183JWBT514_ch08.indd 183 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

184 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

professional capacity to further assess and intervene appropriately (Shea, 1988).

Appearance, Attitude, and Activity. The mental status exam typically begins with the social worker’s observations of the client’s ap- pearance, attitude, and activity (Lukas, 1993; Trzepacz & Baker, 1993). This part of the mental status exam includes attention to these considerations:

• Client’s degree of consciousness (Is the person alert? Does she respond to stimuli?)

• Congruence between the client’s age and appearance (Does she appear to be her “stated age”? Does she seem older or younger?)

• Client’s posture and position (Does the cli- ent’s posture appear rigid or relaxed? Is the client in a hospital bed? Is the client able to sit down during the interview?)

• Client’s attire and personal hygiene (Is the client dressed appropriately for the season? Are there any signifi cant observations re- garding the client’s personal hygiene?)

• Notable physical characteristics, in addition to race, ethnicity, and gender

• Client’s attitude toward the social worker and toward the interview (How does the client respond to you? Are there changes in this response during your meeting?)

• Signifi cant movement or paralysis (Does the client have diffi culty sitting still? Does the client seem to move quickly or slowly? Does the client appear to have any tremors or involuntary movements?)

Mood and Affect. Consideration of the cli- ent’s mood and affect generally follows these observations in the mental status exam. Mood commonly refers to the client’s subjective re- port of his emotional state in general or in the present moment, and affect commonly refers to the social worker’s observations of the ways in which the client demonstrates his emotional state during the clinical interview (Lukas, 1993). Exploration of the client’s mood can begin with open-ended questions, such as “How have you been feeling lately?”

or “How do you feel right now?” (Trzepacz & Baker, 1993, p. 40). Asking the client to describe his mood over the previous 30 days can follow these beginning questions and can add additional specifi c information. It is important to listen closely to the client’s descriptions; follow up with questions that elicit greater detail and specifi city regarding his mood, especially its intensity and the de- gree to which it refl ects his usual mood; and, whenever possible, include direct phrases from the client in a mental status exam sum- mary. The next hypothetical interaction illus- trates such follow-up.

Social worker: Can you tell me about how you’ve been feeling lately?

Client: I’ve been very nervous.

Social worker: In what ways have you been feeling nervous?

Client: I feel sick to my stomach. I can’t eat. I feel very restless and uneasy. I’m tired, but I can’t sleep. I sleep a short time and then I’m up again. I can barely focus at work.

Social worker: Is feeling this way new for you, or have you been feeling this way for a while?

Client: Sometimes I worry, but it wasn’t like this until I got sick. Waiting for all of the test results is very stressful, and it’s got me very worried.

Social worker: How intense are the feelings that you’re having?

Client: Like I said, I worry now and then, but I’ve never felt anything like this.

Social worker: It seems like this worry is pretty intense for you. If you were to rank how you’re feeling right now on a scale of 1 to 10, where 1 is the best you’ve ever felt and 10 is the most nervous you’ve ever felt, what would be your ranking?

Client: I feel pretty far from the best I’ve ever felt (laughs). I would probably say that my nervousness feels like it’s about an 8. It could go higher depending on what the test results say.

JWBT514_ch08.indd 184JWBT514_ch08.indd 184 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Physical and Mental Health: Interactions, Assessment, and Interventions 185

Social worker: It sounds like this nervousness feels very intense and out of the ordinary for you. It also sounds like you feel it quite physically, in your stomach, with your sleep, and in the restlessness you describe; and it sounds like it’s affecting your concentration at work.

In this situation, in addition to the informa- tion the client provided regarding his mood, the social worker likely would observe that his affect appeared congruent with his mood—he appeared tense and nervous as he talked about feeling worried. Through the injection of humor, the client also may have displayed a range of affect even while predominantly expressing anxiety. Finally, the psychological distress the client is experiencing would warrant additional assessment to inform appropriate intervention.

Speech and Language. When observing speech and language, social workers focus on how information is being expressed and what is being said. Of particular interest is the speed with which a person speaks, any notable apha- sia (diffi culty expressing and understanding language, which may be evidenced by word- fi nding problems and more severe inability to express oneself), comprehension of language, volume of speech, prolonged silences, effort in speaking, poverty of speech, and any signifi - cant speech-related impairment (Lukas, 1993; Trzepacz & Baker, 1993). One way to assess comprehension is to ask the client to complete tasks that begin simply and increase in com- plexity. For example, a person could be asked to point to her eyes and then touch her left hand to her right ear, as described by Trzepacz and Baker (1993). These authors also offer a more complex, three-stage request that could involve asking a person to pick up a paper clip, put it on the table, and cross her arms. Ask- ing clients to name objects in the room or in a complex picture is a way to assess aphasia. The assessment of mental status, and of speech and language in particular, should be informed by an awareness of the client’s primary lan- guage and should be conducted with linguis- tic competence (Trzepacz & Baker, 1993). A

person whose primary language is Spanish may display limited comprehension and dif- fi culty naming objects; however, this may be due to limited fl uency in English rather than a mental health issue. Linguistic competence is a central component of accurate assessment. When a social worker’s language ability hin- ders provision of linguistically competent ser- vices, professional interpreters who are able to facilitate communication and cultural un- derstanding should be employed (Hepworth, Rooney, & Larsen, 2002).

The information gathered regarding speech and language can inform inferences regarding mental health problems a person may be ex- periencing. For example, a person experienc- ing symptoms of depression may speak slowly and quietly with long pauses in the rhythm of speech. A person who recently has experienced a stroke, severe head trauma, brain surgery, or an infection may demonstrate diffi culty fi nd- ing words but still may exhibit comprehension. Alternatively, the person may demonstrate loss of the ability to understand or express language. In addition, with the range of dif- fi culties associated with aphasia, individuals may have variable awareness of their language diffi culties. When individuals evidence apha- sia, collaboration with the transdisciplinary health-care team is a key element of ongoing assessment and intervention. Finally, when in- dividuals are experiencing aphasia related to Alzheimer’s and other progressive dementias, they likely will demonstrate gradual deterio- ration in language ability (Trzepacz & Baker, 1993). Routine assessment of mental status among older adults provides a way to moni- tor changes in mental status over time and to engage in early intervention (Rabins, 1991); however, it should be noted that based on cur- rently available evidence, the United States Preventive Services Task Force (2009) neither endorses nor discourages routine screening for dementia among older adults. The Task Force does support assessment of cognitive function- ing among older adults who display cognitive impairment or deterioration.

Thought Processes, Thought Content, and Perception. When assessing thought processes,

JWBT514_ch08.indd 185JWBT514_ch08.indd 185 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

186 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

content, and perception, social workers are focusing primarily on “how a person thinks and . . . what a person thinks about” (Lukas, 1993, p. 20) as well as any perceptual diffi culties (e.g., hearing ability, eyesight, hallucinations, il- lusions) the person is experiencing (Lukas, 1993; Trzepacz & Baker, 1993). Thought processes are assessed by attending to the “organization, fl ow, and production of thought” (Trzepacz & Baker, 1993, p. 84). Specifi cally, the social worker attends to the degree of tangentiality, cir- cumstantiality, fl ight of ideas, and looseness of associations in the person’s verbal expressions. The primary areas of interest regarding thought content include obsessions, compulsions, para- noia, delusions, violent ideation, and poverty of content (Lukas, 1993; Trzepacz & Baker, 1993). Given the increased suicide risk among people with chronic or terminal illnesses (Trzepacz & Baker, 1993), an entire section of this chapter is dedicated to suicide assessment and interven- tion. In terms of risk of injury to another per- son through homicide, abuse, or neglect, social workers should familiarize themselves with their organization’s protocols for assisting such an in- dividual and preventing harm to another person. In addition, social workers should familiarize themselves with state laws regarding their man- dates to warn third parties in the event of risk of imminent harm to an identifi ed person and to report suspected abuse or neglect of children or elders (Lukas, 1993; Trzepacz & Baker, 1993). If a social worker has reason to believe that a person may be at risk of harming another per- son, it is important to consult a supervisor and to formulate a plan to help the identifi ed potential victim remain safe.

Cognition. Assessment of cognition focuses on orientation, perceived level of intelligence, concentration, memory, and abstract thinking (Lukas, 1993; Trzepacz & Baker, 1993). A phrase frequently used in mental status exams is “the person is oriented x 3.” This statement indicates that a person is oriented to person (i.e., who he is; immediate family members), place (i.e., where he is, both specifi c setting and city and state), and time (i.e., time, day, date, and season) (Trzepacz & Baker, 1993). An ad- ditional dimension can include orientation to

activity (i.e., what he is currently doing). For the mental status exam, perceived level of in- telligence is based on the social worker’s as- sessment of the client’s apparent intelligence, described as above average, average, or below average (Lukas, 1993). Concentration typically is assessed by asking the person to engage in a task, such as counting backward from 20, count- ing down from 100 by 7s (this request is called serial 7 subtractions), or spelling “WORLD” backward. With these tasks, the person should be encouraged to complete the task without the use of paper, pencil, or other tools. Short-term memory can be assessed by asking a person to remember three words. This process begins with telling the person the words, asking him to repeat the words (which indicates that informa- tion has been registered), and then asking him to recall the words after fi ve minutes have passed (Trzepacz & Baker, 1993). Long-term memory can be assessed by inquiring about signifi cant aspects in the person’s past, for example, the city where he grew up or details of major life events (Lukas, 1993; Trzepacz & Baker, 1993).

In addition to observing the degree of con- crete and abstract thinking refl ected in the client’s communication, asking him to inter- pret a proverb can be another way to assess abstract thinking. For example, an interpre- tation of the phrase “The grass is greener on the other side” that demonstrates abstraction would be “Things that seem better elsewhere are not necessarily so,” while a more concrete interpretation would be “His lawn is greener than mine” (Trzepacz & Baker, 1993, p. 144). Numerous factors may infl uence the degree to which a person interprets a proverb, including age, cultural relevance, level of education, IQ, psychosis, delirium, injury to the head, dam- age to the frontal lobe, and dementia (Trzepacz & Baker, 1993).

Insight and Judgment. The fi nal component of the mental status exam, which attends to in- sight and judgment, assesses a person’s aware- ness of a problem and her ability to pursue action with awareness of consequences (Lukas, 1993; Trzepacz & Baker, 1993). The mental status exam enables a social worker to assess a number of elements of a person’s mental status

JWBT514_ch08.indd 186JWBT514_ch08.indd 186 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Physical and Mental Health: Interactions, Assessment, and Interventions 187

and can facilitate detection of mental health problems that warrant further assessment. After mental health issues are identifi ed, the social worker proceeds with differential as- sessment to guide appropriate interventions.

Differential Assessment: Depression and Anxiety

Feelings of sadness and worry are part of the human experience (American Psychiatric As- sociation, 2000) and are likely to accompany a number of physical illnesses, including can- cer, HIV, stroke, diabetes, heart disease, and Parkinson’s disease (NIMH, 2002a–f). Psy- chological distress associated with physical illness is likely to range from transient worry and sadness to clinical mood and anxiety dis- orders. This discussion focuses on differentiat- ing feelings of sadness and worry from more persistent mental health problems, including those that meet DSM-IV-TR diagnostic crite- ria (American Psychiatric Association, 2000) for anxiety and mood disorders, to formulate appropriate interventions to assist individuals and their families. As described previously, in- terventions may range from psychoeducation and supportive counseling (to support positive coping) to psychotherapy and psychopharma- cology (to assist people who are experiencing more persistent and severe mental health is- sues) (DHHS, 1999; IOM, 2001).

People experiencing concurrent physical and psychiatric conditions may be particularly vul- nerable to social isolation, medication nonadher- ence, and negative health outcomes (DiMatteo, 2004a; Frasure-Smith & Lesperance, 2003; Ickovics et al., 2001; IOM, 2001). In addition, people with psychiatric conditions have higher rates of illness and mortality. For example, in addition to high rates of suicide, people with mood disorders experience high rates of death due to cardiovascular and cerebrovas- cular conditions, accidents, and intoxication. Furthermore, treatment can reduce some of these risks, including suicide, vascular con- ditions, and cancer (Angst, Stassen, Clayton, & Angst, 2002). It is important for social workers to reach not only these vulnerable

groups but also people whose mental health concerns do not meet DSM-IV-TR diagnostic criteria (American Psychiatric Association, 2000). Subsyndromal psychological concerns can involve signifi cant distress that warrants assistance. Psychosocial interventions can have powerful effects even when targeting a population based on physical, rather than men- tal, health conditions. For example, a meta- analysis of 37 studies published between 1974 and 1997 suggests that psychoeducational interventions focusing on stress management and health education among people with coro- nary disease are associated with reduced risk of cardiac mortality and subsequent myocar- dial infarction as well as improvements in di- etary habits, smoking, exercise, cholesterol, and blood pressure (Dusseldorp, van Elderen, Maes, Meulman, & Kraaij, 1999). In addition, research suggests that quality of life, social support, and group therapeutic interventions that focus on education, coping, support, and stress management are associated with in- creased cancer survival (Butow, Coates, & Dunn, 1999; Fawzy et al., 1993; Fawzy, Fawzy, Arndt, & Pasnau, 1995; Spiegel, Sephton, Terr, & Stites, 1998). Attending to psychosocial el- ements of overall health can extend and im- prove life. Social workers often play a vital role in this process.

Although understanding the unique situ- ation of the individual in his ecological con- text is at the core of assessment, appropriate action also depends on accurate differentia- tion of emotional reactions associated with adjustment to various health conditions and psychiatric disorders. Understanding the se- verity, daily functioning impact, and duration of psychiatric symptoms is critical to this pro- cess (American Psychiatric Association, 2000; J. W. Williams, Hitchcock, Cordes, Ramirez, & Pignone, 2002). The following section provides an overview of steps involved in differentiating the etiology and scope of mental health symp- toms so that appropriate interventions can be formulated. The steps are based on the deci- sion trees included in the DSM-IV-TR. These decisions guide differential diagnosis and take into consideration the possible contribution of

JWBT514_ch08.indd 187JWBT514_ch08.indd 187 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

188 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

medical conditions or substances in the mental health diffi culties a person is experiencing. This discussion builds on the decision trees of the DSM-IV-TR by also addressing the po- tential contribution of ecological factors to a person’s mental health diffi culties. It should be noted that although etiological factors are presented separately, it is possible for a per- son to experience psychological distress due to multiple causes (American Psychiatric Asso- ciation, 2000). Such a situation would require attention to each contributing factor.

Medical Conditions

When mental health symptoms have been de- tected, the decision trees of the DSM-IV-TR can provide helpful guidance regarding initial steps in the differential assessment process. The fi rst step is to determine whether or not the symp- toms may be due to a general medical condition. Many medical conditions have an underlying association with depression or anxiety. For example, Cushing disease or hypothyroidism can cause symptoms of depression (American Psychiatric Association, 2000; J. W. Williams et al., 2002). Several physical illnesses may be obscured by symptoms of anxiety (Culpeper, 2003). Because of the vast number of potential health conditions people may experience, col- laborating with the transdisciplinary health-care team (e.g., nurses, physicians, and others with specialized training) and obtaining condition- specifi c information are necessary for making this determination. If it is determined that the mental health symptoms are due to an under- lying medical condition, intervention should fi rst address that condition, and mental health symptoms should be reassessed following such intervention. When physical conditions are as- sociated with, rather than cause, psychological distress (e.g., diabetes mellitus, coronary heart disease, autoimmune disorders), intervention should concurrently target both the physical and psychological diffi culties the person is ex- periencing (J. W. Williams et al., 2002).

Medications

If mental health symptoms do not appear to be due to a medical condition, the next step

is to assess whether or not the symptoms are due to ingesting or withdrawing from a sub- stance, either a prescribed medication, a toxin, alcohol, or other drugs (American Psychiatric Association, 2000). Side effects of numerous medications, including interferon alfa, ana- bolic steroids, glucocorticoids, and reserpine in high dosage, may involve psychological distress (Strader, Wright, Thomas, Seeff, & American Association for the Study of Liver Diseases, 2004; J. W. Williams et al., 2002). Comprehensive and differential assessment requires that social workers ask about and fa- miliarize themselves with the medications or other substances clients are taking. Gathering substance-specifi c information and collabo- rating with the transdisciplinary health-care team are key elements in understanding the potential contribution of substances to psycho- logical distress and in considering options for intervention.

Substance Use

The use of alcohol and other drugs also may infl uence mental health symptoms. Alcohol use is widely prevalent, with an estimated 51.6% of people 12 years and older in the United States reporting current use; 23.3% re- port binge drinking at least once in the past 30 days (Offi ce of Applied Studies, 2009). The highest rates of both heavy and binge drink- ing are found among young adults aged 18–25 years, at 14.5% and 41.0%, respectively (Of- fi ce of Applied Studies, 2009). Although the effect of alcohol in small amounts can produce feelings of confi dence and a positive mood, al- cohol is a central nervous system depressant that leads to slowed reaction, refl exes, and muscular response. In addition, higher dosages of alcohol lead to greater slowing of the cen- tral nervous system, which typically results in sleep followed by feelings of shakiness, head- aches, depression, and diffi culty concentrating upon waking (Weil & Rosen, 1993).

Cigarette smoking is also widely practiced. More than 1 in 4 people 12 years and older in the United States uses tobacco (Offi ce of Ap- plied Studies, 2009). Tobacco is a plant whose active ingredient, nicotine, is highly addictive

JWBT514_ch08.indd 188JWBT514_ch08.indd 188 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Physical and Mental Health: Interactions, Assessment, and Interventions 189

and has signifi cant pharmacological effects on the brain (Henningfi eld, 1998; Weil & Rosen, 1993). As a stimulant, nicotine may lead some people to feel more energized and alert while others may feel jittery and nervous. Stimu- lants also may affect sleep and eating. Follow- ing the use of stimulants, a person is likely to feel sleepy, fatigued, and depressed (Weil & Rosen, 1993). The National Institute on Drug Abuse (NIDA, 2009) describes numerous psy- chological effects associated with withdrawal of nicotine (e.g. intense tobacco cravings, at- tention diffi culties, irritability).

This discussion of the physiological effects of alcohol and tobacco in relation to mental health symptoms provides just two examples of the numerous ways in which substance use and mental health symptoms may intersect. As part of a comprehensive assessment of a person’s mental health symptoms, a social worker should consider the potential infl uence of substances on these symptoms. For ex- ample, a person recently diagnosed with lung cancer who has been a long-term smoker may describe diffi culty concentrating. With further exploration, you learn that he recently stopped smoking. Although this recent discontinuation of smoking is not likely to be the only factor contributing to his psychological distress, it would be an important consideration in a com- prehensive assessment. Similarly, a person seeking assistance with feelings of depression may describe heavy alcohol consumption. As alcohol is a central nervous system depressant, its consumption may be contributing to her feelings of depression.

This conceptualization of the relationship between mental health and substance use sug- gests a unidirectional, causal relationship in which substance use predates and causes the mental health symptoms a person is experi- encing; however, this type of relationship is but one of several ways in which substance use and mental health symptoms may inter- sect. For example, it is possible for a person to experience mental health diffi culties that predate her substance use, and the substance use may not meet criteria for a diagnosis of abuse or dependence (American Psychiatric

Association, 2000; Hien, Zimberg, Weisman, First, & Ackerman, 1997). Alternatively, a per- son may experience concurrent mental health and substance use disorders that are inde- pendent of each other and do not necessarily share etiology; however, increased symptoms of either disorder may intensify symptoms of the other (Hien et al., 1997). For social work- ers engaged in differential assessment, teasing apart the relationship between mental health and substance use issues involves obtaining a comprehensive history of the person’s mental health symptoms, substance use, and the re- lationship between them. This comprehensive history and assessment can facilitate provision of or referral to appropriate services, depend- ing on the social worker’s setting.

Conceptualizing co-occurring psychiatric and substance use disorders in terms of severity of each condition (e.g., more severe psychiat- ric disorder, less severe substance use disor- der) can assist with identifying the appropriate treatment setting (CSAT, 2005). Detailed gen- eral guidance for addressing substance use in health-care settings can be found in Chapter 17. Additional information for assisting peo- ple experiencing concurrent substance use and psychiatric disorders can be found online in the CSAT’s 2005 publication Substance Abuse Treatment for Persons with Co-Occurring Disorders.

Ecological Context

Although the DSM-IV-TR does not identify ecological factors in its decision trees to inform differential diagnosis of psychiatric disorders (American Psychiatric Association, 2000), the centrality of the person-in-environment perspective in social work suggests that a comprehensive assessment of factors contrib- uting to a person’s mental health symptoms should include explicit consideration of eco- logical context. Inadequate housing, nutrition, fi nancial resources, health insurance, access to medical care, and social support are likely to contribute to feelings of stress, sadness, and worry as well as to negative health out- comes. For example, research suggests that adults who are homeless have greater risk for

JWBT514_ch08.indd 189JWBT514_ch08.indd 189 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

190 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

mental illness, substance use disorders, physi- cal illness, lack of health insurance, and death than the U.S. general population (Barrow, Herman, Cordova, & Streuning, 1999; Fischer & Breakey, 1991; Hibbs et al., 1994; Hwang et al., 1998; Kessler et al., 1994; Kushel, Vittinghoff, & Hass, 2001; Regier et al., 1993). Research involving children experiencing food insecurity indicates that this experience is as- sociated with numerous social, emotional, be- havioral, and physical health problems. (For a summary, see Wight, Thampi, & Briggs, 2010.) Furthermore, research involving moth- ers receiving welfare suggests that increased environmental and social risks (such as liv- ing in an unsafe neighborhood, not having enough food, experiencing domestic violence, and stressful life experiences associated with meeting basic needs) are associated with in- creased risk of depression, and social support and a sense of control over one’s life are as- sociated with reductions in this risk (Siefert et al., 2000). Some service providers and schol- ars also have described unmet basic needs and homelessness as sources of psychologi- cal trauma (Engstrom, Gunn, Petersen, 2011; Goodman, Saxe, & Harvey, 1991). The health concerns associated with unmet basic needs and ecological risks underscore the impor- tance of strategies that help clients in these areas. Attention to concrete needs and ecologi- cal risks often is undervalued, but it is part of social work’s “uncelebrated strength” (John- son, 1999). Such attention can provide critical pathways to improved quality of life, reduced psychological distress, and improved physi- cal health. If a comprehensive assessment indicates that ecological factors are contrib- uting to a person’s mental health diffi culties, intervention should target them. Identifying potential resources and services, discussing them with the client, and facilitating referrals are important aspects of addressing ecologi- cal factors that may be fueling mental health symptoms; these are important functions of meeting the ethical responsibilities of so- cial work (Johnson, 1991) and fulfi ll one of social workers’ key roles: linking people to resources (Hepworth et al., 2002).

After medical conditions, substance use, and ecological factors are addressed as poten- tial contributors to the client’s mental health symptoms, the process of differentiating feel- ings of sadness and worry from psychiatric disorders moves to further consideration of the severity, duration, and functional impact of these experiences (American Psychiatric As- sociation, 2000; Williams et al., 2002). These considerations inform the differential assess- ment process and can guide strategies to help people experiencing psychological distress. Furthermore, these considerations refl ect el- ements of the diagnostic criteria for psychi- atric disorders according to the DSM-IV-TR (American Psychiatric Association, 2000).

Diagnostic Criteria: Depression

When inquiring about a person’s mental health experiences, it is useful to explore the nature of the diffi culty a person is having, its intensity, history, precipitating events or stressors, and any prior mental health diffi culties or treat- ment. The DSM-IV-TR identifi es clusters of mental health symptoms for each disorder and thresholds for the number of symptoms that must be met, their duration, and their impact on functioning. For example, a diagnosis of major depressive disorder would be made if a per- son’s symptoms meet these criteria (American Psychiatric Association, 2000, p. 356):

1. The patient experiences more than two weeks of daily or near daily experiences of symptoms that cause signifi cant distress or impaired functioning.

2. The symptoms are not due to a medical condition, substance, or bereavement.

3. The symptoms include depressed mood (in children and adolescents, it may be irritable mood) or loss of pleasure or interest in activities and at least four of these symptoms:

• Signifi cant change in weight or appetite

• Insomnia or hypersomnia

• Psychomotor agitation or retardation

JWBT514_ch08.indd 190JWBT514_ch08.indd 190 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Physical and Mental Health: Interactions, Assessment, and Interventions 191

• Fatigue or loss of energy

• Feelings of worthlessness or excessive or inappropriate guilt

• Impaired concentration or indecision

• Recurrent thoughts of death, suicidal ideation, or suicide attempt.

A person experiencing fewer symptoms with less impact on functioning may meet the criteria for depressive disorder not otherwise specifi ed. Other diagnostic categories that may be considered when a person presents with symptoms of depression that are not due to a general medical condition or sub- stance include dysthymia, which involves de- pressed mood and two additional symptoms of depression for more than two years that cause signifi cant distress or impairment, and adjustment disorder with depressed mood, which involves symptoms of depression fol- lowing a stressful life event and signifi cant distress or impaired functioning (American Psychiatric Association, 2000; J. W. Williams et al., 2002).

Diagnostic Criteria: Anxiety

Anxiety disorders not due to a general medical condition or to a substance include generalized anxiety disorder, panic attack and disorder, phobias, obsessive-compulsive disorder, acute stress disorder, posttraumatic stress disorder, and anxiety disorder not otherwise specifi ed (American Psychiatric Association, 2000). For illustrative purposes, the diagnostic criteria for generalized anxiety disorder and posttraumatic stress disorder are outlined here. Additional information can be found in the DSM-IV-TR. With both of these conditions, the attention to severity, duration, and functional impact is again part of differentiating worry that might be part of the human experience from gen- eralized anxiety disorder or differentiating responses that might be expected based on exposure to a traumatic event from posttrau- matic stress disorder (American Psychiatric Association, 2000; J. W. Williams et al., 2002). In the case of generalized anxiety disorder, in addition to experiencing excessive worry or

anxiety that is diffi cult to control for six or more months, the person also experiences at least three (only one required with children) of these symptoms (American Psychiatric As- sociation, 2000, p. 476):

1. Restlessness or feeling keyed up or on edge

2. Experiences of becoming easily fatigued

3. Diffi culty concentrating or mind going blank

4. Irritability

5. Muscle tension

6. Sleep disturbance (diffi culty falling or staying asleep or restless unsatisfying sleep)

In addition, the anxiety is generalized and not focused on a single domain. The symp- toms fuel signifi cant distress or impairment in functioning and are not due to a general medi- cal condition or substance.

Diagnostic Criteria: Posttraumatic Stress Disorder

Diagnostic criteria for posttraumatic stress disorder include exposure to a traumatic event in which the person experienced “intense fear, helplessness, or horror.” Among children this experience may be expressed as agitation or disorganization of behavior (American Psychi- atric Association, 2000, p. 467). In addition, the person reexperiences the traumatic event, avoids stimuli associated with it or experiences numbed responsiveness evidenced in at least three symptoms, and experiences heightened arousal evidenced in at least two symptoms. Finally, the symptoms are present for more than one month and involve signifi cant dis- tress or impairment in functioning (American Psychiatric Association, 2000, pp. 467–468).

Diagnostic Hierarchy

It should be noted that when a person’s symp- toms overlap across conditions, the diagnosis that holds a higher place in the diagnostic hier- archy of the DSM-IV-TR (e.g., explanations of

JWBT514_ch08.indd 191JWBT514_ch08.indd 191 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

192 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

mental health symptoms due to a general med- ical condition or to substances are addressed fi rst) or that has greater pervasiveness (e.g., secondary symptoms related to the primary diagnosis are not diagnosed as separate con- ditions) is applied (J. B. W. Williams, 1998). Exclusion criteria found in each diagnostic category will facilitate the application of these principles (American Psychiatric Association, 2000; J. B. W. Williams, 1998). As described by Williams, “A small forest of decision trees is provided [in the DSM-IV-TR] to make the differential diagnostic process easier by help- ing clinicians understand the organization and hierarchic structure of the classifi cation” (pp. 37–38).

Suicide

Suicide is a serious, preventable public health issue and is ranked as the 11th overall cause of death in the United States (DHHS, 1999, 2001b; NIMH, 2009; Xu, Kochanek, Murphy, & Tejada-Vera, 2010). Numerous risk fac- tors are associated with suicidal behavior and completed suicide, including differences by gender, age, race, and marital status (Heron, 2010; Moscicki, 1997, 2001; NIMH, 2009). In general terms, women are more likely to attempt suicide, and men are more likely to complete suicide. Firearms represent the most common method of suicide among men and second most common method among women. Poisoning is the most prevalent method of sui- cide among women (NIMH, 2009).

People older than 65 years are at high risk of suicide, and the highest rate of suicide is among White men older than 85 years (NIMH, 2007, 2009). Young adults age 15 to 24 years are also at risk. For this group, suicide is the third leading cause of death and in 2006 ac- counted for more deaths among this group than the next seven causes, including heart dis- eases, cancers, HIV, congenital problems, and diabetes, combined (Heron, 2010; U.S. Public Health Service, 1999). Although suicide rates among those 10 to 24 years old declined be- tween 1990 and 2003, recent increases have been documented among those younger than 20

years (Bridge, Greenhouse, Weldon, Campo, & Kelleher, 2008; CDC, 2007). Historically, research suggested that White youth have higher suicide rates than African American youth, but recent increases in suicide among African American youth, particularly among African American young men, have reduced the differences in rates between these groups (Cash & Bridge, 2009; Joe, Baser, Neighbors, Caldwell, & Jackson, 2009). Although African American male youth have higher rates of sui- cide completion than their female counterparts (Heron, 2010), recent research documents higher rates of attempted suicide among fe- males in this group (Joe et al., 2009).

Among males and females of all ages, sui- cide ranked among the top 10 causes of death in 2006 among people from American Indian (8th) and Asian or Pacifi c Islander (9th) back- grounds and among White Americans (10th) (Heron, 2010). Two important considerations should be noted in reviewing these data. First, Heron advises caution in interpreting reports for groups other than African Americans or White Americans because of race-related mis- reports on death certifi cates. Second, although suicide did not appear in the top 10 causes of death among all sexes and ages for people who were African American or Hispanic, this ranking differed by age and by gender in both groups. Finally, in her review of epidemiologic studies to identify risk factors for suicide, Moscicki (2001) identifi ed research suggest- ing that rates of suicide among people who are divorced or widowed are higher than among people who are married across age groups and that being widowed earlier in life poses par- ticular risk.

In addition to differences in prevalence of suicidal behavior and completed suicide by age, gender, race, and marital status, there is a growing body of literature regarding increased risk of suicidal behavior among gay, lesbian, bisexual, and transgender (LGBT) youth and adults. Although there appears to be general agreement that gay, lesbian, and bisexual youth and adults experience increased risk of suicidal ideation and attempts (Fergusson, Horwood, & Beautrais, 1999; Frankowski & Committee on

JWBT514_ch08.indd 192JWBT514_ch08.indd 192 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Physical and Mental Health: Interactions, Assessment, and Interventions 193

Adolescence, 2004; Jesdale & Zierler, 2002; King et al., 2008; Remafedi, 1999; Russell & Joyner, 2001), the literature is less conclusive regarding increased risk of completed suicide among gay, lesbian, and bisexual youth and adults compared with their heterosexual coun- terparts because of methodological limitations (Jesdale & Zierler, 2002; Remafedi, 1999). An emerging body of literature also indicates that transgender individuals are at higher risk for suicidality (Clements-Nolle, Marx, & Katz, 2006; Mathy, 2002; Wells, Freedenthal, & Wisneski, 2008). Although the empirical liter- ature on completed suicide among people who are LGBT is limited, a prior suicide attempt is considered a signifi cant risk factor for suicide (Gliatto & Rai, 1999; Moscicki, 1997; Nock et al., 2008; Zametkin, Alter, & Yemini, 2001). Accordingly, health-care professionals should be aware of the potential for heightened sui- cide risk among LGBT youth and adults.

Research suggests an increased risk of suicide is associated with several physical ill- nesses, including “HIV/AIDS, Huntington’s disease, malignant neoplasms, multiple scle- rosis, peptic ulcer, renal disease, spinal cord injuries, and systemic lupus erythematosus”; however, “there is no evidence that medi- cal disorders are independent risk factors for suicide outside the context of depression and substance abuse” (Moscicki, 1997, p. 511). In terms of social work practice in health-care settings, these fi ndings suggest that strategies to address mental health conditions among people with physical illness, including routine screening, assessment, and intervention, are central components of suicide prevention.

Experiencing a psychiatric or substance use disorder is associated with attempted and com- pleted suicide. The risk is increased for those who have more than one disorder, particularly co-occurring mood and substance use disorders (Kessler, Borges, & Walters, 1999; Moscicki, 1997, 2001; Nock et al., 2008). Other widely recognized risk factors for suicidality include:

• Hopelessness

• Previous suicide attempts

• Firearms in one’s home

• Incarceration

• Recent loss

• Signifi cant stressful events (e.g., diagnosis of terminal illness, loss of employment, fi - nancial or legal diffi culties)

• Family history of mood or substance use disorders or suicidal behavior

• Family stress

• Limited social support

• Physical or sexual abuse

• Models of suicidal behavior among one’s family or peer group or among celebrities

• History of impulsive behavior

• Stigma or other obstacles to seeking help (DHHS, 2001b; Hirschfeld & Russell, 1997; Ivanoff & Smyth, 1992; Moscicki, 1997, 2001; NIMH, 2009; New York State Department of Health, 2007; Nock et al., 2008; Sanchez, 2001; Shaffer et al., 2001; U.S. Public Health Service, 1999; Zametkin et al., 2001)

In addition to these considerations, suicide risk factors among youth include domestic violence, rejection, and disciplinary stress (Moscicki, 1997; Zametkin et al., 2001). The National Cancer Institute (NCI, 2010) asserts that people with cancer may be at increased risk for suicide and that additional suicide risk factors to consider include:

• Oral, pharyngeal, and lung cancers (often associated with heavy alcohol and tobacco use)

• Advanced stage of disease and poor prognosis

• Confusion/delirium

• Inadequately controlled pain

• Presence of defi cit symptoms (e.g., loss of mobility, loss of bowel and bladder control, amputation, sensory loss, paraplegia, inability to eat and to swallow, exhaustion, fatigue) (NCI, 2010)

The presence of a suicide risk factor does not mean that a person will engage in suicidal behavior (Ivanoff & Smyth, 1992); however,

JWBT514_ch08.indd 193JWBT514_ch08.indd 193 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

194 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

if a person is experiencing numerous factors, the risk may increase (Moscicki, 1997, 2001). Evaluating a person’s risk for suicide begins with an awareness of risk factors but relies on an individualized assessment. Suicide assess- ment involves employing relevant knowledge and fi nely tuned skills to assess a person’s abil- ity to stay safe and to refrain from self-harm. In this process, generalized information should be considered in the context of the unique ex- periences of each particular individual.

Assessment of Suicide

The fi rst step in suicide assessment is the identifi cation of suicidal ideation. Many peo- ple who complete suicide, particularly older adults, have seen a primary care provider in the month prior to their deaths (Andersen, Andersen, Rosholm, & Gram, 2000; Luoma, Martin, & Pearson, 2002), and physicians often are unaware of clients’ history or risk of suicidality (Gliatto & Rai, 1999; Murphy, 1975a,b). Research also suggests that patients support routine mental health inquiries by their physicians and that people with a history of suicidality may be particularly supportive of such inquiry at each visit (Zimmerman et al., 1995). Although some individuals may readily identify their thoughts about suicide, others may keep them to themselves or may convey them in indirect language. Indirect communication may include expressions of hopelessness, an inability to see a solution to a problem, a feeling that others might be better off without them, a desire to give up, or a feel- ing that current problems are insurmountable (Ivanoff & Smyth, 1992).

Direct inquiry about suicidal ideation has not been shown to cause suicidal behavior (J. W. Williams et al., 2002; Zimmerman et al., 1995). Although the U.S. Preventive Services Task Force (2009) recommends depression screenings in settings with appropriate follow- up services, it neither recommends nor dis- courages routine screening for suicide based on available evidence. However, particularly in settings where people may be at high risk of suicide, routine inquiry about suicidal ideation as part of a mental health assessment may

facilitate early detection and assistance for peo- ple at risk (Ivanoff & Smyth, 1992). Further- more, results from a recent systematic review also indicate that training primary care physi- cians to identify and address suicidality and depression is associated with signifi cant (22%– 73%) reductions in suicides. Finally, psychiatric evaluation guidelines from the American Psy- chiatric Association (2006) include assessment of risk to self or others as a standard domain in an overall clinical assessment.

Although a number of standardized sui- cide assessment instruments are available and widely used in research, the American Psy- chiatric Association (2006) notes their limited predictive abilities. As such, this discussion focuses on direct inquiry about potential self- harm and individualized follow-up questions to assess suicidality. Direct inquiry that is coupled with empathy can provide an inroad into assessing suicidal ideation and intention. For example, interwoven with a discussion in which a client expresses hopelessness and dif- fi culty identifying solutions to a pressing prob- lem, a follow-up question might be: “It sounds like you’ve been feeling pretty discouraged, and maybe a bit desperate. Have you thought about hurting yourself?” Or another follow- up question might be: “It sounds like you’re having a hard time fi nding a way out of this situation and that you’re feeling like you have no options. You mentioned wanting to give up. Have you thought about wanting to die?” If the client reports wanting to die, then the social worker could follow up by asking “You’ve described feeling so down you’ve wanted to die. Have you thought about hurting your- self?” (For additional examples, see American Psychiatric Association, 2006; Gliatto & Rai, 1999; Hirschfeld & Russell, 1997; Ivanoff & Smyth, 1992; Lukas, 1993; Shaffer et al., 2001).

If a client reports suicidal ideation, the so- cial worker’s next questions aim to (a) gather additional information about components of the ideation (e.g., content, timing, onset, fre- quency, intensity) and (b) identify the level of imminent risk associated with it (Ameri- can Psychiatric Association, 2006; Hirschfeld

JWBT514_ch08.indd 194JWBT514_ch08.indd 194 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Physical and Mental Health: Interactions, Assessment, and Interventions 195

& Russell, 1997; Ivanoff & Smyth, 1992). Bearing in mind the risk factors previously discussed, the imminence of suicide risk in- creases with the intensity of the suicidal ide- ation and the presence of these factors:

• A developed plan for hurting one’s self, with particular attention to plans that in- volve violence or irreversibility

• Access to the means to carry out the plan

• Intention to harm one’s self or to carry out the plan

• Consideration of efforts to avoid being dis- covered or interrupted

• Completion of or in process of writing a suicide note

• Alcohol or other substance use

• Presence of psychotic symptoms, with par- ticular attention to command hallucinations that may be instructing the person to en- gage in self-harm

• Hopelessness (American Psychiatric As- sociation, 2006; Hirschfeld & Russell, 1997; Ivanoff & Smyth, 1992; USPSTF, 2009)

Making a determination regarding a client’s level of suicide risk can be facilitated by fi ve additional factors.

1. Gathering specifi c information in the course of the suicide assessment will enable the social worker to further consider the person’s level of risk, to describe it to others from whom consultation may be sought, and to coordinate services as indicated (Lukas, 1993).

2. Consultation with a supervisor or with colleagues often is a vital element in making this assessment and in formulating appropriate intervention.

3. Before conducting a suicide assessment, social workers should familiarize themselves with their organization’s policies and procedures regarding assessment and intervention with clients at risk of suicide. They also should familiarize themselves

with the state laws and regulations in this area.

4. Although social workers should be mindful of the potential negative aspects of inpatient hospitalization (e.g., stigma, loss of control) and the centrality of supporting clients’ self- control (Ivanoff & Smyth, 1992; Lukas, 1993), Lukas asserts that “you should make a practice—both for the client’s well-being and your own—of never letting a client leave your offi ce until you have used all necessary resources to satisfy yourself that she is not at imminent risk of trying to kill herself” (p.119).

5. Clear, thorough documentation can be useful in recording events, decisions made, and actions taken and in serving as a risk management practice (Ivanoff & Smyth, 1992).

Interventions to Address Suicide Risk

If a client is at immediate risk of suicide, in- tervention should focus on physical safety (Hirschfeld & Russell, 1997; Ivanoff & Smyth, 1992); however, throughout the process, Iva- noff and Smyth (1992) recommend “a bias toward maintaining the client’s sense of self- control and personal management whenever possible” (p. 123). This stance suggests that social workers should pursue collaboration and empowerment rather than unilateral ac- tion when working with clients at risk for sui- cide. In social work practice, this perspective would involve seeking clients’ input regarding available intervention options and empowering them to take action—for example, voluntarily pursuing inpatient hospitalization rather than involuntary commitment. However, if a person is unable to pursue action that will uphold his safety and there is imminent risk of suicide, it is the social worker’s responsibility, or the re- sponsibility of another direct service provider, to intervene to support his physical safety.

When a client is at imminent risk of suicide, someone should remain with him, and, in most cases, an evaluation for inpatient hospitaliza- tion should be made (Hirschfeld & Russell, 1997). If the contact with the client is over the

JWBT514_ch08.indd 195JWBT514_ch08.indd 195 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

196 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

phone, the social worker should remain on the phone with the client and not place the client on hold (Millman, Strike, Van Soest, Rosen, & Schmidt, 1998). It may be helpful to involve a reassuring person to stay with the client so that he is not left alone and so that emotional support can begin to be mobilized (Ivanoff & Smyth, 1992; New York State Department of Health, 2007). If the client says that he has a gun or pills during the phone contact, Millman and colleagues (1998) recommend that he should be asked to place the gun (unloaded) in another part of the room or, likewise, to move pills, to dispose of them in the toilet, or to ask another person to keep them temporarily. Contacting emergency medical services or the police would be warranted if a suicide attempt has occurred or is in the process of occurring or if needed to transport the client for inpa- tient hospitalization evaluation (Hirschfeld & Russell, 1997; Ivanoff & Smyth, 1992). A client who needs to be evaluated for inpatient hospitalization should not drive himself there (Holkup, 2002).

Shaffer and colleagues (2001) further spec- ify that with children and adolescents experi- encing suicidality, the social worker should be in contact with the client’s family and should address the importance of treatment as well as its feasibility and family preferences. In addi- tion, they recommend gathering information from multiple sources (e.g., interviews with the client and people who know the client, observation of behavior, completion of stan- dardized scales) and consulting with the cli- ent’s caregiver. Consultation with the client and caregiver should focus on these topics: (a) restricting access to alcohol or drugs because of their disinhibiting effects, (b) securing or removing any fi rearms or lethal medications, (c) identifying that someone supportive will be at home, (d) discussing stressful situations that may precipitate suicidality and coping strate- gies to address them, and (e) confi rming that an appointment for follow-up care has been made.

Verbal and written safety contracts often are made with clients and their families when their risk of suicide is found to not be imminent

(American Psychiatric Association, 2006; Shaffer et al., 2001). These contracts typically include an agreement that the client will not harm himself and that the client will take ac- tion to stay safe, including contact numbers and whom to call if he is not able to stay safe (Holkup, 2002; Ivanoff & Smyth, 1992). Writ- ten contracts typically are signed by both the client and the social worker, and each retains a copy (Holkup, 2002). Although such con- tracts may be widely used, there are important caveats to consider in their use, perhaps most important of which are that they lack empiri- cal research support (Garvey, Penn, Campbell, Esposito-Smythers, & Spirito, 2009; Rudd, Mandrusiak, & Joiner, 2006; Shaffer et al., 2001) and that the American Psychiatric Asso- ciation (2006) cautions against their use as evi- dence of a client’s ability to stay safe or of his eligibility for discharge from outpatient ser- vices or inpatient hospitalization. In addition, the American Psychiatric Association does not recommend the use of safety contracts with clients who display impulsivity, agitation, psy- chosis, or substance intoxication or with cli- ents who are not well known to the provider or who are seen in emergency contexts. Garvey and colleagues (2009) also caution clinicians regarding the use of such contracts. In par- ticular, they emphasize their limited evidence base, the client’s ability to give informed con- sent, the importance of a comprehensive sui- cide risk assessment, and the legal liabilities that may be involved with such contracts. In recognition of the limitations of safety con- tracts, Rudd and colleagues (2006) propose a commitment-to-treatment statement (CTS) that includes attention to roles and expecta- tions of the client and clinician, clear com- munication about treatment and suicide, and a plan to access crisis services as needed. The authors note that the CTS requires empirical investigation; however, it may address some of the limitations of safety contracts. McMyler and Pryjmachuk (2008) also suggest alternate strategies to the safety contract, including safety and crisis planning, nonintrusive observation and reducing environmental risks on inpatient units, addressing precipitants to suicidality, and

JWBT514_ch08.indd 196JWBT514_ch08.indd 196 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Physical and Mental Health: Interactions, Assessment, and Interventions 197

attending to the centrality of communication between the client and clinician. The available evidence base of these alternatives varies.

When a client is at risk for suicide but not imminently, recommended interventions in- clude mobilizing her support system by asking her permission to contact and involve a person with whom she has a close relationship; acting to restrict her access to any fi rearms, ammu- nition, lethal medication, or other potentially lethal methods of self-harm; thoroughly fol- lowing up with her through additional con- tacts (including phone contact, visits, letters, or scheduled meetings); and providing appro- priate intervention or referral to address any co-occurring psychiatric or substance use dis- orders she may be experiencing (Hirschfeld & Russell, 1997; Ivanoff & Smyth, 1992; New York State Department of Health, 2007; Shaffer et al., 2001). The Substance Abuse and Mental Health Services Administration (Of- fi ce of Applied Studies, 2009) has developed a fi ve-step pocket guide to suicide assessment and immediate intervention that may be useful for quick reference (see http://download.ncadi .samhsa.gov/ken/pdf/SMA09-4432/SMA09 -4432.pdf for this resource).

A growing body of evidence-based informa- tion guides intervention with people at risk of suicide. Effective strategies generally include intensive follow-up and a combination of psy- chotherapy and pharmacotherapy (American Psychiatric Association, 2006; Hirschfeld & Russell, 1997; Ivanoff & Smyth, 1992; Shaffer et al., 2001). Because repeat suicide attempts often occur within the fi rst weeks following intake or hospital discharge (Hunt et al., 2009; Meehan et al., 2006), active and immediate fol- low-up is warranted. It is important to note that while some studies of chain-of-care networks, follow-up mailings, and easy access to psy- chiatric care (Morgan, Jones, & Owen, 1993) indicate that such follow-up is helpful in reduc- ing suicidality, other types of follow-up have not consistently been more effective than usual care (Mann et al., 2005). In particular, there have been mixed fi ndings regarding the added value of phone-based interventions. For ex- ample, a Swedish study found no added benefi t

of two phone interventions (contact at 4- and 8-month follow-up) among 216 people who had attempted suicide and received psychiatric care (Cedereke, Monti, & Öjehagen, 2002). Another study conducted in the United States found that three phone contacts over one year, together with two visits with a depression specialist and personalized mailings, improved medication adherence and depressive symptoms among 386 people with major depression or dysthymia who received primary care. (Katon et al., 2001). Although the second study did not examine ef- fects on suicidality, the combined intervention shows promise to improve medication adher- ence and depression, which may reduce suicid- ality. These fi ndings suggest that phone-based interventions may be more effective when part of a multifaceted follow-up plan. Furthermore, the effectiveness of more intensive follow-up by phone cannot be assessed by this research that focuses on highly specifi ed interspersed phone contacts. Of critical importance is timely thera- peutic follow-up for people at risk of suicide (Hunt et al., 2009).

Cognitive-behavioral therapy (CBT) and interpersonal psychotherapy may be useful with persons experiencing depression and sui- cidality; dialectical behavior therapy and psy- chodynamic therapy may be useful for persons experiencing borderline personality disorder, which often is associated with suicidal and self-harming behavior (American Psychiatric Association, 2000, 2006; Mann et al., 2005). For example, in a study with 120 adults who recently attempted suicide, cognitive therapy (10 sessions) was associated with 50% lower likelihood of reattempting suicide than the usual care condition (Brown et al., 2005). An eight-year follow-up of psychodynamic par- tial hospitalization (18 months) and outpatient group treatment (18 months) with 41 people experiencing borderline personality disorder found approximately 60% lower likelihood of suicidality among those in the experimen- tal group compared with those in usual treat- ment (Bateman & Fonagy, 2008). Medication, including lithium, neuroleptics, and antide- pressants, also has been shown to reduce the risk of suicide (Angst, Angst, Gerber-Werder,

JWBT514_ch08.indd 197JWBT514_ch08.indd 197 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

198 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

& Gamma, 2005; Angst, Stassen, Clayton, & Angst, 2002; Baldessarini et al., 2006; Isacsson, Holmgren, Ösby, & Ahlner, 2009). In some cases, when a person is experiencing severe unremitting depression, electroconvul- sive therapy (ECT) may be indicated (Ameri- can Psychiatric Association, 2006; Hirschfeld & Russell, 1997; NIMH, 2008).

Research with older adults experiencing depression suggests that interpersonal psy- chotherapy or medication (primarily citalo- pram, a selective serotonin reuptake inhibitor [SSRI]) provide more timely relief from sui- cidal ideation than does usual care while also facilitating improvements in depression (Bruce et al., 2004). In their practice pa- rameters for intervention with children and adolescents experiencing suicidality, Shaf- fer and colleagues (2001) draw on research with adolescents experiencing depression to cite evidence for the use of these approaches to assist youth at risk of suicide: CBT, inter- personal psychotherapy, dialectical behavior therapy, and family psychoeducation (Brent et al., 1997; Brent, Poling, McKain, & Baugher, 1993; A. L. Miller, Rathus, Linehan, Wetzler, & Leigh, 1997; Mufson, Weissman, Moreau, & Garfi nkel, 1999). The American Academy of Child and Adolescent Psychiatry’s (2007) recent practice parameters to assist children and adolescents experiencing depression also recognize the usefulness of CBT, interpersonal psychotherapy, family therapy, and psychody- namic psychotherapy to address depression among youth, however, its review suggests the need for additional research regarding family therapy and psychodynamic psychotherapy.

Shaffer and colleagues (2001) discuss sev- eral psychopharmacological interventions to assist children and adolescents experiencing suicidality, including lithium, valproate, carba- mazepine, SSRIs, and, in particular, fl uoxetine. Concerns regarding increased risk of suicid- ality with the use of antidepressants among youth have received considerable attention in recent years (March, Silva, Vitiello, & TADS Team, 2006; Olfson, Marcus, & Shaffer, 2006; Schneeweiss et al., 2010; Simon, Savarino, Operskalski, & Wang, 2006; Tiihonen et al.,

2006) and infl uenced the Food and Drug Ad- ministration’s (FDA) 2005 decision to request that drug manufacturers include a black-box warning on antidepressants regarding in- creased risk of suicidal ideation and behavior among children and adolescents (FDA, 2007). In 2007, the FDA proposed revised warnings, including language to indicate that elevated risk continues until age 24 years and that psy- chiatric disorders play the primary role in sui- cide risk. Upon review of available science, the AACAP (2007) provided this summary:

[I]t appears that spontaneously reported events are more common in SSRI treatment. Nevertheless, given the greater number of patients who benefi t from SSRIs than who experience these serious adverse effects, the lack of any completed suicides, and the de- cline in overall suicidality in rating scales, the risk/benefi t ratio for SSRI use in pediatric depression appears to be favorable with care- ful monitoring. (p. 1516)

Close monitoring should include routine inquiry regarding suicidality and attention to worsening depressive symptoms, behavioral changes, and akathisia, a side effect that may increase risk of suicidality (NIMH, 2010b; Shaffer et al., 2001).

For social workers in health-care settings, these fi ndings suggest that, depending on one’s role and setting, training in the provi- sion of CBT, interpersonal, psychodynamic, dialectical behavior, and family therapies or referring clients to such therapies may be in- dicated. In addition, collaboration with physi- cians who can evaluate the use of psychotropic medications, in particular medications that are not lethal in overdose, would be warranted (Hirschfeld & Russell, 1997; Murphy, 1975a).

PSYCHOSOCIAL INTERVENTION STRATEGIES IN HEALTH-CARE SETTINGS

Social work practitioners strive to match in- tervention strategies to individuals in their ecological contexts and to the identifi ed

JWBT514_ch08.indd 198JWBT514_ch08.indd 198 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Physical and Mental Health: Interactions, Assessment, and Interventions 199

problems (Berlin & Marsh, 1993). They do this with the best available evidence and the client’s preferences for intervention (Culpeper, 2003; Gambrill, 2000; J. W. Williams et al., 2002). Comprehensive assessment enables social workers to fully consider the range of factors that may be contributing to the prob- lem and the range of interventions that may resolve it effectively. Furthermore, it enables social workers to discuss intervention options with the client (Gambrill, 2000). As described above, differential assessment involves identi- fying the type of mental health issue a person is experiencing, its possible infl uences, and possible ways to address it. The psychosocial interventions described next begin with strate- gies to support coping and overall well-being and then address strategies to assist people who are experiencing depression and anxiety disorders.

Routine Screening of Psychosocial Conditions

Because of the signifi cant implications of mental health in health-care settings, includ- ing the relationship between psychological distress and physical health conditions, the role of behavior in health, the importance of suicide prevention, and the power of social ties in supporting health, routine screening of psychosocial conditions is highly relevant in health-care settings. Program planning and policy-level initiatives are warranted to ensure the availability of this core element of overall health care.

Transdisciplinary Collaboration and Coordination of Services

Another central component of supporting men- tal health in health-care settings involves trans- disciplinary collaboration with the team of providers working with the client. Transdisci- plinary collaboration is particularly relevant in underscoring the importance of mental health in physical health conditions and outcomes, examining intersections between the client’s mental health and physical condition, and

coordinating comprehensive care with numer- ous providers. When a client is experiencing psychological distress that warrants consulta- tion for psychopharmacological intervention, transdisciplinary collaboration can be helpful in accessing this service and in considering the possible interactions between psychotro- pic medications and any medications the client currently is taking for another condition.

Social workers often serve as brokers of services (Hepworth et al., 2002). In this role social workers can facilitate referrals and ac- cess to needed resources, including physical and mental health care, health insurance cover- age, housing, food, and community-based case management when indicated. Gambrill (2000) highlights the importance of being aware of the effectiveness of services to which clients are referred. Beyond simply linking a client to a given service, the social worker should consider the overall quality of that resource. In some communities, available resources may be limited and may require macro-level advo- cacy to adequately meet the needs of people within the community. In addition to simply providing a phone number or a contact name, the social worker may help facilitate the refer- ral by obtaining written consent from the client to contact the referral agency, by following up with the agency directly, and then by follow- ing up with the client to ensure that the contact was made.

Information and Psychoeducation

Information and psychoeducation are cen- tral components of helping individuals and families understand the physical or mental health condition, including its course, expected outcome, treatment, and psychosocial com- ponents (A. Johnson, Sandford, & Tyndall, 2003; Rolland, 1994). Educational and psy- choeducational approaches typically differ by scope, focus, and qualifi cations of the service provider. Education generally focuses on pro- viding information about an illness, including expected course, treatment, and components of self-care by a person who may not necessarily have professional training. Psychoeducation

JWBT514_ch08.indd 199JWBT514_ch08.indd 199 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

200 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

generally builds on these components by also including psychotherapeutic strategies, such as behavioral and cognitive interventions, led by a person with professional training in mental health services (Lukens & Thorning, 1998). Psychoeducational approaches support the emotional and cognitive processing of infor- mation and may assist people with developing a psychosocial understanding of the condition and its meaning in their lives (Rolland, 1994).

Based on a review of studies that compared the usefulness of written and verbal informa- tion for parents of children discharged from acute hospitals, A. Johnson and colleagues (2003) concluded that greater satisfaction and knowledge were associated with the provision of both written and verbal information. In addi- tion, they underscore the potential for client in- volvement in creating the written information, the importance of its culturally relevant pre- sentation, and attention to the literacy level of written material. Written and verbal informa- tion and psychoeducational interventions are important components of facilitating knowl- edge and strengthening coping with physical and mental health conditions. Furthermore, as described in the sections titled “Stress Man- agement” and “Strengthening Health-Support- ing Behaviors,” such interventions also may play an important role in reducing health risks and promoting longevity.

Adherence Counseling

Adherence to medication and treatment are key contributors to health outcomes. However, nonadherence is highly prevalent, impact- ing approximately 1 in 4 people (DiMatteo, 2004b). Social workers often assist people with adherence to medications and treatment. For comprehensive guidance to support adher- ence in health-care settings, see Chapter 20 in this book.

Stress Management

Several strategies have shown promise in help- ing people to manage stress and in supporting overall health, including mindfulness-based

stress reduction (MSBR; Kabat-Zinn, 2003; Weissbecker et al., 2002), exercise (McEwen & Gianaros, 2010), and relaxation training. Research on these approaches includes com- pelling fi ndings regarding their ability to af- fect not only mood and quality of life but also physical functioning and outcomes. For example, a recent randomized controlled trial of MBSR with 84 women who survived breast cancer found that MBSR was associ- ated with greater reductions in depression and fears of recurrence and greater improvements in energy and physical functioning compared with usual care (Lengacher et al., 2009). In a nonrandomized controlled study involving 75 women with early-stage breast cancer, MBSR was associated with greater improvements in quality of life, coping, and immune function- ing and reduced cortisol levels compared with the control group (Witek-Janusek et al., 2008). Similarly, research involving 133 adults ex- periencing chronic pain found MBSR to be associated not only with improved mental health but also with improved pain and physi- cal functioning (Rosenzweig et al., 2010). A recent meta-analysis indicated small physical effects of MBSR among people with can- cer, but it found greater mental health effects (Ledesma & Kumano, 2009). Another meta- analysis found small but signifi cant mental health effects of MBSR among people with chronic physical illness. The authors suggest that mindfulness-based cognitive therapy may be associated with greater gains, particularly in depression, among people with serious and persistent physical illness (Bohlmeijer, Prenger, Taal, & Cujipers, 2010).

There have been mixed fi ndings about the effectiveness of some relaxation training and stress management interventions among people with cardiac problems (IOM, 2001). A comprehensive review of 36 studies by Rees, Bennett, West, Davey, and Ebrahim (2004), 18 of which examined the effectiveness of stress management strategies, suggested that psychological and stress management inter- ventions among people with coronary heart disease were associated with some decreased depression and anxiety; however, fi ndings

JWBT514_ch08.indd 200JWBT514_ch08.indd 200 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Physical and Mental Health: Interactions, Assessment, and Interventions 201

did not demonstrate reductions in cardiac mortality, which may be due to methodologi- cal limitations of the published research and the range of interventions included in the review. In contrast to these fi ndings, as pre- viously discussed, a meta-analysis of 37 stud- ies found that stress management and health education interventions were, in fact, associ- ated with reduced risk of cardiac mortality as well as reductions in associated risk factors such as smoking, dietary habits, cholesterol, and blood pressure (Dusseldorp et al., 1999). These fi ndings, in conjunction with additional research conducted with people experiencing cancer and other serious illnesses, seem to suggest that stress management interventions are best partnered with psychoeducation to reduce risk factors and to enhance coping and survival (Butow et al., 1999; Conn, Hafdahl, Brown, & Brown, 2008; Dusseldorp et al., 1999; Fawzy et al., 1993, 1995; Spiegel et al., 1998).

Strengthening Health-Supporting Behaviors

Smoking cessation, healthful eating, and weight management are key behaviors that can help improve health (IOM, 2001). Engag- ing people in the change process and facilitat- ing motivation to change behavior are central elements of supporting such health behaviors. Two paradigms—the transtheoretical/stages of change model (Prochaska & DiClemente, 1983) and motivational interviewing (Miller & Rollnick, 1991, 2002; Rollnick, Miller, & Butler, 2008)—have received considerable at- tention as models to inform assisting people with behavior change efforts. Although empiri- cal research has prompted questions regard- ing the theoretical validity of Prochaska and DiClemente’s transtheoretical model (IOM, 2001; Littell & Girvin, 2002), and further research suggests that perceptions of self- effi cacy, expectations about outcomes, and self-control of behavior may predict behavioral changes more effectively, the stages of change model may be useful as a framework for con- ceptualizing readiness for change (IOM, 2001).

The stages of change model proposes that a person’s readiness for behavior change can be understood in the context of fi ve stages: precontemplation, contemplation, prepara- tion, action, and maintenance (Prochaska, DiClemente, & Norcross, 1992). The stages refl ect (a) the degree of awareness a person has about making a behavioral change (e.g., a move from precontemplation to contemplation refl ects increasing awareness of a behavior to be changed and increasing consideration of the possibility of change), (b) the time frame in which behavioral change will happen (e.g., a move from contemplation to preparation re- fl ects increased intention to take action in the near future), and (c) the action a person is tak- ing to achieve behavioral change (e.g., prepa- ration involves planning for change, action involves active modifi cation of behavior or en- vironment to support behavioral change, and maintenance involves steps to uphold change) (Prochaska et al., 1992). Together, Miller and Rollnick’s (1991, 2002) model of motivational interviewing and the stages of change model may provide useful tools for conceptualizing and enhancing motivation and for helping people change behaviors (IOM, 2001). Both of these models are discussed further in Chap- ter 17 of this book. In addition, more detailed information regarding motivational interview- ing in the context of health care can be found in a recent book by Rollnick, Miller, and Butler (2008). As noted earlier, connecting individu- ally focused behavior change interventions with attention to familial, social, and environmental factors, including access to safe places to exer- cise and availability of healthful food, is likely to strengthen their effectiveness (IOM, 2001).

Coping Enhancement

A large body of research suggests that inter- ventions to enhance coping can assist people experiencing psychological stress (Noh & Kaspar, 2003). Rather than focusing on spe- cifi c mental health symptoms among people experiencing physical illness, Folkman and Greer (2000) focus on “psychological well- being and the coping processes that support it”

JWBT514_ch08.indd 201JWBT514_ch08.indd 201 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

202 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

(p. 11). Informed by Lazarus and Folkman’s (1984) cognitive model of stress and coping and relevant research that focuses on elements of effective coping while experiencing illness, Folkman and Greer propose an approach that relies heavily on pursuing meaningful goals to support coping when faced with illness. In essence, this model focuses on continuing to seek goals that matter; facing the inspiring yet potentially frightening possibility that the goal may or may not be realized; and taking action to achieve the goal. Implicit in this model is the notion that pursuing goals that matter and that are not necessarily illness specifi c can be an important mechanism for fostering coping and continued engagement with positive as- pects of life in the midst of illness.

In this model, the social worker fi rst focuses on creating “conditions for challenge” which refl ect a positive appraisal that something valuable can be gained through the experience (Folkman & Greer, 2000, p.16). The impor- tance of challenge in this model is based on the premise that such appraisal holds the pos- sibility of achieving a meaningful goal through the client’s own efforts and of enhancing the client’s sense of control and ability. This chal- lenge combines the exciting possibility of achieving the goal and the potentially worri- some risk of striving without success. Normal- izing this combination of emotions may be helpful. To create the conditions for challenge, Folkman and Greer (2000) suggest exploring what matters to the client, whether it relates to his illness or to other parts of his life. The social worker “needs to help the patient defi ne what is important now, what matters most” (p. 16). Probing recent events and specifi c as- pects of those events that have meaning and that matter to the client will help create con- ditions for challenge. Identifi cation of what matters to the client also may be fostered even as clients discuss negative events. Nega- tive events can be explored and followed with inquiry regarding positive events or personal strengths. Folkman and Greer (2000) offer these specifi c questions: “Tell me about a time when something happened that made you feel good” or “Tell me about a time when things

were really going well. What was going on?’” (p. 16). Other sample questions might include “What are some of your strengths? When was a time that you used that strength?” Explora- tion of what was involved in those times, of how the client was feeling, and of “what mat- tered” to the client can help identify what is important to him (p. 16).

Identifying what matters to the client then informs the creation of a realistic goal that has meaning to him. The goal may be created inde- pendently by the client or with input from the social worker or signifi cant others. Most rel- evant is that the goal matters to the client and that it emphasizes personal control. Folkman and Greer (2000) describe the goal of a person experiencing metastatic bowel cancer to make tea for his companion although he was feel- ing weak physically and somewhat powerless emotionally. They go on to describe that in set- ting this goal and considering steps to achieve it, “the patient realized that there were still things he could control, and this helped lift his spirits” (p. 16). Goals may involve read- ing a book to a loved one, having a conversa- tion with a friend, pursuing a cherished hobby, formulating a system to manage medical treat- ments or side effects, or writing a letter to a partner; what is important is that the goal has value to the client and strengthens a sense of control.

The next step focuses on encouraging the client’s achievement of the goal, including continued support or revision of the goal if the task seems overwhelming. Key elements of this step include active engagement of the client in pursuing a goal that has meaning to him, focusing on steps to achieve the goal, and continuing to create the conditions of positive challenge. The fi nal component of the model involves maintaining “background positive mood” (Folkman & Greer, 2000, p. 17), which may include asking clients to talk about posi- tive happenings in their lives and encouraging them to plan activities that yield feelings of enjoyment and accomplishment.

This theoretically informed and research- guided model provides a framework for en- hancing coping and psychological well-being

JWBT514_ch08.indd 202JWBT514_ch08.indd 202 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Physical and Mental Health: Interactions, Assessment, and Interventions 203

when a person is experiencing serious ill- ness. Key elements of this model include its attention to normative coping and supporting a sense of control and mastery in the context of illness. This model has the potential to sup- port meaning, growth, and well-being in the midst of challenges associated with signifi cant illness (Cordova, Cunningham, Carlson, & Andrykowski, 2001; Folkman & Greer, 2000; Towsley, Beck, & Watkins, 2007).

Family and Social Support and Spiritual Resources

Psychosocial responses to physical and men- tal illness among individuals and their fami- lies are likely to vary according to the timing, onset, course, degree of incapacitation, and anticipated outcome of the illness (Rolland, 1994). Family and social support infl uence health outcomes via these pathways: direct bi- ology (e.g., airborne, bloodborne, and genetic conditions), health behavior (e.g., lifestyle, caregiving, and medical adherence support), and psychophysiology (e.g., physiological ef- fects of emotions and cognitions). Generally evidence-based family interventions include illness-specifi c education and psychoeduca- tion to support knowledge and coping and therapy to address relational problems, as indicated (Campbell, 2003). Multiple family groups, ongoing assessment of family mem- bers’ psychosocial experiences, support for normative coping, early intervention in the event of psychological distress, self-help or professionally facilitated support groups, and the structuring of services to actively involve family members also are recommended (IOM, 2001; Fobair, 1998; Rolland, 1994; Weihs et al., 2002). Enhancing social support and cop- ing skills through support groups and peer support also is likely to improve quality of life and health status. Finally, involvement in religious organizations is linked with positive health outcomes (IOM, 2001). Additional in- formation regarding families and health can be found in Chapter 13, and information regard- ing spiritual resources among families can be found in a recent book by Walsh (2009).

Targeted Interventions for People With Depression and Anxiety Disorders

There is a growing body of evidence to guide intervention with people experiencing depres- sion and anxiety disorders (DHHS, 1999). Unfortunately, most people in the United States who likely need care do not receive ap- propriate treatment, even when “appropriate treatment” is defi ned based on minimal rec- ommended levels of antidepressant medication or at least four meetings focusing on mental health with a mental health specialist or pri- mary care provider (Young, Klap, Sherbourne, & Wells, 2001). With a nationally represen- tative sample of those likely experiencing a depressive or anxiety disorder, only 30% re- ceived appropriate treatment, although 83% had seen a health-care provider. Likelihood of not receiving appropriate care was associated with being male, African American, less well educated, younger than 30 years, or older than 59 years. Income and insurance status were not associated with appropriate treatment, al- though insurance was associated with seek- ing care. No difference in accessing care was found between people who were White Ameri- can or African American, but African Ameri- cans were less likely to receive appropriate treatment; this discrepancy underscores the importance of addressing cultural competence in mental health care. In addition, the research also underscores the importance of addressing mental health-care disparities associated with race and SES (DHHS, 2001a; Young et al., 2001).

These treatment recommendations to assist people experiencing depression and anxiety disorders are informed by empirical studies and consensus statements (Ballenger et al., 2000, 2004; DHHS, 1999; Hollon, Thase, & Markowitz, 2002; NIMH, 2008, 2009; Young et al., 2001). For depression, CBT and interpersonal therapy (IPT) are evidence- based psychotherapeutic interventions that have demonstrated effectiveness with adoles- cents, adults, and older adults (DHHS, 1999; Hollon et al., 2002; NIMH, 2008). A recent review of effective approaches to depression

JWBT514_ch08.indd 203JWBT514_ch08.indd 203 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

204 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

among older adults also recognizes the value of problem-solving therapy and supportive psychotherapy. A new approach, ecosystem- focused therapy, recently has been developed and aims to assist older adults whose cognitive or physical challenges limit gains in therapies that rely heavily on problem-solving strategies (Alexopoulos & Kelly, 2009). NIMH (2010a) notes that light therapy, melatonin, and expres- sive or creative arts therapy have shown prom- ise in the treatment of depression.

Antidepressant medications including SSRIs, serotonin and norepinephrine reup- take inhibitors (SNRIs), tricyclics, and mono- amine oxidase inhibitors (MAOIs) may be helpful for people experiencing depression. It is important to note that antidepressants can take several weeks to achieve therapeutic ef- fects and that if one medication is ineffective, an effective alternative often can be found. Furthermore, some people require additional medications, particularly to address co-occur- ring physical and mental health conditions (NIMH, 2008). When people are experienc- ing severe unremitting depression for which other treatments are not effective or that co-occurs with psychotic symptoms, consid- eration of electroconvulsive therapy (ECT) may be indicated (DHHS, 1999; Hollon et al., 2002; NIMH, 2008).

For people experiencing anxiety disorders, CBT has been demonstrated to be effective as have several antidepressant and antianxiety medications and beta-blockers (DHHS, 1999; NIMH, 2009; Young et al., 2001). A recent clinical trial found that both CBT and short- term psychodynamic psychotherapy improved anxiety among 57 adults with generalized anx- iety disorder, but the CBT group experienced greater gains related to worry, depression, and trait anxiety (Leichsenring et al., 2009). A growing body of empirical research sug- gests that psychodynamic psychotherapy, long used to assist people experiencing a range of mental health concerns, outperforms wait-list or usual-treatment control groups and often is comparable to CBT and other psychothera- pies across psychiatric conditions. Further re- search is needed to examine the effi cacy and

effectiveness of psychodynamic psychother- apy to assist people with specifi c mental health conditions and to assess the optimal match be- tween clients and approaches (Leichsenring & Leibing, 2007; Leichsenring, Rabung, & Leibing, 2004; Leichsenring et al., 2009).

Recommended intervention for people ex- periencing PTSD differs based on when the traumatic event occurred. Immediately fol- lowing the traumatic event, recommendations include attending to safety, providing educa- tion about trauma, accessing natural support systems, and providing supportive counseling (Ballenger et al., 2000; Foa, Hembree, Riggs, Rauch, & Franklin, 2005; National Center for PTSD, 2010). Psychological fi rst aid is a research- and culturally informed model for addressing these and related considerations with children, adults, older adults, and fami- lies in the wake of natural disasters or terror- ism (Brymer et al., 2006). A detailed guide to providing psychological fi rst aid is available electronically at the National Center for PTSD Web site (www.ptsd.va.gov/professional/manuals /psych-fi rst-aid.asp).

Psychoeducation regarding trauma, nor- mal responses, coping strategies, and, when indicated, psychotherapeutic and psychophar- macologic interventions may be particularly useful in primary care. Neither single sessions of critical incident stress debriefi ng nor ben- zodiazepines are recommended as early in- tervention strategies (Ballenger et al., 2004). Ballenger and colleagues underscore the im- portance of encouraging clients who may ac- cess Internet information to pursue it from reputable health-care or advocacy organiza- tions rather than commercial, nonspecialist, or chat room Web sites.

People experiencing high levels of dis- tress with psychological or somatic symptoms should be assisted with relief of symptoms; CBT may be useful in reducing the risk of later PTSD (Ballenger et al., 2004). If after three or four weeks and two assessment sessions the client continues to experience signifi cant dis- tress and symptoms of PTSD, treatment that includes either SSRIs, CBT, or a blend of these strategies is recommended. Further research

JWBT514_ch08.indd 204JWBT514_ch08.indd 204 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Physical and Mental Health: Interactions, Assessment, and Interventions 205

is needed to address possible relapse upon completion of treatment. People experiencing persistent PTSD may benefi t from medication regimens lasting one year or more. CBT may help enhance gains during pharmacotherapy and sustain gains after treatment concludes (Ballenger et al., 2004).

As noted by the National Center for PTSD (Hamblen, Schnurr, Rosenberg, & Eftkhari, 2010), available treatment guidelines are unanimous in their support of CBT to assist people experiencing PTSD. Exposure-based therapy has been studied most and has strong empirical support (Hamblen et al., 2010; IOM, 2008). A recent study of brief eclectic psycho- therapy (BEP), which draws upon CBT and psychodynamic therapies, found that BEP outperformed a wait-list control group among 24 Dutch adults experiencing PTSD (Lindauer et al., 2005). Although further research is needed, the fi ndings suggest that this approach holds promise for helping people experiencing PTSD. Another approach with wide support is eye movement desensitization and reprocess- ing (EMDR) (Hamblen et al., 2010).

Recommended interventions with children and adolescents experiencing PTSD include trauma-focused psychotherapies that may draw on CBT, psychodynamic, and attach- ment theories; active involvement of primary caregivers in the helping process; and attention to resilience, functioning, and positive devel- opment in addition to psychological distress. Trauma-focused cognitive behavioral treat- ment (TF-CBT) has the strongest evidence base and is employed most frequently. Several studies suggest that Cognitive-Behavioral In- tervention for Trauma in Schools (CBITS), a group model that is similar to TF-CBT, can be adapted for use with diverse cultural groups and can reduce symptoms of posttraumatic stress and depression (AACAP, 2010; Ngo et al., 2008). Psychoeducation with children and caregivers, a component of TF-CBT, is recommended to provide information about PTSD and treatment, facilitate coping, and aid parental efforts to support the child or adoles- cent (AACAP, 2010; Cohen et al., 1998). Al- though EMDR has some research support for

use with children, recent practice parameters note signifi cant limitations of much of the cur- rently available research. Finally, SSRIs com- bined with psychotherapy may assist children and adolescents experiencing PSTD. Other medications including risperidone, clonidine, propranalol, and morphine (used with children experiencing burns in one study) also may be helpful (AACAP, 2010). Further informa- tion can be found online through the AACAP (http://www.aacap.org/).

Substance use problems and mental health concerns often co-occur. In general, integrated treatment that addresses these concerns simul- taneously is preferred (CSAT, 2005; NIDA, 2009). Promising treatment approaches and the value of trauma-informed and trauma- specifi c services are discussed in Chapter 17. More detailed information can be found in two electronically available treatment improve- ment protocols (CSAT, 2005, 2009).

CONCLUSION

This chapter addresses myriad intersections between physical and mental health in health- care settings. In many ways, we end where we started—the recognition of the complexity of the mutual infl uences between physical and mental health and ecological contexts. Al- though the general information provided can contribute to one’s evidence-based practice knowledge, it is critical that any knowledge base be informed by the unique preferences and ecological contexts of the people served. When crossing the many intersections between physical and mental health in health-care set- tings, it is important to proceed with engaged, thoughtful attention to assessments and in- terventions that refl ect competence to serve individuals and families across culture, race, ethnicity, SES, sexual orientation, spiritual background, physical ability, gender, and age. This engaged, thoughtful attention, in con- junction with leading-edge, evidence-based practice knowledge, will enable social work- ers to provide the high-quality services that all people deserve.

JWBT514_ch08.indd 205JWBT514_ch08.indd 205 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

206 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

SUGGESTED LEARNING EXERCISES

Learning Exercise 8.1

Discuss the following questions: How do physical and mental health conditions inter- sect? How can attention to psychosocial and ecological concerns infl uence health? What challenges exist in addressing psychosocial and ecological concerns in your practice set- ting? What resources are available to assist with these challenges? What is one step you can take to improve your and your organiza- tion’s ability to address intersections between physical and mental health among the clients you serve?

Learning Exercise 8.2

Discuss the following questions: How does your cultural background infl uence your un- derstanding of physical and mental health, ex- pressions of emotion and pain, and appropriate paths to help? How might these understand- ings infl uence your direct practice with clients and your interactions with the transdisci- plinary health-care team? How do you address culture in your direct practice with clients? What are your strengths and areas for growth in this area? How might you and your organi- zation strengthen the cultural competence of provided services?

Learning Exercise 8.3

Discuss the following questions: What are key components of differential assessments in health-care settings? How do assessments in- form interventions? Either discuss or role-play how you would engage in differential assess- ment and subsequent intervention in the next hypothetical cases.

Exercise 8.3.1

Darren is a 25-year-old man of African Ameri- can background. He and his wife, Paula, have been married for 2 years. Last year he was diagnosed with HIV and hepatitis C. He

recently was prescribed a combination of pro- tease inhibitors and interferon-alfa. He was referred to the social worker by his physician because his feelings of depression are caus- ing him distress; he feels easily fatigued and recently has missed several days of work be- cause he “could not get going.” He is worried about his job and about being able to pay his bills if he does not go to work. He describes having experienced feelings of sadness and worry as a teenager, but prior to two months ago, those feelings had not surfaced for several years.

Exercise 8.3.2

Sandy is a 40-year-old woman of Native Amer- ican background. She and her partner of 15 years, Racquel, have two children, ages 11 and 9. Sandy has experienced asthma since her early 20s; she entered the hospital yesterday with ex- acerbated symptoms. While talking with you, she describes intense fears about the possibil- ity of another asthma attack. She also describes that she has felt increased diffi culty breathing over the past couple of weeks. She was so busy with household and child-care responsibilities that she did not have time to see the doctor to adjust her medication regimen. She describes feeling worried and restless when you meet with her. She has no prior history of mental health diffi culties or of mental health treatment.

Learning Exercise 8.4

Discuss the following questions: How might you proceed in direct practice with Joseph, who was described in the fi rst case example in this chapter? What additional information might you need to inform the assessment? What goals might be collaboratively set with Joseph? How might you intervene to address these goals?

Learning Exercise 8.5

In small groups, defi ne mental health and mental illness. Half of your group should de- velop a principled argument in support of the utility of the DSM-IV-TR and the other half

JWBT514_ch08.indd 206JWBT514_ch08.indd 206 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Physical and Mental Health: Interactions, Assessment, and Interventions 207

should develop a principled argument against the utility of the DSM-IV-TR. Return to one large group to discuss the strengths and limi- tations of the DSM-IV-TR in direct social work practice.

Learning Exercise 8.6

Discuss the following questions: What factors are associated with suicide risk? What are key ingredients of suicide assessment and inter- vention? In pairs, role-play the assessment of Georgina’s suicide risk in the next hypotheti- cal case. What might short- and long-term in- tervention involve?

Exercise 8.6.1

Georgina is a 45-year-old widowed woman of Mexican American background who was diagnosed with breast cancer 5 years ago. At that time she had a mastectomy followed by reconstructive surgery, radiation, and chemo- therapy. She recently has been diagnosed with a recurrence of cancer. Georgina describes a deep sense of sadness and hopelessness about this diagnosis. She fears feeling pain, going through chemotherapy, and losing her hair again and believes “it won’t do any good any- way.” She also describes feeling alone. Al- though her son and her daughter live nearby, they are both busy with their families and jobs. Georgina and her long-time companion separated 6 months ago. Georgina feels over- whelmed by her hopelessness, does not feel it will get better, and says that she wants to die. She has thought about notes that she would write to her family to say good-bye, and she has stored pain medication at her home that she plans to take.

Learning Exercise 8.7

Discuss the following questions: What prac- tice theories currently guide your clinical work with clients? How do these theories fi t with the evidence-based approaches addressed in this chapter? What are the implications of this fi t for providing optimal clinical services to clients?

Learning Exercise 8.8

Discuss the following questions: What addi- tional information would be helpful for you to gain in order to enhance the effectiveness of your assessments and interventions with peo- ple experiencing physical and mental health diffi culties?

Learning Exercise 8.9. Homework

You have been asked to conduct a comprehen- sive assessment of your organization’s capacity to effectively address co-occurring physical and mental health concerns among its clients. This assessment should consider the organization’s strengths and challenges in this area. Although the assessment will readily address the avail- ability and accessibility of appropriate screen- ing, assessment, and intervention, it also should address other factors that infl uence clients’ ex- periences in the organization. Based on your comprehensive assessment, you are asked to provide a thorough action plan that prioritizes steps the organization can take to improve its ef- fectiveness in serving clients with co-occurring physical and mental health concerns.

SUGGESTED RESOURCES

Condition-Specifi c Organizations American Cancer Society—www.cancer.org American Heart Association—www.heart

.org/HEARTORG Join Together—www.jointogether.org National Alliance for the Mentally Ill—

www.nami.org National Center for PTSD—www.ptsd

.va.gov/index.asp National Child Traumatic Stress Network—

www.nctsn.com/nccts/nav.do?pid=hom _main

Cultural Competence Association of Black Cardiologists, Inc.—

www.abcardio.org Cross Cultural Health Care Program—

www.xculture.org

JWBT514_ch08.indd 207JWBT514_ch08.indd 207 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

208 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

Cultural Competence in Care with Older Adults—www.stanford.edu/group/ ethnoger

Offi ce of Minority Health—minorityhealth .hhs.gov

www.stanford.edu/group/ethnoger

Evidence-Based Practice Evidence-Based Practice in Health Care

-Cochrane Collaboration—www.cochrane .org

National Registry of Evidence-Based Pro- grams and Practices—www.nrepp.samhsa .gov

Practice Guidelines—Consumers and Patients—www.ahrq.gov/consumer

Practice Guidelines—National—www.guide line.gov

U.S. Preventive Services Task Force— www.ahrq.gov/clinic/pocketgd.htm

Gay, Lesbian, Bisexual, and Transgender Resources

Gay and Lesbian Health—American Pub- lic Health Association—www.apha.org/ about/Public+Health+ Links/LinksGay andLesbianHealth.htm

Gay and Lesbian Medical Association— www.glma.org

Parents, Families, and Friends of Lesbians and Gays—www.pfl ag.org

Government Organizations Agency for Health Care Quality and Re-

search—www.ahrq.gov Bureau of Primary Health Care—http://

bphc.hrsa.gov National Institute on Drug Abuse—http://

drugabuse.gov/nidahome.html National Institute of Mental Health—www

.nimh.nih.gov Offi ce of Minority Health—http://minority

health.hhs.gov Substance Abuse and Mental Health Ser-

vices Administration—www.samhsa.gov

Medication Information U.S. National Library of Medicine and Na-

tional Institutes of Health—www.nlm

.nih.gov/medlineplus/aboutmedlineplus

.html

Search Engines Google Scholar—http://scholar.google.com PubMed—www.ncbi.nlm.nih.gov/pubmed

Suicide Suicide Prevention—National Institute of

Mental Health—www.nimh.nih.gov/health /topics/suicide-prevention/index.shtml

Suicide Prevention—Substance Abuse and Mental Health Services Adminis- tration (SAMHSA)—National Suicide Prevention Lifeline, 1-800-273-TALK; h t tp : / /menta lhea l th . samhsa .gov / suicideprevention/

REFERENCES

Aben, I., Verhey, F., Strik, J., Lousberg, R., Lodder, J., & Honig, A. (2003). A comparative study into the 1 year cumulative incidence of depression after stroke and myocardial infarction. Journal of Neurology, Neurosurgery, and Psychiatry, 74, 581–585.

Adler, N. E., & Stewart, J. (2010). Preface to the biology of disadvantage: Socioeconomic status and health. Annals of the New York Academy of Sciences, 1186, 1–4.

Alexopoulos, G. S., & Kelly, R. E. (2009). Research advances in geriatric depression. World Psychiatry, 8(3), 140–149.

Allgšwer, A., Wardle, J., & Steptoe, A. (2001). Depressive symptoms, social support, and personal health behaviors in young men and women. Health Psychology, 20(3), 223–227.

American Academy of Child and Adolescent Psychiatry. (2007). Practice parameter for the assessment and treatment of children and adolescents with depressive disorders. Journal of the American Academy of Child and Adolescent Psychiatry, 46(100), 1503–1526.

American Academy of Child and Adolescent Psychiatry. (2010). Practice parameter for the assessment and treatment of children and adolescents with posttraumatic stress disorder. Journal of the American Academy of Child and Adolescent Psychiatry, 49(4), 414–430.

American Psychiatric Association. (1994). Diagnostic and statistical manual of mental disorders (4th ed.). Washington, DC: Author.

American Psychiatric Association. (2000). Diagnostic and statistical manual of mental disorders (4th ed., text revision). Washington, DC: Author.

JWBT514_ch08.indd 208JWBT514_ch08.indd 208 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Physical and Mental Health: Interactions, Assessment, and Interventions 209

American Psychiatric Association. (2006). Practice guidelines for the assessment and treatment of patients with suicidal behaviors. Washington, DC: Author.

Andersen, A. U., Andersen, M., Rosholm, J. U., & Gram, L. F. (2000). Contacts to the health care system prior to suicide: A comprehensive analysis using registers for general and psychiatric hospital admissions, contacts to general practitioners and practising specialists and drug prescriptions. Acta Psychiatrica Scandinavica, 102(2), 126–134.

Angell, B. (2002). Boundary spanning: An ecological reinterpretation of social work practice in health and mental health systems [Book review]. Social Service Review, 76(4), 703–705.

Angst, F., Stassen, H. H., Clayton, P. J., & Angst, J. (2002). Mortality of patients with mood disorders: Follow-up over 34–48 years. Journal of Affective Disorders, 68, 167–181.

Angst, J., Angst, F., Gerber-Werder, R., & Gamma, A. (2005). Suicide in 406 mood-disorder patients with and without long-term medication: A 40–44 years’ follow-up. Archives of Suicide Research, 9, 279–300.

Bagner, D. M., Fernandez, M. A., & Eyberg, S. M. (2004). Parent-child interaction therapy and chronic illness: A case study. Journal of Clinical Psychology in Medical Settings, 11(1), 1–6.

Baldessarini, R. J., Tondo, L., Davis, P., Pompili, M., Goodwin, F. K., & Hennen, J. (2006). Decreased suicides and attempts during long-term lithium treatment: A meta-analytic review. Bipolar Disorders, 8, 625–639.

Ballenger, J. C., Davidson, R. T., Lecrubier, Y., Nutt, D. J., Foa, E. B., Kessler, R. C., . . . Shalev, A. Y. (2000). Consensus statement on posttraumatic stress disorder from the international consensus group on depression and anxiety. Journal of Clinical Psychiatry, 61(Suppl. 5), S60–S66.

Ballenger, J. C., Davidson, J. R., Lecrubier, Y., Nutt, D. J., Marshall, R. D., Nemeroff, C. B., . . . Yehuda, R. (2004). Consensus statement update on posttraumatic stress disorder from the international consensus group on depression and anxiety. Journal of Clinical Psychiatry, 65(Suppl. 1), S55–S62.

Barrow, S. M., Herman, D. B., Cordova, P., & Streuning, E. (1999). Mortality among homeless shelter residents in New York City. American Journal of Public Health, 89(4), 529–534.

Bateman, A., & Fonagy, P. (2008). 8-year follow-up of patients treated for borderline personality disorder: Mentalization-based treatment vs. treatment as usual. American Journal of Psychiatry, 165(5), 631–638.

Berlin, S., & Marsh, J. (1993). Informing practice decisions. New York, NY: Macmillan.

Bing, E., Burnam, A., Longshore, D., Fleishman, J. A., Sherbourne, C. D., London, A. S., . . . Shapiro, M. (2001). Psychiatric disorders and drug use among human immunodefi ciency virus-infected adults in the United States. Archives of General Psychiatry, 58, 721–728.

Bohlmeijer, E., Prenger, R., Taal, E., & Cuijpers, P. (2010). The effects of mindfulness-based stress reduction on mental health of adults with a chronic medical disease: A meta-analysis. Journal of Psychosomatic Research, 68, 539–544.

Brent, D. A., Holder, D., Kolko, D., Birmaher, B., Baugher, M., Roth, C., . . . Johnson, B. A. (1997). A clinical psychotherapy trial for adolescent depression comparing cognitive, family, and supportive therapy. Archives of General Psychiatry, 54(9), 877–885.

Brent, D. A., Poling, K., McKain, B., & Baugher, M. (1993). A psychoeducational program for families of affectively ill children and adolescents. Journal of the American Academy of Child and Adolescent Psychiatry, 32, 770–774.

Brestan, E. V., & Eyberg, S. M. (1998). Effective psychosocial treatments of conduct-disordered children and adolescents: 29 years, 82 studies, and 5,272 kids. Journal of Clinical Child Psychology, 27(2), 180–189.

Bridge, J. A., Greenhouse, J. B., Weldon, A. H., Campo, J. V., & Kelleher, K. J. (2008). Suicide trends among youths aged 10–19 years in the United States, 1996– 2005. JAMA, 300(9), 1025–1026.

Bronfenbrenner, U. (1977, July). Toward an experimental ecology of human development. American Psychologist, 32(7), 513–531.

Bronfenbrenner, U. (1979). Ecology of human development. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University.

Bronfenbrenner, U. (1989). Ecological systems theory. Annals of Child Development, 6, 187–249.

Brown, G. K., Ten Have, T., Henriques, G. R., Xie, S. X., Hollander, J. E., & Beck, A. T. (2005). Cognitive therapy for the prevention of suicide attempts: A randomized controlled trial. JAMA, 294(5), 563–570.

Brown, L. S. (1991). Therapy with an infertile lesbian client. In C. Silverstein (Ed.), Gays, lesbians and their therapists (pp.15–30). New York, NY: Norton.

Bruce, M. L., Ten Have, T. R., Reynolds, C. F., Katz, I. I., Schulberg, H. C., Mulsant, B. H., . . . Alexopoulos, G. S. (2004). Reducing suicidal ideation and depressive symptoms in depressed older primary care patients. JAMA, 291(9), 1081–1091.

Brymer, M., Jacobs, A., Layne, C., Pynoos, R., Ruzek, J., Steinberg, A., . . . Watson, P. (2006). Psychological fi rst aid: Field operations guide (2nd ed.). Retrieved from http://www.ptsd.va.gov/professional/manuals/psych -fi rst-aid.asp

Butow, P. N., Coates, A. S., & Dunn, S. M. (1999). Psychosocial predictors of survival in metastatic melanoma. Journal of Clinical Oncology, 17(7), 2256–2263.

Campbell, D. G., Felker, B. L., Liu, C., Yano, E. M., Kirchner, J. E., Chan, D., . . . Chaney, E. F. (2007). Prevalence of depression-PTSD comorbidity: Impli- cations for clinical practice guidelines and primary- care based interventions. Journal of General Internal Medicine, 22, 711–718.

JWBT514_ch08.indd 209JWBT514_ch08.indd 209 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

210 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

Campbell, T. L. (2003). The effectiveness of family intervention for physical disorders. Journal of Marital and Family Therapy, 29(2), 262–281.

Carlton-LaNey, I. (1999). African-American social work pioneers’ response to need. Social Work, 44(4), 311– 321.

Cash, S. J., & Bridge, J. A. (2009). Epidemiology of youth suicide and suicidal behavior. Current Opinion in Pediatrics, 21, 613–619.

Cedereke, M., Monti, K., & Öjehagen, A. (2002). Telephone contact with patients in the year after a suicide attempt: Does it affect treatment attendance and outcome? A randomized controlled study. European Psychiatry, 17, 82–91.

Center for Mental Health Services, Substance Abuse and Mental Health Services Administration, U.S. Department of Health and Human Services. (2001). Mental health, United States, 2000 (DHHS Publication No. SMA 01-3537). Washington, DC: U.S. Government Printing Offi ce. Retrieved from http://www.eric.ed.gov:80/PDFS/ED469203.pdf

Center for Substance Abuse Treatment, Substance Abuse and Mental Health Services Administration, U.S. Department of Health and Human Services. (2005). Substance abuse treatment for persons with co- occurring disorder (Treatment Improvement Protocol [TIP] Series, 42; DHHS Publication No. SMA 05- 3922). Rockville, MD: Author.

Center for Substance Abuse Treatment, Substance Abuse and Mental Health Services Administration, U.S. Department of Health and Human Services. (2009). Substance abuse treatment: Addressing the specifi c needs of women (Treatment Improvement Protocol [TIP] Series, 51; DHHS Publication No. SMA 09- 4426). Rockville, MD: Author.

Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. (2007). Suicide trends among youths and young adults aged 10–24 years: United States, 1990–2004. Morbidity and Mortality Weekly Report, 56(35), 905–908.

Clements-Nolle, K., Marx, R., & Katz, M. (2006). Attempted suicide among transgender persons: The infl uence of gender-based discrimination and victimization. Journal of Homosexuality, 51(3), 53–69.

Cobb, S. (1976). Social support as a moderator of life stress. Psychosomatic Medicine, 38, 300–314.

Cohen, J. A., Bernet, W., Dunne, J. E., Adair, M., Arnold, V., Benson, S., Sloan, L. E. (1998). Practice parameters for the assessment and treatment of children and adolescents with posttraumatic stress disorder. Journal of the American Academy of Child and Adolescent Psychiatry, 37(Suppl. 10), S4–S26.

Cohen, S., & Herbert, T. B. (1996). Health psychology: Psychological factors and physical disease from perspectives of human psychoneuroimmunity. Annual Review Psychology, 47, 114–132.

Conn, V. S., Hafdahl, A. R., Brown, S. A., & Brown, L. M. (2008). Meta-analysis of patient education interventions to increase physical activity among

chronically ill adults. Patient Education and Counseling, 70, 157–172.

Cordova, M. J., Cunningham, L. L. C., Carlson, C. R., & Andrykowski, M. A. (2001). Posttraumatic growth following breast cancer: A controlled comparison study. Health Psychology, 20(3), 176–185.

Costello, E. J., Compton, S. N., Keller, G., & Angold, A. (2003). Relationships between poverty and psychopathology: A natural experiment. JAMA, 290(15), 2023–2029.

Culpeper, L. (2003). Use of algorithms to treat anxiety in primary care. Journal of Clinical Psychiatry, 64 (Suppl. 2), S30–S33.

DiMatteo, M. R. (2004a). Social support and patient adherence to medical treatment: A meta-analysis. Health Psychology, 23(2), 207–218.

DiMatteo, M. R. (2004b). Variations in patients’ adherence to medical recommendations. Medical Care, 42, 200– 209.

Dohrenwend, B. P., Levav, I., Shrout, P. E., Schwartz, S., Naveh, G., Link, B. G., . . . Stueve, A. (1992). Socioeconomic status and psychiatric disorders: The causation-selection issue. Science, 255(5047), 946–952.

Dusseldorp, E., van Elderen, T., Maes, S., Meulman, J., & Kraaij, V. (1999). A meta-analysis of psychoeducational programs for coronary heart disease patients. Health Psychology, 18(5), 506–519.

Eisenstadt, T. H., Eyberg, S., McNeil, C. B., Newcomb, K., & Funderburk, B. (1993). Parent-child interaction therapy with behavior problem children: Relative effectiveness of two stages and overall treatment outcome. Journal of Clinical Child Psychology, 22(1), 42–51.

Engstrom, M., El-Bassel, N., Go, H., & Gilbert, L. (2008). Childhood sexual abuse and intimate partner violence among women in methadone treatment: A direct or mediated relationship? Journal of Family Violence, 23(7), 605–617.

Engstrom, M., Gunn, A., & Petersen, S. (2011, January). Homelessness, unmet basic needs, and social marginalization: Expanding conventional defi nitions of trauma. Poster presentation at the 15th Annual Conference of the Society for Social Work and Research, Tampa, FL.

Engstrom, M., Shibusawa, T., El-Bassel, N., & Gilbert, L. (2009). Age and HIV sexual risk among women in methadone treatment. AIDS and Behavior, 15(1), 103–113.

Fawzy, F. I., Fawzy, N. W., Arndt, L. A., & Pasnau, R. O. (1995). Critical review of psychosocial interventions in cancer care. Archives of General Psychiatry, 52(2), 100–113.

Fawzy, F. I., Fawzy, N. W., Hyun, C. S., Elashoff, R., Guthrie, D., Fahey, J. L., . . . Morton, D. L. (1993). Malignant melanoma: Effects of an early structure psychiatric intervention, coping, and affective state on recurrence and survival 6 years later. Archives of General Psychiatry, 50(9), 681–689.

JWBT514_ch08.indd 210JWBT514_ch08.indd 210 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Physical and Mental Health: Interactions, Assessment, and Interventions 211

Fergusson, D. M., Horwood, L. J., & Beautrais, A. L. (1999). Is sexual orientation related to mental health problems and suicidality in young people? Archives of General Psychiatry, 56, 876–880.

Fischer, P. F., & Breakey, W. R. (1991). The epidemiology of alcohol, drug, and mental disorders among homeless persons. American Psychologist, 46(11), 1115–1128.

Foa, E. B., Hembree, E. A., Riggs, D., Rauch, S., & Franklin, M. (2005). Guidelines for mental health professionals’ response to the recent tragic events in the United States: National Center for PTSD fact sheet. Washington, DC: U.S. Department of Veterans Affairs.

Fobair, P. (1998). Cancer support groups and group therapies. In J. B. Williams & K. Ell (Eds.), Advances in mental health services research: Implications for practice (pp. 365–398). Washington, DC: National Association of Social Workers.

Folkman, S., & Greer, S. (2000). Promoting psychological well-being in the face of serious illness: When theory, research and practice inform each other. Psycho- oncology, 9, 11–19.

Food and Drug Administration. (2007). New warnings proposed for antidepressants. Retrieved from www .fda.gov/ForConsumers/ConsumerUpdates/ucm 048950.htm

Frankowski, B. L., & Committee on Adolescence. (2004). Sexual orientation and adolescents. Pediatrics, 113(6), 1827–1832.

Frasure-Smith, N., & Lesperance, F. (2003). Depression and other psychological risks following myocardial infarction. Archives of General Psychiatry, 60, 627–636.

Gambrill, E. (2000). The role of critical thinking in evidence-based social work. In P. Allen-Meares & C. Garvin (Eds.), The handbook of social work direct practice (pp. 43–64). Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.

Gambrill, E. (2006). Social work practice: A critical thinker’s guide. New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Garvey, K. A., Penn, J. V., Campbell, A. L., Esposito- Smythers, C., & Spirito, A. (2009). Contracting for safety with patients: Clinical practice and forensic implications. Journal of the American Academy of Psychiatry Law, 37(3), 363–370.

Germain, C. B., & Gitterman, A. (1980). Life model of social work practice. New York, NY: Columbia University Press.

Gliatto, M. F., & Rai, A. K. (1999). Evaluation and treatment of patients with suicidal ideation. American Family Physician, 67(6), 1500–1513. Retrieved from www.aafp.org/afp/990315ap/1500.html

Goodman, L., Saxe, L., & Harvey, M. (1991). Homelessness as psychological trauma. American Psychologist, 46, 1219–1225.

Goodwin, J. S., Zhang, D. D., & Ostir, G. V. (2004). Effect of depression on diagnosis, treatment and survival of older women with breast cancer. Journal of the American Geriatric Society, 52(1), 106–111.

Gotterer, R. (2001). The spiritual dimension in clinical social work practice: A client perspective. Families in Society: Journal of Contemporary Human Services, 82(2), 187–193.

Grant, B. F. (1997). Prevalence and correlates of alcohol use and DSM-IV alcohol dependence in the United States: Results of the National Longitudinal Alcohol Epidemiologic Survey. Journal on Studies of Alcohol, 58, 464-473.

Hahn, R. A., Heath, G. W., & Chang, M. (1998, December 11). Cardiovascular disease risk factors and preventive practices among adults—United States, 1994: A behavioral risk factor atlas [CDC Surveillance Summaries]. Morbidity and Mortality Weekly Report, 47(No. SS-5), 35–69.

Hamblen, J. L., Schnurr, P. P., Rosenberg, A., & Eftkhari, A. (2010). Overview of PTSD treatment research. Retrieved from www.ptsd.va.gov/professional/pages /overview-treatment-research.asp

Henningfi eld, J. E. (1998). Addicted to nicotine—A national research forum: Section 1. History and pharmacology. Retrieved from www.nida.nih.gov /MeetSum/Nicotine/henningfi eld.html

Hepworth, D. H., Rooney, R. H., & Larsen, J. A. (2002). Direct social work practice: Theory and skills (6th ed.). Pacifi c Grove, CA: Brooks/Cole.

Heron, M. (2010). Deaths: Leading causes for 2006. National Vital Statistics Reports, 58(14).

Hibbs, J. R., Benner, L., Klugman, L., Spencer, R., Macchia, I., Mellinger, A., & Fife, D. K. (1994). Mortality in a cohort of homeless adults in Philadelphia. New England Journal of Medicine, 331(5), 304–309.

Hien, D., Zimberg, S., Weisman, S., First, M., & Ackerman, S. (1997). Dual diagnosis subtypes in urban substance abuse and mental health clinics. Psychiatric Services, 48, 1058–1063.

Hirschfeld, R. M. A., & Russell, J. M. (1997). Current concepts: Assessment and treatment of suicidal patients. New England Journal of Medicine, 337(13), 910–915.

Hoge, C. W., Castro, C. A., Messer, S. C., McGurk, D., Cotting, D. I., & Koffman, R. L. (2004). Combat duty in Iraq and Afghanistan, mental health problems, and barriers to care. New England Journal of Medicine, 351(1), 13–22.

Holkup, P. (2002). Evidence-based protocol: Elderly suicide—Secondary prevention. Iowa City, Iowa: University of Iowa Gerontological Nursing Interventions Research Center, Research Dissemination Core.

Hollis, F. (1939). Social case work in practice: Six case studies. New York, NY: Family Welfare Association of America.

Hollon, S. D., Thase, M. E., & Markowitz, J. C. (2002). Treatment and prevention of depression. Psychological Science in the Public Interest, 3(2), 39–77.

Hood, K. K., & Eyberg, S. M. (2003). Outcomes of parent-child interaction therapy: Mothers’ reports of maintenance 3 to 6 years after treatment. Journal

JWBT514_ch08.indd 211JWBT514_ch08.indd 211 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

212 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

of Clinical Child and Adolescent Psychology, 32(3), 419–429.

Horvath, A. (1995). The therapeutic relationship: From transference to alliance. In Session: Psychotherapy in Practice, 1, 1–17.

House, J. S., & Kahn, R. (1985). Measures and concepts of social support. In S. Cohen & S. L. Syme (Eds.), Social support and health (pp. 83–108). Orlando, FL: Academic Press.

Hunt, I. M., Kapur, N., Webb, R., Robinson, J., Burns, J., Shaw, J., & Appleby, L. (2009). Suicide in recently discharged psychiatric patients: A case-control study. Psychological Medicine, 39, 443–449.

Hwang, S. W., Lebow, J. M., Bierer, M. F., O’Connell, J. J., Orav, E. J., & Brennan, T. A. (1998). Risk factors for death in homeless adults in Boston. Archives of Internal Medicine, 158(13), 1454–1460.

Ickovics, J. R., Hamburger, M. E., Vlahov, D., Schoenbaum, E. E., Schuman, P., Boland, R. J., . . . HIV Epidemiology Research Study Group. (2001). Mortality, CD4 cell count decline, and depressive symptoms among HIV- seropositive women: Longitudinal analysis from the HIV epidemiology research study. JAMA, 285(11), 1466–1474.

Insel, T. R. (2004, January). Science to service: Mental health care after the decade of the brain. Paper presentation at the eighth annual conference of the Society for Social Work and Research, New Orleans, LA.

Institute for Clinical Systems Improvement. (2002). Major depression, panic disorder and generalized anxiety disorder in adults in primary care. Bloomington, MN: Author. Retrieved from www.guideline.gov

Institute of Medicine. (2001). Health and behavior: The interplay of biological, behavioral, and societal infl uences. Washington, DC: National Academy Press.

Institute of Medicine. (2008). Treatment of posttraumatic stress disorder: An assessment of the evidence. Washington, DC: National Academies Press.

Isacsson, G., Holmgren, A., Ösby, U., & Ahlner, J. (2009). Decrease in suicide among the individuals treated with antidepressants: A controlled study of antidepressants in suicide, Sweden, 1995–2005. Acta Psychiatrica Scandinavia, 120, 37–44.

Ivanoff, A. J., & Smyth, N. J. (1992). Intervention with suicidal individuals. In K. Corcoran (Ed.), Structuring change: Effective practice for common client problems (pp. 111–137). Chicago, IL: Lyceum Books.

Jesdale, B. M., & Zierler, S. (2002). Enactment of gay rights laws in the United States and trends in adolescent suicides: An investigation of non-Hispanic White boys. Journal of the Gay and Lesbian Medical Association, 6(2), 61–69.

Joe, S., Baser, R. S., Neighbors, H. W., Caldwell, C. H., & Jackson, J. S. (2009). 12-month and lifetime prevalence of suicide attempts among Black adolescents in the National Survey of American Life. Journal of the American Academy of Child & Adolescent Psychiatry, 48(3), 271–282.

Johnson, A., Sandford, J., & Tyndall, J. (2003). Written and verbal information versus verbal information only for patients being discharged from acute hospital settings to home. Cochrane Database of Systematic Reviews, 4.

Johnson, Y. (1999). Indirect work: Social work’s uncelebrated strength. Social Work, 44(4), 323–334.

Jordan, C., & Franklin, C. (1995). Clinical assessment for social workers: Quantitative and qualitative methods. Chicago, IL: Lyceum Books.

Kabat-Zinn, J. (2003). Mindfulness-based interventions in context: Past, present, and future. Clinical Psychology: Science and Practice, 10(2), 144–156.

Katon, W., Rutter, C., Ludman, E. J., Von Korff, M., Lin, E., Simon, G., . . . Unutzer, J. (2001). A randomized trial of relapse prevention of depression in primary care. Archives of General Psychiatry, 58, 241–247.

Kawachi, I., Adler, N. E., & Dow, W. H. (2010). Money, schooling, and health: Mechanisms and causal evidence. Annals of the New York Academy of Sciences, 1186, 56–68.

Kayser, K., & Sormanti, M. (2002a). A follow-up study of women with cancer: Their psychosocial well-being and close relationships. Social Work in Health Care, 35(1/2), 391–406.

Kayser, K., & Sormanti, M. (2002b). Identity and the illness experience: Issues faced by mothers with cancer. Illness, Crisis and Loss, 10(1), 10–26.

Kemeny, M. E., Weiner, H., Taylor, S. E., Schneider, S., Visscher, B., & Fahey, J. L. (1994). Repeated bereavement, depressed mood, and immune parameters in HIV seropositive and seronegative gay men. Health Psychology, 13, 14–24.

Kennard, B. D., Stewart, S. M., Olvera, R., Bawdon, R. E., O’Hailin, A., Lewis, C. P., & Winick, N. (2004). Nonadherence in adolescent oncology patients: Preliminary data on psychological risk factors and relationships to outcome. Journal of Clinical Psychology in Medical Settings, 11(1), 31–39.

Keppel, K. G., Pearcy, J. N., & Wagener, D. K. (2002, January). Trends in racial and ethnic-specifi c rates for the health status indicators: United States, 1990–1998 (Healthy People Statistical Notes, No. 23). Hyattsville, MD: National Center for Health Statistics.

Kerson, T. S. (2002). Boundary spanning: An ecological reinterpretation of social work practice in health and mental health systems. New York, NY: Columbia University Press.

Kessler, D., Lloyd, K., & Lewis, G. (1999). Cross sectional study of symptom attribution and recognition of depression and anxiety in primary care. British Medical Journal, 318, 436–439.

Kessler, R. C., Borges, G., & Walters, E. E. (1999). Prevalence of and risk factors for lifetime suicide attempts in the National Cormorbidity Survey. Archives of General Psychiatry, 56, 617–626.

Kessler, R. C., McGonagle, K. A., Zhao, S., Nelson, C. B., Hughes, M., Eshlerman, S., . . . Kendler, K. S.

JWBT514_ch08.indd 212JWBT514_ch08.indd 212 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Physical and Mental Health: Interactions, Assessment, and Interventions 213

(1994). Lifetime and 12-month prevalence of DSM- II-R psychiatric disorders in the United States. Archives of General Psychiatry, 51, 8–19.

Kessler, R. C., Sonnega, A., Bromet, E., Hughes, M., & Nelson, C. B. (1995). Posttraumatic stress disorder in the National Comorbidity Survey. Archives of General Psychiatry, 52(12), 1048–1060.

King, M., Semlyen, J., Tai, S. S., Killaspy, H., Osborn, D., Popelyuk, D., & Nazareth, I. (2008). A systematic review of mental disorder, suicide, and deliberate self harm in lesbian, gay and bisexual people. BMC Psychiatry, 8(70).

Kirk, S. A., & Kutchins, H. (1992). The selling of the DSM: The rhetoric of science in psychiatry. New York, NY: Aldine de Gruyter.

Kleinman, A., Eisenberg, L., & Good, B. (1978). Culture, illness, and care: Clinical lessons from anthropologic and cross-cultural research. Annals of Internal Medicine, 88(2), 251–258.

Kondrat, M. E. (2002). Actor-centered social work: Re- visioning “person-in-environment” through a critical theory lens. Social Work, 47(4), 435–448.

Krantz, D. S., Sheps, D. S., Carney, R. M., & Natelson, B. H. (2000). Effects of mental stress in patients with coronary artery disease: Evidence and clinical implications. JAMA, 283(14), 1800–1802.

Krieger, N. (2003). Does racism harm health? Did child abuse exist before 1962? On explicit questions, critical science, and current controversies: An ecosocial perspective. American Journal of Public Health, 93(2), 194–199.

Kushel, M. B., Vittinghoff, E., & Haas, J. S. (2001). Factors associated with the health care utilization of homeless persons. JAMA, 285(2), 200–206.

Lazarus, R. S., & Folkman, S. (1984). Stress, appraisal and coping. New York, NY: Springer.

Lecrubier, Y. (2004). Posttraumatic stress disorder in primary care: A hidden diagnosis. Journal of Clinical Psychiatry, 65(Suppl. 1), S49–S54.

Ledesma, D., & Kumano, H. (2009). Mindfulness-based stress reduction and cancer: A meta-analysis. Psycho- Oncology, 18, 571–579.

Leichsenring, F., & Leibing, E. (2007). Psychodynamic psychotherapy: A systematic review of techniques, indications and empirical evidence. Psychology and Psychotherapy: Theory, Research and Practice, 80, 217–228.

Leichsenring, F., Rabung, S., & Leibing, E. (2004). The effi cacy of short-term psychodynamic psychotherapy in specifi c psychiatric disorders. Archives of General Psychiatry, 61, 1208–1216.

Leichsenring, F., Salzer, S., Jaeger, U., Kächele, H., Kreische, R., Leweke, F., . . . Leibing, E. (2009). Short- term psychodynamic psychotherapy and cognitive- behavioral therapy in generalized anxiety disorder: A randomized, controlled trial. American Journal of Psychiatry, 166(8), 875–881.

Lengacher, C. A., Johnson-Mallard, V., Post-White, J., Moscoso, M. S., Jacobsen, P. B., Klein, T. W., . . . Kip, K. E. (2009). Randomized controlled trial of mindfulness-based stress reduction (MBSR) for survivors of breast cancer. Psycho-Oncology, 18, 1261–1272.

Levinson, W., & Engel, C. C. (1997). Anxiety. In M. D. Feldman & J. F. Christensen (Eds.), Behavioral medicine in primary care: A practical guide (pp. 193– 211). Stamford, CT: Appleton & Lange.

Lin, E., Katon, W., Von Korff, M., Tang, L., Williams, J. W., Kroenke, K., . . . IMPACT Investigators. (2003). Effect of improving depression care on pain and functional outcomes among older adults with arthritis: A randomized controlled trial. JAMA, 290(18), 2428–2434.

Lin, K., & Cheung, F. (1999). Mental health issues for Asian Americans. Psychiatric Services, 50(6), 774– 780.

Lindauer, R. J. L., Gersons, B. P. R., van Meijel, E. P. M., Blom, K., Carlier, I. V. E., Vrijlandt, I., & Olff, M. (2005). Effects of brief eclectic psychotherapy in patients with posttraumatic stress disorder: Randomized clinical trial. Journal of Traumatic Stress, 18(3), 205–212.

Littell, J. H., & Girvin, H. (2002). Stages of change: A critique. Behavior Modifi cation, 26(2), 223–273.

Low-Beer, S., Chan, K., Yip, B., Wood, E., Montaner, J. S. G., O’Shaughnessy, M. V., & Hogg, R. S. (2000). Depressive symptoms decline among persons on HIV protease inhibitors. Journal of Acquired Immune Defi ciency Syndromes and Human Retrovirology, 23(4), 295–301.

Lukas, S. (1993). Where to start and what to ask: An assessment handbook. New York, NY: Norton.

Lukens, E. P., & Thorning, H. (1998). Psychoeducation and severe mental illness: Implications for social work practice and research. In J. B. Williams & K. Ell (Eds.), Advances in mental health services research: Implications for practice (pp. 343–364). Washington, DC: National Association of Social Workers.

Luoma, J. B., Martin, C. E., & Pearson, J. L. (2002). Contact with mental health and primary care providers before suicide: A review of the evidence. American Journal of Psychiatry, 159, 909–916.

Mann, J. J., Apter, A., Bertolote, J., Beautrais, A., Currier, D., Haas, A., . . . Hendin, H. (2005). Suicide prevention strategies: A systematic review. JAMA, 294(16), 2064– 2074.

March, J., Silva, S., Vitiello, B., & TADS Team. (2006). The treatment for adolescents with depression study (TADS): Methods and message at 12 weeks. Journal of the American Academy of Child and Adolescent Psychiatry, 45(12), 1393–1403.

Mathy, R. M. (2002). Transgender identity and suicidality in a nonclinical sample: Sexual orientation, psychiatric history, and compulsive behaviors. Journal of Psychology and Human Sexuality, 14(4), 47–63.

JWBT514_ch08.indd 213JWBT514_ch08.indd 213 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

214 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

Matthews, J. R., Spieth, L. E., & Christophersen, E. R. (1995). Behavior compliance in a pediatric context. In M. Roberts (Ed.), Handbook of pediatric psychology (2nd ed., pp. 617–632). New York, NY: Guilford Press.

McEwen, B. S. (1998). Stress, adaptation and disease: Allostasis and allostatic load. Annals of the New York Academy of Sciences, 840, 33–44.

McEwen, B. S., & Gianaros, P. J. (2010). Central role of the brain in stress and adaptation: Links to socioeconomic status, health, and disease. Annals of the New York Academy of Sciences, 1186, 190–222.

McEwen, B. S., & Stellar, E. (1993). Stress and the individual: Mechanisms leading to disease. Archives of Internal Medicine, 153, 2093–2101.

McFarlane, W. R., Lukens, E., Link, B., Dushay, R., Deakins, S. A., Newmark, M., . . . Toran, J. (1995). Multiple-family groups and psychoeducation in the treatment of schizophrenia. Archives of General Psychiatry, 52, 679–687.

McGinnis, J. M., Williams-Russo, P., & Knickman, J. R. (2002). The case for more active policy attention to health promotion. Health Affairs, 21(2), 78–93.

McGoldrick, M. (1982). Ethnicity and family therapy: An overview. In M. McGoldrick, J. K. Pearson, & J. Giordano (Eds.), Ethnicity and family therapy (pp. 3–30). New York, NY: Guilford Press.

McMyler, C., & Pryjmachuk, S. (2008). Do ‘no-suicide’ contracts work? Journal of Psychiatric and Mental Health Nursing, 15, 512–522.

McNeil, C., Eyberg, S., Eisenstadt, T., Newcomb, K., & Funderburk, B. (1991). Parent-child interaction therapy with behavior problem children: Generalization of treatment effects to the school setting. Journal of Clinical Child Psychology, 20(2), 140–151.

Mechanic, D. (1999). Mental health and mental illness: Defi nitions and perspectives. In A. V. Horwitz & T. L. Scheid (Eds.), A handbook for the study of mental health: Social contexts, theories, and systems (pp. 12–28). Cambridge, UK: Cambridge University Press.

Meehan, J., Kapur, N., Hunt, I. M., Turnbull, P., Robinson, J., Bickley, H., . . . Appleby, L. (2006). Suicide in mental health in-patients and within 3 months of discharge. British Journal of Psychiatry, 188, 129–134.

Meyer, C. H. (1993). Assessment in social work practice. New York, NY: Columbia University Press.

Miller, A. L., Rathus, J. H., Linehan, M. M., Wetzler, S., & Leigh, E. (1997). Dialectical behavior therapy adapted for suicidal adolescents. Journal of Practical Psychiatry and Behavioral Health, 3, 78–86.

Miller, G. E., Cohen, S., & Herbert, T. (1999). Pathways linking major depression and immunity in ambulatory female patients. Psychosomatic Medicine, 61, 850–860.

Miller, W. R., & Rollnick, S. (1991). Motivational interviewing: Preparing people to change addictive behavior. New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Miller, W. R., & Rollnick, S. (2002). Motivational interviewing: Preparing people for change (2nd ed.). New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Millman, J., Strike, D. M., Van Soest, M., Rosen, N., & Schmidt, E. (1998). Talking with the caller: Guidelines for crisis line and other volunteer counselors. Thousand Oaks, CA: SAGE.

Morgan, H. G., Jones, E. M., Owen, J. H. (1993). Secondary prevention of non-fatal deliberate self- harm. British Journal of Psychiatry, 163, 111–112.

Moscicki, E. K. (1997). Identifi cation of suicide risk factors using epidemiologic studies. Psychiatric Clinics of North America, 20(3), 499–517.

Moscicki, E. K. (2001). Epidemiology of completed and attempted suicide: Toward a framework for prevention. Clinical Neuroscience Research, 1, 310–323.

Mufson, L., Weissman, M. M., Moreau, D., & Garfi nkel, R. (1999). Effi cacy of interpersonal psychotherapy for depressed adolescents. Archives of General Psychiatry, 56, 573–579.

Mundy, E., & Baum, A. (2004). Medical disorders as a cause of psychological trauma and posttraumatic stress disorder. Current opinion in psychiatry, 17(2), 123–127.

Murphy, G. E. (1975a). The physician’s responsibility for suicide: Pt. 1. An error of commission. Annals of Internal Medicine, 82(3), 301–304.

Murphy, G. E. (1975b). The physician’s responsibility for suicide: Pt. 2. Errors of omission. Annals of Internal Medicine, 82(3), 305–309.

Musick, M. A., Traphagan, J. W., Koenig, H. G., & Larson, D. B. (2000). Spirituality in physical health and aging. Journal of Adult Development, 7(2), 73–86.

National Cancer Institute. (2010). Suicide risk in cancer patients. Retrieved from www.cancer .gov/cancertopics/pdq/supportivecare/depression /HealthProfessional/page4

National Center for PTSD. (2010). Trauma, PTSD, and the primary care provider. Retrieved from http://www .publichealth.va.gov/docs/vhi/posttraumatic.pdf

National Institute of Mental Health. (2002a). Depression and cancer. Bethesda, MD: National Institute of Mental Health, National Institutes of Health, U.S. Department of Health and Human Services (NIH Publication No. 02-5002).

National Institute of Mental Health. (2002b). Depression and diabetes. Bethesda, MD: National Institute of Mental Health, National Institutes of Health, U.S. Department of Health and Human Services (NIH Publication No. 02-5003).

National Institute of Mental Health. (2002c). Depression and heart disease. Bethesda, MD: National Institute of Mental Health, National Institutes of Health, U.S. Department of Health and Human Services (NIH Publication No. 02-5004).

National Institute of Mental Health. (2002d). Depression and HIV/AIDS. Bethesda, MD: National Institute of

JWBT514_ch08.indd 214JWBT514_ch08.indd 214 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Physical and Mental Health: Interactions, Assessment, and Interventions 215

Mental Health, National Institutes of Health, U.S. Department of Health and Human Services (NIH Publication No. 02-5005).

National Institute of Mental Health. (2002e). Depression and Parkinson’s disease. Bethesda, MD: National Institute of Mental Health, National Institutes of Health, U.S. Department of Health and Human Services (NIH Publication No. 02-5007).

National Institute of Mental Health. (2002f). Depression and stroke. Bethesda, MD: National Institute of Mental Health, National Institutes of Health, U.S. Department of Health and Human Services (NIH Publication No. 02-5006).

National Institute of Mental Health. (2007). Older adults: Depression and suicide facts. Retrieved from www.nimh.nih.gov/health/publications/older -adults-depression-and-suicide-facts-fact-sheet /index.shtml

National Institute of Mental Health. (2008). Depression [NIH Publication No. 08-3561]. Bethesda, MD: U.S. Department of Health and Human Services.

National Institute of Mental Health. (2009). Anxiety disorders [NIH Publication No. 09-3879]. Bethesda, MD: U.S. Department of Health and Human Services.

National Institute of Mental Health. (2010a). Psychotherapies. Retrieved from www.nimh.nih.gov /health/topics/psychotherapies/index.shtml

National Institute of Mental Health. (2010b). What medications are used to treat depression? Retrieved from www.nimh.nih.gov/health/publications/mental -health-medications/what-medications-are-used-to -treat-depression.shtml

National Institute on Drug Abuse. (2009). Cigarettes and other tobacco products. Retrieved from www .drugabuse.gov/infofacts/tobacco.html

New York State Department of Health. (2007). Suicidality and violence in patients with HIV/AIDS. New York, NY: Author. Retrieved from www.guideline.gov /content.aspx?id=10413&search=suicidality+and+viol ence+in+patients+with+hiv%2faids

Ng, D. M., & Jeffrey, R. W. (2003). Relationships between perceived stress and health behaviors in a sample of working adults. Health Psychology, 22(6), 638–642.

Ngo, V. M., Langley, A., Kataoka, S. H., Nadeem, E., Escudero, P., & Stein, B. D. (2008). Providing evidence-based practice to ethnically diverse youths: Examples from the cognitive behavioral intervention for trauma in schools (CBITS) program. Journal of the American Academy of Child and Adolescent Psychiatry, 47(8), 858–862.

Nixon, R. D. V., Sweeney, L., Erickson, D. B., & Touyz, S. W. (2003). Parent-child interaction therapy: A comparison of standard and abbreviated treatment for oppositional defi ant preschoolers. Journal of Consulting and Clinical Psychology, 71(2), 251–260.

Nock, M. K., Borges, G., Bromet, E. J., Cha, C. B., Kessler, R. C., & Lee, S. (2008). Suicide and suicidal behavior. Epidemiologic Reviews, 30, 133–154.

Noh, S., & Kaspar, V. (2003). Perceived discrimination and depression: Moderating effects of coping, acculturation, and ethnic support. American Journal of Public Health, 93(2), 232–238.

Offi ce of Applied Studies, Substance Abuse and Mental Health Services Administration, U.S. Department of Health and Human Services. (2009). Results from the 2008 National Survey on Drug Use and Health: National Findings [DHHS Publication No. SMA 09- 4434]. Rockville, MD: Author.

Offi ce of Minority Health, Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. (n.d.). Eliminate disparities in cardiovascular disease (CVD). Retrieved from www .cdc.gov/omhd/amh/factsheets/cardio.htm

Olfson, M., Marcus, S. C., & Shaffer, D. (2006). Antidepressant drug therapy and suicide in severely depressed children and adults. Archives of General Psychiatry, 63, 865–872.

Parmley, W. W. (2001). African American patients and heart disease [Editor’s page]. Journal of the American College of Cardiology, 38(5), 1577.

Patrick, D. L., Ferketich, S. L., Frame, P. S., Harris, J. J., Hendricks, C. B., Levin, B., . . . Vernon, S. W. (2003). National Institutes of Health state-of-the- science conference statement: Symptom management in cancer—Pain, depression, and fatigue, July 15–17, 2002. Journal of the National Cancer Institute, 95(15), 1110–1117.

Perlman, H. H. (1957). Social casework: A problem-solving process. Chicago, IL: University of Chicago Press.

Pignone, M. P., Gaynes, B. N., Rushton, J. L., Burchell, C. M., Orleans, C. T., Mulrow, C. D., Lohr, K. N. (2002). Screening for depression in adults: A summary of the evidence for the U.S. Preventives Services Task Force. Annals of Internal Medicine, 136(10), 760–764.

Pinderhughes, E. (1989). Understanding race, ethnicity, and power: The key to effi cacy in clinical practice. New York, NY: Free Press.

Prins, A., Ouimette, P., Kimerling, R., Cameron, R. P., Hugelshofer, D. S., Shaw-Hegwer, J., . . . Sheikh, J. I. (2004). The primary care PTSD screen (PC–PTSD): Development and operating characteristics. Primary Care Psychiatry, 9(1), 9–14.

Prochaska, J. O., & DiClemente, C. C. (1983). Stages and processes of self-change of smoking: Toward an integrative model of change. Journal of Consulting and Clinical Psychology, 51, 390–395.

Prochaska, J. O., DiClemente, C. C., & Norcross, J. C. (1992). In search of how people change: Applications to addictive behaviors. American Psychologist, 47(9), 1102–1114.

Rabins, P. (1991). Assessing the mental status of the older person [Videorecording]. Baltimore, MD: University of Maryland at Baltimore.

Rees, K., Bennett, P., West, R., Davey, S. G., & Ebrahim, S. (2004). Psychological interventions for coronary heart disease. Cochrane Database of Systematic Reviews, 2, 1.

JWBT514_ch08.indd 215JWBT514_ch08.indd 215 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

216 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

Regier, D. A., Narrow, W. E., Rae, D. S., Manderscheid, R. W., Locke, B. Z., & Goodwin, F. K. (1993). The de facto U.S. mental and addictive disorders service system: Epidemiologic catchment area prospective 1-year prevalence rates of disorders and services. Archives of General Psychiatry, 50(2), 85–94.

Remafedi, G. (1999). Sexual orientation and youth suicide. JAMA, 282(13), 1291–1292.

Richmond, M. (1917). Social diagnosis. New York, NY: Russell Sage.

Rolland, J. S. (1994). Families, illness, and disability: An integrative treatment model. New York, NY: Basic Books.

Rollnick, S., Miller, W., & Butler, C. C. (2008). Motivational interviewing in health care: Helping patients change behavior. New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Rosenzweig, S., Greeson, J. M., Reibel, D. K., Green, J. S., Jasser, S. A., & Beasley, D. (2010). Mindfulness- based stress reduction for chronic pain conditions: Variation in treatment outcomes and role of home meditation practice. Journal of Psychosomatic Research, 68, 29–36.

Rudd, M. D., Mandrusiak, M., & Joiner, T. E. (2006). The case against no-suicide contracts: The commitment to treatment statement as a practice alternative. Journal of Clinical Psychology: In Session, 62(2), 243–251.

Russell, S. T., & Joyner, K. (2001). Adolescent sexual orientation and suicide risk: Evidence from a national study. American Journal of Public Health, 91(8), 1276–1281.

Saleebey, D. (2002). Introduction: Power to the people. In D. Saleebey (Ed.), The strengths perspective in social work practice (3rd ed., pp. 1–22). Boston, MA: Allyn & Bacon.

Sanchez, H. G. (2001). Risk factor model for suicide assessment and intervention. Professional Psychology: Research and Practice, 32(4), 351–358.

Saraceno, B., & Barbui, C. (1997). Poverty and mental illness. Canadian Journal of Psychiatry, 42, 285–290.

Schneeweiss, S., Patrick, A. R., Solomon, D. H., Mehta, J., Dormuth, C., Miller, M., . . . Wang, P. S. (2010). Variation in the risk of suicide attempts and completed suicides by antidepressant agent in adults: A propensity score-adjusted analysis of 9 years’ data. Archives of General Psychiatry, 67(5), 497–506.

Schuhmann, E. M., Foote, R. C., Eyberg, S. M., Boggs, S. R., & Algina, J. (1998). Effi cacy of parent-child interaction therapy: Interim report of a randomized trial with short-term maintenance. Journal of Clinical Child Psychology, 27(1), 34–45.

Seal, K. H., Bertenthal, D., Miner, C., Sen, S., & Marmar, C. (2007). Mental health disorders among 103,788 US veterans returning from Iraq and Afghanistan seen at Department of Veterans Affairs facilities. Archives of General Psychiatry, 167, 476–482.

Segerstrom, S. C., & Miller, G. E. (2004). Psychological stress and the human immune system: A meta-analytic

study of 30 years of inquiry. Psychological Bulletin, 130(4), 601–630.

Shaffer, D., Fisher, P., Dulcan, M. K., Davies, M., Piacentini, J., Schwab-Stone, M. E., . . . Regier, D. (1996). The NIMH diagnostic interview schedule for children (Version 2.3, DISC-2.2): Description, acceptability, prevalence rates, and performance in the MECA study. Journal of the American Academy of Child and Adolescent Psychiatry, 35(7), 865–877.

Shaffer, D., Pfeffer, C. R., Bernet, W., Arnold, V., Beitchman, J., Benson, R. S., . . . Shaw, J. (2001). Practice parameter for the assessment and treatment of children and adolescents with suicidal behavior. Journal of the American Academy of Child and Adolescent Psychiatry, 40(Suppl.), S24–S51.

Shea, S. C. (1988). Psychiatric interviewing: The art of understanding. Philadelphia, PA: Saunders.

Siefert, K., Bowman, P. J., Hefl in, C. M., Danziger, S., & Williams, D. R. (2000). Social and environmental predictors of maternal depression in current and recent welfare recipients. American Journal of Orthopsychiatry, 70(4), 510–522.

Simon, G. E., Savarino, J., Operskalki, B., & Wang, P. S. (2006). Suicide risk during antidepressant treatment. American Journal of Psychiatry, 163(1), 41–47.

Skinner, K. M., Kressin, N., Frayne, S., Tripp, T. J., Hankin, C. S., Miller, D. R., & Sullivan, L. M. (2000). The prevalence of military sexual assault among female Veterans’ Administration outpatients. Journal of Interpersonal Violence, 15(3), 291–310.

Spiegel, D., Sephton, S. E., Terr, A. I., & Stites, D. P. (1998). Effects of psychosocial treatment in prolonging cancer survival may be mediated by neuroimmune pathways. Annals of New York Academy of Science, 840, 674–683.

Stark, D., Kiely, M., Smith, A., Velikova, G., House, A., & Selby, P. (2002). Anxiety disorders in cancer patients: Their nature, association, and relation to quality of life. Journal of Clinical Oncology, 20(14), 3137–3148.

Sterling, P. & Eyer, J. (1988) Allostasis: a new paradigm to explain arousal pathology. In S. Fisher & J. Reason (Eds.), Handbook of Life Stress, Cognition and Health (pp. 629–649). New York, NY: Wiley.

Stein, M. B., McQuaid, J. R., Pedrelli, P., Lenox, R., & McCahill, M. E. (2000). Posttraumatic stress disorder in the primary care medical setting. General Hospital Psychiatry, 22, 261–269.

Strader, D. B., Wright, T., Thomas, D. L., Seeff, L. B., & American Association for the Study of Liver Diseases (2004). Diagnosis, management, and treatment of Hepatitis C. Hepatology, 39(4), 1147–1171.

Surís, A., Lind, L., Kashner, T. M., Borman, P. D., & Petty, F. (2004). Sexual assault in women veterans: An examination of PTSD risk, health care utilization, and cost of care. Psychosomatic Medicine, 66(5), 749–756.

JWBT514_ch08.indd 216JWBT514_ch08.indd 216 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Physical and Mental Health: Interactions, Assessment, and Interventions 217

Susser, E. S., Herman, D. B., & Aaron, B. (2002). Combating the terror of terrorism. Scientifi c American, 287(2), 70–78.

Tiihonen, J., Lönnqvist, J., Wahlbeck, K., Klaukka, T., Tanskanen, A., & Haukka, J. (2006). Antidepressants and the risk of suicide, attempted suicide, and overall mortality in a nationwide cohort. Archives of General Psychiatry, 63, 1358–1367.

Towsley, G. L., Beck, S. L., & Watkins, J. F. (2007). “Learning to live with it”: Coping with the transition to cancer survivorship in older adults. Journal of Aging Studies, 21, 93–106.

Trzepacz, P. T., & Baker, R. W. (1993). The psychiatric mental status examination. New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

U.S. Department of Defense Task Force on Mental Health. (2007). An achievable vision: Report of the Department of Defense Task Force on Mental Health. Falls Church, VA: Defense Health Board.

U.S. Department of Health and Human Services. (1999). Mental health: A report of the surgeon general. Rockville, MD: Author.

U.S. Department of Health and Human Services. (2001a). Mental health: Culture, race, and ethnicity—A supplement to mental health: A report of the surgeon general. Rockville, MD: Author.

U.S. Department of Health and Human Services. (2001b). National strategy for suicide prevention: Goals and objectives for action. Rockville, MD: Author. Retrieved from http://www.sprc.org/library/nssp.pdf

U.S. Preventive Services Task Force, Agency for Health care Research and Quality, U.S. Department of Health and Human Services. (2009). Guide to clinical preventive services, 2009. Retrieved from www.ahrq .gov/clinic/pocketgd.htm

U.S. Public Health Service. (1999). The Surgeon General’s call to action to prevent suicide. Washington, DC: Author. Retrieved from www.surgeongeneral.gov /library/calltoaction/default.htm

Wakefi eld, J. (1999). The measurement of mental disorder. In A. V. Horwitz & T. L. Scheid (Eds.), A handbook for the study of mental health: Social contexts, theories, and systems (pp. 29–57). Cambridge, UK: Cambridge University Press.

Walsh, F. (2004). Spirituality, death, and loss. In F. Walsh & M. McGoldrick (Eds.), Living beyond loss: Death in the family (2nd ed., pp. 182–210). New York, NY: Norton.

Walsh, F. (Ed.). (2009). Spiritual resources in family therapy (2nd ed.). New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Weihs, K., Fisher, L., & Baird, M. (2002). Families, health and behavior: A section of the commissioned report by the Committee on Health and Behavior (Research, Practice, and Policy Division of Neuroscience and Behavioral Health and Division of Health Promotion and Disease Prevention Institute of Medicine, National Academy of Sciences). Families, Systems, and Health, 20(1), 7–46.

Weil, A., & Rosen, W. (1993). From chocolate to morphine: Everything you need to know about mind- altering drugs (2nd ed.). Boston, MA: Houghton Miffl in.

Weir, H. K., Thun, M. J., Hankey, B. F., Ries, L. A. G., Howe, H. L., Wingo, P. A., . . . Edwards, B. K. (2003). Annual report to the nation on the status of cancer, 1975–2000, featuring the uses of surveillance data for cancer prevention and control. Journal of the National Cancer Institute, 95(17), 1276–1299.

Weissbecker, I., Salmon, P., Studts, J. L., Floyd, A. R., Dedert, E. A., & Sephton, S. E. (2002). Mindfulness- based stress reduction and sense of coherence among women with fi bromyalgia. Journal of Clinical Psychology in Medical Settings, 9(4), 297–307.

Wells, N. E., Freedenthal, S., & Wisneski, H. (2008). Suicidal ideation and attempts among sexual minority youths receiving social services. Social Work, 53(1), 21–29.

Wight, V. R., Thampi, K., & Briggs, J. (2010). Who are America’s poor children? Examining food insecurity among children in the United States. New York, NY: National Center for Children in Poverty.

Williams, D. R., González, H., Neighbors, H. W., Nesse, R., Abelson, J. M., Sweetman, J., & Jackson, J. S. (2007). Prevalence and distribution of major depressive disorder in African Americans, Caribbean Blacks, and Non-Hispanic Whites: Results from the national survey of American Life. Archives of General Psychiatry, 64, 305–315.

Williams, D. R., & Mohammed, S. A. (2009). Discrimination and racial disparities in health: Evidence and needed research. Journal of Behavioral Medicine, 32, 20–47.

Williams, D. R., Mohammed, S. A., Leavell, J., & Collins, C. (2010). Race, socioeconomic status, and health: Complexities, ongoing challenges, and research opportunities. Annals of the New York Academy of Sciences, 1168, 69–101.

Williams, D. R., Neighbors, H. W., & Jackson, J. S. (2003). Racial/ethnic discrimination and health: Findings from community studies. American Journal of Public Health, 93(2), 200–208.

Williams, J. B. W. (1998). Classifi cation and diagnostic assessment. In J. B. Williams & K. Ell (Eds.), Advances in mental health services research: Implications for practice (pp. 25–48). Washington, DC: National Association of Social Workers.

Williams, J. W., Hitchcock, P., Cordes, J. A., Ramirez, G., & Pignone, M. (2002). Is this patient clinically depressed? JAMA, 287(9), 1160–1170.

Winkleby, M. A., Kraemer, H., Ahn, D. K., & Varady, A. N. (1998). Ethnic and socioeconomic differences in cardiovascular disease risk factors: Findings from the third national health and nutrition examination survey, 1988–1994. JAMA, 280(4), 356–362.

Witek-Janusek, L., Albuquerque, K., Rambo Chroniak, K., Chroniak, C., Durazo-Arvizu, R., & Matthews, H. L.

JWBT514_ch08.indd 217JWBT514_ch08.indd 217 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

218 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

(2008). Effect of mindfulness-base stress reduction on immune function, quality of life and coping in women newly diagnosed with early stage breast cancer. Brain, Behavior and Immunity, 22, 969–981.

World Health Organization. (2001). World Health Report 2001: Mental health—New understanding, new hope. Geneva, Switzerland: Author.

Wyatt, S. B., Williams, D. R., Calvin, R., Henderson, F. C., Walker, E. R., & Winters, K. (2003). Racism and cardiovascular disease in African Americans. American Journal of the Medical Sciences, 325(6), 315–331.

Xu, J. Q., Kochanek, K. D., Murphy, S. L., & Tejada-Vera, B. (2010). Deaths: Final data for 2007. National Vital Statistics, 58(19). Hyattsville, MD: National Center for Health Statistics.

Yellow Bird, M., Fong, R., Galindo, P., Nowicki, J., & Freeman, E. M. (1996). The multicultural mosaic. In P. L. Ewalt, E. M. Freeman, S. A. Kirk, & D. L. Poole

(Eds.), Multicultural issues in social work (pp. 3–13). Washington, DC: National Association of Social Workers.

Yoo, H. C., Gee, G. C., & Takeuchi, D. (2009). Discrimination and health among Asian American immigrants: Disentangling racial from language discrimination. Social Science and Medicine, 68, 726–732.

Young, A. S., Klap, R., Sherbourne, C. D., & Wells, K. B. (2001). The quality of care for depressive and anxiety disorders in the United States. Archives of General Psychiatry, 58(1), 55–61.

Zametkin, A. J., Alter, M. R., & Yemini, T. (2001). Suicide in teenagers: Assessment, management, and prevention. JAMA 286(24), 3120–3125.

Zimmerman, M., Lish, J. D., Lush, D. T., Farber, N. J., Plescia, G., & Kuzma, M. A. (1995). Suicidal ideation among urban medical outpatients. Journal of General Internal Medicine, 10(10), 573–576.

JWBT514_ch08.indd 218JWBT514_ch08.indd 218 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

219

9

Social Work Practice and Disability Issues

REBECCA BRASHLER

Disability bridges the study of health care and the study of diversity within the social work curriculum. People with disabilities generally have a greater number of health-care encounters than do people without disabilities; therefore, they have a considerable stake in issues such as access to medical care, insurance, quality of care, and the delivery of health services (De- Jong & Basnett, 2001). Disability studies, how- ever, is a distinct, emerging fi eld in academia that embraces the examination of humanities, social science, and the history of people with disabilities and is analogous to identity studies or group studies, such as women’s studies, Af- rican American studies, or Jewish studies. For social workers, the study of disability often fo- cuses on the psychology and the politics of dif- ference—the stigma associated with those who fall outside the mainstream as well as the ben- efi ts found when differences are embraced and societal barriers eliminated. This chapter pres- ents a review of these issues for social workers who provide counseling to individuals with dis- abilities in a variety of settings.

Chapter Objectives • Discuss the challenges faced when attempt-

ing to defi ne disability. • Review disability models and discuss their as-

sumptions as well as their power to infl uence our perspectives as social workers.

• Provide an overview of common challenges social workers encounter when working with clients who have disabilities.

• Explore societal values regarding difference and disability that infl uence both personal perspectives and clinical approaches.

DEFINING DISABILITY

Depending on one’s perspective, disability may be viewed as a personal characteristic, much like blue eyes, brown skin, or curly hair—an identifying but not necessarily de- fi ning feature. Others may view disability as a disease or an abnormality—something to be avoided at all costs; something that will bring with it hardship, suffering, and stigma. Still others may view disability as a source of pride, an entrée into the rich world of dis- ability culture and a disability community that celebrates differences while empowering people with disabilities to demand their rights. When discussing disability, examining one’s perspective becomes critical. Doing this can be challenging because our perspective is ever changing, infl uenced by life experiences, age, and health as well as societal norms, histori- cal context, and our own self-image as people with or without disabilities.

To make matters more complex, there is no universally accepted defi nition of the word disability. Oxford’s Concise Medical Dictionary defi nes disability as “a loss or restriction of functional ability or activity as a result of impairment of the body or mind” (Martin, 2010). The Americans with Disabili- ties Act defi nes a person with a disability as a person who “meets at least one of the three criteria: (1) having a physical or mental im- pairment that substantially limits one’s ability to perform one or more major life activities, (2) having a record of such an impairment, or (3) being regarded as having such an

JWBT514_ch09.indd 219JWBT514_ch09.indd 219 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

220 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

impairment” (National Council of Disability, 1997, Appendix F).

The Social Security Administration (SSA) will consider a person disabled if “you can- not do work you did before and we decide that you cannot adjust to other work because of your medical conditions(s). Your disability also must last or be expected to last for at least a year or to result in death” (www.benefi ts.gov /benefi ts/benefi t-details/4343).

The widely quoted defi nition of disability by the World Health Organization (WHO) in the International Classifi cation of Impair- ments, Disabilities, and Handicaps (ICIDH) distinguishes among the three related concepts of impairment, disability, and handicap:

Impairments are defi ned as “disturbances of body structures or processes.” A disability “is any restriction or lack (resulting from an impairment) of ability to perform an activity in the manner or within the range considered normal for a human being.” And a handicap is “the social disadvantage individuals expe- rience as a result of impairment or disability.” (WHO, 1980)

This defi nition was revised subsequently by WHO’s ICIDH-2 classifi cation, which places further emphasis on the role of environmental or social factors in “personal activity limita- tions” and “social participation restrictions.”

Because disability identifi cation is so elu- sive, attempts to count the number of people with disabilities in our communities are “sub- ject to methodological bias and the distortion of the cultural lens” (Fujiura & Rutkowski- Kmitta, 2001, p. 72). The U.S. Census Bureau (2010) indicates that 19% of the population 5 years and older have some type of disability. Global estimates abound in popular literature, and often people with disabilities are referred to as the nation’s “largest minority” or as “a minority that we all, if we live long enough, join” (Shapiro, 1994, p. 13). Some of us may never have a disability ourselves yet will spend a large portion of our lives caring for and lov- ing a family member with a disability. Further- more, disability happens to people at different

times; some will be born with a disability while others will acquire one through illness or accident. Many people will spend most of the time as individuals without a disability only to experience alterations in functioning as they enter the fi nal years of their lives.

Disabilities can be sorted by impairment type (e.g., mobility impairments, cognitive im- pairments, sensory impairments), or they can be viewed on a continuum from mild to mod- erate to severe, depending on the limitations they cause. Some disabilities are unnoticable by others while others are immediately obvi- ous. Complex typologies have been developed, such as John Rolland’s, which classify disabil- ities according to onset, course, outcome, and incapacity (Rolland, 1994). Although they are of interest to clinicians, most people with dis- abilities seem largely indifferent to these sta- tistics, defi nitions, and classifi cation schemes. What may matter most to people with disabili- ties is that they are fully included in schools, communities, and workplaces and that they are viewed by others as people with value. The perspective that others embrace dramatically shapes the lives of people with disabilities.

HISTORICAL CONTEXT

In the early 19th century, many in the West- ern world viewed disease and disability in the same way that they viewed poverty and di- saster—as “a visitation of a just God upon a frail and erring person . . . a direct consequence of undesirable personal or social behavior” (Trattner, 1974, p. 73). It is not surprising, given this view, that people with disabilities were historically shunned, institutionalized, and feared. What may be surprising are how these same views, left unchallenged and fu- eled by social Darwinism, led to the eugen- ics movement in the United States during the early 20th century (Braddock, 2002; Pfeiffer, 1999). American physicians during this pe- riod routinely facilitated the deaths of babies with birth defects and sterilized institutional- ized residents with intellectual disabilities so that their “inferior genes” would not weaken

JWBT514_ch09.indd 220JWBT514_ch09.indd 220 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Social Work Practice and Disability Issues 221

our society. The true horror of the eugenics movement became evident in Nazi Germany during the 1930s and 1940s, when hundreds of thousands of German citizens with disabili- ties were murdered after being “unworthy of life” (Lifton, 1986, p. 128). This program of euthanasia carried out by physicians under the guise of medical treatment often is seen as the prelude to the mass killings of Jews in concen- tration camps during World War II.

Throughout the 20th century in the United States, people with disabilities, when not locked away in large, poorly funded institu- tions, often were exploited as curiosities, pa- raded before the public for amusement and profi t in circuses and freak shows that re- mained popular well into the 1950s and 1960s (Thomson, 1996). Given this backdrop, the ad- vent of religious and secular organizations that presented people with disabilities as objects of pity and deserving of charity seemed compara- tively humane. However, the era of telethons and poster children offered a view of people with disabilities only as victims of tragic cir- cumstances. Telethons and other charity fund- raisers created sympathy by manipulating the fears of their viewers in order to get them to “open their wallets” (Shapiro, 1994, p. 13). The viewers’ sense of vulnerability could be relieved by sending money that would fund a cure for the unfortunate children—the only acceptable solution, for rarely were images of adults with disabilities shared with the public.

Today we fi nd ourselves in innovative times as the disability rights movement replaces the charity movement and people with disabilities claim their right to equal opportunities and full participation in all aspects of society (Bick- enbach, 2001). Through hard-fought legisla- tive battles, the grassroots independent living movement, and individual efforts to change attitudes, the prevailing view of people with disabilities has changed dramatically in recent years. People with disabilities, previously seen as “the embodiment of misery and lost oppor- tunity,” now claim pride in their identities, willingly embrace a disability subculture, and force us to question our preconceived ideas of capacity and value (Trent, 2000, p. 214). These

changing views of disability challenge social workers and other mental health profession- als to reevaluate their roles and reassess tradi- tional thoughts about treatment.

DISABILITY MODELS

Medical Model

The medical model of treatment can be illus- trated clearly by following a person who wakes up with acute abdominal pain. The person may go to the emergency room, where she becomes a “patient”—someone in need of care from an expert medical professional. The transforma- tion from “person” to “patient” during hospital admissions was described by Goffman (1961) in his study of institutions as a “leaving off and a taking on, with the midpoint marked by physical nakedness” (p. 18). The physician completes an assessment, usually consisting of a physical examination and history, some- times augmented by further tests to determine the problem or pathology. The physician then arrives at a diagnosis, which in turn leads to a course of treatment or intervention. Often dur- ing the intervention phase the patient is asked to give up a fair amount of autonomy and con- trol to health-care professionals. This is easily seen in a patient hospitalized for an appendec- tomy who is instructed on what to eat, what to wear, when to get out of bed, and when to interact with visitors. In the best scenario, the treatment leads to a cure or a resolution of the problem, returning the patient to an exis- tence without pain or dysfunction. In the case of abdominal pain diagnosed as appendicitis and leading to an appendectomy, the medical model seems to provide a satisfactory process for delivering care.

For individuals with chronic illnesses and disabilities, however, the medical model holds some troubling challenges. The diagno- sis of a chronic or permanent condition, one not amenable to cure, seems to trap the indi- vidual in the “patient” or “sick” role forever. As a perpetual patient, people with disabili- ties may never be well and are forever stuck

JWBT514_ch09.indd 221JWBT514_ch09.indd 221 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

222 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

in a position of reduced status and power. Furthermore, because the intervention phase is prolonged for months or years, the person with a chronic illness or disability is asked to give up autonomy to the “expert” health-care professional for an undetermined period, a po- sition that may foster feelings of dependency and helplessness. In addition, the failure of the person with a chronic illness or disability to be cured—a failure to be “a good patient”—often elicits unexpected and negative reactions from physicians and caregivers. Health-care profes- sionals treating patients who cannot be cured may become disheartened and retreat behind an impersonal technical approach (Halpern, 2001). Professionals also may abandon incur- able patients in order to protect themselves from feelings of failure and vulnerability and may move on to treat others who are more likely to have successful outcomes (Gans, 1983; Gunther, 1994).

The diagnostic phase of the medical model also holds some troubling risks for people with disabilities. Diagnostic labels and words used to describe people with disabilities often have served to stigmatize them. As Zola writes, people with disabilities are “de-formed, dis- eased, dis-ordered, ab-normal, and most tell- ing of all . . . in-valid” (Zola, 1982, p. 206). Diagnoses such as “imbecile,” “moron,” and “Mongoloid idiot” were used historically to de- scribe people with cognitive impairments. The self-fulfi lling prophecy and low expectations associated with some diagnoses encouraged institutionalization for many people who later would prove capable of living successfully in the community. It is critical to note that the desire for differential diagnosis schemes and classifi cation systems for physical and men- tal diseases has never been driven by patient needs. The goal of these diagnostic manuals is to “enable clinicians and investigators to di- agnose, communicate about, study, and treat people with various [mental] disorders” (APA, 1994, p. 4). For example, the introduction to the Diagnostic and Statistical Manual of Men- tal Disorders (DSM-IV) cautions readers that it is not a “classifi cation of people” but a “clas- sifi cation of disorders that people have” (p. 7).

Although this distinction is an important one, it offers no assurance that clinicians and others will not view the individual differently once the label or diagnosis has been determined. The labeling process appears to be inevitably stigmatizing, and in the case of chronic illness and disability, the stigma it creates may last a lifetime.

In the medical model, disability resides within the individual—the model assumes that there is something wrong with the per- son. People with disabilities are deviant or abnormal. They may be missing body parts, lacking in function, unable to perform typical tasks, and incapable of going through life like their able-bodied peers. This model focuses exclusively on the pathology and, some would argue, reduces people to laundry lists of ail- ments while ignoring their value and humanity.

Rehabilitation and Biopsychosocial Models

The fi eld of rehabilitation medicine evolved in the mid-1900s and adopted a multidisciplinary team approach with physical therapists, oc- cupational therapists, speech pathologists, social workers, vocational counselors, and psychologists joining physicians and nurses to treat people with disabilities (Albrecht, 1992). Rehabilitation professionals realized that the medical model did not necessarily fi t the needs of their patients and began to ask if “in chronic illness and disability, is it the profes- sional who treats the illness, or is it the patient (or the patient and his family) who actually carries out the routine treatment day after day” (Anderson, 1975, p. 19). The rehabilita- tion model of treatment acknowledges that the patient is not a passive recipient of care but an active member of the treatment team and that the goal of rehabilitation is not a cure but restoration of the best possible physical and psychological functioning. Furthermore, in rehabilitation medicine, there was a distinct shift from focusing solely on the individual with a disability to focusing on the individual, the family, and the community in which that individual resided. Rehabilitation in this sense

JWBT514_ch09.indd 222JWBT514_ch09.indd 222 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Social Work Practice and Disability Issues 223

embraced the biopsychosocial model of health care (Engel, 1977).

The biopsychosocial model expanded thinking beyond the narrow confi nes of bodily pathology and greatly shifted the focus to psy- chological and family issues. However, this shift in focus sometimes led to a tendency to pathologize patients’ psychological makeup along with their bodies. It is not diffi cult to fi nd literature that promotes the belief that physical disability invariably infl icts horribly disruptive and negative psychological consequences and leads to a whole host of personality disorders. For example, a review of the literature reveals that patients with arthritis

have been said to have weak egos; to repress hostility; to be compliant and subservient; to be potentially psychotic; to be depressed, dependent, conscientious, masochistic, emo- tionally labile, compulsive, introverted, con- servative, perfectionistic, moody, nervous, worried, tense, overconcerned about personal appearance, and prone to express psycho- pathology in physical symptoms. (Shontz, 1970, p. 112)

For years, the mind-set among many mental health professionals seemed to be that patho- logical bodies led to pathological personali- ties, and they set out to analyze the “disabled personality” in spite of having limited re- search data to back up their assumptions. Far from freeing patients from the stigma of la- bels, early applications of the biopsychosocial model may have added to the stigma of dis- ability by labeling patients fi rst physically and then psychologically.

Relatives, particularly mothers, of indi- viduals with disabilities also found themselves being labeled and diagnosed as the focus of treatment widened to encompass the entire family system. The classic example of this phenomenon may be Bruno Bettleheim’s the- ory, later disputed, that autism was actually a psychological disturbance arising from cold and detached mothering (Bettleheim, 1967). Others wrote about “narcissistic mothers” of children with asthma who were unable to be

“consistently giving” or of the “overprotective mothers” of hemophiliacs whose denial and guilt feelings were “manifested in severe, un- disguised anxiety” (Travis, 1976, p. 178).

The biopsychosocial model leads one to think about the interactions between the per- son with a disability and the person’s family, community, and social system. It highlights the connection between biological and psy- chological functioning. It also challenges some underlying principles of traditional med- ical thinking, allowing people with disabilities to be seen as active participants in their care and to have legitimate goals and needs even in the absence of a cure. It suggests that peo- ple with disabilities are much more than their functional limitations, but it remains at heart a medical paradigm, one that is prone to misin- terpretation and not completely free from the dangers of labeling.

Social Model and Minority Group Paradigm

The social model of disability shifts the focus from the impairment within an individual or family system to the environment in which the individual interacts. Advocates for the social model challenge traditional beliefs that physi- cal and cognitive differences are inherently bad and generally lead to a lifetime of suffer- ing. According to this model, “the culprit is not the biological, psychic, or cognitive equip- ment but the social, institutional, and physical world in which people with impairments must function—a world designed with the charac- teristics and needs of the nondisabled majority in mind” (Asch, 2001, p. 300).

Using the medical model approach, a child who uses a wheelchair and cannot enter a school with a fl ight of stairs at its entrance is seen as suffering from a “mobility impair- ment.” Furthermore, the medical model would classify her mobility impairment as having a neurological basis (spinal cord injury) with a predictive course (static), a traumatic onset (motor vehicle accident at the age of 5 years), and a distinct prognosis (permanent but not

JWBT514_ch09.indd 223JWBT514_ch09.indd 223 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

224 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

terminal). The child’s inability to walk cre- ates her problem and limits her ability to go to class with “normal” children, leading to a host of social and psychological diffi culties. Using the social model, however, the same child in that situation is seen as healthy and whole but socially excluded and unable to exercise her rights to a free public education by a system unwilling to accommodate her needs. The focus moves from the person to the environ- ment and in the process forces us to examine social norms, issues of discrimination, and po- litical concerns.

It can be diffi cult to switch frameworks and think about disability as a purely socially constructed concept. We are taught to think about health and wellness as ideal states and to view all variation from the norm as un- desirable. Often anthropological studies can help dissect medical model assumptions. In her book Everyone Here Spoke Sign Lan- guage, Groce (1985) writes about hereditary deafness on Martha’s Vineyard in the 18th and 19th centuries. Because the island was populated by large numbers of individuals with hearing impairments, the general popu- lation was fl uent in Island Sign Language, which eliminated the typical communication barriers. Individuals with deafness often were sent off the island to school and therefore re- ceived more extended formal education, mak- ing them more literate than their neighbors and generally fi nancially secure. They were completely integrated into society to the point that oral historians had diffi culty remember- ing who had deafness and who did not. In essence, the disability disappeared because it was no longer seen as a limitation or a sig- nifi cant characteristic. The study led Groce to conclude that if disability “is a question of defi nition, rather than a universal given, per- haps it can be redefi ned, and many of the cul- tural preconceptions summarized in the term ‘handicapped,’ as it is now used, eliminated” (Groce, 1985, p. 108).

The social model helps us recognize par- allels between people with disabilities and people of other recognized minority groups defi ned by race, gender, sexual orientation, or

nationality. Like other minority groups, people with disabilities often are judged solely by a single characteristic. They are segregated in nursing homes and institutions, they receive separate and unequal education, and they have limited access to jobs, which, in turn, leaves them with less power and money than those with majority status. People with disabilities have to fi ght to protect their most basic civil rights and in this regard truly share the experi- ences of other oppressed groups.

Critics of the social model, however, argue that it ignores the real and often distressing as- pects of living life with limitations and illness. It is diffi cult for some to view their disability as a neutral characteristic or based solely in society when they are struggling to live with chronic pain, caring for a loved one who is minimally conscious, or attempting to adjust to the progressive loss of physical and cog- nitive abilities that accompany, for example, amyotophic lateral sclerosis (ALS, Lou Geh- rig’s disease) or Alzheimer’s disease. In gen- eral, we recognize that “all of the problems associated with disability cannot be entirely eliminated by any imaginable form of social arrangements” (Shakespeare, 2006, p. 56).

INTEGRATING MODELS FOR SOCIAL WORK PRACTICE

Undeniable tensions exist among these differ- ent models, and whether one truly can fi nd a synthesis between medical and social frame- works is not clear (Shakespeare, 2006; Turner, 2001). For example, it is diffi cult to advocate for medical advances or searches for a cure, as the actor Christopher Reeve did after his spi- nal cord injury, without sometimes offending those working in the arena of disability rights. Some fear that “Reeve, perhaps inadvertently, bolstered the case against disability rights by offering a story of the disability experience that concurred with those who insisted that what people with severe disabilities faced were personal, medical problems, that what they needed was compassion—and a cure” (Johnson, 2003, p. 129).

JWBT514_ch09.indd 224JWBT514_ch09.indd 224 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Social Work Practice and Disability Issues 225

However, it may be equally closed-minded to think that everyone with a disability will or should approach their situation from the same perspective or that we should make no attempt to mitigate the medical conditions that lead to disability as we advocate for so- cial changes (Kirschner, 2000). Some well- adjusted individuals will choose to celebrate their disabilities and view their disability as a “central element of their identity” while others who seem equally well adjusted may choose to minimize their differences and shy away from the disability rights movement (Glastris, 1997). The challenge for many social work- ers, particularly those who practice in medical facilities, is to balance the skill set needed to negotiate their practice setting while remain- ing ever cognizant of the lessons learned from years of social oppression, institutional dis- crimination, and attitudinal barriers.

CLINICAL PRACTICE ISSUES AND THE ROLE OF THE SOCIAL WORKER

Initial Counseling and Framing the Disability

Social workers in many settings will be called on to provide support and counseling for in- dividuals who are encountering disability for the fi rst time. Whether counseling parents who have learned that their unborn child will have a congenital disability, meeting a child who recently was diagnosed with juvenile diabetes at school, seeing a patient in the intensive care unit who has sustained a spinal cord injury and will not walk again, or helping a family in a private medical practice whose grandmother is disabled from a stroke, the primary challenge is to frame the event in a way that will promote a positive adjustment.

It is important to recognize that social workers are rarely, if ever, capable of simply relaying facts and communicating a diagnosis without revealing their own bias. The profes- sionals involved in presenting disability news to individuals must appreciate that the words

they choose, the tone they adopt, their affect, their body language, and their message inter- twine to create a subtle but sometimes lasting infl uence. The parents of a child with Down syndrome might be told:

I’m afraid we have some very bad news about your child. He has Down syndrome. This is an incurable genetic disorder due to a mutation in one of his chromosomes. He has many of the characteristic physical features associated with this syndrome, including epi- canthal folds, a sloping forehead, a fl at nose, and short limbs. Children with this disorder are also moderately to severely mentally re- tarded and sometimes have other associated medical complications. We will need to con- sult with several specialists before you leave the hospital to make sure that appropriate care can be provided for him.

Alternatively, the parents could be told:

We just saw baby Elizabeth and have to say that she is quite beautiful and wonderfully alert! She looks perfectly healthy, but we recommend that she see another physician because she has Down syndrome and may have some associated medical problems. Children with Down syndrome typically lead very normal lives, go to regular school, and are capable of developing very close rela- tionships. However, she also may have some special learning needs and physical delays, so it will be important that you have an op- portunity to talk with other parents who have children with Down syndrome in order to fully understand some of the programs and services that can help Elizabeth.

Although neither introduction to Down syn- drome is ideal, complete, or without bias, the fi rst clearly frames the disability as a tragedy due to a host of abnormalities and requiring a future of specialized medical care. The em- phasis is on the child’s differences, and the explanation focuses solely on medical con- cerns. The second presentation frames the disability as a manageable set of challenges that will be faced by a beautiful child and her loving parents. The emphasis is on the child’s

JWBT514_ch09.indd 225JWBT514_ch09.indd 225 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

226 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

relationship to others, and the identifi ed ex- perts needed for consultation are other families who have experienced life with a child who has Down syndrome.

During the framing process, which can en- compass multiple conversations, social work- ers and other professionals must realize that they carry preconceived ideas about what life with a disability is like. The literature on at- titudes toward disability clearly indicates that health-care providers often harbor extremely negative views about disability, including beliefs that death is preferable to life with extensive disability and that incurable dis- ability causes irremediable suffering. In fact, research studies have found quality of life to be only weakly correlated with level of im- pairment and that people with disabilities re- peatedly rate their quality of life higher than others would predict they might (Bach & Til- ton, 1994; Craig, Hancock, & Dickson, 1994; Fuhrer, Rintala, Kare, Clearman, & Young, 1992; Gerhart, Koziol-McLain, Lowenstien, & Whiteneck, 1994; Longmore, 1995; Sprangers & Aaronson, 1992). In light of this knowledge, it is imperative that social workers who engage in initial counseling closely examine their own perceptions.

One of the most valuable commodities during the framing process is access to a nonjudgmental counselor who is willing to provide information based on “the views of a wide range of health professionals involved in caring for people affected by the condition, together with the views of individuals and families affected by the condition” (Marteau & Anionwu, 2000, p. 126). It seems critical that at some point during the framing process peo- ple with newly defi ned disabilities have an op- portunity to interact with others who actually live with similar conditions. Support groups, peer counselors, or access to fi rst-person nar- ratives about life with disabilities can be in- valuable when constructing a value-neutral frame. The overriding message always must be that, although the individual now belongs to a specifi c diagnostic class, he or she remains a “distinct and idiosyncratic human,” one who will not by virtue of a single diagnosis

share all the characteristics of others with the same genetic mutation, physical limitation, or chronic illness (Berube, 1996).

Providing adequate time and a safe envi- ronment during these sensitive counseling sessions is also vital. Too often, initial conver- sations are hurried and take place in hospital hallways or school classrooms. There is often a rush to send the family on to the next expert or to refer them immediately for additional examinations and further treatment. The clini- cian’s own discomfort in the face of disability may be what leads to this kind of truncated interaction when, in fact, what individuals need most is the “opportunity to ask their own questions in their own way; to go over diffi - cult, often insoluble, problems in an unhurried manner; and to feel supported” (Harper, 2000, p. 59). One mother’s advice to professionals in similar situations should be heeded carefully: “Do not disappear. Do not leave the room. Make eye contact. Look me in the eye and ask me what you can do to help me deal with this” (Berube, 1996, p. 38).

Responses to Disability

Therapists over the years have searched for concrete models that predict and explain the experience of people as they encounter dis- ability and adapt to changes in appearance or altered functioning. Various models of adjust- ment to disability can be found in the litera- ture, but it is important to recognize that there is limited empirical data in this area and no universally accepted theory regarding disabil- ity adjustment.

Stage models of adjustment to disability are derived from Elisabeth Kübler-Ross’s work with terminally ill patients with can- cer (Kübler-Ross, 1969). These models sug- gest that individuals confronted with a new diagnosis of disability experience predictable stages or reactions, such as shock, denial, anger, bargaining, or depression, and that the desired end point is a fi nal stage of adaptation or acceptance. The value of stage theories is that they can depathologize the process of adjustment by emphasizing that even healthy

JWBT514_ch09.indd 226JWBT514_ch09.indd 226 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Social Work Practice and Disability Issues 227

and ultimately well-adjusted individuals may experience periods of disruption in func- tioning when fi rst confronting a disability. However, in order to have any utility, stage theories cannot be taken literally and must ac- count for individual differences. The adjust- ment process is rarely linear, and individuals with disabilities have both good and bad days along their journey. Not everyone will pass through the stages in the same order; some in- dividuals may skip a stage completely while others will linger longer than expected in a particular stage without experiencing a nega- tive outcome (Gunther, 1969; Livneh, 1992; Olkin, 1999).

Grief models compare reactions to disabil- ity with the process of bereavement following a death. Mourning often is defi ned as the ad- aptation to loss (Worden, 1991) and can have relevance to the loss of a limb, the loss of func- tion, or the loss of the dream for a healthy child. The primary difference between bereavement and adaptation to disability is that death by its very nature is fi nite while disability is ongo- ing or chronic. The concept of chronic sorrow, or periods of grief that resurface from time to time (often associated with key developmen- tal milestones), acknowledges this distinction. Although on the surface the idea of chronic sorrow may seem depressing and pessimis- tic, it does serve to caution professionals not to become impatient during the adjustment process and not to think of prolonged adjust- ment periods as evidence of neurosis. It also challenges professionals “to abandon the sim- plistic and static concept of . . . acceptance,” at least acceptance that will be reached through a handful of therapy sessions (Olshansky, 1970, p. 22). Others have remarked that the losses as- sociated with disability, particularly those that accompany disabilities like severe brain injury and late-stage Alzheimer’s disease, are more ambiguous and complex than those that sur- round death (Boss, 2000). In these situations, the individual survives but often has lost the essence of the person he had previously been. There is a death of sorts, but one that often is devoid of any comforting rituals and that is largely unrecognized by society.

Crisis intervention models emphasize the temporary disruption in functioning and emo- tional stability that is created whenever one experiences an event that is perceived to be a threat to one’s life or the life of a loved one or that has the potential to become overwhelming (Aguilera & Messick, 1978). This framework has some utility when thinking about disability because it values the perception of the person involved in the crisis. A young couple learn- ing that their toddler has been diagnosed with cerebral palsy may indeed feel that they are in the midst of a crisis, while a single par- ent who chooses to bring home a child with a similar disability from an adoption agency may view the event as joyful. A professional violinist who loses a fi nger in an accident may feel that she is facing a crisis of great mag- nitude while a machinist may view the same injury as minor and unimportant. A crisis can be defi ned only by the person, not by others who may have a different perspective of the same experience. Because crises are viewed as turning points or opportunities for growth, this framework also reminds the client and the therapist that people frequently emerge from crisis with improved coping skills and greater feelings of competence. The notion that people actually benefi t from adversity is one that can be very reassuring to people experiencing dis- ability challenges (Elliot, Kurylo, & Rivera, 2002; McMillen, 1999).

Regardless of which adjustment model frames their work, it remains critical that so- cial workers not become so distracted by the disability adjustment process that they fall into the trap of blaming the disability for any and all diffi culties an individual experiences. In- dividuals with disabilities experience marital problems, life-adjustment issues, child-rearing challenges, and emotional problems that may bring them to a therapist’s offi ce. Assuming that disability is the root cause of any of these diffi culties is dangerous. This assumption may be particularly lethal for situations in which individuals with disabilities present with sui- cidal ideation and are treated less aggressively because of beliefs that anyone in their physical condition rationally would prefer to be dead.

JWBT514_ch09.indd 227JWBT514_ch09.indd 227 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

228 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

People with disabilities turn to suicide in re- sponse to the same triggers as people without disabilities, and “there is no evidence of a unique death-seeking dynamic associated with disability that . . . is somehow more rational than ‘ordinary’ suicide” (Gill, 2004, p. 185).

In 1986, Elizabeth Bouvia, a woman in her 20s with cerebral palsy and arthritis, requested that a California hospital admit her and allow her to die by keeping her sedated while she stopped her gastric feedings. Although indi- viduals without disabilities with suicidal in- tentions are routinely hospitalized and treated for their emotional distress, the courts in this case ruled that Ms. Bouvia should be allowed to facilitate her death because her life with disabilities was regarded as intolerable (Asch, 2001). They were completely willing to over- look the fact that this young woman had lived successfully with her disability since birth but recently had experienced multiple losses, in- cluding the death of her brother, a miscarriage, a divorce, and withdrawal from her master’s- level graduate school program in social work. The presence of a disability is often only one of many factors that will prompt an individual to question the value of life and exhibit signs of depression, hopelessness, and anxiety.

The most useful of adjustment perspectives are those that can account for the paradoxical feelings and ideas that most individuals have toward disability (Larson, 1998). They ac- knowledge that an individual can hold simul- taneously seemingly contradictory thoughts about life with differences. Individuals do not really move through stages; they live in two or more stages at the same time. They do not experience distinct, easily defi ned periods of grieving; distress about losses may come and go in unpredictable patterns for years. Often people with disabilities experience a series of crises rather than a single event followed by adjustment. One can be absolutely devastated about not being able to walk yet simultaneously hopeful about the future. One can truly love a child unconditionally yet simultaneously pray that she will be cured miraculously. One can bitterly grieve for the lost capacity to talk yet simultaneously be grateful to be alive. One can

be angry about the barriers created by society yet simultaneously be joyful about newfound resourcefulness in the face of those barriers. One can completely dismiss a physician’s prog- nosis as overly pessimistic yet simultaneously engage in prescribed therapies. Adaptation to disability is never simple, it is rarely black and white, and, in this sense, it does not lend itself well to any single theory or model.

There are several critical points for clini- cians to remember when assessing adjustment and thinking about structuring interventions:

• When confronted by disability, individu- als are likely to encounter a period of dis- rupted functioning that, in and of itself, is not pathological or abnormal. Repeatedly normalizing the process may be the single most important service a social worker can provide.

• There is no right or wrong way for patients to approach disability adjustment.

• Each individual will perceive his or her dis- ability differently, and it is the individual’s perceptions, not ours, that are most relevant. Social workers must listen carefully to their clients’ perceptions, inform them that their perceptions may be fl uid, and expose them to other perspectives when appropriate.

• People’s perceptions of their disability change over time, and people often hold paradoxical views regarding disability.

• The adaptation process cannot be defi ned in terms of weeks or years. It may ebb and fl ow throughout one’s lifetime. Just as in- dividuals adjust to different stages of life, individuals adjust to different stages of life with a disability. Social workers should remain available well beyond the initial adjustment phase yet not associate this availability with the notion that our clients will never be psychologically well.

• Individuals may experience periods of de- pression or anxiety that require treatment at any point during their experience with disability, but therapists cannot assume that these symptoms are caused solely by the disability; rather, they may be related to and

JWBT514_ch09.indd 228JWBT514_ch09.indd 228 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Social Work Practice and Disability Issues 229

interwoven with other life issues or be the result of frustration over societal barriers.

• People with disabilities often have a history of unsatisfactory health-care encounters and may be distrustful or disillusioned about the benefi ts of seeking treatment. Be prepared to review this history with them to learn about their experiences, build rapport, and create a solid therapeutic alliance.

• There is no idealized state of fi nal adapta- tion or acceptance with a disability, just as there is no idealized state of adjustment to life without a disability.

DISABILITY AND ETHICS

Some of the most pressing ethical issues of our times involve disability on some level. Physician-assisted suicide, stem cell research, genetic engineering, health-care resource al- location, and end-of-life care are just a few examples. Examining a landmark case in de- tail can help tease apart how the disability perspective alters one’s thinking about ethi- cal dilemmas and may lead to asking differ- ent questions and possibly drawing different conclusions.

On February 25, 1990, Terri Schiavo had a cardiac arrest resulting in severe hypoxic- ischemic encephalopathy. Fifteen years later, her name and face became widely known as physicians, lawyers, journalists, and the gen- eral public discussed the many complex and controversial issues that surrounded her situ- ation and the choice of removing her from life support. Her private family confl ict be- came painfully public, and political lines were drawn based on “right to life” and “right to die” slogans. Legal and legislative history was made when the case was debated in Congress, and journalists struggled to summarize some of the most complex ethical issues into sound bites suitable for the nightly news. In the midst of this activity, many were surprised to fi nd that disability advocates were among those deeply invested in the outcome of the pro- ceedings that were taking place to determine if Schiavo’s feeding tube could be withdrawn.

Furthermore, the disability perspective brought a unique way of viewing the feeding tube that was keeping Schiavo alive—one that others may not have considered previously (Brashler, Savage, Mukherjee, & Kirschner, 2007).

The prevailing medicolegal view is that the “right of competent patients to refuse unwanted medical treatment, including artifi cial hydra- tion and nutrition, is a settled ethical and legal issue” (Quill, 2005, p. 1631). Furthermore, the courts have ruled that this right is not lost when a patient becomes incompetent as long as there is clear and convincing evidence that withdrawal of the artifi cial feeding is consis- tent with the patient’s prior wishes. The Catho- lic church and many others, however, viewed the removal of Schiavo’s feeding tube as inhu- mane. Pope John Paul II stated that there was a “moral obligation” to provide tube feedings to patients in vegetative states (Vatican, 2004). Those who adhered to this viewpoint felt that removal of the feeding tube could be consid- ered euthanasia by omission and worried that Schiavo would “starve to death.”

A third view, articulated by individuals with disabilities, was that Schiavo’s feeding tube was simply a disability accommodation, not much different from a wheelchair for an individual who cannot walk. People with chronic conditions who use feeding tubes on a daily basis because of swallowing problems often begin to think of the tube as a tool or an implement similar to a fork. The tube gradu- ally becomes devoid of medical meaning and simply allows them to ingest food effi ciently and safely. For example, wheelchairs may seem frightening to individuals who walk, and feeding tubes may seem equally foreign to those who ingest food orally. But the insider perspective of those who use these items rou- tinely is dramatically different. Some individu- als with disabilities felt a kinship to Schiavo, not only because they shared her dependence on adaptive equipment but also because of the judgments being made about her quality of life. Some worried that if it was acceptable to remove Schiavo’s feeding tube, it also would be permissible to remove feeding tubes from people who were still conscious or who used

JWBT514_ch09.indd 229JWBT514_ch09.indd 229 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

230 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

them for other reasons. They feared that “we would be starting down a slippery slope where we might eventually wind up removing tubes from people who are profoundly disabled but not in a permanent vegetative state” (Shep- herd, 2009, p. 12).

The Schiavo case had many observers think- ing carefully about that slippery slope and try- ing to determine for themselves what makes life worth living and when they would want life-sustaining treatments to be withdrawn. The disability concerns embedded in this case became intertwined with profound questions about the value of life and our obligation to protect vulnerable individuals in society.

ADVOCACY

Most social workers provide not only counsel- ing but concrete case management services to clients with disabilities. Counseling and ad- vocacy efforts ideally are provided in an inte- grated fashion rather than being packaged as discrete functions. Counseling an individual experiencing the recent onset of a disability that prevents a return to work without provid- ing information and advocacy around income maintenance would be fruitless, just as assist- ing an older person with a nursing home place- ment without addressing the issues of losses associated with aging and illness would be irresponsible. Throughout the United States, there are confusing arrays of fragmented fi nan- cial, legal, educational, medical, and family services available to people with disabilities, many of which have complex application and eligibility requirements. Social workers in private practice, in schools, and in medical settings must educate themselves about the community resources available to their clients to assist them to navigate the overwhelming maze of disability services that are available.

Disability can bring devastating fi nancial burdens in three areas: (1) hospital/medical expenses, (2) loss of income or earning po- tential for the individual and her family care- giver, and (3) additional community/living expenses. Medicare, Medicaid, managed care,

indemnity, worker’s compensation, veterans’ benefi ts, and other forms of health insurance may cover medical expenses related to disabil- ity, but people often are unfamiliar with their coverage, uncertain how to apply for cover- age, and unaware of what types of medical care may not be paid for under their policies. In cases of catastrophic injuries, fears about fi - nancial ruin may be very real. People who are uninsured and underinsured are certain to have concerns about access to quality health care. For many people, managing the overwhelming amount paperwork required to fi le a claim or navigate the bureaucracy of a large managed care company is more than they can handle while in the midst of a medical crisis. Social work assistance in this area is invaluable.

Income maintenance may be available from Social Security disability insurance, supple- mental security income, the Veteran’s Admin- istration, crime victims’ compensation, private disability insurance, and worker’s compensa- tion. These programs are complex, and ser- vices sometimes are diffi cult to secure. When returning to work, individuals with a disabil- ity also may encounter challenges related to employer biases, disincentives built into the system, and infl exible benefi ts. Knowing both entitlement eligibility and legal protections is important for social workers in this area.

Community living expenses include the cost of transportation, affordable/accessible housing, and attendant care services. Advo- cating for better transportation, housing, and attendant care consumes many local disability rights groups, which understand that access to these basic services frequently mean the dif- ference between being able to live freely in the community and having to live in an institution or nursing home. The politics that surround community living programs are complex, and a bias toward the institutionalization of people with disabilities in our current government programs remains. Even when it may cost less to care for people with a disability in the com- munity, they may end up in a nursing home because they cannot piece together the support systems needed to allow for independent liv- ing. Attendants are diffi cult to fi nd and keep

JWBT514_ch09.indd 230JWBT514_ch09.indd 230 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Social Work Practice and Disability Issues 231

because the job often pays less than other non- skilled jobs in the community and often does not include health-care coverage or other ben- efi ts. Family members willing to provide care in their homes often do so at the expense of their own careers and at the risk of their own health. They remain an invisible source of free labor that goes unrecognized and unaccounted for by traditional economic measures (Gould, 2004).

The right to free and appropriate public education for children regardless of the type or extent of their disability has been secured in the United States through passage of Pub- lic Law 94-142 (1975), later amended and renamed the Individuals with Disabilities Act in 1990. Before this law was enacted, it was estimated that “at least 1 million children in the United States were being excluded from public schools because of their disabilities” (Switzer, 2003, p. 61). With this law, parents became participants in planning for their chil- dren’s education through the use of Individual Education Programs, and schools were man- dated to place children in the “least restrictive environment.” However, these government regulations also led to a complex system of registration, case study evaluations, multidis- ciplinary conferences, placement protocols, and procedural safeguards. Parents often feel the need for an advocate to help them through the process, particularly if there are disagree- ments about their child’s needs. Controversies still surround the move from no education to separate schools to mainstreaming in regular schools with separate classrooms and fi nally to full inclusion. Social workers can help parents and children in their quest to secure the most appropriate and inclusive educational program available in their community.

Advocating for clients who have disabili- ties—whether they face discrimination in the workplace, diffi culties accessing health care, or problems researching available commu- nity services—is a critical role for most so- cial workers. During this process, however, social workers must remain sensitive to the very real power differential that invariably ex- ists between the professional and the client

seeking services, particularly when the client is a member of a vulnerable and oppressed group. Social service professionals who work with vulnerable groups often are seen as exten- sions of the bureaucracies that employ them or gatekeepers who must be manipulated in order to receive needed services. This has been par- ticularly true for many people with disabilities. Patients with disabilities are not “cases,” and they do not need to be “managed.” They need information and support at times, but “help is useful only when it leads to empowerment” (Charlton, 1998, p. 5). True empowerment for people with disabilities, as with other minority groups, will be realized only when they reach positions of status in hospitals, universities, legislative bodies, and governmental agencies in meaningful numbers. Making sure that peo- ple with disabilities represent themselves and assume a primary role in shaping the services they require must be the ultimate goal of social workers whenever we act as advocates.

FINDING MEANING

The search for meaning is a journey than can take many years. It is a universal process in which every person engages, but for people with disabilities, it may have some added poi- gnancy and importance. Many mental health professionals have noted the need to shift our focus from examining the parameters of patients’ physical conditions or analyzing cli- ents’ psychological makeup to helping them clarify their values in an effort to create posi- tive meaning. Trieschmann (1999) writes:

I have become increasingly dissatisfi ed with the conceptual models of traditional west- ern medicine and psychology because they do not offer me comfortable viewpoints or strategies that are really helpful in teaching people to fi nd happiness. When people do fi nd happiness, it derives from a reevaluation of what is important in their lives, usually ac- companied by a deepening of their spiritual- ity and usually accomplished by themselves without help from professionals. (p. 32)

JWBT514_ch09.indd 231JWBT514_ch09.indd 231 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

232 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

The work of Victor Frankl, a psychiatrist who developed a therapy model he called logo- therapy, is particularly helpful when thinking about the process of fi nding meaning. Frankl wrote extensively about his experiences in a concentration camp during World War II and how survival became dependent on fi nding ac- ceptable meaning for an unacceptable atrocity. He wrote that if “one cannot change a situation that causes his suffering, he can still choose his attitude” (Frankl, 1984, p. 148). Frankl and oth- ers emphasize that the meaning people create must be uniquely theirs based on their own life experiences, religion, culture, family structure, worldviews, and belief systems. Health-care professionals can facilitate this search for mean- ing, but it will be different for each individual.

First-person narratives from people living with a disability illustrate how varied their in- dividual meanings can be, yet they all seem to refl ect changing perspectives, a reassessment of values, or a process of “sifting out the trivial from the important” (Wright, 1983, p. 191). One father takes comfort in the randomness of the universe by saying:

I’ve come to believe that there’s no design for tragedy nor a design whereby the sins of the past return to punish the sinner. . . . This means that there’s no method to the madness and sad- ness found here on Earth. Life is as random and unpredictable as the shape of the next snowfl ake, and we all must take our chances if we are to stick. (Seerman, 1995, p. 89)

Others fi nd meaning in religious terms:

I have a higher power, my God, who is with me always, even though I may not feel that presence all the time. I know that I can make it; I know that I can keep up hope; I know that even if things do not turn out as they should, I am not alone. . . . What more could a person want? (Kahlback, 2001)

Another father writes about the essence of humanity:

Peering into the crib of a child with disability in the predawn moonlight can bring tears of

truly unconditional love, love that will not be based on the report card performance, scores as a star quarterback or excellent perfor- mance as a trial lawyer. This love is for who the person is, for their qualities, their trials and for the inner strength they must develop to take their place. (Kappes, 1995, p. 25)

A writer with a facial difference due to cancer surgery struggles to tease out the difference between internal and external images. She once thought:

I was my face, I was ugliness . . . the one immediately recognizable place to point to when asked what was wrong with my life. (Grealy, 1994, p. 7)

She later writes:

I experienced a moment of the freedom I’d been practicing for behind my Halloween mask all those years ago. As a child I had expected my liberation to come from get- ting a new face to put on, but now I saw it came from shedding something, shedding my image. (Grealy, 1994, p. 222)

A mother of a son with autism who lives and works on a university campus writes:

To have an autistic child is to learn to love difference, the humanity that runs far deeper than the success and achievement we are all taught to value. . . . I was forced to confront my deepest prejudices. . . . Living all my adult life in an academic environment, I had never been forced to consider that intellect is not the same as merit, it is not the same as virtue. It is a gift of nature as surely as any other. (McDonnell, 1993, p. 324)

A man with a spinal cord injury fi nds meaning by shifting his focus from the negative to the positive and says:

Before I was paralyzed, there were ten thou- sand things I could do, ten thousand things I was capable of doing. Now there are nine thousand. I can dwell on the one thousand or

JWBT514_ch09.indd 232JWBT514_ch09.indd 232 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Social Work Practice and Disability Issues 233

concentrate on the nine thousand I have left. And of course the joke is that none of us in our lifetime is going to do more than two or three thousand of these things in any event. (Corbet, 1980, p. 32)

An important social work role is to help peo- ple formulate a meaning that works for them, a meaning that brings them to a place where the disability becomes understood and therefore less frightening. American society places a premium on youth, athleticism, independence, power, wealth, beauty, and achievement. Help- ing people look beyond these ubiquitous values and treasure the spirit that they and their loved ones bring to our world, a spirit uniquely theirs that transcends the mundane issues of how one walks or talks or eats or looks or thinks, can be tremendously rewarding work.

SUGGESTED LEARNING EXERCISE

This learning exercise helps students explore their personal values related to people with disabilities and facilitate an open discussion of societal ideals.

Learning Exercise 9.1

Students are told that they comprise the board of directors of a small community hospital. Their community has been hit with a new illness that is 100% fatal—usually within a few hours. The only successful treatment is an injection of a new drug that has just been developed and cures the patient almost im- mediately. Unfortunately, the drug is in short supply, and diffi cult decisions have to be made regarding which patients will be treated and which patients will be left to die from the infection. The hospital currently houses 10 patients who have the infection and are in dire need of treatment. The hospital has just received a shipment of fi ve doses of the medi- cation. The board members must decide which of the patients, based only on the next profi les, will get the injection.

1. A 65-year-old nun who has spent her entire life in a secluded convent and has devoted herself to a life of prayer and poverty.

2. A 44-year-old African American, sin- gle, foster mother who has adopted fi ve hard-to-place children with disabilities and is raising them on her own.

3. A 24-year-old male model who recently was voted one of the 10 most beautiful people in the United States. He is single and has just been cast in his fi rst fi lm.

4. A 5-year-old Hispanic American boy who is blind, deaf, and mentally retarded. He is well adjusted and lives with his mother, grandmother, and six siblings in a loving and secure home.

5. A 23-year-old woman who is working on her MSW and is engaged to be married. She sustained a spinal cord injury in a car accident 10 years ago. She uses a wheel- chair for mobility and is independent in self-care.

6. A 77-year-old Nobel Prize–winning re- searcher who is working on a cure for arthritis and has made several important breakthroughs in recent months.

7. A 10-year-old Caucasian boy who likes to play soccer and video games. He lives in the suburbs with his parents and his sister in an upper-middle-class home. He has learning disabilities and sometimes strug- gles with impulse control/anger manage- ment.

8. A 50-year-old accomplished concert pia- nist. He is moody, temperamental, and a self-described loner. Never married, he has few friends and lives for his music.

9. A 40-year-old beloved coach of the U.S. Women’s Olympic Softball team, which is preparing to compete in the next Olym- pics in 18 months.

10. A 21-year-old African American teen cur- rently incarcerated on drug charges. He is due to be paroled in 6 months. While in jail, he completed his general equivalency di- ploma and started an innovative program to help teens stay out of gangs.

JWBT514_ch09.indd 233JWBT514_ch09.indd 233 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

234 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

After the exercise, the group should list the de- ciding factors that drove their choices. Is age more important than lifestyle? Is intellectual capacity more important than artistic ability? Did patients without obvious disabilities fare better than others? Is past behavior more criti- cal than future potential? What value do we place on the patient’s capacity to relate to oth- ers? Assuming that the board of directors will have its choices scrutinized by the community at large, will any of its decisions meet with community disagreement or outrage? Why or why not?

REFERENCES

Aguilera, D., & Messick, J. (1978). Crisis intervention: Theory and methodology (3rd ed.). Saint Louis, MO: Mosby.

Albrecht, G. (1992). The disability business: Rehabilitation in America. Newbury Park, CA: Sage.

American Psychiatric Association. (1994). Diagnostic and statistical manual of mental disorders, fourth edition. Washington, DC: Author.

Anderson, T. (1975). An alternative frame of reference for rehabilitation: The helping process versus the medical model. Archives of Physical Medicine and Rehabilitation, 56, 101–104.

Asch, A. (2001). Disability, bioethics and human rights. In G. Albrecht, K. Seelman, & M. Bury (Eds.), Handbook of disability studies (pp. 297–326). Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.

Bach, J. R., & Tilton, M. C. (1994). Life satisfaction and well-being measures in ventilator assisted individuals with traumatic tetraplegia. Archives of Physical Medicine and Rehabilitation, 75, 626–632.

Berube, M. (1996). Life as we know it: A father, a family, and an exceptional child. New York, NY: Pantheon.

Bettleheim, B. (1967). The empty fortress: Infantile autism and the birth of the self. New York, NY: Free Press.

Bickenbach, J. (2001). Disability human rights, law, and policy. In G. Albrecht, K. Seelman, & M. Bury (Eds.), Handbook of disability studies (pp. 565–584). Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.

Boss, P. (2000). Ambiguous loss: Learning to live with unresolved grief. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.

Braddock, D. (Ed). (2002). Disability at the dawn of the 21st century. Washington, DC: American Association on Mental Retardation.

Brashler, R., Savage, T. A., Mukherjee, D., & Kirschner, K. L. (2007). Feeding tubes: Three perspectives. Topics in Stroke Rehabilitation, 14(6), 74–77.

Charlton, J. (1998). Nothing about us without us: Disability oppression and empowerment. Berkeley, CA: University of California Press.

Corbet, B. (1980). Options: Spinal cord injury and the future. Denver, CO: A. B. Hirschfeld.

Craig, A. R., Hancock, K. M., & Dickson, H. G. (1994). Spinal cord injury: A search for determinants of depression two years after the event. British Journal of Clinical Psychology, 33(Pt. 2), 221–230.

DeJong, G., & Basnett, I. (2001). Disability and health policy: The role of markets in the delivery of health services. In G. Albrecht, K. Seelman, & M. Bury (Eds.), Handbook of disability studies (pp. 610–632). Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.

Elliot, T. R., Kurylo, M. & Rivera, P. (2002). Positive growth following acquired physical disability. In C. R. Snyder & S. J. Lopez (Eds.), Handbook of positive psychology (pp. 687–699). Oxford, UK: Oxford University Press.

Engel, G. (1977). The need for a new medical model. Science, 196, 129–136.

Frankl, V. (1984). Man’s search for meaning: An introduction to logotherapy (3rd ed.). New York, NY: Simon & Schuster.

Fuhrer, M. J., Rintala, D. H., Hart, K. A., Clearman, R., & Young, M. E. (1992). Relation of life satisfaction to impairment, disability, and handicap among persons with spinal cord injury living in the community. Archives of Physical Medicine and Rehabilitation, 73, 552–557.

Fujiura, G., & Rutkowski-Kmitta, V. (2001) Counting disability. In G. Albrecht, K. Seelman, & M. Bury (Eds.), Handbook of disability studies (pp. 69–96). Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.

Gans, J. (1983). Hate in the rehabilitation setting. Archives in Physical Medicine and Rehabilitation, 64, 176–179.

Gerhart, K., Koziol-McLain, J., Lowenstien, S., & Whiteneck, G. (1994). Quality of life following spinal cord injury: Knowledge and attitudes of emergency care providers. Annals of Emergency Medicine, 23(4), 807–812.

Gill, C. J. (2004). Depression in the context of disability and the “right to die.” Theoretical Medicine, 25, 171– 198.

Glastris, P. (1997, May 5). Spoiling a proper memorial. U.S. News & World Report, 9.

Goffman, E. (1961). Ayslums. New York, NY: Anchor Books.

Gould, D. (2004). Measuring what matters: Levers for change. In C. Levine (Ed.), Family caregivers on the job: Moving beyond ADLs and IADLs. New York, NY: United Hospital Fund of New York.

Grealy, L. (1994). Autobiography of a face. New York, NY: HarperCollins.

Groce, N. (1985). Everyone here spoke sign language: Hereditary deafness on Martha’s Vineyard. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.

JWBT514_ch09.indd 234JWBT514_ch09.indd 234 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

Social Work Practice and Disability Issues 235

Gunther, M. (1969). Emotional aspects. In D. Ruge (Ed.), Spinal cord injuries (pp. 93–108). Springfi eld, IL: Charles C Thomas.

Gunther, M. (1994). Countertransference issues in staff caregivers who work to rehabilitate catastrophic-injury survivors. American Journal of Psychotherapy, 48(2), 208–220.

Halpern, J. (2001). From detached concern to empathy: Humanizing medical practice. Oxford, UK: Oxford University Press.

Harper, P. (2000). Personal experiences of genetic diseases: A clinical geneticist’s reaction. In T. Marteau & M. Richards (Eds.), The troubled helix: Social and psychological implications of the new genetics (pp. 54–59). Cambridge, UK: Cambridge University Press.

Johnson, M. (2003). Make them go away: Clint Eastwood, Christopher Reeve & the case against disability rights. Louisville, KY: Avocado Press.

Kahlback, D. (2001). Religion and Ethics in America [Television broadcast out takes]. Chicago, IL: WTTW.

Kappes, N. (1995). Matrix. In D. J. Meyer (Ed.), Uncommon fathers: Refl ections on raising a child with a disability (pp. 13–28). Bethesda, MD: Woodbine House.

Kirschner, K. (2000, May 7). My view: Literature fumbles a tough lesson. Chicago Tribune, 13.

Kübler-Ross, E. (1969). On death and dying. New York, NY: Macmillan.

Larson, E. (1998). Reframing the meaning of disability to families: The embrace of paradox. Social Science Medicine, 47(7), 865–875.

Lifton, R. (1986). The Nazi doctors: Medical killing and the psychology of genocide. New York, NY: Basic Books.

Livneh, H. (1992). A unifi ed approach to existing models of adaptation to disability: A model of adaptation. In R. Marinelli & A. Dell Orto (Eds.), The psychological and social impact of disability (3rd ed., pp. 241–248). New York, NY: Springer.

Longmore, P. (1995). Medical decision making and people with disabilities: A clash of cultures. Journal of Law, Medicine & Ethics, 23, 82–87.

Marteau, T., & Anionwu, E. (2000). Evaluating carrier testing: Objectives and outcomes. In T. Marteau & M. Richards (Eds.), The troubled helix: Social and psychological implications of the new genetics (pp. 123– 139). Cambridge, UK: Cambridge University Press.

Martin, E. A. (Ed.). (2010). Concise medical dictionary (8th ed.). Oxford, UK: Oxford University Press.

McDonnell, J. (1993). News from the border: A memoir. Northfi eld, MN: Black Willow.

McMillen, J. C. (1999). Better for it: How people benefi t from adversity. Social Work, 44(5), 455–468.

National Council of Disability. (1997). Equality of opportunity: The making of the Americans with Disabilities Act. Washington, DC: Author.

Olkin, R. (1999). What psychotherapists should know about disability. New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Olshansky, S. (1970). Chronic sorrow: A response to having a mentally defective child. In R. Nolland (Ed.), Counseling parents of the mentally retarded: A sourcebook (pp. 328–331). Springfi eld, IL: Charles C Thomas.

Pfeiffer, D. (1999). Eugenics and disability discrimination. In R. Marinelli & A. Dell Orto (Eds.), The psychological and social impact of disability (4th ed., pp. 12–31). New York, NY: Springer.

Quill, T. (2005). Terri Schiavo—A tragedy compounded. New England Journal of Medicine, 352, 1630–1633.

Rolland, J. (1994). Families, illness and disability: An integrative treatment model. New York, NY: Basic Books.

Seerman, D. (1995). The loneliness of the long-distance daddy. In D. J. Meyer (Ed.), Uncommon father: Refl ections on raising a child with a disability (pp. 79–90). Bethesda, MD: Woodbine House.

Shakespeare, T. (2006). Disability rights and wrongs. New York, NY: Routledge.

Shapiro, J. (1994). No pity. New York, NY: Three Rivers.

Shapiro, M., Spece, R., Dresser, R., & Clayton, E. (Eds). (2003). Bioethics and law: Cases, materials and problems (2nd ed.). St. Paul, MN: West.

Shepherd, L. (2009). If that ever happens to me: Making life and death decisions after Terri Schiavo. Chapel Hill, NC: University of North Carolina Press.

Shontz, F. (1970). Physical disability and personality: Theory and recent research. Rehabilitation Psychology, 17, 51–69.

Social Security Administration. (2007). Supplemental security income (SSI) [Publication no .05-11000]. Retrieved from www.ssa.gov/pubs/11000.pdf

Sprangers, M. A. G., & Aaronson, N. K. (1992). The role of health care providers and signifi cant others in evaluating the quality of life of patients with chronic disease: A review. Journal of Clinical Epidemiology, 45(7), 743–760.

Switzer, J. V. (2003). Disabled rights: American disability policy and the fi ght for equality. Washington DC: Georgetown University Press.

Thomson, R. (Ed.). (1996). Freakery: Cultural spectacles of the extraordinary body. New York: New York University Press.

Trattner, W. (1974). From poor law to welfare state: A history of social welfare in America. New York, NY: Free Press.

Travis, G. (1976). Chronic illness in children: Its impact on child and family. Stanford, CA: Stanford University Press.

Trent. J. (2000). Disability, subculture (culture) of. In The encyclopedia of criminology and deviant behavior: Self destructive behavior and devalued identity (Vol. 4, pp. 213–216). London, UK: Taylor & Francis.

Trieschmann, R. (1999). The energy model: A new approach to rehabilitation. In R. Marinelli & A. Dell Orto (Eds.),

JWBT514_ch09.indd 235JWBT514_ch09.indd 235 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

236 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

The psychological and social impact of disability (4th ed., pp. 32–42). New York, NY: Springer.

Turner, B. (2001), Disability and the sociology of the body. In G. Albrecht, K. Seelman, & M. Bury (Eds.), Handbook of disability studies (pp. 252–266). Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.

U.S. Census Bureau. (2010). U.S. Census Bureau Facts for Features: 20th Anniversary of Americans With Disabilities Act: July 26. Retrieved from www .prnewswire.com/news-releases/us-census-bureau -facts-for-features--20th-anniversary-of-americans -with-disabilities-act-july-26-94914034.html

Vatican. (2004, March 20). Address to the participants in the international congress: Life-sustaining treatments

and vegetative state: Scientifi c advances and ethical dilemmas. Retrieved from www.vatican.va/holy _father/john_paul_ii/speeches/2004/march/documents /hf_jp-ii_spe_20040320_congress-fi amc_en.html

Worden, J. (1991). Grief counseling and grief therapy: A handbook for the mental health practitioner (2nd ed.). New York, NY: Springer.

World Health Organization. (1980). International classifi cation of impairments, disabilities and handicaps. Geneva, Switzerland: Author.

Wright, B. A. (1983). Physical disability—A psychosocial approach (2nd ed.). New York, NY: Harper & Row.

Zola, I. (1982). Missing pieces: A chronicle of living with a disability. Philadelphia, PA: Temple University Press.

JWBT514_ch09.indd 236JWBT514_ch09.indd 236 9/21/11 7:42 PM9/21/11 7:42 PM

237

10

Communication in Health Care

SARAH GEHLERT

Good communication is central to the provision of effective health care. If patient and provider are able to communicate in a way that leads to the accurate exchange of information, health outcomes will be enhanced in several ways. Diagnosis is more accurate, for example, when social workers and other health-care providers are able to establish rapport with patients, take cues from them, and pose questions in a way that is understandable. Likewise, when patients are able to express their symptoms and concerns in a way that can be understood by providers, it is more likely that their conditions will be diag- nosed and any problems assessed with accuracy. Treatment plans based on those assessments will be more effective because they will better refl ect patients’ unique health-care and social needs. It therefore is easy to agree with Fisher’s (1992) assessment that the best scientifi c knowledge in the world is insuffi cient if communication be- tween patient and provider is fl awed.

In this chapter, the goal of health communi- cation is defi ned as obtaining and disseminat- ing the maximum amount of information with the minimum amount of distortion and dis- comfort for the communicators. The chapter’s purpose is to describe (a) the negotiations in- herent in health-care encounters, (b) common sources of communication error, and (c) ways in which communication can be enhanced in a variety of clinical settings.

Chapter Objectives • Convey the structure and dynamics of the

clinical encounter between patient (or patient system) and provider in health-care settings.

• Convey how health beliefs impact health communication.

• Determine how group differences by race, ethnicity, gender, socioeconomic status, religion, and geography can affect health beliefs.

• Discuss the dynamics of health-care teams. • Outline evidence-based methods for im-

proving how health messages and informa- tion are communicated to patients and their families and how information is solicited by health-care providers.

• Outline evidence-based methods for im- proving how patients and families present information to and question health-care providers.

• Distinguish interpretation from translation. • Provide guidelines for accurate translation

of health-care information between patients and providers in health-care settings.

This chapter is designed to be used in con- cert with other chapters in this book, especially those on physical and mental health (Chapter 8), chronic illness (Chapter 20), and alternative health (Chapter 12). Active cross-referencing of these chapters by readers will optimize their learning of how communication can be en- hanced to maximize health-care outcomes.

STRUCTURE AND DYNAMICS OF THE CLINICAL ENCOUNTER IN HEALTH CARE

In a seminal article on communication in health care, Kleinman, Eisenberg, and Good (1978) described the clinical encounter between

JWBT514_ch10.indd 237JWBT514_ch10.indd 237 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

238 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

patient and provider as a negotiation between two cultural constructions of reality that yields clinical reality. The authors defi ned clinical re- ality as the interactions between patients and providers that occur during the health-care encounter and the outcomes that accrue from those interactions. Outcomes may include: (a) the development of treatment plans; (b) adher- ence to those plans; (c) health consequences, such as reduction in asthma attacks or sei- zures; and (d) social consequences, such as a child’s ability to return to school.

Kleinman et al. (1978, 2006) noted that pa- tients bring to their encounters with providers sets of beliefs, expectations, values, and goals that are culturally constructed in the sense that they are determined by each individual’s life experiences. The authors note that illness is shaped by cultural factors governing the perception, labeling, explanation, and evalu- ation of discomforting experiences, the latter of which are analogous to symptoms. These processes are embedded in complex family, social, and cultural nexuses. Prior experience with the illnesses of family members and how these illnesses were managed, for instance, has a signifi cant effect on the ways in which individuals approach or deal with their own illnesses and those of their families. These prior experiences can be as subtle as a child overhearing her parents talk about the serious illness of a family member.

As described by Rolland in Chapter 13 on families and chronic illness, families vary greatly in their approaches to illness. They vary in the extent to which and how they work together to deal with the management of an ill- ness, how they work with providers, and how they communicate with one another and others about the illness. The parents of a child with epilepsy in one family, for instance, may not talk about the condition within the family, may attempt to hide seizures from others, and may take a passive role with the child’s physician. Another set of parents might organize the fam- ily around the child’s seizures, talking freely about the condition, with all members respon- sible for monitoring symptoms, becoming ac- tive in advocacy groups, and joining the child

at clinic visits. A third family may have inte- grated the child’s seizures into family life so that the condition is neither hidden nor domi- nates activities. Each of these three approaches to dealing with a child’s epilepsy likely would have a unique effect on the lifetime responses to illness of the child with epilepsy and his siblings. Determining an individual’s family illness history thus can be a powerful tool for health social workers because it provides valu- able insights into how prior experiences might have shaped the individual’s cultural construc- tion of reality.

Pachter (1994) says that patients’ cultural constructions of reality almost never differ entirely from the biomedical constructions held by health-care providers but instead vary on a continuum between lay or ethnocultural constructions on one end and biomedical con- structions on the other. In fact, most patients’ cultural constructions of reality represent combinations of “ethnocultural beliefs, per- sonal and idiosyncratic beliefs, and biomedical concepts” (p. 690). The farther that patients’ constructions diverge from those of providers, the greater the likelihood that communication problems will occur.

Providers, too, bring to clinical encounters sets of beliefs, expectations, values, and goals that are shaped by their own unique life experi- ences as well as the professional cultures into which they have been socialized (Hall, 2005). Professional cultures, such as those of physi- cians, nurses, health social workers, and physi- cal therapists, entail shared language, rules of behavior, dress, and ways of acknowledging status. Rosenthal (1993, p. B1) described the socialization of medical students, for instance, in this way: “[F]rom the beginning, medical students are told that they are in school to learn to think like a doctor. And when they emerge 4 years later, many will have adopted a profes- sional demeanor such that they not only think like one, but talk like one, and dress like one, too.” Some have gone so far as to suggest that providers’ socialization and culture may con- tribute to health disparities in the United States (Institute of Medicine [IOM], 2002; van Ryn & Fu, 2003).

JWBT514_ch10.indd 238JWBT514_ch10.indd 238 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Communication in Health Care 239

Health Beliefs and Communication

Health beliefs are components of cultural con- structions of reality that guide health behavior and communication. They are guided by cul- ture and dictate (a) how symptoms are identi- fi ed and which are considered appropriate to take to providers, (b) how patients understand the causes and treatment of their illnesses, (c) what patients expect of providers, and (d) what personal and moral meanings patients ascribe to their illnesses and how they address ques- tions such as “Why me? What did I do to de- serve this?” (Weston & Brown, 1989, p. 77).

Leventhal (1985) adds that the natural his- tory of illnesses can shape patients’ health be- liefs and constructions of reality in much the same way that culture shapes health beliefs. This is particularly true with chronic illnesses. Patients’ awareness and understanding of ill- ness increase through time as they are exposed to health information and become more famil- iar with how their bodies respond to chronic illness. This heightened awareness can infl u- ence how symptoms are evaluated and in which situations patients deem it appropriate to seek formal treatment. A patient who initially was frightened by symptoms and sought treatment frequently may in time feel capable of illness self-management as she becomes more famil- iar with the pattern of her symptoms.

From a global perspective, illness is seen as due either to natural causes, such as infection or accident, or to supernatural causes, such as

spirit aggression, sorcery, witchcraft, or mysti- cal retribution (Erasmus, 1952; Foster, 1976; see Table 10.1). Although supernatural causes may seem exotic to many, they are part of the health belief systems of many residents of the United States, especially those who were born outside the country. In 2000, 1 in 10 U.S. residents (28.4 million) was born outside the country (Lollock, 2001). According to data from the 2000 U.S. census (Spector, 2004), 51% were from Latin America, 25.5% from Asia, 15.3% from Europe, and 8.2% from other areas; these fi gures do not include undoc- umented immigrants. Although their numbers are diffi cult to estimate, around 10.9 million undocumented immigrants were thought to be living in the United States in the fi rst quarter of 2009 (Camarota & Jensenius, 2009).

Health beliefs, like cultural constructions of reality in general, are learned through so- cialization. They are often long-held cultural beliefs that remain with a group, especially one that is cut off from mainstream society for socioeconomic, religious, geographic, or po- litical reasons. Religious and political groups might, for example, have reason to hold on to certain beliefs and to eschew mainstream con- structions. Jehovah’s Witnesses, for example, hold strong beliefs against the sharing of blood products and come into confl ict with health- care providers who prescribe transfusions during surgery or after accidents. A number of high-profi le court cases have resulted from situations in which parents who are Jehovah’s

Table 10.1 Four Theories of Supernatural Causation by Region of the World

Theory Defi nition Region

Mystical retribution Acts in violation of some taboo or moral injunction causing disease indirectly

Africa

Sorcery Ascription of impairment of health to the aggressive use of magical techniques by a human being, either independently or with the assistance of a specialized magician or shaman

North America

Spirit aggression Aspiration to the direct, hostile, arbitrary, or punitive action of some malevolent or affronted supernatural being, such as nature spirits, disease, demons, departed ancestors, or ghosts

East Asia, insular Pacifi c, South America

Witchcraft Ascription of impairment of health to the suspected voluntary or involuntary aggressive action of a member of a special class of human beings believed to be endowed with a special power and propensity for evil

Circum-Mediterranean

JWBT514_ch10.indd 239JWBT514_ch10.indd 239 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

240 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

Witnesses refused to allow their children to receive transfusions prescribed by physicians. Orthodox Jews who observe strict dietary laws may come into confl ict with staff mem- bers when admitted to hospitals that are not equipped to provide kosher meals.

Geography can act to maintain traditional health beliefs by limiting access to mainstream sources. Rural areas of the United States are characterized by lower population density, fewer specialized health-care providers, and greater distance between health-care facilities (Coward & Kout, 1998). Because exposure to mainstream culture is likely to be limited to media sources, fewer mainstream health messages are received, and traditional health beliefs are less likely to be challenged. Christakis and Fowler (2007) exam- ined a densely interconnected social network of 12,067 people assessed repeatedly from 1971 to 2003 through the Framingham (Massachusetts) Health Study and found evidence that obesity spreads through person-to-person social ties. A network member’s chances of becoming obese during a certain period of time increased 57% if that person had a friend who became obese during the same period of time. Similar results were found for the spread of alcohol- consumption behavior (Rosenquist, Murabito, Fowler, & Christakis, 2010).

Residents born outside the United States are more likely than their native-born counter- parts to live in the center of cities and to live in poverty (Lollock, 2001). They, like many native-born residents of inner cities, often live in homogeneous groups with strong within- group social network ties. These strong ties are benefi cial to health in that they provide opportunities for support from other group members. If others in the group are similarly impoverished, however, they might not be able to provide fi nancial support in times of need or assist with travel to health-care facilities. Also, strong within-group ties are often at the expense of weak ties to mainstream culture, which represent important sources of health in- formation (Pescosolido & Levy, 2002). Women with weak ties to mainstream culture, for ex- ample, are much less likely to receive informa- tion on breast self-examination and where to

obtain free mammograms. Parents with weak ties to mainstream culture are less likely to know about health-care funding opportunities for their children (see Chapter 5 in this book).

In her book Walkin’ over Medicine (1993), Loudell Snow describes the impact of patients’ health beliefs on their health behavior, observed during her work at a community health clinic serving predominantly African American pa- tients in Lansing, MI. Clinic providers were concerned about nonadherence to prescribed medications, such as medications to lower blood pressure (called antihypertensive medications). Through interviews with clinic patients, Snow found that a number of patients included anemia under the rubric of “low blood.” Many patients in this group had discontinued their medica- tions after providers made statements such as “Congratulations, you’ve brought your blood pressure down. It’s low now!” What seemed to providers to be a healthy state (i.e., low blood pressure among those prone to hypertension) seemed unhealthy to patients, causing them to discontinue taking their medications.

In another example, Snow (1993) was con- sulted on high rates of unplanned pregnancy among young African American women. As part of clinical practice, women were being prescribed oral contraceptives and trained in the rhythm method of contraception. Through in- terviews, Snow determined that the two means of birth control confl icted with the beliefs of a number of women that menstruation was im- portant to health because it allowed toxins and pollutants to be eliminated that might other- wise cause ill health. Oral contraceptives were viewed as deleterious to health because they diminished menstrual fl ow. The rhythm method similarly was seen as dangerous to health be- cause of its prescription that sex should occur near menstruation, a time when women felt that their bodies were particularly open and thus more vulnerable to toxins and pollutants. Ac- cording to the group’s health beliefs, the days most distant from menstruation were safest for sex because the body was least open. This was problematic because days distant in time from menstruation are when women ovulate and are most likely to become pregnant.

JWBT514_ch10.indd 240JWBT514_ch10.indd 240 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Communication in Health Care 241

In both of these examples, a clinical reality could be negotiated that addressed the incon- gruities between the health beliefs of patients and providers. In the case of antihypertensive medications, the task was as simple as identify- ing the two meanings of “low blood” and ad- vising providers to use instead “normal blood pressure” or “good blood pressure.” In the case of confl icting views of birth control, methods that neither restricted menstrual fl ow, as was the case with oral contraception, nor involved hav- ing sex during menstruation, when women con- sidered the body to be particularly vulnerable (e.g., the rhythm method), were emphasized.

Numerous empirical studies have supported the link between health beliefs and success of behavior-change efforts. Patterson, Kristal, and White (1996) measured the baseline be- liefs about the association between diet and cancer of a population-based sample of 607 people in Washington state. They found those with stronger beliefs signifi cantly decreased their percentage of fat consumed and signifi - cantly increased their fi ber intake. In a second study, low-income, rural, African American women who did not believe themselves to be at risk for breast cancer, whether they had pos- itive family histories or not, were less likely to get mammograms than women who believed themselves to be at risk (West et al., 2003).

ILLNESS VERSUS DISEASE

The clinical encounter can be seen as a set of transactions or negotiations between patients and providers. Success is determined at least partly by the extent to which the two can reach a measure of congruence. In general, the more

dissimilar the cultural constructions of real- ity of the two, the more diffi cult will be the negotiation. A gross example of dissimilarity between the patient’s and the provider’s cul- tural constructions of reality is that patients experience illness while physicians treat dis- ease. Disease is defi ned by Kleinman and colleagues (2006) as malfunctioning or mal- adaptation of biologic and psychophysiologic processes in the individual. Helman (1985) says that a disease construction reduces ill health to physicochemical terms and overem- phasizes biological (as opposed to social or psychological) information in reaching a di- agnosis. Illness, however, represents personal, interpersonal, and cultural reactions to disease or discomfort (Kleinman et al., 2006). Accord- ing to Helman (1985), illness is a wider and more diffuse concept that is patterned by so- cial, psychological, and cultural factors.

Disease is determined objectively while ill- ness is determined subjectively. Thus, disease can exist in the absence of illness, for example, when a patient has a biological abnormality of which she is not aware. A woman could, for instance, have a malignant ovarian tumor in the absence of symptoms. Likewise, illness can occur in the absence of disease. Common complaints such as headache and gastroin- testinal distress may be very problematic for patients and cause disruption in social func- tioning, such as the ability to work or go to school, yet occur in the absence of any abnor- mality in the structure or function of body or- gans or systems.

Illness conditions that are specifi c to cer- tain cultures, such as susto in Mexico (Rubel, 1977), koro in Malaysia, and pibloktoq among Eskimos (Foulks, 1972; see Table 10.2), fall

Table 10.2 Culture-Specifi c Syndromes

Syndrome Description Cultural Origins

Koro An episode of sudden, intense anxiety in which the penis recedes into the body and that may cause death

Malaysia

Pibloktoq (Arctic hysteria)

Sudden-onset bizarre behavior that is short lived and thought to be induced by fright

Circumpolar regions

Susto Illness arising from fright in which the soul is thought to leave the body Mexico

JWBT514_ch10.indd 241JWBT514_ch10.indd 241 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

242 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

under the rubric of illness rather than disease. Although these culture-specifi c syndromes are considered real by the culture groups that recognize them, providers do not universally recognize them. They are not included in the International Statistical Classifi cation of Dis- eases and Related Health Problems (ICD), a compendium of internationally recognized diseases published by the World Health Or- ganization. The ICD, now in its tenth revision (ICD-10; World Health Organization, 2003), is the international standard diagnostic classi- fi cation used for monitoring the incidence and prevalence of diseases worldwide and allow- ing the compilation of mortality and morbidity statistics by member nations.

That illness and disease are not directly correlated with one another can be a source of miscommunication and lead to nonadherence to medical treatment recommendations. Con- ditions such as brain cancers are considered se- rious diseases by physicians, yet in their early stages, they may cause less distress and social disruption for patients than muscle spasms of the lower back. In addition, patients with the same degree of organ or system pathology (i.e., disease) report different levels of well-being and social dysfunction (i.e., illness). In other words, some patients with rheumatoid arthritis might report adequate well-being and are able to perform their own activities of daily living (ADLs) while others at the same stage of the disease might report that their well-being is diminished markedly and that they require as- sistance to perform ADLs.

Optimal patient and provider communica- tion can infl uence health outcomes in a num- ber of direct and indirect ways (Street, Makoul, Arora, & Epstein, 2009). Clinical encounters in which providers focus on disease and pa- tients focus on illness are likely to result in frustration, mistrust, and less favorable health outcomes because providers may feel that their recommendations are not being given due con- sideration by patients and patients may per- ceive that their complaints are not being taken seriously. A poignant real-life example comes from a book entitled The Spirit Catches You

and You Fall Down (Fadiman, 1997). This book describes non-English-speaking Hmong immigrant parents of a young girl with epi- lepsy who viewed her illness through the eyes of their culture, namely as the fl ight of her soul from her body. They treated the condition ac- cording to their beliefs, with animal sacrifi ces and traditional remedies. The Merced County, CA, physicians who were treating the child fo- cused on her condition as a disease (epilepsy) requiring fi ne-tuned dosages of prescribed anticonvulsant medications. Both sides were operating with the best intentions and compas- sion, yet their inability to communicate with one another and subsequent mutual mistrust and blaming resulted in a situation in which the two sides could only watch impotently as the child’s situation deteriorated to the point of serious disability.

Social workers who are aware of incon- gruent understandings between patients and providers can help to remedy the situation by pointing out the discrepancy, interpreting each side’s frustration to the other, and helping to establish a clinical accord. Setha Low (1984, p. 13) wrote: “[O]ften the social worker is the only person who can see both sides of the cul- tural picture—the bureaucratic, mainstream, and the ethnic or subcultural perspective—and from this vantage point may be the single most criti- cal actor in the provision of care and informa- tion.” This is congruent with Richard Cabot’s notion of social workers as translators in health- care environments (see Chapter 1 in this book).

A list of questions developed by Kleinman (1980) can serve as a valuable tool for social workers and other providers in their efforts to elicit patients’ health beliefs. These questions include:

• What do you think caused your problem?

• How severe do you think the problem is?

• Do you think that its course will be short or long?

• What diffi culties is the problem causing for you?

• About what are you most concerned?

JWBT514_ch10.indd 242JWBT514_ch10.indd 242 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Communication in Health Care 243

• What treatment do you think is warranted for your problem?

• What benefi ts do you expect to receive from the treatment?

A vivid example of what might occur if a provider is not aware of a patient’s health beliefs comes from the work of Young and Flower (2001, p. 91). A young man named Pete who worked in a fast-food restaurant went to the emergency room after injuring his ankle. He assumed that his ankle was fractured because he was in a great deal of pain and heard the same cracking sound that he had heard when he had fractured his ankle in the past. His greatest concern was that he would lose his job if he missed work. Pete lost trust in the physician when he was told that his ankle was sprained rather than fractured and that the only possible treat- ment was to stay off it for 5 days. He had framed the problem very differently from the physician and had given the situation different meaning. Because his cultural con- struction of reality weighted serious sprains and fractures differently, he assumed that he would not be granted sick leave from his em- ployer if his ankle were sprained rather than broken. The clinical situation deteriorated rapidly with the physician, who had given Pete no opportunity to tell his story, perceiv- ing Pete as being uncooperative and wanting to get off work for no reason. Pete left the encounter assuming that the physician had made a mistake. He promptly threw away the Ace bandage that he had been given for his sprain and returned to work. This left his ankle prone to reinjury and his view of phy- sicians compromised. The physician’s view of patients as malingerers was reinforced.

Social Workers on Health-Care Teams

Although written over 20 years ago, Cleora Roberts’s (1989) observations on the strain in- herent in the professional relationship between social workers and physicians still rings true today. Roberts suggested that an appreciation

of this strain and the necessary tension that it produces could catalyze successful collabora- tion between social workers and physicians. The fi ve areas of major difference in perspec- tives are that:

1. A physician’s goal is to save lives while the social worker’s focus is more on quality than quantity of life.

2. Physicians are more likely to base decisions on objective data, such as laboratory tests, while social workers consider patients’ sub- jective interpretations of events.

3. Physicians are likely to develop treatment plans based on the assumption that the goal of treatment is improved health and the lon- gest possible life, while social workers are trained to encourage self-determined treat- ment goals.

4. Social workers are more likely than physi- cians to feel comfortable in dealing with patients’ emotional problems.

5. Physicians are more likely to take charge on health-care teams while social workers are accustomed to collaboration.

A few studies have examined social worker and physician collaborations. Mizrahi and Abramson (1985) examined self-reports of collaborations between 50 social worker– physician pairs and found the two professions to have similar perspectives in many cases. Social workers were more likely to identify family problems with adjustment to illness and problems with availability of and access to resources than were their physician collabora- tors. This fi nding is congruent with Roberts’s observation that social workers are more likely than physicians to consider quality rather than quantity of life and less likely to focus on objective data.

Turner (1990) describes social work in health care as a transcultural resource. He im- plicates three phenomena in Western medicine as particularly culture specifi c and value laden and thus potential obstacles to health commu- nication. Each of the three confl icts with the

JWBT514_ch10.indd 243JWBT514_ch10.indd 243 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

244 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

values of social work. The “scientifi cation” of medicine is a trend toward addressing the somatic aspects of health at the expense of be- havioral and social aspects. Turner describes the “recurrent, unoffi cial, and popular ‘anti- scientifi c’ theme” (p. 14) of social work as counter to the trend toward scientifi cation. A second trend is toward increased specializa- tion, which Turner says leads to decreased sensitivity to the whole person. Social work’s holistic perspective broadens the health-care team’s view to consider the individual as a whole. The third trend noted by Turner is med- icine’s increasingly patient-only focus, to the exclusion of salient others, events, and issues in the environment. Again, the emphasis of so- cial work on person in environment broadens the scope of the health-care team.

An appreciation of the complex interplay of biological, social, and behavioral factors in health (see, e.g., McGinnis, Williams-Russo, & Knickman, 2002) has led to new concep- tualizations of team science and disciplinary collaboration (Abrams, 2006; Hiatt & Breen, 2008). In 2003, Elias Zerhouni, the director of the National Institutes of Health (NIH), initi- ated the Roadmap for 21st Century Medical Research, which for the fi rst time encour- aged professionals from different disciplines to work together in new ways and to include community members as active participants in scientifi c investigations. NIH personnel, scien- tists, and community members are all consid- ered stakeholders in research.

New professional collaborations fostered by the NIH Roadmap take research from the multidisciplinary and interdisciplinary ap- proach to the new concept of transdisciplinary (see Table 10.3). In the latter, investigators from the biological, social, and behavioral sci- ences work so closely together in addressing major health issues that they must develop new shared languages that incorporate key words from their separate disciplines, pool the best of their disciplinary theories, and forge new methodologies and analytical approaches that allow inclusion of factors at multiple levels in the same analyses (Gehlert et al., 2010). Kahn and Prager (1994) point out that, for

true transdisciplinary teams to be successful, university structures, such as rewards for pub- lishing frequently and on narrow topics, must be modifi ed, a sentiment echoed in a report by the National Academies (National Academy of Sciences, National Academy of Engineering, & IOM, 2005).

Social work education faces similar chal- lenges, especially in providing suffi cient biological and genetic training to students in- terested in working in health care so that they can operate effectively on transdisciplinary teams. Toward that purpose, a guide to under- standing medical terminology is located in an appendix to this chapter.

Additional challenges presented by the transdisciplinary approach to health include preparing students to work with professionals from other disciplinary cultures (Hall, 2005) and teaching them new ways to include com- munity members in health-care decision mak- ing. The tradition of family support in social work education can provide guidance for the latter.

Although the NIH Roadmap addresses re- search directly, it has major implications for how health care is viewed and delivered in

Table 10.3 Types and Descriptions of Health-Care Teams

Type Description

Multidisciplinary Team members represent a variety of professional backgrounds. Although part of the same team, they have separate bodies of professional knowledge and maintain different disciplinary languages.

Interdisciplinary Team members from a variety of professional backgrounds share their bodies of knowledge and disciplinary languages.

Transdisciplinary Team members from a variety of professional backgrounds develop a shared language based on their separate disciplinary languages, pool bodies of knowledge and theories, and jointly develop new methods and analytical techniques.

JWBT514_ch10.indd 244JWBT514_ch10.indd 244 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Communication in Health Care 245

the United States. NIH is the largest funder of medical research in the world, and hospitals and other health-care facilities depend on re- search funding for their operations. This has been the case with teaching hospitals for some time but is increasingly becoming the case for community clinics, other outpatient facilities, illness-specifi c consumer organizations (e.g., the American Heart Foundation), and advo- cacy groups. The broad view of health as a complex interplay of biological, social, and behavioral factors and of community residents as important contributors presented by the NIH Roadmap is signifi cant for how social work is viewed in health care for two major reasons: It forces a broader view of health that includes social and behavioral factors, and it places a premium on being able to establish and ac- cess community ties. Because social work is recognized by other health-care professionals as particularly expert in these two areas, the profi le of the profession is likely to rise.

Group theory traditionally has been used by social workers in health care to understand patients as members of groups. It also serves them well in helping to understand the dy- namics of the teams on which they serve. The often-used classifi cation of group roles that include opinion giver, coordinator, gatekeeper, and special-interest pleader (Benne & Sheets, 1948) works as well for health-care teams as for patient groups. Likewise, the phases of small groups (see e.g., Northouse & Nort- house, 1997)—namely orientation, confl ict, cohesion, working, and termination—work equally well for patient and provider groups in health care, although health-care teams often are ongoing and not time limited.

Yalom (1998) provides a list of factors through which groups work to achieve thera- peutic aims. Understanding factors such as (a) catharsis, which occurs when team members are able to express openly or ventilate their frustrations; (b) the corrective recapitulation of the primary family group, in which group members experience interactions that mimic those they experienced with their parents and siblings but in a more positive way; and (c) interpersonal learning, in which members

learn from one another through observation, can be useful in understanding why members of a health-care team are behaving as they are. Many social workers report anecdotally that they have become team diagnosticians and that other professionals turn to them for advice on personal matters.

Beginning in the 1980s, a number of au- thors have examined the role of social work- ers on health-care teams. Sands, Stafford, and McClelland (1990), for example, echoed the sources of confl ict between social workers and physicians noted by Roberts (1989) and Turner (1990; also see Mizrahi & Abramson, 1985) and added others germane to social workers’ relationships with other health-care team pro- fessionals. These include status differences between disciplines that interfere with demo- cratic functioning and the competition that arises when professional roles and functions overlap.

At the same time, there is evidence that interprofessional collaborations involving so- cial workers are effective. In an experimental study, Sommers, Marton, Barbaccia, and Ran- dolph (2000) compared teams of primary care physicians, nurses, and social workers to pri- mary care physicians working alone in terms of number of hospital admissions; readmissions; offi ce visits; emergency department visits; and changes in self-rated physical, mental, and so- cial functioning of patients. The collaborative team approach resulted in signifi cantly fewer hospitalizations, readmissions, and offi ce vis- its for patients as well as an increase in their levels of social activity. As noted in Chapter 1, social workers in health care have been less likely than other professionals to have roles identifi ed as uniquely their own. This phenomenon was noted originally in a 1980 study by Lister in which health profession- als from 13 disciplines were surveyed on role expectations. No role was assigned uniquely to social work. This leads to confusion when psychologists, nurses, and therapists perform some of the same functions, such as taking so- cial histories or helping patients prepare psy- chologically for medical procedures. Overlap of roles is more likely in some settings than

JWBT514_ch10.indd 245JWBT514_ch10.indd 245 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

246 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

others. Settings that rely more on technology, such as emergency departments or intensive care units, generally exhibit more role distinc- tion and more hierarchical decision making. In settings less tied to technology, such as long- term care facilities or nursing homes, profes- sionals’ roles are less distinct and more likely to overlap. Decision making is more likely to be democratic.

Sands et al. (1990) note that confl ict has a function in health-care teams: to ensure that situations and issues facing the team are viewed from a variety of perspectives. Confl ict can be a catalyst for growth and contribute to good decision making if team members are able to speak freely, negotiate effectively, and achieve resolution. Group think (Janus, 1972), which occurs when group members feel pres- sured to conform, has been implicated in some of the worst disasters in history, including the Bay of Pigs invasion and the escalation of the war in Vietnam.

A number of authors have offered sugges- tions for improving interprofessional function- ing while minimizing pressure to conform (Freeth, 2001; Satin, 1987; Vanclay, 1996). Vanclay suggests that the keys to sustaining effective collaboration between social work- ers and physicians are interprofessional edu- cation, a clear understanding of the roles and responsibilities of other disciplines, regular face-to-face contact, shared information on structures and procedures, and support from senior management.

Communication Patterns in Health-Care Settings

A landmark study of communication in outpa- tient settings noted a pattern in which patients were cut off by physicians before they were able to express all of their health concerns. Beckman and Frankel (1984) recorded 74 out- patient return visits and measured physicians’ questioning style and whether they interrupted patients during their opening statements of concern. In 8% of visits, physicians failed to solicit patients’ concerns entirely and asked only closed-ended questions. In 69% of visits,

physicians interrupted patient within 18 sec- onds of their beginning to talk and redirected interviews. In only 1 of 74 instances (less than 1%) did a physician allow a patient to return to his initial statement of concerns. In the remain- ing 23% of visits, patients were allowed to complete their opening statement of concerns without interruption. The authors cautioned that the physician-directed style observed in their study would almost certainly result in the exclusion of information pertinent to diag- nosis and treatment planning. In a subsequent interview, Frankel (Goleman, 1991) stated that physician interruptions are particularly trou- bling in light of the fact that patients rarely list their most troubling complaint fi rst but instead submerge it in a list of less troubling concerns. The third complaint listed by patients is gener- ally the most troubling for them.

Clinical encounters are even more prob- lematic when providers and patients are from different racial or ethnic groups or different socioeconomic status (SES), especially when providers are White American and patients are low income or members of a minority group. A 2002 report issued by the IOM implicated physician behavior in the growth of health dis- parities in the United States, which often are based on racial, ethnic, or SES differences. McGinnis and colleagues (2002), based on a review of the best available empirical studies, attributed 10% of early deaths in the United States to shortfalls in medical care; a portion of that percentage was thought to be due to provider behavior.

Johnson, Roter, Powe, and Cooper (2004) conducted a study to determine the extent to which patient race and ethnicity affect commu- nication between providers and patients. The outpatient clinic visits of 458 White American and African American patients and 61 physi- cians in the Washington, DC/Baltimore area were rated by experts in terms of physician verbal dominance (measured by dividing the total number of physician statements by the total number of patient statements), patient- centeredness (measured by dividing the total amount of socioemotional talk by the total amount of biomedical talk), and emotional

JWBT514_ch10.indd 246JWBT514_ch10.indd 246 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Communication in Health Care 247

tone (affect) of the interviews. Physicians were 23% more verbally dominant and communica- tion was 33% less patient-centered during phy- sician visits with African American patients than with White American patients. African American patients and their physicians also were rated as exhibiting lower levels of posi- tive affect than were White American patients and their physicians.

Beach and colleagues (2010) analyzed 354 encounters between patients infected with human immunodefi ciency virus (HIV) and their providers across four HIV care sites (Portland, OR; Detroit, MI; Baltimore, MD; and New York, NY) using the Roter Interac- tion Analysis System to explore racial differ- ences in communication. As was the case in the 2004 study by Johnson and colleagues, physicians were more verbally dominant with African American than with White American patients. The total number of socioemotional statements made did not differ between the two groups, however, in the study by Beach and colleagues.

In attempting to tease out the sources of unintentional provider bias that might be im- pacting health disparities, Burgess, Fu, and von Ryn (2004) outlined a number of pos- sible explanations. They suggest that White American providers unknowingly may con- vey negative affect toward African American patients, which triggers the patients’ own negative affect, resulting in a situation that is suboptimal for communication. They suggest that the majority of providers hold conscious beliefs on equality that are inconsistent with their automatic, unconscious reactions to low- income and minority patients. The authors go on to say that in clinical situations in which the time allotted for information gathering is almost never suffi cient, providers tend to fi ll in the gaps with information based on group stereotypes and behave in ways that confi rm those stereotypes.

An example of this phenomenon comes from a study by Lewis, Croft-Jeffreys, and David (1990). In this study, 139 psychiatrists completed a questionnaire after reading one of two versions of a case that varied only by

whether the patient was Afro-Caribbean or White American. Another two versions of the vignette varied only in terms of the patient’s gender. All vignettes described the behavior of a patient with psychosis. Respondents rated the Afro-Caribbean case as more violent and criminal and less likely to need narcoleptics than the White American case. Female cases were rated as less violent, less criminal, and less likely to need narcoleptic medications than male cases.

Two additional studies linked patient race to physicians’ treatment recommendations. In the fi rst, van Ryn and Burke (2000) gath- ered survey data from 618 patients visiting 193 physicians after an angiogram. Physicians tended to rate African American patients as lower in intelligence and less likely to adhere to treatment recommendations and more likely to exhibit risk behaviors than White American patients. They attributed patients of lower and middle SES less favorably than upper-SES patients on measures of personality, ability, role demands, and behavioral tendencies. In a second study (Schulman et al., 1999), 720 primary care physicians attending two national meetings viewed a taped interview with a pa- tient and reviewed hypothetical data on the same patient. They were then surveyed about how they would manage the patient’s chest pain. Women and African American patients were less likely than men and White Ameri- can patients to be referred for cardiac cath- eterization. African American women were signifi cantly less likely to be referred for the procedure than White American men.

Little work has focused on how SES dif- ferences between providers and patients might impact communication, and thus health out- comes, above and beyond the effect of racial and ethnic differences. Jensen, King, Guntz- viller, and Davis (2010) surveyed 131 low- income adults living in Indiana about their satisfaction with their communication with health-care providers. Interestingly, satisfac- tion was lower among younger White Ameri- can patients with higher levels of literacy than among older patients with lower rates of lit- eracy who were African American or Hispanic

JWBT514_ch10.indd 247JWBT514_ch10.indd 247 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

248 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

Americans. The authors suggest that the for- mer group may be more assertive while the latter group may withdraw during health-care encounters.

Biases in communication by gender have been observed in the few studies that have addressed the topic. Although little is known about variation in communication by gender of patient, a number of studies have demonstrated differences in communication between male and female physicians. Roter, Hall, and Aoki (2002) reviewed available studies from 1967 to 2001 and found 26 that used a communica- tion database that could be analyzed by raters. They found no gender differences in the quan- tity or quality of biomedical communication or social conversation between male and fe- male physicians. Female physicians, however, exhibited signifi cantly more patient-centered talk than their male colleagues, specifi cally emotionally focused talk, psychosocial coun- seling, psychosocial question asking, active partnership behaviors, and positive talk. Clinic visits to female physicians were on average two minutes longer (10%) than visits to male physicians.

The 2001 IOM report and empirical studies by Roter and colleagues (2002) and Burgess, Fu, and von Ryn (2004) are aimed at physi- cians, despite the fact that the latter authors use the generic term provider. Yet issues of cross- cultural communication are equally important to social workers in health care. Although the perspectives and values of social workers dif- fer from those of physicians, as aptly pointed out by Roberts (1989) and Turner (1990), so- cial workers are as vulnerable to stereotyping and heuristics as other professions and there- fore have to grapple with the same issues and biases when attempting to communicate with people with other cultural constructions of reality.

There is evidence that being ill equipped to communicate with patients from different cultural backgrounds has consequences for providers as well as patients. Ulrey and Ama- son (2001) measured the cultural sensitivity, intercultural communication skills, and lev- els of state anxiety of 391 employees of two

hospitals and four clinics in the U.S. South and found low levels of sensitivity and com- munication skills to be signifi cantly correlated with high levels of anxiety. In other words, providers who were high in cultural sensitivity and better intercultural communicators expe- rienced less anxiety than providers who were less sensitive and less adept at intercultural communication.

The idea that communication problems can be as problematic for providers as patients is supported by a Dutch study (Zandbelt, Smets, Oort, Godfried, & de Haes, 2004) in which the authors measured the same fi ve visit-specifi c relationship phenomena in 30 physicians and 330 patients following outpatient clinic visits. They found physicians to be less satisfi ed in general with health encounters than patients. Patients were most satisfi ed with physicians whom they thought attended better to their health concerns and from whom they were able to obtain information. Physicians reported greater satisfaction after medical encounters with patients who were better educated, had better mental health, and preferred to receive fewer details about their care.

Patient–Provider Communication and Health Outcomes

A number of empirical studies have linked im- proved provider and patient communication to positive changes in physiological and behav- ioral measures of health status. In addition to helping to ensure an accurate exchange of in- formation, enhanced provider communication skills are thought to improve health outcomes by motivating patients to engage actively in their treatment and increasing their confi dence in their ability to infl uence their health. Ma- guire and Pitceathly (2002, p. 697) add that patients’ propensity for anxiety and depression is lessened when communication is effective; effective communication also enhances pro- viders’ well-being.

Several studies have linked better commu- nication between patients and providers with improved adherence to treatment regimens and other favorable health-care outcomes.

JWBT514_ch10.indd 248JWBT514_ch10.indd 248 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Communication in Health Care 249

Schneider, Kaplan, Greenfi eld, Li, and Wilson (2004), for instance, linked better communi- cation to improved adherence (measured on a 4-point scale) to antiretroviral therapy in a sample of 554 patients treated at 22 outpatient HIV clinics. The study’s seven independent variables were (1–6) quality of physician- patient communication, measured using six available scales—general communication, HIV-specifi c information, egalitarian deci- sion-making style, overall physician satisfac- tion, willingness to recommend physician, and physician trust—and (7) the extent to which patients thought their physicians understood and were able to solve problems with their an- tiretroviral regimens. Six of the seven physi- cian-patient communication variables (all but egalitarian decision-making style) were sig- nifi cantly associated with adherence to antiret- roviral therapy. Conteh, Stevens, and Wiseman (2007) found better communication to be as- sociated with increased adherence to malaria treatment in rural Gambia.

In another study (Stewart et al., 2000), the outpatient visits of 315 patients and their 39 family physicians were audiotaped and rated on patient-centered communication (measured as the extent to which the physicians explored patients’ disease and illness experiences, under- stood patients as whole persons, and discussed and sought agreement with patients on treat- ment plans). Patients were asked to rate their encounters for patient-centered communication independently. Outcomes measured were pa- tients’ health and health care, specifi cally di- agnostic tests taken, referrals made, and visits to the family physician in the two months fol- lowing the audiotaped visit, all of which were extracted from patients’ charts. Higher rates of patient-centered communication were associ- ated signifi cantly with better recovery from the complaint that brought the patient to the phy- sician in the fi rst place, fewer diagnostic tests, and fewer referrals. Additional empirical stud- ies link better communication to reduced pain after surgery (Egbert, Battit, Welch, & Bartlett, 1964) and other physiological outcomes (Orth, Stiles, Scherwitz, Hennrikus, & Vallbona, 1987; Skipper & Leonard, 1968).

METHODS FOR IMPROVING HEALTH COMMUNICATION

The body of literature on interventions that im- prove providers’ and patients’ communication skills has grown in recent years.

Changing Providers’ Behavior

Interventions range from prompting physi- cians to check patients’ understanding of in- formation to complex, comprehensive training programs that address a number of factors thought to improve communication.

Based on data obtained from observations of the clinical performance of 25 physicians, Sideris, Tsouna-Hadjis, Toumanidis, Vardas, and Moulopoulos (1986) developed a four- hour training seminar for physicians on health communication. Physicians were taught how to: (a) explain diagnoses, treatment objectives, and prognoses; (b) provide oral and written in- structions; (c) check patients’ comprehension; and (d) convey positive affect. Communica- tion scores were obtained prior to and after the training seminar by asking dyads of participat- ing and nonparticipating physicians and their patients a series of complementary questions about the medical encounter. Adherence was measured by comparing patients’ behavior with instructions given. Both communication and adherence scores of the dyads of physi- cians who participated in training and their patients were statistically signifi cantly higher than those of dyads in which the physicians did not participate in training.

Maiman, Becker, Liptak, Nazarian, and Rounds (1988) tested an intervention in which pediatricians were trained to use simple in- formational and motivational techniques for enhancing mothers’ adherence to prescribed treatment recommendations. The intervention focused on how to: (a) express sincere con- cern and empathy; (b) provide information in a way that can be understood and remembered; (c) simplify treatment regimens; (d) elicit, as- sess, and modify health beliefs; (e) elicit and meet mothers’ expectations for treatment; and (f) monitor adherence to prescribed treatment

JWBT514_ch10.indd 249JWBT514_ch10.indd 249 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

250 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

recommendations. Mothers whose physicians were in the intervention group were signifi - cantly more likely to adhere to medication recommendations and to keep follow-up ap- pointments than mothers whose physicians were in the control condition.

Kinmonth, Woodcock, Griffi n, Spiegal, and Campbell (1998) tested a 1.5-day train- ing program for nurses and physicians aimed at increasing levels of patient-centered com- munication. Teams of physicians and nurses from 41 practices were randomly assigned to an experimental or a control condition. Nurses in the experimental condition were offered a half day of training to review evidence for patient-centered interviewing and a full day of facilitated practice in implementing patient- centered interviewing skills. Physicians in the experimental group received a half day of training in active listening and negotiating behavioral change. Nurses received two ad- ditional support sessions with the facilitator. Nurse/physician dyads in the control condi- tion received no training. The quality of life, well-being, hemoglobin A1c and lipid concen- trations, blood pressure, and body mass index (BMI) of 250 patients with type 2 diabetes from the same practices as the nurse-physician dyads were measured one year after training. Patients also were asked to rate the quality of communication of their nurses and physicians and their satisfaction with care. Patients of dyads in the experimental condition reported better communication, greater satisfaction with care, and greater well-being than did patients of dyads in the control condition. Pa- tients whose nurses and physicians were in the experimental group did not, however, exhibit more favorable hemoglobin A1c or lipid con- centrations, blood pressure readings, or BMI than the control group.

A second study (Brown, Boles, Mullooly, & Levinson, 1999) failed to fi nd gains in patient satisfaction after a communication skills training program titled “Thriving in a Busy Practice: Physician-Patient Communi- cations.” Sixty-nine primary care physicians, surgeons, medical subspecialists, physician- assistants, and nurse practitioners participated

in a 4-hour interactive workshop focused on skills for building effective relationships with patients (active listening, expressing concern, understanding, respect, and responding to feelings) followed by 2 hours of homework in which they were asked to audiotape at least two patient interviews and listen to the record- ings. A 4-hour follow-up session focused on teaching skills for effective negotiation with patients was conducted one month after the fi rst 4-hour session. Patients of the providers who received training were asked to complete the Art of Medicine survey, which measures both satisfaction with providers’ communica- tion abilities and global visit satisfaction. No difference was seen in the Art of Medicine survey scores of patients whose providers had or had not participated in the communication skills training program.

A systematic review by Rao, Anderson, Inui, and Frankel (2007) assessed 21 random- ized clinical trials published between 1996 and 2005 (none of the studies mentioned ear- lier were included in this group of 21) that tested an intervention to change physicians’ communication behaviors. Most interventions included multiple modalities, such as infor- mation, feedback, modeling, and practice, and were delivered in one or more sessions. In 17 of these trials, physicians practiced and received feedback on their communication. Most studies reported improvement in physi- cians’ behavior. Those that did not, however, involved interventions in which physicians had little or no opportunity to practice and receive feedback on their communication skills.

Changing Patient Behavior

A number of studies have focused on modi- fying patient behavior during interviews with physicians to improve health-care communica- tion and outcomes. Most focus on increasing patients’ participation in treatment.

Roter (1977) developed a 10-minute inter- vention in which a health educator assisted patients in formulating questions for their phy- sicians and asking the questions early in clinic visits. Patients in a control condition were

JWBT514_ch10.indd 250JWBT514_ch10.indd 250 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Communication in Health Care 251

provided only with information on services. Interestingly, patients in the experimental con- dition reported more anxiety than did control patients but were signifi cantly more likely to keep appointments during the 4-month follow- up period of the study. Although patients in the experimental group asked signifi cantly more direct questions of their physicians than did control patients, their visits were no longer than those of patients in the control condition. In other words, the intervention changed the nature of the clinic visit without increasing its length.

In another early study of patient and physi- cian communication, Greenfi eld, Kaplan, and Ware (1985) developed and tested an interven- tion in which patients were helped to read the medical records from their last clinic visit. In a 20-minute session, patients were taught to identify relevant medical issues and deci- sions from their records, devise ways to ne- gotiate these decisions with their physicians, and ask questions. The audiotaped interviews of patients who participated in the interven- tion were compared with those who did not. No signifi cant difference in length of visits was found between the two groups. Patients who received training, however, were found to be signifi cantly more assertive in their interac- tions with physicians. They exhibited a 48% higher ratio of patient-to-physician utterances than the control group and elicited about twice the number of factual statements from their physicians.

Kaplan, Greenfi eld, and Ware (1989) re- ported the results of an intervention study in which patients with ulcer disease, hypertension, breast cancer, and diabetes were given cop- ies of their medical records and an algorithm for interpreting the information and coached in behavioral strategies for increasing their participation in clinical interviews with their physicians. The interviews prior to and after the intervention were audiotaped and coded by experts. More patient control and more affect, especially negative affect on the part of both the patient and physician, and more informa- tion provided by physicians in response to pa- tients’ seeking of information were associated

with better health status, including better con- trol of diabetes and hypertension. The authors interpreted negative physician affect, such as tension, nervous laughter, frustration, and anx- iety, as benefi cial because it conveyed caring on the part of the physician.

Thompson, Nanni, and Schwankovsky (1990) tested a simple intervention to improve patients’ participation in communication dur- ing outpatient clinic visits. Sixty-six women were randomly assigned to a control group or a group that was asked to prepare three writ- ten questions for their physician. The group that prepared questions asked signifi cantly more questions during their clinic visits and reported less anxiety after the visits than did women in the control group.

McCann and Weinman (1996) prepared a pamphlet explaining how patients could in- crease their participation in interviews with their primary care physicians. The pamphlet encouraged patients to take a more active part in their interactions with their physi- cians. The pamphlet fi rst asked patients to describe the nature of their problems and to consider the problems’ possible causes and treatments and likely impacts. The pamphlet then outlined how to voice concerns during visits as well as how to ask questions about diagnosis and treatment and check under- standing. The 59 patients who received the intervention materials prior to their visits asked signifi cantly more questions of their physicians than did the 61 individuals in the control condition who received an educa- tional pamphlet.

In another study (Davison & Degner, 1997), 60 men newly diagnosed with prostate cancer in a community urology clinic were randomly assigned to either an experimental group that received written information about prostate cancer, a list of questions to ask their physi- cians, and an audiotape of the medical consul- tation or to a control group that received only information on prostate cancer. Although the two groups did not differ signifi cantly in lev- els of depression, the men in the intervention group took a more active role in treatment de- cision making and reported signifi cantly lower

JWBT514_ch10.indd 251JWBT514_ch10.indd 251 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

252 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

levels of anxiety 6 weeks after the intervention than did men in the control condition.

Another study included 205 patients with chronic health conditions who were randomly assigned to experimental and control condi- tions. Those in the experimental condition were given copies of their medical record progress notes and asked to prepare two ques- tions about their conditions that would be at- tached to the front of their charts. Patients in the control conditions received educational materials and completed suggestion lists for improving clinic care. Those in the experimen- tal group reported signifi cantly better overall physical functioning and satisfaction with their physicians’ care and were signifi cantly more interested in seeing their medical records than those in the control group. In addition, pa- tients in the experimental group reported a sig- nifi cantly better overall health status than they had prior to the intervention (Maly, Bourque, & Engelhardt, 1999).

Additional Techniques for Improving Health Communication

Several techniques have been suggested for improving health-care communication. They can be divided roughly into individual-level techniques that address building empathy and elicit patients’ thoughts and feelings and group- or community-level techniques.

Coulehan and colleagues (2001) devised a method for improving empathy, which they defi ned as “the ability to understand the pa- tient’s situation, perspective, and feelings and to communicate that understanding to the pa- tient” (p. 221). Their method involved active listening, framing or signposting, refl ecting the content, identifying and calibrating the emotion, and accepting and requesting cor- rection. Active listening involves verbal and nonverbal techniques, such as the mirroring of facial expression, making direct eye con- tact, assuming a posture indicating attention, and exhibiting facilitative responses such as nods of understanding. Framing or signpost- ing is analogous to the empathic responding advocated by social work clinicians (see, e.g.,

Hepworth, Rooney, & Larsen, 2002) and may take forms such as “Sounds like you are say- ing. . . .” Refl ecting the content is another term for paraphrasing. Identifying and calibrating the emotion is a means of eliciting the nature of emotion through the use of statements such as “I have the sense that you feel strongly, but I’m not sure I understand exactly what the feel- ing is. Can you tell me?” (p. 222). Requesting and accepting correction comes after state- ments of providers’ understanding of what pa- tients have said through phases such as “Did I get that right?” The sequence—patient’s nar- rative, provider’s statement of understanding and request for correction—is repeated until the provider’s understanding is validated by the patient.

DuPre (2001) outlines four additional tech- niques to elicit patients’ feelings and thoughts, which she gleaned from a review of interviews conducted by a physician well known for her communication skills. These are: (1) involving patients in decision making, (2) talking openly about patients’ fears, (3) asking open-ended questions, and (4) self-disclosing. The latter is appreciated more by some patients than oth- ers based on their personal preferences and cultural expectations. The decision to self- disclose always should be based on cues and responses from patients.

A category of techniques in which provid- ers partner with groups or communities to achieve health-care goals have gained popu- larity. These techniques fall under the rubric of community-engaged research (CEnR), a major category of which is community-based participatory research. The hallmark of CEnR approaches is the active involvement of com- munity members at every stage of the research process. They share an aim to “enhance under- standing of a given phenomenon and the social and cultural dynamics of the community and integrate the knowledge gained with action to improve the health and well-being of com- munity members” (Israel et al., 2003, p. 54). CEnR approaches have been used with a va- riety of culture groups and illness conditions.

A novel approach was developed in the Wai’anae Cancer Research Project (Matsunaga

JWBT514_ch10.indd 252JWBT514_ch10.indd 252 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Communication in Health Care 253

et al., 1996) to test the effectiveness of a cul- turally appropriate intervention for increasing the participation of native Hawaiian women in cervical and breast cancer screening. The impetus for the intervention was that native Hawaiians had the second highest cancer rates in Hawaii. An advisory committee made up of community residents was selected to work collaboratively with project scientifi c investi- gators to devise and test an intervention over a period of years. The intervention was a series of health-focused support groups using exist- ing social networks based on the traditional Hawaiian value of a mutual willingness to help others without expectation of reciprocity and without having to be asked. Native Hawai- ian paraprofessionals recruited women to host groups, presented information to the groups, and facilitated discussion about breast and cervical cancer screening. Peer group leaders, who volunteered to host groups, helped in- vestigators access community groups. Group discussion took traditional “talk story” form, which was familiar to the women and thus more acceptable. Vouchers for free mammo- grams, breast examinations, and Pap smears were provided to each participant and one of each woman’s friends who was unable to participate. An evaluation of the program in- dicated that it had a positive impact on com- munity knowledge, attitudes, and behaviors about breast and cervical cancer screening. In addition, investigators learned a great deal about traditional Hawaiian health beliefs and forged positive relationship with community members and groups.

Recent efforts have aimed at improving the patient–physician partnership by work- ing with the two groups independently and in patient–physician dyads. An example is the Patient-Physician Partnership Study (Cooper et al., 2009), a culturally tailored, multicom- ponent intervention aimed at improving health outcomes for members of racial and ethnic minority groups and people of lower SES. The intervention, which will be tested using a randomized clinical trial, includes a computer- ized self-study communication skills training program for physicians.

Working With Patients With Limited or No English-Language Profi ciency

Perhaps the greatest challenge to health com- munication comes when patients and fami- lies have very limited or no English-language skills. This is an issue in health care today be- cause, according to data from the 2000 census, 19 million people in the United States have limited profi ciency in English (Marcus, 2003).

The optimal approach to working with a patient and family who have limited or no English-language skills is to work with a pro- fessional medical interpreter. In fact, federal law mandates that health-care facilities that receive Department of Health and Human Ser- vices funding provide interpreter services to all people seeking or receiving medical care. The mandate is enforced by the federal Offi ce for Human Rights. Some states also require the use of interpreters. Illinois, for example, passed the Language Assistance Services Act, which requires that nursing homes and hospi- tals make interpreter services available in per- son or by telephone 24 hours a day.

Professional medical interpreters are spe- cially trained individuals who can take a spo- ken message in one language and render it into another language (Luckman, 2000, p. 152). Their task is not merely to change a word in one language to one in another but they are supposed to accurately refl ect differences in culture that infl uence communication. For this reason, Luckman refers to professional medi- cal interpreters as culture brokers. Interpreta- tion differs from translation in that it deals with spoken language while translation deals with written language.

Several points are known to enhance the ac- curacy of interpretation. It is important for the provider to face and speak directly to the patient instead of to the interpreter. Doing this helps to ensure that some measure of relationship and rapport is established between patient and provider. Providers should make eye contact with patients when they are speaking or listen- ing unless it is inappropriate for the patients’ culture group. Appropriateness of eye con- tact can be determined from the professional

JWBT514_ch10.indd 253JWBT514_ch10.indd 253 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

254 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

interpreter or from family members. Questions and comments should be interpreted exactly as they are stated by the provider and in the same voice (i.e., in fi rst person). If the provider said, for example, “I would like to know why you came in today,” the interpreter should interpret the statement in the fi rst person rather than saying “The doctor would like to know why you came in today.” The provider should avoid asking more than one question at a time (e.g., “How are you feeling and why did you come in today?”) and avoid using acronyms or collo- quialisms (e.g., “Did you hurt your noggin?”), which might be diffi cult to interpret.

The interpreter should be positioned be- hind and to the side of the patient and be- tween the patient and the provider, so that the three form a triangle. If the interpreter has questions for the provider, they should be spoken directly to the provider in English after informing the patient that this will occur. Similarly, questions or requests for clarifi ca- tion from patients should be made directly to the patients, after informing the provider that this is to occur.

Because interpreting from one language to another entails more than merely render- ing a word from one language into a second language, some interpretation may entail ad- ditional explanation. This might occur when a phenomenon does not take the same form in one culture as it does in another. If a patient refers to a culture-specifi c condition, such as evil eye, for instance, a direct word-for-word interpretation would not be suffi cient to con- vey the patient’s meaning to the provider. In these situations, after interpreting word for word, the interpreter should tell the provider that the words do not have the same meaning in English as in the patient’s language and pro- vide an explanation (e.g., “mal ojo or evil eye is a condition in Mr. Garcia’s culture in which illness is thought to occur suddenly when one person casts his gaze on another”). The patient also should be informed that the interpreter is explaining a condition that does not occur in the same way in the two cultures. Otherwise, the patient may wonder why the length of the

interpreter’s statement to the provider in Eng- lish took twice or three times as long his re- sponse in his own language.

Some facilities contract with telephone in- terpretation services, especially for unusual languages. An example is the AT&T Language Line, a 24-hour service available in all parts of the country that employs interpreters in 140 languages. In some states, Medicaid covers the cost of this service. The interview usually is done using the telephone’s speaker feature. The disadvantage of using telephone interpre- tation services is that they do not provide the interpreter with valuable nonverbal cues. Also, people who work for telephone interpretation services often are not familiar with medical terminology.

A key advantage to using in-person profes- sional medical interpreters is that they have no stake in patients’ answers to physicians because they presumably are strangers. When no interpreter is available, such as in com- munity health centers, it may be necessary to use a family member of the patient or some- one working in the facility who is bilingual. Using family members as interpreters poses problems with objectivity, and patients may be reluctant to discuss sensitive information in front of their relatives. Families also might want to make a patient look good to provid- ers and thus minimize problems they think are socially less acceptable, such as hallucinations (Slomski, 1993). Finally, a family member’s English skills may be only slightly better than those of the patient.

Using nonfamily members who speak the patient’s language, such as workers in other units of the hospital, may be expeditious but yield poor results, because they may be unfa- miliar with medical terminology and may not understand how to interpret precisely and ob- jectively (Luckman, 2000). Using nonfamily members also can cause serious privacy issues in the health setting. Regional differences in word use between different countries or cultures that speak the same language also may pres- ent problems. In a review of audiotaped tran- scripts of interviews with six Spanish-speaking

JWBT514_ch10.indd 254JWBT514_ch10.indd 254 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Communication in Health Care 255

patients in which a nonprofessional interpreter was used (either a bilingual employee or family member), 165 errors were noted, 77% of which had the potential to cause serious clinical prob- lems (Flores et al., 2003). These included tell- ing a mother to put antibiotics in a child’s ears instead of his mouth and failing to translate questions about drug allergies.

Although it may be necessary to use bilin- gual relatives or employees to interpret in situ- ations in which a patient has no or very limited English skills, it is preferable to use a profes- sional medical interpreter who is familiar with medical terminology. Telephone interpreting services, with the interpreter participating via telephone, are viable options, especially if they employ interpreters with expertise in medical terminology. In situations involving bilingual family members or employees or telephone in- terpreters who have not been trained in medi- cal terminology, the provider should (a) take time to explain the importance of interpret- ing objectively and without editing what the provider says and (b) use less technical terms that are more likely to be understood by the person interpreting and the patient (e.g., “Have you been running a temperature?” rather than “Have you been febrile?” or “Have you gone to the bathroom today?” instead of “Have you voided today?”). The more technical the lan- guage, the less likely it is that it will be under- stood in the same way by provider, interpreter, and patient.

CONCLUSION

Clinical encounters in health care are prob- lematic and require negotiation when patient and provider come with markedly different cultural constructions of reality and hold dif- ferent health beliefs. Good communication between patient and provider can help to overcome divergent beliefs and smooth the path toward a negotiated clinical reality that optimizes the fl ow of information, motivates patients to engage actively in their treatment, increases patients’ confi dence in their ability

to infl uence their own health, and enhances the well-being of both patient and provider. This type of communication has the potential to decrease group differences in health in the United States.

A number of techniques for promoting ef- fective communication were outlined and dis- cussed. A number of techniques for increasing patients’ participation in treatment have dem- onstrated empirical support and show promise for use in clinical settings. Techniques for im- proving providers’ communication skills by attending more to the nonsomatic aspects of patients’ health and making interviews more patient-centered have stood up less well in em- pirical testing.

Social work input is needed in the de- velopment and testing of interventions to improve communication in health care. Al- though the majority of studies reviewed in this chapter had strong research designs, they were almost exclusively atheoretical. Interventions based on strong social science theory constructed by social workers with experience in health care likely would fare better. Similarly, techniques for maximizing the accuracy of communication with people with no or limited English-language skills need empirical testing.

More challenging for social work and other disciplines is how to acknowledge and mini- mize often subtle provider bias toward patients from sociodemographic groups that are very different from the provider’s own. This is as much a challenge for social workers as for any other professional group. Empirical evidence of the outcomes of health encounters between majority providers and patients from minority and lower- and middle-SES groups is sober- ing, especially in terms of its potential nega- tive impact on health outcomes. A great deal more work is needed to develop interventions for providers to sensitize them to the dangers of unacknowledged bias and provide guid- ance for overcoming that bias. Social workers clearly have a role in developing and testing these interventions and in serving as models of good practice through their positions on

JWBT514_ch10.indd 255JWBT514_ch10.indd 255 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

256 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

transdisciplinary health-care teams. The suc- cess of these efforts could profoundly diminish the contribution of the shortfalls in health care noted by McGinnis and colleagues (2002) to health disparities in the United States and other parts of the world.

SUGGESTED LEARNING EXERCISES

Learning Exercise 10.1

Determine what groups of recent immigrants or refugees are in your area or in the metro- politan area closest to your college, univer- sity, or place of work. Choose the group that is greatest in number. Investigate the group’s culture by consulting library and Internet ser- vices. Interview a health provider who serves the group. This might be someone from the local health department, a community clinic, or a federally qualifi ed health center. Ask if it would be possible to interview a member of the group. Obtain answers to the next ques- tions and include them in a fi ve-page paper:

1. What are the major health problems faced by the group (both in its country of origin and in the United States)?

2. What are the barriers to treating these health problems?

3. How has communication between providers and members of the group progressed?

4. What are the major barriers to communica- tion between providers and members of the group?

5. What medical interpretation services are available?

6. How easy or diffi cult are these services to access?

Conclude your paper by outlining your reac- tions to the situation and what recommenda- tions you would suggest to improve it. For extra credit, suggest for how group members might be included in decision making using

a CEnR approach. You can supplement prac- titioner interviews with written materials, academically published or otherwise, but be careful to distinguish and attribute sources of information throughout your paper.

Learning Exercise 10.2

Using the procedure for understanding medi- cal terminology that is outlined in the appen- dix that follows, determine the meanings of the next 20 terms:

1. Retroperitoneal

2. Neoplasia

3. Hypertrophy

4. Paranasal sinuses

5. Microcephaly

6. Cardiac arrhythmia

7. Myalgia

8. Bronchitis

9. Visceroptosis

10. Splenomegaly

11. Prostatic hypoplasia

12. Arteriosclerosis

13. Hemolysis

14. Prenatal

15. Mammography

16. Metastasis

17. Epigastric

18. Nephritis

19. Cardiomyopathy

20. Bradycardia

APPENDIX 10.1 MEDICAL TERMINOLOGY

This appendix describes how medical terms can be understood by breaking them into their component parts and following a few decision rules. Breaking down medical words into their components and learning the meaning of those components allows a person to understand the meaning of a wide range of terms. This is

JWBT514_ch10.indd 256JWBT514_ch10.indd 256 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Communication in Health Care 257

especially important in preparing social work- ers to work in transdisciplinary environments in which they must communicate with team members from a variety of disciplines.

In analyzing medical terms, begin with the end of the word (the suffi x). For example, the word neurology ends in -LOGY, which means “the study of.” Next, go to the beginning of the word. NEUR- is the word root, or the com- ponent of the word that provides its essential meaning. The root NEUR- means “nerve.” The third part of the word, the letter O, has no meaning of its own but connects the suffi x and the root. It is called a combining vowel. Putting it all together, we get “the study of nerves.”

Another word is gastroenteritis. The suf- fi x -ITIS means “infl ammation.” The root is GASTR-, which means “stomach.” The word has a second root, ENTR-, which means “in- testines.” The connector is O. The word is read from the suffi x, back to the beginning, and then across, from left to right. Gastroenteritis thus means “infl ammation of the stomach and intestines.”

It helps to look for the connector in dividing the word into its component parts. The com- bining vowel and root together are referred to as the combining form. Some words have two combining forms. In this case, the rule is to drop the combining vowel before a suf- fi x that starts with a vowel. In gastroenteritis, for example, the root ENTER- does not have a combining vowel before it joins with -ITIS, because -ITIS begins with a vowel. The com- bining vowel between root components is kept (as in GASTR-O-ENTER), even if the root be- gins with a vowel. Another example of a word with two combining forms is electroencepha- logram. The suffi x -GRAM means “record of.” The combining form ELECTRO- means “electricity.” The combining form ENCEPH- ALO- means “brain.” So the word electroen- cephalogram means “record of the electricity in the brain.”

In addition to suffi xes, roots, combining vowels, and combining forms, some words have components attached to their beginnings, which

are called prefi xes. Prefi xes can change the meanings of words to which they are attached. An example is the word pericardial. The suf- fi x -AL means “pertaining to.” CARDI- is a root that means “heart.” PERI- is a prefi x that means “surrounding.” So pericardial means “pertaining to the area that surrounds the heart.” RETRO- is a prefi x means “behind.” Thus, retrocardial means “pertaining to the area be- hind the heart.” Because the prefi x EPI- means “above,” the word epicardial means “pertaining to the area above the heart.”

Tables 10.4 to 10.6 provide a number of common medical suffi xes, prefi xes, and roots. The information provided is general because of space considerations and should be seen as a resource for learning rather than a complete list of medical terms. A number of excellent manuals are available that can supplement the information in this text and provide medical terms germane to specialty areas. A number of these manuals are listed in the “Suggested Resources” at the end of this appendix.

The information in these three tables should allow social workers in health care to decon- struct and understand medical terms that they encounter. Remember these fi ve steps in iden- tifying medical terms:

1. Identify the suffi x and determine its mean- ing.

2. Identify any prefi x that may occur and de- termine its meaning.

3. Identify the fi rst root and combining vowel, which make up the combining form, that occur after a prefi x or in the absence of a prefi x. Determine its meaning.

4. Identify additional combining forms that may occur after the fi rst combining form that was identifi ed. Determine their mean- ings. Recall that the last root before a suf- fi x that begins with a vowel will not have a combining vowel.

5. Read the word from its suffi x to its prefi x to its combining forms or roots.

JWBT514_ch10.indd 257JWBT514_ch10.indd 257 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

258 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

Table 10.4 Common Medical Prefi xes, Their Meanings, and Examples of Their Use

Prefi x Defi nition Example

a-, an- not, without apnea

ante- before, forward antepartum

anti- against antibiotic, antiseptic

auto- self, own autoimmune

bi- two bilateral, bifurcation

brady- slow bradycardia

cata- down catabolism

con- with, together congenital

contra- against, opposite contralateral

de- down, lack of dehydration

dia- through, apart, complete dialysis, diarrhea

dys- bad, painful, diffi cult dyspnea

ec-, ecto- out, outside ectopic

en-, endo- in, within endoscope

epi- upon, on, above epithelium

eu- good, well euphoria

ex- out, away from exopthalmia

hemi- half hemiplegia

hyper- excessive, above hyperplasia

hypo- below hypothermia

in- not, in insomnia, incision

infra- beneath infracostal

macro- large macrocephalia

mal- bad malignant

meta- change, beyond metastasis

micro- small microscope

neo- new neoplasm

pan- all pancytopenia

para- alongside of, near, beside, beyond parathyroid, paralysis

peri- surrounding pericardial

poly- many, much polyneuritis

post- after, behind postmortem, postnatal

pre- before, in front of prenatal, precancerous

pro- before, beyond prodrome, prolapse

pseudo- false pseudocyesis

re- back, again relapse

retro- behind, backward retroperitoneal

sub- below, under subcutaneous

supra- above, upper supracutaneous

syn-, sym- together, with synthesis, symphysis

tachy- fast tachycardia

trans- across, through transfusion

uni- one unilateral

JWBT514_ch10.indd 258JWBT514_ch10.indd 258 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Communication in Health Care 259

Table 10.5 Common Medical Roots and Connecting Vowels and Their Defi nitions

Root Defi nition

abdomin/o abdomen

aden/o gland

angi/o vessel

arthr/o joint

carcin/o cancer

cardi/o heart

cerebr/o cerebrum (largest part of the brain)

chondr/o cartilage

cutane/o skin

encephal/o brain

enter/o intestines

gastr/o stomach

gynec/o women, female

hepat/o liver

hemat/o blood

lapar/o abdominal wall

mamm/o breast

mast/o breast

nephr/o liver

neur/o nerve

onc/o tumor

opthalm/o eye

orch/o testes

oste/o bone

ovari/o ovary

ped/o child

psych/o mind

pulmon/o lung

rhin/o nose

sarc/o fl esh

thel/o nipple

thorac/o thorax

thyr/o thyroid

trache/o trachea

urethr/o urethra

Table 10.6 Common Medical Suffi xes, Their Meanings, and Examples of Their Use

Suffi x Meaning Example of use

-algia pain neuralgia

-centesis surgical puncture to remove fl uid for analysis

amniocentesis

-coccus berry-shaped bacterium

streptococcus

-cyte cell lymphocyte

-dynia pain mastodynia

-ectomy removal of, excision tonsillectomy

-genesis producing, forming carcinogenesis

-genic producing, produced carcinogenic

-gram record mammogram

-itis infl ammation tonsillitis

-logy study of morphology

-lysis breakdown, separation

paralysis

-malacia softening osteomalacia

-megaly enlargement splenomegaly

-oma tumor, collection myoma

-osis condition, usually abnormal

necrosis

-pathy disease condition cardiopathy

-penia defi ciency leucopenia

-plasia development, growth achondroplasia

-plasty surgical repair angioplasty

-ptosis sagging, drooping visceroptosis

-sclerosis hardening arteriosclerosis

-stasis stopping, control metastasis

SUGGESTED RESOURCES

Chabner, D. (2008). Medical terminology: A short course. Philadelphia, PA: Elsevier.

Chabner, D. (2010). The language of medi- cine. Philadelphia, PA: Elsevier.

Stedman, J. M.. (2008). Stedman’s medical dictionary for the health professions and nursing. Philadelphia, PA: Lippincott, Williams & Wilkins.

Steiner, S. S. (2002). Quick medical termi- nology: A self-teaching guide. Hoboken, NJ: Wiley.

REFERENCES

Abrams, D. B. (2006). Applying transdisciplinary research strategies to understanding and eliminating health disparities. Health Education & Behavior, 33(4), 515–531.

Beach, M. C., Saha, S., Korthuis, P. T., Sharp, V., Cohn, J., Wilson, I. B., . . . Moore, R. (2010). Patient-provider

JWBT514_ch10.indd 259JWBT514_ch10.indd 259 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

260 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

communication differs for Black compared to White HIV-infected patients. AIDS and Behavior, January 10 [E-pub ahead of print], doi:10.1007/s10461-009- 9664-5.

Beckman, H. B., & Frankel, R. M. (1984). The effect of physician behavior on the collection of data. Annals of Internal Medicine, 101, 692–696.

Benne, K. D., & Sheets, P. (1948). Functional roles of group members. Journal of Social Issues, 4, 41–49.

Brown, J. B., Boles, M., Mullooly, J. P., & Levinson, W. (1999). Effect of clinician communication skills training on patient satisfaction. Annals of Internal Medicine, 131, 822–829.

Burgess, D. J., Fu, S. S., & von Ryn, M. (2004). Why do providers contribute to disparities and what can be done about it? Journal of General Internal Medicine, 19, 1154–1159.

Camarota, S. A, & Jensenius, K. (2009, July). A shifting tide: Recent trends in the illegal immigrant population. Retrieved from www.cis.org/IllegalImmigration -ShiftingTide

Christakis, N. A., & Fowler, J. H. (2007). The spread of obesity in a large social network over 32 years. New England Journal of Medicine, 357(4), 370–379.

Conteh, L., Stevens, W., & Wiseman, V. (2007). The role of communication between clients and health care providers: Implications for adherence to malaria treatment in rural Gambia. Tropical Medicine and International Health, 12(3), 382–391.

Cooper, L. A., Roter, D. L., Bone, L. R., Larson, S. M., Miller, E. R., III, Barr, M. S., . . . Levine, D. M. (2009). A randomized controlled trial of interventions to enhance patient-physician partnership, patient adherence and high blood pressure control among ethnic minorities and poor persons: Study protocol NCT00123045 [Electronic version]. Implementation Science, 4, doi: 10.1186/1748-5908-4-7

Coulehan, J. L., Platt, F. W., Egener, B., Frankel, R., Lin, C.-T., Lown, B., & Salazar, W. H. (2001). “Let me see if I have this right . . .” Words that help build empathy. Annals of Internal Medicine, 135, 221–227.

Coward, R. T., & Kout, J. A. (Eds.). (1998). Aging in rural settings: Life circumstances and distinctive features. New York, NY: Springer.

Davison, B. J., & Degner, L. F. (1997). Empowerment of men newly diagnosed with prostate cancer. Cancer Nursing, 20, 187–196.

DuPre, A. (2001). Accomplishing the impossible: Talking about body and soul and mind in a medical visit. Health Communication, 14, 1–21.

Egbert, L. D., Battit, G. E., Welch, C. E., & Bartlett, M. K. (1964). Reduction of postoperative pain by encouragement and instruction of patients. New England Journal of Medicine, 270, 825–827.

Erasmus, C. J. (1952). Changing folk beliefs and the relativity of empirical knowledge. Southwestern Journal of Anthropology, 8, 411–428.

Fadiman, A. (1997). The spirit catches you and you fall down: A Hmong child, her American doctors, and the collision of two cultures. New York, NY: Noonday.

Fisher, N. L. (1992). Ethnocultural approaches to genetics. Pediatric Clinics of North America, 39, 55–64.

Flores, G., Laws, M. B., Mayo, S. J., Zuckerman, B., Abreu, M., Medina, L., & Hardt, E. J. (2003). Errors in medical interpretation and their potential clinical consequences in pediatric encounters. Pediatrics, 111, 6–14.

Foster, G. M. (1976). Disease etiologies in non-western medical systems. American Anthropologist, 78, 773– 782.

Foulks, E. F. (1972). The Arctic hysterias of the North Alaska Eskimo. Washington, DC: American Anthropological Association.

Freeth, D. (2001). Sustaining interprofessional collaboration. Journal of Interprofessional Care, 15(1), 37–46.

Gehlert, S., Murray, A., Sohmer, D., McClintock, M., Conzen, S., & Olopade, O. (2010). The importance of transdisciplinary collaborations for understanding and resolving health disparities. Social Work in Public Health, 25(3), 408–422.

Goleman, D. (1991, November 13). All too often, the doctor isn’t listening, studies show. New York Times. Retrieved from www.nytimes.com/1991/11/13/health /all-too-often-the-doctor-isn-t-listening-studies-show .html?scp=72&sq=&st=nyt

Greenfi eld, S., Kaplan, S., & Ware, J. E. (1985). Expanding patient involvement in care: Effects on patient outcomes. Annals of Internal Medicine, 102, 520–528.

Hall, P. (2005). Interprofessional teamwork: Professional cultures as barriers. Journal of Interprofessional Care, 19(Suppl. 1), 188–196.

Helman, C. G. (1985). Communication in primary care: The role of patient and practitioner explanatory models. Social Science and Medicine, 20, 923–931.

Hepworth, D. H., Rooney, R. H., & Larsen, J. (2002). Direct social work practice: Theory and skills. Pacifi c Grove, CA: Brooks/Cole.

Hiatt, R. A., & Breen, N. (2008). The social determinants of cancer: A challenge for transdisciplinary science. American Journal of Preventive Medicine, 35(Suppl. 2), S141–S150.

Institute of Medicine. (2002). Unequal treatment: What healthcare providers need to know about racial and ethnic disparities in health care. Washington, DC: National Academy Press.

Israel, B. A., Schulz, A. J., Parker, E. A., Becker, A. B., Allen, A. J., III, & Guzman, J. R. (2003). Critical issues in developing and following community based participatory research principles. In M. Winkler & N. Wallerstein (Eds.), Community-based participatory research for health (pp. 53–76). San Francisco, CA: Jossey-Bass.

JWBT514_ch10.indd 260JWBT514_ch10.indd 260 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Communication in Health Care 261

Janus, I. L. (1972). Victims of groupthink. Boston, MA: Houghton Miffl in.

Jensen, J. D., King, A. J., Guntzviller, L. M., & Davis, L. A. (2010). Patient–provider communication and low-income adults: Age, race, literacy, and optimism predict communication satisfaction. Patient Education and Counseling, 79, 30–35.

Johnson, R. L., Roter, D., Powe, N. R., & Cooper, L. A. (2004). Patient race/ethnicity and quality of patient- physician communication during medical visits. American Journal of Public Health, 94, 2084–2090.

Kahn, R. L., & Prager, D. J. (1994, July 11). Interdisciplinary collaborations are a scientifi c and social imperative. Scientist, p. 12.

Kaplan, S. H., Greenfi eld, S., & Ware, J. E. (1989). Assessing the effects of physician–patient interactions on the outcomes of chronic disease. Medical Care, 27, S110–S127.

Kinmonth, A. L., Woodcock, A., Griffi n, S., Spiegal, N., & Campbell, M. J. (1998). Randomised controlled trial of patient centered care of diabetes in general practice: Impact on current wellbeing and future disease risk. British Medical Journal, 31, 1202–1208.

Kleinman, A. (1980). Patients and healers in the context of culture: An exploration of the borderland between anthropology, medicine, and psychiatry. Berkeley, CA: University of California Press.

Kleinman, A., Eisenberg, L., & Good, B. (1978). Clinical lessons from anthropologic and cross-cultural research. Annals of Internal Medicine, 88, 251–258.

Kleinman, A., Eisenberg, L., & Good, B. (2006). Culture, illness, and care: Clinical lessons from anthropologic and cross-cultural research. Focus, 4(1), 140–149.

Leventhal, H. (1985). The role of theory in the study of adherence to treatment and doctor-patient interactions. Medical Care, 23, 556–563.

Lewis, G., Croft-Jeffreys, C., & David, A. (1990). Are British psychiatrists racist? British Journal of Psychiatry, 157, 410–415.

Lister, L. (1980). Role expectations of social workers and other health professionals. Health & Social Work, 5, 41–49.

Lollock, L. (2001). The foreign born population of the United States: March 2000. Current population reports (pp. 20–534). Washington, DC: U.S. Census Bureau.

Low, S. M. (1984). The cultural basis of health, illness and disease. Social Work in Health Care, 9, 13–23.

Luckman, J. (2000). Transcultural communication in health care. Scarborough, Ontario, Canada: Delmar Thomson Learning.

Maguire, P., & Pitceathly, C. (2002). Key communication skills and how to acquire them. British Medical Journal, 325, 697–700.

Maiman, L. A., Becker, M. H., Liptak, G. S., Nazarian, L. F., & Rounds, K. A. (1988). Improving pediatricians’ compliance-enhancing practices: A randomized trial.

American Journal of Disease of Children, 142, 773– 779.

Maly, R. C., Bourque, L. B., & Engelhardt, R. F. (1999). A randomized controlled trial of facilitating information giving to patients with chronic medical conditions: Effects on outcomes of care. Journal of Family Practice, 48, 273–276.

Marcus, E. N. (2003, April 8). When a patient is lost in the translation. New York Times, p. D7. Retrieved from www.nytimes.com/2003/04/08/health/cases-when-a -patient-is-lost-in-the-translation.html

Matsunaga, D. S., Enos, R., Gotay, C. C., Banner, R. O., DeCambra, H., Hammond, O. W., . . . Tsark, J. (1996). Participatory research in a native Hawaiian community: The Wai’anae cancer research project. Cancer, 78, 1582–1586.

McCann, S., & Weinman, J. (1996). Empowering the patient in the consultation: A pilot study. Patient Educational Counseling, 27, 227–234.

McGinnis, J. M., Williams-Russo, P., & Knickman, J. R. (2002). The case for more active policy attention to health promotion. Health Affairs, 21, 78–93.

Mizrahi, T., & Abramson, J. (1985). Sources of strain between physicians and social workers: Implications for social workers in health care settings. Social Work in Health Care, 10, 33–51.

National Academy of Sciences, National Academy of Engineering, and Institute of Medicine. (2005). Facilitating interdisciplinary research. Washington, DC: National Academies Press.

Northouse, P. G., & Northouse, L. L. (1997). Health communication: A handbook for health professionals. Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice-Hall.

Orth, J. E., Stiles, W. B., Scherwitz, L., Hennrikus, D., & Vallbona, C. (1987). Patient exposition and provider explanation on routine interviews and hypertensive patients’ blood pressure control. Health Psychology, 6, 29–42.

Pachter, L. M. (1994). Culture and clinical care: Folk illness beliefs and behaviors and their implications for health care delivery. JAMA, 271, 690–694.

Patterson, R. E., Kristal, A. R., & White, E. (1996). Do beliefs, knowledge, and perceived norms about diet and cancer predict dietary change? American Journal of Public Health, 86, 1394–1400.

Pescosolido, B. A., & Levy, J. A. (2002). The role of social networks in health, illness, disease and healing: The accepting present, the forgotten past, and the dangerous potential for a complacent future. Social Networks and Health, 8, 3–25.

Rao, J. K., Anderson, L. A., Inui, T. S., & Frankel, R. M. (2007). Communication interventions make a difference in conversations between physicians and patients: A systematic review of the evidence. Medical Care, 45(4), 340–349.

Roberts, C. S. (1989). Confl icting professional values in social work and medicine. Health & Social Work, 14, 211–218.

JWBT514_ch10.indd 261JWBT514_ch10.indd 261 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

262 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

Rosenquist, J. N., Murabito, J., Fowler, J. H., & Christakis, N. A. (2010). The spread of alcohol consumption behavior in a large social network. Annual Review of Internal Medicine, 152, 426–433.

Rosenthal, E. (1993, November 28). How doctors learn to think they’re doctors. New York Times, pp. B1, B4. Retrieved from www.nytimes.com/1993/11/28 /weekinreview/how-doctors-learn-to-think-they-re -doctors.html?scp=1&sq=How%20doctors%20 learn%20to%20think%20they%E2%80%99re%20 doctors&st=cse

Roter, D. L. (1977). Patient participation in patient–provider interaction: The effects of patient question-asking on the quality of interaction, satisfaction, and compliance. Health Education Monographs, 5, 281–315.

Roter, D. L., Hall, J. A., & Aoki, Y. (2002). Physician gender effects in medical communication. JAMA, 288, 756–764.

Rubel, A. J. (1977). The epidemiology of a folk illness: Susto in Hispanic America. In D. Landy (Ed.), Culture, disease, and healing: Studies in medical anthropology (pp. 119–128). New York, NY: Macmillan.

Sands, R. G., Stafford, J., & McClelland, M. (1990). “I beg to differ”: Confl ict in the interdisciplinary team. Social Work in Health Care, 14, 55–72.

Satin, D. G. (1987). The diffi culties of interdisciplinary education: Lessons from three failures and a success. Educational Gerontology, 13, 53–69.

Schneider, J., Kaplan, S. H., Greenfi eld, S., Li, W., & Wilson, I. B. (2004). Better physician-patient relationships are associated with higher reported adherence to antiretroviral therapy in patients with HIV infection. Journal of General Internal Medicine, 19, 1096–1103.

Schulman, K. A., Berlin, J. A., Harless, W., Kerner, J. F., Sistrunk, S., Gersh, B. J., . . . Escarce, J. J. (1999). The effect of race and sex on physicians’ recommendations for cardiac catheterization. New England Journal of Medicine, 25, 618–626.

Sideris, D. A., Tsouna-Hadjis, P., Toumanidis, S. T., Vardas, P. E., & Moulopoulos, S. D. (1986). Attitudinal educational objectives at therapeutic consultation: Measures of performance, educational approach and evaluation. Medical Education, 20, 307–313.

Skipper, J. J., & Leonard, R. C. (1968). Children, stress, and hospitalization: A fi eld experiment. Journal of Health and Social Behavior, 9, 275–287.

Slomski, A. J. (1993, May 24). Making sure that your care doesn’t get lost in translation. Medical Economics, pp. 122–139.

Snow, L. (1993). Walkin’ over medicine. Boulder, CO: Westview Press.

Sommers, L. S., Marton, K. I., Barbaccia, J. C., & Randolph, J. (2000). Physician, nurse, and social worker collaborations in primary care for chronically ill seniors. Archives of Internal Medicine, 160, 1825–1833.

Spector, R. (2004). Cultural diversity in health and illness. Upper Saddle River, NJ: Pearson Education.

Stewart, M., Brown, J. B., Donner, A., McWhinney, I. R., Oates, J., Weston, W. W., & Jordan, J. (2000). The impact of patient-centered care on outcomes. Journal of Family Practice, 49, 796–804.

Street, R. L., Makoul, G., Arora, N. K., & Epstein, R. M. (2009). How does communication heal? Pathways linking clinician-patient communication to health outcomes. Patient Education and Counseling, 74(3), 295–301.

Thompson, S. C., Nanni, C., & Schwankovsky, L. (1990). Patient-oriented interventions to improve communication in a medical offi ce visit. Health Psychology, 9, 390–404.

Turner, F. J. (1990). Social work practice theory: A trans- cultural resource for health care. Social Science and Medicine, 31, 13–17.

Ulrey, K. L., & Amason, P. (2001). Intercultural communication between patients and health care providers: An exploration of intercultural communication effectiveness, cultural sensitivity, and anxiety. Health Communication, 13, 449–463.

van Ryn, M., & Burke, J. (2000). The effect of patient race ad socio-economic status on physician perceptions of patients. Social Science and Medicine, 50, 813–828.

van Ryn, M., & Fu, S. S. (2003). Paved with good intentions: Do public health and human service providers contribute to racial/ethnic disparities in health? American Journal of Public Health, 93(2), 248–255.

Vanclay, L. (1996). Sustaining collaboration between general practitioners and social workers. London, UK: CAIPE.

West, D. S., Greene, P. G., Kratt, P. P., Pulley, L., Weiss, H. L., Siegfried, N., & Gore, S. A. (2003). The impact of a family history of breast cancer on screening practices and attitudes in low-income, rural, African American women. Journal of Women’s Health, 12, 779–787.

Weston, W. W., & Brown, J. B. (1989). The importance of patients’ beliefs. In M. Stewart & D. Roter (Eds.), Communicating with medical patients (pp. 77–85). Newbury Park, CA: Sage.

World Health Organization. (2003). International classifi cation of diseases and related health problems, Revision 10 (ICD-10). Geneva, Switzerland: Author. Retrieved from www.who.int/classifi cations/icd/en

Yalom, I. D. (1998). The Yalom reader. New York, NY: Basic Books.

Young, A., & Flower, L. (2001). Patients as partners, patients as problem-solvers. Health Communication, 14, 69–97.

Zandbelt, L. C., Smets, E. M., Oort, F. J., Godfried, M. H., & de Haes, H. C. (2004). Satisfaction with the outpatient encounter: A comparison of patients’ and physicians’ views. Journal of General Internal Medicine, 19, 1088–1095.

Zerhouni, E. (2003). Medicine: The NIH roadmap. Science, 3, 63–72.

JWBT514_ch10.indd 262JWBT514_ch10.indd 262 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

263

11

Religion, Spirituality, Health, and Social Work

TERRY A. WOLFER

This chapter provides information to assist social workers in developing religious and spiritual competence. It begins by briefl y summarizing data regarding the importance of religion for Americans. Then it defi nes religion and spirituality and summarizes a variety of terms associated with a multidi- mensional conceptualization of these over- lapping terms. Next it summarizes some empirical research on the relationships among religion, spirituality, and aspects of physical and mental health. Finally, it intro- duces a variety of assessment strategies for use in clinical practice ranging from brief tools to in-depth interviews.

Chapter Objectives • Describe levels of religiosity in the Ameri-

can population and why this matters to health social workers and other health pro- fessionals.

• Defi ne the concepts of religion and spiri- tuality, their multiple dimensions, and how they interrelate.

• Discuss the major pathways that link reli- gion and spirituality to physical and mental health and the empirical evidence to sup- port these pathways.

• Outline a rationale for assessing client spirituality and major methods of spiritual assessment (including brief screening in- struments, pictorial tools, and in-depth in- terview formats).

• Discuss the importance for health social workers of understanding a client’s religion and spirituality.

Several recent and ongoing controversies demonstrate the complex relationship be- tween religion and health in American soci- ety. For example, Oregon was the fi rst state in the United States to legalize euthanasia— allowing people to choose and hasten their own deaths—usually in the context of a termi- nal illness. Euthanasia remains illegal in most other states partly because of religiously based concern for the value of human life.

A recent court case in Oregon involved simi- lar issues but in a different context. The case involved members of the Followers of Christ Church (Mayes, 2010). A couple was charged with criminal negligence in the death of their 16-year-old son for failing to obtain medical care for his urinary tract infection. In this case, the parents rejected medical care in favor of prayer, anointing with oil, and the ceremonial laying on of hands. The Followers of Christ Church is one of several groups, including the better- known Church of Christ, Scientist, that refuse medical care on religious grounds. For most Americans, including most religious people, the group’s refusal of medical care seems extreme and unwarranted. But it also represents the sig- nifi cant diversity of religious belief and practice in America related to health care and social ser- vices. (A child welfare worker had visited the family only months before the teen died.) Health social workers in situations like this need to bal- ance respect for the religious rights of patients and their families with protecting the individual lives, especially those of minors.

Obviously, euthanasia, or physician-assisted suicide, differs from refusing medical treatment

JWBT514_ch11.indd 263JWBT514_ch11.indd 263 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

264 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

on religious grounds. Nevertheless, the two situ- ations have some important things in common: profound religious or ethical disagreements about issues regarding the value of preserving human life, quality of life, patient self-determination, religious freedom, and paternalism.

Another example of religiously based con- troversy in health care involves organ dona- tion. Because almost all organ donations come from patients who are brain dead rather than cadavers, organ procurement teams often must obtain consent from family members for organ removal. Intense debate has arisen regarding religious and ethical issues surrounding brain death and organ donation. Two facts make this debate more intense: (1) The number of dona- tions remains steady; and (2) the number of people awaiting organ transplants each year continues to grow. As a result, the pressure to donate organs is on the rise.

Bresnahan and Mahler (2010) identify the perspectives of the fi ve major religious tradi- tions regarding organ donation in the context of brain death and then compare the perspec- tives to information readily available online. These authors found that health-care work- ers and most Internet sources typically report that major religious traditions support organ donation. However, some Internet Web sites may contradict this information. This mat- ters because consumers increasingly turn to the Internet for information. A health social worker might be fl ummoxed by the refusal of family members to consider donation for reli- gious reasons if the social worker knows that major religious groups generally approve of organ donation but does not know of this con- tradictory information online. As a result, the social worker might be less able to assist the family in respectfully exploring their concerns and reaching a satisfactory decision. Health practitioners who wish to establish and main- tain trust with deeply religious families must treat their religious arguments and points of view with respect (Röcklinsberg, 2009).

Currently there is heated debate about an- other ethical issue involving religious per- spectives: whether health-care practitioners may refuse to provide medical treatments that

they personally oppose on ethical or religious grounds. This issue was heightened during the recent debates about national health-care re- form. Many Americans agree that health-care professionals should have a right to refuse to provide services to which they have moral or religious objections. At the same time, many Americans also believe that patients have a right to information about all legal options for medical treatment. Occasionally these ex- pectations are in confl ict. Curlin, Lawrence, Chin, and Lantos (2007) surveyed a national sample of physicians regarding controversial procedures, such as “administering terminal sedation in dying patients, providing abor- tion for failed contraception, and prescribing birth control to adolescents without parental approval” (p. 593). They found that most phy- sicians believe it acceptable to express reserva- tions regarding treatments they fi nd personally objectionable but also that most feel obligated to provide information to their patients about all legal options and willingly refer their pa- tients to other practitioners for treatments they oppose. Nevertheless, Curlin and colleagues (2007) report that a substantial number of phy- sicians “do not believe they are obligated to disclose information about or provide referrals for legal yet controversial treatments” (p. 597).

Health social workers may encounter this ethical issue in two ways. Like physicians, some social workers may struggle with decid- ing whether to help patients obtain interventions they fi nd morally objectionable, or whether to inform patients of such interventions. Or they may work with physicians or other health-care professionals who oppose certain interventions that they do not. This puts them in a position to discuss these controversial interventions with their mutual patients. Health social work- ers must be aware of these controversies, draw their own conclusions, and be prepared to work with professional colleagues whose beliefs may differ from their own.

It should not be surprising that health and health care are fraught with religious, spiri- tual, and moral issues. In one form or another, physical and mental health often involve pain and suffering and questions regarding

JWBT514_ch11.indd 264JWBT514_ch11.indd 264 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Religion, Spirituality, Health, and Social Work 265

meaning and the beginning and ending of life. Health and health care involve profound as- pects of human existence, aspects historically addressed by religion and religious institu- tions, and increasingly addressed by scientifi c research. At the same time, medical innova- tions have pressed boundaries and opened doors previously unimagined, often raising profound religious and spiritual concerns. For all these reasons, social workers who work in health care need to be aware of and sensitive to religion and spirituality in the lives of their clients, the families of these clients, their col- leagues, and themselves.

This chapter provides information to as- sist social workers in developing religious and spiritual competence. Before going further, it may be helpful to refl ect on what is known and not known about religion and spirituality. What individuals know and believe, to a large extent, is infl uenced, if not determined, by per- sonal experience. Individuals, including health social workers and patients, have positive or negative experiences within their families, with friends, and with colleagues. They also have learned things from formal education and cultural media of many types. They use their own experiences and education to understand others. Although that is true with any topic, it seems uniquely diffi cult with religion and spirituality, because it often happens with less awareness and self-refl ectiveness. Because people have such different experiences, it is important to avoid assumptions and work hard at understanding others. A Brazilian physician and researcher put it this way:

Studying spirituality scientifi cally is a very exciting although somewhat precarious enterprise. This is a fi eld fi lled with preju- dices, biases for and against spirituality. Many people have opinions to give, but usually these judgments are not based on an in-depth analysis of the evidence avail- able. It is easy to slip into an intolerant and Pyrrhonean skepticism or to give a naive ac- ceptance of doubtful claims. Regardless of whether we hold spiritual or materialistic beliefs, religious or anti-religious postures or not, we have a responsibility to explore the

relationship between spirituality and health in order to improve our knowledge and our care for human beings. (Moreira-Almeida, 2007, pp. 3–4)

RELIGIOSITY AND SPIRITUALITY IN THE AMERICAN POPULATION

There are a variety of ways to gauge the im- portance of religion for Americans. Perhaps the simplest and most direct is simply to ask. For ex- ample, according to the Pew Forum on Religion and Public Life (2009), more than half (56%) of Americans state that religion is “very important” in their lives. The percentage of people stating that religion is “very important” ranges from a low of 36% in New Hampshire and Vermont to a high of 82% in Mississippi. As another exam- ple, according to Pew, nearly two fi fths (39%) of Americans report that they “attend worship services at least once a week,” while many oth- ers attend worship services less frequently. By comparison, according to the 2008 General Social Survey (www.norc.uchicago.edu/GSS), more than one quarter (27.5%) of the population attends worship services at least weekly while nearly half (48.3%) attend at least monthly. Again, weekly attendance varies by state, from a low of 22% in Alaska to a high of 60% in Mis- sissippi (Pew Forum, 2009). Nearly half (48%) of Americans report that they “pray at least once a day,” with a low of 40% in Maine and a high of 77% in Mississippi (Pew Forum, 2009). By comparison, according to the 2008 General So- cial Survey, a majority (57.6%) of Americans pray at least daily, and others (17.7%) pray at least once a week (Association of Religion Data Archives [ARDA], n.d.). More than 90% of Americans state that they “believe in God or a universal spirit,” and more than two thirds (71%) state that they are “absolutely certain” in this belief (Pew Forum, 2009).

There is considerable disparity in these variables across the United States. In general, these surveys suggest that southern states have higher rates on each of these measures, while northeastern and western states have lower

JWBT514_ch11.indd 265JWBT514_ch11.indd 265 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

266 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

rates. But the rates suggest that social work- ers in any geographical area are likely to en- counter some patients who consider religion important, who attend worship services on a weekly basis, and who pray daily. Culturally competent health social work practice requires that social workers be prepared to understand and take account of these realities.

The region in which a social worker prac- tices will infl uence the likelihood of encoun- tering people from certain religious traditions. “The Midwest most closely resembles the re- ligious makeup of the overall population. The South, by a wide margin, has the heaviest con- centration of members of evangelical Protes- tant churches. The Northeast has the greatest concentration of Catholics, and the West has the largest proportion of unaffi liated people, in- cluding the largest proportion of atheists and ag- nostics” (Pew Forum, 2009, p. 8). Nevertheless, given the nation’s signifi cant religious diversity, social workers may encounter people with little or no religious faith in any region of the United States. That is clearly true in metropolitan areas but often is also true in rural areas. For example, one may encounter atheists or agnostics in rural areas and small towns in Nebraska or conserva- tive evangelicals in Southern California.

This religious diversity is evident in another way. Although more than 3 out of 4 Americans (78.4%) identify themselves as “Christian,” this diverse grouping includes Protestants (in- cluding evangelical, mainline, and historically African American denominations), Catholics, Mormons, Jehovah’s Witnesses, Orthodox, and others (Pew Forum, 2009). About 1 in 6 (16.1%) Americans report no religious affi li- ation, including atheists and agnostics (1.6% and 2.4%, respectively). Slightly fewer than 1 out of 20 Americans (4.7%) identify with all other religions, including Jewish, Muslim, Buddhist, Hindu, and others. More than 4 out of 5 (80.8%) Americans identify with one of the three Abrahamic traditions (i.e., Christian, Jewish, Muslim). Looked at another way, 97.2% of Americans who identify themselves as religious identify with one of the Abraha- mic traditions, including 93.4% who identify as Christian (Pew Forum, 2009).

Research on religion and spirituality over the life span is confounded by age, cohort, and period effects (Smith, 2009, p. 10). In other words, some changes in religiosity apparently result from the aging process itself (i.e., life cycle experience and concern with mortality) while others result from conditions and ex- periences shared by people born at about the same time or by events that occur at the time of survey or interview (Smith, 2009). For ex- ample, research on Millennials—people born after 1980—shows they are generally less religious in terms of belief, attendance, and practice than previous generations of adults (Pond, Smith, & Clement, 2010). However, it also fi nds them similar to previous genera- tions, when they were a similar age. Pond et al. (2010) conclude: “This suggests that some of the religious differences between younger and older Americans today are not entirely generational, but result in part from people’s tendency to place greater emphasis on religion as they age” (p. 2). If previous trends con- tinue, we may expect young people to become somewhat more religious as they age.

In summary, while sizable groups within the American population do not self-identify as religious, attend worship services, or pray, large groups of Americans do. Furthermore, this is true in every region of the country. It is also true for people across the life span and ap- pears to increase with age. Finally, people ex- periencing severe stress, disability, illness, or dying (and their family members) often have heightened interest in spirituality, and these are the very people encountered by health so- cial workers.

These data suggest that health social work- ers must be prepared to work with people of faith. In the United States, that usually will mean people who identify themselves as Christian, although that designation itself in- cludes great diversity. But social workers also must be prepared to work with people of other faiths or no religious faith.

The United States often is referred to as a religiously diverse nation (Eck, 2001). Indeed, the United States has been religiously diverse since colonial times. In the early 1600s, for

JWBT514_ch11.indd 266JWBT514_ch11.indd 266 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Religion, Spirituality, Health, and Social Work 267

example, there were “Huguenots in Charles- ton, Anglicans in Tidewater Virginia, Catholics in St. Mary’s City, Swedish Lutherans along the Delaware River, Quakers and Presbyteri- ans further up the river, Dutch Reformed in Manhattan, Puritans in New England, Baptists, and Heaven-knows-what-else in Rhode Island” (Gaustad, 1968, p. 835). Notably, this diver- sity occurred primarily within the Christian tradition. But from the beginning, American religious diversity also included and was in- fl uenced by Native American and African reli- gious traditions. “Since then,” as Smith (2002) writes, “America has continued to both import foreign and spawn indigenous religions” (p. 1).

Historically, changes in U.S. immigration laws signifi cantly increased the fl ow of immi- grants, many of who come from non-Christian traditions. In particular, the Immigration and Nationality Act of 1965 substantially increased the fl ow of followers of other religious tradi- tions. According to the 2000 census, 11.1% of the U.S. population was foreign born. After Mexico, the leading countries are China, the Philippines, India, and Vietnam. “While Americans still overwhelmingly adhere to their traditional faiths, the United States is home to all of the world’s religions and non- Judeo-Christian religions make up a small, but growing, share of America’s religious mosaic” (Smith, 2002, p. 4).

WHY CONSIDER RELIGION AND SPIRITUALITY IN HEALTH CARE?

Demographics alone suggest that social work- ers must consider religion and spirituality when conducting psychosocial assessments with pa- tients. Because so many Americans report that religion and spirituality are important parts of their lives and regularly participate in individ- ual and corporate religious activities, it seems important that social workers routinely inquire about those activities. In health-care settings, however, it is even more important. For many people, religion and spirituality have numer- ous profound connections with their health

and well-being as well as their illnesses, suf- fering, disability, recovery, coping, and dying. According to the 2004 General Social Survey, more than half of Americans (51.2%) agree that at least daily, “I fi nd comfort in my religion or spirituality” (ARDA, n.d.). Another quarter (26.9%) agree with this statement “some days” or “most days.” Likewise, the same survey found that nearly half (48%) agree that at least daily, “I fi nd strength in my religion or spiritu- ality,” and another quarter (28.5%) agree with this statement “some days” or “most days” (ARDA, n.d.). Indeed, religion and spirituality often represent important resources for pre- venting or coping with illness and dying. “By keeping patients’ beliefs, spiritual/religious needs and supports separate from their care, we are potentially ignoring an important ele- ment that may be at the core of patients’ cop- ing and support systems and may be integral to their well-being and recovery” (D’Souza, 2007, p. S57). More than that, “religion provides things that are good for health and well-being, including social support, existential meaning, a sense of purpose, a coherent belief system and a clear moral code” (Eckersley, 2007, p. S54). Of course, these benefi ts also can come from other sources, but they often are associ- ated with religion. “The process of ‘human- izing’ health care involves the consideration of individuals’ unique psychosocial reso urces, including their spirituality, during illness and recovery. Spirituality encompasses feelings of connection to others and fi nding meaning in life” (Dalmida, Holstad, Dilorio, & Laderman, 2009, p. 120).

DEFINING RELIGION AND SPIRITUALITY

It may be helpful to consider formal defi nitions for the terms religion and spirituality and how they are related. In fact, there are many con- fl icting defi nitions for these terms. More than a decade ago, Scott (1997) scanned 20th-century social science for defi nitions of religion and spirituality. She found 31 defi nitions of reli- giousness and 40 defi nitions of spirituality.

JWBT514_ch11.indd 267JWBT514_ch11.indd 267 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

268 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

Interestingly, she found that these defi nitions were quite evenly distributed across nine con- tent categories, suggesting both considerable diversity within defi nitions for either religious- ness or spirituality and considerable overlap between the two. Scott’s fi ndings should alert health social workers to the diffi culty and complexity of defi ning the terms.

Adding to this complexity, in recent de- cades, popular and scholarly understandings of religion and spirituality have changed. “The word ‘religion’ comes from the Latin root re- ligio which signifi es a bond between humanity and some greater-than-human power” (Hill et al., 1998, p. 15). Historically, it was under- stood to mean: “(1) a supernatural power to which individuals must respond; (2) a feeling present in the individual who conceives such a power; and (3) the ritual acts carried out in respect of that power” (p. 15). These meanings depict religion as a profound and pervasive part of human experience. However, growing secularism and disillusionment with religious institutions have disrupted the historically close relationship between religion and spiri- tuality. Many people now differentiate spiritu- ality and religion, associating spirituality with personal experience of the transcendent and religion with possible restrictions and barriers to such experience. As a result, they tend to view spirituality more positively and religion more negatively (p. 16) and also to emphasize spirituality as subjective (i.e., individualized) and religion as institutional.

Distinguishing between religion and spiri- tuality makes it possible for people to identify themselves as either religious or spiritual, both religious and spiritual, or neither. In fact, the General Social Survey found that while most Americans identify themselves as equally reli- gious and spiritual, a growing minority in 2008 identify themselves as more spiritual than reli- gious, compared with the number who did so in 1998 (Smith, 2009).

Despite the trend, dichotomizing religion and spirituality in this way may be problem- atic. Hill and colleagues (1998) argued that dichotomizing religion and spirituality poses several dangers. “The fi rst subtle danger can

be expressed in two forms of polarization: individual vs. institutional and good vs. bad” (p. 18). They go on to explain that speaking of individual spirituality and institutional re- ligion ignores two basic facts: “(1) virtually all religions are interested in matters spiritual, and (2) every form of religious and spiritual expression occurs in some social context.” In other words, religions consistently address matters of transcendent or ultimate concern, and all beliefs and practices, whether religious or spiritual, occur in a social and cultural envi- ronment. Furthermore, Hill et al. (1998) write, “to argue that spirituality is good and religion is bad (or vice-versa) is to deny a substantial body of research demonstrating that both reli- gion and spirituality can be manifested in both healthy and unhealthy ways” (p. 18). A simple dichotomy obscures this complexity.

Hill and colleagues (1998) identify yet an- other danger, one they argue is perhaps most serious: losing the distinctive sacred core of religion and spirituality. In religion, the sacred “has to do with a higher power, God, or ul- timate truth. This sacred content is often de- fi ned through institutional mechanisms, such as ecclesiastical authority, sacred writings, and traditions” (p. 19). In spirituality, the sacred also has to do with matters of transcendent or ultimate concern (i.e., beyond ordinary expe- rience or material existence). Yet spirituality often emphasizes a highly individualized, ex- periential path for each person. This potentially trivializes, and may even obscure, the search for the sacred by individuals. In light of these issues, the authors agree that the sacred core is central to the experience of both religion and spirituality. Furthermore, they agree that both religion and spirituality involve a search for the sacred. Thus, they defi ne spirituality and religion in ways that highlight their similarities (see Table 11.1).

These defi nitions highlight the signifi cant overlap these constructs have in the lives of people. Spirituality involves a search for the sacred. Likewise, religion involves a search for the sacred, a search for other, nonsacred goals in a context primarily concerned with the sa- cred, or both. Religion also involves the means

JWBT514_ch11.indd 268JWBT514_ch11.indd 268 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Religion, Spirituality, Health, and Social Work 269

and methods of this search, supported by a group. In short, while spirituality and religion both involve a search for the sacred, religion also incorporates the sociocultural context (and other goals in that context). Defi ned in this way, spirituality for an individual always involves a search for the sacred. But religion for an individual may involve a search for the sacred or a search for nonsacred goals (e.g., social identity, health) in the context of a group organized to search for the sacred. The group may legitimate nonsacred goals, the search for either sacred or nonsacred goals, and the meth- ods or means of the search. By these criteria, spirituality may be considered as the more fundamental category, with religion being the more concrete one. Consistent with these defi nitions, Hufford (2005) defi nes spirituality most simply as “personal relationship to the transcendent” and religion as “the community, institutional aspects of spirituality” (p. 2).

The importance of this emphasis on the sacred in both religion and spirituality be- comes more apparent when one considers it in terms of research. Without this emphasis on the sacred, spirituality cannot be readily distinguished from humanism or positive psy- chology (Koenig, 2008). If that is the case, researchers cannot distinguish between and draw clear conclusions about the relationships

among spirituality, humanism, positive psy- chology, and health. These distinctions be- come especially diffi cult in relation to mental health. As Koenig notes, spirituality research- ers sometimes confuse causes and conse- quences. “Simply defi ning spirituality as good mental health and including mental health in- dicators as part of the measures of spirituality precludes any ability to actually study the rela- tionship between spirituality and mental health” (p. 18). The result would be tautological, essen- tially correlating a concept with itself.

Koenig (2008) argues that the meaning of spirituality has changed and currently is too vague for research purposes. But this ambigu- ity actually may be useful in clinical care set- tings. In clinical practice, social workers must attend to the idiosyncratic perspectives and needs of individual clients. Thus, Koenig ad- vocates the use of primarily religious catego- ries for research purposes—because they lend themselves to more reliable operationaliza- tion—with the addition of spiritual categories for clinical care—because these encourage and enable understanding of client uniqueness.

Before reviewing research on the relation- ships among religion, spirituality and health, it is helpful to explore further how these concepts can be operationalized, whether for research or for clinical assessment. The next section clari- fi es the numerous ways people can be involved with religion and spirituality.

Dimensions of Religiosity and Spirituality

Early research on religion and health typically focused on the patient’s religious affi liation or denomination. In approximately 250 studies conducted between 1937 and 1984, the “inves- tigation of religion [was] confi ned to compari- sons of morbidity and mortality rates across religious denominations’’ (Levin & Markides, 1986, p. 589). Often these distinctions went no further than Catholics, Protestants, and Jews. Beginning in the 1960s, some health research- ers began asking respondents how often they attended religious services, generally referred to as “church attendance” in the research

Table 11.1 Defi ning Religion and Spirituality

Criterion for Spirituality The feelings, thoughts, and behaviors that arise from a search for the sacred. The term “search” refers to attempts to identify, articulate, maintain, or transform. The term “sacred” refers to a divine being, ultimate reality, or ultimate truth as perceived by the individual.

Criterion for Religion/Religiousness The feelings, thoughts, and behaviors that arise from a search for the sacred (a divine being, ultimate reality, or ultimate truth as perceived by the individual); and/or a search or quest for non-sacred goals (such as identity, belongingness, meaning, health, or wellness).

Source: From “Defi nitions of Religion and Spirituality,” by P. C. Hill, K. I. Pargament, J. P. Swyers, R. L. Gorsuch, M. E. McCullough, R. W. Hood, and R. F. Baumeister, 1998. In D. B. Larson, J. P. Swyers, and M. E. McCullough (Eds.), Scientifi c Research on Spirituality and Health: A Consensus Report (p. 21). Rockville, MD: National Institute of Healthcare Research.

JWBT514_ch11.indd 269JWBT514_ch11.indd 269 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

270 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

literature. It usually was measured by a single survey item, such as “How often do you attend Sunday worship services?” (Hall, Meador, & Koenig, 2008, p. 140). Subsequently, research- ers began to use self-reported, global assess- ments of religion. These often take the form of a question asking “To what extent do you consider yourself to be a religious person?” (p. 142) or “How important is religion for you?” (Veenhoven, 2003, p. 145). In the past decade, however, researchers have attempted to conceptualize and measure numerous addi- tional dimensions of religion and spirituality. This section briefl y reviews these dimensions as a basis for understanding current empirical research and, more generally, expanding our recognition and understanding of religion and spirituality in the lives of patients.

Table 11.2 compares domains of religious- ness identifi ed by several groups of scholars. King and Hunt (1972) led an early attempt to identify domains empirically by factor- analyzing numerous religiously oriented items. Larson, Swyers, and McCullough (1998) pres- ent a “consensus report,” based on a series of conferences sponsored by the John Temple- ton Foundation and the National Institute for Healthcare Research. Their report refl ects the thinking of more than 70 prominent research- ers in the area of religion and spirituality. One chapter of the report provides a defi ni- tion of religion and spirituality (Hill et al., 1998). Funded by the Fetzer Institute and the National Institute on Aging (NIA), a smaller national working group of scholars created a new tool, the Multidimensional Measurement of Religiousness/Spirituality for Use in Health Research (Fetzer Institute/National Institute of Aging, 1999). This measure includes 11 do- mains of religion and spirituality. The instru- ment has been embedded in the General Social Survey, and domain-specifi c components have been widely used in health research. Hill and Hood (1999) compiled what remains the larg- est collection of standardized measures of religiosity and developed a list of domains. Likewise, Koenig, McCullough, and Larson (2001) identifi ed a variety of domains based on their comprehensive review of the empirical

literature through 2000. Their review included more than 1,200 studies and 400 research re- views. Table 11.2 lists the various domains identifi ed by these groups to highlight unique and overlapping categories.

Going well beyond demographic variables reported earlier, the concepts listed in Table 11.2 allow a fi ne-grained understanding of re- ligiosity and spirituality in people’s lives. Of these dimensions, religious affi liation is the most widely used by researchers. As recently as four decades ago, scholars and health pro- fessionals were content to inquire whether people were Catholic, Protestant, or Jewish. But changes in religious demographics result- ing from social dynamics and immigration have made these categories inadequate. Like- wise, another common measure of religious participation—weekly worship attendance— has been recognized as an overly crude mea- sure of religiosity.

Table 11.2 makes clear that numerous other dimensions of religion and spirituality may be signifi cant for particular populations of pa- tients seen in health or other settings. A reli- gious or spiritual history may be the best means of assessing these intertwined and overlapping dimensions. A history identifi es crucial, often idiosyncratic, formative factors in the client’s experience. Religious and spiritual histories are especially well suited to clinical practice, but because they are highly qualitative, they are less amenable to research on religion and health outcomes. These dimensions are inter- related. For example, besides participating in weekly worship services, many people par- ticipate in private religious activities, such as prayer, watching religious television, listen- ing to religious radio, meditation, or reading scripture or other religious literature. Such activity may be encouraged by organizational participation but also may occur in its absence. Religious activities—both organizational and private—probably contribute to people’s re- ligious knowledge, beliefs, and values (three separate yet overlapping dimensions). Reli- gious knowledge, beliefs, and values may fos- ter religious meaning making and appraisals regarding one’s own life. Furthermore, they

JWBT514_ch11.indd 270JWBT514_ch11.indd 270 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Religion, Spirituality, Health, and Social Work 271

Table 11.2 Dimensions of Religion and Spirituality

King and Hunt (1972)

Larson, Swyers, and McCullough (1998)

Fetzer Institute/ National Institute of Aging (1999)

Hill and Hood (1999)

Koenig, McCullough, and Larson (2001)

Creedal assent Beliefs and values Beliefs Belief and practice Belief

Belief versus nonbelief

Certainty of belief

Orthodoxy of belief

Religious knowledge Values Moral values

Preference or affi liation Religious preference

Affi liation or denomination

Organizational activity

Social participation Organizational religiousness

Institutional religion

Organizational religiosity

Congregational involvement

Membership

Church attendance Attendance at religious services

Social activity

Study/Prayer groups

Church leadership (elder, deacon)

Sacramental/Ritual participation

Financial support Financial support

Devotionalism Private practices Private religious practices

Spirituality and mysticism

Nonorganizational religiosity

Private prayer

Private reading (scripture/theology)

Religious television/ radio

Salience Subjective religiosity

Behavior Importance of religion

Cognition Self-rating religiosity

Orientation to religion

Commitment Commitment Commitment orientation

Commitment and motivation

Growth and striving Intrinsic

Extrinsic Extrinsic

Meaning “Quest” (search for truth)

Experiences Daily spiritual experiences

Experience Experience

Religious well-being

Coping Coping Coping and problem solving

Coping

History History History (spiritual history)

Development Maturity

(continued)

JWBT514_ch11.indd 271JWBT514_ch11.indd 271 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

272 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

Table 11.2 Dimensions of Religion and Spirituality (Continued)

King and Hunt (1972)

Larson, Swyers, and McCullough (1998)

Fetzer Institute/ National Institute of Aging (1999)

Hill and Hood (1999)

Koenig, McCullough, and Larson (2001)

Attitudes Attitudes and Practices

Motivation for regulating and reconciling relationships

Forgiveness Forgiveness

Support Support

Concept of God

Fundamentalism

View of afterlife

Divine intervention

Source: Adapted from “Measuring Religiousness in Health Research: Review and Critique,” by D. E. Hall, K. G. Meador, and H. G. Koenig, 2008, Journal of Religion and Health, 47(2), 134–163.

may contribute to religious and spiritual coping (i.e., the use of religious ideas and practices to deal with stressors). Furthermore, participation in organized religiosity may specifi cally con- tribute to exchange of religious and spiritual support (i.e., support within religious groups or for religious reasons, a form of social sup- port). Religious and spiritual thinking and be- havior also may lead to religiously infl uenced motivation. For example, religiosity may pro- vide substantive content for ideals and goals (e.g., honesty, fi delity, apology, forgiveness). Over time, it may encourage behavior consis- tent with these ideals and, subsequently, build commitment to their achievement. Some peo- ple report experiences of the sacred, ranging from a sense of peace or awe to more explicit and direct involvement, such as conversion or healing. Just as people vary in their experience of the sacred, they also differ in their sense of subjective or personal religiosity. Some people experience a sense of quest and adventure in relation to religious and spiritual experience, and many people can identify the presence or absence of spiritual well-being in their lives.

Do religion and spirituality do all of these things? Perhaps not on the individual level, but for groups of people in various combinations, they probably do. Although religious and spiritual involvement may vary dramatically

between individuals and groups, these differ- ences provide some of the key dimensions for understanding and assessing them. As Krause (2008) argues, it is time to move beyond simple conceptualizations of religion and spirituality. “If researchers hope to better understand the relationship between religion and health, then more attention must be given to the complex ways in which religion is measured” (pp. 5–6).

A complete list of religiosity domains may serve four purposes.

1. It reveals the multifaceted nature of the un- derlying concepts of religion and spiritual- ity.

2. It provides a starting point for researchers wishing to operationalize these concepts, and for practitioners considering how to in- clude them in client assessment.

3. It provides a basis for understanding and interpreting empirical research on the relationships between religion and spiritu- ality and health.

4. More generally, it may help to untangle vague and overlapping conceptualizations of religion and spirituality and to develop more precise understanding of these im- portant concepts. This will provide a foundation for exploring how religion and spirituality relate to health.

JWBT514_ch11.indd 272JWBT514_ch11.indd 272 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Religion, Spirituality, Health, and Social Work 273

EMPIRICAL RESEARCH ON RELIGION AND HEALTH

In 2001, Koenig et al. published the Handbook of Religion and Health, a 700-page review of empirical research on the relationship between religion and a variety of physical and mental health conditions. The authors examined more than 1,200 research studies and 400 research reviews, with the goal of including all English- language published studies available at that time. Koenig and his colleagues published the second edition of the Handbook in 2011, and the current edition reviews research from the past decade. Refl ecting the dramatic growth of scholarly interest in the topic, more research has been conducted in the decade since the fi rst edition was published than in the entire previous century (H. Koenig, personal com- munication, February 8, 2008). Rather than provide a comprehensive review, this section discusses the major pathways through which religion and spirituality are theorized to infl u- ence health.

In the burgeoning empirical literature, sev- eral potential pathways have been theorized for the infl uence of religion and spirituality on health. Some of these are less inclusive while others involve biological and physiological mechanisms. The latter are not reviewed in this chapter.

First, some religious groups prescribe and encourage what Oman and Thoreson (2005) refer to generally as lifestyle health behav- iors. For example, George, Ellision, and Lar- son (2002) note that Mormons prohibit use of alcohol and illegal drugs, cigarette smoking, and nonmarital sex. Mormons also provide guidelines for diet and sleep. Likewise, Sev- enth Day Adventists prohibit consumption of alcohol, illegal drugs, tobacco, and caffeine and encourage a vegetarian diet and Sabbath keeping. Less directly, many religious groups promote gratitude for the gift of life and en- courage respect and care for the human body as the temple of God (Park, 2007, p. 322) or as an instrument of God’s service (Oman & Thoreson, 2005). These positive messages

are assumed to contribute to healthy choices (George et al., 2002).

Indeed, empirical data supports this psy- chosocial mechanism. Based on their review of evidence-based literature, for example, Powell, Shahabi, and Thoreson (2003) con- clude that “the relationship between religion or spirituality and cardiovascular death is, to a large extent, explained by the encouragement that religion or spirituality provides for living a healthier lifestyle” (p. 42). As another ex- ample, religious prohibitions regarding smok- ing represent a major factor for some religious groups in lowered tobacco-related cancers. Despite substantial recent declines in smok- ing, tobacco-related cancers remain the lead- ing cause of cancer deaths in the United States (Centers for Disease Control [CDC], 2010). Building on recent psychological research, Geyer and Baumeister (2005) proposed spiri- tual self-regulation as a means of understand- ing how people use religion to increase their self-control in an attempt to align their lives with important values.

Related to healthy behaviors, religion is associated with increased use of preventive health care and adherence to medical regi- mens (Oman & Thoreson, 2005, p. 446). For example, in a nationally representative sample of older adults, Benjamins and Brown (2004) found that people who reported high levels of religiosity were more likely to use preven- tive services (fl u shots, cholesterol screening, breast self-exams, mammograms, pap smears, and prostate screening). They speculate that religious beliefs may motivate healthier living and use of preventive care, or that religious set- tings may directly provide information, instru- mental support (e.g., transportation), or on-site preventive services. Either by encouraging use of preventive health care or facilitating access to such care, religious involvement appears to increase older adults’ use of preventive health care and to improve their health outcomes.

More broadly, most religious groups pro- vide signifi cant social support for their mem- bers, especially when members need it most (Koenig, 2008, p. 57f). “This is not surprising

JWBT514_ch11.indd 273JWBT514_ch11.indd 273 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

274 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

because virtually all religions in the world extol the virtues of loving one another and caring for those who are in need. In fact, this is one rea- son why some researchers maintain that social ties in the church are specially close-knit and may be more benefi cial than social relation- ships that arise in secular setting” (Krause, 2008, p. 1216). Like religion and spirituality, social support is a complex, multidimensional construct. This creates the possibility of nu- merous relationships. For example, religious and spiritual involvement correlates with larger and more stable social networks, more interaction within social networks, greater per- ception of social and emotional support, and greater satisfaction with support (George, Lar- son, Koenig, & McCullough, 2000; Oman & Thoreson, 2005).

Social support provides a context for in- dividuals to be open and disclose their health conditions and concerns. In turn,

disclosure evokes cognitive and affective responses, which can ameliorate stress and moderate its deleterious effects on human physiology. In addition, confi ding in others, human or divine, and reinforcing reciprocal bonds of assistance among individuals, or with divine others, has both health-promotive and disease-preventive consequences for populations, as shown through decades of social and epidemiologic research on social support. (Levin, 2009, p. 90)

Religious groups often promote what Krause (2008) terms “close companion friends,” an in- tense type of relationship uncommon outside of families.

In research on religion and health, a com- monplace fi nding is that people’s religious in- volvement is related to both the amount and the quality of social support they experience (Koenig, 2008). This is especially true for older adults and for people with health prob- lems. For example, older adults are more likely to be involved with religious groups than other social groups, and controlling for other factors, this involvement has greater effects on their happiness and health (Koenig, 2008; Krause, 2008).

Religious traditions provide signifi cant resources to help members fi nd meaning and purpose in their struggles, to make sense of their experience, and to establish a sense of coherence (George et al., 2002). Through religion, “people understand their role in the universe, the purpose in life, and develop the courage to endure suf- fering” (George et al., 2000, p. 111). Interest- ingly, there is no assumption that the meanings are positive. It appears that simply being able to make sense of experience is most critical.

Likewise, religious traditions provide a vari- ety of coping resources to assist people in deal- ing with illness, suffering, and death (Koenig, 2008). Somewhat ironically, for many people, trust in God appears to enhance their sense of control and to promote active coping (Hood, Hill & Spilka, 2009; Pargament, 1997). “For example, persons adopting a ‘collaborative’ coping orientation with the divine, viewing God as a partner, experienced better outcomes than persons using either a primarily ‘deferring’ coping style (involving passive attitude toward problems) or a primarily ‘self-directive’ coping style” (Oman & Thoreson, 2005, p. 445).

Although religious coping may be benefi - cial in general, it appears especially benefi cial for people dealing with chronic illness or with the loss of a loved one (Hood et al., 2009). There is limited evidence for benefi cial ef- fects of religious coping on physical health; it appears that the effects may be obscured by the failure to distinguish negative and positive coping (Park, 2007). Nevertheless,

an impressive number of studies done in a wide range of social settings indicate that people who rely on positive religious cop- ing responses are more likely to avoid the pernicious effects of stress than individuals who do not turn to religion in an effort to deal with the adversity that confronts them. (Krause, 2004, p. 1217)

Psychosocial resources, such as self-esteem, self-effi cacy, and mastery, also may partly ex- plain the health benefi ts of religious participa- tion. Religious participation is associated with higher levels of these psychosocial resources, although the evidence to support this connection

JWBT514_ch11.indd 274JWBT514_ch11.indd 274 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Religion, Spirituality, Health, and Social Work 275

is based on cross-sectional data (Krause, 2008). There also is evidence that these psychosocial resources are associated with better health, al- though, again, this conclusion rests largely on the results of cross-sectional studies

Most religious traditions endorse forgiving attitudes and behaviors (McCullough, Bono & Root, 2005; Oman & Thoreson, 2005). Krause (2004) suggests that forgiveness may help people in several ways. First, those unwilling to forgive “often relive the hurtful act over and over” (p. 1218). This rumination may pro- duce stress and lead to poor health outcomes. Conversely, “forgiving others helps restore and renew social ties that were previously a source of signifi cant support.” These ties may pro- duce better health. Finally, “forgiving others promotes positive emotions.” At noted previ- ously, these actions exert a benefi cial effect on health. Furthermore, interventions to promote forgiveness improve psychological well-being, reduce chronic stress and anger, reduce anxi- ety and depressive symptoms, and increase self-esteem and hope (Enright & Coyle, 1998; as cited in McCullough et al., 2005). For these reasons, it seems plausible that forgiveness may contribute to improved health.

Likewise, religious traditions promote altru- ism and service to others by offering both reasons and opportunities for involvement. For example, volunteering, philanthropy, altruism, and other kinds of helping behavior are generally higher among religious people, and these activities are associated with both mental and physical health (Koenig, 2008). “Regular church attendance may encourage meaningful social roles that pro- vide a sense of self-worth and purpose through the act of helping. This is in contrast to the more common conceptualizations of social support where the emphasis is on being helped” (Powell et al., 2003, p. 48). Beyond this, religious in- volvement promotes formal volunteer work and informal helping, both of which may be associ- ated with improved health outcomes.

Religious and spiritual people often exhibit

qualities such as gratitude, hope, optimism, and compassion (referring to, respectively, an appreciation for life, expectancies of favorable

outcomes, a sense that one can achieve these outcomes, and a deep and abiding sense of love for all of humankind) may provide in- dividuals with a deeper sense of meaning in life and a source of direction and comfort in diffi cult times. (Park, 2007, p. 322)

Furthermore, they may experience positive psychological states as a result of better cop- ing, meaning derived from religious goals, the experience of forgiveness, helping others, and faith-related expectancy (Oman & Thoreson, 2005). If so, these positive psychological states may contribute to positive health outcomes.

These positive emotional states, in turn, may affect health by reducing allostatic load (AL). AL represents the cumulative wear and tear on one’s body from adapting to the de- mands of everyday living. These demands require ongoing adjustments to maintain phys- iological systems within normal operating ranges. The adjustment process itself may be- come damaged, especially when the demands are chronic, the adjustment is inadequate, or for other reasons it does not shut off. Thus, AL is conceptualized as a failure of bodily systems to regulate normally and posited to mediate the relationship between stress and health, thus in- creasing the risk of illness (Maselko, Kubzan- sky, Kawachi, Seeman, & Berkman, 2007).

Oman and Thoreson (2005) speculate that at- tachment styles also provide a plausible pathway between religion and health. Secure attachment to God is linked with greater life satisfaction and lower levels of anxiety, depression, and loneliness, and these, in turn, are related to better physical health (Oman & Thoreson, 2005).

Considering macro-level relationships be- tween religion and health, faith-based efforts to improve community health are becoming more popular. Griffi th and colleagues (2010) describe a community health promotion ef- fort that was successful in partnering with African American churches in the Flint, MI, area to reduce HIV/AIDS. Working with these churches, the community groups were able to reach over 4,000 congregants across 11 churches to increase awareness, knowledge, and understanding of human immunodefi ciency

JWBT514_ch11.indd 275JWBT514_ch11.indd 275 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

276 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

virus (HIV)/acquired immunodefi ciency syn- drome (AIDS). Duru, Sarkisian, Leng, and Mangione (2010) conducted the fi rst random- ized controlled trial of a faith-based physical activity program to increase physical activity in older African American women at three Los Angeles churches. As part of that trial, congregants followed a curriculum that in- cluded Bible reading and prayer in addition to walking. Their research suggests that a church-based physical activity program may be successful in promoting physical activ- ity among members. A majority of the par- ticipants in rural North Carolina focus groups about community kidney disease screenings by Jennette, Vupputuri, Hogan, Falk, and Harward (2010) suggested that such screen- ings would be most successful if held in com- munity churches. One focus group member stated: “I think the church is a good place if you want to start in the community because that’s a common place, no matter how poor or rich we are” (p. 7). Campbell et al. (2007) suggest that collaborative partnerships with churches can improve community health and that program leaders of such partnerships should incorporate key components of com- munity-based participatory research (such as involving churches in program design and de- livery) to be most effective.

This brief summary of potential pathways linking religion and health refl ects a growing body of empirical evidence. “To summarize, we conclude that a relationship between reli- gion or spirituality and physical health does exist but that it may be more limited and more complex than has been suggested by others” (Powell et al., 2003, p. 50). As Park (2007) notes, “[W]hile it is useful to keep [the pathways] conceptually distinct, they likely interact and overlap in many ways” (p. 321).

Suicide

Social workers in many settings, including health care, encounter clients who contemplate or attempt suicide. It is well known that in the United States suicide attempts and suicide rates

vary signifi cantly by gender, age, and ethnic- ity (CDC, 2010). Suicide is a leading cause of death among young people but actually occurs more frequently among older adults. Non- Hispanic Whites, American Indians, and Native Alaskans are twice as likely to commit suicide as other ethnic groups (CDC, 2010). It may be less known that suicide risk and suicide rates are also associated with religion.

Research consistently has demonstrated that suicide rates vary by religious tradition and by level of participation: Both religious affi liation and religious participation serve as protective factors for suicide (Gearing & Lizardi, 2009; Lizardi & Gearing, 2010). In a review of 68 studies, Koenig and Larson (2001) report that 84% found lower rates of suicide or more negative attitudes toward suicide among more religious persons. Most religious traditions condemn taking one’s own life, provide reasons for living, and dis- courage aggressive behavior and hostility. More broadly, religious participation also may contribute to social support and increase emotional well-being. Because of this protec- tive potential, psychosocial assessment for suicide risk should consider religion. Indeed, Gearing and Lizardi (2009) recommend that social workers ask a variety of questions to assess: the importance of religion to the cli- ent, the role of religiosity in previous times of stress and diffi culty, how suicide is con- ceptualized in the client’s religion, and the potential benefi t of encouraging the client’s religiosity (pp. 237–238).

SPIRITUAL ASSESSMENT

The previous discussion about components of religion and spirituality alerts us to the mul- tiple ways that religion and spirituality may relate to health. Furthermore, it suggests ways that religion and spirituality may infl uence the development and course of particular diseases and psychosocial problems across the life course. It suggests the importance of consid- ering religion and spirituality as an integral part of a thorough psychosocial assessment

JWBT514_ch11.indd 276JWBT514_ch11.indd 276 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Religion, Spirituality, Health, and Social Work 277

process. Indeed, several authors have offered a variety of reasons for including religion and spirituality in the assessment process.

If the spiritual and religious diversity pres- ent in the United States is taken seriously, data may be overwhelming. But it may be less important that social workers know de- tails about specifi c religions and spiritual ap- proaches and more important that they know how to ask about a patient’s religious and spiritual beliefs and involvement. As a subset of cultural competence, religious and spiritual competence requires the ability to explore the unfamiliar. Given time and attention, patients often are willing to teach health-care provid- ers about their health concerns and how these relate to religion or spirituality. Barnes and Harris (2001) recommend “respectful curios- ity” as an important way to approach clients. “The broader skill—as in all effective medi- cal care—involves developing the capacity to listen differently, in a way that is personally respectful, clinically insightful, and aimed at understanding rather than agreement or dis- agreement” (pp. 7–8).

In a brief chapter such as this, it is impos- sible to provide an adequate introduction to the variety of religious and spiritual beliefs and practices that health social workers may encounter in their professional practices. Furthermore, there is great diversity within as well as between religious groups. Thus, religiously competent practice requires con- tinual efforts to individualize assessments and to avoid stereotyping and making as- sumptions.

Rationale for Spiritual Assessment

There are a number of reasons for social workers to address religion and spirituality with patients and their families. As previ- ously discussed, many Americans identify themselves as religious or spiritual and in- dicate that this is important for them. Things that are important for people, such as reli- gion and spirituality, likely will have impli- cations for their health care. If so, it appears that social workers will want to determine

whether this is true for particular patients and incorporate this information into their work with those patients. For example, re- ligion and spirituality may shape people’s beliefs about pain and suffering, quality of life, meaning and purpose, and mortality. Those beliefs also may infl uence patients’ access to social support and other resources. The purpose of conducting religious or spiri- tual assessment is to clarify their roles in the lives of patients, which allow the develop- ment of more complete and better-informed treatment plans.

Why should we assess and attempt to ad- dress religious and spiritual issues with our pa- tients? Koenig (2008) and others give several reasons (for additional information, see Canda & Furman, 2010). As discussed previously, many patients are religious, and most would like to have their faith considered in their health care (Cloninger, 2006; Koenig, 2008). Also, a large proportion of Americans iden- tify themselves as religious or spiritual, and of these, a large percentage report religion or spirituality is an important part of their lives. For these patients, inquiring about religion and spirituality signals an interest in the whole person and may further enhance the treatment relationship and the therapeutic effects of treatment (D’Souza, 2007).

Religion and spirituality infl uence people’s efforts and ability to cope with illness, whether physical or mental. More specifi cally, religion may infl uence “motivation toward self-care, willingness to cooperate with plan treatments, and ability to comply with medical therapies” (Koenig, 2008, p. 157). Because these are important contributors to treatment success, it is important for social workers and other health-care providers to take religion into ac- count. In particular, religion may be critical for discharge planning and aftercare—a frequent focus for social workers in health settings— because religious groups often represent a signifi cant source of concrete assistance (e.g., transportation, meals) and social support for their newly discharged members. Many churches, for example, have health ministries or outreach efforts.

JWBT514_ch11.indd 277JWBT514_ch11.indd 277 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

278 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

In addition, religious beliefs and practices may infl uence medical outcomes (Koenig, 2008). As Koenig suggests, unmet spiritual and emotional needs may create physiological stress, thus impacting body systems. These, in turn, infl uence the way patients respond to surgical and medical treatments. Thus, identi- fying and trying to address spiritual needs may reduce stress and enhance medical treatment.

Hospitalized patients often are isolated from their usual spiritual care and support. Pa- tients may be hospitalized far from home and their spiritual communities. Even when they are not distant, their clergy may have limited time and ability to visit. In such situations, so- cial workers may play a critical role in helping patients acquire spiritual care and support, by initiating contact with the patient’s clergy, clergy within the community, or the hospital chaplain. In addition, most clergy will have limited understanding of medical conditions and medical procedures and thus have limited ability to connect these with spiritual con- cerns. In these situations, social workers may serve as intermediaries among patients, clergy, and other health professionals. This may be of considerable importance when patients wish for spiritual counsel regarding certain proce- dures (e.g., starting or stopping life support).

As outlined by Koenig (2008), religious be- liefs and rituals may confl ict with or otherwise infl uence medical decisions that patients make, particularly when they are seriously ill. Reli- gious beliefs and rituals may infl uence medical decisions by family members as well, in ways that may or may not be consistent with the patient’s wishes. Although uncommon, such confl icts often are high profi le and attract dis- proportionate attention. These include avoid- ance of medical care by Christian Scientists, suspicion of psychiatric care by fundamental- ist Christians, refusal of blood transfusions by Jehovah’s Witnesses, and so on. Health social workers must be prepared to work with people holding these views and intercede with health- care administrators, attorneys, and members of the judicial system.

Whether and to what extent a patient par- ticipates in a religious congregation may have signifi cant implications for follow-up care. For

example, religious communities may provide a variety of signifi cant material and emotional supports. Potential supports include meals, transportation, social visits, prayers, telephone calls, supervision, caregiving, and respite for caregivers. Such supports may hasten and fa- cilitate discharge to the community, prolong community stay, and improve the quality of life. These congregational supports may be especially important for patients who do not have many family members nearby or whose family members cannot provide much support.

Major professional organizations now recommend or even require practitioners to conduct routine spiritual assessment as part of competent practice. In recognition of the foregoing benefi ts, the Joint Commission for the Accreditation of Hospital Organizations requires a spiritual assessment of all patients in hospitals, nursing homes, and home-health agencies (Hodge, 2006). Related to this, the Joint Commission also requires that medical, nursing, and psychiatric training programs pre- pare their students to provide culturally sensi- tive health care, including sensitivity to deeply held religious beliefs (Koenig, 2008). Like- wise, the World Health Organization (WHO) has emphasized the importance of addressing religion and spirituality in clinical practice (WHO, 1998; WHOQOL SRPB Group, 2006). Other groups of health professionals also have recommended spiritual assessment as part of competent practice in palliative care (e.g., American College of Physicians; Qaseem et al., 2008), cancer care (National Cancer Institute, 2009), and mental health (Substance Abuse and Mental Health Services Administration, 2006; Royal College of Psychiatrists, 2010).

The National Association of Social Workers (NASW) has promulgated standards in several areas of professional practice that recommend assessment of spirituality. These include NASW Standards for Services in Long-Term Care Fa- cilities (NASW, 2003), Social Work Practice in Health Care Settings (NASW, 2005b), and So- cial Work Practice with Clients with Substance Use Disorders (NASW, 2005a). The standards for health-care settings include this assertion: “Social workers recognize that ethnic, cultural, spiritual, and religious factors can have an

JWBT514_ch11.indd 278JWBT514_ch11.indd 278 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Religion, Spirituality, Health, and Social Work 279

impact on healthcare choices and adherence to regimens of care” (NASW, 2005b, p. 18). More generally, NASW recommends spiritual assess- ment as an essential aspect of cultural compe- tence (NASW, 2001, 2007). Thus, professional competence will require assessment of spiritual and religious factors.

Approaches to Assessment

This chapter has identifi ed numerous dimen- sions of religion and spirituality. Scholars have developed a variety of standardized mea- sures for assessing religion and spirituality in empirical research, even though they tend to focus on only a few of the specifi ed dimen- sions. The Multidimensional Measurement of Religiousness/Spirituality for Use in Health Research is one of the best measures for study- ing the relationships between religion, spiritu- ality, and health. It can be used in its entirety or particular sections can be selected for more focused investigations. Hill and Hood (1999) compiled a large collection of religious mea- sures developed for research purposes, many of which are appropriate for health research. More recently, Hill and Maltby (2009) iden- tifi ed measures of religion and spirituality related to well-being. The National Cancer Institute (NCI, 2010) also identifi ed several measures for research on religion and health. To add religion and spirituality to a larger health study, the Duke University Religion Index (DUREL) is a simple fi ve-item measure that taps several key dimensions (Koenig & Büssing, 2010). Developed for use in epide- miological studies, it can be easily incorpo- rated into health research.

At the same time, scholars have developed a variety of tools for assessing religion and spirituality in clinical practice. This chapter provides a set of categories for such tools and discusses exemplars in each category. Tools for assessing spirituality in clinical practice can be categorized as brief screening tools, pictorial interview tools, and in-depth interviews. By including several tools in each category, this chapter enables practitioners to select an ap- proach that fi ts client needs and priorities, and the practitioner’s own preferences. These tools

may be included with a conventional intake procedure or used as part of a more thorough psychosocial assessment process.

Health social workers have several ways to address religious and spiritual concerns with patients. They can wait for patients to bring up spiritual concerns. They can routinely use brief paper-and-pencil assessment or oral screening tools with patients. Or they can use a spiritual inquiry or assessment to explicitly address these issues and indicate their open- ness to further discussion (NCI, 2010). These approaches have different strengths and weak- nesses. Uncertain of how their social worker will respond, some patients may be reluc- tant or fearful to raise spiritual concerns on their own. Some may think it inappropriate to discuss their spiritual concerns with a so- cial worker while others wish to do so. Some patients may be relieved to have their social worker indicate openness to address these is- sues. For these reasons, a brief routine inquiry may adequately signal practitioner interest and openness without putting undue pressure on the patient. As the NCI suggests,

simply inquiring about an area such as reli- gious or spiritual coping may be experienced by the patient as an opening for further ex- ploration and validation of the importance of this experience. Evidence suggests that such an inquiry will be experienced as intrusive and distressing by only a very small propor- tion of patients. (NCI, 2010)

Brief Screening Tools

Several brief screening tools are available for use by health-care practitioners, including physicians, nurses, and social workers. Most provide an acronym to remind practitioners of the recommended questions or topics. For example, the HOPE questions (Anandarajah & Hight, 2001, p. 86) address:

H Sources of hope, meaning, comfort, strength, peace, love, and connection

O Organized religion P Personal spirituality and practices E Effects on medical care and end-of-life

issues

JWBT514_ch11.indd 279JWBT514_ch11.indd 279 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

280 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

These few questions highlight the existential, social, and personal aspects of religion and spir- ituality and invite patients to comment on how these might be related to their medical care.

Similarly, another set of four questions for physicians focus on “the meaning and effect of spirituality in the patient’s life and coping sys- tem” (Frick, Riedner, Fegg, Hauf, & Borasio, 2006, p. 238). The SPIR questions (p. 240) address:

S Would you describe yourself—in the broadest sense of the term—as a believing/ spiritual/ religious person?

P What is the place of spirituality in your life? How important is it in the context of your illness?

I Are you integrated in a spiritual community?

R What role would you like to assign to your doctor, nurse, or therapist in the domain of spirituality?

These questions emphasize patients’ prefer- ences regarding spiritual identity and its sig- nifi cance, their involvement with a spiritual community, and the role of health-care profes- sionals in spirituality.

Yet another set of four questions may be the most widely used as a brief screening tool in health care (Puchalski, 2004; Puchalski & Romer, 2000). Puchalski’s model uses the ac- ronym FICA and provides specifi c questions to guide spiritual assessment (Pulchalski & Romer, 2000, p. 131):

F Faith and Belief: “Do you consider yourself spiritual or religious?” or “Do you have spiritual beliefs that help you cope with stress?” If the patient responds “No,” the health-care provider might ask, “What gives your life meaning?” Sometimes patients respond with answers such as family, career, or nature.

I Importance: “What importance does your faith or belief have in our life? Have your beliefs infl uenced how you take care of yourself in this illness? What role do your beliefs play in regaining your health?”

C Community: “Are you part of a spiritual or religious community? Is this of support to you and how? Is there a group of people you really love or who are important to you?” Communities such as churches, temples, and mosques, or a group of like- minded friends can serve as strong support systems for some patients.

A Address in Care: “How would you like me, your health-care provider, to address these issues in your health care?”

Like previous models, FICA invites patients to: self-identify whether they are religious or spiritual and let health-care professionals know what terminology they prefer, indicate how important religion and spirituality is and how it may relate to their illness, identify their religious or spiritual communities as potential support networks for patients, and indicate their comfort with and preferences for health- care professionals to engage openly these matters. In short, the FICA helps health-care professionals determine what may be not only permissible but also desirable in their collabo- ration with patients.

Any of these brief screening tools elicit basic information about a patient’s spiritual- ity and provide a foundation for initiating the professional/ patient relationship. Of course, professionals still must decide whether and how to use this information. If a health-care professional has reason to believe that religion and spirituality play a signifi cant role in a pa- tient’s history, medical condition, or potential response to treatment, then she may decide to pursue additional information using one of the methods discussed next.

Pictorial Interview Tools

Although brief screening tools provide a good place to begin, they generally provide only limited information about religion and spiri- tuality in patients’ lives. To go further, social workers need additional, interview-based tools. Starting with assessment tools widely used in social work direct practice, Hodge (2005a) has adapted assessment tools for use

JWBT514_ch11.indd 280JWBT514_ch11.indd 280 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Religion, Spirituality, Health, and Social Work 281

in social work practice. Specifi cally, he has proposed several pictorial tools for supple- menting verbal interviews regarding religion and spirituality, something that many patients will appreciate for disclosing sensitive reli- gious and spiritual experiences.

Spiritual Life Maps

Hodge (2005a,c) proposed spiritual life maps as an alternative to exclusively verbal spiritual histories. Hodge (2005a) notes that life maps have several advantages for clinical practice: (a) They encourage an active role for clients in the assessment process; (b) they provide a respectful context for discussing potentially sensitive matters; (c) they may facilitate com- munication by less verbal clients and those for whom English is not the fi rst language and provide a concrete focus for subsequent ex- ploration; and (d) they help to make concrete what otherwise may seem amorphous and subjective, thus making it more readily avail- able for intervention. Furthermore, construc- tion of a life map may itself represent a form of intervention. The process of selecting and refl ecting on past experience may promote in- sight and help patients to articulate things they have not understood previously, reinterpret or reframe themselves and their experience more positively, and generally encourage greater narrative coherence. Many of these advantages apply to other pictorial interview tools as well.

Constructing a spiritual life map simply requires a large sheet of paper and writing instruments. Along a line representing the cli- ent’s life, the client can draw or paste pictures and write words representing key events and experiences that have spiritual signifi cance. These events may be positive or negative, great or small, public or private. The process of constructing the life map serves as a trig- ger for memory and a focus for conversation in the clinical encounter. To encourage greater creativity, practitioners may provide color pen- cils or crayons, construction paper, magazines for cutting photos, scissors, and glue. They can continue clinical conversation while the patient works on the life map, inviting patients to talk about the events chosen for inclusion.

Although clients and practitioners may learn most from constructing life maps in a clinical session, they also can be assigned as home- work and discussed in the next session. In either case, the life map provides a concrete point of reference to which practitioners may return in treatment (i.e., to discuss particular incidents, strengths, responses). Of several pictorial tools, spiritual life maps probably are least structured and, thus, most fl exible and client directed.

Canda and Furman (2010) suggest spiritual development timelines, a similar tool that has slightly more structure than the life map. Their timelines also are designed to help clients tell the story of their lives; however, they assume a developmental process that brings some narra- tive coherence to the story. Their timelines in- clude a horizontal axis that marks the passage of time and a vertical axis that represents de- velopmental stages of spiritual consciousness.

Spiritual Genograms

Much as spiritual life maps focus on the life course of an individual patient, spiritual geno- grams frame the patient’s life in its historical family context. Building on the traditional portrayal of family trees, family genograms capture additional qualitative information about family relationships and highlight fam- ily patterns over time (McGoldrick, Gerson, & Shellenberger, 1999). Going further, spiri- tual genograms emphasize the spiritual and religious aspects of family experience within and across generations (Frame, 2000; Hodge, 2001b, 2005a). Because genograms usually in- clude information about three or more genera- tions of a family system, they can illuminate the ways that religion and spirituality have both strengthened and disrupted family functioning. For example, genograms can help patients to recognize those members who have been key contributors to their spiritual socialization and support and how religion may relate to alli- ances and confl ict in the family system, and can highlight patterns of continuity and change over time. They also may trigger memories of how family members used religion and spiritu- ality to deal with illness positively.

JWBT514_ch11.indd 281JWBT514_ch11.indd 281 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

282 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

As described by Hodge (2001b, 2005a), spiritual genograms resemble traditional geno- grams, except that they use additional symbols to represent religion and spirituality and spe- cifi cally include information about religion and spirituality. For example, in addition to the traditional squares for males and circles for females, practitioners can use triangles to represent key religious fi gures from outside the family system. By using different col- ors for different religious traditions, they can highlight interfaith marriages and the multi- plicity of religious backgrounds in an extended family. Likewise, they can use lines to refl ect spiritual and religious bonds between indi- viduals. They also include words and symbols to convey other important information about people, relationships, and events. See Hodge (2001b) and Frame (2000) for vignettes dem- onstrating use of a spiritual genogram and for possible interview questions to explore com- pleted genograms more deeply.

Spiritual Ecomaps

In contrast to spiritual life maps and genograms, spiritual ecomaps emphasize patients’ current ecological contexts rather than personal or re- lational histories. In short, they focus attention on religious and spiritual resources as well as relationships in which patients currently are involved. By doing so, ecomaps highlight and affi rm what is already present and may clarify what is absent. Both types of information can be useful for intervention planning. As Hodge (2000) notes, patients who may be skeptical of exploring past relationships nevertheless may appreciate how current relationships infl uence their situations. Indeed, spiritual ecomaps fi t well with the emphasis on relationships and so- cial support prevalent in most religion traditions.

The ecomap was fi rst developed by Hartman (1995) to depict a client’s ecological context, for example, including connections with the extended family, work, school, and social services. Spiritual ecomaps essentially bring a focus on religious and spiritual aspects of this context. The ecomap consists of a central circle depicting the patient and patient’s fam- ily with a series of additional circles arranged

around the perimeter of the page. The sur- rounding circles are labeled to represent key elements in the patient’s environment and then connected to the central circle with different types of lines to represent the nature of each relationship. For a spiritual ecomap, Hodge (2000) suggests these categories for the sur- rounding circles: God/transcendence, religious community, spiritual leader, transpersonal be- ings, ritual/practice, and religious traditions of patient’s parents. He also discusses how the categories may be applied and provides a vi- gnette to demonstrate use of the ecomap.

Spiritual Ecogram

Hodge (2005b) also describes the spiritual eco- gram, a combination of the spiritual genogram and ecomap. The spiritual ecogram provides a dual focus on history and current context and thus helps patients and practitioners to recog- nize complex interactions. But this tool is also the most complex and time-consuming of the pictorial ones described here. For that reason, practitioners must decide whether its comple- tion warrants the effort and time required. The spiritual ecogram can be constructed following guidelines already provided for both ecomaps and genograms.

In-Depth Interviews

In situations where religion and spiritual- ity loom signifi cant, it may be appropriate to conduct an in-depth interview focused on relevant aspects. Nelson-Becker, Nakashima, and Canda (2007) recommend beginning an interview on religion and spirituality with two prefatory questions:

1. Is spirituality, religion, or faith important in your life?

2. What terms do you prefer to talk about spirituality, religion, or faith? Please explain.

Such questions ensure that the social worker can use the patient’s preferred language for discussing these issues.

Canda and Furman (2010) provide guidance for exploring the role of religion or spirituality

JWBT514_ch11.indd 282JWBT514_ch11.indd 282 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Religion, Spirituality, Health, and Social Work 283

in the lives of patients in depth. Although their interview suggestions are not specifi - cally targeted to health-care settings, most are relevant to such practice environments. They distinguish among three types of spiritual as- sessment: implicit, brief explicit, and detailed explicit. For example, questions for implicit spiritual assessment include:

• What currently brings a sense of meaning and purpose to your life?

• Where do you go to fi nd a sense of deep inspiration or peace?

• What are the important sources of strength and help for you in getting through times of diffi culty or crisis?

• What are the deepest questions your situation raises for you? (p. 102)

For remembering their brief explicit spiritual assessment, Canda and Furman offer the ac- ronym MIMBRA. This stands for: meaning, importance, membership, beliefs, relevance, and action. The corresponding questions are:

• What helps you to experience a deep sense of meaning, purpose, morality, hope, con- nection, joy, or peace in your life?

• Are spirituality, religion, or faith impor- tant to you? Please explain why or why not.

• Are you a member of any groups or com- munities (such as a religious group, sup- port group, or cultural group) that give you a sense of belonging and help you fi nd meaning and support in life? Please explain.

• Please describe any important beliefs, practices (such as prayer, meditation, ritu- als, or holistic therapies), or values that shape your understanding and response to your current situation.

• From what we discussed so far, what if anything is relevant to your current situ- ation and your goals for our work to- gether?

• Is there anything we discussed that you would like us to act on in our work to- gether? For example, is there anything that has been helpful that we could apply or unhelpful that we should avoid or deal with? Are there close friends, relatives,

mentors, clergy, or spiritual teachers who I should be aware of or contact? Please explain. Thank you. (Canda & Furman, 2010, p. 267)

In an appendix, Canda and Furman (2010) provide a more complete set of interview ques- tions organized in 10 categories:

1. Spiritual group membership and partici- pation

2. Spiritual beliefs

3. Spiritual activities

4. Spiritual experiences and feelings

5. Moral and value issues

6. Spiritual development

7. Spiritual sources of support

8. Spiritual sources of transformation

9. Spiritual well-being

10. Extrinsic/intrinsic styles of spiritual propensity

Within these categories, they provide more than 50 questions. Depending on what seems important for a particular patient, a health so- cial worker could select one or more of these categories for further exploration.

Nelson-Becker et al. (2007) identify a similar set of interview categories and provide a smaller set of questions for each category. But they also provide helpful vignettes to demonstrate how client responses to questions in each category may yield increased understanding of clients and their unique situations. For that reason, their article may be especially helpful for understand- ing the potential payoff of questions in particular categories. Although the vignettes portray older adults, social workers can use the interview questions with other populations as well.

Specifi cally formulated for oncology set- tings, the NCI (2009) recommends that spiritual assessment interviews with patients address these categories:

• R eligious denomination, if any

• Beliefs or philosophy of life

• Important spiritual practices or rituals

JWBT514_ch11.indd 283JWBT514_ch11.indd 283 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

284 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

• Using spirituality or religion as a source of strength

• Being part of a community of support

• Using prayer or meditation

• Loss of faith

• Confl icts between spiritual or religious be- liefs and cancer treatments

• Ways that health-care providers and care- givers may help with the patient’s spiritual needs

• Concerns about death and afterlife

• Planning for the end of life

No assessment approach will work with all patients (Hodge, 2005b). For this reason, it seems important that practitioners be familiar with several different assessment approaches, so they can choose the appropriate approach for individual patients. Beyond the choice of a brief screening tool or initial interview ques- tions, the preferred assessment approach will require practitioner judgment regarding client preferences, areas of substantive importance, and time constraints.

APPROACHES TO INTERVENTION

Koenig and colleagues (2001) identify several ways in which health professionals can ad- dress or incorporate religion and spirituality in health care. As suggested, clinicians should as- sess the role of religion and spirituality in a pa- tient’s life. Besides gathering basic information that may guide treatment, doing so will com- municate that the health professional is open to discussing religious and spiritual concerns. If a patient’s religious beliefs and practices appear helpful, the professional may encour- age or “support those that the patient fi nds helpful” (p. 441). It may be helpful to ensure that the patient has access to desired religious resources, ranging from religious reading or listening material to hospital chaplains. It may be even more helpful to ensure that patients have visits with clergy and other members of their religious communities. As a related

matter, health professionals should recognize chaplains or community religious leaders as part of the health-care teams, especially in hospitals, residential institutions, and hospice agencies. Health professionals also should be prepared to address spiritual concerns directly and substantively when chaplains or other clergy are unavailable. Finally, health profes- sionals may wish to use spiritual interventions in particular situations with specifi c patients. But they must do so with caution. “Patients and situations should be carefully selected and the interventions highly individualized to fi t the patient’s religious background and spiri- tual need” (Koenig et al., 2001, p. 443).

Potential Spiritual Interventions

Besides these efforts to incorporate spiritual concerns of clients in health care, there is an emerging category of explicitly religious or spiritual therapies. In a recent article, Hook et al. (2010) conducted a systematic review of studies reporting on empirically supported and explicitly religious and spiritual thera- pies. The criteria for inclusion in the study specifi ed mental health interventions for di- rect practice with individuals or groups and excluded medical interventions or religious interventions outside a therapy context. Fur- ther, the review included only those inter- ventions that explicitly integrate religion or spirituality, thus excluding many interven- tions that have a basis in spirituality (i.e., mindfulness). Finally, the review included only randomized clinical trials. A total of 24 studies met these selection criteria. The studies included treatments for depression (8 studies), anxiety (6), unwillingness to for- give (3), eating disorders (2), schizophrenia (1), alcoholism (1), anger (1), and marital issues (1). The religions represented were Christianity (10 studies), Islam (7), Taoism (1), Buddhism (1), and a generic spiritual- ity (5). Most of the interventions consisted of a religious or spiritual add-on to standard secular interventions.

Several of the treatments were found to be benefi cial for clients, with gains maintained at

JWBT514_ch11.indd 284JWBT514_ch11.indd 284 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Religion, Spirituality, Health, and Social Work 285

follow-up. One study found that religious ther- apy was effective for highly religious clients but no more effective than secular alternatives for other clients. Given the generally positive fi nd- ings but small number of studies, the authors suggest that selecting religious or spiritual ther- apies may be primarily a matter of client prefer- ence or therapist comfort. The authors conclude with a call for more research on these therapies.

CONCLUSIONS

In an article on religion, aging, and health, Krause (2004) makes three general observa- tions that seem relevant here as well.

1. The associations between religion and health are imperfect. Religion appears to have some benefi ts, but not for everyone or for all conditions. Given the multidi- mensional nature of religion and spiritual- ity, we need to know much more about the specifi c relationships between health and religion.

2. It is important to remember that everyone dies, including those who are religious or spiritual, and most people become ill before they die. That means there are obvious lim- its to any benefi ts of religion.

3. “[S]ome (but not all) deeply religious people strongly believe that religion should not be pursued for the purpose of improving one’s health” (Krause, 2004, p. 1220). In other words, an instrumental focus on the health benefi ts of religion and spirituality may lead to extrinsic rather than intrinsic religion, un- dermining the essential and primary purposes of religion and spirituality.

SUGGESTED LEARNING EXERCISES

Learning Exercise 11.1

The Association for Religion Data Archives (n.d.) provides a fascinating, easy-to-use tool for understanding religious diversity in

the United States. Using a Graphic Informa- tion System (GIS), it maps population sta- tistics by zip code for the years 1980, 1990, and 2000. For example, it reports percentages of the population by major religious groups (Catholic, mainline Protestant, evangelical Protestant, Jewish, Muslim, Orthodox) as well as by more than 130 specifi c denominations (e.g., Baha’i, Roman Catholic, Presbyterian Church, Southern Baptist, Unitarian Univer- salist Association). In small groups or pairs, spend some time with its online GIS resource to learn about religious affi liation in the area where you live or work. Discuss how this re- source may be helpful to health social workers in settings in which social workers collaborate with a team to help individuals and those in which social workers work with a community, neighborhood, and other organizations.

Learning Exercise 11.2

The Pluralism Project at Harvard (Eck, 2010) provides an introduction to numerous religious traditions present in the United States. Among other things, this Web site includes extensive information organized by either state or reli- gious tradition. Individually, read about one spiritual tradition with which you are unfamil- iar. In small or large groups, share the informa- tion you learned from this project, and discuss how this information can help health social workers intervene on both an individual pa- tient level and a community/organization level.

Learning Exercise 11.3

To learn more about spiritual assessment and how to use one brief screening tool, go to the George Washington Institute on Spirituality and Health Web site (www.gwish.org/). It offers a free, multimedia training module, Spiritual As- sessment in Clinical Practice, for “assessing the spiritual beliefs, values, and practices important in your patients’ responses to illness or stress.” The course provides detailed information about how to use the FICA, one of the tools mentioned in this chapter. Using this module and tool, role- play a spiritual assessment with a partner.

JWBT514_ch11.indd 285JWBT514_ch11.indd 285 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

286 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

Learning Exercise 11.4

For additional resources on spiritual assess- ment in health care, browse the Spirituality and Health Online Education and Resource Center (SOERCE). Funded by the John Templeton Foundation, “SOERCE aims to be the premiere online location for educational and clinical re- sources in the fi elds of spirituality, religion, and health.” It is available at www.gwumc.edu /gwish/soerce/. The Web site includes articles; assessment tools; case studies; teaching mod- ules, methods, or exercises; guides, handbooks, and manuals; video or audio presentations; and patient or caregiver educational materials.

Learning Exercise 11.5

For in-depth group discussion, facilitators may select cases from Spirituality and Religion in Social Work Practice: Decision Cases for So- cial Work Practice, a casebook published by the Council on Social Work Education. All of the open-ended decision cases in this collec- tion were based on interviews with actual so- cial workers, and most come from health-care settings.

SUGGESTED RESOURCES

Print Canda, E. R., & Furman, L. D. (2010).

Spiritual diversity in social work prac- tice: The heart of helping. New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Fetzer Institute/National Institute of Aging. (1999). Multidimensional measurement of religiousness/spirituality for use in health research. Kalamazoo, MI: Fetzer Institute.

Hill, P. C., & Hood, R. W., Jr. (1999). Mea- sures of religiosity. Birmingham, AL: Religious Education Press.

Koenig, H. G. (2007). Spirituality in patient care: Why, how, when, and what (2nd ed.). West Conshohocken, PA: Temple- ton Foundation Press.

Koenig, H. G. (2008). Medicine, religion, and health: Where science and spiri- tuality meet. West Conshohocken, PA: Templeton Foundation Press.

Koenig, H. G., King, D. E., & Carson, V. B. (2011). Handbook of religion and health (2nd ed.). New York, NY: Oxford Uni- versity Press.

Koenig, H. G., McCullough, M. E., & Larson, D. B. (2001). Handbook of reli- gion and health. New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Krause, N. M. (2008). Aging in the church: How social relationships affect health. West Conshohocken, PA: Templeton Foundation Press.

Pargament, K. I. (1997). The psychology of religion and coping: Theory, research, practice. New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Pargament, K. I., Exline, J. J., & Jones, J. (Eds.). (Forthcoming). APA handbook of psychology, religion and spiritual- ity (Vol. 1). Washington, DC: American Psychological Association.

Puchalski, C. M., & Ferrell, B. (2010). Making health care whole: Integrating spirituality into patient care. West Con- shohocken, PA: Templeton Press.

Richards, P. S., & Bergin, A. E. (Eds.). (1999). Handbook of psychotherapy and religious diversity. Washington, DC: American Psychological Association.

Online Barnes, L. L. (2010). Boston Healing Land-

scape Project: A program for the study of cultural, therapeutic and religious plural- ism. Available at www.bu.edu/bhlp/

Center for Spiritual Development in Child- hood and Adolescence, Search Institute. (2010). Spirituality measures. Available at www.spiritualdevelopmentcenter.org /Display.asp?Page=measure2#intrinsic

Center for Spirituality and Healing, Univer- sity of Minnesota. (2003). Spirituality in health care. Available at www.csh.umn .edu/modules/spirituality/index.html

JWBT514_ch11.indd 286JWBT514_ch11.indd 286 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Religion, Spirituality, Health, and Social Work 287

Center for Spirituality, Theology and Health, Duke University. (2007). Center for Spirituality, Theology and Health. Avail- able at www.spiritualityandhealth.duke .edu/index.html

Eck, D. (2010). The Pluralism Project at Harvard University. Available at http:// pluralism.org

Ehman, J. (2009). Spiritual assessment and health care: A select bibliogra- phy of Medline-indexed articles pub- lished 2001–2009. Available at www .uphs. upenn.edu/pastoral/cpe/Res_Bib _Spiritual_Asessment_MEDLINE_2009 .pdf

George Washington Institute for Spiritu- ality & Health. (n.d.). Spirituality and Health Online Education and Resource Center (SOERCE). Available at www .gwumc.edu/ gwish/soerce/

George Washington Institute on Spirituality and Health. (n.d.). Spiritual assessment in clinical practice. Available at: www .gwish.org

Harrington, A. (2009). Health and spiritu- ality. Available at http://nccam.nih.gov /training/ videolectures/spirituality.htm

National Cancer Institute: PDQ®. (2010). Spirituality in cancer care [Professional version]. Bethesda, MD: National Can- cer Institute. Available at www. cancer .gov/cancertopics/pdq/supportivecare /spirituality/HealthProfessional

Free online course from National Center for Complementary and Alterna- tive Medicine, National Institutes of Health.

Maloof, P. S. (n.d.). Body/mind/spirit: To- ward a biopsychosocial-spiritual model of health. Available at http://nccc.georgetown .edu/body_mind_spirit/

Pew Forum on Religion and Public Life. (2008). U.S. religious landscape survey. Religious affi liation: Diverse and dy- namic. Washington, DC: Author. Avail- able at http://religions. pewforum.org /pdf/report-religious-landscape-study -full.pdf

Pew Forum on Religion and Public Life. (2009). How religious is your state? Available at http://pewforum.org/How -Religious-Is-Your-State-.aspx

REFERENCES

Anandarajah, G., & Hight, E. (2001). Spirituality and medical practice: Using the HOPE questions as a practical tool for spiritual assessment. American Family Physician, 63(1), 81–88.

Association of Religion Data Archives [ARDA]. (n.d.). Quickstats. Available at www.thearda.com/ quickstats/

Barnes, L., & Harris, G. (2001, November/December). A changing medical landscape: Religious pluralism and competent care. The Park Ridge Center Bulletin, 7–8.

Benjamins, M. R., & Brown, C. (2004). Religion and preventative health care utilization among the elderly. Social Science & Medicine, 58, 109–118.

Bresnahan, M. J., & Mahler, K. (2010). Ethical debate over organ donation in the context of brain death. Bioethics, 24(2), 54–60.

Campbell, M. K., Hudson, M. A., Resnicow, K., Blakeney, N., Paxton, A., & Baskin, M. (2007). Church-based health promotion interventions: Evidence and lessons learned. Annual Review of Public Health, 28, 213–234.

Canda, E. R., & Furman, L. D. (2010). Spiritual diversity in social work practice: The heart of helping. New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Centers for Disease Control and Prevention [CDC]. (2010). Diseases & conditions. Available at http:// www.cdc.gov/DiseasesConditions/.

Cloninger, C. R. (2006). The science of well-being: An integrated approach to mental health and its disorders. World Psychiatry, 5(2), 71–76.

Curlin, F. A., Lawrence, R. E., Chin, M. H., & Lantos, J. D. (2007). Religion, conscience, and controversial clinical practices. New England Journal of Medicine, 356(6), 593–600.

Dalmida, S. G., Holstad, M. M., Dilorio, C., & Laderman, G. (2009). Spiritual well-being, depressive symptoms, and immune status among women living with HIV/ AIDS. Women Health, 49(2–3), 119–143.

D’Souza, R. (2007). The importance of spirituality in medicine and its application to clinical practice. Medical Journal of Australia, 186(10), S57–S59.

Duru, O. K., Sarkisian, C. A., Leng, M., & Mangione, C. M. (2010). Sisters in motion: A randomized controlled trial of a faith-based physical activity intervention. Journal of the American Geriatrics Society, 58(10), 1863–1869.

Eck, D. (2001). A new religious America: How a “Christian country” has become the world’s most religiously diverse nation. New York, NY: HarperCollins.

JWBT514_ch11.indd 287JWBT514_ch11.indd 287 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

288 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

Eck, D. (2010). The Pluralism Project at Harvard University. Retrieved from http://pluralism.org/index.php

Eckersley, R. M. (2007). Culture, spirituality, religion and health: Looking at the big picture. Medical Journal of Australia, 186(10), S54–S56.

Enright, R. D., & Coyle, C. T. (1998). Researching the process model of forgiveness within psychological interventions. In Dimensions of Forgiveness: Psychological Research & Theological Forgiveness. E. L. Worthington, (Ed.), pp. 139–161. Philadelphia, PA: Templeton Foundation Press.

Fetzer Institute/National Institute of Aging. (1999). Multidimensional measurement of religiousness/ spirituality for use in health research. Kalamazoo, MI: Fetzer Institute.

Frame, M. W. (2000). The spiritual genogram in family therapy. Journal of Marriage and Family Therapy, 26(2), 211–216.

Frick, E., Riedner, C., Fegg, M., Hauf, S., & Borasio, G. D. (2006). A clinical interview assessing cancer patients’ spiritual needs and preferences. European Journal of Cancer Care, 15, 238–243.

Gaustad, E. S. (1968). America’s institutions of faith. In D. R. Cutler (Ed.), The religious situation: 1968 (pp. 835–870). Boston, MA: Beacon Press.

Gearing, R. E., & Lizardi, D. (2009). Religion and suicide. Journal of Religion and Health, 48(3), 332–341.

George, L. K., Ellision, C. G., & Larson, D. B. (2002). Explaining the relationships between religious involvement and health. Psychological Inquiry, 13(3), 190–200.

George, L. K., Larson, D. B., Koenig, H. G., & McCullough, M. E. (2000). Spirituality and health: What we know, what we need to know. Journal of Social and Clinical Psychology, 19(1), 102–116.

Geyer, A. L., & Baumeister, R. F. (2005). Religion, morality, and self-control: Values, virtues, and vices. In R. F. Paloutzian & C. L. Park (Eds.), Handbook of the Psychology of Religion and Spirituality (pp. 412– 432). New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Griffi th, D. M., Allen, J. O., DeLoney, E. H., Robinson, K., Lewis. E. Y., Campbell, B., . . . Reischl, T. (2010). Community-based organizational capacity building as a strategy to reduce racial health disparities. Journal of Primary Prevention, 31, 31–39.

Hartman, A. (1995). Diagrammatic assessment of family relationships. Families in Society, 76, 111–122.

Hall, D. E., Meador, K. G., & Koenig, H. G. (2008). Measuring religiousness in health research: Review and critique. Journal of Religion and Health, 47(2), 134–163.

Hill, P. C., Pargament, K. I., Swyers, J. P., Gorsuch, R. L., McCullough, M. E., Hood, R. W., . . . Baumeister, R. F. (1998). Defi nitions of religion and spirituality. In D. B. Larson, J. P. Swyers, & M. E. McCullough (Eds.), Scientifi c research on spirituality and health: A consensus report (pp. 14–30). Rockville, MD: National Institute of Healthcare Research.

Hill, P. C., & Hood, R. W., Jr. (1999). Measures of religiosity. Birmingham, AL: Religious Education Press.

Hill, P. C., & Maltby, L. E. (2009). Measuring religiousness and spirituality: Issues, existing measures, and the implications for education and wellbeing. In M. de Souza, L. J. Francis, J. O’Higgins-Norman, & D. Scott (Eds.), International handbook of education for spirituality, care and wellbeing (Vol. 3, pp. 33–50). New York, NY: Springer.

Hodge, D. R. (2000). Spiritual ecomaps: A new diagrammatic tool for assessing marital and family spirituality. Journal of Marital and Family Therapy, 26(2), 217–228.

Hodge, D. R. (2001a). Spiritual assessment: A review of major qualitative methods and a new framework for assessing spirituality. Social Work, 46(3), 203–214.

Hodge, D. R. (2001b). Spiritual genograms: A generational approach to assessing spirituality. Families in Society: Journal of Contemporary Social Services, 82(1), 35–48.

Hodge, D. R. (2005a). Developing a spiritual assessment toolbox: A discussion of the strengths and limitations of fi ve different assessment methods. Health & Social Work, 30(4), 314–323.

Hodge, D. R. (2005b). Spiritual ecograms: A new assessment instrument for identifying clients’ spiritual strengths in space and across time. Families in Society, 86(2), 287–296.

Hodge, D. R. (2005c). Spiritual lifemaps: A client- centered pictorial instrument for spiritual assessment, planning, and intervention. Social Work, 50(1), 77–87.

Hodge, D. R. (2006). A template for spiritual assessment: A review of the JCAHO requirements and guidelines for implementation. Social Work, 51(4), 317–326.

Hood, R. W., Jr., Hill, P. C., & Spilka, B. (2009). Religion, health, psychopathology, and coping. In K. I. Pargament (Ed.), The psychology of religion: An empirical approach (4th ed., pp. 435–476). New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Hook, J. N., Worthington, E. L., Jr., Davis, D. E., Jennings, D. J., II, Gartner, A. L., & Hook, J. P. (2010). Empirically supported religious and spiritual therapies. Journal of Clinical Psychology, 66(1), 46–72.

Hufford, D. J. (2005). An analysis of the fi eld of spirituality, religion and health (S/RH). Retrieved from www .templetonadvancedresearchprogram.com/pdf/TARP -Hufford.pdf

Jennette, C., Vupputuri, S., Hogan, S. L., Falk, R. J., & Harward, D. H. (2010). Community perspectives on kidney disease and health promotion from at-risk populations in rural North Carolina, USA. Rural and Remote Health, 10, 1388.

King, M. B., & Hunt, R. A. (1972). Measuring the religious variable: National replication. Journal for the Scientifi c Study of Religion, 14(1), 13–22.

Koenig, H. G. (2008). Medicine, religion, and health: Where science and spirituality meet. West Conshohocken, PA: Templeton Foundation Press.

JWBT514_ch11.indd 288JWBT514_ch11.indd 288 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Religion, Spirituality, Health, and Social Work 289

Koenig, H. G., & Büssing, A. (2010). The Duke University Religion Index (DUREL): A fi ve-item measure for use in epidemological studies. Religions, 1(1), 78–85.

Koenig, H. G., & Larson, D. B. (2001). Religion and mental health: Evidence for an association. International Review of Psychiatry, 13, 67–78.

Koenig, H. G., McCullough, M. E., & Larson, D. B. (2001). Handbook of religion and health. New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Koenig, H. G., McCullough, M. E., & Larson, D. B. (2011). Handbook of religion and health, 2nd Edition. New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Krause, N. (2004). Religion, aging and health: Exploring new frontiers in medical care. Southern Medical Journal, 97(12), 1215–1222.

Krause, N. M. (2008). Aging in the church: How social relationships affect health. West Conshohocken, PA: Templeton Foundation Press.

Larson, D. B., Swyers, J. P., & McCullough, M. E. (Eds.). (1998). Scientifi c research on spirituality and health: A consensus report. Rockville, MD: National Institute of Health care Research.

Levin, J. S. (2009). How faith heals: A theoretical model. Explore, 5(2), 77–95.

Levin, J. S., & Markides, K. S. (1986). Religious attendance and subjective health. Journal for the Scientifi c Study of Religion, 25(1), 31–40.

Lizardi, D., & Gearing, R. E. (2010). Religion and suicide: Buddhism, Native American and African religions, atheism, and agnostism. Journal of Religion and Health, 49(3), 377–384.

Maselko, J., Kubzansky, L., Kawachi, I., Seeman, T., & Berkman, L. (2007). Religious service attendance and allostatic load among high-functioning elderly. Psychosomatic Medicine, 69, 464–472.

Mayes, S. (2010, January 9). Oregon City trial raises new questions in faith-healing debate. The Oregonian.

McCullough, M. E., Bono, G., & Root, L. M. (2005). Religion and forgiveness. In R. F. Paloutzian & C. L. Park (Eds.), Handbook of the psychology of religion and spirituality (pp. 394–411). New York, NY: Guilford Press.

McGoldrick, M., Gerson, R., & Shellenberger, S. (1999). Genograms: Assessment and intervention (2nd ed.). New York, NY: Norton.

Moreira-Almeida, A. (2007). Spirituality and health: Past and future of a controversial and challenging relationship. Revista de Psiquiatria Clinica, 34(S1), 3–4.

National Association of Social Workers. (2001). NASW Standards for cultural competence in social work practice. Washington, DC: Author. Available at www.socialworkers.org/ practice/standards/NASW CulturalStandards.pdf

National Association of Social Workers. (2003). NASW Standards for social work in long-term care facilities. Washington, DC: Author. Available at www.socialworkers.org/ practice/standards/NASW LongTermStandards.pdf

National Association of Social Workers. (2005a). NASW Standards for social work practice with clients with substance use disorders. Washington, DC: Author. Available at www.socialworkers.org/practice/standards /NASWATODStatndards.pdf

National Association of Social Workers. (2005b). NASW Standards for social work practice in health care settings. Washington, DC: Author. Available at www.socialworkers.org/practice/standards/NASW HealthCareStandards.pdf

National Association of Social Workers. (2007). Indicators for the achievement of the NASW Standards for cultural competence in social work practice. Washington, DC: Author. Available at www.socialworkers.org/practice /standards/NASWCulturalStandards Indicators2006 .pdf

National Cancer Institute. (2009). Spirituality in cancer care (PDQ®): Health professional version. Bethesda, MD: National Cancer Institute. Retrieved from http://cancer.gov/cancertopics/pdq/supportivecare /spirituality/HealthProfessional

National Cancer Institute. (2010). Spirituality in cancer care (PDQ®): Health professional version. Retrieved from www.cancer.gov/cancertopics/pdq /supportivecare/spirituality/HealthProfessional /allpages

Nelson-Becker, H., Nakashima, M., & Canda, E. R. (2007). Spiritual assessment in aging: A framework for clinicians. Journal of Gerontological Social Work, 2(3/4), 331–347.

Oman, D., & Thoreson, C. E. (2005). Do religion and spirituality infl uence health? In R. F. Paloutzian & C. L. Park (Eds.), Handbook of the psychology of religion and spirituality (pp. 435–459). New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Pargament, K. I. (1997). The psychology of religion and coping: Theory, research, practice. New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Park, C. L. (2007). Religiousness/spirituality and health: A meaning systems perspective. Journal of Behavioral Health, 30, 319–328.

Pew Forum on Religion and Public Life. (2009). How religious is your state? Retrieved from http:// pewforum.org/How-Religious-Is-Your-State-.aspx

Pond, A., Smith, G., & Clement, S. (2010). Religion among the Millennials: Less religiously active than older Americans, but fairly traditional in other ways. Washington, DC: Pew Forum on Religion & Public Life. Available at: http://pewforum.org /docs/?DocID=510

Powell, L. H., Shahabi, L., & Thoreson, C. E. (2003). Religion and spirituality: Linkages to physical health. American Psychologist, 58(1), 36–52.

Puchalski, C. M. (2001). The role of spirituality in health care. Baylor University Medical Center Proceedings, 14(4), 352–357.

Puchalski, C. M. (2004). A conversation with Dr. Christina Puchalski. Spirituality and Health International, 5(2), 82–87.

JWBT514_ch11.indd 289JWBT514_ch11.indd 289 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

290 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

Puchalski, C., & Romer, A. L. (2000). Taking a spiritual history allows clinicians to understand patients more fully. Journal of Palliative Medicine, 3(1), 129–137.

Qaseem, A., Snow, V., Shekelle, P., Casey, D. E., Jr., Cross, J. T., Jr., & Owens, D. (2008). Evidence- based interventions to improve the palliative care of pain, dyspnea, and depression at the end of life: A clinical practice guideline from the American College of Physicians. Annals of Internal Medicine, 148, 141–146.

Röcklinsberg, H. (2009). The complex use of religion in decisions on organ transplantation. Journal of Religion and Health, 48(1), 62–78.

Royal College of Psychiatrists. (2010). Spirituality and mental health. Retrieved from http://www.rcpsych .ac.uk/mentalhealthinfo/treatments/spirituality.aspx

Scott, A. B.  (1997).  Categorizing defi nitions of religion and spirituality in the psychological literature: A content analytic approach. Unpublished Manuscript.

Smith, T. W. (2002). Religious diversity in America: The emergence of Muslims, Buddhists, Hindus, and others [GSS Social Change Report No. 4]. Chicago,

IL: National Opinion Research Center. Retrieved from http://publicdata.norc.org:41000/ gss/DOCUMENTS /REPORTS/Social_Change_Reports/SC47.pdf

Smith, T. W. (2009). Religious change around the world [Report for the Templeton Foundation]. Chicago, IL: National Opinion Research Center/University of Chicago. Available at: http://news.uchicago.edu/fi les /religionsurvey_20091023.pdf

Substance Abuse and Mental Health Services Administration. (2006). National consensus statement on mental health recovery. Retrieved from http://store .samhsa.gov/ shin/content//SMA05–4129/SMA05 –4129.pdf

Veenhoven, R. (2003). Findings on happiness & religion [World Database on Happiness]. Retrieved from http:// publishing.eur.nl/ir/repub/asset/655/ Religion.pdf

World Health Organization. (1998). WHOQOL and spirit- uality, religiousness and personal beliefs: Report on WHO consultation. Geneva, Switzerland: Author.

WHOQOL SRPB Group. (2006). A cross-cultural study of spirituality, religion, and personal beliefs as components of quality of life. Social Science & Medicine, 62(6), 1486–1497.

JWBT514_ch11.indd 290JWBT514_ch11.indd 290 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

291

12

Developing a Shared Understanding: When Medical Patients Use Complementary and Alternative Approaches

PENNY B. BLOCK

The use of alternative medicine in this coun- try represents neither a passing trend nor a marginal sociological phenomenon. National surveys conducted in the 1990s trumpeted the substantial and escalating use of alterna- tive treatments among Americans but profi led the typical user of such care by drawing from a limited population sampling, thus misiden- tifying the adults who seek such therapies as primarily White, middle-age females with higher education and income (Astin, 1998b; Eisenberg et al., 1993, 1998). A later correc- tive report that relied on data representative of wider demographics came up with a differ- ent conclusion: Use of at least one alternative therapy was prevalent across all ethnic groups, income levels, and age ranges (MacKenzie, Taylor, Bloom, Hufford, & Johnson, 2003). Only the patterns of preferred healing mo- dalities varied among different ethnic groups; these fi ndings were echoed by comparable conclusions from a later analysis (Hsiao et al., 2006). To be truly effective in our professional role with ethnically and socially diverse cli- ents and to respond with genuine respect and helpful sensitivity to individuals from many cultural backgrounds presenting in a medi- cal setting, it is essential to reach beyond our own predominantly biomedical backgrounds and augment our understanding of divergent health philosophies and practices. Knowing about and demonstrating regard for noncon- ventional modalities that are important to

clients is a precondition to developing con- fi dence, trust, and mutual respect. Doing so should help engage clients and patients in the cooperative planning of their treatment strategy by bridging conventional thinking with individual health beliefs and strengthen therapeutic alliances that enhance adherence to comprehensive and individually meaningful medical treatments. Moreover, when informed about benefi cial synergies or problematic in- teractions among therapies, social workers can coordinate services for optimal health care more completely.

Chapter Objectives • Learn about the patterns and prevalence of

alternative and complementary use among different populations.

• Distinguish alternative, complementary, and integrative categories.

• Discuss divergent health models and thera- pies grouped under the alternative umbrella.

• Understand the rationale for use of alternative therapies, examples of supporting research, and effective applications.

• Learn about potentials for engaging clients in an open discussion about their personal health practices.

• Identify appropriate applications of mind– body strategies as stress-mitigating tools.

• Provide resources for more detailed in- formation and evaluation of nonallopathic therapies.

JWBT514_ch12.indd 291JWBT514_ch12.indd 291 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

292 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

ALTERNATIVE AND COMPLEMENTARY PRACTICES IN THE UNITED STATES

Although some experts have predicted that the popularity of unconventional practices might fade, increasing numbers of Americans are seeking health treatments outside modern Western medicine. Adults across the United States schedule more sessions with noncon- ventional providers (600 million annually) than medical visits with physicians. In the 1998 follow-up to their eye-opening 1993 re- port, Eisenberg and colleagues documented a 25% increase in the use of alternatives among Americans, expanding from 33% in 1990 to 42.1% in 1997. During this same time period, the number of estimated annual visits to un- conventional practitioners swelled from 427 million to 629 million, an upsurge of 47.3%, or a projected 243 million more visits than to all U.S. primary care physicians that same year. This escalating trend continued so that by 2002, national surveys indicated that 74.6% of U.S. adults had used at least one form of com- plementary and alternative medicine (CAM) (Barnes, Powell-Griner, McFann, & Nahin, 2004). The concomitant fi nancial outlay had become substantial. Refl ecting only data from 1997, those Americans using alternative care were spending approximately $27 billion, which was not reimbursed, on unconventional therapies—up 45.2% from 1990, a total that slightly exceeded out-of-pocket expenditures on total physician services (Eisenberg et al., 1998). Later surveys revealed that 33.9 billion out-of-pocket dollars had been spent by U.S. adults for CAM treatments during the preced- ing 12 months alone (Nahin, Barnes, Stussman, & Bloom, 2009). In a sample of 453 patients with different cancer diagnoses, 69% reported using at least one type of nonstandard practice or product within the preceding year (Spar- ber et al., 2000). Variant rates appear in the records for pediatric use, with some surveys showing approximately 21% of parents treat- ing their children with alternative or comple- mentary practices but seeking unconventional

modalities for 73% of children diagnosed with cancer (Noonan, 2002).

Represented in these surveys were a range of relaxation techniques, herbal treatments, massage therapies, chiropractic practices, spir- itual healing, megavitamins, self-help groups, imagery, dietary plans and other lifestyle pro- grams, folk remedies, energy healing, homeop- athy, hypnosis, biofeedback, and acupuncture (Eisenberg et al., 1998). Although biofeed- back, hypnosis, guided imagery, relaxation techniques, lifestyle, diet, and vitamin supple- mentation fall closer to conventional medicine on a continuum (i.e., seem more readily ac- cepted by mainstream medicine for specifi c chronic conditions), these therapies accounted for less than 10% of alternative practitioner visits (Eisenberg et al., 1998). What usually propels people toward modalities outside the conventional armamentarium are chronic dis- orders unrelieved by allopathic methods (e.g., back problems, allergies, fatigue, arthritis, headaches, neck problems, high blood pres- sure, insomnia, skin problems, digestive dif- fi culties, depression, anxiety), but unremitting back pain or annoying allergies top the list as the disorders most commonly treated with un- conventional techniques (Eskinazi, 1998).

These combined data refl ect a consumer- driven revolution in the health-care system that seems to be gaining momentum—not a simple fascination with exotic practices or passing fad but a manifestation of the growing public de- mand for a broader medical armamentarium than the more limited inventory in the conven- tional medicine cabinet. In response to rather startling survey data and certain political pres- sures, a 1998 congressional mandate led the Na- tional Institutes of Health (NIH) to redesign its Offi ce of Alternative Medicine to the National Center for Complementary and Alternative Medicine (NCCAM) with a budget that grew from an initial $2 million (1992 total) to more than $100 million allocated to research the ef- fi cacy and safety of alternative treatments and to develop a public clearinghouse of information (Goldberg, Anderson, & Trivieri, 2002). Federal appropriations for NCCAM grants continued to expand gradually so that by 2010, they had

JWBT514_ch12.indd 292JWBT514_ch12.indd 292 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Developing a Shared Understanding 293

reached $125,471,000, representing an increase of 2.7% over what had been allocated in 2009.

Even with a surge in patient use of noncon- ventional therapies in conjunction with a con- tinuation of conventional treatments, only a small proportion of patients actually divulged or discussed their use of these alternatives with their medical doctor. The 1998 report revealed that 1 in 3 adults consulting a conventional doc- tor for a serious condition simultaneously uti- lized an alternative therapy, but less than 40% of those patients ever mentioned such thera- pies to their physicians; specifi cally, 39.8% of alternative therapies were disclosed to physi- cian in 1990, with a slight downward trend to 38.5% in 1997 (see Table 12.1). A follow-up 2008 paper emphasized that as many as 72% of Americans never revealed their use of CAM therapies. The authors of this study empha- sized that the percentage of disclosure was es- timated to be substantially lower among racial/ ethnic minorities (Chao, Wade, & Kronenberg, 2008). What is perhaps even more problem- atic is a 1994 assessment that indicated that 83% of those diagnosed with a serious medi- cal condition combined unconventional along with conventional treatment but often did so surreptitiously—that is, 72% of these patients withheld this information from their doctor (Brown, Cassileth, Lewis, & Renner, 1994). Believing that their primary care physician would not be interested or approve and thus would dismiss CAM practices summarily, or feeling too embarrassed and deeming their traditional or alternative practices irrelevant to medical dialogue, many patients will not broach the subject in medical consultations (Brown et al., 1994; Richardson, Sanders, Palmer, Greisinger, & Singletary, 2000). Chao and colleagues (2008) found that most patients would discuss their nonconventional practices more readily and openly if they perceived this discussion would be acceptable to their phy- sicians. Disclosure of CAM utilization might well affect treatment outcomes by virtue of physicians being biased against complemen- tary and alternative practices.

Accompanying this picture of nondisclo- sure and contributing to legitimate medical

worry are statistics showing soaring herbal use. The percentage of Americans taking herbal remedies almost quadrupled in 1998– 2008, and growth in high-dose vitamin supple- mentation has surged 130%, which Sullivan (2000) speculates places an estimated 15 mil- lion adults taking prescription medicines con- currently with supplemental agents at risk for possible adverse interactions. Specifi c supple- ments possibly could produce drug-action in- hibition, substantial interference with effi cacy, or magnifi cation of the bioavailability of cer- tain pharmaceuticals, resulting in serious com- plications that demand attention. Too often, contraindicated practices remain unknown and unaccounted for in the medical setting. It is here, at the nexus of alternative use and medical implications, that the social worker, intervening on behalf of the patient as liaison/ coordinating presence with the medical pro- vider, is so critical to the larger health needs of individual clients.

ALTERNATIVE USE AMONG ETHNIC MINORITIES

One fi nding echoed in several surveys but in- consistent with expectations is that alternative use is uncommon among ethnic minorities. Al- though Eisenberg and colleagues’ data (1993, 1998) described the typical CAM user as White, female, and of higher educational and socioeconomic status (SES), this description belies what we know from ethnomedicine and

Table 12.1 Reasons for Nondisclosure of Complementary Therapies Utilization

Not important for doctor to know 61%

Doctor never asked 60%

None of doctor’s business 31%

Doctor wouldn’t understand 20%

Doctor would disapprove or discourage use of alternatives

14%

Source: From “Perceptions about Complementary Therapies Relative to Conventional Therapies Among Adults Who Use Both: Results from a National Survey,” by D. M. Eisenberg et al., 2001, Annals of Internal Medicine, 135(5), 344–351.

JWBT514_ch12.indd 293JWBT514_ch12.indd 293 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

294 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

is contradicted by data in medical anthropol- ogy research (Barnes et al., 2004; Becerra & Iglehart, 1995; Hsiao et al., 2006; MacKenzie et al., 2003; Ni, Simile, & Hardy, 2002) and experience with populations using traditional healing techniques (Culliton & Kiresuk, 1996). The Eisenberg teams acknowledged that their database was neither suffi ciently large nor ad- equately inclusive of different ethnicities to refl ect minority use (MacKenzie et al., 2003). Even though the Eisenberg team (1998) re- ported that the typical users of CAM—48% of those surveyed—were in a higher income bracket (with an annual income of $50,000 or more), their data revealed that 43% of those utilizing CAM interventions were in the low- est income bracket (earning less than $20,000 annually). In addition, the three earlier national surveys of CAM trends (Astin, 1998a; Eisen- berg et al., 1993, 1998) were conducted only in English, whereas MacKenzie and colleagues’ 2003 data relied on surveys conducted in multiple languages (e.g., Spanish, Mandarin, Cantonese, Vietnamese, Korean). Analyzing the 1995 National Comparative Survey of Mi- nority Health Care, the MacKenzie team found that use of nonstandard approaches did not dif- fer by ethnicity; 43.1% of adults surveyed used at least one such therapy with no statistically signifi cant difference in percentage of use among African Americans, Hispanic Ameri- cans, Asian Americans, Native Americans, and non-Hispanic Whites. With their analysis, they concluded that earlier prevalence stud- ies that reported that CAM practices were not medically signifi cant among ethnic minorities, and especially among lower-SES populations, were as a result inaccurate. Only preferences for specifi c alternatives—categorized as herbal medicines, acupuncture, chiropractic, tradi- tional healer, and home remedies—were found to vary among ethnic populations (e.g., using herbal formulations was more common or popular among Asian and Native Americans, whereas White Americans were found to use chiropractic services more frequently). Even with MacKenzie and colleagues’ recharacter- ization of CAM demographics, surveys may be prone to underestimation because some

cultural traditions consider home remedies such as special foods, botanicals, herbals, and spices as the norm and thus do not report them as “alternative” (Committee on the Use of Complementary and Alternative Medicine by the American Public, 2005).

The MacKenzie investigation clearly as- serts that aggregate statistics of alternative and complementary use, ignoring divergent mo- dalities, obscure actual usage among different minorities. For data to mirror the true profi le of users, surveys must distinguish divergent practices lumped summarily under the CAM umbrella (see Table 12.2).

CAM use, they conclude, does not belong to any single demographic—not ethnicity, in- come, age, or being foreign-born predicted

Table 12.2 Patterns of Alternative Use Among Racial Groups

Categories of Practice Prevalence of Use

Herbal medicines Asian Americans 3 times more likely than White Americans to use Latino Americans 2 times more likely than White Americans to use African Americans 1.5 times more likely than White Americans to use

Acupuncture Asian Americans 12.84 times more likely than White American counterparts Uninsured respondents 2 times higher rate than insured

Traditional healera Beyond high school education—about 3 times more likely

Home remedy African Americans 1.24 times more likely to use than White Americans Women 1.24 times more likely to use than men Uninsured 1.5 times more likely to use than insured

a This label is more academic than commonly used and understood terms such as curandero (medicine man or root-worker).

Source: From “Ethnic Minority Use of Complementary and Alternative Medicine (CAM): A National Probability Survey of Cam Utilizers,” by E. R. MacKenzie, L. Taylor, B. S. Bloom, D. J. Hufford, and J. C. Johnson, 2003, Alternative Therapies, 9(4), 50–56.

JWBT514_ch12.indd 294JWBT514_ch12.indd 294 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Developing a Shared Understanding 295

use—so understanding these various prac- tices and their true prevalence is essential to the delivery of culturally competent medical care. Even with their more complete detail- ing, the MacKenzie team (2003) noted cer- tain defi cits that skewed their accounting. For example, they did not survey religious or spiritual healing practices, keystones of most traditional medicines, or home remedies and special diets. In addition, the label traditional healer—more of an academic reference than the common terms used in different ethnic circles, such as curandero, “medicine man” or “root-worker”—might not have elicited true numbers of followers because of the un- familiar terminology. Beyond its particulars, MacKenzie and colleagues’ (2003) message is a compelling reminder that medicine is al- ways a cultural construct, that the biomedical model is but one paradigm that originated in European science, and that many Americans continue to follow health-care approaches that emerged from nonallopathic medical phi- losophies. As a fi nal caution, having data on ethnic patterns of medical preferences is es- sential but should not blind the social worker to individual divergences from cultural norms, which can be identifi ed only with appropriate questions through supportive inquiry (Becerra & Iglehart, 1995; Krajewski-Jaime, 1991; Pachter, 1994).

DEFINITION OF TERMS: DISTINCTIONS AMONG ALTERNATIVE, COMPLEMENTARY, AND INTEGRATIVE

Alternative, complementary, and integrative are labels often used loosely and interchange- ably to refer to nonstandard medical practices. But this changing, elusive, and overlapping terminology perpetuates confusion and im- precision in efforts to distinguish the merits of different practices. Surprisingly, despite the swelling proportion of Americans seeking nonconventional therapies in the past decade,

a governmental agency dedicated to studying such treatments with vast expansion in fed- eral funding for this purpose, and signifi cant growth of insurance coverage, no clear or con- sistent defi nition of alternative medicine has emerged. Experts still fumble with negative conceptualizations, the most prominent ex- ample of which is what is not taught in U.S. medical schools and what is not insurance re- imbursed (Eisenberg et al., 1993). Yet even by 1997, several insurance carriers had initiated cost coverage for certain alternative practices (Wetzel, Eisenberg, & Kaptchuk, 1998), and in 2002, complementary and alternative course- work appeared in the curriculum of 98 out of 125 medical schools (Barzansky & Etzel, 2003).

Using terminology such as alternative, un- conventional, and unproven to indicate prac- tices outside the armamentarium of Western medicine implicitly censures such therapies (Scholten & Van Rompay, 2000). What words connote can subtly but effectively sabotage or substantially infl uence acceptance and cred- ibility. For example, using the label orthodox to identify the currently dominant medical sys- tem in the United States confers automatic au- thority because the words accepted, approved, established, and standard are understood as synonyms for orthodox. Even the word bio- medical presumes that all practices under this umbrella are based on scientifi c confi rmation, obscuring other evidence that the human or- ganism is more than a biochemical entity and obviating the value of mind–body approaches (MacIntosh, 1999). The next discussion is of- fered to help unravel the tangled meanings of the terms alternative, complementary, and integrative so that professional dialogue with colleagues and conversations with clients will be less susceptible to misinterpretation.

Alternative Medicine

Alternative medicine is not a singular practice or tradition but divergent systems and prac- tices of health care that emerge from widely disparate medical philosophies. Alternative medical systems are complete diagnostic and treatment approaches with distinctive

JWBT514_ch12.indd 295JWBT514_ch12.indd 295 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

296 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

theoretical foundations, such as those tradi- tional to non-Western cultures (e.g., traditional Chinese medicine [TCM] and Ayurveda) and those developed in Western cultures (e.g., homeopathy and naturopathic medicine). In distinction, alternative practices are specifi c discrete treatments or modalities independent of comprehensive or coherent medical schema (MacIntosh, 1999). The chief commonality connecting disparate alternative practices and systems is that they differ in some obvious re- spect from modern biomedicine and therefore are seen as challenges to the prevailing medical paradigm. Indeed, the term alternative often is employed to indicate medical practices used in place of modern medical treatments (e.g., iridology used as diagnostic technique instead of conventional blood assays).

Beyond the defi ning characteristic of alter- natives just mentioned, there are several more positive, shared premises. For one thing, these alternative modalities see the human organism as an indivisible system, an ecological whole. This is the fundamental assumption that body, mind, and spirit are not separable but dynami- cally interconnected, stimulating the healing process as a unifi ed system. In distinction, the Western medical model presumes that the psyche and soma are separate entities to be treated independently; it is believed that a disor- der of one organ is not interrelated with the dys- function of another. Also, in biomedicine, the body as a machine with interworking but semi- independent anatomic parts is assumed and re- fl ected in specialties of medicine that commonly do not interact. Also, alternative practices share a core belief in the body’s inherent potential for self-healing with medical regimens designed to encourage and support that process.

Next, the primary objectives of alternative methods are optimal health and total heal- ing, not elimination of symptoms and signs of the presenting complaint. Western medi- cine maintains a fi xation on physical sickness; the concepts of disease and restoring health, however, are not the same thing. Jonas (1998) refers to this nonallopathic emphasis on health as “salutogenesis” compared to the biomedi- cal fi xation on “pathogenesis.” Furthermore,

traditional systems presuppose that ill health results from a disturbance or imbalance in life force or energy (e.g., qi, pronounced “chee,” in China, ki in Korea and Japan, prana in India, and “vital force” in homeopathy or other tradi- tional Western systems) for which there is no Western anatomical equivalent. Restoring that balance will reestablish health in all dimen- sions of being. Alternative practices also share the principle of the patient’s active engagement or partnership in the healing process. In addi- tion, they share an assumption that spirituality is inseparable from physical and psychological health and is critical to a full resolution of what Western physicians diagnose and treat solely as a biological disorder (see full discussion in Chapter 11). This spiritual underpinning of al- ternative practices is refl ective of each culture’s dominant religious and cosmological beliefs; for example, TCM is connected to Taoism, Ay- urveda rests on the Hindu belief system, and Tibetan medicine is congruent with specifi c Buddhist precepts (Eskinazi, 1998).

In some cases, what is casually labeled as alternative actually may mesh effectively with the dominant model of medicine (e.g., hydrazine sulfate treatments for cancer) and therefore may be considered more accurately a complementary adjunct. The same allopathic paradigm still determines the architecture of care, with an herbal or botanical medicament substituted or added alongside a convention- ally prescribed drug, but the diagnostic cat- egories and essential treatment planning is consistent with orthodox Western medicine (Pietroni, 1994).

Complementary Approaches

As certain alternatives (e.g., acupuncture, mind/body techniques including meditation, relaxation and biofeedback, chiropractic, massage therapies) gained access to modern medical centers/medical mainstream, new sta- tus brought new nomenclature (Brown et al., 1994). Complementary medicine—actually a misnomer—is not a comprehensive system of health care but a heterogeneous assortment of hundreds of treatment modalities lumped

JWBT514_ch12.indd 296JWBT514_ch12.indd 296 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Developing a Shared Understanding 297

under one categorical label. These therapies are used in conjunction with, rather than in lieu of, conventional treatments and often are implemented to relieve discomfort or sec- ondary consequences of modern medical in- terventions (i.e., specifi c herbals used with prescription drug therapies to help mitigate untoward effects, relaxation strategies to ac- company and alleviate symptomatic distress of surgery or chemotherapy). When applied, the model that prevails over the implementa- tion of complementary treatments is still the Western medical paradigm (Pietroni, 1994). Although many times used interchangeably with the word alternative, complementary by defi nition means something that completes or provides what is lacking (Merriam-Webster, 2003), whereas alternative indicates some- thing that is mutually exclusive of, “offering a choice between two incompatible courses.” If what was judged alternative is brought in- house—joined to mainstream medicine pro- tocols—and institutionalized, it is assigned a peripheral or ancillary role and therefore is no longer perceived as competitive or challenging to the dominant medical model. Complemen- tary is more a designation that identifi es the relationship of diverse treatments to the pre- vailing health system than a term that actually describes different healing techniques.

In records of CAM usage, the most com- mon health complaints have been disorders that seem unremitting, such as chronic back pain, insomnia, arthritic problems, headaches, musculoskeletal diffi culties, and psychological distress (Campion, 1993; Institute of Medicine, 2005). Among those who do seek CAM thera- pies for more severe health concerns, a large majority (83%) continue treatment with their standard provider, but 85% of those using non- standard therapies choose not to inform their physicians they have done so (Eisenberg et al., 2001). At the time of the Cassileth, Luck, Strouse, and Bodenheimer paper (1984), 60% of CAM practitioners were physicians—that is, those providing unorthodox therapies were not stereotypical untrained charlatans; this proportion has increased steadily, but few CAM practitioners are oncologists (Cassileth

& Chapman, 1996). It is when conventional and nonstandard treatment are uncoordinated that CAM can prove most harmful.

CAM practices are a frequent choice for pa- tients diagnosed with cancer (Campion, 1993; Eisenberg et al., 2001; Ernst & Cassileth, 1998). According to Campion’s (1993) report, a full 58% were convinced that such treatments likely would provide a cure. Even data from 1984 revealed that 54% of patients surveyed in a major U.S. cancer center were CAM adher- ents, but at least 40% of patients at that cen- ter at one point had abandoned their standard medical treatments to pursue CAM exclusively (Cassileth & Chapman, 1996). A systematic review found that the proportion of cancer patients using an amalgam of CAM and con- ventional treatments—either simultaneously or sequentially—was 64% (Ernst & Cassileth, 1998). In another survey of cancer patients que- ried soon after completing chemotherapy, 91% reported routinely utilizing at least one CAM modality during their treatment cycles (Yates et al., 2005). Certainly a major concern arises if patients desert potentially effective conven- tional care, opting to use only alternatives, even ones that as complements could prove truly helpful, because these patients could lose their way on an unnecessarily perilous treat- ment path. Most analyses seem to concur that CAM applications—including diet therapies; healing relaxation programs; metabolic thera- pies; acupuncture; homeopathy; manual and body therapies; vitamin, herbal, and botanicals or other supplemented compounds (e.g., Isca- dor, a proprietary cancer treatment formulation derived from mistletoe)—represent a global phenomenon. Eisenberg acknowledges CAM as an “invisible mainstream” within current health care (Cassileth, 1998; Eisenberg, 1997).

Integrative Medicine

Integrative medicine, a term in current parlance, designates an approach to health care that combines, in careful treatment programming, mainstream medical treatments and certain com- plementary therapies that have demonstrated safety and potential effi cacy. Not a specifi c

JWBT514_ch12.indd 297JWBT514_ch12.indd 297 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

298 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

traditional system of health care based on a distinguishing philosophical or theoretical foundation, integrative medicine is used by pro- viders who are formally trained in allopathic therapies and equally profi cient in or knowl- edgeable about relevant alternative modalities. To produce a truly melded protocol of integra- tive care, practitioners must be fully versed in and able to anticipate positive synergies as well as problematic interactions that can occur when previously unfused therapies are combined. Even though it is not a single system of medi- cine, there are certain consistent, identifi able standards of care in this medical fi eld. A true integrative approach requires a systematic fu- sion of conventional and alternative treatments intended to marshal the body’s own recovery processes; it maintains an openness to para- digms other than Western allopathy, focuses on the larger goal of optimal health beyond ame- liorating specifi c disease issues, and begins by creating a partnership of provider and patient. This last principle echoes and is consistent with one of the key practice tenets of social work, re- affi rming the true professional fi t for the health- care social worker in the integrative sphere.

Proponents postulate therapeutic advan- tages if regimens are integrated properly and tailored to each individual’s particular health needs. What is required are treatment plans for individual patients that rely on a sound coupling of therapies from both conventional protocols (e.g., prescription medications) and alternative practices (e.g., herbal/botanical agents), a melding guided by evidence-based information, and a watchful eye to potentially problematic interactions (certain combinations contraindicated because of specifi cs about medical status of a patient or intervention). The totality of an integrative program can yield a better-than-sum-of-its-parts outcome; that is, a comprehensive and coherent treatment plan can produce full synergistic benefi ts beyond mere adjunctive add-ons of disconnected, ex- otic practices. Nevertheless, an unanswered conundrum hovers over the enthusiasm of in- tegrative intentions: Can systems shaped by dissimilar, nonparallel paradigms of health and healing ever be fully blended?

REASONS FOR SEEKING ALTERNATIVE TREATMENTS

More than a decade after the Eisenberg and colleagues’ initial report (1993), the disagree- ment surrounding actual determinants of CAM still smolders. Discussing this dispute does not simply serve in the interest of debate or polem- ics but familiarizes us with proposed reasons to encourage an open but knowledgeable discus- sion with patients, to act as an informed liaison between patients and the medical team, and to impact an administrative response to cultural and medical pluralism in effective programs.

Some argue, based on results from surveys, that dissatisfaction with orthodox treatments is not a signifi cant predictor of alternative usage. Astin (1998a) cites data showing that 54% of those using alternatives reported feeling very satisfi ed with their conventional experience. Astin’s conclusion supports a “philosophi- cal congruence theory.” That is, patients felt aligned with comprehensive treatments de- signed to promote health rather than oriented wholly on pathology and disease and with ap- proaches that value dietary, mind–spirit, and lifestyle factors in self-care programs. From this perspective, modern medicine represents a necessary but insuffi cient response to health concerns.

Others contend that even philosophical congruence can be construed as an indicator of disappointment with orthodox care. Although most users of CAM are not distrustful of or totally displeased with mainstream medical treatments, many would concur that electing to use an alternative implicitly signifi es some dissatisfaction with results of the conventional armamentarium—that conventional therapies have not been fully effective, prompting the pa- tient to seek other and more (Baldwin, 1998). From this perspective, electing CAM therapies suggests that even if patients do not eschew conventional interventions, they are not fully pleased with their experience in mainstream medical facilities. It has been argued that be- cause Astin (1998b) did not include a direct question about perceived effi cacy (i.e., “Has conventional treatment worked for you?”) and

JWBT514_ch12.indd 298JWBT514_ch12.indd 298 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Developing a Shared Understanding 299

because satisfaction with treatment is a pri- mary determinant of each individual’s medi- cal choice, Astin’s conclusions are based on inadequate data. In Baldwin’s words, “patients in general would not part with good money unless they felt they were getting better re- sults outside conventional health care” (1998, p. 1660).

Although standard Western medicine is un- paralleled at crisis intervention—trauma and emergency care—and battling microbial dis- ease, it has been less successful at identifying how to achieve and maintain optimal health or how to respond to unalleviated chronic ailments: problems that fail to disappear. No doubt the drive toward CAM can be very id- iosyncratic, but certain recurring themes lead people to unorthodox practices:

1. Discomfort with an impersonal quality per- vasive in institutional settings

2. Discontent with technological procedures that presume a mechanistic and reduc- tionistic model of human health (Borins, 2002)

3. Unresolved chronic medical problems (e.g., arthritis and allergies that often do not respond to conventional interventions) and reduced faith in the ability of medical breakthroughs to eliminate vexing health concerns (Jonas, 1998; Testerman, Morton, Mason, & Ronan, 2004)

4. Growing fascination in spiritual dimensions of health

5. Mounting unease about the toxic potential and adverse consequences of invasive medi- cal practices (Jonas, 1998) combined with confi dence in lower toxicity and greater safety of most alternative treatments

6. The repeated experience of dispiriting or perfunctory communications from medical providers

7. The desire to regain a modicum of personal control over the direction and process of care

This last reason—the intent to reclaim responsibility for treatment decisions and

medical care rather than remain passive re- cipients of medical interventions and invasive technology—frequently propels cancer pa- tients toward nonstandard practices (Lerner & Kennedy, 1992). Beyond avoidance of dreaded side effects and iatrogenic consequences, many people diagnosed with a malignancy suspect that pollution, dietary patterns, and stressors are implicated in the etiology of their disease; the logical recovery strategy requires altering food intake and a personal regimen of lifestyle adjustments (Borins, 2002). Fur- ther motivating cancer patients to adopt CAM practices is a desire to augment biological factors deemed vital in battling malignancy to mitigate symptoms, such as fatigue, pain, and nausea; diminish side effects; and en- hance emotional well-being (Molassiotis et al., 2005). Although 43% of patients believed that their supplement programs were a truly effective tactic in their cancer battle (Cassileth et al., 1984), when cancer patients elect al- ternative or complementary modalities, they usually do not limit CAM options to a sin- gular practice. The likelihood of CAM use is heightened the longer a patient has been dealing with their cancer (Lerner & Ken- nedy, 1992). In addition, oncology patients choose these combination therapies because conventional treatments hold out poor cure and remission statistics—very bleak show- ings on desired outcomes—and seem unable to deliver desired outcome. All of these rea- sons indicate dissatisfaction, if not total disil- lusionment (Borins, 2002; Lerner & Kennedy, 1992). Added to these issues is an increasing frustration among patients—and substantial numbers of doctors—with their experience in standard medicine, perpetuated by a man- aged care economics that permits too little physician time and encourages a system that often feels impersonal (Weil, 2001). There- fore, although most users of alternatives may not be truly distrustful of mainstream medical treatment—and in fact stay with conventional regimens simultaneous to alternative and complementary modalities—neither are they fully satisfi ed with the results of their conven- tional modalities.

JWBT514_ch12.indd 299JWBT514_ch12.indd 299 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

300 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

SYSTEMS AND PRACTICES

Learning the divergent cultural models of health and medicine that are the philosophical underpinnings of specifi c alternative interven- tions is as critical for social workers as is be- coming familiar with names and types of single practices, agents, or therapies. Traditional or indigenous health-care systems emerge from centuries-old philosophical principles and fundamentals of health care that differ ap- preciably from those underlying the model of biomedicine. They developed from ancient texts and medical ideologies embedded in and refl ective of the specifi c traditions and societal and spiritual beliefs of each culture.

Traditional Chinese Medicine

In the traditional Chinese medical system, health is understood as the unimpeded fl ow of vital energy (qi) traveling through a network of bioelectrical pathways that have no exact correlate in the Western model of anatomy. In addition, health implies a balance of op- posed universal forces of yin and yang within all systems—body, mind, and spirit—and with the larger external environment. To reestablish balance and optimize health, traditional Chi- nese doctors prescribe a complex regimen of dietary adjustments, meditative physical exer- cises (e.g., tai chi, qi gong), specifi c massage treatments, herbal formulations, and acupunc- ture. These recommendations are tailored to match the individual’s diagnosis (e.g., hot liver excess; TCM diagnoses bear no exact corre- spondence to Western disease categories) and are determined by pulse evaluations (again, unlike Western pulse taking or blood pressure readings) and other signature indicators (e.g., tongue signs, vocal tone, skin quality). In diag- nosis, the practitioner identifi es the underlying cause of body’s pattern of disharmony that is unique to that individual and at that time. For example, an individual diagnosed as suffering from cold-defi ciency disease will be placed on a regimen of specifi c foods known as body heating (not synonymous with temperature, but a quality believed to strengthen the blood).

Acupuncture

Because disrupted energy fl ow is understood as the basis of disease, acupuncture treatment involves the insertion of very thin needles at blockage junctures or specifi c meridian points to release or restore fl ow of energy through channels or meridians. It is theorized that there are more than 2,000 points connected to par- ticular organ systems. Although deemed alter- native in the United States, acupuncture is a traditional, standard healing practice in China, with origins in the classic text of Chinese med- icine, the Nei Ching (ca. 2500 b.c.). Currently it is the most commonly used medical practice worldwide, applied as a full diagnostic and healing treatment in Asian cultures (Gerber, 1988; NCCAM, 2000).

A report published in 1998 calculated that more than 5 million visits are made to acupunc- ture practitioners annually in the United States (Eisenberg et al., 1998). With research primar- ily on its effectiveness at alleviating different degrees and types of discomfort, acupuncture has earned gradual medical acceptance for cer- tain pain syndromes (NIH, 1992). Even though its specifi c mechanisms continue to elude sci- entifi c explanations, compelling evidence has found acupuncture effi cacious beyond placebo in relieving chronic and acute pain (Jackson, 1997; Takeda & Wessel, 1994), easing the se- verity of drug withdrawal (Gandhi, 1996), and diminishing chemotherapy-induced nausea and vomiting (Beinfi eld & Korngold, 2003; Ezzo et al., 2005). Beyond analgesic and an- esthetic applications, when administered as an adjunct for cerebral vascular episodes, acupunc- ture reduced recovery time by 50% and per- patient cost by $26,000 (Johansson, Lindgren, Widner, Wiklund, & Johansson, 1993). In broader medical settings, acupuncture has been gaining favor as a therapy for asthma, gastrointestinal problems, and chronic fatigue (Sullivan, 2000) and as an effective treatment for night sweats, diarrhea, vomiting, diges- tive diffi culty, insomnia, and other debilitating symptoms of acquired immunodefi ciency syn- drome (AIDS) symptoms, particularly when combined with moxibustion (specially heated

JWBT514_ch12.indd 300JWBT514_ch12.indd 300 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Developing a Shared Understanding 301

herbs applied to parts of the body) and herbal formulas (Hudson, 1996). For those who are truly needle phobic, resistance to acupuncture might interfere with and obstruct anticipated benefi ts (D. P. Lu, Lu, & Kleinman, 2001).

Ayurvedic Medicine (or Ayurveda)

The traditional medical system known as Ay- urvedic medicine has roots in 5,000-year-old Indian texts that, similar to TCM, explain ill- ness as disruption of harmony and balance in the vital life force, or prana. Restoration of health—reestablishing balance—depends on individualized dietary, herbal, massage, and meditative therapies that correspond to the in- dividual’s predominant constitutional or meta- bolic body type, known as a dosha (e.g., kapha, pitta, and vatta) (Chopra, 1989). Rather than focusing exclusively on disease particulars and their specifi c treatment, Aurvedic plans of care are equally directed at systematic preventive care and optimization of health.

Alternative Health-Care Systems

Homeopathy

Homeopathy, a complete system of medi- cine, originated during the latter 1790s and early 1800s in Germany and is founded on the theory that “like cures like,” also spoken of as similia similibus curantur or “law of similars” (Moore & Schmais, 2000). In this country, homeopathy was not only popular but was highly regarded professionally as a full medical approach during the 1800s and early 20th century. By 1900, homeopathic institutions included 22 medical schools and approximately 200 hospitals; 15% of physi- cians were homeopathic doctors. The advent of allopathic standards, the pervasive impact of our cultural ideal of empiricism, and the increasing infl uence of the American Medical Association and its determination of accept- able practices (Wharton, 1999) diminished homeopathy’s stature, another manifestation of cultural and social confi guration of medi- cal models. However, homeopathy is more

widely used globally than any other system of medical care, is commonly applied in Western Europe (Sullivan, 2000), and has been attract- ing research interest and gaining advocacy once again in the United States.

The principles of homeopathy seem para- doxical and defy conventional pharmaco- logical explanations. That is, homeopathy treats health disorders by administering tiny, dilute doses of natural substances—mineral, plant extracts, metals, even disease-produc- ing germs, diluted in pure water or alcohol (Goldberg et al., 2002)—that, if given in a larger quantity, could produce the undesired symptoms or medical complaint. This doc- trine of practice is referred to as the law of infi nitesimal doses: The more highly dilute dosages (30 successive dilutions) are con- sidered more potent than less dilute (6×) formulations (Moore & Schmais, 2000). The basic assumption is that these precisely for- mulated microdosages target the root causes of disease by initiating the body’s inherent healing mechanisms. In this system of care, symptoms are viewed as a functional attempt of the organism to right or heal itself (Taylor, 1995) and therefore are not the primary focus of treatment. For instance, two patients pre- senting with the very same Western medical disease diagnosis might exhibit very different symptoms. After careful analysis of other sub- tly related indicators, pointing to noncompa- rable origins of their malady, the practitioner would recommend entirely different homeo- pathic remedies (choosing among hundreds) in contradistinction to the precise algorithms of Western medicine that would identify a sin- gular protocol for a single diagnosis.

Although homeopathic assumptions con- tradict Western medical precepts, more than 80 randomized trials show homeopathic ef- fi cacy for disorders such as severe diarrhea among young children (Jacobs, Jimenez, Gloyd, Gale, & Crothers, 1994), asthma, der- matitis, and otitis media (Sullivan, 2000). A meta-analysis found measurable benefi ts for disorders as various as hay fever, asthma, and infl uenza (Kleijnen, Knipschild, & Riet, 1991).

JWBT514_ch12.indd 301JWBT514_ch12.indd 301 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

302 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

Naturopathic Medicine

With an ebb-and-fl ow history, naturopathy is now regaining popular interest and recognition and is formally licensed in 15 states and the District of Columbia. Originating in the United States in the early 1900s (fi rst with Benjamin Lust and later systemized in Henry Lindlahr’s texts on natural therapeutics), this is a medical discipline of nontoxic regimens derived from worldwide healing systems. Treatment plans are designed to enhance the body’s inherent healing capac- ity (vis medicatrix naturae) and are based on a meticulous composite of therapeutic diet, herbal medicine, homeopathic remedies, acupuncture, detoxifi cation therapies (colonic irrigation, salt- water baths, and fasting), hydrotherapy, physical therapies, spinal/soft tissue manipulation, and hyperthermia—the compendium derived from various traditional healing modalities. The most common application of naturopathy is treatment of chronic and degenerative problems rather than acute or trauma conditions.

A basic principle of naturopathy (primum no nocere) and of Western medicine holds that disease symptoms are the body’s innate mech- anism for correcting unhealthy imbalances. It is believed, for example, that reducing a fever or medicating infl ammation—simple manifes- tations of imbalance—rather than eliminating the root cause (tolle causam) of an elevated temperature or the infl ammatory condition will perpetuate the disorder and result in chronic disease. Often during the therapeutic regimen to remove causative factors, a patient will ex- perience an acute episode, or a healing crisis, which, according to naturopathic thinking, in- dicates an expected reaction to treatment and a signal that the therapy is on track. It is as- sumed that subsequent to this amplifi cation of symptoms, the adverse condition will subside naturally (Goldberg et al., 2002).

Folk Medicines

In dictionary terms, folk medicine (or lay medicine) refers to a tradition of health beliefs and illness treatments transmitted orally and by imitation among a group of people with a

common cultural or ethnic identity (Hurdle, 2002; Merriam-Webster, 2003). What this term inaccurately seems to conjure is a set of quaint practices predominant among rural or nonacculturated populations. In a 1995 paper, Becerra and Iglehart reported the com- mon practice of folk medicine, particularly for minor disorders or as preventive, among diverse urban populations who do have ac- cess to modern scientifi c interventions. For example, Chinese Americans may selectively apply traditional Chinese practices while con- tinuing to follow modern medical recommen- dations, deeming each differentially effective with particular health problems. Surprisingly, from surveying parents from different ethnic groups (Chinese American, African American, Mexican American, and non-Hispanic Whites), Becerra and Iglehart (1995) observed that level of assimilation was not predictive of reliance on folk medicine, but personal injury or ill- ness of children during the prior 6 months was. Why these medicines still attract loyal adher- ents and are resilient even in modern urban so- cieties can be attributed fi rst and foremost to their effectiveness for specifi c problems plus an unwillingness to abandon heritage and tradi- tion, a desire to preserve self-determination in personal health, affordability, and congruence with spiritual belief systems (Neff, 2004).

Although specifi c remedies or “cures” em- braced by folk medicines often are used in combination with conventional medicine, these practices are not easily tagged as complemen- tary. That is, folk practices will not neatly fi t the allopathic model. Their theoretical under- pinnings and diagnostic and healing categories can be incompatible with biomedical thinking. This may pose a substantial challenge to pro- fessional providers trained in the conventional medical paradigm. Folk medicines represent consistent and coherent patterns of practice, not disconnected assortments of remedies and preventives. Each folk system refl ects its cul- tural source with a distinct explanatory model of sickness appreciably different from that of Western biomedicine that divorces spiritual and religious meaning from disease etiology and treatment.

JWBT514_ch12.indd 302JWBT514_ch12.indd 302 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Developing a Shared Understanding 303

These folk diagnostics and curatives seem to share the belief that a patient’s disorder and subsequent health are embedded in an environ- ment that is simultaneously social, ecological, and spiritual—a tenet that echoes and coheres with the person-in-environment fundamental of professional social work. Another important distinction is that, unlike allopathic medicine, which prescribes treatments even when dis- ease causation is unknown or uncertain, folk systems do not proceed with curative therapies before identifying clear etiology (Krippner, 1995).

Because it is not feasible in one chapter to present a full discussion of the complex topic of folk medicine, examples will be used to highlight certain distinctions among systems and identify possible points of incongruity between modern medical thinking and folk models—ones that refl ect vastly different ways of construing health and sickness issues. For the health-care social worker, familiarity with folk practices helps bridge separate cul- tures of medicine and engender mutual respect for a more effective delivery of services.

As an example, among Mexican Americans, curanderismo, or folk healing, is a continu- ing and stable presence in family health care (Becerra & Iglehart, 1995). Not an assortment of piecemeal remedies, this is a comprehensive tradition that holds religion as a core element with practices that derive from an elaborate classifi cation of maladies. These maladies have no exact corollary in orthodox medicine, thus may not be resolvable by Western medi- cal techniques and, as a result, necessitate folk healer (curandera or curandero) interventions. Although disease causation is not understood as God’s punishment, the divine is viewed as the ultimate source of relief and recovery from illness (Becerra & Iglehart, 1995). Most often, the curandera determines a diagnosis by read- ing the patient’s aura or energy body, by ques- tioning both patient and family about signs or symptoms and peculiar patterns of patient behavior, and ultimately by information from the spirit guide in dreams (Krippner, 1995). In curanderismo diagnostics, there are fi ve principal folk sicknesses, four of which are

deemed natural disorders (males naturales)— caida de la mullera (fallen fontanel in infants due to mother’s neglect), empacho (a diges- tive disorder understood as obstruction in the bowel or stomach by saliva or soft foods), mal ojo (the evil eye, which occurs when stared at with envy or desire), and susto (shock or fright)—and one with its source in witchcraft or sorcery—mal puesto, due to a hex (Becerra & Iglehart, 1995; Krippner, 1995). Symptom patterns can be complex and include fever, headaches, vomiting, and drooping eyes for mal ojo but do not in and of themselves de- fi ne the problem. Depending on diagnosis, curatives can involve herbals, incantations, manipulations, and spiritual practices with the curandera present to enlist divine assistance or the intercession of helpful spirits (Krippner).

A patient case example of the ethnomedical condition known in Latin American traditions as empacho exemplifi es a successful folk- biomedical interface. A 20-month-old Puerto Rican toddler was admitted to a hospital for dietary and behavioral observation because of “failure to thrive”—the diagnosis in bio- medical terminology for his continuing weight loss—but assumed by his parents to signify empacho, a disorder with no correspondence in modern medicine. Respecting the convic- tion and insistence of both parents, the doc- tors invited a local santiguadora along with the owner of a botanica (a local Puerto Rican shop selling herbs, remedies, and specifi c religious artifacts) into the hospital unit to perform rit- ual healing with massage and other folk me- dicaments, concurrent with conventional care. Within days, the boy was able to return home after evidencing appropriate weight gain. Im- portantly, achieving this successful outcome did not require the parents to relinquish their culturally determined beliefs about illness, nor was the physician compelled to concur with those beliefs. This result suggests how dis- crepant explanatory models can be negotiated effectively—can peacefully coexist and de- liver effective care—in a conventional medi- cal environment that demonstrates openness and the ability to suspend judgmental thinking (Pachter, 1994).

JWBT514_ch12.indd 303JWBT514_ch12.indd 303 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

304 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

Other folk practices persist in an urban set- ting. For example, without abandoning their modern medical care, African Americans may specifi cally seek herbal remedies (“root” work) or spiritual practices to cure sickness (“the misery”) when illness is attributed to divine punishment or natural or magical forces. In contradistinction, White non-Hispanics seem to rely more on specifi c food preparations and mechanical applications (e.g., poultices rather than herbals) as remedies, but, parallel to mod- ern medicine, Anglo popular medicines (as they are labeled by Becerra & Iglehart, 1995) separate spiritual rituals from physical health practices. These authors imply that although not as elaborate and codifi ed as other folk medicines, continuity of Anglo healing mea- sures is ensured because it enables and echoes values of independence and self-reliance.

Among many Native American practices, a rigorous logic informs practice, and, in fact, the Pima Indian model with its specialties and subspecialties is seen by medical anthro- pologists as perhaps as highly developed as that of Western medical systems (Krippner, 1995). Comparisons, however, are not simple because many diagnostic categories are not comprehensible outside of a particular cul- tural perspective. The Pima model holds that one category of disease responds to external treatment while other types may heal only with the body’s innate mechanisms or might not be remediable, such as infant deformities (Krippner, 1995). According to Pima theory, the body of each patient refl ects the accumula- tive repository of resources and weaknesses to be evaluated and analyzed by the shaman with the assistance of benevolent spirit guides be- fore the individual is assigned to the appropri- ate intervention of other practitioners. Specifi c behaviors inform the shaman’s diagnostic con- clusions. In this system, “wandering sickness” (impurities such as germs, pus, or heat that traverse the body), identifi ed with signs such as fever, hives, piles, and sores, is treated with herbals and spirit entreaties. Another category of maladies, “staying sickness” (manifestation of proscribed behavior toward power object from nature), persists in the body because the

individual has violated sacred laws. This group includes “wind sickness,” “deer sickness,” and “rabbit sickness” and requires shamanic chant- ing and ritual removal of toxic substance from the ill person’s body, often in conjunction with sand painting and/or special feasting (Krippner, 1995). In some instances, a disease is deemed untreatable (an intrinsic condition that is char- acterologically induced), obviating interven- tions, which would interfere with a specifi c and necessary life lesson (Cohen, 1999).

CAM Practices

As mentioned earlier, what usually is classi- fi ed as complementary medicine is not a true medical system but an umbrella term for non- standard practices that can be applied within the allopathic model (i.e., when nonstandard treatments dovetail with, instead of supplant- ing, conventional plans of care). It is still the conventional biomedical model and theory that determine usage (MacIntosh, 1999). Al- though a listing of CAM modalities is far too extensive for full coverage in this chapter, some of the more common CAM categories of treatment are mentioned to increase familiarity (Loveland-Cook, Becvar, & Pontious, 2000).

Body and Massage Therapies (Manual Therapies)

The manual therapy modality encompasses multiple distinctive therapies that primarily use physical touch for diagnostic and treat- ment plans (Loveland-Cook et al., 2000).

Chiropractic is foremost a system of spinal adjustments and is the most immediately iden- tifi able form of CAM (Lawrence & Meeker, 2007). It is estimated that 23 to 38 million Amer- icans visit chiropractors annually (Goldberg et al., 2002). Although the primary chiropractic function remains treatment of back pain, one of the most common health complaints in the United States second only to the common cold, in some states (e.g., Illinois), chiroprac- tors may be licensed to perform certain inter- ventions, such as throat cultures, and to treat minor health issues (Rattenbury, 1995). Ac- cording to the guiding premise in chiropractic,

JWBT514_ch12.indd 304JWBT514_ch12.indd 304 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Developing a Shared Understanding 305

health ultimately is determined by the central nervous system. Misalignment of the spine, referred to as “subluxation,” engenders pain and other health problems, requiring spinal ad- justments, achieved with varying methods and equipment, to restore healthier nerve function- ing. Numerous studies have found chiropractic to effect better and longer-maintained relief of back pain than that achieved by medical doctors (Meade, Dyer, Browne, Townsend, & Frank, 1990) and at signifi cantly reduced cost (Jarvis, Phillips, & Morris, 1991).

Naprapathy is a back/body modality related to chiropractic, but this practice treats muscu- loskeletal pain by manipulating connective tissue and muscles rather than bones. Napra- paths most commonly treat muscle spasms, joint pain, infl ammation, and scar tissue (Rattenbury, 1995).

Refl exology, another manual therapy, is based on the premise that each body organ or system has one or several corresponding points on the feet and hands. By applying precise pressure to these points, it is believed that the practitioner can unlock disrupted path- ways of energy that have produced pain or an unrelieved structural disorder (Stephenson & Dalton, 2003). Research has shown refl exol- ogy to be an effective treatment for chronic migraines and tension headaches (Launso, Brendstrup, & Amberg, 1999).

Therapeutic touch (TT) has as its underly- ing rationale the theory that bioelectrical en- ergy fi elds make up soma and psyche of each individual, and these fi elds interact with envi- ronmental factors to produce health problems. This practice involves realigning or rebalanc- ing disturbances in this energy fi eld. Studies regarding effi cacy have found that gentle TT bolstered weight gain among premature in- fants (Harrison, Olivet, Cunningham, Bodin, & Hicks, 1996) and helped calm children dis- tressed during hospitalization (Kramer, 1990); other data suggest that TT aids factors that enhance immune response, particularly an in- crease in helper T4 cells and reduction of sup- pressor T8 cells (Quinn & Strelkauskas, 1993). Moreover, TT has been associated with reduced pain of tension headaches (Keller & Bzdek,

1986) and has found applications in more than 200 hospitals (Goldberg et al., 2002).

Aromatherapy uses essential oils, distilled from plant oils, to relieve and relax symptoms associated with disease and side effects of treatment and more generally to enhance over- all well-being through the olfactory system. The usual routes of aromatherapy are through inhalation of oils dispensed by diffusers or massaged directly on skin. The latter method requires knowledgeable professional guidance as certain oils, such as cinnamon and clove, can burn or irritate the skin. In addition, even the most purifi ed oils should not be ingested because they can be quite toxic. But benefi - cial effects abound. Lavender induces calm- ing, almost sedative benefi ts on brain wave activity (Birchall, 1990) and can be very help- ful with sleep disorders, particularly sleep- onset problems. During childbirth, lavender and lemon relieved tension in early stages of labor, whereas in later phases peppermint was found to alleviate nausea and vomiting (Burns & Blarney, 1994). In an intensive care unit, aromatherapy combined with massage pro- vided patients with greater observed ease and relaxation than massage alone (Dunn, Sleep, & Collett, 1995).

Therapeutic massage and bodywork in- cludes multiple practices, such as Swedish, deep tissue, sports, and lymphatic massage. Estimates suggest they are used by 20 million Americans annually (Goldberg et al., 2002). Research on various forms of manual therapy has produced substantial documentation that massage therapy can relieve psychological stress and lift mood (Corley, Ferriter, Zeh, & Gifford, 1995; Dunn et al., 1995; Sims, 1986). Physiologically, massage enhances blood and lymph circulation and parasympathetic re- sponse (e.g., decreased heart and respiratory rate, relieved muscle tension, lowered blood pressure). It has been associated with bet- ter gastrointestinal functioning, diminished reliance on analgesics, and improved active functional levels (DeGood, 1996). In research with another focus, preterm infants have ben- efi ted, showing signifi cantly improved weight gain and shortened hospitalization with daily

JWBT514_ch12.indd 305JWBT514_ch12.indd 305 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

306 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

massage (Field et al., 1986). Other physical manipulation therapies—too numerous for this chapter—include deep-tissue work to restruc- ture the body such as Rolfi ng or the gentler craniosacral therapy, pressure point techniques like acupressure, or health awareness through movement redesign of the Feldenkrais approach.

The term mind–body refers to a broad category of techniques—meditation, hypno- sis, biofeedback, autogenic training, relaxed abdominal breathing, guided imagery, pro- gressive muscle relaxation—based on the understanding that psyche and soma are in- terconnected in a dynamic, unifi ed system. The bidirectional communication among auto- nomic, musculoskeletal, and psychoneuroen- docrine systems via neurotransmitters means that stressors can exert a harmful impact on physiology and biochemistry, but inversely, relieving stressor impact can afford salutary effects on the body and total health.

Blumenthal and colleagues at Duke Univer- sity (1997) assessed patients with angina in a 16-week mind–body program and found fewer subsequent episodes than among controls. Al- though stressors that initiate damaging physi- ological reactions may not be perceived or processed consciously, both acute and chronic psychological distress produce symptoms, such as elevated pulse and blood pressure as well as respiratory rates, platelet aggregation, insulin levels, sodium retention, and decre- ments in immune response (Seaward, 1997; Wells-Federman et al., 1995). Techniques with empirical support of benefi ts offsetting dam- aging levels of stress include the techniques discussed next.

• Guided imagery techniques have demon- strated effectiveness, but guided imagery also affords personal customization. For example, a detailed mental image, using all senses—visual, auditory, olfactory, tac- tile—can be evoked that represents for that individual a safe, comfortable, and healing setting. Strong associations were reported between such practices and mitigation of chronic pain as well as improvements in

immune-infl uenced diseases (Benson & Stuart, 1993; Hillhouse & Adler, 1991). In cancer settings, guided imagery combined with progressive muscle relaxation was more effective at reducing the experience of pain severity among women with stage II, III, and IV disease than simple sup- portive communications (Sloman, 1995); cancer patients trained in guided imagery were able to diminish the severe oral mu- cositis pain that followed chemotherapy (Pan, Morrison, Ness, Fugh-Berman, & Leipzig, 2000). In another study among women with breast cancer, a link was ob- served with improved killer-cell activity along with mood enhancement (Fawzy et al., 1993; Newton, 1996). Also, with breast cancer patients, enhanced interferon levels accompanied by improved stamina and well-being that was substantially greater than controls resulted with this mind–body technique (Justice, 1996). In addition, guided imagery relieved chemotherapy- induced nausea and vomiting in the oncol- ogy setting (Troesch, Rodehaver, Delaney, & Yanes, 1993).

• Meditation is a traditional practice in many cultures with technical variations, but when it is stripped of religious or cultural overlay, it reveals substantial commonalities. Basic guidelines involve keeping the mind calmly focused on the present moment and diminishing painful ruminations about the past and anxious preoccupations with the future. In the concentrative approach of meditation, one is instructed to maintain attention on the breath or the repetition of a special word, phrase, sound (mantra), or image; alternatively, the mindfulness approach encourages nonjudgmentally observing sensations and thoughts as they enter the mindscape. The psychophysiological ben- efi ts evidenced with mindfulness-based stress reduction, a meditative discipline developed by John Kabat-Zinn and his team at University of Massachusetts and utilized in more than 200 U.S. hospitals, include alleviation of chronic and here-

JWBT514_ch12.indd 306JWBT514_ch12.indd 306 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Developing a Shared Understanding 307

tofore unremitting pain (Cassileth, 1998; Hafner, 1982; Kabat-Zinn, Lipworth, & Burney, 1985); 4 times more rapid heal- ing of psoriasis (Kabat-Zinn et al., 1998); and anxiety and stress relief with accom- panying physiological benefi ts (e.g., re- duced hypertension).

• Hypnosis is a practice that uses selective attention to induce a specifi c altered state (trance), which enhances communica- tion between conscious and unconscious processes (e.g., functioning of autonomic nervous system) for therapeutic benefi t. All hypnosis is in effect self-hypnosis— that is, to produce a hypnotic state, the cli- ent must be engaged actively as a willing participant with the therapist as facilita- tor. Although it is thought that the brain’s limbic system, which infl uences emotions and controls what is believed to be invol- untary body functions, responds to hyp- notic suggestions, a precise understanding of how this intervention works still eludes scientifi c explanation. By 1991, at least 15,000 health professionals practiced hypnotherapy in combination with their conventional medicine to ameliorate many conditions (Goldberg et al., 2002). Hypnotherapy helps to accelerate healing (Ginandes, Brooks, Sando, Jones, & Aker, 2003), triggering the release of endog- enous anti-infl ammatory properties; curb secretion of excess stomach acids among ulcer patients; soothe chronic and acute pain (Montgomery, DuHamel, & Redd, 2000); relieve side effects of chemother- apy, such as nausea and vomiting (Levi- tan, 1992; Lynch, 1998; Marchioro et al., 2000; Syrjala, Cummings, & Donaldson, 1992); reduce blood loss and pain medi- cation needs associated with surgery (Dis- brow, Bennett, & Owings, 1993; Enqvist, 1991); assist in asthma relief (Hackman, Stern, & Gershwin, 2000); and provide measurable relief with other diffi cult treat- ments (Goldberg et al., 2002). Generating important implications, a randomized clin- ical trial comparing a 15-minute hypnosis session just prior to a breast biopsy or

lumpectomy to a control group of patients who did not receive hypnosis resulted in signifi cantly reduced need for anesthetics, reported pain intensity, and postsurgical nausea and fatigue among the experimen- tal group. Another striking benefi t of this brief intervention was an institutional cost savings of $773 per patient, which is par- ticularly germane when considering na- tional concerns about runaway health-care expenses (Montgomery et al., 2007). With a different focus, one study demonstrated that burn patients healed more rapidly and with less pain when a light trance was in- duced soon after the trauma (Findlay, Po- dolsky, & Silberner, 1991). With pediatric patients, hypnosis was helpful with prob- lems from recurrent migraines to sickle cell anemia (Goldberg et al., 2002). Con- trary to earlier estimations, approximately 94% of patients experience some relief, and those more easily hypnotized benefi t even more substantially (Podolsky, 1991).

• Biofeedback is a painless procedure in which sensors, attached to electrodes, are slipped on fi ngers or placed as upper arm cuffs while a client observes signals on a computer monitor indicating that he or she is able to achieve a desired state, for ex- ample, reduced heart rate, relief of tension headaches, or warmer peripheral tempera- ture (Long, Machiran, & Bertell, 1986). This technique involves patients learning to control seemingly involuntary body func- tioning (e.g., skin temperature, brain wave patterns) when they practice relaxation tactics. It has been found useful with Rey- naud’s disease (in which fi ngers become painfully cold in cooler but not necessarily frigid conditions). Numerous insurers reim- burse the cost of this therapy (Goldberg et al., 2002).

Mind–body techniques are congruent with social work objectives of empowering patients to implement positive changes through self- management and with social work values of respecting and tailoring to individual needs, because each of these techniques is amenable

JWBT514_ch12.indd 307JWBT514_ch12.indd 307 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

308 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

to individual adjustment. Moreover, through professional training programs and workshops, mind–body approaches can be added to clini- cal skills and incorporated into professional social work practice. By engaging patients and clients in these complementary techniques— training and treating individuals whose health can benefi t from mind–body modalities—so- cial workers enlarge their clinical role beyond that of patient advocate and medical liaison and in treatment ideals that echo social work fundamentals.

Nutrition and Lifestyle Regimens

Traditional medical systems rely heavily on dietary adjustments to restore or maintain bal- ance, seen as the essence of health. Depending on environmental factors and the individual’s energetic status, specifi c foods are to be eaten and others are to be deliberately avoided or eliminated.

Macrobiotic regimen is a lifestyle and dietary discipline emerging from Japanese Zen practices that prescribe individualized regimens to restore yin-yang energy balance. Dietary guidelines are based on fresh, whole foods, such as whole cereal grains, fresh veg- etables, legumes, seeds, nuts, fruits, and some fi sh, with adjustments to match the individu- al’s particular imbalanced energy, which is determined by evaluating condition and con- stitution, and to correspond to changing cli- mate exigencies.

Lifestyle Heart Trial showed patients with substantial coronary artery disease had signifi - cant regression of atherosclerosis when fol- lowing a specifi c low-fat diet combined with nonimpact exercise and relaxation strategies (Ornish et al., 1983, 1998). Other dietary in- formation from epidemiological and observa- tional research suggests that vegetarian eating may relieve rheumatoid arthritis symptoms and may reduce arthritic incidence and allergy problems by cutting protein triggers (Adam, 1995). Furthermore, high fi ber as well as other aspects of whole grain, vegetable, legume, and fresh fruit consumption is linked with healthier gastrointestinal functioning and diminished risk of specifi c cancers and cardiovascular

problems (Block, 1999; Burkitt, Walker, & Painter, 1974).

Nutritional supplementation has shown a continual and dramatic rise in use among Americans in recent decades, despite medical controversy (Murray & Pizzorno, 1996). This fact reconfi rms the public conviction that bo- tanicals, herbals, and nutrients do make a sig- nifi cant difference and are generally less toxic than pharmaceutical drugs. Even in the midst of a media furor, there is little contest that spe- cifi c agents can improve resistance to and du- ration of certain infectious sicknesses (Hemila, 1994), even among elderly people (Chandra, 1992). Supplements can augment preventive measures to counter severe disorders (e.g., protective against heart diseases as well as certain cancers), particularly vitamins E and C as well as carotenoids (Loveland-Cook et al., 2000). Preliminary evidence also supports the value of coenzyme Q10 for supportive benefi ts with cardiovascular problems, such as congestive heart failure (Gaby, 1999), and protection from cardiotoxic chemotherapies like doxorubicin (Mortensen, Aabo, Jonsson, & Baandrup, 1986). Chromium is helpful with type 2 diabetes (Sullivan, 2000).

Bioelectronic therapies depend on the theo- retical premise that all living organisms are affected by and exist within electromagnetic (EM) fi elds. Therapeutic improvement of EM fi elds—altering the individual’s energy for physiological relief—is postulated by creat- ing bodily contact of an individual’s EM fi eld with a weak, nonthermal EM fi eld to enhance blood and lymph circulation, cellular oxygen- ation, and detoxifi cation, thus relieving pain, hastening the healing process, and boosting energy. Enhanced healing of bone fractures was evidenced in studies reported in 1984 (Barker, Dixon, Sharrard, & Sutcliffe), and ac- celerated wound healing was conferred by this energy modality (Bassett, 1993; Lee, Canaday, & Doong, 1993). Research to verify benefi ts of magnets applied on the body has not produced statistically signifi cant results.

Biological treatments are chemical formu- lations for injection or ingestion theorized to achieve very particularized physiological

JWBT514_ch12.indd 308JWBT514_ch12.indd 308 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Developing a Shared Understanding 309

responses, such as enhancing specifi c immune factors, but are not pharmaceutical drugs that target the elimination of disease-producing organisms or disease processes. Chelation therapy, for example, involves an injectable substance (ethylene diamine tetracetic acid [EDTA]) said to attach to toxic materials in the body (e.g., aluminum and lead) that are then eliminated from the body through excretion rather than reabsorbed. Chelation has been shown useful with cases of lead poisoning and is being assessed for other health problems (Chappell, 1995). EDTA has been added as an effective adjunct for atherosclerotic problems, including strokes and peripheral vascular disease (Goldberg et al., 2002).

Herbal Medicines (Botanical Medicine)

Medicinal herbal applications have a 60,000-year-old history, the most ancient form of medical treatment, with evidence dating as far back as the Neanderthal era (Solecki, 1975). In Europe, herbal therapies hold a long- honored tradition and are more commonly in- corporated into standard treatment plans than in American medicine. Even across the United States, herbal regimens are inching into main- stream medical plans with science verifying what medical folklore has long posited. Herb- als are plant substances, which can include the root, fl ower, stem, seeds, or leaves, used to enhance or correct improper functioning of or- gans and represent a core treatment component in TCM, Ayurvedic medicine, and naturopa- thy. Garlic (and its compounds), the herb most universally recognized for medicinal value (Blumenthal, Goldberg, & Brinckmann, 2000; Goldberg et al., 2002), takes a lead in varied applications. It is ingested to help reduce prob- lematic cholesterol and elevated blood pres- sure (Vorberg & Schneider, 1990; Warshafsky, Kramer, & Sivak, 1993), is taken commonly for its antibiotic and antimicrobial properties (Sullivan, 2000), is a popular antidote for gout and rheumatism (Foster, 1991), and has been shown to reverse arterial plaqueing (Koscielny et al., 1999). In addition, in large epidemiolog- ical studies, modest intake was linked statisti- cally with reduced intestinal cancer (Lawson,

1997). By 1998, 1,990 research papers had been published on the benefi cial activities of garlic (Goldberg et al., 2002). In just one study among heart patients, 6 milligrams garlic daily resulted in a 35% reduction of heart attacks and a 45% reduction in mortality compared with placebo (Lawson, 1997).

RESEARCH DILEMMA

The best potential for increased respect and comprehension of CAM and integrative ben- efi ts is continuing controlled research. What impedes full investigation are issues of eco- nomics and real methodological conundrums. The bias against full studies can be signifi cant, because unlike testing of single pharmaceuti- cal drugs, the likelihood of fi nancial gain from CAM is minuscule and the cost is great. In addition, most alternative systems, CAM pro- tocols, and integrative regimens are diffi cult to study because they usually involve com- plex, multifaceted programs that are diffi cult to evaluate against single therapies and seem to defy unifocal investigative efforts, the most common scientifi c investigational approach. One additional puzzle is how to design a true double-blind study on certain practices such as meditation; that is, what can serve as a genu- ine placebo control? And fi nding groups to maintain as controls is a thorny task because surveys tell us the vast numbers of patients on their own initiative and in secret are receiving alternative treatments. Finally, even diagnostic categories among alternative systems do not always correspond to those of biomedicine, so comparisons can be inexact.

PROBLEMS AND CONCERNS

What confuses a defi nitive evidence base is that specifi cs of treatment vary considerably (e.g., Chinese versus Korean acupuncture). This vari- ance among practices can be very problematic if counseling a client, for example, on the value of acupuncture for musculoskeletal pain based on documented randomized controlled trials

JWBT514_ch12.indd 309JWBT514_ch12.indd 309 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

310 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

due to uncertainty about real correspondence between the methodology used by the local acupuncturist and the precise approach tested in the research. For another example, it is not clear for migraines which precise acupuncture points are most effective, the appropriate dura- tion for needle insertion, or the necessary num- ber of treatments (Vickers, 2003).

An unresolved quandary haunts a full melding of practices: Can different medi- cal models be integrated effectively and truly? That is, when diagnostic and thera- peutic systems are based on very different biological and philosophical premises, can treatment plans be merged successfully? For example, a single disease presentation, in Western medicine labeled as stomach can- cer, can point to several very different mala- dies in the Chinese system, such as stomach yin defi ciency due to stomach heat, blood stagnation due to chi stagnation, or stom- ach yang defi ciency (Beinfi eld & Korngold, 2003), each demanding a distinct, even in- congruent, treatment. Although an Ameri- can physician would reasonably and almost automatically prescribe one chemotherapy protocol intended specifi cally for stomach cancer, the Chinese doctor might advise very dissimilar regimens for this same stomach cancer, determined by the different Chinese diagnostic categories.

Another continuing concern is that formal training, credentialing, and licensure of CAM practitioners remains inconsistently monitored or required across the 50 states. (An excep- tion is chiropractic, licensed in all states with specifi c training standards.) Even though the risk of toxicity of most herbal preparations is usually very small because many formulations incorporate multiple chemical substances be- lieved to synergistically enhance their thera- peutic potential, toxic consequences and adverse herb–drug interactions are possible. However, compared to prescriptive pharma- ceuticals, supplements carry fractional haz- ards. Furthermore, experts acknowledge that at least 51% of prescriptive drugs can produce severe side effects that went undetected even in controlled testing prior to approved use

(Moore, Psaty, & Furberg, 1998). For these reasons, expert guidance is essential when a patient is being treated simultaneously for se- rious disease.

Because dietary supplements are sold as food compounds, they are unregulated by Food and Drug Administration standards. Quality issues, such as contamination and variation in content and processing, are a continuing worry for an untutored public (De Smet, 1999; Marrone, 1999). Some formulations hit the market with meaningless amounts of identifi ed key ingredients; many do not even dissolve or disintegrate after ingested; and most are not standardized. Even if positive research fi nd- ings are available on one product (e.g., black cohosh) indicating safety and benefi ts, there is no assurance that a different cohosh product will produce the same effect because actual dosing might be inconsistent.

Certainly some more aggressive alternative practices do carry the possibility of untoward consequences, but the potential for truly severe side effects from most CAM therapies seems dwarfed by that of pharmaceuticals or more invasive procedures. When CAM therapies are practiced skillfully and applied appropri- ately, the likelihood of problematic effects is minimized (Jonas, 1998). This consideration does not deny limited but real concerns about problematic interactions between alternative practices and conventional drugs. One such ex- ample is the use of special grapefruit prepara- tions (as reported informally by a woman from Jamaica, October 2003) to reduce symptoms of hypertension. Regular grapefruit juice con- sumption is known to increase blood volume of specifi c antihypertensives, antihistamines, and antidepressants by down-regulating cy- tochrome P450, an enzyme that functions in the body to metabolize drugs (Beinfeld & Korngold, 2003). An example of possible herbal contraindication is the use of Hyperi- cum perforatum (St. John’s wort), available for purchase in health food stores and backed by scientifi c and popular literature as normally safe and effective with mild to moderate de- pressive symptoms. This usually benign herb is known to (a) augment the metabolism of

JWBT514_ch12.indd 310JWBT514_ch12.indd 310 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Developing a Shared Understanding 311

protease inhibitors, thus reducing blood levels of such medications; (b) elevate the body’s se- rotonin to potentiate the impact of monoamine oxidase inhibitor and selective serotonin reup- take inhibitor antidepression drugs; and (c) in- terfere with the full effectiveness of drugs such as cyclosporine and theophylline (Croom, 2000). Another undesired herb-drug complica- tion, Ginkgo biloba, which is commonly used for memory and cognitive enhancement, can inhibit platelet aggregation (as does garlic), elevating anticoagulant effects of some pre- scription drugs. However, warnings such as these stem from scientifi c evaluations of each herb as a single agent. The impact observed is moderated when an herb or nutrient is one component in a multiple compound formula- tion, whereby, for instance, any anticoagulant concern is mitigated by the presence of other herbs. One recommendation for modifying posited drug-supplement problems is taking drugs separately from food consumption to avoid undesired digestive tract interactions (Blumenthal et al., 2000).

INSURANCE COVERAGE ISSUES

Several third-party insurance carriers were re- ported, even in the prior decade, to have cov- ered 25% of the cost for CAM treatments used by cancer patients (Campion, 1993). One of the appeals of alternative practices to Ameri- can consumers is fi nancial. Many alternative treatments are less costly than conventional therapies; exceptions may be interventions such as antineoplastons (Ernst, 1994, 1995). In fact, in reporting use of alternatives among ethnic minorities, MacKenzie and her team (2003) noted that being uninsured—paying out of pocket—predicted greater likelihood of un- conventional practices. Yet managed care com- panies, confronted by fi erce competition, are now chasing the very lucrative CAM market to attract new enrollees from a public enamored with these once-obscure or seemingly exotic practices. One marketing strategy of man- aged care corporations to counter a growing

disenchantment with health maintenance or- ganization restrictions is to attach a rider to a general policy to include some alternative care options. Other groups provide discounted ac- cess to nonconventional services—25% off practices such as chiropractic, acupuncture, and so on (Rauber, 1998). By 2000, 43 insur- ers covered alternative care, up from just 2 or 3 a few years earlier, and some are marketing packages with a blend of benefi ts (Pelletier & Astin, 2002).

CONCLUSION

Today’s health-care terrain is a mélange of medical preferences and practices mirroring the nation’s cultural plurality. Encouraging evidence implies that deep-rooted prejudices may be fading gradually and a new consen- sus emerging, one that holds that distinctions between alternative and conventional medicine are detrimental (Fontanarosa & Lundberg, 1998). Advocates of a broader medical phi- losophy believe that there is only good or bad medicine and that all health professionals are mandated to maintain an open mind to what might be most benefi cial for each patient. On this principle, MacKenzie and her coau- thors (2003) pointedly ask, “How well do the health systems we have created fi t the persons we wish to serve?” (p. 56). One attempt to address this issue has been a corrective re- sponse to linguistic problems to untangle and rephrase complex medical terminology and to improve how professionals communicate disease and treatment information to patients from diverse backgrounds. But this effort has been motivated largely by the medical need to persuade patient compliance to seemingly for- eign and misunderstood protocols (MacKenzie et al., 2003). Although medical professionals have initiated efforts at greater language con- gruence, the need to acknowledge and better integrate components of divergent medical practices and thinking into our biomedical par- adigm is still unmet. To effectively serve and support individual clients, who embrace cultur- ally diverse or idiosyncratic health beliefs but

JWBT514_ch12.indd 311JWBT514_ch12.indd 311 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

312 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

who might get lost in a labyrinth of technical and personally incongruent medical thinking, social workers are called on in their special- ized professional role to build an expanding familiarity with divergent approaches as a bridge to better care.

SUGGESTED LEARNING EXERCISES

Learning Exercise 12.1

Consider this question: Can medical models shaped by dissimilar, nonparallel paradigms of health and healing be integrated effectively? If you believe it is possible, discuss limitations to combining modern conventional modalities with a treatment plan from an alternative sys- tem of medicine using detailed examples. Also, how would you propose that a medical team go about helping a client or patient have access to a treatment plan based on this integration of dis- parate medical models? If this is not possible in your opinion, explain why, with detailed and specifi c examples from the different alternative systems and how you would communicate this impossibility to a client/patient.

Learning Exercise 12.2

Using material from this chapter in conjunc- tion with issues addressed in Chapter 11 on spirituality in health care and Chapter 6 on health theories, discuss how you would engage one of the next people in an open and support- ive conversation of personal health practices to enable better care.

• A 40-year-old Mexican American (or Chinese American) woman diagnosed with stage II breast cancer, which can be treated effectively with chemotherapy, has not shown up for two of her scheduled ap- pointments. Assume for this assignment that you have helped her fi nd appropriate practical support and have communicated effectively the value of treatment and availability of pharmaceuticals to coun-

teract side effects, but you wish to under- stand what other factors prevent her from continuing with the oncologist’s recom- mendations. Taking into account cultural health values while respecting individual preferences and examining your own med- ical predispositions, describe your prepa- ratory thinking and your interaction with this woman. What do you need to consider before you actually meet with her? What questions and what suggestions might you offer? Then describe how you might present to her physician the rationale for why she has been using practices he or she might regard as problematic alternatives and how the physician can best create cul- turally and individually congruent recom- mendations.

• Consider your advance thinking and sub- sequent conversations with a 50-year-old African American man with uncontrolled hy- pertension. Either his disease is unresponsive to medications or, as his doctor implies, he is not adhering to his medical regimen. Al- ternatively, consider a Native American man in a similar scenario but with diabetes rather than hypertension. What alternative recom- mendations are worth consideration and in- vestigation? What are some possible barriers to medical effects?

SUGGESTED RESOURCES

Beinfi eld, H., & Korngold, E. (1992). Be- tween heaven and earth: A guide to Chinese medicine. New York, NY: Bal- lantine Books.

Blumenthal, M. (2003). The ABC clinical guide to herbs. Austin, TX: American Botanical Council.

Goldberg, B., Anderson, J.W., & Trivieri, L. (Ed.). (2002). Alternative medicine: The defi nitive guide (2nd ed.). Berkeley, CA: Celestial Arts.

Jonas, W. B., & Levin, J. S. (1999). Essen- tials of complementary and alternative medicine. Philadelphia, PA: Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.

JWBT514_ch12.indd 312JWBT514_ch12.indd 312 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Developing a Shared Understanding 313

Moss, D. (Ed.). (2003). Handbook of mind- body medicine for primary care. Thou- sand Oaks, CA: Sage.

Pizzorno, J., & Murray, M. T. (1998). En- cyclopedia of natural medicine (revised 2nd ed.). Roseville, CA: Prima.

INFORMATIONAL WEB SITES

National Center for Complementary and Alternative Medicine (NCCAM)—Toll- free (888) 644-6226; TTY (for deaf or hard-of-hearing callers): (866) 464- 3615; e-mail [email protected]

Insurance—www.consumeraction.gov /insurance.shtml

For a client/patient with medical insurance, information on CAM treatment cover- age may be provided by state insurance departments.

Ornish, Dean—http://www.pmri.org/index .html

Medicare has proposed coverage for Dr. Dean Ornish’s Program (a full diet/fi tness /stress care regimen, a possible alternative to surgery) for Reversing Heart Disease, scheduled to begin September 2010.

REFERENCES

Adam, O. (1995). Anti-infl ammatory diet in rheumatic diseases. European Journal of Nutrition, 49(10), 703–717.

Astin, J. A. (1998a). Why patients use alternative medicine: Results of a national study. JAMA, 279(19), 1548–1553.

Astin, J. A. (1998b). In reply. JAMA, 280(19), 1660–1661.

Baldwin, L. (1998). Letter to the editor. JAMA, 280(19), 1659–1660.

Barker, A. T., Dixon, R. A., Sharrard, W. J., & Sutcliffe, M. L. (1984). Pulsed magnetic fi eld therapy for tibial non-union: Interim results of a double-blind trial. Lancet, 1(8384), 994–996.

Barnes, P. M., Powell-Griner, E., McFann, K., & Nahin, R. L. (2004). Complementary and alternative medicine use among adults: United States, 2002. Vital Health and Statistics, 343, 130–136.

Barzansky, B., & Etzel, S. I. (2003). Educational programs in U.S. medical schools, 2002–2003. JAMA, 290, 1190–1196.

Bassett, C. A. (1993). Benefi cial effects of electromagnetic fi elds. Journal of Cellular Biochemistry, 51(4), 387–393.

Becerra, R. M., & Iglehart, A. P. (1995). Folk medicine use: Diverse populations in a metropolitan area. Social Work in Health Care, 21(4), 37–58.

Beinfi eld, H., & Korngold, E. (2003). Chinese medicine and cancer care. Alternative Therapies, 9(5), 38–52.

Benson, H., & Stuart, E. (1993). The wellness book: The comprehensive guide to maintaining health and treating stress-related illness. New York, NY: Simon & Schuster.

Birchall, A. (1990). A whiff of happiness. New Scientist, 127, 45–57.

Block, K. I. (1999). Nutritional biotherapy. In W. B. Jonas & J. S. Levin (Eds.), Essentials of complementary and alternative medicine (pp. 490–521). Philadelphia, PA: Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.

Blumenthal, J. A., Jiang, W., Babyak, M. A., Krantz, D. S., Frid, D. J., Coleman, R. E., . . . Morris, J. J. (1997). Stress management and exercise training in cardiac patients with myocardial ischemia: Effects on prognosis and evaluation of mechanisms. Archives Internal Medicine, 157(19), 2213–2223.

Blumenthal, M., Goldberg, A., & Brinckmann, J. (2000). Herbal medicine: Expanded Commission E Monographs. Newton, MA: Integrative Medicine Communications.

Borins, M. (2002, June). Taking care: Perspectives on complementary and alternative medicine. Symposium presented at the meeting of the College of Physicians and Surgeons of Nova Scotia, Canada.

Brown, H., Cassileth, B. R., Lewis, J. P., & Renner, J. H. (1994, June 15). Alternative medicine, or quackery? Patient Care, 28(11), 80.

Burkitt, D. P., Walker, A. R., & Painter, N. S. (1974). Dietary fi ber and disease. JAMA, 229(8), 1068–1074.

Burns, E., & Blarney, C. (1994). Using aromatherapy in childbirth. Nursing Times, 90, 54–60.

Campion, E. W. (1993). Why unconventional medicine? New England Journal of Medicine, 328, 282.

Cassileth, B. R. (1998). Overview of alternative/ complementary medicine. Cancer Practice, 6(4), 243–245.

Cassileth, B. R., & Chapman, C. C. (1996). Alternative cancer medicine: A 10-year update. Cancer Investigation, 14(4), 396–404.

Cassileth, B. R., Luck, E., Strouse, T., & Bodenheimer, B. (1984). Contemporary unorthodox treatments in cancer medicine: A study of patients, treatments, and practitioners. Annals of Internal Medicine, 101, 105–113.

Chandra, R. K. (1992). Nutrition and immunity in the elderly. Nutritional Review, 50(12), 367–371.

Chao, M. T., Wade, C., & Kronenberg, F. (2008). Disclosure of complementary and alternative medicine to conventional medical providers: Variation by race/ ethnicity and type of CAM. Journal of the National Medical Association, 100(11), 1341–1349.

JWBT514_ch12.indd 313JWBT514_ch12.indd 313 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

314 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

Chappell, L. T. (1995). EDTA chelation therapy should be more commonly used in the treatment of vascular disease. Alternative Therapies Health Medicine, 1(2), 53–57.

Chopra, D. (1989). Quantum healing: Exploring the frontiers of mind/body medicine. New York, NY: Bantam.

Cohen, K. (1999). Native American medicine. In W. B. Jonas & J. S. Levin (Eds.), Essentials of complementary and alternative medicine (pp. 233–251). Philadelphia, PA: Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.

Committee on the Use of Complementary and Alternative Medicine by the American Public. (2005). Complementary and Alternative Medicine in the United States. Washington, DC: National Academies Press.

Corley, M. C., Ferriter, J., Zeh, J., & Gifford, C. (1995). Physiological and psychological effects of back rubs. Applied Nursing Research, 8(1), 39–42.

Croom, E. M. (2000, April 14). Major herbal medicines for which clinical studies appear promising. In D. M. Eisenberg & D. Foster (Eds.), Recent advances in complementary and alternative medicine. (Symposium, Harvard Clinical and Translational Science Center, course code PN 12).

Culliton, P. D., & Kiresuk, T. J. (1996). Overview of substance abuse acupuncture treatment research. Journal of Alternative and Complementary Medicine, 2(1), 149–165.

DeGood, D. (1996). Effect of massage therapy and post- surgical outcomes. Research grant abstracts and results. Rockville, MD: NIH Offi ce of Alternative Medicine.

De Smet, P. A. (1999). The safety of herbal products. In W. B. Jonas & J. S. Levin (Eds.), Essentials of complementary and alternative medicine (pp. 108–147). Philadelphia, PA: Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.

Disbrow, E. A., Bennett, H. L., & Owings, J. T. (1993). Effect of preoperative suggestion on postoperative gastrointestinal motility. West Journal Medicine, 158, 488–492.

Dunn, C., Sleep, J., & Collett, D. (1995). Sensing an improvement: An experimental study to evaluate the use of aromatherapy, massage and periods of rest in an intensive care unit. Journal Advances Nursing, 21(1), 34–40.

Eisenberg, D. M. (1997). Advising patients who seek alternative medical therapies. Annals of Internal Medicine, 127(1), 61–69.

Eisenberg, D. M., Davis, R. B., Ettner, S. L., Appel, S., Wilkey, S., Van Rompay, M., & Kessler, R. C. (1998). Trends in alternative medicine use in the United States, 1990–1997: Results of a follow-up national survey. JAMA, 280(18), 1569–1575.

Eisenberg, D. M., Kessler, R. C., Foster, C., Norlock, F. E., Calkins, D. R., & Delbanco, T. L. (1993). Unconventional medicine in the United States:

Prevalence, costs, and patterns of use. New England Journal of Medicine, 326(4), 246–252.

Eisenberg, D. M., Kessler, R. C., Van Rompay, M. I., Kaptchuk, T. J., Wilkey, S. A., Appel, S., & Davis, R. B. (2001). Perceptions about complementary therapies relative to conventional therapies among adults who use both: Results from a national survey. Annals of Internal Medicine, 135(5), 344–351.

Enqvist, B. (1991). Preoperative hypnotherapy and preoperative suggestions in general anesthesia: Somatic responses. Hypnosis, 28, 72–77.

Ernst, E. (1994). Complementary medicine: Common misconceptions [Editorial]. Journal Research Sociology of Medicine, 88(5), 244.

Ernst, E. (1995). Complementary cancer treatments: Hope or hazard? Clinical Oncology, 7(4), 259–272.

Ernst, E., & Cassileth, B. R. (1998). The prevalence of complementary/alternative medicine in cancer: A systematic review. Cancer, 83(4), 777–782.

Eskinazi, D. P. (1998). Factors that shape alternative medicine. JAMA, 280(18), 1621–1623.

Ezzo, J., Vickers, A., Richardson, M. A., Allen, C., Dibble, S. L., Issell, B., . . . Zhang, G. (2005). Acupuncture- point stimulation for chemotherapy-induced nausea and vomiting. Journal of Clinical Oncology, 23(28), 7188–7198.

Fawzy, F. I., Fawzy, N. W., Hyun, C. S., Elashoff, R., Guthrie, D., Fahey, J. L., & Morton, D. L. (1993). Malignant melanoma: Effects of an early structured psychiatric intervention, coping, and affective state on recurrence and survival 6 years later. Archives of General Psychiatry, 50(9), 681–689.

Field, T. M., Schanberg, S. M., Scafi di, F., Bauer, C. R., Vega-Lahr, N., Garcia, R., . . . Kuhn, C. M. (1986). Tactile/kinesthetic stimulation effects on preterm neonates. Pediatrics, 77(5), 654–658.

Findlay, S., Podolsky, D., & Silberner, J. (1991, September 23). Wonder cures from the fringe. U.S. News & World Report, 68–71, 73–74.

Fontanarosa, P. B., & Lundberg, G. D. (1998). Alternative medicine meets science. JAMA, 280(18), 1618–1619.

Foster, S. (1991). Garlic botanical series 311. Austin, TX: American Botanical Council.

Gaby, A. R. (1999). Orthomolecular medicine and megavitamin therapy. In W. B. Jonas & J. S. Levin (Eds.), Essentials of complementary and alternative medicine (pp. 459–471). Philadelphia, PA: Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.

Gandhi, R. (1996). The uses of auricular acupuncture in the fi eld of substance misuse. Psychiatric Care, 3, 40–41.

Gerber, R. (1988). Vibrational medicine: New choices for healing ourselves. Sante Fe, NM: Bear & Co.

Ginandes, C., Brooks, P., Sando, W., Jones, C., & Aker, J. (2003). Can medical hypnosis accelerate post- surgical wound healing? American Journal of Clinical Hypnosis, 45(4), 333–351.

JWBT514_ch12.indd 314JWBT514_ch12.indd 314 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Developing a Shared Understanding 315

Goldberg, B., Anderson, J. W., & Trivieri, L. (Eds.). (2002). Alternative medicine: The defi nitive guide (2nd ed.). Berkeley, CA: Celestial Arts.

Hackman, R. M., Stern, J. S., & Gershwin, M. E. (2000). Hypnosis and asthma: A critical review. Journal of Asthma, 37(1), 1–15.

Hafner, R. J. (1982). Psychological treatment of essential hypertension: A controlled comparison of meditation and meditation plus biofeedback. Biofeedback & Self- Regulation, 7(3), 305-316.

Harrison, L., Olivet, L., Cunningham, K., Bodin, M. B., & Hicks, C. (1996). Effects of gentle human touch on pre-term infants: Pilot study results. Neonatal Network, 15(2), 35–42.

Hemila, H. (1994). Does vitamin C alleviate the symptoms of the common cold? A review of current evidence. Scandinavian Journal of Infectious Disease, 26(1), 1–6.

Hillhouse, J., & Adler, C. (1991). Stress, health, and immunity: A review of the literature and implications for the nursing profession. Holistic Nurse Practitioner, 5(4), 22–23.

Hsiao, A. F., Wong, M. D., Goldstein, M. S., Yu, H. J., Andersen, R. M., Brown, E. R., . . . Wenger, N. S. (2006). Variation in complementary and alternative medicine (CAM) use across racial/ethnic groups and the development of ethnic-specifi c measures of CAM use. Journal of Alternative and Complementary Medicine, 12(3), 281–290.

Hudson, C. (1996, Spring). Acupuncture and traditional Oriental medicine in the treatment of HIV and AIDS. STEP Perspective, 8(1), 2–3.

Hurdle, D. E. (2002). Native Hawaiian traditional healing: Culturally based interventions for social work practice. Social Work, 47(2), 183–193.

Institute of Medicine. (2005). Complementary and alter- native medicine in the United States. Washington, DC. National Academy of Science.

Jacobs, J., Jimenez, L. M., Gloyd, S. S., Gale, J. L., & Crothers, D. (1994). Treatment of acute childhood diarrhea with homeopathic medicine: A randomized clinical trial in Nicaragua. Pediatrics, 93(5), 718–725.

Jackson, D. A. (1997). Acupuncture for the relief of pain: An overview. Physical Therapy Reviews, 2, 13–18.

Jarvis, K. B., Phillips, R. B., & Morris, E. K. (1991). Cost per case of back injury claims: Chiropractic versus medical management for conditions with identical diagnosis codes. Journal of Occupational Medicine, 33(8), 847–852.

Johansson, K., Lindgren, I., Widner, H., Wiklund, I., & Johansson, B. B. (1993). Can sensory stimulation improve the functional outcome in stroke patients? Neurology, 43(11), 2189–2192.

Jonas, W. B. (1998). Alternative medicine: Learning from the past, examining the present, advancing to the future. JAMA, 280(18), 1616–1617.

Justice, B. (1996). Alternative medicine’s relevance to public health practice and research. Alternative Therapies and Health Medicine, 2(3), 24–25.

Kabat-Zinn, J., Lipworth, L., & Burney, R. (1985). The clinical use of mindfulness meditation for the self- regulation of chronic pain. Journal of Behavioral Medicine, 8(2), 163–190.

Kabat-Zinn, J., Wheeler, E., Light, T., Skillings, A., Scharf, M. J., Cropley, T. G., . . . Bernhard, J. D. (1998). Infl uence of a mindfulness meditation-based stress reduction intervention on rates of skin clearing in patients with moderate to severe psoriasis undergoing phototherapy (UVB) and photochemotherapy (PUVA). Psychosomatic Medicine, 60(5), 625–632.

Keller, E., & Bzdek, V. M. (1986). Effects of therapeutic touch on tension headache pain. Nurse Researcher, 35(2), 101–106.

Kleijnen, J., Knipschild, P., & Riet, G. (1991). Trials of homeopathy. British Medical Journal, 302(6782), 960.

Koscielney, J., Klussendorf, D., Latza, R., Schmitt, R., Siegel, G., & Kiesewetter, H. (1999). The antiatherosclerotic effect of Allium sativum. Atherosclerosis, 144(1), 237–249.

Krajewski-Jaime, E. R. (1991). Folk-healing among Mexican-American families as a consideration in the delivery of child welfare and child health care services. Child Welfare, 70(2), 157–167.

Kramer, N. A. (1990). Comparison of therapeutic touch and casual touch in stress reduction of hospitalized children. Pediatric Nursing, 16(5), 483–485.

Krippner, S. (1995). A cross-cultural comparison of four healing models. Alternative Therapies, 1(1), 21–29.

Launso, L., Brendstrup, E., & Amberg, S. (1999). An exploratory study of refl exological treatment for headache. Alternative Therapies in Health and Medicine, 5(3), 57–65.

Lawrence, D. J., & Meeker, W. C. (2007). Chiropractic and CAM utilization: A descriptive review. Chiropractic and Osteopathy, 15(2), 1–27.

Lawson, L. D. (1997, May). The science and therapeutic effects of garlic and other allium species. Program book entry from the Functional Foods for Health, Sixth Annual Retreat, University of Illinois at Chicago and the University of Illinois at Urbana-Champaign.

Lee, R. C., Canaday, D. J., & Doong, H. (1993). A review of the biophysical basis for the clinical application of electric fi elds in soft tissue repair. Journal of Burn Care and Rehabilitation, 14, 319–335.

Lerner, I. J., & Kennedy, B. J. (1992). The prevalence of questionable methods of cancer treatment in the United States. CA: A Cancer Journal for Clinicians, 42(3), 181–191.

Levitan, A. A. (1992). The use of hypnosis with cancer patients. Psychiatric Medicine, 10(1), 119–131.

Long, J. M., Machiran, N. M., & Bertell, B. L. (1986). Biofeedback: An adjunct to social work practice. Social Work, 31, 476–478.

JWBT514_ch12.indd 315JWBT514_ch12.indd 315 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

316 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

Loveland-Cook, C. S., Becvar, D. S., & Pontious, S. L. (2000). Complementary alternative medicine in health and mental health: Implications for social work practice. Social Work in Health Care, 31(3), 39–47.

Lu, D. P., Lu, G. P., & Kleinman, L. (2001). Acupuncture and clinical hypnosis for facial and head and neck pain: A single crossover comparison. American Journal of Clinical Hypnosis, 44(2), 141–148.

Lynch, D. (1998). Applications of clinical hypnosis in cancer therapy. In W. Mathews & J. H. Edgette (Eds.), The evolution of brief therapy: An annual publication of the Milton H. Erickson Foundation (pp. 161–203). New York, NY: Brunner/Mazel.

MacIntosh, A. (1999, July). Understanding the differences between conventional, alternative, complementary, integrative and natural medicine. Townsend Letter for Doctors and Patients, 60–62.

MacKenzie, E. R., Taylor, L., Bloom, B. S., Hufford, D. J., & Johnson, J. C. (2003). Ethnic minority use of complementary and alternative medicine (CAM): A national probability survey of CAM utilizers. Alternative Therapies, 9(4), 50–56.

Marchioro, G., Azzarello, G., Viviani, F., Barbato, F., Pavanetto, M., Rosetti, F., . . . Vinante, O. (2000). Hypnosis in the treatment of anticipatory nausea and vomiting in patients receiving cancer chemotherapy. Oncology, 59(2), 100–104.

Marrone, C. M. (1999). Safety issues with herbal products. Annals of Pharmacotherapy, 33(12), 1359–1362.

Meade, T. W., Dyer, S., Browne, W., Townsend, J., & Frank, A. O. (1990). Low back pain of mechanical origin: Randomized comparison of chiropractic and hospital outpatient treatment. British Medical Journal, 300(6737), 1431–1437.

Merriam-Webster. (2003). Merriam-Webster’s Collegiate Dictionary (11th edition). Springfi eld, MA: Author.

Molassiotis, A., Fernadez-Ortega, P., Pud, D., Ozden, G., Scott, J. A., Panteli, V., . . . Patiraki, E. (2005). Use of complementary and alternative medicine in cancer patients. Annals of Oncology, 16(4), 655–663.

Montgomery, G. H., DuHamel, K. N., & Redd, W. H. (2000). A meta-analysis of hypnotically induced analgesia. International Journal of Clinical and Experimental Hypnosis, 48(2), 138–153.

Montgomery, G. H., Bovbjerg, D. H., Schnur, J. B., David, D., Goldfarb, A., Weltz, C. R., . . . Silverstein, J. (2007). A randomized clinical trial of a brief hypnosis intervention to control side effects in breast surgery patients. Journal of the National Cancer Institute, 99(17), 1304–1312.

Moore, K., & Schmais, L. (2000, November/December). The ABCs of complementary and alternative therapies and cancer treatment. Oncology Issues, 20–22.

Moore, T. J., Psaty, B. M., & Furberg, C. D. (1998). Time to act on drug safety. JAMA, 279(19), 1571–1573.

Mortensen, S. A., Aabo, K., Jonsson, T., & Baandrup, U. (1986). Clinical and non-invasive assessment

of anthracycline cardiotoxicity: Perspectives on myocardial protection. International Journal of Clinical Pharmacological Research, 6(3), 137–150.

Murray, M. T., & Pizzorno, J. (1996). Encyclopedia of nutritional supplements: The essential guide for improving your health naturally. New York, NY: Random House.

Nahin, R. L., Barnes, P. M., Stussman, B. J., & Bloom, B. (2009). Costs of complementary and alternative medicine (CAM) and frequency of visits to CAM practitioners: United States, 2007. National Health Statistics Reports, 18.

National Center for Complementary and Alternative Medicine. (2000, June). General information about complementary and alternative medicine and the National Center for Complementary and Alternative Medicine (Pub. M-42). Silver Spring, MD: NCCAM Clearinghouse.

National Institutes of Health. (1992). Alternative medicine: Expanding medical horizons. Washington, DC: U.S. Government Printing Offi ce.

Neff, N. (2004). Folk medicine in Hispanics in the southwestern United States (Module VII). Retrieved from www.rice.edu/projects/HispanicHealth/Courses /mod7/mod7.

Newton, P. (1996). Hypnotic imagery and immunity. Research grant abstracts and results. Rockville, MD: NIH Offi ce of Alternative Medicine.

Ni, H., Simile, C., & Hardy, A. M. (2002). Utilization of complementary and alternative medicine by United States adults: Results from the 1999 National Health Interview Survey. Medical Care, 40(4), 353–358.

Noonan, D. (2002, December 2). For the littlest patients. Newsweek, 58–62.

Ornish, D., Scherwitz, L. W., Billings, J. H., Brown, S. E., Gould, K. L., Merritt, T. A., Brand, R. J. (1998). Intensive lifestyle changes for reversal of coronary heart disease. JAMA, 280(23), 2001–2007.

Ornish, D., Scherwitz, L. W., Doody, R. S., Kesten, D., McLanahan, S. M., Brown, S. E., . . . Gotto, A. M., Jr. (1983). Effects of stress management training and dietary changes in treating ischemic heart disease. JAMA, 249(1), 54–59.

Pachter, L. (1994). Culture and clinical care: Folk illness beliefs and their implications for health care delivery. JAMA, 271, 690–694.

Pan, C. X., Morrison, R. S., Ness, J., Fugh-Berman, A., & Leipzig, M. (2000). Complementary and alternative medicine in the management of pain, dyspnea, and nausea and vomiting near the end of life: A systematic review. Journal of Pain and Symptom Management, 20(5), 374–387.

Pelletier, K. R., & Astin, J. A. (2002). Integration and reimbursement of complementary and alternative medicine by managed care and insurance providers: 2000 update and cohort analysis. Alternative Therapies in Health Medicine, 8(1), 38–39.

JWBT514_ch12.indd 316JWBT514_ch12.indd 316 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Developing a Shared Understanding 317

Pietroni, P. C. (1994). The interface between complementary medicine and general practice. Journal of the Royal Society of Medicine (Suppl. 22), S28–S30.

Podolsky, D. (1991, September 23). Big claims, no proof. U.S. News & World Report, 77.

Quinn, J. F., & Strelkauskas, A. J. (1993). Psychoimmuno- logical effects of therapeutic touch on practitioners and recently bereaved recipients: A pilot study. Advances in Nursing Science, 15(4), 13–26.

Rattenbury, J. (1995, January). The other health care reform: From acupuncture to massage therapy and beyond—A guide to alternative treatments that are winning patients and even, in some cases, the grudging acceptance of the medical establishment. Chicago, 62–65.

Rauber, C. (1998). HMO: Open to alternatives. Modern Healthcare, 28(36), S7.

Richardson, M. A., Sanders, T., Palmer, J. L., Greisinger, A., & Singletary, S. E. (2000). Complementary/ alternative medicine use in a comprehensive cancer center and the implications for oncology. Journal of Clinical Oncology, 18, 2505–2521.

Scholten, R., & Van Rompay, M. (2000, January). Complementary and alternative medical (CAM) therapies: Information resources for health professionals. Boston, MA: Beth Israel Deaconess Medical Center, Center for Alternative Medicine Research and Education.

Seaward, B. L. (1997). Managing stress: Principles and strategies for health and well-being (2nd ed.). Boston, MA: Jones and Bartlett.

Sims, S. (1986). Slow stroke back massage for cancer patients. Nursing Times, 82(13), 47–50.

Sloman, R. (1995). Relaxation and the relief of cancer pain. Nursing Clinics of North America, 30(4), 697– 709.

Solecki, R. S. (1975). Shanidar IV, a Neanderthal fl ower burial of northern Iraq. Science, 190(28), 880–881.

Sparber, A., Bauer, L., Curt, G., Eisenberg, D., Levin, T., Parks, S., . . . Wootton, J. (2000). Use of complementary medicine by adult patients participating in cancer clinical trials. Oncology Nurses Forum, 27(4), 623– 630.

Stephenson, L. N., & Dalton, J. (2003). Using refl exology for pain management: A review. Journal of Holistic Nursing, 21(2), 179–191.

Sullivan, M. J. (2000, October). Integrative medicine: Making it work for you. Emergency Medicine, 10, 76–83.

Syrjala, K. L., Cummings, C., & Donaldson, G. W. (1992). Hypnosis or cognitive behavioral training for the reduction of pain and nausea during treatment: A controlled clinical trial. Pain, 63(2), 189–198.

Takeda, W., & Wessel, J. (1994). Acupuncture for the treatment of pain of osteoarthritic knees. Arthritis Care and Research, 7(3), 118–122.

Taylor, E. (1995). Homeopathic medicine. Alternative Therapies in Health and Medicine, 1(1), 72–73.

Testerman, J. K., Morton, K. R., Mason, R. A., & Ronan, A. M. (2004). Patient motivations for using complementary and alternative medicine. Complementary Health Practice Review, 9(2), 81–92.

Troesch, L. M., Rodehaver, C. B., Delaney, E. A., & Yanes, B. (1993). The infl uence of guided imagery on chemotherapy-related nausea and vomiting. Oncology Nursing Forum, 20, 1179–1185.

Vickers, A. (2003). Introduction to evidence-based complementary medicine. Retrieved from http:// ktclearinghouse.ca/cebm/syllabi/complementary/intro

Vorberg, G., & Schneider, B. (1990). Therapy with garlic: Results of a placebo-controlled, double-blind study. British Journal of Clinical Practice Supplement, 69, 7–11.

Warshafsky, S., Kramer, R., & Sivak, S. (1993). Effect of garlic on total serum cholesterol: A meta-analysis. Annals of Internal Medicine, 119(7), 599–605.

Weil, A. (2001). CAM and continuing education: the future is now. Alternative Therapies in Health and Medicine, 7(3), 32–34.

Wells-Federman, C. L., Stuart, E. M., Deckro, J. P., Mandle, C. L., Baim, M., & Medich, C. (1995). The mind-body connection: The psychophysiology of many traditional nursing interventions. Clinical Nursing Specialist, 9(1), 59–66.

Wetzel, S., Eisenberg, D. M., & Kaptchuk, T. J. (1998). Courses involving complementary and alternative medicine at U.S. medical schools. JAMA, 280(9), 784–787.

Wharton, J. C. (1999). The history of complementary and alternative medicine. In W. B. Jonas & J. S. Levin (Eds.), Essentials of complementary and alternative medicine (pp. 16–45). Philadelphia, PA: Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.

Yates, J. S., Mustian, K. M., Morrow, G. R., Gillies, L. J., Padmanaban, D., Atkins, J. N., . . . Colman, L. K. (2005). Prevalence of complementary and alternative medicine use in cancer patients during treatment. Supportive Care in Cancer, 13(10), 806–811.

JWBT514_ch12.indd 317JWBT514_ch12.indd 317 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

318

13

Families, Health, and Illness

JOHN S. ROLLAND

Illness, disability, and death are universal expe- riences in families. The real question is not if we will face these issues but when in our lives they will occur, under what kinds of conditions, how long they will last, and how serious they will be. With major advances in medical tech- nology, people are living much longer with conditions that in the past have been fatal. This means that ever-growing numbers of families are living with chronic disorders over an in- creasingly long time span and coping with a greater number of conditions, often simulta- neously. This chapter provides a normative, preventive model for assessment, psychoedu- cation, and intervention with families facing chronic and life-threatening conditions. This model offers a systemic view of healthy family adaptation to serious illness as a developmental process over time in relation to the complexi- ties and diversity of contemporary family life, modern medicine, and existing fl awed models of health-care delivery and access to care.

Chapter Objectives • Outline a comprehensive family systems

model for assessment and clinical interven- tion with families facing chronic illness and disability.

• Describe the psychosocial demands of ill- ness based on their pattern of onset, course, outcome, incapacitation, and level of uncer- tainty.

• Delineate the crisis, chronic, and terminal phases of illness; the transitions between phases; and the psychosocial developmental tasks associated with each phase.

• Discuss the interface of illness, individual, and family development; multigenerational

legacies of illness and loss; and how these legacies relate to coping and adaptation to chronic illness.

• Describe how health belief systems affect a patient’s or family’s response to illness.

OVERVIEW OF THE FAMILY SYSTEMS-ILLNESS MODEL

Over the past 30 years, family-centered, collaborative, biopsychosocial models of health care have grown and evolved (Blount, 1998; Doherty & Baird, 1983; Engel, 1977; McDaniel, Campbell, Hepworth, & Lorenz, 2005; McDaniel, Hepworth, & Doherty, in press; Miller, McDaniel, Rolland, & Feetham, 2006; Rolland, 1994a; Seaburn, Gunn, Mauksch, Gawinski, & Lorenz, 1996; Wood et al., 2008). There is substantial evidence for the mutual infl uence of family functioning, health, and physical illness (Carr & Springer, 2010; D’Onofrio & Lahey, 2010; Weihs, Fisher, & Baird, 2002) and the usefulness of family-centered interventions with chronic health conditions (Campbell, 2003). Weihs and colleagues (2002) summarized the increasing body of research regarding the impact of se- rious illness on families across the life span and the relationship of family dynamics to ill- ness behavior, adherence, and disease course. In this report, a broad defi nition of family was used. Family was defi ned as a “group of in- timates with strong emotional bonds . . . and with a history and a future as a group” (p. 8). Most illness management takes place within the context of the family environment. Social work interventions in health settings aim to

JWBT514_ch13.indd 318JWBT514_ch13.indd 318 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Families, Health, and Illness 319

help families adjust to and live with the de- mands of an illness or disability, assist fami- lies in navigating the health-care system, and enhance quality of life for the entire family.

There is a clear need for a conceptual model that provides a guide useful to both clinical practice and research, one that allows a dynamic, open communication between these disciplines. What is most needed is a compre- hensive way to organize our thinking about all the complex interactions among biologi- cal illness, family, individual family members, and professionals involved in providing care. We need a model that can accommodate the changing landscape of interactions between these “parts of the system” over the course of the illness and the changing seasons over the life course.

Families enter the world of illness and dis- ability without a psychosocial map. To master the challenges presented by an illness or dis- ability, families must understand the impact of the condition on the entire family network. The Family Systems-Illness Model that was developed by Rolland (1984, 1987a, b, 1990, 1994a, 1998) is based on a strength-oriented perspective, viewing family relationships as a resource and emphasizing possibilities for resilience and growth, not just liabilities and risks (Walsh, 2006). This model provides so- cial workers with a framework for assessing the impact of an illness or disability on family life and for structuring interventions to meet the needs of family members.

Defi ned in system terms, an effective psy- chosocial model for assessing the impact of illness on family life needs to encompass all people affected by the condition. The fi rst step to constructing such a model is to redefi ne the unit of care to include the family or caregiv- ing system rather than just the ill individual (McDaniel et al., in press). This is a departure from the medical model’s narrow focus on the patient alone. By using a broad defi nition of family as the cornerstone of the caregiving system, we can describe a model of successful coping and adaptation based on family system strengths. By viewing the family as the unit of care, in which a broad range of family forms

and dynamics is normative, social workers can apply a model that addresses the fi t between family resources and strengths and the de- mands of the condition over time.

In situations of chronic disorders, a basic task for families is to create a meaning for the illness situation that preserves their sense of competency and mastery. At the extremes, competing ideologies can leave families with a choice between a biological explanation or one of personal responsibility (e.g., illness as retribution for wrongdoing). Families desper- ately need reassurance that they are handling illnesses appropriately. (Bad things do happen to good people.) These needs often occur in the context of a vague or nonexistent psycho- social map. Many families, particularly those with untimely disorders, fi nd themselves in unfamiliar territory and without guides. This fact highlights the need for a preventive, psy- choeducational approach that helps families anticipate normative illness-related develop- mental tasks over time in a fashion that maxi- mizes their sense of control and mastery.

To create a normative context for their ill- ness experience, families need a four-part foundation:

1. They need a psychosocial understanding of the condition in systems terms. This means learning the expected pattern of practical and affective demands of a disorder over the life course of the condition, including a time frame for disease-related developmental tasks associated with different phases of the unfolding disorder.

2. Families need to understand themselves as a systemic functional unit.

3. They need an appreciation of individual and family life-cycle patterns and changes to facilitate their incorporation of changing developmental demands for the family unit and individual members in relation to the demands of a chronic disorder.

4. Families need to understand the cultural, ethnic, spiritual, and gender-based beliefs that guide the type of caregiving system they construct. This includes guiding principles

JWBT514_ch13.indd 319JWBT514_ch13.indd 319 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

320 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

that defi ne roles, rules of communication, defi nitions of success or mastery, and fi t with beliefs of the health-care providers. Family understanding in these areas facilitates a more holistic integration of the disorder and the family as a functional family-health/ illness system evolving over time.

The Family Systems-Illness Model ad- dresses three dimensions: (1) psychosocial types of health conditions, (2) major develop- mental phases in their natural history, and (3) key family system variables (see Figure 13.1). It attends to the expected psychosocial de- mands of a disorder through its various phases, family systems dynamics that emphasize fam- ily and individual development, multigenera- tional patterns, and belief systems (including infl uences of culture, ethnicity, spirituality, and gender; see Figure 13.2). The model em- phasizes the match between the psychosocial demands of the disorder over time and the strengths and vulnerabilities of a family.

Psychosocial Types of Illness

The standard disease classifi cation used in medical settings is based on purely biological

criteria that are clustered in ways to establish a medical diagnosis and treatment plan rather than on the psychosocial demands on patients and their families. The alternative classifi ca- tion scheme presented here provides a better link between the biological and psychoso- cial worlds and thereby clarifi es the relation- ship between chronic illness and the family (Rolland, 1984, 1994a). The goal of this ty- pology is to defi ne meaningful and useful categories with similar psychosocial demands for a wide array of chronic illnesses affecting individuals across the life span.

Onset

Illnesses can be divided into those that have ei- ther an acute onset, such as strokes, or a grad- ual onset, such as Alzheimer’s disease. For acute-onset illnesses, emotional and practical changes are compressed into a short period of time, requiring families to mobilize their crisis-management skills more rapidly. Fami- lies that are able to tolerate highly charged emotional situations, exchange roles fl exibly, problem-solve effi ciently, and utilize outside resources will have an advantage in managing acute-onset conditions. Gradual-onset con- ditions, such as Parkinson’s disease, allow a more gradual period of adjustment.

Course

The course of chronic diseases generally takes three forms: progressive, constant, or

In di

vid ual

, Fam ily, and Illness Life Cycles

Be lief

System s – Culture/Ethnicity

Type of Illness/Disability/L

oss

Figure 13.2 Family Systems-Illness Model

Source: From Families, Illness, and Disability: An Integrative Treatment Model, by J. S. Rolland, 1994a, New York, NY: Basic Books. Reprinted with permission.

Illness Type

Components of Family Functioning

Time Phases

Figure 13.1 Three-Dimensional Model

Source: From “Chronic Illness and the Life Cycle: A Conceptual Framework,” by J. S. Rolland, 1987a, Family Process, 26(2), 203–221. Reprinted with permission.

JWBT514_ch13.indd 320JWBT514_ch13.indd 320 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Families, Health, and Illness 321

relapsing/episodic. With a progressive disease, such as Alzheimer’s or Parkinson’s, the family is faced with a perpetually symptomatic fam- ily member whose disability worsens in a step- wise or gradual way. The family must live with the prospect of continual role change and ad- aptation to continued losses as the disease pro- gresses. Increasing strain on family caregiving is caused by exhaustion, with few periods of relief from the demands of the illness, and by new caregiving tasks over time.

With a constant-course illness, the oc- currence of an initial event is followed by a stable biological course, such as a single heart attack or spinal cord injury. Typically, after an initial period of recovery, the ill- ness is characterized by some clear-cut defi - cit or limitation. The family is faced with a semipermanent change that is stable and predictable over a considerable time span. Therefore, the potential for family exhaus- tion exists without the strain of new role de- mands over time.

Relapsing, or episodic-course illnesses, such as back problems and asthma, are dis- tinguished by the alternation of stable low- symptom periods with periods of fl are-up or exacerbation. Families are strained by both the frequency of transitions between periods of crisis and noncrisis and ongoing uncertainty about when the disorder might recur. Families must develop two modes of operation, one to cope with fl are-ups and another to address periods of relative stability. Families must re- main fl exible as they alternate between these two forms of organization. The wide psycho- logical discrepancy between low-symptom periods versus fl are-up is a particularly taxing feature unique to relapsing diseases.

Outcome

The extent to which a chronic illness leads to death or shortens a person’s life span has a profound psychosocial impact. The most crucial factor is the initial expectation of whether a disease will cause death. On one end of the continuum are illnesses that do not typically affect the life span, such as allergies

or arthritis. At the other extreme are illnesses that are clearly progressive and fatal, such as metastatic cancer. An intermediate, more un- predictable category includes both illnesses that shorten the life span, such as heart dis- ease, and those that may bring sudden death, such as hemophilia. A major difference be- tween these kinds of outcome is the degree to which the family experiences anticipatory loss and its pervasive effects on family life (Rolland, 1990, 2004).

Incapacitation

Disability can involve impairment of cogni- tion (e.g., Alzheimer’s disease), sensation (e.g., blindness), movement (e.g., stroke with paralysis), stamina (e.g., heart disease), dis- fi gurement (e.g., mastectomy), and conditions associated with social stigma (e.g., acquired immunodefi ciency syndrome [AIDS]; Olkin, 1999). The extent, kind, and timing of dis- ability imply sharp differences in the degree of family stress. For instance, the combined cognitive and motor defi cits caused by a stroke necessitate greater family reorganization than those caused by a spinal cord injury, in which cognitive abilities are unaffected. For some ill- nesses, such as stroke, disability often is worst at the beginning. For progressive diseases, such as Alzheimer’s, disability looms as an increasing problem in later phases of the ill- ness, allowing a family more time to prepare for anticipated changes and an opportunity for the ill member to participate in disease-related family planning while still cognitively able (Boss, 1999).

The predictability of an illness, or the de- gree of uncertainty about the specifi c way in which it will unfold, overlays all other vari- ables. For illnesses with highly unpredictable courses, such as multiple sclerosis, family cop- ing and adaptation, especially future planning, are hindered by anticipatory anxiety and am- biguity about what the family will encounter. Families able to put long-term uncertainty into perspective are best prepared to avoid the risks of exhaustion and dysfunction.

By combining the types of onset, course, outcome, and incapacitation into a grid, we

JWBT514_ch13.indd 321JWBT514_ch13.indd 321 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

322 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

generate a typology that clusters illnesses ac- cording to similarities and differences in pat- terns that pose differing psychosocial demands.

Time Phases of Illness

Too often, discussions of “coping with can- cer,” “managing disability,” or “dealing with life-threatening disease” approach illness as a static state and fail to appreciate the dynamic unfolding of illness processes over time. The concept of time phases allows social work- ers and families to think longitudinally and to understand chronic illness as an ongoing process with normative landmarks, transitions, and changing demands. Each phase of an ill- ness poses its own psychosocial demands and developmental tasks that require signifi cantly different strengths, attitudes, or changes from a family. The core psychosocial themes in the natural history of chronic disease can be de- scribed in three major phases: crisis, chronic, and terminal (see Figure 13.3, Table 13.1).

Crisis Phase

The crisis phase includes any symptomatic period before diagnosis through the initial readjustment period after a diagnosis and ini- tial treatment planning. This phase presents a number of key tasks for the ill member and family. Moos (1989) describes certain univer- sal, practical illness-related tasks, including (a) learning to cope with any symptoms or disability, (b) adapting to health-care settings and treatment procedures, and (c) establishing and maintaining workable relationships with

Figure 13.3 Timeline and Phases of Illness

Source: From Families, Illness, and Disability: An Integrative Treatment Model, by J. S. Rolland, 1994a, New York, NY: Basic Books. Reprinted with permission.

Table 13.1 Phases of Illness Developmental Tasks

Crisis Phase 1. Family understands itself in systems terms.

2. Family has a psychosocial understanding of illness.

a. In practical and emotional terms.

b. In longitudinal and developmental terms.

3. Family appreciates developmental perspective (individual, family, illness life cycles).

4. Family experiences crisis reorganization.

5. Family creates meaning that promotes family mastery and competence.

6. Family defi nes challenge as shared one in “we” terms.

7. Family accepts permanence of illness/disability.

8. Family grieves loss of family identity before chronic disorder.

9. Family acknowledges possibilities of further loss while sustaining hope.

10. Family develops fl exibility to ongoing psychosocial demands of illness.

11. Family learns to live with symptoms.

12. Family adapts to treatments and health-care settings.

13. Family establishes functional collaborative relationship with health-care providers.

Chronic Phase 1. Maximize autonomy for all family members given

constraints of illness.

2. Balance connectedness and separateness of family members.

3. Minimize relationship skews in the family.

4. Maximize mindfulness to possible impact on current and future phases of family and individual life cycles.

Terminal Phase 1. Complete the process of anticipatory grief and

unresolved family issues.

2. Support the terminally ill member.

3. Help survivors and dying member live as fully as possible in the time remaining.

4. Begin the family reorganization process.

JWBT514_ch13.indd 322JWBT514_ch13.indd 322 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Families, Health, and Illness 323

the health-care team. There also are critical tasks of a more general, existential nature. The family needs to (a) create a meaning for the illness that maximizes a sense of mastery and competency, (b) grieve for the loss of health, (c) gradually accept the illness as permanent while maintaining a sense of continuity be- tween its past and future, (d) pull together to cope with the immediate crisis, and (e) in the face of uncertainty, develop goals for the future.

During this initial adjustment period, health professionals have enormous infl uence over a family’s approach to and sense of competence in accomplishing these developmental tasks. Initial meetings and advice given at the time of diagnosis can be thought of as a “framing event.” Because families are so vulnerable at this point, clinicians need to be extremely sensitive in their interactions with family members. They should be aware of messages conveyed by their behavior in interactions with the family. This framing event has a powerful infl uence on what the family decides is nor- mal. For instance, if a clinician meets with parents separately from adolescents to give them information about a cancer diagnosis and prognosis, the parents may assume they were being instructed implicitly to protect their adolescent from any discussion of the illness. Social workers can encourage physicians to ask patients whom they would like to include in important discussions or can help reframe these experiences for families by asking them about their preferences.

With life-threatening conditions that can cause sudden death (e.g., heart attack), there is a higher premium on early frank conversation. Knowing an ill member’s wishes concerning heroic medical efforts and life support can benefi t everyone. For example, in one family, the father had serious heart disease. Every- one, including the father, became emotionally paralyzed by fear because end-of-life decision making had been avoided. Family consulta- tions facilitated the father making his wishes known regarding the limits on life-saving ef- forts. This relieved his family members be- cause they knew his feelings if they had to

make life-and-death decisions. For the father, making his wishes known not only gave him a sense of personal control over the end of his life but also freed him to focus on living well and maximizing his physical well-being. Despite the short-run challenge of having end- of-life discussions, it is important to keep in mind that many of the most wrenching end- of-life experiences for families occur when the wishes of a dying member are unknown or have been disregarded. With conditions, such as Alzheimer’s disease, involving progressive dementia, there is added incentive for conver- sations before the affected person’s cognitive impairment makes meaningful discussion im- possible (Boss, 1999).

Chronic Phase

The chronic phase, whether long or short, is the time span between the initial diagnosis/re- adjustment and the third phase, when issues of death and terminal illness predominate. This phase can be marked by constancy, progres- sion, or episodic change. It has been referred to as “the long haul” or “day-to-day living with chronic illness” phase. Often the patient and family have come to grips psychologically and organizationally with permanent changes and have devised an ongoing coping strategy. The ability of the family to maintain the sem- blance of a normal life, attending as equitably as possible to both the illness and to normative developmental tasks, is key during this period. If the illness is fatal, this is a time of living in limbo. For certain highly debilitating but not clearly fatal illnesses, such as a massive stroke or dementia, the family can feel saddled by an exhausting problem “without end.” Paradoxi- cally, the family may feel its hope to resume a “normal” life can be realized only after the death of the ill member. The maintenance of maximum autonomy for all family members in the face of prolonged adversity helps to offset trapped, helpless feelings.

For long-term disorders, customary pat- terns of intimacy for couples become skewed by discrepancies between the ill member and the well spouse/caregiver (Rolland, 1994b). As one young husband lamented in a clinical

JWBT514_ch13.indd 323JWBT514_ch13.indd 323 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

324 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

meeting regarding his wife’s cancer, “It was hard enough 2 years ago to absorb that, even if Ann was cured, her radiation treatment would make pregnancy impossible. Now I fi nd it un- bearable that her continued slow, losing battle with cancer makes it impossible to go for our dreams like other couples our age.” Normative ambivalence and escape fantasies often remain underground and contribute to survivor guilt. Psychoeducational family interventions that normalize such emotions related to threatened loss can help prevent destructive cycles of blame, shame, and guilt.

Terminal Phase

In the terminal phase of an illness, the inevi- tability of death becomes apparent and domi- nates family life. At this point, the family must cope with issues of separation, death, mourn- ing, and beginning the reorganization process needed for the resumption of “normal” fam- ily life beyond the loss (Walsh & McGoldrick, 2004). Families that adapt best to this phase are able to shift their views of hope and mas- tery from controlling the illness to a successful process of letting go. Optimal coping involves emotional openness as well as dealing with the myriad practical tasks at hand. This includes seeing this phase as an opportunity to share precious time together to acknowledge the impending loss, to deal with unfi nished busi- ness, and to say good-byes. If they have not decided beforehand, the patient and key fam- ily members need to decide about such things as a living will; the extent of medical heroics desired; preferences about dying at home, in the hospital, or at hospice; and wishes about a funeral or memorial service and burial.

Transitions Between Phases

Critical transition periods link the three time phases. These transitions present opportuni- ties for families to reevaluate the appropri- ateness of their previous life structures in the face of new illness-related developmental demands. Unfi nished business from the previ- ous phase can complicate or block movement through the transitions. Families can become

permanently frozen in an adaptive structure that has outlived its utility (Penn, 1983). For example, the usefulness of pulling together in the crisis phase can become maladaptive and stifl ing for all family members in the chronic phase. An illness timeline delineates psycho- social developmental phases of an illness, each with its own unique developmental tasks. It is important for families to address normative phase-related tasks in sequence to optimize successful adaptation over the long haul of a chronic disorder.

New Genetics and an Extended Illness Timeline

With the mapping of the human genome, burgeoning scientifi c knowledge is rapidly increasing our understanding of the mecha- nisms, treatment, and prevention of disease. New genetic technologies are enabling physi- cians to test for increased risk of developing a serious and life-threatening illness before it actually occurs. This means that individuals and families now can be living with illness risk information long before loved ones have developed symptoms of those illnesses (Miller et al., 2006), which signifi cantly increases the amount of time and energy that families spend considering an illness and lengthens the illness timeline to include nonsymptomatic phases (Rolland & Williams, 2005). The nonsymp- tomatic phases are awareness, pretesting, test/ posttesting, and long-term adaptation. These nonsymptomatic phases are distinguished by questions of uncertainty. Fundamental issues include the potential amount of genetic knowl- edge medically available, decisions about how much of that information various family mem- bers choose to access, and living with the psy- chosocial impact of those choices.

For some, the nonsymptomatic crisis phase begins when predictive testing becomes avail- able, continuing through the decision to pursue testing and initial posttesting adaptation. For others, this phase begins as individuals reach signifi cant developmental milestones and begin to consider testing. Sometimes, plans for having children raise fears of passing on

JWBT514_ch13.indd 324JWBT514_ch13.indd 324 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Families, Health, and Illness 325

a mutation and thus spark an interest in test- ing. Some women decide to be tested for he- reditary breast and ovarian cancer genes when they reach an age that coincides with the age at which another blood relative—a mother, aunt, or older sister—was diagnosed. During the posttesting phases, families need to accept the permanence of the genetic information. They must develop meanings that preserve their sense of competency and fl exibility in the face of future uncertainty or loss (Rolland, 2006a; Werner-Lin, 2008).

After receiving genetic information, fami- lies may live in limbo for years in the long- term adaptation phase. Social workers can help families maintain mastery during this pe- riod by leading them to acknowledge the pos- sibility, probability, or inevitability of illness and loss, fi nd meaning that transcends biologi- cal outcomes, and build family fl exibility into planning that balances illness concerns with normative family developmental milestones.

The involvement of the health-care system is very different with predictive testing than with a diagnosed illness, a fact that presents a major psychosocial challenge. Despite the enormous psychosocial impact of positive testing results, families usually have limited contact with health professionals after initial testing. There is a need for ongoing, family- centered, collaborative approaches to prevent isolation and fear.

We can orient families to the value of prevention-oriented consultations at key fu- ture life-cycle transitions, when the experi- ence of genetic risk likely will be heightened. Concerns about loss may surface that family members had postponed or thought they had worked through. It is vital to prepare fam- ily members for the fact that concerns about genetic risk and decisions about whether to pursue genetic testing will be more activated during transitional periods, such as launching young adults and marriage or partner commit- ments. Such feelings also can be reactivated by critical events, such as genetic testing of another family member, diagnosis of a serious illness in immediate or extended families or friends, or death of a loved one. Social workers

can help family members decide about circum- stances when further family discussion would be helpful, who would be appropriate to in- clude, and how to discuss genetic risk with children or adolescents.

CLINICAL AND RESEARCH IMPLICATIONS

The Family System-Illness Model provides a framework for assessment and clinical in- tervention by facilitating an understanding of chronic illness and disability in psychosocial terms. The interaction of the time phases and typology of illness provides a framework for a normative psychosocial developmental model for chronic disease that resembles models for human development. The time phases—crisis, chronic, and terminal—can be considered broad developmental periods in the natural his- tory of a chronic disease. Attention to features of onset, course, outcome, and incapacitation provides markers that focus clinical assessment and intervention with a family. For instance, acute-onset illnesses demand high levels of adaptability, problem solving, family reorgani- zation, and balanced cohesion. In such circum- stances, helping families to maximize fl exibility enables them to adapt more successfully.

This framework can help in research design. The typology and time-phase framework can facilitate research aimed to sort out the relative importance of different psychosocial variables across a spectrum of chronic disorders. Par- ticular “psychosocial types” of disorders can be considered crudely matched as to onset, course, outcome, incapacitation, and level of uncertainty. Specifi c typology variables can be utilized to analyze and compare individual and family dynamics related to different con- ditions over time. Time phases can facilitate a methodology for longitudinal studies. Mul- tiple observations can be spaced at intervals that correspond to different time phases.

The model is guided by awareness of the components of family functioning most relevant to particular types or phases of an illness and therefore can inform goal setting and treatment

JWBT514_ch13.indd 325JWBT514_ch13.indd 325 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

326 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

planning. Using a psychoeducational approach, social workers can work with families to create a psychosocial map, deciding on specifi c goals together to maximize a sense of control and re- alistic hope. This process empowers families in their journey of living with a chronic disorder. This knowledge also educates family members about warning signs that should alert them to request brief, goal-oriented treatment at appro- priate times. The framework is useful for timing family psychosocial checkups to coincide with key transition points over the course of both the illness and individual family members’ and the family’s development. For families with limited resources or access to psychosocial care, social workers can educate families in their limited time together about what to expect at nodal points in the illness journey to minimize future distress.

The model also informs evaluation of gen- eral functioning and illness-specifi c family dynamics, such as the interface of the illness with individual and family development; the family’s multigenerational history of cop- ing with illness, loss, and other adversity; the family’s health and illness belief system; the meaning of the illness to the family; social support; use of community resources; and the family’s capacity to manage illness-related cri- ses or perform home-based medical care. At a larger systems level, the model provides a lens for clinicians to analyze shifts in relationships among health-care institutions, professionals, the patient, and family members.

Psychoeducational Family Groups

Preventively oriented family psychoeduca- tional or support groups for patients and their families (Gonzalez & Steinglass, 2002; Ste- inglass, 1998) are an increasingly utilized, cost-effective way to address illness concerns of families and can be designed to deal with different types of conditions (e.g., progres- sive, life-threatening, relapsing). They can be provided in either as 1-day or as time-limited, weekly or biweekly meetings for three to six sessions. Brief psychoeducational modules, timed for critical phases of particular types

of diseases, enable families to digest manage- able portions of a long-term coping process. Modules can be tailored to particular phases of the illness and to family coping skills nec- essary to confront disease-related demands. This method provides a cost-effective preven- tive service that networks families, counteracts their isolation, and helps identify families at high risk for maladaptation.

Grounded in a family systems-based psy- choeducational framework, these groups bring together families facing conditions with similar psychosocial demands. The goals of psychoedu- cational family groups are to help families cope as a team with the continued demands of chronic illness, to mobilize the ill individuals’ natural support networks, and to reduce the negative ef- fects of both normative and illness-related fam- ily stressors. In other words, the aim is to fi nd “a place for the illness in the family while at the same time keeping the illness in its place” (Gon- zalez, Steinglass, & Reiss, 1989, p. 80). This is achieved by providing informational support through collaboration with health-care provid- ers, social networking, and skill building.

These groups emphasize a resilience per- spective, focusing on family strengths and the development of positive coping techniques and problem-solving skills. This allows families to minimize negative and pathologizing views about their adaptation to illness management. Finally, the intervention addresses the needs of all family members, giving each participant the opportunity to voice concerns and to form cross-family alliances with others in similar family roles (Gonzalez & Steinglass, 2002; Steinglass, 1998). Social workers facilitating such groups may use tools such as social skills and problem-solving training, practicing these skills during group sessions, and encouraging families to bring their experiences with these skills back to the group for consideration.

FAMILY ASSESSMENT

As chronic illnesses become incorporated into the family system and all its processes, cop- ing is infl uenced by illness-oriented family

JWBT514_ch13.indd 326JWBT514_ch13.indd 326 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Families, Health, and Illness 327

dynamics that concern the dimension of time and belief systems.

Multigenerational Legacies of Illness, Loss, and Crisis: Constructing a Genogram

A family’s current behavior, and therefore its response to illness, cannot be understood ad- equately apart from its history (Boszormenyi- Nagy, 1987; Bowen, 1993; Byng-Hall, 1995; Framo, 1992; McGoldrick, Garcia-Preto, & Carter, 2010; Walsh & McGoldrick, 2004). Social workers can use historical question- ing and construct a basic genogram, and timeline to track nodal events and transitions (McGoldrick, Gerson, & Petry, 2008; see Ap- pendix 13.1). This process helps clinicians gain an understanding of a family’s organizational shifts and coping strategies as a system in re- sponse to past stressors and, more specifi cally, to past illnesses. Such inquiry helps explain and predict the family’s current style of coping, adaptation, and creation of meaning. A multi- generational assessment helps to clarify areas of strength and vulnerability. It also identifi es high-risk families burdened by past unresolved issues and dysfunctional patterns that prevent them from adequately addressing the chal- lenges presented by a serious condition.

A genogram oriented toward illness focuses on how a family organizes itself and adapts as an evolving system around major stressors, especially previous illnesses and unexpected crises, in the current and previous genera- tions. A central goal is to bring to light areas of consensus and “learned differences” that are sources of cohesion and confl ict. Patterns of coping, replications, discontinuities, shifts in relationships (e.g., triangles, cutoffs), and sense of competence are noted. These patterns can be transmitted across generations as fam- ily pride, myths, taboos, catastrophic expecta- tions, and belief systems (Seaburn, Lorenz, & Kaplan, 1992; Walsh & McGoldrick, 2004). In one case involving a couple where the husband was diagnosed with basal cell carcinoma, the oncologist discussed a favorable prognosis. In spite of this reassurance, the wife believed

her husband would die from this skin cancer. This resulted in increased marital discord and ultimately a couple’s consultation with the on- cologist. In the initial interview, when asked about prior experiences with illness and loss, the wife revealed that her own father had died tragically of a misdiagnosed malignant mela- noma. This woman had a catastrophic fear based on both sensitization to cancer (particu- larly any related to the skin) and the possibility of human error by health professionals. Had the oncologist inquired about prior experi- ences at the time of diagnosis, earlier interven- tion would have been facilitated.

It also is useful to inquire about other forms of loss (e.g., divorce, migration), crisis (e.g., lengthy unemployment, rape, natural disaster such as Hurricane Katrina), and protracted adversity (e.g., poverty, racism, war, political oppression). These experiences can provide transferable sources of resilience and effective coping skills in the face of a serious health problem (Walsh, 2006).

Illness Type and Time Phase Issues

Whereas a family may have certain standard ways of coping with any illness, there may be critical differences in its styles and success in adaptation to different “types” of diseases. In a social work assessment, it is important to track prior family illnesses for areas of per- ceived competence, failures, or inexperience. Inquiry about experiences with different types of illness (e.g., life-threatening versus nonlife- threatening) may fi nd, for instance, that a fam- ily dealt successfully with nonlife-threatening illnesses but reeled under the weight of meta- static cancer. Such a family might be well equipped to deal with less severe conditions but be particularly vulnerable to the occur- rence of another life-threatening illness. Some families may lack familiarity with chronic ill- ness. The next case consultation highlights the importance of family history in uncovering areas of inexperience.

Tracking a family’s coping capabilities in the crisis, chronic, and terminal phases of previous chronic illnesses highlights legacies of strength as well as complications in adaptation related

JWBT514_ch13.indd 327JWBT514_ch13.indd 327 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

328 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

to different points over the course of the illness. One man grew up with a father who was par- tially disabled with heart disease and witnessed his parents successfully renegotiate traditional gender-defi ned roles when his mother went to work while his father assumed household re- sponsibilities. This man, who now has heart dis- ease himself, has a positive legacy about gender roles from his family of origin that facilitated a fl exible response to his own illness.

Another family with a member suffering from chronic kidney failure functioned very well in handling the practicalities of home di- alysis. However, in the terminal phase, their limitations with emotional expression left a legacy of unresolved grief. Tracking prior ill- ness experiences in terms of time phases helps clinicians see both the strengths and vulner- abilities of a family, which counterbalances the assignment of dysfunctional labels. Social workers need to ask specifi cally about posi- tive family-of-origin experiences with illness and loss that can be highlighted as family suc- cesses and used as models to adapt to the cur- rent situation.

Although many families facing chronic dis- ease have healthy multigenerational family patterns of adaptation, any family may falter in the face of multiple superimposed disease and nondisease stressors that occur in a relatively short period of time. With progressive, inca- pacitating diseases or the concurrence of ill- nesses in several family members, a pragmatic approach that focuses on expanded or creative use of supports and resources outside the fam- ily is most productive.

Interface of the Illness, Individual, and Family Development

Addressing the impact of the illness over the life span provides a powerful way to construct a normative framework for serious illness. In- dividual and family life cycle perspectives ad- dress development over time in discrete phases, each with expectable challenges to be mastered sequentially before continuing on to the next phase. Illness frequently disrupts these norma- tive challenges as family resources are directed toward illness management and treatment. To

CASE EXAMPLE

Joe, his wife, Ann, and their three teenage children presented for a family evaluation 10 months after Joe’s diagnosis with severe asthma. Joe, age 44, had been employed for many years as a spray painter. Apparently, exposure to a new chemical triggered the onset of asthmatic attacks that necessitated hospitalization and occupational disability. Although somewhat improved, he continued to have persistent, moderately severe respiratory symptoms. Initially, his physicians had predicted that improvement would occur but remained noncommittal as to the level of chronicity to be expected. Continued breathing diffi culties contributed to increased symptoms of depression, uncharacteristic temperamental outbursts, alcohol abuse, family discord, and fi nally admission to an alcohol detoxifi cation unit. In the initial assessment, after

Joe’s discharge to outpatient psychiatric treatment, the social worker inquired as to the family’s prior illness experience. This was the nuclear family’s fi rst encounter with chronic illness, and their families of origin had limited experience. Ann’s father had died 7 years earlier of a sudden and unexpected heart attack. Joe’s brother had died in an accidental drowning. Neither had experience with disease as an ongoing process. Joe had assumed that improvement meant “cure.” In addition, Joe had a history of alcoholism that had been in remission for 20 years. Illness for both Joe and his wife had meant either death or recovery. The physician/family system was not attuned to the hidden risks for this family coping with the transition from the crisis to the chronic phase of his asthma, the juncture where the permanency of the disease needed to be addressed.

JWBT514_ch13.indd 328JWBT514_ch13.indd 328 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Families, Health, and Illness 329

place the unfolding of chronic disease into a developmental context, it is crucial to under- stand the intertwining of three evolutionary threads: illness, individual, and family devel- opment (see Rolland, 1987a, 1994a, 2010).

Individual and Family Development

It is essential to consider the interaction of in- dividual and family development. A chronic disorder infl uences the development of the af- fected person and various family members in distinct ways depending on a number of fac- tors, including age of onset of the illness, the core commitments in the affected person and each family member’s life at that time, and the phase of the family life cycle. Life cycle mod- els can facilitate thinking proactively about the timing and nature of strains on the family unit and each member over the course of a major health problem.

Life cycle and life structure are central concepts for both family and individual devel- opment. The term life cycle refers to a basic se- quence and unfolding of the life course within which individual, family, or illness uniquely occurs. Life structure refers to the core ele- ments (e.g., work, child rearing, caregiving) of an individual’s or family’s life at any phase of the life cycle.

Illness, individual, and family development have in common the notion of phases, each with its own developmental challenges. Mc- Goldrick and colleagues (2010) have divided the family life cycle into six phases, where marker events (e.g., marriage, birth of fi rst child, adolescence, children leaving home) herald the transition from one phase to the next. The family life cycle also can be viewed as oscillating between phases where family developmental tasks require intense bonding or relatively higher cohesion (e.g., early child rearing) versus phases during which time the external family boundary is loosened, such as families with adolescents, which often emphasize personal identity and autonomy (Combrinck-Graham, 1985). Levinson (1986), in his description of individual adult develop- ment, describes how individuals’ and families’ life structures can move between periods of

life structure transition and building/stability. Transition periods are sometimes the most vulnerable because previous individual, fam- ily, and illness life structures are reappraised in light of new developmental tasks that may require major discontinuous change rather than minor alterations. The primary goal of a life structure building/maintaining period is to form a life structure and enrich life within it based on the key choices an individual/family made during the preceding transition period.

These unifying concepts provide a base to think about the fi t among illness, individual, and family development. Each phase in these three kinds of development pose tasks and challenges that move through periods of being more or less in sync with each other. The model distinguishes: (a) the phases of the family life cycle, particularly the kind and degree of cohe- sion required; (b) the alternation of transition and life structure building/maintaining periods in family and individual development; and (c) periods of higher and lower psychosocial de- mands, requiring relatively greater and lesser degrees of family cohesion over the course of a chronic condition.

Generally, illness and disability tend to push individual and family developmental processes toward transition and increased co- hesion. Analogous to the addition of a new family member, illness onset sets in motion an inside-the-family-focused process of socializa- tion to illness. Symptoms, loss of function, the demands of shifting or acquiring new illness- related roles, and the fears of further disability or death all require a family to focus inward.

The need for family cohesion varies enor- mously with different illness types and phases. The tendency for a disease to pull a family inward increases with the level of disability or risk of progression and death. Progressive diseases over time inherently require a greater cohesion than constant course illnesses. The ongoing addition of new demands as an illness progresses keeps a family’s energy focused inward, often impeding or halting the natural life cycle evolution of other members. After an initial period of adaptation, a constant-course disease (without severe disability) permits a

JWBT514_ch13.indd 329JWBT514_ch13.indd 329 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

330 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

family to get back on track developmentally. Relapsing illnesses alternate between periods of drawing a family inward and periods of re- lease from immediate demands of disease. But the on-call nature of many such illnesses keeps part of the family focus inward despite asymp- tomatic periods, hindering the natural fl ow be- tween phases of development.

With major health conditions, previous norms concerning family organization may need greater fl exibility. Enmeshment with blurred generational boundaries is touted as the hallmark of family dysfunction. Yet the very real demands on older children and adoles- cents to assume adult functions in the interest of family survival must be distinguished from rigid pathological descriptions of “parentifi ed” children. For instance, when a parent develops a serious disorder during a child-rearing phase of development, a family’s ability to stay on course is most severely taxed. The impact is twofold. A new family burden is added as a parent is “lost.” To meet simultaneous child- rearing and caregiving needs, an older child or grandparent may need to assume parental responsibilities. These forms of family adapta- tion are appropriate, if structural realignments are fl exible, shared, and sensitive to competing age-related developmental needs. Frequently, however, family or cultural dictates put chil- dren, especially girls, in highly responsible roles before it is developmentally appropriate to do so. Social workers can help families set up culturally appropriate structures that do not overburden any one family member by naming expectations and helping families to delegate tasks across a number of participating family members. Social workers also can aid families in enlisting neighbors, community members, and religious congregations in aiding them during particularly challenging times.

In clinical assessment, two basic questions arise: “What is the fi t between the psychoso- cial demands of a condition and family and individual life structures and developmental tasks at a particular point in the life cycle?” and “How will this fi t change as the course of the illness unfolds in relation to the family’s and each member’s development?”

From a systems viewpoint, at the time of diagnosis, it is important to know the phase of the family life cycle and the stage of individual development of all family members, not just the ill member. Chronic disease in one family member can profoundly affect developmental goals of another member. For instance, an in- fant disability can be a serious roadblock to parents’ preconceived ideas about competent child rearing, or a life-threatening illness in a young married adult can interfere with the well spouse’s readiness to become a parent. Family members also frequently do not adapt equally to chronic illness. Each member’s ability to adapt, and the rate at which he or she does so, is related to his or her own developmen- tal phase and role in the family. When family members are in tune with each other’s devel- opmental processes, and promote fl exibility and alternative means to satisfy developmen- tal needs, successful long-term adaptation is maximized.

By adopting a longitudinal developmental perspective, a clinician will stay attuned to future developmental transitions. Imagine a family in which the father (a carpenter) and primary fi nancial provider has a heart attack. Dad’s rehabilitation is uneventful and includes appropriate lifestyle modifi cations and a return to work. The oldest son, age 15, seems rela- tively unaffected. Two years later, his father experiences a second heart attack, leaving him with a disability. His son, now 17, has dreams of going away to college. The specter of fi - nancial hardship and the perceived need for a “man in the family” creates a serious dilemma of choice for the son and the family, which surfaces with the boy’s precipitously declining academic performance and alcohol abuse. In this case, there is a fundamental clash between developmental issues of individuation and the ongoing demands of a progressive, life- threatening type of heart disease on the fam- ily. Further, there is a resurgence of fears of loss fueled not only by the recurrence but also its timing with a major developmental transi- tion for the oldest son. The son may fear that if he were to move away, he might never see his father alive again. This case demonstrates

JWBT514_ch13.indd 330JWBT514_ch13.indd 330 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Families, Health, and Illness 331

the potential clash between simultaneous tran- sition periods—the illness transition to a more disabling, progressive, and life-threatening course; the adolescent son’s transition to early adulthood; and the family’s transition from the “living with teenagers” to “launching young adults” phase. At the time of initial diagno- sis, inquiry about anticipated major transitions over the next three to fi ve years and discussing them in relation to the specifi c kind of heart disease and its related uncertainties would help avert a future crisis.

The timing of chronic illness in the life cycle can be normative (e.g., expectable in relation to chronological and social time) or nonnormative (e.g., “off-time”). Coping with chronic illness and death are considered nor- mally anticipated challenges in late adult- hood, whereas their occurrence earlier is out of phase and developmentally more disruptive (Neugarten, 1976). For instance, chronic dis- eases that occur during the child-rearing pe- riod can be most challenging because of their potential impact on family fi nancial and child- rearing responsibilities. The actual impact will depend on the type of illness and pre-illness family roles. Families governed by fl exible gender-infl uenced rules about who is the fi - nancial provider and caregiver of children will tend to have an easier adjustment.

When a parent develops a major health con- dition during the child-rearing phases of the life cycle, a family’s ability to stay on course is severely taxed. For more serious and debili- tating diseases, such as stroke, the impact of the illness is like the addition of a new infant member, one with “special needs” who will compete with those of the other children for potentially scarce family resources that are di- minished by parental loss. Moreover, in two- parent families, the well parent must juggle child-rearing demands with caregiving of a spouse (Rolland, 1994b).

With chronic disorders, an overarching fam- ily goal is to deal with the developmental de- mands of the illness without family members sacrifi cing their own or the family’s develop- ment as a system over time. It is important to determine whose life plans were or might be

canceled, postponed, or altered and when plans put on hold and future developmental issues will be addressed. In this way, clinicians can anticipate developmental nodal points related to “autonomy within” versus “subjugation to” the condition. Family members can be helped to strike a healthier balance with life plans that resolve feelings of guilt and hopelessness and fi nd family and external resources to enhance freedom, both to pursue personal goals and to provide needed care for the ill member.

HEALTH/ILLNESS BELIEF SYSTEM

When illness strikes, a primary developmen- tal challenge for families is to create mean- ing for the illness experience that promotes a sense of mastery and competency (Kleinman, 1988; Rolland, 1987b, 1994a, 1997; Wright & Bell, 2009). Because serious illness often is experienced as a betrayal of fundamental trust in our bodies and belief in our invul- nerability (Kleinman, 1988), creating an em- powering narrative can be a formidable task. Family health beliefs help us grapple with the existential dilemmas of our fear of death, ten- dency to want to sustain our denial of death, and attempts to reassert control when suffer- ing and loss occur. They serve as a cognitive map guiding decisions and action and provide a way to approach new and ambiguous situa- tions for coherence in family life, facilitating continuity between past, present, and future (Antonovsky & Sourani, 1988; Reiss, 1981). Inquiry into and curiosity about family beliefs is perhaps the most powerful foundation stone of collaboration between families and health professionals (Rolland, 1998; Wright & Bell, 2009). There is growing research evidence that family members’ distress about a disease, such as cancer, can be associated more closely to perceived risk or appraisals of seriousness than objective characteristics of the disease (Franks & Roesch, 2006; Hurley, Miller, Rubin, & Weinberg, 2006; Thompson & Kyle, 2000).

In the initial crisis phase, it is essential for clinicians to inquire about key family beliefs

JWBT514_ch13.indd 331JWBT514_ch13.indd 331 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

332 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

that shape the family’s illness narrative and coping strategies. This inquiry includes track- ing: (a) beliefs about normality and mind-body relationship, control, and mastery; (b) assump- tions about what caused an illness and what will infl uence it’s course and outcome; (c) meanings attached by a family, ethnic group, religion, or the wider culture to symptoms (e.g., chronic pain) (J. Griffi th & Griffi th, 1994; McGoldrick, Pearce, & Garcia-Preto, 2005), types of illnesses (e.g., life threaten- ing), or specifi c diseases (e.g., AIDS) (Sontag, 2001) that have shaped a family’s health be- liefs; and (e) anticipated nodal points in ill- ness, individual, and family development when health beliefs are strained or need to shift. A clinician also should assess the congruence of health beliefs within the family and its various subsystems (e.g., spouse, parental, extended family) as well as between the family and the health-care system and wider culture.

Beliefs About Normality

Family beliefs about what is normal or abnor- mal, and the importance members place on conformity and excellence in relation to the average family, have far-reaching implications for adaptation to chronic disorders. Family values that allow having a “problem” without self-denigration have a distinct advantage, en- abling one to seek outside help and yet main- tain a positive identity in the face of chronic conditions. Families that defi ne help seeking as weak and shameful undercut this kind of resilience. Essentially, with chronic disorders in which problems are to be expected and the use of professionals and outside resources is necessary, a belief that pathologizes this nor- mative process can be seen as adding insult to injury.

Two excellent questions that can be used to elicit these beliefs are: “How do you think other average families would deal with a similar situation to yours?” and “How would a healthy family ideally cope with your situ- ation?” Families with strong beliefs in high achievement and perfectionism are prone to apply standards in a situation of illness in

which the kind of control they are accustomed to is impossible. Particularly with untimely conditions that occur early in the life cycle, there are additional pressures to keep up with normative socially expectable developmental milestones of age peers or other young cou- ples. The fact that developmental goals may take longer to achieve than anticipated or need revision requires a fl exible belief about what is normal and healthy. To sustain hope effec- tively, particularly in situations of long-term adversity, families need to embrace a fl exible defi nition of normality.

Mind–Body Relationships

Varied conceptualizations of the mind–body relationship have been the subject of discourse and debate for millennia. Traditional mental health theories and research endeavors have been pathology based, tending to emphasize character traits or emotional states that affect body chemistry adversely. From this perspec- tive, emotions can be seen to affect the body negatively, but possible positive infl uences of healthy attitudes are overlooked. More re- cently, the public has been drawn increasingly to popular literature citing the importance of positive attitudes in healing, emphasizing the unity of mind and body. This literature de- scribes healing as a state of being, involving mind and body, rather than in strictly biomedi- cal terms where something is done to the body. Social workers must be particularly mindful that families may be more familiar with and open to positive attitudes as a powerful source of healing.

As social workers assess family beliefs about illness, it is useful to distinguish beliefs about the mind as a logical, thinking process that can determine actions that may help in healing the body (e.g., seeking medical care, chang- ing diet or activity patterns) from those of the mind as a source of thought or energy that can directly impact body physiology. These beliefs about mind and spirit often extend beyond the individual to include family, community, or a higher spiritual power. Anthropologists have found tremendous diversity in the role of

JWBT514_ch13.indd 332JWBT514_ch13.indd 332 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Families, Health, and Illness 333

family, community, God, or nature as a source of healing. Such beliefs typically are expressed in the form of rituals (Imber-Black, Roberts, & Whiting, 2003). In our society, for example, a family’s religious community often will orga- nize a prayer service to promote healing for an ill member. Social workers can inquire about the role of spirituality in family life (Walsh, 2009), family beliefs regarding healing, and rituals that are important expressions of those beliefs. Sometimes important family healing rituals confl ict with hospital rules, leading to power struggles that alienate families and erode a functional collaborative relationship with the health-care team.

Family’s Sense of Mastery Facing Illness

It is important to determine how a family defi nes mastery or control in general and in situations of illness (Taylor, Helgeson, Reed, & Skokan, 1991; Thompson & Kyle, 2000). Mastery is similar to the concept of health locus of control, which indicates beliefs about infl uence over the course/outcome of an illness (Lefcourt, 1982). It is useful to distinguish whether a family’s beliefs are based on the premise of internal control, external control by chance, or external control by powerful others. Families with an internal locus of control be- lieve they can affect the outcome of a situation. In illness, such families believe they have di- rect control of their health and have the power to recover from illness (Wallston, 2004). An external orientation entails a belief that out- comes are not contingent on the individual’s or family’s behavior. Families that view illness in terms of chance believe that illness occurs as a matter of luck and that fate determines re- covery. Those who see health control as in the hands of powerful others view health profes- sionals, God, or sometimes powerful family members as exerting control over their bodies and illness course.

Family beliefs about mastery strongly af- fect each member’s relationship with the ill- ness and the health-care system, impacting adherence and preferences about family par- ticipation in treatment and healing processes.

Families that view a disease’s course/outcome as a matter of chance tend to establish mar- ginal relationships with health professionals largely because their belief system minimizes the importance of their own or the profession- al’s impact on a disease process. Families of lower socioeconomic statuses, especially mi- norities, also may receive inadequate care or lack insurance or access, leading to a fatalistic attitude and lack of engagement with health- care providers, whom they may not trust to help. Just as any psychotherapeutic relation- ship depends on a shared belief system about what is therapeutic, a workable accommoda- tion among the patient, family, and health-care team in terms of these fundamental values is essential. Families that feel misunderstood by health professionals often are reacting to a lack of joining at this basic value level. Too often their healthy need to participate has been ig- nored or preempted by a professional needing unilateral control (Rolland, 1998).

A family may adhere to a different set of beliefs about control when dealing with physi- cal illness as opposed to typical day-to-day is- sues. Therefore, it is important to assess both a family’s basic beliefs and those about control for illnesses in general, for chronic and life- threatening illness, and fi nally for the specifi c disease facing the family. For instance, regard- less of the actual severity or prognosis in a par- ticular case, cancer may be equated with death or a lack of control because of medical sta- tistics, cultural myth, or prior family history. Alternatively, families may have enabling sto- ries about a member or friend who, in spite of cancer and a shortened life span, lived a “full” life centered on effectively prioritizing the quality of relationships and goals. Clinicians can highlight these positive narratives to help families counteract cultural beliefs that focus exclusively on control of biology as defi ning success.

The goodness of fi t between family beliefs about mastery can vary depending on the time phase of the condition. For some conditions, the crisis phase involves protracted medical interventions outside the family’s direct con- trol. This may be stressful for a family that

JWBT514_ch13.indd 333JWBT514_ch13.indd 333 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

334 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

prefers to tackle its own problems without outside control and “interference.” The pa- tient’s return home may increase the work- load but allow members to reassert more fully their competence and leadership. In contrast, a family guided more by a preference for ex- ternal control by experts can expect greater diffi culty when their family member returns home. Recognition of such normative differ- ences in belief about control can guide an ef- fective psychosocial treatment plan tailored to each family’s needs and affi rming rather than disrespecting their core values.

Social workers must be cautious about judg- ing the relative denial or acceptance of pain- ful realities. Often people need to do both. The healthy use of minimization, or selective focus on the positive, and timely uses of humor should be distinguished from denial. The skilled social worker must support both the usefulness of ex- aggerated hope and the need for treatment to control the illness or a new complication. There is greater incentive for a family to confront de- nial when there is hope that preventive action or medical treatment can affect the outcome or when an illness is entering its terminal phase. Yet to cope with an arduous, uncertain course, families often need simultaneously to acknowl- edge the condition while minimizing treatment risks or the likelihood of a poor outcome.

Family Beliefs About the Cause of an Illness

When a signifi cant health problem arises, it is natural to wonder “Why me (or us)?” and “Why now?” (Roesch & Weiner, 2001; Taylor, 1983). We almost invariably construct an ex- planation or story that helps organize our experience. With limits of current medical knowledge, tremendous uncertainties persist about the relative importance of myriad fac- tors, leaving individuals and families to make idiosyncratic attributions about what caused an illness. A family’s beliefs about the cause of an illness should be assessed separately from its beliefs about what can affect the outcome. It is important to elicit each family member’s explanation. Responses generally will refl ect a

combination of medical information and fam- ily mythology. Beliefs might include punish- ment for prior misdeeds (e.g., an affair), blame of a particular family member (“Your drinking made me sick!”), a sense of injustice (“Why am I being punished? I have been a good per- son.”), genetics (e.g., cancer runs on one side of the family), negligence by the patient (e.g., careless driving) or by parents (e.g., sudden in- fant death syndrome), or simply bad luck.

Highly adaptive family narratives respect the limits of scientifi c knowledge, affi rm basic competency, and promote the fl exible use of multiple biological and psychosocial heal- ing strategies. In contrast, causal attributions that invoke blame, shame, or guilt make it ex- tremely diffi cult for a family to cope and adapt in a functional way. With a life-threatening ill- ness, a blamed family member is implicitly, if not explicitly, held accountable if the patient dies. Decisions about treatment then become confounded and fi lled with tension. A husband who believes his drinking caused his wife’s coronary and subsequent death may increase self-destructive drinking because of his pro- found guilt. A mother who secretly blames herself for their daughter’s leukemia may be less able to stop a low-probability experimen- tal treatment than the husband who sees fur- ther treatment as causing additional suffering to their terminally ill child (see Box 13.1).

Belief System Adaptability

Because illnesses vary enormously in their responsiveness to psychosocial factors, both families and providers need to make distinc- tions among beliefs about their overall partici- pation in a long-term disease process, beliefs about their ability to control the biological un- folding of an illness, and the fl exibility with which they can apply these beliefs. Families’ experience of competence or mastery depends on their grasp of these distinctions. Optimal family and provider narratives respect the limits of scientifi c knowledge, affi rm basic competency, and promote the fl exible use of multiple biological and psychosocial healing strategies.

JWBT514_ch13.indd 334JWBT514_ch13.indd 334 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Families, Health, and Illness 335

A family’s belief in their participation in the total illness process can be thought of as independent from whether a disease is stable, improving, or in a terminal phase. Sometimes mastery and the attempt to control biologi- cal process coincide, as when a family tailors its behavior to help maintain the health of a member with cancer in remission. This might include changes in family roles, communi- cation, diet, exercise, and balance between work and recreation. Optimally, when an ill family member comes out of remission and as the family enters the terminal phase of the illness, participation as an expression of mas- tery is transformed to a successful process of letting go that eases suffering and allows pal- liative care to be provided (Lynn, Schuster, Wilkinson, & Simon, 2007).

Families with fl exible belief systems are more likely to experience death with a sense of equanimity rather than profound failure. The death of a patient whose long, debilitating illness has heavily burdened others can bring relief as well as sadness to family members.

Because relief over death goes against soci- etal conventions, it can trigger massive guilt reactions that may be expressed through such symptoms as depression and family confl ict. Clinicians need to help family members accept ambivalent feelings they may have about the death as natural.

Flexibility within both the family and the health professional system is a key variable in optimal family functioning. Rather than linking mastery in a rigid way with biologi- cal outcome (survival or recovery) as the sole determinant of success, families can defi ne control in a more “holistic” sense with in- volvement and participation in the overall process as the main criteria defi ning success. This is analogous to the distinction between curing “the disease” and “healing the system.” Healing the system may infl uence the course and outcome, but a positive disease outcome is not necessary for a family to feel successful. This fl exible view of mastery permits the qual- ity of relations within the family or between the family and health professionals to become

Box 13.1 Family Beliefs About Cause of Illness

Lucy and Tom G., a young couple, have a daughter, Susan, age 5, who is terminally ill with leukemia. The pediatric oncologist offered the parents the choice between an experimental treatment with a low probability of success or halting treatment. Tom’s position was “Let’s stop; enough is enough.” Lucy, however, felt, “We must continue; we can’t let her die.” The couple could not reach an agreement, and the physician was immobilized. He requested a social work consultation for the couple.

When the consultant asked, “What is your explanation of how your daughter got leukemia?” the critical story emerged. Tom basically saw it as bad luck. Lucy, however, had a very different belief. During her pregnancy with Susan, Lucy’s father had a heart attack and died several months later from a second episode. Lucy experienced this

as a time of great stress and grief, which she felt adversely affected Susan’s intrauterine life. After Susan’s birth by normal delivery, Lucy was still mourning the loss of her father and felt that this affected the quality of her bonding with Susan and led to a hidden depression in her infant. Further, Lucy had read research linking depression with a lowering of the effectiveness of the immune system, which could, in turn, decrease normal surveillance and clearing of cancer cells from the body. She believed this combination of factors caused her child’s cancer and that if she had been a more competent mother, this never would have happened. Lucy said she had never told this story to anyone (including her husband), because no one had ever asked, and she was very ashamed. She had hoped for a cure, so that the whole issue could be resolved. She could not accept stopping treatment because, to her, it meant that Susan’s death then would be her fault.

JWBT514_ch13.indd 335JWBT514_ch13.indd 335 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

336 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

more central to criteria of success. The health provider’s competence becomes valued from both a technical and a caregiving perspective not solely linked to the biological course.

Ethnic, Spiritual, and Cultural Beliefs

Ethnicity, race, and spiritual beliefs strongly infl uence family beliefs concerning health and illness (McGoldrick et al., 2005; Rolland, 2006b; Walsh, 2009). Signifi cant ethnic dif- ferences regarding health beliefs typically emerge at the time of a major health crisis. Health professionals need to be mindful of the belief systems of various other ethnic, ra- cial, and religious groups in their community, particularly as these translate into behavioral patterns that differ from their own. Cultural norms vary in such areas as the defi nition of the appropriate “sick role” for the patient, the kind and degree of open communication about the disease, who should be included in the illness caregiving system (e.g., extended family, friends, professionals), who is the primary caretaker (almost always the wife, mother, daughter, or daughter-in-law), and the kind of rituals viewed as normative at differ- ent stages of an illness (e.g., hospital bedside vigils, healing, and funeral rituals). This is es- pecially true for a number of minority groups (e.g., African American, Asian American, and Hispanic American) who experience discrimi- nation or marginalization from the prevailing White American culture. Illness provides an opportunity to encourage role fl exibility and shift from defi ning one female member as the caregiver to a collaborative caregiving team that includes male and female siblings/adult children.

Clinicians need to be mindful of cultural differences between themselves and the pa- tient and family as a necessary step to forging a workable alliance that can endure a long- term illness (Seaburn et al., 1996). Disregard- ing these issues can lead families to distance themselves from health providers and avail- able community resources, which is a major cause of adherence problems and treatment failure. Accepting that the patient retains fi nal

responsibility for decisions about his body requires a strong commitment to the core social work value of self-determination.

Fit Among Health-Care Provider, Health System, and Family Beliefs

It is a common but unfortunate error to regard “the family” as a monolithic unit that feels, thinks, believes, and behaves as an undiffer- entiated whole. Social workers should inquire both about the level of agreement and toler- ance for differences among family members’ beliefs and between the family and the health- care system. Is the family rule “We must agree on all/some values,” or are diversity and dif- ferent viewpoints acceptable? To what degree does the family feel the need to stay in sync with prevailing cultural or societal beliefs or with family tradition?

Family beliefs that balance the need for consensus with diversity and innovation are optimal and maximize permissible options. If consensus is the rule, then individual differen- tiation implies disloyalty and deviance. If the guiding principle is “We can hold different viewpoints,” diversity is allowed. This is adap- tive because it facilitates the use of novel and creative forms of problem solving that may be needed in a situation of protracted adversity, such as serious illness. Social workers can facilitate open communication and effective confl ict resolution when members differ on major health-care/treatment decisions.

The same questions are relevant to the fi t between the family, social worker, and health- care team. What are their attitudes about their own and the family’s ability to infl uence the course/outcome of the disease? How does the health-care team see the balance between its own participation in the treatment process and the family’s involvement? If basic differ- ences in beliefs about control exist, how can these differences be reconciled? These ques- tions will inform the types of interventions social workers employ to help families facing chronic and terminal illness.

It is common for differences in beliefs or attitudes to erupt during any major life cycle

JWBT514_ch13.indd 336JWBT514_ch13.indd 336 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Families, Health, and Illness 337

or illness transition. For instance, in situations of severe disability or terminal illness, one member may want the patient to return home, whereas another prefers long-term hospital- ization or transfer to an extended care facility. Because the chief task of patient caregiving usually is assigned to the wife/mother, she is the one most apt to bear the chief burdens in this regard. A family able to anticipate the col- lision of gender-based beliefs about caregiving with the potential overwhelming demands of home-based care for a dying family member and fl exibly modify its rules would avert the risk of family caregiver overload, resentment, and deteriorating family relationships.

The murky boundary between the chronic and the terminal phases highlights the potential for professionals’ beliefs to collide with those of the family. Physicians can feel bound to a technological imperative that requires them to exhaust all possibilities at their disposal, regardless of the odds of success. Families may not know how to interpret continued life- saving efforts, assuming real hope where virtu- ally none exists. Health-care professionals and institutions can collude in a pervasive societal wish to deny death as a natural process truly beyond technological control (Becker, 1973). Endless treatment can represent the medical team’s inability to separate a general value placed on controlling diseases from their be- liefs about participation (separate from cure) in a patient’s total care.

CHALLENGES IN IMPLEMENTATION OF FAMILY-BASED RESEARCH

Interventions for families facing medical ill- ness currently are being implemented in a number of settings, including hospitals, com- munity health and mental health clinics, hos- pices, and wellness organizations (Campbell, 2003). It is important that social workers base the development of interventions on the best available research knowledge. A major chal- lenge for family intervention research is the need to further develop research methods and

protocols that demonstrate the relationship of family system dynamics to health status, health-care outcomes, and cost containment (Carr & Springer, 2010; Law & Crane, 2007; Weihs et al., 2002).

Despite advances in evidence-based knowledge, signifi cant challenges persist for conducting such systematic and rigorous inter- vention research (Kazak, 2002). Often imple- mentation of family-centered biopsychosocial research is more diffi cult in health-care set- tings (e.g., hospitals) focused primarily on the treatment and management of the individual with the disease. Although psychosocial care may improve family functioning, this outcome might not be the established goal of medical settings or health insurance corporations, both of which are concerned with biomedical cure and controlling costs. Family-based interven- tions, such as multifamily discussion groups (McFarlane, 2002) and collaborative family- oriented primary and tertiary care (McDaniel et al., 2005; Weihs et al., 2002), have proven effective in health-care settings to (a) promote patient and family coping and adaptation, (b) reduce medical and psychiatric morbid- ity for all family members, (c) contain overall health-care costs, and (d) facilitate collabora- tion between families and health-care teams to increase treatment adherence. Despite these data, these interventions are rarely offered as part of routine care.

In the era of managed health care, evi- dence-based practice highlighting positive outcomes is essential in social work’s effort to maintain a clear and integrated presence in hospitals and medical settings. By illus- trating how family-based interventions fa- cilitate illness management, ease the burden on health-care teams, and are cost effective, social workers can join with other health- care professionals to advocate for collabora- tive models of health care that include such interventions as part of standard practice. Social workers can carve a unique niche for themselves in medical settings by working collaboratively to fi ll these methodological and clinical gaps and by conducting sound intervention research.

JWBT514_ch13.indd 337JWBT514_ch13.indd 337 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

338 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

CONCLUSION

The most resilient families are able to harness the experience of facing the risks and burdens of chronic illness or disability to improve the quality of life. Families can achieve a healthy balance between accepting limits and promot- ing autonomy. For conditions with long-range risks, families can maintain mastery in the face of uncertainty by enhancing their capacities to acknowledge the possibility of loss, sustain hope, and build fl exibility into both the fami- ly’s and each member’s life cycle planning that conserves and adjusts major goals and helps circumvent the forces of uncertainty.

A serious illness, such as cancer, or a brush with death, provides an opportunity to confront catastrophic fears about loss. This confrontation can lead family members to develop a better appreciation and perspective on life that results in clearer priorities and closer relationships. Seizing opportunities can replace procrastina- tion for the “right moment” or passive waiting for the dreaded moment. By emphasizing life’s fragility and preciousness, major health condi- tions provide families with an opportunity to heal unresolved issues and develop more im- mediate, caring relationships. For diseases in a more advanced stage, clinicians should help families emphasize quality of life by defi ning goals that are attainable more immediately and that enrich their everyday lives.

As the new era of genetics unfolds, families and clinicians are facing unprecedented com- plex clinical and ethical challenges (Miller et al., 2006). Families increasingly will be able to choose genetically informed knowledge of their future health risks or fate. Some key questions include:

• Which individuals and families will benefi t by genetic risk screening and knowledge of their health risks or fate?

• How can we best help family members reach decisions about whether to pursue predictive testing?

• Who are the relevant family members to in- clude in these decisions—spouses or part- ners? Extended family?

• Our societal fi xation on “the perfect healthy body” could meld seamlessly with technol- ogy and eugenics, forcing families living with disability, illness, or genetic risk to further hide their suffering in order to dem- onstrate the value of their lives and avoid increased stigmatization (Rolland, 1997, 1999).

Clinicians also need to consider their own ex- periences and feelings about illness and loss (McDaniel, Hepworth, & Doherty, 1997). Awareness and ease with our own multigenera- tional and family history with illness and loss, our health beliefs, and our current developmen- tal phase will enhance our ability to work effec- tively with families facing serious illness.

Living well with the strains and uncertainties of illness can be a monumental challenge. The Family Systems–Illness model offers a way to address this challenge and make the inevitable strains more manageable. Attending to the psy- chosocial demands of different kinds of con- ditions over time within a multigenerational, developmental, and belief system context can provide a strength-based framework—a com- mon language that facilitates collaborative, creative problem solving and quality of life for families facing illness, disability, and loss.

SUGGESTED LEARNING EXERCISES

Learning Exercise 13.1

You are called by the head nurse for the oncol- ogy inpatient unit to intervene with a patient and his family who are disrupting the unit. The patient is a 34-year-old African Ameri- can male who has been diagnosed with stage IV prostate cancer. The patient’s mother has been very emotional about his condition and insists on staying in her son’s room. This is in confl ict with the rules of the oncology unit. The patient, Keith, has been married for 6 months to a White woman named Lisa who is quite distressed by Keith’s condition but es- tranged from her own family. An unpleasant

JWBT514_ch13.indd 338JWBT514_ch13.indd 338 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Families, Health, and Illness 339

triangular confl ict has existed for the couple because of Keith’s strong relationship to his family of origin, particularly his mother, which is problematic for his spouse. On admission, his mother began a 24-hour vigil by her son’s hospital bed. Lisa greatly resents her mother- in-law’s seemingly intrusive and smothering behavior. Keith’s mother is critical of what she perceives as Lisa’s emotional coldness. Keith feels caught between his mother and wife and complains of anxiety and fatigue.

1. Thinking in terms of different cultural tra- ditions of the family members, including your own, how would you react to this case? Thinking systemically, how would you approach a consultation with the pa- tient and family?

2. Thinking in terms of the intersection of three distinct belief systems—your work setting (hospital), yourself as a social worker, and your personal cultural/ethnic/ family values—how might these affect your strategy in this case? What biases might in- terfere with your effectiveness? How could you avoid taking sides?

Learning Exercise 13.2

Mrs. L. tells you that she is concerned that her daughter Janice, age 5, has been compul- sively masturbating for the past 3 months and that it is an indication of sexual abuse. When the child assessment reveals no evidence of abuse, you inquire about other recent stress- ful events in the family. Only at that point does the mother reveal that her husband had a subtotal gastrectomy 9 months ago because of stomach cancer and that 3 months ago he had been rehospitalized for further tests that proved inconclusive. When Mrs. L. is asked what the children have been told, she re- ports that, after her husband’s surgery, they had told the children only that “Daddy had a tummyache, so the doctors removed Daddy’s stomach so he’d feel better.” Mrs. L. reveals that she herself worries constantly about her husband’s condition but that he will not come in to see the doctor and will not discuss his

problems. She states that, after the surgery, “He was adamant that he did not want ever to talk about it. He went back to work almost im- mediately and insisted that everything is fi ne.” Asked if this medical crisis had any impact on the children, especially Janice, she replies, “Well, she doesn’t tell me about any worries, but now that you ask, at dinner every night, when we say grace, Janice prays out loud for Daddy’s stomach. But no one in the family comments on this.”

1. Thinking in terms of healthy family communication in the face of threatened loss, how would you intervene in this case? Who would you try to convene, and why?

2. In what ways would you handle commu- nication with the children differently than with the couple?

3. How would you view the husband’s per- sonal decision to minimize his problem and keep it private in the context of other symp- tomatic family members?

Learning Exercise 13.3

Mr. and Mrs. Ellis, both in their early 80s, live alone on a farm in rural Illinois. Mr. Ellis has been experiencing a progressive dementia, which was diagnosed by a consulting neurolo- gist as Alzheimer’s disease. At a recent visit to her primary care physician, Mrs. Ellis revealed that Mr. Ellis’s confusion has been worsening and that he has hit her on occasion, causing se- rious bruising. The family physician feels the couple have reached their limits and has sug- gested a nursing home placement for Mr. Ellis. The family includes three adult children, Amy, John, and Jerry. Amy lives 100 miles away and visits weekly. The two sons live far away and are married and raising children. Amy agrees with the family physician and is very worried about her mother. The sons, however, think that Amy and her mother are exaggerating and have accused their mother of “never un- derstanding our dad.” The family is in a stale- mate about the current dilemma, and tensions between the two camps are rising.

JWBT514_ch13.indd 339JWBT514_ch13.indd 339 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

340 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

1. What might explain the differences in per- ception about Mr. Ellis’s condition by his wife and daughter and sons? How might it affect each family member’s feelings about placing Mr. Ellis in a nursing home?

2. Would you schedule a family meeting? How would you decide whether to include Mr. Ellis? What about John and Jerry, who are not in town?

3. How might gender norms be a factor in this case? How might you address them with this family?

4. How are life cycle issues (e.g., couple in later life, adult children in child-rearing phase with aging parents) pertinent, and how would you make them part of the con- sultative process?

5. What do you see as the choices for this fam- ily? How would you explore them in a col- laborative manner?

APPENDIX 13.1 CONSTRUCTING A FAMILY GENOGRAM

Genograms provide graphic representations of family structure and patterns over several generations that offer social workers a quick sense of a family’s strengths and vulnerabili- ties in relation to the current health situation and places present issues in the context of mul- tigenerational family patterns. Clarifi cation of complex family patterns can be used to gener- ate hypotheses about the evolution of current issues and to develop intervention strategies. Genograms provide a useful clinical tool to frame certain family challenges as developing over generations and, in complex family con- texts, minimizing blame, and helping families regain a sense of control as they move forward. Social workers can use a genogram in their practice setting to elicit key family narratives, highlighting important family and community members, patterns of illness and coping, and re- lational ties. McGoldrick et al. (2008) provide a standardized format for constructing a family genogram that includes (a) mapping the family

structure, (b) recording information about the family, and (c) describing family relationships. The basic family structural map is a pictorial representation of nuclear and extended family members and signifi cant nonfamily people or organizations usually encompassing three gen- erations. This structural map is fl eshed out by adding demographic information, functioning, and critical events. Key demographic data in- clude ages, dates of birth and death, occupa- tion, education, ethnic background, religion, and geographic location of key family mem- bers who may be involved in caregiving.

Usually a family fi nds the process of shar- ing its history a useful way to communicate important family values, and sometimes it is an easier fi rst step than discussing emotionally charged problems. Families typically enjoy constructing a genogram (some may even ask for a copy to take home) and approach it ea- gerly, giving the social worker clues as to the family’s capacity for and interest in collabora- tion.

Social workers can use genograms cre- atively, depending on their practice setting and the family’s presenting problem. For example, in health-care settings, the genogram can be targeted toward tracking prior family illness experiences and patterns of response to high- light the particular strengths and challenges for the family in confronting a current diag- nosis. The genogram promotes continuity and comprehensiveness of care by supplying a ver- satile, succinct clinical summary that can be used to quickly familiarize other consultants and health-care providers with a case.

REFERENCES

Antonovsky, A., & Sourani, T. (1988). Family sense of coherence and family adaptation. Journal of Marriage and the Family, 50, 79–92.

Becker, E. (1973). The denial of death. New York, NY: Free Press.

Blount, A. (1998). Integrated primary care: The future of medical and mental health collaboration. New York, NY: Norton.

Boss, P. (1999). Ambiguous loss: Learning to live with unresolved grief. Boston, MA: Harvard University Press.

JWBT514_ch13.indd 340JWBT514_ch13.indd 340 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Families, Health, and Illness 341

Boszormenyi-Nagy, I. (1987). Foundations of contextual therapy: Collected papers of Borzomenyi-Nagy, MD. New York, NY: Brunner/Mazel.

Bowen, M. (1993). Family therapy in clinical practice. New York, NY: Jason Aronson.

Byng-Hall, J. (1995). Rewriting family scripts. New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Campbell, T. (2003). The effectiveness of family interventions for physical disorders. Journal of Marital and Family Therapy, 29(2), 263–281.

Carr, D., & Springer, K. W. (2010). Advances in families and health research in the 21st century. Journal of Marriage and the Family, 72(3), 743–761.

Combrinck-Graham, L. (1985). A developmental model for family systems. Family Process, 24, 139–150.

Doherty, W., & Baird, M. (1983). Family therapy and family medicine: Towards the primary care of families. New York, NY: Guilford.

D’Onofrio, B. M., & Lahey, B. B. (2010). Biosocial infl uences on the family: A decade review. Journal of Marriage and the Family, 72(3), 762–782.

Engel, G. L. (1977). The need for a new medical model: A challenge for biomedicine. Science, 196, 129–136.

Framo, J. (1992). Family-of origin therapy: An intergenerational approach. New York, NY: Brunner/ Mazel.

Franks, H. M., & Roesch, S. C. (2006). Appraisals and coping in people living with cancer: A meta-analysis. Psychooncology, 15(12), 1027–1037.

Gonzalez, S., & Steinglass, P. (2002). Application of multifamily discussion groups in chronic medical disorders. In W. R. McFarlane (Ed.), Multifamily groups in the treatment of severe psychiatric disorders (pp. 315–340). New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Gonzalez, S., Steinglass, P., & Reiss, D. (1989). Putting the illness in its place: Discussion groups for families with chronic medical illnesses. Family Process, 28, 69–87.

Griffi th, J., & Griffi th, M. (1994). The body speaks. New York, NY: Basic Books.

Hurley, K., Miller, S. M., Rubin, L., & Weinberg, D. S. (2006). The individual facing genetic issues: Information processing, decision making, perception, and health-protective behaviors. In S. M. Miller, S. H. McDaniel, J. S. Rolland, & S. L. Feetham (Eds.), Individuals, families, and the new era of genetics: Biopsychosocial perspectives. New York, NY: Norton.

Imber-Black, E., Roberts, J., & Whiting, R. (Eds.). (2003). Rituals in families and family therapy (2nd ed.). New York, NY: Norton.

Kazak, A. E. (2002). Challenges in family health intervention research. Families, Systems, and Health, 20(1), 51–59.

Kleinman, A. (1988). The illness narratives: Suffering, healing, and the human condition. New York, NY: Basic Books.

Law, D., & Crane, R. (2007). The infl uence of individual, marital, and family treatment on high utilizers of health care. Journal of Marital and Family Therapy, 29(3), 353–363.

Lefcourt, H. M. (1982). Locus of control (2nd ed.). Hillsdale, NJ: Erlbaum.

Levinson, D. J. (1986). A conception of adult development. American Psychologist, 41, 3–13.

Lynn, J., Schuster, J. L., Wilkinson, A., & Simon, L. N. (2007). Improving care for the end of life: A sourcebook for health care managers and clinicians (2nd ed.). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

McDaniel, S., Campbell, T., Hepworth, J., & Lorenz, A. (2005). Family-oriented primary care (2nd ed.). New York, NY: Springer.

McDaniel, S., Hepworth, J., & Doherty, W. (Eds.). (in press). Medical family therapy: A biopsychosocial approach to families with health problems (2nd ed). New York, NY: Basic Books.

McDaniel, S., Hepworth, J., & Doherty, W. (Eds.). (1997). The shared experience of illness: Stories of patients, families, and their therapists. New York, NY: Basic Books.

McFarlane, W. F. (Ed.). (2002), Multifamily groups in the treatment of severe psychiatric disorders. New York, NY: Guilford Press.

McGoldrick, M., Garcia-Preto, N., & Carter, B. (2010). The expanded family life cycle: Individual, family and social perspectives (4th ed.). New York, NY: Allyn & Bacon.

McGoldrick, M., Gerson, R., & Petry, S. (2008). Genograms in family assessment (3rd ed.). New York, NY: Norton.

McGoldrick, M., Pearce, J. K., & Garcia-Preto, N. (2005). Ethnicity and family therapy (3rd ed.). New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Miller, S., McDaniel, S., Rolland, J., & Feetham, S. (Eds.). (2006). Individuals, families, and the new era of genetics: Biopsychosocial perspectives. New York, NY: Norton.

Moos, R. (Ed.). (1989). Coping with physical illness. Volume 2: New perspectives. New York, NY: Plenum Press.

Neugarten, B. (1976). Adaptation and the life cycle. Counseling Psychologist, 6(1), 16–20.

Olkin, R. (1999). What psychotherapists should know about disability. New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Penn, P. (1983). Coalitions and binding interactions in families with chronic illness. Family Systems Medicine, 1(2), 16–25.

Reiss, D. (1981). The family’s construction of reality. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.

Roesch, S., & Weiner, B. (2001). A meta-analytic review of coping with illness: Do causal attributions matter. Journal of Psychosomatic Research, 50(4), 205–219.

Rolland, J. (2006b). Genetics, family systems, and multicultural infl uences. Families, Systems, & Health, 24(4), 425–442.

JWBT514_ch13.indd 341JWBT514_ch13.indd 341 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

342 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

Rolland, J. (2010). Mastering family challenges in illness, disability, and genetic conditions. In F. Walsh (Ed.), Normal family processes (4th ed., pp. 411–439). New York, NY: Guilford.

Rolland, J. S. (1984). Toward a psychosocial typology of chronic and life-threatening illness. Family Systems Medicine, 2, 245–263.

Rolland, J. S. (1987a). Chronic illness and the life cycle: A conceptual framework. Family Process, 26(2), 203–221.

Rolland, J. S. (1987b). Family illness paradigms: Evolution and signifi cance. Family Systems Medicine, 5(4), 467–486.

Rolland, J. S. (1990). Anticipatory loss: A family systems developmental framework. Family Process, 29(3), 229–244.

Rolland, J. S. (1994a). Families, illness, and disability: An integrative treatment model. New York, NY: Basic Books.

Rolland, J. S. (1994b). In sickness and in health: The impact of illness on couples’ relationships. Journal of Marital and Family Therapy, 20(4), 327–349.

Rolland, J. S. (1997). The meaning of disability and suffering: Socio-political and ethical concerns. Family Process, 36(4), 437–440.

Rolland, J. S. (1998). Beliefs and collaboration in illness: Evolution over time. Families, Systems and Health, 16(1/2), 7–27.

Rolland, J. S. (1999). Families and genetic fate: A millennial challenge. Families, Systems and Health, 16(1), 123–133.

Rolland, J. S. (2004). Helping families with anticipatory loss and terminal illness. In F. Walsh & M. McGoldrick (Eds.), Living beyond loss: Death in the family (2nd ed., pp. 213–236). New York, NY: Norton.

Rolland, J. S. (2006a). Living with anticipatory loss in the new era of genetics: A life cycle perspective. In S. Miller, S. McDaniel, J. Rolland, & S. Feetham. (Eds.), Individuals, families, and the new era of genetics: Biopsychosocial perspectives (pp. 139–172). New York, NY: Norton.

Rolland, J. S., & Williams, J. K. (2005). Toward a biopsychosocial model for 21st century genetics. Family Process, 44(1), 3–24.

Seaburn, D., Gunn, W., Mauksch, L., Gawinski, A., & Lorenz, A. (Eds.). (1996). Models of collaboration: A guide for mental health professionals working with physicians and health care providers. New York, NY: Basic Books.

Seaburn, D., Lorenz, A., & Kaplan, D. (1992). The transgenerational development of chronic illness meanings. Family Systems Medicine, 10, 385–395.

Sontag, S. (2001). Illness as metaphor and AIDS and its metaphors. New York, NY: Picador.

Steinglass, P. (1998). Multiple family discussion groups for patients with chronic medical illness. Families, Systems, and Health, 16(1/2), 55–71.

Taylor, S. (1983). Adjustment to threatening events: A theory of cognitive adaptation. American Psychologist, 38(11), 1161–1173.

Taylor, S., Helgeson, V., Reed, G., & Skokan, L. (1991). Self-generated feelings of control and adjustment to physical illness. Journal of Social Issues, 47(4), 91–109.

Thompson, S., & Kyle, D. (2000). The role of perceived control in coping with the losses associated with chronic illness. In J. Harvey & E. Miller (Eds.), Loss and trauma: General and close relationship perspectives. Philadelphia, PA: Brunner-Routledge.

Wallston, K. A. (2004). Control and Health. In N. Anderson (Ed.), Encyclopedia of Health & Behavior, Volume 1 (pp. 217–220). Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.

Walsh, F. (2006). Strengthening family resilience (2nd ed). New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Walsh, F. (Ed.). (2009). Spiritual resources in family therapy (2nd ed.). New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Walsh, F., & McGoldrick, M. (Eds.). (2004). Living beyond loss: Death in the family (2nd ed.). New York, NY: Norton.

Weihs, K., Fisher, L., & Baird, M. (2002). Families, health, and behavior: A section of the commissioned report by the committee on Health and Behavior: Research, Practice and Policy, Division of Neuroscience and Behavioral Health and Division of Health Promotion and Disease Prevention, Institute of Medicine, National Academy of Sciences. Families, Systems, and Health, 20(1), 7–47.

Werner-Lin, A. (2008). Beating the biological clock: The compressed family life cycle of young women with BRCA gene alterations. Social Work in Health Care, 47(4): 416–437.

Wood, B. L., Lim, J., Miller, B., Cheah, P., Zwetsch, T., Ramesh, S., & Simmens, S. (2008). Testing the biobehavioral model in pediatric asthma: Pathways of effect. Family Process, 47(1), 21–40.

Wright, L. M., & Bell, J. (2009). Beliefs and illness: A model for healing. Calgary, Alberta, Canada: 4th Floor Press.

JWBT514_ch13.indd 342JWBT514_ch13.indd 342 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

343

14

Human Sexual Health

LES GALLO-SILVER AND DAVID S. BIMBI

Sexuality and physical intimacy contribute to every individual’s quality of life. However, many people fi nd these aspects of life diffi - cult to discuss with health-care professionals, particularly those who may feel stigmatized by their sexual identity (e.g., lesbian, gay, bi- sexual, and transgender [LGBT] people; peo- ple who engage in atypical sexual behaviors). Understanding the development of humans as sexual beings, details of the human sexual re- sponse, and changes and challenges presented by medical illnesses and traumatic injuries can help social workers in health-care settings feel more comfortable and confi dent when address- ing sexuality with patients and their partners. Often the social worker is the only member of the health-care team who is willing and able to address issues of sexuality and physical in- timacy in the context of communication, con- nection, and healing (Hazan & Shaver, 1987; McCabe, 1994; Schover, 2000). It is crucial for health social workers to help patients preserve this important part of life in the face of injury or illness. This chapter provides a foundation of basic information about human sexuality and the impact of illness or injury.

Many words describe various aspects of sexuality and physical intimacy. For the pur- poses of this chapter, sexuality refers to the desire to have sexual contact and intercourse and the body’s responses to sexual stimulation; physical intimacy refers to physical acts of af- fection, comfort, and support. Sensuality refers to types of stimulation that are pleasurable but are not necessarily sexual.

Chapter Objectives • Introduce social workers to a perspective

that focuses on psychosexual developments

in the context of verbal and nonverbal com- munication and interpersonal relationships.

• Guide social workers in strategies to become comfortable addressing sexual issues and ex- ploring sexual content with patients.

• Guide social workers through an assess- ment that includes the questions needed to understand life, behavior, sexual relation- ships, and activities appropriate to health social work settings.

• Provide an understanding of the human sex- ual response, and identify areas of preserved sexual functioning in people with medical illness or injury in order to address issues of disenfranchisement (see Box 14.1).

• Introduce social workers to sexual rehabili- tation counseling techniques that focus on

Box 14.1 Institutional Obstacles to Physical Intimacy

Health facilities and related environments that assist the medically ill or injured often have policies and procedures that present obstacles to physical intimacy. These policies and procedures refl ect a lack of basic knowledge about human sexuality and an avoidance of sexual issues. An example is rules that discourage the partners of adult patients from sleeping or resting in bed with them. The same institution may consider it routine for parents to share the beds of their pediatric patients. This incongruity is most apparent in cancer treatment centers where both the adult and pediatric patients receive chemotherapy and may have a weakened immune system yet face disparate policies for overnight visitation and bed sharing.

ch14.indd 343ch14.indd 343 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

344 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

diffi culties in sexual functioning and recov- ering functioning or creatively accommo- dating for the impairment.

• Introduce social workers to concerns unique to LGBT people.

• Introduce social workers to cultural and faith-based issues that may impact sexual rehabilitation.

• Introduce social workers to macrolevel is- sues of creating sex-positive care environ- ments, and encourage social workers to learn how to provide sex-positive education, advocacy, and leadership in both inpatient and outpatient settings.

DEMYSTIFYING HUMAN SEXUAL DEVELOPMENT

Social workers are obligated by the National Association of Social Workers Code of Ethics to explore issues of suicidal thinking, domestic violence, and substance abuse. This explora- tion might be diffi cult for some, but few social workers would argue that they are not important to social work practice. Sexuality and physical intimacy, as healthy and potentially healing aspects of the quality of life, require the same professional attention from social workers.

The natural biological sexual capabilities of humans are evident throughout the life cycle, even at an early age, before the concept of sexual desire develops or intercourse occurs. For instance, infant boys may experience erec- tions and infant girls may become lubricated (Horner, 2004; Kelly & Hockenberg-Eaton, 1999; Ryan, 2000; Walker & Casale, 1997). From a very young age, children may ex- plore their bodies, including their genitals, be- cause of the pleasurable sensation it provides (Kaplan, 1974; Zoldbrod, 2003).

Early Theories of Sexual Development

Freud’s pleasure principle, introducing the concept of libido, has infl uenced many social workers’ professional thoughts about sexual development (Freud, 1922). Libido is a concept that includes sexual desire, fantasy, and the initial

sensations of being sexually stimulated. Freud believed that libido was concerned with pleasure seeking to relieve sexual tension. He presented a theory that seems devoid of many interper- sonal processes, such as love seeking, comfort, and receiving pleasure from another person. It is thus incongruent with social work’s philosophy of preserving and enhancing the quality of life. An unfortunate consequence of viewing sexual feelings primarily as a way to release tension is that issues of sexuality and physical intimacy are considered to be outside of a person’s day- to-day functioning and thus, by defi nition, less important than activities such as going to work or school or caring for children.

Erickson’s (1968) work on the formation of a person’s identity from childhood to adult- hood better represents sexuality and physical intimacy as aspects of the human experience by which people connect and communicate their thoughts and feelings. At each develop- mental stage, people express their wish to be close to others through displays of physical affection, comforting, and, at times, sexual de- sire (Erickson, 1968).

The gap between Freud’s and Erickson’s perspectives arguably may be bridged by the work of W. Ronald D. Fairbairn (1946), who suggested that libido was not concerned simply with seeking release but rather with an object or person with whom to connect intimately. The need to connect physically is rooted in the infant–parent relationship, which is based partly on touch and is each human’s fi rst experience of physical connection. Considering sexuality as relationship-based may lend it deeper meaning than if it is considered a purely pleasure-seeking activity. This idea demystifi es human sexuality by placing it in an interpersonal context rather than one that is purely biological. This concep- tualization is the basis of Zoldbrod’s Milestones in Sexual Development (1998, 2003).

Zoldbrod’s Milestones in Sexual Development

Zoldbrod’s Milestones in Sexual Develop- ment begins with birth and progresses to the parent’s initial bonding experience with the

ch14.indd 344ch14.indd 344 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

Human Sexual Health 345

infant. Parental love is communicated through touch—the foundation of empathy as the par- ent searches for the right response to an infant’s cry. As the baby’s cry is interpreted correctly, the baby develops a sense of trust in the world and a belief that his needs will be met, which allows the infant to be soothed by the parent. Because parents must help their infants with all basic needs, such as bathing and feeding, a par- ent’s attitude toward her baby’s body becomes refl ected in the baby’s own attitude about his body and is therefore the foundation of body image. Body image is ultimately refi ned to in- clude the establishment of gender identity.

As the growing child becomes more certain of his gender identity, he develops self-esteem and feels accepted. Regardless of later sexual and gender identity, children with atypical gender expression may encounter overt hostil- ity, condemnation, and withdrawal of affection by their parents and same-age peers. As chil- dren continue to develop, they become more aware of their effect on other people and real- ize that their words and actions impact others. Thus begins the process of learning how to manage power within relationships with oth- ers. As children enter puberty, they develop a sense of “owning” themselves; that is, they begin to discover the parameters of autonomy and the concept of interdependence with oth- ers as an aspect of each being his own person.

Adolescence is a time of sexual exploration. A parent’s permission to explore sexual issues is primarily a function of open communication, sharing, and recognition that the adolescent is experiencing intense sexual feelings. The ex- ploration of both sexual and emotional feelings remains within a social and interpersonal context and provides an opportunity to develop more so- phisticated social skills. A key part of this journey of sexual development is the creation of sexual fantasies and masturbation. The fi nal milestone in the Zoldbrod model is the development of lov- ing sexual interpersonal relationships.

Zoldbrod’s milestones ground sexual devel- opment in an interpersonal perspective—the parent–child relationship. The parent’s care of the child’s bodily needs and functioning and the physical and emotional affection that travels

with the child, as he develops into an adolescent and then a young adult, position sexuality and physical intimacy more as an aspect of human communication and connection than one of sensation or pleasure seeking. Thus these mile- stones naturally progress from the love and touch of caring parents to loving and sexual rela- tionships with others as adults (Zoldbrod, 1998, 2003). Parental touch responds to the needs of preverbal infants, both emotionally and physi- cally, and becomes the foundation for empathy and trust. We learn that touch will soothe us and help us relax. Parents who talk to their chil- dren while diapering and bathing them convey the message that the child and the child’s body are beautiful. This experience helps form our fi rst notions of positive body image (Clawson & Reese-Weber, 2003; Connolly, Slaghter, & Mealey, 2004; Ehrenberg & Ehrenberg, 1988). The pleasure of being touched is the basic foundation of human sexuality and physical in- timacy (Frohlick & Meston, 2005).

Communication and the Health-Care Team

People with medical conditions often are sexu- ally disenfranchised by the medical establish- ment. In the 1940s, Alfred Kinsey studied human sexual practices in the United States, providing data on the age of fi rst sexual ex- perience, prevalence and fl uidity of same sex practices, frequency of sexual intercourse within marriage, and masturbatory behavior in adolescents and adults (Kinsey, Pomeroy, & Martin, 1948, 1953). Kinsey’s research was revisited by Laumann, Gagnon, Michael, and Michaels (1994) at the University of Chicago, who collected data to compare to Kinsey’s. Included among the changes indicated by the comparison of the two collections of data are that Americans had their fi rst sexual experience at a younger age, more women were willing to report that they masturbated, heterosexual oral intercourse had become more prevalent, and more unmarried people were living together in sexual relationships. The sexual practices of people with medical illness or injuries, how- ever, were not addressed by either study.

ch14.indd 345ch14.indd 345 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

346 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

People with medical problems become sexu- ally disenfranchised when their sexual concerns are neither explored nor addressed (Gallo- Silver & Parsonnet, 2001; Kroll & Klein, 2001; McCabe, 1999). Health-care professionals tend to wait for patients and their partners to raise issues of sexuality and do not themselves ini- tiate them (Esmail, Yashima, & Munro, 2002). This silence further isolates patients and their partners, sending the message that questions and concerns about sex are less than appropri- ate (Katzin, 1990; McInnes, 2003).

Discomfort with issues and discussion of sex and sexual expression may be based on cultural or religious beliefs. Prohibitions about premari- tal sex, masturbation, and nonprocreative sex may be part of the cultural or faith-based milieu that have been integrated into patients’ belief

systems. The health social worker needs to be educated about these issues, with the patient being one of the sources of information. At times, the health social worker collaborates with faith- based leaders to help negotiate these restrictions in a respectful and productive manner. Helen Singer Kaplan (1974) described a constrictive upbringing by parents who were uncomfortable with sexual issues as a source of sexual alien- ation and adult diffi culties in sexual functioning.

LGBT people may be uncomfortable dis- cussing their sexual behaviors and expression with social workers outside their communities, and some may avoid the topic altogether. So- cial workers may have to establish that they are LGBT friendly and demonstrate cultural credibility to facilitate disclosure and discus- sion from these patients (see Box 14.2).

Box 14.2 Glossary of Terms Used Within the LGBT Community

Members of the LGBT community self- identify using specifi c terms.

Lesbian: A woman who identifi es as someone erotically, romantically, and affectionately attracted to other women.

Gay: An individual who identifi es as someone erotically, romantically, and affectionately attracted to the same gender. Typically used by men and frequently interpreted as referring to men but also commonly used by women.

Bisexual: An individual who is erotically, romantically, and affectionately attracted to both genders. Used both as an identity label and as an adjective to describe behavior.

Transgender: Often used to describe all gender-variant people; clinically used to describe a person who lives or identifi es as a gender other than that expected based on their anatomical sex.

In addition to these terms, additional self- identifi ers are important to understand. Homosexual refers to a behavior and not to a person. Gender identity is a person’s sense of being male, female, or other gendered.

Gender variant: A person who, either by nature or choice, does not conform to gender-based expectations of society.

Intersexed: A person born with ambiguous genitals may self-identify as being a member of both genders. At times this is used to self-identify a woman with an elongated clitoris or a man born with a micropenis and undescended testicles.

Transsexual: Often used interchangeably with the word transgender. It clinically describes those who may have surgically modifi ed their secondary and/or primary sexual characteristics to match their gender identity.

Many of these terms have become stigmatized within specifi c cultures and often are associated with urban communities. People may use other labels to describe their identity and behavior, such as queer, men who have sex with men, same-gender loving, two-spirited, pansexual, and polyamorous, among others. When in doubt, always ask clients to defi ne the term they use to describe themselves or their behaviors in a respectful and open manner.

ch14.indd 346ch14.indd 346 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

Human Sexual Health 347

Social Worker’s Role

Successful professional intervention is infl u- enced in part by the attitudes of patients and their partners. The functioning of the health- care team also is affected by its members’ cul- tural and religious backgrounds, which may result in a reluctance to focus on the sexual re- lationships between patients and their partners. In addition, some health-care professionals may be concerned that raising the issue of sex will alarm a patient or partner and be seen as inappropriate or unprofessional. Social work- ers are trained to address diffi cult issues, such as family violence, chemical dependence, and suicidal thoughts. Although these issues are diffi cult to discuss, they are seen as necessary issues for social workers’ interventions. Health social workers need to be equally comfortable discussing sexuality and intimacy issues with patients and their partners in order to assess and address patients’ psychosocial issues fully as well as to plan effective programs and ser- vices for individuals, groups, and communi- ties. In addition, health social workers need to develop a sex-positive approach to people, for example, one that does not assume that ev- eryone is heterosexual or that a person is “too old” for sexual activity. Although currently people who are LGBT are labeled according to their sexual orientation and lifestyle, many are no more or less inhibited and embarrassed about discussing sexual activity than are other

Americans. In some instances, LGBT people may be more inhibited than other people be- cause of fear of rejection or stigmatization.

INTIMACY OF HEALTH SOCIAL WORK

Health social work often requires a level of intimacy that social workers in other settings rarely experience. In acute care medical fa- cilities, patients are often in bed and wearing hospital gowns or sleepwear when the social worker is present. In both outpatient and in- patient settings, as well as in nursing homes, the health social worker often must discuss a patient’s body and its functions. Health social workers who are part of visiting nurse or hos- pice programs face situations in which their patients’ bodies and functioning become part of the clinical focus, and most contact takes place in or near where patients sleep.

The intimacy of health social workers’ prac- tice settings requires an acute sensitivity to the patient’s need for privacy and feelings of vul- nerability. In most instances, the social worker is well advised to ask the patient’s permission to join her at the bedside and to empower her to communicate when would be a comfortable time to be interviewed. Knocking on the door to the hospital or nursing home room, even if the door is open, sets a tone of respect and indi- cates that one is entering the patient’s intimate

CASE EXAMPLE

Ms. King, who is 75 years old, is recovering from a hysterectomy after ovarian cancer and is struggling with feeling less feminine. Her physician indicated that she was recovering nicely and told her that, because she was postmenopausal and therefore beyond childbearing age, the surgery would have a negligible effect on her life. Ms. King decided not to ask her doctor how her surgery might affect her sexual activity with her female partner. With empathy and respect, the social worker seeks a better

understanding of Ms. King’s relationship with her partner. A joint session with the couple prior to discharge from the hospital helps them explore the issue of physical intimacy in a direct and frank manner. Ms. King’s doctor then is asked to explain the medical issues that would impact their sexual functioning and how those issues can be accommodated. The social worker provides the couple with reading material about sexual activity and arranges for them to meet with the physician in order for them to get specifi c information.

ch14.indd 347ch14.indd 347 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

348 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

environment. Some cultures prefer a more for- mal way of addressing and being addressed by health-care professionals. The social worker should begin the relationship with patients with formal greetings (i.e., using an honorifi c and the patient’s last name) until she is able to assess what is the norm for the person’s cultural group. Eye contact is best maintained on an equal plane; that is, if a patient is in bed or seated in a wheelchair, the health social worker also should be seated and at the patient’s eye level instead of forcing the patient to look up by standing above her. Even for patients who come from cultures in which eye contact is considered impolite, being at the same level as the patient is almost always considered a sign of respect.

It is within these environments that patients may exchange information on body functioning and sexuality that is rarely, if ever, exchanged with social workers in other practice settings. Within these intimate contexts, it is important that all discussions about sexuality, sexual func- tioning, and physical intimacy address patients as people with complete adult lives that hap- pen to have been disrupted by illness or injury (Schover, 2000; Schover & Jensen, 1988). In addition, the health social worker must establish some level of privacy, which may be diffi cult in some medical environments.

Obtaining a Sexual History

Early in the acquired immunodefi ciency syn- drome (AIDS) epidemic and prior to the de- velopment of the current family of antiviral drugs, people with AIDS experienced long hospital stays. The health social worker’s role in discharge planning and the profession’s commitment to underserved and isolated communities provided an opportunity to edu- cate other health-care professionals (Eagan, 1993; Fahs & Wade, 1996; Mantell, Shulman, Belmont, & Spivak, 1989; Napoleone, 1988). Health social workers on the forefront of AIDS intervention claimed as part of their professional roles counseling to hetero- sexuals, bisexuals, and gay women and men about safer sex practices and harm reduction (Berkman & Zinberg, 1997; Christ, Moynihan,

& Gallo-Silver, 1995; Gallo-Silver, Raveis, & Moynihan, 1993; Weiner & Siegel, 1990). The counseling uses a sex-positive approach (Furstenberg & Olson, 1984; Samuel & Boyle, 1989). Health social workers accomplish this task by assessing a person’s sexual practices with acceptance and respect and view the pro- cess as an integral part of their work.

Similarly, a psychosocial assessment of a person challenged by any illness or injury that fails to address sexual issues is incomplete. The health social worker is the one member of the health-care team who is not specifi cally and exclusively focused on the patient’s illness or injury in terms of treatment or procedures. Rather, the health social worker’s focus is on emotional coping skills and practical problem solving. The social work relationship provides the most comfortable and safe environment and opportunity for patients and partners to discuss issues of sexuality and physical inti- macy. The natural time during a social work assessment to ask patients if they are sexu- ally active and if they have partners is when discussing relationships and social supports (Fuentes, Rosenberg, & Marks, 1983; Gallo- Silver & Parsonnet, 2001; Weerakoon, Jones, Pynor, & Kilburn-Watt, 2004).

These assessments provide health social workers with opportunities to convey the mes- sage that sexuality and physical intimacy are natural and normal parts of life (Andrews, 2000). As a rule, people who have enjoyed their sexuality and the physical intimacy of their relationships want to recover and resume that aspect of their lives. People who have had long-standing diffi culties with their sexuality fear that their medical conditions will render these diffi culties intractable. In either case, the support and empathy of a social worker can help individuals feel less alone and over- whelmed by issues of sexuality and physical intimacy. Gaining an understanding of a pa- tient’s most recent and current sexual relation- ships helps the social worker learn what has been lost, or perceived to have been lost, due to adverse health conditions. All assessments should elicit information about signifi cant re- lationships (see Box 14.3).

ch14.indd 348ch14.indd 348 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

Human Sexual Health 349

Box 14.3 Five Suggested Social Work Assessment Questions and Strategies for Patients

1. A patient’s demographics enable the health social worker to integrate questions about sexuality and physical intimacy into a psychosocial assessment. If a patient is married, a social worker can ask, “Your admissions sheet indicates that you are married. How long have you been married? Do you have children? What are their ages? Are you currently sexually active?” or “Your admission sheet lists an emergency contact person; what is this person’s relationship to you? Is this person a relative, friend, or partner? Are you currently sexually active with your partner?” Some patients are gay or lesbian. Therefore, discussions of wives and husbands that presume the patient is heterosexual are an obstacle to open and helpful discussions about sexual issues. The term partner is more gender neutral.

2. Assessing a couple’s emotional intimacy is the fi rst step in assessing their sexual relationship. Emotional intimacy is a good barometer of the couple’s abilities to communicate and share intimate details of their lives together with each other. Areas to consider are an understanding of the history of their meeting and how the relationship progressed, the pre-illness/ pre-injury sleeping arrangements, special enjoyable milestones, and the recreation/ leisure time they spent together.

3. Patients defi ne sexual activity and physical intimacy in an individual way. Asking patients how they defi ne the terms sexually active or physical intimacy can be accomplished in a respectful and professional manner: “Thank you for sharing with me that you have a partner and that prior to your illness or injury you have been sexually active. Do you feel comfortable enough to share with me what, in particular, you mean by sexual activity?”

4. Patients will want to share sexual material with health-care professionals because they have concerns, worries, and distress about the impact of their illnesses or injury on their sexual functioning. Health social workers can share their discomfort with the issue, even their embarrassment, as such a disclosure can help put patients at ease. The reason to explore sexual issues is to diminish a sense of isolation and to help patients gain access to medical information and interventions that might improve their functioning. Health social workers demonstrate this by making clear the purpose of the discussion: “I appreciate you sharing such personal issues with me. It is a little awkward for me to ask you these questions about sexual activity. My goal in exploring the issue with you is to help you identify areas where you may want help and facilitate getting specialized help for your concerns.”

5. Sometimes a patient’s concerns are not specifi cally about how her body functions but how she looks to others and her perceived loss of attractiveness and desirability. These feelings can be very discouraging to people as they diminish self-esteem. At times, these feelings can impede a person’s commitment to treatment or rehabilitation and can be an aspect of depression (McCabe & Taleporos, 2003; Sundquist & Yee, 2003; Tanyi, 2002) The health social worker’s interventions are listening empathically, tolerating silence, and not presenting an obstacle to exploration by quickly reassuring the patient, “Your feelings about the way you look are very important. You have shared with me how much distress this causes for you. I don’t think there are any quick or easy solutions, but I do think that discussing these issues can bring us closer to fi nding some solutions.”

ch14.indd 349ch14.indd 349 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

350 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

Social workers must be particularly attentive to the additional stressors and barriers faced by patients who are LGBT because of the lack of national legal recognition of their relationships. Because of this lack of recognition, members of the LGBT community may use terms such as boyfriend or girlfriend to describe their part- ners, even if they are in committed long-term relationships, while some patients may use husband or wife, even if the relationship is not legally recognized where they live.

The patient’s partner is an important partici- pant in understanding the sexual and affection- ate aspects of their relationship. Interviewing the partner can elicit more information about a

person’s life functioning before illness or dis- ability (see Box 14.4; Cagle & Bolte, 2009; Lemieux, Kaiser, Periera, & Meadows, 2004). Partners may be reluctant to approach issues of sex or physical intimacy due to the belief that by doing so, they are selfi shly placing their own needs before those of their partner who is ill or has a disability (Soloway, Soloway, Kim, & Kava, 2005; Wimberly, Carver, Laurenceau, Karris, & Antoni, 2005; Zunkel, 2002). The health social worker who is willing to address the issues of sexuality and physical intimacy with a partner can help normalize and validate concerns about how life has changed due to the illness or injury (Esmail et al., 2002).

Box 14.4 Four Suggested Social Work Assessment Questions and Strategies for Partners

1. Social workers should understand the couple’s experience of sexuality and physical intimacy during the beginning of their relationship. The health social worker needs to engage the partner in sharing how he met the patient to learn how the relationship unfolded emotionally. Questions such as “What were the reasons the two of you became a couple? At what point did you decide to become a couple? and What was it like in the beginning of the relationship?” focus the partner on the emotional underpinning of the relationship and ultimately its sexual underpinnings as well.

2. Relating emotional commitment to the expression of physical love through sexuality and physical intimacy helps a partner understand the health social worker’s interest in this area of their lives. The health social worker’s questions need to refl ect this interpersonal approach: “My next question is a logical one but also a very personal one, and I want to avoid any embarrassment for you or for me. How has your relationship grown over the years in the areas of sexuality

and physical intimacy? What has this been like for the two of you before your partner became ill/was injured? What types of touching and affection can/do the two of you share now?”

3. The health social worker needs to ascertain the importance of sexuality and physical intimacy for the partner at this time in his or her and the patient’s life. “How important was making love/sex to you and your partner before the illness/injury? What do you miss now? Are you interested in fi nding out how you and your partner might be able to return to what the two of you enjoyed before the illness/injury?”

4. The health social worker’s interventions are empathic: listening, tolerating silence, and not presenting an obstacle to exploration by quickly reassuring the partner or changing the subject. “Thank you for giving me a very clear understanding of how much the two of you share and how close the two of you are. Sexuality and physical intimacy are an important part of a couple’s life. Perhaps as I talk further with you and your partner we can fi nd some solutions and/or specialized services to help you both retain/reclaim the physically intimate aspects of your relationship.”

ch14.indd 350ch14.indd 350 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

Human Sexual Health 351

The health social worker’s approach to ob- taining a sexual history and ultimately helping the patient and her partner problem-solve around sexual issues is based in supportive counseling techniques. The health social worker uses ques- tioning to increase the couple’s understanding of their thoughts, feelings, concerns, and needs; identifi es patients and partners who want fur- ther intervention; and collaborates with other health-care professionals to access specialized services.

In addition to this process-oriented outline for assessment, other interventions are used more commonly in health-care settings that employ a medical model. The health social worker needs to be aware of how other health professionals may approach issues of sexuality and physical intimacy.

The EX-PLISSIT model of assessment has been developed and enhanced by nursing pro- fessionals and often is used by health social workers (Cagle & Bolte, 2009). EX-PLISSIT is based on the original PLISSIT model de- veloped by Anon in 1976 (Taylor & Davies, 2006). The acronym stands for

EXtended. Social workers need to take a well-paced, ongoing approach to help- ing people with sexual issues.

Permission. Social workers need to give pa- tients permission to talk about and con- sider sexual issues using generalization and normalization interventions.

Limited Information. Social workers need to gather limited information to capture the patient/family education aspects of a sexual assessment.

Specifi c Suggestions. Social workers need to provide specifi c suggestions and rec- ommendations to the patient and the couple based on their sexual activity be- fore their illness or injury.

Intensive Therapy. Social workers may sug- gest and intensive therapy to address an identifi ed need through an appropriate referral.

Many health social workers use the EX- PLISSIT model, but a social work–developed

model also can be used. The CARESS model was designed originally to assess sexual issues for patients receiving palliative care or at the end of life (Gallo-Silver, 2011) The acronym stands for:

Counseling. Health social workers often provide a variety of services and psycho- social interventions concurrently, and sexual issues often are presented within the context of ongoing meetings with patients and families focused on adjust- ment to illness.

Assessment. After the health social worker has developed a therapeutic alliance with the patient and partner, sexual is- sues should be introduced in a way that enables them to provide a description of their emotional and physical intimacy (see Box 14.4).

Research. The social worker must conduct research to become familiar with the specifi c needs and sexual issues con- fronting each patient due to specifi c ill- nesses or conditions.

Education. The social worker must provide education to the patient and her partner based on the social worker’s research and in collaboration with the health-care team to help the couple understand their current medically related sexual obsta- cles.

Strategies. The social worker, in collabo- ration with the patient and her partner, must strategize for solving specifi c prob- lems, because often the couple are too embarrassed or inhibited to share ideas with each other.

Sustainment. Social workers must make an ongoing commitment to help the couple when medical issues change.

Health social workers help other health pro- fessionals understand how certain terminology and phrasing might confuse patients who may be too uncomfortable to ask for clarifi cation. Given the number of euphemisms used for sexual activities, defi nitions can vary from in- dividual to individual.

ch14.indd 351ch14.indd 351 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

352 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

CHILDHOOD SEXUAL ABUSE

People’s sexual histories can be fraught with joy, contentment, resignation, or disappoint- ment. After a health social worker uses his skill set to normalize issues of sexuality and physical intimacy and validate them as a natu- ral part of life, other issues can be uncovered. Sadly, not all children are touched with paren- tal tenderness and affection. Researchers esti- mate that 1 in 3 women and 1 in 7 men were sexually abused as children (Finkelhor, 1984; Maltz, 2001, 2003; Russell, 1999). Child- hood sexual abuse is an umbrella designation for a series of behaviors that include vaginal and anal penetration by a penis, fi nger, hand, or other object; receptive or active oral sex; fondling and masturbation; invasion of privacy when bathing and toileting; sexually provoca- tive behavior and nudity; and exposure to and involvement in pornography (Johnson, 2004). Survivors of childhood sexual abuse often feel violated by the health-care system (Jehu, 1992). The requirement that patients remove their clothes and appear inadequately dressed in a hospital gown, undergo X-rays and other radiographic tests that require them to stay still or be posed in certain ways, and receive invasive examinations, such as a gynecologi- cal or digital rectal exams, all can evoke feel- ings and thoughts about childhood sexual abuse that previously have been avoided or not acknowledged (Draucker, & Spadlin, 2001; Gallo-Silver & Weiner, 2006; Hobbins, 2004; Sansone, Gaither, & Sansone, 2001; Sansone, Skaife, & Rhodes, 2003).

A health social worker may become aware of a history of childhood sexual abuse when working with a patient who is in distress or having diffi culty coping with the health-care environment. Helping a patient feel safe in these circumstances is achieved by increasing her sense of control over a given situation. All medical procedures require some form of con- sent, that can be rescinded or altered according to the patient’s wishes. The next case example depicts how health social workers can use their clinical skills to help this emotionally fragile population.

The exploration of childhood sexual abuse in the health-care setting is appropriate when the history represents an obstacle to care, as illustrated in the last case. The ability to re- spond empathetically to a patient’s disclosure of abuse is the social worker’s most important skill when working with this population. The nature of the experiences described is often diffi cult to hear and can evoke considerable anxiety for the health social worker and other health-care professionals. It is both respect- ful and supportive for survivors of childhood sexual abuse to know that their histories are hard to hear. The pacing of the questioning is essential; survivors can overwhelm themselves

CASE EXAMPLE

Mr. Allen is slowly recovering from a stem cell transplant to treat cancer. He underwent intensive chemotherapy and needed the transplant to help his bone marrow recover from the treatment. He becomes reluctant to change his pajamas, refuses to bathe, and struggles whenever he is being examined. His social worker, who had provided counseling to him in anticipation of the transplant, indicates that Mr. Allen’s behavior is not consistent with how he had coped with his cancer prior to the transplant. After a medical reason for his change in behavior is ruled out, the social worker continues to help Mr. Allen become more aware of his feelings and thoughts. The simple questions “What is troubling you about the staff touching you? Do you think you could put it into words for me?” helps Mr. Allen share that his father fondled him when he was young, telling him that his skin was smooth and soft. Mr. Allen shares with the social worker that the loss of all his body hair frightens him because it makes him feel that his body has reverted back to the body his father molested. Continued counseling and psychiatric intervention with medication helps Mr. Allen manage the remaining course of his treatment.

ch14.indd 352ch14.indd 352 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

Human Sexual Health 353

and be retraumatized by sharing too much in- formation at one time. By setting a limit on how much material will be discussed in any one session, the health social worker will help the survivor feel cared for rather than re- jected (Gallo-Silver & Weiner, 2006; Schacter, Radomsky, Stalker, & Teram, 2004).

HUMAN SEXUAL RESPONSE

The hormonal surge during adolescence increases the skin’s sensitivity to touch (Neufi eld, Klingbell, Borgen, Silverman, & Thomas, 2002). Sensitivity to touch remains intact as people age and become ill (Gelfand, 2000; Kingsberg, 2000). Even seriously ill people can respond to the sensual experience of bed baths, the application of moisturizers to their feet, and assistance with repositioning their body in bed. For people with spinal cord injury, the part of their body above the point of spinal injury remains highly sensitive. Some people with spinal cord injury report that their skin’s sensitivity seems heightened because of the lack of sensation they experience below the point of injury (Sipski, 1998).

Human sexual response also can be seen as a neurological process. The centers of the brain interpret stimulation and send messages to the body to respond. The brain interprets both touch and nontouch types of stimulation. The brain is the repository of learning, experience, and recollection, all of which have a memory component. The brain stores a variety of sexual memories (Karma, Lecours, & Leroux, 2002), including memories of the physical sensations related to excitement, arousal, and orgasm; the memory of sexual and masturbatory fantasies; and the memory of actual sexual experiences (Cranston-Cuebas & Barlow, 1990; Holstege, Georgiadis, & Paans, 2003; McKenna, 1999). Masturbatory fantasies are thought to change only superfi cially as people mature; their basic concepts remain constant throughout the life span (Green & Mosher, 1985; Hurlbert & Whittaker, 1991; Lukianowicz, 1960; Mosher, 1980; Nutter & Condron, 1985; Rowan, 2000). As part of the long-term memory bank, sexual

memories are resilient and retrievable (Jones & Barlow, 1990). Retrieving these memories can help medically ill and injured people en- hance their sexual responsiveness through the use of masturbatory fantasies.

Masters and Johnson (1966, 1970) divided the human sexual response into interdependent phases. The four identifi ed phases expanded existing knowledge of human sexuality beyond the previous notions of impotence and frigidity, two terms that have not added to our under- standing of sexual dysfunction and have pejo- rative connotations that may add to patients’ feelings of hopelessness and rejection. The phases determined by Masters and Johnson in- clude: (1) the desire phase, which encompasses the feelings and thoughts about sex and sexual feelings; (2) the excitement phase, which in- volves increased blood supply to the genitals, erection of the penis, and lubrication of the va- gina during sexual stimulation; (3) the orgasm phase, with rapid muscle spasms, increased heart and respiratory rates, changes in body temperature, and ejaculation; and (4) the reso- lution phase, which is marked by the body’s return to a resting heart rate and a decrease in the supply of blood to the genitals.

Medical illnesses and injuries can disrupt some of these phases, but it is rare for all to be markedly disrupted (Black, 2004; Boone & Kelly, 1990; Ide, 2004; Katz, 2007; McCabe & Taleporos, 2003; McInnes, 2003). Because not all phases are disrupted, sexual rehabilita- tion for people with medical illnesses or in- juries is possible. Sexual rehabilitation is the process of helping a medically ill or injured person restore and resume sexual functioning. A rehabilitative approach identifi es the phase or phases that remain intact and helps patients maximize their responsiveness and enjoyment by building on the strengths of the remain- ing phases (Gallo-Silver, 2000; Kaplan, 1974, 1983; Schover & Jensen, 1988). Sex therapists using this model focus on cognitive and behav- ioral techniques that help obviate sexual con- cerns and worries (Gallo-Silver, 2000).

The phases of sexual response developed by Masters and Johnson are considered to be linear in nature. For this reason, some sex

ch14.indd 353ch14.indd 353 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

354 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

therapists consider them to be more relevant for men than for women. Basson (2001), for example, considers women’s sexual responses to be more cyclical than those of men. Basson’s sexual response cycle for women begins and ends with emotional intimacy that creates receptivity to sexual stimulation. The cycle continues to subjective arousal that is both emotional and physical, which leads in turn to objective arousal and responsive desire (simi- lar to the Masters and Johnson’s phase of ex- citement), followed by orgasm, resolution, and emotional and physical satisfaction. Emotional and physical satisfaction can engender further emotional intimacy. In Basson’s formulation, emotional intimacy is both the beginning and end of the cycle of sexual functioning. Sex therapists whose interventions are based on Basson’s conceptualization use a strengths- based approach that identifi es those aspects of the response cycle that are intact as building blocks to sexual and emotional satisfaction.

It is easy for a patient challenged by a changed body and functioning to be discour- aged about and fearful of sexual issues. A strengths-based approach presents this same patient with a measure of hope and possi- bilities for a different approach to sexuality. A rehabilitation approach based on Basson’s (2001) model would focus on the interpersonal and intrapsychic issues that likely represent obstacles to comfort and enjoyment of physi- cal intimacy. It should be noted that the gender patterns outlined here are not invariable.

DEVELOPMENTAL PERSPECTIVE

Older Adults

Often sexuality is considered the domain of the young, able, slim, and well. Although some baby boomers (individuals born in the post-World War II period from 1945 to 1968) consider sexually active older adults to be a new phenomenon, Kinsey in the 1940s, as well as Laumann in the 1990s, found individuals of both genders to be sexually active and satisfi ed

with the quality of physical intimacy in their lives into their 80s and 90s (Kinsey, Pomeroy, & Martin, 1948, 1953; Laumann et al., 1994). Kinsey’s fi ndings are more illuminating, be- cause the median age of survival during the period of his research was lower than it is at present, and medicine was less capable of addressing serious medical problems. Social workers should consider all patients as sexual beings, because sexuality is basic to the human condition. This approach will ensure that no group (e.g., those older than 80 years, those with physical disabilities) is desexualized and assumed to be sexually inactive.

After a certain age, women begin to produce less estrogen. The decreased estrogen levels can diminish vaginal lubrication, and the walls of the vagina may become thicker and less elas- tic. Desire, which is to some extent hormonally determined, might diminish, and some women report less intense orgasms as they age (Denner- stein & Lehert, 2004; Dennerstein, Lehert, Dudley, & Burger, 1999). However, hormone replacement therapy remains controversial due to empirical evidence that it can increase risk for breast and ovarian cancers (Aubuchon & Santoro, 2004; Chen et al., 2004; Ching & Lip, 2002; Durna et al., 2004).

Postmenopausal women may benefi t from vaginal lubricants or moisturizers to facilitate comfortable sexual intercourse. As men age, they may require more tactile stimulation to achieve erections, and erections may be less rigid. The intensity of their orgasm also may diminish, as might the quantity of their ejacu- lates. Men also may require longer periods of time to achieve erections following orgasm. Erectile dysfunction medications are said to be effective for men who have diffi culties due to natural aging, medical problems, or emotional obstacles to becoming aroused.

Laumann and colleagues (1994) suggest that partner availability might be a more im- portant obstacle to sexual activity for older adults than the physical sequelae of aging. Older adults who do not have partners may use masturbation as their primary sexual activity. Masturbation is often a part of their sleep ritual. There is evidence to suggest that masturbation

ch14.indd 354ch14.indd 354 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

Human Sexual Health 355

among older adult women without partners is almost as high as among adolescent males (Laumann et al., 1994). Health-care staff who work in congregate living settings often report discomfort when encountering a patient who is masturbating. Social workers can educate staff about masturbation in older adults and, in the process, help normalize the experience.

People in congregate living situations, such as assisted living residences, supportive senior apartments, nursing homes, and chronic care institutions, at times form sexual relation- ships with other residents. Nursing homes and chronic care facilities often do not permit un- married patients to share rooms, but couples in love fi nd ways to have private time nonethe- less. Although it is important for institutions to protect vulnerable patients from being sexu- ally exploited, some rules about privacy and sexual activity are more refl ective of society’s discomfort with sex rather than a need to pro- tect. Social workers should advocate for pa- tients who are competent to consent to sexual activity to have the privacy they desire in ways that are still consistent with the institutional policy and procedures.

Gay and lesbian older adults, whether in assisted living facilities, nursing homes, or chronic care environments, may feel par- ticularly isolated (D’Augelli, Grossman, Hershberger, & O’Connell, 2001; Grossman, D’Augelli, & Hershberger, 2000; McMahon, 2003). The AIDS epidemic has left some gay men without the support of groups of male friends. Gay and lesbian adults in congregate or assisted living situations often feel they can- not be themselves or talk openly about their sexual identity or orientation, even though they may have led open lives before entering a facility or group living situation (Spitzer, Neuman, & Holden, 2004). Social workers can enable LGBT people to adjust to new living situations, including feeling safe and able to be themselves without the threat of being os- tracized or scapegoated. It is crucial for the so- cial worker to model acceptance for the other residents as well as staff members.

Health social workers can inform other members of the health-care team about

patients’ need for information about sexuality. At times, the health social worker seems to be the “safest” member of the health-care team to approach about sexual issues. This may be be- cause of the therapeutic bond that health social workers establish around other issues impor- tant to their patients.

Young Adults

Adolescence is a time of rapid emotional and physical change. A major feature of adoles- cence, and the engine for the emotional up- heaval during this stage of development, is the increased production of testosterone and estrogen. Adolescents are challenged by in- tense changes in body image and functioning due to the development of pubic hair, breasts, and muscle mass. Medical illness and injury further complicate young adults’ relationships with their own bodies and their developing sexuality (Berman et al., 1999; Greydanus, Rimsza, & Newhouse, 2002).

CASE EXAMPLE

Mr. Jones, who is 80 years old, is in the hospital’s recovery area after a cardiac catheterization to clear several blockages in his arteries. At his bedside is his “friend,” Ms. Thomas, who is 75 years old. His doctor visits and tells him that he will recover well and can return to his regular activities a few weeks but that he should not overly exert himself during that time. The doctor does not mention sexual intercourse, and neither Mr. Jones nor Ms. Thomas feels comfortable bringing it up, although they previously had made love a few times a month.

Once home, they are fearful of even cuddling, because they have heard stories of people dying of heart attacks during sexual activity. The social worker reassures them during her session with Mr. Jones by asking about his relationship with Ms. Thomas, and she makes it clear that talking about their sexual relationship is important.

ch14.indd 355ch14.indd 355 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

356 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

Health-care professionals are obligated to inform patients that recommended treatment may interrupt or impair fertility. Often these discussions fail to address the sexual chal- lenges that treatment presents, leaving young adults with many unanswered questions about the impact of their illness or treatment on their ability to function sexually. Some illnesses, such as testicular cancer, gynecological can- cers, and cancer of the penis, affect both the functioning of the genitals and their appear- ance (Anderson, Woods, & Copeland, 1997; Katz, 2007; Nazareth, Lewin, & King, 2001; Opjordsmoen, Waehre, Aass, & Fossa, 1994). The health social worker can advocate for complete and comprehensive information to be given to patients, which is a crucial fi rst step in helping them cope.

Advocacy is an important leadership func- tion of social workers on health-care teams. It is essential that health social workers are in- formed about the impact of the illness, injury, and/or treatment to patients’ genitals before the patient is given this information by physicians or nurses (Fuentes et al., 1983; Weerakoon et al., 2004). Being present when this discus- sion occurs maximizes the health social work- er’s ability to shape discussions that may be distressing and diffi cult for patients.

The use of clear and accurate terms is es- sential in discussing sexual issues to a popula- tion that may be sexually naive. It is part of the

health social worker’s advocacy role to inform other health-care professionals when a patient does not understand the information given to him or when he might misconstrue information.

In addition to issues related to fertility, an- other psychosocial barrier that young adults may struggle with are issues of attractiveness and desirability. Body image issues can create crises of self-esteem for people who do not cur- rently have a partner or who have had limited sexual experiences (Horgan & MacLachlan, 2004; Ide, Watanabe, & Toyonaga, 2002; Lawrence, Fauerbach, Heinberg, & Doctor, 2004; McCabe & Taleporos, 2003). Changes in appearance are painful for any young adult, re- gardless of their sex. Many people view young adulthood as a time for entering long-term re- lationships, getting married, and having chil- dren; therefore, people experiencing physical changes during this period may be particularly vulnerable to issues with self-esteem. This may be especially true for young adults coping

CASE EXAMPLE

Mr. Crane, a 19-year-old with lymphoma, proudly walks into the clinic and announces to his social worker that the doctors were “wrong” and that his chemotherapy would not prevent him from having children. He reports that he and his girlfriend had made love the night before and that everything was about the same as it always had been. Mr. Crane had been confused by the euphemistic and medical language used to discuss his illness. He thought that infertility meant he could not have an erection.

CASE EXAMPLE

Ms. Dean, a 22-year-old woman, underwent an amputation of her left leg above her knee after a car accident. About the same time, her boyfriend decided to end their relation- ship. During the period in which she is awaiting a prosthesis, she repeatedly cancels appointments and misses her outpatient physical therapy appointments. She tells her social worker that there is little point in keeping her appointments, because she would rather just stay in a wheelchair.

Counseling with her social worker helps her mourn the loss of both her boyfriend and her leg. Support and education help Ms. Dean feel more in control and willing to accept her prosthesis. Counseling continues as an integral part of her physical therapy. Ms. Dean gradually begins to pay more attention to her appearance. She tells her social worker that she feels more confi dent when socializing with her friends and that she hopes to meet the “right person” with whom to begin a new relationship.

ch14.indd 356ch14.indd 356 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

Human Sexual Health 357

with an amputation. Amputation of a limb and facial disfi gurement can be profoundly disor- ganizing to a person’s self-esteem because it often has an immediate impact on how oth- ers interact with the affected person (Horgan & MacLachlan, 1004; Lawrence et al., 2004; McCabe & Taleporos, 2003; Monga, Tan, Ostermann, & Monga, 1997).

Given the many changes that are character- istic of adolescent physical development, the additional changes due to illness and injury serve to separate affected adolescents from their peers. The validation and normalization of adolescents sharing thoughts and concerns about bodily changes with their peers are often unavailable to those challenged by illness or injury. In some ways, the relationship with the health social worker becomes the environment for validation of and normalization to the spe- cial circumstances caused by illness or injury.

Although prosthetic devices can help a young adult amputee look “whole” in cloth- ing that covers the affected limb, the loss of a limb becomes apparent in intimate situations. This reality can affect how the young adult ap- proaches and adheres to the required physical therapy and prosthetic fi ttings. The health so- cial worker’s role is often to permit the young adult to mourn the lost body part, bear witness to the loss, and confront fears about how the loss will affect sexual relationships. Educa- tion about the normal or typical process of ad- justing to an amputation and the provision of supportive counseling either before or directly after a physical therapy session can help young adults with amputations begin to integrate their experiences (Bodenheimer, Kerrigan, Garber, & Monga, 2000; Shell & Miller, 1999). The goal of the health social worker’s interventions is for the patient to accept the loss of the limb as part of an ongoing process of adjustment.

The young adult’s adjustment to facial dis- fi gurement is accompanied by a tendency to become socially isolated and anxious about meeting new people, including new health- care professionals (Bianchi, 1997; Monga et al., 1997; Whitehead, 1993). The health social worker can build a relationship of trust by maintaining eye contact with the patient

and acknowledging the discomfort caused by facial disfi gurement. Assisting young adults with facial disfi gurement to gain social con- fi dence can be accomplished by helping them develop strategies to put people at ease and ad- dress hurtful reactions to their disfi gurement in an open and direct manner. The health social

CASE EXAMPLE

Mr. North, age 15, had been challenged by a variety of physical problems due to cerebral palsy. He shares a friendship with Ms. White, also 15 years old and challenged by cerebral palsy. They met at the medical clinic where they both receive care. The parents are aware that their children have formed a close friendship.

They are observed by a medical assistant kissing and touching each other in what the teens had assumed was a private place. The medical assistant tells Ms. White’s mother, believing Ms. White needs to be “protected.”

The social worker intervenes after Ms. White’s mother complains about Mr. North to clinic staff. Gently but empathically, the social worker helps Ms. White’s mother place her daughter’s behavior and the behavior of her male friend in the perspective of adolescence. The mother had not focused much on her daughter’s body changes, beyond helping her understand her menstrual cycles, purchase a bra, and learn to address her personal hygiene activities. The mother admits to the social worker that she never considered that her daughter might have “those” thoughts. Similarly, Mr. North’s parents were aware that he was masturbating but had not discussed sexual development or feelings with him.

The health social worker can help these two families communicate with one another about many diffi cult issues using empathy as well as even-handed neutrality. In this instance, normalizing adolescent behavior helps the parents realize that all parents of adolescents struggle with the same issues.

ch14.indd 357ch14.indd 357 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

358 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

worker can help young adults who are chal- lenged by amputation or facial disfi gurement consider issues of sexuality and physical inti- macy and manage social situations in general.

Social workers should not assume heterosex- uality, because many lesbian, gay, and bisexual people are “coming out” or becoming self-aware of their sexual orientation in middle and high school (Grov, Bimbi, Nanin, & Parsons, 2006). In addition, many transgender people begin to struggle with their gender identity during ado- lescence (Koken, Bimbi, & Parsons, 2009).

Finally, adolescents with complex medical needs often struggle with intensifi ed issues of independence from parents, who necessarily are involved in their ongoing care. Parents’ in- creased involvement in adolescents’ lives and physical needs may delay their acknowledgment of their child’s maturation and sexual develop- ment. Health social workers often educate par- ents about the additional struggles experienced by their adolescent and the adolescent’s expe- riences with sexuality and physical intimacy. Heterosexual and LGBT youth may use sexual contact to affi rm their sense of self and identity.

SPECIFIC ISSUES RELATED TO WORKING WITH COUPLES

“Parentifi cation” of the Well Partner

Hospital stays have become progressively shorter because of improvements in medi- cine’s ability to treat illnesses, the expansion of outpatient services, and the demands of medical insurers. Families have become more involved in the practical care of people with both acute and chronic illness. The shift in care from health-related facilities to patients’ homes may have unintended, negative conse- quences for couples.

Medical illnesses and traumatic injuries place patients in a vulnerable position and in- crease their dependence on others, both prac- tically and emotionally. The well partner often must monitor the patient’s condition, supervise medications, provide transportation to physician

visits and treatments, assist with bathing and toileting, and participate in physical and occu- pational therapies. As the level of practical and personal care increases, partners may report that they feel like parents rather than romantic partners. Other health-care professionals are often unaware of this shifting dynamic in cou- ple relationships as the well partner begins to focus on the details of the care, treatment, and progress. A health social worker’s awareness of this potential “parentifi cation” of the well part- ner can help diminish the isolation and loneli- ness that develops among couples. The health social worker’s use of problem-solving skills

CASE EXAMPLE

Ms. Richards is recovering from a gunshot wound that left her paralyzed from the waist down. Her partner, Mr. Barry, visits her daily and participates in her therapy at the acute care rehabilitation center. Ms. Richards complains to her social worker that, while Mr. Barry is attentive and helpful, the affection and physicality of their relationship has suffered.

The social worker meets with Mr. Barry and asks him how well he thinks he and his partner are adjusting to her spinal cord injury. He reports that he has learned a lot, wants to help Ms. Richards in every way, but misses aspects of their previous life together. When the social worker questions further, Mr. Barry begins to cry, relating how he feels more like his partner’s father than her lover. He recalls to the social worker how he loved to hold her and caress her breasts. Mr. Barry seems quite embarrassed when sharing this with the social worker. The social worker reassures him and suggests that because the spinal cord injury did not change Ms. Richards’s breasts in any way, and because touching them would not hurt her in any way, perhaps that is something they can still share. She suggests that he pull the curtain around her bed, giving them enough privacy to show how much they love each other.

ch14.indd 358ch14.indd 358 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

Human Sexual Health 359

engages the partner in an exploration of what aspects of physical intimacy could be integrated into daily care routines. The activity is identi- fi ed by the partner, and the health social worker works on helping the couple consider ways to incorporate physical intimacy into these ac- tivities. This might include adding massage to bathing activities or kissing when helping the patient with meals.

Straightforward suggestions can give couples permission to demonstrate their love physically. The health social worker can work collaboratively with occupational therapists to help couples feel more “normal” in the face of traumatic injuries that affect day-to-day self- care functioning as well as issues of sexuality.

Physical Intimacy as an Aspect of Couples’ Communication

Medical illness and traumatic injury can have an enormous impact on a couple’s ability to communicate, share, and understand each other.

If communication problems existed before the health crisis, they likely will not improve under the challenge of poor health or disability. Physi- cal intimacy for people with medical conditions requires verbal communication. Often couples need to relearn how to listen to each other so they can rekindle the physical intimacy they en- joyed before the crisis. Adjusting to a changed body and body image requires sensitivity and clarity, both of which are best achieved through good communication.

The Speaker/Listener Technique (Markham, Stanley, & Blumberg, 1994) was developed to help couples improve their ability to com- municate and share their thoughts, concerns, and worries. The technique entails teaching couples how to concentrate on the words that the other person is saying instead of focusing on how they should respond. Couples are in- structed to try to paraphrase what their partner has said and then inquire whether their inter- pretation accurately refl ected their partner’s statement. The couple takes turns complet- ing the exercise. For couples who need more structure, the speaker may hold a card, which is called the “fl oor.” The term holding the fl oor means that only the person with the card is allowed to speak at that time. The Speaker/ Listener Technique can be taught at the bed- side or in a clinic exam room.

EFFECTS OF MEDICAL ILLNESSES AND TRAUMATIC INJURIES

Impact on Sexuality and Physical Intimacy

Illness and injury often disrupt aspects of the human sexual response, but rarely do they dis- rupt them entirely. Many people retain func- tioning in at least one of the major phases (i.e., desire, excitement, and orgasm) of the response.

Many anecdotal stories exist about people who suffer heart attacks during sexual activ- ity. Although instances of cardiac arrest dur- ing sexual intercourse are uncommon, people with heart disease often approach the issue of

CASE EXAMPLE

Mr. Wong is a 28-year-old man recovering from the surgical treatment of testicular cancer. He was referred to the health social worker when a nurse walked in on him while he was trying to masturbate. He explains to the health social worker that he wanted to make “sure it [his penis]” still worked. He was reassured by his surgeon prior to his surgery that his erectile capacity would be unchanged. Mr. Wong reports fearing that his boyfriend of two years, Mr. Perez, would leave him if he could not sexually “perform.” Although he is fearful of talking at all to Mr. Perez, he is more fearful of returning home without some discussion of the issue. The health social worker facilitates a couple’s session that helps them rediscover the vast number of ways they enjoy each other’s bodies. Specifi cally, Mr. Perez’s hugs and kisses reassure Mr. Wong of his emotional commitment to him and their relationship.

ch14.indd 359ch14.indd 359 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

360 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

physical intimacy with fear and dread (De- busk, 2000). Cardiovascular disease, hyperten- sion, and diabetes often diminish the body’s sensitivity to touch and stimulation, secondary to diminished blood fl ow. This has its great- est impact on the genitals, which require in- creased blood supply to achieve erection of the penis or lubrication of the vagina. At the same time, however, diminished blood fl ow would not likely affect the desire for sexual stimula- tion or the overall quality of orgasm.

Although desire is highly governed by hor- mones, it also may be affected by systemic problems. This is because emotional vibrancy and vigor also play a part in the desire phase. People in renal failure lose energy and stamina due to the buildup of impurities in the blood that would ordinarily be cleaned by the kid- neys. Dialysis can assume the functioning of the kidneys, but the process leaves the body fatigued and diminishes its overall response to stimulation. Therefore, erectile and lubrication capabilities are impaired, although orgasm is largely unaffected (Schover, 2000; Schover & Jensen, 1988).

Pulmonary disease robs the body of energy, which in turn diminishes feelings of desire. Although they are able to be stimulated to the excitement or arousal phase of response, peo- ple with pulmonary disease sometimes do not have the lung capacity to tolerate orgasm, and the quality and intensity of their orgasms are diminished (F. Haas & Haas, 2000; Walbroehl, 1992).

Cancer is a generic term for a number of ill- nesses, all of which involve cells multiplying and growing out of control (see Chapter 19). Women with breast or gynecological cancers may experience diminished desire, problems with excitement or arousal, and diminished quality of orgasm. Men with prostate can- cer are challenged by diminished desire and erectile diffi culties, yet they retain orgasmic functioning. Men with testicular cancer retain desire and erectile capabilities but report some diminished quality of orgasm. People with colorectal cancers and bladder cancer experi- ence problems with erection and lubrication but retain desire and orgasm. Women treated

for bladder, cervical, and other gynecologi- cal cancers may experience changes in the shape or size of the vaginal vault. This may necessitate the use of dilators to maintain and stretch the contours of the vagina. Dilators are used until the penis can be inserted comfort- ably into the vagina. Health-care profession- als may recommend vaginal intercourse as a way of preserving the vagina’s contours. This is a sex-negative recommendation be- cause it places women in the position of hav- ing uncomfortable and painful intercourse in the short run for longer-term sexual comfort. People with leukemia or lymphomas experi- ence a loss of desire and some fatigue-related erectile or lubrication dysfunctions yet retain orgasm. People with brain tumors can experi- ence a loss of desire but often retain some abil- ity to achieve erection or lubrication as well as orgasm (American Cancer Society, 1998; Schover, 1999).

Spinal cord injury disrupts the individual’s ability to feel below the injury. Desire remains intact, and erections and lubrication occur, but the individual is not able to feel these changes. Because orgasm is a total body response not confi ned to the genitals, people can experience orgasmic feelings in parts of the body that are above the injury. Kroll and Klein (2001) report that skin over areas that retain feeling express some of the orgasmic reactions.

The social work profession encourages a strengths-based perspective. Supportive and educational social work interventions focus on the aspects of sexual functioning that remain intact while at the same time respecting the loss or impairment of certain sexual abilities. The health social worker who is able to help people feel comfortable with sharing their sex- ual feelings can help them locate reactions that can serve as building blocks to more satisfying physical intimacy.

Impact on Stamina

The loss of overall physical stamina caused by cancer, AIDS, pulmonary disease, mul- tiple sclerosis, and other chronic medical problems can impair the body’s ability to

ch14.indd 360ch14.indd 360 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

Human Sexual Health 361

respond to sexual stimulation (Ferrando et al., 1998; Harden, 2005; Parish, 2002; Schmidt, Hofmann, Niederwieser, Kapfhammer, & Bonelli, 2005; Walbroehl, 1992). As the body moves from an aroused state to orgasm, heart- beat and respiration increase. Cardiologists have compared the energy needed for sexual activity to that of climbing two fl ights of stairs or walking three miles on level ground (Brody & Pruet, 2003; Debusk, 2000; Thorson, 2003). Energy conservation is a crucial element in en- abling people with a medical illness or injury to resume or return to sexual activity. Accom- modations in lovemaking positions transfer more of the “work” of sexual intercourse to the well partner (Haas & Haas, 2000).

Fatigue is a major obstacle to sexual activ- ity for people with challenging medical condi- tions. Fatigue is a physiological phenomenon that does not respond to sleep or rest and often is intensifi ed by increased inactivity. Tiredness is usually muscular in nature and can be re- solved by sleep and rest. Although it is coun- terintuitive to be active when fatigued, exercise can work to offset fatigue. It is important that people can identify the times at which they ex- perience higher energy levels so they can plan for physical intimacy.

For people with pulmonary disease, the morning is a time to clear secretions that have built up in the lungs during sleep. After se- cretions have been cleared, many people feel more energetic. For people who are challenged by paralysis due to either stroke or spinal cord injury and are wheelchair-bound, energy levels may seem higher when they move from bed to their wheelchairs. Physical intimacy for peo- ple who require the use of wheelchairs is often more easily undertaken while they are in their chairs rather than in bed because the chair pro- vides both physical and emotional support (a person may feel more confi dent in the wheel- chair), and offers more mobility than the bed.

People on kidney dialysis usually un- dergo the procedure three days a week. Usu- ally people will experience a bit more energy on the morning of the second day after di- alysis (Camsari et al., 1999; Reynolds & Postlethwaite, 1996; Uttley, 1996). Those

undergoing chemotherapy for cancer also have breaks between treatments during which their body recovers from the side effects of the chemotherapy. The days just before the next administration of chemotherapy are often days of higher energy (Burt, 1995; Hughes, 2000; Wood & Tombrink, 1983). Health so- cial workers aware of the relationship between treatment and energy level are better able to help couples preserve the sense of normalcy achieved when they are able to resume being physically intimate.

People with human immunodefi ciency virus (HIV) often have few symptoms in the early stages of their infections. Medications that inhibit the growth of the virus may present side effects, such as fatigue and some gastric complaints that may diminish sexual vibrancy (Roak, Webster, Darrow, & Stempel, 2005). The challenge for people with HIV is integrat- ing harm-reduction practices into their sexual routines to limit the chance that they will in- fect others. The use of barriers, including con- doms for men, dental dams for women, and spermicidal preparations, requires a thoughtful and planned approach to sexual activity.

Impact of Complications From Medications

Medicines that affect sexual functioning are said to have sexual side effects. Medications can disrupt any of the phases of sexual re- sponse (Dickman, 2003; Kaplan, 1983).

Because medical illness and traumatic in- jury can cause mood disorders, patients may be prescribed antidepressant or anxiolytic medications. Antidepressant medications may diminish sexual desire. Men who experience erectile dysfunction due to prostate cancer, diabetes, or cardiovascular disease may expe- rience depression in response to their inability to achieve an erection. The treatment of pros- tate cancer, diabetes, and cardiovascular dis- ease may include the prescription of additional medications, such as hormonal treatment and antihypertensive medications, which can di- minish desire, cause erectile dysfunction, and diminish the intensity of orgasm. The inclusion

ch14.indd 361ch14.indd 361 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

362 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

of antidepressant medication to the list that may inhibit sexual desire may cause men to feel sexually “shut down.” Although erectile dys- function medications can help a man achieve higher-quality erections, and thus rekindle his desire, such medications cannot improve the quality of orgasms that has been impaired by other medications or nerve damage.

Like men, women can experience depres- sion in reaction to cancer, diabetes, and cardio- vascular disease. This depression compounds the impact of illness on the body’s ability to function sexually. Chemotherapy induces per- manent menopause in women ages 35 to 40 years in about half of cases. Chemotherapy- induced menopause occurs about 70% of the time in women ages 40 to 45 years and 80% of the time in women between the ages of 45 and 50 (Poniatowski, Grimm, & Cohen, 2001). Transient menopause is much more common.

Some gynecological cancers require remov- ing a woman’s ovaries, a procedure called an oopherectomy (Schover, 1997). The treatment for breast cancer that is estrogen-receptor pos- itive can lead to early menopause in women (Chen et al., 2004; Schover, 1997, 1999). By virtue of their effects on estrogen production and metabolism, these treatments may affect vaginal lubrication and the elasticity of the vaginal walls.

Most antidepressants, beta blockers, and antihypertensive medications cause problems in women similar to those in men (Dickman, 2003; Schover, 2000). Diminished desire, loss of ability to lubricate naturally, and dimin- ished quality of orgasm have been reported by women who are taking these medications. Currently no widely accepted treatment for fe- male sexual dysfunction has been developed that appreciably improves women’s response to stimulation. Some herbal combinations de- pend on plant estrogens to improve a woman’s sexual functioning (Rowland & Tai, 2003). These preparations come as a salve to be ap- plied directly to the vaginal wall and clitoris. Some of these preparations have a mild irri- tant that draws blood to the genitals, and others contain progesterone. The latter come either in a salve form applied to the abdomen or in a

ring-shaped vaginal insert that slowly releases hormones. It should be cautioned, however, that none of these methods has approval from the Food and Drug Administration, and health social workers should refer patients who are contemplating using these approaches to their physicians.

Health social workers should ensure that patients are aware of the sexual side effects of their medications and medical regimes and feel empowered to talk to their physi- cians about their concerns. This is important even if no viable alternatives to the prescribed medications are available. When patients are able to mourn the losses that illness, injury, and treatment cause, they feel more in control of their conditions. Requesting erectile dys- function medications or asking a physician to revisit the issue of hormonal replacement or enhancement requires self-advocacy. An important role of health social workers is to help people learn how to communicate with their physicians about sexual issues. At times, role-playing can be an effective method to help people practice new ways of communicating in stressful situations.

Sexual Rehabilitation of People With Medical Illness or Traumatic Injuries

Sex therapy addresses pervasive problems and obstacles to physical intimacy that may be psychogenic or emotional in nature. The goal of sex therapy is to help patients establish a new, improved baseline of functioning. Sexual rehabilitation counseling also focuses on the impact of medical illness or injury on sexual functioning and intimacy. Its goal is to help individuals restore or return to their baseline functioning or to accommodate a changed baseline of functioning (Gallo-Silver, 2000).

Sexual rehabilitation counseling includes a number of cognitive and behavioral interven- tions, including safe-touch exercises, the pro- longed kiss, “dressing” for bed in new pajamas, self-exploration and self-pleasuring exercises, sensate focus or sensual massage exercises, and altering coital positions to accommodate a changed body (Gallo-Silver & Parsonnet,

ch14.indd 362ch14.indd 362 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

Human Sexual Health 363

2001; Schover, 2000). Safe-touch exercises and body mapping are consistent with the concept that physical intimacy and sexuality have their foundations in touch. Sexual reha- bilitation counseling may employ a series of safe-touch exercises, which were devised to help people who were sexually traumatized by rape, incest, and childhood sexual abuse regain comfort with being touched (Maltz, 2003). Several of these exercises can be use- ful in helping couples challenged by illness or injury. Back-writing involves having the per- son with the medical challenge trace a word on the back of his partner using the tip of his fi n- ger. The person traces the word over and over again until the partner is able to identify the word correctly. The exercise is then reversed with the partner tracing a word on the back of the person with the medical challenge.

Another exercise is a variation of the child’s game Red-Light-Green-Light, in which the person with the medical challenge gives cues to her partner about where on her body it feels good to be touched (green light), which touches are not comfortable (red light), and which touches are okay at times (yellow light). Body mapping is based on a similar concept. An outline of the body is drawn in green, red, and yellow, and the partner then has a map of the parts of the body where the person with the medical challenge enjoys being touched.

The prolonged kiss and the second kiss exercises recognize that couples under duress due to medical problems may kiss each other in a quick, almost perfunctory and, at times, parental manner. The second kiss exercise is based on the premise that the couple will be more aware and connected to each other if they kiss a second time. Typically, the second kiss is held for a longer period of time, and the cou- ple tends to feel greater emotional resonance from the second kiss.

Self-exploration and self-pleasuring, or masturbation, are basic behaviors to discover enjoyable sensations (Lukianowicz, 1960; Rowan, 2000). Although many cultures and religions prohibit masturbation, it remains a primary way in which men and women dis- cover their sexuality and orgasmic capabilities.

Sexual rehabilitation counseling gives people with medical challenges permission to explore and regain comfort with their changed bodies. Self-pleasuring exercises are included as part of bathing (Gallo-Silver & Parsonnet, 2001). The exercises are then duplicated in a bed or chair. Ultimately the person with the medical challenge instructs the partner on what feels good and how to best stimulate her body.

From this foundation, couples frequently turn to sensate focus exercises. Sensate focus exercises are a series of sensual massage tech- niques that help couples whose sexual activity has been interrupted by illness or injury. De- veloped by Masters and Johnson (1970), the exercises avoid direct genital massage until the couple has become more comfortable ca- ressing other parts of the body (Kaplan, 1974, 1987; Masters & Johnson, 1970). Altering co- ital positions to avoid injured or “red-light” areas of the body helps people with medical challenges conserve energy and helps couples feel safe and secure so they can enjoy physical intimacy with each another.

Sexual rehabilitation exercises have a self- help aspect to them as well. Instructional texts provide easy-to-follow, systematic instructions with drawings that help couples understand exercises. Many of these materials focus on opposite-sex couples but can be easily adapted for same-sex couples.

Creating Sex-Positive Environments of Care

The health social worker is a problem solver. Privacy is a major obstacle to physical inti- macy in institutional settings. Policies and procedures that insist that hospital room doors remain open at all times are changed when pa- tients have a communicable infection or need protection, such as when they are recovering from a bone marrow or organ transplant. Poli- cies and procedures that frown on adult visitors climbing into bed with adult patients are not used on pediatric fl oors, where it is routine for parents and their children to be in bed together. Discomfort about physical displays of affection also changes on obstetric units, on which the

ch14.indd 363ch14.indd 363 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

364 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

staff helps to provide a romantic setting for new parents. The contradiction between how inti- macy is fostered in these settings for everyone but adults with medical illnesses or injuries is not always apparent to other health profession- als. Health social workers advocate for “bending the rules” on an individual, case-by-case basis. Often, educating the staff about the patient’s and partner’s needs for privacy emphasizes the couple’s love and devotion for one another. So- cial workers can defi ne a couple’s privacy as part of a supportive-care plan that addresses the symptoms of loneliness and sadness about separation. At times, the health social worker is able to change policy with a creative idea that helps coprofessionals understand patients’ needs for privacy and physical contact.

Hospital libraries for patients and profes- sionals generally contain few, if any, books on physical intimacy and sexuality. Health social workers can advocate for enriching the libraries by including these materials. Social workers who perform home visits can provide a list of books or pamphlets that can help pa- tients and their partners remain physically close. People with chronic and acute illness

or injuries do not have routine access to urol- ogists and gynecologists with a knowledge base in sexual diffi culties. Social workers can address these gaps by developing educational programs to which they invite local experts to meet with patients and their partners in a group setting.

CONCLUSION

Issues of sexuality and physical intimacy are greatly affected by cultural norms. It is beyond the scope of this chapter to explore these issues in detail, but it is important to consider how cultural norms change depending on a mixture of scientifi c discovery and political infl uences. Homosexuality was once considered a psy- chiatric illness by many in the mental health professions. Physicians once believed that mas- turbation caused a host of physical and psycho- logical conditions and that the only “healthy” reason for sexual intercourse was procreation. Specialists in child abuse and health-care pro- fessionals once believed that childhood sexual abuse rarely, if ever, occurred. Transgender- ism still is not widely understood, and debates are ongoing about etiology and whether it is a condition requiring a DSM diagnosis. Nonethe- less, the changes in attitudes about these and other sexual issues are by no means universal. The ideas of health-care professionals and the community often are based on religious beliefs, cultural conventions at the time, beliefs of the person’s specifi c ethnic or cultural group, and the basic scientifi c understanding of people as sexual beings. All of these factors may change, become more widely infl uential, or lose infl u- ence depending on the political and cultural cli- mate at the time. Nonetheless, sexual issues are quintessentially human issues. When, by reason of culture, politics, or ignorance, the human as- pects of sexuality are overlooked or replaced by viewing it as a completely biological function, an important aspect of quality of life is dimin- ished. People challenged by medical illnesses and injuries suffer many losses, among them a sense of being entitled to be sexual beings. One of the health social worker’s roles is to humanize

CASE EXAMPLE

The health social worker reports in oncology multidisciplinary rounds that patients frequently want more “alone” time with their partners. Even when patients’ doors are closed, staff members sometimes enter without knocking or while they are knocking. The social worker points out that health-care staff are used to looking at closed doors for special instructions related to protecting the patient and others from infection. The social worker proposes that when a partner is visiting, the patient or partner could place a cardboard cutout of a cupid on the door so that the staff would be aware that the partner was with the patient and wanted privacy. The staff institutes the change, and the social worker’s suggestion becomes part of the facility’s marketing campaign.

ch14.indd 364ch14.indd 364 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

Human Sexual Health 365

the health-care experience. Helping medically ill and injured patients reclaim their ability to con- nect with their loved ones, communicate their love physically, receive the loving touch of oth- ers, and feel pleasurable physical sensations is a part of humanizing the health-care environment.

SUGGESTED LEARNING EXERCISES

Learning Exercise 14.1

Your sibling or cousin tells you that he is transgendered. Write down how you would feel about learning this. What would be the impact on your relationship with him? What would be the impact on your family? Would your sibling’s/cousin’s partner of choice be welcomed by you and by the family?

Learning Exercise 14.2

Identify one policy or procedure at your current internship or practice setting that is an obsta- cle to physical intimacy. Develop a strategy to change the policy. With whom must you meet with to begin this process? What would be the best environment for this discussion: a private meeting, team meeting, or rounds? How many alternatives can you devise that preserve some of the policy but enhance a person’s opportuni- ties for physical intimacy?

Learning Exercise 14.3

Write down your own sexual history. Read it silently to yourself. How diffi cult would it be to share this information with a stranger? What would a stranger need to do, say, or demonstrate to help you feel more comfort- able with a discussion of your history? Share your thoughts with the class either in a small or a large group.

Learning Exercise 14.4

With what type of client or patient would you feel most comfortable discussing sexual issues,

and why? With what type of client or patient would you feel most uncomfortable discussing sexual issues, and why?

SUGGESTED RESOURCES

Professional Education American Association of Sex Educators,

Counselors and Therapists (ASSECT)— www.assect.org

ASSECT sponsors and provides continu- ing education credits through a num- ber of training seminars and workshops throughout the United States for profes- sionals at various levels of skill develop- ment.

LGBT Communities Education Advocates for Youth (LGBT Adoles-

cents)—www.advocatesforyouth.org Family Caregiver Alliance (LGBT frequently

asked questions)—www.caregiver.org LAMBDA (LGBT Adults)—www.lambda

.org

Illness- or Condition-Specifi c Sex Education

American Association of Kidney Patients— www.aakp.org

American Cancer Society—www.cancer .org

American Heart Association—www .americanheart.org

American Lung Association—www.lungusa .org

American Social Health Association (Sexu- ally Transmitted Diseases, Hepatitis, HIV/AIDS)—www.ashastd.org

American Spinal Injury Association— www.asia-spinalinjury.org/

Instructional Books for Professionals and Patients/Partners

Altman, C. (1997). You can be your own sex therapist. San Francisco, CA: Caper.

Britton, P. (2005). The art of sex coaching. New York, NY: Norton.

ch14.indd 365ch14.indd 365 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

366 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

DeVillers, L. (2002). Love skills. Marina Del Rey, CA: Aphrodite Media.

Westheimer, R. K. (2005). Sex after 50: Revving up the romance, passion & excitement. Sanger, CA: Quill Driver Books/Works Dancer Press.

REFERENCES

American Cancer Society. (1998). For the man/woman with cancer and their partners: Companion booklets. Atlanta, GA: Author.

Anderson, B. L., Woods, X. A., & Copeland, L. J. (1997). Sexual self esteem and sexual morbidity among gynecologic cancer survivors. Consulting Clinical Psychology, 65(2), 221–229.

Andrews, W. C. (2000). Approaches to Taking a Sexual history. Journal of Women’s Health & Gender-Based Medicine, 9(Suppl.), S21–S24.

Aubuchon, M., & Santoro, N. (2004). Lessons learned from WHI; HRT requires a cautious individualized approach. Geriatrics, 59(1), 22–26.

Basson, R. (2001). Human sex response cycles. Journal of Sex and Marital Therapy, 27, 33–43.

Berkman, C. S., & Zinberg, G., (1997). Homophobia and heterosexism in social workers. Social Work, 42(4), 319–332.

Berman, H., Harris, D., Enright, R., Gilpin, M., Cathers, T., & Bukovy, G. (1999). Sexuality and the adolescent with a physical disability: Understandings and misunderstandings. Issues in Comprehensive Pediatric Nursing, 22(4), 189–196.

Bianchi. T. L. (1997). Aspects of sexuality after burn injury: Outcomes in men. Journal of Burn Care Rehabilitation, 18(2), 183–186.

Black, P. K. (2004). Psychological, sexual and cultural issues for patients with a stoma. British Journal of Nursing, 3(2), 692–697.

Bodenheimer, C., Kerrigan, A. J., Garber, S. L., & Monga, T. N. (2000). Sexuality in persons with lower extremity amputations. Disability and Rehabilitation, 22(9), 409–415.

Boone T., & Kelly, R. (1990). Sexual issues and research in counseling the post myocardial infarction patient. Journal of Cardiovascular Nursing, 4(4), 65–75

Brody, S., & Pruet, R. (2003). Vaginal intercourse and heart rate variability. Journal of Sex and Marital Therapy, 29(5), 371–380.

Burt K. (1995). The effects of cancer on body image and sexuality. Nursing Times, 91(7), 36–37.

Cagle, J. G., & Bolte, S. (2009). Sexuality and life- threatening illness: Implications for social work and palliative care. Health & Social Work, 34(3), 223–232.

Camsari, T., Cavdar, C., Yemez, B., Ozkahya, M., Atabay, G., Alkin, T., & Akçiçek, F. (1999). Psychosexual function in CAPD and hemodialysis patients. Peritoneal Dialysis International, 19(6), 585–588.

Chen, W. Y., Hankinson, S. E., Schnitt, S. J., Rosner, B. A., Holmes, M. D., & Colditz, G. A. (2004). Association of hormone replacement therapy to estrogen and progesterone receptor status in invasive breast carcinoma. Cancer, 101, 1490–1500.

Ching, A. Y., & Lip, G. Y. (2002). Hormone replacement therapy and cardiovascular risk. Treatment Endocrinology, 1(2), 95–103.

Christ, G. H., Moynihan, R. T., & Gallo-Silver, L. (1995). Crisis intervention with AIDS patients and their families (pp. 231–247). In A. R. Roberts (Ed.), Crisis intervention and time-limited cognitive treatment. London, UK: Sage.

Clawson, C. L., & Reese-Weber, M. (2003). The amount and timing of parent-adolescent sexual communication as predictors of late adolescent sexual risk-taking behaviors. Journal of Sex Research, 40(3), 256–265.

Connolly, J. N., Slaghter, V., & Mealey, L. (2004). The development of preferences for specifi c body shapes, Journal of Sex Research, 41(1), 5–15.

Cranston-Cuebas, M. A., & Barlow, D. H. (1990). Cognitive and affective controls to sexual functioning. Annual Review of Sex Research, 1, 119–161.

D’Augelli, A. R., Grossman, A. H., Hershberger, S. L., & O’Connell, T. S. (2001). Aspects of mental health among older lesbian, gay and bisexual adults. Aging Mental Health, 5(2), 149–158.

Debusk, R. F. (2000). Evaluating the cardiovascular tolerance for sex. American Journal of Cardiology, 86(Suppl. 2A), 51F–56F.

Dennerstein, L., & Lehert, P. (2004). Modeling mid-aged women’s sexual functioning: A prospective population based study. Journal of Sex and Marital Therapy, 30(3), 175–184.

Dennerstein, L., Lehert, P., Dudley, E., & Burger, H. (1999). Factors affecting sexual functioning of women in the mid-life years. Climacteric, 2, 254–262.

Dickman, G. (2003). A role for sexologists: Helping manage the medication induced sexual dysfunctions associated with treatment of depression. Contemporary Sexuality, 37(5), i–viii.

Draucker, C. B., & Spadlin, D. (2001). Women sexually abused as children: Implications for orthopaedic nursing care. Orthopaedic Nursing, 20(6), 41–48.

Durna, E. M., Heller, G. Z., Leader, L. R., Sjoblom, P., Eden, J. A., & Wren, B. G. (2004). Breast cancer in premenopausal women: Recurrence and survival rates and relationship to hormone replacement therapy. Climacteric, 7(3), 284–291.

Eagan, M. (1993). Resilience at the front lines: Hospital social work with AIDS patients and burnout. Social Work in Health Care, 18(2), 109–125.

ch14.indd 366ch14.indd 366 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

Human Sexual Health 367

Ehrenberg, M., & Ehrenberg, O. (1988). The intimate circle of sexual dynamics of family life. New York, NY: Simon & Schuster.

Erickson, E. H. (1968). Identity, youth and crisis. New York, NY: Norton.

Esmail, S., Yashima, E., & Munro, B. (2002). Sexuality and disability: The role of health care professionals in providing options and alternatives for couple. Sexuality and Disability, 9(4), 267–282.

Fahs, M. C., & Wade, K. (1996). An economic analysis of two models of hospital care for AIDS patients: Implications for hospital discharge planning. Social Work in Health Care, 22(4), 21–34.

Fairbairn, W. R. D. (1946). Object-relationships and dynamic structure. International Journal of Psycho- Analysis, 27(1–2), 30–37.

Ferrando, S., Evans, S., Goggin, K., Sewell, M., Fishman, B., & Rabkin, J. (1998). Fatigue in HIV illness: Relationship to depression, physical limitations and disability. Psychosomatic Medicine, 60(6), 759–764.

Finkelhor, D. (1984). Child sexual abuse: New theory and research. New York, NY: Free Press.

Freud, S. (1922). Beyond the pleasure principle. London, UK: International Psycho-Analytic Press.

Frohlick, P. F., & Meston, C. M. (2005). Tactile sensitivity in women with sexual arousal disorder. Archives of Sexual Behavior, 34(2), 207–217.

Fuentes, P., Rosenberg, J., & Marks, R. (1983). Sexual side effects: What to tell your patients, what not to say. Registered Nurse, 46(2), 35–41.

Furstenberg, A. L., & Olson, M. M. (1984). Social work and AIDS. Social Work in Health Care, 9(4), 45–62.

Gallo-Silver, L. (2000). The sexual rehabilitation of people with cancer. Cancer Practice: A Multidisciplinary Journal of Cancer Care, 8(1), 10–15.

Gallo-Silver, L. (2011). Sexuality and physical intimacy for people receiving palliative care. In S. Otis-Green & T. Altilio (Eds.), Handbook of palliative social work (pp. 261–270). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Gallo-Silver, L., & Parsonnet, L. (2001). Sexuality and fertility. In M. M. Lauria, E. J. Clark, J. F. Hermann, & N. M. Stearns (Eds.), Social work in oncology: Supporting survivors, families and caregivers (pp. 279–298). Atlanta, GA: American Cancer Society.

Gallo-Silver, L., Raveis, V. H., & Moynihan, R. T. (1993). Psychosocial issues in adults with transfusion-related HIVB infection and their families. Social Work in Health Care, 18(2), 63–74.

Gallo-Silver, L., & Weiner, M. (2006). Survivors of childhood sexual abuse with cancer: Managing the impact of early trauma on cancer treatment. Journal of Psychosocial Oncology, 24(1), 107–134.

Gelfand, M. M. (2000). Sexuality among older women. Journal of Women’s Health and Gender Based Medicine, 9(Suppl.), S15–S20.

Green, S. E., & Mosher, D. L. (1985). A causal model of sexual arousal to erotic fantasies. Journal of Sex Research, 21(1), 1–23.

Greydanus, D. E., Rimsza, M. E., & Newhouse, P. A. (2002). Adolescent sexuality and disability. Adolescent Medicine, 13(2), 223–247.

Grossman, A. H., D’Augelli, A. R., & Hershberger, S. L. (2000). Social support networks of lesbian, gay and bisexual adults 60 years of age and older. Journal of Gerontology Behavioral Psychology and Social Science, 55(3), 171–179.

Grov, C., Bimbi, D. S., Nanin, J. E., & Parsons, J. T. (2006). Race, ethnicity, gender, and generational factors associated with the coming out process among gay, lesbian, and bisexual individuals. Journal of Sex Research, 4, 115–121.

Haas, F., & Haas, S. S. (2000). The chronic bronchitis and emphysema handbook. New York, NY: Wiley.

Harden, J. (2005). Developmental life stage and couples’ experiences with prostate cancer: A review of the literature. Cancer Nursing, 28(2), 85–98.

Hazan, C., & Shaver, P. (1987). Romantic love conceptualized as an attachment process. Journal of Personality and Social Psychology, 52, 511–524.

Hobbins, D. (2004). Survivors of childhood sexual abuse: Implications for perinatal nursing care. Journal of Obstetrics, Gynecology and Neonatal Nursing, 33(4), 485–497.

Holstege, G., Georgiadis, J. R., & Paans, A. M. J. (2003). Brain activation during human male ejaculation. Journal of Neuroscience, 23(27), 9185–9193.

Horgan, O., & MacLachlan, M. (2004). Psychosocial adjustment to lower-limb amputation: A review. Disability and Rehabilitation, 26(14–15), 837–850.

Horner, G. (2004). Sexual behavior in children: Normal or not? Journal of Pediatric Health Care, 18(2), 56–64.

Hughes, M. K. (2000). Sexuality and the cancer survivor: A silent coexistence. Cancer Nursing, 23(6), 477–482.

Hurlbert, D. F., & Whittaker, K. E. (1991). The role of masturbation in marital satisfaction: A comparative study of female masturbators and non-masturbators. Journal of Sex Education and Therapy, 17, 272–282.

Ide, M. (2004). Sexuality in persons with limb amputation: A meaningful discussion of re-integration. Disability and Rehabilitation, 14–15, 939–949.

Ide, M., Watanabe, T., & Toyonaga, T. (2002). Sexuality in persons with limb amputation. Prosthetics and Orthotics International, 26(3), 189–194.

Jehu, D. (1992). Long-term consequences of childhood sexual abuse: Presentation and management in gynaecological practice. In K. Wijma & B. von Schoultz (Eds.), Reproductive life: Advances in research in psychosomatic obstetrics and gynaecology (pp. 513–520). Stockholm, Sweden: Parthenon.

ch14.indd 367ch14.indd 367 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

368 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

Johnson, C. F. (2004). Child sexual abuse. Lancet, 364, 462–470.

Jones, J. C., & Barlow, D. H. (1990). Self reported frequency of sexual urges, fantasies and masturbatory fantasies in heterosexual males and females. Archives of Sexual Behavior, 19, 269–279.

Kaplan, H. S. (1974). The new sex therapy: Active treatment of sexual dysfunction. New York, NY: Brunner/Mazel.

Kaplan, H. S. (1983). The evaluation of sexual disorders: Psychological and medical aspects. New York, NY: Brunner/Mazel.

Kaplan, H. S. (1987). The illustrated manual of sex therapy. New York, NY: Brunner/Mazel.

Karma, S., Lecours, A. R., & Leroux, J. M. (2002). Areas of brain activation in males and females during viewing of erotic fi lm excerpts. Human Brain Mapping, 16, 1–16.

Katz, A. (2007). Breaking the silence on cancer and sexuality: A handbook for healthcare providers. Pittsburgh, PA: Oncology Nursing Society.

Katzin, L. (1990). Chronic illness and sexuality. American Journal of Nursing, 90(1), 54–59.

Kelly, D. C., & Hockenberg-Eaton, M. (1999). Communication about sexual issues: Mothers, fathers and friends. Journal of Adolescent Health, 24(3), 181–189.

Kingsberg, S. A. (2000). The psychological impact of aging on sexuality and relationships. Journal of Women’s Health and Gender Based Medicine, 9(Supp), S33–S38.

Kinsey, A. C., Pomeroy, W. B., & Martin, C. E. (1948). The sexual behavior in the adult male. Philadelphia, PA: Saunders.

Kinsey, A. C., Pomeroy, W. B., & Martin, C. E. (1953). The sexual behavior of the adult female. Philadelphia, PA: Saunders.

Koken, J. A., Bimbi, D. S., & Parsons, J. T. (2009). Experiences of familial rejection-acceptance among transgender women. Journal of Family Psychology, 23, 853–860.

Kroll, K., & Klein, E. L. (2001). Enabling romance: A guide to love, sex, and relationships for people with disabilities. Horsham, PA: No Limits Communications.

Laumann, E. O., Gagnon, J. H., Michael, R. T., & Michaels, S. (1994). The social organization of sexuality: Sexual practices in the United States. Chicago, IL: University of Chicago Press.

Lawrence, J. W., Fauerbach, J. A., Heinberg, L., & Doctor, M. (2004). Visible vs. hidden scars and their relationship to body esteem. Journal of Burn Care and Rehabilitation, 25(1), 25–32.

Lemieux, L., Kaiser, S., Periera, J., & Meadows, L. M. (2004). Sexuality in palliative care: Patient perspectives. Palliative Medicine, 18, 630–637.

Lukianowicz, N. (1960). Imaginary sexual partners and visual masturbatory fantasies. Archives of General Psychiatry, 3, 429–449.

Maltz, W. (2001). The sexual healing journey: A guide for survivors of sexual abuse. New York, NY: Quill.

Maltz, W. (2003). Treating the sexual intimacy concerns of sexual abuse survivors. Contemporary Sexuality, 37(7), i–viii.

Mantell, J. E., Shulman, L. C., Belmont, M. F., & Spivak, H. B. (1989). Social workers respond to the AIDS epidemic in an acute care hospital. Health Social Work, 14(1), 41–51.

Markham, H., Stanley, S., & Blumberg, S. L. (1994). Fighting for your marriage. San Francisco, CA: Jossey-Bass.

Masters, W. H., & Johnson, V. E. (1966). Human sexual response. Boston, MA: Little Brown.

Masters, W. H., & Johnson, V. E. (1970). Human sexual inadequacy. Boston, MA: Little Brown.

McCabe, M. P. (1994). The interrelationship between intimacy, sexual functioning and sexuality among men and women in committed relationships. Canadian Journal of Human Sexuality, 8, 31–38.

McCabe, M. P. (1999). Sexual knowledge, experience and feelings among people with disability. Sexuality & Disability, 17(2), 157–170.

McCabe, M. P., & Taleporos, G. (2003). Sexual esteem, sexual satisfaction and sexual behavior among people with physical disabilities. Archives of Sexual Behavior, 32(4), 359–369.

McInnes, R. A. (2003). Chronic illness and sexuality. Medical Journal of Australia, 179(5), 263–266.

McKenna, K. (1999). The brain is the master organ in sexual functioning: Central nervous system control of male and female sexual functioning. International Journal of Impotence Research, 11, 48–55.

McMahon, E. (2003). The older homosexual: Current concepts of lesbian, gay, bisexual, and transgender older Americans. Clinical Geriatric Medicine, 19(3), 587–593.

Monga, U., Tan, G., Ostermann, H. J., & Monga, T. N. (1997). Sexuality in head and neck cancer patients. Archives of Physical and Medical Rehabilitation, 78(3), 298–304.

Mosher, D. (1980). The dimensions of depth involvement in human sexual response. Journal of Sex Research, 16, 1–42.

Napoleone, S. (1988). Inpatient care of persons with AIDS. Social Casework, 69(6), 376–379.

Nazareth, I., Lewin, J., & King, M. (2001). Sexual dysfunction after treatment for testicular cancer: A systemic review. Journal of Psychosomatic Research, 51(6), 735–743.

Neufi eld, J. A., Klingbell, F., Borgen, D. N., Silverman, B., & Thomas, A. (2002). Adolescent sexuality and disability. Physical Medicine and Rehabilitation Clinics of North America, 13(4), 857–873.

ch14.indd 368ch14.indd 368 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

Human Sexual Health 369

Nutter, D. E., & Condron, M. C. (1985). Sexual fantasy and activity patterns of males with inhibited sexual desire and males with erectile dysfunction versus normal controls. Journal of Sex and Marital Therapy, 11, 91–98.

Opjordsmoen, S., Waehre, H., Aass, N., & Fossa, S. D. (1994). Sexuality in patients treated for penile cancer: Patients’ experience and doctors’ judgment. British Journal of Urology, 73(5), 554–560.

Parish, K. L. (2002). Sexuality and haemophilia: Connections across the lifespan. Haemophilia, 8(3), 353–359.

Poniatowski, B. C., Grimm, P., & Cohen, G. (2001). Chemotherapy-induced menopause: A literature review. Cancer Investigations, 19, 641–648.

Reynolds, J. M., & Postlethwaite, R. J. (1996). Psychosocial burdens of dialysis treatment modalities: Do they differ and does it matter. Peritoneal Dialysis International, 16(Suppl. 1), S548–S550.

Roak, R. A., Webster, R. D., Darrow, W. W., & Stempel, R. R. (2005). HIV testing among men who have sex with men: How often should one test? Journal of Public Health Management Practice, 11, 18–24.

Rowan, E. L. (2000). The joy of self pleasuring. Amherst, NY: Prometheus Books.

Rowland, D. L., & Tai, W. (2003). A review of plant- derived and herbal approaches to the treatment of sexual dysfunctions. Journal of Sex and Marital Therapy, 29, 185–206.

Russell, D. (1999). The secret trauma: Incest in the lives of girls and women. New York, NY: Basic Books.

Ryan, G. (2000). Childhood sexuality: A decade of study, Part II, dissemination and future direction. Child Abuse and Neglect, 24, 49–69.

Samuel, J. C., & Boyle, M. (1989). AIDS training and social services. AIDS Care, 1, 287–296.

Sansone, R. A., Gaither, G. A., & Sansone, L. A. (2001). Childhood trauma and adult somatic preoccupation by body area among women in an internal medicine setting: A pilot study. International Journal of Psychiatry in Medicine, 31, 147–154.

Sansone, P., Skaife, K., & Rhodes, J. (2003). Abuse, dissociation and somatization in irritable bowel syndrome: Toward an explanatory model. Journal of Behavioral Medicine, 1, 1–18.

Schacter, C. L., Radomsky, N. A., Stalker, C. A., & Teram, E. (2004). Women survivors of child sexual abuse: How can health care professionals promote healing? Canadian Family Physician, 50, 341–346.

Schmidt, E. Z., Hofmann, P., Niederwieser, G., Kapfhammer, H. P., & Bonelli, R. M. (2005). Sexuality and multiple sclerosis. Journal of Neural Transmission, 112(9), 1201–1211.

Schover, L. R. (1997). Sexuality and fertility after cancer. New York, NY: Wiley.

Schover, L. R. (1999). Counseling cancer patients about changes in sexual function. Oncology, 13, 1585–1596.

Schover, L. R. (2000). Sexual problems in chronic illness. In S. R. Leiblum & R. C. Rosen (Eds.), Principles and practice of sex therapy (pp. 57–81). New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Schover, L. R., & Jensen, J. B. (1988). Sexuality and chronic illness: A comprehensive approach. New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Shell, J. A., & Miller, M. E. (1999). The cancer amputee and sexuality. Orthopeadic Nursing, 18, 62–65.

Sipski, M. (1998). Sexual functioning in the spinal cord injured. International Journal of Impotence Research, 10(Suppl. 2), 128–130.

Soloway, C. T., Soloway, M. S., Kim, S. S., & Kava, B. R. (2005). Sexual, psychological, and dyadic qualities of the prostate cancer “couple.” British Journal of Urology International, 95, 780–785.

Spitzer, W. J., Neuman, K., & Holden, G. (2004). The coming of age for assisted living: New options for senior housing and social work practice. Social Work in Health Care, 38, 21–45.

Sundquist, K., & Yee, L. (2003). Sexuality and body image after cancer. Australian Family Physician, 32, 19–23.

Tanyi, R. A. (2002). Sexual unattractiveness: A patient’s story. Medsurg Nursing, 11, 95–99.

Taylor, B., & Davies, S. (2006). Using the extended PLISSIT model to address sexual healthcare needs. Nursing Standards, 21(11), 35–40.

Thorson, A. I. (2003). Sexual activity and the cardiac patient. American Journal of Geriatric Cardiology, 12, 38–40.

Uttley, L. (1996). Treatment of sexual dysfunction. Peritoneal Dialysis International, 16(Suppl. 1), S402– S405.

Walbroehl, G. S. (1992). Sexual concerns of the patient with pulmonary disease. Postgraduate Medicine, 91, 455–460.

Walker, J. R., & Casale, A. J. (1997). Prolonged penile erection in the newborn. Urology, 50, 796–799.

Weerakoon, P., Jones, M. K., Pynor, R., & Kilburn- Watt, E. (2004). Allied health professional students’ perceived level of comfort in clinical situations that have sexual connotations. Journal of Allied Health, 33, 189–193.

Weiner, L. S., & Siegel, K. (1990). Social worker’s comfort in providing services to AIDS patients. Social Work, 35, 18–25.

Whitehead, T. L. (1993). Sexual health promotion of the patient with burns. Journal of Burn Care and Rehabilitation, 14, 221–226.

Wimberly, S. R., Carver, C. S., Laurenceau, J. P., Karris, S. D., & Antoni, M. H. (2005). Perceived partner reactions to diagnosis and treatment of breast cancer: Impact on psychosocial and psychosexual development. Journal of Consulting and Clinical Psychology, 73, 300–311.

ch14.indd 369ch14.indd 369 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

370 Health Social Work Practice: A Spectrum of Critical Considerations

Wood, J. D., & Tombrink, J. (1983). Impact of cancer on sexuality and self-image: A group program for patients and partners. Social Work in Health Care, 8, 45–54.

Zoldbrod, A. (2003). Assessing intrapsychic blocks to pleasure using the Milestones of Sexual Development Model. Contemporary Sexuality, 37, 7–14.

Zoldbrod, A. P. (1998). SexSmart: How your childhood shaped your sexual life and what to do about it. Oakland, CA: New Harbinger.

Zunkel, G. (2002). Relational coping process: Couples response to a diagnosis of early stage breast cancer. Journal of Psychosocial Oncology, 20, 39–55.

ch14.indd 370ch14.indd 370 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

PART II I

Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

ch15.indd 371ch15.indd 371 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

ch15.indd 372ch15.indd 372 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

373

15

Social Work With Children and Adolescents With Medical Conditions

NANCY BOYD WEBB AND ROSE A. BARTONE

Utilizing a strengths perspective that acknowl- edges the stress and trauma factors associated with medical conditions and their treatment, this chapter illustrates various methods social workers can use to help children and adoles- cents who have serious and chronic medical conditions. The chapter reviews the knowledge base needed by social workers to collaborate effectively with medical and school personnel as well as methods for helping the child and family members (with family defi ned broadly) understand and cope with the numerous stress- ors associated with the youth’s medical real- ity. Detailed examples of both hospital-based social work interventions and those occurring while the child is living at home illustrate help- ing methods at different stages of illness. Work with the family is an essential part of helping medically compromised children, as is trans- disciplinary collaboration. This chapter illus- trates the necessity and value of collaborative teamwork, often initiated by the social worker who interfaces with schools and other commu- nity organizations in addition to hospital-based medical practitioners for the purpose of provid- ing competent, comprehensive, and compas- sionate care for youth with medical conditions.

Chapter Objectives • Understand the prevalence and scope of

children’s health conditions. • Understand the infl uence of a child’s age and

level of development on the attribution of meaning in medical diagnosis and prognosis.

• Recognize the necessary collaboration among the family, school, and medical set- ting in providing care to youth with medical conditions.

• Learn of interventions that social workers can employ to help children with medical conditions in the hospital, home, and com- munity.

• Explore palliative care and end-of-life is- sues for the child, family, and interdisci- plinary team.

• Understand issues and challenges for the social worker dealing with youth who have medical conditions, including vicarious traumatization.

• Discover resources in the community and on the Internet to help children and families challenged by medical conditions.

PREVALENCE AND SCOPE OF CHILDREN’S HEALTH PROBLEMS

Children’s health problems range from those that cause pain and discomfort for a few days (such as the chicken pox or the fl u) to others that require ongoing monitoring and periodic hospitalizations over the course of the child’s life (such as cancer or diabetes; see Table 15.1). This section focuses on the most prevalent serious childhood conditions, indicating the frequency of each, the course of each illness, and the typical range of treatments.

ch15.indd 373ch15.indd 373 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

374 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Children with special health-care needs comprise 12.8% of all children younger than 18 years in the United States, and half a mil- lion young adults with special health-care needs reach their 18th birthdays each year (Oftedahl, Benedict, & Katcher 2004). Special health-care needs may result from premature birth, illness, injury, or congenital causes.

DEVELOPMENTAL CONSIDERATIONS AND CHILD AND FAMILY ATTRIBUTION OF MEANING TO MEDICAL DIAGNOSES

The formal diagnosis of a medical condition may occur unexpectedly or following a series of symptoms or problems that have disturbed the child and family for a period of weeks, months, or years. Parents may have suspected

that something was seriously wrong and may have awaited a formal diagnosis with great trepidation. Other times, families may down- play a child’s symptoms and remain unaware of the possible signifi cance of the child’s com- plaints.

A diagnosis gives parents and youth a rea- son about the reason for the complaints but also may confer a reality requiring substantial changes in the lifestyle of the family and the child for many years or even a lifetime. Often the diagnosis brings a cruel awareness that things will never again be the same as they have been. The knowledge that a child has a serious medical condition results in a shock- ing and major loss for all concerned, who real- ize that they will need to fi nd a way to adapt and cope with this new reality, which will im- pact the lives of all the family members (see Chapter 13 for a full discussion of families and health).

Table 15.1 Most Frequent Pediatric Illnesses in the United States

Medical Condition Prevalence

Usual Course of Illness Range of Treatment

Asthma 6.7 million U.S. children under 18 years; highest among children 11 to 17 (Akinbami, Moorman, Garbe, & Sondik, 2009)

Lifelong Short-acting relievers Long-acting inhalers Environmental control Clinical trials

Cancer Approximately 12,400 American children under the age of 20 (Mariotto et al., 2009)

Sudden onset Chemotherapy Steroids Antinausea medications Radiation therapy Surgery Clinical trials

Diabetes Type 1 is more prevalent in ages 0 to 19, affecting 182 per 100,000 U.S. children

Type 2 is more prevalent in ages 10 to 19, affecting 174 per 100,000 U.S. children (SEARCH for Diabetes in Youth Study, 2006)

Type 1 (juvenile onset) autoimmune; develops under 21 years

Type 2 nonautoimmune; develops in overweight children under 21

All types: diet and exercise Type 1: insulin Type 2: may require insulin

Juvenile rheumatoid arthritis

1.6–86.1 per 100,000 U.S. children (Helmick et al., 2008)

Lifelong; degenerative Steroids

Obesity 16.9% of U.S. children ages 2 to 19 (Ogden, Carroll, Curtin, Lamb, & Flegal, 2010)

Genetic; lifestyle; cultural; medical conditions

Diet Exercise Medications

ch15.indd 374ch15.indd 374 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

Social Work With Children and Adolescents With Medical Conditions 375

Researchers who have studied the family im- pact of medical diagnoses propose a four-stage model to describe the typical adjustment to a youth’s medical condition. According to Clarke- Steffen (1993; Dell Clark, 2010), the stages are:

Stage 1: First clue. The family and child begin to have some awareness that “something is defi nitely wrong.”

Stage 2: Limbo. The family and child react to the diagnosis with varying degrees of uncertainty and feelings of vulnerability.

Stage 3: Reconstructing meaning. The fam- ily reorganizes its lifestyle and routines to manage the requirements of the thera- peutic program.

Stage 4: New normal. The family and child operate with a shared tolerance of the new routines and uncertainties, even though this state differs from their prior, “normal” experiences.

Although this model seems to progress logically toward an end point of acceptance, all families do not move consistently through the stages. Some families persist in denial of

the diagnosis and may insist on additional tests and procedures. Likewise, the unpre- dictability of the child’s illness may cause relapses and impair coping even when all are doing their best to comply with medical regimens.

The case of Carl, age 13, provides an ex- ample of a family’s and child’s positive and ideal adjustment to the diagnosis of asthma. It is presented as an ideal situation. Asthma is the most common chronic childhood illness, affecting over 6 million children younger than 18 years in the United States (Brown, Daly, & Rickel, 2007; Clay, 2004). It causes more school absences per year than any other chronic illness and is the third most common reason for hospitalization among children younger than 15 years (Taylor & Newacheck, 1992). Social workers and others who deal with chil- dren with medical conditions such as asthma must be aware that the youth’s friends will no- tice and sometimes worry about their friend’s need to use an inhaler or other treatments. The case illustrates a successful adaptation of a child and family who were motivated to make their personal experiences public in the hope

CASE EXAMPLE: Child with Asthma, Carl, Age 13

This summary is based on a preadolescent boy’s account of his reaction to receiving a diagnosis of asthma when he was 3 years old and his experiences growing up with the disease (Huegel, 1998). He documents his daily need for medications and frequent need to confer with his physician. Despite his condition, Carl manages to engage in sports and other school activities, includ- ing gym class. His mother has been a very positive presence in Carl’s life and started a support group for parents and children with asthma in their community.

Carl reports that he has been responsible for taking his own daily medications (with parental monitoring) since the fourth grade. He makes it very clear that he lives within the ongoing constraints of his asthma and

prepares himself for a possible attack by wearing a Medic Alert bracelet and carrying his medications and an EpiPen in a pouch. When he participates in sports, his physical education teachers and coaches are informed that he will use an inhaler before playing vig- orous games and that he may have to sit out part of the game. He attends sleep-away camp for 3 weeks every summer, well supplied with instructions for counselors and with extra medications and inhalers to permit him to carry out the daily activities of camp life.

Carl has helped other young people with asthma, both by talking with and encourag- ing them and by writing his personal story. He makes it very clear that although he does not like living with asthma, he is determined not to let it interfere with his success in life. This positive attitude represents an ideal to which others may aspire.

ch15.indd 375ch15.indd 375 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

376 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

that it might inspire others to maintain hope despite the considerable necessary adaptations required by the disease (Huegel, 1998).

TYPICAL RESPONSES OF CHILDREN AND THEIR PARENTS WHEN DEALING WITH A CHILD’S MEDICAL CONDITION

Children and families react very differently to a serious medical diagnosis. Although Carl reported that when he was diagnosed with asthma at age 3, he was too young to compre- hend the meaning of his condition, an older child in the same situation might assume that the diagnosis will lead to certain death. This was the case for a 10-year-old girl whose mother told her at age 7 that she had diabetes. She burst into tears, and even after her parents convinced her that she was not going to die, she remained convinced that her life was going to change completely (Krementz, 1992; Webb, 2009).

Because children take their cues from the adults around them, it is important for social workers to be informed about various ill- nesses so that they in turn can help to inform parents. Often parents may not accurately re- call the doctor’s recommendations and prog- nostic statements about the management of illness and its likely course. This is why writ- ten explanations and guidelines are helpful, together with an offer by the social worker to be available to answer future questions about the illness and its management or to act as a go-between with other providers. It is also critical for the social worker to maintain a relationship with the patient and family to ensure that they understand instructions for medications, diet, and follow-up visits. The resource list at the end of this chapter pro- vides some Web sites with helpful informa- tion about the most typical chronic medical conditions.

It is understandable that diagnosis of a medical condition inevitably arouses questions

and anxiety for parents, which may not be ver- balized to the provider. Parents may wonder why their child became ill and in some cases may feel responsible, especially if there is a genetic component to the disease. They may try to present a positive front to the child de- spite their mixed feelings of anger, worry, and loss. However, the child usually senses the par- ents’ feelings. When parents feel overwhelmed and anxious, it is helpful for them to become involved in individual or group counseling to help mourn their losses and feel more able to support their children. Groups for the chil- dren also can be very helpful, as are Internet contacts with other parents and children con- fronting similar medical challenges. Internet support and information groups moderated by social workers trained in the area of a specifi c disorder can be helpful resources for those who live in rural areas or at great distance from the treatment centers; for example, see: http://healthfi nder.gov/scripts/SearchContext .asp?topic=833&section=3

Young people may be more focused on their current lives than on the future ramifi - cations of their illnesses. Nonetheless, they will need to understand the details of their daily medical routines that may involve tak- ing medications and making periodic offi ce or hospital visits for checkups that some- times will require regular blood work and other tests. It is common for young people to resist all or some of these procedures, and parents will need help in dealing fi rmly with this resistance in a manner that emphasizes its necessity. Goodman (2007) presents an account of a boy’s transition from extreme distress when anticipating upcoming treat- ments for his cancer to a subsequent attitude of acceptance and wanting to help other kids facing procedures such as spinal taps. This change was due at least partly to his therapy with a sympathetic art therapist, who encour- aged him to express his feelings symbolically through drawing. Support groups specifi c to certain medical conditions may be very helpful for children who, without such con- tacts, would feel very isolated and discour- aged about their conditions (see the chapter

ch15.indd 376ch15.indd 376 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

Social Work With Children and Adolescents With Medical Conditions 377

resource list for a listing of organizations that sponsor specialized support groups).

Although living with a medical condition brings with it stressors and constraints on ac- tivities, it is important that young people do not identify themselves primarily in terms of their diagnoses. Some adolescent survivors of can- cer and their parents report positive attitudes a year after supportive treatment (Barakat, Alderfer, & Kazak, 2006). This phenomenon, called posttraumatic growth, refers to posi- tive changes in views about oneself, others, and plans for the future following a medical diagnosis. Although this may not occur in all cases, it does provide convincing evidence that a medical crisis need not bring with it a legacy of negative consequences.

COLLABORATION AMONG FAMILY, SCHOOL, AND MEDICAL SETTING IN CARING FOR YOUTH WITH MEDICAL CONDITIONS

Because children live in worlds that include networks of school, community, and family members, the social worker needs to facili- tate connections with these networks after a medical diagnosis. Confi dentiality always must be observed, and written permission from the parent should be obtained before sharing any medical information with the school or others. The Health Insurance Por- tability and Accountability Act of 1996 (U.S. Department of Health and Human Services, n.d.) provides legal protection for the confi - dentiality of medical information. Although parents may want school personnel to be in- formed of a child’s diagnosis, it is advisable for parents to refrain from disclosing details of the medical condition because what they tell the school becomes part of the perma- nent school record. The school nurse is piv- otal in coordinating the child’s medical care at school. The social worker, parents, stu- dent, and nurse can collaborate on care while protecting the privacy of the child’s medical information.

Educating any child with a chronic or acute medical condition is a diffi cult task for all involved, especially the child. However, edu- cating a child with cancer or other diagnosis that is life threatening presents special chal- lenges. At diagnosis, the parents’ initial focus likely is directed toward the child’s survival and perhaps the cost of care. After the shock of diagnosis abates, attention shifts to the real- ization that treatment and its side effects may interfere with the educational process and like- lihood of success later in life (Keene, 2003). Chemotherapeutic agents, radiation therapy, and surgical interventions can affect memory and cognitive functioning (CureSearch, 2008). The effects of treatment may, in fact, cause a host of impairments in cognitive and physical functioning well into adulthood (Leukemia & Lymphoma Society, 2007).

Treatment for brain tumors, tumors of the eye and ear, acute lymphoblastic leukemia, and non-Hodgkin’s lymphoma are more likely to cause learning and memory problems be- cause of the nature of treatment. Methotrexate; cytosine arabinoside; brain surgery; and radia- tion therapy to the brain, ear, or total body put children at higher risk of learning diffi culties. Cisplatin or carboplatin can affect hearing. Neuropsychological testing is important to identify learning losses so that they may be di- agnosed in a timely manner and an appropriate education plan can be developed. Even if ini- tial testing is normal, it is imperative to repeat testing at regular intervals over the school year so that adjustments can be made to educational plans (CureSearch, 2008).

It is crucial for social workers to understand the legal rights of students under federal law so that they and parents can advocate for minor patients; see Table 15.2 for some laws that as- sist and protect student rights. Social workers can act both as educators and advocates in this area. They have the opportunity to teach the parents and school personnel about the laws that affect a student’s rights. They also have the chance to communicate effectively and collaborate with those who will directly im- pact the current life and future endeavors of the student. The outcome of this intervention

ch15.indd 377ch15.indd 377 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

378 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

has the potential to positively affect the child’s quality of life for years.

FERTILITY

Young adulthood brings many changes and challenges. Although young people take for granted the possibility of having children when they wish to do so, a cancer diagnosis may challenge that assumption. Certain che- motherapies and high-dose radiation therapies can cause infertility. The social worker’s role is to provide the patient and his family with information and resources so that they are ready for the transition to adulthood and the obstacles that it may bring. This is best done early in the diagnostic period and addressed periodically as needed through and beyond the period of treatment.

Sperm cryopreservation and embryo freez- ing offers the highest likelihood of success for cancer survivors who have reached puberty. Sperm collection is a relatively simple process. The patient donates sperm cells by masturbat- ing, and the sperm is then frozen and stored for future use. Embryo freezing, while offering the best chance at reproduction, is less likely to happen for a female patient because an em- bryo must be fertilized before it is frozen and

stored. Egg freezing, where mature eggs are surgically removed, frozen, and stored, may be a more viable option for females.

Other methods of preserving reproductive ability are available for those who are prepu- bescent, such as testicular tissue freezing for males and ovarian tissue freezing for females. The process involves removal of testicular tis- sue surgically, which is then frozen. Females may have part or all of the ovary surgically removed for later use. These procedures re- main experimental, and  their costs are high (Leukemia & Lymphoma Society, 2007). Chapter 21 presents the special dilemmas of young women who fi nd that they are posi- tive for breast cancer mutations that greatly heighten their risks for the disease.

SELECTED INTERVENTIONS FOR HOSPITAL-BASED AND COMMUNITY-BASED SOCIAL WORKERS WHO HELP YOUTH WITH MEDICAL CONDITIONS

A young person who is hospitalized for medi- cal treatment faces many stressors. First and foremost is a fear of the unknown. These young people are in unfamiliar environments

Table 15.2 Laws That Assist and Protect Student Rights

Rehabilitation Act of 1973, Section 504a Federal assistance is provided through the Department of Education to protect against discrimination and provides services for individuals with a physical or mental impairment in at least one major life activity.

American with Disabilities Act (ADA) of 1990 The ADA guarantees the civil rights of a person with a disability; see http://www.usdoj.gov/crt/ada/adahom1.htm

Individuals with Disabilities Education Act (IDEA)a

The IDEA guarantees a free and appropriate education, including preschool, elementary, and secondary (ages 3 to 21). An Individualized Education Plan (IEP) is developed to assist students to achieve their maximum potential.

Family Education and Privacy Act (FERPA) This 1974 act ensures the confi dentiality of the student’s written record, making it available only to those with legitimate concerns and only with the student’s express permission.

aUnder Section 504 and IDEA, colleges and universities that receive federal money are required to provide accommodations for their students.

Source: Beyond the Cure: The Mountain You Have Climbed, National Children’s Cancer Society, Saint Louis, MO: Author, 2008.

ch15.indd 378ch15.indd 378 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

Social Work With Children and Adolescents With Medical Conditions 379

and surrounded by strangers, many of whom subject them to painful or uncomfortable pro- cedures. Even when a parent is present, the child comes to realize that in this particular setting the parent is no longer “in charge,” and this reality may further confuse and upset the youngster. Recognizing that their parent is relatively helpless with very little control or choice over what will happen to them mag- nifi es the young person’s fears. Furthermore, the treatment that is supposed to help often causes pain, which can be very confusing to very young children. Often children will fear damage to their bodies and wonder if they will ever be able to return home and to function normally. A hospital can be a very scary place for a child, and even an adolescent who under- stands the necessity of treatment may strongly resent having to submit to it.

Joan Lovett, a behavioral pediatrician, lists these factors that can make a medical experi- ence traumatic for a child (Lovett, 2010):

• Helplessness and vulnerability

• Discomfort and pain

• Confusion

• Parental distress

• Uncertainty about outcome

Social workers can help young patients and their families cope with these psychosocial stressors that accompany illness. Social work interventions should include collaboration with the family, including the patient’s sib- lings, who often are overlooked because of the focus on the designated patient. In addition to the family, the social worker also gives atten- tion to hospitalized patients and tries to ad- dress their major concerns, including anxiety and fear about the future.

The role of the social worker may encom- pass using play therapy approaches and re- hearsal to help alleviate the child’s anxieties during various phases of the hospitalization. Some hospitals employ child-life specialists whose function includes preparing children for medical procedures and interacting with him after the procedures have been performed

to provide opportunities for mastery. Vilas (2010) describes in detail the role of the child- life professional in using play and expressive therapies to assist hospitalized children. Many of these functions are very similar to those carried out by social workers, who typically interact with the patient, the family, and the medical staff to provide needed services. So- cial work interventions may include play and expressive therapies and anxiety management techniques, or these interventions may be used by other specialists with whom social workers collaborate.

Play and Expressive Therapies

Because all children have diffi culty expressing their emotions in words, play therapists work with them using dolls, puppets, and a variety of toys. The assumption of play therapy is that when the child knows that the purpose of the play therapist’s visit is to help with “troubles and worries” and that it is acceptable to either talk or play, children will use the toys to ex- press their anxieties symbolically.

Any therapist working with children with medical conditions (in a hospital setting, in a school, or elsewhere in the community) will need to have a supply of medical equipment, such as that found in toy medical kits. This equipment usually includes tongue depressors, toy syringes, thermometers, blood pressure gauges, and surgical masks. Often young chil- dren repeatedly use a doll or puppet to act out the procedures that they have experienced. In the process of doing this, the play therapist en- courages the child to verbalize the feelings and questions of the doll patient under the assump- tion that through this process, the children actually are expressing their own emotions and concerns. During this play, the therapist can provide some educational information to clarify any of the child’s confusion about the medical condition and to help the child antici- pate the future. The next interaction is typical.

Therapist: Alice, this doll has had some pains in his tummy like yours, and he had to go to the hospital. Would you like

ch15.indd 379ch15.indd 379 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

380 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

to show him what might happen so he will be ready to go?

Child: Give me the doctor’s bag. [Takes out a toy syringe, and speaks to the doll] Hold out your arm; you have to get a shot.

Therapist: [Speaking for the doll] Is it going to hurt?

Child: Yes, but only for a minute. Then you go to sleep, and then the doctor takes out part of your stomach.

Therapist: [Talking as the doll] How can I eat if I don’t have a stomach?

Child: This is your punishment for eating too much Halloween candy!

Therapist: [As doll] My mommy said I had a big lump in my tummy. I don’t think it came from the candy, because I know that candy and everything we eat gets changed into poop and comes out when we go to the bathroom.

Child: So where did the big lump come from?

Therapist: The doctors aren’t sure, but it’s not from your food, and they are sure that they can take it out, then you won’t feel that pain anymore.

Child: [To doll] Okay. You can wake up now, and you can go home soon.

Therapist: You will have to come back for checkups later, so we can be sure you are okay, but you will be able to go back to school soon and do your regular activities.

This brief excerpt demonstrates how play ther- apy can help clarify points of confusion and misinformation while also permitting the child to express some fears.

Social workers and other professionals can use drawings and board games with older children for a similar purpose in play therapy. Goodman (2007) and Webb (2009) discuss a drawing by a boy taking prednisone who drew a cactus family in which the needles of the cac- tus represented the frequent injections he re- ceived. Play therapy also can be effective using the Milton Bradley board game Operation. For example, with a 10-year-old girl whose

mother was terminally ill, the game provided a wonderful stimulus for a play therapist to en- gage the girl in a discussion (through playing the game) about the doctors’ inability to help (Webb, 2002). See Hart and Rollins (2011) for a complete overview of play activities appro- priate for children with medical conditions.

Most play and expressive therapy methods can be used on an inpatient or an outpatient basis. Some hospitals have play therapy rooms that are equipped with a variety of toys. When a child is ambulatory, the therapist will escort the child to the play therapy room for a ses- sion. Other times, if the child is confi ned to bed, the play therapist may wheel a cart with a variety of toys into the child’s room and in- vite the child to pick a toy. Some hospitals also employ music therapists, who ask children to choose from a variety of instruments and then to make up their own words to a familiar song, such as “The Wheels on the Bus.” An example of music therapy with a 7-year-old boy in- volved playing scary music to chase away the monsters that were interfering with his sleep. After the boy thought the monsters had left, the therapist played and sung a gentle lullaby, soothing the child and enabling him to fall asleep peacefully (Loewy & Stewart, 2004).

The power of play therapy rests in its ability to engage children symbolically with a situation that is similar to their own and to reveal and discuss related feelings without requiring chil- dren to identify these feelings as their own. It is possible to work out solutions with dolls or with drawings or music, and children then can gen- eralize these solutions to their own situations.

Anxiety Management Techniques

Although play therapy methods may be in- trinsically relaxing to children, at times it may be appropriate and more effective to employ specifi c methods that are intended to reduce anxiety. Some of these techniques include:

• Breathing exercises

• Self-control methods, such as “Stop Sign” and “Change the Channel”

• Safe-place imagery

ch15.indd 380ch15.indd 380 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

Social Work With Children and Adolescents With Medical Conditions 381

Breathing Exercises

Although breathing slowly and counting one’s breaths does help to calm the body, most children fi nd it boring merely to focus on their breathing. Therefore, creative play therapists and others have created methods to help children engage in deliberate breathing exercises while still having fun. For example, the therapist asks children to pretend that they are blowing bubbles, using a wand and a jar of bubble mixture. While also pretending to blow bubbles, the therapist engages the child in blowing a series of pretend bubbles and talks about their color and size. After a few minutes of this exercise, the child may feel calmer.

Self-Control Methods

Two easy self-control exercises entail cogni- tive therapy methods that begin with an ex- planation to the child that everyone’s head is like a television set. The social worker can say to patients, “Lots of pictures go through your head, and some are nice pictures and some are not nice and may be even scary or terrible.” The children are told that they can be the boss of what goes on in their own head. To do this, they can learn to “change the channel” if they do not like the pictures in their head. The therapist can then say, “Think of and put up a picture of a stop sign in the front of your head. This means that the bad pictures have to stop.

Next, the social worker instructs children to close their eyes and think of a place, ei- ther real or imaginary, where they can go to feel totally safe and where nothing bad or scary can happen to them. The therapist asks them to think about how it looks, smells, feels, and sounds. After a few moments, the social worker asks the children to open her eyes and draw the safe place. It is important for the youngsters to take time to draw all the details. When the drawing is complete, the social worker refers to it as “your own safe place where no one can harm or hurt you.” The social worker can then tell the children to use this safe place when they are

worried or upset after fi rst thinking about the stop sign to push away worries and scary pictures. It is helpful for the social worker to emphasize that this is within the children’s control. The social worker may say: “Some kids like to repeat to themselves this state- ment when they put up the stop sign and change the channel: ‘I’m the boss of me!’” These cognitive therapy–related activities encourage children’s own natural resiliency. They do not take away the pain of the medi- cal condition or the need for ongoing proce- dures, but they do provide an alternative to feeling helpless and vulnerable.

PALLIATIVE CARE AND END-OF-LIFE ISSUES

Approximately 53,000 children die each year in the United States, and at least 400,000 more live every day with chronic, life-threatening conditions (Friebert & Huff, 2009, p. 9). Currently only about 10% to 20% of dying children receive hospice services, and a simi- lar number of children with life-threatening conditions receive palliative care support and interventions (Friebert & Huff, 2009). See Table 15.3 for more information about the pri- mary causes of death for 1- to 19-year-olds.

For adults, hospice care is offered once the medical team has determined that the patient has six or fewer months to live. However, this time frame is less relevant for children, whose course of illness is more diffi cult to predict. In fact, only 20% of American hos- pice programs offer services to children and their parents (Corr, 2009), which may repre- sent a desire to continue treatments for chil- dren and to attempt to cure their conditions until the time of death. Hospice and palliative care programs for children slowly are gain- ing favor among the medical community, and families are becoming more open to receiving the services. A growing number of pediatric palliative care programs in children’s hospi- tals have developed in recent years to “fi ll the gap between traditional hospital care and

ch15.indd 381ch15.indd 381 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

382 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

community-based hospice care” (Himelstein, Hilden, Boldt, & Weissman, 2004, p. 17). Working collaboratively to change the per- ception of palliative care with children may expedite referrals and help children to get ser- vices sooner (Thompson, Knapp, Madden, & Shenkman, 2009).

Hospice and pediatric palliative care share the same goal of alleviating pain and suffer- ing. Pain management, nursing and social work support, pastoral care, and the ongoing support and bereavement services provided after the death of the patient all argue for of- fering these services sooner rather than later. Hospice also offers an aide in the home and volunteer visitors to provide respite for care- givers and greater comfort for patients. These programs serve patients well because they give them nonfamily outlets for talking about their impending death, something that patients often have trouble doing with loved ones (see Chapters 22 and 23 for more details).

When no further treatment options are available for a child, it may be devastating to all concerned, including caregivers, doctors, nurses, social workers, child-life staff, and even auxiliary staff who take vital signs and clean hospital rooms. Social workers can intervene by establishing a link among the patient, fam- ily, and care team early on and create a smooth transition for patients and their families facing palliative and end-of-life care needs.

It is diffi cult to acknowledge or witness both the sudden death of a young person in the emergency room or the steady deterio- ration of a child or young person after the medical team has come to the conclusion that there is nothing further it can do to help. At

that point, the goal becomes one of manag- ing pain and helping the family plan for the future. Doing this may involve a referral to a hospice program or a spiritual counselor who can meet with family members separately and as a group. Social workers can engage termi- nally ill children in a life-review process that may include journal writing and a plan for the distribution of the youth’s special possessions. This needs to happen after the prognosis has been discussed and before the child is intu- bated or heavily sedated, as may occur in the later stages of illness.

A hospital-based social worker may play a critical role in all these processes, which also entail collaboration with other professionals involved with the child and the family. Often the professionals who work together to help children and families at the end of life refer to themselves as the “palliative care team.” They may include the physician, the nurses, the chaplain, and the medical social worker and child-life specialist. A physician whose specialty comprises both ethics and pallia- tive care has stated that “the transition to pal- liative care involves the exchange of curative goals for comfort measures” (Finn, 2006, p. 86). This can feel like a massive shift to the family, who may or may not have been anticipating the ultimate decline of their child into death.

The most complete defi nition of palliative care comes from the National Hospice and Palliative Care Standards (http://www.nhpco .org/i4a/pages/index.cfm?pageid=4900). These standards state that pediatric palliative care is both a philosophy and an organized method for delivering care to children with life-threatening

Table 15.3 Causes of Death in 1- to 19-Year-Olds

All Children 1–19 Years Old Children 1–19 Years Old with Chronic Health Conditions

1. Accidents 1. Malignancy

2. Assault 2. Neuromuscular

3. Malignancy 3. Cardiovascular

Source: “A Key Step in Advancing Care for America’s Children,” by S. Freibert and S. Huff, 2009, Newsline, pp. 9–13. Retrieved from www.dcppcc.org/dp/sites/default/fi les/A%20Key%20Step%20in%20Advancing%20Care%20for%20 Americas%20Children.pdf

ch15.indd 382ch15.indd 382 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

Social Work With Children and Adolescents With Medical Conditions 383

conditions. It involves effective management of pain and other distressing symptoms together with the provision of psychosocial and spiri- tual care. Pediatric palliative care is planned and delivered through the collaborative efforts of a transdisciplinary team, including the child, family, and caregivers, which attempts to guide and assist the child and family in making de- cisions that enable them to work toward their goals in whatever time they have.

End-of-Life Care in the Emergency Room

Some young people have serious accidents that are life threatening and result in their admission to the emergency room or the pe- diatric intensive care unit. Examples of such injuries include falls that cause massive trau- matic head injury or car or bicycle accidents that cause signifi cant injury that may result in death either during or following surgery. Families typically are shocked and may not believe the news that their child will not re- cover. Fortunately, emergency rooms have established protocols for sudden bereavement (see Heggar, 1993; Meyer, 2009). These pro- tocols involve using clear and direct com- munication with the parents about the fact that the youth died despite all medical efforts (Wind, 2009). Often the facts of the death will have to be repeated compassionately until families understand what happened. Many families also benefi t from the assistance of the hospital chaplain or other clergy at this very diffi cult time.

The role of the social worker in situations of sudden death may include the completion of required paperwork and notifi cation of the family physician, providing transportation and other details, helping family members deal with their feelings, and fi nding follow-up be- reavement care. These circumstances are very stressful for everyone, including the medi- cal team. The social worker and others must pay attention to their own feelings and fi nd appropriate ways to avoid or mitigate vicari- ous traumatization, which is discussed later in this chapter.

End-of-Life Care in the Pediatric Intensive Care Unit

Play therapy has been used to ease the pain of dying children, as depicted in a moving case example of 7-year-old Nathan, who was hos- pitalized with a life-threatening illness (Shelby, 2010). The child enjoyed playing on his bed with miniature castles, fi gurines, and horses and would create play scenes involving battles with powerful knights and invading armies. The play therapist observed the play and made some comments about its main themes. In Nathan’s play, the brave men always won, and this rep- resented his own battle and hope for survival.

In time, as Nathan grew weaker, he wanted to play only with the horses and developed a special relationship with one white stallion that he said was going to escape. Soon before his death, Nathan told the horse that he would have to go on without him. This poignant story illustrates how a child used play to prepare for his own death and how the play therapist in her role as witness gave the child the support and understanding he needed.

Methods to Help Families and Youth at the End of Life

The death of a young person is very hard to ac- cept, but the reality is that children and ado- lescents die, and social workers and others can play an important role in making the dying pro- cess dignifi ed and meaningful for all concerned. Some of the methods that should be considered in facilitating a death with dignity include:

• Acknowledging the spiritual needs of the dying person

• Facilitating a life review and identify a legacy

• Creating meaningful rituals

• Connecting with family, friends, and com- munity

Spiritual Needs of the Dying Person

The word spirituality refers to the universal need to understand what lays beyond human experience, including the meaning of life, the

ch15.indd 383ch15.indd 383 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

384 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

quest for vision, and some kind of inspiration (Thayer, 2009). Although the spiritual needs of children may be overlooked or minimized, professionals who work with children with chronic illnesses have found that young peo- ple often create personal narratives about their unique struggles with illness and their efforts to fi nd meaning in their experiences.

Facilitating a Life Review and Identifying a Legacy

Children, like adults, often have the need to feel that they have made some difference through their actions and that others will remember them because of some of their special qualities or talents. It can be very self-affi rming for the social worker to offer to help children create a book of memories, which contains the activi- ties and messages that they want other people to think about when they remember them. For some children, this may involve their accom- plishments in sports, music, cooking, or taking care of animals. Whatever is of special impor- tance should be included in the children’s own words, if possible. The social worker can in- troduce this subject by saying that sometimes she helps kids make a very special and per- sonal book about their lives, and, if the child wants to do that, they can begin by talking about one thing about which the child is es- pecially proud. The social worker can record the child’s statements, make a video, or write down what the child says. The social worker can encourage the child to give this document to parents or family.

Creating Meaningful Rituals

A ritual can be created to serve the needs of terminally ill children. For those who are re- ligious, it may involve saying a prayer and singing a special comforting song. Often the parents may be involved and will be able to suggest and participate in meaningful activi- ties with the child. For example, a child-life music therapist helped a young patient cope with his pain by helping him to write a song that he used to ameliorate his discomfort. To the tune of “Rain, Rain, Go Away,” young Billy rewrote the words as “Pain, pain, go

away. Don’t come back another day. Little Billy wants to play, so pain go away.” As his pain increased, he added different stanzas to his song. This ritual soothed the boy, and as he lay dying the music therapist visited his bed- side and sang him his song. It brought comfort both to the caregivers and to his parents.

Pastoral care also can provide the family of a dying child with the opportunity to express their unique rituals of grief. Understanding and being open to divergent cultural and reli- gious ritual helps the patient and family cope during the last stages of life.

Connecting With Family, Friends, and Community

It is very important for parents and siblings to have quiet, intimate times with a child who has a life-threatening illness. These times help parents with the anticipatory grieving process, and they help the child feel a sense of safety and connection. The child should be reassured that the parents will try to see to it that the child does not experience pain, and they may wish to let the child know that some medica- tions that reduce the pain also may make them drowsy. Both the child and the family should be encouraged to express their love for one another with verbal assurance that they will always remember these special moments.

ISSUES AND CHALLENGES FOR THE MEDICAL SOCIAL WORKER

Working on a daily basis with youth who have medical challenges and their families is not easy. Some young clients will have physi- cal limitations or conditions that will affect their lives forever, and the social worker must fi nd a way to emphasize what the child can achieve rather than focusing on all the limita- tions. Many children respond favorably to this positive approach because children usually do not want to view themselves as having physi- cal limitations. Autobiographies written by chronically ill or terminally ill young people give numerous examples of a positive frame

ch15.indd 384ch15.indd 384 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

Social Work With Children and Adolescents With Medical Conditions 385

of mind that others may label as “transfor- mational.” For example, Matthew Stepanek (2001) wrote poems conveying his sense of hope for the future despite his serious and ter- minal diagnosis of muscular dystrophy.

Not all social workers will be able to func- tion well knowing that a certain percentage of their young clients will die over the course of weeks or months. Although most social work positions include a certain amount of stress, the reality of trauma, pain, and loss pervade the medical fi eld. This fi eld of practice clearly makes special demands on its profession- als and requires that they learn to function in highly stressful environments.

Social workers have different methods for dealing with this stress. Some take pride in the fact that they have helped a young person and family achieve a peaceful, dignifi ed death. Sometimes a child or family member who ex- presses faith in religion and belief in an after- life makes the separation process inspirational despite the pain.

Some pediatric care facilities encourage members of the medical staff to attend a child’s funeral. Typically hospitals have a protocol for reaching out to families of deceased children. The end-of-life helping process often involves sharing the experience of loss with others who also participated in providing comfort to the child and the family. Therefore, some hospi- tals have memorial services for staff, other patients, and family members. The ritual of a remembrance service is critical to helping the staff of caregivers cope with the loss of the patient. Children who have been in care for a long period of time develop relationships with their caregivers, and giving those caregivers the opportunity to express their thoughts and feelings helps them to grieve the loss.

Avoiding Vicarious Traumatization

The high degree of stress involved in trying to help children and families deal with the special circumstances of a medical condition can be very taxing to all involved, including the professional helpers. Research suggests that all medical procedures are traumatizing to

children (Lovett, 2010), yet they also may be traumatizing for practitioners.

The term vicarious traumatization refers to the experience of the helper who identifi es and empathizes with the physical or psycho- logical pain of the client to the extent that the practitioner becomes traumatized. The expres- sion was developed in 1990 by McCain and Pearlman to describe the impact on therapists of working with traumatized individuals be- cause of the empathetic engagement of thera- pists with their clients. Often the helpers are not aware of their own traumatization, but their behavior and views about the world and their work may change in a negative direction. For example, a social worker who previously had felt proud and enthusiastic about working in a children’s cancer facility began to fear for the well-being of the patients because the doc- tors did not seem to be able to restore all of them to their previous levels of functioning. The social worker began to dread returning to work on Mondays, and her family was increas- ingly aware that she seemed irritable and angry with them for no discernible reason. She was exercising less, watching television more, and drinking excessive amounts of alcohol. For- tunately, a staff training session on the topic of vicarious traumatization helped this social worker realize that she had become a victim of the condition. She made a promise to herself that she would follow some of the guidelines for avoiding vicarious traumatization that were discussed in the training (Gamble, 2002; Ryan & Cunningham, 2007; Webb, 2009). These guidelines are:

• Create boundaries between home and work and maintain a personal (as opposed to only a professional) identity.

• Seek supervision from professionals who understand the stresses of health social work with children and families.

• Locate professional colleagues who work in medical settings and who will agree to meet together twice a month to discuss the stresses and trauma of hospital work and who will support each other through a mu- tual debriefi ng process.

ch15.indd 385ch15.indd 385 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

386 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

• Spend time with children who do not have medical challenges to help maintain per- spective on the wide range of typical child and youth behavior.

• Engage in rejuvenating experiences and re- lationships.

• Find a way to relieve stress, such as prayer, meditation, listening to music, gardening, talking a walk, or engaging in physical ex- ercise.

• Accept one’s own limitations and the re- ality that medicine cannot save everyone from pain and untimely death.

• Take comfort in knowing that the children and families whom the social worker helps received the best efforts of the medical team.

Practitioners who follow these guidelines will be more likely to separate their work and per- sonal lives and, as a consequence, return to their work with a sense of optimism and hope.

CONCLUSION

The role of the social worker in dealing with children and youth with serious medical con- ditions is very complex and challenging. On a daily basis, health social workers must deal with systems (both the child’s family and organizations such as the school) on behalf of clients who are in pain and whose young age makes it diffi cult for them to advocate for themselves. The social worker attempts to facilitate the best possible interventions to enhance the youth’s quality of life within the constraints and reality of the medical situation.

The social worker often serves a very im- portant role as someone with whom the fam- ily can discuss the implications and prognosis of the child’s condition. A strong bond often develops between the family and the social worker, and this helping relationship may serve to assist the family through many diffi - cult phases of their child’s illness. Because of the intensity of the situation, a degree of in- timacy may develop that comforts the family

and permits them to focus on their child be- cause they feel emotionally stronger by virtue of the social worker’s assistance. By contrast, the social worker’s empathy with the child and the family may create an unforeseen negative effect on the practitioner and, at times, result in the social worker feeling a degree of trau- matization. This work is diffi cult, and self-care is essential for the social worker to preserve his or her mental health.

Collaboration with other professionals is critical in carrying out the multifaceted respon- sibilities associated with serving youth with medical challenges and their families. Work- ing with a transdisciplinary team on the child’s behalf means that the burden and responsibil- ity is shared. However, the high level of stress associated with daily exposure to end-of-life issues may exhaust and deplete the emotional resources of social workers, whose very job makes them vulnerable to the debilitating ef- fects of vicarious traumatization. Thus, social workers are at risk for empathizing with the family’s pain without addressing their personal grief and loss related to the frequent exposure to end-of-life realities and stressors. Hospitals and other facilities that deal with dying patients must acknowledge the risk for their staff and provide training on methods for coping with this inevitable component of medical work. Fortunately, there are well-documented meth- ods of self-care to prevent the phenomenon of burnout that sometimes accompanies work in this fi eld. The goal for health social workers is to feel a sense of pride and achievement in carrying out a diffi cult job in a compassionate manner that conveys meaning and dignity to children and families who are coping with a serious medical condition.

SUGGESTED LEARNING EXERCISES

Learning Exercise 15.1

Find a partner and discuss the challenges faced by a health social worker working with a pedi- atric population. After these conversations, the

ch15.indd 386ch15.indd 386 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

Social Work With Children and Adolescents With Medical Conditions 387

pairs should report back to the larger group about their discussion. Sample questions to include in this discussion are:

• What unique issues arise when working with children in health-care settings?

• How is working with children in health- care settings different from working with adults?

• When working with children in health-care settings, what would you do if a parent does not want to disclose a diagnosis or progno- sis to a child?

• How is working with an adolescent or young adult different from working with a young child?

• How can a social worker learn all the specialized medical language to communi- cate with one’s colleagues in other profes- sions?

• How can a social worker respond to some- one who thinks that health social work- ers spend most of their time on discharge planning?

Learning Exercise 15.2

Do you think that vicarious traumatization is an appropriate term for describing the burnout that some health social workers report experi- encing? If you noticed one of your colleagues who seemed uncharacteristically abrasive and unable to connect effectively with patients and their families, how could you broach the topic and suggest that the colleague seek help? De- scribe your personal plan to avoid vicarious traumatization.

SUGGESTED RESOURCES

Child-Youth/Family-Related and Health- Related Professional Organizations

American Academy of Pediatrics—www .aap.org

American Art Therapy Association—www .arttherapy.org

American Cancer Society—www.cancer.org/

American Medical Association—www .ama-assn.org

American Music Therapy Association— www.musictherapy.org

American Professional Society on the Abuse of Children—www.apsac.org

American Psychological Association— www.apa.org

Association for Play Therapy, Inc.— www .a4pt.org

Association of Pediatric Oncology Social Workers—www.aposw.org

Asthma and Allergy Foundation of America —www.aafa.org

Brain Injury Association www.biausa.org Children’s Neuroblastoma Cancer

Foundation—[email protected] Child Welfare League of America—www

.cwla.org Eye Movement Desensitization and

Reprocessing International Association— www.emdria.org

International Society for Traumatic Stress Studies—www.istss.org

Leukemia and Lymphoma Society—www .lls.org

Make-A-Wish Foundation—www.wish .org/

National Association of Perinatal Social Workers—www.napsw.org

National Association of Social Workers— www.naswdc.org

National Childhood Cancer Foundation— www.nccf.org

National Parent Network on Disabilities— www.npnd.org

Starlight Starbright Children’s Foundation— www.starbrightworld.org

Resources for Youth and Families American Cancer Society (ACS)—www

.cancer.org This site can provide the telephone

number of local ACS offi ces. It provides general information related to disease and may provide reimbursement for transpor- tation, medicine, and medical supplies. This organization also organizes summer camps for children age 6 to 19.

ch15.indd 387ch15.indd 387 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

388 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Believe in Tomorrow—www.believeintomor row.org

This national, nonprofi t organization has unique programs that provide sup- port to children and their families facing cancer. This program offers respite vaca- tions to families with an ill child.

Cancer Care, Inc.—www.cancercare.org This national nonprofi t agency offers

a range of support services including counseling to cancer patients and their families, fi nancial assistance, and trans- portation.

Children’s Hopes and Dreams Foundation —www.childrenswishes.org

The foundation provides educa- tional booklets for terminally and chronically ill children who suffer any kind of illness, such as cancer, cystic fi brosis, acquired immunodefi ciency syndrome, Hodgkin’s lymphoma, leu- kemia, muscular dystrophy, and sickle cell disease.

National Children’s Cancer Society (NCCS) —www.nationalchildrenscancersociety .com

NCCS assists by providing some fi - nancial assistance for medical treatment, lodging, and travel.

Support Groups for Children, Teens, and Families

List of support groups compiled by the U.S. Department of Health and Human Services—healthfinder.gov/scripts /SearchContext.asp?topic=833&section=3

Gilda’s Club—www.gildasclub.org This free cancer support community

offers a wide range of therapeutic activi- ties and educational programs. It offers teen support groups and Noogieland, a magical space with fun activities and support for children.

Starlight Starbright Children’s Foundation —www.starlight.org, www.myspace.com /starlightfriends

Starlight has launched My Life, an extension of the Starbright World on- line social network for seriously ill teens

and teen  siblings. My Life was devel- oped specifi cally to help teens with life- threatening illnesses acknowledge and cope with the possibility of death.

Internet Teen Support Groups Group Loop—www.grouploop.org I’m Too Young for This—i2y.com/ Planet Cancer—www.planetcancer.org Teens Living with Cancer—www.teenliving

withcancer.org

For Siblings Supersibs!—www.supersibs.org

Camps Camp Make A Dream—www.campdream

.org This camp offers a free weeklong

camp for patients and their families. Camp Sunshine—www.campsunshine.org

This camp offers free weeklong camping experience for patients and families.

For Parents and Teachers Learning Disabilities OnLine—www.ldonline

.com

Parenting Tips, Activities for Children, and Current Research about Learning Disabilities

Cancervive—www.cancervive.org/ This group is dedicated to providing

support, public education, and advocacy to those who have experienced cancer.

Starlight Children’s Foundation—www .starlight.org/sicklecell

This foundation offers a comprehen- sive menu of outpatient, hospital-based, and Internet resources that provide on- going support for children with sickle cell anemia and families.

Miscellaneous Adapting Motor Vehicles for People with

Disabilities—www.nhtsa.dot.gov/cars/ rules/adaptive/brochure/index.html

ch15.indd 388ch15.indd 388 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

Social Work With Children and Adolescents With Medical Conditions 389

Books and Workbooks Alexander-Azlin, M. L. (2000). Beyond the

rainbow. Enumclaw, WA: Wine Press. Best, C. (2002). Goose’s story. New York,

NY: Farrar, Straus & Giroux. Brown, B. S. (1997). Oliver’s high fi ve.

Albuquerque, NM: Health Press. Brown, L. K., & Brown, M. (1996). When

dinosaurs die: A guide to understanding death. New York, NY: Little, Brown.

Carion, H. S. (2008). Sixty-fi ve roses: A sister’s memoir. Toronto, Canada: McArthur & Co.

Foss, K. S. (1996). The problem with hair. Omaha, NB: Centering Corporation.

Heegaard, M. E. (2003). Living well with my serious illness. Lanham, MD: Fairview Press.

Gerner, M. (1990). For bereaved grandpar- ents. Omaha, NE: Centering Corporation.

Gordan, M. A. (1999). Let’s talk about sickle cell anemia. New York, NY: Rosen. 

Gouss, D. J., & Leeds, E. M. Tool box of hope. Atlanta, GA: Healing Hearts Com- munications.

Keane, N., Hobbie, W., & Ruccione, K. (2006) Childhood cancer survivors: A practical guide to your future (2nd ed.). Sebastopol, CA: O’Reilly.

Keene, N. (2003). Chemo, craziness, and comfort. Kensington, MD: Candlelighters.

Keene, N. (Ed.) (2003). Educating the child with cancer. Kensington, MD: Candle- lighters.

Klein, S. D., & Schive, K. (2001). You will dream new dreams: Inspiring personal stories by parents of children with dis- abilities. New York, NY: Kensington Books.

Krishner, T., Levine, A. & Westcott. B. (1992). Kathy’s hats: A story of hope. Atlanta, GA: Whitman & Co.

McCue, K. (1996). How to help children through a parent’s serious illness. New York, NY: St Martin’s Press.

Miles, B. S., & Wong, N. (2006). Imagine a rainbow: A child’s guide to soothing pain. Washington, DC: Magination Press.

Mills, J. C. (2003). Little tree: A story for children with serious medical problems. Washington, DC: Magination Press.

North, S. (2003). My brand new leg. Thou- sand Oaks, CA: Northstar Entertainment.

O’Toole, D. (1995). Facing change: Falling apart and coming together again in the teen years. Burnsville, NC: Compassion Press.

O’Toole, D., & Corr, J. (2004). Helping children grieve and grow: A guide for those who care. Omaha, NB: Centering Corporation.

Platt, A. (2003). Hope and destiny: A pa- tient’s and parent’s guide to sickle cell disease. Munster, IN: Hilton.

Sacerdote, A., Platt, A, and Sacerdote, A. (2002). Hope and destiny: The patient and parent’s guide to sickle cell dis- ease and sickle cell trait. Munster, IL: Hilton.

Salloum, A. (1998). Reactions: A workbook to help young people who are experienc- ing trauma and grief. Omaha, NE: Cen- tering Corporation.

Samuel-Trailsman, E. (1992). Fire in my heart, ice in my veins: A journal for teens experiencing loss. Omaha, NE: Centering Corporation.

Scherago, M. G. (1987). Sibling grief. Redmond, WA: Medic.

Schmidt, R. C. (2003). My book about can- cer: A workbook to help children deal with the diagnosis and treatment of a fa- ther with cancer. Pittsburgh, PA: Oncol- ogy Nursing Society.

Schultz, C. M. (2002).Why, Charlie Brown, why? A story about what happens when a friend is very ill. New York, NY: Ballantine Books.

Schwiebert, P., & DeKlyen, C. (1999). Tear soup. Portland, OR: ACTA Publications.

Shavatt, D., & E. (2002). My grieving jour- ney book. Mahwah, NJ: Paulist Press.

Silverman, J. (1999). Help me say good- bye. Lanham, MD: Fairview Press.

Sonnenblick, J. (2006). Drums, girls, and dangerous pie. New York, NY: Scholastic.

ch15.indd 389ch15.indd 389 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

390 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Temes, R. (1992). The empty place: A child’s guide through grief. Far Hills, NJ: New Horizon Press.

REFERENCES

Akinbami, L. J., Moorman, J. E., Garbe, P. L., & Sondik, E. J. (2009). Status of childhood asthma in the United States, 1980–2007. Pediatrics, 123, S131–S145.

Barakat, L., Alderfer, M., & Kazak, A. (2006). Posttraumatic growth in adolescent survivors of cancer and their families. Journal of Pediatric Psychology, 31, 413–419.

Brown, R. T., Daly, B. P., & Rickel, A. U. (2007). Chronic illness in children and adolescents. Cambridge, MA: Hogrefe & Huber.

Clarke-Steffen, L. (1993). A model of family transition to living with childhood cancer. Cancer Practice, 1(4), 285–292.

Clay, D. L. (2004). Helping schoolchildren with chronic health conditions: A practical guide. New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Corr, C. A. (2009). Children’s hospice care. In K. J. Doka & A. S. Tucci, Living with grief: Children and adolescents (pp. 59–74). Washington, DC: Hospice Foundation of America.

CureSearch. (2008). Healthy living after treatment for childhood Cancer, Educational issues, Version 3.0. Retrieved from www.childrensoncologygroup.org

Dell Clark, C. (2010). The emotional impact of a young person’s illness on the family. In N. B. Webb (Ed.), Helping children and adolescents with chronic and serious medical conditions: A strengths-based approach (pp. 21–34). Hoboken, NJ: Wiley.

Finn, J. J. (2006). A palliative ethic of care: Clinical wisdom at life’s end. Boston, MA: Jones & Bartlett.

Friebert, S., & Huff, S. (2009). A key step in advancing care for America’s children. Newsline (pp. 9–13). Retrieved from http://www.dcppcc.org/dp/sites/default/fi les/A% 20Key%20Step%20in%20Advancing%20Care%20 for%20Americas%20Children.pdf

Gamble, S. J. (2002). Self-care for bereavement counselors. In N. B. Webb (Ed.) Helping bereaved children: A handbook for practitioners (2nd ed., pp. 346–362). New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Goodman, R. (2007). Living beyond the crisis of childhood cancer. In N. B. Webb (Ed.), Play therapy with children in crisis. Individual, group, and family treatment (pp. 197–227). New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Hart, R., & Rollins, J. (2011). Therapeutic activities for children and teens coping with health issues. Hoboken, NJ: Wiley.

Heggar, A. (1993). Emergency room: Individuals, families and groups in trauma. Social Work in Health Care, 18(3/4), 161–168.

Helmick, C. G., Felson, D. T., Lawrence, R. C., Gabriel, S., Hirsch, R., Kwoh, C. K., . . . Stone, J. H. (2008). Estimates of the prevalence of arthritis and other rheumatic conditions in the United States. Arthritis & Rheumatism, 58(1), 15–25.

Himelstein, B. P., Hilden, J. M., Boldt, A. M., & Weissman, D. (2004). Medical progress—pediatric palliative care. New England Journal of Medicine, 350(17), 1752–1762.

Huegel, K. (1998). Young people and chronic illness: True stories, help, and hope. Minneapolis, MN: Free Spirit.

Keene, N. (Ed.). (2003). Educating the child with cancer: A guide for parents and teachers. Kensington, MD: Candlelighters Childhood Cancer Foundation.

Krementz, J. (1992). How it feels to fi ght for your life. New York, NY: Simon & Schuster.

Leukemia & Lymphoma Society. (2007). Fertility: Fact Sheet No. 23. Retrieved from www.leukemia-lymphoma.org /attachments/National/br_1192020700.pdf

Loewy, J. V., & Stewart, K. (2004). Music therapy to help traumatized youth and caregivers. In N. B. Webb (Ed.), Mass trauma and violence: Helping families and children cope (pp. 191–213). New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Lovett, J. (2010). A behavioral pediatrician’s perspective on helping children recover from traumatic medical experiences. In N. B. Webb (Ed.), Helping children and adolescents with chronic and serious medical conditions: A strengths-based approach (pp. 59–72). Hoboken, NJ: Wiley.

Mariotto, A. B., Rowland, J. H., Yabroff, K. R., Scoppa, S., Hachey, M., Ries, L., & Feuer, E. J. (2009). Long-term survivors of childhood cancers in the United States. Cancer Epidemiology, Biomarkers & Prevention, 18(4), 1033–1040.

McCain, L. A., & Pearlman, L. (1990). Vicarious traumatization. A framework for understanding the psychological effects of working with victims. Journal of Traumatic Stress, 3(1), 131–149.

Meyer, E. C. (2009). Hospital treatment of children and youth with life-threatening conditions. In N. B. Webb (Ed.), Helping children and adolescents with chronic and serious medical conditions: A strengths-based approach (pp. 269–284). Hoboken, NJ: Wiley.

National Children’s Cancer Society. (2008). Beyond the cure: The mountain you have climbed. Saint Louis, MO: National Children’s Cancer Society.

Oftedahl, E., Benedict, R., & Katcher, M. L. (2004). National survey of children with special health care needs: Wisconsin-specifi c data. Wisconsin Medical Journal, 103(5), 88–90.

Ogden, C. L., Carroll, M. D., Curtin, L. R., Lamb, M. M., & Flegal, K. M. (2010). Prevalence of high body mass index in US children and adolescents, 2007–2008. JAMA, 303(3), 242–249.

Ryan, K., & Cunningham, M. (2007). Helping the helpers. Vicarious traumatization of play therapists working with traumatized children. In N. B. Webb (Ed.), Play

ch15.indd 390ch15.indd 390 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

Social Work With Children and Adolescents With Medical Conditions 391

therapy with children in crisis. Individual, group, and family treatment 3d ed. (pp. 443–460). New York, NY: Guilford Press.

SEARCH for Diabetes in Youth Study. (2006). The burden of diabetes mellitus among us youth: Prevalence estimates from the search for diabetes in youth study. Pediatrics, 118(4), 1510–1518.

Shelby, J. (2010). Cognitive-behavioral therapy and play therapy for childhood trauma and loss. In N. B. Webb (Ed.), Helping bereaved children: A handbook for practitioners (3rd ed., pp. 263–277). New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Stepanek, M. J. T. (2001). Journey through heartsongs. New York, NY: Hyperion.

Taylor, L., & Newacheck, P. W. (1992). Impact of childhood asthma on health. Pediatrics, 90, 657–662.

Thayer, P. (2009). Meeting the spiritual needs of children with chronic and life-threatening illness. In N. B. Webb (Ed.), Helping children and adolescents with chronic and serious medical conditions: A strengths- based approach (pp. 171–185). Hoboken, NJ: John Wiley & Sons.

Thompson, L. A., Knapp, C., Madden, V., & Shenkman, E. (2009). Pediatricians’ perceptions of and preferred

timing for pediatric palliative care. Pediatrics, 123, e777–e782.

U.S. Department of Health and Human Services. (n.d.) The Health Insurance Portability and Accountability Act of 1996 (HIPAA) Privacy and Security Rules. Retrieved from http://www.hhs.gov/ocr/privacy

Vilas, D. (2009). Child life practice in hospitals. In N. B. Webb (Ed.), Helping children and adolescents with chronic and serious medical conditions: A strengths- based approach (pp. 73–88). Hoboken, NJ: Wiley.

Webb, N. B. (2002). (Ed.). Helping bereaved children: A handbook for practitioners (2nd ed.). New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Webb, N. B. (2009). (Ed.). Helping children and adolescents with chronic and serious medical conditions: A strengths-based approach. Hoboken, NJ: Wiley.

Wind, L. H. (2009). Helping in the emergency room after accidents and traumatic injury. In N. B. Webb (Ed.), Helping children and adolescents with chronic and serious medical conditions: A strengths-based approach (pp. 285–301). Hoboken, NJ: Wiley.

ch15.indd 391ch15.indd 391 9/22/11 5:24 PM9/22/11 5:24 PM

392

16

Social Work With Older Adults in Health-Care Settings

SADHNA DIWAN, SHANTHA BALASWAMY, AND SANG E. LEE

Using a biopsychosocial approach to under- standing health and well-being, this chapter presents an introduction to issues relevant to social work with older adults in health-care settings. It focuses on knowledge needed by social workers to comprehensively assess the needs and resources of diverse groups of older people, provides a review of the avail- able empirical literature on various domains of assessment, and describes the nature of social work practice with older adults in a variety of health-care settings. The subject matter of this chapter overlaps to some degree with that of other chapters in this book, such as those ad- dressing policy, disability, nephrology, oncol- ogy, chronic illness, end-of-life care, and pain management, as they relate to work with older adults. The reader is urged to treat the chapters as overlapping bodies of information rather than discrete and separate entities.

Chapter Objectives • Provide an overview of the demographic

changes related to aging and their implica- tions for social workers in health care.

• Describe the concept of comprehensive ge- riatric assessments and discuss the available empirical literature on their effi cacy.

• Describe the core components of culturally relevant ethnogeriatric assessment.

• Using a biopsychosocial approach, provide an overview of the domains of knowledge necessary to assess the needs and resources of older adults.

• Describe the nature of social work practice with older adults in selected health-care

settings, such as primary care, inpatient acute care, hospital-to-home transitional care, home health care, and nursing homes.

• Discuss the issues and challenges related to working with older individuals that are en- countered by social workers in the current health-care environment.

CHARACTERISTICS OF THE AGING POPULATION

The Administration on Aging (AoA, 2010) provides these facts in A Profi le of Older Americans: 2009.

Demographics

• Older adults (people 65 years or older) numbered 38.9 million in 2008, represent- ing 12.8% of the U.S. population—about 1 in every 8 Americans.

• The older population itself is getting older, and in 2009, people reaching age 65 years had an average life expectancy of an ad- ditional 18.6 years (19.8 years for females and 17.1 years for males).

• The population of adults 65 years of age and older increased from 35 million in 2000 to 40 million in 2010 (a 15% in- crease), and is expected to increase to 55 million in 2020 (a 36% increase for that decade). The number of individuals 85 years and over is expected to more than double by 2030.

ch16.indd 392ch16.indd 392 9/22/11 5:38 PM9/22/11 5:38 PM

Social Work With Older Adults in Health-Care Settings 393

for people 65 years and older is more than three times the comparable rate for people of all ages.

• The average length of stay for people 65 years and older was 5.5 days; the comparable rate for people of all ages was 4.8 days. The average length of stay for older people has decreased by 5 days since 1980.

• Older people averaged more annual physi- cian offi ce visits than did younger people in 2005: 6.5 offi ce visits for those ages 65 to 74 and 7.7 offi ce visits for people older than 75 years; people age 45 to 65 years aver- aged only 3.9 offi ce visits during that year.

• In 2008, over 96% of older people reported that they did have a usual source of medi- cal care and only 2.4% said they failed to obtain needed medical care during the previous 12 months because of fi nancial barriers.

• Older Americans spent 12.5% of their total expenditures on health, more than twice the proportion spent by all consum- ers (5.9%).

Implications of Demographic Changes for Social Work in Health Care

Within the next decade, a larger proportion of individuals seen in all parts of the health-care system (e.g., primary care, specialty care, in- patient hospital, nursing home) will be older adults. Given the shortened length of stay in hospitals and the changing nature of nurs- ing home stays (short stay, postacute care), there will be a heavy emphasis on appropriate post–hospital discharge planning and develop- ment of community-based care models to help maintain older adults in community settings. These community-based care models will need to address physical, functional, psycho- logical, and social needs of older adults and their families, and social workers will need to pay increasing attention to the development of culturally competent models of care to ad- dress the needs of the growing number of mi- nority elders.

• In 2008, 19.6% of people age 65 years and older were racial and ethnic minori- ties—8.3% were African Americans, His- panics represented 6.8%; about 3.4% were Asian or Pacifi c Islander; and fewer than 1% were American Indian or Native Alaskan. About 0.6% of people age 65 years and older identifi ed themselves as being of two or more races.

Health and Health Care

• Most older people have at least one chronic health condition, and many have multiple conditions. Among the most frequently oc- curring conditions for the time period 2005 to 2007 were hypertension (41%), diagnosed arthritis (49%), all types of heart disease (31%), any cancer (22%), diabetes (18%), and sinusitis (15%).

• In 2008, 39% of noninstitutionalized older people rated their health as excellent or very good. Among the older population, African Americans (25%), American Indians/Alaska Natives (23.2%), and Hispanics (28%) were less likely to rate their health as excellent or very good than were White (41.8%) or Asian Americans (35.2%).

• In 2008, 38% of older people reported hav- ing some type of disability (i.e., diffi culty in hearing, vision, cognition, ambulation, self-care, or independent living). Some of these disabilities may be relatively minor, but others result in the need for assistance in meeting important personal needs.

• Limitations on ability to perform specifi c activities of daily living (ADLs) because of chronic conditions increase with age. Fifty- six percent of people older than 80 years reported a severe disability, and 29% of this population reported that they needed assis- tance. Disability status and reported health status are strongly correlated. Among those people 65 years and older with a severe disability, 64% report their health as fair or poor.

• In 2006, over 13.1 million people 65 years and older were discharged after short stays in hospitals. The rate of hospital discharge

ch16.indd 393ch16.indd 393 9/22/11 5:38 PM9/22/11 5:38 PM

394 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

As noted by the Bureau of Labor Statistics (2010):

[G]rowth of medical and public health social workers is expected to be about 22 percent, which is much faster than the average for all occupations. One of the major contributing factors is the rise in the elderly population. These social workers will be needed to as- sist in fi nding the best care and assistance for the aging, as well as to support their families. Employment opportunities for social work- ers with backgrounds in gerontology should be excellent, particularly in the growing numbers of assisted-living and senior-living communities. The expanding senior popula- tion also will spur demand for social workers in nursing homes, long-term care facilities, home care agencies, and hospices. (p. 3)

Although Medicare has enabled access to health care for those 65 years and older, older adults have signifi cantly higher out-of-pocket expenditures related to health care, especially for prescription drugs, compared with other groups, and older adults spend a greater pro- portion of their expenditures on health care (AoA, 2010). Policy advocacy and resource development for health-care products and ser- vices also will remain important tasks for so- cial workers in health-care settings.

COMPREHENSIVE GERIATRIC ASSESSMENT

Comprehensive assessment of needs and re- sources has become a fundamental aspect of providing care to older people. The princi- ples of comprehensive geriatric assessments (CGAs) in health care originated in England in the 1930s in the work of Marjory Warren, who created a specialized geriatric assessment unit in a workhouse infi rmary that housed a large number of older patients who were ne- glected and bedridden (Wieland & Hirth, 2003). Through systematic assessments, War- ren determined who might benefi t from medi- cal and rehabilitation efforts. She remobilized

a majority of these patients and in many cases discharged them to their homes. These experi- ences led her to become a leading proponent of comprehensive assessment of older adults before they were placed in chronic hospital or nursing home facilities (Wieland & Hirth, 2003).

Over time, the National Health Service in the United Kingdom established geriatric assessment units as a point of entry into the health-care system, and these assessments were offered to all older patients through universal health coverage. Many other devel- oped countries (e.g., Canada, Australia, Italy, the Netherlands, Norway) have followed the British model (Urdangarin, 2000). In the United States, however, the use of comprehen- sive geriatric assessment has been restricted to academic centers and Veterans Administration (VA) hospitals (Urdangarin, 2000).

The concept of a CGA in health-care set- tings such as primary care, inpatient care, and nursing homes is based on the assumption that older adults simultaneously experience prob- lems in multiple domains—physical, social, and psychological—which results in many unmet health-care needs. These problems and needs require a more thorough assessment than what is possible in a routine diagnostic examination provided by the physician. The hallmark of a CGA is that it is performed by a multidisciplinary or transdisciplinary team consisting primarily of physicians, nurses, and social workers and can include specialists from fi elds such as occupational and physical ther- apy, nutrition, pharmacy, audiology, and psy- chology (Agostini, Baker, & Bogardus, 2001; American Geriatrics Society, n.d.; Wieland & Hirth, 2003).

According to the American Geriatrics So- ciety (n.d.):

[A] geriatric assessment is more involved and comprehensive than the standard medi- cal exam and includes a health “history” and a physical exam, often also including a review or assessment of the person’s activi- ties of daily living (ADLs), medications, im- munizations, mobility, cognition and signs of

ch16.indd 394ch16.indd 394 9/22/11 5:38 PM9/22/11 5:38 PM

Social Work With Older Adults in Health-Care Settings 395

anxiety or depression. . . . While the geriatri- cian often serves as the “point person,” each member of the geriatrics team is a skilled health professional. All play an important role in the proper assessment and care of an older patient. (p. 1)

Although a CGA is very helpful in mak- ing a diagnosis and understanding a patient’s needs, the value of a comprehensive assess- ment in improving patient outcomes often is limited because the assessment team does not have control over the implementation of the recommendations and treatment plan, which usually are initiated by a primary care physi- cian. Researchers in the United States have noted that many of the recommendations made during the assessment were not followed either by the primary care physician or the patient (Shah, Maly, Frank, Hirsch, & Reuben, 1997; Urdangarin, 2000), resulting in unmet needs and compromised health situations.

Because of the disconnect between the as- sessment and the actual treatment or care pro- vided to the patient, in the United States, there has been increasing recognition that needs assessment should be combined with care management. For this reason, the VA has ad- opted the geriatric evaluation and management (GEM) approach as a basic component of clin- ical geriatric care (Urdangarin, 2000). The VA system fi rst established GEM units in inpatient hospital care and later in ambulatory care to identify, assess, and treat frail and older veter- ans with disabilities in the system who were at risk for institutionalization and failing to ben- efi t from usual care (Wieland & Hirth, 2003). Early studies of the GEM approach within the VA system suggested that it was highly cost ef- fective, leading to its adoption throughout the system. By the mid-1990s, over three fourths of the 172 VA medical centers reported having a GEM program (Wieland & Hirth, 2003).

In GEM programs, patients receive most of their care from the GEM team. The team con- sists of (a) the physician, who provides medi- cal care and generally supervises the team; (b) the nurse, who provides some medical care and education about the condition or disease,

treatments and medications, and the use of home health and emergency services; and (c) the social worker, who provides psychosocial counseling for the patient and caregiver; refer- ral to appropriate fi nancial, social, psychologi- cal, and community services; and appropriate discharge planning if the patient is hospital- ized (Urdangarin, 2000).

The principles of GEM have been incor- porated and tested in other care coordination models, such as Geriatric Resources for As- sessment and Care of Elders (GRACE) and the Program of All Inclusive Care for the Elderly. Although the implementation of comprehen- sive geriatric assessment and evaluation has increased in other inpatient units and outpa- tient departments, 80% of Medicare benefi - ciaries do not have access to such programs (see American Geriatrics Society, n.d.). Some of the barriers to providing this service have been the diffi culty in obtaining adequate reim- bursement for it, the lack of trained geriatric physicians to run these units, and the diffi - culty in maintaining interdisciplinary teams (Wieland & Hirth, 2003). Another issue has been the mixed evidence on the effectiveness of these approaches in infl uencing a variety of outcomes, such as functional status, cognitive ability, affect, use of services, cost of care, sat- isfaction with care, and mortality.

The most commonly reported positive out- comes of CGA and GEM are a reduction in mortality, favorable effects on cognitive and physical functioning, increased likelihood of living at home, and decreased likelihood of hospitalization during follow-up (Urdangarin, 2000). The attempt to move this fi eld forward through research on CGA and GEM has been limited by the diversity of patients in the in- terventions, the differing nature of both in- terventions as well as “usual care” practices, the inherent complexity of geriatric evaluation and management, inconsistent measurement of outcomes and use of assessment tools, and the diffi culty in replicating successful single- site studies (Van Craen et al., 2010; Wieland & Hirth, 2003). A multisite controlled trial is needed to address some of these diffi culties. Despite these issues, comprehensive geriatric

ch16.indd 395ch16.indd 395 9/22/11 5:38 PM9/22/11 5:38 PM

396 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

assessment has become an accepted compo- nent of geriatric primary care and inpatient consultation services, especially with the spread of managed health-care programs. Box 16.1 describes the GRACE model of assess- ment and care coordination (Counsell et al., 2007) in which social worker and nurse prac- titioner teams collaborate with a larger inter- disciplinary team and primary care physicians to assess, develop, and implement individual- ized care plans for low-income seniors. The model has been recognized and described in the Healthcare Innovations Exchange of the Agency for Health Care Research and Quality (AHRQ, 2010) and is being disseminated to other health-care systems.

According to R. L. Kane (2000a, p. 3), “the key to good assessment is using a strong con- ceptual model” that should identify not only specifi c client attributes of interest but also re- lated factors, such as the physical environment and informal support. Using the biopsychoso- cial lens, various domains of assessment, their infl uence on the lives of older individuals, and the implications of their inclusion for social work practice are discussed. Table 16.1 at the end of the section on assessment domains pro- vides a list of tools that are commonly used to assess patients and families in each of the do- mains. Readers are referred to R. L. Kane and R. A. Kane (2000) for details on the items and psychometric properties of the scales.

Physiological Well-Being and Health

Assessment of an individual’s health status is the most basic feature of a comprehensive evaluation in health-care settings. As indi- viduals age, the prevalence of chronic disease conditions increases signifi cantly, with the most common health problems being arthritis, cardiovascular disease, cancer, and diabetes (AoA, 2010). Beyond the genetic or familial predispositions that contribute to developing these chronic conditions, all of these diseases or conditions infl uence and are infl uenced by what individuals do or don’t do in their daily lives (Centers for Disease Control and Pre- vention [CDC], 2004). Other common health

measures that are important to assess are an older individual’s overall health status; pres- ence of pain; nutritional status; risk for fall- ing; incontinence; sleep; alcohol and drug use; dental or oral health; and sensory percep- tion, especially vision and hearing (McInnis- Dittrich, 2009). These health conditions may signifi cantly infl uence other domains, such as lowering psychological well-being, limit- ing functional ability, and diminishing quality of life. For example, arthritis can be painful, limit mobility, and lead to depression. Simi- larly, complications from diabetes can result in a loss of limbs that requires modifi cation of the home, access to assistive devices, and personal care assistance. Social workers generally are called on to help older individuals and their families address these issues.

One important problem associated with having multiple health conditions is polyphar- macy; that is, an individual may visit different doctors and receive prescriptions for different medications that may have signifi cant interac- tions and side effects. Physicians may not be aware that the patient has seen other providers. A review of all medications should be a stan- dard component of every geriatric evaluation (R. L. Kane, 2000a). Social workers need to be aware of the common medications prescribed for older adults and have some knowledge of side effects. Problems experienced with medications or with compliance often can be spotted in the context of home visits and conversations with family caregivers. Another signifi cant issue related to medication use is the cost of medications. Mojtabal and Olfson (2003) report that low-income Medicare ben- efi ciaries with higher out-of-pocket spending for drugs were more likely to not adhere to prescribed medications because of their cost.

Cost-related nonadherence with medica- tion use was associated with poorer health outcomes in terms of worsening chronic con- ditions such as arthritis, heart disease, hyper- tension, and depressive symptoms (Mojtabal & Olfson, 2003). For social workers, advocat- ing for individuals to obtain prescribed medi- cations has become an important feature of their practice in health-care settings. Social

ch16.indd 396ch16.indd 396 9/22/11 5:38 PM9/22/11 5:38 PM

Social Work With Older Adults in Health-Care Settings 397

workers need to remain informed about local and national resources (e.g., Medicare drug discount cards, pharmaceutical company pro- grams) as well as medication assistance pro- grams, which vary from state to state (see Chapter 5 for more information).

Psychological Well-Being and Mental Health

Although older adults experience many of the same mental disorders as other adults, the prevalence, nature, and course of each

Box 16.1 Geriatric Resources for Assessment and Care of Elders (GRACE)

Key Components

• Initial, at-home comprehensive geriatric assessment by support team of a certifi ed nurse practitioner and licensed clinical social worker. The assessment includes medical and psychosocial history, medi- cation review, functional assessment, review of social support and advance di- rectives, and home safety evaluation.

• Meetings with interdisciplinary team (geriatrician, pharmacist, physical thera- pist, mental health social worker, and community-based services liaison) to de- velop an individualized, integrated care plan based on protocols for evaluating and managing 12 common geriatric con- ditions. The conditions include: advance care planning, health maintenance, medi- cation management, diffi culty walking/ falls, malnutrition/weight loss, visual im- pairment, hearing loss, dementia, chronic pain, urinary incontinence, depression, and caregiver burden.

• Team-led implementation, ongoing care coordination supported by a common electronic medical record (EMR) and lon- gitudinal tracking system. The coordina- tion includes in-home follow-up visit by support team to review the care plan and goals.

• Ongoing care coordination and case management. The team encourages goal setting and self-care, teaches problem- solving skills, provides education using low-health-literacy materials that corre- spond to each GRACE protocol, prepares

patients and physicians to address prob- lems and team suggestions during offi ce visits, and assists with transportation arrangements. Each patient receives a minimum of a monthly phone contact to check for and address any new problems, such as changes in medications, social supports, and/or living arrangements. The social worker plays a critical role throughout this process, helping patients to access community-based resources (e.g., discounted fi tness classes) and navigate the health and social services system.

• Periodic interdisciplinary care team re- views and annual reassessments.

Results

The GRACE program: improved the provi- sion of evidence-based care; led to signifi - cant improvements in measures of general health, vitality, social functioning, and men- tal health; reduced emergency visits; and generated high levels of physician and pa- tient satisfaction. Overall hospital admission rates were not affected, but admission rates for high-risk participants were lower than for comparable patients in the usual-care group. A recent analysis found that the pro- gram was cost neutral over a 2-year period and yielded cost savings in the third year for high-risk enrollees.

Source: From “Team-Developed Care Plan and Ongoing Care Management by Social Workers and Nurse Practitioners Result in Better Outcomes and Fewer Emergency Department Visits for Low-Income Seniors.” Washington, DC: Agency for Health Care Research and Quality, Innovations and Tools to Improve Quality and Reduce Disparities, 2010. Retrieved from www.innovations.ahrq.gov/content.aspx?id=2066

ch16.indd 397ch16.indd 397 9/22/11 5:38 PM9/22/11 5:38 PM

398 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

disorder may vary signifi cantly (U.S. Depart- ment of Health and Human Services, 1999). Depression, anxiety, and dementia are some of the pathological disorders that can de- velop in older age (McInnis-Dittrich, 2009). These problems often are underdiagnosed in large part because of several challenges that clinicians encounter when assessing the men- tal health of older people. These challenges include comorbidity (the presence of other health conditions), wherein many symptoms of mood disorders (e.g., sleeplessness, fa- tigue) could be misattributed to health prob- lems. Other challenges include stereotypes about aging; for example, the belief that normal aging is associated with increased negative affect is likely to lead to a lack of attention to the symptoms of mood disorders (Grann, 2000). Family members may believe “senility” is a normal part of aging and delay seeking care for the older individual. Older adults themselves may be less willing to talk about their feelings, as different cohorts and cultures may view psychological symptoms very negatively, and instead focus on somatic complaints (see Chapter 10). For example, older individuals, especially those from Asian cultures, may be more willing to admit to sleep and memory problems than feeling sad or anxious (Kleinman, 2004). Finally, the overlap between the symptoms of dementia and depression makes it diffi cult to assess them separately.

Substance abuse, particularly the abuse of alcohol, prescription drugs, and over-the- counter medications, is another disorder that is underdiagnosed in the older adult population. Because often decreased activity by an older adult is attributed to other age-related fac- tors, substance abuse is not seen as the cause of a disruption from work or social activities (Widlitz & Marin, 2002). Furthermore, clini- cians are often unaware of an older person’s drinking problems because the topic is rarely discussed by the physician (Kane, 2000c). Specialized assessment tools, such as the CAGE or the Michigan Alcoholism Screening Test, that specifi cally target symptoms relating to older people are essential to screen for sub-

stance abuse. These symptoms include mood swings, loss of physical mobility, progressive isolation, unexplained accidents, and a decline in cognitive functioning. Left undiagnosed and untreated, substance abuse can decrease over- all health because it is associated with immu- nodefi ciency; arrhythmia; and increased risk for cancer, gastritis, and new seizure activity (Widlitz & Marin, 2002). See Chapter 17 for further information.

In the assessment of an older individual’s mental health, positive aspects of psychologi- cal well-being often are overlooked. That is, assessments of depression, stress, anxiety, and other disorders generally do not address an in- dividual’s subjective well-being, such as the presence of positive affect, hope, optimism, and life satisfaction. Folkman and Moskow- itz (2000) suggest that positive affect in the context of chronic stress may help prevent worse outcomes, such as clinical depression or adverse physiological consequences of stress. Hope is conceptualized as a future- oriented positive expectation that motivates an individual and provides a means of coping with uncertainty (Raleigh & Boehm, 1994). The lack of hope is predictive of suicidal thoughts among older adults with depression (Uncapher, Gallagher-Thompson, Osgood, & Bonger, 1998).

Although the rate of suicide among those 65 years and older has declined since 1991, suicide rates among seniors are among the highest of all age groups (CDC, 2009). See Box 16.2 for more facts about older adult suicide, as well as Chapter 8 for further in- formation.

Cognitive Capacity

Changes in cognitive capacity occur as people age. Two types of cognitive changes should be noted. The fi rst has to do with small declines in memory, selective attention, information processing, and problem-solving ability that occur with normal aging, although the amount of change varies greatly (Siegler, Poon, Mad- den & Welsh, 1996). The consequences of these cognitive changes may be a slower pace

ch16.indd 398ch16.indd 398 9/22/11 5:38 PM9/22/11 5:38 PM

Social Work With Older Adults in Health-Care Settings 399

of learning and an increased need for repeti- tion of new information (U.S. Department of Health & Human Services, 1999). The second type of cognitive change is a progressive, ir- reversible, global deterioration in capacity that occurs as a result of dementing illnesses such as Alzheimer’s disease, vascular dementia, and subcortical dementia. It is estimated that about 3% of men and women ages 65 to 74 years old have Alzheimer’s, and nearly 50% of those 85 years and older may have the disease (Na- tional Institute on Aging, 2004).

Another important issue is the determina- tion of the competence of people with impaired cognitive capacity to make their own decisions

regarding care. Usually this is accomplished by having either a family member or a social worker (if no family member is available) petition the court for guardianship of the patient’s fi nances and/or person. The decision to grant guardian- ship is a legal determination made by the court but usually also involves a physician’s and social worker’s assessment of the client’s capacity for making decisions that do not cause harm to self or others (Cummings & Jackson, 2000).

As the dementia progresses, profound changes occur in memory, language, ob- ject recognition, and executive functioning (i.e., the ability to plan, organize, sequence, and abstract). Behavioral symptoms such as

Box 16.2 Facts About Suicide Among Older Adults

• Suicide rates increase with age and are highest among individuals age 65 years and over.

• Eighty-fi ve percent of the suicides in this age group were by males. Caucasian males have the highest rates of completed suicide.

• As compared to younger suicide victims, older adults who complete suicide are more likely to have lived alone, be widowed, and have had a physical illness.

• About 70% of older suicide victims had visited their primary care provider in the month prior to their suicide attempt, representing a missed opportunity for intervention.

• Firearms were used in 73% of suicides committed by adults over the age of 65 in 2001 (CDC, 2004).

• In one study, only 58% of physicians asked their depressed and suicidal older patients about their access to fi rearms (Kaplan, Adamek, & Rhoades, 1998).

Prevention of Suicide in Primary Care Elderly: Collaborative Trial (PROSPECT) Study

Most older suicide victims are seen by their primary care provider within a few weeks of their suicide and are experiencing

a fi rst episode of mild to moderate depression. One promising intervention (see Alexopoulos et al., 2009) for reducing suicidal ideation among seniors is a care management intervention involving trained depression care managers (social workers, nurses, and psychologists) who collaborate with primary care physicians by helping the physicians in: • Recognizing depression • Offering guideline-based treatment

recommendations for patients • Monitoring patients’ depressive

symptoms, medication adverse effects, and treatment adherence

• Providing interpersonal psychotherapy when a patient declines medication therapy

A ran domized trial evaluation of the intervention found it to be effective in signifi cantly reducing suicidal ideation among those with major depression and noted that treatment response occurred earlier among those receiving the intervention. Despite the promise of this intervention, Conwell (2009) notes that two thirds of the patients in the trial were women; the effi cacy of this intervention in reducing suicidal ideation and behavior among older depressed men (who are at highest risk) remains to be examined.

ch16.indd 399ch16.indd 399 9/22/11 5:38 PM9/22/11 5:38 PM

400 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

agitation, hallucinations, and wandering are also common. These cognitive changes ne- cessitate increasing supervision of the older individual, leading to considerable strain and burden for both formal and informal caregiv- ers (Alzheimer’s Association, 2004). Much of social workers’ effort is directed toward fi nd- ing resources, such as caregiver support groups, behavior management training, counseling, personal care services, respite, and alternative living arrangements (e.g., foster care, assisted living facilities, nursing homes) to support the informal caregivers. Medications also can be helpful in managing some behavioral symp- toms, such as agitation and hallucinations. So- cial workers should encourage family members to discuss all symptoms and changes in behavior with the physician, social worker, and caregiver support group because many behavior manage- ment techniques can be learned from listening to the experiences of other caregivers.

Functional Ability

Functional ability is usually defi ned as an indi- vidual’s ability to perform certain basic ADLs. The activities classifi ed as basic ADLs refer to personal care (e.g., dressing, bathing, eat- ing, grooming, toileting, getting in and out of bed or a chair, urinary and bowel continence); the term instrumental activities of daily liv- ing (IADLs) refer to activities that need to be performed in order to live in a community set- ting (e.g., cooking, cleaning, shopping, money management, use of transportation, telephone, medication administration). Mobility, which addresses walking, climbing stairs, balance, and transferring in and out of a chair or bed, often is included in the ADLs. The perfor- mance of these activities usually is assessed in terms of being independent, needing assistance (human help or mechanical devices), and being unable or completely dependent on human help to perform the various activities. The progres- sion of disability in performing these activities predicts an individual’s movement along the continuum of care, ranging from independent living, to assisted living (assistance could be in- formal, formal, or both), to nursing home care.

A variety of factors contribute to an indi- vidual’s ability to perform ADLs and IADLs. Pearson (2000) notes: “[F]unctional ability can be conceptualized as the dynamic interaction of an older adult’s physiological status, the emotional or psychological environment, and the external or physical and social environ- ment” (p. 19). For example, many of the health conditions discussed earlier could contribute to limitations in functional ability. Psychological issues such as depression, anxiety (including a fear of falling), and hopelessness may lead to a decreased motivation to perform these ac- tivities. Cognitive changes such as dementia also limit an individual’s functional ability. Fi- nally, the external physical environment (type of dwelling or neighborhood) as well as the social support available to an individual may promote or hinder the ability to perform ADLs and necessitate a change in living conditions. For social workers, the implications are clear: An assessment of functional status requires an evaluation of all of these factors that may con- tribute to an individual’s disability. Limitations in ADLs and IADLs are a prerequisite for eligi- bility for services in all publicly funded home and community-based services programs.

Another signifi cant issue in the area of func- tional limitation is the ability to drive a motor vehicle. According to Stutts, Martell, and Sta- plin (2009), drivers age 60 to 69 years (i.e., the “young-old”) do not show any increase in automobile crashes. The rate begins to rise for those 70 years and older and increases rapidly at 80 years. Thus, it is the oldest drivers who pose more risk to themselves and to public safety. The conditions that substantially in- crease the risk for crashes among older drivers include those that require navigating complex situations, such as intersections and left turns and reacting to an imminent crash.

A variety of age-related and other changes in vision, hearing, reaction time, and cogni- tive function can interfere with an individu- al’s ability to drive. As Stutts and colleagues (2009) note:

Situations that have proven risky for older drivers often include complex visual searches,

ch16.indd 400ch16.indd 400 9/22/11 5:38 PM9/22/11 5:38 PM

Social Work With Older Adults in Health-Care Settings 401

and information from multiple sources that must be processed rapidly under divided attention conditions. These are conditions where context-appropriate driver behavior often depends less upon conformity to formal or informal rules than to judgment or “execu- tive function.” (p. 42)

These fi ndings about particular risk factors can help target educational materials to the appropriate age cohorts and suggest that older adults may be able to extend the safe driving years through engagement in health/wellness programs (Stutts et al., 2009).

In the United States in particular, the abil- ity to drive is one of the most signifi cant com- ponents of the ability to remain independent. Some communities have undertaken environ- mental modifi cations, such as lengthening the time of traffi c signals and increasing the size of lettering and visibility of street signs. Orga- nizations such as the Automobile Association of America and the American Association of Retired Persons (AARP) offer a Mature Driver Safety program to retrain older drivers. Based on a study of older drivers, the Hartford Fi- nancial Services Group, in partnership with the Massachusetts Institute of Technology AgeLab, developed a brochure that prepares family members for how to have a conversa- tion with an older person about driving deci- sions (Hartford, 2005). Older people generally preferred to be approached by individual fam- ily members as opposed to those outside the family (such as a close friend or the police) when having conversations about their driving. Most married older adults preferred to hear fi rst from a spouse, although over 18% of those who were married with a spouse in the household reported that they absolutely did not want to hear from their spouse about driving concerns. Doctors and adult children also were preferred choices for conversations. In cases where older adults lived alone, doctors, followed by adult children, were most often selected (Coughlin, Mohyde, D’Ambrosio, & Gilbert, 2004). So- cial workers can be helpful in educating and engaging family members and physicians about addressing this issue with an older patient.

Social Functioning

When assessing social function, it is impor- tant to remember the subjective and objective components to social functioning. Objective measures would include social support (sup- port or help received), social networks (num- ber of people in the individual’s social circle), social activities (attendance at social events, frequency of contact with others), and social roles (the number and type of roles performed). Subjective measures of social function ask in- dividuals to report on their satisfaction with their social situation and their perception that support is available when needed. Individuals may vary considerably in objective measures of social function yet express similar amounts of satisfaction. In fact, there is a large body of evidence to suggest that subjective evaluations of support are more strongly related to psycho- logical well-being than objective indicators of social functioning, such as the frequency of contact with others (Krause, 1995). Different aspects of social functioning can be addressed depending on the goal of treatment or care planning. For example, social workers may focus on an increase in the frequency of con- tact with existing social networks (e.g., fi nding transportation to attend social or church activi- ties) or an increase in social roles (e.g., fi nd- ing employment or volunteer opportunities), depending on which aspects of social function are most salient to the older person.

Among older individuals, social integration (i.e., having social ties, roles, and activities) is associated with better health outcomes, such as a lower risk of mortality, cardiovascular dis- ease, cancer mortality, and functional decline (Unger et al., 1999). However, health also af- fects social functioning in that individuals who are confi ned to a bed or have severe mobility impairments are likely to disengage from so- cial activities that involve leaving the home. Thus, as Levin (1994) points out, social func- tioning is both an outcome as well as a predic- tor of physical and psychological well-being.

Negative interaction or support is also an important area for assessment. Negative inter- action typically occurs with individuals who

ch16.indd 401ch16.indd 401 9/22/11 5:38 PM9/22/11 5:38 PM

402 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

have a close relationship with the older person (Antonucci, Sherman, & Vandewater, 1997) and can take the form of disagreements, emo- tional and fi nancial abuse, and even physical abuse and neglect (discussed in the section “Assessment of Family and Informal Sup- port”).

One issue that overlaps social, physical, and psychological domains is the expression of sexuality and the experience of intimacy among older people (see Chapter 14 for more details). In a review of the literature, Hooy- man and Kiyak (2002) note that contrary to the misperceptions about the cessation of sexual activity as individuals grow older, research- ers have found that sexual activity continued into older ages and that sexual inactivity ap- peared to depend more on life circumstances rather than decreases in interest or desire. For example, the infl uence of marital sta- tus and interpersonal relationships on sexual behavior is greater for women than for men (Matthias, Lubben, Atchison, & Schweitzer, 1997), whereas physical conditions resulting in sexual dysfunction appear to be the major diffi culty infl uencing sexual activity for men (Wiley & Bortz, 1996). A psychosocial assess- ment of factors that infl uence sexual activity in older adults should include an individual’s past history of sexual activity, attitudes toward sexual activities and intimacy, availability of a partner, anxiety about sexual performance, opportunities for privacy, and attitudes of staff toward sexual activity in institutional settings (Hooyman & Kiyak, 2002). Given the rates of human immunodefi ciency virus (HIV) and acquired immunodefi ciency syndrome (AIDS) among older people—10% of those with HIV are over age 50 and about 3% are older than 60 years (Linsk, 2000)—knowledge about HIV and the practice of risky behaviors also should be part of the assessment.

Physical Environment

As individuals age, social workers often see a widening in the gap between the demands of the environment and the individual’s com- petence to address those demands. The aging

process brings with it many physiological changes in sensory perception, gait, reaction time, and strength, all of which may compro- mise an individual’s ability to negotiate the existing environment. For example, changes in vision and depth perception make it diffi cult to negotiate stairs, which may lead individuals to restrict their trips out of the house, leading to further dependence on assistance and increased social isolation. Inadequacies in the physical environment also may necessitate relocation from a house or residence, which could nega- tively infl uence an individual’s psychological well-being, especially if the older person op- poses the move. This is particularly true in the case of many nursing home admissions.

Although independent homes are the most obvious targets of an assessment of the ad- equacy of the physical environment, Cutler (2000) suggests that “all residential environ- ments can be measured against the principles of universal design, wherein a residential set- ting should be adaptable, supportive, accessi- ble, and safe” (p. 360). In 2000, about 78% of older adults (65 years and older) owned their home (U.S. Census Bureau, 2004), and about 89% of respondents age 55 years and older strongly or somewhat agreed that they would like to remain in their current residence for as long as possible (AARP, 2000). Among older adults, falls are the leading cause of injury deaths and the most common cause of inju- ries and hospital admissions for trauma. Each year, about 35% to 40% of adults 65 years and older fall at least once, and about two thirds to one half of falls occur in or around the home (CDC, 2001). Among community-dwelling older adults, the risk of falling is greater for those who live alone and have some type of functional impairment (Elliott, Painter, & Hudson, 2009).

Assessing the fi t of the home environment with the capabilities of the individual is an im- portant assessment domain, and the prevention of falls is a critical area of intervention. Typi- cal home assessments will examine the con- dition, adequacy, and accessibility of lighting; fl ooring and carpeting, including obstacles or potential hazards for falling; bath and toilet,

ch16.indd 402ch16.indd 402 9/22/11 5:38 PM9/22/11 5:38 PM

Social Work With Older Adults in Health-Care Settings 403

including need for assistive devices; kitchen; heating and cooling; access to home from out- side; access to rooms within the home; and personal safety issues, such as neighborhood conditions. Similar issues are also important when evaluating assisted living or foster care facilities.

Assessment of Family and Informal Support

Family members play an important role in or- ganizing or providing for the care of an older adult. About two thirds (64%) of people who live in the community and need long-term care rely solely on family and friends (i.e., informal support) for help; 28% receive a combination of informal and formal care; and only 8% use formal care or paid help only (Liu, Manton, & Aragon, 2000). Family members of older adults most likely to be caregivers are adult daughters (27%), other female relatives (18%), sons (15%), wives (13%), husbands (10%), and others. About 30% of people caring for older long-term care users were themselves age 65 years or older, and another 15% were between ages 45 and 54 years (Spector, Fleish- man, Pezzin, & Spillman, 2000).

The assessment of informal support gener- ally focuses on the number and relationship of family helpers, amount and type of help provided, the expected permanence of fam- ily help, the strain or burden experienced by caregivers, and more recently on the positive aspects of careg iving (Gaugler, Kane, & Lan- glois, 2000; Pearson, 2000). Many caregivers have competing demands, such as employment and caring for young children. With the declin- ing functional ability that occurs with chronic illnesses and dementia, along with the need for increased vigilance, caregivers experience considerable strain, which puts the older per- son at greater risk for entering a nursing home and also increases the likelihood of abuse or neglect. It is thus important to assess both objective and subjective components of care- giver strain to gain a better understanding of the needs of the caregiver. The term objective components of burden refers to the disruption

in fi nances, family life, and social relations; the term subjective components refers to the caregiver’s appraisal of the situation as stress- ful (Gaugler et al., 2000).

There is some evidence of race/ethnic dif- ferences in the appraisal of strain due to care- giving, such as evidence that African American caregivers have a lower likelihood of viewing caregiving as stressful compared with Cauca- sian caregivers (Pinquart & Sörenson, 2005). However, much of the research on race/ethnic- ity is confounded with socioeconomic status, and little data are available on caregiver per- spectives from different socioeconomic strata within racial and ethnic groups. In many long- term care programs, formal services are pro- vided only when family members are not in a position to do so. Thus it is important that so- cial workers attend to both objective and sub- jective components of caregiver strain when developing a long-term care plan.

In the health-care system, the assessment of family support often is constrained by legal defi nitions of who is a family member. This creates signifi cant structural and legal barriers for older gay and lesbian couples in various health-care settings. For example, partners may be denied access to medical re- cords or visits to intensive care; in matters of medical decision making, health-care profes- sionals may restrict themselves to dealing with family members rather than partners despite the fact that family members may know less about the preferences of the older patient than the partner; and staff may hold negative atti- tudes toward gay and lesbian couples (Hooy- man & Kiyak, 2002). Social workers should be aware of their own values and practices related to this issue and act in accordance with the professional code of ethics to not discriminate against individuals on the basis of a variety of factors, including sexual orientation (National Association of Social Workers, 2003).

Elder abuse often occurs when family mem- bers are overwhelmed with caregiving respon- sibilities, particularly if the care recipient and the care provider are living in the same house- hold and there is a past history of family abuse. Additional risk factors for elder abuse include

ch16.indd 403ch16.indd 403 9/22/11 5:38 PM9/22/11 5:38 PM

404 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

being older than 75 years; being female; hav- ing physical or cognitive limitations; living in a lower socioeconomic household; and caregiver vulnerability to problems such as substance use, mental illness, or fi nancial dependency on the care recipient (McInnis-Dittrich, 2009; Na- tional Center on Elder Abuse [NCEA], 2004). A survey of states by the NCEA in 2000 notes that social workers are mandated reporters of elder abuse in 30 states or territories in this country. This fact is important in part because signs of elder abuse may be overlooked in health-care settings when bruises, bone frac- tures, or painful body symptoms might be attributed to changes due to normal aging, un- expected falls, or pain related to illness.

Economic Resources

Typically the assessment of economic resources (i.e., income, pension, health insurance, other assets) is necessary to determine eligibility for publicly funded home- and community-based services. Almost every state operates a Med- icaid waiver–funded home- and community- based services program that provides for home care services to older adults who are at risk of entering a nursing home. The actual assess- ment and eligibility criteria vary from state to state, but in general they include limitations in functional ability and an income at or near poverty (Centers for Medicare and Medicaid [CMS], 2010a). Individuals whose incomes exceed the criteria are required to “spend down” their assets until they reach the eligi- bility level (CMS, 2010b). See Chapter 5 for additional information. Assessing income and assets can be a frustrating and time-consuming activity because of the reluctance of older peo- ple and their family members to divulge such information, often leading to an increased use of social work time and delays in the Medicaid application process (Diwan, 1999).

Values and Preferences

There is little systematic evaluation of the values and preferences of older adults in most health and long-term care settings (R. L. Kane, 2000c).

Kane outlines several areas in which some sys- tematic ways of eliciting individual preferences are desirable. These areas include preferences:

• For end-of-life care that address whether individuals would want various procedures performed, such as resuscitation, ventila- tor care, intubation, and hydration, and also whether they would like to designate a proxy decision maker in the event they cannot make these decisions

• About outcomes associated with alternative hospital discharge plans; for example, pref- erences related to particular types of home care services needed or the location of post- hospital care

• About housing arrangements, such as those related to independent as well as various types of congregate living arrangements, such as assisted living facilities, small group homes, continuing care retirement commu- nities, or nursing homes

• For how routines of everyday life are con- ducted, especially with ADLs and IADLs

• Related to religious practices

• Related to privacy, especially in congregate settings where individuals may share rooms and be observed by others when being helped with ADLs

• Related to safety versus freedom; for ex- ample, older adults may choose to live in situations that professionals consider less than adequate

In keeping with social work values that pro- mote the principles of client self-determination and autonomy, assessment of values and pref- erences of older adults can help social work practitioners be more attentive to these issues when working with older adults in institutional settings that tend to minimize the opportunity for self-determination.

Spiritual Assessment

A growing body of literature documents the positive link among religiosity, spirituality, participation in religious activities, and health

ch16.indd 404ch16.indd 404 9/22/11 5:38 PM9/22/11 5:38 PM

Social Work With Older Adults in Health-Care Settings 405

Table 16.1 Assessment Domains and Some Commonly Used Assessment Tools

Major Domains of Assessment Some Commonly Used Assessment Tools

Physiological well- being and health

Get Up and Go Test (Mathias et al., 1986) and Expanded Timed Get Up and Go (Wall, Bell, Campbell, & Davis, 2000). Widely used as screens for risk for falls.

Medical Outcomes Study—Short Form-36 Health Survey (SF-36) (Ware & Sherbourne, 1992). Covers eight areas: physical function, role limitations due to physical problems, social function, pain, general mental health, role limitations due to emotional problems, vitality, and general health perceptions.

Psychological well- being and mental health

CAGE Questionnaire (Ewing, 1984). Assesses alcohol problems. Center for Epidemiological Studies Depression Scale (CES-D) (http://chipts.cch.ucla .edu/assessment/Assessment_Instruments/Assessment_pdf_new/assess_cesd_pdf.pdf). Assesses depressed affect, positive affect, somatic/vegetative signs, and interpersonal distress. Available in shorter versions.

Cognitive capacity Global Deterioration Scale (GDS). (Reisberg, Ferris, de Leon, & Crook, 1982). Assesses the severity of dementia related to cognition, functional ability, and problem behaviors.

Mini Mental State Exam (MMSE) (Folstein, Folstein, & McHugh, 1975). Assesses immediate and delayed memory recall; orientation; calculation/working memory; visuospatial abilities; language.

Ability to perform various ADLs

Katz Index of Independence in Activities of Daily Living (Katz et al., 1963). Measures performance in ADLs: dressing, bathing, eating, grooming, toileting, transferring from bed or chair, mobility, and continence.

Older Americans Resources and Services, Instrumental Activities of Daily Living (OARS-IADL) (Fillenbaum & Smyer, 1981). Measures performance in IADLs: cooking, cleaning, shopping, money management, use of transportation, telephone, medication administration.

Social functioning Lubben’s Social Network Scale (Lubben, 1988). Can be used as a screening tool for an older person’s risk for isolation.

Social Support Questionnaire (Sarason et al., 1983). Measures objective and subjective aspects of support received: global, informational, perceived, structural, and provisional.

Physical environment Elderly Resident Housing Assessment Program (ERHAP) (Brent & Brent, 1987). Assesses safety, functioning, comfort in various domains through interviews with homeowner, direct observation, and photographs by rater.

Assessment of family caregivers

Caregiver Strain Index (Robinson, 1983). Assesses physical, personal, family, and fi nancial strain related to caregiving.

Revised Memory and Problem Behavior Checklist (RMBPC) (Teri et al., 1992). Assesses frequency of memory, mood, and problem behaviors in care the older patient and how much these bother the caregiver.

Economic resources Older Americans Resources and Services (OARS-Economic Resources) (Fillenbaum & Smyer, 1981). Assesses income, pension, Social Security, health insurance, and other assets, such as a house, cars, and savings.

Values and preferences

Desire for Choice and Control in Nursing Homes (Kane et al., 1997). Assesses preferences for choice and control in everyday life in nursing homes.

Values Assessment Protocol (Degenholtz, Kane, & Kivnick, 1997). Assesses values and preferences of older people in case-managed home care programs. Could be useful in developing care plans.

Spiritual assessment The Daily Spiritual Experience Scale (Underwood & Teresi, 2002). Attempts to measure experience rather than particular beliefs or behaviors.

ch16.indd 405ch16.indd 405 9/22/11 5:38 PM9/22/11 5:38 PM

406 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

and psychological well-being among older adults (Koenig, 1990; Levin, 1994). Assess- ment of preferences for religious and spiritual activity is important because these factors are known to infl uence an individual’s psycho- logical and social functioning, ability to cope with stress, and overall quality of life. Spiri- tual beliefs and religious worldviews also may infl uence health- and illness-related be- liefs. For many African Americans, spiritual beliefs are a foundation for understanding disease conditions and making treatment deci- sions (e.g., they believe that God is ultimately responsible for physical health, the physi- cian is God’s instrument, and only God has the power to decide life and death) (Johnson, Elbert-Avila, & Tulsky, 2005). Many Mus- lims are taught that illness is a test of faith and a way to strengthen character and that God is responsible for health care. Therefore, Muslims may choose to not cooperate at all with practitioners who discuss the probable course of a disease or death (Gorder & Ellor, 2008). The actual domains of assessment may include religious affi liation, beliefs, com- mitment, participation in religious activities, and private daily experience (Olson & Kane, 2000). The salience of these domains to an individual (e.g., religious strictures for food [kosher for observant Jews, halal for obser- vant Muslims], the availability of religious services) could signifi cantly infl uence care plans for community-based care as well as for institutional long-term care arrangements.

ETHNOGERIATRIC ASSESSMENT

Increasing ethnic and cultural diversity in the older population and the growing demand for culturally competent care have contributed to the development of ethnogeriatics, which is a synthesis of aging, health, and cultural con- cerns about health-care and social services for ethnic older adults (McBride & Lewis, 2004; Yeo, David, & Llorens, 1996). Ethnogeriatric assessment involves adding cultural explo- ration (Andrulis & Brach, 2007) or cultural

investigation (Gorder & Ellor, 2008) to the CGA. Ethnogeriatric assessment is the fi rst step to providing culturally competent care and requires knowledge and skills in several areas, including culturally defi ned health be- liefs, historical and cohort experience, the role of the family in the cultural context, culturally appropriate ways of nonverbal communication (showing respect), ability to address clients with language barriers, and use of linguistic and culturally appropriate assessment instruments.

Cultural Context of Health and Illness

Older clients and families from various ethnic and cultural backgrounds may have culturally defi ned health belief systems that do not exactly match with or exist in the Western health-care system, which is based on the biomedical model (Yeo, 2009). The biomedical model uses defi ni- tions and explanations of health and illness that are based on scientifi c assumptions and pro- cesses whereas ethnic older clients and families may consider factors such as balance, nature, or spirits in explaining their conditions. As a re- sult, social workers may encounter clients who describe culturally defi ned somatic disorders or culture-bound syndromes during assessment (Stanford Geriatric Education Center [SGEC], 2001). For example, in Chinese and other tra- ditional medicine, health is maintained by bal- ancing forces in the body (e.g., yin and yang balance, cold or hot concepts) and free fl ow of qi (Lin, 1980; McBride, Morioka-Douglas, & Yeo, 1996). Vietnamese and other Southeast Asian refugee populations identify “wind illness” as a common cause of various illnesses and also believe that karma from past lives and super- natural or ancestral spirits contribute to health or illness (Yeo, 1996). Older Hmong refugees from Cambodia believe spirit and soul loss af- fect health (Gerdner, Xiong, & Yang, 2006).

Historical Context and Cohort Experience

Historical context and cohort experience, such as immigration patterns, experience of certain events (e.g., war, torture, refugee status), and

ch16.indd 406ch16.indd 406 9/22/11 5:38 PM9/22/11 5:38 PM

Social Work With Older Adults in Health-Care Settings 407

discrimination, may be refl ected in health be- liefs and illness behaviors. Not knowing such experience can result in inaccurate assess- ment of clients’ conditions (Rosich, 2007; Xakellies et al., 2004; Yeo et al., 1998). For example, the most commonly reported symp- tom by older Cambodians, severe headaches frequently combined with dizziness, may be related to their unique cohort experience of the genocide under the Khmer Rouge. Their frequent thinking about loss of and separa- tion from family members during wartime re- sults in headaches (Handelman & Yeo, 1996). Alaska Natives who experience separation from others through death or school in their childhood and are now seniors may exhibit trauma-like symptoms (Rosich, 2007). Know- ing about these unique experiences can help in interpreting symptoms expressed as well in establishing trust with older ethnic clients and their families (SGEC, 2001).

Acculturation, which is the degree to which individuals are infl uenced by and actively en- gage in the traditions, norms, and practices of one or more cultures, can vary by the amount of exposure to those cultures. Cohort experi- ence, length of residence in the United States, and language profi ciency infl uence degree of acculturation (Diwan, 2008). Acculturation thus should be regarded as a continuum rather than a category, and social workers should as- sess the degree of acculturation in thoughts, behaviors, and attitudes to better understand the older person’s frame of reference (Organi- sta, 2009; Yeo, 2009).

Role of Family in Cultural Context

In assessment of ethnic older clients, cultural expectations of their families that guide the family members’ responses, such as levels of involvement and decision making, must be recognized (Yeo, 1996). Values and ethi- cal principles emphasized in U.S. health care, such as independence, autonomy, privacy, and confi dentiality, may not apply in some cultures. For example, in traditional Mexican and Filipino families, physical dependence in old age may be expected, and taking care of

dependent older members is considered to be a family’s responsibility. In many cultures, the family (and not the older client) is responsible for deciding the older person’s health care, and sometimes family members ask providers not to reveal a serious diagnosis or bad news as a way of protecting elders (Yeo, 1996, 2009). Gender roles may be traditional (e.g., in Mus- lim families, men often are regarded as protec- tors by women, and men are responsible for all health-care decisions) (Gorder & Ellor, 2008).

When working with older clients from fam- ily-centered cultures, it is useful to invite fam- ily members to participate in the assessment process in addition to the older adult (Andrulis & Brach, 2007). Likewise, it is useful to iden- tify information related to family composition and structure, kinship patterns, expectations of and for family members, decision-making practices and roles (e.g., individualistic versus collectivistic, family centered, matriarchal or patriarchal), gender role allocation, and the like (SGEC, 2001; Xakellies et al., 2004). Family members can help provide insight- ful information about clients’ problems and contribute to collaborative problem solving (Organista, 2009).

Culturally Appropriate Nonverbal Communication

Cultural preferences about showing respect through nonverbal communication vary greatly across groups, and social workers should be familiar with culturally appropriate behaviors, gestures, and styles (Xakellies et al., 2004). Appropriate physical proximity between a practitioner and a client varies across cultures. Physical contact in greeting and examination by the opposite gender are limited or prohib- ited in many cultures, and direct eye contact is appropriate in some cultures but can be considered impolite or disrespectful in others (Gorder & Ellor, 2008; SGEC, 2001). Practi- tioners should keep these variations in mind and carefully determine what to do or not do during assessment. If in doubt about the appro- priateness of an action, ask clients’ for guid- ance and about their preferences (Yeo, 1996).

ch16.indd 407ch16.indd 407 9/22/11 5:38 PM9/22/11 5:38 PM

408 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Language Barriers

Clear communication is critical for accurate assessment, but it can be a challenge when working with older clients and families with limited English profi ciency and when prac- titioners do not speak the same language as clients (Yeo, 1996). Language barriers can contribute to misunderstanding and errors in communication during assessment and under- mine the practitioner-client relationship (Min, 2005). Likewise, accurate assessment about preferred language and degree of English pro- fi ciency is essential in deciding on whether to use interpreter services and translated materi- als (Andrulis & Brach, 2007; Hasnain-Wynia & Baker, 2006). Please see Chapter 10 on communication for information and resources about using interpreters.

Using Standardized Assessment Instruments

When using standardized assessment instru- ments (e.g., depression and other mental status, health literacy), practitioners need to ensure that instruments have been tested psy- chometrically to determine their appropriate- ness with the individual or group in question (Tran, Ngo, & Conway, 2003). Relying on translated instruments may be problematic be- cause items on the instruments may not have the same meaning to all groups, and level of education and literacy also may impact scores (Andrulis & Brach, 2007; Douglas & Lena- han, 1994; Yeo, 1996).

Choice of format of the instrument can vary based on the ethnic group of clients. For ex- ample, expectation about expressing emotion varies across cultures. Face-to-face interview will be appropriate for clients from cultures encouraging expressing feelings. Self-report- ing will be more appropriate for those who are infl uenced by cultural norms of suppressing emotion because ways of keeping harmony and face-saving may cause individuals to be reluctant to be interviewed or respond using socially desirable response biases (SGEC, 2001).

Implications of Ethnogeriatric Assessment for Social Work in Health Care

Factors shaping individuals’ cultural attitudes are not limited to the areas just mentioned, and social workers should try to solicit extensive information in a sensitive and unobtrusive way that is culturally appropriate (Gorder & Ellor, 2008). Use of cultural liaisons (e.g., health workers, personal care workers) or cul- tural brokers can help social workers resolve diffi cult interactions and communications (Xakellies et al., 2004; Yeo, 2009). As stated earlier, medical interpretation should be un- dertaken by people who are specially trained and licensed (see Chapter 10).

ASSESSMENT VERSUS SCREENING

Although comprehensive assessment of older people and their families is desirable, it is not feasible to assess individuals in depth in all possible areas. Typically the content of an as- sessment is determined by its purpose and the setting in which it occurs. An abbreviated form of assessment often is used for the purposes of screening or case fi nding. Screening usually is done to identify individuals who may have dif- fi culties or problems in certain areas of func- tioning. These individuals then are assessed in greater depth and often referred to specifi c disciplines for continuing care (Finch-Guthrie, 2000). For example, many health maintenance organizations screen all of their older patients by sending surveys at the time of enrollment. Individuals who meet certain “risk” criteria (e.g., those at risk for falling, breakdown of informal support, those likely to be frequent users of emergency room services) then are re- ferred to case managers who develop, imple- ment, and monitor a care plan to address their particular risk factors. Screening, or case fi nd- ing, is also important in primary care settings, where the needs of many older patients may be overlooked because of the lack of time or training to assess psychosocial needs of older

ch16.indd 408ch16.indd 408 9/22/11 5:38 PM9/22/11 5:38 PM

Social Work With Older Adults in Health-Care Settings 409

patients with chronic illness (Berkman et al., 1999). Another example of screening occurs in inpatient units where social workers screen “high-risk” individuals, or those who may re- quire earlier intervention and intensive atten- tion, for the purpose of developing a viable discharge plan (Cummings & Jackson, 2000).

SOCIAL WORK WITH OLDER ADULTS IN HEALTH-CARE SETTINGS

Social work practice with older adults occurs in a range of health-care settings: outpatient clinics, hospitals, emergency rooms, public health departments, home health-care agen- cies, agencies providing home- and com- munity-based services, and residential and rehabilitation facilities such as nursing homes and assisted living facilities. Some essential social work practice skills that are needed to work with older adults in these settings are de- scribed in Table 16.2.

Primary Health-Care Settings

The term primary care refers to the initial entry of the patient into the health-care sys- tem and implies a holistic approach to care focusing on health promotion, disease preven- tion, and integration of mental and physical

health services (Cowles, 2003; Oktay, 1995). Primary health-care centers are considered important one-stop services because they can assist patients and families in navigating other health-care services and promote continuity of care and linkages among patient, family, and community (Donaldson, Yordy, Lohr, & Vane- selow, 1996). Most older patients in primary health-care settings have two or more comor- bid chronic illnesses, such as those described earlier in this chapter.

Generally, social workers come in contact with older people through referral from physi- cians or nurse case managers or via high-risk screening methods. The social worker com- pletes a psychosocial assessment to determine the strengths and service needs of the patient, develops a care plan in partnership with the patient and family, and seeks input from all of the health-care professionals involved in the delivery of care. The social worker’s level of collaboration with health-care professionals varies depending on the type of primary care setting and availability of a geriatric consul- tation team. The GRACE model described in Box 16.1 is an example of interdisciplinary collaboration for assessment and care plan- ning in a primary care setting. Social workers may advocate for access to identifi ed gaps in services and resources within or outside the primary care setting on behalf of the older person to ensure successful implementation of

Table 16.2 Essential Social Work Practice Skills in Health Service Settings

Screening High-risk, service eligibility, special problems

Assessment Problem identifi cation, needs, strengths, resources—individual and community

Communication skills Verbal and nonverbal; interviewing—patient and family; special groups, other professionals and service providers

Interpersonal engagement skills Conveying values—autonomy, empathy, trust; clarifying roles; empowerment

Clinical skills Crisis intervention, counseling and therapy—individual, family, and group

Group facilitation Support groups, psychoeducational groups

Mediation/Negotiation Advocacy, dispute resolution

Documentation Health insurance, medical records, mandated assessments

ch16.indd 409ch16.indd 409 9/22/11 5:38 PM9/22/11 5:38 PM

410 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

the care plan. They also provide information on available resources in the community and refer older patients to community agencies that offer services such as housing, transportation, home health care, counseling/psychotherapy, durable medical equipment, and health insur- ance. The goal is to facilitate comprehensive care that meets the needs of the patient. As di- rect service practitioners, social workers may provide emotional support and counseling to older people to foster coping and adaptation to their illness, treatment, and prognosis. They also help identify and mobilize the social sup- port system (family, friends, and signifi cant others) in the community.

A new approach to increasing access to pri- mary health-care providers that has been used involves house calls made to homebound, high- risk, frail seniors by interdisciplinary teams of geriatricians, nurse practitioners, and social workers. This approach has produced favorable outcomes, such as reduced inpatient hospital services, nursing home placements, and cost of care (Maynard & Stein, 2008). Furthermore, to improve access and adherence to recommended preventive care services among older adults, ex- perts suggest the need for education of the older adults about the diagnosis and treatment of emo- tional health problems, which can be achieved through the use of mental health specialists in primary care settings (De Jonge, Taler, & Boling, 2009; Thrope, Patterson, & Sleath, 2006).

As provision of health care is shifting rap- idly to ambulatory settings, social work experts envision a need for expanding the role of social workers in primary care settings to include more multidisciplinary and transdisciplinary team ap- proaches, organizational networking, case man- agement services, participation in medical ethics consultations, therapeutic and crisis interven- tions, and other supportive counseling and group work interventions (Berkman & Harootyan, 2003; Cowles, 2003; Netting, 1992).

Inpatient Hospital Settings

In hospitals, social workers typically see older patients through referrals from physicians and nurses or through case fi nding using high-risk

screening methods. Characteristics of high- risk patients may include living alone, ter- minal or chronic illness, suicidal tendencies, mental health problems (Becker & Becker, 1986; Thrope et al., 2006), and lack of sup- ports (Berkman et al., 1999). Hospitalized older patients are referred to social workers for a wide range of issues and problems, such as anxiety over being hospitalized; pre- or post- surgical concerns about procedures, treatment, recovery, and discharge; lack of support and resources after discharge; family and patient consent on use of life-sustaining equipment; suspected abuse; and cognitive or functional impairments that require intervention. Acute health problems for which older people may be admitted to the hospital include falls and fractures, physical impairment, iatrogenic ill- ness, nutritional problems, and surgery.

Hospital social workers in inpatient settings are responsible for screening and case fi nding, psychosocial assessment, discharge planning, postdischarge follow-up, outreach, counseling (individual, group work), documentation and record keeping, and collaboration. Depending on the hospital, they may provide emergency services through on-call programs.

The psychosocial assessment evaluates the patient’s level of functioning, service needs, social history, and availability of support, if needed, from family and friends. The process of discharge planning and developing a post- hospitalization care plan involves coordinating input from the various members of a multi- disciplinary team. Social workers coordinate this effort in their important role on the team as liaison for the patient and family (Cotti & Watt, 1989; Cowles, 2003; see Cummings & Jackson, 2000).

Social workers can help inform or edu- cate older individuals about the seriousness of their illness, consequences if the illness is left untreated, resources available to assist in continuity of care, options for alternative care, legal rights, and other matters. Such information can help patients become effec- tive consumers of services and gain a sense of self-effi cacy, which is often lost when a person experiences losses in functioning and

ch16.indd 410ch16.indd 410 9/22/11 5:38 PM9/22/11 5:38 PM

Social Work With Older Adults in Health-Care Settings 411

when dealing with large and complex health- care systems. Through referrals to commu- nity services and family conferences, social workers may engage in informing other for- mal and informal support networks to help the client after discharge or advocating for specialized services within or outside the hospital. Doing this requires knowledge of the availability and eligibility requirements of various community resources. Social workers also are expected to have knowledge and skill in determining the method of reimbursement, such as private or public insurance or out- of-pocket costs.

Social workers often are involved in counsel- ing older patients regarding adjustment-to-ill- ness issues and may provide crisis counseling to help the family and older person reestablish an emotional equilibrium, begin to understand the medical condition, prioritize tasks, and develop a short-term action plan (McInnis-Dittrich, 2009). Social workers also may develop sup- port groups (e.g., bereavement, cancer, demen- tia, high-risk health behaviors) to assist patients and their families with their losses and illness and undertake family counseling when needed. Facilitation of support groups for older patients in this setting requires skills such as relation- ship building, counseling, and communication (Ross, 1995).

The level of social work involvement in discharge planning may vary depending on hospital size, location, number of social work- ers employed, policies, protocols, and organi- zational culture. In general, physicians refer patients to hospital social workers for concrete services, such as assistance with IADLs, or social-environmental problems, such as those involving fi nancial needs, posthospital care, and transportation, rather than for primarily expressive problems involving attitudes, feel- ings, or behaviors related to health (Cowles & Lefcowitz, 1995). However, in a study by Hol- liman, Dziegielewski, and Datta (2001), social workers in the fi eld perceived their role in discharge planning as requiring specifi c skills related to communication and assessment of social and fi nancial issues, and not just provi- sion of concrete services.

Care Transitions Settings

“Care transitions refer to the movement of patients from one health-care practitioner or setting to another as their conditions and care needs change. These may include tran- sitions from hospitals to nursing homes or home care after an acute illness, or transitions from nursing homes to home care” (California Health Care Foundation, 2008, p. 1). During care transitions, older patients with multiple comorbid conditions are particularly at risk for medical errors, service duplication, pa- tient and caregiver distress, and having criti- cal elements of the care plan fall through the cracks. Ineffectively managing care transitions leads to poor clinical outcomes; dissatisfaction among patients; and inappropriate use of hos- pital, emergency, postacute, and ambulatory services (Coleman & Boult, 2003).

A number of efforts have been undertaken to intervene with transitions of care between providers to prevent relapse, reduce rehospi- talizations, and ensure safe and continuous care (Kanaan, 2009; Naylor & Keating, 2008; Parry, Kramer, & Coleman, 2006). The pri- mary goal of transition care is to improve com- munication among hospital or nursing facility providers, primary care physicians, and other community providers. The secondary goal is to establish a follow-up care plan at the time of discharge to ensure quality of care and safety through education and support.

The Coleman Transition Care Intervention (CTI) model, developed and implemented by Dr. Eric Coleman and colleagues, is a brief intervention designed specifi cally to address the immediate needs of the patient following discharge from health-care settings through patient empowerment, support, and educa- tion (Coleman, 2006). Specifi cally, the in- tervention utilizes a transition coach, who is responsible for empowering patients by helping them develop skills in managing their care and well-being as well as devel- oping skills in navigating and communicat- ing with health-care providers. In particular, a transition coach facilitates development of skills in patients and caregivers in four

ch16.indd 411ch16.indd 411 9/22/11 5:38 PM9/22/11 5:38 PM

412 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

areas: (1) medication management (being knowledgeable about medications and having a medication management system), (2) use of a personal health record (PHR) (understand- ing and using the PHR to facilitate communi- cation and continuity of care across settings), (3) knowledge of “red fl ags” (knowing and recognizing health indicators that suggest their condition is worsening and how to re- spond), and (4) primary care and specialist follow-up (scheduling follow-ups and com- municating their conditions). Transition care is accomplished through at least one visit in the hospital or nursing facility before dis- charge, a home visit, and a series of follow- up phone calls to help the patient make the successful transition. Several tools are avail- able to help transition care coaches perform their tasks (e.g., the patient activation assess- ment tool, which assesses the progress of the patient during follow-up visits; the PHR documentation maintained by the patient on medical conditions and medications; a list of questions that patients can ask of their pri- mary care physicians) (Coleman, 2006).

The CTI model is fl exible in its imple- mentation as it promotes engagement of pro- fessionals from various disciplines including nurses, pharmacists, community workers, or social workers as the designated transi- tion coach (California Health Care Founda- tion, 2008). This model has been fi eld-tested by several organizations as a strategy for improving postdischarge patient care across settings (Adler, Lipkin, Cooper, Agolino, & Jones, 2009; California Health Care Founda- tion, 2008; Graham, Ivey, & Neuhauser, 2009; Naylor & Keating, 2008; Parry et al., 2006), and is supported as a strategy to improve care transition by major health-care organizations, including the Medicare Payment Advisory Commission, Centers for Medicare and Med- icaid Services, Joint Commission for Hospitals and Quality Improvement, and the American Board of Internal Medicine (California Health Care Foundation, 2008).

Evidence suggests that while most older patients face diffi culties in making a success- ful transition from one setting to another, the

barriers are even more pronounced for older adults from minority ethnic groups, recent immigrants, older people without spouses, and those who have limited English-language skills (Graham et al., 2009). The CTI model can benefi t these patients, especially if a cul- turally competent transition coach is available. Box 16.3 describes the CTI model in greater detail.

Although the transition coach role for so- cial workers is innovative, there are challenges to its full implementation in health-care set- tings. These include lack of adequate staffi ng, high turnover among staff, lack of resources in the community, collaborating effectively with community providers, convincing patients and families to take part in the process, and mak- ing follow-up home visits within two days of discharge (California Health Care Foundation, 2008).

Home Health-Care Settings

In 2007, 7.6 million individuals in the United States received home health services from more than 17,000 providers (National Associa- tion of Home Care, 2001). The major sources of funding for home health-care are through Medicare and Medicaid, followed by private out-of-pocket payments. Certifi ed Medicare home health-care providers have to meet the minimum federal standards of patient care and are expected to maintain an electronic Outcome and Assessment Information Set (OASIS) database. This database consists of core elements of a clinical assessment for all the adult home care patients served. The major components of the OASIS are living arrange- ments, supportive assistance, sensory status, skin condition, respiratory status, elimination, neuro/behavioral/emotional status, ADLs and IADLs, medications, medical equipment man- agement, and emergent care (Kane, 2000b).

The federal government utilizes this infor- mation for cost reimbursement and ongoing monitoring to measure patient outcomes for purposes of outcome-based quality improve- ment. A physician has to refer an older pa- tient for home health-care services in order

ch16.indd 412ch16.indd 412 9/22/11 5:38 PM9/22/11 5:38 PM

Social Work With Older Adults in Health-Care Settings 413

to receive Medicare and Medicaid reimburse- ment. Similarly, Medicare mandates that so- cial workers’ services are covered only if they are ordered by physician. The goal of home health-care services for an older person is to reduce the length of inpatient hospital stays and delay of discharge or prevent nursing home placement or hospital readmission through the

provision of a range of health and social ser- vices within the home setting (Dyeson, 2004). Recent reports on home health care show an overall increase in the number of home care agencies since 2001. Estimates are that about 12,564 social workers currently are employed, with an average of 3.31 visits per client (National Association for Home Health Care

Box 16.3 Coleman Care Transitions Intervention

The next elements are the essence of the CTI using a transitional coach.

• Identifi cation of patients. Generally, patients who are at high risk for relapse postdischarge are identifi ed through referral or direct recruitment through high-risk screening based on routine screening and assessment by social workers, nurses, or other community health-care workers. High-risk patients can be identifi ed in settings such as hospitals or nursing care facilities.

• Discharge planning. Conduct an initial visit to prepare patient for discharge. Prior to discharge introduce personal health record and the discharge preparation checklist to patient. The PHR includes the patient’s demographic information, medical history, primary care physician, caregiver contact information, advance directives, medications and allergies, and a list of warning signs (red fl ags). The discharge preparation checklist is completed prior to discharge to ensure that patients understand the discharge process and recommendations.

• Follow-up postdischarge. Conduct home visit(s) and/or phone calls within 24 to 48 hours postdischarge depending on patient needs and risk of relapse. Remind the patient to share PHR with the primary care physician/specialist and discuss outcome of this visit with patient to ensure care compliance and reduce potential relapse risk. During home visits, the transition coach

can undertake patient assessment, education, and activation in self-management skills and gather important information on the patient’s functional abilities, mental abilities, social support, and environmental challenges that inform decisions related to self-management capabilities and needs.

• Termination. Length of intervention is approximately four weeks following discharge. Prior to termination, assess patient’s stability and refer the patient to complementary resources in the community to ensure continuity of care and support as needed.

In contrast to traditional case management approaches, the CTI is a self-management model where a transition coach utilizes modeling techniques rather than “doing” it for the patient. To help the patient and caregiver assume greater involvement and control over postdischarge care, the focus is on patient education and training by provid- ing information on health care, symptom management, medication management, follow-up with doctors, and maintenance of the PHR based on self-assessment. Patients who participated in the CTI were signifi cantly less likely to be readmitted to the hospital, and the benefi ts were sustained for at least fi ve months after the end of the one-month intervention.

Source: Adapted from “The Care Transitions Intervention: A Patient-Centered Approach to Ensuring Effective Transfers between Sites of Geriatric Care,” by C. Parry, E. Coleman, J. Smith, J. Frank, and A. Kramer, 2003, Home Health Services Quarterly, 22(3), pp. 1–17; and the Care Transitions Program at www.caretransitions.org/

ch16.indd 413ch16.indd 413 9/22/11 5:38 PM9/22/11 5:38 PM

414 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

and Hospice, 2008). More than three fourths of benefi ciaries reported having no problems accessing home health-care services, which confi rms the existence of a well-coordinated linkage of services to meet client needs. Minority older adults, however, are less likely to use home care services because of lack of awareness of their availability (Choi, Crist, McCarthy, & Woo, 2010).

Home health-care users are more likely to be White, female, poor, widowed, and di- vorced or single; live alone; have functional limitations in ADLs; and reside in urban areas (Kadushin, 2004). About 69% of all Medicare benefi ciaries are 65 years older, with most re- ceiving home health care because of an acute episode of a chronic illness, such as diabe- tes, hypertension, heart failure, chronic skin ulcer, or osteoarthritis (National Association for Home Health Care and Hospice, 2008). In addition, many have psychosocial issues that compound their illnesses and require care from multiple professionals, including social workers (Lee & Gutheil, 2003).

Following hospital discharge, a homebound patient may require multiple services by a variety of health-care providers. Nurses and physical therapists may assist with medication and rehabilitation; home health aides may as- sist the patient with personal care activities, such as bathing and transferring (i.e., getting in and out of bed or a chair); and homemak- ers may assist with light housekeeping, such as meal preparation, shopping, and laundry. In addition to coordinating these supportive ser- vices, home health social workers can arrange for community services, such as transportation and friendly visitor volunteers. They help the family and older person adjust to having pro- viders enter the home and often provide sup- portive or therapeutic counseling services or arrange for similar services from other agen- cies in the community (Dziegielewski, 2004; Lee & Gutheil, 2003; McInnis-Dittrich, 2009).

A critical function of the social worker is to assess and facilitate the caregiver’s in- volvement in the patient’s recovery and reha- bilitation. Social workers may help caregivers identify, secure, and utilize other community

services, such as adult day health care, to meet the changing needs of the patient (Rossi, 1999). Social workers frequently are engaged in negotiating with health-care providers for specifi c services, service units, time slots, requesting for specifi c staff, and the like, to match the patient’s needs with services. The frequency of denial of requested services is greater in home health settings due to changes in cost reimbursement policies (conversion from a cost-based reimbursement system to a prospective payment system), and social work- ers feel ethically obligated to advocate for their patients (Kadushin & Egan, 2001).

Nursing Home Settings

According to the National Nursing Home Sur- vey, 16,000 nursing homes were operating in the United States in 2004 with about 1.5 mil- lion residents, 88.3% of whom were age 65 years and over (National Center for Health Statistics, 2004). Historically, nursing homes were viewed only as long-term care facilities. However, the past decade has seen greater use of nursing homes for short stays for re- habilitation and care after discharge from the hospital with a concomitant increase in the role of Medicare in fi nancing nursing home care (Rhoades & Sommers, 2003). Residents who are married or living with a partner tend to stay in nursing homes for the least amount of time, compared with widowed, divorced, single, or never-married residents (Talley & Crew, 2007). Seventy-one percent of nursing home residents are female, 57% are widowed, and more than half require assistance in all fi ve areas of ADLs—bathing, dressing, eat- ing, transferring, and toileting—indicating a high level of dependence of care. Evidence suggests that nearly a third of residents are bowel incontinent and over three fourths of them have stage 2 pressure ulcers, which are painful and may lead to other health complica- tions and infections. A quarter of the residents have the circulatory problems as their primary diagnosis, followed by mental disorder (22%) and disease of the nervous system and sense organs (National Center for Health Statistics,

ch16.indd 414ch16.indd 414 9/22/11 5:38 PM9/22/11 5:38 PM

Social Work With Older Adults in Health-Care Settings 415

2004). In addition, residents older than 75 years frequently are diagnosed with dementia and psychiatric conditions, such as schizophrenia and mood disorders. According to the report, the most common mental health disorders residents suffer are delirium, dementia, and depression.

Depression is common among nursing home residents (Jakubiak & Callhan, 1995– 1996; Masand, 1995), especially in patients diagnosed with Alzheimer’s disease. Often it is attributed to coexisting conditions or simply to aging, and thus fails to receive appropriate intervention (Adamek, 2003). The most fre- quently received services by residents include nursing, medicines, medical, personal care, nutritional, social services, and equipment or assistive devices. Other services commonly received from other outside sources include hospice, therapy, podiatry services, dental and oral services, and diagnostic services (National Nursing Home Survey, 2004, www.cdc.gov /nchs/nnhs/nnhs.htm). Residents who are older and more functionally and cognitively im- paired are more likely to receive end-of- life care; three quarters of residents have at least one advance directive on their records (National Center for Health Statistics, 2008).

Private for-profi t nursing facilities employ more full-time social workers (19%) than not-for-profi t homes (7%) and government- run nursing homes (6%) (Center for Health Workforce Studies, 2006) with social workers employed as administrators, specialized unit directors (e.g., dementia care) or direct practi- tioners. Within the nursing home setting, social workers perform a variety of functions, such as doing psychosocial assessments (Nathanson & Tirrito, 1998), working to resolve family confl icts with facility staff and administra- tion (Iecovich, 2000; Vinton, Mazza, & Kim, 1998), and addressing problem behaviors of nursing home residents (Tirrito, 1996). In most nursing homes, social workers are responsible for conducting the preadmission screenings to determine if patients have any major mental disorders (mental retardation, developmen- tal disability, or related disorders) in order to provide appropriate referrals and treatment (Cowles, 2003; Dziegielewski, 2004).

All Medicare- and Medicaid-certifi ed nurs- ing home facilities require a comprehensive assessment of residents within 14 days of ad- mission. In response to public and professional concern about the quality of care in nursing homes across the country in the 1980s, Con- gress directed the Health Care Financing Ad- ministration to study how to improve nursing home regulation. That administration con- tracted with the Institute of Medicine, which issued a report in 1986 titled “Improving the Quality of Care in Nursing Homes.” Congress included many of the institute’s recommenda- tions from this report as part of the 1987 Om- nibus Budget Reconciliation Act. Based on the institute’s report, the act’s regulations require the assessment of nursing home residents in 18 functional areas. The Minimum Data Set was developed as a recommended format for that comprehensive assessment (American Geriatrics Society, 2000). In most facilities, social workers complete the psychosocial as- sessment of the minimum data set to develop the care plan for the resident (Cowles, 2003; Dziegielewski, 2004).

Among the most frequently cited sources of distress that older patients face in transi- tioning into nursing home settings are feel- ings of loss and abandonment; adjustment to new environments; fear and anxiety related to life changes, illness, and prognosis; and loss of privacy, independence, and family connec- tion. Social workers can help residents adjust to their environments by providing emotional support and initiating appropriate interven- tions (individual, family, and group) to en- hance psychosocial functioning. They also can facilitate social integration within nursing homes through planned recreational activities in that setting. In conjunction with the provi- sion of direct services to residents, involve- ment of family is especially critical during admission and discharge (Kruzich & Powell, 1995; Vourlekis, Gelfand, & Greene, 1992). Informal support networks can provide valu- able assistance to older people during their stays in nursing homes by providing support and monitoring the quality of care provided by the staff.

ch16.indd 415ch16.indd 415 9/22/11 5:38 PM9/22/11 5:38 PM

416 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Because family members are considered an integral part of care plans, social workers may want to provide meaningful services to them— for example, therapeutic caregiver support groups or educational groups on illness or end- of-life issues. In settings like nursing homes, where the patients and family members may be unable to negotiate the client’s care due to frailty, inability to make personal decisions, or bureaucracy, social workers can advocate on behalf the patient and empower families to voice their concerns and to negotiate the patient’s treatment needs and care. They also may work with resident councils to improve the quality of care in facilities. In other situ- ations, where there may be confl ict between family members and nursing home staff, social workers can mediate to help resolve the con- fl ict and facilitate improved communication.

ISSUES AND CHALLENGES TO SOCIAL WORK WITH OLDER INDIVIDUALS IN THE CURRENT HEALTH-CARE ENVIRONMENT

Demographic trends make clear that within the next decade, older adults will represent a larger proportion of individuals seen in all parts of the health-care system (primary care, specialty care, inpatient hospital stays, nurs- ing care). As the costs of health care continue to skyrocket, attempts to manage these costs have altered the context in which health care is delivered and signifi cantly infl uenced the practice of social work in a variety of health- care settings. The principal idea underlying managed care has been to control the costs by decreasing “unnecessary utilization” of health-care services, which is accomplished through budget restrictions, case management and utilization review, incentives to providers for limiting services, and using the primary care provider as the gatekeeper for access to care (Berkman, 1996). Managed care, how- ever, presents social workers with a dilemma of being a patient advocate while, to a certain

extent, a gatekeeper of resources. For example, can social workers adequately assess the needs of patients and their families given prevailing time restraints? Can they attend to the prefer- ences of the patient and the family given the institutional mandate to develop and imple- ment a discharge plan that minimizes length of stay (Moody, 2004)?

Although Medicare has enabled access to health care for the population that is 65 and older, older adults have experienced signifi - cantly higher out-of-pocket expenditures re- lated to health care through time, especially for prescription drugs, compared to other age groups, and spend a greater proportion of their income on health care (Administration on Aging, 2010). Thus, advocacy and resource development for health-care products and ser- vices will remain important tasks for social workers in health-care settings.

Given the shortening of inpatient stays in hospitals and the changing nature of nurs- ing home stays (short stay, postacute care), community-based care models will need to be developed to help maintain older adults in community settings. However, the ability to maintain older individuals in the community depends on the availability and pulling together of several community resources. In commu- nities where resources are underdeveloped or where services are fi nancially beyond the reach of clients, case management may sim- ply become a referral service that fails to ad- equately address the needs of older adults and their families (Netting, 1992). Policy advocacy for supporting family caregivers will remain an important area of social work practice to sup- port community-based care for older adults. In addition, with increasing frailty among the population as it ages, the need for advocacy to integrate physical care with in-home psychiat- ric care will be critical, to increase access to psychiatric service, reduce hospital readmis- sions, and save cost. Finally, health promotion and disease prevention activities at the indi- vidual and community levels that help older people maintain functional autonomy and physical and psychological well-being will be important areas of social work intervention.

ch16.indd 416ch16.indd 416 9/22/11 5:38 PM9/22/11 5:38 PM

Social Work With Older Adults in Health-Care Settings 417

SUGGESTED RESOURCES

Administration on Aging—www.aoa.gov This site provides information about

programs, services, and opportunities for older adults and their caregivers. Also links to: Eldercare Locator, www .eldercare.gov, which furnishes infor- mation on state and local area agencies on aging as well as community-based service organizations that provide ser- vices to older adults and their care pro- viders.

American Association of Retired Persons (AARP)—www.aarp.org

AARP is a national, nonprofi t advo- cacy organization for adults age 50 and over. Main topic areas include: care and family, health and wellness, legislation and elections, money and work, policy and research, and travel and leisure. The information on the AARP Web site is also available in Spanish.

American Geriatrics Society (AGS)— www.americangeriatrics.org/

AGS is a not-for-profi t organization of health professionals (primarily physi- cians) devoted to improving the health, independence, and quality of life of all older people. The Web site has useful in- formation especially on policy advocacy and publications on ethnogeriatrics, such as Doorway thoughts: Cross-cultural health care for older adults, vols. 1–3 (AGS 2004, 2006, 2008).

Benefi ts Checkup—www.benefi tscheckup .org

This online service allows individuals (age 55 and over) to check whether they may qualify for a variety of program benefi ts. The service screens over 1,100 programs for federal, state, and local public and private benefi ts.

Care Transitions Program—www.caretran sitions.org/

This program provides descriptions, tools, references, and evidence for the effectiveness of the Care Transitions In- tervention designed to improve quality

of care and patient safety during care handoffs.

Centers for Disease Control and Preven- tion—www.cdc.gov/

This is the offi cial Web site for the federal agency that monitors American’s health and safety. Health and safety top- ics applicable to older adults include: disabilities, diseases and conditions, en- vironmental health, health promotion, and vaccines and immunizations. State and national health and safety data and statistics are also available on this Web site.

Centers for Medicare & Medicaid—www .cms.hhs.gov/

This is the agency’s offi cial Web site. It describes programs, benefi ts, and eli- gibility rules for Medicare and Medicaid.

Council on Social Work Education Gero-Ed Center—www.cswe.org/CentersInitiatives /GeroEdCenter.aspx

This site contains evidence-supported resource reviews, teaching modules, and practice demonstration videos on aging- related topics in the advanced social work practice areas of health, mental health, and substance use. The Health Resource Review is an excellent resource review on social work with older adults.

Family Caregiver Alliance (FCA)—www .caregiver.org

FCA is a national advocacy organiza- tion. The Web site’s topic areas include: public policy and research, caregiving information, fact sheets and publica- tions, newsletters, online discussion and support groups (including specialized groups, such as LGBT support groups), and news releases. The Web site infor- mation is also available in Chinese and Spanish.

Hartford Geriatric Nursing Institute— consultgerirn.org/resources

This site is an excellent resource of- fering articles, case studies, and videos demonstrating the use of assessment tools for a variety of topics relevant to the care of older adults.

ch16.indd 417ch16.indd 417 9/22/11 5:38 PM9/22/11 5:38 PM

418 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Massachusetts Institute of Technology Age Lab—agelab.mit.edu/

The Age Lab was created to invent new ideas and creatively translate tech- nologies into practical solutions that im- prove people’s health and enable them to “do things” throughout the life span. The site describes numerous projects that are in process.

Medicare Rights Center—www.medicarerights .org/

Subtitled “Your Guide through the Medicare Maze,” this national, nonprofi t organization provides information on Medicare plan options and current pol- icy changes.

Psychosocial Measures for Asian-American Populations: Tools for Direct Practice and Research—www.columbia.edu /cu/ssw/projects/pmap/about.htm

This site, maintained by the School of Social Work at Columbia University, contains information on the validity and reliability of a number of assessment in- struments with Asian American popula- tions.

Social Security Administration—www .socialsecurity.gov

This is the offi cial SSA Web site. It offers information on Social Security programs and policies. In addition, indi- viduals can process online claims, esti- mate their future benefi ts, and apply for replacement Social Security cards.

Stanford Geriatric Education Center—sgec .stanford.edu/

This Web site provides a compre- hensive curriculum in ethnogeriatrics (a fi ve-module core curriculum with 11 ethnic-specifi c modules. The primary fo- cus of the SGEC is to provide training on culturally sensitive geriatric care. It is an excellent source of ethnogeriatric information.

Veterans Administration (VA)—www .va.gov

This is the VA’s offi cial Web site. It supplies information on veterans’ health

benefi ts and services, vocational reha- bilitation and employment services, pen- sion benefi ts, and burial and memorial benefi ts.

Volunteers in Health Care (VIH)—www .volunteersinhealth care.org/home.htm

This is the national resource center funded by the Robert Wood Johnson Foundation for organizations and clini- cians caring for the uninsured. The Web site contains useful information on pre- scription drug assistance programs at: www.rxassist.org

SUGGESTED READINGS

Beaulieu, E. M. (2002). A guide for nurs- ing home social workers. New York, NY: Springer.

Provides a comprehensive overview of issues that social workers need to know and address in nursing homes.

Hooyman, N., & Kiyak, A. (2010). Social gerontology: A multidisciplinary per- spective (9th ed.). Boston, MA: Allyn & Bacon.

Reviews the literature on various aspects of aging and discusses implica- tions for a multidisciplinary audience in the allied health and mental health pro- fessions.

Kane, R. L., & Kane, R. A. (Eds.). (2000). Assessing older persons: Measures, meanings, and practical applications. New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

An edited book providing an excel- lent review of available assessment tools for each of the domains of assessment discussed in this chapter.

Knight, B. G. (2004). Psychotherapy with older adults (3rd ed.). Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.

Provides a practical account of the knowledge, technique, and skills nec- essary to work with older adults in a therapeutic relationship. Case examples

ch16.indd 418ch16.indd 418 9/22/11 5:38 PM9/22/11 5:38 PM

Social Work With Older Adults in Health-Care Settings 419

illustrate the dynamics of the therapeutic task and issues covered in therapy and stress the human element in working with older adults.

LEARNING EXERCISE 16.1

Mr. and Mrs. C are an older Caucasian couple who came to the attention of a hospital so- cial worker after Mrs. C had been hospital- ized for dehydration. She was brought to the hospital based on the recommendation of her primary care physician, who had found her to be quite confused and delirious during her visit to the doctor’s offi ce. Mrs. C had been stable over the past few days, but her age (73) and her confusion had fl agged her as an at- risk patient who would need additional atten- tion to develop an adequate discharge plan. The social worker learned that the Cs lived in their own home and their only son lived about 200 miles away from them. The Cs lived modestly on their pension and Social Secu- rity. Mr. C indicated that he wanted his wife discharged to their home as he was quite ca- pable of looking after her. Mr. C himself did not appear to have any observable limitations in his ability to carry out activities of daily living, although he did look tired. The social worker was not entirely convinced of Mr. C’s ability to care adequately for his wife—she did, after all, have to be hospitalized due to dehydration. According to the patient’s chart, Mrs. C’s confusion still seemed to persist, al- though she seemed quite lucid when talking to the social worker. The physician and the nursing staff wanted the social worker to de- velop a discharge plan fairly quickly. The hos- pital social worker decided that Mrs. C should be discharged to her home in the care of her husband. However, she recommended that the physician order home health care for Mrs. C as a nurse could monitor her condition and a social worker could do a more comprehensive assessment in the client’s home. This way, at least someone could monitor this situation for several weeks.

Did the hospital social worker do every- thing she could have done with planning for the couple? What were some of the con- straints or dilemmas the social worker expe- rienced?

ABC Home Health is the agency selected to provide in-home care to Mrs. C. The home health social worker visits the home once to make an assessment. The house seems a little cluttered. Mr. C notes that he does all of the housework but because of the pain caused by his arthritis, he cannot get things done quickly. The social worker suggests that they try to get some homemaker assistance. She gives Mr. C the contact information for the local Area Agency on Aging and also sug- gests that Mr. C call his son to discuss long- term care plans since they would likely need more assistance as time went by. Mr. C. calls the Area Agency on Aging for homemaker assistance but is put on a waiting list. One month later, Mr. C trips on an area rug, which results in a leg fracture, and he ends up in the hospital.

How could this fall have been prevented? What are some of the resources in the com- munity that could have been helpful to the couple? What are the options for Mrs. C now? Research your community’s resources to learn more about how you could help the couple.

Additional Discussion Questions

To use the case for an ethnogeriatric assess- ment exercise: Change the ethnic background/ context of the client (e.g., monolingual Mexi- can American, Vietnamese American who immigrated to the United States for family unifi cation), and integrate the ethnogeriatric principles described in the chapter for assess- ment of the case.

To use the case for a care transition coach exercise: Incorporate the use of a transi- tional  coach and  discuss issues to be ad- dressed in assisting the client to maintain stability  and reduce relapse of the primary condition.

ch16.indd 419ch16.indd 419 9/22/11 5:38 PM9/22/11 5:38 PM

420 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

REFERENCES

AARP. (2000). Fixing to stay: A national survey of housing and home modifi cation issues, Washington, D.C., AARP. Retrieved from http://research.aarp.org /il/home_mod.pdf

Adamek, M. E. (2003). Late-life depression in nursing home residents: Opportunities to prevent, educate, and alleviate. In B. Berkman & L. Harootyan (Eds.), Social work and health care in an aging society: Education, policy, practice and research (pp. 15–48). New York, NY: Springer.

Adler, A., Lipkin, C., Cooper, L., Agolino, M., & Jones, V. (2009). Effect of social work intervention on hospital discharge transition planning in a special needs population. Managed Care, 18(11), 50–43.

Administration on Aging. (2010) A profi le of older Americans: 2009. Washington, DC: U.S. Department of Health and Human Services. Retrieved from http://www .aoa.gov/aoaroot/(S(42nfwo55qzegvw45pkhesp45)) /aging_statistics/Profi le/2009/2.aspx

Agency for Health Care Research and Quality. (2010). Team-developed care plan and ongoing  care management by social workers and nurse practitioners result in  better outcomes  and fewer emergency department visits  for low-income seniors. AHRQ Innovations Exchange. Retrieved from http://www .innovations.ahrq.gov/

Agostini, J. V., Baker, D. I., & Bogardus, S. T. (2001). Geriatric evaluation and management units for hospitalized patients. In K. G. Shojania, B. W. Duncan, K. M. McDonald, & R. M. Wachter (Eds.), Making health care safer: A Critical analysis of patient safety practices. Evidence Report/Technology Assessment No. 43. AHRQ Publication No. 01-E058. Rockville, MD: Agency for Healthcare Research and Quality.

Alexopoulos, G. S., Reynolds, C. F., Bruce, M. L., Katz, I. R., Raue, P. J., Mulsant, B. H., … Ten Have, T. (2009). Reducing suicidal ideation and depression in older primary care patients: 24-Month outcomes of the PROSPECT Study. American Journal of Psychiatry, 166, 882–890.

Alzheimer’s Association. (2004). About Alzheimer’s. Retrieved from www.alz.org/

American Geriatrics Society. (n.d.). The principles of geriatric care. Retrieved from www.americangeriatrics .org/files/documents/Adv_Resources/PayReform _fact3.pdf

American Geriatrics Society. (2000). Regulation of nursing facilities position statement. Retrieved from www.americangeriatrics.org/products/positionpapers /regulnl.shtl

Andrulis, D. P., & Brach, C. (2007). Integrating literacy, culture, and language to improve health care quality for diverse populations. American Journal of Health Behavior, 31(suppl. 1), S122–S133.

Antonucci, T. C., Sherman, A. M., & Vandewater, E. A. (1997). Measures of social support and caregiver burden. Generations, 21(1), 48–51.

Becker, N., & Becker, F. (1986). Early identifi cation of high social risk. Health & Social Work, 11(1), 26–35.

Berkman, B. (1996). The emerging health care world: Implications for social work practice and education. Social Work, 41(5), 541–551.

Berkman, B., Chauncey, S., Holmes, W., Daniels, A., Bonander, E., Sampson, S., & Robinson, M. (1999). Standardized screening of elder patients’ needs for social work assessment in primary care: Use of the SF 36. Health & Social Work, 24(1), 9–16.

Berkman, B., & Harootyan, L. (2003). Social work and health care in an aging society: Education, policy, practice and research (pp. 1–15). New York, NY: Springer.

Brent, E. E., & Brent, R. S. (1987). ERHAP: An artifi cial intelligence expert system for assessing the housing of elderly residents. Housing and Society, 14(3), 215–230.

Bureau of Labor Statistics. (2010). Occupational outlook handbook, 2010–11 ed. Social Workers. Retrieved from www.bls.gov/oco/pdf/ocos060.pdf

California Health Care Foundation. (2008). Navigating care transitions in California: Two models for change. Retrieved from www.caretransitions.org/documents/CA _Two_Models.pdf

Center for Health Workforce Studies and NASW Center for Workforce Studies. (2006). Licensed social workers in the United States, 2004. Rensselaer, NY: University at Albany School of Public Health, and Washington, DC: National Association of Social Workers. Retrieved from http://workforce.socialworkers.org /studies/fullStudy0806.pdf

Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. (2001). Falls among older adults: Summary of research fi ndings. Retrieved from www.cdc.gov/ncipc/pub-res/toolkit /SummaryOfFalls.htm

Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. (2004). Health Information for older adults: Chronic diseases. Retrieved from www.cdc.gov/aging /health_issues.htm

Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. (2009). National suicide statistics at a glance. National Center for Injury Prevention and Control, Division of Violence Prevention. Retrieved from www.cdc.gov /violenceprevention/suicide/statistics/aag.html#5

Centers for Medicare and Medicaid. (2010a). Home and community-based services waiver program. Retrieved from www.cms.gov/home/medicaid.asp

Centers for Medicare and Medicaid. (2010b). Medicaid eligibility. Retrieved from www.cms.gov/Medicaid Eligibility/

Choi, M., Crist, J. D., McCarthy, M., & Woo, S. H. (2010). Predictors of home health care service use by Anglo American, Mexican American and South Korean elders. International Journal of Research in Nursing, 6(1), 8–16.

ch16.indd 420ch16.indd 420 9/22/11 5:38 PM9/22/11 5:38 PM

Social Work With Older Adults in Health-Care Settings 421

Coleman, E. A. (2006). Geriatric interdisciplinary teams in practice care transitions model. Retrieved from www.jhartfound.org/ar2007html/pdf/Hart07_care _transitions_model.pdf

Coleman, E. A., & Boult, C. (2003). Improving the quality of transitional care for persons with complex care needs. Position statement of the American Geriatrics Society Health Care Systems Committee. Journal of the American Geriatrics Society, 51(4), 556–557.

Conwell, Y. (2009). Suicide prevention in later life: A glass half full, or half empty? American Journal of Psychiatry, 166, 845–848.

Cotti, M., & Watt, S. (1989). Discharge planning. In M. J. Holosko & P. A. Taylor (Eds.), Social work practice in health care settings (pp. 469–487). Toronto, Ontario, Canada: Canadian Scholars’ Press.

Coughlin, J. F., Mohyde, M., D’Ambrosio, L.A. & Gilbert, J. (2004). Who drives older driver decisions? Retrieved from http://web.mit.edu/agelab/news_ events/pdfs/AgeLab_driver_decision.pdf

Counsell, S. R., Callahan, C. M., Clark, D. O., Tu, W., Buttar, A. B., Stump, T. E., & Ricketts, G. D. (2007). Geriatric care management for low-income seniors: A randomized controlled trial. JAMA, 298(22), 2623–2633.

Cowles, L. A. (2003). Social work in the health fi eld: A care perspective. New York, NY: Haworth Press.

Cowles, L. A., & Lefcowitz, M. J. (1995). Interdisciplinary expectations of the medical social worker in the hospital setting. Part 2. Health & Social Work, 20(4), 279–286.

Cummings, S. R., & Jackson, D. L. (2000). Hospital discharge planning. In R. L. Schneider, N. P. Kropf, & A. J. Kisor (Eds.), Gerontological social work: Knowledge, service settings, and special populations (2nd ed., pp. 191–224). Belmont, CA: Brooks-Cole.

Cutler, L. J. (2000). Assessment of physical environments of older adults. In R. L. Kane & R. A. Kane (Eds.), Assessing older persons: Measures, meanings, and practical applications (pp. 360–382). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Degenholtz, H. D., Kane, R. A., & Kivnick, H. Q. (1997). Care-related preferences and values of elderly community-based LTC consumers: Can case managers learn what is important to clients? Gerontologist, 37(6), 767–776.

De Jonge, K. E., Taler, G., & Boling, P.A. (2009). Independence at home: community-based care for older adults with severe chronic illness. Clinical Geriatric Medicine, 25(1), 155–169.

Department of Health and Human Services. (1999). The Surgeon General’s call to action to prevent suicide. Washington, DC: Author. Retrieved from www .surgeongeneral.gov/library/calltoaction/default.htm

Diwan, S. (1999). Allocation of case management resources in long-term care: Predicting high use of case management time. Gerontologist, 39(5), 580–590.

Diwan, S. (2008). Limited English profi ciency, patterns of social integration, and depressive symptoms among older Asian Indian immigrants in the U.S. Journal of Gerontology: Social Sciences, 63B(3), S184–S191.

Donaldson, M. S., Yordy, K. D., Lohr, K. N., & Vaneselow, N. A. (Eds.). (1996). Primary care: America’s health in new era. Washington, DC: National Academy Press.

Douglas, K. C., & Lenahan, P. (1994). Ethnogeriatric assessment clinic in family medicine. Family Medicine, 26, 372–375.

Dyeson, T. B. (2004). The home health care social worker: A conduit in the care continuum for older adults. Home Health Care Management & Practice, 16(4), 290–292.

Dziegielewski, S. (2004). The changing face of health social work: Professional practice in managed behavioral health care (2nd ed.). New York, NY: Springer.

Elliott, S., Painter, J., & Hudson, S. (2009). Living alone and fall risk factors in community-dwelling middle age and older adults. Journal of Community Health, 34, 301–310.

Ewing, J. A. (1984). Detecting alcoholism: The CAGE questionnaire. JAMA, 252, 1905–1907.

Fillenbaum, G. G., & Smyer, M. A. (1981). The development, validity, and reliability of the OARS Multidimensional Functional Assessment Questionnaire. Journal of Gerontology, 36, 428–434.

Finch-Guthrie, P. (2000) Care planning for older adults in health care settings. In R. L. Kane & R. A. Kane (Eds.), Assessing older persons: Measures, meanings, and practical applications (pp. 406–437). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Folkman, S., & Moskowitz, J. T. (2000). Positive affect and the other side of coping. American Psychologist, 55(6), 647–654.

Folstein, M. F., Folstein, S. E., & McHugh, P. R. (1975). Mini-mental State: A practical method for grading the cognitive state of patients for the clinician. Journal of Psychiatric Research, 12, 189–198.

Gaugler, J. E., Kane, R. A., & Langlois, J. (2000). Assessment of family caregivers of older adults. In R. L. Kane & R. A. Kane (Eds.), Assessing older persons: Measures, meanings, and practical applications (pp. 320–359). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Gerdner, L. A., Xiong, X., & Yang, D. (2006). Working with Hmong American families. In G. Yeo & D. Gallagher-Thompson (Eds.), Ethnicity and the dementias (pp. 209–230). New York, NY: Routledge.

Gorder, A. C., & Ellor, J. W. (2008). Ethnogeriatrics and comparative religions methods for gerontological research into topics of religion and spirituality. Journal of Religion, Spirituality & Aging, 20(3), 206–219.

Graham, C. L., Ivey, S. L., & Neuhauser, L. (2009). From hospital to home: assessing the transitional care needs of vulnerable seniors. Gerontologist, 49(1), 23–33.

ch16.indd 421ch16.indd 421 9/22/11 5:38 PM9/22/11 5:38 PM

422 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Grann, J. D. (2000). Assessment of emotions in older adults: Mood disorders, anxiety, psychological well- being, and hope. In R. L. Kane & R. A. Kane (Eds.), Assessing older persons: Measures, meanings, and practical applications (pp. 129–169). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Handelman, L., & Yeo, G. (1996). Using explanatory models to understand chronic symptoms of Cambodian refugees. Family Medicine, 28(4), 271–276.

The Hartford. (2005). We need to talk . . . Family conversations with older drivers. Retrieved from www.thehartford.com/talkwitholderdrivers/brochure /brochure.htm

Hasnain-Wynia, R., & Baker, D. W. (2006). Obtaining Data on patient race, ethnicity, and primary language in health care organizations: Current challenges and proposed solutions. Health Services Research, 41(4), 1501–1518.

Holliman, D. C., Dziegielewsk, S. F., & Datta, P. (2001). Discharge planning and social work practice. Social Work in Health Care, 32(3), 1–19.

Hooyman, N., & Kiyak, A. (2002). Social gerontology: A multidisciplinary perspective (6th ed.). Boston, MA: Allyn & Bacon.

Iecovich, E. (2000).  Sources of stress and confl icts between elderly patients, their family members and personnel in care settings. Journal of Gerontological Social Work, 34, 73–88. 

Jakubiak, C., & Callhan, J. (1995–1996). Treatment of mental disorder among nursing home residents: Will the market provide? Generations, 19(4), 39–42.

Johnson, K., Elbert-Avila, K. I., & Tulsky, J. (2005). The infl uence of spiritual beliefs and practices on the treatment preferences of African Americans: A review of the literature. Journal of American Geriatrics Society, 53(4), 711–719.

Kadushin, G. (2004). Home health care utilization: A review of the research for social work. Health & Social Work, 29, 219–244.

Kadushin, G., & Egan, M. (2001). Ethical dilemmas in home health care: A social work perspective. Health & Social Work, 26(3), 136–161.

Kanaan, B. K. (2009). The CHCF care transition projects: Final progress report and meeting summary. Retrieved from http://www.chcf.org/projects/2009/coleman-care -transitions-intervention

Kane, R. A. (2000). Values and preferences. In R. L. Kane & R. A. Kane (Eds.), Assessing older persons: Measures, meanings, and practical applications (pp. 237– 260). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Kane, R. A., Caplan, A., Urv-Wong, E., Freeman, I., Aroskar, M. A. & Finch, M. (1997). Everyday matters in the lives of nursing home residents: Wish for and perception of choice and control. Journal of the American Geriatrics Society, 45(9), 1086–1093.

Kane, R. L. (2000a). Choosing and using an assessment tool. In R. L. Kane & R. A. Kane (Eds.), Assessing older persons: Measures, meanings, and practical applications (pp. 237–260). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Kane, R. L. (2000b). Mandated assessments. In R. L. Kane & R. A. Kane (Eds.), Assessing older persons: Measures, meanings, and practical applications (pp. 458–482). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Kane, R. L. (2000c). Physiological well-being and health. In R. L. Kane, & R. A. Kane (Eds.), Assessing older persons: Measures, meanings, and practical applications (pp. 237–260). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Kane, R. L., & Kane, R. A. (Eds.). (2000). Assessing older persons: Measures, meanings, and practical applications. New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Kaplan, M. S., Adamek, M. E., & Rhoades, J. A. (1998). Prevention of elderly suicide: Physicians’ Assessment of fi rearm availability. American Journal of Preventive Medicine, 15, 60–64.

Katz, S., Ford, A. B., Moskowitz, R. W., Jackson, B. A., Jaffe, M. W., & Cleveland, M. A. (1963). Studies of illness in the aged: The index of ADL—a standardized measure of biological and psychosocial function. JAMA, 185, 914–919.

Kleinman, A. (2004). Culture and depression. New England Journal of Medicine, 351(10), 951–953.

Koenig, H. G. (1990). Research on religion and mental health in later life: A review and commentary. Journal of Geriatric Psychiatry, 23(1), 23–53.

Krause, N. (1995). Negative interaction and satisfaction with social support among older adults. Journal of Gerontology, Series B: Psychological Sciences & Social Sciences, 50, 59–74.

Kruzich, J. M., & Powell, W. E. (1995). Decision-making infl uence: An empirical study of social workers in nursing homes. Health & Social Work, 20(3), 215–223.

Lee, J. S., & Gutheil, I. A. (2003). The older patient at home: Social work services and home health care. In B. Berkman & L. Harootyan, Social work and health care in an aging society: Education, policy, practice and research (pp. 73–95). New York, NY: Springer.

Levin, J. S. (1994). Religion and health: Is there an association, is it valid, and is causal? Social Science and Medicine, 38, 1475–1482.

Lin, K.-M. (1980). Traditional Chinese medical beliefs and their relevance for mental illness and psychiatry. In A. Kleinman & T.-Y. Lin (Eds.), Normal and abnormal behavior in Chinese culture (pp. 95–111). Dordrecht, Holland: D. Reidel.

Linsk, N. L. (2000). HIV Among older adults: Age- specifi c issues in prevention and treatment. AIDS Reader, 10(7), 430–440.

ch16.indd 422ch16.indd 422 9/22/11 5:38 PM9/22/11 5:38 PM

Social Work With Older Adults in Health-Care Settings 423

Liu, K., Manton, K. G., & Aragon, C. (2000). Changes in home care use by disabled elderly persons 1982– 1994. Journal of Gerontology–Series B Psychological Sciences and Social Sciences, 55(4), S245–S253. doi: 10./1093/geronb/55.4

Lubben, J. E. (1988). Assessing social networks among elderly populations. Family Community Health, 11(3), 42–52.

Masand, P. S. (1995). Depression in long-term care facilities. Geriatrics, 50(Suppl. 1), S16–S24.

Mathias, S., Nayak, U. S. & Isaacs, B. (1986). Balance in elderly patients: The “get up and go” test. Archives of Physical Medicine and Rehabilitation, 67(6), 387–389.

Matthias, R. E., Lubben, J. E., Atchison, K. A., & Schweitzer, S. O. (1997). Sexual activity and satisfaction among very old adults: Results from a community-dwelling Medicare population survey. Gerontologist, 37, 6–14.

Maynard, G., & Stein, J. (2008). Preventing hospital- acquired venous thromboembolism: A guide for effective quality improvement. Rockville, MD: Agency for Healthcare Research and Quality.

McBride, M. R., & Lewis, I. D. (2004). African American and Asian American elders: An ethnogeriatric perspective. In J. J. Fitzpatrick (Ed.), Annual review of nursing research (Vol. 22) (pp. 161–214). New York, NY: Springer.

McBride, M. R., Morioka-Douglas, N., & Yeo, G. (1996). Aging and health: Asian and Pacifi c Island American elders (SGEC Working Paper Series No. 3, 2nd ed.). Stanford, CA: Stanford Geriatric Education Center.

McInnis-Dittrich, K. (2009). Social work with older adults (3rd ed.) Boston, MA: Allyn and Bacon.

Min, J. W. (2005). Cultural competency: A key to effective future social work with racially and ethnically diverse elders. Families in Society: Journal of Contemporary Social Services, 86(3), 347–358.

Mojtabal, R., & Olfson, M. (2003). Medication costs, adherence, and health outcomes among Medicare benefi ciaries. Health Affairs, 22(4), 220–229.

Moody, H. R. (2004). Hospital discharge planning: Carrying out orders? Journal of Gerontological Social Work, 43(1), 107–118.

Nathanson, I., & Tirrito, T. (1998). Gerontological social work: Theory into practice. New York, NY: Springer.

National Association for Home Health Care and Hospice. (2008). Basic statistics about home care. Washington, DC: Author.

National Association of Social Workers. (2003). Lesbian, gay, and bisexual issues. Social work speaks: National Association of Social Workers policy statements, 2003–2006 (6th ed., pp. 224–235). Washington, DC: NASW Press.

National Center for Health Statistics. (2004). Health status of older adult. Findings from National Health and Nutrition Examination Survey 1999–2004. Retrieved from http://media.pfizer.com/files/products/The_Health _Status_of_Older_Adults_2007.pdf

National Center for Health Statistics. (2008). End of life care. Report by National Nursing Home Survey, No. 9 (pp. 1–24). Washington, DC: Centers for Disease Control and Prevention.

National Center on Elder Abuse. (2004). NCEA: The source of information and assistance on elder abuse. Retrieved from www.elderabusecenter.org

National Institute on Aging. (2004). General information: How many Americans have AD? Alzheimer’s Disease Education & Referral Center. Retrieved from www .alzheimers.org/generalinfo.htm

National Nursing Home Survey (2004). Retrieved from www.cdc.gov/nchs/nnhs.htm

Naylor, M. D., & Keating, S. A. (2008). Transitional care: Moving patients from one care setting to another. American Journal of Nursing, 8(9), 58–63.

Netting, E. F. (1992). Case management: Service or symptom? Social Work, 37(2), 160–164.

Oktay, J. S. (1995). Primary health care. In R. L. Edwards (Ed.), The encyclopedia of social work (19th ed., pp. 1887–1894). Washington, DC: NASW Press.

Olson, D. M., & Kane, R. A. (2000). Spiritual assessment. In R. L. Kane & R. A. Kane (Eds.), Assessing older persons: Measures, meanings, and practical applications (pp. 300–319). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Organista, K. C. (2009). New practice model for Latinos in need of social work services. Social Work, 54(4), 297–305.

Parry, C., Coleman, E., Smith, J., Frank, J., & Kramer, A. (2003). The care transitions intervention: A patient- centered approach to ensuring effective transfers between sites of geriatric care. Home Health Services Quarterly, 22(3), 1–17.

Parry, C., Kramer, H., & Coleman, E. A. (2006). A qualitative exploration of a patient-centered coaching intervention to improve care transitions in chronically ill older adults. Home Health Care Services Quarterly, 25(3–4), 39–53.

Pearson, V. I. (2000). Assessment of function in older adults. In R. L. Kane & R. A. Kane (Eds.), Assessing older persons: Measures, meanings, and practical applications (pp. 17–48). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Pinquart, M., & Sörensen, S. (2005). Ethnic differences in stressors, resources, and psychological outcomes of family caregiving: A meta-analysis. Gerontologist, 45(1), 90–106.

Raleigh, E. H., & Boehm, S. (1994). Development of a Multidimensional Hope Scale. Journal of Nursing, 2(2), 155–167.

Reisberg, B., Ferris, S. H., de Leon, M. J., & Crook, T. (1982). The Global Deterioration Scale for assessment of primary degenerative dementia. American Journal of Psychiatry, 139, 1136–1139.

Rhoades, J., & Sommers, J. P. (2003). Trends in nursing home expenses, 1987–1996. Health Care Financing Review, 25(1), 99–114.

ch16.indd 423ch16.indd 423 9/22/11 5:38 PM9/22/11 5:38 PM

424 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Robinson, B. (1983). Validation of a Caregiver Strain Index. Journal of Gerontology. 38, 344–348.

Rosich, R. M. (2007). The human mosaic. Cultural beliefs and health professions training. Annals of the New York Academy of Sciences, 1114, 310–316.

Ross, J. W. (1995). Hospital work. In R. L. Edwards (Ed.), The encyclopedia of social work, (19th ed., pp. 1365– 1377). Washington, DC: NASW Press.

Rossi, P. (1999). Case management in health care. Philadelphia, PA: WB. Saunders.

Sarason, I. G., Levine, H. M., Basham, R. B., & Sarason, B. R. (1983). Assessing social support: The Social Support Questionnaire. Journal of Personality and Social Psychology, 44(1), 127–139. doi: 10.1037/0022– 3514.44.1.127

Shah, P. N., Maly, R. C., Frank, J. C., Hirsch, S. H., & Reuben, D. B. (1997). Managing geriatric syndromes: What geriatric assessment teams recommend, what primary care physicians implement, what patients adhere to. Journal of the American Geriatrics Society, 45, 413–419.

Siegler, I. C., Poon, L. W., Madden, D. J., & Welsh, K. A. (1996). Psychological aspects of normal aging. In E. W. Busse & D. G. Blazer (Eds.), The American Psychiatric Press textbook of geriatric psychiatry (2nd ed., pp. 105–128). Washington, DC: American Psychiatric Press.

Spector, W. D., Fleishman, J. A., Pezzin, L. E., & Spillman, B. C. (2000, September). The characteristics of long-term care users (AHRQ Publication No. 00– 0049). Agency for Healthcare Research and Policy, Rockville, MD. Retrieved from http://www.ahrq.gov/ research/ltcusers/

Stanford Geriatric Education Center. (2001). Curriculum in ethnogeriatrics. Core curriculum and ethnic- specifi c modules. Retrieved from http://www.stanford. edu/group/ethnoger/index.html

Stutts, J., Martell, C., & Staplin, L. (2009). Identifying behaviors and situations associated with increased crash risk for older drivers. Washington, DC: Offi ce of Behavioral Safety Research, National Highway Traffi c Safety Administration. Report No. DOT HS 811 093.

Talley, R. C., & Crew, J. E. (2007). Framing the public health of caregiving. American Journal of Public Health, 97(2), 224–228.

Teri, L., Truax, P., Logsdon, R., Uomoto, J., Zarit, S., & Vitaliano, P. P. (1992). Assessment of behavioral problems in dementia: The Revised Memory and Behavior Problems Checklist. Psychology of Aging, 7, 622–631.

Thrope, M., Patterson, M. E., & Sleath, B. L. (2006). Psychological distress as a barrier to preventive care in community-dwelling elderly in the United States. Medical Care, 44(2), 187–191.

Tirrito, T. (1996). Mental health problems and behavioral disruptions in nursing homes: Are social workers prepared to provide needed services? Journal of Gerontological Social Work, 27(1–2), 73–87.

Tran, T. V., Ngo, D., & Conway, K. (2003). A cross-cultural measure of depressive symptoms among Vietnamese Americans. Social Work Research, 27, 56–65.

U.S. Department of Health and Human Services. (1999). Mental health: A report of the Surgeon General. Rockville, MD: Author. Retrieved from www .surgeongeneral.gov/library/mentalhealth/home.html

U.S. Census Bureau, (2004). The Older population in the United States: March 2002. Retrieved from www . c e n s u s . g o v / h h e s / w w w / h o u s i n g / h o m e ow n /tab4.html

Unger, J. B., McAvay, G., Bruce, M. L., Berkman, L., & Seeman, T. (1999) Variation in the impact of social network characteristics on physical functioning in elderly persons: MacArthur Studies of Successful Aging. The Journals of Gerontology: Series B, 54(5): S245-51.

Uncapher, H., Gallagher-Thompson, D., Osgood, N., & Bonger, B. (1998). Hopelessness and suicidal ideation in older adults. Gerontologist, 38(1), 62–70.

Underwood, L., & Teresi, J. (2002). The Daily Spiritual Experience Scale: Development, theoretical description, reliability, exploratory factor analysis, and preliminary construct validity using health-related data. Annals of Behavioral Medicine, 24(1), 22–33.

Urdangarin, C. F. (2000). Comprehensive geriatric assessment and management. In R. L. Kane & R. A. Kane (Eds.), Assessing older persons: Measures, meanings, and practical applications (pp. 383–405). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Van Craen, K., Braes, T., Wellens, N., Denhaerynck, K., Flamaing, J., Moons, P., . . . Milisen, K. (2010). The effectiveness of inpatient geriatric evaluation and management units: A systematic review and meta- analysis. Journal of the American Geriatrics Society, 58, 83–92. doi: 10.1111/j.1532–5415.2009.02621.x

Vinton, L., Mazza, N., & Kim Y. (1998). Aggression perpetrated by family members in nursing homes: An investigation of dynamics and interventions. Clinical Gerontologist, 19, 45–68.

Vourlekis, B. S., Gelfand, D., & Greene, R. R. (1992). Psychosocial needs and care in nursing homes: Comparison of views of social workers and home administrators. Gerontologist, 32(1), 113–119.

Wall, J. C., Bell, C., Campbell, S., & Davis, J. (2000). The timed Get-up-and-go Test revisited: Measurement of the component tasks. Journal of Rehabilitation Research and Development, 37 (1), 109–114.

Ware, J. E., & Sherbourne, C. D. (1992). The MOS 36- item short form health survey (SF-36). Conceptual framework and item selection. Medical Care, 30, 473–483.

Widlitz, M., & Marin, D. B. (2002). Substance abuse in older adults: An overview. Geriatrics, 57(12), 29–34.

Wieland, D., & Hirth, V. (2003). Comprehensive geriatric assessment. Cancer Control, 10(6), 454–462.

ch16.indd 424ch16.indd 424 9/22/11 5:38 PM9/22/11 5:38 PM

Social Work With Older Adults in Health-Care Settings 425

Wiley, D., & Bortz, W. M. (1996). Sexuality and aging— Usual and successful. Journals of Gerontology, 51, M142–M146.

Xakellies, G., Brangman, S. A., Hinton, W. L., Jones, V. Y., Masterman, D., Pan, C. X., . . . Yeo, G. (2004). Curricular framework: Core competencies in multicultural geriatric care. Journal of American Geriatric Society, 52(1), 137–142.

Yeo, G. (1996). Ethnogeriatrics: Cross-cultural care of older adults. Generations, 20(1), 72–77.

Yeo, G. (2009). How will the U.S. health care system meet the challenge of the ethnographic imperative?

Journal of American Geriatric Society, 57(7), 1278–1285.

Yeo, G., David, D., & Llorens, L. (1996). Faculty development in ethnogeriatrics. Educational Gerontology, 22(1), 79–91.

Yeo, G., Hikoyeda, N., McBride, M., Chin, S.-Y., Edmonds, M., & Hendrix, L. (1998). Cohort analysis as a tool in ethnogeriatrics: Historical profi les of elders from eight ethnic populations in the United States (SGEC Working Paper Series No.12). Stanford, CA: Stanford Geriatric Education Center.

ch16.indd 425ch16.indd 425 9/22/11 5:38 PM9/22/11 5:38 PM

426

17

Substance Use Problems in Health Social Work Practice

MALITTA ENGSTROM, COLLEEN A. MAHONEY, AND JEANNE C. MARSH

Substance use problems are widespread in our society and are present across diverse age, gender, sexual orientation, racial, cultural, and socioeconomic backgrounds. Social workers, regardless of the setting in which they work, are likely to encounter clients with substance use problems. Given the health effects of sub- stance use, social workers in health-care set- tings are particularly likely to encounter this population. Whether patients present with physical illnesses directly related to substance use (e.g., cirrhosis of the liver) or with health problems with no obvious link to substance use, it is crucial that health social workers be aware of the potential role of substance use in clients’ health, treatment, and social needs (Abbott, 2002). This chapter provides social workers with basic knowledge and core skills necessary to address substance use problems across a variety of clients and health-care settings.

Chapter Objectives • Defi ne terms and diagnostic categories used

to describe substance use problems. • Identify the prevalence of substance use

and problems across sociodemographic groups.

• Present information about the psychoactive and health effects of substances that are commonly used.

• Provide an overview of practice and re- search regarding prominent approaches to assist people experiencing substance use problems.

• Provide general information to guide screening for substance use problems and brief intervention to address these problems in health-care settings.

DEFINITION OF TERMS

A variety of expressions are used to describe substance use problems in lay and professional writing and conversation. Addiction, drug abuse, and alcoholism are but a few common terms. It is widely agreed, however, that these and other terms are not always used in a con- sistent fashion (National Institute on Alcohol Abuse and Alcoholism [NIAAA], Center for Substance Abuse Prevention [CSAP], & Pub- lic Health Service, 1995; White, 1998). Yet the use of a stable vocabulary is essential. In ad- dition, because of the particular role of health social workers as translators between health- care systems and patients (see Chapter 10 in this book for a discussion of communication), it is especially important to use language in a clear, concise, and consistent manner. This chapter begins with a clarifi cation of terms and expressions.

This entire domain often is referred to as the substance abuse fi eld or the addictions fi eld (van Wormer & Davis, 2003). Although both labels provide a shortcut to describing

ACKNOWLEDGMENT: The authors thank Scott Petersen for his helpful comments on an earlier ver- sion of this chapter.

JWBT514_ch17.indd 426JWBT514_ch17.indd 426 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Substance Use Problems in Health Social Work Practice 427

p. 16) and therefore is not included in the dis- cussion of legal drugs.

Certain levels of problematic substance use do not meet the criteria for a diagnosable dis- order but nonetheless may require attention. Standard terminology exists for designating amount of use and potential risk. For example, research on and clinical screening for prob- lematic alcohol use generally defi nes current use as at least one drink in the past 30 days, binge use as fi ve or more drinks on the same occasion at least once in the past 30 days, and heavy use as fi ve or more drinks on the same occasion at least fi ve different days in the past 30 days, according to the Substance Abuse and Mental Health Services Adminis- tration [SAMHSA] (2009). However, NIAAA (2004a) recently has revised the defi nition of binge drinking to consumption that el- evates blood alcohol concentration (BAC) to .08 gram percent and higher. This BAC is typi- cally achieved among men by consuming fi ve drinks or more in a 2-hour period and among women by consuming four drinks or more in a 2-hour period.

Intoxication, withdrawal, craving, toler- ance, dependence, and addiction are impor- tant terms that describe various aspects of the experience of using psychoactive substances. Intoxication describes a reversible state caused by the recent use of a substance that typically is characterized by a substance-specifi c con- stellation of physiological, behavioral, and cognitive-emotional changes. Withdrawal, however, describes substance-specifi c behav- ioral, physiological, and cognitive-emotional changes that result from stopping or reduc- ing substance use, particularly when use has been signifi cant and long term. Withdrawal typically involves the opposite experiences that are associated with intoxication of the substance consumed (e.g., the euphoria of co- caine intoxication is countered by feelings of depression in cocaine withdrawal) and occurs with these psychoactive substances: alcohol; nicotine; cocaine; opioids; amphetamines and related substances; and sedatives, hypnotics, or anxiolytics. Craving, or the intense desire to use the substance, often occurs while in

the fi eld, it is important to note that they also can take on other meanings depending on the context. Substance abuse, although commonly used to denote a range of substance use prob- lems, distinguishes a specifi c disorder in the Diagnostic and Statistical Manual of Men- tal Disorders, Fourth Edition, Text Revision (DSM-IV-TR; American Psychiatric Associa- tion, 2000). Addiction most commonly im- plies a severe level of problematic substance use that involves dependence and continued pursuit and use of substances in the midst of negative consequences. Furthermore, addic- tion often is applied to problematic behaviors other than substance use (e.g., gambling). In this chapter, the discussion is limited to the be- havior of problematic psychoactive substance use; however, it is not restricted to substance use that meets the criteria for specifi c disor- ders but includes all levels of problematic use. Accordingly, the expression substance use problems is used to designate the entire range of problematic substance use. At times, when brevity and grammar require it, the term sub- stance abuse is used in a general way to denote all levels of substance use problems.

The term substance refers to both legal and illegal psychoactive substances that affect the central nervous system (CNS) when consumed. Users experience pleasure or diminished pain through the alteration of mood, cognition, perception, memory, or consciousness. Alco- hol, nicotine, and caffeine are legal psychoac- tive substances. The term drug is used most often to refer to illegal “street” psychoactive substances (e.g., marijuana, cocaine, heroin) and prescribed medications used illegally. The acronyms AOD (alcohol and other drugs) and ATOD (alcohol, tobacco, and other drugs), however, emphasize that alcohol and tobacco are themselves drugs. These acronyms assist in countering the popularly held myth that street drugs are different from, and more dangerous than, alcohol and tobacco. In this chapter, the term substance denotes both legal and illegal psychoactive substances. Although caffeine, a stimulant, is widely used, it “does not ordinar- ily pose a threat to health or an impairment to functioning” (McNeece & Barbanell, 2005,

JWBT514_ch17.indd 427JWBT514_ch17.indd 427 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

428 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

the state of withdrawal to alleviate symptoms (American Psychiatric Association, 2000). After using a substance over time, individuals develop tolerance when they must use more of the substance to achieve the same effect previ- ously achieved with a smaller amount (Wilcox & Erickson, 2005). The terms addiction and dependence are not defi ned consistently. As noted by O’Brien and Volkow (2006), it is important to distinguish between the normal physical dependence that is associated with numerous psychoactive medications (e.g., opi- oids, beta-blockers, and antidepressants) and addiction. Tolerance and withdrawal, which are anticipated physiological responses to nu- merous psychoactive substances, do not nec- essarily indicate that a person is experiencing addiction, which involves problematic pursuit of drugs despite negative consequences. Such confusion, according to O’Brien and Volkow, can keep clinicians from providing appropriate pain medication when clients display tolerance and withdrawal even though addiction is not present. In addition, they argue, some clients may needlessly avoid appropriate pain medi- cation because they equate physical depen- dence with addiction. Finally it is important to note that the DSM diagnosis of substance dependence does not necessarily require the experience of tolerance or withdrawal (Ameri- can Psychiatric Association, 2000).

DIAGNOSTIC CATEGORIES

The DSM-IV-TR (American Psychiatric As- sociation, 2000) classifi es substance-related disorders into two groups. Substance use dis- orders are defi ned by a pattern of problem- atic substance use and include the diagnostic categories of substance abuse and substance dependence. Substance-induced disorders refer to the patterns of physiological, behav- ioral, cognitive, and emotional responses to substance ingestion and substance use cessa- tion. These include substance intoxication and substance withdrawal as well as substance- induced mental disorders (e.g., delirium, per- sisting dementia, persisting amnestic disorder,

psychotic disorder, mood disorder, anxiety disorder, sexual dysfunction, sleep disorder).

The DSM-IV-TR (American Psychiatric Association, 2000) provides general criteria that apply across substances for substance abuse, de- pendence, intoxication, and withdrawal. In ad- dition, it provides specifi c information for each of these diagnoses across 11 different classes of substances. This section describes general crite- ria for substance use disorders.

Substance Abuse

This disorder is characterized by repeated use of a substance that leads to negative conse- quences but is not severe enough to meet the criteria for substance dependence diagnosis. Nicotine and caffeine are not included among the substances that can meet criteria for abuse. Specifi c DSM-IV-TR criteria for substance abuse can be found in the Diagnostic and Sta- tistical Manual of Mental Disorders, Fourth Edition, Text Revision (American Psychiatric Association, 2000).

Substance Dependence

This disorder is characterized by a constella- tion of symptoms indicating that the individ- ual continues to use the substance although signifi cant negative consequences result. The individual repeatedly seeks and consumes the substance and may experience tolerance for and withdrawal from the substance. Indi- viduals who meet the criteria for substance dependence disorder are not diagnosed with substance abuse disorder. Specifi c criteria can be found in the Diagnostic and Statistical Manual of Mental Disorders, Fourth Edition, Text Revision (American Psychiatric Associa- tion, 2000).

The terms alcoholism and drug addiction are generally interchangeable with substance dependence. Alcoholic and addict are terms used to describe the person with alcohol dependence disorder or another substance (generally illegal) dependence disorder, re- spectively. These terms are part of a common vocabulary within many self-help groups,

JWBT514_ch17.indd 428JWBT514_ch17.indd 428 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Substance Use Problems in Health Social Work Practice 429

such as Alcoholics Anonymous (AA), and can be important identifying labels for those active in these groups. Nonetheless, these labels also can be stigmatizing. It is prefer- able to replace the terms alcoholic and addict with person-fi rst language, such as “a person experiencing alcohol (or other substance) de- pendence.” Person-fi rst language, which often is used with other physical, psychological, and developmental conditions, assists in con- veying the fact that the health condition does not defi ne the person’s entire identity. In addi- tion, such language assists with emphasizing that one is a person rather than a health con- dition. There are efforts under way to replace the term substance dependence with addiction in the development of the DSM-5 (O’Brien & Volkow, 2006). If such change occurs, person- fi rst language that describes a person experi- encing addiction still can be employed.

COMMONLY USED SUBSTANCES

Media representations of substance abuse tend to convey stereotypes that focus on people with limited incomes in inner cities selling and using illegal drugs (Cornelius, 2002). Al- though there is no question that drug use is a problem for the inner city, its reach and magni- tude go far beyond the confi nes of urban areas with high rates of poverty and include diverse racial, cultural, gender, and income groups. Furthermore, the use of legal drugs —tobacco and alcohol—across socioeconomic groups and regions represents the most prevalent and costly component of drug-related problems (SAMHSA, 2009). This section provides in- formation about the epidemiology and the psychoactive and health effects of legal and illegal substances that are commonly used in problematic ways.

Alcohol

The 2008 NSDUH indicates that just over half of all Americans 12 years and older report cur- rent use of alcohol (SAMHSA, 2009). More

than 50% of American adults have a close family member who has met the diagnostic criteria for alcohol dependence (Dawson & Grant, 1998). Among children younger than 18 years in the United States, approximately 1 in 4 is exposed to alcohol abuse or alcohol dependence in the family (Grant, 2000). In the United States and worldwide, alcohol is one of the most widely used and dangerous drugs. Problematic use of alcohol leads to deleteri- ous effects on biological, psychological, and social well-being. Furthermore, its effects may extend beyond the individuals engaged in problematic alcohol use to their families and communities.

Alcohol is a CNS depressant that, un- like many other psychoactive substances, is thought to affect multiple CNS neurotransmit- ter systems (Moak & Anton, 1999). Kranzler and Anton (1994) suggest that the relation- ships between alcohol and neurotransmitter systems are likely to vary across subtypes of persons with alcohol use problems. Relatedly, individuals vary in their levels of vulnerability toward alcohol use disorders. Research sug- gests that genetics account for approximately 60% of total vulnerability (Prescott & Kendler, 1999). Thus, close relatives of persons with al- cohol use disorders should be educated about their increased risk.

Epidemiology

The 2008 NSDUH indicates that young adults age 18 to 25 years experience the highest rates of problem drinking (SAMHSA, 2009). Approximately 41% of this group reported binge drinking in the past month, and 14.5% reported heavy alcohol use in the same time period. Within this group, men were more likely than women to report binge (48.4% ver- sus 33.6%) and heavy (19.9% versus 9.0%) al- cohol use. Asian American young adults were least likely to report binge (24.9%) and heavy (6.4%) use. White American young adults age 18 to 25 years reported the highest rates of problematic alcohol use (47.1% and 18.1% for binge and heavy use, respectively).

In the same survey, adolescents age 12 to 17 years reported alcohol use at rates that are

JWBT514_ch17.indd 429JWBT514_ch17.indd 429 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

430 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

cause for concern. Approximately 30.8% used alcohol in the past year, and 8.8% of the same group had engaged in binge drinking in the past month. Gender differences in drinking rates were less signifi cant among adolescents than among young adults. Interestingly, girls age 12 to 17 years reported greater lifetime alcohol use than boys (39.1% versus 37.6%). Rates of past-month binge use were compara- ble for boys and girls (8.9% and 8.7%, respec- tively). Among diverse racial/ethnic groups, Asian adolescents reported the lowest rates of lifetime use (25.2%) and past-month binge use (2.0%). African American youth also reported relatively low binge use rates (4.0%). Ameri- can Indian, Hispanic, and White American ad- olescents reported the highest levels of lifetime use (46.6%, 39.3%, and 39.8%, respectively).

After a peak in young adulthood, rates of alcohol use, binge use, and heavy use slowly decline as people age (SAMHSA, 2009). Be- tween the ages of 26 and 64 years, current alcohol use decreases from 67.4% to 50.3%. Likewise, rates of binge and heavy alcohol use slowly decrease as adults become older (from 42.6% to 14.6% for binge drinking and from 13.2% to 3.6% for heavy drinking). Men and women age 26 years and older differed in their reported rates of binge drinking (31.7% ver- sus 13.2%). Among racial groups within the same age range, Hispanic adults report the highest rate of binge drinking (26.4%), Asian adults report the lowest rate of binge drink- ing (10.7%), and all other racial groups report rates between 21.4% and 24.0%.

Over 8% (8.2%) of adults 65 years and older reported binge drinking, and 2.2% re- ported heavy drinking (SAMHSA, 2009). Although these rates are relatively low when compared with younger and middle-age adults, alcohol use in older populations constitutes a serious problem that should not be overlooked. Older adults have unique vulnerabilities that put them at greater risk of negative outcomes when using even relatively small amounts of alcohol. For example, individuals in this group may reach higher BAC with less alcohol con- sumption than individuals in other groups (NIAAA, 2004a). In addition, alcohol use may

increase the risk of falls among older adults, and recovery from such incidents can be dif- fi cult (Center for Substance Abuse Treatment [CSAT], 1998).

Health Effects

The health effects of alcohol use are wide ranging and staggering. Alcohol has an effect on multiple organs and systems and is asso- ciated with several types of cancer. Illnesses that are a direct result of or are severely ex- acerbated by alcohol use account for 20% to 40% of patients in urban hospitals (NIAAA, 2000). Alcohol often is involved in episodes of violence, injury, and trauma, which leads to signifi cant and repeated contacts with the health-care system. Research suggests that alcohol is associated with 67% of partner as- saults, 50% of homicides, 40% of traffi c fa- talities, and 37% of rapes (NIAAA, 2000). Perhaps the most telling evidence of alcohol’s negative impact on health is the fact that aver- age life span is decreased by 10 to 15 years for persons with alcohol dependence (Schuckit & Tapert, 2004).

Considerable research demonstrates that chronic heavy drinking is a leading cause of cardiovascular illnesses (NIAAA, 2000). In fact, heart disease is the leading cause of early mortality among those with alcohol depen- dence (Schuckit & Tapert, 2004). Men with alcohol dependence are two times more likely than men without alcohol dependence to die from atherosclerotic and degenerative heart disease; women with alcohol dependence are four times more likely to die from these dis- eases than those who do not have alcohol de- pendence (McNeece & DiNitto, 2005). Based on a review of available evidence, the Dietary Guidelines Advisory Committee (DGAC, 2010), appointed by the U.S. Drug Admin- istration (USDA) and the U.S. Department of Health and Human Services (DHHS), cites the association between low to moderate amounts of drinking (i.e., average alcohol consump- tion of not more than two drinks per day for men and one drink per day for women) and re- duced risk of coronary heart disease, diabetes, and all causes of mortality among middle-age

JWBT514_ch17.indd 430JWBT514_ch17.indd 430 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Substance Use Problems in Health Social Work Practice 431

and older adults; however, as discussed by Williams, Mohammed, Leavell, and Collins (2010), African Americans, particularly Af- rican American men, do not experience the same gains. In addition, the effects of even low or moderate levels of alcohol on risk of breast cancer, colon cancer, liver cancer, and unintentional injuries complicate the risk- benefi t considerations of alcohol use. It should be noted that gender, diet, lifestyle, and other health factors may differentially infl uence the relationship between alcohol and these cancers (DGAC, 2010).

Liver disease commonly is associated with alcohol use. According to the 10th Special Report to the U.S. Congress on Alcohol and Health (NIAAA, 2000), “long-term heavy al- cohol use is the leading cause of illness and death from liver disease in the United States” (p. 198). The liver is central to human survival and health because it both processes key nutri- ents and assists the body’s defense system to fi lter toxins from the blood. Long-term mod- erate to heavy alcohol use is associated with changes in the liver that are described in three phases, together known as alcoholic liver dis- ease. Fatty liver, the fi rst phase of the disease, is generally reversible with abstinence. The sec- ond phase of alcoholic liver disease, alcoholic hepatitis, is characterized by infl ammation of the liver. Cirrhosis, or scarring of the liver, is the fi nal phase of this disease. The prognosis for persons who have both alcoholic hepatitis and cirrhosis is poor, with a death rate over a four-year period greater than 60% (Chedid et al., 1991). Alcohol also plays a signifi cant role in other types of liver diseases. For ex- ample, alcohol consumption may enhance ac- etaminophen liver toxicity, and although the specifi c mechanism is unknown, alcohol con- sumption is associated with greater severity of hepatitis C (NIAAA, 2000).

People who have alcohol dependence are at increased risk for cancer, especially of the head, neck, esophagus, and stomach; lung can- cer occurs at higher rates in this group even after controlling for smoking status. Although not yet well understood at a physiological level, it is clear that heavy alcohol use has

a signifi cant effect on the immune system. Infections that are a result of immune defi - ciency, such as pneumonia, occur at higher rates among persons who are heavy alcohol users than among the general population. Human immunodefi ciency virus (HIV) rates are higher among persons who abuse alcohol. Several factors may contribute to this fi nding, including high-risk sexual activity and injec- tion drug use associated with alcohol use and alcohol’s immune-suppressing effect, which may increase susceptibility to HIV.

Chronic alcohol use can lead to multiple neurological disorders. Neuropathy, a disorder of the nerves in which an individual experi- ences pain and numbness in the legs and feet, is associated with heavy alcohol use. Wernicke’s syndrome and Korsakoff’s psychosis also are related to heavy use. They often occur in com- bination and are characterized by confusion, inability to learn new material, and other cog- nitive defi cits (McNeece & DiNitto, 2005).

Risk of fetal alcohol syndrome and other alcohol exposure–related disorders are of par- ticular concern for women of childbearing age. Drinking alcohol during pregnancy increases the risk of spontaneous abortion, low birth weight, small brain volume, heart defects, varying levels of mental retardation, and fa- cial abnormalities. Although binge drinking is associated with increased risk to the fetus, no amount of alcohol consumption during preg- nancy has been established as safe (Stratton, Howe, & Battaglia, 1995).

Tobacco

Although it is common knowledge that tobacco is toxic and that its nicotine component is ex- tremely addictive, tobacco use is not always included in the substance abuse literature. Nevertheless, no other psychoactive substance is associated with the morbidity and mortal- ity of tobacco (Slade, 1999). The National In- stitute on Drug Abuse (NIDA, 2001a) reports that “tobacco kills more than 430,000 U.S. citizens each year—more than alcohol, co- caine, heroin, homicide, suicide, car accidents, fi re, and AIDS [acquired immunodefi ciency

JWBT514_ch17.indd 431JWBT514_ch17.indd 431 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

432 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

syndrome] combined” (p. 3). In spite of high rates of use, known negative health conse- quences, and the fact that treatment works (NIDA, 2001a), health providers rarely offer smokers assistance with quitting (U.S. Pub- lic Health Service [USPHS], 2000). Further- more, individuals who have other substance use problems or serious mental illness are of- fered assistance with smoking cessation even less frequently, even though they may have a greater need for services than the general population (Grant, Hasin, Chou, Stinson, & Dawson, 2004).

The reasons for this treatment failure are complex. Until recently, few effective treat- ments for smoking cessation had been iden- tifi ed. Furthermore, health-care systems did not support their consistent delivery (USPHS, 2000). However, research conducted by Lemon, Friedman, and Stein (2003) with 2,316 participants from the Drug Abuse Treat- ment Outcome Study (DATOS) who reported consumption of cigarettes at the beginning of the study and who participated in follow-up interviews suggests that smoking cessation is positively associated with increased absti- nence from illegal drug use 12 months after completing substance use treatment. Although it should be noted that those who smoke less were more likely to stop and that those who completed treatment were more likely to be in this sample, the research can “raise questions about the clinical myth that nicotine depen- dence should be treated only after stabilization of the primary drug dependence” (p. 1330). Similarly, smoking cessation efforts may be particularly relevant among people living with HIV, for whom smoking may negatively affect immune functioning over time and in- crease risk of infections of the respiratory tract (Chiasson, 1994).

Initial ingestion of nicotine can result in unpleasant experiences, such as headaches and nausea. Tolerance for these symptoms develops quickly, however, and regular users report that tobacco helps with relaxation and concentration (Slade, 1999). Addiction occurs with regular use, and withdrawal symptoms, such as irritability, sleep disturbances, craving,

and cognitive defi cits, can occur for a month or more following cessation of use (NIDA, 2001a).

Epidemiology

The 2008 NSDUH estimated that 28.4% of the U.S. population 12 years and older were current users of tobacco products. Adolescents age 12 to 17 years reported current use rates of 11.4%. Boys were more likely than girls to report use (12.6% versus 10.2%). American Indian adolescents reported the highest rates of tobacco use (22.0%) and Asian youth the lowest rates (4.4%) of all racial groups.

Similar to patterns of alcohol use, current tobacco use rates peaked during young adult- hood. Among persons age 18 to 25 years, 41.4% reported using tobacco in the past month. Rates of use among gender and ra- cial groups in this age group varied similarly to those seen among adolescents. Men used at rates greater than women (48.8% versus 33.8%). Asian and African American young adults reported the lowest rates of current use (20.0% and 30.7%, respectively); American Indian and White American young adults re- ported the highest rates of current use (52.8% and 47.5%).

Among people 26 years and older, 28.3% reported current tobacco use. Men continued to use at rates greater than women (35.0% versus 22.2%).

Health Effects

The negative effects of tobacco on health and the health-care system are legion. In fact, NIDA (2010b) reports that “tobacco use is the lead- ing preventable cause of disease, disability, and death in the United States.” Approximately 8.6 million Americans suffer from at least one seri- ous illness caused by smoking, and annual esti- mates indicate that smoking is responsible for economic losses of $75 billion in excess medi- cal expenditures (Centers for Disease Control and Prevention [CDC], 2004). Cigarette use is strongly associated with lung cancer, heart dis- ease, and chronic obstructive pulmonary disease (emphysema and chronic bronchitis). Smokers are at increased risk for stroke and peripheral

JWBT514_ch17.indd 432JWBT514_ch17.indd 432 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Substance Use Problems in Health Social Work Practice 433

vascular disease, and many cancers of the mouth, throat, larynx, and esophagus are related to cigarette use (NIDA, 2001a; Slade, 1999). In 2001, NIDA (2001a) reported that “cigarette smoking is the most important preventable cause of cancer in the United States” (p. 5).

It is estimated that approximately 20% of pregnant women in the United States smoke throughout their pregnancies (NIDA, 2001a), an alarming statistic given that maternal smok- ing is associated with a variety of adverse pregnancy outcomes, including abruption of the placenta (separation from the uterine wall), low birth weight, premature delivery, and in- creased risk of sudden infant death syndrome (SIDS; NIDA, 2001a; Slade, 1999). In a large study examining the prenatal effects of mul- tiple substances, Shiono and colleagues (1995) concluded, “[I]n the United States, cigarette smoking remains the single largest preventable cause of adverse pregnancy outcomes” (p. 26).

Cannabis

Among the U.S. population 12 years and older, approximately 10.3% and 6.1% reported mari- juana use in the past year and month, respec- tively (SAMHSA, 2009). These prevalence rates make marijuana the most commonly used illegal drug. Literature examining the effects of marijuana is confl icting, and most purported fi ndings are in need of replication. For exam- ple, some longitudinal studies have found that heavier marijuana use in adolescence is associ- ated with less stability in adult roles (Kandel, Davies, Karus, & Yamaguchi, 1986); however, it is unclear whether these outcomes are due to marijuana use or if they are better explained by other substance use or preexisting differ- ences between heavy marijuana users and oth- ers (Stephens, 1999).

Cannabis is most often smoked but some- times is mixed into food. Users may experience mild euphoria, relaxation, and enhancement or distortion of perceptual experiences. Intoxi- cation often involves impairment in attention and short-term memory. Typically lethargy and sleepiness occur as the effects wear off (Stephens, 1999). Addiction can occur as a

result of long-term use in some people (NIDA, 2004a), and some authors report that clinicians are encountering “more marijuana-dependent patients than ever before” (Gold, Frost-Pineda, & Jacobs, 2004, p. 177).

Epidemiology

As previously noted, the 2008 NSDUH re- ported that 6.1% of persons 12 years and older were current users of marijuana. Among illicit-substance users specifi cally, 75.7% reported that they had used marijuana, mak- ing it the most commonly used illegal sub- stance. This fi nding was true across broad age groups; however, it is interesting to note that 12- and 13-year-olds reported current use of psychotherapeutics (prescription-type medi- cations used nonmedically; 1.5%) and inhal- ants (1.3%) at rates greater than marijuana (1.0%). Rates of cannabis use peaked for 18- to 25-year-olds, with 16.5% reporting current use. Male young adults reported higher current use rates (20.1%) than female young adults (12.8%). This gender difference continued among people 26 years and older, with 5.8% of men and 2.8% of women reporting current use. Among adolescents, the gender differ- ences were in the same direction but were less substantial, with 7.3% of boys and 6.0% of girls reporting current use.

Asian and African American youth age 12 to 17 years reported the lowest rates of current use (1.0% and 5.9%, respectively), whereas youths who identifi ed as two or more races or as White American reported the highest rates (10.6% and 7.2%, respectively). Among 18- to 25-year-olds, persons identifying as two or more races or as American Indian re- ported the highest rates of current use (22.8% and 20.4%, respectively), whereas White and African American young adults reported lower, but still substantial, rates of use (17.8% and 18.2%, respectively).

Health Effects

Few conclusive negative health effects directly related to marijuana use exist. One primary concern is related not to the psychoactive ingredients of marijuana but to the preferred

JWBT514_ch17.indd 433JWBT514_ch17.indd 433 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

434 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

mode of its administration (Stephens, 1999). Like tobacco, marijuana frequently is smoked and appears to pose similar health risks, such as increased rates of respiratory problems and cancer (NIDA, 2002a; Slade, 1999). Research examining marijuana use during pregnancy has produced mixed fi ndings (Keegan, Parva, Finnegan, Gerson, & Belden, 2010). Some studies have shown that smoking marijuana during pregnancy is associated with low birth weight (Hatch & Bracken, 1986; Zuckerman et al., 1989); however, a large multicenter study found that when tobacco use was con- trolled for, marijuana use was not related to low birth weight or preterm delivery (Shiono et al., 1995).

Increasing attention is being given to the positive or medicinal effects of marijuana use; however, it is not without controversy. Proponents state that marijuana is effective in treating a range of symptoms associated with cancer, HIV/AIDS, multiple sclerosis, and glaucoma. Detractors emphasize the potential harm and suggest that medicalizing marijuana is simply a strategy to allow easier access for recreational use. By 2010, 15 states had ac- tive medical marijuana programs, but their laws stand in contrast to federal law, which prohibits all use of cannabis. A review of the evidence by the Institute of Medicine (IOM) culminated in a report issued in 1999. The report summarized research examining the ef- fectiveness of marijuana to treat pain, wasting syndrome, nausea, muscle spasticity, move- ment disorders, epilepsy, and glaucoma. Evi- dence is strongest for alleviating pain, nausea, and appetite loss such that “for patients such as those with AIDS or who are undergoing chemotherapy, and who suffer simultaneously from severe pain, nausea, and appetite loss, cannabinoid drugs might offer broad-spectrum relief not found in any other single medica- tion” (Joy, Watson, & Benson, 1999, p. 177). However, the report also is cautious to rec- ommend smoking marijuana as “good medi- cine” (p. 177). Although tetrahydrocannabinol (THC), the active ingredient in marijuana, is shown to have therapeutic effects, marijuana also delivers other toxic substances, including

many found in tobacco smoke. Thus, the re- port recommends that future research include clinical trials with the aim of developing safer delivery systems of cannabinoid drugs.

Cocaine

Cocaine is a powerful stimulant currently used by approximately 0.7% of persons 12 years and older in the United States (SAM- SHA, 2009). It is sold as a white powder or in crack form and can be snorted, injected, or smoked. Immediate effects include mental alertness; increased energy; euphoria; and in- creased heart rate, blood pressure, and body temperature. With high duration and doses of stimulants, individuals may experience stimu- lant delirium, which can include symptoms of disorientation, confusion, anxiety, and fear; in episodes of high doses, individuals also may experience symptoms of psychosis and para- noia and behavioral compulsions (Kosten & Sofuoglu, 2004).

The onset, duration, and intensity of these effects depend on the route of administration. For example, crack cocaine, easily made by cooking powder cocaine with water and am- monia or sodium bicarbonate (baking soda), is smoked, resulting in an intense high within a matter of seconds (Kosten & Sofuoglu, 2004; NIDA, 1999a). Snorting powder cocaine gen- erally elicits effects within 20 minutes; intra- venous injection generally elicits effects in 30 seconds (Kosten & Sofuoglu, 2004).

Epidemiology

In 2008, 14.7% of U.S. persons 12 years and older reported that they had used cocaine dur- ing their lifetimes. Men were more likely than women to report both lifetime use (17.7% versus 11.9%) and current use (1.0% versus 0.5%). Among adolescents 12 to 17 years old, however, girls reported greater lifetime use than boys (2.1% versus 1.7%), but boys re- ported greater current use (0.5% versus 0.3%). Youth who identifi ed as being of two or more races or as White American reported a cur- rent cocaine use rate of 0.5%, the highest in this age group. The lowest rates of current use

JWBT514_ch17.indd 434JWBT514_ch17.indd 434 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Substance Use Problems in Health Social Work Practice 435

were reported by Asian (0.0%) and African American (0.1%) adolescents.

Current cocaine use peaked among 21-year- olds (2.3%). Young adult men (18–25 years old) reported current use rates of 1.8% whereas 1.3% of women age 18 to 25 years reported current use. As with adolescent racial groups, Asian and African American young adults re- ported the lowest rates of current cocaine use at 0.2% and 0.3%, respectively. This trend changed, however, among adults 26 years and older, with African Americans reporting the highest current use rate (1.2%).

Health Effects

Some of cocaine’s health effects differ with the route of administration (NIDA, 2010a). For example, intranasal use (snorting) may re- sult in nosebleeds, lost sense of smell, and a persistently runny nose, and injecting cocaine may result in allergic reactions and risk of con- tracting HIV and other blood-borne infections, including viral hepatitis. Sharing drug-related equipment for intranasal and inhalation use of cocaine also may increase the risk of contract- ing viral hepatitis (Aaron et al., 2008; Macias et al., 2008; NIDA, 2010a).

Heavy use of cocaine and other stimulants often results in health problems involving mul- tiple systems. Cardiovascular and gastrointesti- nal illnesses are common, as are problems with the CNS and reproductive system (Weaver & Schnoll, 1999). Research suggests that cocaine is particularly dangerous when used in com- bination with alcohol. The body transforms cocaine and alcohol into a substance (cocaeth- ylene) that is more toxic than either drug alone. This mixture results in more deaths than any other two-drug combination (NIDA, 1999a).

Some have argued that the primary nega- tive effects of problematic cocaine use are psy- chological and social rather than physiological (Weil & Rosen, 1993), but it is important to note that cocaine abuse is associated with acute car- diovascular and cerebrovascular events, includ- ing heart attack and stroke, that may result in death (NIDA, 2010a). Two recent studies—one in New Mexico and one in British Columbia— found elevated rates of cocaine overdose since

the 1990s (Buxton et al., 2009; Shah, Lathrop, Reichard, & Landen, 2007). Recent research from New York City suggests that elevated am- bient temperature (above 24°C—approximately 75°F) is associated with accidental, fatal over- dose of cocaine and that public health efforts to reach at-risk populations during warm weather are particularly important (Bohnert, Prescott, Vlahov, Tardiff, & Galea, 2010).

Many studies have documented that ba- bies born to women who use cocaine during pregnancy are prematurely delivered, have low birth weight, and have smaller head circumfer- ences than babies not exposed to cocaine in utero (NIDA, 1999a). Because of methodolog- ical limitations, however, it has been diffi cult for research to tease out the effects of cocaine from those of other co-occurring conditions, such as maternal use of other substances, lack of prenatal care, and low socioeconomic status (Singer, 1999). Furthermore, NIDA (1999a) asserts that predictions about “crack babies” suffering profound irreversible damage has proven to be a “gross exaggeration” because most of these children have been able to re- cover from earlier defi cits (p. 6). They do cau- tion, however, that more sophisticated research techniques now are demonstrating an associa- tion between fetal cocaine exposure and later subtle defi cits in behaviors such as concentra- tion and blocking out distractions.

Heroin

In 2008, approximately 213,000 Americans (0.1% of the population) older than 12 years reported current heroin use (SAMHSA, 2009). In spite of the relatively small number of users, it represents a serious and signifi cant public health problem. Heroin can be smoked, snorted, injected under the skin (“skin-popping”), or injected into a vein (“mainlining”). Users gen- erally experience a pleasurable sensation, or “rush,” followed by a period of drowsiness and mental cloudiness. Although heroin long has been associated with marginalized groups of people, the 1990s saw its use spread to people from middle and upper-middle socioeconomic classes (Stine & Kosten, 1999).

JWBT514_ch17.indd 435JWBT514_ch17.indd 435 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

436 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Heroin, derived from morphine, belongs to a class of substances known as opioids, which are used for relieving pain. Prescription medications belonging to this class include morphine, codeine, oxycodone (OxyContin), hydrocodone (Vicodin), propoxyphene (Darvon), meperidine (Demerol), and hydromorphone (Dilaudid) (NIDA, 2009b, 2010b). For epi- demiological purposes, these prescription medications are covered in the “Psychothera- peutics” section; they tend to produce effects similar to those of heroin.

Epidemiology

In 2008, 1.5% of persons in the United States 12 years and older reported that they had used heroin in their lifetime. Predictably, lifetime use rates were highest for those 26 years and older (1.7%) and lowest for those 12 to 17 years old (0.3%). Young adults age 18 to 25 reported a lifetime heroin use rate of 1.4%.

Health Effects

NIDA (2000) states: “[O]ne of the most det- rimental long-term effects of heroin is addic- tion itself” (p. 3). Regular users experience tolerance, need to administer higher doses to get the desired effects, and develop physical dependence. If heroin is not readministered, painful physiological withdrawal symptoms may occur for up to a week. Some people continue to experience withdrawal symptoms for months (NIDA, 2010b). These symptoms include restlessness, muscle and bone pain, in- somnia, gastrointestinal disturbance, involun- tary leg movements, and cold fl ashes (NIDA, 2005a). Overdose leading to death is possible and is a signifi cant risk for street users who do not know the purity level of the heroin they have obtained. Heroin injectors run the risk of acquiring blood-borne viruses, such as HIV and hepatitis C, particularly when needles are shared. Intranasal use also may increase the risk of viral hepatitis (Aaron et al., 2008). Col- lapsed veins, liver disease, abscesses, infection of the heart lining and valves, and pulmonary complications are possible outcomes of long- term heroin use (NIDA, 2000).

Studies indicate that infants born to women with heroin dependence are more frequently premature, tend to have low birth weight, and often experience a range of perinatal complications and abnormalities (McNeece & DiNitto, 2005). Maternal heroin use also is associated with miscarriage and a greater risk of SIDS. Maternal and infant outcomes can be improved with a combination of com- prehensive methadone treatment and prenatal care (NIDA, 2010b). Infants born to women who are engaged in methadone treatment can be treated safely if they show signs of physi- cal dependence (NIDA, 2000). Buprenor- phine is emerging as a promising treatment during pregnancy. Detoxifi cation from opi- oids during pregnancy should be considered carefully in light of risk to the fetus (NIDA, 2010c).

Hallucinogens

Hallucinogens comprise a broad group of over 100 different substances that share the capacity to effect a variety of sensory distor- tions and hallucinations. Historically, select hallucinogens have been used among some groups as part of religious and spiritual ritu- als. For example, mescaline, derived from the peyote cactus, is used by certain Native Indian peoples of Mexico and is also a central compo- nent of rituals in the Native American Church (Durrant & Thakker, 2003).

Hallucinogens commonly known in the United States include LSD, PCP, mushrooms, and ecstasy (MDMA). Ecstasy is a designer drug that is tailor-made to produce specifi c effects. It is known as a party drug and a yuppie psychedelic and can produce both stim- ulant and hallucinogenic effects (McNeece & DiNitto, 2005). Users may experience mild euphoria and expanded mental perspective and insight. Negative effects include confu- sion, sleep disruption, anxiety, and paranoia, sometimes weeks after taking the substance. Physiological symptoms such as dehydration, blurred vision, teeth clenching, chills, sweat- ing, and nausea have been observed (McNeece & DiNitto, 2005).

JWBT514_ch17.indd 436JWBT514_ch17.indd 436 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Substance Use Problems in Health Social Work Practice 437

Epidemiology

In 2008, an estimated 1.06 million Americans 12 years and older reported current hallucino- gen use, and about 3.7 million people reported using hallucinogens in the past year. Among past-year users, approximately 640,000 people reported using ecstasy, 154,000 reported using LSD, and 24,000 people reported using PCP (SAMHSA, 2009).

Among racial groups, younger Asian and African American people reported the lowest rates of lifetime hallucinogen use. Specifi - cally, they reported rates of 0.8% and 1.4% as adolescents and 7.5% and 9.5% as young adults. Among people 26 years and older, their reported lifetime use rates remained low (5.2% and 9.9%, respectively), along with those of Latinos (9.4%). Estimates of reported lifetime hallucinogen use were not available for Amer- ican Indians 26 years and older; however, among adolescents and young adults, their re- ported rates were highest (13.8% and 31.9%).

Health Effects

With the exception of ecstasy, hallucinogens pose few known health risks. The use of LSD has been associated with enduring psychoses, but it is unclear the extent to which LSD is causal (Abraham, Aldridge, & Gogia, 1996). During the acute hallucinogenic state, there is the risk of accidental injury or death. This is particularly true with PCP use because para- noia and confusion are associated with its acute effects (Stephens, 1999).

Taken in high dosages, ecstasy is associated with hyperthermia and can lead to cardiovas- cular, kidney, and liver failure. Neurotoxicity has been demonstrated in animals, and al- though studies have not defi nitively shown the same results in humans (NIDA, 2005c), clinical reports have documented toxic effects and fatality associated with ecstasy use (Dar & McBrien, 1996).

Inhalants

Inhalants are breathable chemical vapors found in many common items and household

substances. Examples include gasoline, paint, cleaning fl uids, glue, marking pens, lighter fl uid, and lacquer thinner. These substances are sniffed, or “huffed,” for their psychoac- tive effects. Although the effects of each of the particular substances can vary, intoxication generally resembles that of alcohol and may include stimulation and euphoria, followed by disinhibition, agitation, and light-headedness. With increased volume of vapor inhalation, anesthesia and unconsciousness can result (NIDA, 2005b).

Epidemiology

Because of their accessibility and affordabil- ity, inhalants are often a substance of choice for young people. In 2008, an estimated 1.1% of American youth age 12 to 17 years reported current inhalant use (SAMHSA, 2009). Among the same group, 9.3% reported lifetime use. Lifetime rates were higher for girls (10.1%) than for boys (8.4%), and American Indians reported the highest rate (16.8%) in this age group among ethnic/racial groups. Among all adolescents, 14-year-olds were the most likely to report inhalant use in the past month (1.5%) and past year (5.1%) (SAMHSA, 2009).

Health Effects

Inhalants are extremely toxic and potentially lethal. Over 700 deaths, mostly of teens and preteens, were reported to the National Inhal- ant Prevention Coalition between 1996 and 2001 (CSAP, 2003). Negative health effects include damage to the brain, lungs, kidneys, and liver. Inhalant use has been associated with sudden death, known as sudden sniffi ng death syndrome (NIDA, 2005b).

Psychotherapeutics

Psychotherapeutic medication is the second most commonly used illegal substance today. In 2008, 2.5% of Americans 12 years and older reported current use of these substances. Psychotherapeutics include the nonmedical use of prescription-type pain relievers, tran- quilizers, stimulants, and sedatives. They comprise numerous kinds of substances that

JWBT514_ch17.indd 437JWBT514_ch17.indd 437 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

438 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

are obtained either with a prescription or il- legally, “on the street.” Classes of these substances most commonly abused include opioids (e.g., morphine, codeine, oxycodone), CNS depressants (barbiturates and benzo- diazepines), and stimulants (e.g., dextroam- phetamine [Dexedrine], methylphenidate [Ritalin], methamphetamine) (NIDA, 2001b). Depending on the dose administered, opioid users often experience euphoria followed by a signifi cant decrease in tension and anxiety (Stine & Kosten, 1999). CNS depressants pro- vide a calming and sedating function (Brady, Myrick, & Malcolm, 1999), whereas stimu- lants cause an increase in alertness, attention, and energy along with a feeling of euphoria (Weaver & Schnoll, 1999).

Epidemiology

Among those 12 years and older in the United States, 20.8% reported that they had used psy- chotherapeutics in their lifetime (SAMHSA, 2009). Men reported slightly higher lifetime rates than women (22.4% versus 19.3%), and young adults age 18 to 25, when compared with other age groups, reported the highest lifetime use rate (29.2%). Young adults also reported the highest current use rate (5.9%) among age groups. People 26 years and older reported the lowest current use rate at 1.9%. Almost 3% of adolescents (12- to 17-year olds) reported cur- rent use of psychotherapeutics.

Overall, men reported slightly greater cur- rent and lifetime use rates of psychotherapeu- tics than women (2.6% versus 2.4% and 22.4% versus 19.3%). This gender pattern varied, however, when examined by age groups. Girls 12 to 17 years old were more likely than boys of the same age to report current use and life- time use (3.3% versus 2.5% and 12.4% ver- sus 9.9%, respectively). This gender pattern switched, however, among 18- to 25-year-olds, with men reporting current and lifetime use rates (6.3% and 30.8%) higher than those of women (5.5% and 27.6%). Among adults 26 years and older, women and men were similar in their current use (1.8% and 1.9%), but men were more likely than women to report life- time use (22.6% versus 18.8%).

Among youth age 12 to 17 years, Asian ado- lescents reported the lowest current rate of psy- chotherapeutic use (0.7%). Youth identifying as two or more races or as American Indian re- ported the highest rates of use (4.2% and 4.0%, respectively). During young adulthood, White Americans joined American Indians and peo- ple identifying as two or more races to report the highest rates of current psychotherapeutic use (7.2%, 5.9%, and 7.7%, respectively) while Asian American persons continued to report the lowest rates (3.0%). Among people older than 26 years, Asian Americans again reported the lowest rates of current psychotherapeutic use (0.7%) while American Indians and White Americans retained their position as report- ing the highest rates of current use (2.2% and 2.1%, respectively).

Health Effects

The health consequences of psychotherapeu- tics vary widely because the substances them- selves have such wide variation in chemical and psychoactive properties. Opioids, prescribed to treat pain, include morphine, codeine, oxy- codone, meperidine, and propoxyphene. Long- term use of these and other opioids can result in tolerance, physical dependence, and addic- tion. If use is reduced or stopped abruptly, withdrawal symptoms such as restlessness, in- somnia, irritability, diarrhea, nausea, and cold fl ashes may occur (NIDA, 2001b). Severe in- toxication or overdose is potentially lethal and requires immediate medical attention (Stine & Kosten, 1999). Recent research suggests increasing rates of overdose from prescrip- tion opioids (Compton & Volkow, 2006; Hu & Baker, 2009; Paulozzi, Ballesteros, & Stevens, 2006).

A particular challenge in health-care set- tings involves balancing attention to opioid medication risks with appropriate pain man- agement (Savage, Kirsh, & Passik, 2008; Zacny et al., 2003). The physical dependence associated with opioid medications does not in and of itself demonstrate problematic use of the medication (O’Brien & Volkow, 2006); however, as noted by Zacny and colleagues, opiophobia, driven by inadequate medication

JWBT514_ch17.indd 438JWBT514_ch17.indd 438 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Substance Use Problems in Health Social Work Practice 439

information and intense fears of medication misuse, persists and contributes to poor treat- ment of pain. Although social workers do not prescribe medication, they may play an impor- tant role in assessing clients’ current and past substance use, intervening to support clients’ pain management strategies, assisting cli- ents experiencing problematic substance use, referring clients for additional services and self-help programs, and collaborating with the entire treatment team (Savage et al., 2008). A recent publication by Savage and colleagues (2008) provides more detailed guidance for social workers engaged in balancing pain management and substance use concerns with clients in their settings.

CNS depressants, prescribed to treat sleep and anxiety disorders, include barbitu- rates and benzodiazepines such as diazepam (Valium), chlordiazepoxide (Librium), alpra- zolam (Xanax), and clonazepam (Klonopin). Tolerance for these substances develops when they are taken over time, and physical de- pendence, withdrawal, and addiction are also risks. Sleep disorder medications such as zol- pidem (Ambien), eszopiclone (Lunesta), and zaleplon (Sonata) are also CNS depressants, although they seem to be associated with reduced risk of problematic use. If used in combination with alcohol, pain medications, some cold and allergy medications, or other substances that make one drowsy, CNS de- pressants can slow one’s breathing and heart rate, possibly leading to death (NIDA, 2009a). Benzodiazepines must be used cautiously with older adults because their use is a risk factor for falls causing fractures and for cognitive impairment (NIDA, 2001b).

Prescription-type stimulants include am- phetamines such as dextroamphetamine and Adderall and methylphenidate as found in Ritalin and Concerta. Users may experience euphoria, decreased appetite, and heightened energy and attention. Irregular heartbeat, high body temperature, and cardiovascular failures or seizures are associated with high dosages of stimulants. Combining stimulants with decon- gestants may result in dangerous elevations in blood pressure or heart arrhythmias; combining

them with antidepressants may heighten the stimulant’s effects (NIDA, 2009a).

Methamphetamine is closely related to the substance amphetamine; however, its ef- fects on the CNS are greater (NIDA, 2004b). Highly addictive, it produces a high of lon- ger duration than that of cocaine. It can cause a variety of serious health effects including rapid heart rate, increased blood pressure, hy- perthermia, and, over time, changes in brain functioning, signifi cant weight loss, dental problems, psychosis, and various problems related to mood and behavior. Methamphet- amine overdose can lead to hyperthermia and convulsion and, without proper medical atten- tion, can be fatal. Research suggests that use during pregnancy may lead to prenatal com- plications, premature delivery, and heart and brain problems for the baby; further research is needed in this area to address methodologi- cal limitations of the available research as well as altered patterns of neonatal behavior (NIDA, 2002b).

PROMINENT APPROACHES TO CONCEPTUALIZE AND ADDRESS SUBSTANCE USE PROBLEMS

Interventions to address substance use prob- lems are informed and shaped by a variety of factors. Conceptual models that explain the development of substance use problems tend to articulate and advocate for specifi c inter- ventions and desired outcomes. For example, a conceptualization of substance use problems as the result of a complex illness that requires God’s power for healing (AA, 2001) is promi- nent in spiritually based, 12-step approaches, such as AA (Miller & Hester, 1995; Schil- ling & El-Bassel, 1998) while conceptualiza- tions of substance use problems as the result of learning processes are prominent in cog- nitive-behavioral approaches (Longabaugh & Morgenstern, 1999; Marlatt & Gordon, 1985). With attention to evidence-based practices (Miller, Zweben, & Johnson, 2005), this sec- tion briefl y describes prominent approaches

JWBT514_ch17.indd 439JWBT514_ch17.indd 439 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

440 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

and modalities to assist people experiencing substance use problems. It then provides more detailed discussion of screening and brief in- terventions that are likely to be employed by social workers in health-care settings.

Reconciling Diverse Perspectives

Proponents of particular approaches are di- vided as to their effi cacy (Miller & Hester, 1995). Commitment to particular approaches and conceptual frameworks is shaped in com- plex ways. For example, such commitments may be shaped by evaluation of available evidence, personal preferences, one’s own treatment and recovery experiences, and af- fi liations based on training and association (Borden, 2000). The overview of prominent approaches presented here focuses specifi - cally on their conceptual tenets, implications for intervention, and available evidence that supports them. Furthermore, although intense divisions exist among proponents of particular approaches, no one approach has been shown to be effective in serving all persons (Miller & Hester, 1995; NIDA, 2009b).

The term systematic or informed eclecticism has been used to describe the process through which social workers and other service provid- ers should approach making decisions about which models to employ to help people ef- fectively (Hepworth, Rooney, & Larsen, 2002; Miller & Hester, 1995). This process involves systematically considering available evidence to guide intervention, with preference for ap- proaches that are evidence based, comprised of clearly described strategies and techniques, consistent with social work ethics, within the social worker’s competencies, and culturally competent (Hepworth et al., 2002). To facili- tate this process of systematic or informed eclecticism, this discussion addresses available evidence regarding each of the approaches.

Moral and Temperance Perspectives

Throughout the course of history, many per- spectives have informed approaches to un- derstanding and addressing substance use

problems. Numerous authors describe the evo- lution of understanding regarding problematic substance use (McNeece & DiNitto, 2005; Miller & Hester, 1995; Schilling & El-Bassel, 1998). Early models conceptualized problem- atic substance use as a moral issue, refl ecting moral weakness, sin, and volitional disregard for social norms of behavior (McNeece & DiNitto, 2005; Miller & Hester, 1995). The temperance movement emerged in the United States in the late 1800s and advocated for the judicious, moderate use of alcohol, based on its potential for harmful consequences (Miller & Hester, 1995). Differing perspectives exist on the role of the temperance movement in con- tributing to a moralistic view of problematic substance use. Some authors assert that “the core of the temperance model is that the cause of alcohol problems is alcohol itself” (Miller & Hester, 1995, p. 3). This conceptualization would suggest that limiting access to alcohol by making it more costly or less available and encouraging moderation and abstinence would be useful interventions (Miller & Hes- ter, 1995). Others assert, “[P]rior to the activi- ties of the Temperance Movement, a force that eventually led to the adoption of Prohibition in the United States, the consumption of alcohol was not necessarily considered to be a sinful act” (Marlatt, 1985b, p. 182). This view of the role of the temperance movement puts par- ticular emphasis on the moral perspective of problematic substance abuse, with attention to the individual’s lack of self-control (Marlatt, 1985b). The moral perspective informs inter- ventions that focus on punishment through so- cial and legal consequences for substance use (Miller & Hester, 1995).

Disease Models

Early in the 19th century, Benjamin Rush, a physician in the United States, proposed a disease framework for understanding alcohol use problems (Marlatt, 1985a). This frame- work further evolved through the 20th cen- tury. In 1935, AA began and contributed to disseminating the concept of alcoholism as a disease rather than a moral failing (Kinney &

JWBT514_ch17.indd 440JWBT514_ch17.indd 440 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Substance Use Problems in Health Social Work Practice 441

Leaton, 1991; Schilling & El-Bassel, 1998). In the 1940s, E. M. Jellinek and his colleagues at Yale University also contributed to the for- mulation of the current disease model of al- coholism (Kinney & Leaton, 1991; Marlatt, 1985a). One way of considering elements of the disease model is refl ected in the perspec- tive of William Silkworth, known as a friend of AA: “an obsession of the mind and an allergy of the body” (Kinney & Leaton, 1991, p. 54). This conceptualization refl ects recognition of the psychological and biological components of the disease perspective; however, as argued by Miller and Hester (1995), the 12-step ap- proach also incorporates considerable em- phasis on spirituality as a primary component of recovery. In fact, the 12-step approach of AA views alcoholism as “an illness which only a spiritual experience will conquer” (AA, 2001, p. 21).

The conceptualization of problematic sub- stance use as a persistent medical condition has continued to evolve with recognition that it is infl uenced by biological, environmental, be- havioral, and genetic components (Alterman, McLellan, O’Brien, & McKay, 1998; O’Brien & McLellan, 1996). A similar view is presented by the Center for Substance Abuse Treatment (CSAT; 1999b), which describes “an emerging biopsychosocial-spiritual model” (p. 8). These viewpoints recognize that complex, intersect- ing factors infl uence the onset and course of substance use problems and, as with other chronic health conditions, require multifaceted intervention strategies (CSAT, 1999b; Leshner, 1997; NIDA, 2009b). Furthermore, as with other chronic health conditions, long-term treatment is required to address addiction as “a chronic, relapsing illness” (Leshner, 1997, p. 45; O’Brien & McLellan, 1996). Although risk for relapse often dominates common un- derstanding of addiction, rates of relapse with addiction (40%–60%) are comparable to re- lapse rates associated with type 1 diabetes (30%–50%), hypertension (50%–70%), and asthma (50%–70%; NIDA, 2009b). Although a complex combination of factors can infl u- ence the effectiveness of treatment (e.g., type and severity of client’s presenting problems,

capacity of available services to address the client’s presenting problems, nature of the client’s interactions with service providers), NIDA (2009c) notes that “according to re- search that tracks individuals in treatment over extended periods of time, most people who get into and remain in treatment stop using drugs, decrease their criminal activity, and improve their occupational, social, and psychological functioning” (p. 11).

Several intervention strategies emerge from the conceptualization of substance use disor- ders as a disease. Although there are distinc- tions between a dispositional disease model and the more comprehensive perspective of AA (Miller & Kurtz, 1994), AA and other 12- step approaches are among the most promis- ing to emerge from disease conceptualizations of substance use disorders. Research regard- ing 12-step approaches is limited, but a 2004 research review suggests that participation in AA and Narcotics Anonymous is associated with increased abstinence and self-effi cacy and enhanced socialization. Augmenting 12- step meeting attendance with participation in additional group-related activities seems to add to effects (Humphreys et al., 2004). In addition, fi ndings from this review also sug- gest that self-help group participation is best considered as continuing care rather than as a replacement for acute professional treatment. Findings from a more recent research review indicate that several aspects of AA participation are associated with better outcomes, including connecting with a sponsor, attending meetings frequently and over a longer period of time, affi liating with AA more rapidly, and receiving support from other AA members (Krentzman, 2007). In addition, recent research with ado- lescents indicates that 12-step involvement is associated with drug and alcohol abstinence at three years after treatment (Chi, Kaskutas, Sterling, Campbell, & Weisner, 2009). Finally, while focused on facilitating attendance at AA meetings and incorporating elements of the 12-step approach, fi ndings of Project MATCH, a large clinical trial of alcohol treatment con- ducted with 1,726 clients over 10 years, sug- gest that 12-step facilitation conducted by a

JWBT514_ch17.indd 441JWBT514_ch17.indd 441 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

442 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

therapist is as effective as cognitive-behavioral and motivational enhancement therapy (Dono- van, Carroll, Kadden, DiClemente, & Roun- saville, 2003).

Numerous pharmacotherapies have emerged to assist people experiencing substance use problems. Among the best known are:

• Nicotine lozenges, patches, or gum or oral medications such as bupropion (Zyban) or varenicline (Chantix), which can be help- ful to people with nicotine addiction. (Note, however, that the transdermal patch is the only addiction medication approved by the Food and Drug Administration [FDA] for use with adolescents.)

• Disulfi ram (Antabuse), which may help people with alcohol use disorders who have high motivation, are entering a treat- ment contract with a signifi cant other, or are attending events where alcohol is served.

• Acamprosate (Campral) and topiramate (Topamax), which can help people abstain from or reduce drinking. (Topiramate is not yet approved by the FDA.)

• Naltrexone (Revia), which has shown promise in treating alcohol and opiate use problems.

• Methadone and Subutex, which have been effective in treating opioid depen- dence.

• Selective serotonin reuptake inhibitors, which have been effective in enhancing al- cohol treatment retention, reducing alcohol consumption among clients experiencing co-occurring anxiety, and reducing cocaine consumption among clients engaged in methadone treatment (Alterman et al., 1998; NIDA, 2009b).

Combining medication with psychosocial in- terventions, which are discussed further next, refl ects a multifaceted approach to address “addiction as a prototypical psychobiological illness, with critical biological, behavioral, and social-context components” (Leshner, 1997, p. 46).

Psychological Models

Prominent psychological models for under- standing substance abuse include behavioral and cognitive perspectives (Miller & Hester, 1995). One such model is Relapse Prevention, in which “addictive behaviors are viewed as overlearned habits that can be analyzed and modifi ed in the same manner as other hab- its” (Marlatt, 1985a, p. 9). As described by Marlatt, analysis of these habits involves the examination of factors that contribute to main- taining the behavior, such as antecedents in the situation or environment (e.g., relational confl icts, social infl uences, emotions), expec- tations about the outcome of substance use (e.g., anticipation of positive consequence of consumption), and previous experiential learn- ing about the substance (e.g., observations of peers and family members using substances, positive reinforcement of behavior through enjoyable effects of consumption, negative reinforcement of behavior through relief of distress with consumption). The analysis also includes examination of consequences of the behavior (e.g., ways in which substance use is reinforced to encourage the behavior and ways in which negative outcomes may discourage behavior), with particular attention to the so- cial context and interpersonal components as- sociated with substance using behavior.

Another central element of this model is its perspective on relapse, or reengaging in sub- stance use behavior. In fact, Marlatt (1985a) distinguishes a lapse, or a single experience of returning to prior behavior, from a relapse, a more complete experience of returning to prior behavior. In this model “a single slip (mistake)” is not seen “as an indication of total failure” (p. 32). Thus, the notion of being in or out of control of substance use is not viewed dichotomously, and efforts are made to use lapses and relapses as learning experiences that can inform future relapse-prevention strategies (Larimer, Palmer, & Marlatt, 1999; Marlatt, 1985a).

The phrase abstinence violation effect is used by Marlatt (1985a) to describe the cog- nitive and affective responses people may

JWBT514_ch17.indd 442JWBT514_ch17.indd 442 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Substance Use Problems in Health Social Work Practice 443

experience when they are committed to abso- lute abstinence but then engage in substance use. After committing to total abstinence, peo- ple who engage in substance use may be more likely to experience negative affective states (e.g., guilt) and cognitions that involve self- blame or that reinforce lack of self-control. Such experiences may increase their risk for relapse (Larimer et al., 1999; Marlatt, 1985a; Miller, Westerberg, Harris, & Tonigan, 1996; for review, see Dimeff & Marlatt, 1998). In- terventions based on the model’s conceptu- alization of substance use problems focus on assisting clients to identify situations that may increase their risk of relapse, strengthen their ability to cope with or modify such situations, address expectations regarding anticipated outcomes of substance use, strengthen self- effi cacy, reduce the intensity of the abstinence violation effect through cognitive interven- tions, and foster learning from lapses and re- lapses (Larimer et al., 1999).

NIDA (2009b) notes the effectiveness of cognitive-behavioral treatment with people experiencing problematic use of alcohol, nicotine, marijuana, cocaine, and metham- phetamine and highlights that people often experience sustained retention of skills in the year following treatment. Findings from Proj- ect MATCH suggest that cognitive-behavioral therapy was as effective as 12-step facilitation and motivational enhancement therapy (Miller & Longabaugh, 2003). In addition, a review of research on cognitive-behavioral relapse pre- vention presents positive fi ndings of several studies that suggest that this approach can help increase the period of abstinence, reduce the severity of relapse, and have comparable ef- fectiveness with a 12-step approach with both alcohol and other drug use (Dimeff & Marlatt, 1998). Although there is research support for relapse prevention, Dimeff and Marlatt note that there have been some mixed fi ndings. For example, in a review by Miller and Hester (1995), three of seven studies that specifi cally examined “relapse prevention” yielded posi- tive fi ndings, but four yielded mixed fi ndings, including fi ndings that indicated improve- ments in both experimental groups. Miller and

Hester (1995) also note fi ndings indicating that supportive therapy may be more effec- tive in alcohol-related outcomes than relapse prevention for clients who have lower levels of verbal learning ability (Dimeff & Marlatt, 1998; Jaffe et al., 1996).

Motivation and Change Theory Perspectives

Motivation and change theory perspectives emphasize understanding the motivation for and the nature and processes of change.

Motivational Interviewing

First published in 1991, Miller and Rollnick’s (1991, 2002) motivational interviewing model focuses on why people change behavior rather than why they do not. Although specifi c prin- ciples and methods are associated with moti- vational interviewing, Miller and Rollnick’s revised edition places greater weight on the spirit of the approach. The authors focus on three primary components that contribute to the spirit of the approach: collaboration, evoca- tion, and autonomy (p. 34). These components are contrasted with their opposing counter- parts: confrontation, education, and authority (p. 35). A spirit of collaboration aims to create an egalitarian partnership rather than a context of confrontation and argument between the so- cial worker and the client. The aim is “to cre- ate a positive interpersonal atmosphere that is conducive but not coercive to change” (p. 34). Rather than presuming that clients lack aware- ness, information, or competence and then at- tempting to impart them to clients, the worker engaged in motivational interviewing aims to evoke from clients their perspectives, interests, and sources of motivation. The presumption of evocation is that change is facilitated by elicit- ing intrinsic motivation regarding what is most meaningful to clients and their aims. Finally, rather than focusing on an authoritarian rela- tionship in which the social worker tells clients what to do, motivational interviewing recog- nizes that clients have a choice regarding ac- cepting assistance and that ultimately they will be responsible for making a behavior change.

JWBT514_ch17.indd 443JWBT514_ch17.indd 443 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

444 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

As further described by Miller and Rollnick (2002), “when motivational interviewing is done properly, it is the client rather than the counselor who presents the arguments for change” (p. 34). Building on the spirit of the approach, Miller and Rollnick (p. 36) suggest four principles that can inform motivational interviewing: (1) express empathy, (2) develop discrepancy, (3) roll with resistance, and (4) support self-effi cacy.

As described by Miller and Rollnick (2002), the expression of empathy draws on the work of Carl Rogers with an emphasis on refl ective listening and the recognition that ambivalence about change is normal. In developing discrep- ancy, the social worker aims to assist clients with exploration of the difference between the current situation and their future goals. In this process, it once again is the clients rather than the social worker who provide the reasons for change. This process is facilitated by eliciting client perspectives regarding the discrepancies and then amplifying their perspectives to facil- itate change and to resolve ambivalence. Cen- tral to the idea of rolling with resistance is that “argumentation is counterproductive” (Miller & Rollnick, 2002, p. 39). In fact, according to Miller and Rollnick, when clients display “resistance,” it should be taken as a cue to the social worker that the current approach should be modifi ed. Finally, self-effi cacy is supported by two main elements: The social worker’s be- lief that change is possible and the recognition that ultimately clients will be responsible for the change. These two ideas are interwoven: “To assert that a person is responsible for de- ciding and directing his or her own change is to assume that the person is capable of doing so” (Miller & Rollnick, 2002, p. 41).

Motivational interviewing has been evalu- ated in more than 200 clinical trials, showing promise with a wide range of substance use problems and other health concerns, includ- ing physical inactivity, HIV risk, HIV medi- cation adherence, co-occurring substance use and mental health problems, hypertension, cardiovascular rehabilitation, and diabetes management (Britt, Hudson, & Blampied, 2004; Miller & Rose, 2009; Miller, Yahne,

& Tonigan, 2003; Parsons, Golub, Rosof, & Holder, 2007; Weir et al., 2009). Findings from recent meta-analyses indicate that motivational interviewing facilitates positive outcomes re- lated to substance use, although there appear to be differential effects by substance. In these studies, the comparative effects were greater with weak comparison groups; however, it should be noted that motivational interviewing involved fewer sessions than usual treatment, which suggests that motivational interviewing may require less cost and time to achieve gains (Hettema, Steele, & Miller, 2005; Lundahl & Burke, 2009; Lundahl, Kunz, Brownell, Tollef- son, & Burke, 2010; Vasilaki, Hosier, & Cox, 2006). The effects of motivational interviewing were not shown to differ by gender or problem severity in the meta-analyses that examined these variables; some analyses do indicate that people from racial/ethnic minority groups and those who are older may experience greater effects of motivational interviewing (Hettema et al., 2005; Lundahl et al., 2010).

Motivational enhancement therapy (MET), a four-session adaptation of motivational in- terviewing, was conducted over 12 weeks of treatment in Project MATCH (Donovan et al., 2003; Miller & Longabaugh, 2003). Findings of Project MATCH indicate that MET is as effective as cognitive-behavioral therapy and 12-step facilitation; however, given the brevity of the MET intervention, it is deemed a more cost-effective intervention (Miller & Long- abaugh, 2003). In its recent review of effective treatments, NIDA (2009b) indicates that MET’s success appears to differ by drug used, with greater effectiveness for alcohol and marijuana, and it is particularly useful in enhancing treat- ment engagement rather than altering drug use.

Understanding the mechanisms through which motivational interviewing facilitates and sustains change and its intersections with environmental factors (e.g., familial and social support of change efforts) are central ques- tions to be addressed in ongoing research (Dunn, Deroo, & Rivara, 2001; Heather, 2005; Vasilaki et al., 2006). Emerging efforts to iden- tify mechanisms of change in motivational interviewing suggest that several factors may

JWBT514_ch17.indd 444JWBT514_ch17.indd 444 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Substance Use Problems in Health Social Work Practice 445

be particularly important, including: relational elements (e.g., empathy and motivational in- terviewing spirit); technical elements (e.g., consistency with motivational interviewing, capacity for evoking and supporting change talk, use of decisional balance exercise, pro- viding feedback); and client experiences (e.g., demonstration of change talk and intention to change, sense of discrepancy between the pres- ent situation and valued goals). The scholar- ship in this area draws confl icting conclusions regarding the role of relational elements, in- cluding empathy and the spirit of motivational interviewing, in facilitating change (Apodaca & Longabaugh, 2009; Miller & Rose, 2009). Continued knowledge development in this area is likely to strengthen theoretical under- standings of motivational interviewing, direct practice that draws on this approach, and posi- tive outcomes for people facing substance use and other health concerns.

Transtheoretical/Stages of Change Model

The transtheoretical model provides a frame- work for understanding the incremental pro- cesses that facilitate intentional changes in behavior (DiClemente & Velasquez, 2002). Central to this model is the idea that people experience fi ve stages in the process of mak- ing changes in their behaviors, hence the name stages of change (DiClemente & Velasquez, 2002; Prochaska, DiClemente, & Norcross, 1992). The fi ve stages of change include pre- contemplation, contemplation, preparation, action, and maintenance (see Box 17.1).

Key tenets of the stages of change model involve three concepts.

1. The change process can begin before people have identifi ed that they have a problem (precontemplation) and proceeds with increased recognition of a problem- atic behavior (contemplation), to con- siderations about how change might be approached (preparation), to engaging in behavior change (action), and fi nally to making a sustained behavioral change (maintenance).

2. Relapse, as “the rule rather than the excep- tion with addictions,” leads to a spiral model of progression through the stages of change (Prochaska et al., 1992, p. 1104). In this spiral model, a person who has taken action and experienced a relapse may return to the contemplation or preparation phase and then continue to proceed through the stages of change (Prochaska et al., 1992). As in the Relapse Prevention model, relapse is viewed as an opportunity for learning rather than as a failure (Prochaska & Prochaska, 1999). As further described by Prochaska and Pro- chaska (1999), people who attempt to stop smoking typically engage in three or four action efforts over a period of 7 to 10 years before achieving sustained maintenance.

Box 17.1 Five Stages of Change

1. Precontemplation. No intention of changing behavior in the foreseeable future. Many people are unaware or underaware of their problems during this stage.

2. Contemplation. Awareness that a problem exists and serious consideration about overcoming it but no commitment to take action at this time. Contemplators typically experience ambivalence and often weigh the pros and cons of the problem and its solution.

3. Preparation. Intention to take action in the next month; unsuccessful in taking action during the past year.

4. Action. Modifi cation of behavior, experiences, or environment to overcome problems. This stage involves successful alteration of the addictive behavior for a period of one day to six months.

5. Maintenance. Prevention of relapse and consolidation of gains attained during action.

Source: Adapted from “In Search of How People Change: Applications to Addictive Behaviors,” by J. O. Prochaska, C. C. DiClemente, and J. C. Norcross, 1992, American Psychologist, 47(9), pp. 1103–1114.

JWBT514_ch17.indd 445JWBT514_ch17.indd 445 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

446 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Although the social worker does not set people up for failure by expecting relapse, it is important to frame relapse in terms of lessons that can be learned, to provide feedback for clients regarding the time required to achieve sustained behavioral change, and to assist clients with maintain- ing self-effi cacy and reengaging in change efforts (DiClemente, 1991; DiClemente & Velasquez, 2002; Prochaska & Prochaska, 1999; Prochaska et al., 1992).

3. DiClemente and Velasquez (2002) de- scribe the importance of matching the in- tervention strategy to the client’s stage of change. For example, clients who do not view their drinking habits as problematic and are not considering changing them would be considered to be in the precon- templation stage. In this stage, action- oriented steps are likely to be premature and to yield limited success (Prochaska et al., 1992). Rather than proceeding with action-oriented steps, motivational interviewing strategies (e.g., empathic, refl ective listening; recognizing client autonomy to make decisions about ac- cepting assistance; weighing out the ben- efi ts and drawbacks of current alcohol use; providing a menu of options) that facilitate movement from precontempla- tion to contemplation would be indicated (DiClemente & Velasquez, 2002).

Although the stages of change model can be useful in conceptualizing a person’s readi- ness to change along a continuum, with impli- cations for numerous populations and settings (e.g., to address substance use, partner vio- lence exposure, health behaviors, and men- tal health), recent scholarship demonstrates mixed fi ndings regarding its effectiveness in practice (Bridle et al., 2005) and critiques the validity of some of its theoretical underpin- nings (IOM, 2001; Littell & Girvin, 2002). Bridle et al. (2005) reviewed behavioral out- comes of 35 trials based on the transtheoreti- cal model. Of the 35 studies, which focused on a range of health issues including smok- ing, dietary change, and treatment adherence,

the model was favored in approximately one- quarter of the comparisons. In approximately half of the comparisons, the intervention and control group outcomes were similar, and in another quarter, the fi ndings were inconclu- sive. Based on a review of 87 studies that examined the stages of change with diverse target problems, Littell and Girvin (2002) concluded that this model is limited in two main ways. First, their review suggests that there is a lack of distinction between each of the discrete stages and that there is limited clarity regarding the relationship between readiness for change and the stages. Second, their review suggests that there is a lack of evidence to suggest that people move through the stages in a stepwise fashion. Little and Girvin propose that conceptualizing change along a continuum that may not refl ect linear progression may be useful and that the model may have heuristic utility; however, they cau- tion against intervention matched to stages, and they argue that future research should fur- ther explore change processes across diverse problems and sociocultural contexts.

Public Health: Harm Reduction Approach

Emerging out of the Netherlands in the 1980s, the harm reduction approach is relatively new in the substance abuse fi eld. Although a grow- ing body of literature addresses the potential of harm reduction and traditional approaches to work in complementary and integrated ways (Denning, 2001; Futterman, Lorente, & Silverman, 2004; Housenbold Seiger, 2004; Kellogg, 2003; Lee, Engstrom, & Petersen, in press; Marlatt, Blume, & Parks, 2001), harm reduction sometimes is seen as at odds with abstinence-oriented traditional approaches. Harm reduction philosophy, however, does not dismiss the fact that abstinence is often an ideal goal for many substance-using indi- viduals (Marlatt, 1998). In addition, promi- nent scholars in the addictions fi eld argue that because addiction is a chronic health condi- tion, “improvement rather than cure” is “the only realistic expectation for the treatment of

JWBT514_ch17.indd 446JWBT514_ch17.indd 446 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Substance Use Problems in Health Social Work Practice 447

addiction” (O’Brien & McLellan, 1996, p. 237). The approach recognizes that many cli- ents are not ready to pursue abstinence at the time they come into contact with treatment systems. Rather than arguing with this group of clients about appropriate goals or, worse, turning them away from treatment, harm re- duction is a method of engaging clients as they are. It recognizes that people who currently are using substances have strengths, and it draws on these strengths to empower clients to re- duce harms in their lives and to achieve goals that are important to them. As noted by Miller and Miller (2009), “[C]lients themselves have priorities, and the extent to which we address them is likely to infl uence our success with en- gagement, retention, and outcomes” (p. 685). Their perspective that treatment should focus on improving people’s lives, not just the sup- pression of substance use, is consistent with a harm perspective. Harm reduction values posi- tive changes in clients’ lives, including those who may not focus on their substance use. The Harm Reduction Coalition (n.d.) describes that this approach “establishes quality of individ- ual and community life and well-being—not necessarily cessation of all drug use—as the criteria for successful interventions and poli- cies.” Finally, in many ways, a harm reduction approach is consistent with social work values (Brocato & Wagner, 2003; MacMaster, 2004). By meeting clients where they are, the worker acknowledges the inherent worth and dignity of each person regardless of the substances they may use. Furthermore, this approach embodies the value of social justice by recog- nizing that all substance users, regardless of their motivation to abstain from using, deserve treatment services (Brocato & Wagner, 2003).

The public health approach of harm re- duction has numerous key components. As described by the Harm Reduction Coalition (n.d.), harm reduction “does not attempt to minimize or ignore the real and tragic harm and danger associated with licit and illicit drug use”; however, it also “accepts, for better and for worse, that licit and illicit drug use is part of our world and chooses to work to minimize its harmful effects rather than simply ignore

or condemn them.” Harm reduction strategies that aim to reduce harmful effects of drug use include direct practice or treatment interven- tions, environmental modifi cations or pub- lic health approaches, and public policy and advocacy initiatives (Marlatt, 1998; Rotgers, Little, & Denning, 2005). Direct practice and treatment interventions can involve these strat- egies: low-threshold service access; motiva- tional interviewing; education conducted with a collaborative, participatory spirit; relapse prevention strategies informed by cognitive- behavioral approaches; pharmacotherapy, such as methadone treatment and nicotine re- placement; and integration of substance use screening, brief intervention, and referral in emergency departments and trauma centers (Hunt, 2003; Logan & Marlatt, 2010; Marlatt, 1998; Marlatt & Witkiewitz, 2010; Rotgers et al., 2005).

Environmental modifi cations and public health approaches can involve making clean needles and condoms available; facilitating designated driver programs; facilitating access to health care and to safe, affordable housing without treatment and abstinence contingen- cies; and preventing overdose with adminis- tration training and distribution of naloxone (Narcan) (Harm Reduction Coalition, n.d.; Marlatt, 1998; Marlatt & Witkiewitz, 2010; Rotgers et al., 2005). Public policy and advo- cacy initiatives can involve reducing barriers and facilitating access to services, working to eliminate discrimination against people with substance use problems, reforming legal con- sequences for substance consumption, and ad- dressing sentencing disparities (Marlatt, 1998; Rotgers et al., 2005).

One such sentencing disparity is the 100 to 1 disparity for the federal mandatory mini- mum sentence for possession of crack and powder cocaine that disproportionately affects people who are African American (Hatsukami & Fischman, 1996). Under this policy, a per- son with a fi rst-time offense of possession of 5 g of crack cocaine would be mandated to a minimum sentence of fi ve years; this sentence would require possession of 500 g of cocaine hydrochloride (Hatsukami &

JWBT514_ch17.indd 447JWBT514_ch17.indd 447 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

448 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Fischman, 1996). The U.S. Senate and House of Representatives passed a bill to reduce this disparity, and President Obama signed the Fair Sentencing Act in 2010. In this bill, the 5-year sentence would be enacted with 28 g of crack cocaine (Fields, 2010). Addressing such disparities refl ects public policy initia- tives to reduce harm and to pursue social jus- tice. Last, harm reduction values a range of positive outcomes that refl ect reduced harm associated with drug use at multiple levels (e.g., individual, community, society), and it favors individualized approaches to refl ect the unique experiences and interests of indi- viduals and communities (Harm Reduction Coalition, n.d.; Hunt, 2003).

Research regarding harm reduction has fo- cused heavily on needle exchange and metha- done treatment interventions (Hunt, 2003). In a review of 42 studies of syringe exchange pro- grams, Gibson, Flynn, and Perales (2001) iden- tifi ed positive outcomes with 28 of them. The authors discuss methodological issues, such as the design of the research and selection and di- lution biases, which may have infl uenced the negative (2 studies) and null or mixed (14 stud- ies) fi ndings; however, based on their review, the authors conclude that “there is substantial evidence that syringe exchange programs are effective in preventing HIV risk behavior and HIV seroconversion among IDUs [injection drug users]” (p. 1338). Methadone treatment has been researched for nearly 40 years; fi nd- ings indicate positive effects on reductions in the use of heroin and HIV risk behaviors (Hunt, 2003). In their more recent review, Marlatt and Witkiewitz (2010) conclude that opioid substi- tution therapy not only reduces illicit opiate use and HIV risk behaviors but also illegal activity and death related to opioid use. Furthermore, they note that for every dollar spent on treat- ment for opioid use, there is a $12 cost savings. Finally, as described by NIDA (2009b), “pa- tients stabilized on adequate, sustained dosages of methadone or buprenorphine can function normally” (p. 39).

There are numerous additional harm reduc- tion strategies with empirical support. These strategies include motivational interviewing

(Britt et al., 2004; Hettema et al., 2005; Lundahl & Burke, 2009; Lundahl et al., 2010; Miller & Rose, 2009; Miller et al., 2003; Parsons et al., 2007; Vasilaki et al., 2006; Weir et al., 2009); cognitive-behavioral relapse prevention (Dimeff & Marlatt, 1998; Larimer et al., 1999; Miller & Hester, 1995); behavioral self-con- trol training, overdose prevention (Seal et al., 2005); housing programs without treatment or abstinence requirements (Larimer et al., 2009; Tsemberis, Gulcur, & Nakae, 2004); and sub- stance use screening, brief intervention, and treatment referral in medical settings (Madras et al., 2009).

Additional Evidence-Based Approaches

The prominent approaches discussed in this section are not exhaustive. They provide an introduction to various ways of thinking about and intervening to address substance use problems. Additional approaches that are described by NIDA (2009b) as evidence based include: (a) behavioral strategies that incorporate vouchers or incentives to support abstinence from cocaine, alcohol, stimulants, opioids, marijuana, and nicotine and (b) the Matrix model, which incorporates relapse pre- vention, group therapy, self-help, education about drugs, and family therapy to assist peo- ple with reduction of stimulant and other drug use. Much of the research regarding family- oriented intervention in the substance abuse fi eld has focused on adolescents, and the next models have a developing evidence base: mul- tisystemic treatment, multidimensional fam- ily therapy, and brief strategic family therapy (Henggeler, Schoenwald, Borduin, Rowland, & Cunningham, 1998; Liddle & Hogue, 2001; Liddle, Rowe, Dakof, Henderson, & Greenbaum, 2009; NIDA, 2009b; Szapocznik & Williams, 2000). A growing body of evi- dence also supports the use of family-oriented interventions with adults experiencing sub- stance use problems. Gains associated with such interventions include reductions in sub- stance use, greater treatment engagement and attendance, improved family member well-be- ing, and enhanced family relationships (NIDA,

JWBT514_ch17.indd 448JWBT514_ch17.indd 448 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Substance Use Problems in Health Social Work Practice 449

2009b; O’Farrell & Fals-Stewart, 2008; O’Farrell, Murphy, Alter, & Fals-Stewart, 2010; Smith, Meyers & Austin, 2008). In ad- dition, as noted by O’Farrell & Fals-Stewart (2008), behavioral couples therapy, a NIDA- recognized evidenced-based treatment, results in a 5-to-1 reduction in social costs, meaning that for every dollar invested in this treatment, $5 are saved in social costs, including health- care, criminal justice, and public assistance expenditures.

Mental illness frequently co-occurs with substance use problems, affecting an estimated 50% to 75% of people with substance use dis- orders (CSAT, 2005; NIDA, 2009b). Among people experiencing co-occurring substance use and psychiatric disorders, integrated treat- ment that focuses on both conditions simultane- ously is recommended (NIDA, 2009b; CSAT, 2005). Promising approaches to assist people with co-occurring substance use and mental health concerns include motivational inter- viewing, contingency management, cognitive- behavioral treatment, relapse prevention, assertive community treatment, intensive case management, and the modifi ed therapeutic community model (CSAT, 2005). In addition, trauma-informed programming may be critical to support engagement and treatment success of clients, particularly women, affected by co- occurring trauma and substance use concerns (CSAT, 2005; Elliott, Bjelajac, Fallot, Markoff, & Reed, 2005; Finkelstein et al., 2004; Harris & Fallot, 2001). A growing body of evidence supports the use of trauma-specifi c treatments to address co-occurring trauma and substance use (Cook, Walser, Kane, Ruzek, & Woody, 2006; Cusack, Morrissey & Ellis, 2008; Gilbert et al., 2006; Hien, Cohen, Miele, Litt, & Capstick, 2004; Hien et al., 2010; Morrissey et al., 2005; Najavits, 2002; Najavits, Schmitz, Gotthardt, & Weiss, 2005; Zlotnick, Johnson, & Najavits, 2009). The Center for Substance Abuse Treatment has published two Treat- ment Improvement Protocols, one focused on co-occurring substance use and mental health conditions (2005) and one focused on treat- ment needs of women (2009), which provide detailed practice guidance.

Intervention Modalities

Interventions vary not only according to the etiological models that inform them but also in their functions, modalities, and organiza- tional structures. For example, interventions may vary according to focus (e.g., detoxifi - cation, long-term rehabilitation, aftercare), location (e.g., hospital, community), inten- sity (e.g., inpatient, residential, outpatient, self-help groups), identity of the helping system (e.g., substance abuse services, mental health center, child welfare, family and social support), client system (e.g., in- dividual, group, family), and public or pri- vate funding sources (McNeece & DiNitto, 2005). Knowledge of various treatment modalities and locally available resources is particularly relevant for social workers in health-care settings, who often facilitate referrals for additional specialized and com- prehensive services that people with sub- stance use problems frequently need and that can affect treatment outcomes (El-Bassel, Gilbert, Wu, Chang, & Fontdevila, 2007; Engstrom, El-Bassel, Go, & Gilbert, 2008; Engstrom, Shibusawa, El-Bassel, & Gilbert, 2009; Grella & Stein, 2006; Marsh, Cao, & D’Aunno, 2004; McLellan et al., 1998). De- tailed guidance for referring adolescent and adult clients to an appropriate level of care given their substance use characteristics, biopsychosocial conditions, and environ- mental context is provided by the American Society of Addiction Medicine’s 2001 Pa- tient Placement Criteria for the Treatment of Substance-Related Disorders.

SCREENING AND BRIEF INTERVENTION COORDINATION IN HEALTH- CARE SETTINGS

For health social workers to incorporate consideration of potential substance use problems into their clients’ care, they must skillfully gather information about their cli- ents’ substance-using behaviors. For a variety

JWBT514_ch17.indd 449JWBT514_ch17.indd 449 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

450 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

of reasons, many health and social service providers simply do not inquire and thus in- advertently overlook possible substance use problems. The IOM (1990) recommends that questions about substance use be included with routine lifestyle and behavioral ques- tions, such as those about diet and exercise, with all people who come into contact with health-care systems. Especially in light of the large numbers of people with substance use problems who do not identify that they have a problem or seek treatment (approximately 95.5%; IOM, 1990; Madras et al., 2009), substance use screening, brief intervention, and referral to treatment (SBIRT) provides an excellent opportunity to reach this popu- lation. In addition, research regarding SBIRT demonstrates powerful fi ndings (Babor et al., 2007; Madras et al., 2009). A recent study in- volving 459,599 people employed the SBIRT model across diverse health-care settings (e.g., emergency rooms, trauma centers, pri- mary care, school health clinics) and diverse populations (e.g., diversity by race/ethnicity, gender, age, substances used). In this study, alcohol and drug use screening identifi ed peo- ple who needed brief intervention, brief treat- ment, or referral to specialized treatment. Of those who screened positively for drug use at baseline, rates of drug use and heavy alcohol use were 67.7% and 38.6% lower at six-month follow-up. Furthermore, brief treatment or re- ferral to specialized treatment generally was associated with gains in other domains as well, including health status, emotional prob- lems, employment, arrests, and homelessness (Madras et al., 2009).

The next section provides information and tools necessary for detecting potential sub- stance use problems. First it discusses issues related to professional use of self when talk- ing with clients about substance use behav- iors. Then it offers some basic considerations about gathering information. Finally it pres- ents information about established screening tools and protocols and how to consolidate in- formation gathered to conduct brief interven- tions or to make referrals for other services as needed.

Screening

Although screening and assessment are pre- sented separately from interventions in this chapter, it is important to note that, just as in other types of social work practice, they are actually overlapping activities. More often than not, assessment continues during the in- tervention process. In fact, NIAAA (2004b) includes both screening and assessment activi- ties as part of a brief intervention framework. Furthermore, the interpersonal experience of asking clients about their behaviors and pro- viding feedback based on their answers can be a potent intervention in and of itself (Miller, 2000).

This chapter focuses more on screening than on assessment. In general, screening is a relatively brief process and is aimed at iden- tifying individuals with potential substance use problems (Abbott & Wood, 2000; Dono- van, 1999). When an individual is identifi ed as being at risk, further assessment is required. The assessment process is more comprehen- sive in scope and aims to diagnose substance use disorders, assess related health and psy- chosocial effects, and inform specialized and comprehensive services (Cooney, Zweben, & Fleming, 1995). This section presents infor- mation to incorporate substance use screening into a more general psychosocial assessment and to make appropriate referrals for further assessment and intervention when necessary.

Empathic, Invitational, and Supportive Stance

Because of the stigma and shame often associ- ated with substance use problems, the manner in which social workers ask about potential problems is critical. McCrady (1993) identi- fi ed several provider characteristics that ap- pear to be conducive to successful treatment with persons with alcohol problems. These characteristics are relevant for accurate screen- ing as well.

(1) The clinician must be empathic and rec- ognize that it is often embarrassing and diffi cult for clients to talk about their

JWBT514_ch17.indd 450JWBT514_ch17.indd 450 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Substance Use Problems in Health Social Work Practice 451

substance use. If they have struggled with substance use over time, it is likely that they have encountered criticism and disap- proval from family, friends, and previous treatment providers. In addition, it is im- portant that clinicians have an appreciation for how diffi cult it can be to change sub- stance-using behavior. Often clients have made multiple attempts at stopping their use of alcohol, tobacco, or other drugs only to relapse and feel as if they have failed, thus leading to greater demoraliza- tion. The ability to empathize with both the stigma of substance use and the diffi culty in changing substance-using behavior is critical.

(2) The clinician needs to be able to dis- criminate between the person and his or her substance-using behavior. McCrady (1993) notes that this process can involve a “delicate” balance. First and foremost, clinicians need to convey a sense of respect for the person, acknowledging her inher- ent dignity, value, and worth. At the same time, however, McCrady cautions that cli- nicians should be careful not to dismiss or overlook the problematic substance-using behavior. Furthermore, given that sub- stance use problems are so common, it is not unusual for professional service pro- viders to have had personal experiences of problematic substance use in their own families and social networks. Some treat- ment programs prefer providers who have gone through their own recovery. Although personal experience often can facilitate empathy, it also carries the potential to narrow the provider’s beliefs about what works (Imhof, 1995). Ongoing clinical su- pervision is critical to facilitate providers’ capacity to honestly acknowledge their own beliefs and biases and to encourage the use of emerging knowledge to support informed engagement, screening, assess- ment, and intervention.

(3) It is important to be mindful that recent research has not supported numerous myths that have infl uenced strategies to

assist people experiencing substance use problems. For example, evidence does not support that there is such a thing as an “ad- dictive personality,” that people with sub- stance use problems have more enhanced defense mechanisms that are displayed as resistance or denial, or that aggressive confrontation facilitates change (CSAT, 1999b).

Sources of Information

Health social workers gather important infor- mation about clients’ substance use–related behaviors from a variety of sources. First and especially, they gather information from the clients themselves. In addition, they may gather information from involved family and friends and other treatment providers. Finally, they also may gather information from existing medical/ treatment records, from biological tests such as toxicology screenings, and from other service providers. The next sections answer two impor- tant questions about the process of gathering information: (1) What is the purpose of gath- ering this information? and (2) What kinds of information should be gathered?

Purpose of Gathering Information About Substance Use Behavior

It is important to understand the purpose of gathering information about clients’ substance use history and patterns. Clearly, strong as- sociations exist between substance use and a variety of health and social problems that may bring people into contact with health-care systems. Often the identifi ed health problem cannot be treated fully unless the associated substance use problem is addressed simultane- ously. Thus, screening for potential substance use problems is central to recommending and providing comprehensive treatment for cli- ents’ identifi ed health problems. For example, active use of alcohol and other substances may contraindicate certain pharmacotherapies and medical procedures. Specifi c information about the frequency and amount of use, as well as consequences of use, allows the health

JWBT514_ch17.indd 451JWBT514_ch17.indd 451 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

452 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

social worker to make appropriate recommen- dations and referrals.

What Information to Gather

When screening for substance use problems, social workers may gather information that falls into several different categories: sub- stances being used, frequency of use, amount of use, consequences of use, and circum- stances in which one uses. In addition, be- cause of the genetic infl uence for substance dependence, social workers may want to ask about substance use by close family members (NIAAA, 2004b). Established tools, which are discussed next, may include questions from one or more of these categories. In general, questions that ask about consequences of al- cohol and other drug use tend to be effective for detecting people who have substance use disorders; however, such questions may miss identifying people who are at risk for develop- ing a substance use disorder. Questions about frequency and amount are typically important for detecting persons at risk (CSAT, 1997).

Because it may be particularly diffi cult for clients to respond honestly about using illicit substances, it is generally helpful to begin with inquiring about alcohol use (IOM, 1990) and then to discuss other drug use. Questions re- garding other drug use may be less stigmatizing when paired with questions regarding alcohol use. Risk factors for other drug use include psychiatric illness, genetic predisposition, peers who use alcohol and other drugs, familial con- fl ict, and HIV-positive status (CSAT, 1997).

NIAAA (2007) recommends simply begin- ning by asking “Do you sometimes drink beer, wine, or other alcoholic beverages?” Negative answers should be followed up with the ques- tion “What made you decide not to drink?” (CSAT, 1997, p. 15). If the client has been a lifelong abstainer or reports abstinence for fi ve years or longer, the screening, with a few exceptions discussed next, can be concluded. Regardless of what they report about drinking alcohol, adolescents should be asked about use of other drugs, particularly marijuana. Women who are pregnant or who have experienced a major life transition should be asked about

prescription drug use and over-the-counter sleep aids (CSAT, 1997). Finally, all older adults (those 60 years and older) also should be asked about over-the-counter and prescrip- tion drug use (CSAT, 1998).

NIAAA (2007) recommends that positive answers to “Do you sometimes drink beer, wine, or other alcoholic beverages?” should be followed with a question about frequency and amount. Such questions can begin with “How many times in the year have you had fi ve or more drinks in a day [for men] or four or more drinks in a day [for women]?” If the person reports one or more days of heavy drinking, the next questions should include “On average, how many days a week do you drink?” and “On a typical drinking day, how many drinks do you have?” (p. 4). It can be useful to ask the client “What is the maximum number of drinks you consumed on any given occasion during the past month?” With this question in particu- lar, standard drink measures should be clearly identifi ed. One drink is equivalent to 12 oz of beer or wine cooler; 8–9 oz of malt liquor; 5 oz of table wine; 3–4 oz of fortifi ed wine (such as sherry or port); 2–3 oz of cordial, liqueur, or aperitif; and 1.5 oz of spirits (NIAAA, 2004b).

With information about the frequency and amount of alcohol use, the social worker is able to determine if the client’s alcohol con- sumption is within a safe range or is poten- tially problematic. In defi ning “at risk” alcohol use, NIAAA (2004b, 2007) states that criteria differ by age, gender, pregnancy/health/medi- cation status, and family history of substance dependence. Consumption of alcohol accord- ing to these conditions is considered “at risk”:

• More than 14 drinks per week or more than 4 drinks on a given occasion by men

• More than 7 drinks per week or more than 3 drinks on a given occasion by women

• Any amount of alcohol consumption by pregnant women

• More than 7 drinks per week or more than 3 drinks on any given occasion by older adults

• Any alcohol consumption by children or adolescents

JWBT514_ch17.indd 452JWBT514_ch17.indd 452 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Substance Use Problems in Health Social Work Practice 453

In addition, problematic substance use may intersect with a variety of health and psy- chosocial problems. The presence of the fol- lowing factors may suggest increased risk of substance use problems:

• Mental health problems

• Presence of infectious diseases such as HIV, hepatitis B and C, and tuberculosis

• Trauma exposure

• Involvement with peers who use drugs and alcohol

• Homelessness/housing instability

• Signifi cant familial confl ict or instability

• Familial history of substance use problems

• Vocational instability

• Legal problems (CSAT, 1997)

Although the presence or absence of any of these risk factors cannot predict whether a person will experience substance use prob- lems, their presence can cue the social worker to further consider possible risk (CSAT, 1997). In addition, these health and psychosocial risk factors likely would be points of intervention for social workers in health-care settings as part of comprehensive biopsychosocial assess- ment and intervention.

Established Tools

Multiple measures have been developed to screen and assess for problems with substance use. These clinical tools include structured interviews and self-administered question- naires. It is essential that these tools dem- onstrate accuracy in their screening ability as refl ected by the measure’s sensitivity and specifi city. Sensitivity refers to the measure’s ability to identify all persons with the desig- nated problem (i.e., to avoid false negatives). Specifi city refers to the instrument’s ability not to include people who do not have the designated problem (i.e., to avoid false posi- tives) (NIAAA, 2004b). For example, if a measure included the single question “Do you drink alcohol?” and identifi ed any person who answered positively as having an alcohol use

disorder, it would have very high sensitivity and low specifi city. A measure that identifi es a person as having a problem with alcohol use by a positive response to the single question “Have you ever blacked out or lost time when you were drinking alcohol?” would have low sensitivity and high specifi city. The sensitivity and specifi city of instruments can be altered by shifting their cut-off scores, changing their designated problem, and deleting or adding items. The next discussion illustrates some of these principles.

CAGE

The CAGE is one of the most widely used short screening tools in the substance abuse fi eld. Originally designed to detect alcohol de- pendence, it consists of four questions about aspects of alcohol use (http://pubs.niaaa.nih .gov/publications/arh28-2/78-79.htm):

1. Have you ever felt that you should cut down on your drinking?

2. Have people annoyed you by criticizing your drinking?

3. Have you ever felt bad or guilty about your drinking?

4. Have you ever had a drink fi rst thing in the morning to steady your nerves or get rid of a hangover (“eye opener”)?

A positive answer to two or more questions is considered clinically signifi cant (Ewing, 1984). Research suggests that this measure has high levels of sensitivity and specifi city for identifying persons with alcohol use disor- ders (Buchsbaum, Buchanan, Centor, Schnoll, & Lawton, 1991). Because it does not include questions about frequency or amount of alco- hol use, however, it is likely to miss some per- sons who do not meet diagnostic criteria yet are at-risk drinkers (Adams, Barry, & Fleming, 1996). In an attempt to increase the CAGE’s sensitivity for a wider range of substance use problems, both NIAAA (2004b) and CSAT (1997) recommend using the CAGE in con- junction with questions about frequency and amount of alcohol use. Furthermore, both

JWBT514_ch17.indd 453JWBT514_ch17.indd 453 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

454 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

agencies recommend that a positive answer to one question prompt further assessment.

The CAGE has been modifi ed to screen for other drugs in addition to alcohol. The CAGE- AID (CAGE Adapted to Include Drugs) con- sists of the original CAGE questions, but rather than focusing solely on drinking, the CAGE-AID inquires about drinking or drug use with each of the questions previously identifi ed. With the CAGE-AID, the ques- tions should be preceded by the instruction “When thinking about drug use, include ille- gal drug use, and the use of prescription drugs other than as prescribed” (Brown, Leonard, Saunders, & Papasouliotis, 1998, p. 102). Because the CAGE-AID, like the CAGE, inquires about negative consequences only, CSAT (1997) recommends asking the addi- tional question “Have you used street drugs more than fi ve times in your life?” (p. 17). A positive answer to this question or to any of the CAGE-AID questions suggests the need for further assessment.

The CAGE and CAGE-AID have been tested with older adults and shown to be ef- fective in screening for both alcohol and other drug use problems among this population. Buchsbaum and colleagues (1991) used a score of 2 or greater on the CAGE to defi ne problem drinking in a sample of medical out- patients over the age of 60 years and found it to have reasonable sensitivity (.70) and very good specifi city (.91). Another study examin- ing the utility of the CAGE-AID for use with older adults demonstrated high sensitivity for detecting persons with alcohol or other drug use disorders (.91 and .92, respectively) but low specifi city (.48) (Hinkin et al., 2001). The authors noted that many older adults, re- gardless of whether they had a substance use disorder, answered positively to the question “Have you ever felt you ought to cut down on your drinking or drug use?” By omitting this question, specifi city was signifi cantly in- creased to .69 although sensitivity decreased to .83. Taken together, these fi ndings suggest that providers may want to make adjustments in how they use the CAGE depending on the population, setting, and goals.

AUDIT

The Alcohol Use Disorders Identifi cation Test (AUDIT) includes 10 items that can be com- pleted in an interview or written format. It was designed through a six-country, multicul- tural, collaborative project of the World Health Organization to detect alcohol use–related prob- lems (Saunders, Aasland, Amundsen, & Grant, 1993). The work group’s initial intent was to create a screening tool that detected problems before the development of dependence or se- rious harm to provide early intervention. The measure covers three conceptual domains: level of consumption (items 1–3), dependence symp- toms (items 4–6), and alcohol-related conse- quences (items 7–10). It is scored by summing the numbers of the answers to each question.

1. How often do you have a drink containing alcohol?

(0) Never

(1) Monthly or less

(2) Two to four times a month

(3) Two to three times a week

(4) Four or more times a week

2. How many drinks containing alcohol do you have on a typical day when you are drinking?

(0) 1 or 2

(1) 3 or 4

(2) 5 or 6

(3) 7 to 9

(4) 10 or more

3. How often do you have six or more drinks on one occasion?

(0) Never

(1) Less than monthly

(2) Monthly

(3) Weekly

(4) Daily or almost daily

4. How often during the last year have you found that you were not able to stop drink- ing once you had started?

(0) Never

(1) Less than monthly

JWBT514_ch17.indd 454JWBT514_ch17.indd 454 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Substance Use Problems in Health Social Work Practice 455

(2) Monthly

(3) Weekly

(4) Daily or almost daily

5. How often during the last year have you failed to do what was normally expected from you because of drinking?

(0) Never

(1) Less than monthly

(2) Monthly

(3) Weekly

(4) Daily or almost daily

6. How often during the last year have you needed a fi rst drink in the morning to get yourself going after a heavy drinking ses- sion?

(0) Never

(1) Less than monthly

(2) Monthly

(3) Weekly

(4) Daily or almost daily

7. How often during the last year have you had a feeling of guilt or remorse after drinking?

(0) Never

(1) Less than monthly

(2) Monthly

(3) Weekly

(4) Daily or almost daily

8. How often during the last year have you been unable to remember what happened the night before because you had been drinking?

(0) Never

(1) Less than monthly

(2) Monthly

(3) Weekly

(4) Daily or almost daily

9. Have you or someone else been injured as a result of your drinking?

(0) No

(2) Yes, but not in the last year

(4) Yes, during the last year

10. Has a relative or friend or a doctor or other health worker been concerned about your drinking or suggested you cut down?

(0) No

(2) Yes, but not in the last year

(4) Yes, during the last year

Scores range from 0 to 40. In general, a score of 8 or greater points to the strong likelihood of problematic alcohol use (Saunders, Aasland, Babor, De La Fuente, & Grant, 1993).

Recent research suggests that, in general, the AUDIT has utility across gender and racial groups, although some differences in performance be- tween groups have been found (Reinert & Allen, 2002). For example, Cherpitel (1998) found that when used with a standard cut-off score of 8, the AUDIT was less sensitive for women than for men. NIAAA (2007) recommends that a cut-off score of 8 or higher refl ects a positive screening for men and a cut-off score of 4 or higher refl ects a positive screening for women.

TICS

The Two-Item Conjoint Screening (TICS) for alcohol and other drug use has shown strong sensitivity and specifi city (approximately 81%) in an evaluation with 434 adults in pri- mary care (Brown, Leonard, Saunders, & Papasouliotis, 1997). The TICS involves two questions:

1. In the last year, have you ever drank or used drugs more than you meant to?

2. Have you felt you wanted or needed to cut down on your drinking or drug use in the last year?

As noted by Brown and colleagues (1997), a positive response to either question is likely to accurately identify the presence of a current substance use disorder among 80% of adults (age 18–59 years) who are screened.

JWBT514_ch17.indd 455JWBT514_ch17.indd 455 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

456 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Additional Tools

Many other tools have been developed for screening and comprehensive assessment of substance use–related problems. Although there are too many to describe here, a few are mentioned. The Michigan Alcoholism Screen- ing Test (MAST) is a 25-item instrument de- signed to detect alcohol problems (Selzer, 1971). Two shorter versions are available, the 13-item Short MAST (SMAST; Selzer, Vinokur, & van Rooijen, 1975) and the 10- item Brief MAST (B-MAST; Pokorny, Miller, & Kaplan, 1972). The MAST-Geriatric Ver- sion (MAST-G; Blow et al., 1992) has been validated for use with older adults. Finally, the Drug Abuse Screening Test (DAST; Skinner, 1982) was designed to identify problems re- lated to the use of drugs other than alcohol.

From Screening to Brief Intervention

If the screening process indicates that a person may have a possible substance use problem, the social worker will then want to follow up with further assessment for substance use dis- orders, conduct a brief intervention, and, de- pending on the severity of the problem, make a referral for more comprehensive assessment and services (Babor et al., 2007; Madras et al., 2009; NIAAA, 2007; SAMHSA, 1999). Brief interventions, which are discussed next, pro- vide a means by which social workers talk with clients about risks related to their use and en- hance their motivation to take positive steps to- ward addressing their substance use problems. Feedback about the screening results is the fi rst step of an initial brief intervention. CSAT (1997, 1999a,b) recommends that feedback be given promptly, in a direct and nonjudgmental manner, and framed in a way that conveys re- spect, relates to the client’s medical health, and is delivered with cultural competence.

Brief Interventions

Opportunities for addressing substance use problems frequently occur in nonsubstance

abuse treatment settings. Health social workers and other professionals can be equipped to act on these opportunities through the use of brief interventions. Brief interventions are defi ned as “those practices that aim to investigate a potential problem and motivate an individual to begin to do something about his substance abuse, either by natural, client-directed means or by seeking additional treatment” (SAM- SHA, 1999, p. 5). Brief interventions are in- formed by general guidelines and include a variety of strategies and techniques.

General Goals and Guidelines

The general goal of all brief interventions is based on a philosophy of harm reduction: “to lower the likelihood of damage that could result from continued use of substances” (SAMHSA, 1999, p. 5). Goals specifi c to in- dividuals depend on their aims, the character- istics of their use (e.g., substance of choice, severity of use, history of use), their readiness for change, and the setting in which the inter- vention is offered (CSAT, 1999a). Although eliciting goals that are of interest to the cli- ent should guide the goal-setting process, specifi c goals might include these examples: participating in a more comprehensive as- sessment, identifying costs and benefi ts of substance use, recording amount of use over a given time period, decreasing amount of use over a given time period, declining an offer for a drink or other substance, attending an AA or NA meeting, expanding a supportive social network, and identifying positive ac- tivities that can be substituted for substance use (CSAT, 1999a). These possibilities are only a few examples. The social worker and client can creatively brainstorm to identify other goals appropriate for the particular circumstances of the client. Social workers should emphasize the positive quality of any goal that decreases the risk of harm resulting from substance use.

In an extensive review of 32 studies in 14 countries, the fi ndings of Bien, Miller, and Tonigan (1993) provide substantial support for the effectiveness of brief interventions to

JWBT514_ch17.indd 456JWBT514_ch17.indd 456 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Substance Use Problems in Health Social Work Practice 457

assist people experiencing problematic alcohol use. In 11 out of 12 trials, brief intervention enhanced referrals and engagement in specialized services. In seven out of eight tri- als, brief interventions were effective in reduc- ing alcohol use or problems associated with use in comparison to no intervention. Miller and Sanchez (1993) examined the brief inter- vention strategies employed in these outcome studies to determine common ingredients among the interventions. Six components of ef- fective brief interventions were identifi ed and are summarized by the now widely known and recommended FRAMES acronym: “Feedback, Responsibility, Advice, Menu, Empathy, and Self-effi cacy” (Bien et al., 1993, p. 326; Britt et al., 2004; CSAT, 1999a; Miller & Sanchez, 1993). Such brief interventions, including the FRAMES approach, are important ingredients in the SBIRT model addressed earlier (Madras et al., 2009).

(1) Providers offer feedback to clients to in- form them about the risks associated with their substance use; however, this feedback process should be interactive, with incre- mental provision of information and elici- tation of the client’s responses to it (CSAT, 1999a,b). Effective brief interventions typically include structured screening, such as those discussed earlier. Follow- ing this screening, clients receive infor- mation about the status of their substance use. In addition to educating clients about their general status, health social workers also should provide clients with informa- tion regarding the health interactions and consequences of their substance use. For example, active substance use contrain- dicates many medical interventions (e.g., organ transplants, particular medications).

(2) Responsibility for change is placed with the clients (CSAT, 1999a). It is important for clients to know that while the profes- sional is concerned and interested in their welfare, ultimately it is the decision and responsibility of clients to make changes in substance use behavior. Care must be

taken so that clients do not feel alone in trying to change or blamed for their problems. Rather, social workers should recognize that this step is about self-de- termination and empowerment (CSAT, 1999b), which refl ects the spirit of auton- omy, a central component of motivational interviewing (Miller & Rollnick, 2002).

(3) The provider gives advice to clients to change their behavior (Bien et al., 1993; CSAT, 1999b). This advice will vary de- pending on the client and can range from suggesting a change in substance use be- havior to providing relevant information about substance use (CSAT, 1999b). Key elements of giving advice in a way that is consistent with motivational interviewing include asking permission from clients to provide the advice (e.g., “Can I tell you what I’ve seen in the past in these situa- tions?” (CSAT, 1999b, p. 27), providing in- formation in culturally relevant ways, and attending to the way in which the sugges- tions are made (Britt et al., 2004; CSAT, 1999b).

(4) The social worker provides a menu of vari- ous options to facilitate change (Bien et al., 1993; CSAT, 1999b). Such options may include treatment services, self-help, and other change strategies. Providing clients with information about the options and dis- cussing their perspectives about them are central elements of assisting clients with making an informed decision about how they would like to proceed (CSAT, 1999b).

(5) The social worker should use an empa- thetic stance that conveys respect, caring, warmth, and refl ective listening (Bien et al., 1993; CSAT, 1999b).

(6) Social workers should seek to enhance cli- ents’ sense of self-effi cacy, that is, the be- lief that they can and will accomplish goals they set for themselves (CSAT, 1999b). Conveying hope, optimism, and recogni- tion of clients’ strengths are meaningful ways in which to achieve this goal (Bien et al., 1993; CSAT, 1999b).

JWBT514_ch17.indd 457JWBT514_ch17.indd 457 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

458 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

CONCLUSION

Health social workers face many challenges in providing effective assistance to persons strug- gling with substance use problems. The knowl- edge base is expansive, the fi eld sometimes is perceived as in fl ux, and substance use problems can seem impermeable to change. In addition, such problems have a far-reaching presence across persons of diverse age, gender, sexual orientations, and racial, cultural, and socioeco- nomic backgrounds. This chapter orients the provider to foundational information that is use- ful for offering hopeful and effective interven- tions with clients experiencing substance use problems. Information about short-term psycho- active and long-term health effects of commonly used substances, along with current prevalence data, is aimed to equip health social workers with the ability to identify individuals who may be at risk for diffi culties with use of particular substances. In addition, such information can assist with strengthening the developmental and cultural competence of services to reach affected groups. The overview of prominent approaches to conceptualizing and addressing substance use problems familiarizes the health social worker with intervention options and their research sup- port. It is essential that social workers be aware of the existing evidence base for particular ap- proaches and, when possible, provide or refer clients to services that utilize evidence-based practice strategies. Finally, the chapter provides screening knowledge and tools as well as a framework for brief intervention strategies. This information offers guidance so that the social worker can assist people experiencing substance use problems in ways that offer hope, enhance motivation, reduce harm, and strengthen efforts to pursue and sustain change.

SUGGESTED LEARNING EXERCISES

Learning Exercise 17.1

How would you defi ne tolerance, withdrawal, physical dependence, and addiction? How can

clarity regarding these concepts be helpful in health social work practice?

Learning Exercise 17.2

How can knowledge regarding the epidemiol- ogy and effects of various substances be used in health social work practice with clients?

Learning Exercise 17.3

What are some of the prominent approaches to conceptualizing and addressing substance use problems? Do you prefer particular ap- proaches? What informs your preference for particular approaches? What does research suggest about the effectiveness of the ap- proaches discussed in this chapter, and how does that information fi t with your perspective of “what works”? How might the research fi nd- ings and your preferences inform your direct practice with people experiencing substance use problems? What additional evidence can inform your direct practice in this area?

Learning Exercise 17.4

What does the acronym SBIRT represent? What is known about its effectiveness? To what degree do you and the agency you work or intern at en- gage in SBIRT activities with the clients you serve? How might SBIRT efforts be strength- ened in your own practice and in your agency?

Learning Exercise 17.5

In pairs, role-play how might you draw on the FRAMES model in brief intervention with Alex in the next hypothetical situation.

Alex is a 25-year-old, heterosexual, Cauca- sian man of Italian American descent who re- sides with his mother, who is 60 years old. His brother, Carl, brought him to the community health clinic because he is concerned about his drinking, his use of cocaine, his overall health, and the worry their mother is expe- riencing about Alex. After seeing a primary care physician, Alex was referred to you. Your

JWBT514_ch17.indd 458JWBT514_ch17.indd 458 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Substance Use Problems in Health Social Work Practice 459

brief screening with Alex indicates that he has made numerous attempts to stop using cocaine and to reduce his drinking. He explains that these efforts “have not quite worked out,” but he feels he can address this issue on his own. He also feels angry with his brother for “mak- ing such a big deal about all of this,” but at the same time he describes feeling guilty about his behavior when he drinks and uses cocaine. Alex states that he usually drinks a six-pack of beer four or fi ve times a week, but he recently has increased this amount and has not “really kept track of it.” Alex describes that he uses cocaine less often since he lost his job a month ago and cannot afford it. Currently Alex does not have health insurance or regular income.

Learning Exercise 17.6

What do you consider your strengths and chal- lenges in working with people experiencing substance use problems? What additional in- formation would help strengthen your ability to effectively assist people experiencing sub- stance use problems?

Learning Exercise 17.7

If you were asked to develop one of the groups listed next, how might you proceed? What approach(es) would guide the group, and how would you structure it? How might you recruit participants? Who would be included in the group? How would you measure the success of the group? What would be the rationale for these decisions? What challenges might you face with implementing this group, and how might you address them proactively?

Group Topics

• Substance use and health for a general population

• Pain management for people at risk of developing substance use

• Problems while managing persistent pain

• Overdose prevention for people at risk and their loved ones

SUGGESTED RESOURCES

Al-Anon and Alateen—www.al-anon.alateen .org

Alcoholics Anonymous—www.aa.org Alcoholism and Drug Addiction Counselor

Information and Certifi cation—www .naadac.org/index.php?option=com _content&view=article&id=478&Itemid =129 Current Clinical Trials—www .clinicaltrials.gov

Double Trouble in Recovery—www .doubletroubleinrecovery.org

Based on a 12-step approach, this program assists people experiencing co-occurring substance use and mental health problems.

Harm Reduction Coalition—www.harm reduction.org

Health Effects of Substance Use—www .drugabuse.gov/consequences

International Harm Reduction Association— www.ihra.net

Join Together—www.jointogether.org Motivational Interviewing—www.motiva

tionalinterview.org Narcotics Anonymous—www.na.org National Clearinghouse for Alcohol and

Drug Information (NCADI)—www .health.org

This clearinghouse contains informa- tion and resources about alcohol and oth- er drugs available from NIAAA, NIDA, and SAMHSA. Resources include vid- eos, posters, pamphlets, educational tools and kits, and reports. Information geared toward a range of audiences (e.g., families, youth, health providers, educa- tors, researchers) are available. Many of the resources are free.

National Institute on Alcoholism and Alco- hol Abuse—www.niaaa.nih.gov

This branch of the National Institutes of Health (NIH) researches the effects and treatment of problematic alcohol use.

National Institute on Drug Abuse—www .nida.nih.gov

JWBT514_ch17.indd 459JWBT514_ch17.indd 459 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

460 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

This branch of the NIH researches the effects and treatment of drug abuse.

National Registry of Evidence-Based Programs and Practices—www.nrepp .samhsa.gov

Substance Abuse and Mental Health Ser- vices Administration—www.samhsa.gov

This branch of the Department of Health and Human Services is charged with developing and disseminating ef- fective prevention and treatment pro- grams. SAMHSA includes both the Center for Substance Abuse Prevention (CSAP) and the Center for Substance Abuse Treatment (CSAT).

Substance Abuse Treatment for Gay, Les- bian, Bisexual, and Transgender Individ- uals—http://kap.samhsa.gov/products /manuals/pdfs/lgbt.pdf

Treatment Locator (NCADI)—http:// dasis3.samhsa.gov

This resource locates substance abuse treatment providers sorted by geograph- ic location, population, and type of treat- ment.

World Health Organization—http:// whqlibdoc.who.int/hq/1992/WHO_PSA _92.4. pdf This site provides guidelines for using

the AUDIT in primary health care. University of Washington Alcohol and

Drug Abuse Institute—https://depts .washington.edu/adai

REFERENCES

Aaron, S., McMahon, J. M., Milano, D., Torres, L., Clatts, M., Tortu, S., . . . Simm, M. (2008). Intranasal transmission of hepatitis C virus: Virological and clinical evidence. Clinical Infectious Diseases, 47, 931–934.

Abbott, A. A. (2002). Health care challenges created by substance abuse: The whole is defi nitely bigger than the sum of its parts. Health & Social Work, 27, 162–165.

Abbott, A. A., & Wood, K. M. (2000). Assessment: Techniques and instruments for data collection. In A. A. Abbott (Ed.), Alcohol, tobacco, and other drugs: Challenging myths, assessing theories, individualizing interventions (pp. 159–186). Washington, DC: National Association of Social Workers Press.

Abraham, H. D., Aldridge, A. M., & Gogia, P. (1996). The psychopharmacology of hallucinogens. Neuro- psychopharmacology, 14, 285–298.

Adams, W. L., Barry, K. L., & Fleming, M. F. (1996). Screening for problem drinking in older primary care patients. JAMA, 276, 1964–1967.

Alcoholics Anonymous. (1972). A brief guide to Alcoholics Anonymous. New York, NY: Alcoholics Anonymous World Services. Retrieved from www .alcoholics-anonymous.org

Alcoholics Anonymous. (2001). Alcoholics Anonymous: The story of how many thousands of men and women have recovered from alcoholism (4th ed.). New York, NY: Author.

Alterman, A. I., McLellan, A. T., O’Brien, C. P., & McKay, J. R. (1998). Differential therapies and options. In R. J. Frances & S. I. Miller (Eds.), Clinical textbook of addictive disorders (2nd ed., pp. 447–478). New York, NY: Guilford Press.

American Psychiatric Association. (2000). Diagnostic and statistical manual of mental disorders (4th ed., text revision). Washington, DC: Author.

American Society of Addiction Medicine. (2001). ASAM patient placement criteria for the treatment of substance-related disorders (2nd ed.). Chevy Chase, MD: Author.

Apodaca, T. R., & Longabaugh, R. (2009). Mechanisms of change in motivational interviewing: A review and preliminary evaluation of the evidence. Addiction, 104, 705–715.

Babor, T. F., McRee, B. G., Kassebaum, P. A., Grimaldi, P. L., Ahmed, K., & Bray, J. (2007). Screening, brief intervention, and referral to treatment (SBIRT): Toward a public health approach to the management of substance abuse. Substance Abuse, 28(3), 7–30.

Bien, T. H., Miller, W. R., & Tonigan, J. S. (1993). Brief interventions for alcohol problems: A review. Addiction, 88, 315–336.

Blow, F. C., Brower, K. J., Schulenberg, J. E., Demo- Dananberg, L. M., Young, J. P., & Beresford, T. P. (1992). The Michigan Alcoholism Screening Test— Geriatric Version (MAST-G): A new elderly-specifi c screening instrument. Alcoholism: Clinical and Experimental Research, 16, 372.

Bohnert, A. S. B., Prescott, M. R., Vlahov, D., Tardiff, K. J., & Galea, S. (2010). Ambient temperature and risk of death from accidental drug overdose in New York City, 1990–2006. Addiction, 105, 1049–1054.

Borden, W. (2000, September). The relational paradigm in contemporary psychoanalysis: Toward a psychodynamically informed social work perspective. Social Service Review, 352–379.

Brady, K. T., Myrick, H., & Malcolm, R. (1999). Sedative- hypnotic and anxiolytic agents. In B. S. McCrady & E. E. Epstein (Eds.), Addiction: A comprehensive guidebook (pp. 95–104). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

JWBT514_ch17.indd 460JWBT514_ch17.indd 460 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Substance Use Problems in Health Social Work Practice 461

Bridle, C., Riemsma, R. P., Pattenden, J., Sowden, A. J., Mather, L., Watt, I. S., & Walker, A. (2005). Systematic review of the effectiveness of health behavior interventions based on the Transtheoretical Model. Psychology and Health, 20(3).

Britt, E., Hudson, S. M., & Blampied, N. M. (2004). Motivational interviewing in health settings: A review. Patient Education and Counseling, 53, 147–155.

Brocato, J., & Wagner, E. F. (2003). Harm reduction: A social work practice model and social justice agenda. Health & Social Work, 28(2), 117–125.

Brown, R. L., Leonard, T., Saunders, L. A., & Papasouliotis, O. (1997). A two-item screening test for alcohol and other drug problems. Journal of Family Practice, 44(2), 151–160.

Brown, R. L., Leonard, T., Saunders, L. A., & Papasouliotis, O. (1998). The prevalence and detection of substance use disorders among inpatients ages 18 to 59: An opportunity for prevention. Preventive Medicine, 27, 101–110.

Buchsbaum, D. G., Buchanan, R. G., Centor, R. M., Schnoll, S. H., & Lawton, M. J. (1991). Screening for alcohol abuse using CAGE scores and likelihood ratios. Annals of Internal Medicine, 115, 774–777.

Buxton, J. A., Skutezky, T., Tu, A. W., Waheed, B., Wallace, A., & Mak, S. (2009). The context of illicit drug overdose deaths in British Columbia, 2006. Harm Reduction Journal, 6(9). Retrieved from http:// harmreductionjournal.com/content/6/1/9

Center for Substance Abuse Prevention. (2003). Here’s the latest on inhalants. CSAP Prevention Alert, 6(11), 1–3.

Center for Substance Abuse Treatment. (1997). A guide to substance abuse services for primary care clinicians (Treatment Improvement Protocol [TIP] Series, No. 24, DHHS Pub. No. SMA 03–3807). Washington, DC: U.S. Government Printing Offi ce.

Center for Substance Abuse Treatment. (1998). Substance abuse among older adults (Treatment Improvement Protocol [TIP] Series, No. 26, DHHS Pub. No. SMA 98–3179). Rockville, MD: Substance Abuse and Mental Health Services Administration.

Center for Substance Abuse Treatment. (1999a). Brief interventions and brief therapies for substance abuse (Treatment Improvement Protocol [TIP] Series, No. 34, DHHS Pub. No. SMA 04–3952). Rockville, MD: Substance Abuse and Mental Health Services Administration.

Center for Substance Abuse Treatment. (1999b). Enhancing motivation for change in substance abuse treatment (Treatment Improvement Protocol [TIP] Series, No. 35, DHHS Pub. No. SMA 04–3922). Rockville, MD: Substance Abuse and Mental Health Services Administration.

Center for Substance Abuse Treatment. (2005). Substance abuse treatment for persons with co-occurring disorder (Treatment Improvement Protocol [TIP] Series, 42. DHHS Pub. No. SMA 05–3922). Rockville, MD: Substance Abuse and Mental Health Services Administration.

Center for Substance Abuse Treatment. (2009). Substance abuse treatment: Addressing the specifi c needs of women (Treatment Improvement Protocol [TIP] Series, 51 DHHS Pub. No. SMA 09–4426). Rockville, MD: Substance Abuse and Mental Health Services Administration.

Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. (2004). January 11, 2004 marks the 40th anniversary of the inaugural surgeon general’s report on smoking and health. Retrieved from www.cdc.gov/tobacco /overview/anniversary.htm

Chedid, A., Mendenhall, C. L., Gartside, P., French, S. W., Chen, T., & Rabin, L. (1991). Prognostic factors in alcoholic liver disease. American Journal of Gastroenterology, 86, 210–216.

Cherpitel, C. J. (1998). Differences in performance of screening instruments for problem drinking among Blacks, Whites and Hispanics in emergency room population. Journal of Studies on Alcohol, 59, 420–426.

Chi, F. W., Kaskutas, L. A., Sterling, S., Campbell, C. I., & Weisner, C. (2009). Twelve-step affi liation and 3-year substance use outcomes among adolescents: Social support and religious service attendance as potential mediators. Addiction, 104(6), 927–939.

Chiasson, R. E. (1994). Smoking cessation in patients with HIV. JAMA, 272(7), 564.

Compton, W. M., & Volkow, N. D. (2006). Major increases in opioid analgesic abuse in the United States: Concerns and strategies. Drug and Alcohol Dependence, 81, 103–107.

Cook, J. M., Walser, R. D., Kane, V., Ruzek, J. I., & Woody, G. (2006). Dissemination and feasibility of a cognitive-behavioral treatment for substance use disorders and posttraumatic stress disorder in the Veterans Administration. Journal of Psychoactive Drugs, 38, 89–92.

Cooney, N. L., Zweben, A., & Fleming, M. F. (1995). Screening for alcohol problems and at-risk drinking in health-care settings. In R. K. Hester & W. R. Miller (Eds.), Handbook of alcoholism treatment approaches: Effective alternatives (2nd ed., pp. 45–60). Boston, MA: Allyn & Bacon.

Cornelius, L. J. (2002). Defi ning substance abusers using a prism: What you see is what you get. Health & Social Work, 27, 234–237.

Cusack, K. J., Morrissey, J. P., & Ellis, A. R. (2008). Targeting trauma-related interventions and improving outcomes for women with co-occurring disorders. Administration and Policy in Mental Health and Mental Health Services Research, 35(3), 147–158.

Dar, K. J., & McBrien, M. E. (1996). MDMA induced hyperthermia: Report of a fatality and review of current therapy. [Review]. Intensive Care Medicine, 22, 995–996.

Dawson, D. A., & Grant, B. F. (1998). Family history of alcoholism and gender: Their combined effects on DSM-IV alcohol dependence and major depression. Journal of Studies of Alcohol, 59, 97–106.

JWBT514_ch17.indd 461JWBT514_ch17.indd 461 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

462 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Denning, P. (2001). Strategies for implementation of harm reduction in treatment settings. Journal of Psychoactive Drugs, 33(1), 23–26.

DiClemente, C. C. (1991). Motivational interviewing and the stages of change. In W. R. Miller & S. Rollnick, Motivational interviewing: Preparing people to change addictive behavior (pp. 191–202). New York, NY: Guilford Press.

DiClemente, C. C., & Velasquez, M. M. (2002). Motivational interviewing and the stages of change. In W. R. Miller & S. Rollnick (Eds.), Motivational interviewing: Preparing people for change (2nd ed., pp. 201–216). New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Dietary Guidelines Advisory Committee. (2010). Report of the DGAC on the dietary guidelines for Americans, 2010. Retrieved from www.cnpp.usda .gov/DGAs2010-DGACReport.htm

Dimeff, L. A., & Marlatt, G. A. (1998). Preventing relapse and maintaining change in addictive behaviors. Clinical Psychology: Science and Practice, 5, 513–525.

Donovan, D. M. (1999). Assessment strategies and measures in addictive behaviors. In B. S. McCrady & E. E. Epstein (Eds.), Addictions: A comprehensive guidebook (pp. 187–215). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Donovan, D. M., Carroll, K. M., Kadden, R. M., DiClemente, C. C., & Rounsaville, B. J. (2003). Therapies for matching: Selection, development, implementation and costs. In G. Edwards (Series Ed.), T. F. Babor & F. K. Del Boca (Vol. Eds.), International Research Monographs in the Addictions (IRMA): Treatment matching in alcoholism (pp. 42–61). Cambridge, UK: Cambridge University Press.

Dunn, C., Deroo, L., & Rivara, F. (2001). The use of brief interventions adapted from motivational interviewing across behavioral domains: A systematic review. Addiction, 96, 1725–1742.

Durrant, R., & Thakker, J. (2003). Substance use and abuse: Cultural and historical perspectives. Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.

El-Bassel, N., Gilbert, L., Wu, E., Chang, M., & Fontdevila, J. (2007). Perpetration of intimate partner violence among men in methadone treatment programs in New York City. American Journal of Public Health, 97(7), 1230–1232.

Elliott, D. E., Bjelajac, P., Fallot, R. D., Markoff, L. S., & Reed, B. G. (2005). Trauma-informed or trauma- denied: Principles and implementation of trauma- informed services for women. Journal of Community Psychology, 33(4), 461–477.

Engstrom, M., El-Bassel, N., Go, H., & Gilbert, L. (2008). Childhood sexual abuse and intimate partner violence among women in methadone treatment: A direct or mediated relationship? Journal of Family Violence, 23(7), 605–617.

Engstrom, M., Shibusawa, T., El-Bassel, N., & Gilbert, L. (2009). Age and HIV sexual risk among women in methadone treatment. AIDS and Behavior, 15(1), 103–113.

Ewing, J. A. (1984). Detecting alcoholism: The CAGE Questionnaire. JAMA, 252, 1905–1907.

Fields, G. (2010, July 29). House passes bill easing crack- cocaine sentences. Wall Street Journal.

Finkelstein, N., VandeMark, N., Fallot, R., Brown, V., Cadiz, S., & Heckman, J. (2004). Enhancing substance abuse recovery through integrated trauma treatment. Sarasota, FL: National Trauma Consortium. Avail- able at www.nationaltraumaconsortium.org/documents /IntegratedTrauma.pdf

Futterman, R., Lorente, M., & Silverman, S. (2004). Integrating harm reduction in abstinence-based substance abuse treatment in the public sector. Substance Abuse, 25(1), 3–7.

Gibson, D. R., Flynn, N. M., & Perales, D. (2001). Effectiveness of syringe exchange programs in reducing HIV risk behavior and HIV seroconversion among injecting drug users. AIDS, 15, 1329–1341.

Gilbert, L., El-Bassel, N., Manuel, J., Wu, E., Go, H., Golder, S., . . . Sanders, G. (2006). An integrated relapse prevention and relationship safety intervention for women on methadone: Testing short-term effects on intimate partner violence and substance use. Violence and Victims, 21(5), 657–672.

Grant, B. F. (2000). Estimates of U.S. children exposed to alcohol abuse and dependence in the family. American Journal of Public Health, 90, 112–115.

Grant, B. F., Hasin, D. S., Chou, S. P., Stinson, F. S., & Dawson, D. A. (2004). Nicotine dependence and psychiatric disorders in the United States. Archives of General Psychiatry, 61, 1107–1115.

Grella, C. E., & Stein, J. A. (2006). Impact of program services on treatment outcomes of patients with comorbid mental and substance use disorders. Psychiatric Services, 57(7), 1007–1015.

Harm Reduction Coalition. (n.d.). Principles of harm reduction. Retrieved from www.harmreduction.org

Harris, M., & Fallot, R. D. (Eds.) (2001). Using trauma theory to design service systems. San Francisco, CA: Jossey-Bass.

Hatch, E. E., & Bracken, M. B. (1986). Effect of marijuana use in pregnancy on fetal growth. American Journal of Epidemiology, 124, 986–993.

Hatsukami, D. K., & Fischman, M. W. (1996). Crack cocaine and cocaine hydrochloride: Are the differences myth or reality? JAMA, 276, 1580–1588.

Heather, N. (2005). Motivational interviewing: Is it all our clients need? Addiction Research and Theory, 13, 1–18.

Henggeler, S. W., Schoenwald, S. K., Borduin, C. M., Rowland, M. D., & Cunningham, P. B. (1998). Multisystemic treatment of antisocial behavior in children and adolescents. New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Hepworth, D. H., Rooney, R. H., & Larsen, J. A. (2002). Direct social work practice: Theory and skills (6th ed.). Pacifi c Grove, CA: Brooks/Cole.

JWBT514_ch17.indd 462JWBT514_ch17.indd 462 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Substance Use Problems in Health Social Work Practice 463

Hettema, J., Steele, J., & Miller, W. R. (2005). Motivational interviewing. Annual Review of Clinical Psychology, 1, 91–111.

Hien, D. A., Cohen, L. R., Miele, G. M., Litt, L. C., & Capstick, C. (2004). Promising treatments for women with comorbid PTSD and substance use disorders. American Journal of Psychiatry, 161(8), 1426–1432.

Hien, D. A., Jiang, H., Campbell, A. N. C., Hu, M.-C., Miele, G. M., Cohen, L. R., . . . Nunes, E. V. (2010). Do treatment improvements in PTSD severity affect substance use outcomes? A secondary analysis from a randomized clinical trial in NIDA’s Clinical Trials Network. American Journal of Psychiatry, 167(1), 95–101.

Hinkin, C. H., Castellon, S. A., Dickson-Fuhrman, E., Daum, G., Jaffe, J., & Jarvik, L. (2001). Screening for drug and alcohol abuse among older adults using the modifi ed version of the CAGE. American Journal on Addiction, 10(4), 319–326.

Housenbold Seiger, B. (2004). The clinical practice of harm reduction. In S. L. A. Straussner (Ed.), Clinical work with substance abusing clients (2nd ed., pp. 65– 81). New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Hu, G., & Baker, S. P. (2009). Trends in unintentional injury deaths, U.S., 1999–2005: Age, gender and racial/ethnic differences. American Journal of Preventive Medicine, 37(3), 188–194.

Humphreys, K., Wing, S., McCarty, D., Chappel, J., Gallant, L., Haberle, B., . . . Weiss, R. (2004). Self- help organizations for alcohol and drug problems: Toward evidence-based practice and policy. Journal of Substance Abuse Treatment, 26, 151–158.

Hunt, N. (2003). A review of the evidence-base for harm reduction approaches to drug use. Retrieved from www .ihra.net/files/2010/05/31/HIVTop50Documents11 .pdf

Imhof, J. E. (1995). Overcoming countertransference and other attitudinal barriers in the treatment of substance abuse. In A. M. Washton (Ed.), Psychotherapy and substance abuse: A practitioner’s handbook (pp. 3–22). New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Institute of Medicine. (1990). Broadening the base of treatment for alcohol problems. Washington, DC: National Academy Press.

Institute of Medicine. (2001). Health and behavior: The interplay of biological, behavioral, and societal infl uences. Washington, DC: National Academy Press.

Jaffe, A. J., Rounsaville, B., Chang, G., Schottenfeld, R. S., Meyer, R. E., & O’Malley, S. S. (1996). Naltrexone, relapse prevention, and supportive therapy with alcoholics: An analysis of patient treatment matching. Journal of Consulting and Clinical Psychology, 64, 1044–1053.

Joy, J. E., Watson, S. J., Jr., & Benson, J. A., Jr. (Eds.). (1999). Marijuana and medicine: Assessing the scientifi c base. Washington, DC: National Academy Press.

Kandel, D. B., Davies, M., Karus, D., & Yamaguchi, K. (1986). The consequences in young adulthood of adolescent drug involvement. Archives of General Psychiatry, 43, 746–754.

Keegan, J., Parva, M., Finnegan, M., Gerson, A., & Belden, M. (2010). Addiction in pregnancy. Journal of Addictive Diseases, 29, 175–191.

Kellogg, S. H. (2003). On “gradualism” and the building of the harm reduction-abstinence continuum. Journal of Substance Abuse Treatment, 25, 241–247.

Kinney, J., & Leaton, G. (1991). Loosening the grip: A handbook of alcohol information. St. Louis, MO: Mosby-Year Book.

Kosten, T. R., & Sofuoglu, M. (2004). Stimulants. In M. Galanter & H. D. Kleber (Eds.), Textbook of substance abuse treatment (3rd ed., pp. 189–197). Washington, DC: American Psychiatric Press.

Kranzler, H. R., & Anton, R. F. (1994). Implications of recent neuropsychopharmacologic research for understanding the etiology and development of alcoholism. Journal of Consulting and Clinical Psychology, 62, 1116–1126.

Krentzman, A. (2007). The evidence base for the effectiveness of Alcoholics Anonymous: Implications for social work practice. Journal of Social Work Practice in the Addictions, 7(4), 27–48.

Larimer, M. E., Malone, D. K., Garner, M. D., Atkins, D. C., Burlingham, B., Lonczak, H. S., . . . Marlatt, G. A. (2009). Health care and public service use and costs before and after provision of housing for chronically homeless persons with severe alcohol problems. JAMA, 301(13), 1349–1357.

Larimer, M. E., Palmer, R. S., & Marlatt, G. A. (1999). Relapse prevention: An overview of Marlatt’s cognitive-behavioral model. Alcohol Research and Health, 23, 151–160.

Lee, H., Engstrom, M., & Petersen, S. (in press). Harm reduction and twelve steps: Complementary, oppositional, or something in-between? Substance Use & Misuse.

Lemon, S. C., Friedman, P. D., & Stein, M. D. (2003). The impact of smoking cessation on drug abuse treatment outcome. Addictive Behaviors, 28, 1323–1331.

Leshner, A. I. (1997). Addiction is a brain disease, and it matters. Science, 278, 45–47.

Liddle, H. A., & Hogue, A. (2001). Multidimensional family therapy for adolescent substance abuse. In E. F. Wagner & H. B. Waldron (Eds.), Innovations in adolescent substance abuse interventions (pp. 227– 261). London, UK: Pergamon/Elsevier Science.

Liddle, H. A., Rowe, C. L., Dakof, G. A., Henderson, C. E., & Greenbaum, P. E. (2009). Multidimensional family therapy for young adolescent substance abuse: Twelve-month outcomes of a randomized controlled trial. Journal of Consulting and Clinical Psychology, 77(1), 12–25.

Littell, J. H., & Girvin, H. (2002). Stages of change: A critique. Behavior Modifi cation, 26(2), 223–273.

JWBT514_ch17.indd 463JWBT514_ch17.indd 463 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

464 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Logan, D. E., & Marlatt, G. A. (2010). Harm reduction therapy: A practice-friendly review of research. Journal of Clinical Psychology: In Session, 66(2), 201–214.

Longabaugh, R., & Morgenstern, J. (1999). Cognitive- behavioral coping-skills therapy for alcohol dependence. Alcohol Research and Health, 23, 78–85.

Lundahl, B., & Burke, B. L. (2009). The effectiveness and applicability of motivational interviewing: A practice-friendly review of four meta-analyses. Journal of Clinical Psychology: In Session, 65(11), 1232–1245.

Lundahl, B. W., Kunz, C., Brownell, C., Tollefson, D., & Burke, B. L. (2010). A meta-analysis of motivational interviewing: Twenty-fi ve years of empirical studies. Research on Social Work Practice, 20(2), 137–160.

Macias, J., Palacios, R. B., Claro, E., Vargas, J., Vergara, S., Mira, J. A., . . . Pineda, J. A. (2008). High prevalence of hepatitis C virus infection among noninjecting users: Association with sharing the inhalation implements of crack. Liver International, 28(6), 781–786.

MacMaster, S. A. (2004). Harm reduction: A new perspective on substance abuse services. Social Work, 49(3), 356–363.

Madras, B. K., Compton, W. M., Avula, D., Stegbauer, T., Stein, J. B., & Clark, H. W. (2009). Screening, brief interventions, referral to treatment (SBIRT) for illicit drug and alcohol use at multiple health care sites: Comparison at intake and 6 months later. Drug and Alcohol Dependence, 99, 280–295.

Marlatt, G. A. (1985a). Theoretical rationale and model. In G. A. Marlatt & J. R. Gordon (Eds.), Relapse prevention (pp. 3–70). New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Marlatt, G. A. (1985b). Cognitive factors in the relapse process. In G. A. Marlatt & J. R. Gordon (Eds.), Relapse prevention (pp. 128–200). New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Marlatt, G. A. (1998). Basic principles and strategies of harm reduction. In G. A. Marlatt (Ed.), Harm reduction: Pragmatic strategies for managing high-risk behaviors (pp. 49–66). New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Marlatt, G. A., Blume, A. W., & Parks, G. A. (2001). Integrating harm reduction therapy and traditional substance abuse treatment. Journal of Psychoactive Drugs, 33(1), 13–21.

Marlatt, G. A., & Gordon, J. R. (Eds.). (1985). Relapse prevention. New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Marlatt, G. A., & Witkiewitz, K. (2010). Update on harm- reduction policy and intervention research. Annual Review of Clinical Psychology, 6, 591–606.

Marsh, J. C., Cao, D., & D’Aunno, T. (2004). Gender differences in the impact of comprehensive services in substance abuse treatment. Journal of Substance Abuse Treatment, 27, 289–300.

McCrady, B. S. (1993). Alcoholism. In D. S. Barlow (Ed.), Clinical handbook of psychological disorders (2nd ed., pp. 362–395). New York, NY: Guilford Press.

McLellan, A. T., Hagan, T. A., Levine, M., Gould, F., Meyers, K., Bencivengo, M., & Durell, J. (1998). Supplemental social services improve outcomes in public addiction treatment. Addiction, 93(10), 1489–1499.

McNeece, C. A., & Barbanell, L. D. (2005). Defi nitions and epidemiology of substance use, abuse, and disorders. In C. A. McNeece & D. M. DiNitto (Eds.), Chemical dependency: A systems approach (3rd ed., pp. 3–24). Boston, MA: Pearson Education.

McNeece, C. A., & DiNitto, D. M. (2005). Chemical dependency: A systems approach (3rd ed.). Boston, MA: Pearson Education.

Miller, P. G., & Miller, W. R. (2009). What should we be aiming for in the treatment of addiction? Addiction, 104, 685–686.

Miller, W. R. (2000). Rediscovering fi re: Small interventions, large effects. Psychology of Addictive Behaviors, 14, 6–18.

Miller, W. R., & Hester, R. K. (1995). Treatment for alcohol problems: Toward an informed eclecticism. In R. K. Hester & W. R. Miller (Eds.), Handbook of alcoholism treatment approaches: Effective alternatives (2nd ed., pp. 1–11). Boston, MA: Allyn & Bacon.

Miller, W. R., & Kurtz, E. (1994). Models of alcoholism used in treatment: Contrasting AA and other perspectives with which it is often confused. Journal of Studies on Alcohol, 55, 159–166.

Miller, W. R., & Longabaugh, R. (2003). Summary and conclusions. In G. Edwards (Series Ed.), T. F. Babor, & F. K. Del Boca (Vol. Eds.), International research monographs in the addictions (IRMA): Treatment matching in alcoholism (pp. 207–237). Cambridge, UK: Cambridge University Press.

Miller, W. R., & Rollnick, S. (1991). Motivational interviewing: Preparing people to change addictive behavior. New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Miller, W. R., & Rollnick, S. (2002). Motivational interviewing: Preparing people for change (2nd ed.). New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Miller, W. R., & Rose, G. S. (2009). Toward a theory of motivational interviewing. American Psychologist, 64(6), 527–537.

Miller, W. R., & Sanchez, V. C. (1993). Motivating young adults for treatment and lifestyle change. In G. Howard & P. E. Nathan (Eds.), Issues in alcohol use and misuse by young adults (pp. 55–82). Notre Dame, IN: University of Notre Dame Press.

Miller, W. R., Westerberg, V. S., Harris, R. J., & Tonigan, J. S. (1996). What predicts relapse? Prospective testing of antecedent models. Addiction, 91(Suppl.), S155–S171.

Miller, W. R., Yahne, C. E., & Tonigan, J. S. (2003). Motivational interviewing in drug abuse services: A randomized trial. Journal of Consulting and Clinical Psychology, 71, 754–763.

Miller, W. R., Zweben, J., & Johnson, W. R. (2005). Evidence- based treatment: Why, what, where, when and how? Journal of Substance Abuse Treatment, 29, 267–276.

JWBT514_ch17.indd 464JWBT514_ch17.indd 464 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Substance Use Problems in Health Social Work Practice 465

Moak, D. H., & Anton, R. F. (1999). Alcohol. In B. S. McCrady & E. E. Epstein (Eds.), Addictions: A comprehensive guidebook (pp. 75–94). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Morrissey, J. P., Ellis, A. R., Gatz, M., Amaro, H., Reed, B. G., Savage, A., . . . Banks, S. (2005). Outcomes for women with co-occurring disorders and trauma: Program and person-level effects. Journal of Substance Abuse Treatment, 28(2), 121–133.

Najavits, L. M. (2002). Seeking safety: A treatment manual for PTSD and substance abuse. New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Najavits, L. M., Schmitz, M., Gotthardt, S., & Weiss, R. D. (2005). Seeking safety plus exposure therapy: An outcome study on dual diagnosis men. Journal of Psychoactive Drugs, 37(4), 425–435.

National Institute on Alcohol Abuse and Alcoholism, Center for Substance Abuse Prevention, & Public Health Service. (1995). The alcohol and other drug thesaurus: A guide to concepts and terminology in substance abuse and addiction (2nd ed., Vol. 1). Washington, DC: U.S. Department of Health and Human Services.

National Institute on Alcohol Abuse and Alcoholism (NIAAA). (2000). The economic costs of alcohol and drug abuse in the United States 1992. Rockville, MD: National Institutes of Health.

National Institute on Alcohol Abuse and Alcoholism. (2004a). NIAAA council approves defi nition of binge drinking. Retrieved from http://pubs.niaaa.nih .gov/publications/newsletter/winter2004/newsletter _number3.pdf

National Institute on Alcohol Abuse and Alcoholism. (2004b). Social work curriculum on alcohol use disorders. Retrieved from http://pubs.niaaa.nih.gov /publications/social/main.html

National Institute on Alcohol Abuse and Alcoholism. (2007). Helping patients who drink too much (NIH Publication No. 07–3769). Retrieved from http://pubs.niaaa.nih.gov/publications/practitioner /cliniciansguide2005/clinicians_guide.htm.

National Institute on Drug Abuse. (1999a). Cocaine abuse and addiction (NIDA Research Report Series, NIH Publication No. 99–4342). Retrieved from www .drugabuse.gov/PDF/RRCocaine.pdf

National Institute on Drug Abuse. (1999b). Principles of drug addiction treatment: A research-based guide (NIH Publication No. 99–4180). Retrieved from www .drugabuse.gov/PODAT/PODATindex.html

National Institute on Drug Abuse. (2000). Heroin abuse and addiction (NIDA Research Report Series, NIH Publication No. 00–4165). Retrieved from www .drugabuse.gov/PDF/RRHeroin.pdf

National Institute on Drug Abuse. (2001a). NIDA Research Report Series: Nicotine Addiction (NIH Publication No. 01–4342). Washington, DC: Author.

National Institute on Drug Abuse. (2001b). Prescription drugs: Abuse and addictions (NIDA Research Report

Series, NIH Publication No. 01–4881). Retrieved from www.drugabuse.gov/PDF/RRPrescription.pdf

National Institute on Drug Abuse. (2002a). Marijuana abuse (NIDA Research Report Series, NIH Publication No. 99-4342). Retrieved from www.drugabuse.gov /PDF/RRMarijuana.pdf

National Institute on Drug Abuse. (2002b). Methamphetamine abuse and addiction (NIDA Research Report Series, NIH Publication No. 02–4210). Retrieved from www. drugabuse.gov/PDF/RRMetham.pdf

National Institute of Drug Abuse. (2004a). Marijuana. Retrieved from www.nida.nih.gov/tib/marijuana.html

National Institute of Drug Abuse. (2005a). NIDA InfoFacts: Heroin. Retrieved from http://nida.nih.gov/infofacts/ heroin.html

National Institute on Drug Abuse. (2005b). Inhalant abuse (NIDA Research Report Series, NIH Publication No. 05–3818). Retrieved from www.drugabuse.gov/PDF /RRInhalants.pdf

National Institute of Drug Abuse. (2005c). Research report series-MDMA (ecstacy) abuse. Retrieved from http:// nida.nih.gov/researchreports/mdma/MDMA6.html

National Institute on Drug Abuse. (2009a). Prescription and over-the-counter medications (NIDA InfoFacts). Retrieved from www.drugabuse.gov/PDF/Infofacts /PainMed09.pdf

National Institute on Drug Abuse. (2009b). Principles of drug addiction treatment: A research-based guide (2nd edition). Retrieved from www.drugabuse.gov /podat/podatindex.html

National Institute on Drug Abuse. (2009c). Principles of drug addiction treatment. Retrieved from http:// drugabuse.gov/PDF/PODAT/PODAT.pdf

National Institute on Drug Abuse. (2010a). Cocaine (NIDA InfoFacts). Retrieved from www.drugabuse .gov/pdf/infofacts/Cocaine10.pdf

National Insitute on Drug Abuse. (2010b). NIDA InfoFacts: Cigarettes and other tobacco products. Retrieved from www.nida.nih.gov/inforfacts/tobacco.html

O’Brien, C. P., & McLellan, A. T. (1996). Myths about the treatment of addiction. Lancet, 347(8996), 237–240.

O’Brien, C. P., & Volkow, N. (2006). What’s in a word? Addiction versus dependence in DSM-V. American Journal of Psychiatry, 163(5), 764–765.

O’Farrell, T. J., & Fals-Stewart, W. (2008). Behavioral couples therapy for alcoholism and other drug abuse. Alcoholism Treatment Quarterly, 26(1), 195–219.

O’Farrell, T. J., Murphy, M., Alter, J., & Fals-Stewart, W. (2010). Behavioral family counseling for substance abuse: A treatment development pilot study. Addictive Behaviors, 35, 1–6.

Parsons, J. T., Golub, S. A., Rosof, E., & Holder, C. (2007). Motivational interviewing and cognitive-behavioral intervention to improve HIV medication adherence among hazardous drinkers: A randomized controlled trial. Journal of Acquired Immune Defi ciency Syndrome, 46(4), 443–450.

JWBT514_ch17.indd 465JWBT514_ch17.indd 465 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

466 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Paulozzi, L. J., Ballesteros, M. F., & Stevens, J. A. (2006). Recent trends in mortality from unintentional injury in the United States. Journal of Safety Research, 37, 277–283.

Pokorny, A. D., Miller, B. A., & Kaplan, H. B. (1972). The brief MAST: A shortened version of the Michigan Alcoholism Screening Test. American Journal of Psychiatry, 129, 342–345.

Prescott, C., & Kendler, K. (1999). Genetic and environmental contributions to alcohol abuse and dependence in a population-based sample of male twins. American Journal of Psychiatry, 156, 34–40.

Prochaska, J. O., & Prochaska, J. M. (1999). Why don’t continents move? Why don’t people change? Journal of Psychotherapy Integration, 9, 83–101.

Prochaska, J. O., DiClemente, C. C., & Norcross, J. C. (1992). In search of how people change: Applications to addictive behaviors. American Psychologist, 47(9), 1102–1114.

Reinert, D. F., & Allen, J. P. (2002). The Alcohol Use Disorders Identifi cation Test (AUDIT): A review of recent research. Alcoholism: Clinical and Experimental Research, 26(2), 272–279.

Rotgers, F., Little, J., & Denning, P. (2005). Harm reduction and traditional treatment: Shared goals and values. Addiction Professional, July, 20–26.

Saunders, J. B., Aasland, O. G., Amundsen, A., & Grant, M. (1993). WHO Collaborative Project on Early Detection of Persons with Harmful Alcohol Consumption: Pt. I. Alcohol consumption and related problems among primary health care patients. Addiction, 88, 349–362.

Saunders, J. B., Aasland, O. G., Babor, T. F., De La Fuente, J. R., & Grant, M. (1993). Development of the Alcohol Use Disorders Identifi cation Test (AUDIT): WHO Collaborative Project on Early Detection of Persons with Harmful Alcohol Consumption-II. Addiction, 88, 791–804.

Savage, S. R., Kirsh, K. L., & Passik, S. D. (2008). Challenges in using opioids to treat pain in persons with substance use disorders. Addiction Science and Clinical Practice, 4(2), 4–25.

Schilling, R. F., & El-Bassel, N. (1998). Substance abuse interventions. In J. B. Williams & K. Ell (Eds.), Advances in mental health services research: Implications for practice (pp. 437–481). Washington, DC: National Association of Social Workers Press.

Schuckit, M. A., & Tapert, S. (2004). Alcohol. In M. Galanter & H. D. Kleber (Eds.), Textbook of substance abuse treatment (3rd ed., pp. 151–166). Washington, DC: American Psychiatric Press.

Seal, K. H., Thawley, R., Gee, L., Bamberger, J, Kral, A. H. Ciccarone, D., . . . Edlin, B. R. (2005). Naloxone distribution and cardiopulmonary resuscitation training for injection drug users to prevent heroin overdose death: A pilot intervention study. Journal of Urban Health, 82(2), 303–311.

Selzer, M. L. (1971). The Michigan Alcoholism Screening Test: The quest for a new diagnostic instrument. American Journal of Psychiatry, 127, 1653–1658.

Selzer, M. L., Vinokur, A., & Van Rooijen, L. (1975). A self-administered Short Michigan Alcoholism Screening Test (SMAST). Journal of Studies on Alcohol, 36, 117–126.

Shah, N. G., Lathrop, S. L., Reichard, R. R., & Landen, M. G. (2007). Unintentional drug overdose death trends in New Mexico, USA, 1990–2005: Combinations of heroin, cocaine, prescription opioids and alcohol. Addiction, 103, 126–136.

Shiono, P. H., Klebanoff, M. A., Nugent, R. P., Cotch, M. F., Wilkins, D. G., Rollins, D. E., . . . Behrman, R. E. (1995). The impact of cocaine and marijuana use on low birth weight and preterm birth: A multicenter study. American Journal of Obstetrics and Gynecology, 172, 19–27.

Singer, L. T. (1999). Advances in redirections in understanding effects of fetal drug exposure. Journal of Drug Issues, 29(2), 253–262.

Skinner, H. A. (1982). The Drug Abuse Screening Test. Addictive Behaviors, 7, 363–371.

Slade, J. (1999). Nicotine. In B. S. McCrady & E. E. Epstein (Eds.), Addictions: A comprehensive guide (pp. 162–170). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Smith, J. E., Meyers, R. J., & Austin, J. L. (2008). Working with family members to engage treatment-refusing drinkers: The CRAFT program. Alcoholism Treatment Quarterly, 26(1), 169–193.

Stephens, R. S. (1999). Cannabis and hallucinogens. In B. S. McCrady & E. E. Epstein (Eds.), Addictions: A comprehensive guidebook (pp. 121–140). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Stine, S. M., & Kosten, T. R. (1999). Opioids. In B. S. McCrady & E. E. Epstein (Eds.), Addictions: A comprehensive guidebook (pp. 141–161). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Stratton, K., Howe, C., & Battaglia, F. (1995). Fetal alcohol syndrome: Diagnosis, epidemiology, prevention, and treatment. Washington, DC: Institute of Medicine, National Academy Press.

Substance Abuse and Mental Health Services Administration [SAMSHA]. (2009). Results from the 2008 National Survey on Drug Use and Health: National fi ndings (Offi ce of Applied Studies, NSDUH Series H-36, DHHS Publication No. SMA 09–4434). Rockville, MD: Author.

Szapocznik, J., & Williams, R. A. (2000). Brief strategic family therapy: Twenty-fi ve years of interplay among theory, research and practice in adolescent behavior problems and drug abuse. Clinical Child and Family Psychology Review, 3, 117–134.

Tsemberis, S., Gulcur, L., & Nakae, M. (2004). Housing fi rst, consumer choice, and harm reduction for homeless individuals with a dual diagnosis. American Journal of Public Health, 94(4), 651–656.

JWBT514_ch17.indd 466JWBT514_ch17.indd 466 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

Substance Use Problems in Health Social Work Practice 467

U.S. Public Health Service. (2000, June). Treating tobacco use and dependence. Retrieved from www .surgeongeneral.gov/tobacco/smokesum.htm

van Wormer, K., & Davis, D. R. (2003). Addiction treatment: A strengths perspective. Pacifi c Grove, CA: Brooks/Cole.

Vasilaki, E., Hosier, S. G., & Cox, W. M. (2006). The effi cacy of motivational interviewing as a brief intervention for excessive drinking: A meta-analytic review. Alcohol and Alcoholism, 41(3), 328–335.

Weaver, M. F., & Schnoll, S. H. (1999). Stimulants: Amphetamines and cocaine. In B. S. McCrady & E. E. Eptstein (Eds.), Addictions: A comprehensive guidebook (pp. 105–120). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Weil, A., & Rosen, W. (1993). From chocolate to morphine: Everything you need to know about mind- altering drugs (Rev. ed.). Boston, MA: Houghton Miffl in.

Weir, B. W., O’Brien, K., Bard, R. S., Casciato, C. J., Maher, J. E., Dent, C. W., . . . Stark, M. J. (2009). Reducing HIV and partner violence risk among women with criminal justice system involvement: A randomized controlled trial of two motivational interviewing-based interventions. AIDS and Behavior, 13, 509–522.

White, W. L. (1998). Slaying the dragon: A history of addiction treatment and recovery in America.

Bloomington, IL: Chestnut Health Systems/ Lighthouse Institute.

Wilcox, R. E., & Erickson, C. K. (2005). The brain biology of drug abuse and addiction. In C. A. McNeece & D. M. DiNitto (Eds.), Chemical dependency: A systems approach (pp. 42–60). Boston, MA: Pearson Education.

Williams, D. R., Mohammed, S. A., Leavell, J., & Collins, C. (2010). Race, socioeconomic status, and health: Complexities, ongoing challenges, and research opportunities. Annals of the New York Academy of Sciences, 1186, 69–101.

Zacny, J., Bigelow, G., Compton, P., Foley, K., Iguchi, M., & Sannerud, C. (2003). College on Problems of Drug Dependence taskforce on prescription opioid non- medical use and abuse: Position statement. Drug and alcohol dependence, 69, 215–232.

Zlotnick, C., Johnson, J., & Najavits, L. M. (2009). Randomized controlled pilot study of cognitive- behavioral therapy in a sample of incarcerated women with substance use disorder and PTSD. Behavior Therapy, 40(4), 325–336.

Zuckerman, B., Frank, D., Hingson, R., Amaro, H., Levenson, S., Kayne, H., . . . Bauchner, H. (1989). Effects of maternal marijuana and cocaine use on fetal growth. New England Journal of Medicine, 320, 762–768.

JWBT514_ch17.indd 467JWBT514_ch17.indd 467 9/21/11 7:43 PM9/21/11 7:43 PM

468

18

Nephrology Social Work

TERI BROWNE

End-stage renal disease (ESRD) is a chronic condition that requires lifelong treatment via hemodialysis, peritoneal dialysis, or a kidney transplant. ESRD is a signifi cant American public health issue. It is also an important practice focus for health social work because it provides the only Medicare mandate for MSW service provision for a disease or treatment category. This chapter presents an overview of psychosocial issues related to ESRD and a discussion of the role of the nephrology social worker in various arenas.

Chapter Objectives • Explore psychosocial aspects of renal fail-

ure and its treatment regimes. • Identify roles and responsibilities of ne-

phrology social workers. • Explore nephrology social work assessment

and intervention recommendations. • Examine the history of nephrology social

work in dialysis and transplantation. • Defi ne professional issues of nephrology

social workers.

END-STAGE RENAL DISEASE AS A PUBLIC HEALTH ISSUE

ESRD is a signifi cant and growing American public health issue, as evidenced by these

fi ndings from the U.S. Renal Data System An- nual Data Report (2010):

• In 2008, 547,982 U.S. residents had ESRD (354,600 on hemodialysis; 26,517 on peri- toneal dialysis; 165,639 with a kidney transplant). It is projected that by 2030, the number of ESRD patients will increase to 2.24 million.

• The total spending for ESRD care in 2008 was $39.46 billion.

• ESRD care represents a signifi cant proportion of federal health-care costs, comprising 5.9% of the Medicare budget in 2008.

• Medicare contributions to the ESRD pro- gram rose from $5.8 billion in 1991 to $26.8 billion in 2008. Non-Medicare ex- penditures for ESRD care from Medicaid, private insurers and state kidney programs rose from $2.2 billion in 1991 to $12.66 bil- lion in 2008.

ESRD is a chronic illness that results in kidney failure and necessitates renal replace- ment therapy via dialysis or kidney transplan- tation. ESRD also is referred to as “chronic kidney disease stage 5.” When an individual’s kidneys fail, waste products and fl uids ac- cumulate in the body, urine output decreases (and may cease entirely), and red blood cell production diminishes. ESRD may develop suddenly or over many years; without treat- ment, a patient with ESRD will die. ESRD has many causes, with diabetes and hypertension being the two greatest. Other causes of ESRD include lupus, gout, chemotherapy, cancer, substance use, and kidney diseases such as

Note: The author would like to thank her USC College of Social Work research assistants, Sonya Davis-Kennedy, Lesley Jacobs, Olivia Jones, Derrick Jordan, Cassidy Shaver, Valerie Stiling, Felix Weston, and Jennifer Worthington, for reviewing this chapter and making suggestions for added content.

JWBT514_ch18.indd 468JWBT514_ch18.indd 468 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

Nephrology Social Work 469

standard three-times-per-week hemodialysis. After a year of this randomized clinical trial, patients who received more frequent dialysis were found to have lower mortality rates and better cardiac status.

In his meta-analysis of the research related to the benefi ts of home hemodialysis, Rosner (2010) concludes that patients who receive hemodialysis at home rather than in a dialysis center have signifi cantly better outcomes, in- cluding improved mortality, morbidity, nutri- tional status, and quality of life. This and other research that evaluates the benefi ts of home hemodialysis suggests that the improved out- comes related to this treatment modality can be attributed to the longer dialysis treatment times that home hemodialysis patients usually receive compared to patients who dialyze in outpatient centers only three times per week.

Home hemodialysis is a treatment option that allows patients to perform their own di- alysis at home. Patients and social support net- work members receive comprehensive training to master their own hemodialysis. Dialysis centers arrange for equipment and supplies needed for home hemodialysis to be deliv- ered and set up, using the small hemodialysis machines that the technology related to this modality now supports. Patients are trained to insert their own hemodialysis needles, set up and run hemodialysis machines, and trouble- shoot any concerns. Patients can dialyze in the comfort of their homes or perform hemodialy- sis when traveling. Patients who receive home hemodialysis see the members of their dialysis teams when they return to the dialysis clinic for laboratory testing and follow-up visits.

Peritoneal dialysis is also a renal replace- ment treatment modality conducted by patients themselves. A catheter is surgically implanted in patients that protrudes from the abdomen and is used to attach tubing to containers of dialysate fl uid, which is drained into patients’ abdomens. Using the peritoneal membrane surrounding the abdominal cavity, the fl uid fi l- ters patients’ blood and attracts excess fl uids and is drained and refi lled periodically. Perito- neal dialysis is done daily, either several times throughout the day or overnight via a machine.

glomerulonephritis, nephritis, and polycystic kidney disease.

Dialysis is mostly provided by large for- profi t national dialysis chains, usually on an outpatient basis at free-standing dialysis clin- ics. Transplants are provided in hospitals that have transplant centers. The average 2010 Medicare cost per patient for hemodialysis was $77,506 per year; the cost for peritoneal dialysis was $57,639; the cost for kidney trans- plantation was approximately $116,100 for the year in which the transplant was received and $26,668 per year after the transplant (U.S. Renal Data System, 2010). Two types of dial- ysis currently are available: hemodialysis and peritoneal dialysis.

Hemodialysis is a medical treatment in which a patient is connected to a dialysis ma- chine via tubing joined to an external catheter in the patient’s chest or needles that are inserted into a permanent vascular access (called a fi s- tula or graft, which is usually in the patient’s arm), which is attached to tubing that leads to the machine. The hemodialysis machine consists of tubing, solutions, monitors, and a fi ltering device called a dialyzer that removes excess fl uid from the patient and cleanses the blood prior to its return to the body through tubing connected to the catheter or access. He- modialysis usually is performed three times a week (referred to as in-center dialysis), for at least 3 hours per treatment in an outpatient dialysis clinic by nurses and patient care tech- nicians. Hemodialysis patients see their health- care team while receiving treatments.

The hemodialysis regime can vary, and daily, overnight, and home hemodialysis are available patient treatment options. Research suggests that hemodialysis received more frequently than three times a week provides patients with better outcomes, including im- proved mortality, morbidity, and quality of life. In the Frequent Hemodialysis Network (FHN) Trial Group’s 2010 investigation re- ported in the New England Journal of Medi- cine, 125 patients were randomly assigned to a clinical trial and received hemodialysis six times per week while 120 patients were randomly assigned to a group receiving the

JWBT514_ch18.indd 469JWBT514_ch18.indd 469 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

470 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Peritoneal dialysis patients see their health- care team during monthly visits to the clinic.

Research suggests that patients who re- ceive peritoneal dialysis instead of in-center hemodialysis have better outcomes, includ- ing improved mortality and morbidity rates. A study of 9,277 dialysis patients from across the United States demonstrated that peritoneal patients have a 40% decrease in risk of mortal- ity, compared to patients who received hemo- dialysis three times a week (Charnow, 2010). Interestingly, a recent anonymous survey of nephrologists suggests that the overwhelming majority of nephrologists would choose perito- neal or home hemodialysis if they themselves needed renal replacement treatment (Schatell, Bragg-Gresham, Mehrotra, Merighi, & Witten, 2010). When asked what treatment modality they would choose for themselves if they had kidney failure and a 5-year wait for a kidney transplant, only 6.4% of the 660 nephrologists indicated that they would choose standard three- times-per-week in-center hemodialysis. Forty- fi ve percent responded that they would choose peritoneal dialysis for themselves, and 45% that they would choose home hemodialysis.

Kidney transplantation is a surgical proce- dure in which a donor kidney is placed in the ESRD patient’s body. The donor kidney can come from a deceased (also known as cadav- eric) or a living donor. To get a transplant, a patient must undergo extensive evaluation and testing. If a living donor cannot be located, the patient is placed on a waiting list for a deceased donor kidney. Patients with living donors may be scheduled for surgery at a fu- ture date. A person whose kidneys are healthy can function with only one kidney, making a living donation an increasingly popular form of transplantation. Although it usually occurs between patients and donors who have a rela- tionship with one another, altruistic donations from donors who do not know transplant re- cipients are becoming more common.

These altruistic kidney donations include “paired donors,” which is a growing phenom- enon in kidney transplantation. In its sim- plest form, paired donation matches strangers who need kidney transplants and have kidney

donors in their social support networks who are not good matches for transplantation. These donors are paired with other patients, who receive their kidneys for transplantation. For example, Joe is an ESRD patient who needs a kidney transplant. His wife, Doris, wants to donate a kidney to Joe and is suitable in most ways to donate, yet her kidney would not be compatible with Joe’s blood type. Ann is an- other ESRD patient in the same situation—her sister Nancy wants to donate a kidney to Ann, but she is not compatible with Ann’s blood type. Transplant centers facilitate a pairing be- tween these two patients, so that Joe receives Nancy’s kidney (because they are a good match) and Ann receives Doris’s kidney (be- cause they have the same blood type). Paired donations are becoming increasingly compli- cated. Rees and colleagues (2009) report on a paired donor chain that resulted in 10 different kidney transplants at six different transplant centers in fi ve different states. In November 2010, Georgetown University Hospital set the record for the size of a paired donation kidney swap, transplanting 16 different ESRD pa- tients with organs from donors who included spouses, aunts, parents, children, cousins, and strangers to these 16 patients. The donors were not biologically compatible with their family members with ESRD (or were strangers with benevolent motives for donating a kidney) and were matched in this “kidney swap” with one of the 16 patients by Georgetown University’s kidney transplant center. Because of the scar- city of deceased organ donors in the United States, transplant centers and the United Net- work of Organ Sharing want to increase future rates of paired kidney donation (Georgetown University Hospital, 2010).

Transplantation is considered a form of ESRD treatment, not a cure, because patients must take immunosuppressant medications for the life of the kidney to ensure that their bodies do not reject the donor kidney. Trans- plants may fail, requiring a patient to return to dialysis. In an ESRD patient’s lifetime, he may experience all three forms of ESRD treatment.

Kidney transplantation is the most cost- effective treatment for ESRD and provides

JWBT514_ch18.indd 470JWBT514_ch18.indd 470 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

Nephrology Social Work 471

patients with enhanced physical and mental health, especially when compared to dialysis (Becker et al., 2000). An objective of Healthy People 2010 and a proposed objective of Healthy People 2020 is to increase the number of dialysis patients who get kidney transplants (U.S. Department of Health and Human Ser- vices, 2000). Transplants may not be possible, however, in situations where patients are not medically suited for transplant surgery or in which they prefer another form of treatment.

Acute dialysis was fi rst done in the 1940s, the fi rst kidney transplant was performed in 1951, and chronic outpatient dialysis was fi rst available in the early 1960s. In 1965, there were only 200 dialysis patients in the world; prior to 1972, hemodialysis machines were scarce, and dialysis was largely paid for by pa- tients or with donated funds (Fox & Swazey, 1979). Selection committees chose individuals for dialysis, and lack of funding and scarcity of treatment venues prevented many ESRD patients from having dialysis. Selection com- mittees were comprised of lay individuals who chose dialysis patients based on their perceived “social worth,” with preference given to fam- ily breadwinners and community leaders (Jon- sen, 2000). On October 30, 1972, the national ESRD program, Public Law 92–601, was passed after signifi cant lobbying by patients, their families, and the community in response to the rationing of dialysis care (Fox & Swazey, 1979). This law provides Medicare coverage of dialysis or kidney transplantation for all ESRD patients regardless of age. Medicare also pays for the expenses for kidney donors, including paired donors. This coverage is unique, be- cause ESRD is the only disease category that guarantees Medicare eligibility (with suffi cient work history of the patient or spouse/parent).

DEMOGRAPHICS OF RENAL PATIENTS

The demographics of the renal patient popula- tion have changed dramatically since the start of widespread ESRD care in the United States. The majority of dialysis patients used to be

younger heads of families. Today, individu- als 65 years and older comprise the fastest- increasing population among ESRD patients (Kutner, 1994). Older adults with ESRD have more comorbidities, greater psychosocial is- sues and needs, and more physical problems than do younger adults with the condition (Chen, Wu, Wang, & Jaw, 2003).

ESRD affects certain groups in the United States disproportionately; African Americans, Hispanics, American Indians, and Alaskan Natives are dramatically more likely to de- velop renal failure than are White Americans. Compared to White Americans with an ESRD incidence of 273 per million, African Ameri- cans have an incidence rate of ESRD of 998 per million, Hispanics have an incidence of 508 per million for ESRD, Native Americans have an incidence of 495 per million, and Asians have an incidence of 296 per million (U.S. Renal Data System, 2009). Higher inci- dence of ESRD in minority populations gen- erally is attributed to the greater prevalence of diabetes and hypertension in these popula- tions, leading to ESRD.

Disparity in kidney transplantation also ex- ists, with White American males more likely to receive a kidney transplant than any other demographic group in the United States. Af- rican American ESRD patients are much less likely than White Americans to be referred for renal transplant, placed on a waiting list for a kidney, or to receive a kidney transplant (U.S. Renal Data System, 2010). Reasons for this disparity include a lack of preventive care, pa- tient preference, socioeconomic disadvantage, distrust of the medical community, a lack of knowledge about kidney transplantation, and medical reasons. Further research on ESRD disparity is needed.

PSYCHOSOCIAL ASPECTS

Eighty-nine percent of ESRD patients report experiencing signifi cant lifestyle changes from the disease (Kaitelidou et al., 2005). The chro- nicity of ESRD and the intrusiveness of its required treatment provide renal patients with

JWBT514_ch18.indd 471JWBT514_ch18.indd 471 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

472 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

multiple disease-related and treatment-related psychosocial stressors that affect their every- day lives (Devins et al., 1990). Illness intru- siveness related to ESRD is defi ned as “the extent to which the illness and/or its treatment interfere with important facets of a patient’s life” (Landsman, 1975, p. 328). Researchers have found that psychosocial issues negatively impact health outcomes of patients and dimin- ish patient quality of life (Auslander, Dobrof, & Epstein, 2001; Burrows-Hudson, 1995; Kimmel et al., 1998). Social workers can help patients ameliorate psychosocial barriers to ESRD care such as:

• Adjustment and coping to the illness and treatment regime(s)

• Medical complications and problems

• Issues related to pain, palliative care, and end-of-life care

• Social role adjustment: familial, social, and vocational

• Concrete needs: fi nancial loss, insurance problems, and prescription coverage

• Diminished quality of life

• Body image issues

• Numerous losses, such as fi nancial security, health, libido, strength, independence, mo- bility, schedule fl exibility, sleep, appetite, freedom with diet and fl uid

Disease-Related Psychosocial Aspects

ESRD may impair sense of taste, diminish ap- petite, and cause bone disease that can require surgery and impair a person’s ability to walk. A buildup of toxins in the blood may cause patients to be anemic and uremic. Uremia and anemia lead to symptomatology such as con- fusion, lethargy, and sleep problems that have psychosocial sequelae. Anemia is common among ESRD patients and impairs activities of daily living, diminishes energy, and con- sequently can affect quality of life (Gerson et al., 2004). ESRD patients have a comprised nutritional status, and a subsequent low blood albumin level also decreases patient quality of life (Frank, Auslander, & Weissgarten, 2003).

Moreover, ESRD usually occurs along with chronic illnesses, such as hypertension and diabetes. These illnesses bring their own psychosocial issues that require ESRD pa- tients to access health services from a number of community sources frequently (Merighi & Ehlbrcht, 2004c).

ESRD patients often require complex medi- cation regimes due to kidney failure and other health conditions. Medications and blood transfusions may be needed during dialysis to address anemia and iron defi ciency. Dialysis patients often must take several phosphorous- binding tablets with every meal as well as numerous other medications related to ESRD and its side effects, such as cramping and rest- less legs syndrome. Transplant patients may, in fact, have to take dozens of pills a day to manage their transplant and prevent rejection of the organ. Self-management of oral medica- tions is a signifi cant problem among the ESRD population (Browne & Merighi, 2010). Chiu and colleagues (2009) conclude that dialysis patients take the highest number of pills per day of all patients with chronic illness—25% of hemodialysis patients must take at least 25 pills per day (median 19 pills).

The toll of these disease-related stressors is great. Some researchers have found ESRD patients to be signifi cantly more likely than persons in the general population to commit suicide (Kurella, Kimmel, Young, & Chertow, 2005). Others have noted that ESRD results in anxiety and depression. Auslander and colleagues (2001) found that 52% of ESRD patients had signifi cant anxiety; Wuerth and colleagues (2001) found that 49% of patients were depressed. Depression in ESRD patients is a signifi cant issue because:

• Kimmel, Peterson, Weihs, and their fellow researchers (2000) determined that ESRD patients who are depressed are more likely to have poor nutritional outcomes and have a higher mortality rate. Koo and colleagues (2003) also have found that depression leads to malnutrition. Patients who are de- pressed are not likely to eat properly. De- pression is linked to higher mortality rates

JWBT514_ch18.indd 472JWBT514_ch18.indd 472 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

Nephrology Social Work 473

(Hedayati et al., 2004). In addition, DeOreo (1997) found that depressed patients were less likely to adhere to their recommended treatment regimes than nondepressed pa- tients and were more likely to have a higher level of morbidity and mortality.

• Paniagua, Amato, Vonesh, Guo, and Mujais (2005) found that ESRD patients who are depressed are more likely to be hospitalized.

Depression can also diminish patients’ quality of life (Frank et al., 2003; Mollaoglu, 2004). This is relevant to public policy and is a public health concern because DeOreo (1997) and Mapes and colleagues (2004) have shown that a low quality of life in ESRD pa- tients is signifi cantly related to a higher hos- pitalization rate, greater morbidity, and higher mortality.

ESRD patients have a lower functional status than the population as a whole and are likely to need assistance with activities of daily living (Kimmel, 2000). ESRD patients often have insomnia and sleeping problems (Valdez, 1997). They also may have body image issues related to their dialysis access and medication side effects (Beer, 1995). Vascular accesses for hemodialysis can become quite large and vis- ible on patients’ arms. Peritoneal accesses and catheters used for hemodialysis are surgically implanted and protrude from the body. Medi- cations, especially transplant immunosuppres- sant drugs, can cause weight gain or other changes in patients’ physical appearance.

Sexual functioning may be diminished due to ESRD, another major source of concern for patients (Wu et al., 2001). ESRD female pa- tients have decreased rates of fertility because the disease impairs reproductive endocrine functioning. This impaired endocrine func- tioning results in numerous complications of pregnancy, and ESRD patients are unlikely to have a successful pregnancy (Holley & Reddy, 2003).

Poor adjustment to ESRD may be exacer- bated by what Landsman (1975) refers to as “the marginal man syndrome.” Most ESRD patients may appear “healthy” despite being chronically ill. Others may therefore have

unrealistic expectations of their abilities and expect more of them than is appropriate. Friends, neighbors, and coworkers may not understand why patients cannot participate in a pizza party due to the renal diet or other social functions due to the dialysis schedule. Landsman (1975) describes the necessity of coping with the “concept of perpetual treat- ment without cure, suspended in a state of limbo between the world of the sick and the world of the well, belonging to neither, yet a part of both, [questioning], am I sick or am I well?” (p. 268).

Restless legs syndrome, in which patients have persistent tremors in their extremities, is common in ESRD patients (Takaki et al., 2003). Acute and chronic pain is very com- mon among ESRD patients and can impair quality of life (Devins et al., 1990). Pain can result from surgeries, cramping, needle sticks, neuropathy, and bone disease. Iacono (2003, 2004) found that 60% of dialysis patients have chronic pain and that 66% of these pa- tients were using prescription medication for pain. Lori Hartwell (2002), an ESRD patient and advocate, describes her own experiences with pain:

During my many medical procedures, I’ve had to endure hundreds of needle pricks. When I was younger, I would never complain about the number of sticks the nurses made. Consequently, they repeatedly told me what a good patient I was. In reality, those needles hurt! I wanted to cry and scream at the per- son who kept poking me. Most often I was silent and tried to be as accommodating as possible. (p. 8)

Palliative care and end-of-life issues are prevalent in ESRD. The life expectancy of patients is 75% lower than similar individu- als without ESRD (Moss, 2005). Discontinu- ing dialysis is a recognized treatment choice, and patients may opt to stop their treatment, which will lead to death. Without dialysis, the median number of days that patients will survive is eight, although there is much vari- ability in survival time after stopping dialysis

JWBT514_ch18.indd 473JWBT514_ch18.indd 473 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

474 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

(Germain & Cohen, 2007). A study of 115,239 deceased dialysis patients found that 96% of patients who stopped dialysis died within a month (Murray, Arko, Chen, Gilbertson, & Moss, 2006). In the United States, fewer than 5% of patients opt not to start dialysis (Germain & Cohen, 2007). Kidney disease teams are encouraged to discuss realistic ex- pectations of prognosis and quality of life re- lated to starting this life-extending treatment. Russ, Shim, and Kaufman (2007) recommend that nephrologists have frank discussions with their patients about their prognoses, how long they can expect to live on dialysis, and how di- alysis will impact their quality of life and that of their families. Many ESRD patients have psychosocial problems and concerns prior to death, including signifi cant pain in the last week of life (Cohen, Germain, Woods, Mirot, & Burleson, 2005). See Browne (2011) for a full discussion about palliative and end-of-life care for kidney disease patients.

Finally, there are particular disease-related challenges for children suffering from ESRD. Pediatric ESRD patients and their families face unique psychosocial stressors. Infants born with ESRD require frequent hospitalization and medical visits. Their development is im- paired, and they may need supplemental nour- ishment or a feeding tube. Parents of pediatric ESRD patients are more likely to have anxiety, depression, and coping problems than parents of well children (Fukunishi & Honda, 1995). This is in part because ESRD alters normal infant care. Infants with ESRD may not pro- duce urine, for instance, which can be anxiety provoking for parents (Brady & Lawry, 2000).

Children and adolescents with ESRD may be concerned especially about body image related to dialysis accesses (Fielding et al., 1985). Along with body image issues, they may have a diffi cult time adjusting to the ESRD regime of treatment and a special diet. Kurtin, Landgraf, and Abetz (1994) found that 59% of ESRD adolescents have poor adher- ence to medical regimes.

ESRD has signifi cant psychosocial rami- fi cations for patients’ families as well (see Box 18.1). Dialysis patients’ partners have

problems coping with the illness and its treat- ment regimes (White & Greyner, 1999). Mac- Donald (1995) found that families of ESRD patients have problems adjusting to the impact of the illness on their lifestyle. Other authors have noted spouses’ and partners’ increased levels of stress and problems with managing role reversal and the need to assume more re- sponsibilities than usual due to ESRD (Gudes, 1995; Pelletier-Hibbert & Sohi, 2001). The family also must cope with the possible fi - nancial burden of ESRD. Because of the time needed to care for patients and transport them to treatments, a spouse or child may need to limit work hours. Kaitelidou and colleagues (2005) found that 51% of ESRD family mem- bers reported absences from work related to the patient’s illness.

ESRD may present patients and fami- lies with a loss of income, which is another very important concern of patients and their families (Wu et al., 2001). One study found that only 13% of ESRD patients were able to resume employment after starting dialy- sis (Dobrof, Dolinko, Lichtiger, Uribarri, & Epstein, 2000). Sixty percent of a sample of hemodialysis patients in Greece had to change professions or retire due to ESRD (Kaitelidou et al., 2005). Thus, it may be particularly im- portant for renal social workers to consider the employment options of their patients. Main- taining employment and being active after a diagnosis of ESRD can be benefi cial. Work- ing patients are less depressed than their un- employed counterparts (Chen et al., 2003). Patients with a good rehabilitation status who stay active through employment or other ac- tivities also may have a better quality of life (Mollaoglu, 2004).

Treatment-Related Psychosocial Aspects

The treatment regimes related to ESRD can have serious psychosocial ramifi cations. Di- alysis patients are required to assume strict diets due to their inability to process food products with high levels of potassium and phosphorous and a need for sodium restric- tions. Poor self-management of the standard

JWBT514_ch18.indd 474JWBT514_ch18.indd 474 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

Nephrology Social Work 475

renal diet can have signifi cant consequences because potassium levels outside the range considered appropriate can lead to heart fail- ure. High phosphorous levels can lead to

permanent bone disease and calcifi cation of the heart. Dialysis patients therefore are placed on diets that severely limit foods such as ba- nanas, melons, dried fruit, tomatoes, oranges,

Box 18.1 ESRD Case Example

Dan is a 17-year-old peritoneal dialysis patient. The nephrology social worker had been working with Dan and his father, Chris, for over a year to improve his adherence to the renal diet and medication regime in order to have him physically prepared for kidney transplantation surgery and recovery. Dan has not been taking his phosphorus- binding medication with his meals, which indicates a lack of potential commitment to take his immunosuppressive medications posttransplant. If Dan fails to take these medications as prescribed, his kidney transplant would be at serious risk of failure. Dan’s father and the social worker met several times about this matter with little success. Chris was emotionally debilitated due to two jobs and sole custody of his three children, and had little energy to follow through with the constant monitoring that Dan required.

Because Dan was the oldest child and Chris was often working or asleep, Dan had been the primary caregiver of his siblings since he was 7 years old. The combination of an overwhelming age-inappropriate sense of responsibility and the normal growth and development of adolescence was not mixing well. Chris had come to rely on Dan a great deal and found Dan’s illness to be a major interference in their routine. He brought Dan to the appointments but remained disengaged and angry; Dan and his father were in open confl ict much of the time. The social worker intervened on a number of clinic visits to reduce the confl ict between the two.

The social worker was able to gain Dan’s and his father’s agreement to attend one of the groups she held to educate and support youth and their parents as they prepared for transplant. Fortunately, one of her other

challenging patients, Jeff, also attended that group with his mother. Jeff, a 15-year- old, had struggled with his own adherence issues. With social work counseling and education, Jeff had been able to manage his medications and a year ago had received a successful transplant. As the group progressed, it was clear that Dan found the group “lame” and wanted to leave. Jeff confronted Dan directly, one teen to another. Jeff’s mother, Denise, offered to bring Dan lunch every day at school to make sure he took his phosphorus binders with his meals. Chris cried as Denise told them that she truly understood what he was dealing with and how overwhelmed she often felt trying to care for Jeff. The social worker was able to direct the discussion to facing challenges with the benefi t of a support system.

Dan’s school grades improved and both Dan and his father began to come out of their self-imposed isolation. They kept appointments on time and eagerly reported on things they were doing to have fun. A couple of group sessions later, Dan, Chris, Jeff, and Denise arrived together. They had had an early supper in the cafeteria, where Denise asked Dan about his medications. Rather than the surly responses he was famous for, he laughed and produced his pills. It was clear that the four had connected and felt they could help each other within the support group as well as outside the hospital milieu. Within the year, Dan’s phosphorous level was within range, and he was emotionally ready for his transplant. His level of responsibility, as demonstrated by his adherence with the treatment plan, was an accomplishment that he reveled in and has shared with the group on a routine basis.

Source: Prepared by Sandra Coorough, Phoenix Children’s Hospital Kids Kidney Center, Phoenix, AZ.

JWBT514_ch18.indd 475JWBT514_ch18.indd 475 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

476 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

potatoes, nuts, dairy, cola products, and so- dium. Patients also may require a high protein diet due to their low albumin levels. Efforts toward optimal diet often are hampered by patients’ impaired appetite and a diminished sense of taste.

Because of their inability to produce urine effectively, patients have very strict fl uid restrictions, as little as 48 ounces per day. Otherwise, excess liquid will build up and cause patients’ extremities to swell and their lungs to fi ll with fl uid. Extreme weight gain between dialysis treatments can lead to dis- comfort during hemodialysis, and removal of excessive fl uid results in severe cramp- ing and low blood pressure. Dry mouth and thirst are common among dialysis patients. Peritoneal dialysis patients have much less restrictive dietary and fl uid intake restric- tions, and transplant patients normally are not required to follow renal diets or limit their fl uids.

Poor self-management of ESRD treatment regimes can have serious ramifi cations for pa- tients. Missed treatments and high fl uid weight gains between treatments are associated with increased mortality in dialysis patients (Saran et al., 2003). Failing to take transplant immu- nosuppressant medications leads to transplant rejection (Russell & Ashbaugh, 2004). Many dialysis patients may not adhere to medical recommendations about diet, prescriptions, or fl uid restrictions (Friend, Hatchett, Schneider, & Wadhwa, 1997). A study of hemodialysis patients found that:

• 27% to 31% of patients missed one dialysis treatment per month.

• 35% to 41% of patients signed off of dialysis early and did not receive their full treatment.

• 76% to 85% patients had problems following their recommended diet.

• 75% of patients who were coping poorly were likely to miss treatments.

• 50% of patients who were coping poorly did not follow recommended fl uid restrictions (Dobrof et al., 2000).

The ESRD treatment regime is both very intrusive and unrelenting (see Box 18.2). Patients may fi nd it diffi cult to travel, because dialysis must be done while they are away

Box 18.2 A Day in the Life of a Hemodialysis Patient

Florence is a 65-year-old patient who attends dialysis every Monday, Wednesday, and Friday. Her treatment begins at 5:00 in the morning, so she must awaken at 3:30 in the morning to begin the 25-mile journey to her dialysis unit. Because she is diabetic, Florence must eat breakfast before leaving her home. She must get to the dialysis unit by 4:45 in the morning so that she can weigh herself (so that the treatment team will know how much fl uid to remove during hemodialysis), have her blood pressure taken, set up the pillow and blanket she will use during her treatment, tune the television that is above her dialysis chair to her favorite morning news channel, and greet her fellow patients before the technician puts the needles in her forearm that connect her to the machine. During her four-hour treatment, her vital signs will be taken, her medications will be given, and she likely will be visited by her physician, nurses, dietitian, and social worker. After dialysis, Florence sometimes has problems with excessive bleeding or low blood pressure, so she may have to wait for her problems to stabilize to go home. Florence takes the local senior citizen van to her home (because the van does not operate before 9:00 in the morning, Florence must pay her neighbor to take her there) and often must wait over 30 minutes for the van to arrive at the dialysis center. Many times the van does not take Florence home directly, because other people are traveling to doctor appointments or shopping. Because of this, Florence usually does not get home from dialysis until noon. This means that it has been almost eight hours since she initially left her house.

JWBT514_ch18.indd 476JWBT514_ch18.indd 476 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

Nephrology Social Work 477

from home. It can be diffi cult to access dialy- sis treatment services while traveling in rural areas, areas in which the number of patients exceeds treatment possibilities, or in areas experiencing staff shortages. Payment can be challenging for dialysis patients who are trav- eling. Some private insurers refuse to pay for out-of-network procedures, Medicaid cover- age is specifi c to the state in which the patient resides, and dialysis in territories outside the United States is not covered by Medicare and most insurers. Hemodialysis usually takes be- tween 4 and 6 hours, including transportation, pre- and posttreatment procedures, and atten- tion to complications, three times per week.

Common side effects of hemodialysis in- clude cramping, nausea, and vomiting. A se- rious complication of peritoneal dialysis is an infection called peritonitis, which is pain- ful and occasionally fatal. Transplantation requires signifi cant workup, frequent post- surgical visits, and numerous daily immuno- suppressant medications. Transplantation is a serious surgery and may lead to complica- tions. Long-term immunosuppressant usage may cause serious negative physical outcomes.

RAMIFICATIONS OF PSYCHOSOCIAL ISSUES

Many psychosocial factors can negatively impact renal patients’ nutritional status and albumin management (Vourlekis & Rivera- Mizzoni, 1997). Barriers to a quality diet may include patients’ education and literacy level because they may not comprehend the diet in- structions. Insurance may not allow patients to obtain recommended nutritional supplements. Social support availability is another psycho- social attribute related to poor diet in ESRD patients because they may need assistance to purchase groceries and prepare meals. Patients also may have decreased appetite due to de- pression or anxiety. These factors are very im- portant for social workers to address because a poor nutritional status has been clearly linked to death in ESRD patients (Lowrie & Lew, 1990).

ESRD patients with psychosocial problems who are less cognizant of the illness and its treatment are more likely to have high fl uid gains and missed treatments, which lead to poor health outcomes. Patients with poor psy- chological status are less likely to be adher- ent to treatment regimes and to have more hospitalizations and higher rates of mortality (DeOreo, 1997). ESRD patients who feel they are less in control of their illness tend to cope less effectively and have a lower quality of life (Mapes et al., 2004).

Patients are likely to experience several dif- ferent treatment regimes during the course of the disease, including unsuccessful kidney transplants. As they cope with numerous losses, repeated lifestyle adjustments, and diffi cult transitions between transplant and dialysis, these changes can lead to the compounding ef- fect of the burden of ESRD (Levine, 1999). One patient describes her experience in this way:

I lived through dialysis treatments, three transplants, and two rejections. Each trans- plant brought renewed hope; each rejection would send me reeling. It took me years to learn how to manage the feelings that came along with the constant diagnoses, the seem- ingly endless stream of bad news. (Hartwell, 2002, p. 7)

SOCIAL WORK INTERVENTION

The signifi cant psychosocial issues faced by ESRD patients and their families require so- cial work intervention, referred to as nephrol- ogy social work or renal social work. ESRD is the only disease category or treatment regime with a public policy inclusion for master’s- level social workers on health teams. Medicare regulations mandate that a master’s-level so- cial worker be on staff in every dialysis center and kidney transplant program (Federal Reg- ister, 1976, 2008). These social workers focus on “improving the patient’s ability to adjust to and cope with chronic illness and the health- care system’s ability to meet the needs of the patient” (McKinley & Callahan, 1998, p. 123).

JWBT514_ch18.indd 477JWBT514_ch18.indd 477 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

478 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Megan Prescott, MSW, LCSW is an exam- ple of a nephrology social worker who works at both an inpatient hospital setting and an outpatient dialysis clinic setting. She works for the University of Colorado Hospital at both its outpatient dialysis unit and inpatient acute dialysis unit. She splits her time be- tween the two units each week. In the chronic outpatient setting, her population is primar- ily Medicaid eligible and disadvantaged. She fi nds that her patients have low health literacy. Most did not have access to health care before kidney failure and many were unaware of kid- ney problems prior to  starting dialysis. She helps patients to adjust to the dialysis treat- ment regimen; this includes helping them to identify and utilize available support sources, develop effective coping strategies, and un- derstand and engage in educational support from the team, to maximize self-management and outcomes. Prescott conducts psychosocial assessments to determine barriers to optimal psychosocial functioning and health-care out- comes. One important aspect of this assess- ment is a quality-of-life survey, which helps the team, with the patient at the center, to set goals for the coming year.

Prescott assists patients in accessing avail- able resources, including Medicare, Medicaid, vocational rehabilitation services, housing, and other community resources. In the acute care setting, she works as a social worker and discharge planner for hospitalized dialysis patients. With her knowledge of the  chronic care setting, she can help develop safe strat- egies for discharge, keeping in mind the pa- tients’ dialysis schedule and associated needs. She coordinates with staff at the patient’s es- tablished dialysis center to follow up on any new medical needs for continuity of care. Some patients will leave the hospital with- out any changes in routine while others may need home health assistance or nursing home care following their hospitalizations. In ad- dition to this role, Prescott also works with patients newly diagnosed with kidney failure who need to begin treatment. She is often their fi rst social work contact after discovering that they will need renal replacement therapy. She

introduces patients to the variety of modalities and with other members of the care team pro- vides education to choose the best modality to begin treatment and help coordinate the start of that treatment. Prescott initiates conversa- tions about immediate patient concerns, such as eligibility for Medicare, transportation, and other resources in the community. These con- versations will continue when patients estab- lish care with their dialysis team.

Social workers are included on renal medi- cal teams, which also include patients, their family members, nephrologists (kidney doc- tors), nurses, dietitians, and patient-care tech- nicians. Teams also may include transplant surgeons and pharmacists. The inclusion of a number of specialists refl ects the complex- ity of the needs and issues renal patients face and has been linked empirically with optimal service delivery (Goldstein, Yassa, Dacouris, & McFarlane, 2004). For example, Lindberg and colleagues (2005) found that a team ap- proach to patient education about vascular ac- cesses that included a social worker was more successful than a single-disciplinary approach. A report on morbidity and mortality of dialy- sis by the National Institutes of Health (1993) states: “[T]he social and psychological welfare and the quality of life of the dialysis patient are favorably infl uenced by the involvement of a multidisciplinary team” (p. 1). Although many teams provide patient care in a collaborative transdisciplinary environment (see Chapter 2 in this volume), the Medicare policies for this unique practice setting use the term interdisci- plinary to describe these teams. It is important to note that the 2008 Medicare Conditions for Coverage for dialysis and kidney transplant settings mandate that patients and their fam- ily members should be considered important members of the team, and patients have the right to participate in assessments and care planning and to refuse any aspect of their treat- ment (Federal Register, 2008).

Nephrology social work interventions tend to be valued by patients. Siegal, Witten, and Lundin’s 1994 survey of ESRD patients found that 90% of respondents “believed that access to a nephrology social worker was important”

JWBT514_ch18.indd 478JWBT514_ch18.indd 478 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

Nephrology Social Work 479

(p. 33) and that patients relied on nephrology social workers to assist them with coping, adjustment, and rehabilitation. According to Rubin and colleagues (1997), dialysis patients have ranked a “helpful social worker” as being more important to them than nephrologists or nurses. One study reported that 70% of pa- tients said that social workers gave the most useful information about treatment modali- ties compared to nurses and physicians (Hol- ley, Barrington, Kohn, & Hayes, 1991). These researchers also found that patients thought that social workers were twice as helpful as nephrologists in helping them to choose be- tween hemodialysis and peritoneal dialysis for treatment.

Nephrology Social Work Tasks

Social workers can help renal patients with their psychosocial needs in a variety of ways in collaboration with the renal health team. The activities conducted by nephrology social workers may include assessment, counseling, education, crisis intervention, end-of-life care, case management, rehabilitation assistance, and patient advocacy. Social workers also in- tervene at the community level.

Assessment

Comprehensive individual psychosocial as- sessment of ESRD patients is central to the achievement of optimal patient outcomes (Fox & Swazey, 1979). Nephrology social workers conduct an assessment of patients’ psychoso- cial status to identify their strengths, needs, and the areas for social work intervention. So- cial work assessments are completed for every dialysis and transplant patient and take into account each patient’s social, psychological, fi nancial, cultural, and environmental needs.

A unique attribute of ESRD social work care is that it is provided on a chronic, rather than episodic, basis. Nephrology social work- ers are fortunate to work in settings that allow them to develop long-term relationships with patients. Long-term relationships provide them the opportunity to evaluate the effective- ness of services and reassessment of clients’

needs through time. In her article for the New Social Worker, Devon Rocha (2010) explains her view of being a dialysis social worker:

There are many advantages to social work in this setting. One of these is getting to work with a consistent client base for potentially several years. Since I work full time at one dialysis unit, I get to see everyone a couple of times each week. This is especially helpful if or when a patient is experiencing a particu- larly diffi cult time. It gives a nice opportunity to at least “check in” on how the patient is doing, instead of having to wait a full week in a typical counseling/therapeutic relationship. There can also be a real opportunity for col- laboration with the patient’s outside support system. A teamwork approach involving the patient’s loved ones can be very effective for diffi culties such as medication management, nutrition, or adherence to the treatment regi- men. It is also rewarding to be there with a person who is undergoing such a signifi cant life change, as when a person is newly diag- nosed with end-stage renal disease and needs to start dialysis. Some patients have never even known they were at risk for kidney fail- ure. Then all of a sudden they must deal with this new self-image as someone who is “sick.” This can be very anxiety provoking, with so many new terms, routines, and new people involved. There is often a great sense of loss and always there is a huge lifestyle change.

Social workers also assess transplant do- nors. Living donor kidney transplants, includ- ing donations from strangers, have become increasingly popular in the United States. Social workers assess donors and recipients to gauge any normative pressures on donors that may infl uence their decisions to donate as well as their motivations for donating and their ability to make informed consent. This is important because kidney donation requires signifi cant surgery and recovery. If individu- als feel pressured to donate a kidney, a social worker may recommend that they not donate, pending further assessment. Social workers investigate the nature of relationships be- tween donors and recipients as well as their psychosocial and mental health statuses and

JWBT514_ch18.indd 479JWBT514_ch18.indd 479 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

480 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

developmental and substance use histories in order to make a recommendation to the trans- plant team regarding surgery (Leo, Smith, & Mori, 2003). The 2007 Medicare guidelines for transplant centers mandate that every trans- plant center have an independent living donor advocate (Federal Register, 2007). This advo- cate is in place to ensure that living donors are evaluated independently and to maximize their informed consent. In some transplant cen- ters, social workers serve as the living donor advocates.

Nephrology social workers use various standardized assessment tools with demon- strated validity and reliability, including those to measure depression and quality of life. The 2008 Medicare Conditions for Coverage for dialysis units mandate that every dialysis unit that bills Medicare for services must have the social worker assess patients’ quality of life (Federal Register, 2008). This mandate was in response to research fi ndings that suggest that quality of life can independently predict dialy- sis patients’ morbidity and mortality (DeOreo, 1997; Knight, Ofsthun, Teng, Lazarus, & Curhan, 2003). Because future Medicare clini- cal performance measures for dialysis units suggest using the Kidney Disease Quality of Life, most dialysis social workers use this measurement to assess patient quality of life.

Counseling and Education

Nephrology social workers provide emotional support, encouragement, and counseling to pa- tients and members of their support networks. ESRD patients and their families may have diffi culty adjusting to the illness and treatment regimes. Social workers can help them cope through individual, family, and group counsel- ing as well as through support groups.

Social workers can provide counseling and education to decrease patient depression. De- pression is a serious issue that often is experi- enced by ESRD patients. Chen and colleagues (2003) recommend that “a good psychosocial support program should be incorporated into the treatment of patients with chronic renal failure to reduce the possibility and severity of depression” (p. 124). In an empirical study,

Beder (1999) found that nephrology social work counseling and cognitive-behavioral education interventions signifi cantly lower patient depression. In her experimental study, Cabness (2005) found that a cognitive- behavioral education group led by social work- ers is signifi cantly linked to lower depression. Johnstone and LeSage (1998) found that 76% of depressed dialysis patients indicate that they prefer to seek counseling from the nephrology social worker on their treatment team rather than pursue care from an outside mental health practitioner.

Nephrology social workers help patients deal with emotional concerns that stem from the numerous losses associated with ESRD. These include failed vascular accesses and transplants, schedule and dietary restrictions, the death of fellow patients, decreased activ- ity levels, and employment and professional losses. Kidney transplant patients also require social work assistance when coping with anxi- ety and frustration over being on a transplant waiting list because it can take several years to get a kidney transplant. Transplant patients may need help with feeling guilty about ac- cepting a deceased donor organ. They also may have concerns about receiving a kidney from a living donor because the donor is placed at risk from the surgery.

Through patient education and other inter- ventions, nephrology social workers are suc- cessful in improving patient’s adherence to the ESRD treatment regime (see Box 18.3). For ex- ample, Rita-An Kiely and her social work col- leagues counseled patients on the importance of attending all hemodialysis treatments, tracked attendance, and provided ongoing encourage- ment for adhering to the treatment regime. As a result of this social work education and coun- seling, there was a 50% decrease in missed hemodialysis treatments (Medical Education In- stitute, 2004). Auslander and Buchs (2002) and Root (2005) have shown that social work coun- seling and education led to reduced fl uid weight gains in patients. Johnstone and Halshaw (2003) found that social work education and encour- agement were associated with a 47% improve- ment in fl uid restriction adherence.

JWBT514_ch18.indd 480JWBT514_ch18.indd 480 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

Nephrology Social Work 481

Beder, Mason, Johnstone, Callahan, and LeSage (2003) conducted an experimental research study to determine the effect of cog- nitive-behavioral social work services. They

found that patient education and counseling by nephrology social workers was signifi cantly associated with increased medication com- pliance. This study also determined that such interventions improved patients’ blood pres- sure. Sikon (2000) discovered that social work counseling can reduce patients’ anxiety level. Several researchers have determined that ne- phrology social work counseling signifi cantly improves ESRD patient quality of life (Chang, Winsett, Gaber, & Hathaway, 2004; Frank et al., 2003; Johnstone, 2003).

Nephrology social workers play an impor- tant role in educating patients about the dif- ferent treatment modalities for ESRD and in helping patients pursue different treatment options. This is particularly important in as- sisting dialysis patients with getting a kidney transplant. Despite evidence that a kidney transplant is the ESRD treatment with the best outcome, research has demonstrated that vulnerable patients, particularly African Americans, are less likely to be successful in receiving a kidney transplant (Browne, 2008). The 2008 Medicare Conditions for Coverage recognize that patients need extra help from their dialysis team in navigating the pathway to getting a kidney transplant and now man- date that all dialysis teams specifi cally and methodically help all patients who are inter- ested in a kidney transplant to get one (Federal Register, 2008). Nephrology social workers are well suited to oversee this task and help patients get kidney transplants.

Crisis Intervention

Nephrology social workers provide crisis intervention services in dialysis and trans- plant units. Patients may act inappropriately during hemodialysis, yelling at staff or pa- tients, threatening violence, or trying to pull the needles out of their arms. Social workers also resolve crises with peritoneal dialysis and transplant patients. Social workers often effectively mediate confl icts in dialysis set- tings (Johnstone, Seamon, Halshaw, Molinair, & Longknife, 1997). Merighi and Ehlebracht (2004a) found that more than 75% of nephrol- ogy social workers mediate confl icts.

Box 18.3 Outcomes-Oriented Nephrology Social Practice

Nephrology social workers at Fresenius Medical Care in San Diego, CA, have created an exemplar of outcomes-oriented dialysis social work intervention. They also provide “wellness programs” for patients with ESRD. Because of the barriers that arise for people to attend these programs, they have started a telephonic group for depression management. Patients will meet once to establish supportive relationships and then complete fi ve telephonic sessions with a social worker. Similar to programs offered to cancer patients, wellness programming for the patient with ESRD focuses on three areas: 1. These programs highlight the key role

of patients as part of the renal team and invite them to participate actively in their care.

2. The programs focus on imparting life skills that help patients learn to manage the complex medical regime in order to improve survival and quality of life.

3. The programs, often featured as wellness classes, launch patients out with a sense of empowerment over their own medical destiny. The perception of control and self-effi cacy that improve with these programs, combined with the additional social support that the classes offer, are seen as the key change agents to their improved outcomes. This group of social workers also conducts a number of research projects related to various psychosocial interventions and are frequent contributors to renal publications and presentations.

Source: Prepared by Stephanie Johnstone, Fresenius Medical Care, San Diego, CA.

JWBT514_ch18.indd 481JWBT514_ch18.indd 481 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

482 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

End-of-Life Care

Social work has an important role in the pal- liative and end-of-life care of ESRD patients. Social workers provide end-of-life information to patients and their families (Promoting Ex- cellence in End-of-Life Care, 2002). Yusack (1999) found that patient education provided by social workers about advance directives led to a 51% increase in the use of such docu- ments. Terminally ill ESRD patients and their families said that they would like more emo- tional support and other interventions from social workers and requested that social work- ers make contact with their families after they died (Woods et al., 1999).

The National Program Offi ce of the Robert Wood Johnson Foundation created an ESRD workgroup entitled “Promoting Excellence in End-of-Life Care” in 2002. It recommends that nephrology social workers:

• Provide education to ESRD patients and their families on palliative and end-of-life care.

• Create palliative care programs that include attention to pain and symptom manage- ment, advance care planning, and psycho- social and spiritual support.

• Advocate for the adoption of patient self- determination policies.

• Create peer-mentoring initiatives and be- reavement programs.

Case Management

Renal social workers provide information to patients and their families about resources and information that are unknown to the family (McKinley & Callahan, 1998). They routinely provide case management services, including information, referrals, and linkages to local, state, and federal agencies and programs.

Rehabilitation Assistance

Social workers help patients maximize their rehabilitation status. Doing this includes as- sessing barriers to patient goals of rehabili- tation, providing patients with education and

encouragement, and providing case manage- ment with local or state vocational rehabili- tation agencies. Helping patients maximize the achievement of their rehabilitation goals is very important for this patient population and is included in the Medicare Conditions for Coverage as a required focus for all dialysis units (Federal Register, 2008). Research sug- gests that many patients do not return to work after starting dialysis. A survey of 296 ran- domly selected dialysis clinics in the United States determined that only 33% of all patients who were working prior to starting dialysis maintained employment after the start of treat- ment (Kutner, Zhang, Huang, & Johansen, 2010).

In a literature review about nephrology so- cial work and rehabilitation, Romano (1981) outlines different roles for social workers related to rehabilitation:

• Enabler/facilitator. Social workers can en- courage patients to be as active as possible with work, social activities, and exercise. In addition to helping patients maintain em- ployment after starting ESRD treatment, social workers also can encourage patients who are unable to or are not interested in working to be involved in other activities, such as volunteering and exercise.

• Educator/advocate. Social workers can educate patients and their families about vocational rehabilitation resources avail- able for ESRD patients. They also can educate schools, workplace settings, and vocational rehabilitation agencies about the needs of ESRD patients and advocate for patients within these settings (Raiz, 1999). At times, patients may think they can- not work because of the intrusive dialysis schedule. Social workers can provide pa- tient education about home dialysis treat- ment options that may be more conducive to employment and allow a more fl exible daily schedule. Social workers also can ad- vocate with facility administrators at dialy- sis units to offer patients dialysis schedules that allow them to work, such as late-night or overnight dialysis shifts.

JWBT514_ch18.indd 482JWBT514_ch18.indd 482 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

Nephrology Social Work 483

• Administrator. Social workers can develop and oversee programs that offer rehabili- tation opportunities for ESRD patients as well as conduct relevant research. Many social workers are involved as board mem- bers and advisors for the national organi- zation Life Options, which provides the ESRD community with information about rehabilitation.

Team Collaboration

Nephrology social workers collaborate with the renal team in providing patient care. They participate in quality assurance pro- grams and team care planning, and train other health-care professionals on the topic of psychosocial issues. The 2008 Medicare Conditions for Coverage for dialysis units mandate that every unit implement a Qual- ity Assessment and Performance Improve- ment (QAPI) program to assess patient and clinic outcomes (Federal Register, 2008). The QAPI initiatives, often called QA (Quality Assessment) or CQI (Continuous Quality Improvement) programs, must be interdisciplinary and include the dialysis so- cial worker’s participation.

Advocacy

Social workers advocate for their patients within their clinics as well as with community agencies (see Box 18.4). For example, a so- cial worker can explain to the nurse manager that a patient’s hemodialysis schedule cannot be changed because the patient would like to attend a computer class in the afternoons. A transplant team may hesitate to transplant a patient with a history of substance use; a so- cial worker can advocate for this patient and explain that her four years of sobriety and her three years of demonstrated adherence to a dialysis regime merits her consideration for transplant. Social workers also advocate for patients on a systems level, with various orga- nizations and governmental agencies. Arthur, Zalemski, Giermek, and Lamb (2000) found that nonrenal medical professionals, such as home care or nursing home care providers,

are unfamiliar with the psychosocial issues associated with ESRD. Renal social workers can help patients navigate complex systems of service provision, educate nonrenal commu- nity care providers on the unique issues related to ESRD care, and advocate for patients with community providers not familiar with their special needs.

Community-Level ESRD Social Work Intervention

Nephrology social workers are committed to social reform and infl uencing policy and pro- grams affecting renal patients. Arizona dialy- sis social worker Kay Smith organized weekly garage sales to raise money for patients and persistently lobbied for dialysis services for undocumented workers. She was suspended temporarily from her job at a for-profi t dialy- sis center because of these activities. Smith was named the 2003 “Social Worker of the Year” by the National Association of Social Workers (NASW). Her award noted that “she made an outstanding difference in areas of advocacy for clients, social policy, social work practice, program development, admin- istration, and research, while demonstrating outstanding leadership and contributing to a positive image for the profession” (NASW, 2003). Social worker Steve Bogatz (2000) successfully advocated with a managed care organization to secure payment of a kidney transplant for a patient.

Social workers also are employed in mac- rolevel services to the ESRD community (see Box 18.5). They may be clinical managers of treatment facilities, social work directors of dialysis corporations, regional social work coordinators, academic researchers, members of boards of directors of community agen- cies, or independent consultants to ESRD or- ganizations. Nephrology social workers are employed by nondirect patient care organiza- tions, including the Centers for Medicare and Medicaid, the National Kidney Foundation (national and regional offi ces), the American Kidney Fund, the American Association of Kidney Patients, the ESRD Networks, and state kidney programs.

JWBT514_ch18.indd 483JWBT514_ch18.indd 483 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

484 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Box 18.4 Social Workers as Advocates: Changing Health Policy

In 1982, Arizona Medicaid coverage for organ transplantation was limited to kidney transplants only. Many poor and working poor individuals were enrolled in Medicaid who needed heart, liver, and bone marrow transplants, but Medicaid would not provide coverage for those life-saving treatments. By the late 1980s and early 1990s, Medicaid patients eligible for Medicaid based on federal entitlement, such as Supplemental Security Income (SSI) or Aid to Families with Dependent Children (AFDC), were covered for life-saving organ transplants. But those working poor individuals not federally entitled but eligible based on low income and high medical costs or “spend down” still were not covered for life-saving transplants, even though they were enrolled in Medicaid. It was not uncommon for patients to become disabled and receive SSI for the fi rst six months of disability and be eligible for Medicaid coverage of their transplant only to lose SSI and that coverage once they began receiving Social Security Disability Income (SSDI). Patients receiving SSDI then had to wait two years before becoming eligible for Medicare that would cover their life-saving transplant. Many did not live that long. In 1985, the social workers from the Arizona transplant hospitals were able to document that in the previous several years, over 50 people enrolled in Medicaid had died as a result of this policy.

In November 1994, transplant social workers joined with support group leaders to form a coalition to lobby the Arizona State Legislature and the governor to change the Medicaid policy that denied heart, liver, and bone marrow transplants to the working poor enrolled in Medicaid (Thomas, 1999). The coalition met regularly and invitations were sent to every transplant support group in Arizona, administrators from the transplant programs, the State Organ Procurement Organization, the Coalition

on Donation, the Health Departments from the major metropolitan counties, the State Health and Medicaid Departments, the National Kidney Foundation (NKF), the American Liver Foundation, the American Association of Kidney Patients, the lobbyists from the transplant hospitals, the American Hospital Association, the Legislative Liaisons (lobbyists) from the counties, and individuals denied transplants by Medicaid and their families. The social workers from the transplant centers functioned as community organizers.

Rothman’s (1968) principles of social work practice were utilized: locality development, social planning, and social action. Locality development occurred in developing the coalition of concerned stakeholders. The social planning principle was important because the coalition was able to document that Medicaid was paying more to provide medical services to individuals dying than it would have to provide a heart, liver, or bone marrow transplant. For example, one woman who received extensive media coverage died needing a bone marrow transplant that would have cost $130,000; Medicaid paid over $800,000 to provide services as she was dying. The coalition identifi ed three alternative funding sources: additional federal funds, unused Medicaid funds in the annual budget, and revenue from a new tobacco tax. The social action phase included the development of a policy brief or white paper that documented how Medicaid “discriminated” against the working poor in its transplant policy, contacting the media, and training coalition members and others on the legislative process and how to engage the legislature.

The legislature and Medicaid were slow to respond to the coalition, and many of the coalition members were in urgent need of a transplant. Utilizing a tactic from Alinsky (1971)—“The threat is usually more terrifying than the thing itself”—the coalition threatened media coverage every time a Medicaid patient who had been

JWBT514_ch18.indd 484JWBT514_ch18.indd 484 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

Nephrology Social Work 485

PROFESSIONALIZATION OF NEPHROLOGY SOCIAL WORKERS

Social workers are very involved in provid- ing effective intervention with ESRD patients. However, nephrology social workers may face professional challenges, and they may be as- signed tasks inappropriately by their employ- ers. Tasks that are clerical in nature or involve

admissions, billing, and determining insurance coverage prevent nephrology social workers from performing the clinical tasks central to their mission (Callahan, Witten, & Johnstone, 1997). Russo (2002) found that all of the nephrology social workers he surveyed felt that transporta- tion was not an appropriate task for them, yet 53% of respondents were responsible for mak- ing transportation arrangements for patients. He found that 46% of the nephrology social

denied a transplant died. As noted, the media previously had reported on several individuals who had died after Medicaid denied coverage for the transplant. This proved to be very effective in getting the legislature’s attention. The coalition increased its direct lobbying of the legislature, the governor, and the media.

In March 1995, fi ve months after organizing the coalition, the Arizona State Legislature passed emergency legislation authorizing the immediate appropriation of $8.2 million from the tobacco tax to pay for 63 heart, liver, and bone marrow transplants for the working poor. The governor personally came to the fl oor of the state senate to sign the bill into law. In October 1995, the coalition persuaded the governor to call the legislature into special session when an additional $2.7 million from the tobacco tax was appropriated to fund 17 heart-lung and lung transplants. In 1996, the legislature expanded the state renal medication program from $100,000 per year to $250,000 per year. In 1997, an additional $100,000 was added to the renal medication program for a total of $350,000 per year. In 1998, legislation was passed that created a new $200,000 per-year nonrenal medication program for heart, liver, and lung transplant patients. One unexpected outcome of this process was the development of a policy that allowed transplant candidates on waiting lists to remain on the lists if they lost their Medicaid eligibility and Medicaid was the payer when the transplant eventually occurred. By 2004, over 120 working poor individuals were transplanted. The average

cost to the state was approximately $5 million annually, and over $4 million of state appropriations have helped needy transplant recipients with the costs of their medications.

In 2010, due to the economic recession, the Arizona State Legislature eliminated Medicaid coverage of liver transplants for hepatitis C, all lung transplants, all single pancreas transplants, and reduced coverage for certain heart transplants and certain bone marrow transplants. There were also budget cuts to other areas of Medicaid as well as to public education and the universities. Social workers and the transplant community mobilized but were not able to stop this reduction in transplants. Unlike the earlier success of expanding Medicaid coverage for transplants, the state was in a fi scal crisis, and no funds were available. The campaign expanded beyond the Arizona transplant community to the national organizations such as the American Society for Transplantation, the American Society for Transplant Surgeons, and the United Network for Organ Sharing. Serious concerns arose that other states would follow Arizona’s example and that Medicaid coverage of life- saving transplants in other states would be threatened. This issue has not been resolved to date. Social workers, transplant hospitals, patients and families, and now national organizations continue the advocacy.

Source: Prepared by Charles M. Thomas, Banner Good Samaritan Medical Center Transplant Services, Phoenix, AZ.

JWBT514_ch18.indd 485JWBT514_ch18.indd 485 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

486 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Box 18.5 Social Work and the End-Stage Renal Disease Networks

The ESRD Network system was established by law on June 3, 1976, after Medicare coverage was extended on October 30, 1972, to individuals younger than 65 years of age with permanent kidney failure to promote the effi cient and equitable distribution of quality medical care to persons with end- stage renal disease. On June 13, 1978, the Social Security Act was amended establishing the ESRD Networks.

The current 18 ESRD Networks, operating as contractors to the Centers for Medicare and Medicaid Services (CMS), manage a computerized patient registry system, ensure quality of care through continuous quality improvement methodology and data analysis, provide community education, process patient benefi ciary complaints, and provide regulatory guidance for providers. The mission of ESRD Network Patient Services professionals is to provide a patient-centered perspective in the design and implementation of ESRD Network programs and to meet the needs of ESRD patients by assuring quality of care through communication, education, and confl ict resolution.

Full-time Patient Services Coordinator (PSC) positions were mandated by CMS at each network in 2003. PSCs must be master’s-prepared social workers or equally qualifi ed individuals (experienced nephrology nurses or counselors). Most of the networks utilize social workers for the position, who are responsible for addressing challenging patient situations. This practice creates a strong social work perspective in the network system and allows facility social workers to serve as contacts for assistance. Network organizations are viewed by many as resources far beyond regulatory concerns.

A challenging patient is defi ned as an individual who is nonadherent to the treatment regimen and can be verbally abusive, physically threatening, or physically violent. In some instances, staff response

is not appropriate and exacerbates the situation. All PSCs, regardless of discipline, assume a proactive role in the prevention, facilitation, and resolution of diffi cult patient and facility situations. This role may include implementing educational programs that will assist facility staff in handling diffi cult situations and advocating for individual patient rights and rights of all patients at a facility, depending on the situation presented.

Although regional differences due to geography, cultural concerns, and density of population create network-specifi c PSC tasks, the overall purpose is the same. Some of these tasks include visits to facilities to meet with patients, staff, and administrators for the purposes of patient education, staff training, and responding to grievances; attending regional conferences as a participant or presenter; and creating network-wide patient newsletters. Some networks have a patient advisory committee (PAC) consisting of patients who volunteer their time to help improve the quality of care in their facilities. The network PSC usually coordinates the PAC.

Most PSCs process grievances at the network level and seek resolution through interactions with the facility or follow through with appropriate agency referrals while maintaining a database that is used to track trends. Network vocational rehabilitation efforts to assist facilities to encourage patients to return to work are under the purview of most PSCs, as are efforts to encourage patient exercise programs. Some PSCs communicate network policies, concerns, and goals to other professional organizations, such as the NKF, Kidney and Urology Foundation of America, American Kidney Fund, American Association of Kidney Patients, Society for Social Work Leadership in Health Care, and the national and local Councils of Nephrology Social Workers.

In this environment, PSCs respond to patient needs with an expanded view of quality of care, embracing psychosocial as well as medical concerns. The social work

JWBT514_ch18.indd 486JWBT514_ch18.indd 486 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

Nephrology Social Work 487

workers in his survey were responsible for making dialysis transient arrangements (which involved copying and sending patient records to out-of-town units) yet only 20% were able to do patient education. The 2002 report of Promoting Excellence in End-of-Life Care recommends that dialysis units discontinue using master’s- level social workers for clerical tasks to ensure that they will have suffi cient time to provide clinical services to their patients and their families. The 2005 Department of Health and Human Services’ proposed conditions for cov- erage of ESRD facilities recognize this issue:

[W]e recognize that dialysis patients also need other essential services including transporta- tion and information on Medicare benefi ts, eligibility for Medicaid, housing, and medi- cations, but these tasks should be handled by other facility staff in order for the MSW to par- ticipate fully with the patient’s interdisciplinary teams so that optimal outcomes of care may be achieved. (Federal Register, 2005, p. 6222)

Merighi and Ehlebracht (2004a,b, 2005), in a survey of 809 randomly sampled dialysis social workers in the United States, found that:

• 94% of social workers did clerical tasks and 87% of those respondents considered these tasks to be outside the scope of their social work training.

• 61% of social workers were solely responsible for arranging patient transpor- tation.

• 57% of social workers were responsible for making travel arrangements for pa- tients who were transient, taking 9% of their time.

• 26% of social workers were responsible for initial insurance verifi cation.

• 43% of social workers tracked Medicare coordination periods.

• 44% of social workers were primar- ily responsible for completing admission packets.

• 18% of social workers were involved in collecting fees from patients. Respondents noted that this could signifi cantly dimin- ish therapeutic relationships and decrease trust.

• Respondents spent 38% of their time on insurance, billing, and clerical tasks versus 25% of their time on counseling and assess- ing patients.

• Only 34% of the social workers thought that they had enough time to suffi ciently address patient psychosocial needs.

The study also noted that as nephrology social workers increased their involvement in insurance and billing, their job satisfaction decreased. This was true particularly for so- cial workers who collected fees from patients. Nephrology social work job satisfaction was correlated positively with the amount of time spent in counseling and patient education and negatively with insurance-related, clerical tasks. Nephrology social workers who spent

perspective has enhanced the awareness of patient needs in national discussions on quality-of-care issues for renal patients. These discussions have had impact in meetings with CMS offi cials and in developing network policies that support patient health and address quality of life concerns.

ESRD Network resources and newsletters can be accessed through its Web sites. Links to all networks can be found at the Forum of ESRD Networks Web site, http://www.esrd

networks.org. In addition, publications by Network PSCs (E. Anderson, R. Bachelder, B. K. Campbell, R. Bova-Collis, B. Dyson, L. Hall, M. Meir, K. Niccum, M. L. Peder- son, D. Perez, R. Russo, K. Thompson, R. Valdez, among others) have added to social work literature, as well as that of other disci- plines, via numerous articles in nephrology publications and journals.

Source: Prepared by Rick Russo, MSW, LSW, Media, PA.

JWBT514_ch18.indd 487JWBT514_ch18.indd 487 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

488 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

more time on insurance, billing, and clerical activities reported increased emotional ex- haustion. Those who spent more time doing counseling and patient education reported less emotional exhaustion. The authors posited that providing education and direct counsel- ing to patients and family members were more congruent with the professional training and education of master’s-level social workers and thus more satisfying for them.

Another professional concern for nephrol- ogy social workers is high patient caseloads. The Council of Nephrology Social Workers (CNSW) conducted an anonymous online salary and caseload survey of nephrology so- cial workers from March 31 to June 21, 2010 (Merighi, Browne, & Bruder, in press). This survey (n = 1,037) indicates that full-time dialy- sis social workers have caseloads ranging from 1 and 711 patients (median 125). Transplant social workers can be responsible for hundreds of patients and organ donors. Large nephrol- ogy social work caseloads have been linked to decreased patient satisfaction and less success- ful patient rehabilitation outcomes (Callahan, Moncrief, Wittman, & Maceda, 1998). Social workers report that high caseloads prevent them from providing adequate nephrology clinical services, most notably counseling (Merighi, & Ehlebracht, 2002, 2005).

The CNSW (2002) recommends an acuity- based social worker-to-patient ratio that takes into consideration the psychosocial risks of pa- tients and recommends a maximum of 75 pa- tients per full-time dialysis social worker. The state of Texas mandates a load of 75 to 100 patients per full-time social worker. Nevada likewise has a mandated ratio of 1 full-time social worker per 100 dialysis patients. How- ever, Merighi and Ehlebracht’s (2004c) na- tional survey of social workers found that only 13% of full-time dialysis social workers had caseloads of 75 or fewer, 40% had caseloads of 76 to 100 patients, and 47% had caseloads of more than 100 patients.

As of 2010, no nephrology social work ratios had been mandated by federal authori- ties. However, the 2008 Medicare Conditions for Coverage for dialysis units do indicate that

every dialysis unit needs to make sure that all professionals have caseloads that allow them to fulfi ll their duties (Federal Register, 2008). Specifi cally, condition 494.180 states:

An adequate number of qualifi ed personnel are present whenever patients are undergo- ing dialysis so that the patient/staff ratio is appropriate to the level of dialysis care given and meets the needs of patients; and the registered nurse, social worker, and di- etitian members of the interdisciplinary team are available to meet patient clinical needs. (p. 20483)

Nephrology social workers have reported that large caseloads hindered their ability to provide clinical interventions (Bogatz, Colas- anto, & Sweeney, 2005). Social work respon- dents in this study reported caseloads as high as 170 patients; 72% had a median caseload of 125 patients. The researchers found that 68% of social workers did not have enough time to do casework or counseling; 62% did not have enough time to do patient education; and 36% said that they spent excessive time doing cleri- cal, insurance, and billing tasks. One partici- pant in their study stated: “The combination of a more complex caseload and greater num- ber of patients to cover make it impossible to adhere to the federal guidelines as written. I believe our patients are being denied access to quality social work services” (p. 59).

COUNCIL OF NEPHROLOGY SOCIAL WORKERS

The CNSW, a professional council affi liated with the NKF, is the largest organization of nephrology social workers in the world. The organization’s goals are to: (1) develop and promote patient and public education; (2) sup- port and promote the profession and education of renal social work; (3) impact regulatory and legislative issues; (4) ensure that quali- fi ed social workers are employed in ESRD settings; and (5) provide ongoing support and education to renal patients. In 2010, more than

JWBT514_ch18.indd 488JWBT514_ch18.indd 488 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

Nephrology Social Work 489

900 members belonged to the organization, the majority of whom were from the United States. More than 55 local CNSW chapters are located around the country, all of which are overseen by the national organization. Ne- phrology social workers may belong to other professional organizations, including:

• The Society for Transplant Social Workers, which was founded in 1986 and is active in the United States and Canada

• The European Dialysis and Transplant Nurses Association, which has a social work component

• The Kidney Foundation of Canada, which includes a nephrology social work organization

The CNSW became a national entity and an advisory board to the NKF in April 1973. Prior to this time, nephrology social workers had met regionally to discuss common is- sues and concerns. Early CNSW activities in- cluded providing input on the ESRD federal regulations and lobbying for the inclusion of master’s-level social workers on renal teams. Since then, CNSW has developed a number of professional resources, including an an- nual training program for nephrology so- cial workers, as well as publications such as “Standards of Practice for Nephrology Social Work” and “Continuous Quality Improvement for Nephrology Social Workers.” When the Medicare Conditions for Coverage of dialy- sis and transplant facilities were being revised in 2005, a CNSW-directed initiative resulted in social workers being the profession that commented most frequently on the proposed conditions, which set policy and practice in all ESRD facilities. The CNSW partners with the other NKF professional councils, such as the Council of Renal Nutrition, Council of Advanced Practitioners, and Council of Ne- phrology Nurses and Technicians, on various projects and to publish a quarterly professional newsletter. Since 1981, the CNSW has pro- vided funding for research projects initiated by nephrology social workers.

Addressing the professional challenges dis- cussed here and providing outcomes-oriented nephrology social work care is a major em- phasis of CNSW. In 1995, CNSW collabo- rated with the NASW to create the “NASW/ CNSW Clinical Indicators for Social Work and Psychosocial Services in Nephrology Set- tings,” a set of guidelines for measuring social work outcomes. CNSW also has a series of 18 training sessions entitled “Refocusing Ne- phrology Social Work: An Outcomes Training Program,” which consist of live presentations, regional continuing education trainings via videotape, and Internet-based professional education programs on these topics:

• “Assessment of Cultural Barriers and Design for Effective Care Plans”

• “Assessment and Management of the Patient with Altered Mental Status”

• “Conducting a Comprehensive Clinical Assessment”

• “Conducting Interventions to Improve Adherence”

• “Continuous Quality Improvement”

• “Delivering, Scoring, and Interpreting Bio- psychosocial Instruments to Enhance As- sessment, Monitor Treatment Outcomes, and Guide Continuing Interventions”

• “Developing Individualized Plans for Reha- bilitation”

• “End-of-Life Issues”

• “Providing Case Management Services”

• “Facilitating Support, Psychoeducational, and Brief Therapy Groups”

• “Interdisciplinary Team Collaboration and Teaching”

• “Marital and Family Counseling to En- hance Patient Adaptation to Illness”

• “Patient Education”

• “Providing Protective Services”

• “Treating Depression”

• “Understanding and Assessing for Depres- sion in the ESRD Patient”

• “Understanding Psychosocial Predictors of Treatment Outcome”

JWBT514_ch18.indd 489JWBT514_ch18.indd 489 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

490 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

A major CNSW emphasis is legislative advocacy. CNSW is an active member of the National Consortium of Health Care So- cial Work Organizations and works with the NKF to lobby for improvement in health in- surance coverage for ESRD patients as well as to extend Medicare coverage for trans- plant recipients to include immunosuppres- sive medications. Another focus of CNSW is professional advocacy; the organization has created a number of documents to clarify the role of a nephrology social worker. The council has four very active e-mail listservs, one each for general membership, regional chapter chairpersons, kidney transplant social workers, and pediatric social workers. These Internet resources allow members quick ac- cess to their colleagues.

In October 2008, Medicare enacted the fi rst update to the conditions of coverage for trans- plant and dialysis facilities in 30 years. These regulations specify the care provided in all ESRD facilities in the United States and its ter- ritories, and are used by state and federal sur- veyors to determine if facilities are performing adequately. The CNSW organized its members to provide a response to these conditions, ad- vocating for attention to ESRD psychosocial issues and appropriate utilization of MSWs on renal teams.

CONCLUSION

ESRD is a signifi cant public health concern with serious biopsychosocial ramifi cations. Nephrology social work interventions have demonstrated effectiveness in addressing the psychosocial barriers to optimal ESRD patient care. Nephrology social workers practice in all types of settings and levels of practice and work with patients of all ages and backgrounds. This chapter presents in- formation that can guide social work practice in nephrology as well as inform all health social workers about ESRD and its psycho- social issues.

SUGGESTED LEARNING EXERCISES

Learning Exercise 18.1

Increasingly, kidney transplant patients are older (over 65 years) or have chronic illnesses such as human immunodefi ciency virus (HIV) and hepatitis. In the United States, there is a signifi cant shortage of organs for patients on the kidney transplant waiting list. Because of this, in some areas of the country, patients wait as long as 8 years to receive a deceased donor kidney transplant. Recently there has been a de- bate about changing the allocation system for kidney transplants. Historically, children have been given preference for organs, followed by perfect antigen matches (i.e. if a donated kid- ney perfectly matches the antigens of someone on the transplant waiting list, that person usu- ally will get the kidney), and length of time someone has been on the list (i.e., the longer you are on the list, the more likely you are to receive a transplant). The proposed new kidney allocation policy would emphasize “life years from transplant” and prioritize the distribu- tion of deceased donor kidneys to those on the waiting list who would be most likely to live the longest after a kidney transplant. Propo- nents of this new allocation system argue that because deceased donor kidneys are in short supply, changes to the system are necessary in order to maximize utility from this scarce commodity. Opponents of this system argue that this new procedure would disadvantage older patients or patients with comorbid ill- nesses and in effect prohibit such patients from timely transplantation. Through small or large group discussion (or a written assignment), have students discuss or debate these questions (refer to Chapter 3 for more information about ethics; also see http://optn.transplant.hrsa.gov /kars.asp for more information about the kid- ney transplant allocation proposal):

1. What do you think about a 75-year-old pa- tient, or a patient with HIV or hepatitis, re- ceiving a kidney transplant from a deceased

JWBT514_ch18.indd 490JWBT514_ch18.indd 490 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

Nephrology Social Work 491

donor? How does the fact that there are thousands of people (many of whom are younger or less ill) waiting for a kidney transplant infl uence your decision?

2. What do you think about the new proposal for kidney allocation that would emphasize “life years from transplant”? What social work ethical considerations should be taken into account when thinking about this?

3. If you agree with the new proposal and think that life years from transplant should be the primary consideration when allo- cating kidneys for transplant, how would you explain this new system to a healthy 70-year-old patient or to a 30-year-old pa- tient with hepatitis or HIV who is interested in a kidney transplant?

Learning Exercise 18.2

Healthy People 2020 is a set of health objec- tives for the United States that relates to many different health areas, including kidney dis- ease (U.S. Department of Health and Human Services, 2000; see Chapter 4 for more in- formation). Have group members investigate Healthy People 2020 and report back to the group on (or write a paper addressing) these questions:

1. What is Healthy People 2020?

2. What recommendations for kidney disease patients are included in Healthy People 2020? (Students can fi nd this information at http://www.healthypeople.gov)

3. What are at least fi ve ways that so- cial workers can help the United States achieve the kidney disease objectives in Healthy People 2020? Be sure to include individual- and family-level roles with policy-level roles for social workers in this discussion.

Learning Exercise 18.3

Divide the students into six groups. Within these groups, half of the group will take

Case Example 18.1

Joseph is a 52-year-old White American male with hypertension who just started dialysis. He did not know that his kidneys were failing and was shocked to be admitted to the hospital with ESRD after going to the emergency room because he was short of breath. Before that, he had not been to see a doctor for over 10 years. After spending a week in the hospital, he started dialysis at an outpatient hemodialysis clinic three times per week. He is newly married, and had been working full time as a construction worker. He is concerned about how the dialysis schedule will work around his job duties, and is also very upset that he may not even be able to return to his physically demanding job because he is so weak. He does not know about the different treatment options for kidney failure and tells you that he is afraid he is going to die.

Case Example 18.2

Rita is a 32-year-old Hispanic female who has been on dialysis for 6 months in a busy urban area. She is interested in a kidney transplant and went to the hospital for an evaluation by the transplant social worker. Her family already has been tested as pos- sible living donors for the transplant; as no one is a good blood match, she must go on the transplant waiting list for a deceased donor kidney. She is concerned about the waiting time for a kidney, as some of her friends from the dialysis clinic have been waiting for a kidney for more than six years. Her dialysis unit reported to the transplant clinic that Rita has not adhered completely to her dialysis regime, as she does not al- ways stay for her recommended treatment time or may miss treatments altogether. This concerns the unit staff, who are unsure whether Rita would take all of her im- munosuppressant medications if she got a transplant, which would put her at risk for rejecting a transplanted kidney.

JWBT514_ch18.indd 491JWBT514_ch18.indd 491 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

492 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

the role of a nephrology social worker and complete a social work assessment of the other half of the group (who will role-play one of the patient scenarios in case examples 18.1–18.3, improvising details as they wish). Each group will report back to the class about the unique psychosocial issues identifi ed in the role-play. If time allows, the groups can create an inter- vention plan for the hypothetical patient.

SUGGESTED RESOURCES

Nephrology Social Work Canadian Association of Nephrology So-

cial Workers—www.cansw.org National Kidney Foundation—www.kidney

.org/professionals/CNSW/index.cfm Society for Transplant Social Workers—

www.transplantsocialworker.org/

Kidney Disease, Psychosocial Issues, and Treatment Options

American Association of Kidney Patients— www.aakp.org

American Kidney Fund—www.akfi nc.org American Society of Nephrology—www

.asn-online.org American Society of Pediatric Nephrology

—www.aspneph.com American Society of Transplant Surgeons

—www.asts.org Centers for Medicare and Medicaid Services

www.cms.gov/ Dialysis from the sharp end of the needle

(Patient-created Web site about kidney disease—www.billpeckham.com/from _the_sharp_end_of_the)

Healthy People 2020—www.healthypeople .gov

Home Dialysis Central—www.homedialysis .org

Institute on Rehabilitation Issues—www .rcep6.org/IRI_PublicaNational

Kidney and Urology Foundation of America —www.kidneyurology.org

Kidney Directions: For Research in Polycystic Kidney Disease—www .kidneydirections.com

Case Example 18.3

John is a 42-year-old African American male who came to the transplant center for a so- cial work assessment from the living donor advocate, in preparation for donating a kid- ney to his sister Monique, who has been on dialysis for a year. Monique has three small children and has had many hospitalizations since starting dialysis. Of all his siblings, family, and parents, Joe is the only person who matches Monique for a kidney dona- tion. The family reports that this match is a “miracle.” John is very ambivalent about transplantation, however, because he is con- cerned about missing work due to the kidney donation workup, surgery, and recovery period. He has never been very close to Mo- nique and feels pressured by his family to donate his kidney to his sister.

Case Example 18.4

Mary is a 20-year-old single White Ameri- can female dialysis patient. She receives hemodialysis at an outpatient clinic three times a week. She started dialysis 2 years ago after the failure of a transplant she received at the age of 14. The dialysis-unit team is very fond of Mary. She has been on the deceased donor waiting list for another kidney transplant and has no family mem- bers who are able to donate a kidney to her. (Her kidney failure is due to a genetically inherited disease, which precludes fam- ily members from donating a kidney.) In Mary’s city, the wait for a kidney transplant is about six years. Inspired by a television news story about a grocery store clerk who donated a kidney to one of his customers, Mary has been asking the dialysis team members if they would donate a kidney to her. One of the patient care technicians, Kim, is interested in donating a kidney to Mary. After role-playing an assessment with Mary, discuss the ethical issues that may be related to Kim donating a kidney to Mary.

JWBT514_ch18.indd 492JWBT514_ch18.indd 492 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

Nephrology Social Work 493

KDQOL Complete—www.kdqol-complete .org Resource to help administer and score

KDQOL assessments. Kidney Disease Quality of Life (KDQOL)

Working Group—http://gim.med.ucla .edu/kdqol/

Kidney School—www.kidneyschool.org Life Options—www.lifeoptions.org National Institute of Diabetes and Digestive

and Kidney Diseases—www.niddk.nih .gov

National Kidney Disease Education Program —www.nkdep.nih.gov/

National Kidney Foundation—www .kidney.org

Nephron Information Center—www .nephron.com

NephrOnline—www.nephronline.com NephroWorld: The Whole World of Ne-

phrology—www.nephroworld.com PKD Foundation: For Research in Polycys-

tic Kidney Disease—www.pkdcure.org /home.html

Promoting Excellence in End of Life Care—www.promotingexcellence.org

RenalWeb: Vortex Web Site of the Dialysis World—www.renalweb.com

United Network of Organ Sharing—www .unos.org

United States Renal Data System—www .usrds.org

International Nephrology European Dialysis and Transplant Society—

www.era-edta.org/ International Society for Hemodialysis—

www.ishd.net International Society of Nephrology—

www.isn-online.org International Society of Peritoneal

Dialysis—www.ispd.org Kidney Foundation of Canada—www

.kidney.ca Kidney Health Australia—www.kidney

.org.au National Kidney Research Fund—www

.nkrf.org.uk

U.K. National Kidney Federation—www .kidney.org.uk

World Kidney Fund—www.worldkidneyfund .org

REFERENCES

Alinsky, S. (1971). Rules for radicals. New York, NY: Random House.

Arthur, T., Zalemski, S., Giermek, D., & Lamb, C. (2000). Educating community providers changes beliefs towards caring for the ESRD patient. Advances in Renal Replacement Therapy, 7(1), 85–91.

Auslander, G. K., & Buchs, A. (2002). Evaluating an activity intervention with hemodialysis patients in Israel. Social Work in Health Care, 35(1/2), 407–423.

Auslander, G., Dobrof, J., & Epstein, I. (2001). Comparing social work’s role in renal dialysis in Israel and the United States: The practice-based research potential of available clinical information. Social Work in Health Care, 33(3/4), 129–151.

Becker, B. N., Becker, Y. T., Pintar, T., Collins, B. H., Pirsch, J. D., Friedman, A., . . . Brazy, P. C. (2000). Using renal transplantation to evaluate a simple approach for predicting the impact of end-stage renal disease therapies on patient survival: Observed/ expected life span. American Journal of Kidney Diseases, 35(4), 653–659.

Beder, J. (1999). Evaluation research on the effectiveness of social work intervention on dialysis patients: The fi rst 3 months. Social Work in Health Care, 30(1), 15–30.

Beder, J., Mason, S., Johnstone, S., Callahan, M. B., & LeSage, L. (2003). Effectiveness of a social work psychoeducational program in improving adherence behavior associated with risk of CVD in ESRD patients. Journal of Nephrology Social Work, 22, 12–22.

Beer, J. (1995). Body image of patients with ESRD and following renal transplantation. British Journal of Nursing, 4(10), 591–598.

Bogatz, S. (2000). Winning an HMO appeal: A case studying social work advocacy. Journal of Nephrology Social Work, 20, 61–67.

Bogatz, S., Colasanto, R., & Sweeney, L. (2005, January). Defi ning the impact of high patient/staff ratios on dialysis social workers. Nephrology News and Issues, 55–60.

Brady, D., & Lawry, K. (2000). Infants, families and end stage renal disease: Strategies for addressing psychosocial needs in the fi rst 2 years of life. Journal of Nephrology Social Work, 20, 17–20.

Browne, T. (2008). Social networks and pathways to kidney transplantation (Doctoral dissertation). Retrieved from ProQuest.

JWBT514_ch18.indd 493JWBT514_ch18.indd 493 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

494 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Browne, T. (2011). Palliative care in chronic kidney disease. In T. Altilio & S. Otis-Green (Eds.), Oxford textbook of palliative social work (pp. 339–350). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Browne, T., & Merighi, J. R. (2010). Barriers to adult hemodialysis patients’ self-management of oral medications. American Journal of Kidney Diseases, 56(3), 547–557.

Burrows-Hudson, S. (1995). Mortality, morbidity, adequacy of treatment, and quality of life. American Nephrology Nurses Association Journal, 22(2), 113–121.

Cabness, J. (2005). National Kidney Foundation second quarter research progress report. New York, NY: National Kidney Foundation.

Callahan, M. B., Moncrief, M., Wittman, J., & Maceda, M. (1998). Nephrology social work interventions and the effect of caseload size on patient satisfaction and rehabilitation interventions. Journal of Nephrology Social Work, 18, 66–79.

Callahan, M. B., Witten, B., & Johnstone, S. (1997). Improving quality of care and social work outcomes in dialysis. Nephrology News and Issues, 2(4), 42–43.

Chang, C. F., Winsett, R. P., Gaber, A. O., & Hathaway, D. K. (2004). Cost-effectiveness of post-transplantation quality of life intervention among kidney recipients. Clinical Transplantation, 18(4), 407–415.

Charnow, J. A. (2010, April 10). Death risk is lower with peritoneal dialysis. Renal & Urology News. Retrieved from http://www.renalandurologynews.com/death- risk-is-lower-with-peritoneal-dialysis/article/168306/

Chen, Y. S., Wu, S. C., Wang, S. Y., & Jaw, B. S. (2003). Depression in chronic hemodialysed patients. Nephrology, 8(3), 121–126.

Chiu, Y. W., Teitelbaum, I., Misra, M., de Leon, E. M., Adzize, T., & Mehrotra, R. (2009). Pill burden, adherence, hyperphosphatemia, and quality of life in maintenance dialysis patients. Clinical Journal of the American Society of Nephrology, 4(6), 1089–1096.

Cohen, L. M., Germain, M. J., Woods, A. L., Mirot, A., & Burleson, J. A. (2005). The family perspective of ESRD deaths. American Journal of Kidney Diseases, 45(1), 154–161.

Council of Nephrology Social Workers. (2002). Standards of practice for nephrology social work (5th ed.). New York, NY: National Kidney Foundation.

DeOreo, P. B. (1997). Hemodialysis patient-assessed functional health status predicts continued survival, hospitalization, and dialysis-attendance compliance. American Journal of Kidney Diseases, 30(2), 204–212.

Devins, G. M., Mandin, H., Hons, R. B., Burgess, E. D., Klassen, J., Taub, K., . . . Buckle, S. (1990). Illness intrusiveness and quality of life in end-stage renal disease: Comparison and stability across treatment modalities. Health Psychology, 9(2), 117–142.

Dobrof, J., Dolinko, A., Lichtiger, E., Uribarri, J., & Epstein, I. (2000). The complexity of social work

practice with dialysis patients: Risk and resiliency factors, interventions and health-related outcomes. Journal of Nephrology Social Work, 20, 21–36.

Federal Register. (1976, June). Conditions for coverage for ESRD facilities, 42 CFR Part 405, Subpart U. Washington, DC: U.S. Government Printing Office.

Federal Register. (2005). Proposed conditions for coverage for ESRD facilities, 42 CFR Parts 400, 405, 410, 412, 413, 414, 488, and 494. Washington, DC: U.S. Government Printing Offi ce.

Federal Register. (2007, March). Hospital Conditions of participation: Requirements for approval and re-approval of transplant centers, to perform organ transplants, 42 CFR Parts 405, 482, 488, & 498. Washington, DC: U.S. Government Printing Office.

Federal Register. (2008, April). Conditions for coverage for end stage renal disease facilities, 42 CFR Part 405, Subpart U. Washington, DC: U.S. Government Printing Offi ce.

Fielding, D., Moore, B., Dewey, M., Ashley, P., McKendrick, T., & Pinkerton, P. (1985). Children with end-stage renal disease: Psychological effects on patients, siblings and parents. Journal of Psychosomatic Research, 29, 457–465.

Fox, R. C., & Swazey, J. P. (1979). Kidney dialysis and transplantation. In E. Fox (Ed.), Essays in medical sociology (pp. 105–145). New York, NY: Wiley.

Frank, A., Auslander, G. K., & Weissgarten, J. (2003). Quality of life of patients with end-stage renal disease at various stages of the illness. Social Work in Health Care, 38(2), 1–27.

Friend, R., Hatchett, L., Schneider, M. S., & Wadhwa, N. K. (1997). A comparison of attributions, health beliefs, and negative emotions as predictors of fl uid adherence in renal dialysis patients: A prospective analysis. Annals of Behavioral Medicine, 19, 344–347.

Fukunishi, I., & Honda, M. (1995). School adjustment of children with end-stage renal disease. Pediatric Nephrology, 9, 553–557.

Georgetown University Hospital. (2010). 32 participants in paired kidney exchange get an early start on the season of Thanksgiving. Georgetown University Hospital Press & Media. Retrieved from www .georgetownuniversityhospital.org/body.cfm?id =15&action=detail&ref=215

Germain, M., & Cohen, L. M. (2007). Renal supportive care: View from across the pond: The United States perspective. Journal of Palliative Medicine, 10(6), 1241–1244.

Gerson, A., Hwang, W., Fiorenza, J., Barth, K., Kaskel, F., Weiss, L., . . . Furth, S. (2004). Anemia and health-related quality of life in adolescents with chronic kidney disease. American Journal of Kidney Diseases, 44(6), 1017–1023.

JWBT514_ch18.indd 494JWBT514_ch18.indd 494 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

Nephrology Social Work 495

Goldstein, M., Yassa, T., Dacouris, N., & McFarlane, P. (2004). Multidisciplinary predialysis care and morbidity and mortality of patients on dialysis. American Journal of Kidney Diseases, 44(4), 706–714.

Gudes, C. M. (1995). Health-related quality of life in end-stage renal failure. Quality of Life Research, 4(4), 359–366.

Hartwell, L. (2002). Chronically happy: Joyful living in spite of chronic illness. San Francisco, CA: Poetic Media Press.

Healthy People 2020. (n.d.). Healthy People 2020. Retrieved from www.healthypeople.gov

Hedayati, S. S., Jiang, W., O’Connor, C. M., Kuchibhatla, M., Krishnan, K. R., Cuffe, M. S., . . . Szczech, L. A. (2004). The association between depression and chronic kidney disease and mortality among patients hospitalized with congestive heart failure. American Journal of Kidney Diseases, 44(2), 207–215.

Holley, J. L., Barrington, K., Kohn, J., & Hayes, I. (1991). Patient factors and the infl uence of nephrologists, social workers, and nurses on patient decisions to choose continuous peritoneal dialysis. Advances in Peritoneal Dialysis, 7, 108–110.

Holley, J. L., & Reddy, S. S. (2003). Pregnancy in dialysis patients: A review of outcomes, complications, and management. Seminars in Dialysis, 16, 384–388.

Iacono, S. A. (2003). Coping with pain: The dialysis patient’s perspective. Journal of Nephrology Social Work, 22, 42–44.

Iacono, S. A. (2004). Chronic pain in the hemodialysis patient population. Dialysis and Transplantation, 33(2), 92–101.

Johnstone, S. (2003). Evaluating the impact of a physical rehabilitation program for dialysis patients. Journal of Nephrology Social Work, 22, 28–30.

Johnstone, S., & Halshaw, D. (2003). Making peace with fl uid: Social workers lead cognitive-behavioral intervention to reduce health-risk behavior. Nephrology News and Issues, 17(13), 20–27, 31.

Johnstone, S., & LeSage, L. (1998). The key role of the nephrology social worker in treating the depressed ESRD patient: Patient utilization preferences and implications for on-site staffi ng practices. Unpublished manuscript.

Johnstone, S., Seamon, V. J., Halshaw, D., Molinair, J., & Longknife, K. (1997). The use of medication to manage patient-staff confl ict in the dialysis clinic. Advances in Renal Replacement Therapy, 4(4), 359–371.

Jonsen, A. (2000). A short history of medical ethics. New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Kaitelidou, D., Maniadakis, N., Liaropouls, L., Ziroyanis, P., Theodorou, M., & Siskou, O. (2005). Implications of hemodialysis treatment on employment patterns and everyday life of patients. Dialysis and Transplantation, 34(3), 138–147, 185.

Kimmel, P. (2000). Psychosocial factors in adult end- stage renal disease patients treated with hemodialysis:

Correlates and outcomes. American Journal of Kidney Diseases, 35(Suppl.), S132–S140.

Kimmel, P. L., Peterson, R. A., Weihs, K. L., Simmens, S. J., Alleyne, S., Cruz, I., & Veis, J. H. (1998). Psychosocial factors, behavioral compliance and survival in urban hemodialysis patients. Kidney International, 54, 245–254.

Kimmel, P. L., Peterson, R. A., Weihs, K. L., Simmens, S. J., Alleyne, S., Cruz, I., & Veis, J. H. (2000). Multiple measurements of depression predict mortality in a longitudinal study of chronic hemodialysis outpatients. Kidney International, 57(3), 2093–2098.

Knight, E. L., Ofsthun, N., Teng, M., Lazarus, J. M., & Curhan, G. C. (2003). The association between mental health, physical function, and hemodialysis mortality. Kidney International, 63(5), 1843–1851.

Koo, J. R., Yoon, J. W., Kim, S. G., Lee, Y. K., Oh, K. H., Kim, G. H., . . . Son, B. K. (2003). Association of depression with malnutrition in chronic hemodialysis patients. American Journal of Kidney Diseases, 41(5), 1037–1042.

Kurella, M., Kimmel, P. L., Young, B. S., & Chertow, G. M. (2005). Suicide in the United States end-stage renal disease program. Journal of the American Society of Nephrology, 16, 774–781.

Kurtin, P. S., Landgraf, J. M., & Abetz, L. (1994). Patient- based health status measurements in pediatric dialysis: Expanding the assessment of outcome. American Journal of Kidney Diseases, 24(2), 376–382.

Kutner, N. G. (1994). Psychosocial issues in end-stage renal disease: Aging. Advances in Renal Replacement Therapy, 1(3), 210–218.

Kutner, N. G., Zhang, R., Huang, Y., & Johansen, K. L. (2010). Depressed mood, usual activity level, and continued employment after starting dialysis. Clinical Journal of the American Society of Nephrology, 5(11), 2040–2045.

Landsman, M. K. (1975). The patient with chronic renal failure: A marginal man. Annals of Internal Medicine, 82(2), 268–270.

Leo, R. J., Smith, B. A., & Mori, D. L. (2003). Guidelines for conducting a psychiatric evaluation of the unrelated kidney donor. Psychosomatics, 44(6), 452–460.

Levine, B. J. (1999). “The emerald city complex” transitional depression in adjustment to organ transplant: A review of the literature and implications for transplant social work. Journal of Nephrology Social Work, 18, 12–17.

Lindberg, J. S., Husserl, F. E., Ross, J. L., Jackson, D., Scarlata, D., Nussbam, J., . . . Elzein, H. (2005). Impact of multidisciplinary early renal education on vascular access placement. Nephrology News and Issues, 19(3), 35–43.

Lowrie, E. G., & Lew, N. L. (1990). Death risk in hemodialysis patients: The predictive value of commonly measured variables and an evaluation of death rate differences between facilities. American Journal of Kidney Diseases, 15, 458–482.

JWBT514_ch18.indd 495JWBT514_ch18.indd 495 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

496 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

MacDonald, H. (1995). Chronic renal disease: The mother’s experience. Pediatric Nursing, 21, 503–507, 574.

Mapes, D., Bragg-Gresham, J. L., Bommer, J., Fukuhara, S., McKevitt, P., & Wikstrom, B. (2004). Health- related quality of life in the Dialysis Outcomes and Practice Patterns Study (DOPPS). American Journal of Kidney Diseases, 44(Suppl. 5), S54–S60.

McKinley, M., & Callahan, M. B. (1998). Utilizing the case management skills of the nephrology social worker in a managed care environment. In National Kidney Foundation (Ed.), Standards of practice for nephrology social work (4th ed., pp. 120–128). New York, NY: Author.

Medical Education Institute. (2004). Social work project reduces missed treatments. Control, 1(3), S2, S8.

Merighi, J. R., Browne, T., & Bruder, K. (in press). 2010 nephrology social work salary and caseload survey summary results. Journal of Nephrology Social Work.

Merighi, J. R., & Ehlebracht, K. (2002). Advocating for change in nephrology social work practice. Nephrology News and Issues, 16(7), 28–32.

Merighi, J. R., & Ehlebracht, K. (2004a). Issues for renal social workers in dialysis clinics in the United States. Nephrology News and Issues, 18(5), 67–73.

Merighi, J. R., & Ehlebracht, K. (2004b). Unit-based patient services and supportive counseling. Nephrology News and Issues, 18(6), 55–60.

Merighi, J. R., & Ehlebracht, K. (2004c). Workplace resources, patient caseloads, and job satisfaction of renal social workers in the United States. Nephrology News and Issues, 18(4), 58–63.

Merighi, J. R., & Ehlebracht, K. (2005). Emotional exhaustion and workload demands in renal social work practice. Journal of Nephrology Social Work, 24, 14–20.

Mollaoglu, M. (2004). Depression and health-related quality of life in hemodialysis patients. Dialysis and Transplantation, 33(9), 544–555.

Moss, A. H. (2005). Improving end-of-life care for dialysis patients. American Journal of Kidney Diseases, 45(1), 209–212.

Murray, A., Arko, C., Chen, S., Gilbertson, D., & Moss, A. (2006). Use of hospice in the United States dialysis population. Clinical Journal of the American Society of Nephrology, 1, 1248–1255.

National Association of Social Workers. (2003). Hospital social worker, Kay Smith, recognized as the NASW social worker of the year 2003. Retrieved from www .socialworkers.org/pressroom/2003/070103_swoty.asp

National Institutes of Health. (1993). Morbidity and mortality of dialysis: NIH Consensus Statement, 11(2). Bethesda, MD: Author.

Paniagua, R., Amato, D., Vonesh, E., Guo, A., & Mujais, S. (2005). Health-related quality of life predicts outcomes but is not affected by peritoneal clearance: The ADEMEX trial. Kidney International, 67(3), 1093–2005.

Pelletier-Hibbert, M., & Sohi, P. (2001). Sources of uncertainty and coping strategies used by family members of individuals living with end stage renal disease. Nephrology Nursing Journal, 28(4), 411–419.

Promoting Excellence in End-of-Life Care. (2002). End- stage renal disease workgroup recommendations to the fi eld. Missoula, MT: Robert Wood Johnson Foundation.

Raiz, L. R. (1999). Employment following renal transplantation: The employer perspective. Journal of Nephrology Social Work, 19, 57–68.

Rees, M. A., Kopke, J. E., Pelletier, R. P., Segey, D. L., Rutter, M. E., Fabrega, A. J., . . . Montgomery, R. A. (2009). A nonsimultaneous, extended, altruistic-donor chain. New England Journal of Medicine 360(111), 1096–1101.

Rocha, D. (2010). Rewards & challenges in dialysis social work. New Social Worker, 17(3). Retrieved from www.socialworker.com/home/Feature_Articles/General /Rewards_%26_Challenges_in_Dialysis_Social _Work/

Romano, M. (1981). Social worker’s role in rehabilitation: A review of the literature. In J. Brown, B. Kirlin, & S. Watt (Eds.), Rehabilitation services and the social work role: Challenge for change (pp. 13–21). Baltimore, MD: Williams & Wilkins.

Root, L. (2005). Our social work group’s process of conducting an outcomes-driven project. Journal of Nephrology Social Work, 24, 9–13.

Rosner, M. H. (2010). Home hemodialysis: Present state of the evidence. Dialysis & Transplantation, 39(8), 330–334.

Rothman, J. (1968). Social work practice. New York, NY: Columbia University Press.

Rubin, H., Jenckes, M., Fink, N., Meyer, K., Wu, A., Bass, E., … Powe, N. R. (1997). Patient’s view of dialysis care: Development of a taxonomy and rating of importance of different aspects of care. American Journal of Kidney Disease, 30(6), 793–801.

Russell, C. L., & Ashbaugh, C. (2004). The experience of immunosuppressive medication on compliance: A case study. Dialysis and Transplantation, 33(10), 610–621.

Russ, A. J., Shim, J. K., & Kaufman, S. R. (2007). The value of “life at any cost”: Talk about stopping kidney dialysis. Social Science and Medicine, 64(11), 2236–2247.

Russo, R. (2002). The role of the renal social worker in the 21st century. Nephrology News and Issues, 16(3), 38, 40.

Saran, R., Bragg-Gresham, J. L., Rayner, H. C., Goodkin, D. A., Keen, M. L., Van Dijk, P. C., . . . Port, F. K. (2003). Nonadherence in hemodialysis: Associations with mortality, hospitalization, and practice patterns in the DOPPS. Kidney International, 64(1), 254–263.

Schatell, D. R., Bragg-Gresham, J. L., Mehrotra, R., Merighi, J. R., & Witten, B. (2010, November). A description of nephrologist training, beliefs, and practices from the national nephrologist dialysis

JWBT514_ch18.indd 496JWBT514_ch18.indd 496 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

Nephrology Social Work 497

practice survey. Proceedings from the 2010 American Society of Nephrology Annual Meeting & Scientifi c Exposition, Denver, CO.

Siegal, B., Witten, B., & Lundin, A. P. (1994, April). Patient access and expectations of nephrology social workers. Nephrology News and Issues, 40, 32–33.

Sikon, G. M. (2000). Pre-dialysis education reduces anxiety in the newly diagnosed chronic renal failure patient. Dialysis and Transplantation, 6(346), 344–345.

Takaki, J., Nishi, T., Nangaku, M., Shimoyama, H., Inada, T., Matsuyama, N., . . . Kuboki, T. (2003). Clinical psychological aspects of restless legs syndrome in uremic patients on hemodialysis. American Journal of Kidney Diseases, 41(4), 833–839.

Thomas, C. (1999). The Arizona experience: Empowering patients and families. Transplantation Proceedings, 31(Suppl. 4A), 7–12.

U.S. Department of Health and Human Services. (2000). Healthy People 2020. Washington, DC: U.S. Government Printing Offi ce.

U.S. Renal Data System. (2009). Annual data report. Bethesda, MD: National Institutes of Health, National Institute of Diabetes and Digestive and Kidney Diseases.

U.S. Renal Data System. (2010). Annual data report. Bethesda, MD: National Institutes of Health, National Institute of Diabetes and Digestive and Kidney Diseases.

Valdez, R. (1997). A comparison of sleep patterns among compliant and noncompliant chronic hemodialysis

patients. Journal of Nephrology Social Work, 17, 28–36.

Vourlekis, B., & Rivera-Mizzoni, R. (1997). Psychosocial problem assessment and ESRD patient outcomes. Advances in Renal Replacement Therapy, 4(2), 136– 144.

White, Y., & Greyner, B. (1999). The biopsychosocial impact of end-stage renal disease: The experience of dialysis patients and their partners. Journal of Advanced Nursing, 30(6), 1312–1320.

Woods, A., Berzoff, J., Cohen, L. M., Cait, C. A., Pekow, P., German, M., & Poppel, D. (1999). The family perspective of end-of-life care in end-stage renal disease: The role of the social worker. Journal of Nephrology Social Work, 19, 9–21.

Wu, A. W., Fink, N. E., Cagney, K. A., Bass, E. B., Rubin, H. R., Meyer, K. B., . . . Powe, N. R. (2001). Developing a health-related quality-of-life measure for end-stage renal disease: The CHOICE health experience questionnaire. American Journal of Kidney Diseases, 37, 11–21.

Wuerth, D., Finkelstein, S. H., Ciarcia, J., Peterson, R., Kliger, A. S., & Finkelstein, F. O. (2001). Identifi cation and treatment of depression in a cohort of patients maintained on chronic peritoneal dialysis. American Journal of Kidney Diseases, 37(5), 1011–1017.

Yusack, C. M. (1999). The effectiveness of a structured education program on the completion of advance directives among hemodialysis patients. Journal of Nephrology Social Work, 19, 51–56.

JWBT514_ch18.indd 497JWBT514_ch18.indd 497 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

498

19

Oncology Social Work

DANIEL S. GARDNER AND ALLISON WERNER-LIN

Oncology social work is a specialization in social work that addresses the psychosocial responses and needs of individuals and fami- lies affected by cancer. Emerging from a long tradition of social work in health care, the subspecialty of oncology social work fl our- ished in the 20th century as biomedical ad- vances transformed cancer from a terminal to a chronic disease. The conceptual founda- tions of oncology social work are found in a number of disciplines, including psychosocial oncology, an area of clinical practice and re- search that addresses the psychological, social, behavioral, spiritual, and other dynamics of cancer among individuals, families, and com- munities. Through multisystemic and holistic practice, research, education, and advocacy, social workers are integral to adding to the knowledge base of cancer and the provision of comprehensive care to people with and af- fected by cancer. This chapter will introduce readers to the foundations of oncology social work and to social work’s unique contributions to comprehensive and integrated cancer care.

Chapter Objectives • Provide an introduction of cancer epidemi-

ology, treatment, and the psychosocial, be- havioral, and spiritual impact of the disease on individuals and families.

• Describe the history, conceptual founda- tions, and functions of oncology social work in general, and the fi eld of psychoso- cial oncology.

• Describe the contributions of social work to oncology research.

• Defi ne the scope of practice knowledge, skills, and interventions that oncology

social workers use to assess and ameliorate psychosocial and quality of life concerns.

• Address emerging issues in psychosocial oncology including cancer survivorship, family decision making, genetic testing, and end-of-life care.

• Present selected resources available for patient education and support, and profes- sional development.

CANCER EPIDEMIOLOGY

Over an average American life span, 44% of men and 38% of women will develop some form of cancer during their lifetimes, and an es- timated 1.5 million new cases will be diagnosed this year alone (Altekruse et al., 2010). Cancer is an umbrella term for hundreds of diseases characterized by uncontrollable growth of ab- normal cells in the body. Oncologists classify the diseases according to the type of cell or the organ in which the cancer originated. Although incidence rates vary by gender, race, and eth- nicity, non-Hodgkin’s lymphoma and mela- noma, in addition to cancers of the prostate, breast, lung, colon and rectum, uterus, bladder and kidney, and ovary, are the most common cancers in men and women of all races (Altek- ruse et al., 2010; see Tables 19.1 and 19.2).

Cancer typically begins with damage to genetic material that leads to the growth of abnormal cells, at times because of the failure to repair mutations. These cells act in a dis- organized manner, divide more rapidly than healthy cells, and lack the requisite program- ming to complete their genetically assigned functions. Cancer cells form tumors (also

JWBT514_ch19.indd 498JWBT514_ch19.indd 498 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

Oncology Social Work 499

Table 19.1 Leading Cancer Sites for Females by Site, Race

Cancer Site

U.S. Prevalence

2007 (SEER)

Estimated New Cases, 2010 (ACS)

U.S. Prevalence,

White

U.S. Prevalence,

Black

U.S. Prevalence,

Hispanic

U.S. Prevalence,

Asian

ALL SITES 6,360,682 739,940 5,614,748 479,368 268,580 133,712

Breast (female) 2,591,855 207,090 2,296,698 201,276 102,436 58,562

Uterine corpus 575,108 43,470 523,613 26,175 19,390 10,533

Colon & Rectum 571,857 70,480 489,901 58,546 21,186 14,223

Melanoma 408,229 26,260 391,407 1,605 6,063 750

Non-Hodgkin Lymphoma 211,470 30,160 188,249 15,490 10,719 4,382

Lung & Bronchus 197,878 105,770 172,551 17,957 4,795 4,049

Ovary 177,162 21,880 156,821 12,072 8,061 8,061

Kidney 116,651 22,870 102,098 13,778 7,288 1,816

Thyroid 100,521 338,026 298,625 19,155 21,041 10,761

Pancreas 16,939 21,770 13,718 2,330 1,082 589

Source: Adapted from SEER Cancer Statistics Review, 1975–2007, edited by S. Altekruse et al., 2008. Bethesda, MD: National Cancer Institute.

Table 19.2 Leading Cancer Sites for Males by Site, Race

Cancer Site

U.S. Prevalence

2007 (SEER)

Estimated New Cases, 2010 (ACS)

U.S. Prevalence,

White

U.S. Prevalence,

Black

U.S. Prevalence,

Hispanic

U.S. Prevalence,

Asian

ALL SITES 5,353,054 789,620 4,688,195 462,999 233,031 94,285

Prostate 2,276,112 217,730 1,923,891 273,813 99,902 35,457

Colon & Rectum 540,636 72,090 472,191 43,302 23,519 15,315

Urinary Bladder 395,480 52,760 370,034 12,835 9,507 4,559

Melanoma 385,054 38,870 371,219 1,083 3,723 595

Non-Hodgkin Lymphoma 226,855 35,380 203,436 15,559 11,662 4,732

Lung & bronchus 172,739 116,750 145,246 17,728 4,879 4,504

Kidney 164,839 35,370 144,338 15,097 9,831 2,881

Oral cavity & Pharnyx 161,112 25,420 141,976 10,436 5,218 4,324

Leukemia 137,398 24,690 122,770 7,877 10,181 2,685

Pancreas 16,057 21,370 14,093 1,291 451 840

Source: Adapted from SEER Cancer Statistics Review, 1975–2007, edited by S. Altekruse et al., 2008. Bethesda, MD: National Cancer Institute.

known as malignancies) that spread via the blood or lymphatic system in a process called metastasis, invading and destroying healthy tissue. If the growth of invasive cells continues unabated, the affected areas cease to function

(Eyre, Lange, & Morris, 2001). In fast-growing or aggressive cancers, this process often leads to death. In many cancers, however, tumor growth is slow, and the disease can be stopped or controlled with medical treatment.

JWBT514_ch19.indd 499JWBT514_ch19.indd 499 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

500 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Malignant cell types present, behave, and are treated differently, so accurate diagnosis of type is critical. Diagnosis can involve care- ful examination, blood tests, scans, or surgi- cal biopsy, after which the cancer generally is classifi ed as one of fi ve types. Carcinoma, a term sometimes used to describe all cancers, specifi cally refers to malignancies that origi- nate in the epithelial linings of organs such as the skin, lung, breast, liver, colon, or prostate. Sarcomas affect bones, cartilage, muscle, or connective tissues. Adenomas begin in the ad- renal, pituitary, and hormonal glands. Lympho- mas are cancers of the lymphatic system and affect the organs affi liated with the immune system. Leukemias are blood cancers that arise in the bone marrow where stem cells mature and travel through the bloodstream. Some can- cers, such as melanomas and small-cell lung carcinomas, do not fi t into any of these broad categories (Beers, Porter, Jones, Kaplan, & Berkwits, 2006).

Etiology and Mortality

Cancers are caused by multiple mechanisms and operate along a variety of pathways, in- cluding interactions among genetic, envi- ronmental, or behavioral processes. Some malignancies are caused by genetic damage or mutations that occur randomly or spo- radically, and others are due to hereditary mutations that are passed from generation to generation. Other cancers are strongly as- sociated with age, gender, ethnicity, race, or ancestry. Environmental infl uences (e.g., exposure to toxic chemicals, air pollutants, viruses, or sunlight and ultraviolet rays), be- havioral patterns (such as the use of alcohol or tobacco, obesity and dietary habits, sexual and reproductive behaviors), and social cir- cumstances (e.g., poverty, racial disparities in treatment, or the lack of access to adequate housing and nutrition, clean air, education, and health-care and preventive screening) also can contribute to cancer expression, treatment response, and mortality (Ghafoor et al., 2003; McGinnis, Williams-Russo, & Knickerman, 2002; Shavers & Brown, 2002).

Approximately 570,000 Americans die each year from cancer, representing nearly 25% of all deaths (American Cancer Society [ACS], 2010a). Because of prevention efforts, improved early screening, and treatment ad- vances, mortality rates from cancer overall have decreased since the 1990s (Altekruse et al., 2010; Edwards et al., 2009). Although survival rates vary by cell type and stage at diagnosis, fewer than half of all people diag- nosed with cancer will die from the disease (Eyre et al., 2001). Despite these trends, in- cidence and mortality rates demonstrate sig- nifi cant health disparities based on gender, age, race/ethnicity, ancestry, geography, and socioeconomic status (SES). According to the Centers for Disease Control and Prevention (CDC, 2010), while different cancers affect men and women at different rates, men are at an overall greater risk than women for devel- oping the disease. Incidence for all cancers combined is signifi cantly higher for African American men than for men of other races/eth- nicities, and cancer mortality is higher for Af- rican American men and women than for other men and women. In general, lower SES puts people at increased risk for developing cancer (Ghafoor et al., 2003), and older adults are 10 times more likely to develop cancer than those younger than 65 years (Altekruse et al., 2010).

Although well documented, the causes of health disparities in cancer and other chronic diseases are not fully understood and likely refl ect complex interactions among biological, social, and behavioral factors, including ge- netic differences, exposure to environmental toxins, and lack of access to good nutrition, preventive screening, and health insurance (Link & Phelan, 1995; Williams, 1997). Fac- tors such as bias among health-care providers and skepticism about mainstream medicine among some individuals and lack of access to primary and preventive care services have in- creased cancer risks for vulnerable communi- ties and marginalized populations (Shavers & Brown, 2002). African American women, for example, are less likely to have breast cancer than White women but are signifi cantly more likely to die from the disease (Chu et al., 1997;

JWBT514_ch19.indd 500JWBT514_ch19.indd 500 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

Oncology Social Work 501

Dignam, 2000). Gehlert and colleagues (2008) propose a “downstream” model of disease that links structural and environmental vari- ables (e.g., poverty, poor nutrition, exposure to crime, and substandard housing) with so- cial isolation, depression, and stress-hormone reactions, creating pathways to illness and higher mortality among lower socioeconomic and racial/ethnic communities.

Cancer Treatment

A variety of conventional and experimen- tal treatments are designed to eliminate or shrink tumors and to prevent the spread or recurrence of cancer. Oncologists base treat- ment decisions primarily on the type and the invasiveness of the disease, or its stage of de-

velopment (see Box 19.1). Other important considerations include the effectiveness of a particular treatment option; the overall health of the individual; the short- and long-term side effects of treatments, which may vary across groups; and fi nancial considerations, such as insurance coverage (Eyre et al., 2001). Physi- cians generally discuss treatment alternatives with the patient, who then makes decisions in consultation with health-care professionals and family members. Treatment may include some combination of surgery, chemotherapy, and radiation.

Surgery is used for prevention, diagnosis, and treatment of cancer. Surgical biopsies provide visual confi rmation of tumor size and extent of spread and obtain tissue for analy- sis of cell type and disease stage. When the

Box 19.1 Cancer Staging

Staging is the process of determining the se- verity and invasiveness of disease to inform treatment decisions, determine prognosis, identify clinical trials that might be appropri- ate, and facilitate communication between providers. Commonly, staging integrates infor- mation about the location and size of primary tumor(s), whether the cancer has spread into the surrounding lymph nodes, and whether cancer cells have invaded other organs.

Because criteria for stages vary by can- cer type, the American Joint Committee on

Cancer developed the TNM classifi cation system to provide common language. T describes the size (in millimeters or centi- meters) or extent of the original tumor; N indicates whether cells have traveled to the surrounding lymph nodes, and M indicates the presence of metastases. Each criterion has grades to indicate the degree of severity.

Generally, however, cancer staging is dis- cussed differently with patients and families. This staging system is shown next.

Staging Type Description

Stage 0 in situ Abnormal cells are contained to the primary organ. Generally, Stage 0 cancers are curable.

Stage 1 localized Cancer is limited to the organ in which it began, without evidence of spread.

Stages 2–3 regional Cancer is locally advanced, may have spread to local lymph nodes.

Stage 4 distant Cancer has spread from the primary site to distant organs or distant lymph nodes. Generally, Stage 4 cancers are referred to as metastatic and may be inoperable.

recurrent Disease that recurs either in the area of the primary tumor (locally recurrent) or as metastasis (distant recurrence).

Source: From www.cancer.gov/cancertopics/factsheet/Detection/staging and www.cancerstaging.org/mission/whatis .html

JWBT514_ch19.indd 501JWBT514_ch19.indd 501 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

502 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

cancer is contained or easily removed, surgery remains the most effective treatment. Surgery frequently is used in combination with other treatment modalities, including radiation, che- motherapy, and/or hormonal therapy. Radia- tion therapy uses ionizing radiation to destroy or minimize malignancies and is used to target precisely and reach cancer cells and tumors that often are diffi cult to reach. Used success- fully in curative and palliative treatment, ra- diation treatment can be prescribed alone or as an adjuvant treatment to surgery or chemother- apy. Radiation often requires daily treatments that last for many weeks. It is time consuming and fatiguing and can result in localized skin reactions, hair loss, or internal scarring in the areas of the body that are treated (Eyre et al., 2001; Weinberg, 2006).

In contrast to more localized treatment, chemotherapy, a broad term describing hun- dreds of medications that attack cancer cells throughout the body, often affects healthy organs and functions during treatment. Like radiation therapy, chemotherapy can be used for curative or palliative purposes, and is used alone or as an adjuvant to other treat- ments, depending on cancer type and staging. Chemotherapy uses specifi c combinations of cancer-fi ghting agents, provided via a range of methods (e.g., transfusions, injections, oral medications), schedules, and dosages, to maxi- mize the effects of treatment while minimiz- ing the impact on healthy organs (Beers et al., 2006). Although chemotherapy plays a large role in reducing mortality among cancer pa- tients, its physical side effects can be severe and cause great anxiety. A nonexhaustive list includes nausea and vomiting, suppression of immune systems, hair loss, mouth sores, fa- tigue, and decreased libido (Weinberg, 2006).

Experimental approaches to treating cancer may be offered to people with cancers that do not respond well to conventional treatments and to those experiencing metastatic growth or recurrences (Eyre et al., 2001). Patients can try new treatments by participating in clini- cal trials that test the effectiveness of newly developed protocols. Access to clinical trials often is limited because of strict exclusion and

inclusion criteria for protocols, meaning that not everyone who might be helped by an ex- perimental treatment will qualify. Rural resi- dents who live a distance from comprehensive cancer centers are less likely to have the oppor- tunity to use experimental approaches. Clini- cal trials generally are performed at a handful of research and teaching hospitals, and travel requirements may be prohibitive for people with fi nancial or instrumental constraints. Psy- chosocial and structural barriers such as these frequently prevent ethnic and racial minorities from participating in clinical trials (Wells & Zebrack, 2008). Experimental treatments often are tested against placebo or Food and Drug Administration–approved protocols in double- blind tests.

Many people with cancer supplement their conventional treatments with complementary or alternative therapies. An estimated 53% to 68% of all adults in the United States have re- ported using prayer or spiritual practices, natu- ropathic supplements, breathing and relaxation exercises, yoga, and chiropractic to enhance their health (Richardson et al., 2000; Tilden, Drach & Tolle, 2004). The use of less conven- tional remedies to complement treatment has risen steadily in recent years, and the National Center for Complementary and Alternative Medicine at the National Institutes for Health anticipates that the trend will continue as the baby boom generation ages (Kessler et al., 2001). See Chapter 12 in this volume for more discussion of complementary and alternative treatments.

BRIEF HISTORY OF PSYCHOSOCIAL ONCOLOGY

Fight Against a Devastating Disease

Although cancer has affected individuals for much of recorded history, prior to the 20th century, a defi nitive diagnosis was diffi cult to make, and the disease was nearly always fatal (Mukherjee, 2010). People diagnosed with cancer often experienced uncontrolled pain, incapacitation, disfi gurement, foul-smelling

JWBT514_ch19.indd 502JWBT514_ch19.indd 502 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

Oncology Social Work 503

tumors, social isolation, and loss of self- esteem (Holland, 1998). Because little was known about the disease or its etiology, cancer engendered fears of contagion and stigmatiza- tion (Sontag, 2001; Waskul & van der Riet, 2002). Cancer was a shameful secret; until the late 20th century, social mores dictated that a cancer diagnosis was rarely discussed publicly and often not even disclosed to the patient by physicians and family members. The introduction of anesthesia in the late 19th century allowed surgical intervention, the fi rst potentially curative treatment for cancer. Early surgeries often were devastating, however, and carried long-term physical and functional side effects. In the 1920s, radiation therapy was found to be effective in shrinking some tumors and was used in conjunction with surgery. Following World War II, compounds initially developed by the military for use in chemical warfare were found to be successful in treating acute leukemia in children (Mukherjee, 2010). This discovery presaged the development of widespread chemotherapy treatments begin- ning in the early 1950s (ACS, 2010c).

Public and private funding for cancer re- search and training began to increase once ef- fective treatments became more common. The federal government established the National Cancer Institute (NCI) in 1937 to centralize efforts to understand and reduce cancer mor- bidity and mortality. After World War II, not- for-profi t organizations dedicated to improving cancer care and prevention, such as the Ameri- can Society of Clinical Oncology (ASCO) and ACS, increased public education about cancer prevention and testing and helped fund a gen- eration of research that produced signifi cant breakthroughs in early detection and treatment of a variety of cancers (ACS, 2010c; Fobair et al., 2009). In 1970, President Nixon declared a “War on Cancer,” and Congress enacted leg- islation to focus efforts to fi nd a cure for the disease (NCI, 2010). The National Cancer Act of 1971 broadened the scope and responsi- bilities of the NCI, created a National Cancer Program, and organized the development of 12 (currently expanded to over 40) compre- hensive cancer centers around the country to

integrate research and clinical practice. The National Cancer Act created the infrastructure for the generation and collection of data on cancer etiology, treatment, and biological and psychological impact that have fueled remark- able advances in cancer screening, treatment, and survivorship over the past 40 years.

Progress and Hope in the Late 20th Century

Because of continuing advances in cancer screening and detection, diagnosis, and treat- ment technologies, the 1960s and 1970s saw increased long-term survivorship of cancer. According to the ACS (2010a), the 5-year survival rate for the 15 most common cancers increased from 50% to 66% across race and gender over the past two decades. This trans- lates to an estimated 540,000 deaths that have been avoided because of advances in cancer treatment and early detection (Jemal et al., 2010). Approximately 10.5 million people nationwide have survived cancer, and mortal- ity rates from the four leading cancers—lung, breast, prostate, and colorectal—have fallen for over a decade (Altekruse et al., 2010). As greater numbers of people are living with can- cer and experiencing the long-term side effects of treatment, it has come to be considered a chronic, episodic illness rather than a terminal condition (Witter & LeBas, 2008). Although curing cancer remains the goal, long-term sur- vival has broadened the aims of treatment to include controlling symptoms and optimizing patient quality of life (Gunnars, Nygren, & Glimelius, 2001; Holland & Lewis, 2000).

Growing public awareness about behav- ioral and environmental aspects of cancer (e.g., smoking, exposure to ultraviolet rays and other carcinogens) and increasing survi- vorship helped stimulate the development of psycho-oncology, a medical subspecialty that deals with psychological responses to the dis- ease and treatment and the biopsychosocial determinants of cancer morbidity and mortal- ity (Holland, 1998; Montgomery, 1999). The transdisciplinary fi eld of psycho-oncology aims to develop and evaluate interventions

JWBT514_ch19.indd 503JWBT514_ch19.indd 503 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

504 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

that alleviate distress, increase supports, and maximize quality of life among individuals with cancer and their families. Efforts to in- tegrate psychosocial care for cancer patients and their families have increased signifi cantly over the past 30 years. The ACS, ASCO, In- stitute of Medicine (IOM), and NCI all have promoted research, conferences, and scholarly publications that have advanced the fi eld of psychosocial oncology, addressing topics such as cancer prevention, coping and adaptation, survivorship, quality-of-life assessment, fam- ily caregiving, cultural differences and health disparities, psychoneuroimmunology, and can- cer genetics (Montgomery, 1999).

The hospice and end-of-life care movement in the 1970s developed in response to concerns about the need to improve the quality of care in chronic and terminal illness (Connor, 2007). Advocating for enhanced patient autonomy, pain and symptom control, communication with patients about their medical status and treatment options, and the importance of social support networks at the end of life, hospice ad- vocates and early programs had a pronounced effect on the fi eld of oncology, leading to in- creased public awareness and funding of pain management teams and psychosocial care services. In the ensuing 20 years, the hospice movement spurred the development of pal- liative medicine, which has brought a more patient- and family-centered, holistic approach to cancer treatment, beginning at the time of diagnosis (Connor, 2007; National Hospice and Palliative Care Organization, 2010). See Chapters 22 and 23 for more details about pal- liative and hospice care.

Social Work’s Contribution to Practice

Health social workers have helped individu- als and their families cope with the biopsy- chosocial aspects of illness in hospitals and outpatient clinics since the early 20th century (Beder, 2006; Fobair et al., 2009; see Chap- ter 1 for more information). Pioneering social workers like Ida Cannon and Harriet Bartlett applied a holistic, “person-in-environment” perspective to their clinical practices, which

led the way for the subspecialty of oncol- ogy social work (Fobair et al., 2009). In the 1940s, social workers developed the fi rst hos- pital departments dedicated to addressing the psychosocial concerns of cancer patients and their families, and oncology social workers have become integral members of interdisci- plinary health-care teams at major hospitals around the nation since that time (Holland, 2002). Today, oncology social workers provide comprehensive psychosocial assessment; case management; and supportive individual, fam- ily, and group interventions that help patients and their families navigate medical systems, make use of community resources, and attain optimal adjustment to the disease and treat- ment (Hermann & Carter, 1994)

Oncology social work leaders are deeply committed to enhancing patient care. Many of them helped to refi ne and disseminate clinical knowledge and skills in the 1980s by build- ing accomplished and highly respected de- partments, developing standards of care, and promoting professional training and research programs (Fobair et al., 2009). These include Grace Christ, who was the director of social work at Memorial Sloan-Kettering Cancer Center in New York; Joan Hermann, formerly at the Fox Chase Cancer Center in Philadel- phia; and Naomi Stearns, currently the director of social work at Dana-Farber Cancer Institute in Boston. With the support of the ACS, these and other pioneers formed the National As- sociation of Oncology Social Work in 1983 (renamed the Association of Oncology Social Work [AOSW] in 1993), which has grown into a major professional organization representing social workers in the subspecialty. Psychoso- cial support services are increasingly being integrated into standard medical guidelines for oncology (Blum, Clark & Marcusen, 2001; Holland, 2002). National and international on- cology social work organizations have helped lead efforts to improve psychosocial care of cancer patients and their families through the creation of professional standards of practice specifi c to social work in oncology; posi- tion papers on areas such as euthanasia and pain management; national conferences and

JWBT514_ch19.indd 504JWBT514_ch19.indd 504 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

Oncology Social Work 505

research awards; and formal continuing edu- cation in areas such as end-of-life care and family-centered practice (Fobair et al., 2009).

PSYCHOSOCIAL IMPACT OF CANCER

Despite the advances in early detection and treatment, a diagnosis of cancer can be an emotionally devastating and life altering ex- perience (IOM, 2007). Newly diagnosed patients experience a range of emotions, in- cluding fear, shock, uncertainty, and grief, and many struggle to mobilize the coping skills needed to manage these emotions (Hermann & Carter, 1994). Patients and family members must absorb and comprehend a great deal of information and medical terminology about the disease, undergo blood tests and diagnos- tic procedures, manage the disease and treat- ment regimens, navigate complex health-care systems, ask informed questions and make critical treatment decisions, and adapt to often- extensive dietary and behavioral restrictions. Cancer patients and their families struggle to become experts in managing the illness, keep- ing track of medical appointments and proce- dures, interacting with a variety of health-care providers, and monitoring insurance benefi ts, including short- and long-term disability poli- cies (Smith, Walsh-Burke, & Crusan, 1998). Psychosocial stressors associated with cancer and its sequelae can undermine an individual’s sense of self and self-worth, provoke fears and anxieties, and test coping mechanisms, values, and social support systems like never before. Coping with the emotional impact of the dis- ease over time involves adapting to changes in self and identity, living with uncertainty and a heightened sense of mortality, and radical disruptions in all arenas of one’s life, includ- ing work, leisure, and social relationships (Holland & Lewis, 2000; Waskul & van der Riet, 2002).

Treatment often is associated with greater discomfort and disruption of the patient’s life than the disease itself. Cancer surgery can re- sult in short-term complications, such as pain

and discomfort, lack of mobility, bleeding, or infection, and long-term side effects, such as scarring, nerve and tissue damage, and sig- nifi cant functional limitations (e.g., disrup- tion of gastrointestinal, respiratory, or sexual functioning, and limited mobility or range of motion) (Eyre et al., 2001). Despite the de- velopment of interventions and protocols that moderate symptomatic responses to treatment, treatment effects of chemotherapy and radia- tion therapy, such as fatigue, pain, nausea, and vomiting, are still quite common (IOM, 2007). Treatment effects can affect quality of life sig- nifi cantly because they diminish energy and limit mobility, autonomy, and the ability to carry out day-to-day activities. Side effects, such as hair loss and appetite and weight fl uc- tuations, and radical surgical procedures carry additional stigma by displaying visible clues of a serious illness (Rosman, 2004).

Individuals with cancer have higher rates of mental illness than their peers, especially adjustment disorders, anxiety, and depres- sion (Carlson et al., 2004; Spiegel, 1996). Psychological distress may be preexisting or a response to the diagnosis and can be exac- erbated by ongoing disease and treatment. Anxiety and depression are not related specifi - cally to different types of cancer, but cancers with poorer prognoses (e.g., pancreatic) tend to be associated with greater levels of distress (Carlson et al., 2004; Zabora, Brintzenhofeszoc, Curbow, Hooker, & Piantadosi, 2001). Depres- sion in cancer patients often is underdiagnosed or viewed by health-care professionals as a “natural” response to life-threatening disease (Spiegel, 1996). The failure to accurately de- tect and treat psychosocial diffi culties or men- tal illness can exacerbate patient and family distress, get in the way of disease management and adherence to treatment protocols, and de- crease quality of life (IOM, 2007).

Research on psychosocial response to can- cer suggests that several factors may enhance the patient’s adaptation to the disease. Cancer patients who approach their illness with an in- ternal sense of control over the disease process and an optimistic or hopeful attitude generally experience less emotional distress and higher

JWBT514_ch19.indd 505JWBT514_ch19.indd 505 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

506 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

psychological adjustment than do other cancer patients (Ell, Nishimoto, Mediansky, Mantell, & Hamovitch, 1992; Livneh, 2000). Using active engagement-oriented coping styles that emphasize problem solving, seeking in- formation and social support, processing and expressing emotions, and adopting a fi ghting spirit also may enhance psychological adapta- tion to the cancer experience (Stanton et al., 2000). In addition, patients who report higher levels of social support, and those who turn to religion or faith in coping with the disease, may experience less distress and improved well-being (Wright, 1999). This literature has many inconsistencies, however, and the role of neuroimmunological changes, illness fac- tors, and sociodemographic variables such as gender, age, and race/ethnicity in coping and psychological adjustment have yet to be fully explored (Livneh, 2000).

Cancer and the Family

Cancer is considered a disease that affects families because of the many ways in which an individual’s illness affects and is affected by the functioning of families and extended kin. Cancer and its treatment can disrupt family and social roles, causing emotional upheaval and requiring changes in all family members to manage the disease and maintain normal family functioning (Weihs & Politi, 2006). Families adapt to chronic and advanced ill- ness through complex and often unconscious changes in structure, rules, and communica- tion with one other and with those outside the family (Gardner, 2008; Patterson & Garwick, 1994). Having a parent, for example, who is too ill or exhausted to care for her children, a family breadwinner who is temporarily un- able to work, or a partner who has signifi cant changes in appearance or sexual desire can bring about devastating changes in family in- teractions, resources, and health.

Family caregivers provide the bulk of care for cancer patients (Rabow, Hauser, & Adams, 2004; Wolff, Dy, Frick, & Kasper, 2007) and play a signifi cant role in providing hands- on, day-to-day care; ensuring adherence with

medications and care plans; and maintaining communication with health-care team mem- bers, friends, and family about the patient’s daily status, needs, and concerns. This is particularly salient when the cancer patient is a child, elderly, or has advanced cancer (Glajchen, 2004; Hauser & Kramer, 2004; Waldrop, Kramer, Skretny, Milch, & Finn, 2005). A rich empirical literature suggesting that family caregivers share much of the emo- tional, physical, and fi nancial strains of living with a chronic and progressive illness, often at the risk of their own physical and mental health (Hudson, Aranda, & Kristjanson, 2004; Waldrop, 2007). Despite the potential benefi ts of providing care for family members with chronic illness (Kramer, 1997), doing so sig- nifi cantly increases the caregiver’s vulnerabil- ity to a range of mental and physical health problems (Braun, Mikulincer, Rydall, Walsh, & Rodin, 2007).

Family adaptation to cancer is infl uenced by family dynamics, such as communication, fl exibility, mutuality, cohesion, and family life stage, as well as illness variables, including disease course (i.e., acute or chronic, and pro- gressive, constant, or relapsing), anticipated outcome, and patient’s level of functioning (Rolland, 2005; see Chapter 13 for further discussion). Flexibility of family roles and boundaries, which allows families to use out- side supports while maintaining some consis- tency in family functioning, is associated with coping and resilience (F. Walsh, 2006). Living with cancer changes family communication patterns and requires families to talk about things they often have little or no experience in talking about. Although open and intimate communication is thought to be helpful in families living with chronic illness, barriers to effective communication include preexist- ing family confl icts, differing health beliefs or care preferences, family secrets, or confl ict- ing family narratives (Kramer, Boelk, & Auer, 2006; Werner-Lin & Gardner, 2009). Dyadic and relational stressors can compound the tasks of the cancer experience and negatively affect marital or partner relationships (Kayser, Watson, & Andrade, 2007; Manne, 1998).

JWBT514_ch19.indd 506JWBT514_ch19.indd 506 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

Oncology Social Work 507

Genetic Testing and Reproductive Decision Making

Recent advances in mapping the human ge- nome have uncovered alterations in the genetic code that predispose carriers to increased risk for a variety of adult-onset cancers (see Chap- ter 21). According to the National Human Ge- nome Research Institute (n.d), genetic cancers account for approximately 5% to 15% of all cancer diagnoses. A blood test can identify the presence of one of these mutations, and receiving results is complex and frequently distressing (Meiser, 2005). Because of the na- ture of genetic inheritance, test results provide information about an entire family bloodline. Because every generation is at risk for inher- iting mutations, a major motivation for young adults to pursue genetic testing is to inform family planning (Decruyenaere et al., 1996; Denayer, Evers-Kiebooms, Tejpar, Legius, & Van Cutsem, 1999; Werner-Lin, 2010). Ge- netic counseling and testing can reduce anxi- ety for patients by clarifying risk perceptions (Meiser & Halliday, 2002), increasing con- trol over inherited risk, and opening avenues to pursue advanced and targeted preventive medical care (Gooding, Organista, Burack, & Beisecker, 2006). Yet patients frequently have trouble understanding, interpreting, and using complex genetic health information. Furthermore, although preventive measures do exist, they provide no guarantees and may sig- nifi cantly impact quality of life, identity, self- esteem, sexuality (Lostumbo, Carbine, Wallace, Ezzo, & Dickersin, 2004; Lux, Fasching, & Beckmann, 2006; Metcalfe, Lynch, Ghadirian, & Nadine, 2004), and long-term health out- comes (Kauff et al., 2008; Rebbeck, 2002).

A mutation of the BRCA gene, just one of the gene mutations that has been implicated in inherited breast cancer risk, confers an esti- mated 14% to 87% lifetime risk for breast can- cer to women as well as a 10% to 68% lifetime risk of ovarian cancer (Antoniou et al., 2003; Szabo & King, 1997). High rates of cancer ex- pression suggest that extended family systems may have experienced many cancer-related di- agnoses and losses with few periods of respite

between one diagnosis and the next. Experi- ences with cancer treatment and loss may be- come a familiar backdrop for family life and may shape perceptions of cancer risk and deci- sions about prevention and early detection for asymptomatic family members (Werner-Lin, 2010).

Cancer Over the Life Course

Childhood and Adolescence

The psychosocial impact of cancer on individ- uals, families, and communities depends to a great extent on the biological, developmental, historical, and culturally defi ned age of the pa- tient. Children of different ages, for example, interpret and experience illness and treatment differently, according to their cognitive and developmental capacities and in the context of their family and peer relationships. Children with cancer often experience increased anxi- ety, depression, social isolation, and regres- sion (Zebrack & Chesler, 2001). As a result, a cancer diagnosis in childhood or adolescence may impede the resolution of normal devel- opmental tasks, such as individuation from caregivers, identity development, and build- ing intimate friendships. Children may experi- ence anticipatory symptoms, including nausea and vomiting, prior to treatment as a result of classical conditioning or anxiety. Nonadher- ence to cancer treatment is reported in 33% of children younger than 13 years and 59% of adolescents (Keene, Hobbie, & Ruccione, 2000; Richardson & Sanchez, 1998). Although parents are responsible for their children’s ad- herence to treatment, a child may still refuse treatment. Social workers can intervene by refo- cusing the child’s need for control toward other, less harmful behaviors and by assessing how parenting styles may be problematic for the child. Referral for individual and family coun- seling is crucial if ongoing diffi culties persist.

School experiences have a signifi cant im- pact on development and support during child- hood and adolescence (Patenaude & Kupst, 2005). Children often miss signifi cant amounts of school, which impacts their classroom

JWBT514_ch19.indd 507JWBT514_ch19.indd 507 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

508 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

learning, peer relationships, and sense of mas- tery and autonomy. For adolescents, cancer can interfere with sexual development. Psy- chosexual losses surround issues of physi- cal development, menses, fertility, and libido (Zebrack, Casillas, Nohr, Adams, & Zeltzer, 2004). Cancer also can interfere with adoles- cents’ exploration of their sexual identities; an estimated half of adolescent survivors of can- cer feel uncomfortable with the opposite sex and avoid dating (Zebrack & Chesler, 2001).

Parents of School-Age Children

When parents of school-age children are di- agnosed with cancer, balancing parenting and self-care may be problematic. Parents with cancer worry about what and how to tell their children about their illness, how to continue meeting the demands of parenting throughout treatment, and how to plan for their children’s care if they die from the disease (Biank & Sori, 2003). At times, cancer patients rely on their children and teens for treatment or emo- tional support; this “parentifi cation” can add to the child’s burden and is associated with negative mental health outcomes (Hermann, 2001). Children, adolescents, and parents can benefi t from education and support, including support groups in which their needs and con- cerns can be addressed (Werner-Lin, Biank, & Rubenstein, 2010).

Cancer in Later Life

Older adults account for approximately 77% of new cases of cancer each year (ACS, 2010a). Older cancer patients are more likely than those younger than 65 years to live with concurrent, chronic illnesses, such as diabetes, cardiovascular disease, respiratory disease, kidney disease, and Alzheimer’s disease or other dementing illnesses. The pervasiveness of comorbid chronic conditions in later life poses distinct health and psychosocial chal- lenges to older cancer patients, their families, and health-care providers. Chronic illness in later life is associated with increased pain, de- pression, and mortality and with diminished quality of life (Kane & Kane, 2005; Lawton, 2001). Co-occurring chronic and degenerative

diseases often cause or exacerbate functional limitations that threaten older adults’ ability to care for themselves or live independently. Age- related functional concerns, such as vision and hearing loss, diffi culties with balance and walking, falls, eating and nutritional problems, cognitive losses, and incontinence, can signifi - cantly limit an older adult’s ability to carry out daily activities and manage medical treatments (Inouye, Studenski, Tinetti, & Kuchel, 2007). Frailty—a condition defi ned by muscle weak- ness, limited mobility, and fatigue—is increas- ingly common with age and is associated with higher risks of falls, disability, hospitalization, and premature death (Feldt, 2004; Woods et al., 2005; see Chapter 16).

Older patients share many physical, psy- chological, social, and spiritual concerns that shape their aging and illness experiences, quality of life, and palliative care needs. Older adulthood is often a time of signifi cant life transitions, including retirement, changing family roles, the death of a partner and other loved ones, and declining health, function- ing, autonomy, and independence. Although there is wide variability in how older patients experience chronic and progressive illness, some view a life-threatening diagnosis as an “expected” and developmentally consistent phenomenon. Many older adults report that they fear the process of dying more than death itself; frequent concerns include the possibil- ity of experiencing uncontrollable pain, grow- ing incapacity, loss of autonomy and control, and becoming a burden on family members (Cicirelli, 1999; Gardner & Kramer, 2009/10). Elders who have or expect to experience more physical pain, who fear abandonment, or who lack social and spiritual support report having more diffi culty coping with progressive illness and dying (Fortner & Neimeyer, 1999).

Fixed incomes and inadequate insurance benefi ts can limit an older cancer patient’s ac- cess to the resources needed for coping with the demands of cancer treatment, particularly when older individuals themselves are car- ing for adult children, grandchildren, or ill spouses. Common challenges include paying for treatments not covered by Medicare and

JWBT514_ch19.indd 508JWBT514_ch19.indd 508 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

Oncology Social Work 509

other insurances, fi nding transportation to medical appointments, and needing assistance in performing daily self-care activities. Medi- care and third-party insurers rarely cover new or experimental medications and procedures, making it diffi cult for older patients to take full advantage of emerging treatment options. In addition, a growing literature identifi es ageism as a factor in the undertreatment of older pa- tients with a range of cancer diagnoses (Dale, 2003; Peake, Thompson, Lowe, & Pearson, 2003). Older cancer patients frequently are ex- cluded from clinical trials solely on the basis of age, and physicians may refrain from offer- ing aggressive treatments to them under the assumption that older patients cannot physi- cally handle adverse side effects (Marcusen & Clark, 2001; Rohan, Berkman, Walker, & Holmes, 1994).

Feeling that one has reliable, reciprocal social supports and a community or social network (e.g., church congregations, friends, and extended family) is a signifi cant pre- dictor of health and well-being in later life (L. Berkman, 2000; Krause, 2006), and it may mediate the impact of serious illness and stressful life events (Cohen, 2001). Con- versely, older adults who are socially isolated, live alone, and report few social resources are more vulnerable to illness, disability, and mor- tality (Lyyra & Heikkinen, 2006; Moren-Cross & Lin, 2006). Yet older adults generally cope with advanced illness and the threat of dying by turning inward (Atchley, 2009; Werth, Gordon, & Johnson, 2002), engaging in in- quiry about life’s meaning, their legacy, and the afterlife (Bolmsjo, 2000; Nelson-Becker, 2005). Some elders experience renewed faith that can strengthen their connections to family and community and help them adapt to loss, chronic illness, functional decline, dying, and death (Atchley, 2009).

Cancer Survivorship

Outliving a life-threatening condition like cancer often requires managing long-term ef- fects that can cause emotional distress, func- tional limitations, and further chronic health

problems. Some survivors live with “minor” annoyances, such as a dry skin, lymphedema (i.e., fl uid retention, often in the arms or legs), or mild neuropathy in their hands and feet. For others, surviving cancer comes at the cost of developing other serious health concerns, such as cardiac disorders, cognitive defi cits, chronic renal disease, secondary cancers, and infertility (Kornbluth, 1998; Oeffi nger et al., 2006; Pizzo, 2001). These chronic conditions and side effects act as ongoing reminders of the negative emotional experiences associated with cancer.

Survivors of childhood cancer face unique medical and psychosocial issues. They fre- quently worry about recurrence (Zebrack & Chesler, 2001) and may need support with separation from parents and reintegration into peer groups. Learning disabilities can develop as a result of chemotherapy and radiation treatment and may impede academic progress and cause loss of mastery and self-esteem, so- cial isolation, depression, anxiety, and family problems (Shilds et al., 1995; Zebrack, Jaehee, Petersen, & Ganz, 2007). School reintegration is a major area of concern for children and families. Realistic standards should be set for such children, combining appropriate school rules to maintain normalcy while making spe- cifi c illness-related allowances.

As survivors grow into adulthood, they be- come more vulnerable to long-term treatment side effects and early mortality (Mertens et al., 2001). Families and providers may not fully discuss the long-term side effects of cancer treatment with children and adolescent cancer patients, due either to a focus on the imme- diate goals of helping the child to survive or to diffi culty in broaching emotionally charged and potentially painful future losses. Com- mon treatment side effects experienced by childhood cancer survivors in adulthood in- clude the development of secondary cancers, ongoing fatigue and pain, uncertainty about fertility, and challenges to sexual functioning (Zebrack et al., 2007). Sexuality and reproduc- tive functioning present ongoing reminders of childhood cancer experiences. Concerns about fertility and sexual function require young

JWBT514_ch19.indd 509JWBT514_ch19.indd 509 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

510 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

adult survivors to wonder whether they can or should have children and how to discuss these issues with romantic partners (Zebrack, Casillas, Nohr, Adams, & Zeltzer, 2004).

ONCOLOGY SOCIAL WORK

Oncology social workers provide psychosocial support that maximizes the health and func- tioning of individuals, families, groups, and communities affected by cancer. In a variety of oncology settings and across the cancer continuum, they access psychosocial and in- strumental resources, support adaptive coping capacities, and alleviate emotional and envi- ronmental stressors (AOSW, 2010). Social workers draw on the profession’s person-in- environment perspective to treat “the whole person” in the context of social and environ- mental factors that can enhance or exacerbate the illness experience. This approach ad- dresses biopsychosocial and spiritual concerns that pose barriers to managing the illness, ad- hering to treatment protocols, and persevering through treatment, and makes the oncology so- cial worker an essential member of the health- care team (IOM, 2007).

Scope and Functions

Social workers intervene at multiple levels and across systems (see Box 19.2) to enhance pa- tient care and quality of life (Raveis, Gardner, Berkman, & Harootyan, 2010). Psychosocial support at the micro level includes:

• Conducting comprehensive assessments of individual and family emotional, behav- ioral, and social functioning

• Assessing patient and family coping, emo- tional and social resources, and response to the illness; educating and answering ques- tions about medical, practical, and psycho- social aspects of cancer and treatment

• Fostering adaptive coping

• Helping patients and families navigate com- plex health-care and community systems

• Mobilizing supportive resources and ser- vices to improve the quality of care

• Teaching strategies to manage and reduce symptoms and side effects

• Providing supportive and therapeutic inter- ventions to individuals, groups, and fami- lies to address uncertainty, reduce anxiety and emotional distress, and enhance qual- ity of life throughout the illness course (AOSW, 2010)

Oncology social workers use a variety of in- terventions and provide a range of services, from clinical case management, to intensive psychotherapy, to meet the unique needs of cancer patients and their families at different points on the cancer continuum.

Traditionally, oncology social workers have practiced primarily in inpatient and ambula- tory hospital settings, but the subspecialty has grown to a range of inpatient and outpatient programs (e.g., oncology, pain medicine and palliative care, and other specialty services), home health and hospice services, commu- nity-based cancer support programs, private practice, and community-based mental health settings (AOSW, 2010). The profession’s em- phasis on social context and working across multiple systems positions social workers well to provide care coordination and enhance con- tinuity of care for patients who commonly ex- perience multiple transitions over the course of the illness (Raveis et al., 2010).

Support groups can be an effective resource for cancer patients, caregivers, and other fam- ily members to fi nd answers to illness-related questions and ameliorate psychosocial con- cerns. Social group work often is used in cancer care to reduce social isolation and build social supports, facilitate the sharing of emotional concerns, and provide safe places to exchange strategies for managing symptoms, interacting with family members and health-care provid- ers, and coping with multiple illness-related changes (Fobair, 1998; Spiegel & Classen, 2000). Patients and caregivers participating in support groups feel less distress about cancer and cope with illness-related concerns more

JWBT514_ch19.indd 510JWBT514_ch19.indd 510 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

Oncology Social Work 511

effi ciently (Goodwin et al., 2001; Spiegel & Classen, 2000). Support groups can help to keep children and adolescents on track de- velopmentally, support overburdened and ex- hausted parents, and provide continuity during chaotic or uncertain transitions (Werner-Lin et al., 2010).

Oncology social workers emphasize the family as the unit of care, a perspective that expands the traditional focus on the physician– patient relationship to include the primary

social relationships that patients turn to most for support when facing life-threatening, chronic illness. Family-centered care engages family members as allies in providing qual- ity treatment, treats families with dignity and respect, and helps patients and families make more informed and consensual care decisions (Johnson, 2000). Oncology social workers help families adapt to illness-related changes in family roles and responsibilities, provide emotional support and resources to reduce the burdens of family caregiving, assist with fi nancial and other logistical concerns, and empower families to stay informed about a pa- tient’s status. They also advocate for patients through the course of the illnesses. Family caregivers benefi t from clinical case manage- ment, resource referral, respite, and support around transitions. Families also benefi t from psychotherapeutic support and psychoedu- cation around problem solving and decision making, working through family confl icts, and communicating more effectively with one an- other and with team members (Hudson et al., 2004; Johnson, 2000).

Family conferences are used extensively by oncology social workers to increase communi- cation and enhance management of the illness among patients, family members, and mem- bers of the health-care team (Hudson, Thomas, Quinn, & Aranda, 2009). Social workers often coordinate and facilitate family meetings and help families and health-care team members create an environment in which they can con- nect with one another and address the concerns of all participants. Effective family meetings provide opportunities for communicating about changing medical information and dis- cussing treatment options, provide emotional support to patients and families, and facilitate communication and decision making about goals and care preferences (Glajchen, 2004). Family meetings also allow social workers to bring together patients, families, friends, neighbors, and representatives of community institutions (e.g., workplaces, schools, and houses of worship) to lend instrumental and emotional assistance to families as they adapt to living with cancer.

Box 19.2 Association of Oncology Social Workers Scope of Practice

The scope of practice in oncology social work as identifi ed in the AOSW Standards of Practice includes:

1. Services to cancer survivors, families, and caregivers through clinical practice providing comprehensive psychosocial services and programs through all phases of the cancer experience.

2. Services to institutions and agencies to increase their knowledge of the psychosocial, social, cultural, and spiritual factors that impact coping with cancer and its effects, and to ensure provision of quality psychosocial programs and care.

3. Services to the community through education, consultation, research, and volunteering to utilize, promote, or strengthen the community services, programs, and resources available to meet the needs of cancer survivors.

4. Services to the profession to support the appropriate orientation, supervision and evaluation of clinical social workers in oncology; participate in and promote student training and professional education in oncology social work; and advance knowledge through clinical and other research.

Source: From Association of Oncology Social Workers. (2010). Scope of practice. Retrieved from www.aosw.org/html/prof-scope.php

JWBT514_ch19.indd 511JWBT514_ch19.indd 511 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

512 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

The scope of oncology social work prac- tice extends beyond the patient and family to include service to other professionals on the oncology team, health-care systems, commu- nities, the social work profession, and soci- ety at large. Oncology social workers act as a bridge between patients and the health-care system, advocate for patients and families, and help keep the oncology team informed about the unique concerns, strengths, cultural beliefs, and care preferences that affect the patient’s experience with cancer. Social work contributes to the advancement of cancer pre- vention and quality care by working to develop and strengthen community resources; devel- oping and implementing social services and programs that are responsive to the needs of cancer patients and survivors; promoting pub- lic education about early cancer screening and treatment options; and conducting research on the impact of the disease on individuals and families, the effectiveness of psychosocial oncology interventions, and the long-term ex- periences of cancer survivors and family mem- bers (AOSW, 2010; Hermann & Carter, 1994). In addition, social workers in oncology are ac- tive in professional development, creating and disseminating guidelines for ethical and com- petent practice, providing clinical supervision, and working to educate the next generation of oncology health-care professionals.

Conceptual Foundations

Oncology social work practice is grounded in a variety of theoretical frameworks and empirical literatures, including psychosocial oncology, attachment and loss, stress and cop- ing models (Livneh, 2000), family systems and relational coping (Boss, 2001; Kayser et al., 2007), child and adult development, and narrative and meaning making (Fife, 1994; Werner-Lin & Gardner, 2009). In addition, an ecosystems perspective (Germain & Gitterman, 2008; Meyer, 1995) and commitment to treat- ing the person in environment are integral to social work in oncology, sensitizing social workers to team and organizational issues, community processes, and macro-level policy

while they simultaneously attend to the intra- psychic and interpersonal needs of individuals and families. For the oncology social worker, “the ecosystems perspective is a way of seeing case phenomena (the person and the environ- ment) that are interconnected and multilayered to order and comprehend complexity and avoid oversimplifi cation” (Meyer, 1995, p. 18).

Oncology social work practice refl ects the ethics and values that guide the social work profession, such as promoting service to cli- ents, individual dignity and self-determination, social justice, the importance of social rela- tionships, and integrity in professional conduct (NASW, 2008). The profession’s commitment to meeting the needs of the most vulnerable and oppressed members of society is particu- larly important in the cancer context, where social workers work to mobilize resources for individuals, families, and groups and work to- ward the elimination of health disparities and inequities in treatment. The aims of oncology social work are consistent with those of pallia- tive care, gerontology, and health social work, in that they focus on enhancing individual and family functioning, autonomy and choice in decision making, communication and access to resources, and quality of life in chronic and end-of-life care.

Essential Knowledge and Skills

Although cancer diagnoses, treatment pro- tocols, and symptoms vary greatly, and each patient’s experience is unique, the knowledge and competencies presented in Box 19.3 are fundamental to providing quality psychosocial care for cancer patients and their families.

Medical and Psychosocial Knowledge About Cancer and Oncology

Social workers in oncology must be well in- formed about common types of cancer, symp- toms, treatment protocols, medical procedures, short- and long-term side effects, illness tra- jectories, and survivorship. Knowing the fun- damentals of cancer and oncology is important in tracking a patient’s changing medical situa- tion, assessing the extent to which patients and

JWBT514_ch19.indd 512JWBT514_ch19.indd 512 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

Oncology Social Work 513

families understand disease and treatment, and helping them to prepare and ask appropriate questions of their health-care and psychosocial service providers. Having a basic understand- ing of cancer prevention and control, including early screening, genetic testing, and physical and behavioral predictors of different cancers, is also important for oncology social workers. Research suggests that social workers can help with cancer prevention by tailoring individual, behaviorally oriented interventions to tar- get harmful behaviors among groups (Gotay, 2005).

Understanding the physical, emotional, psychological, social, spiritual, and practi- cal effects of living with cancer across the course of the illness represents the fundamen- tal knowledge base of oncology social work. It is essential that social workers continually build on their command of developmental dy- namics, ego functions, coping skills, family

dynamics and adaptation to illness, the excep- tional needs of family caregivers, fi nancial and other concrete needs, the role of social sup- port, and community responses to cancer and its sequelae to effectively assess and develop plans that respond to the needs of patients and families (Hermann & Carter, 1994). Oncology social workers should be familiar with scien- tifi c publications, professional listservs, and opportunities for continuing education that expose them to evidence-based research and practice.

Oncology social workers also must keep abreast of current knowledge about mental health and illness, particularly regarding mani- festations of psychopathology and psychiatric symptoms associated with chronic and life- threatening illness. Such knowledge, along with a familiarity with the Diagnostic and Statistical Manual of Mental Disorders and psychopharmacology, is essential for com- prehensive assessment, case planning, and provision of appropriate services or referrals. Individuals with cancer may be vulnerable to anxiety and depression, and these and other se- rious mental health concerns may be underdi- agnosed and undertreated among people with cancer. As the member of the transdisciplinary care team who may have the most expertise in mental and behavioral health, oncology social workers should be familiar with risk factors and treatment options for mental health condi- tions that are common among cancer patients and caregivers.

Health-Care and Social Service Systems and Resources

To help patients and families navigate com- plex systems and access resources necessary to ensure quality care, oncology social work- ers must be familiar with health-care organi- zations and services, service delivery systems, and fi nancial structures and processes (i.e., health insurance, managed care, Medicare, and Medicaid). Oncology social workers are trained to understand the aspects of the con- tinuum of care from health promotion and dis- ease prevention to critical and end-of-life care, including programs and services ranging from

Box 19.3 Essential Knowledge and Skills for Oncology Social Workers

Knowledge about cancer, symptoms, treatment, and side effects

Biopsychosocial impact of chronic and life-threatening illness on individuals, families, and communities

Health-care and social service systems and resources

Mental health diagnoses and treatment Ethical and legal concerns Conducting comprehensive

biopsychosocial assessment Clinical case management Direct clinical practice across the cancer

continuum Family-centered practice Educating patients and family

members about cancer prevention, health promotion, and disease self-management

End-of-life and palliative care Interdisciplinary and ethical practice Cultural competence and advocacy Research- and evidence-based practice

JWBT514_ch19.indd 513JWBT514_ch19.indd 513 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

514 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

community-based clinics to inpatient hospi- tals, rehabilitation, and long-term care facili- ties. Linking patients with essential programs and resources (e.g., information, fi nancial or transportation assistance, home-care and home health aides, Medicaid and third-party insur- ance, etc.) requires up-to-date knowledge of ever-changing policies and services, includ- ing eligibility requirements, application pro- cedures, and strategies for communicating information to cancer patients and their care- givers. Oncology social workers often also work closely with patient navigators to pro- vide information and services to patients and families. Navigators are individuals hired by hospitals and clinics to help patients operate within treatment systems effi ciently and effec- tively.

Ongoing Assessment of Individuals and Families

The skills needed to conduct comprehensive biopsychosocial assessments are fundamen- tal to understanding and addressing the psy- chosocial resources, challenges, and unmet needs facing cancer patients and their fami- lies. Early assessments help identify and re- solve problematic coping and health behaviors (Brintzenhofszoc, Smith, & Zabora, 1999; Zabora et al., 2001). Comprehensive assess- ments can predict morbidity and mortality in older patients with cancer (Extermann & Hur- ria, 2007). Assessment should be ongoing as cancer progresses, remits, or recurs. For ex- ample, assessment of survivorship experiences may mitigate ongoing distress (Zebrack et al., 2007) or help to address complicated bereave- ment after a patient dies (Brintzenhofszoc et al., 1999). Although many standardized as- sessment instruments are designed to measure adjustment to cancer and patient quality of life (e.g., FACT, COPES; see Goodwin et al., 2001, for a review), a comprehensive assess- ment should include (IOM, 2007; Walsh, 2005; Zebrack, Walsh, Burg, Maramaldi, & Lim, 2008):

• Current medical situation and symptoms, including illness course and trajectory,

multidimensional assessment of pain and other symptoms, and patient and family perceptions of illness and care

• Cognitive and functional status

• Individual and family illness history (in- cluding physical and mental illness and use of medical and psychosocial support services)

• Family and relational processes (family structure, communication, problem solving, adaptability, cohesion, and confl ict, etc.)

• Developmental capacities and concerns

• Coping skills and ego functioning

• Social supports (informational, emotional, and practical) and resources

• Cultural, spiritual, and religious beliefs, values, and practices

• Financial status and resources

• Access to community programs and services

• Family meaning making

• Mental health and coping concerns

Cultural Competence and Advocacy

In an increasingly diverse and aging society, the ability to practice with people from a vari- ety of cultural, ethnic, racial, socioeconomic, and religious backgrounds is a requisite skill for oncology social workers. Social workers are trained to provide culturally sensitive as- sessment, care planning, and psychosocial support services (Bonder, Martin, & Miracle, 2001). Oncology social workers must remain attentive to differe nces in the way patients and families perceive of and cope with ill- ness, medical treatment, grief, and loss based on ethnicity, culture, religion, life history, and SES. Effective pain and symptom manage- ment, for example, is impossible without un- derstanding individual, familial, and cultural perceptions, values, and beliefs about pain and developing interventions that respect the unique, individualized experiences of patients with chronic illness and their families (Altilio, 2004; Davidhizar & Gige, 2004). Competent social workers should be aware of their own

JWBT514_ch19.indd 514JWBT514_ch19.indd 514 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

Oncology Social Work 515

cultural assumptions and biases, engage in exploring and appreciating the worldviews of their diverse clients, and strive, develop, and practice appropriate, relevant, and sensitive intervention strategies in helping all clients (Pérez Foster, 1998).

Social work’s core value of respect for the dignity and worth of those they serve draws attention to the dynamics of difference and so- cial inequities that affect individuals, families, and communities (NASW, 2008). Understand- ing health disparities and the pervasive effects of racism, xenophobia, sexism, ageism, eco- nomic oppression, and cumulative disadvan- tage thus are essential to oncology social work practice. Promoting awareness of the unique perspectives and concerns of diverse cancer patients and their families, advocating for their needs and concerns, and educating mem- bers of the palliative care team about distinct beliefs and values regarding aging, illness, pain, and treatment can expand the reach and enhance the quality of care (Del Rio, 2004). Social workers have a professional mandate to intervene on multiple levels (i.e., individual, familial, institutional, community, and soci- etal), ensure the provision of just and equi- table care to all patients, and advocate within health-care systems to balance the desire for cost effi ciency and measurable outcomes with services that are accessible and affordable to all cancer patients and their families (Christ & Diwan, 2008; Harootyan & O’Neill, 2006).

Clinical Practice With Multiple Modalities Through the Cancer Continuum

Oncology social workers provide psychosocial support to individuals, families, and commu- nities from the point of screening through the period of long-term survivorship. Many can- cer patients experience turning points along the disease continuum at which they feel vul- nerable, frightened, and uncertain about their futures. These points may occur at the time of cancer diagnosis, the inception of treatment, remission, recurrence or metastasis, the con- clusion of treatment, and, for many, when fac- ing death from the disease or its complications.

Social workers are familiar with the challenges specifi c to various cancer diagnoses and are skilled at crisis intervention and supportive counseling to help patients and families cope with the emotional, practical, and existential crises that often arise at this time.

Education and psychosocial support are critical to helping patients understand medical information and procedures, clarify the roles of different health-care providers, and man- age the demands of undergoing diagnostic workups, navigating health-care systems, and making informed decisions about treatment, providers, and care settings. At the beginning of treatment, oncology social workers continue to support patients and family caregivers around the fears and uncertainties inherent in adhering to medical protocols, dealing with side effects, and adjusting to new routines at home and in the hospital or clinic. During treatment, social workers help patients marshal their strengths and adhere to often complex and demanding treatment regimens and their accompanying anxiety, uncertainty, and emotional exhaustion (Eyre et al., 2001).

The termination of treatment presents an ex- istential crisis for some patients, who feel they are no longer actively fi ghting the cancer and become anxious about its recurrence (Holland & Lewis, 2000). The extraordinarily taxing nature of cancer treatment makes the prospect of a recurrence devastating for the cancer sur- vivor, and each diagnostic test or exam in the ensuing months and years can raise fears of having to resume treatment. Oncology social workers help survivors understand and adapt to a new “normal” (Rolland, 2005) by pro- viding individual, group, and family therapy to enhance adaptation to long-term physical, functional, and emotional effects of the dis- ease and its treatment. This helps survivors to anticipate concerns and mobilize the resources needed to resume their previous roles and ac- tivities.

Oncology social workers must be skilled in a variety of direct practice methods. Social workers are trained in using multiple modali- ties, such as cognitive-behavioral, psychody- namic, family and group therapy, to address

JWBT514_ch19.indd 515JWBT514_ch19.indd 515 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

516 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

illness related concerns. Being familiar with treatment guidelines and evidence-based prac- tices for patients with mental health concerns, such as anxiety, depression, or chronic men- tal illness, is essential to providing effective psychosocial care. These skills enable social workers to move fl uidly between modalities and methods to support patients and their families at different points along the cancer continuum.

Clinical practice with families and family caregivers is a central component of oncology social work. Given dramatic changes in health care, families have increasingly assumed the burden of providing care for loved ones with cancer and other chronic illnesses. Conducting comprehensive family assessments, develop- ing family-centered care plans, providing fam- ily counseling around illness-related changes and concerns, and arranging and facilitating family conferences to apprise everyone of the patient’s medical condition and treatment op- tions are essential to supporting the psycho- social needs of patients and family members (Given, Charles, Given, & Kozachik, 2001). Oncology social workers support family care- givers through a range of evidence-based care- giver interventions and respite services, and link families to such resources as home care, medication and fi nancial assistance, transpor- tation, and social supports.

Case Management and Coordination of Care

Case management has long been a critical role for oncology social workers. Given their pro- fessional skills in working with multiple com- munity and institutions, social workers are well suited to assist cancer patients in mak- ing transitions between care settings as they recover, receive rehabilitation, or need addi- tional medical and psychosocial assistance. Social workers, who have long practiced in the context of community and institution-based health-care teams, bring well-established skills of collaboration, advocacy, and leadership to their work with physicians, nurses, and allied health professionals (Raveis et al., 2010). Care coordination and case management require

collaboration across multiple settings (e.g., hospital, home, long-term care) to support pa- tients and families through the course of their illness. In an increasingly fragmented health- care environment, case managers ensure integration across health-care settings and pro- mote continuity of care that benefi ts patients, families, and health-care teams. Oncology social workers support timely and effective discharge planning by coordinating services among various providers and settings; manag- ing insurance and helping to access eligible benefi ts; providing transportation services and family and community support and services; and procuring equipment and services to sup- port home-based care.

Patient Education

Throughout the course of disease, oncology social workers are involved in educating pa- tients and their families about cancer and its anticipated disease trajectory, treatment, common psychosocial responses, community resources, and symptom management. Oncol- ogy social workers help families to access re- liable resources online and in the community (AOSW, 2010). Through ongoing guidance, clarifi cation, and psychoeducation, oncology social workers provide cancer patients and their caregivers with tools to navigate health- care and social service systems and teach them strategies for communication, problem solving, and decision making around patients’ changing needs, concerns, and preferences (Glajchen, 2004; Hermann & Carter, 1994).

Oncology social workers empower patients and families to be more engaged in their care by helping them ask to questions and make in- formed decisions about all aspects of medical treatment. Changing medical technology has opened new areas of decision making, such as reproductive choices prior to treatment. An example is whether to harvest eggs or collect sperm prior to radiation therapy for later use. Although such procedures are costly (Keene et al., 2000; Richardson & Sanchez, 1998), they have the potential to provide the cancer patient with some control over future family planning. Furthermore, social workers encourage adult

JWBT514_ch19.indd 516JWBT514_ch19.indd 516 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

Oncology Social Work 517

survivors to seek accurate information about their own fertility as well as cancer-related pregnancy risks for themselves and their off- spring. For survivors, obtaining accurate in- formation can signifi cantly reduce ongoing distress and damage to self-esteem (Zebrack & Chesler, 2001).

Palliative and End-of-Life Care

Oncology social workers are aware of transi- tions at the end of life and with services to control pain and discomfort for chronically and terminally ill cancer patients. Hospice is an innovative model of care that assumes pri- mary management of dying patients care to provide state-of-the-art medical care and pain management to reduce physical, psychologi- cal, and spiritual suffering in the last months of life. Palliative care teams and programs pro- vide integrated and holistic care at any point during a serious chronic illness, with the aim of enhancing patient autonomy and function- ing, managing pain and other symptoms, and working to improve the quality of care and quality of life for seriously ill and dying in- dividuals and their families. Unlike hospice, palliative medicine often is provided simulta- neously with curative treatment, until the pa- tient’s condition improves or hospice services are recommended (National Hospice and Pal- liative Care Organization, 2010).

Although cancer mortality has decreased (Altekruse et al., 2010), oncology social workers should be skilled and comfortable in working with patients who are chronically ill and dying. In palliative and end-of-life care, oncology social workers may serve as consul- tants, mediators, and advocates on transdis- ciplinary teams addressing complex ethical dimensions of medical decision making, fam- ily communication, and care preferences. Requisite skills include psychoeducation for families and patients about symptom manage- ment and end of life, advanced care planning and family therapy to help synchronize the pa- tient’s end-of-life care preferences and wishes with those of the family, and supportive coun- seling around grief and bereavement (Blacker et al., 2004).

Social workers are uniquely trained to ad- dress complex ethical dilemmas involving in- dividual autonomy and quality of life and to mediate among the individual needs, perspec- tives, values, and responsibilities of patients, their family members, and health-care pro- viders (Csikai, 2004). In the case of terminal cancer, social workers may provide end-of-life care to patients and family members by fa- cilitating discussion of the patient’s end-of- life wishes and supporting the selection of a health-care proxy, if indicated. Finally, when patients are dying, oncology social workers can support families in funeral preparation and providing bereavement counseling or bereave- ment resources. See Chapters 22 and 23 for more information about palliative and end-of- life care.

Research on Evidence-Based Practice

An important way in which oncology social workers can improve psychosocial care is by engaging in research that addresses the cancer experience for individuals and families across the cancer care continuum (Brintzenhofszoc et al., 1999; Clark, 2001; Institute for the Ad- vancement of Social Work Research, 2003). Social workers can conduct primary research on the biopsychosocial aspects of cancer, with the goal of enhancing our understanding of patient and family needs, and developing and evaluating psychosocial interventions. This breadth of focus and the profession’s holistic perspective of individual and family function- ing makes social work research particularly important in cancer care.

Social work research provides an opportu- nity for producing evidence of the effective- ness of social work and other interventions. Important areas of inquiry include health sta- tus and quality of life in cancer survivorship, the interface of cancer and aging, the impact of disparities and strategies to reduce these disparities, improving the quality of care, enhancing communications among families and between patients and health-care provid- ers, the needs of family caregivers, improv- ing palliative care, behavioral interventions to enhance cancer prevention and screening, and

JWBT514_ch19.indd 517JWBT514_ch19.indd 517 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

518 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

identifying genetic contributions cancer and treatment outcomes. Social workers have been active in developing these interventions and testing them for their effi cacy and effective- ness. Social workers contribute to knowledge building, too, by conducting primary research on how the social environment contributes to worse cancer outcomes (Gehlert et al., 2008).

CHALLENGES TO ONCOLOGY SOCIAL WORK

Despite how much is known about the psy- chological and emotional toll of living with cancer, the health-care system has not ad- dressed adequately the psychosocial concerns of cancer patients, cancer survivors, and their families. A report by the IOM (2007) suggests that many health-care providers do not address these concerns or consider psychosocial sup- port to be an integral part of quality oncology care. It is not surprising, therefore, that can- cer patients and families often are dissatisfi ed with the amount of supportive information and psychosocial care that they receive from their health-care teams and that they report that their emotional, psychological, behavioral and spiritual needs are largely unmet by the health- care system (Christ, 2010; IOM, 2007).

Although transdisciplinary teams in oncol- ogy settings are increasingly common, so- cial workers are not always part of oncology teams. The medical model traditionally has focused primarily on biological and clinical aspects of cancer to the exclusion of social and psychological factors (IOM, 2007). Sig- nifi cant changes in the treatment of cancer and the structure and delivery of health care also have complicated the work of social workers in oncology. Traditional functions, such as crisis and long-term counseling, case management, and discharge planning become problematic as inpatient stays are shortened. Technological advances in genetic screening, complex and specialized treatment options, and life-sustaining technology, coupled with a shift toward greater patient choice in treat- ment decision making, simultaneously have

provided opportunities and placed additional strains on individuals and families and present important new roles for oncology social work- ers. These developments in cancer care serve as an impetus and opportunity for social work- ers to develop innovative interventions to meet the needs of their clients.

CONCLUSION

Social workers in oncology contribute signifi - cantly to the provision of high-quality, fam- ily-centered, biopsychosocial care for cancer patients and their families in a wide variety of settings. This subspecialty within health social work includes many roles, such as helping pa- tients and families to communicate with one another and with providers about their needs and care preferences and how to participate in advance care planning. Oncology social work- ers also help with decision making and serve as advocates for patients and families within the health-care system. Their distinct knowl- edge, skills, and values make social workers a resource for cancer patients, families, and health-care teams.

Self-advocacy, a cornerstone of social work practice, is essential for social workers in on- cology to survive in the fi eld, both personally and professionally (Stearns, 2001). Oncology social workers who are hospital-based face the effects of downsizing, and accessible psycho- social resources continue to be scarce for can- cer patients and their families in all domains. Institutional and social advocacy on behalf of the profession and clients is essential to main- taining adequate and high-quality services (Institute for the Advancement of Social Work Research, 2003). Political activity and policy development, particularly through or in part- nership with national organizations, continues to be a powerful tool for change to improve the lives of our clients and to advance the profession.

Given the high incidence of cancer and the growing number of adult survivors, all social workers should expect to work with at least one person affected by cancer at some point in

JWBT514_ch19.indd 518JWBT514_ch19.indd 518 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

Oncology Social Work 519

their careers. Discoveries in science and tech- nology, early detection, cancer genetics, health disparities, and translational research will con- tinue to transform cancer into a chronic disease that is managed primarily in the community (NCI, 2010). Oncology social workers will be at the forefront of addressing psychosocial and spiritual concerns and enhancing quality-of-life among cancer patients and their families, all done through research, policy making, and practice.

SUGGESTED LEARNING EXERCISES

Learning Exercise 19.1

Using common genogram notation,* construct a multigenerational genogram (for your family or a client’s family) focused on experiences of illness, family caregiving, and loss. Include at least three generations.

1. Begin by adding basic demographic infor- mation: dates of birth and death, marriage, separation, and divorce; geographic loca- tion; dates of immigration; and religious or spiritual orientation.

2. Identify major illnesses or health-related in- cidents. Include dates of onset, signifi cant medical intervention (such as hospitaliza- tion or surgery), and cause of death.

3. Add select family dynamics related to ill- ness and caregiving roles, alliances, or losses related to illness treatment or loss.

Refl ect on this genogram. Possible questions to explore include:

• How do the etiology, treatment, and re- quired care from physicians and family caregivers impact coping and family life?

• How did the family adjust to the demands of the illness? What was helpful in coping? What might have facilitated greater coping?

• How did health or spiritual beliefs play into the story of the disease?

Learning Exercise 19.2

One common psychosocial intervention to help people coping with cancer is a support group. These groups frequently are composed of par- ticipants coping with different types of cancer at various stages. Members bring unique family and work concerns to the group for consider- ation. The role of the oncology social worker is to provide a safe place for participants to dis- cuss these concerns, fi nd common elements in their stories, and facilitate connections.

For this exercise, ask six students from the class to role-play a session of such a support group. Write descriptions of six roles, includ- ing group facilitator and fi ve group partici- pants, on slips of paper and place them, folded, in a hat. The slips should include basic cancer and demographic information. The volunteer facilitator should not take on a role but should come to the role-play with her own personal history and lead the group as she would in a real clinical setting.

Each student pulls one slip of paper from the hat and then acts out that role for 15 min- utes in a group role-play. Once the role-play is complete, the students and facilitator should take 10 minutes to process the experience of leading, participating in, or observing the in- teraction. Students should be encouraged to provide constructive feedback to each other.

This activity can be modifi ed to address different populations (e.g., family caregiv- ers, children with cancer, siblings of cancer patients, or bereaved adolescents).

SUGGESTED RESOURCES

Oncology Social Work Support Organizations

American Psychosocial Oncology Society— www.apos-society.org

* For guidance constructing a family genogram, refer to information from your social work practice courses or see R. Gerson, M. McGoldrick, and S. Petry (2008), Genograms: Assessment and intervention, 3rd ed. (New York, NY: Norton Professional Books).

ch19.indd 519ch19.indd 519 9/22/11 1:08 AM9/22/11 1:08 AM

520 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Association of Oncology Social Work— www.aosw.org

Association of Pediatric Oncology Social Worker—www.aposw.org

International Psycho-Oncology Society— www.ipos-society.org/

Society of Behavioral Medicine—www .sbm.org

National Cancer Organizations American Cancer Society—www.acs.org

(800) ACS-2345 Cancer Care, Inc.—www.cancercare.org

(800) 813-HOPE Cancer Support Community—www

.thewellnesscommunity.org (202) 659– 9709

National Cancer Institute—www.cancer .gov (800) 4-CANCER

Professional Organizations and Support Networks

American Society of Clinical Oncology— www.asco.org

Association of Cancer Online Resources— www.acor.org

Cancer News—www.cancernews.com National Association of Social Workers—

www.naswwebed.org Online continuing education. National Center for Complementary and

Alternative Medicine—nccam.nih.gov National Chronic Care Consortium—www

.nccconline.org National Coalition for Cancer Survivor-

ship—www.canceradvocacy.org/ National Registry of Evidence-Based

Programs and Practices—www.nrepp .samhsa.gov

Oncolink at the University of Pennsylvania Cancer Center—www.oncolink.org

Resources for Family Caregivers Caregiver Resource Directory—www

.stoppain.org/caregivers/resource_form

.html National Alliance for Caregiving—www

.caregiving.org

National Family Caregiver Association— www.nfcacares.org

U.S. Administration on Aging, National Family Caregiver Support Program— www.aoa.gov/aoaroot/aoa_programs /oaa/resources/faqs.aspx#Caregiver

REFERENCES

Altekruse, S., Kosary, C., Krapcho, M., Neyman, N., Aminou, R., Waldron, W., . . . Edwards, B. (2010). SEER cancer statistics review, 1975–2007. Bethesda, MD: National Cancer Institute.

Altilio, T. (2004). Pain and symptom management: An essential role for social work. In J. Berzoff & P. R. Silverman (Eds.), A handbook for end-of-life healthcare practitioners (pp. 380–408). New York, NY: Columbia University Press.

American Cancer Society. (2010a). Cancer facts & fi gures 2010. Atlanta, GA: Author.

American Cancer Society. (2010b). Glossary. Retrieved from www.cancer.org

American Cancer Society. (2010c) The history of cancer. Retrieved from www.cancer.org/acs/groups/cid /documents/webcontent/002048-pdf.pdf

Antoniou, A., Pharoah, P., Narod, S., Risch, H., Eyfjord, J., Hopper, J., . . . Easton, D. F. (2003). Average risks of breast and ovarian cancer associated with BRCA1 or BRCA2 mutations detected in case series unselected for family history: A combined analysis of 22 studies. American Journal of Human Genetics, 72, 1117–1130.

Association of Oncology Social Workers. (2010). Standards of practice. Retrieved from www.aosw .org

Atchley, R. (2009). Spirituality and aging. Baltimore, MD: Johns Hopkins University Press.

Beder, J. (2006). Hospital social work: the interface of medicine & caring. New York, NY: Routledge, Taylor & Francis.

Beers, M. H., Porter, R. S., Jones, T. V., Kaplan, J. L., & Berkwits, M. (2006). The Merck manual of diagnosis and therapy, 18th ed. Whitehouse Station, NJ: Merck Research Laboratories.

Berkman, L. (2000). Social support, social networks, social cohesion, and health. Social Work & Health Care, 31, 3–14.

Biank, N., & Sori, C. (2003). A child’s impossible and scariest task. In C. F. Sori & L. Hecker, (Eds.), The therapist’s notebook for children and adolescents: Homework, handouts, and activities for use in psychotherapy (pp. 18–24). Binghamton, NY: Haworth.

JWBT514_ch19.indd 520JWBT514_ch19.indd 520 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

Oncology Social Work 521

Blacker, S., et al. (2004). NASW standards for palliative and end of life care. Washington, DC: NASW Press. Retrieved from www.naswdc.org/practice/bereavement /standards/standards0504New.pdf

Blum, D., Clark, E. J., & Marcusen, C. P. (2001). Oncology social work in the 21st century. In M. M. Lauria, E. J. Clark, J. F. Hermann, & N. M. Stearns (Eds.), Social work in oncology: Supporting survivors, families, and caregivers (pp. 45–72). Washington, DC: American Cancer Society.

Bolmsjo, I. (2000). Existential issues in palliative care; Interviews with cancer patients. Journal of Palliative Care, 16, 20–24.

Bonder, B., Martin, L., & Miracle, A. (2001). Achieving cultural competence: The challenge for clients and healthcare workers in a multicultural society. Generations, 25(1), 35–42.

Boss, P. (2001). Family stress management: A contextual approach. New York, NY: Sage.

Braun, M., Mikulincer, M., Rydall, A., Walsh, A., & Rodin, G. (2007). Hidden morbidity in cancer: Spouse caregivers. Journal of Clinical Oncology, 25(30), 4829–4834.

Brintzenhofszoc, K., Smith, E., & Zabora, J. (1999). Screening to predict complicated grief in spouses of cancer patients. Cancer Practice, 7(5), 233–239.

Carlson, L., Angen, M., Cullum, J., Goodey, E., Koopmans, J., Lamont, L., . . . Bultz, B. D. (2004). High levels of untreated distress and fatigue in cancer patients. British Journal of Cancer, 90(12), 2297–2304.

Centers for Disease Control, Offi ce of Cancer Prevention and Control. (2010). Health disparities in cancer— basic information. Retrieved from www.cdc.gov /cancer/healthdisparities/basic_info/index.htm

Christ, G. (2010). Cancer as a chronic life-threatening condition. In S. Diwan (Ed.), Health care and older adults resource review. CSWE Gero-Ed Center, Master’s Advanced Curriculum Project. Retrieved from www.cswe.org/CentersInitiatives/GeroEdCenter /Programs/MAC/Reviews/Health/22419/22536 .aspx

Christ, G., & Diwan, S. (2008). Role of social work in managing chronic illness care. In S. Diwan (Ed.), Health care and older adults resource review. CSWE Gero-Ed Center, Master’s Advanced Curriculum Project. Retrieved from http://depts.washington.edu /geroctr/mac/1_6health.html

Chu, K., Tarone, R., Kessler, L., et al. (1997). Recent trends in U.S. breast cancer incidence, survival, and mortality rates. Journal of the National Cancer Institute, 88, 1571–1579.

Cicirelli, V. (1999). Personality and demographic factors in older adults’ fear of death. Gerontologist, 39(5), 569–579.

Cohen, E. (2001). The complex nature of ageism: What is it? Who does it? Who perceives it? Gerontologist, 41, 576–577.

Clark, E. (2001). The importance of research in oncology social work. In M. Lauria, E. J. Clark, J. Hermann, & N. Stearns (Eds.), Social work in oncology (pp. 193– 210). Atlanta, GA: American Cancer Society.

Connor, D. (2007). Development of hospice and palliative care in the United States. Omega: Journal of Death & Dying, 56(1), 89–99.

Csikai, E. (2004). Social workers’ participation in the resolution of ethical dilemmas in hospice care. Health & Social Work, 29(1), 67–76.

Dale, D. (2003). Poor prognosis in elderly patients with cancer: The role of bias and undertreatment. Journal of Supportive Oncology, 1(Suppl. 2), S11–S17.

Davidhizar, R., & Gige, J. (2004). A review of the literature on care of clients in pain who are culturally diverse. International Nursing Review, 51(1), 47–55.

Del Rio, N. (2004). A framework for multicultural end-of- life care: Enhancing social work practice. In J. Berzoff & P. Silverman (Eds.), Living with dying: A handbook for end-of-life practitioners (pp. 439–461). New York, NY: Columbia University Press.

Decruyenaere, M., Evers-Kiebooms, G., Boogaerts, A., Cassiman, J. J., Cloostermans, T., Demyttenaere, K., . . . Van den Berghe, H. (1996). Prediction of psychological functioning one year after the predictive test for Huntington’s disease and impact of the test result on reproductive decision making. Journal of Medical Genetics, 33, 737–743.

Denayer, L., Evers-Kiebooms, G., Tejpar, S., Legius, E., & Van Cutsem, E. (1999). Illness perception, transfer of information and risk perception in familial adenomatous polyposis families. Gedrag & Gezondheid: Tijdschrift voor Psychologie en Gezondheid, 27, 244–254.

Dignam, J. (2000). Differences in breast cancer prognosis among African-American and Caucasian women. CA: Cancer Journal for Clinicians, 50(10), 50–64.

Edwards, B., Ward, E., Kohler, B., Eheman, C., Zauber, A. G., Anderson, R. N., . . . Ries, L. A. G. (2009). Annual report to the nation on the status of cancer, 1975–2006, featuring colorectal cancer trends and impact of interventions (risk factors, screening, and treatment) to reduce future rates. Cancer, 116(3), 544–573.

Ell, K., Nishimoto, R., Mediansky, L., Mantell, J., & Hamovitch, M. (1992). Social relations, social support and survival among patients with cancer. Journal of Psychosomatic Research, 32, 531–541.

Extermann, M., & Hurria, A. (2007). Comprehensive geriatric assessment for older patients with cancer. Journal of Clinicians in Oncology, 25(14), 1824–1831.

Eyre, H., Lange, D. P., & Morris, L. B. (2001). Informed decisions: The complete book of cancer diagnosis, treatment, and recovery. Washington, DC: American Cancer Society.

Feldt, K. (2004). The complexity of managing pain for frail elders. Journal of the American Geriatrics Society, 52, 840–841.

JWBT514_ch19.indd 521JWBT514_ch19.indd 521 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

522 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Fife, B. (1994). The conceptualization of meaning in illness, Social Science & Medicine, 38, 309–316.

Fobair, P. (1998). Cancer support groups and group therapies. In K. Ell & J. Williams (Eds.), Advances in mental health research (pp. 365–398). Washington, DC: NASW Press.

Fobair, P., Stearns, N. N., Christ, G., Dozier-Hall, D., Newman, N. W., Zabora, J., . . . Desonier, M. (2009). Historical threads in the development of oncology social work. Journal of Psychosocial Oncology, 27, 155–215.

Fortner, B., & Neimeyer, R. (1999). Death anxiety in older adults: A quantitative review. Death Studies, 23(5), 387–411.

Gardner, D. (2008). Cancer in a dyadic context: Older couples’ negotiation of ambiguity and meaning in end-of-life. Journal of Social Work in End-of-Life and Palliative Care, 4(2), 1–25.

Gardner, D., & Kramer, B. J. (2009/10). End-of-life challenges, fears and care preferences: Congruence in reports of low-income elders and their family members. OMEGA: Journal of Death and Dying, 60(3), 273–297.

Gehlert, S., Somer, D., Sacks, T., Miniger, C., McClintock, M., & Olopade, O. (2008). Targeting health disparities: A model linking upstream determinants to downstream interventions. Health Affairs, 27(2), 339–349.

Germain, C. B., & Gitterman, A. (2008). The life model of social work practice: Advances in theory & practice (3rd ed.). New York, NY: Columbia Press.

Gerson, R., McGoldrick, M., & Petry, S. (2008). Genograms: Assessment and intervention, 3rd ed. New York, NY: Norton Professional Books.

Ghafoor, A., Jemal, A., Ward, E., Cokkinides, V., Smith, R., & Thun, M. (2003). Trends in breast cancer by race and ethnicity. CA: Cancer Journal for Clinicians, 53(6), 342–355.

Given, B., Charles, W., Given, C., & Kozachik, S. (2001). Family support in advanced cancer. CA: Cancer Journal for Clinicians, 51, 213–231.

Glajchen, M. (2004). The emerging role and needs of family caregivers in cancer care. Journal of Supportive Oncology, 2(2), 145–155.

Gooding, H. C., Organista, K., Burack, J., & Biesecker, B. B. (2006). Genetic susceptibility testing from a stress and coping perspective. Social Science & Medicine, 62, 1880–1890.

Goodwin, P., Leszcz, M., Ennis, M., Koopmans, J., Vincent L., Guther, H., . . . Hunter, J. (2001). The effect of group psychosocial support on survival in metastatic breast cancer. New England Journal of Medicine, 345(24), 1719–1726.

Gotay, C. C. (2005). Behavior and cancer prevention. Journal of Clinical Oncology, 23, 301–310.

Gunnars, B., Nygren, P., & Glimelius, B. (2001). Assessment of quality of life during chemotherapy. Acta Oncologica, 40(2:3), 175–184.

Hauser, J., & Kramer, B. J. (2004). Family caregivers in palliative care. Clinics in Geriatric Medicine, 20, 671–688.

Harootyan, L., & O’Neill, G. (2006). National advocacy groups for older adults. In B. Berkman (Ed.), Handbook of social work in health and aging (pp. 817–822). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Hermann, J., & Carter, J. (1994). The dimensions of oncology social work: Intrapsychic, interpersonal, and environmental interventions. Seminars in Oncology, 21(6), 713–717.

Hermann, J. F. (2001). Children of cancer patients: Issues and interventions. In M. M. Lauria, E. J. Clark, J. F. Hermann, & N. M. Stearns (Eds.), Social work in oncology: Supporting survivors, families, and caregivers (pp. 73–92). Washington, DC: American Cancer Society.

Holland, J. C. (1998). Societal views of cancer and the emergence of psycho-oncology. In J. C. Holland (Ed.), Psycho-oncology (pp. 3–15). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Holland, J. C. (2002). History of psycho-oncology: Overcoming attitudinal and conceptual barriers. Psychosomatic Medicine, 64(2), 206–221.

Holland, J. C., & Lewis, S. (2000). The human side of cancer. New York, NY: HarperCollins.

Hudson, P., Aranda, S., & Kristjanson, L. (2004). Meeting the supportive needs of family caregivers in palliative care: Challenges for health professionals. Journal of Palliative Medicine, 7(1), 19–25.

Hudson, P., Thomas, T., Quinn, K., & Aranda, S. (2009). Family meetings in palliative care: Are they effective? Palliative Medicine, 23, 150–157.

Inouye, S., Studenski, S., Tinetti, M., & Kuchel, A. (2007). Geriatric syndromes: Clinical, research, and policy implications of a core geriatric concept. Journal of the American Geriatrics Society, 55(5), 780–791.

Institute for the Advancement of Social Work Research. (2003). Social Work’s Contribution To Research On Cancer Prevention, Detection, Diagnosis, Treatment And Survivorship. Retrieved from www .charityadvantage.com/iaswr/images/nci_final _report_9_15_03.pdf

Institute of Medicine. (2007). Cancer care for the whole patient: Meeting psychosocial health needs. Washington, DC: National Academies Press.

Jemal, A., Siegel, R., Ward, E., Hao, Y., Xu, J., Murray, T., & Thun, M. (2010). Cancer statistics: 2008. CA— Cancer Journal for Clinicians, 58, 71–96.

Johnson, B. H. (2000). Family-centered care: Four decades of progress. Family Systems & Health, 18(2), 133–156.

Kane, R., & Kane, R. (2005). Ageism in healthcare and long-term care. Generations, 29(3), 49–54.

Kauff, N. D., Domchek, S. M., Friebel, T. M., Robson, M. E., Lee, J., Garber, J. E., . . . Rebbeck, T. R. (2008). Risk-reducing salpingo-oophorectomy for the

JWBT514_ch19.indd 522JWBT514_ch19.indd 522 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

Oncology Social Work 523

prevention of BRCA1- and BRCA2-associated breast and gynecologic cancer: A multicenter, prospective study. Journal of Clinical Oncology, 26, 1331–1337.

Kayser, K., Watson, L., & Andrade, J. (2007). Cancer as a “we” disease: Examining the process of coping from a relational perspective. Families, Systems, & Health, 25(4), 404–418.

Keene, N., Hobbie, W., & Ruccione, K. (2000). Childhood cancer survivors: A practical guide to your future. Cambridge, MA: O’Reilley.

Kessler, R., Davis, R., Foster, D., Van Rompay, M. I., Walters, E. E., Wilkey, S. A., . . . Eisenberg, D. M. (2001). Long-term trends in the use of complementary and alternative medical therapies in the United States. Annals of Internal Medicine, 135(4), 262–268.

Kornbluth, A. B. (1998). Psychosocial adaptation of cancer survivors. In J. C. Holland (Ed.), Psycho-oncology (pp. 223–241). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Kramer, B. J. (1997). Gain in the caregiving experience: Where are we? What next? Gerontologist, 37(2), 218–232.

Kramer, B. J., Boelk, A., & Auer, C. (2006). Family confl ict at the end of life: Lessons learned in a model program for vulnerable older adults. Journal of Palliative Care, 9(3), 791–801.

Krause, N. (2006). Social relationships in late life. In R. Binstock & L. George (Eds.), Handbook of aging and the social sciences, 6th ed. (pp. 182–201). New York, NY: Academic Press.

Lawton, M. (2001). Quality of life and the end of life. In J. Birren & K. W. Schaie (Eds.), Handbook of the psychology of aging (5th ed., pp. 593–616). New York, NY: Academic Press.

Link, B., & Phelan J. (1995). Social conditions as fundamental causes of disease. Journal of Health & Social Behavior, 35, 80–94.

Livneh, H. (2000). Psychosocial adaptation to cancer: The role of coping strategies. Journal of Rehabilitation, 66(2), 40–50.

Lostumbo, L. N., Carbine, N. E., Wallace, J., Ezzo, J., & Dickersin, K. (2004). Prophylactic mastectomy for the prevention of breast cancer. Cochrane Database of Systematic Reviews, 4, CD002748.

Lux, M. P., Fasching, P. A., & Beckmann, M. W. (2006). Hereditary breast and ovarian cancer: Review and future perspectives. Journal of Molecular Medicine, 84, 16–28.

Lyyra, T., & Heikkinen, R. (2006). Perceived social support and mortality in older people. Journals of Gerontology, 61B, S147–S153.

Manne, S. (1998). Cancer in the marital context: A review of the literature. Cancer Investigation, 16(3), 188–202.

Marcusen, C., & Clark, E. (2001). Cancer and the elderly population. In M. Lauria, E. Clark, J. Hermann, & N. Stearns (Eds.), Social work in oncology: Supporting survivors, families, and caregivers (pp. 269–278). Washington, DC: American Cancer Society.

McGinnis, J. M., Williams-Russo, P., & Knickerman, J. R. (2002). The case for more active policy attention to health promotion. Health Affairs, 21(2), 78–93.

Meiser, B. (2005). Psychological impact of genetic testing for cancer susceptibility: An update of the literature. Psycho-Oncology, 14, 1060–1074.

Meiser, B., & Halliday, J. L. (2002). What is the impact of genetic counselling in women at increased risk of developing hereditary breast cancer? A meta-analytic review. Social Science & Medicine, 54(10), 1463–1470.

Mertens, A. C., Yasui, Y., Neglia, J. P., Potter, J. D., Nesbit, M. E., Jr., Ruccione, K., . . . Robison, L. L. (2001). Late mortality experience in fi ve-year survivors of childhood and adolescent cancer: The Childhood Cancer Survivor Study. Journal of Clinical Oncologists, 19, 3163–3172.

Metcalfe, K., Lynch, H. T., Ghadirian, P., & Nadine, T. (2004). Contralateral breast cancer in BRCA1 and BRCA2 mutation carriers. Journal of Clinical Oncology, 22, 2328–2335.

Meyer, C. (1995). The ecosystems perspective: Implications for practice. In C. Meyer & M. Mattaini (Eds.), The foundations of social work practice (pp. 72–89). Washington, DC: National Association of Social Workers.

Montgomery, C. (1999) Psycho-oncology: A coming of age. Psychiatric Bulletin, 23(7), 431–435.

Moren-Cross, J., & Lin, N. (2006). Social networks and health. In R. Binstock & L. George (Eds.), Handbook of aging and the social sciences, 6th ed., (pp. 111– 127). New York, NY: Academic Press.

Mukherjee, S. (2010). The emperor of all maladies: A biography of cancer. New York, NY: Scribner.

National Association of Social Workers. (2008). Code of ethics of the National Association of Social Workers. Retrieved from www.socialworkers.org/pubs/code /code.asp

National Cancer Institute. (2010). The nation’s investment in cancer research: 2011 plan. Retrieved from plan .cancer.gov/pdf/nci_2011_plan.pdf

National Hospice and Palliative Care Organization. (2010). The history of hospice care. Retrieved from www.nhpco.org/i4a/pages/index.cfm?pageid=3285

National Human Genome Research Institute. (n.d). Retrieved from www.genome.gov/

Nelson-Becker, H. (2005). Spiritual, religious, nonspiritual, and nonreligious narratives in marginalized older adults: A typology of coping styles. Journal of Religion, Spirituality and Aging, 17(1 & 2), 21–38.

Oeffi nger,  K., Mertens,  A., Sklar,  C., Kawashima, T., Hudson, M. M., Meadows, A. T., . . . Robison, L. L. (2006). Chronic health conditions in adult survivors of childhood cancer.  New England Journal of Medicine, 355(15), 1572–1582. 

Patenaude, A., & Kupst, M. (2005). Psychosocial functioning in pediatric cancer. Journal of Pediatric Psychology, 30(1), 9–27.

JWBT514_ch19.indd 523JWBT514_ch19.indd 523 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

524 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Patterson, J., & Garwick, A. (1994). The impact of chronic illness on families: A family systems perspective. Annals of Behavioral Medicine, 16(2), 131–142.

Peake, M., Thompson, S., Lowe, D., & Pearson, M. (2003). Ageism in the management of lung cancer. Age and Ageing, 32(2), 171–177.

Pérez Foster, R. M. (1998). The clinician’s cultural countertransference: The psychodynamics of culturally competent practice. Clinical Social Work Journal, 26(3), 253–270.

Pizzo, P. A. (2001). The medical diagnosis and treatment of childhood cancer. In M. M. Lauria, E. J. Clark, J. F. Hermann, & N. M. Stearns (Eds.), Social work in oncology: Supporting survivors, families, and caregivers (pp. 93–116). Washington, DC: American Cancer Society.

Rabow, M., Hauser, J., & Adams, J. (2004). The role of nurse practitioners in end-of-life care. JAMA, 291(4), 483–491.

Raveis, V., Gardner, D., Berkman, B., & Harootyan, L. (2010). Linking the NIH strategic plan to the research agenda for social workers in health and aging. Journal of Gerontological Social Work, 53(1), 77–93.

Rebbeck, T. R. (2002). Prophylactic oophorectomy in BRCA1 and BRCA2 mutation carriers. European Journal of Cancer, 38(6), 15–17.

Richardson, J. L., & Sanchez, K. (1998). Compliance with cancer treatment. In J. Holland (Ed.), Psycho-oncology (pp. 67–77). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Richardson, M. A., Sanders, T., Palmer, J. L., Greisinger, A., & Singletary, S. E. (2000). Complementary/ alternative medicine use in a comprehensive cancer center and the implications for oncology. Journal of Clinical Oncology, 18, 2505–2521.

Rohan, E., Berkman, B., Walker, S., & Holmes, W. (1994). The geriatric oncology patient: Ageism in social work practice. Journal of Gerontological Social Work, 23(1/2), 201–221.

Rolland, J. S. (2005). Cancer and the family: An integrative model. Cancer, 704(Suppl.), S2584–S2595.

Rosman, S. (2004). Cancer and stigma: experience of patients with chemotherapy-induced alopecia. Patient Education & Counseling, 4(52), 333–339.

Shavers, V., & Brown, M. (2002). Racial and ethnic disparities in the receipt of cancer treatment. Journal of the National Cancer Institute, 94(5), 334–357.

Shilds, G., Schondel, C., Barnhart, L., Fitzpatrick, V., Sidell, N., Adams, P., . . . Gomez, S. (1995). Social work in pediatric oncology: A family needs assessment. Social Work in Health Care, 21(1), 39–54.

Smith, E. D., Walsh-Burke, K., & Crusan, C. (1998). Principles of training social workers in oncology. In J. C. Holland (Ed.), Psycho-oncology (pp. 1061–1068). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Sontag, S. (2001). Illness as metaphor and AIDS and its metaphors. New York, NY: Picador USA.

Spiegel, D. (1996). Cancer and depression. British Journal of Psychiatry, 168 (Supp. 30), 109–116.

Spiegel, D., & Classen, C. (2000). Group therapy for cancer patients: A research-based handbook of psychosocial care. New York, NY: Basic Books.

Stanton, A., Cameron, C., Danoff-Burg, S., Bishop, M., Collins, C., Kirk, S., . . . Twillman, R. (2000). Emotionally expressive coping predicts psychological and physical adjustment to breast cancer. Journal of Consulting and Clinical Psychology, 68(5), 875–882.

Stearns, N. (2001). Professional issues in oncology social work. In M. M. Lauria, E. J. Clark, J. F. Hermann, & N. M. Stearns (Eds.), Social work in oncology: Supporting survivors, families, and caregivers (pp. 213– 232). Washington, DC: American Cancer Society.

Szabo, C. I., & King, M. C. (1997). Population genetics of BRCA1 and BRCA2. American Journal of Human Genetics, 60, 1013–1020. Retrieved from www.ncbi .nlm.nih.gov/pmc/articles/PMC1712447/

Tilden, V., Drach, L., & Tolle, S. (2004). Complementary and alternative therapy use at end-of-life in community settings. Journal of Alternative and Complementary Medicine, 10(5), 811–817.

Waldrop, D. (2007). Caregiver grief in terminal illness and bereavement: A mixed-methods study. Health & Social Work, 32(3), 197–206.

Waldrop, D., Kramer, B. J., Skretny, J., Milch, R., & Finn, W. (2005). Final transitions: Family caregiving at the end of life. Journal of Palliative Medicine, 8(3), 623–638.

Walsh, F. (2006). Strengthening family resilience, 2nd ed. New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Walsh, K. (2005). Oncology social work roles and functions across the continuum of care. Washington, DC: National Patient Advocate Foundation.

Waskul, D., & van der Riet, P. (2002). The abject embodiment of cancer patients: Dignity, selfhood and the grotesque body. Symbolic Interaction, 25, 487–513.

Weihs, K., & Politi, M. (2006). Family development in the face of cancer. In D. Crane & E. Marshall (Eds.), Handbook of Families and Health (pp. 3–18). Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.

Weinberg, R. (2006). The biology of cancer. Florence, KY: Garland Science.

Wells, A., & Zebrack, B. (2008). Psychosocial barriers contributing to the under-representation of racial/ ethnic minorities in cancer clinical trials. Social Work in Health Care, 46(2), 1–14.

Werner-Lin, A. (2010). Building the cancer family: Family planning in the context of inherited breast and ovarian cancer risk. Journal of the Society of Social Work and Research, 1(1), 14–27.

Werner-Lin, A., Biank, N., & Rubenstein, B. (2010). There’s no place like home: Preparing children for geographical and relational attachment disruptions following parental death to cancer. Clinical Social Work Journal, 38, 132–143.

JWBT514_ch19.indd 524JWBT514_ch19.indd 524 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

Oncology Social Work 525

Werner-Lin, A., & Gardner, D. (2009). Family illness narratives of inherited cancer risk: Continuity and transformation. Families, Systems & Health, 27(3), 201–212.

Werth, J., Gordon, J., & Johnson, R. (2002). Psychosocial issues near the end of life. Aging and Mental Health, 6, 402–412.

Williams D. (1997). Race and health: Basic questions, emerging directions. Annals of Epidemiology, 7, 322–333.

Witter, D., & LeBas, J. (2008). Cancer as a chronic disease. OncoLog, 53(4). Retrieved from www2 .mdanderson.org/depts/oncolog/articles/08/4-apr /4-08-1.html

Wolff, J., Dy, S., Frick, K., & Kasper, J. (2007). End-of- life care: Findings from a national survey of informal caregivers. Archives of Internal Medicine, 167(1), 40–46.

Woods, N., LaCroix, A., Gray, S., Aragaki, A., Cochrane, G., Brunner, R., . . . Newman, A. (2005). Frailty: Emergence and consequences in women aged 65 and older in the Women’s Health Initiative Observational Study. Journal of the American Geriatrics Society, 53(8), 1321–1330.

Wright, L. (1999). Spirituality, suffering and beliefs: The soul of healing with families. In F. Walsh (Ed.),

Spiritual resources in family therapy (pp. 61–75). New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Zabora, J., Brintzenhofeszoc, K., Curbow, B., Hooker, C., & Piantadosi, S. (2001). The prevalence of psychological distress by cancer site. Psycho-Oncology, 10(19), 19–28.

Zabora, J., Brintzenhofeszoc, K., Jacobsen, P., Curbow, B., Piantadosi, S., Hooker, C., . . . Derogatis, L. (2001). A new psychosocial screening instrument for use with cancer patients. Psychosomatics, 42(3), 241–246.

Zebrack, B., Casillas J., Nohr, L., Adams, H., & Zeltzer, L. (2004). Fertility issues for young adult survivors of childhood cancer. Psycho-Oncology, 13(10), 689–699.

Zebrack, B., & Chesler, M. (2001). Health-related worries, self-image, and life outlooks of long-term survivors of childhood cancer. Health & Social Work, 26(4), 245–256.

Zebrack, B., Jaehee, Y., Petersen, L., & Ganz, P. A. (2007). The impact of cancer and quality of life for long-term survivors. Psycho-Oncology, 17(9), 891–900.

Zebrack, B., Walsh, K., Burg, M. A., Maramaldi, P., & Lim, J. (2008). Oncology social worker competencies and implications for education and training. Social Work in Health Care, 47(4), 355–375.

JWBT514_ch19.indd 525JWBT514_ch19.indd 525 9/21/11 7:45 PM9/21/11 7:45 PM

526

20

Adherence and Mental Health Issues in Chronic Disease: Diabetes, Heart Disease, and HIV/AIDS

WENDY AUSLANDER AND STACEY FREEDENTHAL

Direct practice issues increasingly present challenges for social workers who treat people with chronic disease. Rates of chronic disease continue to grow, and psychosocial problems often accompany or arise from chronic dis- ease. People with chronic diseases face many diffi culties maintaining sometimes complex and burdensome treatment regimens. As mem- bers of the health-care team who have exper- tise in mental health and behavioral issues, social workers are in a unique position to help people who have a chronic disease.

This chapter provides an overview of the epidemiology of heart disease, diabe- tes, and human immunodefi ciency virus (HIV)/acquired immunodefi ciency syndrome (AIDS), three common chronic diseases that social workers encounter within health-care and community settings. Then it describes a systematic practice model with which social workers can promote patient adherence to treatment, provides a review of strategies that enhance patients’ recall of information, and provides instructions for social workers to use in their role as educators. Finally, the chap- ter describes the relationship between mental health problems and chronic disease etiology and management.

Many other direct practice issues are im- portant for social workers who treat persons with chronic disease, such as family and indi- vidual coping, social support, developmental

issues as they relate to illness and economic and cultural factors that infl uence disease man- agement; these issues are discussed in detail elsewhere in this book (see Chapters 7, 10, and 13).

Chapter Objectives • Exhibit knowledge about the epidemiology

of heart disease, HIV/AIDS, and diabetes in the United States, including racial and ethnic disparities.

• Identify and assess psychosocial factors that infl uence adherence to treatment among in- dividuals with chronic disease.

• Incorporate a systematic model of adher- ence counseling in practice with individuals with chronic disease.

• Understand the importance of communi- cation techniques in patient education and adherence counseling for individuals with chronic disease.

• Understand the relationship between men- tal health and chronic disease.

CURRENT TRENDS IN THE CARE OF PATIENTS WITH A CHRONIC DISEASE

Signifi cant changes in the health status of Americans have occurred within the past century due to some relatively recent trends.

JWBT514_ch20.indd 526JWBT514_ch20.indd 526 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Adherence and Mental Health Issues in Chronic Disease: Diabetes, Heart Disease, and HIV/AIDS 527

For one thing, individuals are living longer than ever before. The average life span in the United States increased by 27 years in the past century—from 49.2 years in 1900 to 76.5 years in 2000 (Guyer, Freedman, Strobino, & Sondik, 2000)—largely due to public health measures such as vaccinations, antibiotics, and other methods for controlling infectious diseases (Centers for Disease Control and Pre- vention [CDC], 1999a). A second trend is an increase in the number of individuals living with chronic diseases because of advances in medical treatment and technology and the in- creasing average life span. In addition, chronic diseases have replaced infectious diseases as the leading causes of death in the United States (Guyer et al., 2000). For example, in 1900, the top causes of death were pneumonia, tubercu- losis, and intestinal problems such as diarrhea (CDC, 1999b). Combined with diphtheria, these acute diseases accounted for one-third of all deaths in the United States (CDC, 1999b). Today, heart disease, diabetes, and AIDS are chronic diseases that are among the top causes of death; heart disease is the number-one cause of death in the United States, diabetes ranks 7th, and HIV/AIDS ranks 20th (CDC, 2010b) Although still incurable, these diseases often respond to medications, surgery, or other types of medical management.

The increasing prevalence of chronic dis- ease in the United States has led to a major shift from viewing individuals as consumers of health care to seeing them for what they really are—providers of health care. Most of the responsibility for preventing and manag- ing chronic disease lies with the patient and the patient’s family. Individuals with chronic disease and their families are the members of the health-care team who are most responsible for the day-to-day activities necessary to carry out treatment regimens. Because of this shift in perspective, understanding how to promote patient adherence to treatment has become in- creasingly important in the past two decades. In particular, diabetes, HIV/AIDS, and heart disease are chronic diseases that, once di- agnosed, require adherence to complex and challenging treatment regimens. Prevention

of these diseases involves behavioral changes such as weight loss, exercise, dietary changes, and reduction of risky sexual behaviors, all of which patients may have diffi culty maintain- ing in the long term.

In addition to the importance of patient adherence in chronic disease prevention and management, three other issues related to chronic disease are also important for social workers to understand.

1. There are no known cures for chronic dis- eases such as diabetes, heart disease, and HIV/AIDS, and they are usually progres- sive in nature. Unlike some disabilities or acute illnesses, chronic diseases fl uctuate in symptoms and disease-related compli- cations. Disease-specifi c complications for individuals with chronic disease can be viewed as “predictable crises” (Hamburg & Inoff, 1983) because they can cause a state of anxiety and disequilibrium that is expected, given what we know about how the diseases progress.

2. Because of the progressive nature of chronic disease, the patient and family must adjust to continual treatment changes. For exam- ple, new medications continually are being developed that often subject the patient to new side effects. The past few decades have seen new medical technologies for the man- agement of diabetes (e. g., insulin infusion pumps and home glucose monitoring), yet they all include some costs (e. g., fi nancial and physical pain) along with the benefi ts they provide for patients.

3. Because chronic diseases usually continue throughout the patient’s lifetime, develop- mental and lifestyle changes (such as preg- nancy, puberty, divorce, or college) often infl uence or pose additional challenges to the person with a chronic disease.

Each of these challenges (i.e., disease, treat- ment regimens, and developmental changes), unique to chronic diseases, offers opportuni- ties for social work intervention to promote positive adaptation and management behaviors among patients.

JWBT514_ch20.indd 527JWBT514_ch20.indd 527 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

528 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

EPIDEMIOLOGY OF DIABETES, HEART DISEASE, AND HIV/AIDS

Social workers encounter people with heart disease, diabetes, and HIV/AIDS in virtually all health-care settings, including emergency rooms, hospitals, outpatient clinics, commu- nity centers, hospices, nursing homes, and rehabilitation centers. Before describing some practice issues for social workers who work with individuals who have been diagnosed

with diabetes, heart disease, and HIV/AIDS, we fi rst present an overview of disease rates, risk factors, racial and ethnic disparities and other information related to these three major killers in the United States and worldwide (see Table 20.1).

Heart Disease: A Leading Killer

The term heart disease can refer to any of sev- eral cardiac conditions including coronary ar- tery disease, congestive heart failure, and heart

Table 20.1 Epidemiology of Chronic Diseases in the United States

Heart Disease Diabetes HIV/AIDS

Deaths (in 2007)a

Ranking 1 7 20b

Number 616,067 71,382 11,295

Percentage in the United States 25.4% 2.9% 0.5%

People living with disease 18 millionc 13.4 million (6.6%)d

16.7 million (8.3%)c HIV: 800,000e

AIDS: 362,827d

Possible symptoms Chest pain or tightness Shortness of breath Fluid retention

Excessive thirst Frequent urination Extreme hunger Unusual weight loss Fatigue Blurry vision

Rapid weight loss Recurring fever or night sweats Profound fatigue Swollen lymph glands Chronic diarrhea Pneumonia

Risk factors Diabetes High cholesterol High blood pressure Smoking Physical inactivity Obesity Older age Family history

Type 2 only Obesity Physical inactivity Older age Family history Black, Hispanic, or American Indian/Alaska Native High blood pressure

Unprotected sex Injection drug use

Preventive measures Exercise Diet rich with fi ber, fruits, and vegetables No smoking

Type 2 only Weight control Healthy diet

Condom use Clean needles Blood donor screening

aFrom “WISQARS Leading Cause of Death Reports: 1981–1998,” by Centers for Disease Control and Prevention (2010b), retrieved from http://webappa.cdc.gov/sasweb/ncipc/leadcaus9.html bHIV ranks as the 8th leading cause of death for the 15- to 54-year-old age group. cFrom “Prevalence of Diabetes and Impaired Fasting Glucose in Adults: United States, 1999–2000,” by C. C. Cowie, K. F. Rust, D. Byrd-Holt, M. S. Eberhardt, S. Saydah, L. S. Geiss, et al., 2003, Morbidity and Mortality Weekly Report, 52, pp. 833–837. dFrom Summary Health Statistics for U.S. Adults: National Health Interview Survey, 2002 (DHHS Publication No. PHS 2004–1550), by U.S. Department of Health and Human Services, 2004, Hyattsville, MD: Author. eFrom HIV/AIDS Surveillance Report, 13th ed. (pp. 1–44), Centers for Disease Control and Prevention, 2001. Atlanta, GA: Author.

JWBT514_ch20.indd 528JWBT514_ch20.indd 528 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Adherence and Mental Health Issues in Chronic Disease: Diabetes, Heart Disease, and HIV/AIDS 529

attack. Heart disease itself is a type of cardio- vascular disease, along with hypertension and stroke. Stroke also is a major leading cause of death in the United States and results from the brain being deprived of oxygen, usually due to plaque in the arteries (CDC, 2010b). Although stroke and hypertension are themselves impor- tant public health problems, this section fo- cuses only on chronic diseases directly related to the heart (see Table 20.2).

Gender

Many people mistakenly believe that heart disease primarily affects men, when in fact men have experienced a decline in heart fa- talities in recent years. However, the rate of heart disease in women continues to increase (American Heart Association, 2002), and heart disease has become the leading cause of death for women (CDC, 2010b). Hormones, particularly estrogen, appear to protect many women from heart disease until after meno- pause, although a causal relationship is not certain (Barrett-Connor, 2003). Research in- dicates that hormone replacement therapy for postmenopausal women actually may in- crease the risk of heart disease (Manson et al., 2003). This negative effect may increase with age, with estrogen having a positive effect in the years immediately following menopause (Manson et al., 2007).

Racial and Ethnic Disparities

Like diabetes and HIV/AIDS, heart disease disproportionately affects certain racial and ethnic minority groups. Of the 700,000 people who died of heart disease in the U.S. general population in 2007, 19.5% were younger than 65 years (CDC, 2010b). Yet among American Indians and Alaska Natives, 38.1% of people who died of heart disease were younger than 65 years (CDC, 2010b). The rates were 35.4% and 26.5% for African Americans and His- panic Americans, respectively (CDC, 2010b). The reasons for these disparities are not fully understood but may include factors such as dif- ferences in access to medical and emergency care, diet, exercise, risk behaviors such as smoking, and health behaviors such as check- ing blood pressure regularly. For example, the proportion of American Indians who smoke is twice that of White Americans; African Americans are more likely than White Ameri- cans to have high blood pressure; and African Americans, American Indians, and Hispanic Americans are more likely than White Ameri- cans to lack health insurance coverage (Bolen, Rhodes, Powell-Griner, Bland, & Holtzman, 2000). Physician bias also may contribute to racial and ethnic disparities in heart disease fatalities. In an experiment using videotaped, hypothetical case scenarios, physicians were almost twice as likely to recommend a heart

Table 20.2 Major Types of Heart Disease

Name Description

Coronary artery disease Arteries become hardened and narrowed by plaque (arteriosclerosis), decreasing blood fl ow to the heart and oxygen to the heart muscle.

Acute myocardial infarction (“heart attack”) A blood clot cuts off blood to part of the heart, resulting in damage to the heart muscle and sometimes death.

Congestive heart failure The heart fails to pump blood effectively, resulting in shortness of breath, fl uid retention, and fatigue.

Congenital heart defects The heart or blood vessels around the heart failed to develop properly at birth.

Cardiomyopathy The heart muscle is weakened.

Angina Chest pain or discomfort is caused by the heart not getting enough blood, usually as a result of arteriosclerosis (hardening of the arteries).

JWBT514_ch20.indd 529JWBT514_ch20.indd 529 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

530 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

procedure to White Americans and men than to African Americans and women despite identical symptoms among all the characters (Schulman et al., 1999).

Diabetes: A Global Epidemic

Diabetes mellitus affects the body’s ability to metabolize blood glucose (sugar). A healthy person’s pancreas produces suffi cient insulin for cells to absorb and convert food into blood sugar. With diabetes, the person’s body either fails to use insulin properly or produce it at all. Many people with diabetes must therefore limit their sugar intake or take insulin by either giv- ing themselves injections or using an insulin infusion pump. When diabetes is uncontrolled and blood sugar levels get too high (hypergly- cemia), the individual may experience short- ness of breath; nausea; vomiting; excessive thirst; and a life-threatening, precoma condi- tion called diabetic ketoacidosis. Controlled diabetes always carries the risk of hypogly- cemia (low blood sugar) caused by too much insulin or medication. Symptoms and signs of hypoglycemia include shakiness, irritability, heart palpitations, hunger, and sweating. Left untreated, severe hypoglycemia can lead to loss of consciousness, seizures, and coma.

Most people with diabetes live and function for many years with the disease. Many people with diabetes are not even aware they have it because the onset of symptoms is gradual. Yet diabetes can take an enormous toll on a person’s health and quality of life. People with diabetes commonly develop an array of complications that can include cardiovascu- lar disease, vision problems (including blind- ness), amputations, kidney failure, and nerve damage. Ultimately, diabetes can be fatal. It ranked as the seventh leading cause of death in the United States in 2007, resulting in 71,382 deaths (CDC, 2010b). Mortality rates under- estimate the true extent of diabetes’s lethality because the damage it exacts on lungs, tissues, and organs contributes to other major causes of death—heart disease, stroke, and kid- ney disease, to name a few (National Center for Health Statistics [NCHS], 2010). Half of

people with diabetes eventually die of heart disease or stroke (World Health Organization [WHO], 2009a).

Types of Diabetes

There are four major types of diabetes. Type 1 diabetes, formerly called juvenile diabetes, frequently is diagnosed in children and young adults and accounts for 5% to 10% of all dia- betes cases (National Institute of Diabetes and Digestive and Kidney Diseases [NIDDK], 2008). Type 1 diabetes is an autoimmune dis- ease, whereby a person’s immune system inap- propriately attacks necessary tissues. In type 1 diabetes, the immune system destroys the cells that produce the hormone insulin, which me- tabolizes blood sugar. People with type 1 dia- betes must take insulin every day, sometimes before every meal, via injections or an insulin infusion pump.

Type 2 diabetes accounts for 90% to 95% of all diabetes cases (NIDDK, 2008). In type 2 diabetes, formerly called adult-onset diabe- tes, the body still may produce insulin, but the body’s cells cannot absorb it. Eventually the pancreas may lose the ability to produce insu- lin altogether. This type of diabetes frequently is associated with being overweight and physi- cally inactive. Many people with type 2 dia- betes control their blood sugar by managing their diet, losing weight, exercising regularly, and taking oral medications. Roughly 10% to 15% of people with type 2 diabetes require in- sulin, either alone or in combination with oral medication (NIDDK, 2008).

Gestational diabetes is a form of glucose intolerance that occurs in about 14% of women during pregnancy (Kim, Newton, & Knopp, 2002). The condition typically disappears after childbirth, but various studies have shown that, 2.6% to 7% of women with gestational diabe- tes develop type 2 diabetes (Kim et al., 2002).

Other types of diabetes include conditions caused by genetic defects, drug use, infection, or less common forms of autoimmune illness (American Diabetes Association, 2004). These types of diabetes are the least common, mak- ing up only 1% to 5% of diabetes cases in the United States (NIDDK, 2008).

JWBT514_ch20.indd 530JWBT514_ch20.indd 530 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Adherence and Mental Health Issues in Chronic Disease: Diabetes, Heart Disease, and HIV/AIDS 531

Epidemiology

Diabetes has been diagnosed in more than 17.9 million people in the United States, and an additional 5.7 million people are believed to have diabetes without being aware of their condition (NIDDK, 2008). Diabetes rates have increased substantially in recent years, includ- ing a 50% increase in the United States from 1997 to 2004 (CDC, 2006). Rates are increas- ing so rapidly nationally and worldwide that the WHO regards it as an epidemic with pre- mature deaths of a similar magnitude, although less recognized, to HIV/AIDS (WHO, 2004). More than 1.1 million people worldwide died from diabetes in 2005 (WHO, 2009a). About 220 million people worldwide have been di- agnosed with diabetes (WHO, 2009a), and the number is expected to increase to 366 million by 2030 (Wild, Roglic, Green, Sicree, & King, 2004). The number of Americans with diabe- tes is expected to grow to 38 million during the same time period (Mainous et al., 2007).

Risk Factors

Type 2 diabetes is considered to be largely pre- ventable. The increasing prevalence of type 2 diabetes parallels increases in obesity, sugar and fat consumption, and physical inactivity in today’s society (Mokdad et al., 2000). Dia- betes is almost twice as common in developed countries than in developing countries (Black, 2002), refl ecting the excess fat consumption and lack of exercise that often accompany higher socioeconomic status.

Racial and Ethnic Disparities

People from certain racial and ethnic minor- ity groups are especially vulnerable to diabe- tes (Black, 2002). Compared to non-Hispanic White populations, Hispanic people in the United States are 1.5 times more likely to have diabetes, African Americans are 1.6 times more likely, and American Indians and Alaska Natives are 2.3 times more likely (CDC, 2004a). For example, almost 1 in 4 Af- rican American women between the ages of 65 and 74 years have diabetes (Tull & Roseman, 1995). In some areas of the country, more than

1 in 3 American Indians have type 2 diabetes (Lee et al., 2000). Pima Indians in southern Arizona have the highest rate of diabetes in the world, with 1 of every 2 tribal members diagnosed with the disease (Black, 2002; Knowler, Saad, Pettitt, Nelson, & Bennett, 1993). The higher rates of diabetes among mi- norities are attributed to having less access to health care and genetic differences in glucose tolerance in addition to the other primary risk factors of diabetes, including higher rates of obesity and inactivity (Black, 2002).

Racial and ethnic minorities in the United States also tend to suffer greater negative ef- fects from diabetes than White Americans. For example, compared to White Americans in the United States, rates of death attributable to diabetes among African Americans and His- panic Americans are twice as high and, among American Indians, 3 times as high (CDC, 2000).

HIV/AIDS: FROM TERMINAL ILLNESS TO CHRONIC DISEASE

HIV and AIDS are two different but overlap- ping disorders. HIV infects the body’s immune system, in particular cells called T4 lympho- cytes (T cells), which protect the body against infection and other threats. AIDS is the most advanced stage of HIV infection and is defi ned as a specifi c group of diseases or conditions that severely suppress the body’s immune sys- tem (CDC, 2001). An HIV-positive person is diagnosed with AIDS when he or she has fewer than 200 T cells per cubic millimeter of blood, in comparison to levels of more than 1,000 in healthy adults (National Institute of Allergy and Infectious Diseases [NIAID], 2003). It can take 10 or more years for an HIV-positive person to develop AIDS (NIAID, 2003). This lag time makes the virus especially dangerous, because infected individuals may unknow- ingly pass HIV to others.

HIV is transmitted through contact with infected blood, which can occur from sexual contact, sharing needles, or blood transfusions.

JWBT514_ch20.indd 531JWBT514_ch20.indd 531 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

532 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Women also can pass the virus on to their in- fants during pregnancy, birth, or breast milk. The use of condoms during sexual intercourse may prevent the transmission of HIV. Public health approaches to preventing HIV include screening blood donations, promoting non- sharing of needles, and distributing free con- doms on college campuses.

Epidemiology

The fi rst case of AIDS was reported in 1981 in the United States (NIAID, 2003). Within just four years, AIDS was diagnosed in 16,000 people in the United States, 8,000 of whom died (Center for Infectious Diseases, 1985). A diagnosis of HIV or AIDS used to be a virtual death sentence. The median survival time for a person in the United States newly diagnosed with AIDS in the mid-1980s was 11.6 months (Jacobson et al., 1993). No effective treat- ments existed, and patients’ suppressed im- mune systems made them vulnerable to dying from infections not typically deadly among young individuals, such as pneumonia.

The death rate from HIV/AIDS in the United States slowed in 1996, when patients began taking potent medications called highly active antiretroviral therapy (HAART). This therapy combines different types of medica- tions in what is frequently called a drug cock- tail. The medications in a drug cocktail are reverse transcriptase inhibitors, which prevent the virus from making copies of itself, and protease inhibitors, which control the enzyme in HIV that spreads infectious viral particles. Antiretroviral therapy does not cure HIV or AIDS, but it does reduce the amount of virus and prolong both the quality and length of life. After the introduction of antiretroviral therapy in the United States, deaths from HIV declined dramatically—from 31,130 deaths in 1996 to 16,516 in 1997 (CDC, 2010b). That same year, HIV/AIDS fell out of the top 10 causes of death. A study of AIDS deaths in 12 high-income countries found that antiretrovi- ral therapy reduced mortality by 85% overall (Bhaskaran et al., 2008).

In recent years, AIDS deaths in the United States have consistently declined, dropping

from 14,478 deaths in 2000 to 11,295 in 2007, the most recent year with available statistics (CDC, 2010b). Most deaths from AIDS occur in younger people; among youth and adults age 15 to 54 years, HIV is the eighth leading cause of death in the United States (CDC, 2010b).

AIDS Worldwide: A Leading Cause of Death

At least 20 million people worldwide have died from AIDS since the very fi rst case was reported almost 30 years ago (Joint United Na- tions Programme on HIV/AIDS [UNAIDS], 2004). HIV/AIDS now ranks as the sixth lead- ing cause of death worldwide (WHO, 2008). The devastation is enormous, particularly in southern Africa, which accounts for 22 million of the world’s 33 million AIDS cases (WHO, 2009b). In 2008 alone, 1.4 million people in southern Africa died of AIDS (UNAIDS, 2009). New, potent antiretroviral medications have only recently become available to people in these poorer countries; only 7% of south- ern Africans with HIV received antiretroviral medications in 2003, compared with 48% in 2008 (UNAIDS, 2009). Furthermore, rates of HIV continue to increase. In 2008, an esti- mated 2.7 million people in the world acquired HIV (UNAIDS, 2009).

Almost all new HIV infections occur in the world’s developing countries, and they spread most commonly through heterosexual con- tact. In Africa, more than 80% of HIV infec- tions among women result from heterosexual contact, and the remainder are transmitted from mother to child or via blood transfusion (Lamptey, 2002).

Gender and AIDS

For many years, AIDS was identifi ed in the United States, often pejoratively, as a “gay disease” because the majority of AIDS- related cases occurred among men who had sex with men without using a condom to protect against sexually transmitted diseases (CDC, 2001; Herek & Glunt, 1988). Yet even from its earliest days, the disease also claimed the lives of women who had sex with HIV-positive men, infants and children born

JWBT514_ch20.indd 532JWBT514_ch20.indd 532 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Adherence and Mental Health Issues in Chronic Disease: Diabetes, Heart Disease, and HIV/AIDS 533

to mothers who had AIDS, people who re- ceived tainted blood transfusions, and people who used injectable drugs and shared con- taminated needles.

The disease still disproportionately affl icts men who have sex with men in the United States, but that is changing. In 2008, one- third of people newly infected with AIDS contracted the disease through heterosexual contact (CDC, 2010a). Nationally, HIV is more common among men than women, with 75% of cases occurring in men (CDC, 2010a). Worldwide, almost half of all people with AIDS are female, and heterosexual con- tact is the primary means of infection (UN- AIDS, 2009). For example, 60% of people infected with HIV in southern Africa are women and girls (UNAIDS, 2009). Gender inequalities, especially including violence against women, are blamed for women’s dis- proportionate burden of the disease in Africa (UNAIDS, 2009).

Racial and Ethnic Disparities

In wealthier, industrialized countries such as the United States, deaths from AIDS have dropped for all racial and socioeconomic groups since antiretroviral therapies began, but the progress has been smaller for some vulner- able groups. The decline in deaths was lowest among African American women and highest among White American men and residents of more affl uent areas (Karon, Fleming, Steketee, & DeCock, 2001). Furthermore, HIV rates are increasing among African Americans, Asian Americans, and American Indians (CDC, 2010a). Although African Americans make up 13% of the U.S. population, they accounted for 52% of all new HIV infections in 2008 (CDC, 2010a). A study of 38 states that keep track of HIV cases found that the highest rates of HIV infection occur among African Americans (CDC, 2010a). The disparities largely refl ect differences in HIV-testing patterns and access to new drugs (Karon et al., 2001). Minorities, women, and people with low income may be less likely to have access to and receive ef- fective therapy for HIV and AIDS (Andersen et al., 2000).

AIDS in the United States: A Continuing Public Health Problem

Although more people with HIV and AIDS in the United States survive and function well with antiretroviral therapy, the conditions still represent major, national public health prob- lems (Arias, Anderson, Kung, Murphy, & Ko- chanek, 2003). Even though AIDS deaths have declined, the number of HIV cases reported each year continues to grow (CDC, 2010b). HIV primarily affects young people, espe- cially minorities. Medical researchers caution that the new drug therapies have resulted in treatment-resistant types of HIV. Even when the drug cocktails are effective and acces- sible, many people fail to take them properly because of complicated dosing regimens and side effects (Conway, 2007; Fleming, Wortley, Karon, DeCock, & Janssen, 2000). Immedi- ate side effects can include rash, recurrent or chronic diarrhea, vomiting, and fatigue; long- term effects can include pancreatic, liver, and kidney dysfunction (Sax & Kumar, 2004). Although some writers disagree (e.g., Elford, 2006), others have suggested that the new, ef- fective treatments lead to complacency among high-risk groups who used to protect them- selves against HIV infection (Fleming et al., 2000). For these reasons, social workers in health-care settings will continue to encoun- ter people who are HIV-positive or living with AIDS.

ADHERENCE TO TREATMENT REGIMENS

The successful management of diabetes, heart disease, and HIV/AIDS depends largely on the extent to which patients adhere to and take responsibility for their treatment regimens. As such, facilitating patient adherence to medical regimens has emerged as an important function for the social worker on the health-care team. Adherence is defi ned broadly as the extent to which a patient’s behavior corresponds with medical advice (Meichenbaum & Turk, 1987). Although the terms adherence and compliance

JWBT514_ch20.indd 533JWBT514_ch20.indd 533 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

534 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

sometimes are used interchangeably, adher- ence implies an active and collaborative role with health-care professionals whereas com- pliance connotes a more passive, submissive role. Treatment effectiveness for many chronic diseases, such as diabetes, heart disease, and HIV/AIDS, is strongly infl uenced by the pa- tient’s willingness and ability to adhere to a complicated medical regimen.

For example, the diabetes treatment regi- men involves multiple daily insulin injections or use of an insulin infusion pump for type 1 diabetes or oral medications for type 2 diabe- tes, frequent daily blood glucose testing, ad- herence to a meal plan, and a regular exercise program. Adherence to treatment for heart dis- ease involves diet and exercise as well as oral medications, blood pressure and lipid monitor- ing, and regular visits to the cardiologist for routine stress tests and electrocardiograms. For HIV/AIDS, adherence to preventive behaviors (e.g., use of condoms and clean needles) is necessary to reduce the risk of transmission or infection; once infected, adherence to treat- ment is critical for slowing progression and delaying complications of HIV. Current treat- ment guidelines for HIV recommend HAART, a complex regimen of usually three or four an- tiretroviral drugs (Deeks, Smith, Holodniy, & Kahn, 1997).

The magnitude of nonadherence to medical regimens has been studied for decades. In a re- view of 50 years of research across 569 stud- ies, nonadherence ranged from 4.6% to 100%, with an average of 75.2% (DiMatteo, 2004). In this review, adherence was signifi cantly higher in more recent smaller studies, those involving pharmacological treatment rather than modi- fi ed health behaviors, and populations with greater resources such as higher education and income. The IOM revealed that approximately 90 million adults have low literacy, the literacy profi ciency needed to understand and respond to health information (Kindig, Nielsen- Bohlman, & Panzer, 2004). Individuals with low income, ethnic minorities, and those who live in rural areas are more likely to face health literacy barriers (Kirsch, Jungeblut, Jenkins & Kolstad, 1993).

Many studies have examined the correlates or predictors of adherence among individuals with diabetes, heart disease, and HIV/AIDS, such as familial, mental health, health beliefs, literacy, and demographic factors (Anderson, Auslander, Jung, Miller, & Santiago, 1990; Auslander, Thompson, Dreitzer, White, & Santiago, 1997; DiMatteo, Haskard, & Wil- liams, 2007; Frain, Bishop, Tschopp, Ferrin, & Frain, 2009; Glasgow & Toobert, 1988; Jacobson et al., 1990). Results from several studies indicate that the degree of adherence to one aspect of the diabetic regimen is un- related to adherence to other aspects of the regimen (Glasgow, Wilson, & McCaul, 1985). These data suggest that there are multiple in- fl uences on patient adherence and highlight the complexities involved in facilitating be- havioral changes among individuals with chronic disease.

More recently, there has been an increase in the number of studies about adherence to HAART in patients infected with HIV. This is due in part to the fact that effective treat- ment requires at least a 95% adherence rate to HAART to reduce viral loads and pre- vent drug-resistant HIV variants (Chesney, 2003). Because nonadherence among these patients can increase the risk of death sig- nificantly, studies have focused on the bar- riers to adherence as well as factors that promote adherence behaviors (Chesney, 2003; Garcia & Cote, 2003; Steele & Grauer, 2003). Identified barriers to adher- ence include complicated dosing schedules and food restrictions, medication side ef- fects, psychosocial issues (i.e., substance abuse, depression, stress), and unsupportive relationships with providers (Altica, Mosta- shari, & Friedland, 2001; Chesney, 2003; Gonzalez et al., 2004).

Likewise, a review of the literature on the antecedents of adherence of cardiovascular risk reduction (Cohen, 2009) indicated that the collaborative relationship between the practi- tioner and patient is very important. Adherence is infl uenced by perception of personal risk, decision support, motivation, self-effi cacy, and credible health information.

JWBT514_ch20.indd 534JWBT514_ch20.indd 534 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Adherence and Mental Health Issues in Chronic Disease: Diabetes, Heart Disease, and HIV/AIDS 535

Systematic Model of Adherence Counseling

Many studies have evaluated the effi cacy or effectiveness of interventions designed to im- prove adherence to treatment regimens, par- ticularly for patients with diabetes and HIV/ AIDS (Anderson, Brackett, Ho, & Laffel, 1999; Smith-Rogers, Miller, Murphy, Tanney, & Fortune, 2001; Wysocki et al., 2000), and there are numerous systematic reviews of adherence interventions (van Dulmen et al., 2007). Yet few studies have specifi ed the pro- cesses of adherence counseling that are com- mon across these interventions. The adherence counseling process described in this chapter is not an evidence-based intervention, but rather a comprehensive and systematic overview of strategies that have been shown to improve ad- herence in clinical settings (Auslander, 1993; Auslander, Bubb, Peelle, & Rogge, 1989; Bubb, Auslander, & Manthei, 1989; Lorenz et al., 1996). The approach has a cognitive- behavioral orientation and integrates classic works by Becker (1974; Becker & Maiman, 1980), Meichenbaum and Turk (1987), and Marlatt and Gordon (1985). Typically, evi- dence-based interventions to improve adher- ence target a portion of the behavioral change strategies outlined in this model, such as en- couraging peer and family support, assessing and modifying health beliefs, or encourag- ing joint decision making. In practice, social workers often use all of the strategies, either singly or in various combinations, depending on the adherence-related problem. As shown in Table 20.3, adherence counseling includes four distinct phases that the social worker im- plements: (1) assessment and identifi cation of adherence problems, (2) planning the medical treatment regimen, (3) facilitating behavioral change, and (4) maintaining patient adherence.

Phase 1: Assess and Identify Adherence Problems

The assessment phase focuses on those fac- tors that are most likely to infl uence adher- ence. Clinical experience and health behavior research have identifi ed several areas that are

associated with a patient’s willingness and ability to follow a treatment regimen (Marlatt & Gordon, 1985; Meichenbaum & Turk, 1987). These areas include social support, lifestyle, fi nancial status, psychological well- being, health beliefs, past adherence history, and satisfaction with the treatment regimen (see Table 20.3). Assessment of these fac- tors provides information that is important in developing a realistic treatment plan de- signed to increase the probability of regimen adherence.

Social Support. The family assessment is designed to identify family strengths and risk factors associated with adherence. The family assessment should include: (a) the family’s so- cial and economic status; (b) the family’s will- ingness to be supportive and competence to do so (i.e., family member’s disease knowledge, technical skills, ability to learn, problem-solv- ing ability, and organizational skills); (c) fam- ily stressors, such as divorce, remarriage, loss of a job, a new baby, or a death in the family; and (d) observation of family interactions to gain information about the family’s ability to work together and resolve confl ict. This is an important area, given the wealth of research that shows signifi cant associations between family characteristics and adherence (Ander- son et al., 1990; Glasgow & Toobert, 1988; Thompson, Auslander, & White, 2001a,b). Pa- tients spend a great deal of their time at work or school, and, as at home, they need coop- eration from those around them to create an environment that promotes adherence. Patients also need competent assistance in the case of a medical emergency. Therefore, it is crucial to assess the extent of support available from friends, teachers, coworkers, employers, and others outside of the family.

Lifestyle/Daily Schedule. Assessment of pa- tients’ and families’ daily routines frequently reveals confl icts between lifestyle and treat- ment regimens that can undermine or prevent adherence. The lifestyle/daily schedule assess- ment can be accomplished by asking the pa- tient to recall the events of a typical day, hour by hour, from waking until bedtime, as well as asking her to describe how weekends differ

JWBT514_ch20.indd 535JWBT514_ch20.indd 535 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

536 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

from weekdays. This methodology, a 24-hour recall, has been widely used in research to as- sess adherence to diet in patients with diabetes and heart disease (Anding, Kubena, McIntosh, & O’Brien, 1996; Johnson, Perwien, & Silver- stein, 2000). Often, knowledge of the small details of a patient’s life will lead to the under- standing of major adherence problems.

Psychological Factors. As discussed earlier in this chapter, several psychological problems have been associated with adherence to medi- cal regimens: depression (Anderson, Freed- land, Clouse, & Lustman, 2001; Lustman et al., 2000; Starace et al., 2002), anxiety disor- ders (Anderson et al., 2002), eating disorders (Jones, Lawson, Daneman, Olmsted, & Rodin, 2000), and substance use (Arnsten et al., 2002). It is critical to assess for psychological factors, because many of these conditions may adversely affect adherence.

Beliefs. In his Health Belief Model, Becker (1974; Becker & Maiman, 1980) suggested that patients’ health-related decisions and behaviors are infl uenced more by personal medical experiences, beliefs, and attitudes than by recommendations from health-care

professionals. It is important for members of the health-care team to understand a patient’s health beliefs so they can correct misinforma- tion and misconceptions that could undermine adherence. Becker’s model points to several key assessment areas: (a) the patient’s beliefs about whether the disease is serious enough to warrant the effort involved in following the treatment regimen, (b) the patient’s beliefs about the probability of the treatment regimen improving the medical condition, and (c) the patient’s beliefs about the likelihood that the benefi ts of treatment will outweigh the diffi - culties and inconveniences of adherence.

Adherence History/Treatment Satisfac- tion. A review of the patient’s past adherence performance is important because practitio- ners consider past adherence behaviors good predictors of future adherence. Adherence behavior patterns can be assessed by asking the patient specifi c questions about how often he follows each aspect of his prescribed regi- men. For example, the patient can be asked how frequently during the previous day, week, or month he exercised. It also should be de- termined when and where adherence is most

Table 20.3 Adherence Counseling for Chronic Disease Management

Phase 1: Patient and Family Assessment Lifestyle and daily schedule. Psychological factors. Health beliefs. Prior adherence history and treatment satisfaction.

Phase 2: Planning the Treatment Regimen Promote a realistic medical regimen. Encourage patient participation in regimen planning. Facilitate communication. Encourage joint decision making.

Phase 3: Facilitate Behavioral Change Initiate new behaviors. Translate treatment goals into behavioral goals. Encourage self-management strategies. Teach patients to plan for high-risk situations. Activate social support. Family support. Increase family involvement, promote shared responsibility. Strengthen emotional support. Social support outside of the family. Enhance patient’s ability to activate social and medical support

Phase 4: Strategies for Long-Term Adherence Develop skills for maintaining adherence. Teach how to cope with lapses in adherence. Increase accessibility to health care. Reinforce positive health-care behaviors.

JWBT514_ch20.indd 536JWBT514_ch20.indd 536 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Adherence and Mental Health Issues in Chronic Disease: Diabetes, Heart Disease, and HIV/AIDS 537

diffi cult. During the assessment of the pa- tient’s adherence history, the social worker also can identify why the patient did not follow a specifi c area of treatment. The social worker can determine if, for example, nonadherence resulted from the patient’s misunderstanding of the prescribed regimen. In the assessment of prior adherence history, it is important to determine the patient’s satisfaction with his adherence performance. If the patient is dis- satisfi ed with his performance, he already may have a plan and be motivated to change ad- herence behaviors. In contrast, if the patient is nonadherent according to the assessment but satisfi ed with his performance, his readiness to change will be limited. This situation demands renegotiation of treatment goals between the health-care provider and patient, which is dis- cussed in Phase 2.

Phase 2: Plan the Medical Treatment Regimen

Social workers must take an active role in treatment planning because they often can en- hance the plan’s effectiveness and increase pa- tient adherence by ensuring that psychosocial and behavioral factors are not overlooked or disregarded.

Promote the Development of a Realistic Medical Regimen. By encouraging patients and health-care professionals to utilize the social worker’s adherence assessment, a medi- cal regimen can be developed that is feasible for a patient in terms of her life. Patients are more likely to be adherent if their regimens are tailored to their specifi c lifestyle, behav- ioral changes are minimized, and convenience is enhanced (Chesney, 2003; DiMatteo, 2004).

Encourage Patient Participation in Regi- men Planning. Adherence can be enhanced by developing individualized medical regimens that refl ect patient preference. It is important that the social worker urge the health-care team to actively involve the patient in treat- ment planning and to seriously consider the patient’s desires and expectations. The social worker should ensure that the patient has been informed of all treatment options, including the risks and benefi ts of each option.

Facilitate Communication. Several research studies have found positive correlations be- tween a physician’s communication style and the patient’s comprehension, satisfaction, and adherence (Roter & Hall, 1997). Physicians and other health-care providers may commu- nicate more effectively with a patient after the social worker consults with the health-care team regarding the patient’s individual life demands and adherence diffi culties. Patients, too, must be willing to listen to and understand their health-care providers. To ensure accurate understanding, social workers should encour- age health professionals routinely to ask pa- tients to restate important medical information and instructions; misunderstandings then can be corrected. At the end of this chapter, we re- view strategies that social workers can use to enhance patient recall of information.

Encourage Joint Decision Making. After effective communication is established, the social worker can encourage and guide health- care professionals in negotiating a treatment plan with the patient. Research has shown that actively engaging patients in treatment decision making or shared decision mak- ing has potential to improve adherence and health outcomes (Fraenkel & McGraw, 2007; Heisler, 2008; Stacey, Samant, & Bennett, 2008). Shared decision making is important because patients’ treatment goals often differ from those of their health-care professionals. For example, in the case of diabetes treatment planning, the diabetes team might prescribe a treatment designed to normalize blood sugar levels when the patient’s goal is to prevent uncomfortable episodes of low blood glucose, thus intentionally keeping blood sugars higher than normal. The patient may then be adherent in terms of behaviors to reach goals, but non- adherent from the perspective of the health- care professional.

Phase 3: Facilitate Behavioral Change

Patients with recently diagnosed chronic dis- ease often must develop new behaviors and change established behaviors to most effec- tively implement the recommended treatment regimen. Strategies that can be used by social

JWBT514_ch20.indd 537JWBT514_ch20.indd 537 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

538 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

workers to facilitate behavioral change can be grouped into two categories: initiating new behaviors, and activating social support.

Initiating New Behaviors. Early success in the process of behavioral change reinforces and motivates patients. The techniques de- scribed here are designed to ensure that pa- tients feel a sense of accomplishment as soon as possible after they begin to establish new adherence behaviors (Meichenbaum & Turk, 1987). The fi rst technique is to assist patients in translating treatment goals into behavioral goals. Patients must understand exactly what new or changed behaviors are required in order to achieve their treatment goals. They must plan specifi cally how, when, and where the new behavior(s) will occur. If the treatment goal is to increase exercise, simply advising the patient to exercise more frequently will not be as effective as guiding her in devising a plan specifying, for instance, the type of activity, exercise frequency, and when and where she will engage in the activity. Meichenbaum and Turk warn that the plans should be moderately specifi c, but not overly rigid, for best results.

A second technique is to encourage patients to use self-management strategies. After be- havioral goals are set, patients can be encour- aged to establish a daily self-monitoring or self-recording system. Changes seem easier to achieve when taken day by day. Daily moni- toring or recording also reinforces patients’ efforts by giving them a sense of immediate achievement. In addition, patients and health- care providers can use information from self-monitoring forms to manage treatment regimens more effectively. Small changes are easier to make than big changes. Patients may be more successful if they graduate the treat- ment plan; that is, change their behaviors in a step-by-step fashion. For example, a patient who is instructed to exercise fi ve times per week may be overwhelmed by the task. It may seem less daunting to the patient to begin by exercising twice per week, gradually adding more activity. Another self-management strat- egy is to structure the physical environment by organizing the home and work site. Doing this often entails encouraging patients to make

simple adjustments, such as keeping tempting, high-fat foods out of the house, setting up an exercise mat in a convenient place, or keeping blood-testing equipment in a convenient place. Last, cueing is another self-management strat- egy that has been successful in increasing pa- tient adherence. Patients can be taught to use cues to prompt them to remember new behav- iors. Patients can use routine events, such as a favorite television show or the evening news, as a prompt to take medication. Medication containers separated into daily doses are also helpful. Be creative, even humorous, in help- ing patients identify behavioral cues.

A third technique to foster the initiation of new behaviors is to teach patients to plan ahead for high-risk situations (Marlatt & Gordon, 1985). During the assessment, the patient may have identifi ed or given clues to behaviors, situations, events, or persons that are likely to interfere with adherence to the treatment regimen. Anticipating these obstacles to adher- ence and planning ways to manage them are key strategies to successful behavioral change. Role-play and rehearsal are useful in prepar- ing patients to cope with the challenges of everyday living.

Activating Social Support. Results of a wide range of studies strongly suggest that so- cial support and social relationships positively affect health, in part through health behav- iors (Heaney & Israel, 1997). Strengthening and expanding a patient’s support network, within the family and without, is an essential component of the third phase of adherence counseling.

Knowledge of family strengths and risk factors revealed in the initial adherence as- sessment enables the social worker to focus interventions on areas where the need is great- est. In general, to activate effective family sup- port, the social worker can encourage family involvement and competence, promote shared responsibility among family members, and strengthen the family’s emotional support for the patient (Anderson et al., 1990; Glasgow & Toobert, 1988). To encourage family involve- ment and competence, it is crucial that the so- cial worker encourage the health-care team to

JWBT514_ch20.indd 538JWBT514_ch20.indd 538 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Adherence and Mental Health Issues in Chronic Disease: Diabetes, Heart Disease, and HIV/AIDS 539

include family members in disease-related ed- ucation and regimen planning, especially those members who play key roles in areas related to adherence. For example, family members who do the shopping and cooking must learn about the recommended diet for individuals with heart disease or diabetes and help the health-care team tailor the patient’s diet to the at-home situation. In order to accomplish this type of involvement, classes or meetings must be scheduled at a time convenient not only for the patient and health-care team, but for fam- ily members as well. If family members are reluctant to learn about the disease or seem hesitant about helping with the regimen, the social worker can talk with them about the rea- sons for their reluctance to become involved. Do they fear medical procedures? Do they know how to help? Are they resentful of the demands being placed on them? Once these is- sues surface, the social worker and family can openly deal with them. Family members are more likely to want to continue helping if they know their efforts have made a difference and are appreciated.

Promoting shared responsibility among family members is another way to improve the effectiveness of family support. Because research has shown that disagreements be- tween family members regarding the division of responsibility for disease-related tasks have been associated with problems with adherence (Anderson et al., 1990), patients and their families should be encouraged to discuss and decide on the tasks and roles each person is willing to assume. Families often are anxious about handling medical emergencies, so often it is useful to devote the fi rst meeting to help- ing them plan what must be done in an emer- gency and who will carry out each task.

Emotional support can be strengthened by encouraging family members to openly share their feelings. Often the patient and family try to hide painful emotions, such as sadness, grief, or anxiety, in order to protect each other. In doing so, they miss an opportunity to com- fort one another and grow closer as a family. Social workers also can encourage families to share angry feelings so that differences can be

negotiated and confl icts resolved. Many stud- ies have found that cohesive families with low levels of confl ict have better adherence and im- proved medical outcomes (Hanson, De Guire, Schinkel, & Kolterman, 1995; Herskowitz et al., 1995).

Adhering to a treatment regimen for heart disease, diabetes, or HIV/AIDS may be diffi - cult, if not impossible, if the patient has unin- formed or unsympathetic friends, coworkers, bosses, or teachers. Encouraging the patient to educate at least one or two coworkers or fellow students can strengthen the supportive atmo- sphere and increase the probability of adher- ence. Support from others at work or school can be encouraged by educational efforts by the patient. In children with diabetes, personal contacts by a member of the health-care team may be used to reinforce parental education of school personnel.

Linking patients with support groups fre- quently reduces the sense of isolation and provides opportunities for learning practical ways of dealing with adherence problems. Linking patients with appropriate community resources, a traditional and essential social work function, helps patients access supplies and services that are important for regimen adherence.

Patients will be better served in the long run if they learn how to activate their own support. Social workers can guide patients to identify those persons who might provide social sup- port by having them recall people who have helped them in the past and by asking them to think of those who might be willing to help in the future. Further, social workers can prepare patients to ask for support and cope with refus- als by using role-play and rehearsal techniques as described by Marlatt and Gordon (1985). Patients who are uncomfortable about “bother- ing the doctor” can be taught patient activation or assertiveness skills to obtain medical sup- port. One patient activation strategy is to en- courage patients to prepare a list of questions before they make telephone calls to the doc- tor or go to offi ce visits (Roter, 1977). Other strategies include encouraging patients to learn about their medical condition by reading their

JWBT514_ch20.indd 539JWBT514_ch20.indd 539 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

540 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

medical charts and helping them negotiate medical treatment decisions with their health- care providers. In a study of the cognitive and behavioral determinants of adherence to the diabetes regimen, Amir, Rabin, and Galatzer (1990) found that a patient’s ability to assert- ively request follow-up with a specifi c doctor was signifi cantly correlated with adherence.

Phase 4: Maintaining Patient Adherence

Marlatt and Gordon (1985) observed that the high rate of failure associated with attempts to change behaviors may stem from a lack of emphasis on the maintenance phase of treat- ment. Chronic disease patient education and management programs commonly suffer from a lack of attention to maintenance issues. Health-care professionals often are naive in as- suming that their job is done once the patient has been educated and launched onto a new treatment regimen. However, for patients, the challenges are just beginning. The next strate- gies have been helpful in facilitating long-term adherence.

Assist in Maintenance Skills. Many of the strategies described previously as effective in initiating behavioral change are also effective in maintaining behavioral change. In general, the most successful strategies will be those di- rected toward helping patients develop a sense of personal responsibility for their own adher- ence and helping them acquire the skills needed to carry out this responsibility (Meichenbaum & Turk, 1987). One of the most crucial of these skills, described earlier in this chapter, is the ability to anticipate and plan ahead for situ- ations that are likely to result in nonadherent behaviors. This skill is particularly important in light of Marlatt and Gordon’s (1985) fi nd- ings that most episodes of nonadherence occur in a limited number of high-risk situations that are unique to each individual.

Other skills that will help patients indepen- dently maintain adherence are problem-solving skills, assertiveness skills, interpersonal skills, and stress management skills (Meichenbaum & Turk, 1987). When a patient is defi cient in these areas, the social worker’s role is to

strengthen these skills as they relate to adher- ence. The patient also can be referred to skills training programs offered by community agen- cies. The social worker then can help the pa- tient apply the knowledge and skills learned from the training program to his personal regi- men adherence problems.

Teach Techniques for Coping with Lapses. To maintain long-term adherence, patients must learn to cope successfully with lapses in adherence. Marlatt and Gordon (1985) stress the importance of cognitive reframing for pa- tients who view each slip in adherence as a sign of personal inadequacy or as an indication that adherence is not achievable. Patients who think this way become easily discouraged and lose motivation. Cognitive reframing involves helping patients view lapses as errors or mis- takes in the process of learning new behaviors, not as indications of personal defi ciencies, so they can understand, as with any mistake, the possibility of corrective learning. The social worker can then assist patients in reviewing and debriefi ng the lapse so that causes can be identifi ed and strategies devised to prevent recurrences. Marlatt and Gordon (1985) also suggest lapse rehearsal as a technique for pre- paring patients to handle lapses in adherence. Lapse rehearsal gives patients an opportunity to anticipate an adherence lapse, to imagine their response to the lapse, and to receive feed- back and coaching from the social worker.

Utilize Follow-up Techniques. There are a number of very direct ways that the health-care team can encourage long-term maintenance, some of which involve ongoing communica- tion between patient and health-care profes- sional. Regular phone calls, text messages, e-mails, and reminders help some patients keep on track.

Social workers can utilize strategies to re- duce health-care costs, such as locating low- cost sources of medications and supplies and making referrals to state and federal agencies for fi nancial and medical assistance. Chronic diseases, such as HIV/AIDS, diabetes, and heart disease, can be very expensive to man- age because of the high cost of prescription drugs, blood glucose testing supplies, dietary

JWBT514_ch20.indd 540JWBT514_ch20.indd 540 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Adherence and Mental Health Issues in Chronic Disease: Diabetes, Heart Disease, and HIV/AIDS 541

restrictions, frequent doctor visits, medical transportation, child care, and laboratory tests. Patients frequently fail to maintain their regi- men because of the hardships these expenses cause for their families over time. In the long term, other fi nancial demands may take prior- ity over disease-related expenses. Social work- ers should be aware that changes in adherence over time may be due to competing fi nancial needs.

Social workers must consistently recognize and reinforce patients’ positive health-care behaviors. Reinforcement will be more effec- tive if done in such a way that patients real- ize their successes are due to their own efforts rather than those of their health professionals (Meichenbaum & Turk, 1987). Patients need self-confi dence and a belief in their own self- effi cacy to follow the treatment regimen suc- cessfully for a lifetime.

Applicability to Diverse Populations

This approach holds promise for individu- als from diverse socioeconomic and ethnic backgrounds because it uses an ecological approach for assessing barriers and facilita- tors to adherence. This approach also ac- knowledges and examines the infl uence of the broader social context, such as societal and cultural factors, that affect adherence behav- iors. For example, cultural factors, such as health beliefs and extended family social sup- port networks among minority patients, may differ from those of the majority culture and are crucial to successful adherence counsel- ing. Furthermore, this approach to adherence counseling can be used as a strategy to prevent adherence problems from developing with newly diagnosed patients or patients who are changing their regimens. Clinical wisdom, as well as research about chronically ill children, suggests that it is easier to prevent the occur- rence of family-related adherence and disease management problems than it is to reverse already existing negative patterns within the family (Auslander, Anderson, Bubb, Jung, & Santiago, 1990; Auslander, Bubb, Rogge, & Santiago, 1993).

ADHERENCE AND PATIENT–PRACTITIONER COMMUNICATION

Outcomes Associated With Positive Patient–Practitioner Communication

After three decades of research about patient– practitioner communication, several consistent fi ndings that characterize interactions between patients and practitioners have been shown to be associated with adherence to treatment. For example, when practitioners engage in more positive and less negative talk, ask fewer ques- tions, and offer more information, patients are more likely to be adherent. In fact, more infor- mation giving is associated with better patient recall and more partnership building (Hall, Roter, & Katz, 1988; Roter & Hall, 1997). Although many of these studies have been conducted with physicians as the practitioner, general principles and techniques used to im- prove communication skills can be extrapo- lated to other members of the health-care team, such as social workers, nurses, and dietitians.

Likewise, the strongest predictor of patient satisfaction is how much information is pro- vided to the patient; that is, patients who re- ceive more information are more satisfi ed with medical care than those who receive less infor- mation (Hall et al., 1988). The strong relation- ship between more information and greater satisfaction may be due to the need patients have for knowledge about their condition. It also may be related to patients’ perceptions that practitioners who share more informa- tion with them are more concerned and caring people. Studies even link patient–practitioner communication with health outcomes such as improved recovery from surgery and de- creased use of pain medication (Roter & Hall, 1997). As patients with chronic diseases take greater responsibility for their own treatment and health, their needs for information will increase. Social workers can lead the medi- cal team in changing the interaction between patients and providers to a more collaborative style of communication. (See Chapter 10 for further discussion of these issues.)

JWBT514_ch20.indd 541JWBT514_ch20.indd 541 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

542 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Information Giving and the Educator Role

Patients with chronic diseases are continu- ally coping and adapting to changes, whether they are the co-occurrence of a mental health problem, changes in their medical condition, changes in their treatment regimen, or devel- opmental or lifestyle changes. All of these changes pose demands on the patient to con- tinually seek out new information and learn new ways of coping. In response to this patient need, social workers play a large role in de- livering information to patients and educating them about disease-related and psychosocial issues. Although there is an emphasis on con- ducting psychosocial assessments in most so- cial work programs, little attention is spent on training social workers to deliver information to patients. Research in patient–practitioner communication indicates that patients are dis- satisfi ed and nonadherent when (a) they do not understand what they are told and do not ask questions, (b) they forget what they are told, and (c) too much time is spent on assessing personal histories as opposed to providing pa- tient education (Robbins et al., 1993; Roter, 1977; Roter, Hall, & Katz, 1987).

Communication Techniques to Enhance Information Recall

Patients forget much of what practitioners tell them by the time they leave the building. To increase the amount of information recalled by patients, the next communication strategies have been identifi ed as useful in the medical encounter. The fi rst strategy is to use explicit categorization. When giving a lot of informa- tion to patients, social workers should present the information in categories or blocks and de- scribe each category in advance. For example, “I am going to tell you the various types of support groups that are available for you and your family, what the potential benefi ts are to participating in these groups, who facilitates or sponsors each of these groups, and where and when these groups are held and how you can sign up for them. ”

A second strategy is to use repetition. Com- bined with explicit categorization, repeating the most important information to patients and their families can increase recall. In one of the pioneer studies on patient–practitioner communication, providers asked patients to repeat the information back to the physician to make sure they understood what they were told. Any information that was misunderstood or forgotten was repeated to the patient. Re- sults of this study showed that individuals in the experimental group were better able to re- call information from the physicians and also more satisfi ed with the medical visit (Bertakis, 1977).

Another strategy to enhance recall of in- formation is to provide specifi c instructions. Patients can remember and more easily follow concrete or specifi c, detailed advice or infor- mation more easily than general, abstract in- formation, because the former better enhances imagery than the latter. For example, the clas- sic general statement, “You should reduce the sugar in your diet,” often is ignored by patients not only because it is diffi cult to achieve but because it does not provide specifi c enough advice. A more specifi c statement would be “Substitute fresh fruit and crackers for dessert after meals in your diet.” When using specifi c instructions, social workers should avoid using medical jargon and long sentences that are dif- fi cult to follow.

Ley (1982), another pioneer in studying in- formation giving to patients, examined the or- dering of information presented to the patient. Results indicated that patients presented with information in a medical encounter remember best what they are told fi rst and what they con- sider most important. Because practitioners often end their visits with patients by provid- ing them with information and recommenda- tions, patients may be more likely to forget this information. Instead, Ley’s early work suggests that social workers should present the most important information early in their visit with patients so that patients are more likely to remember it. Providing a rationale to help patients understand why a treatment is recom- mended is another strategy that may increase

JWBT514_ch20.indd 542JWBT514_ch20.indd 542 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Adherence and Mental Health Issues in Chronic Disease: Diabetes, Heart Disease, and HIV/AIDS 543

patient recall. Last, practitioners should elicit patient expectations and involvement. None of these techniques will improve the interac- tion with patients, unless the practitioner asks what the patients want to know and encour- ages patient involvement in their interactions. A recent study that assessed how frequently recall-promoting physician behaviors are used in primary care settings indicated that rep- etition was the most common technique used (53.7%), followed by a rationale for treat- ment (28.2%) (Silberman, Tentler, Ramgo- pal, & Epstein, 2007). Because longer visits were associated with increased use of recall- promoting techniques, social workers can play a strong role in enhancing recall by having ex- tended visits with patients after the physician completes her interaction.

Previous research on adherence and com- munication between practitioners and patients has led to the understanding that health-care professionals are most effective when they adopt a collaborative style with patients. When patients choose to not adhere to a treat- ment regimen, it should be viewed as a logical, motivated choice. The solution is to renegoti- ate the agreed-on prescribed treatment so that patients can realistically follow it. Lessons learned from a multisite controlled trial of intensive therapy (the Diabetes Control and Complications Trial) for individuals with type 1 diabetes (Lorenz et al., 1996) demonstrated that for intensive therapy to be successful, health professionals must change as much as patients.

RELATIONSHIP BETWEEN MENTAL HEALTH AND CHRONIC DISEASE

One of the most important issues for social workers who work with chronically ill patients is the co-occurrence of mental health problems. People with chronic illnesses, such as heart disease, diabetes, or HIV/AIDS, have higher rates of emotional problems than the general population. Chronic illness can cause func- tional disabilities, ongoing pain, burdensome

medication regimens, reliance on caregivers, and awareness of one’s mortality, any of which can lead to feelings of grief, anxiety, and de- pression. But the relationship between mental disorder and chronic illness goes beyond the easily explainable premise that chronic ill- nesses cause patients distress. Research also indicates that the relationship occurs in the other direction as well—distress can be a causal factor in the etiology of chronic illness. Depression can increase the risk of heart dis- ease, diabetes, and HIV/AIDS through direct and indirect pathways.

Social workers bring a holistic, person-in- environment perspective to the care of people with chronic illness. Part of this perspective requires knowledge of how mental illness and other physical illnesses can inextricably con- verge. To summarize such knowledge, this section examines: the prevalence of mental disorders among individuals with heart dis- ease, diabetes, or HIV/AIDS; the bidirectional relationship of these chronic illnesses and mental disorders; factors associated with men- tal health in people with chronic illness; and approaches to providing social work services for people with a mental disorder and heart disease, diabetes, or HIV/AIDS.

Prevalence of Mental Disorders Among People With Heart Disease, Diabetes, or HIV/AIDS

Heart Disease

An estimated 15% to 20% of people with heart disease also have depression, compared to 4% to 7% in the general population (Lett et al., 2004). Research shows that depression can exacerbate heart disease, perhaps because of behavioral consequences of depression, such as poor eating and exercise habits, or because of physiological correlates, such as decreased heart rate variability and platelet activity in depressed individuals (Ferketich, Schwartzbaum, Frid, & Moeschberger, 2000). In 20 studies that followed patients with heart disease for up to 15 years, people with heart disease and depression were, on average,

JWBT514_ch20.indd 543JWBT514_ch20.indd 543 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

544 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

2 times more likely to die of cardiac compli- cations than people with heart disease and no depression (Barth, Schumacher, & Herrmann- Lingen, 2004). Studies generally indicate that people who experience coronary artery disease, acute myocardial infarction, conges- tive heart failure, or heart surgery and who subsequently experience depression are 1.5 to 2.5 times more likely to die from their cardiac condition than people with heart disease and no depression (Lett et al., 2004). Although depression is a major risk factor for suicide (Rihmer, 2007), a review of studies on sui- cide and medical illness found no increased suicide risk for cardiac conditions such as hypertension and heart transplant (Hughes & Kleespies, 2001).

Diabetes

Studies consistently show the risk for depres- sion is 2 times higher among people with type 1 or type 2 diabetes compared with those who do not have diabetes (Ali, Stone, Peters, Davies, & Khunti, 2006; Anderson et al., 2001). This effect is consistent for women, men, children, and adults, as well as for dif- ferent types of diabetes. In general, a review of 39 studies including 20,218 participants in- dicated that 11% of people with diabetes had major depression and an additional 31% had a high number of depression symptoms (An- derson et al., 2001). In a longitudinal study of children with type 1 diabetes, 28% developed depression over a 10-year period (Kovacs, Goldston, Obrosky, & Bonar, 1997). Psychi- atric disorders occurred most commonly in the fi rst year after treatment. Depression among people with diabetes is related to poor nutri- tion, lack of medication adherence, increased health problems, and lower quality of life (An- derson et al., 2001; Ciechanowski, Katon, & Russo, 2000; Lustman & Clouse, 2005). Vari- ous studies have shown that depression is re- lated to a greater likelihood of hyperglycemia, eye damage, heart disease, hospitalization, and other complications among people with dia- betes (Clouse et al., 2003; Kovacs, Mukerji, Drash, & Iyengar, 1995; Lustman et al., 2000; Lustman & Clouse, 2005; Rosenthal, Fajardo,

Gilmore, Morley, & Naliboff, 1998). The se- verity of diabetes and functional impairment appears to increase the risk for depression (de Groot, Anderson, Freedland, Clouse, & Lustman, 2001; Lustman et al., 2000).

Other emotional problems and disorders, particularly anxiety and general psychological distress, also occur with higher-than-average frequency among people with diabetes. Anxi- ety is twice as likely in people with diabetes (Kruse, Schmitz, & Thefeld, 2004), and it is especially associated with hyperglyce- mia (Anderson et al., 2002). Overall, 14% of people with diabetes also have general- ized anxiety disorder, and an additional 40% have elevated symptoms of anxiety (Grigsby, Anderson, Freedland, Clouse, & Lustman, 2002). In a study of almost 10,000 people in New York City, people who had been diag- nosed with diabetes were twice as likely as those without diabetes to be in serious psy- chological distress, defi ned as having at least 13 symptoms of anxiety, depression, schizo- phrenia, and other mental disorders (McVeigh, Mostashari, & Thorpe, 2004). Although little research has examined whether psychological disorders occur at equal rates among people with diabetes of different races and ethnici- ties, one major study in the United States found that American Indians with diabetes had the highest rates of depression, followed by White, Hispanic, and African American patients; Asian American patients with diabe- tes had the lowest rates (Li, Ford, Strine, & Mokdad, 2008).

Finally, the need to focus on food and exercise continually may give rise to eat- ing disorders in some people with diabetes. Some adolescent and young adult women with type 1 diabetes engage in what is called “insulin purging” (Rydall, Rodin, Olmsted, Devenyi, & Daneman, 1997), by which they regulate their weight by withholding insulin and thus purging themselves of food that would be stored as fat. Perhaps as a result, women with type 1 diabetes have almost twice the risk for bulimia nervosa com- pared with women without type 1 diabetes (Mannucci et al., 2005).

JWBT514_ch20.indd 544JWBT514_ch20.indd 544 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Adherence and Mental Health Issues in Chronic Disease: Diabetes, Heart Disease, and HIV/AIDS 545

HIV/AIDS

Because the human immunodefi ciency virus invades the central nervous system, numerous types of psychiatric complications can accom- pany HIV and AIDS (Forstein & McDaniel, 2001). HIV-associated dementia and minor cognitive-motor disorder can result from the in- volvement of the virus with the central nervous system. Studies have reported high prevalence rates (4%–19%) of HIV/AIDS among people with serious mental illness, but these stud- ies lacked random samples or control groups (Lyon, 2001). The risk for suicide among peo- ple with HIV/AIDS is generally 2 times higher than average (Dannenberg, McNeil, Brundage, & Brookmeyer, 1996; Marzuk et al., 1997), although earlier studies produced dramatically larger estimates (Komiti et al., 2001)

Treatment for HIV/AIDS also can trigger psychiatric problems. For example, antiretro- viral therapy can induce psychosis in some pa- tients, which may subside once the therapy is withdrawn and antipsychotic medication is in- troduced (Foster, Olajide, & Everall, 2003). At the same time, antiretroviral therapy has been as- sociated with a marked decline in cases of AIDS- related dementia (Liner, Hall, & Robertson, 2008) and with improvement of depression in people with HIV/AIDS (Low-Beer et al., 2000).

Depression and Other Mental Illness: Cause or Consequence of Chronic Illness?

Chronic illness can engender suffi cient stress and anxiety to affect a person’s mental health. But what about the possible infl uence of men- tal health on the etiology of chronic disease? Indeed, evidence is building that poor mental health can increase the risk for chronic illness. The research involving depression, in particular, is the strongest; studies of many diseases indicate that depression can both directly and indirectly increase the risk of certain health conditions.

Heart Disease

Studies have found that depression increases the risk of subsequent heart disease by an

average 1.5 to 2 times, almost as much as smoking, which increases the risk of heart dis- ease by 2.5 times (Lett et al., 2004; Wulsin & Singal, 2003). One of the fi rst studies of this phenomenon, the Epidemiologic Catchment Area study, found that people with no history of heart disease and a history of major de- pression in 1981 were 4.5 times more likely to have had a heart attack by 1994 than those with no depression history (Pratt et al., 1996). A more recent study discerned that, among adults with no previous history of heart dis- ease, people with depression were 2.7 times more likely than those without depression to die of heart disease within an average of 8.5 years (Surtees et al., 2008). The relation- ship between depression and heart disease complications may be more profound for men than for women. One study found that men with depression were 2.75 times more likely than men without depression to develop heart disease, but depression did not increase risk of heart disease for women (Hippisley-Cox, Fielding, & Pringle, 1998).

Why depression increases the risk of heart disease and heart-related complications is not known. One hypothesis asserts that behav- ioral consequences of depression—specifi cally smoking, alcohol use, or physical inactivity— and physiologic effects increase the risk of heart disease or complications (Lett et al., 2004). Depression’s effects on motivation, energy, and hopefulness are known to impair compliance with treatment regimens, which can in turn lead to graver health outcomes. Physiologic effects of depression that may en- courage heart problems include alterations in blood platelet activity, serotonin dysregulation, infl ammation, and diseases such as diabetes, obesity, and hypertension (Lett et al., 2004). Antidepressant medications that target sero- tonin (fl uoxetine [Prozac], sertraline [Zoloft], and other selective serotonin reuptake inhibi- tors) provide evidence supporting a relation- ship between serotonin and heart disease. At the same time, Lett and colleagues caution that factors related to both depression and heart disease need more longitudinal study before any causal relationships can be established.

JWBT514_ch20.indd 545JWBT514_ch20.indd 545 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

546 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Diabetes

Although we know that depression may follow a diagnosis of diabetes, depression also is associated with increased risk of ac- quiring diabetes (Knol et al., 2006; Mezuk, Eaton, Albrecht, & Golden, 2008). It is not clear why depression may increase the risk of diabetes. As with heart disease, one pos- sible explanation is that depression itself leads to poor diet, lack of exercise, smoking, social isolation, and stress, all risk factors for diabetes (Barth et al., 2004; Rozanski, Blumenthal, & Kaplan, 1999). Another pos- sibility is that depression produces biochem- ical changes that make an individual more susceptible to other types of illness or that depression directly affects cardiac and meta- bolic regulation.

Diabetes also is associated with other men- tal illnesses besides depression. People with schizophrenia have higher rates of impaired glucose tolerance than people in the general population, even when no antipsychotic medi- cations that might affect physiology are taken (Ryan, Collins, & Thakore, 2003). In fact, people with schizophrenia who take antipsy- chotic medications are at an elevated risk for developing diabetes (Koro et al., 2002; Leslie & Rosenheck, 2004; Sacchetti et al., 2005). This relationship is particularly strong among newer antipsychotic medications, such as olanzapine (Zyprexa), risperidone (Risperdal), and quetiapine (Seroquel). One study found that 1% of people developed diabetes within three months of initiating quetiapine (Koro et al., 2002).

Weight gain, which is another side effect of the medications (Allison et al., 1999), may help explain the increased risk for diabetes. For these reasons, it is especially important that people who start taking antipsychotic medications be monitored regularly by a phy- sician, eat low-fat and high-fi ber diets, and act preventively in general. Yet schizophrenia itself may affect the metabolic system (Ryan et al., 2003), and the challenges posed by schizophrenia can make it diffi cult for people to exercise diligently and eat well.

HIV/AIDS

In the case of HIV/AIDS, in which transmis- sion of the disease is preventable with be- havioral measures, mental illness indirectly increases the chances of acquiring the sexu- ally transmitted disease. Many people with serious mental illness engage in dispropor- tionately high rates of risky behaviors that can lead to HIV infection, including unprotected sex, drug use involving needles, and prostitu- tion (Meade & Sikkema, 2005). Feelings of hopelessness and lethargy produced by de- pression can inspire risky sexual behavior. In a study of 460 gay men, those with dys- thymic disorder were 2.4 times more likely than those without any depressive disorder to have engaged in unprotected anal intercourse with a casual partner in the previous 6 months (Rogers et al., 2003). Cognitive problems, particularly those associated with schizophre- nia, can hinder a person’s understanding of the magnitude of HIV/AIDS and methods for prevention (Lyon, 2001).

Even after an individual contracts HIV, de- pression is associated with graver outcomes. A 7-year study of 1,716 women with HIV found that the proportion of women with chronic symptoms of depression who died of AIDS was double that of those with few or intermittent depression symptoms (Cook et al., 2004).

Mental Illness and Adherence to Treatment Regimens

Not surprisingly, depression, anxiety, schizo- phrenia, substance use disorders, and other types of mental disorders can negatively affect a person’s compliance with treatment recom- mendations. Depression itself is perhaps the largest culprit (DiMatteo, Lepper, & Croghan, 2000). The nature of depression lessens moti- vation, concentration, energy, and hopefulness. These problems make it diffi cult to exercise, eat healthfully, test blood sugar regularly, and maintain medications (Ciechanowski et al., 2000; Rubin, Ciechanowski, Egede, Lin, & Lustman, 2004).

JWBT514_ch20.indd 546JWBT514_ch20.indd 546 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Adherence and Mental Health Issues in Chronic Disease: Diabetes, Heart Disease, and HIV/AIDS 547

Depression hinders compliance with treat- ment for heart disease, diabetes, and HIV/ AIDS (Ciechanowski et al., 2000; DiMatteo et al., 2000; Starace et al., 2002). In a study of patients with cardiac problems, those with depression were less likely, than those without depression, to take their medications regularly, to quit smoking, to attend cardiac rehabilita- tion appointments, and to exercise regularly (Kronish et al., 2006). Among adults with depression and HIV, those who took antide- pressants were more likely to comply with an- tiretroviral therapy (Yun, Maravi, Kobayashi, Barton, & Davidson, 2005). Illicit drug use also infl uences adherence. In a study of 85 current and former drug users infected with HIV, only 27% of cocaine users adhered to their medication regimen compared to 68% of people who reported no cocaine use during the six-month study (Arnsten et al., 2002). Al- though depression and other mental illnesses may disturb a person’s motivation and ability to follow a medical regimen of diet, exercise, and medication, Rubin and Peyrot (2001) stress that many people with depression do adhere to their treatment plan and, likewise, many people who do not follow their medical regimen are not depressed.

Protective Factors and Mental Health in Chronic Illness

Not everybody with a chronic illness develops a mental disorder. Most people with heart dis- ease, diabetes, or HIV/AIDS do not merit a di- agnosis of major depression, despite managing constant stress and fears related to their illness.

What helps people cope with their chronic illness without experiencing depression, anxi- ety, or other mental disorder? Studies gener- ally fi nd that marriage and higher levels of education, income, and social support are associated with fewer psychiatric complica- tions with diabetes (Blazer, Moody-Ayers, Craft-Morgan, & Burchett, 2002; McVeigh et al., 2004; Peyrot & Rubin, 1997). In cases of diabetes, well-controlled blood sugar is as- sociated with a decreased risk for depression

(Rubin & Peyrot, 2001), as are lower weight, insulin treatment, and older age (Katon et al., 2004). White Americans with diabetes are less likely to experience major or minor depression than African Americans (Blazer et al., 2002) and other people of color who have diabetes (Katon et al., 2004).

It is hard to know whether depression or poor health habits (such as control of blood sugar) come fi rst because of the reciprocal effect they have on each other. This is also true of exercise, diet, and sleep, which can help prevent depres- sion but also can be dramatically affected by depression. As Rubin and Peyrot (2001) note, “The helplessness and hopelessness often as- sociated with depression may contribute to a vicious cycle of poor self-management, worse glycemic control, and exacerbation of depres- sion” (p. 461). A synergistic effect seems to exist when a person has comorbid physical and mental illnesses: The worse the physical or psychosocial situation, the worse the conse- quences for one’s mental health. Psychological, economic, social, and physical health problems are likely to interact with each other in what can be either a vicious or a productive cycle, depending on the circumstances.

Interventions to Improve Mental Health in People With Chronic Disease

Social workers have numerous interventions available to help people with mental health problems. Medical crisis counseling, psycho- therapy, and relaxation training are briefl y described here. Antidepressant medication is omitted because social workers do not pre- scribe medications but rather work with psy- chiatrists and other physicians who prescribe them. However, it is helpful for social workers to be aware of the benefi ts and risks of psy- chiatric medications so that they can educate and advocate for their patients. For example, antidepressants can reduce depression effec- tively but also carry risks, including increased risk for suicidal behavior in children, adoles- cents, and young adults (Barbui, Esposito, & Cipriani, 2009).

JWBT514_ch20.indd 547JWBT514_ch20.indd 547 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

548 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Medical Crisis Counseling

Medical crisis counseling is a short-term inter- vention that centers on fears, anxieties, disabil- ities, and other problems posed by a person’s medical condition (Pollin, 1995). The premise of medical crisis counseling is that eight fears impede a person’s ability to cope with illness: loss of control, loss of self-image, dependency, stigma, abandonment, expressing anger, isola- tion, and death. The counseling typically lasts for only 10 or fewer sessions, and an active, problem-solving approach is stressed. The role of the social worker or other therapist “is that of a facilitator, problem-solver, health educa- tor, and coach to the patient with a solution- focused orientation” (Pollin, 1995, p. 53). The ultimate therapeutic goal is to help people with illness feel some sense of control over their situation and, in turn, cope more effectively. A small, randomized controlled trial indicated that crisis counseling may help increase so- cial support for patients with diabetes, heart disease, and other conditions without increas- ing costs (Koocher, Curtiss, Pollin, & Patton, 2001).

Psychotherapy

Various studies attest to psychotherapy’s ef- fectiveness in general (Nathan & Gorman, 2007), but evidence is mixed regarding psy- chotherapy and people with specifi c illnesses. Psychotherapy may vary by orientation (e.g., cognitive-behavioral or psychodynamic), mode (individual or group), or focus (cognitive dis- tortions, grief, or stress).

Cognitive-behavioral therapy has reduced depression effectively (Petrak & Herpertz, 2009; Snoek et al., 2008) and improved glyce- mic control (Ismail, Winkley, & Rabe-Hesketh, 2004) among people with type 2 diabetes. Rubin and Peyrot (2001) propose that interper- sonal psychotherapy also would benefi t people with diabetes because so much of the illness’s management requires effectively interacting with other people. In one of the fi rst studies to examine stress-reduction training and heart disease outcome, men who had a heart attack and received stress-reduction training had

lower fatality rates than those with no psycho- logical intervention (Frasure-Smith & Prince, 1985). In addition, psychotherapy delivered over the telephone has demonstrated positive results; in a randomized controlled trial with cardiac patients, patients who received six ses- sions of telephone therapy reported less de- pression and anxiety than those who did not receive the intervention (McLaughlin et al., 2005).

Not all studies of psychotherapy effective- ness yield positive results. An intervention including group and individual psychotherapy failed to reduce rates of depression, recur- rence of heart attack, or death rates among 2,328 people who had a recent heart attack (Jones & West, 2004). A large study of indi- vidual and group cognitive-behavioral therapy for adults with depression and a recent heart attack showed that the intervention was asso- ciated with reduced depression and increased social support. However, within the average follow-up period of 29 months, 1 in 4 people had died regardless of whether they received psychotherapy (Berkman et al., 2003). More research is needed into the effectiveness of different types, modes, and foci of psycho- therapy, specifi cally for people with chronic illness.

Relaxation Training

Relaxation techniques have generated consid- erable evidence of effectiveness among people with chronic health conditions. In his classic book The Relaxation Response, Benson (1976) showed that meditating for 10 to 20 minutes a day can produce physiologic changes, such as lower blood pressure and heart rate. Relax- ation techniques are associated with improved blood glucose control among people with dia- betes (McGinnis, McGrady, Cox, & Grower- Dowling, 2005). Deep relaxation techniques can help children and adolescents with type 1 diabetes feel less fear and anxiety when re- ceiving injections and other stressful medical procedures (Sewell, 2004).

Numerous types of relaxation training exist. In meditation, a person sits still while concentrating on counting, repeating a phrase,

JWBT514_ch20.indd 548JWBT514_ch20.indd 548 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Adherence and Mental Health Issues in Chronic Disease: Diabetes, Heart Disease, and HIV/AIDS 549

or visualizing an object. In progressive mus- cle relaxation, a person breathes deeply and relaxes specifi c muscle groups one at a time, starting either from the head and going down to the feet or vice versa. In hypnotherapy, also called deep relaxation (Sewell, 2004), another person induces relaxation in the patient by directing the patient to focus attention on an object or a visualization. For detailed instruc- tions on how to use relaxation techniques with clients, see Bernstein, Borkovec, and Hazlett- Stevens (2000) or Payne and Donaghy (2010).

CONCLUSION

Social workers in all types of health-care set- tings frequently work with people who have heart disease, diabetes, HIV/AIDS, or some other chronic disease. Chronic disease brings ongoing challenges to patients, particularly in the form of issues with mental health, treat- ment adherence, and gathering information to better cope with ongoing changes associated with the disease. Chronic illness may lead to mental health problems, such as depression and anxiety, which in turn can exacerbate physi- cal complications of chronic illness. Mental health problems such as depression also can negatively affect a patient’s ability to follow through with medication, diet, and other com- ponents of the medical regimen. Adherence to medical treatment is of utmost importance for people with chronic illness. How patients live on a daily basis—whether they eat, exer- cise, take medication regularly, or act preven- tively—can profoundly impact the course and outcome of their illness.

Social workers have multiple roles in their work with chronically ill patients: adherence counselor, mental health specialist, and edu- cator. Each of these roles demands that social workers are knowledgeable about the pa- tients’ diseases and treatments in addition to their unique psychosocial issues. Perspectives on nonadherence have changed from one of blame to one of choice, whereby the practi- tioner and patient must take responsibility for renegotiating the agreed-on treatment.

Future trends in health care may infl u- ence the roles that social workers assume in health-care settings and in the community. For example, increased rates of obesity and diabe- tes among individuals of all age groups, even children and adolescents, will strengthen so- cial work’s role in promoting lifestyle changes and adherence. The relatively new emphasis on prevention of heart disease, diabetes, and HIV/AIDS will enhance social workers educa- tional role in community-based public health settings, such as schools, primary care clinics, and mental health and social service agencies. Finally, the continued disparities in health found between people of color and White Americans will highlight the need for social workers’ expertise in sociocultural and family factors that infl uence health outcomes. Knowl- edge of heart disease, diabetes, and HIV/AIDS is critical for social workers who work with growing numbers of individuals who are ac- tively preventing and managing these chronic diseases.

SUGGESTED LEARNING EXERCISES

Read a book about an individual’s struggle to cope or adapt to a chronic disease. The book can be a personal account (autobiographical) or written by someone else.

Suggested Learning Exercise 20.1

In a case study presentation or paper, analyze the individual’s ability to manage the disease using the adherence counseling model de- scribed in this chapter. First, describe the dis- ease by its etiology, symptoms, treatment, and progression. Then analyze how various factors, such as family social support, lifestyle, cul- tural factors, mental health status, emotional reaction to the diagnosis, health beliefs, and treatment satisfaction, may affect the charac- ter’s ability to manage the disease and adhere to treatment. Based on this assessment, how might a social worker intervene with the client

JWBT514_ch20.indd 549JWBT514_ch20.indd 549 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

550 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

and family to facilitate behavioral changes, ac- tivate social support, and help them cope more effectively?

Suggested Learning Exercise 20.2

In pairs, assume the role of the individual from the book that you read, and role play by tak- ing turns conducting a social work assessment with one other. Once you have completed this assessment, individuals can take turns com- pleting a social work intervention plan based on strengths and challenges identifi ed in the role-plays. After the work done in pairs, indi- viduals can share information and feedback from the role-play experience with the larger group.

Suggested Learning Exercise 20.3

Considering the information in this chapter, along with information from Chapter 15 (“Social Work With Children and Adolescents With Health Conditions”) and Chapter 16 (“Social Work With Older Adults in Health-Care Settings”) from this book, have small- or large-group discussions about the unique (1) psychosocial barriers and (2) social work intervention issues related to chronic illnesses, such as diabetes, HIV/AIDS, and heart disease among children, adolescents, and older adults. Among each of these popula- tions, what may be unique issues related to ad- hering to medical recommendations?

REFERENCES

Ali, S., Stone, M. A., Peters, J. L., Davies, M. J., & Khunti, K. (2006). The prevalence of co-morbid depression in adults with type 2 diabetes: A systematic review and meta-analysis. Diabetic Medicine, 23, 1165–1173.

Allison, D. B., Mentore, J. L., Heo, M., Chandler, L. P., Cappelleri, J. C., Infante, M. C., & Weiden, P. J. (1999). Antipsychotic-induced weight gain: A comprehensive research synthesis. American Journal of Psychiatry, 156, 1686–1696.

Altica, F. L., Mostashari, F., & Friedland, G. H. (2001). Trust and acceptance of and adherence to antiviral therapy. Journal of Acquired Immune Defi ciency Syndromes, 28, 47–58.

American Diabetes Association. (2004). Diagnosis and classifi cation of diabetes mellitus. Diabetes Care, 27, S5–S10.

American Heart Association. (2002). Heart disease and stroke statistics—2003 update. Dallas, TX: Author.

Amir, S., Rabin, C., & Galatzer, A. (1990). Cognitive and behavioral determinants of compliance in diabetics. Health & Social Work, 15, 144–151.

Andersen, R., Bozzette, S., Shapiro, M., St. Clair, P., Morton, S., Crystal, S., . . . Cunningham, W. (2000). Access of vulnerable groups to antiretroviral therapy among persons in care for HIV disease in the United States. Health Services Research, 2, 389–416.

Anderson, B. J., Auslander, W. F., Jung, K. G., Miller, J. P., & Santiago, J. V. (1990). Assessing family sharing of diabetes responsibilities. Journal of Pediatric Psychology, 15, 477–492.

Anderson, B. J., Brackett, J., Ho, J., & Laffel, L. M. (1999). An offi ce-based intervention to maintain parent- adolescent teamwork in diabetes management: Impact on parental involvement, family confl ict, and subsequent glycemic control. Diabetes Care, 22, 713–721.

Anderson, R. J., Freedland, K. E., Clouse, R. E., & Lustman, P. J. (2001). The prevalence of comorbid depression in adults with diabetes: A meta-analysis. Diabetes Care, 24, 1069–1078.

Anderson, R. J., Grigsby, A. B., Freedland, K. E., de Groot, M., McGill, J. B., & Clouse, R. E. (2002). Anxiety and poor glycemic control: A meta-analytic review of the literature. International Journal of Psychiatry in Medicine, 32, 235–247.

Anding, J. D., Kubena, K. S., McIntosh, W. A., & O’Brien, B. (1996). Blood lipids, cardiovascular fi tness, obesity, and blood pressure: Presence of potential coronary heart disease risk factors in adolescents. Journal of the American Dietetic Association, 96(3), 238–242.

Arias, E., Anderson, R. N., Kung, H., Murphy, S. L., & Kochanek, K. D. (2003). Deaths: Final data for 2001. National Vital Statistics Reports, 52, 1–116.

Arnsten, J. H., Demas, P. A., Grant, R. W., Gourevitch, M. N., Farzadegan, H., Howard, A. A., & Schoenbaum, E. E. (2002). Impact of active drug use on antiretroviral therapy adherence and viral suppression in HIV-infected drug users. Journal of General Internal Medicine, 17, 377–381.

Auslander, W. F. (1993). Brief family interventions to improve family communication and cooperation regarding diabetes management. Spectrum, 6(5), 330–333.

Auslander, W., Anderson, B. J., Bubb, J., Jung, K. G., & Santiago, J. V. (1990). Risk factors to health in diabetic children: A prospective study from diagnosis. Health & Social Work, 15, 133–142.

Auslander, W., Bubb, J., Peelle, A., & Rogge, M. (1989, August). Intervention to improve family role sharing in high risk diabetic adolescents. Paper presented at the annual meeting of the American Association of Diabetes Educators, Seattle, WA.

JWBT514_ch20.indd 550JWBT514_ch20.indd 550 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Adherence and Mental Health Issues in Chronic Disease: Diabetes, Heart Disease, and HIV/AIDS 551

Auslander, W. F., Bubb, J., Rogge, M., & Santiago, J. V. (1993). Family stress and resources: Potential areas of intervention in recently diagnosed children with diabetes. Health & Social Work, 18, 101–113.

Auslander, W. F., Thompson, S., Dreitzer, D., White, N., & Santiago, J. V. (1997). Disparity in glycemic control and adherence between African American and Caucasian youths with diabetes: Family and community contexts. Diabetes Care, 20(10), 1569– 1575.

Barbui, C., Esposito, E., & Cipriani, A. (2009). Selective serotonin reuptake inhibitors and risk of suicide: A systematic review of observational studies. Canadian Medical Association Journal, 180, 291–297.

Barrett-Connor, E. (2003). An epidemiologist looks at hormones and heart disease in women. Journal of Clinical Endocrinology and Metabolism, 88, 4031– 4042.

Barth, J., Schumacher, M., & Herrmann-Lingen, C. (2004). Depression as a risk factor for mortality in patients with coronary heart disease: A meta-analysis. Psychosomatic Medicine, 66, 802–813.

Becker, M. H. (1974). The health belief model and personal health behavior. Health Education Monographs, 2.

Becker, M. H., & Maiman, L. A. (1980). Strategies for enhancing patient compliance. Journal of Community Health, 6, 113–135.

Benson, H. (1976). The relaxation response. New York, NY: HarperTorch.

Berkman, L. F., Blumenthal, J., Burg, M., Carney, R. M., Catellier, D., Cowan, M. J., . . . Enhancing Recovery in Coronary Heart Disease Patients Investigators. (2003). Effects of treating depression and low perceived social support on clinical events after myocardial infarction: The Enhancing Recovery in Coronary Heart Disease Patients (ENRICHD) randomized trial. JAMA, 289, 3106–3116.

Bernstein, D. A., Borkovec, T. D., & Hazlett-Stevens, H. (2000). New directions in progressive relaxation: A guidebook for helping professionals. Westport, CT: Praeger.

Bertakis, K. D. (1977). The communication of information from physician to patient: A method for increasing patient retention and satisfaction. Journal of Family Practice, 5(2), 217–222.

Bhaskaran K., Hamouda, O., Sannes, M., Boufassa, F., Johnson, A. M., Lambert, P. C., & Porter, K. (2008). Changes in the risk of death after HIV seroconversion compared with mortality in the general population. JAMA, 300, 51–59.

Black, S. A. (2002). Diabetes, diversity, and disparity: What do we do with the evidence? American Journal of Public Health, 92, 543–548.

Blazer, D. G., Moody-Ayers, S., Craft-Morgan, J., & Burchett, B. (2002). Depression in diabetes and obesity: Racial/ethnic/gender issues in older adults. Journal of Psychosomatic Research, 53, 913–916.

Bolen, J. C., Rhodes, L., Powell-Griner, E. E., Bland, S. D., & Holtzman, D. (2000). State-specifi c prevalence of selected health behaviors, by race and ethnicity: Behavioral Risk Factor Surveillance System, 1997. Morbidity and Mortality Weekly Report, 49, 1–60.

Bubb, J., Auslander, W. F., & Manthei, D. (1989, November). A model of adherence counseling for chronically ill patients. Paper presented at the annual meeting of the National Association of Social Workers, San Francisco, CA.

Center for Infectious Diseases. (1985). Acquired immuno- defi ciency syndrome (AIDS) weekly surveillance report—United States. Retrieved from www.cdc.gov /hiv/stats/surveillance85.pdf

Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. (1999a). Achievements in public health, 1900–1999: Control of infectious diseases. Morbidity and Mortality Weekly Report, 48, 621–629.

Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. (1999b). Ten great public health achievements—United States, 1900–1999. Morbidity and Mortality Weekly Report, 48, 241–243.

Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. (2000). Data on health disparities. Washington, DC: National Center for Health Statistics.

Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. (2001). HIV/ AIDS Surveillance Report (13th ed., Vol. 2). Atlanta, GA: Author.

Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. (2004a) National diabetes fact sheet: General information and national estimates on diabetes in the United States, 2003. Rev. ed. Atlanta, GA: U.S. Department of Health and Human Services, Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. Retrieved from www.cdc.gov /diabetes/pubs/pdf/ndfs_2003.pdf

Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. (2006). QuickStats: Number of persons with diagnosed diabetes and number of ambulatory care visits related to diabetes: United States, 1997–2004. Morbidity and Mortality Weekly Report, 55, 825.

Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. (2010a). HIV surveillance report, 2008, vol. 20. Retrieved from www .cdc.gov/hiv/topics/surveillance/resources/reports

Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. (2010b). WISQARS leading cause of death reports: 1999–2007. Retrieved from http://webappa.cdc.gov/sasweb/ncipc /leadcaus10.html

Chesney, M. (2003). Adherence to HAART regimens. AIDS Patient Care and STDs, 17, 169–177.

Ciechanowski, P. S., Katon, W. J., & Russo, J. E. (2000). Depression and diabetes: Impact of depressive symptoms on adherence, function, and costs. Archives of Internal Medicine, 160, 3278–3285.

Clouse, R. E., Lustman, P. J., Freedland, K. E., Griffi th, L. S., McGill, J. B., & Carney, R. M. (2003). Depression and coronary heart disease in women with diabetes. Psychosomatic Medicine, 65, 376–383.

JWBT514_ch20.indd 551JWBT514_ch20.indd 551 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

552 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Cohen, S. M. (2009). Concept analysis of adherence in the context of cardiovascular risk reduction. Nursing Forum, 44(1), 25–36.

Conway, B. (2007). The role of adherence to antiretroviral therapy in the management of HIV infection. Journal of Acquired Immune Defi ciency Syndromes, 45, S14– S18.

Cook, J. A., Grey, D., Burke, J., Cohen, M. H., Gurtman, A. C., Richardson, J. L., . . . Hessol, N. A. (2004). Depressive symptoms and AIDS-related mortality among a multisite cohort of HIV-positive women. American Journal of Public Health, 94, 1133–1140.

Cowie, C. C., Rust, K. F., Byrd-Holt, D., Eberhardt, M. S., Saydah, S., Geiss, L. S., . . . Gregg, E. W. (2003). Prevalence of diabetes and impaired fasting glucose in adults: United States, 1999–2000. Morbidity and Mortality Weekly Report, 52, 833–837.

Dannenberg, A. L., McNeil, J. G., Brundage, J. F., & Brookmeyer, R. (1996). Suicide and HIV infection: Mortality follow-up of 4147 HIV seropositive military service applicants. JAMA, 276, 1743–1746.

Deeks, S. G., Smith, M., Holodniy, M., & Kahn, J. O. (1997). HIV-1 protease inhibitors: A review for clinicians. JAMA, 277, 145–153.

de Groot, M., Anderson, R., Freedland, K. E., Clouse, R. E., & Lustman, P. J. (2001). Association of depression and diabetes complications: A meta-analysis. Psychosomatic Medicine, 63, 619–630.

DiMatteo, M. R. (2004). Variations in patients’ adherence to medical recommendations. Medical Care, 42, 200– 209.

DiMatteo, M. R., Haskard, K. B., & Williams, S. L. (2007). Health beliefs, disease severity, and patient adherence: A meta-analysis. Medical Care, 45(6), 521–528.

DiMatteo, M. R., Lepper, H. S., & Croghan, T. W. (2000). Depression is a risk factor for noncompliance with medical treatment: Meta-analysis of the effects of anxiety and depression on patient adherence. Archives of Internal Medicine, 160, 2101–2107.

Elford, J. (2006). Changing patterns of sexual behaviour in the era of highly active antiretroviral therapy. Current Opinion in Infectious Diseases, 19, 26–32.

Ferketich, A. K., Schwartzbaum, J. A., Frid, D. J., & Moeschberger, M. L. (2000). Depression as an antecedent to heart disease among women and men in the NHANES I study. Archives of Internal Medicine, 160, 1261–1268.

Fleming, P. L., Wortley, P. M., Karon, J. M., DeCock, K. M., & Janssen, R. S. (2000). Tracking the HIV epidemic: Current issues, future challenges. American Journal of Public Health, 90, 1037–1041.

Forstein, M., & McDaniel, J. S. (2001). Medical overview of HIV infection and AIDS. Psychiatric Annals, 31, 16–20.

Foster, R., Olajide, D., & Everall, I. (2003). Antiretroviral therapy-induced psychosis: Case report and brief review of the literature. HIV Medicine, 4, 139–144.

Fraenkel, L., & McGraw, S. (2007). What are the essential elements to enable patient participation in medical decision making? Society of General Internal Medicine, 22, 614–619.

Frain, M. P., Bishop, M., Tschopp, M. K., Ferrin, M. J., & Frain, J. (2009). Adherence to medical regimens: Understanding the effects of cognitive appraisal, quality of life, and perceived family resiliency. Rehabilitation Counseling Bulletin, 52, 237–250.

Frasure-Smith, N., & Prince, R. (1985). The ischemic heart disease life stress monitoring program: Impact on mortality. Psychosomatic Medicine, 47, 431–445.

Garcia, P. R., & Cote, J. K. (2003). Factors affecting adherence to antiretroviral therapy in people living with HIV/AIDS. Journal of the Association of Nurses in AIDS Care, 14(4), 37–45.

Glasgow, R. E., & Toobert, D. J. (1988). Social environment and regimen adherence among type II diabetic patients. Diabetes Care, 11, 377–386.

Glasgow, R. E., Wilson, W., & McCaul, K. D. (1985). Regimen adherence: A problematic construct in diabetes research. Diabetes Care, 8, 300–301.

Gonzalez, J. S., Penedo, F. J., Antoni, M. H., Duran, R. E., Fernandez, M. I., McPherson-Baker, S., . . . Schneiderman, N. (2004). Social support, positive states of mind, and HIV treatment adherence in men and women living with HIV/AIDS. Health Psychology, 23, 413–418.

Grigsby, A. B., Anderson, R. J., Freedland, K. E., Clouse, R. E., & Lustman, P. J. (2002). Prevalence of anxiety in adults with diabetes: A systematic review. Journal of Psychosomatic Research, 53, 1053–1060.

Guyer, B., Freedman, M. A., Strobino, D. M., & Sondik, E. J. (2000). Annual summary of vital statistics: Trends in the health of Americans during the twentieth century. Pediatrics, 106, 1307–1317.

Hall, J. A., Roter, D. L., & Katz, N. R. (1988). Meta- analysis of correlates of provider behavior in medical encounters. Medical Care, 26, 657–675.

Hamburg, B. A., & Inoff, G. E. (1983). Coping with predictable crises of diabetes. Diabetes Care, 6, 409–416.

Hanson, C. L., De Guire, M. J., Schinkel, A. M., & Kolterman, O. G. (1995). Empirical validation for a family-centered model of care. Diabetes Care, 18, 1347–1356.

Heaney, C. A., & Israel, B. A. (1997). Social networks and social support. In K. Glanz, F. M. Lewis, & B. K. Rimer (Eds.), Health behavior and health education (pp. 179–205). San Francisco, CA: Jossey Bass.

Heisler, M. (2008). Actively engaging patients in treatment decision making and monitoring as a strategy to improve hypertension outcomes in diabetes mellitus. Circulation, 117, 1355–1357.

Herek, G. M., & Glunt, E. K. (1988). An epidemic of stigma: Public reactions to AIDS. American Psychologist, 43, 886–891.

Herskowitz, D. R., Jacobson, A. M., Cole, C., Hauser, S. T., Wolfsdorf, J. I., Willett, J. B., . . . Wertlieb, D.

JWBT514_ch20.indd 552JWBT514_ch20.indd 552 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Adherence and Mental Health Issues in Chronic Disease: Diabetes, Heart Disease, and HIV/AIDS 553

(1995). Psychosocial predictors of acute complications of diabetes in youth. Diabetic Medicine, 12, 612–618.

Hippisley-Cox, J., Fielding, K., & Pringle, M. (1998). Depression as a risk factor for ischaemic heart disease in men: Population based case-control study. British Medical Journal, 316, 1714–1719.

Hughes, D., & Kleespies, P. (2001). Suicide in the medically ill. Suicide and Life-Threatening Behavior, 31(Suppl.), S48–S59.

Ismail, K., Winkley, K., & Rabe-Hesketh, S. (2004). Systematic review and meta-analysis of randomized controlled trials of psychological interventions to improve glycaemic control in patients with type 2 diabetes. Lancet, 363, 1589–1597.

Jacobson, A. M., Hauser, S. T., Lavori, P., Wolfsdorf, J. I., Herskowitz, R. D., Milley, J. E., . . . Stein, J. (1990). Adherence among children and adolescents with insulin-dependent diabetes mellitus over a 4-year longitudinal follow-up: Pt. 1. The infl uence of patient coping and adjustment. Journal of Pediatric Psychology, 15, 511–526.

Jacobson, L. P., Kirby, A. J., Polk, S., Phair, J. P., Besley, D. R., Saah, A. J., . . . Schrager, L. K. (1993). Changes in survival time after acquired immunodefi ciency syndrome (AIDS): 1984–1991. American Journal of Epidemiology, 138, 952–964.

Johnson, S. B., Perwien, A. R., & Silverstein, J. H. (2000). Response to hypo- and hyperglycemia in adolescents with type 1 diabetes. Journal of Pediatric Psychology, 25, 171–178.

Joint United Nations Programme on HIV/AIDS. (2004). 2004 report on the global AIDS epidemic: 4th global report. Geneva, Switzerland: Author. Retrieved from www.unaids.org

Joint United Nations Programme on HIV/AIDS. (2009). AIDS epidemic update: November 2009. Geneva, Switzerland: Author. Retrieved from http://data.unaids .org/pub/Report/2009/JC1700_Epi_Update_2009 _en.pdf

Jones, D. A., & West, R. R. (2004). Psychological rehabilitation after myocardial infarction: Multicentre randomised controlled trial. British Medical Journal, 313, 1517–1521.

Jones, J. M., Lawson, M. L., Daneman, D., Olmsted, M. P., & Rodin, G. (2000). Eating disorders in adolescent females with and without type 1 diabetes: cross- sectional study. British Medical Journal, 320, 1563– 1566.

Karon, J. M., Fleming, P. L., Steketee, R. W., & DeCock, K. M. (2001). HIV in the United States at the turn of the century: An epidemic in transition. American Journal of Public Health, 91, 1060–1068.

Katon, W., Von Korff, M., Ciechanowski, P., Russo, J., Lin, E., Simon, G., . . . Young, B. (2004). Behavioral and clinical factors associated with depression among individuals with diabetes. Diabetes Care, 27, 914–920.

Kim, C., Newton, K. M., & Knopp, R. H. (2002). Gestational diabetes and the incidence of type 2 diabetes: A systematic review. Diabetes Care, 25, 1861–1868.

Kindig, D. A., Nielsen-Bohlman, L., & Panzer, A. (Eds.) (2004). Health literacy: A prescription to end confusion. Washington DC: National Academy Press.

Kirsch, I., Jungeblut, A., Jenkins, L., & Kolstad, L. (1993). Adult literacy in America: A fi rst look at the results of the National Adult Literacy Survey. Washington, DC: National Center for Education Statistics, U.S. Department of Education.

Knol, M. J., Twisk, J. W., Beekman, A. T., Heine, R. J., Snoek, F. J., & Pouwer, F. (2006). Depression as a risk factor for the onset of type 2 diabetes mellitus: A meta- analysis. Diabetologia, 49, 837–845.

Knowler, W. C., Saad, M. F., Pettitt, D. J., Nelson, R. G., & Bennett, P. H. (1993). Determinants of diabetes mellitus in the Pima Indians. Diabetes Care, 16, 216– 227.

Komiti, A., Judd, F., Grech, P., Mijch, A., Hoy, J., Lloyd, J. H., & Street, A. (2001). Suicidal behavior in people with HIV/AIDS: A review. Australian and New Zealand Journal of Psychiatry, 35, 747–757.

Koocher, G. P., Curtiss, E. K., Pollin, I. S., & Patton, K. E. (2001). Medical crisis counseling in a health maintenance organization: Preventive intervention. Professional Psychology: Research and Practice, 32, 52–58.

Koro, C. E., Fedder, D. O., L’Italien, G. J., Weiss, S. S., Magder, L. S., Kreyenbuhl, J., . . . Buchanan, R. W. (2002). Assessment of independent effect of olanzapine and risperidone on risk of diabetes among patients with schizophrenia: Population based nested case-control study. British Medical Journal, 325, 243–251.

Kovacs, M., Goldston, D., Obrosky, D. S., & Bonar, L. K. (1997). Psychiatric disorders in youths with IDDM: Rates and risk factors. Diabetes Care, 20, 36–44.

Kovacs, M., Mukerji, P., Drash, A., & Iyengar, S. (1995). Biomedical and psychiatric risk factors for retinopathy among children with IDDM. Diabetes Care, 18, 1592– 1599.

Kronish, I. M., Rieckmann, N., Halm, E. A., Shimbo, D., Vorchheimer, D., Haas, D. C., & Davidson, K. W. (2006). Persistent depression affects adherence to secondary prevention behaviors after acute coronary syndromes. Journal of General Internal Medicine, 21, 1178–1883.

Kruse, J., Schmitz, N., & Thefeld, W. (2004). On the association between diabetes and mental disorders in a community sample: Results from the German National Health Interview and Examination Survey. Diabetes Care, 26, 1841–1846.

Lamptey, P. R. (2002). Reducing heterosexual transmission of HIV in poor countries. British Medical Journal, 324, 207–211.

JWBT514_ch20.indd 553JWBT514_ch20.indd 553 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

554 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Lee, E. T., Howard, B. V., Go, O., Savage, P. J., Fabsitz, R. R., Robbins, D. C., & Welty, T. K. (2000). Prevalence of undiagnosed diabetes in three American Indian populations: The Strong Heart Study. Diabetes Care, 23, 181–186.

Leslie, D. L., & Rosenheck, R. A. (2004). Incidence of newly diagnosed diabetes attributable to atypical antipsychotic medications. American Journal of Psychiatry, 161, 1709–1711.

Lett, H. S., Blumenthal, J. A., Babyak, M. A., Sherwood, A., Strauman, T., Robins, C., & Newman, M. F. (2004). Depression as a risk factor for coronary artery disease: Evidence, mechanisms, and treatment. Psychosomatic Medicine, 66, 305–315.

Ley, P. (1982). Giving information to patients. In J. R. Eiser (Ed.), Social psychology and behavioral science (pp. 339–373). Hoboken, NJ: John Wiley & Sons.

Li, C., Ford, E. S., Strine, T. W., & Mokdad, A. H. (2008). Prevalence of depression among U.S. adults with diabetes: Findings from the 2006 behavioral risk factor surveillance system. Diabetes Care, 31, 105–107.

Liner, K. J., Hall, C. D., & Robertson, K. R. (2008). Effects of antiretroviral therapy on cognitive impairment. Current HIV/AIDS Reports, 5, 64–71.

Lorenz, R. A., Bubb, J., Davis, D., Jacobson, A., Jannasch, K., Kramer, J., . . . Schlundt, D. (1996). Changing behavior. Diabetes Care, 19, 648–652.

Low-Beer, S., Chan, K., Yip, B., Wood, E., Montaner, J. S., O’Shaughnessy, M. V., & Hogg, R. S. (2000). Depressive symptoms decline among persons on HIV protease inhibitors. Journal of Acquired Immune Defi ciency Syndromes, 23, 295–301.

Lustman, P. J., Anderson, R. J., Freedland, K. E., de Groot, M. K., Carney, R. M., & Crouse, R. E. (2000). Depression and poor glycemic control: A meta-analytic review of the literature. Diabetes Care, 23, 934–942.

Lustman, P. J., & Clouse, R. E. (2005). Depression in diabetic patients: The relationship between mood and glycemic control. Journal of Diabetes Complications, 19, 113–122.

Lyon, D. E. (2001). Human immunodefi ciency virus (HIV) disease in persons with severe mental illness. Issues in Mental Health Nursing, 22, 109–119.

Mainous, A. G., Baker, R., Koopman, R. J., Saxena, S., Diaz, V. A., Everett, C. J., & Majeed, A. (2007). Impact of the population at risk of diabetes on projections of diabetes burden in the United States: An epidemic on the way. Diabetologia, 50, 934–940.

Mannucci, E., Rotella, F., Ricca, V., Moretti, S., Placidi, G. F., & Rotella, C. M. (2005). Eating disorders in patients with type 1 diabetes: A meta-analysis. Journal of Endocrinological Investigation, 28, 417–419.

Manson, J. E., Allison, M. A., Rossouw, J. E., Carr, J., Langer, R. D., Hsia, J., . . . WHI and WHI-CACS Investigators. (2007). Estrogen therapy and coronary- artery calcifi cation. New England Journal of Medicine, 356, 2591–2602.

Manson, J. E., Hsia, J., Johnson, K. C., Rossouw, J. E., Assaf, A. R., Lasser, N. L., . . . Women’s Health Initiative Investigators. (2003). Estrogen plus progestin and the risk of coronary heart disease. New England Journal of Medicine, 349, 523–534.

Marlatt, G. A., & Gordon, J. R. (1985). Relapse prevention: Maintenance strategies for addictive behavior change. New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Marzuk, P. M., Tardiff, K., Leon, A. C., Hirsch, C. S., Hartwell, N., Portera, L., & Iqbal, M. I. (1997). HIV seroprevalence among suicide victims in New York City, 1991–1993. American Journal of Psychiatry, 154, 1720–1725.

McGinnis, R. A., McGrady, A., Cox, S. A., & Grower- Dowling, K. A. (2005). Biofeedback-assisted relaxation in type 2 diabetes. Diabetes Care, 28, 2145–2149.

McLaughlin, T. J., Aupont, O., Bambauer, K. Z., Stone, P., Mullan, M. G., Colagiovanni, J., . . . Locke, S. E. (2005). Improving psychologic adjustment to chronic illness in cardiac patients: The role of depression and anxiety. Journal of General Internal Medicine, 20, 1084–1090.

McVeigh, K. H., Mostashari, F., & Thorpe, L. E. (2004). Serious psychological distress among person with diabetes—New York City, 2003. Morbidity and Mortality Weekly Report, 53, 1089–1090.

Meade, C. S., & Sikkema, K. J. (2005). HIV risk behavior among adults with severe mental illness: A systematic review. Clinical Psychology Review, 25, 433–457.

Meichenbaum, D., & Turk, D. C. (1987). Facilitating treatment adherence: A practitioner’s guidebook. New York, NY: Plenum Press.

Mezuk, B., Eaton, W. W., Albrecht, S., & Golden, S. H. (2008). Depression and type 2 diabetes over the lifespan. Diabetes Care, 31, 2383–2390.

Mokdad, A. H., Ford, E. S., Bowman, B. A., Nelson, D. E., Engelgau, M. M., Vinicor, F., & Marks, J. S. (2000). Diabetes trends in the United States: 1990 to 1998. Diabetes Care, 23, 1278–1283.

Nathan, P. E., & Gorman, J. M. (2007). A guide to treatments that work (3rd ed.). Oxford, UK: Oxford University Press.

National Center for Health Statistics. (2010). Health, United States, 2009: With special feature on medical technology. Hyattsville, MD: Author. Retrieved from www.cdc.gov/nchs/data/hus/hus09.pdf

National Institute of Allergy and Infectious Diseases. (2003). HIV infection and AIDS: An overview. Hyattsville, MD: U.S. Dept. of Health and Human Services. Retrieved from www.niaid.nih.gov/fact sheets/hivinf.htm

National Institute of Diabetes and Digestive and Kidney Diseases. (2008). National diabetes statistics, 2007. Bethesda, MD: National Institutes of Health. Retrieved from http://diabetes.niddk.nih.gov/dm/pubs /statistics/

Payne, R. A., & Donaghy, M. (2010). Payne’s handbook of relaxation techniques: A practical handbook for

JWBT514_ch20.indd 554JWBT514_ch20.indd 554 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Adherence and Mental Health Issues in Chronic Disease: Diabetes, Heart Disease, and HIV/AIDS 555

the health care professional (4th ed.). Edinburgh, Scotland: Churchill Livingstone.

Petrak, F., & Herpertz, S. (2009). Treatment of depression in diabetes: An update. Current Opinion in Psychiatry, 22, 211–217.

Peyrot, M., & Rubin, R. R. (1997). Levels and risks of depression and anxiety symptomatology among diabetic adults. Diabetes Care, 20, 585–590.

Pollin, I. (1995). Medical crisis counseling: Short-term treatment for long-term illness. Evanston, IL: Norton.

Pratt, L. A., Ford, D. E., Crum, R. M., Armenian, H. K., Gallo, J. J., & Eaton, W. W. (1996). Depression, psychotropic medication, and risk of myocardial infarction: Prospective data from the Baltimore ECA follow-up. Circulation, 94, 3123–3129.

Rihmer, Z. (2007). Suicide risk in mood disorders. Current Opinion in Psychiatry, 20, 17–22.

Robbins, J. A., Bertakis, K. D., Helms, L. J., Azari, R., Callahan, E. J., & Creten, D. A. (1993). The infl uence of physician practice behaviors on patient satisfaction. Family Medicine, 25(1), 17–20.

Rogers, G., Curry, M., Oddy, J., Pratt, N., Beilby, J., & Wilkinson, D. (2003). Depressive disorders and unprotected casual anal sex among Australian homosexually active men in primary care. HIV Medicine, 4, 271–275.

Rosenthal, M. J., Fajardo, M., Gilmore, S., Morley, J. E., & Naliboff, B. D. (1998). Hospitalization and mortality of diabetes in older adults: A 3-year prospective study. Diabetes Care, 21, 231–235.

Roter, D. L. (1977). Patient participation in the patient- provider interaction: The effects of patient question asking on the quality of interaction, satisfaction and compliance. Health Education Monographs, 5(4), 281–315.

Roter, D. L., & Hall, J. A. (1997). Patient-provider communication. In K. Glanz, F. M. Lewis, & B. K. Rimer (Eds.), Health behavior and health education (pp. 206–226). San Francisco, CA: Jossey-Bass.

Roter, D. L., Hall, J. A., & Katz, N. R. (1987). Relations between physicians’ behaviors and patients’ satisfaction, recall, and impressions: An analogue study. Medical Care, 25, 437–451.

Rozanski, A., Blumenthal, J. A., & Kaplan, J. (1999). Impact of psychological factors on the pathogenesis of cardiovascular disease and implications for therapy. Circulation, 99, 2192–2217.

Rubin, R. R., Ciechanowski, P., Egede, L., Lin, E. H. B., & Lustman, P. J. (2004). Recognizing and treating depression in patients with diabetes. Current Diabetes Reports, 4, 119–125.

Rubin, R. R., & Peyrot, M. (2001). Psychological issues and treatments for people with diabetes. Journal of Clinical Psychology, 57, 457–478.

Ryan, M. C. M., Collins, P., & Thakore, J. H. (2003). Impaired fasting glucose tolerance in fi rst episode,

drug naive patients with schizophrenia. American Journal of Psychiatry, 160, 284–289.

Rydall, A. C., Rodin, G. M., Olmsted, M. P., Devenyi, R. G., & Daneman, D. (1997). Disordered eating behavior and microvascular complications in young women with insulin-dependent diabetes mellitus. New England Journal of Medicine, 336, 1849–1854.

Sacchetti, E., Turrina, C., Parrinello, G., Brignoli, O., Stefanini, G., & Mazzaglia, G. (2005). Incidence of diabetes in a general practice population: A database cohort study on the relationship with haloperidol, olanzapine, risperidone or quetiapine exposure. International Clinical Psychopharmacology, 20, 33–37.

Sax, P. E., & Kumar, P. (2004). Tolerability and safety of HIV protease inhibitors in adults. Journal of Acquired Immune Defi ciency Syndromes, 37, 1111–1124.

Schulman, K. A., Berlin, J. A., Harless, W., Kerner, J. F., Sistrunk, S., Gersh, B. J., . . . Escarce, J. J. (1999). The effect of race and sex on physicians’ recommendations for cardiac catheterization. New England Journal of Medicine, 340, 618–626.

Sewell, G. (2004). Using deep relaxation in children and adolescents with diabetes. Journal of Diabetes Nursing, 8, 309–313.

Silberman, J., Tentler, A., Ramgopal, R., & Epstein, R. M. (2007). Recall-promoting physician behaviors in primary care. Journal of General Internal Medicine, 23(9), 1487–1490.

Smith-Rogers, A., Miller, S., Murphy, D. A., Tanney, M., & Fortune, T. (2001). The TREAT (Therapeutic Regimens Enhancing Adherence in Teens) Program: Theory and preliminary results. Journal of Adolescent Health, 298, 30–38.

Snoek, F. J., van der Ven, N. C., Twisk, J. W., Hogenelst, M. H., Tromp-Wever, A. M., & van der Ploeg, H. M. (2008). Cognitive behavioural therapy (CBT) compared with blood glucose awareness training (BGAT) in poorly controlled type 1 diabetic patients: Long- term effects on HbA moderated by depression: A randomized controlled trial. Diabetic Medicine, 25, 1337–1342.

Stacey, D., Samant, R., & Bennett, C. (2008). Decision making in oncology: A review of patient decision aids to support patient participation. CA: A Cancer Journal for Clinicians, 58, 293–304.

Starace, F., Ammassari, A., Trotta, M. P., Murri, R., De Longis, P., Izzo, C., . . . AdICoNA and the NeuroIcoNA Study Groups. (2002). Depression is a risk factor for suboptimal adherence to highly active antiretroviral therapy. Journal of Acquired Immune Defi ciency Syndromes, 31, S136–S139.

Steele, R. G., & Grauer, D. (2003). Adherence to antiretroviral therapy for pediatric HIV infection: Review of the literature and recommendations for research. Clinical Child and Family Psychology Review, 6, 17–30.

JWBT514_ch20.indd 555JWBT514_ch20.indd 555 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

556 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Surtees, P. G., Wainwright, N. W. J., Luben, R. N., Wareham, N. J., Bingham, S. A., & Khaw, K. (2008). Depression and ischemic heart disease mortality: Evidence from the EPIC-Norfolk United Kingdom Prospective Cohort Study. American Journal of Psychiatry, 165, 515–523.

Thompson, S., Auslander, W. F., & White, N. (2001a). Comparison between single-mother and two-parent families on metabolic control of youths with diabetes. Diabetes Care, 24, 234–238.

Thompson, S., Auslander, W. F., & White, N. (2001b). Infl uence of family structure on health among youths with diabetes. Health & Social Work, 26, 7–14.

Tull, E. S., & Roseman, J. M. (1995). Diabetes in African Americans. In National Diabetes Data Group (Ed.), Diabetes in America (NIH Publication No. 95–1468, 2nd ed.). Washington, DC: National Institute of Diabetes and Digestive and Kidney Diseases.

U.S. Department of Health and Human Services. (2004). Summary health statistics for U.S. adults: National Health Interview Survey, 2002 (DHHS Publication No. PHS 2004–1550). Hyattsville, MD: Author.

van Dulmen, S., Sluijs, E., van Dijk, L., de Ridder, D., Heerdink, R., & Bensing, J. (2007). Patient adherence to medical treatment: a review of reviews. BMC Health Services Research, 7, 55.

Wild, S., Roglic, G., Green, A., Sicree, R., & King, H. (2004). Global prevalence of diabetes: Estimates for the year 2000 and projections for 2030. Diabetes Care, 27, 1047–1053.

World Health Organization. (2004). Diabetes action now: An initiative of the World Health Organization and International Diabetes Federation. Geneva, Switzerland: Author. Retrieved from www.who.int /diabetes/actionnow/en/DANbooklet.pdf

World Health Organization. (2008). Fact sheet: The top ten causes of death. Geneva, Switzerland: Author. Retrieved from www.who.int/mediacentre/factsheets /fs310_2008.pdf

World Health Organization. (2009a). Diabetes. Geneva, Switzerland: Author. Retrieved from www.who.int /mediacentre/factsheets/fs312/en/print.html

World Health Organization. (2009b). Global health risks: Mortality and the burden of disease attributable to selected major risks. Geneva, Switzerland: Author. Retrieved from www.who.int/healthinfo/global_burden _disease/GlobalHealthRisks_report_full.pdf

Wulsin, L., & Singal, B. (2003). Do depressive symptoms increase the risk for the onset of coronary disease? A systematic quantitative review. Psychosomatic Medicine, 65, 201–210.

Wysocki, T., Harris, M. A., Greco, P., Bubb, J., Danda, C. E., Harvey, L. M., . . . White, N. H. (2000). Diabetes mellitus in the transition to adulthood: Adjustment, self-care, and health status. Journal of Developmental and Behavioral Pediatrics, 25, 23–33.

Yun, L. W., Maravi, M., Kobayashi, J. S., Barton, P. L., & Davidson, A. J. (2005). Antidepressant treatment improves adherence to antiretroviral therapy among depressed HIV-infected patients. Journal of Acquired Immune Defi ciency Syndrome, 38, 432–438.

JWBT514_ch20.indd 556JWBT514_ch20.indd 556 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

557

21

Social Work and Genetics

ALLISON WERNER-LIN AND KATE REED

Historically, social workers in health care have helped families cope with the psychoso- cial implications of genetic conditions (Schild & Black, 1984). The earliest articles that ad- dress how to integrate genetic concepts and concerns into social work practice were pub- lished over 45 years ago. Two seminal articles, one by Schild (1966) and the other by Schultz (1966), outlined advances in genetics and their potential infl uence on social work practice. Both emphasized the importance of psychoso- cial support for individuals and families deal- ing with genetic disorders and suggested that social workers are particularly well suited to provide counseling about genetics.

Since then, scientifi c advances have al- tered the landscape of genetic medicine dra- matically. Most notably, the Human Genome Project was launched in 1990 to determine the exact makeup of the human genome with the hope of improving health by identifying ge- netic variants that contribute to disease. Com- pleted in 2003, the Human Genome Project (www.ornl.gov/sci/techresources/Human _Genome/home.shtml) allows us to read the human genetic blueprint. This opens the door for improved methods of understanding the underlying biology and genetics of disease and the development of effective interventions for both rare and common genetic conditions. Sci- entists have made great strides in identifying genetic contributions that cause or predispose individuals to specifi c disorders. Identifying these genetic variants has enabled the devel- opment of genetic tests for individuals inter- ested in learning whether they carry specifi c gene variants (commonly called mutations or alterations) that predispose or cause illness.

Yet the ability to identify genetic contribu- tions to disease continues to outpace the de- velopment of targeted therapies. Furthermore, our understanding of the relationship between single gene variants and disease expression has increased in complexity, and the interplay between multiple genes and environmental factors further complicates prediction. Thus an unintended result of the Human Genome Project was the creation of a new class of pa- tients for whom we can detect risk variants but cannot determine whether or when disease will develop.

The identifi cation of genetic variations that predispose individuals to a variety of condi- tions means that social workers must contend with a new risk concept, one that is micro- scopic. Our person-in-environment lens must be broadened to include consideration of ge- netic variation as a core feature of develop- mental, social, and environmental assessment without essentializing genetic contributions to conditions or traits. As scientists identify genes linked to stigmatized disorders, such as mental illness and addiction, or personality traits, such as aggression and anxiety, the abil- ity to identify genetic predispositions comes with a potent ethical, social, and personal cost. Knowledge of basic genetic concepts and how they are presented and understood in medical care is critical to competent practice, especially with marginalized and vulnerable populations, such as those with limited health literacy and inadequate resources.

The genetic revolution offers a variety of opportunities for social workers to partici- pate in the comprehensive care of patients and families to address an entire range of health

JWBT514_ch21.indd 557JWBT514_ch21.indd 557 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

558 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

shape the ways humans grow and develop. For example, only a subset of people ex- posed to tobacco become addicted. Genetic variants infl uence how nicotine is processed in the body; people with one variant experi- ence the effects of nicotine for longer than others because it is metabolized more slowly. These individuals need to smoke fewer ciga- rettes during the course of a day than people who metabolize nicotine more rapidly. These genetic variants interact with other environ- mental and behavioral factors, such as access to cigarettes and composition of the social network, to determine whether an individual develops an addiction.

Genetic variation refers to the differences that exist in the genetic code across individu- als and groups. Those differences contribute to diversity in physical appearance, health, and behavior and affect the ways individuals respond to their environment. The code that determines the basic instructions for growth and development, DNA (deoxyribonucleic acid), is grossly the same among all indi- viduals because those instructions are neces- sary to support life. For example, all humans have the same basic body shape and develop organs in the same order and at around the same time. Beyond these fundamental in- structions, though, variation is the rule, not the exception.

A rapidly growing body of literature ad- dresses genetic variation and the interplay between genes and environments (Manolio, 2009). This literature tells us that genetic variation contributes to the array of personal- ity and behavioral traits we develop, to illness expression and treatment response, and to the development of psychopathology. Genetic fac- tors play a role in an individual’s stress and coping response, thus shaping the way individ- uals engage with and respond to environmen- tal stressors (Caspi, Hariri, & Holmes, Uher, & Moffi tt, 2010). Social workers are trained to assess environments and to hypothesize and test links between environmental strengths and constraints and mental health and health outcomes. Recognizing genetic as well as en- vironmental factors will allow social workers,

concerns, including genetic aspects of well-be- ing. The strengths perspective and person-in- environment lens suggest a potent role for social workers to participate in designing in- formation-sharing models and approaches to genetic services that are tailored to the specifi c needs of individuals, families, and communi- ties (Kent, 2003). The aim of this chapter is to present an overview of basic genetic concepts and dilemmas most relevant to social work practice.

Chapter Objectives • Introduce basic concepts and recent devel-

opments in genetic medicine. • Identify variation and gene–environment

interaction as a foundation for building strengths-based knowledge and practice in genetics.

• Discuss opportunities and challenges for in- tegrating social work into transdisciplinary clinical and research teams in genetic medi- cine.

• Introduce common ethical issues faced by providers and patients involved in genetic medicine.

• Examine recent policy developments in the area of genetic medicine.

• Suggest roles for social work in develop- ing and implementing research, advocacy, education, and intervention protocols in genetics.

INTRODUCTION TO GENETIC VARIATION

No two people or environments are identi- cal. Even twins born with identical genetic blueprints develop distinct personalities, interests, and social networks. Researchers have long studied twin pairs in an attempt to identify the impact of varied environmental conditions on the ways genes are expressed (their phenotype) (Rose & Kaprio, 2008; Shih, Belmonte, & Zandi, 2004). Yet great variation exists in how specifi c genes are ex- pressed and in how those genes interact with similar and diverse environmental factors to

JWBT514_ch21.indd 558JWBT514_ch21.indd 558 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Social Work and Genetics 559

in partnership with other health and mental health professionals, to develop interventions and resources that are targeted to an individ- ual’s specifi c circumstances across a variety of presenting problems. Thus, with respect to social work practice in the age of genetic dis- covery, social workers are in the ideal position to identify the environmental, behavioral, and familial factors that provide the context for gene expression.

The Basics

Variation ultimately occurs at the level of DNA, which is the source of all genetic in- formation. DNA carries genetic information encoded in four different chemicals bases— adenine, thymine, cytosine, and guanine, or, more familiarly, A, T, C, and G—which pair (A-T and C-G) together. Each pair is called a nucleotide, and the sequence of nucleotides conveys specifi c instructions about the growth, function, and development of the cells. Genes are segments of DNA with a unique combi- nation of nucleotides that contain instructions for making a specifi c protein required for cell growth, development, and/or maintenance. Human beings have about 20,000 to 25,000 genes. All human beings have roughly the same genes, but no two people, except identi- cal twins, have the same versions (alleles) of each of those genes. Each person generally has two copies of each gene, one inherited from each parent (see Figure 21.1).

Chromosomes provide the organizational structure for DNA. They are composed of complexes of genes and proteins found in the nucleus of the cell. A normal human cell has 46 chromosomes. We inherit 23 chromosomes from each parent, which means we have 23 pairs of chromosomes and two copies of every gene. The chromosomes that we inherit from each parent are grossly the same for 22 pairs. The 23rd pair of chromosomes determines biological sex of the individual. Females have two X chromosomes and males have one X and one Y chromosome.

Sources of Genetic Variation

Genetic variation refers to the changes that exist in the genetic code across individuals and groups that affect the function of the gene. These changes can be small or large, and their effect on an individual depends on their loca- tion in the genome and whether the change has functional signifi cance. Variation itself is neutral; not all changes lead to negative health consequences. Some genetic changes have no effect, some make individuals less susceptible to certain diseases, and some increase the risk for disease.

There are two main types of genetic varia- tion, reproductive and structural. Structural variation, in many ways, can be thought of as “mistakes” that occur during the replication of DNA. By contrast, we all have genes that facili- tate the process of increasing variation through reproduction. The following explanations are designed to provide an overview of the me- chanics of variation that have signifi cance for how individuals, families, and groups present for treatment, the kinds of questions or medi- cal decisions they may be facing, and the scope of psychosocial intervention that may facilitate positive health and mental health outcomes.

Reproductive Variation

The union of genetically distinct egg and sperm produces a unique combination of genetic in- formation, thereby increasing variation. During the process of reproduction, genetic material from each biological parent is sorted randomly Figure 21.1 DNA

Deoxyribonucleic Acid (DNA)

Chromosome

JWBT514_ch21.indd 559JWBT514_ch21.indd 559 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

560 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

to ensure a full complement of genes from each parent. Therefore, each egg or sperm cell is a mix of what that individual inherited from each biological parent. This random as- sortment creates a unique person with risk factors and disease susceptibly inherited from the combination of the parents’ genetic risk factors and susceptibility. Random assortment further ensures that siblings are not genetically identical (except for twins); they will inherit different combinations of their parents’ DNA (see Box 21.1).

Structural Variation

Structural variation refers to changes in the genetic code that may be as large as an entire chromosome or as small as a single nucleo- tide (A-T or C-G pair) within a gene. These include genetic mutations and polymorphisms. Changes that are seen in less than 1% of the population typically are referred to as muta- tions. A mutation is a change to DNA that, depending on its location on the gene and the type of change, can impact the function of a protein encoded for by that gene. In some

Box 21.1 Patterns of Inheritance

Most traits and conditions have a genetic component that is inherited in one of a few common patterns. Identifying the pattern can inform diagnostic and counseling approaches about the risk of developing the trait or condition for the individual and their family members. Patterns of inheritance also can impact individuals’ understanding of and experience with the condition.

Autosomal Dominant Inheritance

Autosomal dominant patterns of inheritance are indicated by conditions or traits for which having a mutation on one copy of the causative gene is suffi cient to develop the phenotype. An individual with an autosomal dominant condition or trait often has a parent with the same condition. Each child of a carrier has a 50% chance of inheriting an autosomal dominant mutation, with males and females equally likely to be affected. Dominant traits usually are seen in multiple, successive generations in a family.

Autosomal Recessive Inheritance

Autosomal recessive patterns of inheritance are indicated by conditions that require both copies of the gene in question to carry mutations that prevent normal functioning. Individuals who have one working copy of a gene and one nonworking copy are called carriers and are at increased risk of having a child with the condition if the other parent is also a carrier. Males and females are equally likely to be affected by autosomal recessive conditions, and these conditions often are found in siblings. Affected individuals may have unaffected parents, and all offspring of an affected individual are carriers of the gene mutation. Each child of two carrier parents has a 25% chance of being affected.

Carrier

X-Linked Inheritance

X-linked patterns of inheritance are indicated by conditions or traits that are caused by changes in genes found on the X chromosome. The X and Y chromosomes determine an individual’s sex; males have one X chromosome and one Y chromosome

JWBT514_ch21.indd 560JWBT514_ch21.indd 560 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Social Work and Genetics 561

cases, a mutation can change the meaning of the DNA substantially, resulting in an ineffec- tive or nonfunctional protein. In other cases, mutations do not disable to protein and are be- nign. Environmental conditions also infl uence the impact of a mutation. For example, a muta- tion in the gene that codes for hemoglobin B can result in sickle cell trait. This trait causes considerable damage and discomfort at high altitudes but has no impact at sea level.

Some genetic mutations have enabled adap- tive responses to changing environments. For example, a small subset of people who are reg- ularly exposed to human immunodefi ciency virus (HIV) carry a specifi c mutation that pre- vents infection by denying the virus access to human cells. As far as we know, this mutation is not associated with any negative effects and may have other undiscovered properties, and most carriers are unlikely to know they have it. This mutation likely existed well before the HIV epidemic, but only with a changed

environment within which HIV exists did we become aware of its existence. Other benefi cial mutations in our current environment include the ability to digest lactose and resistance to malaria infection in carriers of sickle cell trait.

Somatic mutations occur sporadically after birth. Although they may have a signifi cant impact on the carrier, the carrier’s children are not at risk of inheriting the mutation. Most types of cancer, for example, are due to genetic mutations in a single cell caused by exposure to environmental toxins. These mutations affect the individual but, because they are not present in the sex cells, cannot be passed onto the next generation. Only specifi c types of mutations, called germline mutation, are passed from one generation to the next in a family bloodline. Germline mutations are those that are present in the sex (egg and sperm) cells. A small subset of people who develop cancer carry a germline mutation, such as the BRCA1 or BRCA2 mu- tations, which predispose carriers to elevated

while females have two X chromosomes. This means that males have only one copy of each of the genes found on the X chromosome while females have two copies. As a result, females typically are less affected by X-linked conditions because they have one normal copy of the gene that may partially compensate for the missing or incorrect gene product. Because affected males transmit their only X chromosome to their daughters but not their sons (who inherit their Y chromosome instead), all daughters will become carriers while sons will not. Women who carry one normal copy and one mutated copy of a gene implicated in an X-linked disorder are called carriers. Each son has a 50% risk of inheriting the mutated version and thus, having the condition.

Multifactorial Inheritance

Multifactorial patterns of inheritance are implicated by conditions or traits with many contributing factors, including both genetic and environmental factors. These conditions or traits often occur in multiple family members due to shared environmental and genetic factors. Most commonly, chronic conditions such as heart disease and diabetes are multifactorial, as are many traits, including height and depression. Because multiple factors are involved in combination, some of which may not be easily identifi ed, it is diffi cult to predict whether individuals will develop symptoms even if genetic testing for the known genetic factors is available.

mood disorder

alcoholism suicide

ADHD

anxiety/ depression

depression

JWBT514_ch21.indd 561JWBT514_ch21.indd 561 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

562 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

risk of developing breast and ovarian cancer. In this subset of individuals, cancer develops only after exposure to an environmental toxin that causes an additional genetic mutation to occur. In this case, the germline mutation and the somatic mutation each act as an indepen- dent “strike” against the individual’s resistance to cancer. Cancer in these individuals tends to occur at an earlier age because the mutation is present from birth.

Polymorphisms are changes in the DNA that are present in more than 1% of the popula- tion, making them genetically common. Many polymorphisms consist of a change to a single nucleotide (single nucleotide polymorphism or SNP). Although some polymorphisms are associated with moderate increases in risk for common diseases, not all polymorphisms are associated with disease risk. Examples of non– disease-related polymorphisms are those that contribute to eye and skin color.

Chromosomes provide the organizational structure for genes. Each chromosome con- tains hundreds of genes, and changes to the number or structure of the chromosome can have profound effects on the development of the individual. An extra chromosome 21 results in the constellation of health and cognitive is- sues known as Down syndrome. The presence of a single X chromosome with no other sex chromosome (each individual should have two sex chromosomes) causes Turner’s syndrome in women, characterized by small stature, non- verbal learning disabilities, and fertility and other health concerns. Other disorders result from the deletion, duplication, or inversion of segments of specifi c chromosomes. Chro- mosomal abnormalities related to the number of chromosomes are thought to cause 50% to 60% of miscarriages because these changes are not compatible with supporting life.

New technology called microarray can identify deletions and duplications on chro- mosomes that are too small to have been detected by previous technologies. In most cases, microarrays are indicated for individu- als who have signifi cant developmental and health problems. Microarrays assess the entire genome rather than focusing in on detecting

a specifi c mutation or condition. Because the technology is nonspecifi c, it has the potential to detect a genetic anomaly for a growing pro- portion of the affected population. Yet the use of this technology raises ethical and medical challenges. For one thing, microarrays identify changes in areas of the chromosomes that have not previously been associated with disease, so interpreting the results requires educated guesswork about the causative nature of the change and its impact on development. Also, analysis may identify risk information that is not connected to the concerns that initially led an individual or family to pursue genetic test- ing. For example, a deletion of a gene that is associated with an adult-onset disorder, such as amyotrophic lateral sclerosis (ALS, also known as Lou Gehrig’s disease), could be identifi ed in a child being worked up for de- velopmental delay. Although these types of unanticipated results are not unique to genet- ics, they present a challenge to the introduc- tion of new technologies, informed consent, and medical decision making.

GENE–ENVIRONMENT INTERACTION

A variety of models demonstrate current theo- retical assumptions about the ways genes and environments interact. All diseases are caused by a combination of genetic and environmen- tal factors. In some cases, disease occurs only after risk factors accumulate. It is similar to the threshold effect with exposure to environmen- tal toxins—a certain amount of mercury is be- lieved to be safe and tolerated by the body, but beyond that amount there is increased risk for health and cognitive problems. In the context of genetics, the presence of a mutation alone may not be suffi cient to cause disease, but when environmental risk factors also are pres- ent (e.g., high-fat diet, smoking), the scales are tipped and the individual may meet the crite- ria for a clinical diagnosis. It is important to note that prior to having a clinical diagnosis, a person may have symptoms. For example, an individual may have relatively high blood

JWBT514_ch21.indd 562JWBT514_ch21.indd 562 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Social Work and Genetics 563

pressure but not have clinical hypertension; an individual may have a persistent, relatively severe depressed mood (dysthymia) but never meet the diagnostic criteria for major depres- sion. Early symptoms such as these also are due to a combination of genetic and environ- mental factors.

Some conditions occur only if specifi c environmental and genetic risk factors are both present. For example, people with a mutation in a gene responsible for breaking down certain components of alcohol, alcohol dehydrogenase, will develop facial fl ushing, heart palpitations, light-headedness, and nau- sea when consuming alcohol. Both alcohol consumption and this specifi c mutation are required for the effect to occur. Individuals with phenylketonuria (PKU) are missing an enzyme that breaks down one of the main components of protein, the amino acid phe- nylalanine, because of a genetic mutation. Phenylalanine is present in virtually all natu- rally occurring protein sources (e.g., beef, chicken, milk, pork). Individuals with PKU must eliminate phenylalanine from their diet or they will develop cognitive impairment over time. This specifi c genetic mutation is problematic only in a world where phenyl- alanine is an essential component of pro- tein. In an environment that did not rely on phenylalanine, having the mutation would not affect a person’s health or development. Because the disease is managed successfully if caught early, the United States Preventive Services Task Force (2009) recommends that all newborns be screened for PKU. As a re- sult, all babies in the United States are tested for PKU right after they are born. In both ex- amples, the genetic mutation has no impact unless specifi c environmental factors also are present.

Current research is focusing on understand- ing gene–environment interactions in more common diseases. For example, the interac- tion between genes that control pigment, such as melanin, and sunlight both are implicated in the development of skin cancer. Exposure to ultraviolet rays causes disease in combination with a genetic variant that produces insuffi cient

pigment for protection. Similar interaction studies are being completed for other diseases, including diabetes and metabolic syndrome. Al- though more work is needed to fully elucidate the biology behind these disease processes, this type of investigation helps us better understand the way in which genetic and environmental risk factors impact disease risk.

Perhaps most exciting for social workers and others who seek to measure and modify environments to improve the health and mental health of individuals, families, and communi- ties is the fi eld of epigenetics. Epigenetics is the study of how environmental factors impact gene expression in individuals and groups. Al- though these changes are acquired during the course of an individual’s life, that individual’s children may inherit them. Epigenetic factors may impact the onset and expression of dis- ease. For example, research on early breast cancer in African American women has linked social environments and hypervigilance to in- creased breast cancer risk for African Ameri- can women on Chicago’s South Side (Gehlert et al., 2008). Epigenetic research such as this has signifi cant implications for social work in- terventions designed to identify environmental risk for and prevent health and mental health conditions before they occur. This research shows that living in an environment that re- quires heightened vigilance impacts hormone levels because of an increased need to modu- late response to stress (McClintock, Conzen, Gehlert, Masi, & Olopade, 2005). Hormone levels impact breast cancer risk. Although this research is ongoing, initial fi ndings from these studies suggest that changing the social environment may impact disease risk in the community. Epigenetic research demonstrates the important connection between animal and human research as well. Evidence from rat models links maternal care (licking) of infant pups to adult rat stress responses (Weaver et al., 2004). Here the environment infl uences the control of DNA processing by shaping how and when specifi c genes (stress response genes) are expressed later in life. Both of these epigenetic projects required collaboration across several disciplines.

JWBT514_ch21.indd 563JWBT514_ch21.indd 563 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

564 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Understanding Phenotypes

Phenotypes are the detectable end product of the interaction among genetic and environmen- tal factors that contribute to a particular trait or disease process. They are the outcomes that we observe: physical traits, such as hair, skin and eye color, height, and weight, or disease processes, such as diabetes, heart disease, al- coholism, and depression. Yet one’s phenotype is frequently too vague to direct effective in- terventions. Breaking down a broad phenotype into intermediate end points that correspond to each underlying pathway has clinical and so- cial value. For example, heart disease can be caused by a variety of factors, of which poor food choice is only one pathway. For individu- als living in minimally resourced environments, access to heart-healthy food choices are limited. For others, genetic factors impact their ability to metabolize cholesterol. For yet others, infec- tions, such as rheumatic fever, or other disease processes, such as high blood pressure, can lead to heart disease. Different pathways may have specifi c indicators that are measurable before heart disease is diagnosed, such as cholesterol level, allowing for targeted intervention. Each of these pathways leads to heart disease in different ways, requiring targeted social and medical indicators and interventions. Dietary changes will not help to remediate heart disease linked to rheumatic fever.

Select phenotypes incur social stigma. Race, discussed later, is one. Cultural discourse links these phenotypes to patterns of trait or disease expression. For some, such as obesity, stigma grows from assumptions about the lack of self- control. Teasing apart the overarching pheno- type, obesity, allows health and mental health professionals to identify the varied pathways leading to disease. From there social miscon- ceptions can be addressed and individualized interventions designed. This section presents background on select phenotypes with which social workers are familiar.

Environment, Culture, and Evolution

Understanding the biological basis for dif- ferences among human populations requires

understanding of genetic history and the im- pact of evolutionary pressures. Differences exist between populations for a number of reasons, including environmental conditions that create a selective advantage for a particular trait. For example, darker skin color for individuals living near the equator provides protection from the harmful effects of intense sunlight. Similarly, the ability to digest lactose is more prevalent in populations with a historically greater exposure to lactose-containing foods (i.e., dairy products). In both examples, the original population had some individuals with different forms of each trait (e.g., individuals with lighter and darker skin color near the equator and individuals with and without the ability to digest lactose in lands with cows). Over generations, individuals with the more advantageous trait for the environment were more likely to survive and have more chil- dren, thereby passing on that genetic variant and having it become more prevalent in that specifi c population. This phenomenon is called natural selection (Darwin, 1859) and can be seen over generations for many different types of traits and in all species.

Social and cultural pressures also may im- pact the type and prevalence of genetic attri- butes within a population. Groups descended largely from a relatively small founding popu- lation may have genetic disorders that were present among the founders. For example, the Old Order Amish population in the United States has cultural and social restrictions on marrying individuals outside the commu- nity. Consequently, the gene pool is relatively small, and there is a higher prevalence of cer- tain predisposition to and incidence of genetic disorders than is seen in a larger population with more genetic variation. Specifi cally, the Old Order Amish have a higher prevalence of some rare, single-gene disorders as well as gene variants that convey risk for certain com- plex disorders including diabetes (McKusick, 1973; Pollin et al., 2008). The Ashkenazi Jewish population faces a different set of con- ditions because of what was present in the founding population and cultural mandates to marry within the group. Although more preva- lent in these groups, these conditions can be seen in any population.

JWBT514_ch21.indd 564JWBT514_ch21.indd 564 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Social Work and Genetics 565

Race

Race is a powerful social construction in which phenotypic expression is linked to layers of sociopolitical history and cultural meaning. As genetic discovery enables differ- entiation of subgroups of the population, the genetics of race has been explored in a variety of politically and socially charged contexts. Hypotheses about links between genes and race are founded on assumed covariance be- tween phenotype and other skills or attributes, such as intellectual prowess and athletic per- formance. An examination of social dialogue about genetics and race is beyond the scope of this chapter. Yet we would be remiss not to mention the ways genetics research has ad- dressed the concept of race and the risks of using racial distinctions to categorize genetic variation. Of signifi cant concern is genetics research that inadvertently (or deliberately) may promote essentialist thinking, where en- vironmental conditions that lead to health and mental health disparities are obscured in favor of explanations that look to deterministic and “inevitable” genetic variation (Sankar, 2009). As social workers well know, understanding an individual’s specifi c social, familial, and medical context rather than relying on assump- tions based on a diagnosis or demographic in- formation allows for the development of more effective approaches to practice.

In medical settings, race often serves as a heuristic, or cognitive shortcut, for the health professional to focus on certain disease risks based on the prevalence within that population (Satel, 2002). Although race is used as a cate- gorical variable in research, it is diffi cult to op- erationalize since it is a social construct rather than a biological one (Bonham, Warshauer- Baker, & Collins, 2005; Dupre, 2008; Hunt & Megyesi, 2008). As a result, categorization of participants based on racial categories relies either on self-report or the researchers’ percep- tion based on visual cues. As a result, the term race may be used ambiguously, inconsistently, and without rigor (Hunt & Megyesi, 2008).

Furthermore, increased mobility and inter- marriage have blurred the physical and social attributes that determine one’s race. Although

originally the observable genetic differences between races may have served as reliable marker of other unique characteristics of the population, such as beliefs or cultural heritage, which do not have a genetic basis, the mixing of populations and increasing globalization have made those markers much less useful. As race diminishes in its usefulness as a proxy for genetic background, this use has become less effective. Such an approach assumes race in- volves salient and innate differences, but this claim has not been substantiated in genetics research.

Genetic Contributions to Mental Illness

Psychiatric disorders tend to cluster in fami- lies; thus, interest in exploring genetic contri- butions to mental illness has grown since the inception of the Human Genome Project. Even with new technologies that make the entirety of the human genome more accessible, no strong single gene has been identifi ed for any psychiatric disorder. State-of-the-art research suggests that mental illness develops like other complex disorders. That is, many genes, each associated with a small increase in risk, con- tribute to disease in combination with environ- mental factors (Dick, Rose, & Jaakko, 2006; Jaffee & Price, 2007; Wermter et al., 2010). For example, several researcher teams are in- vestigating a gene–environment interaction in the development of depression in individuals exposed to stressful life events. A particular mutation in a gene that responds to a chemi- cal (serotonin) released in the brain during stressful situations has been implicated in risk for developing depression. Some studies have found that having the mutation alone does not cause any problems. When the environmental factor (stress) is present, serotonin interacts with the altered protein and sets off a chain of events that increases risk for depression. Al- though other studies have not found the same interaction, the underlying disease pathway still is being considered and may help to clar- ify the specifi c mechanism (e.g., Caspi et al., 2003; Risch et al., 2009). A parallel body of research, pharmacogenomics, examines gene variants that impact the ability of individuals

JWBT514_ch21.indd 565JWBT514_ch21.indd 565 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

566 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

to metabolize drugs used to treat psychiatric conditions (Malhotra, Lencz, Correll, & Kane, 2007). The aim of this research is to opti- mize treatment by avoiding adverse effects and determining effective dosing effi ciently. In combination, these bodies of research sug- gest a future role for personalized psychiatric– genetic medicine.

The mutation in the gene that responds to serotonin is implicated in elevating risk of depression and also has been tied to other mental health outcomes, including alcohol dependence. Depending on the research or clinical environment, explanations for addic- tion vacillate among genetic factors, adverse familial and social conditions, and personal- ity or character defi cits. Although addictions run in families, teasing apart how much of the clustering is due to genetic factors versus shared environmental factors, including ex- posure to addictive behaviors, is complicated (e.g., Crabbe, 2002). Twin, adoption, and fam- ily studies provide support for both genetic and environmental contributions (Agrawal & Lynskey, 2008). These studies suggest that the initiation of substance use is highly familial, yet not inherited. Shared genotypes within families may account for common behavioral responses to known environmental variants. Thus, some family members may be more sen- sitive to environmental determinants than oth- ers. Understanding the complex relationship of genes and environment in addiction may help elucidate other behavior pathways as well as help to target interventions.

TRANSDISCIPLINARY TEAMS IN PRACTICE AND RESEARCH

In many ways, genetics provides a unifying structure that brings specialists together to ad- dress different aspects of a single underlying disease. Listed in this section are the types of professionals most frequently involved in caring for an individual and family with a ge- netic condition. This list is likely to expand to include primary care providers, as additional

genetic factors related to common disease are identifi ed and as clinical testing becomes available. This list is not exhaustive. Spe- cialists involved who can respond to specifi c concerns (e.g., endocrinologists, neurologists, dermatologists) will change based on the med- ical, psychosocial, and developmental needs of the affected individual and family. In gen- eral, the role of these specialists will be to di- agnose, treat, and manage specifi c symptoms. Although genetics professionals typically will take the lead on patient care coordination, pa- tient management is a shared responsibility among these professionals.

Who Is on the Team?

Clinical geneticists are physicians who have completed additional residency training in medical genetics. Clinical geneticists typically see patients for medical diagnosis and man- agement. They help connect patients with the appropriate specialists to ensure current and anticipated medical issues associated with the underlying condition are addressed.

Genetic counselors are health-care profes- sionals with combined graduate level train- ing and expertise in medical genetics, patient education, and psychosocial counseling. Some genetic counselors are generalists while others may specialize exclusively in one area of med- icine, such as cardiovascular or psychiatric ge- netics. In clinical settings, genetic counselors help individuals and families to understand and address genetic risks, make testing deci- sions, and adapt to genetic diagnoses, mainly on a short-term basis.

Nutritionists/dietitians work primarily with patients who have conditions that require their diets to be restricted, such as those with metabolic conditions such as PKU who can- not metabolize certain nutrients. Nutritionists/ dietitians develop diet plans that ensure that individuals get the appropriate nutrients given their underlying condition and work with fam- ilies to help them integrate changes in diet into their lives.

Physical, occupational, and speech thera- pists provide both short- and long-term support

JWBT514_ch21.indd 566JWBT514_ch21.indd 566 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Social Work and Genetics 567

for individuals who have either delayed de- velopment of skills or experienced changes in skills due to a genetic condition. Patients affected at the beginning of life may benefi t from these therapies by virtue of the help that they receive in meeting their developmental milestones. Adults who develop neurodegen- erative conditions may lose abilities, including coordination, speech, and swallowing. Thera- pists sometimes can help to preserve and im- prove functioning.

Social workers, psychologists, and psychia- trists are part of the recommended care model for individuals experiencing infertility and considering predictive testing for adult-onset, neurodegenerative conditions such as Hunting- ton disease. Their role in the testing process is to assess the individuals’ baseline emotional state to determine the presence of risk factors associated with pregnancy. Social workers are trained to understand clients and families in their social and historical milieu by: eliciting family narratives of illness, caregiving, and loss; addressing outstanding emotional con- cerns; fostering active client participation in counseling and decision making; and bolster- ing client self-awareness. They may provide a variety of psychosocial services to individuals and families with genetic conditions, includ- ing: referrals; individual and family counsel- ing; consultation; and ongoing support to individuals, families, and groups attempting to cope with genetic conditions. They also may facilitate family meetings about genetic testing and treatment, support medical decision mak- ing, and structure group interventions.

Research

Social workers currently are involved in genet- ics research of various types, and opportunities to be more involved are becoming more abun- dant. Social workers’ training and perspec- tive in assessing environmental conditions, dynamics, and development provide a needed perspective when considering the implications of genetic discoveries. Social workers have the skills to lead transdisciplinary teams to exam- ine problems from a holistic perspective. To

support social work leadership and participa- tion in genetic research, in August 2010, the National Institutes of Health offered a week- long, intensive summer institute addressing the potential to integrate social work and genetic research. The program highlighted a number of opportunities and challenges to the interdis- ciplinary collaboration required to bridge pro- fessional boundaries successfully.

Opportunities

As the fi eld of epigenetics expands, geneticists increasingly will need to partner with social scientists trained to: assess environments; hypothesize links between environmental strengths, constraints, and health outcomes; and design research to test these links. Social work strength in these partnerships lies in the profession’s expertise in understanding the impact of familial and social conditions on human development throughout the life cycle and across diverse and dynamic environments. The rich history of innovative and applied re- search by social workers will facilitate ethical translation of genetic discovery into tangible products to support vulnerable and marginal- ized groups.

Challenges

Although complementary knowledge and skills across collaborators can potentiate re- search impact, disparate professional lexicons, beliefs about standard and rigorous research methodology, and perceptions about important targets of research and change may threaten collaboration. The use of discipline-specifi c terminology or different defi nitions of the same term can impede communication among team members. Laboratory research, common in genetics, may share little with participatory research, qualitative methods, intervention research, or self-report measures common in social work research (Padgett, 2008). Further- more, meaningful outcomes may be defi ned differently by professional discipline. For ex- ample, polymorphisms (defi ned as “common” genetic variants) are those mutations present in at least 1% of the population. Understand- ing 1% of the variance in a population is

JWBT514_ch21.indd 567JWBT514_ch21.indd 567 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

568 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Box 21.2 Common Research Questions by Professional Discipline

Clinical geneticists investigate many aspects of the fi eld, including molecular genetics, clinical application, and ethical and social questions about genetic testing. Common research questions include: • How do we best defi ne the phenotype and

spectrum for a condition or trait? • What are the distinct genetic

contributions and gene–environment interactions for related phenotypes?

• What novel genetic variants are associated with common conditions or traits?

• What new therapies can be developed based on our understanding of genetic mechanisms?

• How do changes in gene expression impact the characteristics of disease?

Genetic counselors examine social science questions within the fi eld of genetics and explore the process and outcomes of the profession. Common research questions include: • How do patients respond psychologically

to discovery of a deleterious trait? • How can genetic counselors facilitate

adaptation to a genetic condition? • How does cultural or ethnic group

identifi cation affect patient educational and psychosocial needs?

• How do individuals share the results of genetic testing with family, friends, and partners?

• Does genetic counseling change compliance with medical recommendations?

Genetic epidemiologists examine the etiology, prevalence, and mechanisms of complex traits, focusing on the intersection of genes and environment in particular groups and populations. Common research questions include: • Why is a certain trait or condition

aggregating in a particular family or population?

• What are the prevalence, impact, and burden of a genetic variant in a population?

• What are the relative contributions of genes and environment for a given trait?

• What areas of the genome might yield the most information about particular conditions or traits (i.e., mutation hot spots)?

Population geneticists apply the techniques of molecular genetics to the study of human evolution and diversity. They typically have training in evolutionary biology or biological anthropology. Common research questions include: • What genetic markers are associated with

particular racial/ethnic admixture, linguistic group, or cultural/geographic heritage?

• What can we learn about human history and patterns of migration by tracing genetic markers?

• What factors infl uence population divergence or convergence?

• How have specifi c genetic variants moved through human populations and geography over time?

Social workers and other mental health and social science professionals examine the factors that infl uence the expression of and response to genetic information and testing for individuals, families, and groups. Common research questions include: • How do environments shape the

expression of conditions or traits? • How do family legacies shape pursuit and

interpretation of genetic testing results? • How do shared understandings of disease

shape medical decision making and management of genetic risk or conditions?

• How does health literacy impact interpretation of genetic test results?

• How do genetic variants contribute to mental illness risk behaviors, such as suicide and substance abuse?

• How can mental health providers best support decision making, family communication, and coping for patients engaged in genetic testing?

Source: Adapted from NCHPEG program Genetics for Social and Behavioral Science Researchers (in development).

JWBT514_ch21.indd 568JWBT514_ch21.indd 568 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Social Work and Genetics 569

meaningful from the perspective of a geneti- cist, but from a social science perspective, this may not constitute a meaningful fi nding.

Each member of the research team brings unique knowledge, research aims, and skills to collaborative endeavors (see Box 21.2). When these are congruent and complementary, trans- disciplinary work is possible. However, cultural assumptions about what constitutes “good” sci- ence may thwart collaborative efforts if disparate understandings are not equally communicated, valued, or integrated into research plans.

GENETIC COUNSELING, EDUCATION, TESTING, AND REFERRAL

Genetic testing identifi es changes in chromo- somes, genes, or proteins. Unlike many other medical tests, the results of genetic tests largely do not change over time and are not infl uenced by the environment. Instead, tests identify ge- netic mutations that are a permanent part of a patient’s DNA. Although test results are static, our understanding of how these results impact health and disease evolves as we learn more about genetic variation and environment inter- actions.

Different types of genetic testing are used to identify genetic contributions to disease in different contexts. The most common catego- ries of and purposes for genetic tests are listed next.

• Diagnostic testing is used to identify an underlying diagnosis for individuals showing symptoms that indicate a genetic condition.

• Carrier testing is offered to asymptom- atic individuals who are at risk of carry- ing a mutation for an X-linked or recessive condition due to family history or ethnic background. This type of testing is used most commonly to inform reproductive planning.

• Predictive testing is offered to (a) asymp- tomatic individuals who are at high risk

of adult-onset genetic disorders (such as Huntington disease) based on their family history and (b) individuals diagnosed with a disorder known to have a genetic compo- nent (such as certain cancers).

• Prenatal testing uses fetal DNA to test for certain single-gene and chromosomal dis- orders in fetuses at high risk due to family history, results of screening tests, or ad- vanced maternal age.

• Newborn screening for a number of genetic conditions is performed on most newborns to identify those who would benefi t from further testing, including diagnostic genetic tests, or treatment.

• Susceptibility testing is a relatively new category of genetic tests that provides in- formation about risk to develop common and complex disorders. Results from this type of testing do not predict the onset of disease; they just indicate increased or de- creased risk.

Referrals to Genetic Services

In general, genetics professionals use an indi- vidual’s medical and family history to assess the genetic contribution to health and disease. Most often this assessment occurs when there is an increased risk for an underlying genetic condition, due to current health, family his- tory, or background attributes (i.e., age, eth- nicity). Increasingly, though, clinical tests are becoming available to test for genetic changes that increase risk for common, complex condi- tions. This means that a larger proportion of the population may be soon gaining knowl- edge about their genetic makeup.

Social workers frequently ask clients with physical and mental illness about family his- tory and may, therefore, be in a good position to identify families that could benefi t from genetic counseling. Before referrals are made, social workers should ask clients about interest in a referral. If the client is interested, referrals are appropriate when factors are present in the individual or family that suggest an increased risk for a genetic condition. For example,

JWBT514_ch21.indd 569JWBT514_ch21.indd 569 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

570 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

parents of children with multiple medical is- sues may benefi t from a genetics referral to try to identify an underlying diagnosis. With the availability of new technologies that have been shown to be effective for multiple outcomes, genetic testing in the pediatric setting outside of genetic services is becoming increasingly common. Unfortunately, the interpretation of the genetic testing results can be complicated. Social workers can help to facilitate optimal care for their patients by assessing the needs of the individuals and their family and connect- ing them to the appropriate services.

Genetic services have long been integrated into standard prenatal care. Screening for a variety of common and preventable disorders, genetic and nongenetic, are offered routinely during pregnancy to identify fetuses that are at risk of being affected. Screening tests are not diagnostic, so prospective parents who screen positive are offered diagnostic testing for common chromosomal disorders. Follow- up genetic testing is provided for prospective parents to prepare for a child with special needs or to offer the possibility of termination if a condition is identifi ed. Diagnostic test- ing also may be offered if there is a known genetic diagnosis in either parent’s family or if either parent fi ts a specifi c risk profi le, such as advanced maternal age or a specifi c ethnic background. The only genetic services incor- porated into routine pediatric practice involve newborn screening for identifi able and treat- able genetic disorders, yet the number and consistency of screening varies across state lines. Recent expansion of newborn screen- ing recommendations includes conditions for which early detection will be benefi cial, such as hearing loss (Berg et al., 2002). There is ongoing discussion and concern about the best approach to obtaining informed consent for newborn screening, since many parents are unaware that their children have been screened (Fernhoff, 2009).

Individuals, couples, and families often pursue genetic services after being diagnosed with or having a family history of a serious condition that may have an identifi able ge- netic component, such as adult-onset cancers

or neurological diseases. Predictive testing raises psychosocial, and sometimes ethical, issues for patients and requires input from knowledgeable professionals, including social workers, to facilitate decision making that is congruent with patient values and priorities. Social workers should be prepared to provide reliable referrals and resources to clients in- terested in pursuing genetic consultation. This list of resources should include providers who specialize in genetic education and counseling in addition to online resources that can link clients to supportive and informative commu- nities, particularly for rare genetic conditions. Because of the vast amount and variable qual- ity of information available online, especially with respect to rare conditions, social workers also should be prepared to help patients inter- pret and assess the quality of information.

Although not routine, genetic services are increasingly available in other specialties, in- cluding oncology, cardiology, and neurology, to help facilitate assessment, testing, and treat- ment decisions. As genetic testing becomes more widely available for common, complex conditions and traits, there will be an increas- ing need for individuals to help both provid- ers and patients understand and interpret the results.

The shortage of trained specialists, specifi - cally genetic counselors and medical geneti- cists, who can deliver genetic services limits the availability of these tests through regulated channels, specifi cally in rural or underre- sourced environments. Genetic tests for com- mon and rare diseases are more common now than they were a decade ago. Yet, as genetic testing moves from tightly controlled research settings with stringent procedures for informed consent to the primary care arena, in which a physician can order a test with little or no pre- test or posttest counseling, informed consent may be compromised and the potential for mis- use of testing increased (Resnik, 2003). In ad- dition, some companies are marketing genetic tests directly to the consumer (DTC), enabling individuals and families to access them out- side of medical settings. Although most DTC tests identify genetic variants that change only

JWBT514_ch21.indd 570JWBT514_ch21.indd 570 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Social Work and Genetics 571

moderately an individual’s risk for common conditions and traits, results could negatively impact patients, both medically and psycho- socially (Gray et al., 2009). The validity and utility of these tests currently is being debated (e.g., Annes, Giovanni, & Murray, 2010; U.S. General Accountability Offi ce, 2010; Waalen & Beutler, 2009). Whatever the fate of any one type of genetic testing, it is likely that with- out regulation, disparities will grow between those who have access to supportive care, ge- netic education, and counseling to manage test results and those who do not.

Access to genetic services is hindered fur- ther by widespread problems with health lit- eracy, patient and provider lack of awareness about genetic tests and services, and diffi culty negotiating complex health information and systems. In addition to limited access to ge- netic testing and quality risk management, marginalized groups have been less willing to engage in genetic research and testing to iden- tify disease risk or traits than privileged groups (Halbert et al., 2006; Murphy, Wickramarante, & Weissman, 2009; Nanda et al., 2005). This may be due to skepticism about how results will be used and kept private and concern about whether results will be misinterpreted to exploit communities and groups. The legacy of the Tuskegee experiment and the recent bi- ography of Henrietta Lacks (Skloot, 2010; see Chapter 3 for further discussion) support con- cerns that genetic testing may reinforce rac- ism and that minority patients will be used as guinea pigs (Bussey-Jones et al., 2009).

Thus, access to genetic services is com- promised not only by minimally resourced environments with few trained professionals and limited health profi ciency, but also by the nation’s centuries-old history of exploiting people of color for the benefi t of privileged groups. Social workers must partner with com- munity groups and advocates to enhance con- fi dence in skeptical communities when quality services are available that can lead to early detection, treatment, and prevention of life- threatening disease. These partnerships pro- vide valuable contexts for engaging vulnerable groups in cutting-edge research and practice

while also protecting them from coercion or unfair burden.

As the demands for genetic services con- tinue to increase beyond the capacity of ge- netic counselors and nurses to provide them, non-health-care providers may increasingly help patients to access, interpret, and adjust to genetic information. Social workers are in a unique position to promote access to resources, facilitate medical decision mak- ing, and provide emotional support over the dynamic and long-term adaptation to genetic information (Smets, van Zwieten & Michie, 2007).

Communicating and Interpreting Genetic Risk Information

Communicating genetic risk information to individuals and families is a complex and multilayered process. In addition to disease risk information, providers should be alert to the ways emotional reactions, perceptions of self-effi cacy, social context (McCoyd, 2008), family loyalties, and medical histories (Kenen, Ardern-Jones, & Eeles, 2003; Werner-Lin, 2007) cloud comprehension and judgment. Evidence suggests the emotional and sup- portive parts of genetic services help patients understand risk information more than the educational or informational components (Ed- wards et al, 2008; Meiser & Halliday, 2002). Yet a recent literature review suggests that pro- viders rely heavily on medical language while providing counseling and education (Meiser, Irle, Lobb, & Balrow-Stewart, 2008). Some providers may not be comfortable with the emotional tenor and intensity of genetic coun- seling and education and may retreat into the safety of neutral medical terminology. In such cases, social workers can provide support not only to patients, but also to providers, on how to manage countertransference reactions and seek collegial support to help providers to en- gage fully with distressed individuals and fam- ilies. Providers must be coached to integrate the dual demands of sharing complex medical information and supporting the emotional ex- perience of receiving that information.

JWBT514_ch21.indd 571JWBT514_ch21.indd 571 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

572 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Health Literacy and Numeracy

Health literacy is defi ned as the degree to which individuals are able to “obtain, process, and understand basic health information and services needed to make appropriate health decisions” (Ratzen & Parker, 2000). Health literacy is mediated by education, culture, and language profi ciency and involves a variety of intellectual skills, including listening, speak- ing, writing, and reading. Approximately 90 million Americans, or half of all adults, have trouble understanding and using health infor- mation (Nielson-Bohlman, Panzer, & Kindig, 2010). Those most signifi cantly impaired, and thus at risk of poor health outcomes, are el- derly persons and individuals with limited education or English profi ciency. A signifi cant piece of health literacy involves numeracy, or the ability to fi nd, understand, and use nu- merically based health information, such as probabilistic or risk information (Ancker & Kaufman, 2007). Genetic information is often expressed in numbers, including disease risk, penetrance (the proportion of mutation carriers who will manifest symptoms), mutation preva- lence, inheritance patterns, and the benefi ts of risk reduction. Providers may assume individ- uals and families are able to interpret and use numerical information to make rational deci- sions, yet numerical risk estimates are hard to understand for the average patient. As a result, risk evaluations based on numerical data are overshadowed by vivid examples from the individual’s family and social worlds (Hur- ley, Miller, Rubin, & Weinberg, 2006). Social workers should promote the use of basic health literacy screening tools to identify at-risk pa- tients and to support their understanding and informed uptake of research, genetic testing, and treatment protocols.

Estimating Risk: Coping and Calculating

In genetic risk counseling, patients receive, and are presumed to integrate, objective risk information regarding their likelihood of de- veloping disease, or of their child being born with a disease, based on the most up-to-date

medical information available. Patients tend to interpret probabilistic information using a dichotomous, deterministic lens (Lippman- Hand & Fraser, 1979). This makes ambiguous information more manageable for them. Shift- ing risk estimated into absolutes (e.g., 1/0; yes/ no; 100%/0%) prevents individuals from hav- ing to entertain the uncertainty (or multiple uncertainties) associated with genetic risk and its management. For example, if a fetus is di- agnosed with an anomaly that is incompatible with life, women are much more likely to ter- minate. Although this certainty does not obvi- ate the occurrence of signifi cant and painful grief reactions, it facilitates decision making (McCoyd, 2008). When genetic testing infor- mation is more ambiguous, cognitive distor- tions may interfere with patients’ ability to comprehend risk information accurately due to unique and complex family histories with the disease (Kenen et al., 2003; Werner-Lin, 2007), poor preexisting knowledge of genetic concepts, innumeracy, risk aversion, and de- fensive pessimism (Hurley et al., 2006). In- terventions have been developed to improve patients’ comprehension and ultimately to bring their “subjective” risk perception more closely in line with “objective” estimates through systematic analysis of evidence (e.g., Schwartz, 2001; Slovic, Finucane, Peters, & MacGregor, 2004). This formal risk analysis perspective tends to view affective responses as irrational. More recent scholarship argues that “rational” decision making requires an in- tegration of both analytic and experiential (af- fective) systems. This perspective is congruent with the view that risk perception is “inevita- bly mediated through social and cultural pro- cesses and can never be known in isolation from these” (Lupton, 1999, p. 35).

For conditions with ambiguous penetrance, risk is diffi cult to quantify accurately (Sivell et al., 2008). Defensively pessimistic (Norem & Cantor, 1986) individuals may prepare for the worst by overestimating personal risk. Yet this may lead to drastic prevention measures that adversely impact health and quality of life (Braithwaite, Emery, Walter et al., 2004; Hallowell & Richards, 1997). Protectively

JWBT514_ch21.indd 572JWBT514_ch21.indd 572 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Social Work and Genetics 573

ignorant (Yaniv, Benador, & Sagi, 2004) indi- viduals may underestimate their own risk and thus avoid risk management or early detection protocols that could extend their lives while simultaneously maintaining their quality of life. As individuals “stage” closer to expected ages for disease onset, they may experience greater emotional distress and become averse to seeking information about genetic testing and risk management (Johnson, Case, An- drews, & Allard, 2010). In any case, attempts to correct mistaken beliefs may improve health outcomes. Social workers may partner with genetic counselors and other health profes- sionals to help patients understand estimates as probabilistic rather than prophetic. Depar- ture from deterministic understandings may increase anxiety but also will support informed medical decision making.

Reproductive Genetics and Infertility

Genetic information frequently becomes sa- lient for individuals and couples considering pregnancy or anticipating the birth of a child. At these times, couples and providers focus on the health of the fetus and the risks that may impact a pregnancy or delivery. Because of the complexities of development, all preg- nancies have a risk of miscarriage and birth defects, regardless of the genetic and envi- ronmental background of the biological par- ents. Most birth defects occur during the fi rst trimester (www.acog.org/publications/patient _education/bp165.cfm), and some can be de- tected through ultrasound and blood tests. Others cannot, making it important to clarify the limitations of prenatal testing to the pro- spective parent(s).

Genetic services, specifi cally prenatal ge- netic counseling, often are incorporated into family planning and pregnancy care, because of the ability to detect certain types of genetic conditions prior to the birth, and in some cases the conception, of the child. Prenatal counsel- ing discussions inherently evoke ethical and moral issues, because they involve decisions about an unborn fetus. Genetic counselors may be involved in providing information

about the potential diagnosis and risks, as well as helping prospective parents with decision making that is compatible with their values and beliefs. Counselors are trained to facili- tate these discussions in a nondirective way. Social workers also can be part of these dis- cussions, especially with regard to exploring the couple’s social and familial context and how certain decisions might affect their family system. Understanding the options available for testing may help to facilitate the decision- making process.

Social workers have long been involved in providing prenatal genetic services. Ongo- ing research examines the support needs of women carrying fetuses that have been diag- nosed with genetic anomalies (McCoyd, 2008, 2010). This work suggests that one of the most critical factors in supporting women through genetic testing and decision making about pregnancy termination is a connection with empathic providers (McCoyd, 2010). This fact speaks to the need for social workers to sup- port clients and educate physicians on how to provide compassionate and holistic care.

Prenatal Diagnosis

Genetic diagnosis of a fetus during pregnancy is done using a variety of methods. Screening tests do not test the fetus’s blood directly but rather test pregnancy-associated proteins for the possibility of a genetic condition. These screening tests do not provide defi nitive diag- noses. Instead, they provide risk information that can help with making decisions about whether to seek further testing.

First-trimester screening involves a blood test and an ultrasound. These procedures can provide information about increased risk for certain chromosomal problems, includ- ing Down syndrome and trisomy 18 (having three copies of chromosome 18 rather than two). They allow the identifi cation of Down syndrome in 82% to 87% of cases. Second- trimester screening for Down syndrome, tri- somy 18, trisomy 13, and neural tube defects uses a blood test. If a woman has had a negative screen during the fi rst trimester, she requires only one additional blood test, for neural tube

JWBT514_ch21.indd 573JWBT514_ch21.indd 573 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

574 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

defects, during her second trimester. Typically, a detailed ultrasound is performed at 18 to 20 weeks into a pregnancy to visualize the fetus and to screen for major structural abnormali- ties. Not all birth defects can be visualized, and some can develop after 20 weeks.

Women at high risk for having a child with detectable genetic disorders because of results from screening tests, ultrasound, family history, or advanced maternal age (greater than 35) may be offered prenatal testing of fetal cells. Cho- rionic villis sampling (CVS) and amniocente- sis remove and isolate fetal cells that are then grown and examined for chromosomal anoma- lies. CVS can be done earlier in pregnancy (between 10 and 13 weeks) than amniocentesis (after 14 weeks). Both carry a risk for miscar- riage in around 1% of cases. If there is a known single-gene disorder in the family, the fetal cells obtained through CVS or amniocentesis can be used to test for the presence of that known mutation. Social workers should be aware that although nearly all women receiving prenatal care receive an ultrasound, many low-income women cannot afford amniocentesis or CVS. Furthermore, any woman covered by a federal health insurance plan, such as through the mili- tary or a public program, will not be covered for pregnancy termination; federal law prohib- its federal funds from being used for abortion under any circumstance.

In Vitro Fertilization and Preimplantation Genetic Diagnosis

In vitro fertilization (IVF) is a reproductive technology that enables some infertile couples to carry and give birth to a biologically related child. IVF fi rst was used successfully nearly three decades ago and has become widely available around the United States. The pro- cedure is expensive, and insurance coverage is not standard across plans. The procedure also is said to be emotionally exhausting, with mul- tiple attempts often needed before a successful pregnancy is achieved. Male and female fac- tors, or a combination of the two, contribute. Cultural mandates to procreate, fear of social judgment, and shame about infertility fre- quently push couples to keep their infertility

and IVF experiences secret, potentially depriv- ing them of critical emotional support.

Preimplantation genetic diagnosis (PGD) was fi rst developed in 1990 and by early 2005 had been used in over 3,000 IVF cycles, re- sulting in over 700 births (Klipstein, 2005). PGD is a technically complex and expensive procedure by which blastocysts (pre-embryo produced by cell division following fertiliza- tion) produced through IVF are examined for a specifi c genetic disorder before transfer. Only those embryos that are determined to be unaffected are transferred to the uterus. PGD allows couples at risk to begin a preg- nancy with a blastocyst known to be free of the disorder in question. PGD commonly is used to detect chromosomal aneuploidies (an abnormal number of chromosomes) that produce disorders such as Down syndrome (trisomy 21) or Turner syndrome (monosomy X) and approximately 100 single-gene disor- ders. Currently, it is impossible to use a single PGD procedure to detect multiple conditions without compromising the viability of the blastocyst. Finally, IVF and PGD may both produce viable embryos that are never trans- ferred to the uterus. Thus, initiating these procedures requires couples to consider what to do with unused embryos: to freeze them for potential future use, donate them for re- search, or destroy them.

PGD raises ethical and moral issues for both the couple and the population as a whole. Tech- nically, PGD can be used to test embryos for a range of disorders, from those that are lethal in childhood, such as Tay-Sachs disease, to those that are adult onset and for which treatments are available, such as BRCA1/2 associated breast and ovarian cancer. It also can be used to detect conditions such as deafness, for which there is disagreement about its consideration as a dis- ease. Despite the issues it raises, PGD broad- ens the options for individuals who previously chose not to have children because they might pass on a genetic condition.

Carrier Screening

Couples who are planning a pregnancy and have a family history of genetic illness or

JWBT514_ch21.indd 574JWBT514_ch21.indd 574 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Social Work and Genetics 575

who are among a high-risk group for a genetic illness may request carrier screening to identify genetic mutations or anomalies. Some of the disorders for which carrier screening is avail- able are Tay-Sachs disease, sickle cell disease, and cystic fi brosis. If recessive genetic disor- ders are known to exist in a family, individuals may choose to know their carrier status for the disorder. Carrier screening may reveal that a person has an altered gene for the disorder. If the person’s partner is also a carrier, the risk for a child with the condition is 25%. If only one person is a carrier, the couple’s offspring will not be affected; thus, a single test may be all that the couple need. If a single member of the couple is a carrier, the couple may elect to replace that partner’s germ cell (ovum or sperm) with donor ova or sperm to minimize risk. The use of donor material requires the use of assisted reproductive techniques. As a rule, donor sperm requires only intrauterine insemi- nation while donor ovum requires a full IVF cycle for both the donor and the gestational mothers.

Ensuring that someone is not a carrier is diffi cult in some cases. For example, cystic fi brosis (CF) is an autosomal recessive condi- tion caused by mutations in the CFTR gene. Although over 1,000 mutations are known to cause cystic fi brosis, the carrier screening panel is required to test for only 23 of them (Watson et al., 2004), because these 23 ac- count for the vast majority of mutations found in the population with CF. Negative carrier screening using this panel will substantially decrease the chance that the individual is a carrier for CF but cannot eliminate the pos- sibility entirely. In addition, the panel is opti- mized for the population that has the highest prevalence of people affected with CF, north- ern Europeans. Individuals in other popula- tions may be more likely to have CF caused by mutations that do not occur on the stan- dard carrier panel. Consequently, the detec- tion rate is not the same across groups. This is true for other conditions as well. Therefore, couples must be counseled adequately about the limitations of testing as well as its ben- efi ts (see Box 21.3).

Genetic Testing for Adult-Onset Disorders

Genetic testing for adult-onset disorders iden- tifi es germline mutations in blood or tissue samples that are linked to specifi c patterns of disease risk. These illnesses typically pres- ent in adulthood, as is the case Huntington’s disease and certain cancers. Individuals may present for genetic testing for a variety of rea- sons. If an abnormality is discovered, a patient or loved one is peridiagnostic, or if a family history indicates patterns of genetic inheri- tance, the individual may pursue genetic test- ing to inform treatment decisions. Individuals and couples frequently pursue genetic testing to inform family planning. Early population- based studies of interest in genetic testing for adult disorders predicted signifi cant uptake, yet only a small percentage of individuals and families referred for genetic counseling com- plete that testing (Struewing, Lerman, & Kase, 1995). Individuals with family histories of disorders for which prevention and treatment remain elusive pursue genetic testing even less frequently than do individuals with disease for which effective treatment exists (e.g., Decruy- enaere et al., 1997).

Genetic testing may provide individuals from families with extensive disease histories with a sense of increased control over inherited risk by minimizing uncertainty and opening avenues for advanced and targeted preventive medical care (Gooding, Organista, Burack, & Biesecker, 2006). If genetic testing reveals a genetic mutation, carriers must make crucial, and frequently distressing, decisions, about how to monitor their health (Erblich, Bovbjerg, & Valdimarsdottir, 2000; Schlich-Bakker, ten Kroode, & Ausems, 2006). Predominant mod- els of health behavior suggest health decisions are “rational” when informed by a combina- tion of a risk–benefi t calculus, pressures from and modeling of important others, beliefs about control and mastery, and available re- sources (see Chapter 6, “Theories of Health Behavior”). Although socially focused models of health behavior and decision making exist, these models were conceptualized well before

JWBT514_ch21.indd 575JWBT514_ch21.indd 575 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

576 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Box 21.3 Essential Skills for Social Workers in Genetics

Social workers should develop skills to: • Acquire a basic understanding about

genetics as a science and a fi eld of study, including its biological, psychosocial, ethical, and legal aspects.

• Gather relevant genetic family history information, including a multigenerational family history that includes parents, children, siblings, grandparents, aunts/uncles, and cousins.

• Identify clients who might benefi t from a referral for genetic services.

• Properly communicate to clients the purpose of genetic services and the role of various genetic professionals.

• Provide culturally sensitive services to clients with or at risk of developing genetic conditions.

• Seek assistance from and refer to appropriate genetics experts and peer support resources.

• Explore with clients the possible range of emotional effects they and family members may experience as a result of receiving or refusing genetic information.

• Assist clients and their families in the genetic decision-making process and in adapting to genetic information throughout the life cycle.

• Discuss costs of genetic services and insurance benefi ts.

• Safeguard privacy and confi dentiality of genetic information of clients to the extent possible.

• Facilitate the creation and maintenance of support resources for clients with genetic conditions.

• Obtain current genetic information from reliable sources, for self, clients, and colleagues.

• Educate clients, professionals, and the community about policy issues regarding genetics.

• Advocate for client-focused public policy in genetics.

• Assist clients in understanding the limitations and benefi ts of participating in genetics research and the importance of informed consent.

• Develop specialized knowledge and understanding about the history, traditions, values, and family systems of client groups as they relate to genetics.

• Participate in multidisciplinary teams that deliver comprehensive genetics services and conduct genetics research.

• Contribute to the development of research- based and practice-relevant knowledge of the psychosocial, cultural, economic, and ethical implications of genetics on individuals, families, and society.

Source: NASW Standards for Integrating Genetics into Social Work Practice by J. Weiss et al., 2003, Washington, DC: NASW Press.

the genetic revolution and may prove insuf- fi cient for the examination of individual and family experiences with hereditary disease. For example, these models do not take into account the importance of family histories in shaping cognitive representations of the illness experience long before the individual experi- ences a symptom or diagnosis, a scenario in which grief, self-concept, and relational dy- namics are tied intimately to illness expecta- tions and decision making.

Risk assessment and subsequent medical decision making often involve calculating

genetically determined disease risk against other pressing psychosocial risks, such as the burden of a potential diagnosis on loved ones or anticipated decision regret from a specifi c course of action (or inaction). Psychosocial assessment of individuals pursuing genetic testing for adult-onset disorders must take into account the individual’s dependencies, inter- dependencies, and obligations in family life. These obligations intersect with (anticipated) physical symptoms, affective factors that im- pact information processing and coping, and social contexts (Howard et al., 2009) to shape

JWBT514_ch21.indd 576JWBT514_ch21.indd 576 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Social Work and Genetics 577

medical decision making about genetic test- ing, risk management, and prevention. For ex- ample, empirical fi ndings suggest these factors shape the decision to complete risk-reducing mastectomy, salpingo-oophorectomy, or col- ectomy to minimize inherited cancer risk. In the absence of illness, some individuals may experience inertia in changing health behav- iors. For others, anxiety and distress are con- sistent predictors of how they manage disease risk.

Genetic testing is available for some con- ditions for which no treatments exist. For disorders such as Huntington’s disease and early-onset Alzheimer’s disease, risk is not malleable via medical, surgical, or lifestyle intervention. Living with uncertainty about when and how a dormant genetic condition will become symptomatic may increase an- ticipatory mourning for a healthy identity and challenge adaptive coping to genetic testing results (Rolland, 2006).

Mapping Genetic Risk in Family Histories

Uncertainty about genetic testing results (e.g., many BRCA variants are not yet linked to con- crete risk information), disease penetrance (not all gene mutation will lead to disease), illness onset and course (Alzheimer’s disease onset varies tremendously), and outcomes (whether treatment will be effective in preventing or treating disease) shape coping and adaptation. Ambiguity challenges understandings of risk and makes advance planning diffi cult. Given that limited research addresses the variety of factors that scatter gene alteration carriers across spectrums of disease risk, clinicians continue to look at family histories as predic- tors of risk, as do individuals (Werner-Lin, 2007). Subjective perceptions of risk, couched in family histories with disease rather than sta- tistical risk estimates, are powerful predictors of interest in and uptake of genetic testing and risk management choices for high-risk indi- viduals and families.

A pedigree is a multigenerational represen- tation of patterns of biological inheritance and

disease expression that includes information about the family’s geographic origins, births and deaths, medical problems, birth defects, and developmental delays (Bennett, 1999). Designed to identify patterns of genetic inheri- tance, a family pedigree focuses on biological families (Atkinson, Parsons, & Featherstone, 2001; Kenen & Peters, 2001) rather than the affective experiences and cognitive percep- tions that guide health promotion and risk management behaviors around inherited risk (Patenaude, 2004). Early attempts to identify the genetic mutation for increased breast and ovarian cancer risk recruited families with multiple affected members within and across generations. In these studies, family history tools such as the pedigree were used exten- sively to identify patterns of illness expression and to suggest genetic markers for disease risk (e.g., Lynch & de la Chapelle, 2003).

Like the pedigree, a genogram maps mul- tigenerational family patterns, helping to ex- pand the family’s scope of attention from the individual to the familial (Kenen & Peters, 2001; McDaniel, Rolland, Feetham, & Miller, 2006). A medically oriented genogram incor- porates developmental, familial, community, and social factors that infl uence and are af- fected by disease expression and management as well as the emotional sequela (McGoldrick, Gerson, & Shellenberger, 1999). The process of creating a family genogram can bring to light shared and individual narratives and dis- courses around familial disease (Eunpu, 1997) and enable shifts in perceptions of disease risk (Werner-Lin & Gardner, 2009).

Mounting evidence supports the notion that individuals in families with ambiguous genetic testing interpret their risk based on patterns of illness expression in their families, family loyalties, and visual and personality charac- teristics (Werner-Lin, 2007). Reaching the age of a parent at their diagnosis and reactions to prior losses contribute to meaning attribution about genetic testing results (Gabriel, 1992; Werner-Lin, 2008). For example, signifi cant illness milestones may increase anxiety or anticipatory loss. As illness experiences ac- cumulate and recur over generations, as they

JWBT514_ch21.indd 577JWBT514_ch21.indd 577 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

578 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

frequently do with hereditary disease, they be- come family myths that include beliefs about who gets sick and why, how families care for ill members, appropriate modes of communi- cation within the family and with outsiders, and illness outcomes. Those who test negative for genes linked to familial disease experience their own unique challenges in integrating ge- netic testing results, including survivor guilt, the need to alter trajectories so that they no longer make room for a future diagnosis, or disbelief at test results (Bakos et al., 2008; Sobel & Cowan, 2003).

Inherited Adult-Onset Disease Risk Across the Life Cycle

The timing of genetic testing in the life course plays a signifi cant role in coping with and ad- aptation to testing results. Furthermore, coping and adaptation to genetic information changes over the life cycle, as salient developmental tasks shift.

Childhood. Children growing up in homes with parents affected by critical or termi- nal illness frequently grow up faster than peers because of responsibilities to maintain the household or to care for ill parents and younger siblings. Early parental loss drasti- cally alters normative developmental trajec- tories and shapes perceptions of vulnerability to inherited disease in addition to coping and medical decision making.

Adolescence. Treatment has improved sub- stantially for some genetic conditions (e.g., cystic fi brosis), and children with genetic con- ditions that previously were fatal now live well into adulthood. Providers are not necessarily prepared to address the concerns of adoles- cents aging out of pediatric care. Research is needed to identify the new challenges faced by adolescents as their disorders shift from fatal to chronic and as their care shifts from pedi- atric clinics with holistic resources to adult fa- cilities that rely on patients to coordinate and manage their own care.

Young Adulthood. Individuals with inher- ited disease risk frequently pursue genetic testing during their reproductive years to in- form marriage and family planning. Couples

may promise to love each other in sickness and in health, yet the experience of creating a life plan that integrates the possibility of early illness and death is developmentally out of sync with normative developmental tasks of establishing intimate relationships and the start of family planning. Inherited disease risk may shape the qualities an individual seeks in a life partner (Werner-Lin, 2008) as well as a couple’s hopes and fears about family plan- ning. Genetic testing during this life stage in- forms: (a) life planning surrounding marriage, childbearing, and professional development (Hoskins, Roy, Peters, Loud, & Green, 2008); (b) the adult’s capacity to remain healthy and vital to parent a child; and (c) the child’s risk of developing the same condition as they reach adulthood. In some communities, such as Or- thodox Jewish communities, genetic testing provides information about one’s viability as a spouse. Parents may feel responsibility to pro- tect children from genetic conditions or may experience guilt at potentially passing on ge- netic mutations to children.

NEGOTIATING COMMON ETHICAL CHALLENGES

Competent and skilled practice requires famil- iarity with common ethical challenges faced by health and mental health providers. Attempts to deal with ethical dilemmas must rely both on the National Association of Social Workers Code of Ethics and on major principles of bio- ethics, such as respect for autonomy, benefi - cence, and justice. This section of the chapter highlights some of the more challenging di- lemmas confronting providers today, including informed consent, family communication and confi dentiality, patient autonomy, and genetic testing of minors for adult-onset disorders.

Informed Consent

Originating in the doctrine of self- determination, informed consent is a process of communication between a provider and a patient, during which the risks and benefi ts

JWBT514_ch21.indd 578JWBT514_ch21.indd 578 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Social Work and Genetics 579

associated with a procedure are explained, thus enabling the patient to make an educated and personal choice about whether to proceed. In- dividuals give informed consent when agreeing to any medical procedure. This consent should be voluntary and based on adequate and accu- rate information and understanding. A variety of issues challenge providers’ ability to obtain informed consent across medical settings. For example, some have argued that informed con- sent procedures have suffered as prenatal ge- netic testing became integrated into standard prenatal care (McCoyd, 2010; Rapp, 1999). Although genetics is not the only medical dis- cipline that has struggled with how to ensure informed consent, the nature of genetic re- search and treatment protocols present unique challenges. These protocols frequently involve complex and sophisticated explanations of di- agnostic, treatment, and research procedures. That 90 million Americans have limited health literacy means that individuals across a vari- ety of medical and community settings might agree to participate in protocols without suf- fi cient understanding of the medical, social, psychological, economic, and legal risks they could incur.

Our ability to identify genetic vulnerability to a condition continues to outpace medicine’s ability to treat it, marking a signifi cant thera- peutic gap (Holtzman & Watson, 1997) in ge- netic medicine. The information contained in informed consent documents presented at the time of genetic testing may be confusing and leave a person with unrealistic expectations or false assumptions about test results (Freedman, 1997). A person considering genetic testing or research participation in which genetic mark- ers are used should engage voluntarily. There may be internal (anxiety, fear) or external pres- sures (family members or health-care provid- ers) to engage in these activities. The question of how well individuals understand consent forms is subjective and is infl uenced by their emotional state at the time. Thus, the stress of genetic counseling and testing may limit the patient’s or family’s ability to attend suf- fi ciently to the detailed explication of the risk and benefi ts of the procedure.

Currently, genetics research projects funded by the National Institutes of Health (NIH) are required to add genotype and phenotype data into a single, large database (dbGAP) that can be accessed by other NIH researchers. This is a protected database, and access is heav- ily regulated with specifi c attention to privacy and confi dentiality. Pooling data among stud- ies will increase the ability of researchers to investigate genetic contributions to both rare and common diseases, yet protocols using this database do not routinely query patients who have provided blood samples or tissue about informed consent that addresses confi dential- ity, the scope of future research, or the return of laboratory results (Ludman et al., 2010; Wolf, Bouley, & McCulloch, 2010).

Current protocols also have led to questions about the ownership of genetic material and about who should benefi t from genetic discov- eries. These issues are explored in the recent biography of Henrietta Lacks, who unknow- ingly “donated” the fi rst human cells success- fully cultured in a laboratory (Skloot, 2010). Although discoveries using her cells (called HeLa cells) led to signifi cant breakthroughs in public health, her children and grandchildren remain impoverished and uninsured. Further- more, they did not know that Ms. Lacks’s cells had been obtained, cultured, or used for scien- tifi c research. Although new protections exist to prevent such situations, genetic research has identifi ed signifi cant gaps that remain in informed consent protocols for research.

Family Communication and Confi dentiality

The familial implications of identifying ge- netic links to conditions and traits shifts the existing biomedical paradigm that focuses on the rights of the individual patient to a broader focus on the rights of family members. Al- though genetic testing information may be probabilistic, genetic testing of one family member for a condition may identify other family members at risk. This may motivate in- dividuals to pursue testing, as in the case of a perimenopausal woman with a breast cancer

JWBT514_ch21.indd 579JWBT514_ch21.indd 579 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

580 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

diagnosis who pursues genetic testing not only to inform her own treatment decisions, but also to identify risk to her children. Patients may withhold genetic testing information from fam- ily members because they do not want to upset bereaved loved ones if they are estranged, if they perceive family members are unlikely to take action, or if they want to keep their risk information private (Offi t, Groeger, Turner, Wadsworth & Weiser, 2004; Patenaude, 2004).

Genetic research using a family systems lens identifi ed challenging family roles created by the possibility of genetic testing. The fi rst individual in a family to pursue testing and to discuss risk with family members is the mes- senger of genetic information. Children test- ing positive for a recessive or X-linked genetic condition may identify parents as obligate carriers (Adelsward & Sachs, 2003, Dudokde Wit et al., 1997). Obligate carriers and others implicated by genetic testing in the bloodline may be unprepared to learn about or address their risk. Furthermore, perceptions of risk may be skewed, if risk information is communi- cated unclearly or inaccurately within families (Smith, Dancyger, Wallace, & Michie, 2010).

If genetic testing reveals risk information about an entire bloodline, the needs of the en- tire family must be considered. Providers may be challenged to help family members ap- proach this question in a way that is respectful to everyone. Facilitating disclosure of genetic testing results in families includes attention to the rights of family members not to know. The concerns of individual family members unprepared to address and use genetic test- ing information reach beyond health risks; this information may impact mental health, individual development and family formation, relationship, and dynamics (Gilbar, 2007). So- cial work training includes skills that can be applied to support planned disclosure and to facilitate family discussion of genetic testing.

Because genetic testing reveals risk informa- tion for an entire family, individuals who do not know they may have inherited disease risk do not have the opportunity to engage in treatment or prevention. If treatments are available to pre- vent a fatal illness or improve quality of life and

prevent suffering, are doctors obligated to share genetic information with other members of the bloodline? The Health Insurance Portability and Accountability Act requires physicians to breech confi dentiality to “prevent or lessen a serious and immediate threat” (Department of Health and Human Services, www.hhs.gov/ ocr/privacy/hipaa/understanding/summary /index.html). The Institute of Medicine concurs that when failure to communicate genetic in- formation can result in serious, imminent harm or death, the physician may contact the family if the patient has not done so. Although some genetic diseases follow predictable patterns of expression, many inherited predispositions are ambiguous and uncertain, leaving signifi cant gray area in interpreting federal policy and medical guidelines.

Patient Autonomy and Testing Minors

Children constitute an especially vulnerable group in terms of genetic screening, because they are dependent on adults (Knoppers, Avard, Cardinal, & Glass, 2002). When a ge- netic condition presents in childhood, genetic testing before the child is symptomatic, or as the child becomes symptomatic, may help physicians to manage the condition medically (Field, Shanley, & Kirk, 2007).

Genetic testing of minors is more ethically questionable for disorders that present later in life. These disorders vary widely, and fami- lies should be discouraged from genetic test- ing, unless children and teens can benefi t from testing before they reach adulthood. The pro- fessional ethics of both geneticists and genetic counselors do not support testing children for adult onset disorders in most circumstances (e.g., the National Society of Genetic Counselors position statement, 1995). This is because they believe that children should have the right to decide about testing when they reach adulthood. Beyond the inability of a child to give informed consent, genetic testing in childhood presents a host of ethi- cal and social concerns for children and fami- lies. Genetic testing in childhood removes children’s right to know (or not know) their

JWBT514_ch21.indd 580JWBT514_ch21.indd 580 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Social Work and Genetics 581

genetic status; opens them up to the possi- bility of discrimination in social, academic, and medical settings; and may impact their self-concept, self-esteem, and the ways they are parented (Ross & Fost, 2006). Although genetic testing at any stage of the life cycle informs family planning, testing during child- hood removes reproductive confi dentiality and may shape the messages children receive about becoming parents. Furthermore, the ab- stract nature of probabilistic risk information is hard for adults to comprehend; it is even more diffi cult for children to do so, as they have not yet developed the cognitive tools to understand abstractions or probability, or may be learning about their risk from parents with skewed perceptions or distinct motivations. Finally, as prenatal testing becomes more so- phisticated, parents may be able to decide to pursue prenatal genetic testing for adult-onset conditions, whether to make decisions about pregnancy termination or to skirt recommen- dations against genetic testing in childhood. This means that a child may be born as a known carrier of a genetic condition that is unlikely to present for decades.

No legally defi nitive statement regulates the testing of minors for genetic conditions pre- senting in adulthood. In the absence of legal guidance, bioethicists and health and mental health professionals are left to debate what is in the best interests of the child. Who is in the best position to decide for or about the child? Although parents express considerable inter- est in genetic testing for adult-onset disorders during childhood, such testing is not recom- mended when no treatments exist for children. This is particularly evident when genetic test- ing may result in psychosocial harm (stigma, self-esteem) to the child and the family. Al- though parental anxiety may be reduced by genetic testing, families may have problems planning and adjusting expectations about the child’s life and abilities. Parents may benefi t from an explanation of why testing is not in the child’s best interest. Children may be (uninten- tionally) coerced by parents or feel motivated by a parent’s guilt and distress to pursue test- ing (Wilfond & Ross, 2009). Instead, children

should be informed about genetic testing after they reach adulthood (McConkie-Rosell & Spiridigliozzi, 2004).

POLICY DEVELOPMENTS

Health-care professionals and individuals, families, and groups pursuing genetic testing have been hindered by the concern that results might be used for discriminatory purposes. Of specifi c concern is the impact of genetic test- ing information on health insurance coverage and deductibles and other fees. In a few cases, employers inappropriately have required ge- netic testing of employees and then used results to make employment or promotion de- cisions. Although the civil rights of individuals with genetic conditions are protected under the Americans with Disabilities Act, protection from other types of discrimination does not exist. These concerns constitute a signifi cant barrier to genetic services, particularly genetic testing.

After a 13-year process that culminated in May 2008, President George W. Bush signed the Genetic Information Nondiscrimination Act (GINA) into law (see Box 21.4). All as- pects of the law were in effect as of November 2009. GINA was created to remove barriers to the appropriate use of genetic services. The legislation protects the public from the mis- use of genetic information by health insurers and employers. GINA amended laws that do not apply to certain groups of individuals re- ceiving federal benefi ts. Those excluded are members of the United States military, veter- ans obtaining health care through the Veterans Administration, individuals using the Indian Health Service, or federal employees enrolled in the Federal Employees Health Benefi ts program. However, the military and veterans’ health-care systems have policies in place that provide protections similar to GINA. Federal employees likewise are protected by an execu- tive order that was signed by President Clin- ton in 2000. Despite its limitations, GINA is landmark legislation that removes a signifi cant barrier to genetic testing.

JWBT514_ch21.indd 581JWBT514_ch21.indd 581 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

582 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Box 21.4 Genetic Information Nondiscrimination Act

Genetic Information Nondiscrimination Act (GINA) states:

Under GINA, group and individual health insurers cannot: • Use a person’s genetic information to

set eligibility requirements or establish premium or contribution amounts.

• Request or require that a person undergo a genetic test.

Under GINA, employers cannot: • Use a person’s genetic information

in decisions about hiring, fi ring, job assignments, or promotions.

• Request, require, or purchase genetic information about an employee or family member.

GINA protects genetic information related to: • Family medical history. • Carrier testing: that is, cystic fi brosis,

sickle cell anemia, spinal muscular atrophy, fragile X, and other conditions.

• Prenatal genetic testing: that is, amniocentesis, chorionic villus sampling, and other techniques.

• Susceptibility and predictive testing: for example, BRCA testing for risk of breast or ovarian cancer, testing for Huntington’s disease, or HNPCC testing for risk of colon cancer.

• Analysis of tumors or other assessments of genes, mutations, or chromosomal changes.

GINA does not protect against or apply to: • A condition that is already diagnosed and

manifest, even if that condition is genetic. • Life, disability, or long-term-care insurers

(as of the date listed on this document). • Information about current health status. • Employers with fewer than 15 employees.

GINA does not protect certain groups of individuals.

Source: The Genetic Nondiscrimination Act (GINA), National Coalition of Health Professional Education in Genetics, 2010. Retrieved from www.nchpeg.org/index .php?option=com_content&view=article&id=97&Item id=120

CONCLUSION

Genetic discovery may provide new interpre- tive frames for the meaning and cause of dis- ease. The movement toward consumer-driven health care is challenged by the combination of limited health literacy and the beliefs about the promise of genetic discoveries that have yet to develop. Recognizing genetic, as well as environmental, factors that impact conditions and traits will allow social workers, in part- nership with other health and mental health professionals, to develop interventions and resources that are targeted to educating and supporting the unique circumstances of indi- viduals, families, and communities.

Adapting to and integrating genetic informa- tion into a life plan is an ongoing process, with fl uctuating periods of tranquility and distress. For individuals from families with extensive

disease histories, genetic explanations may in- crease distress and anticipatory loss by altering expectations about future health status. Alterna- tively, genetic mechanisms and the ability to test for the presence (or absence) of a disease-re- lated mutation may enable patients to construct life plans that maximize healthy years. Whereas contact with genetic counselors and physicians is time limited, an underestimated strength of social work in genetics is social workers’ abil- ity to have ongoing contact with clients and their families (Weiss et al. 2003). The potential for prolonged contact with mental health ser- vices allows social workers to facilitate adapta- tion and coping over extended periods of time and throughout the life cycle as new concerns emerge and the meaning of risk shifts. Social workers are in a unique position to develop and implement relevant programs to provide ongo- ing support for families with educational and

JWBT514_ch21.indd 582JWBT514_ch21.indd 582 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Social Work and Genetics 583

supportive services delivered at key points in the adaptation to genetic conditions (Taylor- Brown & Johnson, 1998).

SUGGESTED LEARNING EXERCISES

Read the exercises and discuss how you would help clients deal with their genetic concerns.

Learning Exercise 21.1

Tina and Jon are referred to a social worker after routine ultrasound identifi ed multiple birth defects in their developing baby. The spe- cifi c pattern of defects indicates their child has a rare, inherited genetic condition. After the initial diagnosis by the obstetrician, the couple met with a fetal-maternal specialist at a medi- cal center who performed a high-resolution ul- trasound and confi rmed the fi ndings. Because the couple is only eight weeks from the due date, pregnancy termination is not an option.

The couple was referred for genetic counsel- ing after the diagnosis. The genetic counselor explored Tina and Jon’s family medical histo- ries and documented that no one has reported a stillbirth or neonatal death in three genera- tions. Tina is 31 years old, and this is her fi rst pregnancy. She has two older sisters and sev- eral nieces and nephews who are healthy. Jon is 38 years old and has two healthy school-age children from a previous marriage who stay with the couple on alternating weekends. The genetic counselor tells Tina and Jon that each of them carries a specifi c gene alteration and when they both pass the gene on to a child, the presence of the two altered genes will re- sult in disruption of fetal development. There is no genetic test to confi rm this diagnosis. Furthermore, each child they conceive has a 25% chance of inheriting both altered forms of the gene. Both appear to be too distracted and angry to absorb this risk information.

Tina and Jon are both distraught that so little is known about their baby’s condition. Both are appropriately concerned and fright- ened. Jon is worried about Tina and how this

baby will impact her and their marriage. Tina is angry that she needs to wait and see what happens at delivery. When Jon is out of the room, she tells you she is jealous that Jon’s other children are fi ne and worries about what she might have done to deserve this, to “ruin” her baby. Jon is not sleeping and is actively engaging Tina in discussions about a timeline and plans for conceiving the next baby.

1. Draw a genogram of this family, indicating both medical and family data.

2. What are the key pieces of information about the genetic condition? What is the mode of inheritance? Describe the risk to each future pregnancy.

3. You recognize that you need better information to counsel this couple. Find resources that will help you learn about this condition so that you can support them in their efforts at family planning.

4. What are the primary psychosocial concerns this couple might face after the child is born?

5. Prioritize these psychosocial concerns, and identify interventions and resources that will help support the family in your com- munity.

Learning Exercise 21.2

Carolyn and Michael have been attempting to achieve a pregnancy since their wedding 8 months ago. Carolyn is 39 years old, and Michael is anxious about her fertility be- cause of her age. Carolyn’s mother was di- agnosed with breast cancer at age 46 and died at age 51. Carolyn’s maternal aunt and grandmother also died of breast cancer. After meeting Michael, Carolyn pursued genetic testing and was found to carry a BRCA1 genetic mutation. Carolyn is eager to have children quickly given her age and her de- sire to complete risk-reducing mastectomy (surgical removal of breasts) and salpingo- oophorectomy (surgical removal of her ova- ries and fallopian tubes) to minimize her chances of developing cancer.

JWBT514_ch21.indd 583JWBT514_ch21.indd 583 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

584 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

For fertility reasons, Carolyn asks for a referral to a reproductive endocrinologist to discuss assisted reproduction. Michael and Carolyn come to the fi rst appointment with questions in hand and a growing sense of ur- gency. Their consultation leads to several test- ing appointments with the good news that no obvious clinical condition appears to exist. During the discussion of what interventions might have the best success, the reproductive endocrinologist brings up the BRCA1 mutation and introduces the possibility of pre-implanta- tion genetic diagnosis (PGD) in combination with in vitro fertilization (IVF). PGD screens embryos from IVF for the BRCA1 mutation, thus allowing only embryos without the muta- tion to be implanted. IVF is not guaranteed to achieve a successful pregnancy. The doc- tor advises the couple that there is no good data about the impact of IVF-associated hormone treatment on breast cancer risk for women with a BRCA mutation. The data for women at average risk for breast cancer show that there is no increased breast cancer risk associated with the hormone treatment. PGD is an additional cost on top of IVF, which is generally costly and not always covered by insurance.

Carolyn is interested in pursuing PGD. She discusses the procedure with her sisters, both physicians, and they agree that it is an attractive option. Michael is not interested in pursuing PGD. He is concerned about expense and the impact of the hormone treatments on Carolyn’s cancer risk, especially given how close in age she is to when her mother was diagnosed initially. Carolyn and Michael meet with a genetic counselor who explains that, because of their age, there is a slightly greater than 1% chance that any fetus they conceive may have a chromosomal abnormality. Mi- chael is very concerned about the risk and would like to conceive quickly. Carolyn feels differently; compared to her lifetime risk of developing cancer, her interpretation of chro- mosomal risk is more positive: a 99% chance that a conception at this age will not have any chromosomal abnormalities. She would like

to proceed immediately with PGD. Michael disagrees, stating they should not interfere with the natural process of creating a baby if no obvious fertility issue exists, since they have been trying to conceive for less than 12 months, and the baby may not inherit the mu- tation. Carolyn disagrees and feels very disap- pointed in Michael. She begins to experience severe anxiety, and they argue regularly. The couple is referred to you for counseling.

1. Draw a genogram of this family, indicating both medical and family data.

2. The couple has a number of competing pragmatic and emotional concerns. De- scribe these concerns and how they are re- lated to perceptions of risk.

3. You recognize that you need better informa- tion to counsel this couple. Find resources that will help you learn about these condi- tions so that you can support them in their efforts at family planning.

4. Identify targets for change and appropriate interventions to support the couple.

SUGGESTED RESOURCES

American College for Medical Genetics— www.acmg.net

This site provides information about clinical geneticists and includes a search function to locate a clinical geneticist. The site also presents educational materials, including information about newborn screening and statements covering a variety of genetics issues.

Centre for Genetics Education—www.gen etics.com.au/home.asp

The Centre for Genetics Education is dedicated to providing current and relevant genetics information to individuals and family members affected by genetic conditions and to professionals who work with them.

Duke Center for Human Genetics—www .chg.duke.edu/education/online.html

JWBT514_ch21.indd 584JWBT514_ch21.indd 584 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Social Work and Genetics 585

The mission of the Duke Center for Human Genetics is to discover genetic infl uences on human health, to charac- terize the relationship between genetic and environmental infl uences, and to foster the application of this knowledge to the practice of medicine. The site con- tains online educational programs for a variety of audiences as well as research resources.

Genetic Alliance—www.geneticalliance.org Genetic Alliance was started by so-

cial workers to increase the ability of genetic advocacy groups to achieve their missions and leverage the voices of millions of individuals and families living with genetic conditions. The al- liance has an annual conference, links to support groups for common and rare conditions, advocacy resources includ- ing specialty issue teams (e.g., access, disparities), a resource repository for educational materials and presentations, and news.

Genetic and Rare Conditions Site—www .kumc.edu/gec

The University of Kansas Medical Center has links to lay advocacy and sup- port groups and information on genetic conditions/birth defects for profession- als, educators, and individuals, national and international organizations.

Genetics and Public Policy Center—www .dnapolicy.org

The center helps policy leaders, deci- sion makers, and the public better under- stand and respond to the challenges and opportunities arising from advances in genetics and their application to human health and well-being. The center’s mul- tidisciplinary team monitors advances in human genetics and their translation into clinical applications and conducts quali- tative and quantitative social science and legal and policy analysis.

Genetics Science Learning Center—http:// learn.genetics.utah.edu/gslc/

The Genetics Science Learning Cen- ter is a science and health education program that aims to make biology and genetics concepts accessible. It provides educational materials and interactive programs on genetics for local and glob- al audiences.

National Coalition of Health Professional Education in Genetics—www.nchpeg.org

NCHPEG promotes health profes- sional education and access to infor- mation about advances in human ge- netics. NCHPEG draws on the collec- tive experience and expertise of mul- tiple organizations, professionals, and specialists to promote genetics educa- tion. The Web site offers free, online educational programs for a variety of audiences as well as biannual newslet- ters, core competencies in genetics, and information from the annual pro- fessional meetings.

National Human Genome Research Insti- tute (NHGRI) at the National Institutes of Health—www.genome.gov

NHGRI is one of the 27 institutes and centers at National Institutes of Health. NHGRI led NIH’s efforts toward the Inter- national Human Genome Project, which had as its primary goal the sequencing of the human genome. This project was completed successfully in April 2003. Now the NHGRI’s mission has expanded to encompass a broad range of studies aimed at understanding the structure and function of the human genome and its role in health and disease. The Web site has informational and educational materi- als about all aspects of genetics.

National Society of Genetic Counselors— www.nsgc.org

This site provides information about genetic counseling and a search feature to assist people to fi nd a genetic coun- selor. It also includes a list of resources for patients concerned about genetic dis- crimination.

JWBT514_ch21.indd 585JWBT514_ch21.indd 585 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

586 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

REFERENCES

Adelsward, V., & Sachs, L. (2003). The messenger’s dilemmas—Giving and getting information in genealogical mapping for hereditary cancer. Health, Risk & Society, 5(2), 125–138.

Agrawal, A., & Lynskey, M. T. (2008). Are there genetic infl uences on addiction: Evidence from family, adoption, and twin studies. Addiction, 103(7), 1069– 1081.

Ancker, J. S., & Kaufman, D. (2007). Rethinking health numeracy: A multidisciplinary literature review. Journal of the American Medical Informatics Association, 14(6), 713–721.

Annes, J. P., Giovanni, M. A., Murray, M. F. (2010). Risks of presymptomatic direct-to-consumer genetic testing. New England Journal of Medicine, 363(12), 1100–1101.

Atkinson, P. A., Parsons, E., & Featherstone, K. (2001). Professional constructions of family and kinship in medical genetics. New Genetics and Society, 20, 6–24.

Bakos, A. D., Hutson, S. P., Loud, J. T., Peters, J. A., Giusti, R. M., & Greene, M. H. (2008). BRCA mutation-negative women from hereditary breast and ovarian cancer families: A qualitative study of the BRCA-negative experience. Health Expectations, 11, 220–231.

Bennett, R. (1999). The practical guide to the genetic family history. Indianapolis, IN: Wiley.

Berg, A. O., Allan, J. D., Homer, C. J., Johnson, M. S., Klein, J. D., Lieu, T. A., . . . U.S. Preventive Service Task Force of the Agency for Healthcare Policy and Research (2002). Newborn hearing screening: Recommendations and rationale. American Journal of Nursing, 102(11), pp. 83–89.

Bonham, V. L., Warshauer-Baker, E., & Collins, F. (2005). Race and ethnicity in the Genome Era: The complexity of constructs. American Psychologist, 60(1), 9–15.

Braithwaite, D., Emery, J., Walter, F., Prevost, A. T., & Sutton, S. (2004). Psychological impact of genetic counseling for familial cancer: A systematic review and meta-analysis. Journal of the National Cancer Institute, 96(2), 122–133.

Bussey-Jones, J., Henderson, G., Garrett, J., Moloney, M., Blumenthal, C., & Corbie-Smith, G. (2009). Asking the right questions: Views on genetic variation research among Black and White research participants. Journal of General Internal Medicine, 24(3), 229–304.

Caspi, A., Sugden, K., Moffi tt, T. E., Taylor, A., Craig, I. W., Harrington, H., . . . Poulton, R. (2003). Infl uence of life stress on depression: Moderation by a polymorphism in the 5-HTT gene. Science, 301(5631), 386–389.

Crabbe, J. C. (2002). Genetic contributions of addiction. Annual Review of Psychology, 53(1), 435–462.

Darwin, C. (1859). On the origin of species: By means of natural selection, or the preservation of favoured races in the struggle for life. London, England: John Murray.

Decruyenaere, M., Evers-Kiebooms, G., Boogaerts, A., Cloostermans, T., Cassiman, J. J., Demyttenaere, R., & Van den Berghe, H. (1997). Non-participation in predictive testing for Huntington’s disease: Individual decision making, personality and avoidant behavior in the family. European Journal of Human Genetics, 5(6), 351–363.

Department of Health and Human Services. (2005). Understanding HIPAA. Retrieved from www.hhs.gov /ocr/privacy/hipaa/understanding/summary/index.html

Dick, D. M., Rose, R., J., & Jaakko, K. (2006). The next challenge for psychiatric genetics: Characterizing the risk associated with identifi ed genes. Annals of Clinical Psychiatry, 18(4), 223–231.

Dudokde Wit, A. C., Tibben, A., Frets, P. G., Meijers- Heijboer, E. J., Devilee, P., Klijn, J. G. M., . . . Niermeijer, M. F. (1997). BRCA1 in the family: A case description of the psychological implications. American Journal of Medical Genetics, 71, 63–71.

Dupre, J. (2008). What genes are and why there are no genes for race. In B. A. Koenig, S. S. Lee, & S. Richardson (Eds.), Revising race in the genomic age: Studies in medical anthropology (pp. 39–55). Piscataway, NJ: Rutgers University Press.

Edwards, A., Gray, A., Clarke, A., Dundon, J., Elwyn, G., Gaff, C., . . . Thornton, H. (2008). Interventions to improve risk communication in clinical genetics: Systematic review. Patient Education & Counseling 71(1), 4–25.

Erblich, J., Bovbjerg, D. H., & Valdimarsdottir, H. B. (2000). Looking forward and back: Distress among women at familial risk for breast cancer. Annals of Behavioral Medicine, 22, 53–59.

Eunpu, D. L. (1997). Generations lost: A cancer genetics case report commentary. Journal of Genetic Counseling, 6, 173–176.

Fernhoff, P. M. (2009). Newborn screening for genetic disorders. Pediatric Clinics of North America, 56(3), 505–513.

Field, M., Shanley, S., & Kirk, J. (2007). Inherited cancer susceptibility syndromes in paediatric practice. Journal of Paediatrics and Child Health, 43(4), 219–229.

Freedman, T. G. (1997). Genetic susceptibility testing: A therapeutic illusion? Cancer, 79(11), 2063–2065.

Gabriel, M. A. (1992). Anniversary reactions: Trauma revisited. Clinical Social Work Journal, 20, 179–191.

Gehlert, S. D., Sohmer, D., Sacks, T., Mininger, C., McClintock, M. & Olopade, O. (2008). Targeting health disparities: A model linking upstream determinants to downstream interventions. Health Affairs, 27(2), 339–349.

Gilbar, R. (2007). Communicating genetic information in the family: The familial relationship as the forgotten

JWBT514_ch21.indd 586JWBT514_ch21.indd 586 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Social Work and Genetics 587

factor. Journal of Medical Ethics: Journal of the Institute of Medical Ethics, 33(7), 390–393.

Gooding, H. C., Organista, K., Burack, J., & Biesecker, B. B. (2006). Genetic susceptibility testing from a stress and coping perspective. Social Science & Medicine, 62, 1880–1890.

Gray, S. W., O’Grady, C., Karp, L., Smith, D., Schwartz, J. S., Hornik, R. C., & Armstrong, K. (2009). Risk information exposure and direct-to-consumer genetic testing for BRCA mutations among women with a personal or family history of breast or ovarian cancer. Cancer Epidemiology, Biomarkers & Prevention, 18, 1303–1311.

Halbert, C. H., Kessler, L., Wileyto, E. P., Weathers, B., Stopfer, J., Domchek, S., . . . Brewster, K. (2006). Breast cancer screening behaviors among African American women with a strong family history of breast cancer. Preventive Medicine: An International Journal Devoted to Practice and Theory, 43(5), 385–388.

Hallowell, N., & Richards, M. P. M. (1997). Understanding life’s lottery: An evaluation of studies of genetic risk awareness. Journal of Health Psychology, 2(1), 31–43.

Holtzman, N. A., & Watson, M. S. (1997). Promoting safe and effective genetic testing in the United States: Final report of the Task Force on Genetic Testing. Retrieved from www.genome.gov/10001733

Hoskins, L. M., Roy, K., Peters, J. A., Loud, J., & Greene, M. H. (2008). Disclosure of positive BRCA 1/2-mutation status in young couples: The journey from uncertainty to bonding through partner support. Families, Systems & Health, 26, 296–316.

Howard, A. F., Blaneaves, J. L., Bottorff, L. G., & Kim- Sing, C. (2009). Women’s constructions of the “right time” to consider decisions about risk-reducing mastectomy and risk-reducing oophorectomy. BMC Women’s Health, 10, 24.

Hunt, L. M., & Megyesi, M. S. (2008). Genes, race and research ethics. Journal of Medical Ethics: Journal of the Institute of Medical Ethics, 34(6), 495–500.

Hurley, K., Miller, S., Rubin, L., & Weinberg, D. (2006). The individual facing genetic issues: Information processing, decision making, perception, and health protective behaviors. In S. M. Miller, S. H. McDaniel, J. S. Rolland, & S. L. Feetham (Eds.), Individuals, families, and the new era of genetics: Biopsychosocial perspectives (pp. 79–117). New York, NY: Norton.

Jaffee, S. R., & Price, T. S. (2007). Gene-environment correlations: A review of the evidence and implications for prevention of mental illness. Molecular Psychiatry, 12(5), 432–442.

Johnson, J. D., Case, D. O., Andrews, J. E., & Allard, S. L. (2010). Genomics: The perfect information-seeking research problem. Journal of Health Communication, 10(4), 323–329.

Kenen, R., Ardern-Jones, A., & Eeles, R. (2003). Family stories and the use of heuristics: Women from suspected

hereditary breast and ovarian cancer (HBOC) families. Sociology of Health & Illness, 25, 838–865.

Kenen, R., & Peters, J. A. (2001). The colored, eco-genetic relationship map (CEGRM): A conceptual approach and tool for genetic counseling research. Journal of Genetic Counseling, 10, 289–309.

Kent, A. (2003). Consent and confi dentiality in genetics: whose information is it anyway? Journal of Medical Ethics: Journal of the Institute of Medical Ethics, 29(1), 16–18.

Klipstein, S. (2005). Preimplantation genetic diagnosis: Technological promise and ethical perils. Fertility and Sterility, 83, 1347–1353.

Knoppers, B. M., Avard, D., Cardinal, G., & Glass, K. C. (2002). Science and society: Children and incompetent adults in genetic research: consent and safeguards. Nature Reviews: Genetics, 3, 221–225.

Lippman-Hand, A., & Fraser, F. C. (1979). Genetic counseling: provision and reception of information. American Journal of Medical Genetics, 3(2), 113–127.

Ludman E. J., Fullerton, S. M., Spangler, L., Trinidad, S. B., Fujii, M. M., Jarvik, G. P., . . . Burke, W. (2010). Glad you asked: Participants’ opinions of re-consent for dbGap data submission. Journal of Empirical Research on Human Research Ethics, 5(3), 9–16.

Lupton, D. L. (1999). Risk. London, UK: Routledge.

Lynch, H. T., & de la Chapelle, A. (2003). Hereditary colorectal cancer. New England Journal of Medicine, 348, 919–932.

Malhotra, A., Lencz, T., Correll, C. U., & Kane, J. (2007). Genomics and the future of pharmacotherapy in psychiatry. International Review of Psychiatry, 19(5), 523–530.

Manolio, T. A. (2009). Collaborative genome-wide association studies of diverse diseases: Programs of the NHGRI’s offi ce of population genetics. Pharmacogenomics, 10(2), 235–241.

McClintock, M. K., Conzen, S. D., Gehlert, S., Masi, C., & Olopade, F. (2005). Mammary cancer and social interactions: Identifying multiple environments that regulate gene expression throughout the life span. Journals of Gerontology; 60B(Spec. no. 1), 32–41.

McConkie-Rosell, A., & Spiridigliozzi, G. A. (2004). “Family matters”: A conceptual framework for genetic testing in children. Journal of Genetic Counseling, 13(1), 9–29.

McCoyd, J. (2008). “I’m not a saint”: Burden assessment as an unrecognized factor in prenatal decision making. Qualitative Health Research, 18, 1489–1500.

McCoyd, J. (2010). Authoritative knowledge, the technological imperative and women’s responses to prenatal diagnostic technologies. Culture, Medicine, and Psychiatry, 34, 590–614.

McDaniel, S. H., Rolland, J. S., Feetham, S. K., & Miller, S. M. (2006). “It runs in the family”: Family systems concepts and genetically linked disorders. In S. M. Miller, S. H. McDaniel, J. S. Rolland, & S. L. Feetham

JWBT514_ch21.indd 587JWBT514_ch21.indd 587 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

588 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

(Eds.), Individuals, families, and the new era of genetics: Biopsychosocial perspectives (pp. 118–138). New York, NY: Norton.

McGoldrick, M., Gerson, R., & Shellenberger, S. (1999). Genograms: Assessment and intervention. New York, NY: Norton.

McKusick, V. A. (1973). Genetic studies in American inbred populations with particular reference to the Old Order Amish. Israel Journal of Medical Science, 9(9), 1276–1284.

Meiser, B., & Halliday, J. L. (2002). What is the impact of genetic counseling in women at increased risk of developing hereditary breast cancer? A meta-analytic review. Social Science & Medicine, 54(10), 1463– 1470.

Meiser, B., Irle, J., Lobb, E., & Balrow-Stewart, K. (2008). Assessment of the process and content of genetic counseling: A critical review of empirical studies. Journal of Genetic Counseling, 17(5), 434–451.

Murphy, E. J., Wickramarante, P., & Weissman, M. M. (2009). Racial and ethnic differences in willingness to participate in psychiatric genetic research. Psychiatric Genetics, 19(4), 186–194.

Nanda, R., Schumm, L. P., Cummings, S., Fackenthal, J. D., Sveen, L., Ademuyiwa, F., . . . Olopade, O. I. (2005). Genetic testing in an ethnically diverse cohort of high- risk women: A comparative analysis of BRCA1 and BRCA2 mutations in American families of European and African ancestry. JAMA, 294(15), 1925–1933.

National Coalition of Health Professional Education in Genetics. (2010). The Genetic Nondiscrimination Act (GINA). Retrieved from www.nchpeg.org/index .php?option=com_content&view=article&id=97& Itemid=120

Nielson-Bohlman, L., Panzer, A. M., & Kindig, D. A. (Eds.). (2010). Health literacy: A prescription to end confusion. Washington, DC: National Academies Press.

Norem, J. K., & Cantor, N. (1986). Anticipatory and post hoc cushioning strategies: Optimism and defensive pessimism in “risky” situations. Cognitive Therapy and Research, 10, 347–362.

National Society of Genetic Counselors. (1995). Prenatal and childhood testing for adult-onset disorders [Position statement]. Retrieved from www.nsgc.org /Advocacy/PositionStatements/tabid/107/Default.aspx #PrenatalChildTestingAdultOnset

Offi t, K., Groeger, E., Turner, S., Wadsworth, B., & Weiser, M. A. (2004). The “duty to warn” a patient’s family members about hereditary disease risk. JAMA, 292(12), 1469–1473.

Padgett, D. K. (2008). Qualitative methods in social work research (2nd ed.). Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.

Patenaude, A. (2004). Genetic testing for cancer: Psychological approaches for helping patients and families. Washington, DC: American Psychological Association Press.

Pollin, T. I., Damcott, C. M., Haiqing, S., Ott, S. H., Shelton, J., Horenstein, R. B., . . . Shuldiner, A. R. (2008). A null mutation in human APOC3 confers a favorable plasma lipid profi le and apparent cardioprotection. Science, 322(5908), 1702–1705.

Rapp, R. (1999). Testing women, testing the fetus: The social impact of amniocentesis in America. New York, NY: Routledge.

Ratzen, S. C., & Parker, R. M. (2000). Introduction. In Z. Selden, M. Zorn, S. Ratzan, & R. Parker (Eds.), National medicine current bibliographies in medicine: Health literacy (pp. v–vi). Bethesda, MD: National Institutes of Health, U.S. Department of Health and Human Services.

Resnik, D. B. (2003). Genetic testing and primary care: A new ethic for a new setting. New Genetics and Society, 22(3), 245–256.

Risch, N., Herrell, R., Lehner, T., Liang, K., Eaves, L. Hoh, J., . . . Merikangas, K. R. (2009). Interaction between the serotonin transporter gene (5-HTTLPR), stressful life events, and risk of depression: A meta- analysis. JAMA, 301(23), 2462–2471.

Rolland, J. S. (2006). Living with anticipatory loss in the new era of genetics: A life cycle perspective. In S. M. Miller, S. H. McDaniel, J. S. Rolland, & S. L. Feetham (Eds.), Individuals, families, and the new era of genetics: Biopsychosocial perspectives (pp. 139– 172). New York, NY: Norton.

Rose, R. J., & Kaprio, J. (2008). Genes, environments, and adolescent substance use: retrospect and prospect from the FinnTwin studies. Acta Psychologica Sinica, 40(10), 1017–1026.

Ross, L. F., & Fost, N. (2006). Ethical issues in pediatric genetics. In S. M. Miller, S. H. McDaniel, J. S. Rolland, & S. L. Feetham (Eds.), Individuals, families, and the new era of genetics: Biopsychosocial perspectives (pp. 486–505). New York, NY: Norton.

Sankar, P. (2009). Genetics research and race: Whither bioethics? In V. Ravitsky, A. Fiester, & A. L. Caplan (Eds.), The Penn Center guide to bioethics (pp. 391– 402). New York, NY: Springer.

Satel, S. (2002, May 5). I am a racially profi ling doctor. New York Times.

Schild, S. (1966). The challenging opportunity for social workers in genetics. Social Work, 11, 22–28.

Schild, S., & Black, R. B. (1984). Social work and genetics: A guide for practice. New York, NY: Haworth Press.

Schlich-Bakker, K. J., ten Kroode, H. F. J., & Ausems, M. G. (2006). A literature review of the psychological impact of genetic testing on breast cancer patients. Patient Education and Counseling, 62, 13–20.

Schultz, A. (1966). The impact of genetic disorders. Social Work, 11, 29–34.

Schwartz, L. R. (2001). Psychosocial interventions for women at increased risk for breast cancer. In A. Baum & B. L. Anderson (Eds.), Psychosocial interventions for cancer (vol. 19, pp. 287–304). Washington, DC: American Psychological Association.

JWBT514_ch21.indd 588JWBT514_ch21.indd 588 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Social Work and Genetics 589

Shih, R. A., Belmonte, P. L., & Zandi, P. (2004). A review of the evidence from family, twin and adoption studies for a genetic contribution to adult psychiatric disorders. International Review of Psychiatry, 16(4), 260–283.

Sivell, S., Elwyn, G., Gaff, C. L., Clarke, A., Iredale, R., Shaw, C., . . . Edwards, A. (2008). How risk is perceived, constructed and interpreted by clients in clinical genetics, and the effects on decision making: Systematic review. Journal of Genetic Counseling, 17(1), 30–63.

Skloot, R. (2010). The immortal life of Henrietta Lacks. New York, NY: Crown.

Slovic, P., Finucane, M. L., Peters, E., & MacGregor, D. G. (2004). Risk as analysis and risk as feelings: Some thoughts about affect, reason, risk, and rationality. Risk Analysis, 24(2), 311–322.

Smets, E., van Zwieten, M., & Michie, S. (2007). Comparing genetic counseling with non-genetic health care interactions: Two of a kind? Patient Education & Counseling, 68(3), 225–234.

Smith, J. A., Dancyger, C., Wallace, M., & Michie, S. (2010). the development of a methodology for examining the process of family communication of genetic test results. Journal of Genetic Counseling. doi: 10.1007/s10897-010-9317-x.

Sobel, S., & Cowan, C. B. (2003). Ambiguous loss and disenfranchised grief: The impact of DNA predictive genetic testing on the family as a system. Family Process, 42, 47–57.

Struewing, J. P., Lerman, C., Kase, R. G., Giambarresi, T. R., & Tucker, M. A. (1995). Anticipated uptake and impact of genetic testing in hereditary breast and ovarian cancer families. Cancer Epidemiology, Biomarkers & Prevention, 4(2), 169–173.

Taylor-Brown, S., & Johnson, A. M. (1998). Social work’s role in genetic services. Washington, DC: National Association of Social Workers Press.

U.S. General Accountability Offi ce. (2010, July 22). Direct-to-consumer genetic tests: Misleading test results are further complicated by deceptive marketing and other questionable practices. Subcommittee on Oversight and Investigations, Committee on Energy and Commerce.

U.S. Preventive Services Task Force. (2009). Screening for phenylketonuria: Reaffi rmation recommendation statement. American Family Physician, 80(12).

Waalen, J. & Beutler, E. (2009). Genetic screening for low-penetrance variants in protein-coding genes. Annual Review Genomics and Human Genetics, 10, 431–450.

Watson, M. S., Cutting, G. R., Desnick, R. J., Driscoll, D. A., Klinger, K., Mennuti, M., . . . Grody, W. W. (2004). Cystic fi brosis population carrier screening: 2004 Revision of American College of Medical Genetics mutation panel. Genetic Medicine, 6(5), 387–391.

Weaver, I. C. G., Cervoni, N., Champagne, F. A., D’Alessio, A. C., Sharma, S., Seckl, J. R., . . . Meaney, M. J. (2004). Epigenetic programming by maternal behavior. Nature Neuroscience, 7, 847–854.

Weiss, J., Black, P. N., Weissman, N., Oktay, J., Rodriguez, G., Johnson, A. M., & Whittemore, V. H. (2003). NASW standards for integrating genetics into social work practice. Washington, DC: NASW Press.

Wermter, A., Laucht, M., Schimmelmann, B. G., Banaschweski, T., Sonuga-Barke, E. J. S., Rietschel, M., & Becker, K. (2010). From nature to nurture, to gene x environment interaction in mental disorders. European Child & Adolescent Psychiatry, 19(3), 199–210.

Werner-Lin, A. (2007). Danger zones: Risk perceptions of young women from families with hereditary breast and ovarian cancer. Family Process, 46, 335–349.

Werner-Lin, A. (2008). Beating the biological clock: The compressed family life cycle of young women with BRCA mutations. Journal of Health Social Work, 47(4), 416–437.

Werner-Lin, A., & Gardner, D. S. (2009). Family illness narratives of inherited cancer risk: Continuity and transformation. Families, Systems and Health, 27(3), 201–212.

Wilfond, B., & Ross, L. F. (2009). From genetics to genomics: Ethics, policy, and parental decision- making. Journal of Pediatric Psychology, 34(6), 639–647

Wolf, L. E., Bouley, T. A., & McCulloch, C. E. (2010). Genetic research with stored biological materials. IRB: Ethics and Human Research, 32(2), 7–18.

Yaniv, I., Benador, D., & Sagi, M. (2004). On not wanting to know and not wanting to inform others: choices regarding predictive genetic testing. Risk Decision and Policy, 9, 317–336.

JWBT514_ch21.indd 589JWBT514_ch21.indd 589 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

590

22

Pain Management and Palliative Care

TERRY ALTILIO, SHIRLEY OTIS-GREEN, SUSAN HEDLUND, AND IRIS COHEN FINEBERG

The unique values that inform the purpose and perspective of social work practice are essen- tial to the provision of quality palliative care and comprehensive pain management. Social workers historically have seen the alleviation of suffering as part of their mission, and this is refl ected in a code of ethics that supports service, social justice, respect for the dignity and worth of the person, a belief in the cen- tral importance of human relationships, integ- rity, and competence (National Association of Social Workers [NASW], 1999). These ideals are woven through the fi elds of palliative care and pain management, yet social work has not been fully engaged in these areas of practice. In addition to shared values however, knowl- edge and expertise is essential if social work is to strengthen its voice in these practice arenas. In this chapter, we discuss the interface of val- ues and knowledge and detail the richness of opportunity presented to social workers in the fi elds of palliative care and comprehensive pain management.

Chapter Objectives • Defi ne palliative care, including domains

and guidelines established by the National Consensus Project for Quality Palliative Care and the preferred practices endorsed by the National Quality Forum.

• Defi ne and distinguish pain and symptom management as both a focus of palliative care as well as an independent focus of so- cial work practice.

• Confi rm the unique opportunity and histori- cal framework of palliative care that invites

social work participation and leadership in this area of practice, and explore the obsta- cles to realizing the opportunity.

• Describe aspects of a biopsychosocial- spiritual assessment that inform a plan of care in palliative care and pain management.

• Defi ne interventions, and illustrate their usefulness through patient narratives.

• Discuss ethical principles that relate to palliative care and the management of pain.

• Explore various models of team collabora- tion, sources of professional gratifi cation and work-related stress, and opportunities for enhancing self-care.

PALLIATIVE CARE AND PAIN MANAGEMENT: AN OVERVIEW

The chapter fi rst focuses on palliative care and its comprehensive approach to the care of patients with life-threatening illness. Although pain and symptom management are included as a core pal- liative care skill, a separate section discusses pain management as an independent subspecialty. Underlying both practice areas is a multidimen- sional focus encompassing biological, emotional, cognitive, socioeconomic, cultural, and spiritual aspects of the unique experience of patients and families. It is at this critical, yet nuanced, nexus that social work expertise is essential.

Palliative Care

According to the American Heritage Dic- tionary, palliate means “to alleviate without

JWBT514_ch22.indd 590JWBT514_ch22.indd 590 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Pain Management and Palliative Care 591

cure.” The World Health Organization (WHO, n.d.) has adapted this basic defi nition to in- clude that palliative care improves the quality of life of patients and families who are fac- ing life-threatening illness through preven- tion and relief of suffering. Quality-of-life improvement might be achieved through the assessment and treatment of pain and other physical, psychosocial, and spiritual distress. Palliative care is important throughout the course of illness and may be integrated with disease-modifying therapies that are intended to prolong life. For example, palliative care may be incorporated with chemotherapy and radiation therapy in an oncology setting. In chronic renal disease, it may be provided along with dialysis. Interventions are adapted to the changing course of illnesses, such as when disease-modifying therapies lose their benefi t or appropriateness. When this oc- curs, palliative care may become the primary focus of intervention. Palliative interventions affi rm life and treat dying as a natural pro- cess. Clinicians generally work together as a team to assist patients and families, including children, to live as actively as possible with enhanced quality of life. Social workers help patients and members of their social support networks to cope during illness and their own bereavement. Palliative care interventions may include referral to a hospice program and a team-based program of care, support, and bereavement services for persons whose life expectancy is six months or fewer.

Pain and symptom management are essen- tial components of palliative care, because uncontrolled pain and symptoms not only shape the lived experience of the patient, family, and staff but also infl uence bereave- ment and the legacy of the illness as it be- comes integrated into the family narrative. Families describe this dynamic through com- ments such as “My mother suffered terrible pain; I cannot bear to think that my husband will suffer in the same way.” The desire to create a family legacy of comfort and respect is one of the factors that drives the shared professional commitment to symptom as- sessment and intervention.

Pain Management

Although pain and symptom management are essential foci of palliative care, pain manage- ment as a specialty extends beyond life-limiting illness to chronic conditions such as migraine headaches, fi bromyalgia, arthritis, and back pain. In 2006, the National Center for Health Statis- tics reported that more than 26% of Americans age 20 years and older had a pain problem dur- ing the last month that lasted for more than 24 hours. Thirty percent of adults age 45 to 64 years and 21% of persons age 65 years and older re- ported pain that lasted more than 24 hours. An estimated 9% of the U.S. adult population suf- fers from moderate to severe pain at any point in time (Roper Starch Worldwide, 1999). Although not necessarily life limiting, these conditions can force major life adaptation. As in palliative care, assessment and treatment ideally is based on a biopsychosocial-spiritual model. As a generic concept, pain management refers to both chronic and acute pain. The populations highlighted in this chapter include people who experience pain as a consequence of a life-limiting illness and those who are affected by chronic pain.

The International Association for the Study of Pain (2010) defi nes pain as

an unpleasant sensory and emotional experi- ence associated with actual or potential tis- sue damage, or described in terms of such damage. Although it is unquestionably a sensation in part or parts of the body, it is always unpleasant and, therefore, an emo- tional experience. (www.iasp-pain.org/AM /Template.cfm?Section=Pain_Defi %20.isplay .cfm&ContentID=1728#Pain)

It is clear from this defi nition that pain in- volves the physical and emotional self at a very basic level.

Acute pain differs from chronic pain in that it has a clear onset, follows an injury, and often but not always is accompanied by objective physi- cal signs of autonomic nervous system activity, such as increased heart rate. It is self-limited, and its duration roughly parallels the healing of the injury. An example might be a fractured toe or a toothache. Chronic pain is largely defi ned

JWBT514_ch22.indd 591JWBT514_ch22.indd 591 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

592 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

temporally, and although it may begin as acute, it continues beyond the normal period of heal- ing. Because pain may not be associated with observable tissue injury or sympathetic nervous system arousal, chronic pain may not be visible to others. This absence of objective signs often confounds inexperienced clinicians, who may conclude that patients’ pain is not real and chal- lenge their credibility (American Pain Society, 2003). This can be distressing for patients who may feel diminished by the experience.

A key characteristic of chronic pain from the patient’s perspective is that it becomes like any other chronic illness. That is, as opposed to acute pain, the focus of care often shifts from searching for a cause and cure to manag- ing the pain itself. Comprehensive assessment and interventions extend beyond the physical to psychological, social, cultural, and spiritual aspects of the patient’s experience, compa- rable to the clinical assessment appropriate to palliative care patients and their families. Col- laborative goals might include minimizing suf- fering and the negative impact of chronic pain and enhancing functioning and quality of life.

Challenges and Opportunities

Principles and values underlying palliative care and pain treatment have much in common with those of social work. In both, comprehensive quality assessment is individualized, patient and family centered, and multidimensional and includes biological, social, emotional, spiritual, and environmental factors that interact and con- tribute to an understanding of the patient and family experience. Underlying values that inform this process are a respect for the central impor- tance of human relationships and an affi rmation of the person-in-environment paradigm in all of its manifestations (Roy, 1981). Consideration of patient and family values, needs, beliefs, and goals is implicit in the principle of respect for the dignity and worth of the person. Historically, health social workers have championed the idea that context, community, and family are critical components of the illness experience of patients. Ida M. Cannon, who led the fi rst social work de- partment at Massachusetts General Hospital (see

Chapter 1 in this book), saw the task of helping physicians understand the impact of the com- munity and social context as essential to social work. This is a unique perspective that is a core element of both palliative care and pain manage- ment. The impact and potential of this role are enhanced by the plethora of interventions, ethical concerns, and policy issues that invite the par- ticipation of compassionate and competent social work clinicians to these two specialty areas of practice (Roff, 2001).

Rich opportunities exist concurrently with signifi cant challenges for health social work- ers in palliative care and pain management. Although there are likely a myriad reasons for social work’s lack of leadership in the two fi elds, lack of adequate training is perhaps the most salient. Increasing numbers of so- cial workers are seeking mentorship in pal- liative and end-of-life care, yet many see pain and symptom management as outside their scope of practice. Very few social workers are exposed to pain management as a poten- tial specialty practice. Schools of social work make diffi cult, complex decisions about cur- riculum content, and even though death is a universal experience, the topic typically is taught only as an elective course. Pain has been viewed largely as a physical problem, and the biopsychosocial-spiritual focus has come primarily from the fi elds of psychiatry and psychology. Few social workers practice in pain management programs in which their person-in-environment and strengths perspec- tive can be well utilized. Many social work- ers in health-care settings struggle with the impact of shortened stays, competing priori- ties, and increasing caseloads. Counseling and pain management interventions may not seem sustainable in understaffed, managed care en- vironments. (See Chapter 5 in this book for an explanation of managed care.) Historically, social workers have been less accountable for providing evidence-based interventions than their colleagues in nursing and medicine.

At the same time that the number of pal- liative care programs is increasing, these programs are expanding into settings such as extended-care facilities and home care. The

JWBT514_ch22.indd 592JWBT514_ch22.indd 592 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Pain Management and Palliative Care 593

Center to Advance Palliative Care (2008) has defi ned doctors, nurses, and social workers as team members. In 2009, the NASW published Standards for Social Work Practice in Pal- liative and End-of-Life Care (NASW, 2009b), which included 12 standards that cover eth- ics and values, knowledge, assessment, inter- vention and treatment planning, attitude and self-awareness, empowerment and advocacy, documentation, interdisciplinary teamwork, cultural competence, continuing education and leadership, supervision, and training. NASW developed two Internet courses to further social workers’ continuing education: Understand- ing End-of-Life Care and Social Work’s Role and Achieving Cultural Competence in Reduc- ing Health Disparities in End-of-Life Care. In 2008, the NASW and the National Hospice and Palliative Care Organization collaborated to develop a social work credential in hospice and palliative care (NASW, 2009a). Concur- rently, accreditation agencies such as the Joint Commission (2010) include pain, palliative, and end-of-life care in their standards, creat- ing opportunities for skilled social workers to participate in and lead institutional initiatives with the goal of both expanding their scope of service and improving patient care.

Social workers who work in any venue— including hospitals, public agencies, hospices, methadone maintenance programs, prisons, long-term care facilities, private practices, and government programs—have the oppor- tunity to enhance the care of patients and the adaptation of patients and families affected by chronic or life-limiting illness. This broad range of practice settings creates a potential for quality care to be transferred from for- mal health-care institutions to the community. Although these settings may impose specifi c challenges, generic competencies and values underlie the social work approach. Understand- ing how community, culture, and institutional and family dynamics impact palliative care is- sues or pain experiences informs and guides intervention. For example, in a rural commu- nity in which pain often accompanies physi- cal labor and thus is expected, it is important to recognize that a new pain may be ignored

or minimized until it interferes with work. In the prison population, tolerating pain may be a sign of strength and a defense against vul- nerability. Expression of need or a request for care, even in cases of life-limiting illness, may be viewed by others as a sign of weakness. In- mates might avoid any medication that would impact their alertness and awareness of their surroundings. In a prison environment, coping skills that utilize internal processes such as re- laxation, imagery, and focused breathing have the potential to restore some control and en- hance internal comfort, thus minimizing suf- fering (Enders, 2004; Linder & Enders, 2011).

HISTORICAL PERSPECTIVE

Principles and behaviors that inform the work of palliative care and the treatment of pain have their roots in human antiquity and serve a vital social function. A historic tension ex- ists between society’s desire to fl ee from the ill, injured, or dead and our recognition that the vulnerable need assistance in order to sur- vive. The need to fl ee is based on the fear that others’ misfortune may befall us. At the same time, the desire to help the vulnerable and suf- fering is derived from an empathic understand- ing that we potentially need others for our own optimal survival. Caring for those who suffer reinforces important social bonds and the ca- pacity to be empathic. Each society throughout history has evolved special ways of caring for its suffering, dying, and bereaved members. For example, shamans or healers proscribed behavior and offered guidance in times of cri- sis. Those who “know what to do” offer com- fort, and such healers might be considered our earliest social work ancestors as they provided what might be thought of as early psychoedu- cational and spiritual support and expertise.

Until recently, limited interventions were available to infl uence the course of illness, so the alleviation of pain and suffering frequently was the most one could hope for. Palliative care was often the only means of medical in- tervention for those with serious illness. These earliest healers typically offered integrated

JWBT514_ch22.indd 593JWBT514_ch22.indd 593 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

594 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

spiritual, herbal, and behavioral interventions to normalize concerns and support the dying and their families. Compassionate support during illness or injury was the imperative, al- though the fi nal outcome of illness or injury was understood to be outside of the healer’s control. From the origin of human life until the development of widespread improvements in sanitation and public health and the advent of anesthesia, antibiotics, and other medical breakthroughs, people typically died relatively quickly after the onset of serious illness (Lynn, Schuster, & Kabcenell, 2000).

The origin of the words hospice and hospi- tal date back to the fourth century. During the Middle Ages, hospices were established at key crossroads on the ways to religious shrines. These shelters helped pilgrims, many of whom were traveling to shrines in search of cures and many of whom died while on their pilgrimage. Returning crusaders, often ill or wounded, also died at these hospices, strengthening the asso- ciation of hospices as places for the dying and destitute (Koppelman, 2003).

In addition to linguistic history, philosophi- cal perspectives infused the evolution of med- icine and the care of the sick. For example, the seventeenth-century lawyer and mathema- tician René Descartes popularized the dualis- tic-mechanistic model, which suggested that the body belonged to the realm of science and the spirit to the realm of religion (Koppelman, 2003). This set the stage for the “medicaliz- ing” of dying, and by the mid-20th century, al- most 80% of people in the United States died in a hospital or nursing home (Koppelman, 2003). This changing death trajectory coin- cided with the widespread use of antibiotics. The discovery of penicillin and other medical advances, such as improvements in anesthe- sia that made more daring surgeries possible, the medical fi eld began to focus on expand- ing possibilities for cure. Attention to the tra- ditional concerns of palliative care and pain management somewhat paradoxically became less important to the providers of mainstream medicine.

Prior to this time, pain medications typi- cally had been herbal in nature, with reliance

on alcohol and morphine as the most potent remedies for serious discomfort. In the mid- 19th century, laudanum was widely available and became immensely popular. Easy access to these remedies allowed individuals to self- medicate, and addiction became a societal evil associated with stigma. Legislative regulations subsequently were enacted to protect the pub- lic. This fear of addiction to pain medications and the stigma associated with addiction and opioid medication use continues to infl uence professional behavior, patient and family per- ceptions of illness and its treatment, and public policy.

In London in the 1960s, Cicely Saunders, a physician previously trained as a nurse and social worker, developed the fi rst modern hos- pice (Saunders, 1996). She pioneered the con- cept of “total pain,” which recognized pain as a social, psychological, spiritual, and physical experience that required intervention provided by an interdisciplinary care team. She revolu- tionized the treatment of pain by scheduling around-the-clock use of opioids with the goal of managing persistent pain and minimiz- ing its exacerbation. She was instrumental in encouraging patients to self-assess pain and incorporated the family into care (Forman, 1998; Saunders, 2001). In 1969, Elisabeth Kübler-Ross’s book On Death and Dying set the stage in the United States for a revolu- tion in the provision of end-of-life care, the development of palliative care as a medical specialty, and the renewal of interest in more sophisticated pain and symptom management strategies. More recently, pioneers like phy- sician Jimmie Holland (Holland et al., 2010) have championed the development of psycho- oncology as a unique specialization that seeks to integrate the biopsychosocial-spiritual fac- tors of illness. This model is exemplifi ed by the decision of the National Comprehensive Cancer Network (Jacobsen, 2007) to encour- age the use of “distress thermometers” as standardized screening tools to measure phys- ical pain as well as psychological suffering in cancer patients.

Social workers often have failed to add their expertise to these developing specialties,

JWBT514_ch22.indd 594JWBT514_ch22.indd 594 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Pain Management and Palliative Care 595

leaving a vacuum that is being fi lled by psy- chologists, chaplains, nurses, and physicians sensitive to psychosocial issues. Although there have been recent efforts to highlight the contributions of social workers in these fi elds (Altilio & Otis-Green, 2011), there remains a need for social work leadership in palliative care and pain management across all aspects of care: policy, research, education, and clini- cal practice.

NATIONAL CONSENSUS PROJECT ON PALLIATIVE CARE

Palliative care programs are increasing in num- ber at a rapid pace. In addition to the growing population of aging persons living with debili- tating and life-limiting illnesses, reports such as the Institute of Medicine’s Approaching Death, When Children Die (2003) and Cross- ing the Quality Chasm (2001) have called for improving access to palliative care during all stages of illness along the continuum of care. In 2004, the National Consensus Project for Quality Palliative Care (NCP) was estab- lished to formulate clinical practice guidelines to promote consistent and high-quality care and guide the development of palliative care services. The project’s participants included professionals, health-care organizations, pol- icy- and standard-setting bodies, consumers, and payers.

The consensus document Clinical Practice Guidelines for Quality Palliative Care that was originally published in 2004 by the NCP describes palliative care as consisting of inter- ventions that may accompany life-prolonging treatments and be practiced at both the gen- eralist and specialist levels. The implication that primary health-care providers integrate basic palliative care invites all health-care providers, including social workers, to learn core skills. The integration of palliative care into generalist practice has great potential to impact care for patients and families in vari- ous settings through the course of illness to the end of life.

In 2004, the NCP described the defi nition, scope, and goal of palliative care in this way:

The goal of palliative care is to prevent and relieve suffering and to support the best pos- sible quality of life for patients and their families, regardless of the stage of the dis- ease or the need for other therapies. Pallia- tive care is both a philosophy of care and an organized, highly structured system for de- livering care. Palliative care expands tradi- tional disease-model medical treatments to include the goals of enhancing quality of life for patient and family, optimizing function, helping with decision making, and provid- ing opportunities for personal growth. As such, it can be delivered concurrently with life-prolonging care or as the main focus of care. Palliative care is operationalized through effective management of pain and other distressing symptoms, while incorpo- rating psychosocial and spiritual care with consideration of patient/family needs, pref- erences, values, beliefs, and culture. Evalua- tion and treatment should be comprehensive and patient-centered with a focus on the cen- tral role of the family unit in decision mak- ing. Palliative care affi rms life by supporting the patient and family’s goals for the future, including their hopes for cure or life-pro- longation, as well as their hopes for peace and dignity throughout the course of illness, the dying process, and death. Palliative care aims to guide and assist the patient and fam- ily in making decisions that enable them to work toward their goals during whatever time they have remaining. Comprehensive palliative care services often require the ex- pertise of various providers to adequately as- sess and treat the complex needs of seriously ill patients and their families . . . (2004, p. 6)

In 2009, this defi nition was reconfi rmed, as were the eight domains of care. The clini- cal practice guidelines were expanded and are delineated in Box 22.1. The 2009 consensus document added justifi cations, supporting and clarifying statements, references, case ex- amples, and suggested criteria for assessing outcomes, creating a rich and comprehensive tool for guiding generalist or specialist pallia- tive care.

ch22.indd 595ch22.indd 595 9/22/11 1:08 AM9/22/11 1:08 AM

596 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Box 22.1 NCP for Quality Palliative Care Domains and Guidelines

Domain 1: Structure and Processes of Care

Guideline 1.1. The timely plan of care is based on a comprehensive interdisciplinary assessment of the patient and family.

Guideline 1.2. The care plan is based on the identifi ed and expressed preferences, values, goals, and needs of patient and family, and is developed with professional guidance and support for decision making.

Guideline 1.3. An interdisciplinary team provides services to the patient and family consistent with the care plan. In addition to nursing, medicine, and social work, other therapeutic disciplines with importance in the assessment of patients and families include physical therapists, occupational therapists, speech and language pathologists, nutritionists, psychologists, chaplains, and nursing assistants. For pediatrics, this should include child life specialists. Complementary and alternative therapies may be included.

Guideline 1.4. The use of appropriately trained and supervised volunteers on the team is strongly encouraged.

Guideline 1.5. Support for education and training is available to the interdisciplinary team.

Guideline 1.6. In its commitment to quality assessment and performance improvement, the palliative care program develops, implements, and maintains an ongoing data-driven process that refl ects the complexity of the organization and focuses on palliative care outcomes.

Guideline 1.7. The palliative care program recognizes the emotional impact on the palliative care team of providing care to patients with life-threatening illnesses and their families.

Guideline 1.8. Palliative care programs should have a relationship with one or more hospices and other community resources in order to ensure continuity of the highest-quality palliative care across the illness trajectory.

Guideline 1.9. The physical environment in which care is provided should meet the preferences, needs, and circumstances of the patient and family to the extent possible.

Domain 2: Physical Aspects of Care

Guideline 2.1. Pain, other symptoms, and side effects are managed based upon the best available evidence, with attention to disease-specifi c pain and symptoms.

Domain 3: Psychological and Psychiatric Aspects of Care

Guideline 3.1. Psychological status is assessed and managed based upon the best available evidence, which is skillfully and systematically applied. When necessary, psychiatric issues are addressed and treated.

Guideline 3.2. A grief and bereavement program is available to patients and families, based upon the assessed need for services.

Domain 4: Social Aspects of Care

Guideline 4.1. Comprehensive interdisciplinary assessment identifi es the social needs of patients and their families, and a care plan is developed to respond to these needs as effectively as possible.

Domain 5: Spiritual, Religious, and Existential Aspects of Care

Guideline 5.1. Spiritual and existential dimensions are assessed and responded to based upon the best available evidence, which is skillfully and systematically applied.

Domain 6: Cultural Aspects of Care

Guideline 6.1. The palliative care program assesses and attempts to meet the needs of the patient, family, and community in a culturally sensitive manner.

Domain 7: Care of the Imminently Dying Patient

Guideline 7.1. Signs and symptoms of impending death are recognized and communicated in developmentally appropriate language for children and patients with cognitive disabilities, with respect for family preferences. Care appropriate for this phase of illness is provided to patient and family.

JWBT514_ch22.indd 596JWBT514_ch22.indd 596 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Pain Management and Palliative Care 597

Guideline 7.2. Postdeath care is delivered in a respectful manner. Cultural and religious practices peculiar to the postdeath period are assessed and documented. The body is cared for in a manner that is congruent with these practices, in accordance with both organizational practice and local law.

Guideline 7.3. A postdeath bereavement plan is activated. An interdisciplinary team member is assigned to the family in the postdeath period, to help with religious practices, funeral arrangements, and burial planning.

Domain 8: Ethical and Legal Aspects of Care

Guideline 8.1. The patient’s goals, preferences, and choices are respected

within the limits of applicable state and federal law, with current accepted standards of medical care, and form the basis for the plan of care.

Guideline 8.2. The palliative care program is aware of and addresses the complex ethical issues arising in the care of persons with life-threatening debilitating illness.

Guideline 8.3. The palliative care program is knowledgeable about legal and regulatory aspects of palliative care.

Source: Clinical Practice Guidelines for Quality Palliative Care, 2nd ed., by National Consensus Project for Quality Palliative Care, 2009, www .nationalconsensusproject.org

In 2006, the National Quality Forum (NQF) released A National Framework and Preferred Practices for Palliative and Hospice Care Quality. This document refl ects the NQF’s de- cision to accept and adopt the Clinical Prac- tice Guidelines for Quality Palliative Care and provides 38 preferred practices on which mea- sures for palliative care are to be developed. The NQF is recognized as the national leader in health-care quality improvement, represent- ing a broad array of practice areas and topics. Consequently, the adoption of these guidelines both recognizes and legitimizes palliative care (NCP, 2009; NQF, 2006).

Although the NCP guidelines delineate shared aspects of practice responsibility for all disciplines, some areas seem to fall natu- rally into the domains of specifi c disciplines. For example, social aspects of care draw on the social work principle that highlights the importance of the person and their environ- ment (Altilio, Otis-Green, & Dahlin, 2008). The domains, guidelines, and preferred prac- tices are invitations for social workers to as- sert and enhance their expertise as essential to palliative care and refl ect social work’s respect for the individual experiences of patients and families. The next section discusses aspects of social work assessment to assist in elucidating the synergy of social work and palliative care.

BIOPSYCHOSOCIAL- SPIRITUAL ASSESSMENT

Comprehensive and ongoing biopsychosocial- spiritual assessment is a key function of social work in health-care settings and is the basis of effective treatment planning. As in any clinical situation, the scope of the assessment is modi- fi ed according to context and immediate needs and goals. The assessment of an individual with chronic pain or a life-limiting illness in- volves gathering in-depth information about the physiological aspects of the symptoms and illness, addresses treatment, and complements competent medical management. A family his- tory might include previous experiences with pain and illness, remote and immediate loss experiences, and pain- and illness-related be- haviors as well as information about family roles, structure, functioning, communication and confl icts, social supports and resources, and cultural and spiritual values and networks.

Unique family factors and illness variables impact family function and response. Did the illness evolve over time or appear suddenly? Do the patient and family have a history with this specifi c disease or symptom? What is the role of the patient in the family? Is the family a cohesive unit? How adaptable and fl exible are family members? Is extended family or social

JWBT514_ch22.indd 597JWBT514_ch22.indd 597 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

598 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

network support available? What life cycle is- sues are present? Is the family experiencing stressors, such as fi nancial worries, preexist- ing confl icts, or illness? What might interfere with the family’s ability to adapt, support each other, or use community resources?

Numerous needs and challenges arise when pain or life-limiting illness arises in the life of a family. Such needs and challenges may in- clude: understanding the disease, its treatment, and potential prognosis; developing strategies to manage the impact of pain or illness; coping with and learning the language of professional caregivers and institutions; maintaining stabil- ity while restructuring to meet the changing individual needs of patient and family mem- bers; dealing with family responses as well as the individual emotions, grief, and adaptation of specifi c family members; planning for the continuation of family life through periods of change and uncertainty and possible death; and fi nding meaning as a family and as individuals.

People with chronic pain or chronic pro- gressive diseases and the members of social support networks experience grief as they come to terms with the myriad losses associ- ated with pain and illness. Many people living with chronic pain face similar loss experiences that are not related to life-limiting illness but similarly evoke grief and demand multiple levels of change and adaptation (MacDonald, 2000).

Illness-related behaviors and responses arise in the context of specifi c family, cul- tural, social, health care, and political systems that may infl uence the suffering component of the experience. Suffering, as defi ned by Webster’s Dictionary, is “to submit to or be forced to endure, to tolerate as inevitable, to sustain loss or damage, to endure death, pain or distress.” Suffering is a subjective experi- ence viewed through the lens of an individu- al’s life, values, perspectives, and priorities and is closely tied to a search for meaning. It may include pain but can exist in the absence of physical symptoms (Cassell, 1991). In the absence of meaning and a reframed vision of hope that extends beyond cure of a condi- tion, suffering may continue despite excellent

management of pain and treatment of disease (Barkwell, 1991). Viktor Frankl, in his book Man’s Search for Meaning (1984), develops “Logotherapy,” a therapeutic concept based in the belief that fi nding meaning allows one to transcend loss and suffering. The construct is useful when working with people whose lives have been derailed by life-limiting illness or chronic pain. Clinicians can create a support- ive space within which patients can gently and respectfully explore alternative sources of meaning and perhaps see the illness as an im- petus for these discoveries (Lethborg, Aranda, Bloch, & Kissane, 2006; Otis-Green, Sher- man, Perez, & Baird, 2002). Systematic psy- chosocial pain assessment (Otis-Green, 2006) can be a useful tool for identifying the unique impact of the multidimensional experience of pain on a patient and their families. Specialized spiritual assessment tools also are available for exploring patients’ spiritual and cultural cop- ing strategies and gathering insights into how they interpret their pain or illness experiences (Puchalski et al., 2009).

People with chronic illness may experience sadness and some symptoms of depression and anxiety. Symptoms may interfere with func- tion and quality of life and be pervasive and persistent. Skilled assessment and treatment, including pharmacology and counseling, are essential to enhancing the quality of life of patients (Hultman, Reder, & Dahlin, 2008). Likewise, caregivers and other family mem- bers may become overwhelmed and exhausted over time and be at risk for physical and psy- chological effects (Schulz & Beach, 1999). In the palliative care model, the unit of care is the patient and those identifi ed as family. Consequently, clinicians attend to the needs of caregivers and family as a necessary part of ongoing assessment and treatment. Compre- hensive care of people with chronic pain also should involve those family members who are observers and often participants in the chronic pain experience (Glajchen, 2003). Caregiv- ing over time has the potential to affect the emotional, physical, and fi nancial well-being of the patient and family. Thus, vigilance, on- going assessment, and advocacy are required

JWBT514_ch22.indd 598JWBT514_ch22.indd 598 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Pain Management and Palliative Care 599

to meet the current and anticipated needs of patients and their caregivers (Glajchen, 2011).

The perceptions, evaluation, and experi- ences of the patient, family, and health-care professional are unique. As a result, discrep- ancies in observations and assessment may occur, and these data become part of a com- prehensive assessment. For example, the clini- cian’s or family caregiver’s appraisal of pain may not agree with that of the patient (Lob- chuk & Degner, 2002; Miaskowski, Zimmer, Barrett, Dibble, & Wallhagen, 1997). Evi- dence suggests that clinicians underrate pain, especially when it is severe (Cleeland et al., 1994; Grossman, Sheidler, Swedeen, Mucen- ski, & Piantadosi, 1991; Von Roenn, Cleeland, Gonin, Hatfi eld, & Pandya, 1993). Appraisals are fi ltered through the experience, suffering, and cognitive and emotional distress of the appraiser; thus objective assessment is crucial to insure that appropriate interventions are di- rected to the right persons (Redinbaugh, Baum, DeMoss, Fello, & Arnold, 2002). For example, a family caregiver may perceive a loved one’s pain to be out of control while the patient re- ports a reasonable level of comfort. The care- giver’s perception may be affected by fatigue, fear, and feelings of helplessness. The appro- priate intervention, therefore, might be for the social worker and team to reevaluate the plan of care and increase support through practical and psychological interventions rather than an increase in medication for the patient.

Individual and family attitudes and be- haviors related to pain, illness, and death are infused with and enriched by cultural infl u- ences. Societal attitudes toward health, illness, and death have been infl uenced by a variety of ethical, political, religious, and philosophi- cal beliefs in addition to changing medical practices through the 20th century. Although the standard medical approach to illness and health care in the United States is largely based on the Western bioethical model of autonomy, self-determination, and informed consent, the United States is a multicultural society in which beliefs and behaviors are informed by a range of values. The assump- tion that patients and families work from a

model of self-determination, accept the values implicit in advance directives, and become informed self-advocates may represent a clini- cian-driven focus that does not necessarily re- fl ect the unique and individualized experiences of patients and their families. Psychosocial- spiritual assessment recognizes that cultural values and nuances inform patient and fam- ily understanding and adaptation to pain and symptoms, illness, and death and that care can be adapted accordingly (Crawley, Marshall, Lo, & Koenig, 2002; Im et al., 2007; Kagawa- Singer & Blackhall, 2001; Koenig & Gates- Williams, 1995; Koffman, Morgan, Edmonds, Speck, & Higginson, 2008). The next case example captures some of the complexity that is involved when the health-care team is faced with cultural beliefs that differ from the tradi- tional Western bioethical model.

Case Example

Mrs. M is a 33-year-old Muslim woman from Nigeria diagnosed with ovarian cancer and hospitalized with symptoms of pain, nau- sea, and weakness. She speaks little English and communicates through her husband or through an AT&T language line interpreter. Although she has decision-making capacity, she requests that information be given to her husband, who will make the health-care deci- sions. This request is troubling to the health- care team who are more comfortable with the traditional Western model of informed, self-determined decision making. The social worker from the palliative care consult service asks the primary team to consider that one can retain autonomy while giving decision-making power to another individual. She acts as cul- tural mediator throughout the hospital stay. A discussion ensues about the harm that may result if staff’s pressure to inform the patient of her prognosis is experienced as an assault on the beliefs and family structure that sustain the couple in times of crisis. The complexity is compounded with the suggestion of possi- ble surgery, because the risk and benefi ts and nature of invasive surgery change the context and quality of the consent discussion. The pa- tient, her husband, and the health-care team

JWBT514_ch22.indd 599JWBT514_ch22.indd 599 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

600 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

explore the interface of cultural, institutional, and legal issues and negotiate an agreement whereby the husband will consent with the pa- tient assenting by marking an X on a witnessed consent form. The social worker also assists the team with these interventions and adapta- tions, which were required in order to provide respectful care to this couple:

• A visual pain assessment tool is combined with observation of nonverbal behaviors to help staff assess and manage Mrs. M’s pain. Mr. M is reassured that when he is not available, his wife’s pain can be assessed and managed in spite of the language difference.

• Issues related to prognosis, as per cultural and religious beliefs, are not discussed with the patient because both the husband and the AT&T interpreter report that discussing the possibility of death will be distressing, may

impact her adversely, and be interpreted by the patient and her husband as a challenge to the ultimate power and will of Allah.

• Postdeath needs and rituals are researched, discussed with an imam, and shared with nursing staff so that all will be prepared to provide respectful care during and after death.

The scope of a palliative care assessment (see Box 22.2) has much in common with a comprehensive pain assessment in that it can include physical, emotional, socioeconomic, cognitive, cultural, behavioral, spiritual or existential, and environmental realms. Qual- ity palliative care also focuses on advance care planning and risk factors for complicated bereavement. A comprehensive assessment involves the individual as well as signifi cant others and seeks to identify needs and any dis- crepancies in perceptions and understanding.

Box 22.2 Assessment in Palliative Care

Physical. Diagnosis and prognosis; his- tory of disease or pain; symptoms; and im- pact on function, sleep, mood, and intimacy.

Emotional. Depression, anxiety, demoralization, fear, anger, grief, sadness, acceptance, guilt, shame, loss of control, helplessness, hopelessness; preexisting or comorbid psychiatric issues; coping skills; bereavement risk.

Socioeconomic. Sources and stability of income; access to care; entitlements; insurance issues; potential issues related to economic disadvantage or ethnic minority status; and impact and symbolic signifi cance of disability status.

Cognitive. Attitudes, beliefs, and values; expectations that inform responses to pain and illness; internal dialogue and symbolic signifi cance of pain, disease, and treatment; attributed meaning; impact on self-effi cacy, self-image, and locus of control.

Cultural. Communication, gender, and language issues; degree of acculturation, assimilation, or generational differences;

beliefs related to illness, pain, decision making, truth telling, death; use of folk remedies and native healers.

Behavioral. Verbal and nonverbal communication; conscious and unconscious bodily responses such as grimacing, restlessness, or crying; regression, dependence, and acting out; problematic handling of medications and inability to cooperate with treatment plans.

Existential/Spiritual. Issues of meaning, despair, faith, and spiritual comfort; life review, hopes, and goals for the future; legacy-building opportunities; illness, pain, and suffering as related to beliefs such as redemption, endurance, and forgiveness; religious or spiritual beliefs that impact treatment decisions and peaceful dying.

Environmental. Emotional signifi cance of the physical environment, including alterations that need to be made consequent to pain or disease-related issues, such as need for equipment, medical personnel at home; behaviors of staff, friends, or family that may increase distress.

JWBT514_ch22.indd 600JWBT514_ch22.indd 600 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Pain Management and Palliative Care 601

INTERVENTIONS

For social work, the fi elds of pain manage- ment and palliative care present an emerging opportunity to apply skill sets that are a routine part of our training and to learn other skills to enhance the care and outcomes of patients and their families. Social work interventions may be focused in the arena of policy or public advocacy work or in the clinical realm of the patient’s family experience.

Advocacy

Advocacy is an ongoing task; needs change, distress varies, and skills of self-advocacy may fade as the patient and family deal with protracted illness, symptoms such as pain and fatigue, and associated feelings of exhaustion, helplessness, and hopelessness. Unrecognized and unrelieved pain and symptoms and confl ict and misunderstandings within families or with staff are examples of clinical situations that may require social work advocacy skills. Patients and families often need assistance in advocating for adequate discharge plans and negotiating with insurance companies. When patients and fami- lies are less distressed, advocacy skills can be taught with the goal of increasing self-effi cacy (McCaffery & Pasero, 1999). In addition, there are multiple opportunities for promoting sys- tems change within institutions as well as at a political and policy level.

Supportive Counseling Interventions

Supportive counseling interventions include techniques of clarifying, exploring, partializ- ing, validating, and problem solving. Patients and family members often are faced with myriad illness-related issues, such as pain and crucial medical decision making. These inter- ventions, along with intensive medical man- agement of symptoms, establish a basis for trust while they explore immediate needs and concerns. They also have the potential to cre- ate a relationship environment within which the patient and family feel understood and validated.

Education and Anticipatory Guidance

Education is an essential part of helping peo- ple master circumstances. In the health-care environment, education often means exposure to the language of medicine in the setting of pain, illness, and anxiety. The health-care community is responsible for accommodat- ing and adapting to the needs of patients and providing information in a way that supports patient and family understanding and compe- tence. Health-care clinicians need to anticipate future challenges and offer preemptive educa- tion and support to patients and their loved ones, which may include exploring the use of advance directives.

Case Example

Maria introduces herself as the family’s so- cial worker by explaining that she is avail- able to offer them support through Mr. S’s upcoming hospitalization for cardiac surgery. In addition to asking about their immediate questions and needs, she provides a folder of information and suggests that they might fi nd the material helpful as treatment evolves. She acknowledges that people have different ways of coping and discusses some of the resources, such as support groups and counseling oppor- tunities, that others have found helpful. Maria closes by saying that she will be available to discuss a range of concerns, such as the im- pact of treatment on the family, its side effects, sexual functioning, fi nances, and spirituality.

The affective and cognitive components of pain described earlier in this chapter can be impacted by providing education and informa- tion about pain, management techniques, and strategies for coping. Many people are familiar with acute pain, and the transition to a chronic pain condition is often gradual and subtle. Con- sequently, the necessary emotional and cogni- tive adaptation to a chronic condition may be delayed. In the absence of clear education, ex- pectation for cure may continue with the result that the patient and family have repeated ex- periences of failure and disappointment. Edu- cation helps patients and families distinguish between the preventive use of medications and

JWBT514_ch22.indd 601JWBT514_ch22.indd 601 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

602 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

addiction, physical dependence, and tolerance. Information should be customized to the needs of individual patients and families, because learning needs, language, and preferred learn- ing styles differ.

Case Example

Mr. W is a 33-year-old unmarried male living at home with his parents who came to Amer- ica from Trinidad. He hurt his back stocking shelves in the supermarket. He has been out of work for two years and, as a result of his ongoing struggle with worker’s compensa- tion insurance, he has become defensive and interprets pain-related assessment questions as a challenge to his credibility and the validity of his pain experience. His mother searched for curative treatment. When his pain contin- ued, however, she began to wonder if he had a psychiatric as well as a physical problem. She sought a chronic pain program where, over time, educational interventions addressed these interrelated issues:

• Mr. W’s pain experience includes physi- cal, psychological, cultural, and systemic components. Multidimensional assessment of his pain is not intended to diminish his pain but rather to acknowledge him as a whole person, including but not limited to his physical self. Diagnostic and medical evaluation indicate that Mr. W’s pain is no longer a signal that he is doing further harm to his body.

• His mother’s behaviors, based in her culture and role, need to be refocused on support- ing independence and recovery rather than “taking care of her son.” His back pain is reframed from an acute to a chronic condi- tion, requiring a caregiving approach that encourages effi cacy and maximum func- tioning.

• Medications are prescribed to diminish his pain and also serve to validate symbolically the clinician’s belief in his reports of pain.

• Mr. W is advised to consider participat- ing in a vocational rehabilitation program rather than waiting for his pain to dissipate,

thus reframing the goal of care as being to maximize functioning rather than to ame- liorate pain.

Cognitive-Behavioral Interventions

Cognitive-behavioral techniques recognize that the biological, cognitive, behavioral, and emotional aspects of experience are related and that interventions focused on any one as- pect have the potential to modify the entire experience. The internal dialogue of the pa- tient or family member becomes a source of rich diagnostic information, and the relation- ship of body, mind, and emotion becomes an avenue for helping to maximize feelings of control and self-effi cacy and modify symp- toms. Cognitive-behavioral interventions may be adjuncts to the medical management of symptoms. They often are used in combina- tion and may be the primary interventions in chronic pain situations. They can be helpful to patients during procedures and diagnostic tests that often create distress and feelings of lack of control.

The strategies selected relate to the goals and condition of the patient and often tap into the patients’ and families’ interests and abilities. For those who are overwhelmed or physically or mentally exhausted, the clinician works to build a successful experience by selecting inter- ventions that require less effort, such as those based in visual or auditory senses, such as au- diotapes and music. These interventions can be taught to individuals and families or can be incorporated into group experiences. Education is often a basic component of these techniques. Normalizing aspects of cognitive-behavioral in- terventions helps patients and families integrate them more easily. To that end, comparing imag- ery to controlled daydreaming or distraction to being engaged in an exciting movie reinforces the familiar at the same time that new skills are being introduced. It can be helpful to intro- duce these techniques as an extension of natu- ral abilities to distract from the painful stimuli, which does not mean that the pain is either nonexistent or psychological in origin (Altilio, 2004; Berlin, 2001; Devine, 2003; Jacobsen

JWBT514_ch22.indd 602JWBT514_ch22.indd 602 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Pain Management and Palliative Care 603

& Hann, 1998; Loscalzo & Jacobsen, 1990). These techniques focus clinical attention on the relationship among body, mind, and emo- tion and provide options for interventions that refl ect the multidimensional experiences of pal- liative care patients and individuals living with chronic pain (Kerr, 2000). The International Association for the Study of Pain (2009) and the National Cancer Institute (NCI, 2010) Web sites are important sources of information and references about how to integrate interventions into practice.

Cognitive Restructuring

Cognitive restructuring involves monitoring a person’s interpretation of events in order to reduce feelings of distress, helplessness, and hopelessness. Exploring a patient’s internal dialogue can help to identify thoughts and feelings that exacerbate pain, symptom inten- sity, and distress. The technique provides an opportunity both to explore fears and miscon- ceptions and to reinterpret thoughts to enhance comfort and control (Bradley, 1996; Syrjala, Donaldson, Davis, Kippes, & Carr, 1995).

Case Example

Mr. K is a 51-year-old Latino married father of two adult children who was admitted to the hospital with back pain. Within a fi ve-day pe- riod, he was diagnosed with lung cancer and informed that his cancer had metastasized to his liver and bones. His sister is an assertive, in- formed advocate who speaks English and is the primary spokesperson for the family with the health-care team. Mrs. K, whose primary lan- guage is Spanish, is frightened and tearful. It is an expected response, but one that is particularly distressing to Mr. K, who has seen himself as protector and provider. Mr. K’s respiratory con- dition worsens precipitously, and before mak- ing a decision about resuscitation or appointing a health-care agent, he requires ventilator sup- port and is therefore unable to communicate. Diagnostic work continues, and antibiotics are prescribed for his respiratory symptoms. The social worker and palliative care team continue to provide service to the patient and family to

maintain continuity throughout the crisis. Sup- portive counseling techniques are used to assist Mr. K and his family to integrate the quickly changing medical situation. They include edu- cation about diagnosis and treatment, validation of the range of emotions, concerns, and ques- tions associated with the medical and family crises, and clarifi cation of the intent and goals of the medical team. In family meetings, Mrs. K is determined to be the surrogate decision maker, although the process of decision making becomes one of family consensus. The social worker sees to it that Mrs. K has a staff inter- preter to ensure that information is interpreted directly to her rather than through distressed family members and to validate the importance of her role and participation. In addition to cur- rent circumstances, the social worker and doc- tor explore the patient’s prior articulated beliefs and values that might inform the decisions to be made on his behalf. This is especially important consequent to the family’s perception that they would be “killing” Mr. K if they agreed to have the ventilator removed. The family indicates that Mr. K had shared his desire not to be sus- tained by machines. He also had told the team chaplain that he had a good life and that quality of life was more important to him than quantity. Using the technique of cognitive reframing, the family was asked to consider that discontinu- ing the ventilator refl ects a respect for Mr. K’s values and that, rather than “killing him,” they were allowing death to occur, consistent with the guidance he had given. Family members allow the medical team to remove the ventila- tor. The social worker and physician provide anticipatory guidance to assist family members with their individual decisions to be present as the ventilator is removed, educating them about this unfamiliar process, using breathing and im- agery techniques both to prepare them for Mr. K’s death and to enhance coping with the actual experience.

Coping Statements

Coping statements are internal or spoken state- ments designed to distract, enhance coping, self-sooth, or diminish the threatening aspect

JWBT514_ch22.indd 603JWBT514_ch22.indd 603 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

604 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

of a situation or experience (International As- sociation for the Study of Pain, 2009; McCaul & Malott, 1984; Syrjala et al., 1995). Cata- strophic and defeating self-statements about pain can be replaced with internal dialogues that enhance coping, calm, and competence.

Distraction

Distraction involves refocusing attention to stimuli other than pain and to other aspects of self, which might include mental activity (internal) such as prayer, reading, or doing crossword puzzles, or physical activity (ex- ternal), such as breathing, rhythm, or engag- ing in conversation (American Pain Society, 2005; Broome, Rehwaldt, & Fogg, 1998). Activities such as telling stories, music, life review, prayer, and reading silently or aloud can have therapeutic value while at the same time distracting from pain and other sources of distress (Altilio, 2002; McCaffrey & Pasero, 1999).

Self-Monitoring Techniques

Self-monitoring techniques such as diaries or journals externalize and objectify thoughts, be- haviors, and feelings and create a personal his- tory. The identifi cation of attitudes, thoughts, and beliefs allows redefi nition of the threaten- ing aspects of experience toward the goal of decreasing distressing feelings and reactions. The techniques are adaptable to different per- sonalities and goals, can be kept for a week or for months, can be written in telegram format or in paragraphs, and provide a link to the cli- nician (Altilio, 2004; American Pain Society, 2005). At times, diaries and audio recordings serve an additional purpose because they come to represent symbolically the therapeutic re- lationship, as in the concept of a transitional object, thereby extending the therapeutic ben- efi t and comfort implicit in that relationship (Winnicott, 1971). Diaries can be useful in understanding the multidimensional aspects of illness and symptoms, including pain, insom- nia, anxiety, and depression, and thereby guide interventions (Kelly & Clifford, 1997).

Case Example

The next journal entries were written over time by Ms. J, a 28-year-old woman with breast can- cer that had metastasized to the bones, causing pain that impacted function, sleep, and mood.

11:00 am: I had a relatively good night’s sleep. When I woke up, instead of turning on the TV, I tried to go back to sleep. I told myself that if I tried for 15 to 20 minutes to go to sleep, I could get up or watch TV. I fell back to sleep both times. [Coping statement integrated with sleep hygiene techniques em- power and diminish helplessness related to sleeplessness.]

2:00 pm: Feeling very depressed because I was supposed to go out to dinner in the city, but I canceled because I feel so horrible. I’m also afraid that I’d be in miserable pain. That’s why I canceled. But now I’m feeling depressed because I feel like this pain has control over my entire life. [Patient’s cata- strophic thinking and anticipation of pain controls behavior, exacerbating her helpless- ness and distress.]

4:30 pm: Feel really depressed about every- thing. The pain is making me feel like I’m dying [attributed meaning]. Not that it’s that bad—it’s not—it’s actually pretty mild, but I just feel overwhelmed by everything; the decisions I have to make. [Patient differen- tiating pain, symbolic meaning of pain and feelings and distress generated by pending decisions.] (Altilio, 2004)

Relaxation Techniques

In the 1970s, a research cardiologist named Herbert Benson developed a simple relaxation technique that incorporates muscle relaxation and rhythmic breathing. Its goal is to elicit a relaxation response that counteracts fi ght or fl ight, the internal adaptive response to threat during which the body secretes catecholamines, or stress hormones, that prepare a person to fi ght or fl ee. This response is essential when facing acute threats and often becomes acti- vated during medical procedures that may be frightening or threatening to patients, because

JWBT514_ch22.indd 604JWBT514_ch22.indd 604 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Pain Management and Palliative Care 605

the anticipated results, such as a diagnosis of cancer, will be life altering. The fi ght-or-fl ight response is not helpful when stress is chronic, as when the threat is an internal experience, such as pain or shortness of breath (Benson, 1975). It also often is disruptive during proce- dures that require patient attention or stillness. Learning the breathing technique that elicits a relaxation response may empower patients and families to cope with events, fears, and over- whelming thoughts, thus enhancing feelings of self-effi cacy.

Many patients use breathing techniques with or without muscle relaxation to reverse their physiologic, emotional, and behavioral reactions to stress and pain. The choice of technique is based on a clinical evaluation. Most exercises combine repetition of a word, phrase, or breath, with or without imagery, and are enhanced by a quiet environment and a secure comfortable physical position. Clini- cians often work with patients and families to practice techniques within the therapeu- tic relationship. Personalized relaxation and imagery exercises can be recorded for use by patients and families, thus creating the potential to extend their therapeutic benefi t (Gallo-Silver & Pollack, 2000; Loscalzo & Jacobsen, 1990).

Imagery

Imagery is the use of mental representations to assist in the control of symptoms, to en- hance relaxation and comfort, or to distance oneself from a problem and in so doing gain insight into it. Imagery often incorporates a relaxation exercise. Although visualization is the most common form, many exercises are enriched by involving the senses of taste, smell, hearing, and touch. Imagery can be used to mentally rehearse upcoming activities or feelings that are threatening (Eller, 1999; Graffam & Johnson, 1987; Luebbert, Dahme, & Hasenbring, 2001; Sheikh, 1983). Images elicited from the patient or family may repre- sent personal memories or imaginary places and have the potential to enhance the thera- peutic impact of intervention.

Hypnosis

Hypnosis is a technique for inducing a state of heightened awareness, increased suggest- ibility, and focused concentration that can be used to alter the perception of pain, reduce associated fear and anxiety, and sometimes control pain itself (Kirsch, Montgomery, & Saperstein, 1995; Montgomery, David, Win- kel, Silverstein, & Bovbjerg, 2002). Autogenic self-hypnosis uses self-suggestions of warmth, heaviness, and relaxation in sequence through- out the body. It can be associated with decrease of pain and enhanced relaxation (Sternbach, 1987). Clinicians who choose to add hypnosis to their skill sets seek specialized training. The concept of suggestion, however, can be inte- grated easily into professional communication simply by attending to language. For example, the phrase “as you become more comfort- able” implies both process and an expectation of positive outcome, a message signifi cantly different from “when or if you become more comfortable.”

Life Review and Legacy Building

The diagnosis of an advanced illness often is associated with an increased awareness that one is indeed mortal. Erikson (1963) specu- lated that those facing death attempted to re- solve the confl ict between “ego integrity” and “despair.” Assisting patients with life review by focusing on generativity (continuing to be engaged in meaningful activities) offers a foundation for positive refl ection at this vul- nerable stage of life. New attention to existen- tial “meaning of life” concerns may begin to take precedence as the individual considers the possibility of a limited life span or living with chronic pain. Social workers can assist dur- ing this period by normalizing these concerns, sharing time for review, and offering resources to assist in the life review process. Tools are available that offer guidance in recording life history on video- or audiotapes, in journals or scrapbooks, or through other artistic strate- gies (Babcock, 1997; McPhelimy, 1997; Otis- Green & Rutland, 2004). These efforts can be

JWBT514_ch22.indd 605JWBT514_ch22.indd 605 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

606 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

tremendously cathartic for the patient and of great value to loved ones as part of an inten- tional legacy-building exercise. With chronic pain, life review may happen as a natural part of integrating the impact of chronic pain as pa- tients and families refl ect on changes in their current lives, as well as their future hopes.

Case Example

Ms. T has been reluctant to come to the De- tours group that meets monthly at the hospital. When her doctor tells her that it was for those with recurrent disease, she summons her cour- age and comes to a meeting. She is relieved to see so many others already grabbing snacks and fi nding seats. The social work facilitator invites the participants to share what “detours” life has thrown each of them. Ms. T fi nds her- self relaxing as she listens to so many stories similar to her own. She has been feeling stuck and unsure of what to do since learning of the recurrence of her illness. The social worker encourages members of the group to think about what is most important to them and to consider how to ensure that what is most es- sential to them is not lost. Ms. T raises her hand to tell the group that her three children are what matters the most and asks the group for suggestions to help her “protect them from all of this.” Later Ms. T tells her doctor that the group helped her to see that, although she might not be able to protect her children, she is thinking more clearly about how she can bet- ter prepare them for whatever they might have to face. In subsequent meetings, Ms. T devel- ops a guardianship plan and works on record- ing and creating memories through videotape. She also prepares a book of reminiscences and memories for her children.

Integrative Strategies: The Use of the Expressive Arts

The expressive arts offer social workers enor- mous opportunities for culturally sensitive interactions with those they serve. Integra- tive interventions are especially useful as a distraction technique for those suffering pain. Although many pediatric units recognize the

benefi ts of expressive art interventions, fewer adult units incorporate art, music, or play strat- egies into routine care. Health social workers are well positioned to recommend and coordi- nate integrative programs (Otis-Green, 2003). For example, hand or foot massage programs may fi t well into a skilled nursing environ- ment, the introduction of a music program may be appropriate for an intensive care setting, or the use of the visual arts may be incorporated into existing support groups. Developing a mind-set that looks for ways to integrate the expressive arts into conventional settings is a fi rst step toward creating opportunities for the successful integration of these strategies.

Case Example

Mr. H is diagnosed with chronic renal disease and signifi cant diabetic neuropathy, yet he comes regularly to the Hands on Harps con- certs and workshops sponsored by the social work department. When asked what makes these meetings so important to him, he always beams and states that when listening to the music, all of his pain disappears and that al- though he lacks digital dexterity, “playing with the harp always sounds so sweet.” When Mr. H becomes too ill to attend the workshops, his social worker arranges for the harpist to visit his hospital room. Mr. H’s family later reports that they played harp music to him while they sat vigil awaiting his death and plan to play the CD at his funeral, since it always brought such comfort to him.

Child/Adolescent-Specifi c Interventions

In years past, children often were excluded from participation and interaction with the illness experiences of their family members. This well-meaning exclusion was intended to protect children from distress and confusion. It is now understood that providing children with age-appropriate information, and allow- ing them to participate as appropriate, can enhance their adjustment to a changed family experience and to the losses and adaptations that accompany chronic pain, progressive ill- ness, and death (Harpham, 2004).

JWBT514_ch22.indd 606JWBT514_ch22.indd 606 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Pain Management and Palliative Care 607

Most children are very perceptive but may lack both the cognitive and developmental abilities to understand what is happening in their family and may not have the language to talk about it. Although cultural variation may infl uence how families engage children and adolescents, clinicians can focus attention to child and adolescent coping by asking relevant questions as part of an overall assessment, not only of the immediate or nuclear family members, but also of grandchildren, nieces, and nephews who are emotionally connected to the patient. Age-appropriate information provided by signifi cant adults can enhance un- derstanding, dispel myths, fears, and anxieties, enhance trust, and help children to make sense of their own feelings as well as those of others. Many children worry that they have caused the pain or illness of loved ones, because of the magical thinking that may accompany their stage of development. They may have fears about their own health, overreact to compa- rable symptoms such as pain, and worry about how they will be cared for if income is lost or a parent becomes disabled or dies. Giving children permission to ask questions and ex- press feelings and fears helps them feel secure and cared for. Techniques such as play ther- apy, art therapy, storytelling, and journaling can be especially helpful. Signs of regression or disinterest, while common for children, can be disconcerting for adults who may already be overwhelmed and misinterpret the behav- iors of their children or adolescents. Educa- tion, reassurance, and maintenance of routine is often helpful (Heiney, Hermann, Bruss, & Fincannon, 2000).

Adolescents are at a particularly vulner- able stage of development that can be com- plicated when an adult is ill or affected by chronic pain. The need to be aligned with peers, to regulate uncertainty and anxiety, and the desire to achieve some degree of emancipation and independence may become more diffi cult when medical issues and role changes create additional anxiety and require the adolescent to limit peer activity and as- sume more responsibility at home. Resulting behaviors may include withdrawal, silence,

or anger, and may refl ect a myriad of feel- ings, such as embarrassment, sadness, guilt, depression, and anxiety. Social work inter- ventions may include:

• Educating the family about adolescent- specifi c issues.

• Engaging and educating adolescents about medical situations in age-appropriate ways.

• Encouraging adults to continue to talk, even in monologue, about what is occurring, re- inforcing stability as well as changes that may occur.

• Monitoring unobtrusively the teen’s school- work and interactions with peers and sig- nifi cant adults.

• Assessing the pros and cons of alerting school personnel—teachers and counselors— about what is occurring in the family, ensuring that they respect the teen’s confi - dentiality while offering additional support.

• Encouraging opportunities for contact with signifi cant adults in the teen’s life, such as aunts, uncles, and coaches.

• Evaluating for depression, anxiety, and changes in sleep and appetite.

Case Example

Mrs. L is a 42-year-old Latina married mother of two children—Paulino, age 9, and Pedro, age 5. She was diagnosed with a Stage 4 glio- blastoma approximately four months ago. De- spite limited response, she has continued to pursue treatments, including chemotherapy, and has chosen to participate in clinical tri- als. Mrs. L reports that when her husband is at work, the children act out. Paulino complains that his “summer is ruined,” and Pedro talks back to his parents, does not adhere to set lim- its, and is beginning to regress, wetting his bed and soiling his garments. Mrs. L responds by apologizing and is overwhelmed by feelings of sadness, anger, and guilt. She is fatigued from treatments and paralyzed by the fear that she will die, leaving her children and husband. The social worker works with Mrs. and Mr. L to explore the potential benefi ts of a family

JWBT514_ch22.indd 607JWBT514_ch22.indd 607 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

608 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

meeting. They agree to a meeting of all family members to explore their understandings and to provide age-appropriate information for the children. During the meeting, the social worker reviews the meaning and etiology of fatigue and assists the children in reframing their understanding of Mrs. L’s waning abil- ity to participate physically in their lives. The age-appropriate needs of the children are ac- knowledged, and the family is encouraged to take advantage of their available supports. They identify family members, specifi cally an uncle and friends, who might assist in helping with the children. In addition to contributing to the lives of the children, allowing friends and family to participate will enable Mrs. L to focus her energy on meaningful activities with her sons, individually and together, cre- ating memories. Friends and family are as- signed tasks that allow them to realize their desire to help. They are grateful to know that they are contributing to the life of Mrs. L and her family. The social worker locates low-cost day camps in their area, providing the children with age-appropriate activities and allowing time for Mrs. L to rest. Mr. L is consistently engaged in planning, because it is essential that the children experience a relationship of trust and confi dence in their father, who is likely to be the parent who raises them.

Family Meetings

Family meetings can be used as therapeu- tic tools for providing family-oriented clini- cal, palliative, and end-of-life care. They are forums for communication in which social workers have the potential to make tremen- dous contributions (Fineberg, 2010). In the hospital setting, such meetings, also called family conferences, may be defi ned as “a meeting which involves a number of family members, the patient, and hospital personnel in discussions concerning the patient’s illness, treatment and plans for their discharge or their care outside the hospital” (Hansen, Cornish, & Kayser, 1998, p. 58). Family conferences are not the same as family therapy (Meyer, Sch- neid, & Craigie, 1989) because they focus on

immediate issues relating to health and care rather than longer-term improvements in fam- ily functioning. They can, however, enhance and enrich therapeutic work. Effective com- munication with families is particularly chal- lenging, because family members are often the “hidden patients” in palliative care, both pro- viding and needing care (Kristjanson & Aoun, 2004). This is especially true when family members, as defi ned by the patient, are chosen rather than related by biological or legal con- nections. By advancing a family systems theo- retical perspective, family conferences bring a holistic approach that is emphasized in pallia- tive and end-of-life care but largely absent in medical systems (Erstling & Devlin, 1989).

Family conferences have been shown to improve communication in palliative care (Hudson, Thomas, Quinn, & Aranda, 2009; Lautrette et al., 2007). Conferences often address emotionally intense topics, such as advance care planning, pain and symptom management, and ethical issues. They are im- portant forums for decision making in hospi- tals, intensive care units, and clinics (Curtis et al., 2001; Hansen et al., 1998; Kushner, Meyer, & Hansen, 1989; Meyer et al., 1989). Con- ferences provide opportunities for collective patient, family, and health-care provider dis- cussions (Ambuel, 2000; Liebman, Silbergleit, & Farber, 1975) that promote the inclusion of patients and families, invite family members to be active participants in care (Atkinson, Stew- art, & Gardner, 1980), allow for collaborative dissemination of information and clarifi cation of misinformation, and increase coordination of health-care providers to reduce the potential for patients and families to receive confl icting messages. Given the complexity of purpose implicit in family meetings, it is important to consider the involvement of both current providers and those who have a historical re- lationship with the patient and family. These providers often bring both emotional and clini- cal continuity as well as valuable information based on an ongoing relationship (Altilio et al., 2008). Although it is challenging to involve providers who may have worked with the pa- tient in the past, technology such as Internet

JWBT514_ch22.indd 608JWBT514_ch22.indd 608 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Pain Management and Palliative Care 609

video conferencing now enables us to enlist participants who may be anywhere in the world. Social work advocacy for clinician continu- ity and participation may mitigate feelings of abandonment and honor prior discussions with patients and families related to their articulated values, goals, and decision-making processes.

Family conferences, while not normative in the care of persons with chronic pain, can serve as forums for educating and assisting families as they emotionally and cognitively struggle to move from an acute care model that anticipates that pain will dissipate to a recognition that pain may have become a chronic condition that requires adaptation and has a continuing impact on the life of the fam- ily. Varying combinations of patients, family members, and health-care providers may par- ticipate in family conferences, making these interventions adaptable for a broad range of family confi gurations and cultural traditions (Fineberg & Bauer, 2011).

SOME ETHICAL CONCEPTS RELATED TO PAIN AND PALLIATIVE CARE

Medical ethics was remarkably continuous and consistent from the time of Hippocrates until the mid-20th century. In recent years sci- entifi c, technological, and social developments have produced rapid changes in the many tra- ditional conceptions of ethical practice and obligations in health-care practice. Medical care, living with chronic illness, and, in many instances, dying have become more complex than in previous generations as a result of our highly technical and disjointed systems of care. At times, it seems that our medical tech- nology has surpassed the ability to make ethi- cal decisions about its use.

Ethics is a branch of philosophy that seeks to determine how human actions may be judged right or wrong. The study of eth- ics implies that the human mind is the funda- mental means by which actions can be judged (Beauchamp & Childress, 1989). Thus, ethics is not the same as moral theology or religious

ethics since ethics uses reason alone and does not invoke religious beliefs as the source of its conclusions. Nor is ethics the same as the law. Although the law is largely concerned with the public good and the protection of individual rights, ethics goes further to look at the obliga- tions of individuals to themselves as well as to others and to society.

In the practice of medicine, these obliga- tions are intimately related to purpose. Pel- ligrino (1979) asserted that the purpose in medicine is a right and good healing action taken in the interest of a particular patient. Kass (1983) emphasized healing as the primary purpose of medicine while acknowledging that the pursuit of health, the prevention of death, and the alleviation of suffering were second- ary to healing. Any dialogue that attempts to explore and expand these values and concepts should be based on a common understanding and acceptance of the language used. Palliative care, with an essential focus on serious illness, risk and benefi ts, goals of care, and decision making, requires that clinicians are familiar with common ethical principles and are suf- fi ciently skilled to identify an ethical dilemma (see Chapter 3 for further discussion of ethics).

The four principles that underlie and guide ethical decision making are autonomy, be- nefi cence, nonmalefi cence, and justice. The following defi nitions establish a common lan- guage as a basis for collaboration and discus- sion.

Autonomy is derived from the Greek autos (self) and nomos (rule, governance, or law). Those who have autonomy “act intention- ally, are informed and free from interference and control by others” (Lo, 2000, p. 11). In Western health-care systems, autonomy is promoted by providing information and assist- ing patients and surrogates to reach decisions. Closely tied to the principle of autonomy are the values of respect for persons, the right of self-determination, and informed consent. Cultural beliefs, values, and family dynamics often require thoughtful clinicians to adapt and negotiate in order to balance the principle of individual autonomy with unique patient and family circumstances. Respect for persons is

JWBT514_ch22.indd 609JWBT514_ch22.indd 609 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

610 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

based on the tacit belief in the value of each person; considers social, economic, and cul- tural variables; and includes the right to self- determination. Respect for persons supports the right of capacitated persons to determine the appropriate level, if any, of medical inter- vention and the right to change their decisions about treatment when their condition changes.

At its most basic, benefi cence means no more than “do good.” Similarly, the principle of nonmalefi cence tells us to avoid doing harm. Ethical medical decision making is complex, and it is not always possible to know clearly what is “doing good” in the face of ambiva- lent and nonspecifi c potential outcomes. In addition, the concept of doing good may dif- fer based on individual opinions, cultural and spiritual beliefs, and social preferences, as evi- denced in the case example describing the care of Mrs. M.

Justice is an important ethical principle that involves provision of health care as related to the availability and distribution of goods and services. Some argue that society is expected to determine a just, or at least reasonable, dis- tribution of the goods necessary to protect the dignity of the individual person. When we ex- pand the construct of “distribution of goods” to include pain management skills and medi- cations, it becomes a violation of the principle of justice as well as benefi cence when vulner- able groups such as older persons, women, and minorities are not provided competent pain management equal to that provided to other groups (Bonham, 2001; Cleeland et al., 1994; Tarzian & Hoffman, 2004). Distribution is concerned with scarce resources. At times, de- mand outstrips supply, a reality that becomes particularly complex in the American health- care system, in which supply also is infl uenced by availability of services and access as deter- mined by geography, fi nances, and socioeco- nomic status (see Chapters 5 and 7 for further discussion).

Ethicists have created specifi c guidelines to assist in deliberations of challenging ethical dilemmas wherein there may be confl ict and confusion about actions that may have both benefi ts and harms. For example, the principle

of double effect assists clinicians struggling with decisions related to interventions that may have intended positive effects at the same time as unintended, but foreseen, harmful ef- fects. The concept of proportionality assists in the weighing of potential benefi ts and harms. The beliefs, values, and responsibilities of cli- nicians, patients and families, and institutions are infused with these profound and complex discussions. Social workers who are privileged to join in these deliberations have an important role in bringing their comprehensive assess- ment and understanding of patients and fami- lies to the process and assisting in ensuring that the process is respectful and informed and honors the participants as well as the complex- ity implicit in these discussions.

In addition to a working knowledge of au- tonomy, benefi cence, nonmalefi cence, justice, and double effect, social workers practicing in palliative care and pain settings require expertise in concepts such as euthanasia and physician-assisted death or assisted suicide. In the care of seriously ill patients, treatment of pain or shortness of breath often requires use of medications that may have the unin- tended side effect of sedation. Euthanasia, physician-assisted suicide, is not the same as withholding or withdrawing interventions that allow death to occur. Confusion about the intent of intensive symptom management, eu- thanasia, and assisted death on the part of the staff, patient, or family requires that social work clinicians, in consult with their nursing and physician colleagues, are knowledgeable, responsive, and vigilant in exploring observa- tions and that they provide accurate informa- tion to dispel misinterpretation and perhaps alter the plan of care. Public discussion of these topics invites thoughtful and compre- hensive social work analysis because they are refl ective of profound and complex ethical and moral issues.

Euthanasia is the deliberate action by a phy- sician or an individual other than the patient to end the patient’s life for benevolent motives, such as the relief of suffering. The act is per- formed with the explicit consent of a compe- tent adult who is the patient. The patient’s death

JWBT514_ch22.indd 610JWBT514_ch22.indd 610 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Pain Management and Palliative Care 611

occurs consequent to the direct action of the medical provider. Involuntary euthanasia is the intentional administration of medications or other interventions to cause the death of a competent patient without the patient’s explicit request and full informed consent. Nonvolun- tary euthanasia is the intentional administration of medications or other interventions to cause the death of an incompetent patient who is in- capable of explicitly requesting it (Emanuel & Emanuel, 1992). All forms of euthanasia are il- legal in the United States.

Physician-assisted death is the provision by a physician of medications or advice that enables patients to end their lives. It is the ingestion of medications by a terminally ill, competent adult intended to hasten death. Patients take the medications themselves and are thus the direct agents of their own deaths. Two states currently allow physician-assisted suicide: Oregon (since 1998) and Washington (since 2008).

The Oregon Death with Dignity Act (ODDA) was structured around the three pil- lars of self-determination, professional immu- nity and integrity, and public accountability. Several unexpected outcomes have occurred over the decade during which ODDA has been in effect. Among them is the fact that rela- tively few persons have chosen to hasten death through this legislative vehicle. Before the act was implemented, opponents anticipated a de- mographic “surge” to Oregon of near-terminal patients. The empirical evidence does not bear this out. In 10 years, 541 Oregon residents have received prescriptions for lethal doses of medication to end their lives; of this number, 341 actually ingested the drugs. These fi gures are lower than those forecasted by those on both sides of the debate. Although those fi g- ures generally have risen each year, the deaths under ODDA are still a very small proportion of Oregon’s total deaths. The principal con- cerns expressed by patients who choose to hasten their deaths is loss of autonomy, dimin- ished quality of life, loss of dignity, and loss of control of bodily functions, all of which are as- pects of care that are within the scope of social

work practice (Oregon Department of Health Services, 2008).

It appears that ODDA may have served as a catalyst for improving end-of-life care among Oregon practitioners, driving the increased use of hospice and palliative care and the im- proved management of pain. Ensuring death with dignity for all patients is a goal beyond the parameters of ODDA. It is infl uenced by improving the practice of all clinicians caring for seriously ill patients. Currently there is a move away from describing “death with dig- nity” and “physician-assisted suicide” toward language that describes the hastening of death by ingestion of medications provided by a phy- sician as “assisted death.” Of note, in Oregon, the cause of death on the death certifi cates of those who chose ODDA is the underlying ter- minal illness, thus not precluding provision of life insurance benefi ts.

Only a few states have offered initiatives to legalize assisted death, either through state legislatures or citizens themselves. Washington State has legalized its own death with dignity act, which was passed in November 2008. The fi rst year’s report is that 63 patients requested medication under the law, and of those 63, 36 people died after ingesting medication (Wash- ington State Department of Health, 2009). These data are similar to data collected in Or- egon, as are the top three reasons for pursu- ing assisted death among Washington patients: loss of autonomy, loss of dignity, and being less able to engage in activities that make life meaningful (Washington State Department of Health, 2009).

PAIN MANAGEMENT: AN OVERVIEW

In addition to the opportunity presented in palliative care, many people who live with chronic pain have needs that fall well within the purview of social work practice. In 2003, a national telephone survey of 1,004 adults revealed 57% of respondents to have reported chronic or recurring pain during the past year

JWBT514_ch22.indd 611JWBT514_ch22.indd 611 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

612 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

(Hart, 2003). The survey considered chronic pain conditions such as back and knee pain, arthritis, headache, and migraine. Of those surveyed, 76% had experienced pain, either directly or through a connection to a fam- ily member or friend. Chronic pain had led to changes in employment, residence, per- sonal freedom, or mobility. Steps taken to cope with pain included applying for disabil- ity and seeking help with activities of daily living. These fi ndings refl ect adaptation and experiences of loss that have the potential to affect self-esteem, identity, role function, and social and economic stability, both for the person living with pain and for close family members and friends. In addition to the per- sonal and family impact, data from an Ameri- can Productivity Audit in 2001 estimated that over half (52.7%) of the workforce reported pain conditions in the two weeks prior to the survey. In that two-week period, 12.7% of respondents lost productive time, with an average loss of 4.6 hours per week, at a cost of $61.2 billion a year (Stewart, Ricci, Chee, Morganstein, & Lipton, 2003). These fi nd- ings point to a health and economic concern of major proportions.

Pain is necessary to survival and gener- ally, but not always, signals physical injury or disease and alerts one to take some kind of action. Although pain arguably is a truly universal experience, at the same time, indi- viduals, including clinicians, relate to pain through a kaleidoscope of cultural, familial, sociopolitical, and spiritual values. For exam- ple, pain can be viewed as a misfortune, as a weakness, a path to redemption, or a form of punishment. Some believe the appropriate response is to bear pain stoically while others view pain as a signal to seek medical atten- tion and expect to receive help and care from family and friends. Although many expect to be healed through medical intervention, oth- ers believe that pain can best be controlled through prayer or psychological or integra- tive interventions (see Chapter 12 for further information). Patients with chronic pain that may or may not be associated with observable

tissue damage sometimes are accused of ex- aggerating pain and disability for secondary gain; yet many feel ashamed and or dimin- ished by dependence on others and the need to apply for disability in a system that often challenges the integrity of applicants. Thus, we begin to see the complexity and impor- tance of comprehensive clinical assessment and interventions to assist persons with pain that has the potential to impact profoundly their identity and the quality of their lives and the lives of their family and friends. This is true for chronic pain or for pain that ac- companies incurable progressive illness.

Pain is also unique as a symptom, in that it is a subjective experience, and unlike other somatic experiences, such as high blood pres- sure, body temperature, or blood glucose lev- els, cannot be measured objectively (American Pain Society, 2003). Clinicians and family members must rely on the person’s report of pain severity and its impact. Social work’s emphasis on starting where the client is and assessing people in their environment serve as frames of reference that imply a respect for in- dividuals’ perceptions of their experiences and a valuing of the whole person, including but not limited to the body. In the management of pain, an analogous principle is to believe the report of pain; in palliative care, a comparable mandate is an understanding of the holistic ex- perience including values, beliefs, and culture that inform the life of the patient and family. The task for social work clinicians is to com- plement values such as respect for the dignity and worth of the person with pain and pallia- tive expertise that empower the profession to intervene on a clinical, institutional, policy, and research level.

Pain in Life-Limiting and Chronic Incurable Illness

In palliative care settings, the experience and management of pain is impacted by the mul- tiple challenges presented by diseases such as cancer, multiple sclerosis, and acquired immunodefi ciency syndrome (AIDS). These

JWBT514_ch22.indd 612JWBT514_ch22.indd 612 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Pain Management and Palliative Care 613

statistics provide a sampling of the diseases for which compassionate care demands that pain and palliative care needs are addressed.

Pain occurs in:

• 40% to 83% of patients with Parkinson’s dis- ease (Beiske, Loge, Ronningen, & Svennson, 2009; Ford, 1998; Goetz, Tanner, Levy, Wilson, & Garron, 1986)

• 42.9% of patients with multiple sclerosis (Solaro et al., 2004)

• 49% of pediatric cancer patients (Collins et al., 2000)

• 59% of cancer patients in active therapy (Van den Beulken-van Everdingen et al., 2007)

• 64% of cancer patients with advanced dis- ease (Van den Beulken-van Everdingen et al., 2007)

• 88% of patients with AIDS (Frich & Borgbjerg, 2000)

Pain and symptoms such as shortness of breath, cognitive impairment, and anorexia pres- ent challenges to patients, their families, and caregivers that intensify the suffering and feel- ings of helplessness often associated with life- threatening and incurable progressive illnesses. The next narrative illustrates the impact of pain, fatigue, and cognitive impairment that extends beyond the direct experience of the patient.

Case Example

Mrs. D is a 65-year-old widowed African American woman diagnosed with chronic renal disease. She has been the emotional and administrative center of a large extended family and is becoming increasingly fatigued, spends more time in bed, and is less able to engage with, and direct, her family. Her pain is being managed intensively, and the medica- tions prescribed have caused cognitive impair- ment. It is expected that as her body becomes tolerant to the medication, her cognition will improve. Her family is becoming increasingly distressed; wanting her to be more awake, physically active, and cognitively clear. They are angry with the palliative care doctor,

because they perceive his lack of expertise in prescribing as the reason for her cognitive im- pairment. Diagnostic assessment indicates that the symptom of fatigue refl ects irreversible, progressive kidney failure. Social work inter- ventions include:

• Reviewing the family’s perception and un- derstanding of the status of disease

• Exploring various factors that might inform the anger expressed at the physician, includ- ing a lack of understanding of the process of trialing and adjusting pain medications, racial tensions or misunderstandings, and fear that patient is being harmed rather than helped

• Exploring the symbolic signifi cance and at- tributed meaning of the symptoms of pain and confusion to understand the impact on family of viewing their mother as confused and unavailable to them

• Assisting the family to integrate medical information by organizing a family meet- ing with the team, eliciting and exploring their own observations of the changes in the patient’s condition

• Working with medical staff to prepare the family for the probability that Mrs. D will become increasingly sleepy and that, as she clears cognitively, they will need to value and maximize the time that she is awake and able to interact

• Acknowledging and exploring the individual and family response to this potential loss, and reinforcing community and spiritual supports that might be helpful to them

• Acknowledging the changing family struc- ture as a loss experience, and assisting the family to consider how to move forward with roles and responsibilities

Mrs. D’s narrative portrays how a multi- dimensional view of symptoms can be at the core of the assessment and intervention pro- cess. Each individual and family experiences symptoms in the context of either a chronic or potentially life-threatening illness and through their own unique history and family

JWBT514_ch22.indd 613JWBT514_ch22.indd 613 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

614 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

constellation. The next narrative takes the same symptoms—pain, fatigue, and cognitive impairment—but demonstrates how the etiol- ogy, impact, symbolic signifi cance, and result- ing interventions may differ.

Case Example

Mrs. J is a 35-year-old married mother of three children, ages 3 to 8. She has back pain that is often debilitating and interferes with her ability to parent, work, and participate in an intimate relationship with her husband. She is engaged in a multimodal treatment plan that includes medication trials, physical therapy, and cognitive-behavioral therapy. As directed by her doctor, she gradually has raised the dose of opioid medications and experiences in- creased side effects of fatigue, sleepiness, and cognitive slowing. Her husband and extended family worry that she is too impaired to care for her children, who appear to be increasingly “out of control.” Her sister-in-law, who is not aware that she is receiving opioids for pain, interprets her behaviors as symptoms of drug addiction, and reports the family to child pro- tective services.

In this context, Mrs. J’s symptoms are med- ication side effects that precipitate an emer- gency situation stemming from her decreased ability to function. It compromises the safety of her family, and results in trauma and fam- ily confl ict consequent to the charge of child endangerment. A proactive and preventive ap- proach from the pain management team might have prevented the deleterious outcome. The social work plan included:

• Assessment of the relationship among the children’s behaviors, Mrs. J’s symptoms and side effects, and the increased family tensions

• Intervention with the family and child pro- tective services to address the needs of the children and ensure the family’s ability to provide support and supervision as medica- tions are stabilized

• In consultation with Mrs. J, a meet- ing with family members, including the

sister-in-law, to educate them about the dif- ferences among addiction, tolerance, and physical dependence, and behaviors related to medication side effects

• Engagement with family members as in- formed supports and participants in a plan of care that would involve multimodal treatments, including ongoing medication trials and titration of medications

VULNERABLE POPULATIONS AND DIVERSE SETTINGS

Undertreatment of pain is a multifaceted problem that involves educational, regula- tory, and reimbursement barriers as well as beliefs, values, and behaviors that impact the individual’s relationship to pain, medications, and health-care professionals. Poorly con- trolled pain causes unnecessary suffering for many, and particular groups have been iden- tifi ed as more vulnerable. The risk of under- treatment increases when assessment of pain becomes more of a challenge; for example, for those who have language or cultural differ- ences and for infants, children, older persons, and people who are cognitively impaired or have mental illness (American Pain Society, 2003). Many of the barriers to pain manage- ment are psychosocial, political, spiritual, or cultural in nature and thus become appropriate foci for social work assessment and interven- tion (Altilio, 2004; Parker-Oliver, Wittenberg- Lyles, Washington, & Sehrawat, 2009).

Social work’s heritage of service, commit- ment to justice, and advocacy for oppressed groups demands that we develop the ability to recognize and advocate for populations whose vulnerability and sense of impotence may be intensifi ed by pain, illness, and the inherent continuing diffi culty in accessing care from a health-care system that can be unresponsive (Mendenhall, 2003).

Geriatrics

Geriatric social work clinicians share responsi- bility for highlighting and solving the problem

JWBT514_ch22.indd 614JWBT514_ch22.indd 614 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Pain Management and Palliative Care 615

of unnecessary suffering in older persons caused by unrecognized and uncontrolled symptoms, including pain and depression (Beekman et al., 2002; Bernabei et al., 1998; Fox, Raina, & Jadad, 1999; Jerant, Azari, Nesbitt, & Meyers, 2004; Liao & Ferrell, 2000). Older people may expe- rience multiple chronic illnesses over time that impact their quality of life as well as the lives of their family and caregivers. Uncontrolled pain can lead to depression and other mood disor- ders, agitation, social isolation, sleeplessness, decreased function, loss of appetite, and risk of falls (American Geriatric Society Panel on Persistent Pain in Older Persons, 2002; Stein, 2001; WHO, 2004). Older people often believe that pain is to be expected and, when asked, may not acknowledge “pain” but willingly af- fi rm “aches” or “soreness.” Additional barriers include myths and misunderstanding regarding addiction and worry about cost and side effects of medications. The focus of assessment often extends beyond physical pain to existential is- sues, such as the mortality of self and friends and the meaning and purpose of life. In this vulnerable population, cognitive impairment can complicate the expression, assessment, and management of pain and increase the clinical team’s responsibility to adapt assessment and treatment for chronic conditions, such as osteo- porosis, or for life-threatening illnesses (Sachs, Shega, & Cox-Hayley, 2004; Stein, 2001).

Palliative care and chronic pain interven- tions require accommodation of the particular needs of older people at the individual level by adapting assessment to functional limitations, such vision or hearing limitations. At the level of group, community, or society, social work- ers are charged to construct alternate palliative care models to respond to those who require care over the course of chronic, slowly pro- gressing illnesses (Jerant et al., 2004).

Gender Issues

A person’s experience with and response to pain is infl uenced by multiple factors, includ- ing gender. Men and women experience pain differently; research suggests that women are more likely to be inadequately treated both

in chronic pain settings (Hoffman & Tarzian, 2001) and in the case of illnesses such as can- cer and AIDS (Breitbart et al., 1995; Cleeland et al., 1994). The study of gender-based dif- ference in pain includes consideration of such complex areas as:

• Biological factors, such as mechanisms re- lated to opioid receptors, sympathetic nervous system function, and hormonal infl uence

• Psychological factors, such as cognitive ap- praisal and attributed meaning

• Behavioral responses, such as coping mech- anisms; communication styles; and health- related activities, such as seeking care and taking medications

• Cultural and socialization factors that im- pact reactions, perceptions, thoughts, and behaviors on both the part of the patient and health-care practitioners (Unruh, 1996)

Although etiology and causation are not well understood, current research suggests that the pain reports of women are taken less seri- ously than those of men, that women’s pain is more likely to be discounted as emotional or psychogenic, and that women receive less aggressive treatment (Fillingim, 2005; Interna- tional Association for the Study of Pain, 2009). This disparity violates the ethical principles of justice and respect for the dignity and worth of the individual (Hoffman & Tarzian, 2001). Keefe and colleagues (2000) report signifi cant differences in pain, pain behavior, and physi- cal disability between men and women with osteoarthritis. Of note, when “catastrophiz- ing” the experience was considered, the previ- ously signifi cant effect of gender disappeared. Gender differences in expression of pain were found in a classic early study in which males reported signifi cantly less pain to female ex- perimenters than they did to male experiment- ers (Levine & De Simone, 1991).

Minority Populations

In 2001, Bonham reviewed multiple stud- ies documenting disparities in pain treatment by race, ethnicity, and socioeconomic status.

JWBT514_ch22.indd 615JWBT514_ch22.indd 615 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

616 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Although reports are somewhat inconsistent, substantial evidence exists to support the troubling conclusion that persons belonging to racial and ethnic minority groups are less likely to receive adequate treatment for acute and chronic pain (Anderson et al., 2000; An- derson, Green, & Payne, 2009; Bonham, 2001; Cleeland et al., 1994; Dannemiller Memorial Educational Foundation, 2004). Variables that underlie these disparities are multifactorial and may exist on the clinician, patient, family, or institutional level. They range from poor com- munication, mistrust, racism, and economic or educational disadvantage, to a health-care system that supports disengagement, lack of continuity of care, and fails to allow suffi cient time in clinical encounters to bridge differ- ences and enhance trust.

In addition, language differences can in- tensify misunderstanding and increase anxiety consequent to the patient’s inability to comfort- ably communicate his or her needs to health- care professionals. Evidence also suggests that inner-city pharmacies do not stock the opioids used to treat moderate to severe pain, creating an additional challenge for an already disad- vantaged group. Informed social workers can assist their patients and colleagues to prevent crises by encouraging patients to contact their pharmacies to ensure that prescribed medica- tions are available or to make alternate plans to secure them (Morrison, Wallenstein, Natale, Senzel, & Huang, 2000).

Substance Abuse

It is estimated that between 6% and 15% of the U.S. population has a substance use disor- der that may involve the abuse of illicit drugs or misuse of prescription medications (Collier & Kopstein, 1991; Groerer & Brodsky, 1992; Zachny et al., 2003; see Chapter 17 for more information). Some medications used in the management of chronic pain and in palliative care are controlled substances. These and other classes of medications have the potential for abuse and diversion, creating a heightened vig- ilance when pain medications are prescribed for patients known to abuse drugs. Treatment

of patients with a current or remote history of addiction is impacted by clinical, social, regu- latory, and policy challenges such as:

• Confusion and lack of understanding of these terms:

• Addiction. A primary, chronic, neuro- biological disease with genetic, psy- chosocial, and environmental factors infl uencing its development and mani- festations. It is characterized by be- haviors that include one or more of the following: impaired control over drug use, compulsive use, continued use de- spite harm, and craving. Use despite harm includes harm in the physical, emotional, or social arenas as well as harm to relationships, including relation- ships with providers. At times, behav- iors suggestive of addiction are actually relief-seeking behaviors that dissipate after pain is managed.

• Physical dependence. A state of adapta- tion that is manifested by a drug-class- specifi c withdrawal syndrome that can be produced by abrupt cessation, rapid dose reduction, decreasing blood level of the drug, or administration of an antagonist. Physical dependence may develop with chronic use of many classes of medica- tions. These include beta-blockers, cor- ticosteroids, antidepressants, and other medications that are not associated with addictive disorders.

• Tolerance. A state of adaptation in which exposure to a drug induces changes that result in a diminution of one or more of the drug’s effects over time. Tolerance may occur to both the desired and unde- sired effects of drugs and may develop at different rates for different effects. For example, in the case of opioids, tol- erance usually develops more slowly to analgesia than to respiratory depression, and tolerance to the constipating effects may not occur at all. In many instances, this dynamic of diminishing effect is due to progression of disease rather than to tolerance to a medication.

JWBT514_ch22.indd 616JWBT514_ch22.indd 616 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Pain Management and Palliative Care 617

• Pseudoaddiction. A term used to describe behaviors that may occur when pain is un- dertreated. Patients with unrelieved pain may become focused on obtaining medi- cations, “clock watch,” or request specifi c medications that they have found helpful in the past. Pseudoaddiction can be dis- tinguished from true addiction in that the behaviors resolve when pain is treated effectively (www.ampainsoc.org/advocacy /opioids2.htm)

• Providers’ fear of the processes and conse- quences of prescribing opioid analgesics, which has been referred to as opiophobia (Morgan, 1986; Shine & Demas, 1984).

• Fear of regulatory, law enforcement, and medical board scrutiny.

• Patient’s, family’s, and clinician’s fears of causing relapse or activating a latent addic- tive disease.

• Worry about potential diversion.

• Lack of time, skill, and interdisciplinary support needed to assess, treat, and monitor the care of people with pain and problem- atic drug use behaviors.

Many people with the disease of addiction have multiple medical problems and conse- quently can be quite symptomatic. They often are marginalized and have few advocates (Otis- Green & Rutland, 2004). Those who used substances early in life may not have learned behaviors or skills that allow them to negoti- ate health-care systems. As a group, they may have no power base or political infl uence and often have alienated friends and family. They require expert and respectful treatment of their addiction or problematic drug-use behaviors as well as symptom management that maximizes benefi t and diminishes harmful outcomes. Al- though experts in these dual fi elds of addic- tion and pain management are few, guidance is available through many resources that are eas- ily accessible through the Internet. A treatment program requires expert assessment, structure, consistency, and psychosocial and psycho- logical interventions to create a treatment plan that maximizes the opportunity for successful

treatment of both pain and addictive disease and creates an environment of safety for pa- tients, families, and prescribers. See Chapter 17 for a full discussion of substance use issues.

Policy Issues: Opportunity for Advocacy and Leadership

In 1998, the National Institutes of Health (NIH) estimated the fi nancial impact of poorly treated pain to be in excess of $100 billion a year, including the costs of health care, com- pensation, and litigation. Above and beyond the multilevel impact of poorly treated pain on the quality of life of individuals and their fami- lies lie the fi nancial implications of a public health problem of signifi cant proportions.

For example, while the standard of care in both pain and palliative care is a multidimen- sional approach with a strong emphasis on psy- chosocial needs, reimbursement is insuffi cient to support this level of care. There is a need to collaborate with insurers and legislators to ad- vocate for research funding and to document the potential impact of pain and palliative care interventions on the quality and cost of care for patients, families, and caregivers. This care often is provided at considerable physical, fi nancial, and emotional cost to caregivers and ultimately to the heath-care system (Levine, 2004). Legis- lative efforts range from pain management bills that mandate professional education to those that recommend monitoring programs that re- quire prescribers to submit patient prescription information to a central database. Although the goal is to decrease abuse and diversion of pre- scription medications, this program challenges core social work and human values, such as pri- vacy, self-determination, autonomy, and confi - dentiality. These legislative efforts are rich areas for social work involvement. Whether as clini- cians, advocates, community organizers, policy planners, or researchers, the need for a social work presence is critical.

Interdisciplinary and Transdisciplinary Team

An interdisciplinary team approach involv- ing health-care providers from a number of

JWBT514_ch22.indd 617JWBT514_ch22.indd 617 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

618 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

professions is central to optimal palliative care practice (Lickiss, Turner, & Pollock, 2004; NCP, 2009; WHO, 1990) and is at the core of chronic pain care. In contrast to a multidisciplinary approach in which differ- ent professionals independently provide care, “interdisciplinary practice refers to people with distinct disciplinary training working together for a common purpose, as they make different, complementary contributions to pa- tient-focused care” (McCallin, 2001, p. 419). A team addresses patients’ and family mem- bers’ needs—biological, psychological, emo- tional, social, and spiritual—by providing the dual benefi t of specialized knowledge and skills from multiple professionals de- livered in combination rather in isolation. Characterized by a collaborative effort that includes information exchange and coordi- nated care planning, it places the patient and family at the center of team deliberations and maximizes the unique contributions of each member (Connor, Egan, Kwilosz, Larson, & Reese, 2002; Loscalzo & Von Gunten, 2009). Intervention techniques, such as family con- ferences that include patients, family mem- bers, and health-care team members, promote such coordinated interdisciplinary practice (Fineberg, 2010).

Some highly coordinated palliative care teams may be using a transdisciplinary approach. The transdisciplinary team is characterized by substantial overlap in functions such that mem- bers share roles in addition to providing their discipline-specifi c contributions to the team. Al- though team professionals are not interchange- able, they share responsibilities for assessing and addressing patient and family care issues.

In transdisciplinary work, roles of the individ- ual team members are blurred as their profes- sional functions overlap. Each team member must become suffi ciently familiar with the con- cepts and approaches of his or her colleagues to be able to assume signifi cant portions of the others’ roles. (Hall & Weaver, 2001, p. 868)

The team approach requires profession- als to act both as unique contributors and as team members. This dual role may be very

challenging to health-care providers but of- fers a very powerful form of care. Team members, while readily able to verbalize and explain their roles both to other team mem- bers and to patients and families, are at the same time fl exible in practicing their profes- sional roles and careful not to compromise patient and family care due to overly guarded application of their professional “turf” (Otis- Green & Fineberg, 2010). Turf issues should be discussed openly so that they can be dis- armed and minimized. In the setting of eco- nomic strains in health care, team members may be especially guarded about their turf in service of job security.

Teams that function well develop effective communication and mutual trust (Blacker & Deveau, 2010; Maddocks, 2006). Coordinated function is important for minimizing the confl ict- ing and confusing transmission of information to patients and families, especially in the sen- sitive context of palliative and end-of-life care. Teams benefi t when members engage in inten- tional team-building efforts, such as becoming more familiar with each other, acknowledging differences and similarities in perspectives, ad- dressing confl ict respectfully and openly, and developing nonhierarchical patterns of com- munication (Otis-Green & Fineberg, 2010). The latter activity is especially challenging in the health-care setting in which the biomedical model imposes a hierarchical perspective.

Self-Care

Practitioners working in the arena of palliative care and pain management often witness the anger, sadness, and suffering of those for whom they care, especially in situations in which pa- tients are facing chronic pain or the end of life (Speck, 2006). In addition to clinical work with patients and families, institutional and setting- specifi c practices and perceptions and complex ethical dilemmas can be a source of stress, job dissatisfaction, and burnout (O’Donnell et al., 2008; Ulrich et al., 2007).

Social workers who remain with patients and their families throughout the course of treatment to the end of life can experience

JWBT514_ch22.indd 618JWBT514_ch22.indd 618 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Pain Management and Palliative Care 619

heavy emotional burdens, sometimes when disease-modifying treatments are continued and deemed to cause unnecessary suffer- ing and at other times when the goal of care changes exclusively to intensive and com- passionate comfort care. The emotional, ex- istential, and spiritual depth of social work practice is characterized by the profession’s use of self and the capacity to witness and “sit with” people’s pain and suffering (Arnd- Caddigan & Pozzuto, 2009; Renzenbrink, 2004). This intensely personal and deep in- volvement on the part of clinicians demands conscious and candid attention to how they are preventing compassion fatigue, espe- cially in the long term. Challenges for all practitioners include maintaining delicate professional boundaries in which investment and attachment to patients and family mem- bers is genuine, but not overly consuming. This balance of closeness and distance al- lows clinicians to provide sincere, meaning- ful, skilled care that is not so depleting that it causes practitioner burnout or compassion fatigue (Renzenbrink, 2004). Social workers who experience burnout and compassion fa- tigue typically report frustration with chal- lenges within their environments of care and experiencing an unbalanced practice in the long term that has worn away their internal emotional resources to the point of apathy and inability to provide empathetic, dedi- cated care (Otis-Green, 2011).

Self-care requires maintaining balance between the personal and professional in the larger context of a social worker’s life. Cli- nicians must develop and preserve boundar- ies between their professional and personal selves. This does not suggest an artifi cial separation, but rather a concerted effort to develop a rich personal life of relationships, interests, hobbies, and activities that are not related to work and an ability to enjoy one’s personal time without having frequent intrud- ing thoughts about work. Engagement in such a personal life, subtly full of life-affi rming activities, becomes important for the rejuve- nation of the self and the ability to continue practice over time.

CONCLUSION

The inclusion of palliative care and pain man- agement in this book validates the emerging presence and potential infl uence of social work in these specialties. Palliative care has been a professional focus in England since the 1960s, as evidenced by the writings of Monroe (2004), Saunders (2001), and Sheldon (1999, 2000). In the United States, we see a burgeon- ing presence of social work in palliative care following in the footsteps of physicians and nurses. Social work presence in the specialty of pain management is limited and has yet to fully emerge.

The research of Sieppert (1996) and the work of Christ and Sormanti (1999) and Ray- mer and Csikai (2005) demonstrate the need for education, research, and leadership in both chronic pain and palliative care. The Social Work Summit on End-of-Life and Palliative Care, held in 2002 and 2005 (Altilio, Gardia, & Otis-Green, 2008), addresses the need for collaboration among practitioners, educators, and researchers.

The formalized curricula represented by Education of Physicians in End-of-Life Care and End-of-Life Nursing Education Consor- tium recently have been joined by the Social Work End-of-Life Curriculum Project (Raymer & Csikai, 2005), the ACE Project (Advocat- ing for Clinical Excellence: Transdisciplinary Palliative Care Education), and the Promoting Excellence in Pain Management and Palliative Care for Social Workers courses (Otis-Green & Ferrell, 2010). In addition to the postgraduate certifi cate programs offered at the New York University Silver School of Social Work and Smith College School of Social Work, organi- zations such as Cancer Care, the National Asso- ciation of Social Workers, and the Association of Oncology Social Workers have created ad- ditional comprehensive continuing education courses, many of which are available online. Since the 1970s, social work authors (Altilio, 2005, 2008; Glajchen, Blum, & Calder, 1995; Hudgens, 1977; Loscalzo & Amendola, 1990; Mendenhall, 2003; Roy, 1981; Subramanian & Rose, 1988) and advocates, including Yvette

JWBT514_ch22.indd 619JWBT514_ch22.indd 619 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

620 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Colón and Kristina Thomson, have champi- oned and encouraged social work expertise in pain management. The Leadership Develop- ment Award, offered to social workers by the Soros Foundation Project on Death in Amer- ica, focuses on end-of-life and palliative care and includes pain and symptom management as core skills for social work clinicians. The inclusion of these specialties in this Handbook further validates the role, responsibility, and opportunity for social work clinicians in these areas of practice.

Since its inception, social work has champi- oned important values, including justice, com- mitment to the underserved and the vulnerable, and respect for the integrity and worth of all human beings. The fi elds of pain management and palliative care are like a tapestry in which these values are woven into every aspect of the work. People who are living with life-limiting illness and/or chronic pain interface with a health-care system that is struggling to repair fractures and bridge deep crevices. They are potentially vulnerable and often underserved. We hope that this chapter helps to alert social workers to the myriad of possibilities and op- portunities to make a difference in the lives of these populations.

SUGGESTED LEARNING EXERCISES

Learning Exercise 22.1

Provide an example of how the skills and code of ethics every social worker learns can be translated to pain and palliative care social work practice.

Learning Exercise 22.2

Select a partner and conduct a role-play. One person takes the role of a patient in the hos- pital and the other of a hospital social worker called to assess why the patient is “so upset.” The patient informs the social worker that she has just learned that the treatment seems to be no longer effective and that she is not going

to live more than three months. Using infor- mation from this chapter and your social work classes, conduct a social work assessment of this patient and create a social work treatment plan for intervention.

Learning Exercise 22.3

Identify a community social worker working in pain management or palliative care, and interview this person about his or her work. Questions might include:

• How did you select this line of work? How long have you worked in this area of health social work practice?

• What are some examples of ethical dilem- mas that you have encountered working in this area of practice? How did you resolve them?

• How do you manage self-care and cope with challenging situations?

• What motivates you to do the work that you do?

• How do you work with other disciplinary professionals in your work setting or in the community?

REFERENCES

Altilio, T. (2002). Helping children, helping ourselves: An overview of children’s literature. In J. Loewy & A. F. Hara (Eds.), Caring for the caregiver: The use of music and music therapy in grief and trauma (pp. 138–146). Baltimore, MD: American Music Therapy Association.

Altilio, T. (2004). Pain and symptom management: An essential role for social workers. In J. Berzoff & P. Silverman (Eds.), Living with dying (pp. 380–408). New York, NY: Columbia University Press.

Altilio, T. (2005). Social work. In M. Boswell & B. Cole (Eds.), Weiner’s pain management: A practical guide for clinicians (7th ed., pp. 239–247). New York, NY: Taylor & Francis.

Altilio, T. (2008). Pain. In T. Mizrahi & L. E. David (Eds.), Encyclopedia of social work, 20th ed. (pp. 335–337). New York, NY: NASW Press/Oxford University Press.

Altilio, T., Gardia, G., & Otis-Green, S. (2008). The state of social work practice. In S. Blacker, G. Christ, & S. Lynch (Eds.), Charting the course for the future

JWBT514_ch22.indd 620JWBT514_ch22.indd 620 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Pain Management and Palliative Care 621

of social work in end-of-life and palliative care: A report of the 2nd Social Work Summit on End-of-Life and Palliative Care [Special report of the Social Work in Hospice and Palliative Care Network], pp. 10–14. Retrieved from www.swhpn.org/monograph.pdf

Altilio, T., & Otis-Green, S. (Eds.). (2011). Textbook of palliative social work. New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Altilio, T., Otis-Green, S., & Dahlin, C. M. (2008). Applying the National Quality Forum Preferred Practices for Palliative and Hospice Care: A social work perspective. Journal of Social Work in End-of- Life & Palliative Care, 4(1), 3–16.

Ambuel, B. (2000). Conducting a family conference. Principles and practice of supportive oncology updates, 3(3), 1–12.

American Geriatric Society Panel on Persistent Pain in Older Persons. (2002). The management of persistent pain in older persons. Journal of the American Geriatric Society, 50, 1–20.

American Pain Society. (2003). Principles of analgesic use in the treatment of acute and cancer pain (5th ed.). Glenview, IL: Author.

American Pain Society. (2005). Guideline for the management of cancer pain in adults and children. Glenview, IL: Author.

Anderson, K. O., Green, C., & Payne, R. (2009). Racial and ethnic disparities in pain: Causes and consequences of unequal care. Journal of Pain, 10(12), 1187–1204.

Anderson, K. O., Mendoza, T. R., Valero, V., Richman, S. P., Russell, C., Hurley, J., . . . Cleeland, C. S. (2000). Minority cancer patients and their providers: Pain management attitudes and practices. Cancer, 88(8), 1929–1938.

Arnd-Caddigan, M., & Pozzuto, R. (2009). The virtuous social worker: The role of “thirdness” in ethical decision making. Families in Society, 90(3), 323–328.

Atkinson, J. H., Jr., Stewart, N., & Gardner, D. (1980). The family meeting in critical care settings. Journal of Trauma, 20(1), 43–46.

Babcock, E. N. (1997). When life becomes precious: A guide for loved ones and friends of cancer patients. New York, NY: Bantam Books.

Barkwell, D. P. (1991). Ascribed meaning: A critical factor in coping and pain attenuation in patients with cancer related pain. Journal of Palliative Care, 7, 5–14.

Beauchamp, T., & Childress, J. (1989). Principles of biomedical ethics. New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Beekman, A. T., Geerlings, S. W., Deeg, D. J., Smit, J. J., Schoevers, R. S., deBeurs, E., . . . van Tilburg, W. (2002). The natural history of late life depression: A 6-year prospective study in the community. Archives of General Psychiatry, 59, 605–611.

Beiske, A. G., Loge, J. H., Ronningen, A., & Svennson, E. (2009). Pain in Parkinson’s disease: Prevalence and characteristics. Pain, 141(1), 173–177.

Benson, H. (1975). The relaxation response. New York, NY: Avon.

Berlin, S. B. (2001). Clinical social work: A cognitive- integrative perspective. London, UK: Oxford University Press.

Bernabei, R., Gambassi, G., Lapane, K., Landi, F., Gatsonis, C., Dunlop, R., . . . Mor, V. (1998). Management of pain in elderly patients with cancer. JAMA, 279, 1877– 1882.

Blacker, S., & Deveau, C. (2010). Social work and interprofessional collaboration in palliative care. Progress in Palliative Care, 18(4), 237–246.

Bonham, V. L. (2001). Race, ethnicity and pain treatment: Striving to understand the causes and solutions to the disparities in pain treatment. Journal of Law, Medicine, and Ethics, 29, 52–68.

Bradley, L. A. (1996) Cognitive behavioral therapy for chronic pain. In R. Gatchel & D. C. Turk (Eds.), Psychological approaches to pain management: A practitioners’ handbook (pp. 131–147). New York, NY: Guilford Press.

Breitbart, W., Rosenfeld, B. D., Passik, S. D., McDonald, M. V., Thaler, H., & Portenoy, R. (1995). The undertreatment of pain in ambulatory AIDS patients. Pain, 65(2/3), 243–249.

Broome, M. E., Rehwaldt, M., & Fogg, L. (1998). Relationship between cognitive behavioral techniques, temperament, observed distress and pain reports in children and adolescents during lumbar puncture. Journal of Pediatric Nursing, 13(1), 48–54.

Cassell, E. J. (1991). Recognizing suffering. Hastings Center Report (May/June), 24–31.

Center to Advance Palliative Care. (2008). Palliative Care FAQ. Retrieved from www.capc.org/reportcard /faq

Christ, G., & Sormanti, M. (1999). Advanced social work practice in end-of-life care. Social Work in Health Care, 30(2), 81–99.

Cleeland, C. S., Gonin, R., Harfi eld, A. K., Edmonson, J. H., Blum, R., Stewart, J. A., & Pandya, K. J. (1994). Pain and its treatment in outpatients with metastatic cancer. New England Journal of Medicine, 330, 592–596.

Collier, J. D., & Kopstein, A. N. (1991). Trends in cocaine abuse refl ected in emergency room episodes reported to DAWN. Public Health Report, 106, 59–68.

Collins, J. J., Byrnes, M. E., Dunkel, I., Lapin, J., Nadel, T., Thaler, H. T. & Portenoy, R. K. (2000). The measurement of symptoms in children with cancer. Journal of Pain and Symptom Management, 19(5), 363–370.

Connor, S. R., Egan, K. A., Kwilosz, D. M., Larson, D. G., & Reese, D. J. (2002). Interdisciplinary approaches to assisting with end-of-life care and decision making. American Behavioral Scientist, 46, 340–356.

Crawley, L. V., Marshall, P. A., Lo, B., & Koenig, B. A. (2002). Strategies for culturally effective end of life care. Annals of Internal Medicine, 136, 673–679.

JWBT514_ch22.indd 621JWBT514_ch22.indd 621 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

622 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Curtis, J. R., Patrick, D. L., Shannon, S. E., Treece, P. D., Engelberg, R. A., & Rubenfeld, G. D. (2001). The family conference as a focus to improve communication about end-of-life care in the intensive care unit: Opportunities for improvement. Critical Care Medicine, 29(Suppl.), N26–N33.

Dannemiller Memorial Educational Foundation. (2004). The role of race, ethnicity and gender in the treatment of pain. Pain Report, 7, 9–11.

Devine, E. C. (2003). Meta-analysis of the effect of psychoeducational interventions on pain in adults with cancer. Oncology Nursing Forum, 30(1), 75–89.

Eller, L. S. (1999) Guided imagery interventions for symptom management. Annual Review of Nursing Research, 17, 57–84.

Emanuel, E. J., & Emanuel, L. L. (1992). Proxy decision making for incompetent patients: An ethical and empirical analysis. JAMA, 267, 2067–2071.

Enders, S. (2004). End of life care in the prison system: Implications for social work. In J. Berzoff & P. Silverman (Eds.), Living with dying (pp. 609–627). New York, NY: Columbia University Press.

Erikson, E. (1963). Childhood and society. New York, NY: Norton.

Erstling, S. S., & Devlin, J. (1989). The single-session family interview. Journal of Family Practice, 28(5), 556–560.

Fillingim, R. B. (2005). Concise encyclopedia of pain psychology. New York, NY: Haworth Press.

Fineberg, I. C. (2010). Social work perspectives on family communication and family conferences in palliative care. Progress in Palliative Care, 18(4), 213–220.

Fineberg, I. C., & Bauer, A. (2011). Families and family conferencing. In T. Altilio & S. Otis-Green (Eds.), Textbook of palliative social work (pp. 235–250). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Ford, B. (1998). Pain in Parkinson’s disease. Clinical Neuroscience, 5, 63–72.

Forman, W. B. (1998). The evolution of hospice and palliative medicine. In A. Berger, R. Portenoy, & D. Weissman (Eds.), Principles and practice of supportive oncology (pp. 735–739). New York, NY: Lippincott-Raven.

Fox, P. L., Raina, P., & Jadad, A. R. (1999). Prevalence and treatment of pain in older adults in nursing homes and other long term care institutions: A systematic review. Canadian Medical Association Journal, 160, 329–333.

Frankl, V. E. (1984). Man’s search for meaning. New York, NY: Simon & Schuster.

Frich, L. M., & Borgbjerg, F. M. (2000). Pain and pain treatment in AIDS patients: A longitudinal study. Journal of Pain and Symptom Management, 19(5), 339–347.

Gallo-Silver, L., & Pollack, B. (2000). Behavioral interventions for lung cancer-related breathlessness. Cancer Practice, 8(6), 268–273.

Glajchen, M. (2003). Role of family caregivers in cancer pain management. In E. Bruera & R. K. Portenoy (Eds.), Cancer pain (pp. 459–466). New York, NY: Cambridge University Press.

Glajchen, M. (2011). Caregivers in palliative care: Roles and responsibilities. In T. Altilio & S. Otis-Green (Eds.), Textbook of palliative social work (pp. 223– 234). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Glajchen, M., Blum, D., & Calder, K. (1995). Cancer pain management and the role of social work: Barriers and interventions. Health & Social Work, 20(3), 200–206.

Goetz, C. G., Tanner, C. M., Levy, M., Wilson, R. S., & Garron, D. C. (1986). Pain in Parkinson’s disease. Movement Disorders, 1(1), 45–49.

Graffam, S., & Johnson, A. (1987). A comparison of two relaxation strategies for the relief of pain and distress. Journal of Pain and Symptom Management, 2, 229– 231.

Groerer, J., & Brodsky, M. (1992). The incidence of illicit substance use in the United States, 1962–1989. British Journal of Addiction, 87, 1345.

Grossman, S. A., Sheidler, V. R., Swedeen, K., Mucenski, J., & Piantadosi, S. (1991). Correlation of patient and caregiver rating of cancer pain. Journal of Pain and Symptom Management, 6, 53–57.

Hall, P., & Weaver, L. (2001). Interdisciplinary education and teamwork: A long and winding road. Medical Education, 35, 867–875.

Hansen, P., Cornish, P., & Kayser, K. (1998). Family conferences as forums for decision making in hospital settings. Social Work in Health Care, 27(3), 57–74.

Harpham, W. S. (2004). When a parent has cancer: A guide to caring for your children. New York, NY: HarperCollins.

Hart, P. D. (2003). Americans Talk about Pain. Available from Peter D. Hart Research Associates, retrieved from www.researchamerica.org/uploads/poll2003pain .pdf

Heiney, S., Hermann, J., Bruss, K., & Fincannon, J. (2000). Cancer in the family: Helping children cope with a parent’s illness. Atlanta, GA: American Cancer Society.

Hoffman, D. E., & Tarzian, A. J. (2001). The girl who cried pain: A bias against women in the treatment of pain. Journal of Law, Medicine and Ethics, 29, 13–27.

Holland, J. C., Breitbart, W. S., Jacobsen, P. B., Lederberg, M. S., Loscalzo, M. J., & McCorkle, R. (2010). Psycho-Oncology, 2nd ed. New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Hudgens, A. (1977). The social worker’s role in a behavioral management approach to chronic pain. Social Work in Health Care, 3, 149–157.

Hudson, P., Thomas, T., Quinn, K., & Aranda, S. (2009). Family meetings in palliative care: Are they effective? Palliative Medicine, 23(2), 150–157.

Hultman, T., Reder, E. R., & Dahlin, C. (2008). Improving psychological and psychiatric aspects of palliative

JWBT514_ch22.indd 622JWBT514_ch22.indd 622 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Pain Management and Palliative Care 623

care: The National Consensus Project and the National Quality Forum Preferred Practices for Palliative and Hospice Care. Omega-Journal of Death and Dying, 57(4), 323–339.

Im, E., Chee, W., Guevara, E., Liu, Y., Lim, H., & Tsai, H., . . . Shin, H. (2007). Gender and ethnic differences in cancer pain experience: A multiethnic study in the United States. Nursing Research, 56(5), 296–306.

Institute of Medicine. (2001). Crossing the Quality Chasm. Washington, DC: National Academies Press.

Institute of Medicine. (2003). When Children Die: Improving Palliative and End-of-Life Care for Children and Their Families. Washington, DC: National Academies Press.

International Association for the Study of Pain. (2009). Psychosocial interventions for cancer pain. Retrieved from www.iasp-pain.org/AM/Template.cfm?Section =Home&Template=/CM/ContentDisplay.cfm& ContentID=7193

International Association for the Study of Pain. (2010). IASP pain terminology. Retrieved from www.iasp-pain .org/AM/Template.cfm?Section=Pain_Defi.isplay .cfm&ContentID=1728#Pain

Jacobsen, P. (2007). Screening for psychological distress in cancer patients: Challenges and opportunities. Journal of Clinical Oncology, 25(29), 4526–4527.

Jacobsen, P., & Hann, D. M. (1998). Cognitive behavioral interventions in psycho-oncology. In J. Holland (Ed.), Psycho-oncology (pp. 717–729). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Jerant, A. F., Azari, R. S., Nesbitt, T. S., & Meyers, F. J. (2004). The TLC model of palliative care in the elderly: Preliminary application in the assisted living setting. Annals of Family Medicine, 2, 54–60.

Joint Commission. (2010). Advancing effective commu- nication, cultural competence, and patient-and family- centered care: A roadmap for hospitals. Oakbrook Terrace, IL: Author.

Kagawa-Singer, M., & Blackhall, L. J. (2001). Negotiating cross cultural issues at the end of life “You got to go where he lives.” JAMA, 286(23), 2993–3002.

Kass, L. (1983). Professing ethically: On the place of ethics in defi ning medicine. JAMA, 249(10), 1305– 1310.

Keefe, F. J. , Lefebvre, J. C., Egert, J. R., Affl eck, G., Sullivan, M. J., & Caldwell, D. S. (2000). The relationship of gender to pain, pain behavior, and disability in osteoarthritis patients: The role of catastrophizing. Pain, 87(3), 325–334.

Kelly, P., & Clifford, P. (1997). Coping with chronic pain: Assessing narrative approaches. Social Work, 42(3), 266–277.

Kerr, K. (2000). Relaxation techniques: A critical review. Critical Reviews in Physical and Rehabilitation Medicine, 121, 51–89.

Kirsch, I., Montgomery, G., & Saperstein, G. (1995). Hypnosis as an adjunct to cognitive-behaviorial

psychotherapy: A meta-analysis. Journal of Consulting and Clinical Psychology, 63(2), 214–220.

Koenig, B., & Gates-Williams, J. (1995). Understanding cultural differences in caring for dying patients. Western Journal of Medicine, 163, 244–249.

Koffman, J., Morgan, M., Edmonds, F., Speck, P., & Higginson, I. (2008). Cultural meanings of pain: A qualitative study of Black Caribbean and White British patients with advanced cancer. Journal of Palliative Medicine, 22, 350–359.

Koppelman, K. (2003). For those who stand and wait. In G. R. Cox, R. A. Bendiksen, & R. G. Stevenson (Eds.), Making sense of death: Spiritual, pastoral, and personal aspects of death, dying and bereavement (pp. 45–54). Amityville, NY: Baywood.

Kristjanson, L. J., & Aoun, S. (2004). Palliative care for families: Remembering the hidden patients. Canadian Journal of Psychiatry, 49, 359–365.

Kübler-Ross, E. (1969). On death and dying. New York, NY: Macmillan.

Kushner, K., Meyer, D., & Hansen, J. P. (1989). Patients’ attitudes toward physician involvement in family conferences. Journal of Family Practice, 28(1), 73–78.

Lautrette, A., Darmon, M., Megarbane, B., Joly, L. M., Chevret, S., Adrie, C., & Azoulay, E. (2007). A communication strategy and brochure for relatives of patients dying in the ICU. New England Journal of Medicine, 356, 469–478.

Lethborg, C., Aranda, S., Bloch, S., & Kissane, D. (2006). The role of meaning in advanced cancer-integrating the constructs of assumptive world, sense-of-coherence and meaning based coping. Journal of Psychosocial Oncology, 24(1), 27–42.

Levine, C. (2004). Always on call: When illness turns families into caregivers. New York, NY: Vanderbilt University Press.

Levine, F. M., & De Simone, L. L. (1991). The effects of experimenter gender on pain report in male and female subjects. Pain, 44(1), 69–72.

Liao, S., & Ferrell, B. A. (2000). Fatigue in an older population. Journal of American Geriatric Society, 49, 426–430.

Lickiss, J. N., Turner, K. S., & Pollock, M. L. (2004). The interdisciplinary team. In D. Doyle, G. Hanks, N. I. Cherny, & K. Calman (Eds.), Oxford textbook of palliative medicine (3rd ed., pp. 42–46). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Liebman, A., Silbergleit, I.-L., & Farber, S. (1975). Family conference in the care of the cancer patient. Journal of Family Practice, 2(5), 343–345.

Linder, J. F., & Enders, S. R. (2011). Key role for social workers in correctional palliative care. In T. Altilio & S. Otis-Green (Eds.), Textbook of palliative social work (pp. 153–168). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Lo, B. (2000). Resolving ethical dilemmas: A guide for clinicians. New York, NY: Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.

JWBT514_ch22.indd 623JWBT514_ch22.indd 623 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

624 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Lobchuk, M. M., & Degner, L.F. (2002). Symptom experiences: Perceptual accuracy between advanced- stage cancer patients and family caregivers in the home care setting. Journal of Clinical Oncology, 20(16), 3495–3507.

Loscalzo, M., & Amendola, J. (1990). Psychosocial and behavioral management of cancer pain: The social work contribution. In K. M. Foley, J. J. Bonica, & V. Ventafridda (Eds.), Advances in pain research and therapy (Vol. 16, pp. 429–442). New York, NY: Raven Press.

Loscalzo, M., & Jacobsen, P. (1990). Practical behavioral approaches to the effective management of pain and distress. Journal of Psychosocial Oncology, 8, 139–169.

Loscalzo, M. J., & Von Gunten, C. F. (2009). Interdisciplinary teamwork in palliative care: Compassionate care for serious complex illness. In H. M. Chochinov & W. Breitbart (Eds.), Handbook of psychiatry in palliative medicine (2nd ed., pp. 172– 185). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Luebbert, K., Dahme, B., & Hasenbring, M. (2001). The effectiveness of relaxation training in reducing treatment related symptoms and improving emotional adjustment in acute nonsurgical cancer treatment: A meta-analytical review. Psycho-Oncology, 10(6), 490–502.

Lynn, J., Schuster, J. L., & Kabcenell, A. (2000). Improving care for the end of life: A sourcebook for healthcare managers and clinicians. New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

MacDonald, J. E. (2000). A deconstructive turn in chronic pain treatment—A redefi ned role for social work. Health & Social Work, 25(1), 51–57.

Maddocks, I. (2006). Communication—an essential tool for team hygiene. In P. Speck (Ed.), Teamwork in palliative care: fulfi lling or frustrating? (pp. 137– 152). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

McCaffery, M., & Pasero, C. (1999). Pain: Clinical manual (2nd ed.). New York, NY: Mosby.

McCallin, A. (2001). Interdisciplinary practice: A matter of teamwork—An integrated literature review. Journal of Clinical Nursing, 10, 419–428.

McCaul, K. D., & Malott, J. M. (1984). Distraction and coping with pain. Psychology Bulletin, 95, 516–533.

McPhelimy, L. (1997). The checklist of life. Rockfall, CT: AAIP.

Mendenhall, T. (2003). Psychosocial aspects of pain management: A conceptual framework for social workers in pain management teams. Social Work in Health Care, 36(4), 5–51.

Meyer, D. L., Schneid, J. A., & Craigie, F. C. (1989). Family conferences: Reasons, levels of involvement and perceived usefulness. Journal of Family Practice, 29(4), 401–405.

Miaskowski, C., Zimmer, E. F., Barrett, K. M., Dibble, S. L., & Wallhagen, M. (1997). Difference in patient and family caregivers’ perceptions of the pain experience infl uence patient and caregiver outcomes. Pain, 72, 217–226.

Monroe, B. (2004). Social work in palliative medicine. In D. Doyle, G. W. C. Hanks, N. Cherny, & K. Calmen (Eds.), Oxford textbook of palliative medicine (3rd ed., pp. 1005–1017). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Montgomery, G. H., David, D., Winkel, G., Silverstein, J. H., & Bovbjerg, D. H. (2002). The effectiveness of adjunctive hypnosis with surgical patients: A meta- analysis. Anesthesia and Analgesia, 94(6), 1639–1645.

Morgan, J. P. (1986). American opiophobia: Customary underutilization of opioid analgesia. New York, NY: Hawthorne.

Morrison, R. S., Wallenstein, S., Natale, D. K., Senzel, R. S., & Huang, L. (2000). “We don’t carry that”: Failure of pharmacies in predominately nonwhite neighborhoods to stock opioid analgesics. New England Journal of Medicine, 342, 1023–1026.

National Association of Social Workers. (1999). Code of ethics. Retrieved from www.socialworkers.org/pubs /code.asp

National Association of Social Workers. (2009a). Certifi ed hospice and palliative social worker (CHP-SW) and advanced certifi ed hospice and palliative social worker (ACHP-SW). Retrieved from www.naswdc .org/credentials/credentials/chpsw.asp

National Association of Social Workers. (2009b). NASW standards for practice in palliative and end-of-life care. Retrieved from www.naswdc.org/practice/bereavement /standards/default.asp

National Cancer Institute. (2010) Pain: Physical and psychosocial interventions. Retrieved from www .cancer.gov/cancertopics/pdq/supportivecare/pain /HealthProfessional/page5

National Center for Health Statistics. (2006). Health, United States, 2006. Hyattsville, MD: U.S. Department of Health and Human Services.

National Consensus Project for Quality Palliative Care. (2004). Clinical practice guidelines executive summary. Retrieved from www.nationalconsensusproject.org

National Consensus Project for Quality Palliative Care. (2009). Clinical practice guidelines for quality palliative care, 2nd ed. Retrieved from http:// nationalconsensusproject.org

National Institutes of Health. (1998). New directions in pain research (PA98–102). Washington, DC: U.S. Government Printing Offi ce. Available from www .painfoundation.org/page_fastfacts.asp

National Quality Forum. (2006). A national framework and preferred practices for palliative and hospice care quality. Washington, DC: Author.

O’Donnell, P., Farrar, A., Brintzenhofeszoc, K., Conrad, A.P., Danis, M., Grady, C., & Ullrich, C. M. (2008) Predictors of ethical stress, moral action and job dissatisfaction in health care social workers. Social Work in Health Care, 46(3) 29–51.

Oregon Department of Health Services. (2008). Oregon Death with Dignity Act records & reports. Retrieved from www.oregon.gov/DHS/ph/pas/

JWBT514_ch22.indd 624JWBT514_ch22.indd 624 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

Pain Management and Palliative Care 625

Otis-Green, S. (2003). Legacy building. Smith Studies in Social Work, 73(3), 395–404.

Otis-Green, S. (2006). Psychosocial pain assessment form. In K. Dow (Ed.), Nursing care of women with cancer (pp. 556–561). St. Louis, MO: Elsevier Mosby.

Otis-Green, S. (2011). Embracing the existential invitation to examine care at the end of Life. In S. H. Quall & J. Kasl-Godley (Eds.), The Wiley Series in clinical geropsychology: End-of-life issues, grief and bereavement: What clinicians need to know (pp. 239– 311). Hoboken, NJ: Wiley.

Otis-Green, S., & Ferrell, B. R. (2010). Professional education in psychosocial oncology. In J. C. Holland, W. S. Breitbart, P. B. Jacobsen, M. S. Lederberg, M. J. Loscalzo, & R. McCorkle (Eds.), Psycho-Oncology (2nd ed., pp. 610–616). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Otis-Green, S., & Fineberg I. C. (2010). Enhancing team effectiveness. In B. Ferrell & N. Coyle (Eds.), Oxford textbook of palliative nursing (3rd ed., pp. 1225– 1235). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Otis-Green, S., & Rutland, C. (2004). Marginalization at the end of life. In J. Berzoff & P. Silverman (Eds.), Living with dying (pp. 462–481). New York, NY: Columbia University Press.

Otis-Green, S., Sherman, R., Perez, M., & Baird, P. (2002). An integrated psychosocial-spiritual model for cancer pain management. Cancer Practice, 10, S58–S65.

Parker-Oliver, D., Wittenberg-Lyles, E., Washington, K., & Sehrawat, S. (2009). Social work role in hospice pain management: A national survey. Journal of Social Work in End of Life and Palliative Care, 5(1–2), 51–74.

Pelligrino, E. (1979). Humanism and the physician. Knoxville, TN: University of Tennessee Press.

Puchalski, C., Ferrell, B., Virani, R., Otis-Green, S., Baird, P., Bull, J., & Sulmasy, D. (2009). Special report: Improving the quality of spiritual care as a dimension of palliative care: The report of the consensus conference. Journal of Palliative Medicine, 12(10), 885–905.

Raymer, M., & Csikai, E. (2005). Social workers educational needs in end-of-life care. Social Work in Health Care, 41(1), 53–72.

Redinbaugh, E. M., Baum, A., DeMoss, C., Fello, M., & Arnold, R. (2002). Factors associated with the accuracy of family caregiver estimates of patient’s pain. Journal of Pain and Symptom Management, 23, 31–38.

Renzenbrink, I. (2004). Relentless self-care. In J. Berzoff & P. R. Silverman (Eds.), Living with dying (pp. 848– 867). New York, NY: Columbia University Press.

Roff, S. (2001). Analyzing end of life care legislation: A social work perspective. Social Work in Health Care, 33(1), 51–68.

Roper Starch Worldwide. (1999). Chronic pain in America: Roadblocks to relief. Retrieved 2010 from www.ampainsoc.org/links/roadblocks/

Roy, R. (1981). Social work and chronic pain. Health & Social Work, 6(3), 54–62.

Sachs, G. A., Shega, J. W., & Cox-Hayley, D. (2004). Barriers to excellent end of life care for patients with dementia. Journal of General Internal Medicine, 19(10), 1057–1063.

Saunders, C. (1996). Hospice. Mortality, 1(3), 317–322.

Saunders, C. (2001). Social work and palliative care, the early history. British Journal of Social Work, 31, 791–799.

Schulz, R., & Beach, S. R. (1999). Caregiving as a risk factor for mortality: The caregiver health effects study. JAMA, 282(23), 2215–2219.

Sheikh, A. A. (1983). Imagery: Current theory, research and application. New York, NY: Wiley.

Sheldon, F. M. (1999). Education for social workers. In D. Doyle, G. W. C. Hanks, & N. McDonald (Eds.), Oxford textbook of palliative medicine (pp. 1209–1212). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Sheldon, F. M. (2000). Dimensions of the role of the social worker in palliative care. Palliative Medicine, 14, 491–498.

Shine, D., & Demas, P. (1984). Knowledge of medical students, residents and attending physicians about opioid abuse. Journal of Medical Education, 59, 501– 507.

Sieppert, J. D. (1996). Attitudes toward and knowledge of chronic pain—A survey of medical social workers. Health & Social Work, 21(2), 122–130.

Solaro, C., Brichetto, G., Amato, M. P., Cocco, E., Colombo, B., Daleo, G., . . . PaIMS Study Group. (2004). The prevalence of pain in multiple sclerosis: A multi-center cross sectional study. Neurology, 63, 919–921.

Speck, P. (2006). Maintaining a healthy team. In P. Speck (Ed.), Teamwork in palliative care: Fulfi lling or frustrating? (pp. 95–115). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Stein, W. (2001). Assessment of symptoms in the cognitively impaired. In E. Bruera & R. K. Portenoy (Eds.), Topics in palliative care (Vol. 5, pp. 123–133). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Sternbach, R. A. (1987). Mastering pain. New York, NY: Putnam Books.

Stewart, W. F., Ricci, J. A., Chee, E., Morganstein, D., & Lipton, R. (2003). Lost productive time and cost due to pain conditions in the U.S. workforce. JAMA, 290(18), 2443–2454.

Subramanian, K., & Rose, S. D. (1988). Social work and the treatment of chronic pain. Health & Social Work, 13(1), 49–60.

Syrjala, K. L., Donaldson, G. W., Davis, M. W., Kippes, M. E., & Carr, J. E. (1995). Relaxation and imagery and cognitive-behavioral training reduce pain during cancer treatment: A controlled clinical trial. Pain, 63(2), 189–198.

JWBT514_ch22.indd 625JWBT514_ch22.indd 625 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

626 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Tarzian, A. J., & Hoffman, D. E. (2004). Barriers to managing pain in the nursing home: Findings from a statewide survey. Journal of the American Medical Directors Association, 5(2), 82–88.

Ulrich, C., O’Donnell, C., Taylor, C., Farrar, A., Danis, M., & Grady, C. (2007). Ethical climate, ethics stress and the job satisfaction of nurses and social workers in the United States. Social Science and Medicine, 65, 1708–1719.

Unruh, A. (1996). Gender variations in clinical pain experience. Pain, 65, 123–167.

Van den Beulken-van Everdingen, M. H. J., de Rijke, J. M., Kessels, A. G., Schouten, H. C., van Kleef, M., & Patijn, J. (2007). Prevalence of pain in patients with cancer: A systematic review of the past 40 years. Annals of Oncology, 18(9), 1437–1449.

Von Roenn, J. H., Cleeland, C. S., Gonin, R., Hatfi eld, A. K., & Pandya, K. J. (1993). Physician attitudes and practice in cancer pain management: A survey from the Eastern Cooperative Oncology Group. Annals of Internal Medicine, 119, 121–126.

Washington State Department of Health. (2009). Washington State Death with Dignity Act. Retrieved from www.doh.wa.gov/dwda/

Winnicott, D. W. (1971). Objects and transitional phenomena in playing and reality. Harmondsworth, Middlesex, UK: Penguin Books.

World Health Organization. (1990). Cancer pain relief and palliative care (WHO Technical Report Series 804). Geneva, Switzerland: Author.

World Health Organization. (2004). Aging, pain, and cancer: The role of geriatrics. Oncology & Palliative Care, 17(1/2), 1–12.

World Health Organization. (n.d.). Defi nition of palliative care. Retrieved from www.who.int/cancer/palliative /defi nition/en/

Zachny, J., Bigelow, G., Compton, P., Foley, K., Iguchi, M., & Sannerud, C. (2003). College on Problems of Drug Dependence Taskforce on prescription opioid non-medical use and abuse: Position statement. Drug Alcohol Dependence, 69(3), 215–232.

JWBT514_ch22.indd 626JWBT514_ch22.indd 626 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

627

23

End-of-Life Care

YVETTE COLÓN

The purpose of this chapter is to provide basic knowledge about end-of-life social work prac- tice. Social workers can have a profound im- pact on the experiences of individuals at the end of their lives and on their families, loved ones, and other health providers. Increasingly, however, social workers are challenged to pro- vide services to the growing number of indi- viduals who need end-of-life care—children and adults who are chronically ill or have life- threatening conditions—as well as those who care for them. Often they are not prepared for the myriad complex issues involved in end-of- life practice. Despite their increasing involve- ment in providing important psychosocial services to dying individuals, social workers do not receive relevant training in their under- graduate and graduate programs.

Chapter Objectives • Defi ne end-of-life care. • Defi ne palliative care at the end of life. • Describe the roles that social workers can

play in end-of-life care. • Describe the importance of effective com-

munication so that patient and family needs are expressed and appropriate end-of-life care is facilitated.

• Understand the process of end-of-life plan- ning, including advance directives, to pro- mote informed choices and help patients and families to clarify and communicate their preferences.

• Demonstrate an understanding of factors that infl uence the death and dying experi- ence of cultural groups and disadvantaged persons at the end of life.

• Describe contemporary grief and loss theories.

The course of death and dying has changed tremendously in the past few decades be- cause of social and technological advances. Increases in average life expectancy due to advances in medical science and technology (National Center for Health Statistics, 2010) have infl uenced our beliefs and attitudes about life and death. The course of illness and dying has changed; at one time, the onset of illness and subsequent death from certain ill- nesses was sudden and rapid, but now the typi- cal death may be more prolonged. The place where death occurs has moved from the home or community to the hospital, nursing home, or institutional setting. These changes have posed enormous challenges in end-of-life and pallia- tive care.

PALLIATIVE CARE

Palliative care is an interdisciplinary care model that focuses on the comprehensive man- agement of physical, psychological, and exis- tential distress. It is defi ned as “the active total care of patients whose disease is not respon- sive to curative treatment.” Control of pain and other symptoms and psychological, social, and spiritual problems is paramount. “The goal of palliative care is the achievement of the best possible quality of life for patients and their families” (World Health Organization [WHO], 1990, p. 7). Palliative care aims to improve the patient’s quality of life by identifying physical,

JWBT514_ch23.indd 627JWBT514_ch23.indd 627 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

628 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

psychosocial, and spiritual issues while man- aging pain and other distressing symptoms. Palliative care “affi rms life and regards dying as a normal process; is applicable early in the course of illness, in conjunction with other therapies that are intended to prolong life, such as chemotherapy or radiation ther- apy, and uses a team approach to address the needs of patients and their families, including bereavement counselling, if indicated” (WHO, 2004, p. 3).

The palliative care model applies through- out the entire course of illness and attempts to address the physical, psychosocial, and spiri- tual concerns that affect both the quality of life and the quality of dying for patients with life- limiting illnesses at any phase of the disease. It includes interventions that are intended to maintain the quality of life of the patient and family. Although the focus intensifi es at the end of life, the priority to provide comfort and attend to the patient’s and family’s psychoso- cial concerns remains important throughout the course of the illness. In the model’s ideal implementation, patient and family values and decisions are respected, practical needs are ad- dressed, psychosocial and spiritual distress are managed, and comfort care is provided as the individual nears the end of life.

Palliative medicine is the medical specialty dedicated to excellence in palliative care. Pal- liative care specialists, including social work- ers, typically work on teams and are involved when patients’ disease is advanced, their life expectancy is limited, and medical and psy- chosocial concerns become complex and more urgent. In practice, these problems often are related to uncontrolled symptoms, confl icted or unclear goals of care, distress related to the process of dying, and increasing family bur- den. The social worker can educate the family about expected symptoms and their manage- ment, clarify information about medications and medical procedures, facilitate commu- nications with the health-care team, help the family make decisions about practical and fi nancial changes in the family structure, nor- malize their emotional experiences, and teach them effective coping skills.

HOSPICE

The emphasis of hospice care is on comfort at the end of life through control of pain and other symptoms. Rather than relying on cura- tive interventions and technology, it returns the focus to natural approaches in the care of dying individuals. Hospice focuses on caring, not curing, and in many cases is provided in the patient’s home. Hospice care also is pro- vided in freestanding hospice centers, hospi- tals, and nursing homes and other long-term care facilities. Hospice services are available to patients of all ages, religions, races, and ill- nesses. Hospice care is covered under Medi- care, Medicaid, most private insurance plans, health maintenance organizations, and other managed care organizations (National Hospice and Palliative Care Organization, 2010).

The hospice movement in the United States began in the 1960s when Dame Cicely Saun- ders, a British physician, introduced the con- cept of hospice at Yale University. She came to the United States to introduce the approach to symptom relief for dying individuals and discussed how St. Christopher’s inpatient hos- pice, the fi rst modern hospice, was established in London. Saunders presented the concepts of hospice to medical and nursing faculty and students at Yale. Florence Wald, dean of the Yale School of Nursing, created a multidis- ciplinary group at Yale-New Haven Hospital to look into changing the way that institu- tion cared for dying patients, modeling their care after St. Christopher’s approach. In 1975, the fi rst hospice in the United States opened in Connecticut due to the work of this small group of individuals (Saunders, 1999).

Signifi cant barriers to effective end-of- life care exist and include patients’ and families’ attitudes about death and dying, inconsistent communication between pa- tients and the health-care team, insuffi cient training of health-care providers, physicians’ inexperience with providing care, lack of ac- cess to care, and inconsistent reimbursement. The National Academies of Science, through its Institute of Medicine (IOM), produced an important report, “Approaching Death: Care

JWBT514_ch23.indd 628JWBT514_ch23.indd 628 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

End-of-Life Care 629

at the End of Life” (Field & Cassell, 2002). Among its recommendations were these:

• Reliable and skillful supportive care should be provided to patients and families facing the end of life.

• Health-care professionals should know and use effective interventions to prevent and relieve pain and other symptoms.

• Palliative care should be recognized as a defi ned area of expertise, education, and research.

• The public should be educated about end- of-life care and advance care planning.

• Tools should be developed for improving patients’ quality of life, and health-care organizations should be required to use them.

• Medical education should be modifi ed to ensure that relevant attitudes, knowledge, and skills regarding end-of-life care are represented and included in teaching.

• Research should be undertaken to strengthen the knowledge base of end-of-life care.

Although efforts have been made to implement these recommendations to improve existing care at the end of life, progress has been slow.

ANTICIPATING THE END OF LIFE

Individuals at the end of life may experience many symptoms that can be distressing to them and their caregivers. Although the dying process is not consistent across individuals and families, some physical, physiological, and emotional changes can be predicted during the end of life. Advanced stage of illness can result in symptoms such as diffi culty breath- ing, insomnia, loss of appetite, pain, nausea, and constipation. Patients also may experi- ence heightened anxiety, depression, anger, or emotional withdrawal. Understanding the nature of the symptoms most frequently expe- rienced by dying people and knowing how to help patients and their signifi cant others cope

are critical to effective end-of-life social work practice. The social worker can take the oppor- tunity to educate patients and families about the management of these physical symptoms and psychological responses.

During this important period of care, the social worker can act as a guide to help the patient and family prepare for the end of life. Knowing what to expect is important for social workers so they can help manage patient and family needs before, during, and after death. Social workers provide anticipatory guidance and expert psychosocial care to promote phys- ical and psychological comfort for the dying person and for family members.

INTERDISCIPLINARY TEAMWORK

Individuals at the end of life often move be- tween different health-care settings—from home to acute or long-term care facilities, out- patient or inpatient treatment (either curative or palliative), home health care, and hospice set- tings—as their disease progresses. They may receive care from several different physicians, nurses, and other health-care professionals during the course of their illness. Coordinat- ing all necessary care during moves from one setting to another presents considerable chal- lenges to patients, families, and health-care providers. Several different organizations and payment sources may be involved that may present barriers to optimal end-of-life care.

The involvement of an interdisciplinary palliative or hospice care team is an excellent solution to care coordination problems. These typically include:

• Patient

• Patient’s family or caregiver

• Palliative care or hospice physician

• Patient’s personal physician

• Nurses

• Social workers

• Clergy/pastoral counselors

• Pharmacists

JWBT514_ch23.indd 629JWBT514_ch23.indd 629 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

630 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

• Home health aides

• Trained volunteers

• Physical, occupational, and speech thera- pists, if needed

Interdisciplinary teams are common in both hospice and inpatient palliative care settings. The team meets on a regular basis to discuss the patients in their care and to develop individ- ualized care plans that focus on each patient’s well-being and need for pain management and symptom control. To varying degrees, private and public insurance companies pay for end- of-life care services for patients who need them, such as medication and treatments, med- ical equipment and miscellaneous procedures, and tests necessary to provide comprehensive comfort care. Comprehensive care can include nursing, physician, and social work services along with homemaker (e.g., light housekeep- ing and meal preparation) and personal care (e.g., bathing and dressing) services.

COMMUNICATION: TALKING ABOUT DEATH AND DYING

Patients, families, and social workers may be infl uenced by misconceptions about death and dying. They may believe that it is depressing to talk about death or that dying patients and families want to talk only about positive things. They may think that talking about dying will make patients and families upset and angry, that individuals do not always know that they are dying, or that dying children do not know how to communicate their concerns and fears, for example. These myths and misconceptions often impede the ability to communicate effec- tively with patients and their signifi cant others. To communicate clearly at the patient’s end of life, social workers must focus on providing clinical care that supports the patient and un- derlying family values and meanings. Effec- tive communication is critically important to understanding the experiences of others.

Social work traditionally has empha- sized therapeutic communication with active

listening. For effective communication with patients and caregivers facing the end of life, the fi rst and most important skill that all social workers must develop is listening. Being fully “present” with another person is essential to effective communication. Asking questions or soliciting comments requires truly listening to responses. Listening involves paying attention not just to the words spoken but to all other verbal and nonverbal cues that are communi- cated simultaneously, no matter how subtle. Much information can be gained by listen- ing to language content and style, choice of words, pauses, silences, body posture, mood, and facial expressions.

Open-ended questions are useful in gath- ering information from the patient and fam- ily. In contrast to closed-ended questions (which only allow yes, no, or another fi xed response), asking open-ended questions pro- vides an opening or invitation for patients and families to share information that is important to them. Gaining an understanding of the pa- tient’s concerns and style of communication enables social workers to provide the informa- tion the patient and family desire in a man- ner that they can understand (Byock, 1998). Rather than asking closed-ended questions, the social worker can ask questions that will elicit more information, such as “Can you tell me what you understand about the changes in your loved one’s condition?” Refl ective state- ments also help to clarify the social worker’s and the patient’s understanding. An example of a refl ective statement is “What I heard you just say is _____________. Is this correct? Is that what you intended?”

The ability to make empathic statements, demonstrating an awareness of and sensitiv- ity to another’s feelings, thoughts, and ex- periences (without having the same feelings, thoughts, and experiences of another), is easy for some and diffi cult for others, but it is a simple skill that can be learned and practiced. Listening to the patient and family, sharing re- fl ective comments about the diffi culty of the situation with them, acknowledging their fears and apprehensions, showing concern and look- ing into their eyes if appropriate are all simple

JWBT514_ch23.indd 630JWBT514_ch23.indd 630 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

End-of-Life Care 631

actions that communicate understanding of the patient’s experience. Additional techniques for gathering information can be found in Chapter 10 in this book.

Communicating with a child who is dying is a special challenge for families and health- care professionals. The death of a child is a unique tragedy, and adults, including social workers, may feel a profound need to protect and nurture the child and themselves against the loss, pain, and suffering inherent in the dying process. For these and many other rea- sons, communicating with dying children is diffi cult, and the resulting discomfort may prevent a social worker from exploring the important needs and concerns of children and their parents.

END-OF-LIFE CARE CONCERNS RELATED TO A DYING CHILD

Social workers are well equipped to help pre- pare parents and families to meet the emo- tional needs of a dying child. Parents and family members are faced with many issues, including concern that they may not be pro- viding care as well as the health-care team in the hospital. They need to know that they are doing all that they can to care for the dying child.

It is important that the personal and pro- fessional challenges of the individual social worker are addressed in caring for terminally ill children and their families. When this is done, social workers are better able to offer support to other members of the health-care team. Health-care professionals, especially physicians, often fi nd it extremely diffi cult to tell parents that there is no longer any effective cure-oriented treatment for their child. How- ever, if parents are supported in discussing treatment focused on the end of cure with pro- viders and the need to move to comfort (pallia- tive) care, most end-of-life care providers may be better able to communicate more directly and effectively. The key for the social worker is to recognize the critical role of encouraging

and supporting parents in expressing their true feelings, concerns, and goals.

Children are never too young to be told that they or someone close to them is dying (Silverman, 1999). Dying children often know they are dying. Failing to acknowledge death creates a barrier between the child and the adults who are caring for her. Sick children have a common fantasy that they are respon- sible for their own illnesses; being sick can be interpreted as punishment. Many children who choose not to discuss painful feelings may be trying to protect their parents and siblings from further emotional pain. In the absence of honest discussion, silence only reinforces this and other misconceptions that the child and his or her siblings create. It isolates the child and limits the sharing needed for coping with overwhelmingly diffi cult experiences. Dying children experience feelings similar to dying adults: anxiety, fear, loneliness, and depres- sion as well as hope and love. Children need to know that they are not responsible for their illnesses. Sharing information in a way that is cognitively and developmentally appropriate is essential.

Dying children of any age, as well as their siblings, have the capacity to communicate their concerns clearly. The ways children com- municate depend on their age and develop- mental stage. Verbal language must be adapted to a conceptual level and vocabulary that the children can understand. Children may express their fears, worries, or concerns directly, indi- rectly, or symbolically. They can communicate in many ways other than direct conversation. Music, art/drawing, drama/storytelling, and play are some expressive therapies that can be used to foster effective communication with children.

SPIRITUALITY

Facing death often forces individuals to con- sider spiritual or existential issues that can be central to end-of-life care. Spirituality can be a profound resource for coping with the chal- lenges of all aspects of life and death. Social

JWBT514_ch23.indd 631JWBT514_ch23.indd 631 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

632 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

workers in end-of-life practice must be sensitive to these concerns in their patients and be will- ing to assist with their spiritual explorations.

As defi ned by the Merriam-Webster Dic- tionary (2004), religion is “the service and worship of God or the supernatural,” “a com- mitment or devotion to religious faith or obser- vance” or a “personal set or institutionalized system of religious attitudes, beliefs, and prac- tices.” In contrast, spirituality is defi ned as a sensitivity or attachment to religious values, the quality or state of being spiritual. Spiritu- ality is related to the human spirit as opposed to material or physical things. Defi nitions of religion and spirituality can be found in the literature discussing the integration of spiri- tuality and mental health practices. Mauritzen (1988) defi nes spirituality as

the human dimension that transcends the biological, psychological and social aspects of living. It is the “agent” for the integra- tion a person’s identity and integrity. In very general terms the spiritual dimension is the “agent” for an individual’s existence as a person. (pp. 116–117)

Constructing a universal defi nition of spiri- tuality, however, is diffi cult. It is important to be aware of the patient’s and family’s spiritual belief system; awareness and appreciation of a patient’s spiritual orientation is essential to end-of-life care. Impending loss and the reality of death may shake people’s spiritual beliefs and may leave them feeling angry or hopeless. For believers and nonbelievers, atheists or ag- nostics, the need to make sense of impending death is central to a person’s struggles regard- ing meaning at the end of life.

Working in end-of-life care also may raise spiritual issues for the social worker. Witness- ing the suffering of others or coping with the stress of working with dying individuals and their families may challenge the social worker’s basic religious or spiritual beliefs. It may require the professional to deal with countertransference issues related to suffer- ing and death (Katz & Johnson, 2006). Before social workers can help with these existential concerns, they must understand their own

spirituality and religious beliefs and the infl u- ence of these beliefs on their professional and personal lives. When patients and caregivers express religious and spiritual concerns, the social worker’s role is to listen so that she can help them fi nd ways to address their needs.

DIVERSITY AND HEALTH DISPARITIES IN END-OF-LIFE CARE

All individuals’ life experiences contribute greatly to the complexity and uniqueness of the end-of-life issues that we all face. These experiences, as much as anything, shape our desires and beliefs about health, illness, death, and dying. The Diversity Committee of the Last Acts Coalition (2001) advocates recognition, acceptance, and support of its recommendations concerning individuals’ experiences with race; historical oppression; war and its aftermath; cultural, religious, and spiritual practices; af- fectional orientation; discrimination; and pov- erty. The true meaning of diversity (especially as it affects the end of life) is as much about these unique, view-shaping experiences as about the narrower yet more common concept that focuses on ethnicity or religion (Last Acts Coalition, 2001, p. 3). Death and dying among members of different racial or ethnic groups and disadvantaged persons can pose tremendous challenges to social workers. Cultural and eco- nomic factors play a signifi cant part in health care, health-care decision making, and end-of- life experiences. Health care is less accessible to disadvantaged individuals, including people of color, immigrants, older individuals, chil- dren, women, the poor and uninsured, and those who are in institutions (i.e., nursing homes and prisons) (Smedley, Stith, & Nelson, 2002).

Because of group differences in health, the U.S. Congress requested a report from the IOM. Disparities consistently were found across disease areas, clinical services, and clinical settings (Smedley et al., 2002). The focus of the IOM report was on conscious and unconscious discrimination or bias and its effect on health-care delivery. The IOM’s

JWBT514_ch23.indd 632JWBT514_ch23.indd 632 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

End-of-Life Care 633

general recommendation was to increase awareness of disparities among the general pub- lic, key stakeholders, and health-care providers. The report provided specifi c recommendations for critical areas, including patient education and empowerment, cross-cultural education in health professions, legal, regulatory, and policy interventions, and health system interventions.

Communication between health-care pro- vider and patient is vitally important to effec- tive end-of-life care. A patient’s understanding of his life-limiting illness will affect the course of his palliative care. Health-care professionals must be aware of subtle cultural variations in language, verbal and nonverbal communica- tion, and expressions of distress (van Ryn & Burke, 2000). They must be able to compre- hend the effects of ethnicity and spiritual be- liefs on the daily lives of patients and families.

Culture infl uences what is considered a health problem, how symptoms are expressed and dis- cussed, how health-care information is received, what type of care should be given, and how rights and protections are exercised (see Chapter 10 this book). In addition, health-care decision making is infl uenced by demographic factors, such as level of education, other socioeconomic status (SES) factors, geographic region (urban, rural), and time spent in the United States.

Kleinman (1988) proposed obtaining a pa- tient’s or caregiver’s explanatory model of ill- ness at any stage of the disease continuum by asking a series of questions designed to elicit their understanding of the situation (p. 42):

• What do you call the problem?

• What do you think caused the problem?

• Why do you think it started when it did?

• What do you think the sickness does? How does it work? How does it affect your body?

• How severe is the sickness? Will it have a long or short course?

• What care do you desire? What are the most important results you hope to get from your care?

• What are the chief problems the sickness has caused?

• What do you fear most about the sickness?

The need to provide culturally competent care has been emphasized in many arenas, that is, to respect and maintain sensitivity to issues related to an individual’s culture, race, gender, sexual orientation, and SES while providing optimal end-of-life care. In 2001, the National Associa- tion of Social Workers (NASW) developed Stan- dards for Cultural Competence in Social Work Practice. NASW defi nes cultural competence as

the process by which individuals and systems respond respectfully and effectively to peo- ple of all cultures, languages, classes, races, ethnic backgrounds, religions, and other di- versity factors in a manner that recognizes, affi rms, and values the worth of individuals, families, and communities and protects and preserves the dignity of each. (p. 11)

The standards address these areas: ethics and values, self-awareness, cross-cultural knowledge, cross-cultural skills, service de- livery, empowerment and advocacy, diverse workforce, professional education, language diversity, and cross-cultural leadership.

ADVANCE DIRECTIVES

Advance directives are written documents completed by an individual that specify treat- ment preferences for health-care decision making, particularly about end-of-life care and whether to use life-sustaining treatment. They provide an avenue for individuals to make known their wishes about end-of-life treat- ment. The most common advance directives are the health-care proxy (durable power of at- torney for health care) and living will.

The Patient Self-Determination Act has done much to increase the use and aware- ness of advance directives. It was signed into law in November 1990 and became effective in December 1991 (Federal Register, 1991). The act is applicable in all 50 states. The law requires that all facilities receiving Medicare or Medicaid reimbursements ask newly ad- mitted patients if they have health-care direc- tives in place, provide a written explanation of the state’s law on health-care directives, and

JWBT514_ch23.indd 633JWBT514_ch23.indd 633 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

634 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

provide an explanation of the hospital’s poli- cies in enforcing them. Health-care facilities also are required to record patients’ health- care directives as part of their medical records. In addition, those facilities must educate staff and the community they serve about advance directives and ensure that patients are not discriminated against, whether they have an advance directive or not. Social workers can initiate direction and leadership in implement- ing this education.

A durable power of attorney for health care involves the legal appointment of an in- dividual to speak for a person should that person become decisionally incapacitated. Multiple types of durable power of attorney are available, covering business, fi nancial, or health-care decisions. The purpose of legally appointing a person as a health-care proxy is to ensure that an individual’s wishes are fol- lowed in the event she is not able to make her own decisions. The person appointed as proxy acts to ensure that health-care providers know of those wishes and can advocate for their enforcement. The person named as an indi- vidual’s health-care proxy should be someone the individual trusts and someone with whom she feels comfortable in discussing her wishes. The person appointed to oversee an individu- al’s health-care wishes could be a spouse or partner, relative, or close friend. An individual serving as a proxy should be aware of state regulations or variations regarding advance di- rectives. In addition, that person must be aware that he or she may have to fi ght to assert the patient’s wishes in the event of a disagreement with the health-care team or with other family members.

A living will is a directive to a physician and health-care team that states a person’s wishes about what life-prolonging treatment should be provided or withheld should he or she lose the ability to communicate those wishes. Life- prolonging therapies include mechanical venti- lation, blood transfusions, dialysis, antibiotics, and artifi cially provided nutrition and hydra- tion. A living will should be viewed as a way to guide a physician to provide medically appro- priate care in keeping with the patient’s wishes.

Any adult with decision-making capacity can complete an advance directive. Directives must be completed by the individual to whom the directive applies (i.e., a relative cannot complete an advance directive for the patient even though he or she may be the health-care proxy). Advance directives can be rescinded at any time for any reason. They should be properly signed and witnessed, but a lawyer is not required to complete or rescind a valid advance directive. The patient should retain copies of the directive and also provide cop- ies to the designated proxy and to appropri- ate health-care providers. Advance directives are used more frequently by White, middle to upper SES individuals than by individuals from lower SES or ethnic or racial minori- ties. Social workers may need to be proactive in educating disadvantaged persons about the value of advance directives and help them with end-of-life care planning. Research suggests that many ethnic or racial minority groups in the United States fear being denied benefi cial treatment at the end of life more than they fear receiving excessive therapy and therefore are less likely to complete an advance directive (Crawley, Marshall, Lo, & Koenig, 2002).

Social workers should discuss advance di- rectives with each of their patients. They can help educate patients and families on the uses and benefi ts of advance directives and advocate for their choices. They can help patients com- plete an appointment of a health-care agent and a living will; ensure that this information is recorded in the patient’s medical record; en- courage the patient to inform the designated proxy of his wishes; and, if requested, help the patient discuss his wishes for end-of-life care with the designated proxy. A Consumer’s Tool Kit for Health Care Advance Planning is available for downloading at the American Bar Association Web site (www.americanbar .org/groups/law_aging/resources/consumer_s _toolkit_for_health_care_advance_planning .html). Advance directives for each state and information about advance care planning also are available from the National Hospice and Palliative Care’s Caring Connections Web

JWBT514_ch23.indd 634JWBT514_ch23.indd 634 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

End-of-Life Care 635

site (www.caringinfo.org/i4a/pages/index.cfm ?pageid=1).

UNDERSTANDING LOSS

Individuals and families facing end-of-life is- sues experience many kinds of loss besides impending death, including multiple losses (outlined next) as the person becomes more ill and withdrawn from prior life and activities. Understanding the common, natural responses to loss can facilitate a social worker’s ability to prepare patients and families with anticipatory guidance and help them normalize the possible and often uncomfortable expressions of grief.

Loss often is thought of in relation to the death of a signifi cant loved or valued person. This can include one’s self, spouse or partner, siblings, children (including through abortion, miscarriage, or stillbirth), and other relatives. However, loss also can occur through:

• Separation or divorce

• Temporary or permanent placement in a nursing home, hospital, hospice facility, adoptive or foster home, or prison

• Geographic moves due to job relocation or assignment in the military

• Death of a pet

• Death of a close friend, coworker, business associate, colleague, or acquaintance

• Deaths of well-known personalities or ce- lebrities (e.g., President John Kennedy, Princess Diana)

For the person who is dying, the end of life also brings the loss of part of the self, which includes physical, psychological, and social losses. Physical loss is the loss of body parts (e.g., amputations) and loss of functioning (e.g., lack of mobility, impaired bladder or bowel con- trol, reduced sexual functioning). Psychological loss is also relevant for patients at the end of life and can include the loss of independence, dignity, self-esteem or self-concept, memory or mental acuity, and opportunity, goals, hopes, and dreams. Social loss includes loss of work

or income and loss of social roles (i.e., role of partner/spouse or parent).

Each loss in a person’s life is experienced uniquely because it is infl uenced by multiple factors, that is, characteristics of the indi- vidual, the nature of the relationship with the deceased person, how the loss occurred, and infl uences from the past.

Controversy has surrounded the concept of “stages” of loss, in part because it implies a linear movement through a grief process. More recent thinking discounts the notion that there is a homogeneous course through which everyone moves due to grief. Grief is a natural response to loss. It is not merely sadness or crying in response to a loss.

Different conceptual frameworks exist to explain the experience of grief. Rando (1984) conceptualized grief within three broad cate- gories: avoidance, confrontation, and reestab- lishment. Avoidance includes “shock, denial, disbelief, emotional anesthesia, confusion, numbness, disorganization, and the intellectu- alized acceptance of the death.” Confrontation is a “highly emotional state wherein the grief is most intense and the psychological reactions to loss are felt most acutely.” Reestablishment is the “gradual decline of the grief and marks the beginning of an emotional and social reen- try back into the everyday world” (pp. 28–29). The tasks of the griever are then to:

• Acknowledge, accept, and understand the reality of the loss.

• Experience the pain of the grief and react to the separation from that which was lost.

• Adapt to a new way of life.

• Reinvest in a new way of life.

There may be ambivalence about the appro- priateness of expressing so many emotions and resistance to revealing those emotions to oth- ers. Grievers may feel overwhelmed by the in- tensity of their emotions and exhausted by the process. They may avoid or repress thoughts, feelings, or memories associated with the de- ceased person. They may protest or feel denial about the death or have feelings of unreality or depersonalization.

JWBT514_ch23.indd 635JWBT514_ch23.indd 635 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

636 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

Factors that infl uence how individuals cope with loss include childhood, adolescence, and adult experiences of loss and how recently those losses occurred; successful or unsuccess- ful resolution of losses; previous mental health problems (i.e., depression); and any physical health problems, life crises, or life changes prior to the current loss. The relationship with the deceased person also plays a role in coping with the loss: the relationship (partner/spouse, child, parent), length of the relationship, role the deceased person occupied, strength of the attachment, and degree of dependency.

In addition, it is important to consider how the loss occurred. The circumstances sur- rounding the loss, preparation for bereavement (anticipatory grief), the griever’s perception of preventability, perception of the deceased per- son’s fulfi llment in life, and any unfi nished business that was present in the relationship with the deceased person all play a role in the grief process. These factors make grief a very personal and individual experience.

Grief counseling involves normalizing the grieving person’s feelings and behavior and helping the griever identify and express her feelings, actualize the loss, facilitate her ability to live without the deceased person and to re- engage with life, and provide continuing sup- port throughout the process. Social workers should be alert to symptoms of complicated or troubled grief while providing counseling to help patients and families normalize their of- ten-diffi cult responses to grief. Uncomplicated grief is a grief reaction that, although painful, moves the survivor closer to acceptance of the loss and enhances the ability to carry on with life. In contrast, complicated grief is a grief re- action that includes diffi culty acknowledging the death, intrusive thoughts about and yearn- ing for the deceased person, and feelings of futility and purposelessness about the future.

ANTICIPATORY MOURNING

Grieving that begins before a death occurs is known as anticipatory mourning; the physi- cal and emotional reactions involved are often

the same as those experienced in normal grieving. Rando (2000) defi ned anticipatory mourning as

The phenomenon encompassing seven ge- neric operations grief and mourning, cop- ing, interaction, psychosocial reorganization, planning, balancing confl icting demands, and facilitating an appropriate death that, within a context of adaptational demands caused by the experiences of loss and trauma, is stimulated in response to the awareness of life-threatening or terminal illness in oneself or a signifi cant other and the recognition of associated losses in the past, present, and future. (p. 51)

Involving the whole family, as defi ned by the patient, in his care and treatment can decrease anxiety and allow for a sense of control, par- ticipation, and support. Meeting with the entire family as a group and establishing a personal relationship with each family member (if pos- sible) is crucial. Within their ability, social workers can help families to express their antic- ipatory grief appropriately and develop or main- tain open communication. Equally important is advising the family about the practical realities of illness and the death. Dying patients may be very concerned about these practical matters and do not want to burden their loved ones. So- cial workers can help patients and families plan for future care needs as well as preferences for burial and associated fi nancial arrangements. These advance directives help people who are at the end of life feel some control and ensure that their wishes are honored.

COMPLICATED GRIEF

It is sometimes diffi cult to differentiate un- complicated from complicated grief. Worden (2008) outlined four complicated grief reac- tions:

1. Chronic grief is grief that is prolonged, is excessive in duration, and never comes to a satisfactory conclusion.

JWBT514_ch23.indd 636JWBT514_ch23.indd 636 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

End-of-Life Care 637

2. Delayed grief is emotion that has been “inhibited, suppressed, or postponed.” A subsequent loss may elicit an exaggerated reaction because the bereaved is grieving for two losses.

3. Exaggerated grief occurs when feelings of fear, hopelessness, depression, or other symptoms become so excessive that they interfere with the daily existence of the be- reaved.

4. Masked grief includes symptoms and be- haviors experienced by a person who does not recognize the fact that these are related to a loss.

One social work task is to recognize symp- toms or responses that may indicate compli- cated grief, including an excessive degree of guilt, remorse, self-blame, a delay of up to six months in beginning the grief process, a prolonged grief process, hostility against the deceased person’s caregivers, avoidance of the loss through overactivity, avoidance of emo- tional expression, severe depression or insom- nia, or self-destructive behaviors (Worden, 2008).

DISENFRANCHISED GRIEF

Doka (2002) defi ned disenfranchised grief as the grief experienced in connection with a loss that is not socially acknowledged, publicly shared, or supported through usual rituals. Ei- ther the signifi cance of the loss is not recog- nized or the relationship between the deceased person and the bereaved survivor is not socially sanctioned—the person suffering the loss is given little or no opportunity to mourn pub- licly. It is experienced when the relationship is not recognized (lovers, ex-spouses, same-sex partners, close friends), when the loss itself is not recognized (stillbirth, miscarriage, abor- tion, adoption, pet loss), or when the griever is not recognized (very young, very old, with de- velopmental disabilities). The manner of death itself can be disenfranchising (murder, suicide, acquired immunodefi ciency syndrome). When

such deaths are treated as less than signifi cant losses, the process of grieving becomes more diffi cult. Social workers who become close to patients who die also can be disenfranchised mourners. Their own grief experiences should be acknowledged and dealt with. Often social workers in the same area form support groups or hold brief ceremonies to recognize all of their patients who have died in a period of time.

SOCIAL WORK IN END-OF- LIFE CARE

Reese and Raymer (2004) provided evidence that social work involvement in hospice opera- tions correlates signifi cantly with reduced pa- tient care costs. Their survey about social work involvement impacting hospice outcomes in- cluded social workers and hospice directors in 66 randomly selected hospices across the United States who completed questionnaires and reviewed 330 patient charts. The survey clearly indicated consistent benefi ts of social work involvement in all aspects of hospice care, to the patients and families as well as to the hospice administration itself. The quali- fi cations of the social work staff and hospice staffi ng and budget policies were also impor- tant variables. Better outcomes were correlated with more experienced social workers, higher social work salaries, and higher social work staffi ng ratios. The authors recommended that social work participation take place from in- take and assessment through continuing care to prevent crises, reduce the severity of an- ticipated problems, promote effective pain and symptom management, provide expert psychosocial interventions, and maximize the opportunities for patients and families to main- tain a good quality of life at the end of life.

The Open Society Institute’s Project on Death in America (PDIA) began the Social Work Leadership Development Awards Pro- gram to identify and support outstanding so- cial work faculty and clinicians committed to improving the care of dying and bereaved people. The program promoted innovative

JWBT514_ch23.indd 637JWBT514_ch23.indd 637 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

638 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

research and training projects that refl ected collaborations between schools of social work and practice sites that would advance the on- going development of social work practice, ed- ucation, and training in the care of the dying. These awards promoted the visibility and pres- tige of social workers committed to end-of-life care and enhanced their effectiveness as aca- demic leaders, role models, and mentors for future generations of social workers. Between 2000 and 2004, 42 social workers were given the award. (For a list of PDIA social workers, please visit www.soros.org/resources/articles _publications/publications/pdia_20040101 /pdia_20040101.pdf.)

The fi rst Social Work Summit on End-of- Life and Palliative Care took place in March 2002. Social work and end-of-life care experts met for a three-day summit to design a social work agenda to improve care for the dying and their families. The agenda called for organized professional leadership, standards of practice, and increased preparation at all levels of social work education. Leaders from national social work organizations, social work schools, hos- pices, hospitals, government agencies, and end-of-life care advocacy groups attended the meeting, representing more than 30 organiza- tions. The summit was cosponsored by Last Acts, the Duke Institute on Care at the End of Life, and the Soros Foundation’s Project on Death in America. The second Social Work Summit on End-of-Life and Palliative Care was held in June 2005; participants to this day continue their work through various projects and through many organizations.

As an outgrowth of the Social Work Summits, the National Association of So- cial Workers (NASW) began an initiative in 2003 to increase social workers’ awareness of end-of-life issues; to create and advocate for more education and training opportunities in the fi eld; and to promote the value of social work in palliative care, hospice care, and other end-of-life practice areas. NASW received a grant from the Project on Death in America to develop practice standards on palliative care, end-of-life care, and grief work to provide social workers with guidance for ethical and

effective practice (NASW, 2004) and to develop both a comprehensive policy statement on and a Web-based course on the standards with pre- and posttesting to document knowledge gains. This initiative complements other NASW pol- icy statements on client self-determination in end-of-life decisions, health care, hospice care, long-term care, and managed care.

Recent signifi cant efforts have been initi- ated to provide more formal transdisciplinary palliative care education to social workers and other professionals. The most notable of these was the Advocating for Clinical Excellence (ACE) project, a fi ve-year National Cancer In- stitute–funded project held at the City of Hope National Medical Center, Duarte, California, and directed by principal investigator Shirley Otis-Green and coinvestigators Betty Ferrell and Marcia Grant. The objective of the ACE project was to improve the delivery of pal- liative care through an intensive advocacy and leadership training program for 300 competi- tively selected psycho-oncology professionals (i.e., social workers, psychologists, spiritual care professionals). The program sought to address the defi cits in the delivery of quality palliative care and to provide the participants with strategies to empower them to become more effective role models and advocates for enhanced palliative, end-of-life, and bereave- ment care in their institutions and disciplines. More information about the program is avail- able at www.cityofhope.org/education/health -professional-education/nursing-education /ace-project/Pages/default.aspx

COMPASSION FATIGUE

Social workers and other health-care profes- sionals who work in end-of-life care experi- ence a great deal of trauma of illness and death. Those who work in end-of-life care can experience short- and long-term effects that can be profoundly disruptive, both profession- ally and personally. Social workers develop and nurture a therapeutic alliance with patients and families; in that process, they can be seri- ously affected as a result of listening to stories

JWBT514_ch23.indd 638JWBT514_ch23.indd 638 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

End-of-Life Care 639

of suffering and pain. Compassion fatigue, also referred to as secondary trauma, is the natural, predictable, treatable, and preventable stress resulting from helping a traumatized or suffering person (Figley, 1994).

Some professionals may be more vulnerable than others to compassion fatigue due to, for example, multiple losses, unresolved personal trauma, or insuffi cient recovery time. Social workers also grieve and need support. Each social worker has her own professional style and ways of coping that may mask symptoms and interfere with coping. All social workers need effective self-care strategies and stress management techniques to treat the symptoms of compassion fatigue. Strategies to prevent or cope with compassion fatigue include super- vision, personal psychotherapy, grief support for staff, stress management, and maintaining a balance between personal and professional responsibilities (Katz & Johnson, 2006).

CONCLUSION

Many issues in end-of-life care are beyond the scope of this chapter: for example, pain management in palliative care and ethical is- sues, such as medical futility, withholding or withdrawing medical therapy, assisted suicide, euthanasia, and terminal sedation (for more details, see Chapters 3 and 22). It is diffi cult for social workers and health-care profession- als to use their considerable skills in situations that ultimately will not change the fi nal out- come of a life-limiting illness. Experience tells us that as patients and families approach the end of life, social workers often feel they no longer have a role to play. They may want to withdraw from the patient and family. One of the hardest tasks is to be emotionally present during moments when further curative medi- cal treatment is not possible. Often all patients and families need is to have a social worker be a physical and emotional witness to their suffering. Accepting the limits of what we are able to do and sitting with a patient and family who are trying to cope with the end of life can be an important and meaningful experience,

for the patient and family as well as the social worker. Cultivating the ability to be present in the moment with patients and families and be a witness to their personal struggles at the end of life is one of the most diffi cult but important and rewarding skills a social worker can pos- sess. Providing psychosocial support, teaching coping and communication skills, providing information and advocacy, collaborating with colleagues, and taking a leadership role within the transdisciplinary health-care team can equip a social worker to make a signifi cant difference in the experiences of the end of life for patients and families.

SUGGESTED LEARNING EXERCISES

Learning Exercise 23.1

Maria is a Puerto Rican woman who was diag- nosed with breast cancer at age 35. During the three and a half years that she lived after diag- nosis, she received a variety of services from a cancer support organization, including weekly individual supportive counseling with a social worker and group therapy. At the time of her diagnosis, Maria had been married to Joseph for 13 years. They experienced fertility prob- lems because of her cancer treatment. Maria reported to her social worker that this was a major source of confl ict in the relationship and that she did not feel emotionally supported by Joseph.

Maria began working in a bank at age 17 and by age 30 had attained a middle manage- ment position. For two years after diagnosis, she worked full time while receiving chemo- therapy every three weeks, refusing to take time off for her cancer treatments. She reported signifi cant depression, anger, and apprehen- sion about recurrence. Within six months of diagnosis, she had begun to reexperience pre- vious losses, most signifi cantly the loss of her mother to breast cancer when Maria was 10 years of age. She reported consistent faith that the chemotherapy would cure her mother and hopeless betrayal by God when her mother

JWBT514_ch23.indd 639JWBT514_ch23.indd 639 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

640 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

died. Her oncology social worker suggested a referral to a psychiatrist for Maria’s worsening depression, which Maria declined, saying that she did not wish to take antidepressant medi- cation.

Ultimately, Maria agreed to a stem cell transplant and left her job after a year of dis- ability leave. She agreed to see a psychiatrist for a one-time consultation yet continued to decline antidepressant medication. The social worker reported that she became increasingly fatigued, depressed, and agoraphobic (e.g., she stopped going out alone secondary to panic at- tacks). Her cancer recurred after one year and she died 18 months later.

Answer these questions based on your in- terpretation of Maria’s case:

1. How do you think that Maria defi ned good quality of life?

2. What do you see as the social worker’s role in providing support to clients like Maria who would help them to achieve good quality of life as well as good quality of death?

3. Arthur Kleinman (1988) offers an explanatory model of illness that fosters a sensitive approach to helping clients like Maria. How might you have used his ap- proach to elicit information from Maria to maximize your ability to help her? Recall that Kleinman suggested using these questions:

• What do you call the problem?

• What do you think caused the problem?

• Why do you think it started when it did?

• What do you think the sickness does? How does it work? How does it affect your body?

• How severe is the sickness? Will it have a long or short course?

• What care do you desire? What are the most important results you hope to get from your care?

• What are the chief problems the sickness has caused?

• What do you fear most about the sickness?

4. What do you consider to be the most press- ing medical, psychosocial, and spiritual concerns that Maria faced? How would you prioritize these concerns in devising your approach to treatment?

5. How would you go about developing a plan of care for Maria that takes into account her cultural and spiritual perspectives and emphasizes her defi nition of good quality of life?

SUGGESTED RESOURCES

Web Sites Aging with Dignity (Five Wishes)—www

.agingwithdignity.org The Aging with Dignity Web site con-

tains the Five Wishes, a document that is an advance directive addressing the dy- ing patient’s holistic needs. It has been translated into a number of languages.

American Pain Foundation—www .painfoundation.org

The APF is a nonprofi t information, advocacy, and support organization serv- ing all people affected by pain. Its mis- sion is to improve the quality of life of those affected by pain by providing prac- tical information, raising public aware- ness and understanding of pain, and advocating against barriers to effective treatment.

Association for Death Education and Coun- seling—www.adec.org

ADEC is dedicated to improving the quality of death education; promoting the development and interchange of re- lated theory and research; and providing support, stimulation, and encouragement to its members and those studying and working in death-related fi elds.

Cancer Care, Inc.—www.cancercare.org Cancer Care is the largest national so-

cial service agency providing free emo- tional support, information, and practical assistance to people with cancer, their loved ones, and caregivers. Its Web site

JWBT514_ch23.indd 640JWBT514_ch23.indd 640 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

End-of-Life Care 641

features a special section on end-of-life and bereavement concerns and includes educational information and resources for patients, caregivers, and profession- als.

Center to Advance Palliative Care—www .capc.org

CAPC is a resource to hospitals and other health-care settings interested in developing palliative care programs.

End-of-Life/Palliative Education Resource Center—www.eperc.mcw.edu

This center shares educational re- source material among the community of health professional educators involved in palliative care education.

Finding Our Way: Living with Dying in America— http://webpages.scu.edu/ftp /fow/

The Finding Our Way national public education initiative focuses on bringing practical information to the American public regarding end of life and its sur- rounding issues.

Growth House—www.growthhouse.org Growth House is an international

gateway to resources for life-threatening illness and end-of-life care. Its primary mission is to improve the quality of end- of-life care through public education and professional collaboration.

Hospice Foundation of America—www .hospicefoundation.org

HFA provides leadership in the de- velopment and application of hospice and its philosophy of care with the goal of enhancing the U.S. health-care sys- tem and the role of hospice within it. It provides end-of-life information for pa- tients, families, and professionals.

National Hospice and Palliative Care Orga- nization—www.nhpco.org

This is the largest nonprofi t mem- bership organization representing hos- pice and palliative care programs and professionals in the United States. The organization is committed to improving end-of-life care and expanding access to

hospice care with the goal of profoundly enhancing quality of life for people dy- ing in America and their loved ones.

Social Work Network in Palliative and End- of-Life Care Listserv—www.stoppain.org /for_professionals/content/information /listserv.asp

Hosted by the Beth Israel Department of Pain and Palliative Care, this listserv provides an opportunity for social work- ers in such fi elds as oncology, geriatrics, human immunodefi ciency virus (HIV), hospice, nephrology, and pediatrics to network and discuss multidimensional aspects of palliative and end-of-life care.

Suggested Books Berzoff, J., & Silverman, P. R. (2004). Liv-

ing with dying: A handbook for end-of- life healthcare practitioners. New York, NY: Columbia University Press.

Bowlby, J. (1980). Attachment and loss: Loss, sadness and depression. New York, NY: Basic Books.

Doka, K. J. (Ed.). (2006). Pain manage- ment at the end of life: Bridging the gap between knowledge & practice. Wash- ington, DC: Hospice Foundation of America.

Doka, K. J., & Davidson, J. (Eds.). (1998). Living with grief: Who we are, how we grieve. Philadelphia, PA: Taylor & Francis.

Fadiman, A. (1997). The spirit catches you and you fall down: A Hmong child, her American doctors, and the collision of two cultures. New York, NY: Farrar, Straus, and Giroux.

Field, M. J., & Behrman, R. (2003). When children die: Improving palliative and end-of-life care for children and their families. Washington, DC: National Academies Press.

Hilden, J. M., Tobin, D. R., & Lindsey, K. (2002). Shelter from the storm: Caring for a child with a life-threatening condi- tion. Philadelphia, PA: Perseus.

Rando, T. A. (1991). How to go on living when someone you love dies. New York, NY: Bantam Books.

JWBT514_ch23.indd 641JWBT514_ch23.indd 641 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

642 Health Social Work: Selected Areas of Practice

REFERENCES

Byock, I. (1998). Dying well: Peace and possibilities at the end of life. New York, NY: Riverhead Books.

Crawley, L. M., Marshall, P. A., Lo, B., & Koenig, B. A. (2002). Strategies for culturally effective end-of-life care. Annals of Internal Medicine, 136(9), 673–679.

Doka, K. J. (2002). Disenfranchised grief: New directions, challenges, and strategies for practice. Champaign, IL: Research Press.

Federal Register. (1991). Federal patient self-determination act 1990. Retrieved from http://euthanasia.procon.org /sourcefi les/patient_selfdetermination_act.pdf

Field, M. J., & Cassel, C. K. (1997). Approaching Death: Improving Care at the End of Life. Washington, D.C.: National Academy Press.

Figley, C. (1994). Compassion fatigue: Coping with secondary traumatic stress disorder in those who treat the traumatized. New York, NY: Brunner/Mazel.

Katz, R. S., & Johnson, T. A. (2006). When professionals weep: Emotional and countertransference responses in end-of-life care. New York, NY: Routledge.

Kleinman, A. (1988). The illness narratives: Suffering, healing and the human condition. New York, NY: Basic Books.

Last Acts Coalition. (2001). Statement on diversity and end-of-life care. Washington, DC: Author.

Mauritzen, J. (1988). Pastoral care for the dying and bereaved. Death Studies, 12(2), 111–122.

Merriam-Webster. (2004). The Merriam-Webster English dictionary. Springfi eld, MA: Author.

National Association of Social Workers. (2001). Standards for cultural competence in social work practice. Retrieved from www.socialworkers.org/practice /standards/NASWCulturalStandards.pdf

National Association of Social Workers. (2004). Standards for social work practice in palliative and end-of-life care. Retrieved from www.socialworkers.org/practice /bereavement/standards/default.asp

National Center for Health Statistics. (2010). Deaths: Final data for 2007. National Vital Statistics Reports, 58(19). Retrieved from www.cdc.gov/NCHS/data/nvsr /nvsr58/nvsr58_19.pdf

National Hospice and Palliative Care Organization. (2010). What is hospice and palliative care? Retrieved from www.nhpco.org/i4a/pages/index.cfm?pageid4648

Project on Death in America. (2001). Report of activities: January 1998–December 2000. New York, NY: Open Society Institute.

Rando, T. A. (1984). Grief, dying, and death: Clinical interventions for caregivers. Champaign, IL: Research Press.

Rando, T. A. (Ed.). (2000). Clinical dimensions of anticipatory mourning. Champaign, IL: Research Press.

Reese, D. J., & Raymer, M. (2004). Relationship between social work involvement and hospice outcomes: Results of the national hospice social work survey. Social Work, 49(3), 415–422.

Saunders, C. (1999). Origins: International perspectives, then and now. Hospice Journal, 14(3/4), 1–7.

Silverman, P. R. (1999). Never too young to know: Death in children’s lives. New York, NY: Oxford University Press.

Smedley, B. D., Stith, A. Y., & Nelson, A. R. (Eds.). (2002). Unequal treatment: Confronting racial and ethnic disparities in health care. Washington, DC: Institute of Medicine.

van Ryn, M., & Burke, J. (2000). The effect of patient race and socio-economic status on physicians’ perceptions of patients. Social Science and Medicine, 50(6), 813–828.

Worden, J. W. (2008). Grief counseling and grief therapy: A handbook for the mental health practitioner (4th ed.). New York, NY: Springer.

World Health Organization. (1990). Cancer pain relief and palliative care: Report of a WHO expert committee (WHO Technical Report Series, No 804). Geneva, Switzerland: Author.

World Health Organization. (2004). The solid facts: Palliative care. Geneva, Switzerland: Author.

JWBT514_ch23.indd 642JWBT514_ch23.indd 642 9/21/11 7:46 PM9/21/11 7:46 PM

643

Afterword

CANDYCE S. BERGER

Much has been written about the changes af- fecting the health-care arena. We are living in times that have been described as chaotic, tumultuous, and unstable (Berger, Robbins, Lewis, Mizrahi, & Fleit, 2003; Dombovy, 2002; Fairfi eld, Hunter, Mechanic, & Flem- ming, 1997; Ross, 1993). Many factors have contributed to this situation. The growing em- phasis on fi scal restraint in health care, the technological explosion, ethical challenges, spiritual concerns, and consumer expectations all have had a signifi cant effect on health-care service delivery. Although social work practice has been infl uenced by these changes, there is no evidence that we are being differentially impacted, experiencing a greater proportion of the negative consequences, such as downsiz- ing and decentralization (Berger et al., 2003). Chapter 1 traces the 100-year history of social work involvement in health, and Chapter 2 ex- plores the factors that have shaped the evolv- ing roles of social workers. These chapters provide a context in which we can examine the environment for health social work today. We struggle more than ever with the challenge of defi ning social work roles in a health-care environment that responds to fi scal priorities, demands by payers for accountability, and consumerism. Today many health social work programs are harnessing their creativity and skills to expand social work roles and secure social work’s position both in the present and for the future (Mizrahi & Berger, 2005).

Much of our unease is in response to a health-care system that is facing runaway costs

without commensurate improvement in health outcomes. The United States has ranked poorly in international comparisons for all measures of health outcomes in spite of our constant ranking of number one for health-care costs. Health care currently consumes almost 16% of the U.S. gross domestic product, while health care in other industrialized countries accounts for 9% to 10% of their GDP. To explain this difference, some may argue that the tax burden of countries with universal health care, such as Sweden, Norway, and Denmark, accounts for their lower spending on health care. However, these countries consistently rank high in posi- tive health outcomes while reporting the per- centage of their GDP associated with health as ranging between 8% and 9% (http://csis.org). In addition, 50 million Americans are without health insurance, and many more struggle with intermittent or poor health-care coverage. The recession of 2009–2010 exacerbated this prob- lem as many individuals fell into the ranks of the unemployed and lost their employer-based health coverage. According to the Centers for Disease Control and Prevention (CDC), 58.5 million Americans were uninsured at some point during 2009, and 38.5 million had been uninsured for more than one year prior to that date. The CDC estimated that about 25 mil- lion Americans are underinsured and fi nd it diffi cult to afford the out-of-pocket medical expenses created by the gap in what their in- surance will cover. Chapter 5 critically exam- ines the fi nancial, regulatory, and governance issues that shape health-care policy and the

JWBT514_Afterword.indd 643JWBT514_Afterword.indd 643 9/21/11 7:41 PM9/21/11 7:41 PM

644 Afterword

delivery of health-care services. Without radi- cal changes to the nation’s health-care policy and systems of care, we will continue to see health-care systems struggle to maintain fi scal viability through a variety of cost-containment strategies, including hospital closures, merg- ers, restructuring, and resizing initiatives and the push to community-based practice. All of these strategies will infl uence the staffi ng ratios in medical centers, service delivery, and social work roles (Berger et al., 2003; Globerman, Davies, & Walsh, 1996; Ross, 1993). Conse- quently, social workers in health care will con- tinue to rely on clinical practice skills, but they also will need to expand their practice reper- toires to incorporate community-based clinical interventions, macro-level practice skills that are essential to autonomous practice, and re- search techniques that enable them to use data to support their practices. A primary function of social workers will be to assist clients to overcome the barriers that inhibit access to high-quality health care services (Burg et al., 2010). Skills in advocacy will become even more critical to challenge policies and regula- tions that are driven by fi scal priorities that can compromise the quality of patient care.

MOVE TO THE COMMUNITY

While these changes promote feelings of fear and insecurity, new opportunities have been and will continue to emerge for social work. In the 20th century, acute care dominated health- care practice, moving the hospital to the cen- tral position within the health-care system. As we look to the 21st century, our emphasis is shifting to a new priority—the management of chronicity. This will promote expansion of community-based systems of care, where pre- vention strategies will assume a higher level of importance. Many scholars in the fi eld of health social work believe, as in the past, that the future of the profession lies in our abil- ity to work within the community, develop- ing successful linkages across systems of care (Berkman, 1996; Davidson, 1990; Rehr, Rosenberg, & Blumenfi eld, 1998).

This book traces the changing roles for health-care social workers, balancing acute care with the movement to community-based models of practice. This shift to the commu- nity will require a greater understanding of interventions aimed at health promotion and disease prevention (Berkman, 1996; David- son, 1990) with a greater awareness of the critical role of individual, family, and commu- nity behavior in shaping health status. Chapter 7 provides the theoretical foundations needed to understand health behavior so that effective, community-based strategies can be designed and implemented. Chapters devoted to com- munity-based practice and public health aug- ment this learning by examining the spectrum of issues shaping social work practice at the community level. These chapters are rich with theory, skills, and practical applications that will promote the development and expansion of social work community-based practice.

EXPANDED CLINICAL BASE

As we move from managing acute episodes of care to the management of chronicity, our focus will shift to the identifi cation of at-risk populations whose health status is compro- mised by poor health behaviors, environmen- tal challenges, and genetic predispositions. Systems of care for older individuals will be of paramount importance (Berkman, Gardner, Zodikoff, & Harootyan, 2006; Oliver & DeCoster, 2006). Another signifi cant popula- tion at risk that will require more attention by health-care professionals is the growing num- ber of immigrants who are entering our coun- try through both legal and clandestine means. As the United States moves to tighten access along its borders, immigrants are being forced to turn to illegal means of gaining entry, often referred to as smuggling or traffi cking. Victims of human traffi cking face a variety of health risks associated with their pretraffi cking con- dition (e.g., preexisting health condition as- sociated with violence, poor access to health care, etc.), health risks associated with their journey (e.g., poor and dangerous traveling

JWBT514_Afterword.indd 644JWBT514_Afterword.indd 644 9/21/11 7:41 PM9/21/11 7:41 PM

Afterword 645

conditions, physical and sexual violence), and risks associated with their arrival in the United States (e.g., exploitation, poor working condi- tions, exposure to unfamiliar infectious dis- eases). Health-care providers, particularly at acute care access points, are likely to be immi- grants’ fi rst point of contact. Effectively caring for this population will require assessment and intervention skills that take into account the dynamics of smuggling and traffi cking as well as promote cultural sensitivity, an awareness of alternative methods of health care indigenous to the client’s country of origin, and resources to assist clients who may be fl eeing exploita- tion (Berger, 2010; Gushulak & MacPherson, 2000; Lusk & Lucas, 2009; Zimmerman, Hos- sain et al., 2006). The importance of taking pa- tients’ culture into account is reviewed in each chapter of this book and is examined in detail in Chapter 10.

Effective and effi cient clinical interven- tions at the acute level will continue to be a priority for social work practitioners, but they will need to incorporate expanded clinical skills in such areas as brief assessments, short- term treatment, population-oriented care, case management, health promotion, and disease prevention. This expertise requires increased understanding of theories of health behavior and the infl uence of risk factors, such as so- cioeconomic status, the environment, mental health, substance abuse, ethnicity, culture, spirituality, family systems, and sexuality, all of which are effectively addressed in this book. Social work practice will be shaped by a grow- ing emphasis on managing larger numbers of patients as their roles span the continuum of health care. This will call for social work prac- titioners who draw from a large repertoire of knowledge and skills and are able to broadly traverse larger systems devoted to service de- livery. Parts II and III capture many of these issues, demonstrating the critical impact of biopsychosocial factors on health behavior and health outcomes. What kind of practitioner will be needed to face the challenges ahead?

There is little debate about the need for clin- ical skills in the future, but debate still rages as to the most effective approach: generalist

versus specialist. A generalist approach uti- lizes fundamental skills of social work that are transferable across settings and populations served. Generalist approaches may be more effective with community-based models of care or in acute, general medical, surgical, or pediatric settings, where a broader understand- ing of illnesses, psychosocial implications of illness, and systems of care may be required. A generalist approach is particularly relevant to community-based practice, where a variety of skill sets are needed to effectively navigate a complex system of providers, payers, and clients (Ross, 1993). This does not mean that specialists will not also be needed.

Specialist models emerged in large, spe- cialty hospitals where social workers were recognized and advanced professionally based on their expertise in a defi ned area of practice (e.g., disease or population expertise). To be successful, social workers needed to under- stand the details of specifi c diagnoses and their biopsychosocial ramifi cations for patients and families; they needed specifi c knowledge re- garding the populations most likely to be af- fected and the resources and systems of care to be mobilized to address issues and problems related to the illness (Ross, 1993).

An interview with recognized health-care leaders (“How Are Hospitals Financing the Future?,” 2004) discusses the importance of health-care systems delineating and promot- ing their unique competencies—they need to carve out their market niche. It was suggested that health-care systems should identify three to four service lines (e.g., cancer, cardiology, trauma) that will be priorities (i.e., Centers of Excellence) for the health-care system rather than equally distributing limited resources across all services. For social workers to be members of the health-care teams in these specialty centers, they will require specialized knowledge and skills to effectively and effi - ciently provide psychosocial services so that they can become an essential member of the team. Specialty content often is handled indi- vidually through scholarly articles or books that address a specifi c disease or population. Although a comprehensive analysis of all

JWBT514_Afterword.indd 645JWBT514_Afterword.indd 645 9/21/11 7:41 PM9/21/11 7:41 PM

646 Afterword

potential areas of specialization is not realis- tic within an overview book, the authors have done an outstanding job weaving in specialty content on key areas where a social worker is likely to be involved (see Part III).

AUTONOMOUS PRACTITIONER

As social workers broaden their knowledge and skills, they will need to be as adept at macro-level interventions as they are at clinical practice (Berger & Ai, 2000). Many health-care systems are moving away from silo organizational structures (i.e., centralized departments) to programmatic structures. So- cial workers may fi nd themselves practicing in more autonomous, multidisciplinary settings where the leader may not be a social worker. Furthermore, as more seamless, comprehen- sive systems of care emerge, practitioners will need to rely on skills that span both micro and macro practice in order to navigate system complexity effectively.

These changes will require social workers to have greater knowledge of fi scal arrangements and processes and increased ability to assess or- ganizational environments, as addressed in Part I. This knowledge needs to be combined with increased skills in decision making, confl ict management, planning, community organizing, marketing, and program management. Political acumen will be essential to survival in an envi- ronment that is politically volatile due to con- stant change and limited access to health-care resources (e.g., money, staff, technology).

EMBRACING RESEARCH AS A PRACTICE NECESSITY

As health care expands over the continuum of care, practitioners will need to draw on skills in research techniques (Zlotnik & Galambos, 2004). Four factors shape the need to embrace research as an essential element of practice. First, population interventions are dependent on population-based research: epidemiology

(Berger & Ai, 2000; Berkman, 1996). This type of research will be essential to identify- ing populations at risk and to understanding the health-care needs of diverse populations by maintaining a cross-cultural perspective in all research endeavors. Second, the ability to assess and intervene effectively in health- care organizations and community systems will be dependent on accurate and timely data. Third, social work practitioners and educators in health cannot continue to ignore the man- dates for evidence-based practice. Many of the health disciplines have already embraced this philosophy, and social work will need to move quickly in this direction to maintain or expand its role. Social work historically has relied on documenting the process of its interventions rather than the outcome. Social work will not survive as a provider unless it can harness available empirical information to design and support practice models and teach students the skills of evidence-based decision mak- ing. Doing this will require the introduction of reliable and valid tools to do assessments and to measure outcomes (Berger & Ai, 2000; Berkman, 1996). Finally, empirical research is an essential ingredient to effective advocacy. Although no single chapter in this book is de- voted to research approaches, this content is woven throughout the book, emphasizing its importance in relation to specifi c settings, ill- nesses, and populations.

ROLE OF ADVOCACY

Advocacy is another theme that permeates throughout this book, acknowledging its im- portance as a priority for social workers in health care. Social workers must act to effect changes in policies and regulations as fi scal priorities threaten to compromise quality of care. We must embrace social work values, priorities, and ethics, recognizing when fi scal priorities compromise these professional te- nets of practice. As health-care professionals, we must join forces with those most affected by the changes—patients and families—and develop coalitions with other health-care

JWBT514_Afterword.indd 646JWBT514_Afterword.indd 646 9/21/11 7:41 PM9/21/11 7:41 PM

Afterword 647

disciplines and advocacy groups to mobilize changes in health-related policies.

In conclusion, health care can be described as a tumultuous and often chaotic setting where change is the constant. Preparing so- cial workers for this new environment borrows from the old as well as the new. To be suc- cessful in the future of health care, our practice must be grounded in theory and data. We need to be strategic, placing increased emphasis on documenting the results of our interven- tions. We need to free our creative energy to critically examine what we do and design and implement innovative strategies that span the continuum of health care. We need to be will- ing and able to take calculated risks, ventur- ing into new arenas of care and incorporating new roles. According to Cowles and Lefcow- itz (1995), “If we don’t actively work to create the future, then we leave the future solely to chance” (p. 14). We must build a reputation as creative and innovative practitioners and assume responsibility for shaping our profes- sional destiny as health-care practitioners.

The authors of this Handbook have put to- gether an excellent resource to prepare social workers for the contemporary and future chal- lenges of social work practice in health care. We need to be aware of our history, drawing strength from our longevity as practitioners in health care. Our historical emphasis on com- munity-based interventions combined with our strengths perspective and sensitivity to cultural competency positions us to succeed in this changing health-care environment. We draw on a strong base of values and ethics that will sup- port our professional goals and directions as we face new challenges and ethical dilemmas.

REFERENCES

Berger, C. S. (2010). Modern day slavery: Human traffi cking and health. In W. J. Spitzer (Ed.), Immigration: Issues in health care social work policy and practice (7–12). Petersburg, VA: Dietz Press.

Berger, C. S., & Ai, A. (2000). Managed care and its implications for social work curricula reform: Policy and research initiatives. Social Work in Health Care, 31(3), 59–82.

Berger, C. S., Robbins, C., Lewis, M., Mizrahi, T., & Fleit, S. (2003). The impact of organizational change on social work staffi ng in a hospital study: A national, longitudinal study of social work in hospitals. Social Work in Health Care, 37(1), 1–18.

Berkman, B. (1996). The emerging health care world: Implication for social work practice and education. Social Work, 41, 541–551.

Berkman, B., Gardner, D., Zodikoff, B., & Harootyan, L. (2006). Social work and aging in the Emerging health care world. Journal of Gerontological Social Work, 48(1/2), 203–217.

Burg, M. A., Zebrack, B., Walsh, K., Maramaldi, P., Lin, J.-W., Smolinski, K. M., & Lawson, K. (2010). Barriers to accessing quality health care for cancer patients: A survey of members of the Association of Oncology Social Work. Social Work in Health Care, 49(1), 38–52.

Cowles, L. A., & Lefcowitz, M. J. (1995). Interdisciplinary expectation of the medical social worker in the hospital setting: Pt. 2. Health & Social Work, 20(4), 279–286.

Davidson, K. (1990). Role blurring and the hospital social worker’s search for a clear domain. Health and Social Work, 15(3), 228–234.

Dombovy, M. L. (2002). U.S. health care in confl ict: Pt. 1. The challenges of balancing cost, quality and access. Physician Executive, 28(4). Retrieved from InfoTrac.

Fairfi eld, G., Hunter, D. J., Mechanic, D., & Flemming, R. (1997). Implication of managed care for health systems, clinicians, and patients. British Medical Journal, 314, 1895.

Globerman, J., Davies, J. M., & Walsh, S. (1996). Social work in restructuring hospitals: Meeting the challenge. Health and Social Work, 21(3). Retrieved from InfoTrac.

Gushulak, B. D., & MacPherson, D. W. (2000). Health issues associated with smuggling and traffi cking of migrants. Journal of Immigrant Health, 2(2), 67–78.

Health Insurance Coverage: Early Release of Estimates from the National Health Interview Survey, 2009. Retrieved from www.cdc.gov/nchs/data/nhis /earlyrelease/insur201006.htm

How are hospitals fi nancing the future? Where the industry will go from here (Report 6: Executive summary). (2004). Healthcare Financial Management, 58(9). Retrieved from InfoTrac.

Lusk, M., & Lucas, F. (2009). The challenge of human traffi cking and contemporary slavery. Journal of Comparative Social Welfare, 25(1), 49–57.

Mizrahi, T., & Berger, C. (2005). A longitudinal look at social work leadership in hospitals: The impact of a changing healthcare system on styles and strategies over time. Health and Social Work, 30(2), 155–165.

Ol iver, D. P., & DeCoster, V. A. (2006). Health care needs of aging adults: Unprecedented opportunities for social work. Health & Social Work, 31(4), 243–245.

JWBT514_Afterword.indd 647JWBT514_Afterword.indd 647 9/21/11 7:41 PM9/21/11 7:41 PM

648 Afterword

Rehr, H., Rosenberg, G., & Blumenfi eld, S. (1998). Creative social work in health. New York, NY: Springer.

Ross, J. W. (1993). Redefi ning hospital social work: An embattled professional domain [Editorial]. Health and Social Work, 18(4). Retrieved from InfoTrac.

Zimmerman, C., Hossain, M., Yun, K., Roche, B., Morison, L., & Watts, C. (2006). Stolen smiles: A summary

report on the physical and psychological health consequences of women and adolescents traffi cked in Europe. London, UK: London School of Hygiene & Tropical Medicine. Retrieved www.humantraffi cking .org/uploads/publications/Stolen_Smiles_July_2006.pdf

Zl otnik, J. L., & Galambos, C. (2004). Evidence-based practices in health care: Social work possibilities. Health & Social Work, 29(4), 259–261.

JWBT514_Afterword.indd 648JWBT514_Afterword.indd 648 9/21/11 7:41 PM9/21/11 7:41 PM

649

About the Editors

Sarah Gehlert, PhD, is the E. Desmond Lee Professor in the George Warren Brown School of Social Work at Washington University, where she serves on the Faculty Advisory Council of the Institute for Public Health and the Execu- tive Committee of the Institute of Clinical and Translational Sciences. Dr. Gehlert is the core leader of the Education and Training Core of the NCI-funded Program for the Elimi- nation of Cancer Disparities at Washington University, and co-principal investigator of the NCI-funded Transdisciplinary Research in Energetics and Cancer Center. Dr. Gehlert directed the University of Chicago’s Mater- nal and Child Health Training Program from 1992 to 1998 and was principal investigator on a NIMH-funded community-based study of rural and urban women’s health and mental health from 1997 to 2001. She was the princi- pal investigator and director of the University of Chicago’s NIH-funded Center for Inter- disciplinary Health Disparities Research and project leader of one of its four interdependent research projects from 2003 to 2010. She is a member of the Board of Scientifi c Counsel- ors of the National Human Genome Research Institute at the National Institutes of Health. Dr. Gehlert is past president of the Society of Social Work and Research. She is a con- sulting editor of Social Work Research and is on the editorial boards of Research on Social Work Practice, Health & Social Work, and

Social Service Research. In 2010, Dr. Gehlert was named a fellow of the American Acad- emy of Social Work and Social Welfare. Dr. Gehlert worked for eight years as a health social worker.

Teri Browne, PhD, is the Health Social Work Services Research Assistant Professor at the University of South Carolina College of Social Work. Dr. Browne is a member of the National Institute of Diabetes and Digestive and Kidney Diseases’ Dialysis Center Working Group of the National Institutes of Health, the National Kidney Foundation of South Carolina Medical Advisory Board, and the Southeastern Kidney Council Medical Review Board. She is the past national chairperson of the Executive Com- mittee of the Council of Nephrology Social Workers of the National Kidney Foundation. Dr. Browne serves on the editorial boards for the American Society of Nephrology Kidney News, Chronic Kidney Disease Update, Ameri- can Society of Nephrology Kidney News, and Journal of Nephrology Social Work. She is also a reviewer for several journals including So- cial Work in Health Care, American Journal of Kidney Diseases, and American Journal of Public Health. From 1998 to 2008, Dr. Browne was a nephrology social worker, working with hemodialysis patients and their families regard- ing assessment, counseling, crisis intervention, and case management.

About the Editors.indd 649About the Editors.indd 649 9/21/11 8:07 PM9/21/11 8:07 PM

About the Editors.indd 650About the Editors.indd 650 9/21/11 8:07 PM9/21/11 8:07 PM

651

Author Index

Aabo, K., 308 Aaron, B., 180 Aaron, S., 435, 436 Aaronson, N. K., 226 Aasland, O. G., 454,

455 Aass, N., 356 Abbott, A. A., 426, 450 Abelson, J. M., 172 Aben, I., 179 Abetz, L., 474 Abraham, H. D., 437 Abrams, D. B., 244 Abramson, J., 243, 245 Abramson, L. Y., 127 Abreu, M., 255 Acheson, D., 158 Ackerman, S., 189 Adair, M., 205 Adam, O., 308 Adamek, M. E., 399,

415 Adams, H., 508, 510 Adams, J., 506 Adams, P., 509 Adams, W. L., 453 Aday, L. A., 133–134 Adelsward, V., 580 Ademuyiwa, F., 571 Adler, A., 412 Adler, C., 306 Adler, M., 130 Adler, N. E., 174 Adrie, C., 608 Adzize, T., 472 Affl eck, G., 615 Agolino, M., 412 Agostini, J. V., 394

Agrawal, A., 566 Aguilera, D., 227 Ahlner, J., 198 Ahmed, K., 450, 456 Ahn, D. K., 172 Ai, A., 646 Aizer, A., 109 Ajzen, I., 128–130 Akçiçek, F., 361 Aker, J., 307 Akinbami, L. J., 374 Albarracín, D., 130 Albrecht, G., 222 Albrecht, S., 546 Albuquerque, K., 200 Alderfer, M., 377 Aldridge, A. M., 437 Alexander, G. R., 153 Alexopoulos, G. S., 204,

399 Algina, J., 177 Ali, S., 544 Alin, T., 361 Alinsky, S., 484 Allan, J. D., 570 Allard, S. L., 573 Allen, A. J., III, 252 Allen, C., 300 Allen, J. O., 275 Allen, J. P., 455 Alleyne, S., 472, 473 Allgšwer, A., 175 Allison, D. B., 546 Allison, M. A., 529 Altekruse, S., 498, 500,

503, 517 Alter, J., 449 Alter, M. R., 193

Alterman, A. I., 441, 442

Altica, F. L., 534 Altilio, T., 514, 597,

602, 604, 608, 619 Alveo, G., 32 Alvin, B. L., 128 Amaro, H., 434, 449 Amason, P., 248 Amato, D., 473 Amato, M. P., 613 Amberg, S., 305 Ambuel, B., 608 Amendola, J., 619 Aminou, R., 500, 503,

517, 598 Amir, S., 540 Ammar, R., 21 Ammassari, A., 536,

547 Amundsen, A., 454 Anandarajah, G., 279 Ancker, J. S., 572 Andersen, A. U., 194 Andersen, M., 194 Andersen, R., 131, 133,

134, 533 Andersen, R. M., 101,

133, 134, 291, 294 Anderson, A., 150 Anderson, B. J., 534–

535, 538, 539, 541 Anderson, B. L., 356 Anderson, C. M., 153 Anderson, J., 83–84 Anderson, J. W., 292,

301, 302, 304, 305, 307, 309

Anderson, K. O., 616 Anderson, L. A., 250 Anderson, R., 544 Anderson, R. J., 536,

544 Anderson, R. N., 500,

533 Anderson, S. L., 153 Anderson, T., 222 Andes, S., 152 Anding, J. D., 536 Andrade, J., 506, 512 Andresen, E., 72 Andrews, J. E., 573 Andrews, W. C., 348 Andrulis, D. P., 406–408 Andrus, M. R., 150 Andrykowski, M. A.,

203 Aneshensel, C. S., 154 Angeles, P., 43, 44, 46 Angell, B., 164 Angen, M., 505 Angold, A., 174 Angst, F., 187, 197, 198 Angst, J., 187, 197, 198 Anionwu, E., 226 Annes, J. P., 571 Anton, R. F., 429 Antoni, M. H., 350, 534 Antoniou, A., 507 Antonovsky, A., 331 Antonucci, T. C., 402 Aoki, Y., 248 Aoun, S., 608 Apodaca, T. R., 445 Appel, S., 292–294,

297, 300

Author Index.indd 651Author Index.indd 651 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

652 Author Index

Appleby, L., 197 Apter, A., 197 Aragaki, A., 508 Aragon, C., 403 Aranda, S., 506, 511,

598, 608 Arango, P., 65 Ardern-Jones, A., 571 Arias, E., 533 Arko, C., 474 Armenian, H. K., 545 Armitage, C. J., 130 Armstrong, K., 571 Arnd-Caddigan, M., 619 Arndt, L. A., 187 Arnold, R., 599 Arnold, V., 193, 194,

196–198, 205 Arnsten, J. H., 536, 547 Arora, N. K., 242 Aroskar, M. A., 405 Arthur, T., 483 Asch, A., 223, 228 Ashbaugh, C., 476 Ashley, P., 474 Assaf, A. R., 529 Astin, J. A., 291, 294,

298, 299, 311 Atabay, G., 361 Atalah, E., 152 Atchison, K. A., 402, 405 Atchley, R., 509 Atkins, D. C., 448 Atkins, J. N., 297 Atkinson, J. H., R., 608 Atkinson, P. A., 577 Aubuchon, M., 354 Auer, C., 506 Aupont, O., 548 Ausems, M. G., 575 Auslander, G., 472 Auslander, G. K., 472,

473, 480, 481 Auslander, W., 535, 541 Auslander, W. F., 21,

534, 535, 538, 539, 541

Austin, J. L., 449 Austin, L., 159 Avard, D., 580 Avula, D., 448, 450,

456, 457 Azari, R., 542

Azari, R. S., 615 Azoulay, E., 608 Azzarello, G., 307

Baandrup, U., 308 Babcock, E. N., 605 Babor, T. F., 450, 455,

456 Babyak, M. A., 306,

543–545 Bach, J. R., 226 Bagner, D. M., 175, 176 Bailey, D., 83, 84 Baim, M., 306 Baird, M., 175, 203,

318, 337 Baird, P., 598 Baker, D. I., 394 Baker, D. W., 408 Baker, R., 48, 531 Baker, R. W., 183–186 Baker, S. A., 130 Baker, S. P., 438 Bakos, A. D., 578 Baldessarini, R. J., 198 Baldwin, L., 298, 299 Ballenger, J. C., 203–

205 Ballesteros, M. F., 438 Balrow-Stewart, K., 571 Bambauer, K. Z., 548 Bamberger, J., 448 Banaschweski, T., 565 Banks, S., 449 Banner, R. O., xvii Barakat, L., 377 Barbaccia, J. C., 23, 245 Barbanell, L. D., 427 Barbato, F., 307 Barbui, C., 173, 547 Bard, R. S., 444, 448 Barefoot, J. C., 155 Barker, A. T., 308 Barker, D., 153 Barkwell, D. P., 598 Barlow, D. H., 353 Barnes, L., 277 Barnes, P. M., 292, 294 Barnhart, L., 509 Barr, M. S., 253 Barrett-Connor, E., 529 Barrington, K., 479 Barrow, S. M., 190

Barry, K. L., 453 Barth, J., 544, 546 Barth, K., 472 Bartlett, H. M., 10, 12, 15 Bartlett, M. K., 249 Barton, P. L., 547 Barzansky, B., 295 Baser, R. S., 192 Baskin, M., 276 Basnett, I., 219 Bass, E., 479 Bass, E. B., 473, 474 Bassett, C. A., 308 Basson, R., 354 Bateman, A., 197 Bateman, N., 22 Batsis, J. A., 151 Battaglia, F., 431 Battit, G. E., 249 Bauchner, H., 434 Bauer, A., 609 Bauer, C. R., 306 Bauer, L., 292 Baugher, M., 198 Baum, A., 180, 599 Baumeister, R. F., 268–

270, 273 Bawdon, R. E., 166 Beach, M. C., 247 Beach, S. R., 598 Beasley, D., 200 Beauchamp, T., 609 Beautrais, A., 197 Beautrais, A. L., 192 Becerra, R. M., 294,

295, 302–304 Beck, A. T., 197 Beck, K., 130 Beck, S. L., 203 Becker, A. B., 159, 252 Becker, B. N., 471 Becker, E., 337 Becker, F., 410 Becker, K., 565 Becker, M., 129 Becker, M. H., 128, 249,

535, 536 Becker, N., 410 Becker, Y. T., 471 Beckman, H. B., 108,

246 Beckmann, M. W., 507 Becvar, D. S., 304, 308

Beder, J., 480, 481, 504 Beecroft, E., 144, 147 Beekman, A. T., 546, 605 Beer, J., 473 Beer, M. C., 68 Beers, M. H., 500, 502 Behrman, R. E., 433,

434 Beilby, J., 546 Beinfi eld, H., 300, 310 Beiske, A. G., 613 Beitchman, J., 193, 194,

196–198 Belden, M., 434 Bell, C., 405 Bell, J., 331 Bellinger, D. C., 153 Belmont, M. F., 348 Belmonte, P. L., 558 Benador, D., 573 Bencivengo, M., 449 Benedict, R., 374 Benjamins, M. R., 273 Benne, K. D., 245 Benner, L., 190 Bennett, C., 537 Bennett, H. L., 307 Bennett, P., 200 Bennett, P. H., 151, 531 Bennett, R., 577 Bensing, J., 535 Benson, H., 306, 548,

605 Benson, J., 112 Benson, J. A., 434 Benson, R. S., 193, 194,

196–198 Benson, S., 205 Ben-Zur, H., 21 Berbaum, M., 68 Beresford, T. P., 456 Berg, A. O., 570 Berg, K., 70, 90 Berger, C., 643 Berger, C. S., 643–645 Bergman, J., 128 Berkman, B., 25, 409,

410, 416, 509, 510, 516, 644, 646

Berkman, C. S., 348 Berkman, L., 275, 401,

509 Berkman, L. F., 64, 548

Author Index.indd 652Author Index.indd 652 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

Author Index 653

Berkwits, M., 500, 502 Berlin, J. A., 247, 530 Berlin, S., 199 Berlin, S. B., 602 Berman, H., 355 Bernabei, R., 615 Bernard, A., 128 Bernard, S. M., 153 Bernet, W., 193, 194,

196–198, 205 Bernhard, J. D., 307 Bernstein, D. A., 549 Berry, H., 84 Bertakis, K. D., 542 Bertell, B. L., 307 Bertenthal, D., 180 Bertolote, J., 197 Berube, M., 226 Berzoff, J., 482 Besley, D. R., 532 Bettes, B. A., 127 Bettleheim, B., 223 Beutler, E., 571 Bhaskaran, K., 532 Bianchi, T. L., 357 Biank, N., 508, 511 Bichenbach, J., 221 Bickley, H., 197 Bien, T. H., 457 Biener, L., 151 Bierer, M. F., 190 Biesecker, B. B., 507, 575 Bigelow, G., 438, 616 Bikson, K., 24 Billings, J. H., 308 Bimbi, D. S., 358 Bing, E., 177 Bingham, S. A., 545 Birchall, A., 305 Birmaher, B., 198 Bishop, K. K., 65 Bishop, M., 506, 534 Bisits, A., 152 Bjelajac, P., 449 Black, P. K., 353 Black, P. N., 576, 582 Black, R. B., 557 Black, S. A., 531 Blacker, S., 517, 618 Blackhall, L. J., 599 Blakeney, N., 276 Blampied, N. M., 444,

448, 457

Bland, S. D., 529 Blaneaves, J. L., 576 Blarney, C., 305 Blazer, D. G., 547 Blendon, R. J., 112 Bloch, S., 598 Block, K. I., 308 Blom, K., 205 Bloom, B., 292 Bloom, B. S., 291, 294,

295, 311 Blount, A., 318 Blow, F. C., 456 Blue-Howells, J., 24 Blum, D., 504, 619 Blum, R., 599, 610, 615,

616 Blumberg, S. L., 359 Blume, A. W., 446 Blumenfi eld, S., 644 Blumenthal, C., 571 Blumenthal, J., 548 Blumenthal, J. A., 306,

543–546 Blumenthal, M., 309,

311 Blythe, B. J., 15, 125 Bodenheimer, B., 297,

299 Bodenheimer, C., 357 Bodenheimer, T., 110,

111 Bodin, M. B., 305 Boehm, S., 398 Boelk, A., 506 Bogardus, S. T., 394 Bogatz, S., 483, 488 Boggs, S. R., 177 Bohlmeijer, E., 200 Bohnert, A. S. B., 435 Boland, R. J., 166, 167,

187 Boland-Prom, K., 54 Boldt, A. M., 382 Bolen, J. C., 529 Boles, M., 250 Boley-Cruz, T., 150 Boling, P. A., 410 Bolmsjo, I., 509 Bolte, S., 350, 351 Bommer, J., 473, 477 Bonander, E., 409, 410 Bonar, L. K., 544

Bonder, B., 514 Bone, L. R., 253 Bonelli, R. M., 361 Bonger, B., 398 Bonham, V. L., 565,

610, 615, 616 Bonner, T., 49 Bono, G., 275 Bonsall, R., 153 Boogaerts, A., 507, 575 Boone, T., 353 Borasio, G. D., 280 Borden, W., 440 Borduin, C. M., 448 Borgbjerg, F. M., 613 Borgen, D. N., 353 Borges, G., 193 Borins, M., 299 Borkovec, T. D., 549 Borman, P. D., 180 Bors, P., 150 Bortz, W. M., 402 Boss, P., 227, 321, 323,

512 Boszormenyi-Nagy, I.,

327 Bottorff, L. G., 577 Boufassa, F., 532 Bouley, T. A., 579 Boult, C., 411 Bourjolly, J. N., 76 Bourque, L. B., 252 Bovbjerg, D. H., 307,

575, 605 Bowen, K., 84 Bowen, M., 327 Bowman, B. A., 531 Bowman, P. J., 173,

190 Boyle, M., 348 Bozzette, S., 533 Brach, C., 406–408 Bracht, N., 14 Bracken, M. B., 434 Brackett, J., 535 Braddock, D., 220 Bradley, L. A., 603 Brady, D., 474 Brady, K. T., 438 Bragg-Gresham, J. L.,

470, 473, 476, 477 Braithwaite, D., 572 Brand, R. J., 308

Brangman, S. A., 407, 408

Brashler, R., 229 Braun, M., 506 Bray, J., 450, 456 Brazy, P. C., 471 Breakey, W. R., 190 Breen, N., xv, 244 Breitbart, W., 615 Breitbart, W. S., 594 Brekke, J. S., 90 Brekke, L., 151 Brendstrup, E., 305 Brenna, R. T., 152 Brennan, T. A., 190 Brent, D. A., 198 Brent, E. E., 405 Brent, R. S., 405 Bresnahan, M. J., 264 Brestan, E. V., 177 Brewster, K., 571 Brichetto, G., 613 Bridge, J. A., 192 Bridle, C., 446 Briggs, J., 190 Briggs, X. S., 154 Brignoli, O., 546 Brinckmann, J., 309,

311 Brintzenhofeszoc,

K., 505, 514, 517 Britt, E., 444, 448,

457 Brocato, J., 447 Broder, D. S., 112 Brodie, M., 112 Brodsky, M., 616 Brody, S., 361 Brogen, M. S., 11 Bromet, E., 179, 180 Bromet, E. J., 193 Bronfenbrenner, U., 70,

167 Bronstein, L., 34 Brookmeyer, R., 545 Brooks, P., 307 Brooks-Gunn, J., 154 Broome, M. E., 604 Brower, K. J., 456 Brown, C., 273 Brown, E. R., 291, 294 Brown, G. K., 197 Brown, H., 293, 296

Author Index.indd 653Author Index.indd 653 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

654 Author Index

Brown, J. B., 239, 249, 250

Brown, L. D., 112 Brown, L. M., 201 Brown, L. S., 175 Brown, M., 500 Brown, R. L., 454, 455 Brown, R. T., 375 Brown, S. A., 201 Brown, S. E., 308 Brown, T. N., 128 Brown, V., 449 Browne, T., 472, 474,

481, 488 Browne, W., 305 Brownell, C., 444, 448 Bruce, M. L., 198, 399,

401 Bruder, K., 488 Brundage, J. F., 545 Brunner, E., 71 Brunner, R., 508 Bruss, K., 607 Brymer, M., 204 Bubb, J., 535, 541, 543 Buchanan, D., 146, 158 Buchanan, R. G., 453, 454 Buchanan, R. W., 546 Buchs, A., 480 Buchsbaum, D. G., 453,

454 Buckle, S., 472, 473 Buckley, K. A., 77 Buka, S. L., 152 Bukovy, G., 355 Bull, J., 598 Bullard, R. D., 87 Bultz, B. D., 505 Burack, J., 507, 575 Burchell, C. M., 181 Burchett, B., 547 Burg, M., 548 Burg, M. A., 514, 644 Burger, H., 354 Burgess, D. J., 17, 247,

248 Burgess, E. D., 472, 473 Burke, B. L., 444, 448 Burke, J., 262, 546, 633 Burke, J. G., 72 Burke, W., 579 Burkitt, D. P., 308 Burleson, J. A., 474

Burlingham, B., 448 Burnam, A., 177 Burney, R., 307 Burns, C., 150 Burns, E., 305 Burns, J., 197 Burrows-Hudson, S., 472 Burt, K., 361 Bussey-Jones, J., 571 Büssing, A., 279 Butler, C. C., 201 Butow, P. N., 187, 201 Buttar, A. B., 396 Buxton, J. A., 435 Byng-Hall, J., 327 Byock, I., 630 Byrd-Holt, D., 528 Byrnes, M. E., 613 Bzdek, V. M., 305

Cabness, J., 480 Cabot, E. D., 7 Cabot, J. E., 7 Cabot, R. C., 8, 9 Cadiz, S., 449 Cagle, J. G., 350, 351 Cagney, K. A., 473, 474 Cait, C. A., 482 Calder, K., 619 Caldwell, C. H., 192 Caldwell, D. S., 615 Calhan, J., 415 Calkins, D. R., 291–295,

298 Callahan, C. M., 396 Callahan, E. J., 542 Callahan, M. B., 477,

481, 482, 485, 488 Callis, J. R. G., 152 Calvin, R., 172 Camacho, T., 154 Camarota, S. A., 16, 239 Cameron, C., 506 Cameron, R. P., 183 Campbell, A. L., 196 Campbell, A. N. C., 449 Campbell, B., 275 Campbell, C. I., 441 Campbell, D. G., 176 Campbell, M. J., 250 Campbell, M. K., 276 Campbell, S., 405 Campbell, T., 318, 337

Campbell, T. L., 175, 203 Campion, E. W., 297,

311 Campo, J. V., 192 Camsari, T., 361 Canaday, D. J., 308 Canda, E. R., 277,

281–283 Cannon, I. M., 3, 5–7, 9,

11, 12, 14, 15, 17 Cantor, N., 572 Cao, D., 449 Caplan, A., 405 Cappelleri, J. C., 546 Capps, R., 109 Capstick, C., 449 Carbine, N. E., 507 Cardinal, G., 580 Carlier, I. V. E., 205 Carlson, C. R., 203 Carlson, L., 505 Carlton, T. O., 33 Carlton-LaNey, I., 171 Carney, R. M., 174, 536,

544, 548 Carr, D., 318, 337 Carr, J., 529 Carr, J. E., 603, 604 Carroll, K. M., 442, 444 Carroll, M., 73, 74 Carroll, M. D., 374 Carse, A., 48 Carter, B., 327 Carter, J., 504, 505, 512,

513, 516 Carver, C. S., 350 Casale, A. J., 344 Casciato, C. J., 444,

448 Case, D. O., 573 Casey, D. E., Jr., 278 Cash, S. J., 192 Cashin, S., 158 Casillas, J., 508, 510 Caspi, A., 585 Cassel, C. K., 629 Cassell, E. J., 598 Cassileth, B. R., 293,

296, 297, 299, 307 Cassiman, J. J., 507, 575 Castellon, S. A., 454 Castelton, D., 54 Castro, C. A., 180

Catellier, D., 548 Cathers, T., 355 Cavdar, C., 361 Caye, J., 83–84 Cecil-Karb, R., 74 Cedereke, M., 197 Centor, R. M., 453, 454 Cervoni, N., 563 Cha, C. B., 193 Champagne, F. A., 563 Chan, D., 176 Chan, K., 167, 545 Chan, S. K. K., 68 Chan, S. S. C., 68 Chandler, L. P., 546 Chandler, P. J., 150 Chandra, R. K., 308 Chaney, E. F., 176 Chang, C. F., 481 Chang, G., 443 Chang, M., 172, 449 Chao, M. T., 293 Chapin, C., 145 Chapman, C. C., 297 Chappel, J., 441 Chappell, L. T., 309 Charles, W., 516 Charlton, J., 231 Charnow, J. A., 470 Chasco, E. E., 68 Chassin, M. R., 101 Chauncey, S., 409, 410 Cheah, P., 318 Chedid, A., 431 Chee, E., 612 Chee, W., 599 Chen, J. T., 72, 77 Chen, S., 474 Chen, T., 431 Chen, W. Y., 354, 362 Chen, Y. S., 471, 474,

480 Cherpitel, C. J., 455 Chertow, G. M., 472 Chesler, M., 507–509,

517 Chesney, M., 534, 537 Cheung, F., 170 Chevret, S., 608 Chi, F. W., 441 Chi, I., 68 Chiasson, R. E., 432 Childress, J., 609

Author Index.indd 654Author Index.indd 654 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

Author Index 655

Chin, M. H., 68, 264 Chin, S.-Y., 407 Ching, A. Y., 354 Chiu, Y. W., 472 Choi, M., 414 Chopra, D., 301 Chou, S. P., 432 Chow, J., 153 Christ, G., 503–505,

515, 518, 619 Christ, G. H., 348 Christakis, N. A., 91,

240 Christophersen, E. R.,

176 Chroniak, C., 200 Chrousos, G. P., 152 Chu, K., 500 Ciarcia, J., 472 Ciccarone, D., 448 Cicirelli, V., 508 Ciechanowski, P., 546,

547 Ciechanowski, P. S.,

544, 546, 547 Cipriani, A., 547 Cipriano-Steffens, T.

M., 90 Claiborne, N., 15, 16 Clark, D. O., 396 Clark, E., 509, 517 Clark, E. J., 504 Clark, H. W., 448, 450,

456, 457 Clark, P., 92 Clarke, A., 571, 572 Clarke-Steffen, L., 375 Claro, E., 435 Classen, C., 510, 511 Clatts, M., 435, 436 Clawson, C. L., 345 Clay, D. L., 375 Clayton, P. J., 187, 198 Clearman, R., 226 Cleeland, C. S., 599,

610, 615–616 Clegg, L. X., 69 Clement, S., 266 Clements-Nolle, K.,

193 Cleveland, M. A., 405 Clifford, P., 604 Cloninger, C. R., 277

Cloostermans, T., 507, 575

Clouse, R. E., 536, 544 Coates, A. S., 187, 201 Cobb, S., 165 Cocco, E., 613 Cochrane, G., 508 Cohen, E., 509 Cohen, G., 362 Cohen, J. A., 205 Cohen, K., 304 Cohen, L. M., 474, 482 Cohen, L. R., 449 Cohen, M. H., 546 Cohen, S., 166 Cohen, S. M., 534 Cohn, J., 247 Cokkindes, V., 500 Colagiovanni, J., 548 Colasanto, R., 488 Colditz, G. A., 354, 362 Cole, C., 539 Cole, G. P., 65 Coleman, E., 413 Coleman, E. A., 411–

412 Coleman, R. E., 306 Collett, D., 305 Collier, J. D., 616 Collins, B. H., 471 Collins, C., 172, 431,

506 Collins, F., 565 Collins, J. J., 613 Collins, J. W., 73, 152 Collins, P., 546 Colman, L. K., 297 Colombo, B., 613 Combrinck-Graham,

L, 329 Compton, P., 438, 616 Compton, S. N., 174 Compton, W. M., 438,

448, 450, 456, 457 Condron, M. C., 353 Conijm, B., 134 Conn, V. S., 201 Conner, M., 130 Connolly, J. N., 345 Connor, D., 504 Connor, S. R., 618 Conrad, A., 44 Conrad, A. P., 618

Conteh, L., 249 Conway, B., 533 Conway, K., 408 Conwell, Y., 399 Conzen, S., 90, 244 Conzen, S. D., 563 Cook, A., 115 Cook, J. A., 546 Cook, J. M., 449 Cook, S. C., 68 Cooke, R., 130 Cooley, W. C., 117 Cooney, N. L., 450 Cooper, H., 72 Cooper, L., 412 Cooper, L. A., 17, 246,

247, 253 Cooper, M., 23 Copeland, L. J., 356 Copeland, V. C., 64, 76,

125 Corbet, B., 233 Corbie-Smith, G., 571 Cordes, J. A., 187, 188,

190, 191, 194, 199 Cordova, M. J., 203 Cordova, P., 190 Corley, M. C., 305 Cornelius, D. S., 14, 15 Cornelius, L. J., 429 Cornish, P., 608 Corr, C. A., 381 Correll, C. U., 566 Cosper, W., 150 Costello, E. J., 174 Cotch, M. F., 433, 434 Cote, J. K., 534 Cotter, L., 148 Cotti, M., 410 Cotting, D. I., 180 Cottrell, R., 128 Coughlin, J. F., 401 Coulehan, J. L., 252 Coulton, C., 15 Coulton, C. J., 153 Coulton, C. K., 154 Counsell, S. R., 396 Cowan, C. B., 578 Cowan, M. J., 548 Coward, R. T., 240 Cowie, C. C., 528 Cowles, L. A., 33, 409–

411, 415, 647

Cox, S. A., 548 Cox, W. M., 444 Cox-Hayley, D., 615 Coyle, C. T., 275 Crabbe, J. C., 566 Craft-Morgan, J., 547 Craig, A. R., 226 Craig, I. W., 585 Craig, J., 54 Craigie, F. C., 608 Crane, R., 337 Cranston-Cuebas, M.

A., 353 Crawley, L. M., 634 Crawley, L. V., 599 Creed, F. H., 148 Creten, D. A., 542 Crew, J. E., 414 Crist, J. D., 414 Croft-Jeffreys, C., 247 Croghan, T. W., 546,

547 Cronkite, R. C., 68 Crook, T., 405 Croom, E. M., 311 Cropley, T. G., 307 Cross, J. T., Jr., 278 Crothers, D., 301 Crouse, R. E., 536, 544 Crum, R. M., 545 Crusan, C., 505 Cruz, I., 472, 473 Crystal, S., 533 Csikai, E., 45, 517, 619 Cuffe, M. S., 473 Cuijpers, P., 200 Culliton, P. D., 294 Cullum, J., 505 Culpeper, L., 181, 188,

199 Cummings, C., 307 Cummings, S., 571 Cummings, S. R., 399,

409, 410 Cunningham, K., 305 Cunningham, L. L. C.,

203 Cunningham, M., 385 Cunningham, P. B., 448 Cunningham, W., 533 Curbow, B., 505, 514 Curhan, G. C., 480 Curlin, F. A., 264

Author Index.indd 655Author Index.indd 655 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

656 Author Index

Currier, D., 197 Curry, M., 546 Curry, S. J., 68 Curt, G., 292 Curtin, L. R., 374 Curtis, J. R., 608 Curtiss, E. K., 548 Cusack, K. J., 449 Cutler, L. J., 402 Cutting, G. R., 575 Cyprien, S., 109

Dacouris, N., 478 Dahlin, C., 598 Dahlin, C. M., 597, 608 Dahme, B., 605 Dai, D., 70 Dakof, G. A., 448 Dale, D., 509 Daleo, G., 613 D’Allessio, A. C., 563 Dalmida, S. G., 267 Dalton, J., 305 Daly, B. P., 375 D’Ambrosio, L. A., 401 Damcott, C. M., 564 Danaei, G., 151 Dancy, B., 150 Dancyger, C., 580 Danda, C. E., 535 Daneman, D., 536, 544 Daniels, A., 409, 410 Danis, F. S., 24 Danis, M., 618 Dannenberg, A. L., 545 Danoff-Burg, S., 506 Danziger, S., 173, 190 Dar, K. J., 437 Darmon, M., 608 Darnell, J., 109 Darnell, J. S., 118 Darrow, W. W., 361 Darwin, C., 8, 564 Datta, P., 411 D’Augelli, A. R., 355 Daum, G., 454 D’Aunno, T., 449 Davey, S. G., 200 David, A., 247 David, D., 307, 406, 605 David, R. J., 152 Davidhizar, R., 514 Davidoff, A. J., 115

Davidson, A. J., 547 Davidson, J. R., 204,

205 Davidson, K., 644 Davidson, K. W., 547 Davidson, P., 133 Davidson, P. L., 101 Davidson, R. T., 203,

204 Davies, J., 152 Davies, J. M., 34, 644 Davies, M., 176, 433 Davies, M. J., 544 Davies, S., 351 Davis, D., 535, 543 Davis, D. E., 284 Davis, D. R., 426 Davis, J., 405 Davis, K., 110, 111 Davis, L. A., 248 Davis, M. W., 603, 604 Davis, P., 198 Davis, R., 502 Davis, R. B., 292–294,

297, 300 Davison, B. J., 251 Dawson, D. A., 429, 432 Deakins, S. A., 175 deBeurs, E., 615 Debusk, R. F., 360, 361 DeCambra, H., xvii Decker, M. R., 68 Deckro, J. P., 306 DeCock, K. M., 533 DeCoster, V. A., 644 Decruyenaere, M., 507,

575 Dedert, E. A., 200 Deeg, D. J., 615 Deeks, S. G., 534 Degenholtz, H. D., 405 Degner, L. F., 251, 599 DeGood, D., 305 DeGraw, C., 109 de Groot, M., 536, 544 de Groot, M. K., 536,

544 De Guire, M. J., 539 de Haes, H. C., 248 DeJong, G., 219 De Jonge, K. E., 410 de la Chapelle, A., 577 De La Fuente, J. R., 455

Delaney, E. A., 306 Delbanco, T., 21, 34 Delbanco, T. L., 291–

295, 298 de Leon, E. M., 472 de Leon, M. J., 405 Dell Clark, C., 375 DeLoney, E. H., 275 De Longis, P., 536, 547 Del Rio, N., 515 Demas, P., 617 Demas, P. A., 536, 547 DeMoss, C., 599 Demyttenaere, K., 507,

575 DeNavas-Walt, C., 103 Denayer, L., 507 Dennerstein, L., 354 Denning, P., 446, 447 Dent, C., 150 Dent, C. W., 444, 448 DeOreo, P. B., 473, 477,

480 de Ridder, D., 535 de Rijke, J. M., 613 Derogatis, L., 505, 514 Deroo, L., 444 De Simone, L. L., 615 De Smet, P. A., 310 Desnick, R. J., 575 Desonier, M., 504, 505 Deveau, C., 618 Devenyi, R. G., 544 Devilee, P., 580 Devine, E. C., 602 Devins, G. M., 472,

473 Devlin, J., 608 DeVries, H., 134 Dewar, A., 130 Dewey, M., 474 Dhooper, S., 25, 27 Diaz, V. A., 531 Dibble, S. L., 300 Dick, D. M., 565 Dickens, C. M., 148 Dickens, J. D., 151 Dickersin, K., 507 Dickey, P., 68 Dickman, G., 361, 362 Dickson, H. G., 226 Dickson-Fuhrman, E.,

454

DiClemente, C. C., 134, 201, 442, 444–446

Diderot, D., 42 Diez Roux, A., 72, 150 Dignam, J., 501 Dijkstra, A., 134 Dilorio, C., 267 DiMatteo, M. R., 175,

187, 200, 534, 537, 546, 547

Dimeff, L. A., 443, 448 DiNitto, D. M., 430,

431, 436, 440, 449 Disbrow, E. A., 307 Diwan, S., 404, 407,

515 Dixon, J., 158 Dixon, R. A., 308 Dobrof, J., 15, 472, 474,

476 Doctor, M., 356, 357 Dodds, T. A., 7, 8 Doescher, M. P., 95 Doherty, W., 318, 319,

337, 338 Dohrenwend, B. P., 173 Doka, K. J., 637 Dolgoff, R., 42, 43,

49, 53 Dolinko, A., 474, 476 Dombovy, M. L., 643 Domcheck, S., 571 Domcheck, S. M., 507 Donaghy, M., 549 Donaldson, G. W., 307,

603, 604 Donaldson, M. S., 409 Dong, A., 128 Donner, A., 249 D’Onofrio, B. M., 318 Donovan, D. M., 159,

442, 444, 450 Doody, R. S., 308 Doong, H., 308 Dormuth, C., 198 Douglas, J., 148 Douglas, K, C., 408 Dow, W. H., 174 Dozier-Hall, D., 503–

505 Drach, L., 502 Drachman, R. H., 128 Drash, A., 544

Author Index.indd 656Author Index.indd 656 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

Author Index 657

Draucker, C. B., 352 Dreitzer, D., 534 Driscoll, D. A., 575 D’Souza, R., 267 Dubay, L., 109, 115 Duder, S., 35 Dudley, E., 354 Dudokde Wit, A. C.,

580 DuHamel, K. N., 307 Dulcan, M. K., 176 Dundon, J., 571 Dunkel, I., 613 Dunlop, R., 615 Dunmore, E., 127 Dunn, C., 305, 444 Dunn, J. R., 71 Dunn, S. M., 187, 201 Dunne, J. E., 205 DuPre, A., 252 Dupre, J., 565 Duran, R. E., 534 Durazo-Arvizu, R., 200 Durell, J., 449 Durna, E. M., 354 Durrant, R., 436 Duru, O. K., 276 Dushay, R., 175 Dusseldorp, E., 187,

201 Dy, S., 506 Dyer, S., 305 Dyeson, T. B., 413 Dzewaltowski, D. A., 68 Dziegielewski, S., 414,

415 Dziegielewski, S. F.,

32, 411

Eagan, M., 348 Earls, F., 152 Easton, D. F., 507 Eaton, W. W., 545, 546 Eaves, L., 565 Eberhardt, M. S., 528 Ebrahim, S., 200 Eck, D., 266, 285 Eckersley, R. M., 267 Eden, J. A., 354 Edlin, B. R., 448 Edlund, L., 150 Edmonds, F., 599 Edmonds, M., 407

Edmonson, J. H., 599, 610, 615, 616

Edwards, A., 571, 572 Edwards, B., 500, 503,

517, 598 Edwards, B. K., 69, 172 Edwards, H. E., 130 Eeeles, R., 571 Eftkhari, A., 205 Egan, K. A., 618 Egan, M., 414 Egbert, L. D., 249 Egede, L., 546 Egener, B., 252 Egert, J. R., 615 Eheman, C., 500 Ehlebracht, K., 472,

481, 487, 488 Ehlert, U., 153 Ehrenberg, M., 345 Ehrenberg, O., 345 Eiseman, E., 59 Eisenberg, D, 292 Eisenberg, D. M.,

291–295, 297, 298, 300, 502

Eisenberg, L., 171, 237, 238, 241

Eisenstadt, T., 177 Eisenstadt, T. H., 177 Elashoff, R., 187, 201,

306 El-Bassel, N., 176,

439–441, 449 Elbert-Avila, K. I., 406 Elford, J., 533 Eliadis, E. E., 74 Elias, R., 108 Ell, K., 90, 506 Eller, L. S., 605 Ellingson, S., 148, 150 Elliot, T. R., 227 Elliott, D. E., 449 Elliott, M., 70 Elliott, S., 402 Ellis, A. R., 449 Ellision, C. G., 273, 274 Ellor, J. W., 406–408 Elwyn, G., 571, 572 Elzein, H., 478 Emanuel, E. J., 119, 611 Emanuel, L. L., 611 Emery, J., 572

Emery, S., 68 Emo-Dananberg, L. M.,

456 Enders, S., 593 Enders, S. R., 593 Engel, C. C., 182 Engel, G., 223 Engel, G. L., 20, 21,

318 Engelberg, R. A., 608 Engelgau, M. M., 531 Engelhardt, R. F., 252 Engelke, P., 74 Engstrom, M., 176, 190,

446, 449 Ennis, M., 511, 514 Enos, R., xvii Enqvist, B., 307 Enright, R., 355 Enright, R. D., 275 Epstein, I., 472, 474,

476 Epstein, L., 15 Epstein, R. M., 242,

543 Erasmus, C. J., 239 Erblich, J., 575 Erdahl, J. C., 15, 125 Erickson, C. K., 428 Erickson, D. B., 177 Erickson, E. H., 344 Erikson, E., 605 Ernst, E., 297, 311 Erstling, S. S., 608 Escarce, J. J., 247, 530 Escudero, P., 205 Eshlerman, S., 190 Eskinazi, D. P., 292, 296 Esmail, S., 346, 350 Esposito, E., 547 Esposito-Smythers, C.,

196 Ettner, S. L., 292–294,

300 Etzel, S. I., 295 Eunpu, D. L., 577 Evans, S., 361 Evenson, K. R., 150 Everall, I., 545 Everett, C. J., 531 Evers, K. E., 134 Evers-Kiebooms, G.,

507, 575

Evison, I. S., 7, 8, 10, 134

Ewalt, C. K., 131, 132 Ewing, J. A., 405, 453 Extermann, M., 514 Eyberg, S., 177 Eyberg, S. M., 175–177 Eyer, J., 165 Eyfjord, J., 507 Eyre, H., 499–502, 505,

515 Ezzati, M., 151 Ezzo, J., 300, 507

Fabrega, A. J., 470 Fabsitz, R. R., 531 Fackenthal, J. D., 571 Fadiman, A., 242 Fahey, J. L., 166, 187,

201, 306 Fahs, M. C., 348 Fairbairn, W. R. D., 344 Fairfi eld, G., 643 Fajardo, M., 544 Falk, R. J., 276 Fallot, R., 449 Fallot, R. D., 449 Fals-Stewart, W., 449 Farber, N. J., 194 Farber, S., 608 Farrar, A., 618 Farzadegan, H., 536,

547 Fasching, P. A., 507 Fauerbach, J. A., 356,

357 Fawzy, F. I., 187, 201,

306 Fawzy, N. W., 187, 201,

306 Featherstone, K., 577 Fedder, D. O., 546 Feetham, S., 318, 324,

338 Feetham, S. K., 577 Fegg, M., 280 Feighery, E., 69 Feins, J. D., 144, 147 Feldt, K., 508 Felker, B. L., 176 Fello, M., 599 Felson, D. T., 374 Fentiman, B. J., 130

Author Index.indd 657Author Index.indd 657 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

658 Author Index

Fergusson, D. M., 192 Ferketich, A. K., 543 Ferketich, S. L., 177 Fernandez, M. A., 175,

176 Fernandez, M. I., 534 Fernhoff, P. M., 570 Ferrando, S., 361 Ferrell, B., 598 Ferrell, B. A., 615 Ferrell, B. R., 619 Ferrin, M. J., 534 Ferris, S. H., 405 Ferriter, J., 305 Feuer, E. J., 374 Field, M., 580 Field, M. J., 629 Field, T. M., 306 Fielding, D., 474 Fielding, K., 545 Fields, G., 448 Fife, B., 512 Fife, D. K., 190 Figley, C., 639 Fillenbaum, G. G., 405 Fillingim, R. B., 615 Fincannon, J., 607 Finch, M., 405 Finch-Guthrie, P., 408 Findlay, S., 307 Fineberg, I. C., 608,

609, 618 Fink, N., 479 Fink, N. E., 473, 474 Finkelhor, D., 352 Finkelstein, F. O., 472 Finkelstein, N., 449 Finkelstein, S. H., 472 Finn, J. J., 382 Finn, W., 506 Finnegan, M., 434 Finucane, M. L., 572 Fiorenza, J., 472 First, M., 189 Fiscella, K., 95 Fischer, P. F., 190 Fischman, M. W., 447 Fishbein, M., 129, 130 Fisher, L., 175, 203,

318, 337 Fisher, N. L., 237 Fisher, P., 176 Fishman, B., 361

Fitzgerald, S. T., 132 Fitzpatrick, V., 509 Fix, M. E., 109 Flay, B. R., 68 Flegal, K. M., 374 Fleishman, J. A., 177, 403 Fleit, S., 643, 644 Fleming, M. F., 450,

453 Fleming, P. L., 533 Flemming, R., 643 Flexner, A., 7, 49 Fliege, H., 21 Flora, J. A., 69 Flores, G., 77, 255 Flower, L., 243 Floyd, A. R., 200 Floyd, M. F., 72 Flynn, N. M., 448 Foa, E. B., 203–204 Fobair, P., 203, 503–

505, 510 Fogg, L., 604 Foley, K., 438, 616 Folkman, S., 165, 173,

201–203, 398 Folstein, M. F., 405 Folstein, S. E., 405 Fonagy, P., 197 Fong, G. T., 130 Fong, R., 170 Fontanarosa, P. B., 311 Fontdevila, J., 449 Foote, R. C., 177 Ford, A. B., 405 Ford, B., 613 Ford, D. E., 545 Ford, E. S., 531, 544 Forman, W. B., 594 Forrest, D. D., 108 Forstein, M., 545 Fortner, B., 508 Fortune, T., 535 Fossa, S. D., 356 Fost, N., 581 Foster, C., 291–295, 298 Foster, D., 502 Foster, G. M., 239 Foster, R., 545 Foster, S., 309 Foulks, E. F., 241 Fowler, F. J., 151 Fowler, J. H., 91, 240

Fox, P. L., 615 Fox, R. C., 471, 479 Fraenkel, L., 537 Frain, J., 534 Frain, M. P., 534 Frame, P. S., 177 Framo, J., 327 Frank, A., 472, 473, 481 Frank, A. O., 305 Frank, D., 434 Frank, J., 413 Frank, J. C., 395 Frank, L., 74 Frankel, R., 252 Frankel, R. M., 246, 250 Frankl, V., 232 Frankl, V. E., 598 Franklin, C., 167 Franklin, M., 204 Frankowski, B. L., 192 Franks, H. M., 331 Franks, P., 95 Fraser, F. C., 572 Frasure-Smith, N., 166,

187, 548 Frayne, S., 180 Frayne, S. M., 68 Freedenthal, S., 193 Freedland, K. E., 536,

544 Freedman, M. A., 527 Freedman, T. G., 579 Freedman, V. A., 72 Freeman, E. M., 170 Freeman, I., 405 Freeth, D., 246 Freinkel, N., 151 Frenandez-Ortega, P.,

299 French, D. P., 130 French, S. W., 431 Frets, P. G., 580 Freud, S., 344 Frich, L. M., 613 Frick, E., 280 Frick, K., 506 Frid, D. J., 306, 543 Friebel, T. M., 507 Friebert, S., 381 Friedland, G. H., 534 Friedman, A., 471 Friedman, A. B., 151 Friedman, P. D., 432

Friend, R., 476 Frohlick, P. F., 345 Frost-Pineda, K., 433 Fu, S. S., 17, 238,

247–248 Fuchs, B. C., 112 Fuentes, P., 348, 356 Fugh-Berman, A., 306 Fuhrer, M. J., 226 Fujii, M. M., 579 Fujiura, G., 220 Fukuhara, S., 473, 477 Fukunishi, I., 474 Fullerton, S. M., 579 Funderburk, B., 177 Furgerg, C. D., 310 Furgiuele, C., 109 Furman, L. D., 277,

281–283 Furstenberg, A. L., 348 Furth, S., 472 Futterman, R., 446

Gaber, A. O., 481 Gabriel, M. A., 577 Gabriel, S., 374 Gaby, A. R., 308 Gaff, C., 571 Gaff, C. L., 572 Gagnon, J. H., 345, 354,

355 Gaither, G. A., 352 Galambos, C., 646 Galatzer, A., 540 Gale, J. L., 301 Galea, S., 435 Galindo, P., 170 Gallagher-Thompson,

D., 398 Gallant, L., 441 Gallo, J. J., 545 Gallo-Silver, L., 346,

348, 351–353, 362, 363, 605

Gambassi, G., 615 Gamble, S. J., 385 Gambrill, E., 169, 199 Gambrill, E. D., 24 Gamma, A., 198 Gandhi, R., 300 Gans, J., 222 Ganz, P., 133 Ganz, P. A., 509, 514

Author Index.indd 658Author Index.indd 658 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

Author Index 659

Garbe, P. L., 374 Garber, J. E., 507 Garber, S. L., 357 Garcia, D., 158 Garcia, P. R., 534 Garcia, R., 306 Garcia-Preto, N., 327,

332, 336 Gardia, G., 619 Gardner, D., 506, 508,

510, 512, 516, 608, 644

Gardner, D. S., 577 Garfi nkel, R., 198 Garfi nkel, R. S., 153 Garner, M. D., 448 Garrard, J., 150 Garrett, B., 115 Garrett, J., 571 Garron, D. C., 613 Gartner, A. L., 284 Gartside, P., 431 Garvey, K. A., 196 Garwick, A., 506 Gates-Williams, J., 599 Gatsonis, C., 615 Gatz, M., 449 Gaugler, J. E., 403 Gaustad, E. S., 267 Gawinski, A., 318, 336 Gaynes, B. N., 181 Gearing, R. E., 276 Gee, G. C., 74, 172 Gee, L., 448 Geerlings, S. W., 615 Gehlert, S., xv, 70, 90,

127, 128, 149, 159, 244, 501, 518, 563

Gehlert, S. D., 563 Gehlert, S. J., 16 Geiss, L. S., 528 Gelberg, L., 133, 134 Gelfand, D., 415 Gelfand, M. M., 353 George, L. K., 273, 274 Georgiadis, J. R., 353 Gerber, R., 300 Gerber-Werder, R., 197 Gerdner, L. A., 406 Gerhart, K., 226 Germain, C., 64 Germain, C. B., 64, 167,

512

Germain, M., 474 Germain, M. J., 474 German, M., 482 Gersh, B. J., 247, 530 Gershwin, M. E., 307 Gerson, A., 434, 472 Gerson, R., 281, 327,

340, 519, 577 Gersons, B. P. R., 205 Geyer, A. C., 273 Ghadirian, P., 507 Ghafoor, A., 500 Giambarresi, T. R., 575 Gianaros, P. J., 165,

166, 200 Gibson, D. R., 448 Giermek, D., 483 Gifford, C., 305 Gige, J., 514 Gilbar, R., 580 Gilbert, J., 401 Gilbert, L., 176, 449 Gilbertson, D., 474 Gill, C. J., 228 Gillies, L. J., 297 Gilligan, C., 47 Gilmore, S., 544 Gilpin, M., 355 Ginandes, C., 307 Giovanni, M. A., 571 Girard, M., 150 Girffi n, S., 250 Girvin, H., 201, 446 Gitterman, A., 64, 167,

512 Giusti, R. M., 578 Given, B., 516 Given, C., 516 Gizlice, Z., 150 Glajchen, M., 506, 511,

516, 598, 599, 619 Glanz, K., 126 Glasgow, R. E., 68, 534,

535, 538 Glass, K. C., 580 Glastris, P., 225 Gliatto, M. F., 193, 194 Glimelius, B., 503 Globerman, J., 32, 34,

35, 644 Gloyd, S. S., 301 Glunt, E. K., 532 Go, H., 176, 449

Go, O., 531 Godried, M. H., 248 Goetz, C. G., 613 Goffman, E., 221 Goggin, K., 361 Gogia, P., 437 Gold, M. S., 433 Gold, P. W., 152 Goldberg, A., 309, 311 Goldberg, A. B., 68 Goldberg, B., 292, 301,

302, 304, 305, 307, 309

Goldberg, D. G., 118 Golden, S. H., 546 Goldenson, S. M., 117 Golder, S., 449 Goldfarb, A., 307 Goldmeier, J., 52 Goldstein, M., 478 Goldstein, M. S., 291,

294 Goldston, D., 544 Goleman, D., 246 Golub, S. A., 444, 448 Gomez, S., 509 Gonin, R., 599, 610,

615, 616 González, H., 172 Gonzalez, J. S., 534 Gonzalez, S., 326 Good, B., 171, 237, 238,

241 Goodey, E., 505 Gooding, H. C., 507,

575 Goodkin, D. A., 476 Goodman, L., 190 Goodman, R., 376, 380 Goodwin, F. K., 181,

190, 198 Goodwin, J. S., 166 Goodwin, P., 511, 514 Gorder, A. C., 406–408 Gordon, J., 509 Gordon, J. R., 439, 535,

538–540 Gordon, L., 65, 66 Gore, S. A., 241 Gorin, S. H., 16 Gorman, J. M., 548 Gorsuch, R. L., 268–270 Gotay, C. C., xvii, 513

Gotterer, R., 172 Gotthardt, S., 449 Gotto, A. M., Jr., 308 Gould, D., 231 Gould, F., 449 Gould, K. L., 308 Gourevitch, M. N., 536,

547 Grady, C., 618 Graffam, S., 605 Grafova, I. B., 72 Graham, C. L., 413 Graham, Y. P., 153 Gram, L. F., 194 Grann, J. D., 398 Grant, B. F., 172, 429,

432 Grant, M., 454, 455 Grant, R. W., 536, 547 Grason, H., 77 Grauer, D., 534 Gray, A., 571 Gray, S., 508 Gray, S. W., 571 Grealy, L., 232 Grech, P., 545 Greco, P., 535 Greeen, J. S., 200 Green, A., 531 Green, C., 616 Green, L. W., 68 Green, S. E., 353 Greenbaum, P. E., 448 Green C., 54 Greene, M. H., 578 Greene, P. G., 241 Greene, R. R., 415 Greenfi eld, S., 249, 251 Greenhouse, J. B., 192 Greer, S., 201–203 Greeson, J. M., 200 Gregg, E. W., 528 Greisinger, A., 293, 502 Grella, C. E., 449 Grey, D., 546 Greydanus, D. E., 355 Greyner, B., 474 Griffi th, D. M., 275 Griffi th, J., 332 Griffi th, L. S., 544 Griffi th, M., 332 Grigsby, A. B., 536, 544 Grimaldi, P. L., 450, 456

Author Index.indd 659Author Index.indd 659 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

660 Author Index

Grimm, P., 362 Grinker, R., 13 Groce, N., 224 Grody, W. W., 575 Groeger, E., 580 Groerer, J., 616 Grogan-Kaylor, A., 74 Grossman, A. H., 355 Grossman, S. A., 599 Grov, C., 358 Groves, A., 34 Grower-Dowling, K.

A., 548 Grumbach, K., 110, 111 Gruskin, S., 72 Guba, E., 46 Gudes, C. M., 474 Guevara, E., 599 Gulcur, L., 448 Gunderson, E. P., 72 Gunn, A., 190 Gunn, W., 318, 336 Gunnars, B., 503 Gunther, M., 222, 227 Guntzviller, L. M., 248 Guo, A., 473 Gupta, J., 68 Gurtman, A. C., 546 Gushulak, B. D., 645 Gutheil, I. A., 414 Guther, H., 511, 514 Guthrie, D., 187, 201,

306 Guyer, B., 527 Guzman, J. R., 252

Haan, M., 154 Haas, A., 197 Haas, D. C., 547 Haas, F., 360, 361 Haas, J. S., 190 Haas, S. S., 360, 361 Haberle, B., 441 Hachey, M., 374 Hackbarth, D. P., 150 Hackman, R. M., 307 Hadler, A., 152 Haefner, D. P., 128 Hafdahl, A. R., 201 Hafner, R. J., 307 Haga, S., 59 Hagan, T. A., 449 Hahn, R. A., 172

Haiqing, S., 564 Halbert, C. H., 571 Hall, C. D., 545 Hall, D. E., 270, 272 Hall, J. A., 248, 537,

541, 542 Hall, P., 238, 244, 618 Halliday, J. L., 507, 571 Hallowell, N., 572 Halm, E. A., 547 Halpern, J., 222 Halshaw, D., 481 Hamblen, J. L., 205 Hamburg, B. A., 527 Hamburger, M. E., 166,

167, 187 Hamilton, B. E., 72, 75 Hammond, O. W., xvii Hamouda, O., 532 Hamovitch, M., 506 Hancock, K. M., 226 Handelman, L., 407 Handler, A., 77 Hankey, B. F., 69, 172 Hankin, C. S., 180 Hankinson, S. E., 354,

362 Hann, D. M., 603 Hansen, J. P., 608 Hansen, P., 34, 608 Hanson, C. L., 539 Hao, Y., 503 Harden, J., 361 Hardinia, D., 55 Hardt, E. J., 255 Hardy, A. M., 294 Harfi eld, A. K., 599,

610, 615, 616 Harland, K. K., 68 Harless, W., 247, 530 Harootyan, L., 410, 510,

515, 516, 644 Harper, D. M., 144, 158 Harper, P., 226 Harpham, W. S., 606 Harrington, H., 585 Harris, D., 355 Harris, G., 277 Harris, J. J., 177 Harris, J. K., 92 Harris, M., 449 Harris, M. A., 535 Harris, R. J., 443

Harrison, L., 305 Hart, K. A., 226 Hart, P. D., 612 Hart, R., 380 Hartig, T., 72 Hartman, A., 282 Hartwell, L., 473, 477 Hartwell, N., 545 Harvey, L. M., 535 Harvey, M., 190 Harward, D. H., 276 Hasenbring, M., 605 Hasin, D. S., 432 Haskard, K. B., 534 Hasnain-Wynia, R., 408 Hatch, E. E., 434 Hatchett, L., 476 Hatfi eld, A. K., 599 Hathaway, D. K., 481 Hatsukami, D. K., 447 Hauf, S., 280 Haukka, J., 198 Hauser, J., 506 Hauser, S. T., 534, 539 Hauser, W. A., 127 Haviland, L., 69 Hawkley, L. C., 152 Hayes, I., 479 Hays, R. D., 70 Hazan, C., 343 Hazlett, R., 68 Hazlett-Stevens, H., 549 Headen, I., 107 Headrick, L. A., 33 Heaney, C. A., 538 Heath, G. W., 172 Heather, N., 444 Heckman, J., 449 Heckman, J. J., 153 Heclo, H., 112 Hedayati, S. S., 473 Heerdink, R., 535 Hefl in, C. M., 173, 190 Heggar, A., 383 Heider, F., 127 Heidrich, F., 128 Heikkinen, R., 509 Heim, C., 153 Heinberg, L., 356, 357 Heine, R. J., 546 Heiney, S., 607 Heisler, M., 537 Heit, S., 153

Helgeson, V., 333 Heller, G. Z., 354 Hellhammer, D. H., 153 Helman, C. G., 241 Helmick, C. G., 374 Helms, L. J., 542 Hembree, E. A., 204 Hemila, H., 308 Henderson, C. E., 448 Henderson, F. C., 172 Henderson, G., 571 Hendin, H., 197 Hendricks, C. B., 177 Hendrix, L., 407 Henggeler, S. W., 448 Hennen, J., 198 Henningfi eld, J. E., 189 Hennrikus, D., 249 Henriques, G. R., 197 Heo, M., 546 Hepworth, D. H., 125,

185, 190, 199, 252, 440

Hepworth, J., 318, 319, 337, 338

Herbert, T., 166 Herbert, T. B., 166 Herek, G. M., 532 Herman, D. B., 180, 190 Hermann, J., 504, 505,

512, 513, 516, 607 Hermann, J. F., 508 Hernandez-Avila, M.,

150 Herndon, K. C., 150 Heron, M., 145, 146,

148, 192 Herpertz, S., 548 Herrell, R., 565 Herrmann-Lingen, C.,

544, 546 Hershberger, S. L., 355 Herskowitz, D. R., 539 Herskowitz, R. D., 534 Hesdorffer, D. C., 127 Hessol, N. A., 546 Hester, R. K., 439–443,

448 Hettema, J., 444, 448 Hiatt, R. A., 244 Hibbs, J. R., 190 Hicks, C., 305 Hien, D., 189

Author Index.indd 660Author Index.indd 660 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

Author Index 661

Hien, D. A., 449 Higginson, I., 599 Hight, E., 279 Hightower, P., 68 Hikoyeda, N., 407 Hildebrandt, M., 21 Hilden, J. M., 382 Hill, I., 109 Hill, M., 54 Hill, P. C., 268–272,

274, 279 Hillhouse, J., 306 Hillier, A. E., 90 Himelstein, B. P., 382 Hines, P. M., 130 Hingson, R., 434 Hinkin, C. H., 454 Hinton, W. L., 407, 408 Hipp, J. A., 84 Hipp, J. R., 69, 92 Hippisley-Cox, J., 545 Hirsch, C. S., 545 Hirsch, G. B., 91 Hirsch, R., 374 Hirsch, S. H., 395 Hirschfeld, R. M. A.,

193–198 Hirth, V., 394, 395 Hitchcock, P., 187, 188,

190, 191, 194, 199 Ho, J., 535 Hobbie, W., 507 Hobbins, D., 352 Hochbaum, G. M., 128 Hockenberg-Eaton, M.,

344 Hodge, D., 43 Hodge, D. R., 278,

280–282, 284 Hoffman, D. E., 610, 615 Hofmann, P., 3661 Hogan, S. L., 276 Hoge, C. W., 180 Hogenelst, M. H., 548 Hogg, R. S., 167, 545 Hogue, A., 448 Hoh, J., 565 Hokenstad, M. S., 85 Holahan, J., 107, 115 Holden, G., 355 Holder, C., 444, 448 Holder, D., 198 Holkup, P., 196

Holland, J. C., 503–505, 516, 594

Hollander, J. E., 197 Holley, J. L., 473, 479 Holliman, D., 32 Holliman, D. C., 411 Hollis, F., 167 Hollon, S. D., 203, 204 Holmes, M. D., 354, 362 Holmes, T. H., 68 Holmes, W., 409, 410,

509 Holmgren, A., 198 Holodniy, M., 534 Holstad, M. M., 267 Holstege, G., 353 Holtzman, D., 529 Holtzman, N. A., 579 Homer, C. J., 570 Homer, J. 2007, 91 Homer, J. B. 2006, 91 Honda, M., 474 Honig, A., 179 Hons, R. B., 472, 473 Hood, K. K., 177 Hood, R. W., 268–272,

279 Hood, R. W., Jr., 274 Hook, J. N., 284 Hook, J. P., 284 Hooker, C., 505, 514 Hopper, J., 507 Horejsi, C., 125 Horenstein, R. B., 564 Horgan, O., 356, 357 Horner, G., 344 Hornik, R. C., 571 Horowitz, I., 59 Horvath, A., 167 Horwood, L. J., 192 Hosier, S. G., 444 Hoskins, L. M., 578 Hossain, M., 645 House, A., 179 House, J. S., 149, 160,

165 Housenbold Seiger, B.,

446 Howard, A. A., 536, 547 Howard, A. F., 576 Howard, B. V., 531 Howe, C., 431 Howe, H. L., 172

Hoy, J., 545 Hoyert, D. L., 145, 146,

148 Hsia, J., 529 Hsiao, A. F., 291, 294 Hu, G., 438 Hu, M.-C., 449 Huang, E. S., 68, 108 Huang, L., 616 Huang, Y., 482 Hudgens, A., 619 Hudson, C., 301 Hudson, M. A., 276 Hudson, M. M., 509 Hudson, P., 506, 511,

608 Hudson, S., 402 Hudson, S. M., 444,

448, 457 Huegel, K., 375, 376 Huff, S., 381 Hufford, D. J., 269, 291,

294, 295, 311 Hugelshofer, D. S., 183 Hughes, D., 544 Hughes, M., 179, 180,

190 Hughes, M. K., 361 Hultman, T., 598 Humphreys, K., 441 Humphreys, L., 57 Hunt, I. M., 197 Hunt, L. M., 565 Hunt, N., 447, 448 Hunt, R. A., 270–272 Hunter, D. J., 643 Hunter, J., 511, 514 Hurdle, D. E., 302 Hurlbert, D. F., 353 Hurley, J., 616 Hurley, K., 331, 572 Hurria, A., 514 Husserl, F. E., 478 Huston, S. L., 150 Hutchins, E., 77 Hutson, S. P., 578 Hwang, S. W., 190 Hwang, W., 472 Hyun, C. S., 187, 201,

306

Iacono, S. A., 473 Icard, L. D., 76

Ickovics, J. R., 166, 167, 187

Ide, M., 353, 356 Iecovich, E., 415 Iglehart, A. P., 294, 295,

302–304 Iguchi, M., 438, 616 Im, E., 599 Imber-Black, E., 333 Imhof, J. E., 451 Inada, T., 473 Infante, M. C., 546 Ingledue, K., 128 Inoff, G. E., 527 Inouye, S., 508 Insel, T. R., 178 Inui, T. S., 250 Iqbal, M. I., 545 Iredale, R., 572 Irle, J., 571 Isacsson, G., 198 Ismail, K., 548 Israel, B. A., 159, 252,

538 Issell, B., 300 Ivanoff, A. J., 193–197 Ivey, S. L., 413 Iyengar, S., 544 Izzo, C., 536, 547

Jaakko, K., 565 Jackson, B. A., 405 Jackson, D., 478 Jackson, D. A., 300 Jackson, D. L., 399,

409, 410 Jackson, J. S., 172, 192 Jackson, V., 125 Jacob, R., 144, 147 Jacobs, A., 204 Jacobs, J., 301 Jacobs, W. S., 433 Jacobsen, P., 505, 514,

594, 602, 603, 605 Jacobsen, P. B., 200, 594 Jacobson, A., 535, 543 Jacobson, A. M., 534,

539 Jacobson, L. P., 532 Jadad, A. R., 615 Jaeger, U., 204 Jaehee, Y., 509, 514 Jaffe, A. J., 443

Author Index.indd 661Author Index.indd 661 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

662 Author Index

Jaffe, J., 454 Jaffe, M. W., 405 Jaffee, S. R., 565 Jakubiak, C., 415 Jannasch, K., 535, 543 Janoff, S., 54 Janssen, R. S., 533 Janus, I. L., 246 Janz, N., 129 Jarman-Rohde, L., 125 Jarrett, M. C., 13 Jarvik, G. P., 579 Jarvik, L., 454 Jarvis, K. B., 305 Jasser, S. A., 200 Jaw, B. S., 471, 474, 480 Jeffrey, R. W., 165 Jehu, D., 352 Jemal, A., 500, 503 Jemmott, J. B., III, 130 Jemmott, L. S., 130 Jenckes, M., 479 Jencks, C., 154 Jenkins, L., 534 Jennette, C., 276 Jennings, D. J., II, 284 Jenny, N. S., 72 Jensen, J. B., 348, 353,

360 Jensen, J. D., 247 Jensenius, K., 16, 239 Jerant, A. F., 615 Jesdale, B. M., 193 Jiang, H., 449 Jiang, W., 306, 473 Jimenez, L. M., 301 Jimenez, M. A., 112 Joe, S., 192 Johansen, K. L., 482 Johansson, B. B., 300 Johansson, K., 300 Johnsen, S. P., 21 Johnson, A., 199, 200,

605 Johnson, A. M., 532,

576, 582, 583 Johnson, B. A., 198 Johnson, B. H., 511 Johnson, B. T., 130 Johnson, C. A., 150 Johnson, C. F., 352 Johnson, H. B., 112 Johnson, J., 449

Johnson, J. C., 291, 294, 295, 311

Johnson, J. D., 573 Johnson, J. L., 134 Johnson, K., 109, 406 Johnson, K. C., 529 Johnson, M., 224 Johnson, M. S., 570 Johnson, R., 509 Johnson, R. L., 17, 246,

247 Johnson, S. B., 536 Johnson, T. A., 632, 639 Johnson, V. E., 353,

354, 363 Johnson, W. R., 439 Johnson, Y., 190 Johnson-Mallard, V.,

200 Johnston, J. M., 68 Johnstone, S., 480, 481,

485 Joiner, T. E., 196 Joly, L. M., 608 Jonas, W. B., 296, 299,

310 Jones, C., 307 Jones, D. A., 548 Jones, E. M., 197 Jones, J., 51, 58 Jones, J. C., 353 Jones, J. M., 536 Jones, M. K., 348, 356 Jones, T. V., 500, 502 Jones, V., 412 Jones, V. Y., 407, 408 Jonsen, A., 50, 51, 53,

471 Jonsson, T., 308 Jordan, C., 167 Jordan, J., 249 Joseph, M., 44 Joy, J. E., 434 Joyner, K., 193 Judd, F., 545 Judis, J. B., 112 Jung, K. G., 534, 535,

538, 539, 541 Jungeblut, A., 534 Justice, B., 306

Kabat-Zinn, J., 200, 307 Kabcenell, A., 694

Kächele, H., 204 Kadden, R. M., 442, 444 Kadushin, G., 414 Kagawa-Singer, M., 599 Kagle, J., 46 Kahlback, D., 232 Kahn, J. O., 534 Kahn, R., 165 Kahn, R. L., 244 Kaiser, S., 350 Kaitelidou, D., 471, 474 Kalkwarf, H., 75 Kanaan, B. K., 411 Kandel, D. B., 433 Kane, J., 566 Kane, R., 508 Kane, R., 508 Kane, R. A., 396, 403,

405, 406 Kane, R. L., 396, 398,

404, 412 Kane, V., 449 Kapfhammer, H. P., 361 Kaplan, D., 327 Kaplan, G., 77 Kaplan, G. A., 149, 154,

157, 160 Kaplan, H. B., 456 Kaplan, H. S., 344, 346,

353, 361, 363 Kaplan, J., 546 Kaplan, J. L., 500, 502 Kaplan, M. S., 399 Kaplan, S., 251 Kaplan, S. H., 249, 251 Kappes, N., 232 Kaprio, J., 558 Kaptchuk, T. J., 293,

295, 297 Kapur, N., 197 Karma, S., 353 Karon, J. M., 533 Karp, L., 571 Karris, S. D., 350 Karus, D., 433 Kase, R. G., 575 Kashner, T. M., 180 Kaskel, F., 472 Kaskutas, L. A., 441 Kaspar, V., 172, 173,

201 Kasper, J., 108, 506 Kass, L., 609

Kassebaum, P. A., 450, 456

Kataoka, S. H., 205 Katcher, M. L., 374 Katon, W., 166, 197,

547 Katon, W. J., 544, 546,

547 Katz, A., 353, 356 Katz, I. R., 399 Katz, L. F., 144, 147 Katz, M., 193 Katz, N. R., 541, 542 Katz, R. S., 632, 639 Katz, S., 405 Katzin, L., 346 Kauff, N. D., 507 Kaufman, D., 572 Kaufman, J. S., 64, 76,

77 Kaufman, S. R., 47 Kava, B. R., 350 Kawachi, I., 64, 174,

275 Kawashima, T., 509 Kayne, H., 434 Kayser, K., 34, 175,

506, 512, 608 Kazak, A., 377 Kazak, A. E., 337 Keane, C. R., 72 Keating, S. A., 411, 412 Kee, R., 158 Kee, R. A., 146, 158 Keefe, F. J., 615 Keefe, R. H., 70 Keefl er, J., 35 Keegan, J., 434 Keen, M. L., 476 Keene, N., 377, 507 Kelleher, K. J., 192 Keller, E., 305 Keller, G., 174 Keller, R. B., 151 Kelley, H. H., 127 Kelley, K. W., 150 Kellogg, S. H., 446 Kelly, D. C., 344 Kelly, G. R., 128 Kelly, P., 604 Kelly, R., 353 Kelly, R. E., 204 Kemeny, M. E., 166

Author Index.indd 662Author Index.indd 662 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

Author Index 663

Kendler, K., 429 Kendler, K. S., 190 Kenen, R., 571, 577 Kennard, B. D., 166 Kennedy, B. J., 299 Kenney, G., 109 Kenney, K. A., 109 Kent, A., 558 Keppel, K. G., 172 Kerlinger, F. N., 126 Kerner, J. F., 247, 530 Kerr, K., 603 Kerrigan, A. J., 357 Kerson, T. S., 164, 170,

171, 178 Kessels, A. G., 613 Kessler, D., 181 Kessler, L., 500, 571 Kessler, R., 502 Kessler, R. C., 179, 180,

190, 193, 203, 204, 291–295, 297, 298, 300

Kesten, D., 308 Kettner, P., 53 Khaleel, N. I., 33 Khaw, K., 545 Khoury, J., 75 Khunti, K., 544 Kiefe, C. I., 72 Kiely, M., 179 Kieswetter, H., 309 Kilburn-Watt, E., 348,

356 Killaspy, H., 193 Kim, C., 530 Kim, G. H., 472 Kim, S. G., 472 Kim, S. S., 350 Kim, Y., 415 Kimerling, R., 68, 183 Kimmel, P., 473 Kimmel, P. L., 472, 473 Kim-Sing, C., 577 Kindig, D. A., 534, 572 King, A. J., 248 King, H., 531 King, M., 152, 193, 356 King, M. B., 270–272 King, M. C., 507 Kingsberg, S. A., 353 Kinmonth, A. L., 250 Kinney, J., 440, 441

Kinsey, A. C., 345, 354 Kip, K. E., 200 Kippes, M. E., 603, 604 Kirby, A. J., 532 Kirchner, J. E., 176 Kiresuk, T. J., 294 Kirk, J., 580 Kirk, S., 506 Kirk, S. A., 178 Kirmeyer, S., 72, 75 Kirsch, I., 534, 605 Kirschner, K., 225 Kirschner, K. L., 229 Kirscht, J. P., 128 Kirsh, K. L., 438, 439 Kissane, D., 598 Kivimaki, M., 71 Kivnick, H. Q., 405 Kjellstrom, T., 84 Klap, R., 203, 204 Klapp, B. F., 21 Klassen, J., 472, 473 Klaukka, T., 198 Klebanoff, M. A., 433,

434 Kleespies, P., 544 Kleijnen, J., 301 Klein, A., 13 Klein, E. L., 346, 360 Klein, J. D., 570 Klein, T. W., 200 Kleinman, A., 171, 237,

238, 241, 242, 331, 398, 633, 640

Kleinman, L., 301 Klesges, L. M., 68 Kliger, A. S., 472 Klijn, J. G. M., 580 Kling, J. R., 144, 147 Klingbell, F., 353 Klinger, K., 575 Klipstein, S., 574 Klugman, L., 190 Klussendorf, D., 309 Knapp, C., 382 Kneebone, I. I., 127 Knickerman, J. R., 500 Knickman, J. R., 75, 143,

149, 165, 173, 175, 244, 246, 256

Knight, E. L., 480 Knipschild, P., 301 Knol, M. J., 546

Knopp, R. H., 530 Knoppers, B. M., 580 Knowler, W. C., 151,

531 Ko, C. M., 128 Kobayashi, J. S., 547 Kochanek, K. D., 71,

72, 75, 145, 146, 148, 192, 533

Koenig, B., 599 Koenig, B. A., 599, 634 Koenig, H. G., 171,

269–279, 284, 406 Koffman, J., 599 Koffman, R. L., 180 Kohler, B., 500 Kohn, J., 479 Kohrman, J., 13 Koken, J. A., 358 Kolko, D., 198 Kolstad, L., 534 Kolterman, O. G., 539 Komiti, A., 545 Kon, A. A., 90 Kondrat, M. E., 64, 92,

167, 169 Koo, J. R., 472 Koocher, G. P., 548 Koontz, A. M., 77 Koopman, R. J., 531 Koopmans, J., 505, 511,

514 Kopels, S., 46 Kopke, J. E., 470 Koppelman, K., 594 Kopstein, A. N., 616 Korbin, J. E., 153 Korn, E., 150 Kornbluth, A. B., 509 Korngold, E., 300, 310 Koro, C. E., 546 Korthuis, P. T., 247 Kosary, C., 500, 503,

517, 598 Koscielny, J., 309 Kosten, T. R., 434, 436,

438 Kotch, J. B., 65 Kout, J. A., 240 Kouvelis, A., 144, 158 Kovacs, M., 544 Kozachik, S., 516 Koziol-McLain, J., 226

Kraaij, V., 187, 201 Kraemer, H., 172 Krajewski-Jaime, E. R.,

295 Kral, A. H., 448 Kramer, A., 413 Kramer, B. J., 506, 508 Kramer, H., 411, 412 Kramer, J., 535, 543 Kramer, N. A., 305 Kramer, R., 309 Krantz, D. S., 174, 306 Kranzler, H. R., 429 Krapcho, M., 500, 503,

517, 598 Kratt, P. P., 241 Krause, N., 274, 275,

285, 401, 509 Krause, N. M., 272, 274 Kreische, R., 204 Krementz, J., 376 Krentzman, A., 441 Kressin, N., 180 Kreuter, M., 159 Kreyenbuhl, J., 546 Krieger, N., 72, 73, 77,

145, 172, 173 Krippner, S., 303, 304 Krishnan, K. R., 473 Kristal, A. R., 241 Kristjanson, L., 506,

511 Kristjanson, L. J., 608 Kroenke, K., 166 Kroll, K., 346, 360 Kronenberg, F., 293 Kronenfeld, J. J., 110,

111, 122 Kronenfeld, M. R., 122 Kronish, I. M., 547 Kruse, J., 544 Kruzich, J. M., 415 Ku, L., 109, 154 Kubena, K. S., 536 Kübler-Ross, E., 226,

594 Kuboki, T., 473 Kubzansky, L., 275 Kuchel, A., 508 Kuchibhatla, M., 473 Kuhn, C. M., 306 Kumano, H., 200 Kumar, P., 533

Author Index.indd 663Author Index.indd 663 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

664 Author Index

Kung, H., 533 Kunz, C., 444, 448 Kupst, M., 507 Kurella, M., 472 Kurtin, P. S., 474 Kurtz, E., 441 Kurylo, M., 227 Kushel, M. B., 190 Kushner, K., 608 Kutchins, H., 178 Kutner, N. G., 471, 482 Kuzel, A. J., 118 Kuzma, M. A., 194 Kwilosz, D. M., 618 Kwoh, C. K., 374 Kyle, D., 331, 333

Lacey, H., 48, 57 LaCroix, A., 508 Laderman, G., 267 Lafffel, L. M., 535 Lahey, B. B., 318 Lakon, C. M., 69, 92 Lam, T. H., 68 Lamb, C., 483 Lamb, M. M., 374 Lambert, P. C., 532 Lamont, L., 505 Lamptey, P. R., 532 Landau, R., 52 Landen, M. G., 435 Landesman, L. Y., 83, 84 Landgraf, J. M., 474 Landi, F., 615 Landon, B. E., 108 Landsman, M. K., 472,

473 Lange, D. P., 499–502,

505, 515 Langer, R. D., 529 Langley, A., 205 Langlois, J., 403 Lanphear, B., 75 Lantos, J. D., 264 Lapane, K., 615 Lapin, J., 613 Larimer, M. E., 442,

443, 448 Larsen, J., 252 Larsen, J. A., 125, 185,

190, 199, 440 Larson, D. B., 171,

269–274, 276, 284

Larson, D. G., 618 Larson, E., 228 Larson, E. B., 128 Larson, S. M., 253 Lasser, N. L., 529 Lathrop, S. L., 435 Latza, R., 309 Laucht, M., 565 Laumann, E. O., 20,

148, 150, 345, 354, 355

Launso, L., 305 Laurenceau, J. P., 350 Lautrette, A., 608 LaVeist, T. A., 152 Lavori, P., 534 Law, D., 337 Lawlor, E. F., 101, 106 Lawrence, D. J., 304 Lawrence, J. W., 356,

357 Lawrence, R. C., 374 Lawrence, R. E., 264 Lawrence, S., 68 Lawry, K., 474 Laws, M. B., 255 Lawson, K., 644 Lawson, L. D., 309 Lawson, M. L., 536 Lawson, R., 127 Lawton, M., 508 Lawton, M. J., 453, 454 Layne, C., 204 Lazarus, A., 54 Lazarus, R. S., 165, 173,

202 Lazcano-Ponce, E., 150 Lazrus, J. M., 480 Leader, L. R., 354 Leake, B. D., 133, 134 Leaton, G., 440, 441 Leavell, J., 172, 431 LeBas, J., 503 Lebow, J. M., 190 Lechman, C., 35 LeClere, F. B., 155 Lecours, A. R., 353 Lecrubier, Y., 181, 183,

203–205 Lederberg, M. S., 594 Ledesma, D., 200 Lee, E. T., 531 Lee, H., 150, 446

Lee, J., 507 Lee, J. S., 34, 414 Lee, R. C., 308 Lee, S., 193 Lee, Y. K., 472 Lefcourt, H. M., 333 Lefcowitz, M. J., 411,

647 Lefebvre, J. C., 615 Legius, E., 507 Lehert, P., 354 Lehner, T., 565 Leibing, E., 204 Leichsenring, F., 204 Leigh, E., 198 Leipzig, M., 306 Leischow, S., 92 Lemieux, L., 350 Lemon, S. C., 432 Lenahan, P., 408 Lencz, T., 566 Leng, M., 276 Lengacher, C. A., 200 Lenox, R., 180 Leo, R. J., 480 Leob, J. M., 101 Leon, A. C., 545 Leonard, R. C., 249 Leonard, T., 454, 455 Lepper, H. S., 546, 547 Lerman, C., 575 Lerner, I. J., 299 Leroux, J. M., 353 LeSage, L., 480, 481 Leshner, A. I., 441, 442 Leslie, D. L., 546 Lesperance, F., 166, 187 Leszcz, M., 511, 514 Lethborg, C., 598 Lett, H. S., 543–545 Leung, G. M., 68 Levay, I., 173 Levenson, S., 434 Leventhal, H., 239 Levethal, T., 154 Levin, B., 177 Levin, J. S., 269, 274,

401, 406 Levin, T., 292 Levine, B. J., 477 Levine, C., 617 Levine, D. M., 253 Levine, F. M., 615

Levine, M., 449 Levine, R., 91 Levinson, D. J., 329 Levinson, W., 20, 182,

250 Levitan, A. A., 307 Levy, J. A., 240 Levy, M., 613 Lew, N. L., 477 Leweke, F., 204 Lewin, J., 356 Lewis, C. P., 166 Lewis, E. Y., 275 Lewis, G., 181, 247 Lewis, I. D., 406 Lewis, J. P., 293, 296 Lewis, M., 643, 644 Lewis, S., 108, 503,

505, 515 Ley, P., 542 Li, C., 544 Li, W., 249 Liang, K., 565 Liao, S., 615 Liaropouls, L., 471, 474 Lichtiger, E., 474, 476 Lickiss, J. N., 618 Liddle, H. A., 448 Liebman, A., 608 Lieu, T. A., 570 Lifton, R., 221 Light, T., 307 Lim, H., 599 Lim, J., 318, 514 Lin, C.-T., 252 Lin, E., 166, 197, 547 Lin, E. H. B., 546 Lin, J.-W., 644 Lin, K., 170 Lin, K.-M., 406 Lin, N., 509 Lin, Y. D., 69 Lincoln, J. D., 89 Lind, L., 180 Lindau, S. T., 20 Lindauer, R. J. L., 205 Lindberg, J. S., 478 Linder, J. F., 593 Lindgren, I., 300 Linehan, M. M., 198 Liner, K. J., 545 Link, B., 175, 500 Link, B. G., 173

Author Index.indd 664Author Index.indd 664 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

Author Index 665

Linsk, N. L., 402 Lip, G. Y., 354 Lipkin, C., 412 Lippman-Hand, A., 572 Liptak, G. S., 249 Lipton, R., 612 Lipworth, L., 307 Lish, J. D., 194 Lister, L., 16, 245 L’Italien, G. J., 546 Litt, L. C., 449 Littell, J. H., 201, 446 Little, J., 447 Liu, C., 176 Liu, K., 403 Liu, Y., 599 Livneh, H., 21, 227, 512 Lizardi, D., 276 Llorens, L., 406 Lloyd, J. H., 545 Lloyd, K., 181 Lo, B., 599, 609, 634 Lobb, E., 571 Lobchuk, M. M., 599 LoCicero, A., 84 Locke, B. Z., 181, 190 Locke, S. E., 548 Lodder, J., 179 Loewy, J. V., 380 Logan, D. E., 447 Loge, J. H., 613 Logsdon, R., 405 Lohr, K. N., 181, 409 Lollock, L., 16, 239–240 Lonczak, H. S., 448 London, A. S., 177 Long, J. M., 307 Long, S. K., 115 Longabaugh, R., 439,

443–445 Longknife, K., 481 Longmore, P., 226 Longshore, D., 177 Lönnqvist, J., 198 Lopez-Jimenez, F., 151 Lorente, M., 446 Lorenz, A., 318, 327,

336, 337 Lorenz, R. A., 535, 543 Loscalzo, M., 603, 605,

619 Loscalzo, M. J., 594,

618

Lostumbo, L. N., 507 Lott, C., 42 Loud, J., 578 Loud, J. T., 578 Lousberg, R., 179 Loveland-Cook, C. S.,

304, 308 Lovett, J., 379, 3385 Low, S. M., 242 Low-Beer, S., 167, 545 Lowe, D., 509 Loweenstien, S., 226 Lowenberg, F., 42, 43,

49, 53 Lown, B., 252 Lowrie, E. G., 477 Lowry, P., 152 Lu, D. P., 301 Lu, G. P., 301 Lubben, J. E., 402, 405 Luben, R. N., 545 Lucas, F., 645 Lucas, J. W., 145, 146 Luck, E., 297, 299 Luckman, J., 253, 254 Ludman, E. J., 197, 579 Luebbert, K., 605 Lukas, S., 183–186,

194, 195 Luke, D. A., 92 Lukens, E., 175 Lukens, E. P., 200 Lukianowicz, N., 353,

363 Lundahl, B., 444, 448 Lundahl, B. W., 444,

448 Lundberg, G. D., 311 Lundin, A. P., 478 Luoma, J. B., 194 Lupton, D. L., 572 Lurie, N., xv Lush, D. T., 194 Lusk, M., 645 Lustman, P. J., 536, 544,

546 Lux, M. P., 507 Lynch, D., 307 Lynch, H. T., 507, 577 Lynch, J., 77 Lynch, V., 115 Lynn, J., 335, 694 Lynskey, M. T., 566

Lyon, D. E., 545, 546 Lyons, B., 108 Lyyra, T., 509

Macchia, I., 190 MacDonald, H., 474 MacDonald, J. E., 598 MacDorman, M. F.,

72, 75 Maceda, M., 488 MacGregor, D. G., 572 MacGregor, H., 13 Machiran, N. M., 307 Macias, J., 435 MacIntosh, A., 295,

296, 304 MacIntyre, S., 150, 156 MacIver, S., 156 MacKenzie, E. R., 291,

294, 295, 311 MacLachlan, M., 356,

357 MacMaster, S. A., 447 MacPherson, D. W., 645 Madden, D. J., 398 Madden, T. J., 128, 130 Madden, V., 382 Maddocks, I., 618 Madras, B. K., 448, 450,

456, 457 Maes, S., 187, 201 Magder, L. S., 546 Maguire, P., 248 Mahay, J., 148, 150 Maher, J. E., 444, 448 Mahler, K., 264 Mahoney, M., 150 Mailick, M. D., 15 Maiman, L. A., 128,

249, 535, 536 Mainous, A. G., 531 Majeed, A., 531 Mak, S., 435 Makoul, G., 242 Malcolm, R., 438 Malhotra, A., 566 Malone, D. K., 448 Malott, J. M., 604 Maloy, K. A., 109 Maltby, L. E., 279 Maltz, W., 352, 363 Maly, R. C., 252, 395 Mamalakis, P., 54

Mamon, J. A., 128 Manderscheid, R. W.,

181, 190 Mandin, H., 472, 473 Mandle, C. L., 306 Mandrusiak, M., 196 Mangione, C. M., 276 Maniadakis, N., 471, 474 Mann, J. J., 197 Manne, S., 506 Mannucci, E., 544 Manolio, T. A., 558 Manson, J. E., 529 Mantell, J., 506 Mantell, J. E., 348 Manthei, D., 535 Manton, K. G., 403 Manuel, J., 449 Mapes, D., 473, 477 Maramaldi, P., 514, 644 Maravi, M., 547 March, J., 198 Marchioro, G., 307 Marconi, K. M., 130 Marcus, E. N., 253 Marcus, S., 92 Marcus, S. C., 198 Marcusen, C., 509 Marcusen, C. P., 504 Margolis, L. H., 65 Marin, D. B., 398 Mariotto, A. B., 374 Markham, H., 359 Markides, K. S., 269 Markoff, L. S., 449 Markowitz, J. C., 203,

204 Marks, J. S., 531 Marks, R., 348, 356 Markus, A., 109 Marlatt, G. A., 159,

439–443, 446–448, 535, 538–540

Marmar, C., 180 Marrone, C. M., 310 Marsh, J., 199 Marsh, J. C., 449 Marshall, G., 70 Marshall, P. A., 599, 634 Marshall, R. D., 204,

205 Marteau, T., 226 Martell, C., 400, 401

Author Index.indd 665Author Index.indd 665 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

666 Author Index

Martin, C. E., 194, 345, 354

Martin, E. A., 219 Martin, J. A., 72, 75 Martin, L., 514 Marton, K. I., 23, 245 Marx, R., 193 Marzuk, P. M., 545 Masand, P. S., 415 Maselko, J., 275 Masi, C., 563 Masi, C. M., 73, 149,

152, 159 Mason, R. A., 299 Mason, S., 481 Masterman, D., 407, 408 Masterov, D. V., 153 Masters, W. H., 353,

354, 363 Mather, L., 446 Mathews, T. J., 72, 75 Mathias, S., 405 Mathy, R. M., 193 Matsunaga, D. S., xvii Matsuyama, N., 473 Matthews, H. L., 200 Matthews, J. R., 176 Matthias, R. E., 402, 405 Mattison, M., 52, 53 Mauksch, L., 318, 336 Mauriello, L. M., 134 Mauritzen, J., 632 Mayer, S., 154 Mayes, S., 263 Maynard, G., 410 Mayo, S. J., 255 Mazza, N., 415 Mazzaglia, G., 546 McAllister, J. W., 117 McAndrew-Cooper, M.,

150, 155, 156 McAvay, G., 401 McBride, M., 407 McBride, M. R., 406 McBrien, M. E., 437 McCabe, M. P., 343,

346, 349, 353, 356, 357

McCaffery, M., 601 McCahill, M. E., 180 McCain, L. A., 385 McCallin, A., 618 McCann, S., 251

McCarthy, M., 414 McCarty, D., 441 McCaul, K. D., 534, 604 McCauley, H. L., 68 McClelland, M., 245,

246 McClintock, M., 90,

244, 501, 518, 563 McClintock, M. K., 563 McConkie-Rosell, A.,

581 McCorkle, R., 594 McCoyd, J., 571–573,

579 McCreath, H., 72 McCree, D. H., 131 McCulloch, C. E., 579 McCullough, M. E.,

268–275, 284 McDaniel, J. S., 545 McDaniel, S., 318, 319,

324, 337, 338 McDaniel, S. H., 577 McDavid, N. L., 158 McDermott, R., 151 McDonald, G., 32 McDonald, M. V., 615 McDonnell, J., 232 McEwen, B. S., 165,

166, 200 McFann, K., 292, 294 McFarlane, P., 478 McFarlane, W. F., 337 McFarlane, W. R., 175 McGeehin, M. A., 153 McGill, J. B., 536, 544 McGinnis, J. M., 75,

143, 149, 165, 173, 175, 244, 246, 256, 500

McGinnis, R. A., 548 McGoldrick, M., 169,

170, 172, 281, 324, 327, 332, 336, 340, 519, 577

McGonagle, K. A., 190 McGowan, J., 68 McGowan, L., 148 McGrady, A., 548 McGrady, B. S., 450,

451 McGraw, S., 537 McGuire, J., 24

McGurk, D., 180 McHugh, P. R., 405 McInnes, R. A., 346,

353 McInnis-Dittrich, K.,

396, 398, 404, 411, 414

McIntosh, W. A., 536 McKain, B., 198 McKay, J. R., 441, 442 McKendrick, T., 474 McKenna, K., 353 McKevitt, P., 473, 477 McKinley, M., 477, 482 McKusick, V. A., 564 McLanahan, S. M., 308 McLaughlin, J. K., 21 McLaughlin, T. J., 548 McLean, M., 152 McLellan, A. T., 441,

442, 447, 449 McMahon, E., 355 McMahon, J. M., 435,

436 McMillen, J. C., 227 McMurty, S., 53 McMyler, C., 196 McNeece, C. A., 427,

430, 431, 436, 440, 449

McNeil, C., 177 McNeil, C. B., 177 McNeil, J. G., 545 McPhelimy, L., 605 McPherson-Baker, S.,

534 McQuaid, J. R., 180 McRee, B. G., 450, 456 McVeigh, K. H., 544,

547 McWhinney, I. R., 249 McWilliam, W., 21 Meade, C. S., 546 Meade, T. W., 305 Meador, K. G., 270, 272 Meadows, A. T., 509 Meadows, L. M., 350 Mealey, L., 345 Meaney, M. J., 563 Mechanic, D., 178, 643 Mediansky, L., 506 Medich, C., 306 Medina, L., 255

Meehan, J., 197 Meeker, W. C., 304 Megarane, B., 608 Megyesi, M. S., 565 Mehrota, R., 470, 472 Mehta, J., 198 Meichenbaum, D., 533,

535, 538, 540, 541 Meier, K. S., 134 Meijers-Heijboer, E. J.,

580 Meiser, B., 507, 571 Mellinger, A., 190 Menacker, F., 72, 75 Mendenhall, C. L., 431 Mendenhall, T., 614,

619 Mendoza, T. R., 616 Mennuti, M., 575 Mentore, J. L., 546 Merighi, J. R., 470, 472,

474, 481, 487–488 Merikangas, K. R., 565 Merlis, M., 112 Mermelstein, R., 68 Merritt, T. A., 308 Mertens, A., 509 Mertens, A. C., 509 Messer, S. C., 180 Messick, J., 227 Meston, C. M., 345 Metalsky, G. I., 127 Metcalfe, K., 507 Meulman, J., 187, 201 Meyer, C., 512 Meyer, C. H., 167 Meyer, D., 608 Meyer, D. L., 608 Meyer, E. C., 383 Meyer, K., 479 Meyer, K. B., 473, 474 Meyer, R. E., 443 Meyers, F. J., 615 Meyers, K., 449 Meyers, R. J., 449 Mezuk, B., 546 Michael, R. T., 345,

354, 355 Michaels, S., 345, 354,

355 Michie, S., 571, 580 Miele, G. M., 449 Mijch, A., 545

Author Index.indd 666Author Index.indd 666 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

Author Index 667

Mikulincer, M., 506 Milano, D., 435, 436 Milch, R., 506 Milinair, J., 481 Miller, A., 58 Miller, A. L., 198 Miller, B., 318 Miller, B. A., 69, 456 Miller, D., 72 Miller, D. R., 180 Miller, E., 68 Miller, E. R., III, 253 Miller, G. E., 165, 166 Miller, J. P., 72, 534,

535, 538, 539 Miller, M., 198 Miller, M. E., 357 Miller, M. S., 26 Miller, P. G., 447 Miller, R., 91 Miller, S., 318, 324,

338, 535, 572 Miller, S. M., 331, 577 Miller, W., 54, 201 Miller, W. R., 201,

439–445, 447, 448, 450, 457

Milley, J. E., 534 Millman, J., 196 Mills, R. J., 103 Milstein, B., 91 Min, J. W., 408 Miner, C., 180 Miniger, C., 501, 518 Mininger, C., 70, 90, 563 Mira, J. A., 435 Miracle, A., 514 Mirot, A., 474 Misra, M., 472 Misra, S., 84 Mitchell, R., 71 Mizrahi, T., 243, 245,

643, 644 Moak, D. H., 429 Moeschberger, M. L.,

543 Moffi tt, T. E., 585 Mohammed, S. A., 172,

431 Mohyde, M., 401 Mojtabal, R., 396 Mokdad, A. H., 531,

544

Molassiotis, A., 299 Mollaoglu, M., 473, 474 Moloney, M., 571 Moncrief, M., 488 Monga, T. N., 357 Monga, U., 357 Monroe, B., 619 Monster, T. B., 21 Montaner, J. S., 545 Montaner, J. S. G., 167 Montgomery, C., 503, 504 Montgomery, G., 605 Montgomery, G. H.,

307, 605 Montgomery, R. A., 470 Monti, K., 197 Moody, H. R., 416 Moody-Ayers, S., 547 Mooney, C., 150 Moore, B., 474 Moore, K., 301 Moore, L., 72 Moore, T. J., 310 Moorman, J. E., 374 Moos, R., 322 Mor, V., 615 Morales, L. S., 70 Moreau, D., 198 Moreira-Almeida, A.,

265 Moren-Cross, J., 509 Moretti, S., 544 Morgan, H. G., 197 Morgan, J. P., 617 Morgan, M., 599 Morganstein, D., 612 Morgenstern, J., 439 Mori, D. L., 480 Morioka-Douglas, N.,

406 Morison, L., 645 Morland, K., 150 Morley, J. E., 544 Morokoff, P. J., 134 Morris, E. K., 305 Morris, J. J., 306 Morris, L. B., 499–502,

505, 515 Morrison, R. S., 306, 616 Morrison, T., 127 Morrissey, J. P., 449 Morrow, G. R., 297 Morrow-Howell, N., 42

Mortensen, S. A., 308 Morton, D. L, 187, 201,

306 Morton, K. R., 299 Morton, S., 533 Moscicki, E. K., 192–

194 Moscoso, M. S., 200 Mosher, D., 353 Mosher, D. L., 353 Moskowitz, J. T., 398 Moskowitz, R. W., 405 Moss, A., 474 Moss, A. H., 473 Mostashari, F., 534, 544,

547 Moulopoulos, S. D., 249 Moynihan, R. T., 348 Mucenski, J., 599 Mueller, K. J., 111 Mueller, N. B., 92 Muellerleile, P. A., 130 Mufson, L., 198 Mujais, S., 473 Mukerji, P., 544 Mukherjee, D., 229 Mukherjee, S., 502, 503 Mullan, M. G., 548 Mullings, D., 34 Mullooly, J. P., 250 Mulrow, C. D., 181 Mulsant, B. H., 399 Mulvey, B., 52 Mundy, E., 180 Munro, B., 346, 350 Munson, R., 48 Murabito, J., 240 Murdach, A., 53 Murphey, L. M., 150 Murphy, D. A., 535 Murphy, E. J., 571 Murphy, G. E., 194, 198 Murphy, M., 449 Murphy, S. L., 71, 72,

75, 145, 146, 148, 192, 533

Murray, A., 90, 244, 474 Murray, C. J., 151 Murray, M. F., 571 Murray, M. T., 308 Murray, T., 503 Murri, R., 536, 547 Musick, M. A., 171

Mussolino, M. E., 75 Mustian, K. M., 297 Mustillo, S., 72 Myrick, H., 438

Nabi, H., 71 Nacman, M., 11, 14 Nadeem, E., 205 Nadel, T., 613 Nadine, T., 507 Nahin, R. L., 292, 294 Najavits, L. M., 449 Najman, J. M., 130 Nakae, M., 448 Nakashima, M., 282,

283 Naliboff, B. D., 544 Nanda, R., 571 Nangaku, M., 473 Nanin, J. E., 358 Nanni, C., 251 Napoleone, S., 348 Narod, S., 507 Narrow, W. E., 181, 190 Nash, R. E., 130 Nason, F., 21, 34 Natale, D. K., 616 Natelson, B. H., 174 Nathan, P. E., 548 Nathanson, I., 415 Navalta, C. P., 153 Naveh, G., 173 Naylor, M. D., 411, 412 Nazareth, I., 193, 356 Nazarian, L. F., 249 Nazmi, A., 72 Neff, N., 302 Neglia, J. P., 509 Neighbors, H. W., 172,

192 Neimeyer, R., 508 Nelson, A. R., 70, 116,

632 Nelson, C. B., 179, 180,

190 Nelson, D. E., 531 Nelson, R. G., 151, 531 Nelson-Becker, H., 282,

283, 509 Nemeroff, C. B., 153,

204, 205 Nesbit, M. E., Jr., 509 Nesbitt, T. S., 615

Author Index.indd 667Author Index.indd 667 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

668 Author Index

Ness, J., 306 Nesse, R., 172 Netting, E. F., 410, 416 Netting, F., 53 Neufi eld, J. A., 353 Neugarten, B., 331 Neuhauser, L., 413 Neuman, K., 56, 355 Newacheck, P. W., 375 Newcomb, K., 177 Newhouse, J. P., 104 Newhouse, P. A., 355 Newman, A., 508 Newman, B., 152 Newman, M. F., 543–

545 Newman, N. W.,

503–505 Newmark, M., 175 Newport, D. J., 153 Newton, K. M., 530 Newton, P., 306 Neyman, N., 500, 503,

517, 598 Ng, D. M., 165 Ngo, D., 408 Ngo, V. M., 205 Ni, H., 294 Niederwieser, G., 361 Nielsen-Bohlman, L.,

534 Nielson-Bohlman, L.,

572 Niemeijer, M. F., 580 Nishi, T., 473 Nishimoto, R., 506 Nixon, R. D. V., 177 Nnorom, I. C., 89 Nock, M. K., 193 Noh, S., 172, 173, 201 Nohr, L., 508, 510 Noonan, D., 292 Norcross, J. C., 201,

445, 446 Norem, J. K., 572 Norlock, F. E., 291–295,

298 Norman, S. A., 130 Northouse, L. L., 245 Northouse, P. G., 245 Norwitz, E. R., 152 Nowicki, J., 170 Nugent, R. P., 433, 434

Nunes, E. V., 449 Nussbam, J., 478 Nutt, D. J., 203–205 Nutter, D. E., 353 Nygren, P., 503

Oakes, J. M., 64, 76, 77 Oates, J., 249 Oberlander, J., 112 O’Brien, B., 536 O’Brien, C. P., 428, 429,

438, 441, 442, 447 O’Brien, K., 444, 448 O’Brien, L., 7 Obrosky, D. S., 544 O’Connell, J. J., 190 O’Connell, T. S., 355 O’Connor, C. M., 473 Oddy, J., 546 Odgen, C. L., 374 O’Donnell, C., 618 O’Donnell, P., 618 Oeffi nger, K., 509 O’Farrell, T. J., 449 Offi t, K., 580 Ofsthun, N., 480 Oftedahl, E., 374 Ogden, C. L., 73, 74 O’Grady, C., 571 Ogunseitan, O. A., 89 Oh, A., xv Oh, K. H., 472 O’Hailin, A., 166 Öjehagen, A., 197 Oken, S. L., 54 Oktay, J., 576, 582 Oktay, J. S., 409 Olajide, D., 545 Oldridge, N. B., 131 Olff, M., 205 Olfson, M., 198, 396 Oliver, D. P., 644 Olivet, L., 305 Olivo, A., 157 Olkin, R., 227, 321 Olmsted, M. P., 536,

544 Olopade, F., 563 Olopade, O., 90, 244,

501, 518, 563 Olopade, O. I., 571 Olsen, M. L., 21 Olshansky, S., 227

Olson, D. M., 406 Olson, L., 77 Olson, M. M., 348 Olvera, R., 166 O’Malley, S. S., 443 Oman, D., 273–275 O’Neill, G., 515 Ooort, F. J., 248 Operskalki, B., 198 Opjordsmoen, S., 356 Orav, E. J., 190 Orbell, S., 130 Orelans, C. T., 181 Orfi eld, G., 144 Organista, K., 507, 575 Organista, K. C., 407 Ormond, B. A., 117 Ornish, D., 308 Orr, L., 144, 147 Orszag, P. R., 119 Orth, J. E., 249 Osborn, D., 193 Ösby, U., 198 Osgood, N., 398 O’Shaughnessy, M. V.,

167, 545 Osibanjo, O., 89 Ostermann, H. J., 357 Ostir, G. V., 166 Otis-Green, S., 595,

597–598, 605, 606, 608, 617–619

Ott, S. H., 564 Ouimette, P., 183 Owen, J. H., 197 Owens, D., 278 Owings, J. T., 307 Oza, S., 151 Ozden, G., 299 Ozkahya, M., 361 Ozminkowski, R. J., 109

Paans, A. M. J., 353 Pachter, L, 295, 303 Pachter, L. M., 238 Padgett, D. K., 567 Padmanaban, D., 297 Padula, J. A., 134 Paik, A., 148, 150 Painter, J., 402 Painter, N. S., 308 Palacio-Mejia, L. S.,

150

Palacios, R. B., 435 Palinkas, L. A., 90 Palmer, J. L., 293, 502 Palmer, R. S., 442, 443,

448 Pan, C. X., 306, 407,

408 Pandey, S., 154 Pandya, K. J., 599, 610,

615, 616 Paniagua, R., 473 Panteli, V., 299 Panzer, A., 534 Panzer, A. M., 572 Papasouliotis, O., 454,

455 Pargament, K. I., 268–

270, 274 Parish, K. L., 361 Park, C. L., 273–276 Parker, E. A., 159, 252 Parker, F. L., 153 Parker, R. M., 572 Parker-Oliver, D., 614 Parks, G. A., 446 Parks, S., 292 Parmley, W. W., 172 Parrinello, G., 546 Parry, C., 411–413 Parsonnet, L., 346, 348,

362, 363 Parsons, E., 577 Parsons, J. T., 358, 444,

448 Parton, N., 46 Parva, M., 434 Pasero, C., 601 Pasnau, R. O., 187 Passel, J. S., 109 Passik, S. D., 438, 439,

615 Patenaude, A., 507, 577,

580 Patijn, J., 613 Patiraki, E., 299 Patmios, G., xv Patrick, A. R., 198 Patrick, D. L., 177, 608 Pattenden, J., 446 Patterson, J., 506 Patterson, M. E., 410 Patterson, R. E., 241 Patton, K. E., 548

Author Index.indd 668Author Index.indd 668 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

Author Index 669

Paulozzi, L. J., 438 Pavanetto, M., 307 Pavao, J., 68 Paxton, A., 276 Payne, R., 616 Payne, R. A., 549 Peake, M., 509 Pearce, J. K., 332, 336 Pearcy, J. N., 172 Pearl, M., 147 Pearlman, L., 385 Pearson, J. L., 194 Pearson, M., 509 Pearson, V. I., 400, 403 Pedrelli, P., 180 Peek-Asa, C., 68 Peelle, A., 535 Pekow, P., 482 Pelleier, R. P., 470 Pelletier, K. R., 311 Pelletier-Hibbert, M.,

474 Pelligrino, E., 609 Pence, G., 54 Penedo, F. J., 534 Penn, J. V., 196 Penn, P., 324 Perales, D., 448 Percival, C., 148 Percival, T., 48 Perez, M., 598 Pérez Foster, R. M., 515 Perez-Lopez, D., 109 Periera, J., 350 Perlman, H. H., 167 Perwien, A. R., 536 Pescosolido, B. A., 240 Peters, E., 572 Peters, J. A., 577–578 Peters, J. L., 544 Peters, K., 155 Petersen, L., 509, 514 Petersen, S., 190, 446 Peterson, C., 127 Peterson, R., 472 Peterson, R. A., 472,

473 Petrak, F., 548 Petry, S., 327, 340 Pettitt, D. J., 151, 531 Petty, F., 180 Peyrot, M., 547, 548 Pezzin, L. E., 403

Pfeffer, C. R., 193, 194, 196–198

Pfeiffer, D., 220 Phadera, L., 115 Phair, J. P., 532 Pharoah, P., 507 Phelan, J., 500 Phelan, K. J., 75 Philipson, T. J., 151 Phillips, R. B., 305 Piacentini, J., 176 Piantadosi, S., 505,

514, 599 Pickett, K., 147 Pickett, K. E., 73, 152 Pietroni, P. C., 296, 297 Pignone, M., 187, 188,

190, 191, 194, 199 Pignone, M. P., 181 Pinderhughes, E., 170,

171 Pineda, J. A., 435 Pinkerton, P., 474 Pinquart, M., 403 Pintar, T., 471 Piotrowski, Z. H., 152 Pirsch, J. D., 471 Pitceathly, C., 248 Pizzo, P. A., 509 Pizzorno, J., 308 Placidi, G. F., 544 Platt, F. W., 252 Pleck, J. H., 154 Pleis, J. R., 145, 146 Plescia, G., 194 Plissner, M., 111 Podolsky, D., 307 Pokorny, A. D., 456 Polcari, A., 153 Polen, M., 54 Poling, K., 198 Politi, M., 506 Polk, S., 532 Pollack, B., 605 Pollack, H., 149, 160 Pollin, I., 548 Pollin, I. S., 548 Pollin, T. I., 564 Pollock, M. L., 618 Pomeroy, W. B., 345,

354 Pompili, M., 198 Pond, A., 266

Ponder, P., 92 Poniatowski, B. C., 362 Pontious, S. L., 304, 308 Poon, L. W., 398 Popelyuk, D., 193 Popham, F., 71 Poppel, D., 482 Port, F. K., 476 Portenoy, R., 615 Portenoy, R. K., 613 Porter, D., 48 Porter, K., 532 Porter, N., 145 Porter, R., 48 Porter, R. S., 500, 502 Portera, L., 545 Posner, R. A., 151 Postlethwaite, R. J., 361 Post-White, J., 200 Potter, J. D., 509 Poulton, R., 585 Pouwer, F., 546 Powe, N. R., 17, 246,

247, 473, 474, 479 Powell, L. H., 273, 275,

276 Powell, W. E., 415 Powell-Griner, E., 292,

294 Powell-Griner, E. E., 529 Pozzuto, R., 619 Prager, D. J., 244 Pratt, L. A., 545 Pratt, N., 546 Prenger, R., 200 Prescott, C., 429 Prescott, M. R., 435 Presler, E., 117 Prevost, A. T., 572 Price, T. S., 565 Prince, R., 548 Pringle, M., 545 Prins, A., 183 Prochaska, J. M., 134,

445, 446 Prochaska, J. O., 134,

201, 445–446 Proctor, B. D., 103 Proctor, E., 42 Pruet, R., 361 Pryjmachuk, S., 196 Psaty, B. M., 310 Puchalski, C., 280, 598

Puchalski, C. M., 280 Pud, D., 299 Pulley, L., 241 Pynoos, R., 204 Pynor, R., 348, 356

Qaseem, A., 278 Quigley, R., 76 Quill, T., 229 Quinn, J. F., 305 Quinn, K., 511, 608

Rabe-Hesketh, S., 548 Rabin, C., 540 Rabin, L., 431 Rabins, P., 195 Rabkin, J., 361 Rabow, M., 506 Rabung, S., 204 Radomsky, N. A., 353 Rae, D. S., 181, 190 Rai, A. K., 193, 194 Raina, P., 615 Raiz, L. R., 482 Raj, A., 68 Raiz, L. R., 482 Raleigh, E. H., 398 Rambo Chroniak, K., 200 Ramesh, S., 318 Ramgopal, R., 543 Ramirez, G., 187, 188,

190, 191, 194, 199 Ranchand, R., 109 Rando, T. A., 635, 636 Randolph, J., 23, 245 Rangel-Gomez, G., 150 Ranjit, N., 872 Rao, J. K., 250 Rapp, R., 579 Rappaport, B., 21 Rathus, J. H., 198 Rattenbury, J., 304, 305 Ratzen, S. C., 572 Raube, K., 101 Rauber, C., 311 Rauch, S., 204 Raudenbush, S. W., 152 Raue, P. J., 399 Rauh, V. A., 153 Raveis, V., 510, 516 Raveis, V. H., 348 Raymer, M., 619, 637 Rayner, H. C., 476

Author Index.indd 669Author Index.indd 669 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

670 Author Index

Reamer, F., 42–44, 49, 50, 53–56

Reamer, F. G., 15 Rebbeck, T., xv Rebbeck, T. R., 507 Rebolledo, A., 152 Redd, W. H., 307 Redding, C. A., 134 Reddy, S. S., 473 Reder, E. R., 598 Redinbaugh, E. M., 599 Redwood, Y., 159 Reed, B. G., 449 Reed, G., 333 Rees, K., 200 Rees, M. A., 470 Reese, D. J., 618, 637 Reese-Weber, M., 345 Regier, D., 176 Regier, D. A., 181, 190 Rehkopf, D. H., 72, 77 Rehr, H., 22, 26, 644 Rehwaldt, M., 604 Reibel, D. K., 200 Reichard, R. R., 435 Reichman, M. E., 69 Reid, W. J., 15 Reidpath, D. D., 150 Reinert, D. F., 455 Reisberg, B., 405 Reischl, T., 275 Reiss, D., 326, 331 Remafedi, G., 193 Renner, J. H., 293, 296 Renzenbrink, I., 619 Resnicow, K., 276 Resnik, D. B., 570 Reuben, D. B., 395 Reynolds, C. F., 399 Reynolds, J. M., 361 Rhoades, J., 414 Rhoades, J. A., 399 Rhodes, J., 352 Rhodes, L., 529 Ricca, V., 544 Ricci, J. A., 612 Richards, M. P. M., 572 Richardson, J. L., 507,

516, 546 Richardson, M. A., 293,

300, 502 Rich-Edwards, J. W.,

152

Richman, S. P., 616 Richmond, M., 167 Rickel, A. U., 375 Ricketts, G. D., 396 Rieckmann, N., 547 Riedner, C., 280 Riensma, R. P., 446 Ries, L., 374 Ries, L. A. G., 172, 500 Riet, G., 301 Rietschel, M., 565 Riggs, D., 204 Rihmer, Z., 544 Rimer, B. K., 126 Rimsza, M. E., 355 Rintala, D. H., 226 Risch, H., 507 Risch, N., 565 Rivara, F., 444 Rivera, P., 227 Rivera-Mizzoni, R., 477 Roak, R. A., 361 Robbins, C., 643, 644 Robbins, D. C., 531 Robbins, J. A., 542 Robert, S. A., 155 Roberts, C. S., 35, 243,

245, 248 Roberts, D., 105 Roberts, J., 333 Robertson, K. R., 545 Robertson, M. M., 127 Robins, C., 543–545 Robinson, B., 405 Robinson, J., 197 Robinson, J. N., 152 Robinson, K., 275 Robinson, M., 409, 410 Robison, L. L., 509 Robson, M. E., 507 Rocha, D., 479 Roche, B., 645 Rock, B. D., 23 Röcklinsberg, H., 264 Rodehaver, C. B., 306 Rodin, G., 506, 536 Rodin, G. M., 544 Rodriguez, G., 576, 582 Roesch, S., 334 Roesch, S. C., 331 Roff, S., 592 Roger, V. L., 151 Rogers, C., 54

Rogers, G., 546 Rogers, R. G., 155 Rogge, M., 535, 541 Roglic, G., 531 Rogowski, J., 72 Rohan, E., 509 Rokeach, M., 43 Rolland, J., 220, 318,

324, 329, 336, 338 Rolland, J. S., 33, 164,

170, 199, 200, 203, 318–325, 329, 331, 333, 338, 506, 515, 577

Rollins, D. E., 433, 434 Rollins, J., 380 Rollnick, S., 54, 201,

443, 444, 457 Romano, M., 35, 482 Romanofsky, P., 5 Romer, A. L., 280 Ronan, A. M., 299 Ronningen, A., 613 Rooney, G. D., 125 Rooney, R. H., 125, 185,

190, 199, 252, 440 Root, L, 480 Root, L. M., 275 Rose, G. S., 444, 445,

448 Rose, M., 21 Rose, R. J., 558, 565 Rose, S. D., 619 Roseman, J. M., 531 Rosen, A. J., 125 Rosen, N., 196 Rosen, W., 188, 189,

435 Rosenbaum, S., 109 Rosenberg, A., 205 Rosenberg, C. E., 4 Rosenberg, G., 644 Rosenberg, J., 348, 356 Rosenfeld, B. D., 615 Rosenheck, R. A., 546 Rosenquist, J. N., 240 Rosenstock, I. M., 128 Rosenthal, E., 238 Rosenthal, M. B., 108 Rosenthal, M. J., 544 Rosenzweig, S., 200 Rosetti, F., 307 Rosholm, J. U., 194 Rosich, R. M., 407

Rosman, S., 505 Rosner, B. A., 354, 362 Rosner, M. H., 469 Rosof, E., 444, 448 Ross, J. L., 478 Ross, J. W., 411,

643–645 Ross, L. F., 581 Rossi, J. S., 134 Rossi, P., 414 Rossouw, J. E., 529 Ross-Sheriff, T., 83, 84 Rotella, C. M., 544 Rotella, F., 544 Roter, D., 17, 246, 247 Roter, D. L., 248,

250, 253, 537, 539, 541–542

Rotgers, F., 447 Roth, C., 198 Rothman, J., 484 Rounds, K., 83, 84 Rounds, K. A., 64, 76,

249 Rounsaville, B., 443 Rounsaville, B. J., 442,

444 Rowan, E. L., 353, 363 Rowe, C. L., 448 Rowland, D. L., 362 Rowland, J. H., 374 Rowland, M. D., 448 Roy, K., 578 Roy, R., 592, 619 Rozanski, A., 546 Rubel, A. J., 241 Rubenfeld, G. D., 608 Rubenstein, B., 508, 511 Rubin, H., 479 Rubin, H. R., 473, 474 Rubin, L., 331, 572 Rubin, R. R., 546–548 Ruccione, K., 507, 509 Rudd, M. D., 196 Ruderman, M., 77 Runnerstrum, M. G., 84 Rushton, J. L., 181 Russ, A. J., 474 Russell, C., 616 Russell, C. L., 476 Russell, D., 352 Russell, J. M., 193–198 Russell, S. T., 193

Author Index.indd 670Author Index.indd 670 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

Author Index 671

Russo, J., 547 Russo, J. E., 544, 546,

547 Russo, R., 485 Rust, K. F., 528 Ruth, B. J., 90 Rutkowski-Kmitta, V.,

220 Rutland, C., 605, 617 Rutter, C., 197 Rutter, M. E., 470 Ruzek, J., 204 Ruzek, J. I., 449 Ryan, G., 344 Ryan, K., 385 Ryan, M. C. M., 546 Rydall, A., 506 Rydall, A. C., 544 Ryujin, L., 128

Saad, M. F., 151, 531 Saah, A. J., 532 Sabia, S., 71 Sacchetti, E., 546 Sachs, G. A., 615 Sachs, L., 580 Sacks, T., 90, 501, 518,

563 Sadler, G. R., 128 Sadowski, L. S., 146,

158 Saftlas, A. F., 68 Sagi, M., 573 Saha, S., 247 Salazar, W. H., 252 Saleebey, D., 178 Salett, E., 85 Salmon, P., 200 Salzer, S., 204 Samant, R., 537 Sampson, S., 409, 410 Samuel, J. C., 348 Sanbonmatsu, L., 144,

147 Sanchez, H. G., 193 Sanchez, K., 507, 516 Sanchez, V. C., 457 Sanders, G., 449 Sanders, T., 293, 502 Sandford, J., 199, 200 Sando, W., 307 Sands, R. G., 245, 246 Sankar, P., 565

Sannerud, C., 438, 616 Sannes, M., 532 Sansone, L. A., 352 Sansone, P., 352 Sansone, R. A., 352 Santiago, J. V., 534,

535, 538, 539, 541 Santoro, N., 354 Saperstein, G., 605 Saphores, J.-D. M., 89 Saraceno, B., 173 Saran, R., 476 Sarason, I. G., 405 Sarkisian, C. A., 276 Satel, S., 565 Satin, D. G., 246 Satz, D., 150 Saunders, C., 594, 619,

628 Saunders, J. B., 454, 455 Saunders, L. A., 454, 455 Savage, A., 449 Savage, D., 32 Savage, P. J., 531 Savage, S. R., 438, 439 Savage, T. A., 229 Savarino, J., 198 Saver, B. G., 95 Sax, P. E., 533 Saxe, L., 190 Saxena, S., 531 Saydah, S., 528 Scafi di, F., 306 Scarlata, D., 478 Schacter, C. L., 353 Schanberg, S. M., 306 Scharf, M. J., 307 Schatell, D. R., 470 Schechter, C. F., 130 Scherwitz, L., 249 Scherwitz, L. W., 308 Schezel, G. W., 130 Schild, S., 557 Schilling, R. F., 439–441 Schimmelmann, B. G.,

565 Schinkel, A. M., 539 Schirop, T., 21 Schlich-Bakker, K. J., 575 Schlundt, D., 535, 543 Schmais, L., 301 Schmaltz, S. P., 101 Schmid, T., 74

Schmidt, E., 196 Schmidt, E. Z., 361 Schmitt, R., 309 Schmitz, M., 449 Schmitz, N., 544 Schneeweiss, R., 128 Schneeweiss, S., 198 Schneid, J. A., 608 Schneider, B., 309 Schneider, J., 249 Schneider, M.-J., 64, 78 Schneider, M. S., 476 Schneider, S., 166 Schneiderman, N., 155 Schnitt, S. J., 354, 362 Schnoll, S. H., 435, 438,

453, 454 Schnur, J. B., 307 Schnurr, P. P., 205 Schoenbaum, E. E., 166,

167, 187, 536, 547 Schoener, G., 55 Schoeni, R. F., 149, 160 Schoenwald, S. K., 448 Schoevers, R. S., 615 Scholten, R., 295 Schondel, C., 509 Schooler, C., 69 Schootman, M., 72 Schottenfeld, R. S., 443 Schouten, H. C., 613 Schover, L. R., 343,

348, 353, 360, 362, 363

Schrager, L. K., 532 Schuckit, M. A., 430 Schuhmann, E. M., 177 Schulenberg, J. E., 456 Schulman, K. A., 247,

530 Schultz, A., 557 Schultz, A. J., 159, 252 Schulz, A. J., 159 Schulz, R., 598 Schumacher, M., 544,

546 Schuman, P., 166, 167,

187 Schumm, L. P., 571 Schuster, J. L., 335, 694 Schwab-Stone, M. E.,

176 Schwankovsky, L., 251

Schwartz, J. S., 571 Schwartz, L. R., 572 Schwartz, S., 173 Schwartzbaum, J. A., 543 Schweitzer, S. O., 402,

405 Schwerwitz, L. W., 308 Scoppa, S., 374 Scott, A. B., 267, 268 Scott, J. A., 299 Scott, J. E., 128 Seaburn, D., 318, 327,

336 Seal, K. H., 180, 448 Seamon, V. J., 481 Seaward, B. L., 306 Seckl, J. R., 563 Seeff, L. B., 188 Seeman, T., 275, 401 Seeman, T. E., 72 Seerman, D., 232 Segal, S. P., 34 Segerstrom, S. C., 165 Segey, D. L., 470 Sehrawat, S., 614 Seigler, M., 53 Sejwacz, D., 130 Selan, K., 13 Selby, P., 179 Seligman, M. E. P., 127 Selzer, M. L., 456 Sember, R., 69 Semlyen, J., 193 Semmel, A., 127 Sen, S., 180 Senzel, R. S., 616 Sephton, S. E., 187,

200, 201 Sewell, G., 548, 549 Sewell, M., 361 Shaffer, D., 176, 193,

194, 196–198 Shah, N. G., 435 Shah, P. N., 395 Shahabi, L., 273, 275,

276 Shakespeare, T., 224 Shalev, A. Y., 203, 204 Shanley, S., 580 Shannon, S. E., 608 Shapiro, A. A., 89 Shapiro, J., 220, 221 Shapiro, M., 177, 533

Author Index.indd 671Author Index.indd 671 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

672 Author Index

Sharma, S., 563 Sharp, V., 247 Sharrard, W. J., 308 Shaver, P., 343 Shavers, V., 500 Shaw, C., 572 Shaw, J., 193, 194,

196–198 Shaw-Hegwer, J., 183 Shea, S. C., 184 Sheafor, B. W., 125 Sheeran, P., 130 Sheets, P., 245 Shega, J. W., 615 Sheidler, V. R., 599 Sheikh, A. A., 605 Sheikh, J. I., 183 Shekelle, P., 278 Shelby, J., 383 Sheldon, F. M., 619 Shell, J. A., 357 Shellenberger, S., 577 Shellengerger, S., 281 Shelton, J., 564 Shenkman, E., 382 Shepherd, L., 230 Sheps, D. S., 174 Sherbourne, C. D., 177,

203, 204, 405 Sherman, A. M., 402 Sherman, R., 598 Sherwood, A., 543–545 Shibusawa, T., 22, 176,

449 Shih, R. A., 558 Shilds, G., 509 Shim, J. K., 474 Shimbo, D., 547 Shimoyama, H., 473 Shin, H., 599 Shine, D., 617 Shiono, P. H., 433, 434 Shipley, M., 71 Shochet, T., 68 Shontz, F., 223 Shrout, P. E., 173 Shuldiner, A. R., 564 Shulman, L. C., 348 Sicree, R., 531 Siddiqui, N., 76 Sidell, N., 509 Sideris, D. A., 249 Sidney, S., 72

Siefert, K., 173, 190 Siegal, B., 478 Siegel, G., 309 Siegel, K., 348 Siegel, R., 503 Siegfried, N., 241 Siegler, I. C., 398 Sieppert, J. D., 619 Sigo, R. L. W., 159 Sikkema, K. J., 546 Sikon, G. M., 481 Silbergleit, I.-L., 608 Silberman, J., 543 Silberner, J., 307 Silva, S., 198 Silverman, B., 353 Silverman, J. G., 68 Silverman, P. R., 631 Silverman, S., 446 Silverstein, J., 307 Silverstein, J. H., 536,

605 Silvestri, B., 150 Simile, C., 294 Simm, M., 435, 436 Simmens, S., 318 Simmens, S. J., 472, 473 Simmons, W. J., 34 Simon, G., 197, 547 Simon, G. E., 198 Simon, L. N., 335 Simon, R., 55 Sims, S., 305 Sinclair, S. J., 84 Singal, B., 545 Singer, L. T., 435 Singh, G. K., 69 Singh-Manoux, A., 71 Singletary, S. E., 293, 502 Sipski, M., 353 Sisco, S., 90 Siskou, O., 471, 474 Sistrunk, S., 247, 530 Sivak, S., 309 Sivell, S., 572 Sjoblom, P., 354 Skaife, K., 352 Skerman, H. M., 130 Skillings, A., 307 Skinner, H. A., 456 Skinner, K. M., 180180 Skipper, J. J., 249 Sklar, C., 509

Skloot, R., 59, 571, 579 Skocpol, T., 112 Skokan, L., 333 Skretny, J., 506 Skutezky, T., 435 Slade, J., 431–434 Slaghter, V., 345 Slater, T., 75 Sleath, B. L., 410 Sleep, J., 305 Sloan, L. E., 205 Sloman, R., 306 Slomski, A. J., 254 Slovic, P., 572 Sluijs, E., 535 Smedley, B. D., 70, 116,

632 Smetana, J., 130 Smets, E., 571 Smets, E. M., 248 Smit, J. J., 615 Smith, A., 179 Smith, B. A., 480 Smith, D., 571 Smith, E., 514, 517 Smith, E. D., 505 Smith, G., 109, 266 Smith, J., 413 Smith, J. A., 580 Smith, J. E., 449 Smith, M., 534 Smith, M. W., 68 Smith, R., 152, 500 Smith, T. W., 267 Smith, V., 105 Smith-Rogers, A., 535 Smolinski, K. M., 644 Smyer, M. A., 405 Smyth, N. J., 193–197 Snoek, F. J., 546, 548 Snow, L., 240 Snow, V., 278 Sobel, S., 578 Sofuoglu, M., 434 Sohi, P., 474 Sohmer, D., 70, 90, 244,

563 Solaro, C., 613 Solecki, R. S., 309 Solomon, D. H., 198 Soloway, C. T., 350 Soloway, M. S., 350 Somer, D., 501, 518

Somers, V. K., 151 Sommers, J. P., 414 Sommers, L. S., 23, 245 Son, B. K., 472 Sondik, E. J., 374, 527 Sonenstein, F. L., 154 Sonnega, A., 179, 180 Sonosky, C., 109 Sontag, S., 332, 503 Sonuga-Barke, E. J. S.,

565 Sooman, A., 150, 156 Sörensen, S., 403 Sorenson, H. T., 21 Sori, C., 508 Sormanti, M., 22, 175,

619 Soule, D. N., 151 Sourani, T., 331 Sowden, A. J., 446 Spadlin, D., 352 Spangler, L., 579 Sparber, A., 292 Speck, P., 599, 618 Spector, R., 239 Spector, W. D., 403 Spencer, R., 190 Spiegal, N., 250 Spiegel, D., 187, 201,

505, 510, 511 Spieth, L. E., 176 Spilka, B., 274 Spillman, B. C., 403 Spiridigliozzi, G. A.,

581 Spirito, A., 196 Spitzer, W. J., 355 Spivak, H. B., 348 Sporer, A. K., 68 Sprangers, M. A. G.,

226 Springer, K. W., 318,

337 Spritzer, K., 70 Spurlin, P., 46 Stacey, D., 537 Stafanini, G., 546 Stafford, J., 245, 246 Stalker, C. A., 353 Stanley, S., 359 Stanton, A., 506 Staplin, L., 400, 401 Starace, F., 536, 547

Author Index.indd 672Author Index.indd 672 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

Author Index 673

Stark, D., 179 Stark, M. J., 444, 448 Starr, P., 110–112 Stassen, H. H., 187, 198 St. Clair, P., 533 Stearns, N., 518 Stearns, N. N., 503–505 Steele, J., 444, 448 Steele, R. G., 534 Stegbauer, T., 448, 450,

456, 457 Stein, B. D., 205 Stein, J., 410, 534 Stein, J. A., 449 Stein, J. B., 448, 450,

456, 457 Stein, M. B., 180 Stein, M. D., 432 Stein, W., 615 Steinberg, A., 204 Steinglass, P., 326 Steketee, R. W., 533 Stellar, E., 165 Stempel, R. R., 361 Stepanek, M. J. T., 385 Stephens, R. S., 433,

434, 437 Stephenson, L. N., 305 Steptoe, A., 175 Sterling, P., 165 Sterling, S., 441 Stern, J. S., 307 Sternbach, R. A., 605 Stevens, J. A., 438 Stevens, W., 249 Stewart, J., 174 Stewart, J. A., 599, 610,

615, 616 Stewart, K., 380 Stewart, M., 249 Stewart, N., 608 Stewart, S. M., 166 Stewart, W. F., 612 Stiles, W. B., 249 Stine, S. M., 436, 438 Stinson, F. S., 432 Stites, D. P., 187, 201 Stites, M. A., 11 Stith, A. Y., 70, 116, 632 Stoddard, J. L., 150 Stokols, D., 84 Stolley, P. D., 130 Stone, G., 125

Stone, J. H., 374 Stone, M. A., 544 Stone, P., 548 Stopfer, J., 571 Strader, D. B., 188 Stratton, K., 431 Strauman, T., 543–545 Street, A., 545 Street, A. E., 68 Street, R. L., 242 Strelkauskas, A. J., 305 Streuning, E., 190 Strik, J., 179 Strike, D. M., 196 Strine, T. W., 544 Stringhini, S., 71 Strobino, D. M., 527 Strom-Gottfried, K.,

54–56, 125 Strouse, T., 297, 299 Struewing, J. P., 575 Stuart, E., 306 Stuart, E. M., 306 Studenski, S., 508 Studts, J. L., 200 Stueve, A., 173 Stump, T. E., 396 Stussman, B. J., 292 Stutts, J., 400, 401 Su, M., 153 Subramanian, K., 619 Subramanian, S. V.,

72, 77 Sucoff, C. A., 154 Sugden, K., 585 Sullivan, L. M., 180 Sullivan, M. J., 293, 300,

301, 308, 309, 615 Sulman, J., 32 Sulmasy, D., 598 Sundquist, K., 349 Supiano, K. P., 68 Surís, A., 180 Surtees, P. G., 545 Susser, E. S., 180 Sussman, S., 150 Sutcliffe, M. L., 308 Sutton, P. D., 72, 75 Sutton, S., 572 Sveen, L., 571 Svennson, E., 613 Swazey, J. P., 471, 479 Swedeen, K., 599

Sweeney, L., 177, 488 Sweetman, J., 172 Switzer, J. V., 231 Swyers, J. P., 268–271 Symons, R., 152 Syrjala, K. L., 307, 603,

604 Szabo, C. I., 507 Szapocznik, J., 448 Szczech, L. A., 473

Taal, E., 200 Tai, S. S., 193 Tai, W., 362 Takaki, J., 473 Takeda, W., 300 Takeuchi, D., 172 Taleporos, G., 349, 353,

356, 357 Taler, G., 410 Talley, R. C., 414 Tan, G., 357 Tang, L., 166 Tanner, C. M., 613 Tanner-Smith, E. E., 128 Tanney, M., 535 Tanskanen, A., 198 Tanyi, R. A., 349 Tapert, S., 430 Tardiff, K., 545 Tardiff, K., J., 435 Tarone, R., 500 Tarzian, A. J., 610, 615 Taub, K., 472, 473 Taylor, A., 585 Taylor, B., 351 Taylor, C., 618 Taylor, E., 301 Taylor, L., 76, 291, 294,

295, 311, 375 Taylor, S., 333, 334 Taylor, S. E., 166 Taylor, W. C., 72 Taylor-Brown, S., 583 Teare, R., 32 Teasdale, J. D., 127 Teicher, M. H., 153 Teitelbaum, I., 472 Tejada-Vera, B., 71, 72,

75, 145, 146, 148, 192

Tejpar, S., 507 Teng, M., 480

Ten Have, T., 197, 399 ten Kroode, H. F. J., 575 Tentler, A., 543 Teram, E., 353 Teresi, J., 405 Teri, L., 405 Terr, A. I., 187, 201 Testerman, J. K., 299 Thakker, J., 436 Thakore, J. H., 546 Thaler, H., 615 Thaler, H. T., 613 Thampi, K., 190 Thase, M. E., 203, 204 Thawley, R., 448 Thayer, P., 384 Thefeld, W., 544 Theodorou, M., 471, 474 Thomas, A., 353 Thomas, C., 584 Thomas, D. L., 188 Thomas, L. A., 68 Thomas, L. R., 159 Thomas, S., 144, 158 Thomas, T., 511, 608 Thompson, L. A., 382 Thompson, S., 331, 333,

509, 534, 535 Thompson, S. C., 251 Thompson, S. J., 21 Thomson, R., 221 Thoreson, C. E., 273–

276 Thorning, H., 200 Thorpe, L. E., 544, 547 Thorson, A. I., 361 Thrope, M., 410 Thun, M., 500, 503 Thun, M. J., 172 Tibben, A., 580 Tiihonen, J., 198 Tilden, V., 502 Tilly, C., 131 Tilton, M. C., 226 Timberlake, D. S., 69,

92 Tinetti, M., 508 Ting, H. H., 151 Tirrito, T., 415 Tolle, S., 502 Tollefson, D., 444, 448 Tomany-Korman, S.

C., 77

Author Index.indd 673Author Index.indd 673 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

674 Author Index

Tombrink, J., 361 Tomenson, B., 148 Tondo, L., 198 Tonigan, J. S., 443, 444,

448, 457 Toobert, D. J., 534, 535,

538 Toran, J., 175 Torpy, D. J., 152 Torres, L., 436 Tortu, S., 435, 436 Toumanidis, S. T., 249 Touyz, S. W., 177 Townsend, J., 305 Townsend, M., 150 Towsley, G. L., 203 Toyonaga, T., 356 Tran, T. V., 408 Traphagan, J. W., 171 Trattner, W., 220 Travis, G., 243 Treece, P. D., 608 Trent, J., 221 Trieschmann, R., 231 Trinidad, S. B., 579 Tripp. T. J., 180 Trivieri, L., 292, 301,

302, 304, 305, 307, 309

Troesch, L. M., 306 Tromp-Wever, A. M.,

548 Trotta, M. P., 536, 547 Truax, P., 405 Trzepacz, P. T., 183–186 Tsai, H., 599 Tsark, J., xvii Tschopp, M. K., 534 Tsemberis, S., 448 Tsouna-Hadjis, P., 249 Tu, A. W., 435 Tu, W., 396 Tucker, M. A., 575 Tull, E. S., 531 Tulsky, J., 406 Turk, D. C., 533, 535,

538, 540, 541 Turnbull, P., 197 Turner, B., 224 Turner, F. J., 243–245,

248 Turner, K. S., 618 Turner, S., 580

Turrina, C., 546 Twillman, R., 506 Twisk, J. W., 546, 548 Tyndall, J., 199, 200

Ullrich, C. M., 618 Ulrey, K. L., 248 Ulrich, C., 618 Uncapher, H., 398 Underwood, L., 405 Unger, J. B., 401 Unruh, A., 615 Unutzer, J., 197 Uomoto, J., 405 Urdangarin, C. F., 394,

395 Uretzky, G., 21 Uribarri, J., 474, 476 Urv-Wong, E., 405 Uttley, L., 361

Vaillant, G. E., 127 Valdez, R., 473 Valdimarsdottir, H. B.,

575 Valero, V., 616 Vallbona, C., 249 Vanclay, L., 246 Van Craen, K., 395 Van Cutsem, E., 507 VandeMark, N., 449 Van den Berghe, H.,

507, 575 Van den Beulken-van

Everdingen, M. H. J., 613

Vandenburgh, H., 15, 16 van der Ploeg, H. M.,

548 van der Riet, P., 503,

505 van der Ven, N. C., 548 VanderWeele, T. J., 146,

158 Vandewater, E. A., 402 van Dijk, L., 535 Van Dijk, P. C., 476 Van Dulmen, S., 535 vanElderen, T., 187, 201 Vaneselow, N. A., 409 van Kleef, M., 613 van Meijel, E. P. M.,

205

Van Rompay, M., 292– 295, 297, 300

Van Rompay, M. I., 502 van Rooijen, L., 456 van Ryn, M., 238, 262,

633 Van Soest, M., 196 van Tilburg, W., 615 van Wormer, K., 426 van Zwieten, M., 571 Varady, A. N., 172 Vardas, P. E., 249 Vargas, J., 435 Vasiliaki, E., 444 Vaughn, J., 83, 84 Veenhoven, R., 270 Vega-Lahr, N., 306 Veis, J. H., 472, 473 Velasquez, M. M., 445,

446 Velikova, G., 179 Ventura, S. J., 72, 75 Vergara, S., 435 Verhey, F., 179 Vernon, S. W., 177 Vickers, A., 300, 310 Vinante, O., 307 Vincent, L., 511, 514 Vinicor, F., 531 Vinokur, A., 456 Vinton, L., 415 Virani, R., 598 Visscher, B., 166 Viswanath, K., 126 Vitaliano, P. P., 405 Vitiello, B., 198 Vittinghoff, E., 190 Viviani, F., 307 Vlahov, D., 166, 167,

187, 435 Volkow, N., 428, 429,

438 Volkow, N. D., 438 Voltaire, F., 41 von Baeyer, C., 127 Vonesh, E., 473 Von Gunten, C. F., 618 Von Korff, M., 166, 197,

547 Von Roenn, J. H., 599 von Ryn, M., 17,

247–248 Vorberg, G., 309

Vorchheimer, D., 547 Vourlekis, B., 477 Vourlekis, B. S., 415 Vrijlandt, I., 205 Vuckovic, N., 54 Vukmir, R. B., 150 Vupputuri, S., 276

Waalen, J., 571 Wachter, R. M., 101 Wade, C., 293 Wade, K., 348 Wadhwa, N. K., 476 Wadsworth, B., 580 Waehre, H., 356 Wagener, D. K., 172 Wagner, E. F., 447 Waheed, B., 435 Wahlbeck, K., 198 Wainwright, N. W. J.,

545 Waite, L. J., 20 Wakefi eld, J., 178 Walbroehl, G. S., 360,

361 Waldron, W., 500, 503,

517, 598 Waldrop, D., 506 Walker, A., 446 Walker, A. R., 308 Walker, E. R., 172 Walker, J. R., 344 Walker, R. E., 72 Walker, S., 509 Wall, J. C., 405 Wall, S., 152 Wallace, A., 435 Wallace, J., 507 Wallace, M., 580 Wallenstein, S., 616 Waller, G., 127 Wallin, S., 117 Wallis, A. B., 68 Wallston, K. A., 333 Walser, R. D., 449 Walsh, A., 506 Walsh, F., 171, 203,

319, 324, 327, 333, 336, 506

Walsh, K., 514, 644 Walsh, S., 644 Walsh, T., 83, 84 Walsh-Burke, K., 505

Author Index.indd 674Author Index.indd 674 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

Author Index 675

Walter, F., 572 Walters, A. E., 68 Walters, E. E., 193, 502 Wang, C., 159 Wang, P. S., 198 Wang, S. Y., 471, 474,

480 Ward, E., 500, 503 Wardle, J., 175 Ware, J. E., 251, 405 Wareham, N. J., 545 Warnecke, R. B., xv Warshafsky, S., 309 Warshauer-Baker, E.,

565 Washington, K., 614 Washington, T. A., 16 Waskul, D., 503, 505 Watanabe, T., 356 Waterman, P. D., 72, 77 Watkins, E. L., 68 Watkins, J. F., 203 Watson, L., 506, 512 Watson, M. S., 575, 579 Watson, P., 204 Watson, S. J., Jr., 434 Watt, I. S., 446 Watt, S., 410 Watts, C., 645 Way, S., 32 Weathers, B., 571 Weaver, I. C. G., 563 Weaver, L., 618 Weaver, M. F., 435, 438 Webb, N. B., 376, 380,

385 Webb, R., 197 Webster, R. D., 361 Weech-Maldonado, R.,

70 Weerakoon, P., 348, 356 Weiden, P. J., 546 Weihs, K., 175, 203,

318, 337, 506

Weihs, K. L., 472, 473 Weil, A., 188, 189, 299,

435 Weinberg, D., 572 Weinberg, D. S., 331 Weinberg, R., 502 Weiner, B., 127, 334 Weiner, H., 166

Weiner, L. S., 348 Weiner, M., 352, 353 Weinman, J., 251 Weir, B. W., 444, 448 Weir, H. K., 172 Weiser, M. A., 580 Weisman, S., 189 Weisner, C., 441 Weiss, H. L., 241 Weiss, J., 576, 582 Weiss, L., 472 Weiss, R., 441 Weiss, R. D., 449 Weiss, S. S., 546 Weissbecker, I., 200 Weissgarten, J., 472,

473, 481 Weissman, D., 382 Weissman, M. M., 198,

571 Weissman, N., 576, 582 Welch, C. E., 249 Weldon, A. H., 192 Wells, A., 502 Wells, H., 68 Wells, K. B., 203, 204 Wells, N. E., 193 Wells-Federman, C. L.,

306 Welsh, K. A., 398 Welty, T. K., 531 Weltz, C. R., 307 Wenger, N. S., 291, 294 Wennberg, D. E., 151 Wennberg, J. E., 150,

155, 156 Wermter, A., 565 Werner-Lin, A., 325,

506–508, 511, 512, 571, 572, 577, 578

Werth, J., 509 Wertlieb, D., 539 Wessel, J., 300 West, D. S., 241 West, R., 200 West, R. R., 548 Westerberg, V. S., 443 Weston, W. W., 239, 249 Wetzel, S., 295 Wetzler, S., 198 Wharton, J. C., 301 Wheeler, E., 307 Whitaker, T., 22

White, E., 241 White, J., 32, 34 White, N., 534, 535 White, N. H., 21, 535 White, W. L., 426 White, Y., 474 Whitehead, T. L., 357 Whiteneck, G., 226 Whiting, R., 333 Whittaker, K. E., 353 Whittemore, V. H., 576,

582 Whitt-Glover, M., 72 Wickramarante, P., 571 Widlitz, M., 398 Widner, H., 300 Wieland, D., 394, 395 Wight, V. R., 190 Wiklund, I., 300 Wikstrom, B., 473, 477 Wilbur, J., 150 Wilcox, M., 153 Wilcox, R. E., 428 Wild, S., 531 Wiley, D., 402 Wileyto, E. P., 571 Wilfond, B., 581 Wilkey, S., 292–294,

300 Wilkey, S. A., 293, 297,

502 Wilkins, D. G., 433, 434 Wilkinson, A., 335 Wilkinson, D., 546 Wilkinson, D. S., 64, 76 Wilkinson, R. G., 73 Willett, J. B., 539 Williams, D., 500 Williams, D. R., 172,

173, 190, 431 Williams, J. B. W., 164,

178, 192 Williams, J. K., 324 Williams, J. W., 166,

187, 188, 190, 191, 194, 199

Williams, R. A., 448 Williams, R. B., 155 Williams, S. L., 534 Williams-Russo, P., 75,

143, 149, 165, 173, 175, 244, 246, 256, 500

Wilson, I. B., 247, 249 Wilson, R. S., 613 Wilson, W., 534 Wilson, W. J., 157 Wimberly, S. R., 350 Wind, L. H., 383 Wing, S., 150, 441 Wingo, P. A., 172 Winick, N., 166 Winkel, G., 605 Winkleby, M. A., 172 Winkley, K., 548 Winnicott, D. W., 604 Winsett, R. P., 481 Winslade, W., 53 Winters, K., 172 Wisdom, J., 54 Wiseman, V., 249 Wisneski, H., 193 Witek-Janusek, L., 200 Witkiewitz, K., 447, 448 Witten, B., 470, 478,

485 Wittenberg-Lyles, E.,

614 Witter, D., 503 Wittman, J., 488 Wolf, L. E., 579 Wolff, J., 506 Wolfsdorf, J. I., 534,

539 Wolinsky, F., 72 Wong, M. D., 291, 294 Woo, P. P. S., 68 Woo, S. H., 414 Wood, B. L., 318 Wood, E., 167, 545 Wood, J. D., 361 Wood, K. M., 450 Woodcock, A., 250 Woods, A., 482 Woods, A. L., 474 Woods, N., 508 Woods, R., 152 Woods, X. A., 356 Woody, G., 449 Wootton, J., 292 Worden, J., 227 Worden, J. W., 636, 637 Worthington, E. L., Jr.,

284 Wortley, P. M., 533 Wren, B. G., 354

Author Index.indd 675Author Index.indd 675 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

676 Author Index

Wright, B. A., 232 Wright, L., 506 Wright, L. M., 331 Wright, T., 188 Wu, A., 479 Wu, A. W., 473, 474 Wu, E., 449 Wu, S. C., 471, 474, 480 Wuerth, D., 472 Wulsin, L., 545 Wyatt, S. B., 172 Wysocki, T., 535

Xakellies, G., 407, 408 Xie, S. X., 197 Xiong, X., 406 Xu, J., 145, 146, 148,

503 Xu, J. Q., 71, 72, 75,

192

Yabroff, K. R., 374 Yahne, C. E., 444, 448 Yalom, I. D., 245 Yamaguchi, K., 433

Yan, Y., 72 Yanes, B., 306 Yang, D., 406 Yaniv, I., 573 Yano, E. M., 176 Yashima, E., 346, 350 Yassa, T., 478 Yasui, Y., 509 Yates, J. S., 297 Yates, P. M., 130 Yee, L., 349 Yehuda, R., 204, 205 Yellow Bird, M., 170 Yemane, A., 115 Yemez, B., 361 Yemini, T., 193 Yen, I. H., 157 Yeo, G., 406–408 Yip, B., 167, 545 Yoo, H. C., 172 Yoon, J. W., 472 Yordy, K. D., 409 Yoshihama, M., 159 Youm, Y., 148, 150 Young, A., 243

Young, A. S., 203, 204 Young, B., 547 Young, B. S., 472 Young, J. P., 456 Young, M. E., 226 Yu, H. J., 291, 294 Yun, K., 645 Yun, L. W., 547 Yusack, C. M., 482

Zabora, J., 503–505, 514, 517

Zachny, J., 616 Zacny, J., 438 Zalemski, S., 483 Zametkin, A. J., 193 Zandbelt, L. C., 248 Zandi, P., 558 Zapata, B. C., 152 Zarit, S., 405 Zauber, A. G., 500 Zebrack, B., 502, 507–

510, 514, 517, 644 Zeh, J., 305 Zeltzer, L., 508, 510

Zerhouni, E., 244 Zhang, D. D., 166 Zhang, G., 300 Zhang, R., 482 Zhao, S., 190 Zierler, S., 193 Zimberg, S., 189 Zimmerman, C., 645 Zimmerman, M., 194 Zimmerman, W., 109 Zinberg, G., 348 Ziroyanis, P., 471, 474 Zlotnick, C., 449 Zlotnik, J. L., 646 Zodikoff, B., 644 Zola, I., 222 Zoldbrod, A., 344, 345 Zoldbrod, A. P., 344,

345 Zuckerman, B., 255,

434 Zunkel, G., 350 Zweben, A., 450 Zweben, J., 439 Zwetsch, T., 318

Author Index.indd 676Author Index.indd 676 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

677

Subject Index

Abortion, 48, 81, 121, 130, 264, 431, 574, 635, 637

Abstinence violation effect, 442, 443

Abuse and neglect children, 22, 31, 32 older adults, 22,

402–404, 410 Access to health care.

See also Barriers to health care; Health- care disparities

children, 87 and ethnicity, 145 health policy, 100–

102, 119 public health issues,

69–71, 75, 87 rural versus urban

areas, 150, 151 social determinants of

health, 149 and socioeconomic

status, 174 Accountability, 100–

102, 119 Act utilitarianism, 47,

55 Activities of daily living

(ADLs), 108, 242, 393, 394, 400, 404, 405, 412, 414, 472, 473, 612

Acupuncture, 292, 294, 296–297, 300–302, 309–311

Acute myocardial infarction. See Myocardial infarction

Acute stress disorder, 191

Addams, Jane, 5, 7–9, 66

Addiction, 426–429, 616, 617. See also Substance use/ abuse

Adenoma, 500 Adherence counseling,

200, 526, 535–541, 549

Adjustment to disability, 226–229

Administration of Children Youth and Families, 82

Administrative role of social workers, 30, 31

Adolescents alcohol use, 429, 430,

452 antidepressants, 198,

547 cancer, 378, 507–509 cocaine use, 434, 435 collaboration among

family, school, and medical setting, 377, 378

community effects on, 152–154

depression, 181, 190, 203, 547

diabetes, 544, 548 (see also Diabetes)

end-of-life care, 383, 384

end-stage renal disease (ESRD), 474

family member’s chronic pain, dealing with, 606, 607

fertility issues, 378 Healthy People 2020

objectives, 67 inhalant use, 437 inherited adult-onset

disease risk, 578 interventions for

youth with medical conditions, 378, 379

lesbian, gay, bisexual, and transgender (LGBT) issues, 357, 358

marijuana use, 433 medical diagnosis,

adjustment and response to, 375–377

obesity, 74 parentifi ed, 330 posttraumatic stress

disorder, 205 psychotherapeutics

use, 438

sexual health/ sexuality, 345, 353, 355, 357, 358

substance use interventions, 441, 448, 449 (see also Substance use/ abuse)

suicide risk intervention, 196, 198

support groups, 511 and Theory of

Reasoned Action, 130

tobacco use, 432, 442

Adult-onset disorders, genetic testing for, 575–578

Adulthood community effects on,

154, 155 older adults (see

Older adults) young adults, 192,

355–357 Advance directives, 45,

601, 633–636 Advocacy

disability, 230, 231 end-stage renal

disease (ESRD), 483–485

health policy issues, 114–119, 644 (see also Health policy)

Subject Index.indd 677Subject Index.indd 677 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

678 Subject Index

older adults, 394, 396, 397, 409, 411, 414, 416

oncology social work, 514

pain management, 601, 617

palliative care, 601, 617

patients, 29 public policy, 75, 646,

647 role of social workers,

356, 364, 483–485, 646, 647

sexual health/ sexuality, 356, 364

for social work profession, 30, 31, 34, 35

student rights, 377, 378

Agency for Healthcare Research and Quality (AHRQ), 89, 116

Aging. See Older adults Agoraphobia, 178, 182 Aid to Families with

Dependent Children (AFDC), 107, 121, 484

AIDS. See HIV/AIDS Alcohol and alcoholism.

See also Substance use/abuse

brief intervention, 456, 457

and cancer, 431, 500 and depression, 188,

189 epidemiology, 429,

430 health effects, 430,

431 older adults, 396,

398, 430, 431, 439, 452, 454

overview, 430 screening for, 450–456 and social networks,

240 terminology, 428, 429

Alcoholics Anonymous (AA), 429, 439– 441, 456, 459

Allostatic load, 165, 166, 275

Almshouses, 4 ALS (amyotrophic

lateral sclerosis), 25, 224, 562

Alternative medicine and complementary approaches

abdominal breathing, 306

acupuncture, 292, 294, 296, 297, 300–302, 309–311

alternative medicine described, 295, 296

aromatherapy, 305 autogenic training,

306, 605 ayurvedic medicine

(ayurveda), 296, 301, 309

bioelectronic therapies, 308

biofeedback, 292, 296, 306, 307

biological treatments, 308, 309

body therapies, 297 botanical medicine

(herbal remedies), 292–294, 296–298, 300–304, 308–311, 362, 594

cancer, 502 Chinese medicine,

traditional (TCM), 296, 300, 302, 310

chiropractic, 292, 294, 296, 304, 305, 310, 311

complementary approaches, 295– 297

curanderismo, 303 curandero/curandera,

295, 303 ethnic groups, 291,

293–295, 302–304, 311

folk medicine, 292, 302–304, 309, 600

guided imagery, 292, 306

health-care systems, alternative, 301– 309

herbal remedies (botanical medicine), 292– 294, 296–298, 300–304, 308–311, 362, 594

homeopathy, 292, 296, 297, 301, 302

hypnosis, 292, 306, 307, 549, 605

insurance coverage, 295, 311

integrative health care, 295, 297, 298, 309–311

massage therapy, 292, 296, 300, 301, 303–306

meditation, 296, 300, 301, 306, 307, 309, 548, 549

mind/body techniques, 295– 298, 332, 333

naprapathy, 305 naturapathic

medicine, 302 nondisclosure of

treatment, reasons for, 293

nutrition and lifestyle regimens, 308, 309

problems and concerns, 309–311

reasons for seeking alternative treatment, 298, 299

refl exology, 305 research dilemma,

309 resources, 312, 313 terminology, 295–298 therapeutic touch

(TT), 305 U.S. practices, 292,

293

Alzheimer’s disease, 108, 185, 224, 227, 320, 321, 323, 399, 400, 415, 508, 577

Ambulatory surgery centers, 22

American Association of Hospital Social Workers, 11, 12

American Association of Medical Social Workers, 12

American Cancer Society (ACS), 118, 207, 365, 387, 504, 520

American Hospital Association, 10, 12, 484

American Medical Association (AMA), 10, 49, 117, 301

American Recovery and Reinvestment Act, 110

Americans with Disabilities Act (ADA), 121, 219, 220, 378, 581

Ammon, Kay, 25 Amniocentesis, 574, 582 Amputation, 70, 193,

356, 357, 530, 635 Amyotrophic lateral

sclerosis (ALS), 25, 224, 562

Angina. See Heart disease

Anticipating end of life, 629

Anticipatory mourning, 636

Antidepressants, 197, 198, 203, 204, 310, 361, 362, 428, 439, 545, 547, 616

Anxiety after major medical

procedures, 21 and cancer, 179, 502,

505, 507, 509, 510, 513, 515, 516

Subject Index.indd 678Subject Index.indd 678 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

Subject Index 679

Anxiety (cont.) and end-stage renal

disease (ESRD), 472–474, 477, 480

management of in children, 380, 381

Anxiety disorders. See also specifi c disorders

diagnostic criteria, 191 differential

assessment, 186– 190

interventions, 203–205 and medical

conditions, 188 not otherwise

specifi ed, 191 older adults, 178, 203,

204, 398, 400, 439 prevalence, 178 screening for in

health-care settings, 181–183

types of, 178 Appearance, attitude,

and activity (mental status exam), 183–184

Applied ethics, 44 Aromatherapy, 305 Artifi cial hydration and

nutrition, 64, 65, 229, 404, 634

Asbestos, 69 Assessment

biopsychosocial- spiritual model and assessment, 441, 590–592, 594, 597–600

cancer patients, ongoing assessments, 514

CARESS model of assessment, 351

community, 68, 75–77, 94

comprehensive geriatric assessment. See Comprehensive geriatric assessment (CGA)

end-stage renal disease (ESRD), patient assessment, 479, 480

EX-PLISSIT model of assessment, 351

families, 319, 325– 334

function of public health agencies, 64

Global Assessment of Functioning (GAF), 177

health impact assessment (HIA), 76

kidney donors, 479, 480

mental status, 183, 185 (see also Comprehensive geriatric assessment [CGA])

palliative care, 600 psychosocial

conditions in health-care settings, 167–198

screening versus assessment, older adults, 408, 409

sexuality and physical intimacy, 348–351

spiritual assessment, 276–284, 597–599

tools, 24 Assisted suicide, 44,

45, 229, 263, 610, 611, 639. See also Euthanasia

Association for Death Education and Counseling, 640

Association of State and Territorial Public Health Social Workers (ASTPHSW), 37, 81, 82

Assurance (public health function), 64, 94, 101

Asthma, 89, 118, 153, 178, 300, 301, 321, 328, 373–376, 441

AT&T Language Line, 254, 599

Attention Restoration Theory (ART), 88

Attribution theory, 127 Attributional Style

Questionnaire, 127 AUDIT (Alcohol

Use Disorders Identifi cation Test), 454–455

Auditory sense, 306, 396, 400, 602, 605. See also Hearing loss

Autogenic training, 306, 605

Autonomous practice/ practitioner, 32, 644, 646

Autonomy, 44–46, 221, 222, 331, 338, 404, 407, 415, 443, 446, 457, 504, 508, 517, 578, 580, 581, 599, 609–611, 617

Autosomal dominant mode of inheritance, 560

Autosomal recessive mode of inheritance, 560, 569, 575, 580

Ayurvedic medicine (ayurveda), 296, 301, 309

Baker, Edith M., 11 Balanced Budget Act of

1997, 109 Barriers to health care.

See also Access to health care

failure to enroll in public programs, 115

lack of knowledge, 106, 108, 109

role of social workers, 26, 27

socioeconomic status, 21, 24

system and institutional barriers, 70

Bartlett, Harriett, 10, 12, 15, 16, 504

Behavioral Model for Vulnerable Populations, 133, 134

Behavioral Model of Health Services Use, 131–135

Benefi cence principle, 45, 57, 59, 609, 610

Benefi t model, 88 Benefi ts Checkup, 417 Benthan, Jeremy, 47 Bereavement

counseling, 23, 25, 26, 32, 517, 628, 636. See also Grief

Bioelectronic therapies, 300, 305, 308

Bioethics, 48–52, 61, 62, 578, 581, 599

Biofeedback, 292, 296, 306–307

Biological treatments, 308–309

Biopsies, 307, 500, 501 Biopsychosocial

approach to health care, 20–24, 33–36, 223, 318, 396, 453, 489, 490, 504, 510, 513, 514, 517, 518, 645

Biopsychosocial- spiritual model and assessment, 441, 590–592, 594, 597–600

Bipartisan Commission on Comprehensive Health Care (Pepper Commission), 111

Bipolar disorder, 178 Birth defects, 573, 574,

577 Bisexuality. See

Lesbian, gay, bisexual, and transgender (LGBT) issues

Subject Index.indd 679Subject Index.indd 679 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

680 Subject Index

Blackwell, Elizabeth, 5 Blank check Medicare,

104 Blank check medicine,

105 Block grants, 65, 80,

94, 158 Body image, 345, 355,

356, 359, 472–474 Body Mass Index

(BMI), 73, 74 Body therapies (manual

therapies), 297, 304–308

Bond, Thomas, 5 Bone marrow transplants,

352, 363, 484, 485 Boretti, Ruth T., 10 Botanical medicine

(herbal remedies), 292–294, 296–298, 300–304, 308–311, 362, 594

Boundary violations, 54, 55

Bouvia, Elizabeth, 228 Brackett, Jeffrey, 6 BRCA gene, 507, 561,

574, 577, 582 Breast cancer. See also

Cancer attitudes toward, 26 and BRCA gene, 507,

561, 574, 577, 582 family support, 21 social support, 21 studies on health

disparities, 26 Breathing exercises,

380, 381 Brief eclectic

psychotherapy (BEP), 205

Brief interventions, substance abuse, 450, 456, 457

Brief MAST (B-MAST), 456

Bruxton, Peter, 51 Bulimia, 22, 544.

See also Eating disorders

Bullard, Robert, 87

Cabot, Elizabeth, 7 Cabot, James, 7, 8 Cabot, Richard, 6–10,

12, 16–18, 134, 242 Cabot, Samuel, 7 CAGE-AID (CAGE

Adapted to Include Drugs), 454

CAGE questionnaire, 398, 405, 453–454

Cancer adenomas, 500 adolescents, 507–509 advocacy, 514 and alcohol use, 431,

500 alternative/

complementary therapies, 502 (see also Alternative medicine and complementary approaches)

anxiety, 179, 502, 505, 507, 509, 510, 513, 515, 516

BRCA gene, 507, 561, 574, 577, 582

carcinoma, 500 case management, 516 causes of, 500, 503 challenges of oncology

social work, 518 chemotherapy, 297,

300, 306–308, 343, 361, 362, 377, 378, 434, 469, 501, 502, 505, 509, 591, 628

children, 373, 374, 376–378, 506–509

as chronic disease, 498, 503

clinical trials, 501, 502, 509

coping strategies, 506 counseling, 515–518 depression, 179, 501,

505, 507–509, 513, 516

diagnosis, 500, 502, 503

and disease management, 15

end-of-life care, 517 (see also End-of- life care)

and end-stage renal disease, 469, 509, 591

epidemiology, 498– 500

etiology, 400 and families, 321–

325, 327, 331, 333–335, 338, 506

fertility issues, 378, 507–510, 517

genetic testing, 325, 507, 513

guided imagery techniques, 306

and health beliefs, 241, 506

health-care disparities, 26, 70, 500, 501, 512, 515, 517, 519

history of psychosocial oncology, 502–504

hormonal therapy, 361, 502

hospice care, 504 (see also Hospice care)

insurance issues, 500, 501, 505, 508, 509, 513, 514

interventions, 510, 511 leukemias, 500 lung cancer, 69, 193,

431, 432 lymphomas, 500 Medicare, 508, 509 melanoma, 500 and men, 498–500 and mental illness, 505 mindfulness-based

stress reduction (MBSR), 200

mortality, 500, 503 older adults, 393, 396,

398, 401, 411, 500, 508, 509

oncology social work, 498, 504, 505, 510–519

ongoing patient and family assessments, 514

pain management, 504, 594, 602, 612, 613, 615

palliative care, 504, 517 (see also Palliative care)

parents of school-age children, 508

patient education, 516, 517

psychosocial effects of, 505–510

radiation therapy, 129, 377, 378, 501–503, 505, 509, 516, 591, 628

research, 503, 504, 517, 518

resources, 519, 520 sarcomas, 500 screening, 22, 70, 79,

150–151, 241, 253, 273, 503, 512

and sexual health/ sexuality, 343, 347, 352, 354, 356, 359– 362, 500, 505–510

side effects of treatment, 501– 503, 505, 509

skin cancer, 563 social support, 21,

504–506, 509, 510, 513, 514

staging, 500–502 and substance abuse,

431–434 support groups, 508,

510, 511 survivorship issues,

509, 510 treatment, 377, 499–

505, 507, 509 (see also Chemotherapy under this heading; Radiation therapy under this heading)

types, 500 and women, 175,

498–500

Subject Index.indd 680Subject Index.indd 680 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

Subject Index 681

Cancer Care, Inc., 388, 520, 619, 640, 641

Cannabis. See Marijuana (cannabis)

Cannon, Ida, 3, 6, 7, 9–12, 14–18, 504, 592

Cannon, Mary Antoinette, 10

Capital, social, 88, 157, 166

Capitation, 103, 105, 119 Carcinoma, 500. See

also Cancer Cardiomyopathy. See

Heart disease Cardiovascular

disease. See also Heart disease; Hypertension; Stroke

adherence to treatment regimen, 534

African Americans, 116, 172

alcohol as cause of, 430

in children, 382 and cocaine use, 435 depression, 21, 361,

362 and diabetes, 530 diet and nutrition, 308 and ecstasy use, 437 health-care

disparities, 72, 116 medical model, 149 medications, side

effects of, 361 motivational

interviewing, 444 nutritional

supplementation, 308

older adults, 396, 401, 508

and psychiatric conditions, 187

religion/spirituality, effect of, 273

and sexuality/sexual health, 360, 361

societal factors, infl uence of, 151

and stimulant use, 439

and stress, 165 types of, 529

Caregiver strain, 405, 423

CARESS model of assessment, 351

Carriers screening, 574, 575 testing, 569, 574, 575,

582 Carter, Jimmy, 111 Carter, Majora, 88 Case management

cancer, 516 end-stage renal

disease (ESRD), 482

role of social workers, 25, 28, 29, 31, 230

transplant patients, 26 Center for

Epidemiological Studies Depression Scale (CES-D), 405

Center for Interdisciplinary Health Disparities Research, 26

Center for Medicare and Medicaid Innovation, 117

Center for Substance Abuse Treatment (CSAT), 176, 430, 441, 449, 460

Center to Advance Palliative Care, 593, 641

Centers for Disease Control and Prevention (CDC), 23, 82, 103, 417

Change, stages of, 134 Chapin, Henry Dwight,

5 Charity care, 103 Chelation therapy, 309 Chemotherapy, 22, 297,

300, 306–308, 343,

361, 362, 377, 378, 434, 469, 501, 502, 505, 509, 591, 628

Chicago Housing Authority, 157

Child abuse, 22, 31, 32 Child Behavior

Checklist, 179 Child Behavior

Inventory (Eyberg), 179

Child-directed interaction (CDI), 177, 179

Children/childhood. See also Infants

abuse, 22, 31, 32 access to health care,

87 (see also Access to health care)

advocacy for student rights, 377, 378

antidepressants, 198 anxiety disorders,

prevalance of, 178 anxiety management,

380, 381 asthma, 89, 153, 178,

374–376 breathing exercises,

380, 381 cancer, 373–374,

376–378, 506–509 collaboration among

family, school, and medical setting, 377, 378, 386

community effects on, 153

confi dentiality issues, 377

dealing with family member’s chronic pain, 606, 607

death, causes of, 382 depression, 181, 190 diabetes, 373, 374,

376, 548 (see also Diabetes)

diagnosis, adjustment to, 374–376

disruptive disorders, 178, 179

end-of-life care, 381–384, 631

end-stage renal disease (ESRD), 474

fears, 378, 379 fertility issues, 378 genetic testing, 580,

581 (see also Genetic testing)

global issues, 84, 85 health problems,

prevalence and scope of, 373, 374

hospice care, 381, 382 inherited adult-onset

disease risk, 578 injuries, home as

source of, 75 interventions, 378–

381, 607, 608 juvenile rheumatoid

arthritis, 374 memorial services, 385 mood disorders, 178 obesity, 68, 74, 128,

151, 374 palliative care,

381–383 play and expressive

therapies, 379, 380, 383

posttraumatic growth, 377

posttraumatic stress disorder, 205

resources, 387–390 responses to medical

condition, 376, 377 self-control exercises,

381 sexual abuse, 352, 353 social causation, 173,

174 social support, 22 social workers,

challenges for, 384–386

social workers, role of, 376, 377, 379, 382, 386

and socioeconomic status, 173, 174

Subject Index.indd 681Subject Index.indd 681 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

682 Subject Index

special needs, 80, 117, 331, 374, 570

spiritual needs of dying child, 383, 384

suicide risk intervention, 196, 198

support groups, 511 support groups for

specifi c medical conditions, 376, 377

traumatic medical experiences, 379

vicarious traumatization, 385, 386

Children with Special Health Care Needs (Title V), 80

Children’s Bureau, 65 Children’s Health

Insurance Program Reauthorization Act of 2009 (CHIPRA), 109

Chinese medicine, traditional (TCM), 296, 300, 302, 310, 406

Chiropractic, 292, 294, 296, 304–305, 310–311, 502

Chorionic villis sampling (CVS), 574

Christ, Grace, 504 Christian Science, 8 Chromosomes, 52,

559–562, 569, 570, 573–574, 582, 584

Chronic disease cancer as, 498, 503

(see also Cancer) challenges of for

social workers, 527 chronic phase, 322–

325, 327 course of, 320, 321,

325 crisis phase, 322, 323,

325, 327

and depression, 534, 536, 543–549

diabetes (see Diabetes) end-stage renal

disease (see End- stage renal disease [ESRD])

family approach to, 238, 318, 319 (see also Families)

and genetic testing, 324, 325

health-care settings, 528

heart disease (see Heart disease)

HIV/AIDS. See HIV/ AIDS

and homelessness, 146 incapacitation, 321,

322, 325 interventions to

improve mental health, 547–549

and life expectancies, 527

and mental health, 534, 536, 543–549

onset phase, 320, 325 outcome, 321, 325 overview, 549 pain management,

612–614 (see also Pain management)

patient-practitioner communication and adherence to treatment, 541–543

quality of life, 21 religious coping, 274

(see also Religion and spirituality)

terminal phase, 322, 324, 325, 327, 328

transition between phases, 324

treatment regimens, adherence to, 533– 541, 546–547

trends in patient care, 526, 527, 644

Chronic phase of illness, 322–324, 328

Civil War, 7 Climate change, 82, 84 Clinical and

translational science (CTS), 90

Clinical base, expansion of, 644–646

Clinical geneticists, 558, 566

Clinical social work and public health social work contrasted, 68

Clinical trials, 90, 374, 501, 502, 509

Clinton, Bill, 111 Clinton, Hillary

Rodham, 58 Cloning, 52, 59 Cocaine, 427, 431,

434–435, 442–443, 447–448, 547. See also Substance use/ abuse

Codes of ethics, 42–44, 46, 49, 50, 57. See also Ethics and ethical issues

Cognition. See also Comprehensive geriatric assessment (CGA)

assessment of, 183, 186, 394, 395, 405

older people, 393 and substance abuse,

427, 443 Cognitive-behavioral

and motivational enhancement therapy, 442

Cognitive-Behavioral Intervention for Trauma in Schools (CBITS), 205

Cognitive-behavioral interventions, 205, 602, 603

Cognitive-behavioral therapy (CBT), 51, 197, 198, 203–205, 439, 442–444, 480, 481, 548, 602, 603, 614

Cognitive restructuring, 603

Coherence, 171, 274, 281, 331

Cole, Rebecca, 5 Coleman Transition

Care Intervention (CTI), 411–413

Collaboration family, school, and

medical setting, 377, 378, 386

health-care teams, 243–246

role of social workers, 32–35

Commission for the Protection of Human Subjects of Biomedical and Behavioral Research, 51

Commission on Social Determinants of Health (CSDS), 72

Commitment-to- treatment statement (CTS), 196, 197

Communicable disease. See Infectious diseases

Communication in health care

clinical encounters, 237–241, 246–248

cultural constructions of reality, 238, 239

culture-specifi c syndromes, 241, 242

end-of-life care, 628, 630, 631, 633

genetic testing information, 579, 580

and health beliefs, 238–243

health-care teams, 25, 243–246

and health outcomes, 248, 249

illness versus disease, communication issues, 241–243

Subject Index.indd 682Subject Index.indd 682 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

Subject Index 683

Communication in health care (cont.)

improving, methods for, 249–255

language barriers, 70, 242, 253–255, 406–408 (see also Interpreters)

medical terminology, 256–259

methods for improving, 249–255

nonverbal, 406, 407 overview, 237, 255, 256 patterns of

communication, 246–248

racial, ethnic, and socioeconomic differences, 16, 17, 246–248

resources, 259 role of social workers,

242, 245 sexual health/sexuality,

346, 356, 359 Community and health

community assessment, 68, 75–77, 94

community-based models of practice, 644, 645

ESRD social work intervention, 479, 483, 486, 487

infl uence of community on health, mechanisms of, 148–151

life course, community effects on, 152–156

neighborhood composition in U.S., 143–148

neighborhood effects, 146–148

overview, 143 resources, 160 social work practice

implications, 156–159

Community assessment, 68, 75–78, 94

Community-based participatory research (CBPR), 89, 159, 252, 276

Community-based services, 25, 64, 78–80, 114, 199, 393, 397, 400, 404, 406, 409, 416, 510, 549, 644, 645, 647

Community education, 27 Community-engaged

research (CEnR), 252

Community health clinics, 22

Community health programs, 22, 27

Community Living Assistance Services and Supports, 113, 114

Compassion fatigue, 619, 638–639

Complementary medicine approaches, 295–297. See also Alternative medicine and complementary approaches

Comprehensive geriatric assessment (CGA)

activities of daily living (ADL), ability to perform, 405

assessment tools, 405 and care management,

395 cognitive capacity,

398–400, 405 cultural background

(ethnogeriatrics), 406–408

economic resources, 404, 405

family and informal support, 403–405

functional ability, 400, 401, 405

geriatric evaluation and management (GEM) approach, 395, 396

Geriatric Resources for Assessment and Care of Elders (GRACE), 395, 397, 409

Medicare, 395 overview, 394, 395 physical environment,

402, 403, 405 physiological well-

being and health, 396, 397, 405

Program of All Inclusive Care for the Elderly, 395

psychological well- being and mental health, 397, 398, 405

social functioning, 401, 402, 405

spiritual assessment, 404–406

standardized assessment instruments, use of, 408

values and preferences, 404, 405

Condition-specifi c organizations, 207, 365

Confi dentiality. See also Privacy issues

cultural issues, 407 ethics, 46, 47, 50, 53,

55–57 genetic testing and

information, 576, 578–581

medical information, 377, 378

student rights, 377, 378 Congenital heart defects.

See Heart disease Congestive heart failure,

308, 528, 529, 544. See also Heart disease

Constructivism, 46–47 Constructs, defi ned, 126 Consumer’s Tool Kit

for Health Care Advance Planning, 634

Content Analysis of Verbatim Explanations, 127

Continuing education. See Education and training for social workers

Coordinated care, 64, 618 Coping, 201–203, 274,

506, 603, 604 Coronary artery disease,

153, 174, 181, 308, 528, 529, 544. See also Heart disease

Correctional facilities. See Prisons/ prisoners

Costs of health care cost control, 14–16,

22–24, 34, 119 (see also Health-care reform)

end-of-life care, 628, 630

fi nance and payment for health-care services, 102–107, 119

health policy, 100– 102, 119

Council of Nephrology Social Workers (CNSW), 12, 37, 488–490

Counseling and education

adherence counseling, 200, 526, 535–541, 549

cancer, 515–518 disabilities, 225, 226,

230 effect of on health,

146 end-stage renal

disease (ESRD), 479–481

Subject Index.indd 683Subject Index.indd 683 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

684 Subject Index

genetics, 507, 557, 566–573, 575, 579, 580, 582

grief/bereavement, 23, 25, 26, 32, 517, 628, 636

and health-care disparities, 70

medical crisis, 548 older adults, 411, 414 pain management,

601, 602 palliative care, 601 psychoeducation, 167,

198–201, 203–205, 319, 324, 326, 511, 516, 517

role of social workers, 23–26, 166, 487, 488

sexual rehabilitation, 362, 363

Crisis intervention, 31, 32, 227, 409, 410, 479, 481, 515

Crisis phase of illness, 322, 324, 325, 331–334

Cruzan, Nancy, 45 Cultural competence,

64, 68, 101, 170–172, 203, 207, 208, 265, 277, 279, 406–408, 455, 458, 513–515, 593, 633, 647

Cultural issues end-of-life care, 632,

633 physical and mental

health, 169–173 Culture brokers, 253 Culture-specifi c

syndromes, 241– 243, 254

Cummins, Anne, 6 Curandero/curandera/

curanderismo, 294, 295, 303

Cystic fi brosis (CF), 575, 578, 582

D’Alembert’s Dream (Diderot), 42

Daniels, Annie, 5 Darwin, Charles, 8, 220,

564 Darwinism, 8, 220 Death. See also End-of-

life care bereavement

counseling (see Bereavement counseling)

causes of in children, 382

death with dignity legislation, 611

Decision making, ethics, 42, 44, 50–53

Dementia Alzheimer’s disease

(see Alzheimer’s disease)

HIV/AIDS related, 545

older adults, 185–186, 323, 397–400, 403, 405, 411, 415

substance-induced, 428

Deontological theory, 46, 47

Depression African Americans,

172 and alcohol use, 188 antidepressants, 197,

198, 203, 204, 310, 361, 362, 428, 439, 545, 547, 616

and cancer, 179, 501, 505, 507–509, 513, 516

depressive disorder not otherwise specifi ed, 191

diagnostic criteria, 190, 191

differential assessment, 187– 190

and end-stage renal disease (ESRD), 472–474

and health problems, 21

and hip fractures, 75 interventions, 203–

205 and medical

conditions, 188 older adults, 166, 198,

203, 204, 396–400, 405, 408, 415

prevalence, 178, 179 screening for in

health-care settings, 181, 182

and substance use, 188, 189

women, 166, 167 Descartes, René, 594 Determinants of health,

67–70 Dewey, John, 8 Diabetes

as cause of end-stage renal disease, 468, 472

children, 373, 374, 376 deaths from, 527 epidemiology, 528,

531 gestational, 530 health-care

disparities, 70, 116 health-care settings,

528 implications of, 527 and mental health,

543, 544, 546, 547 mental health

interventions, 547–549

and obesity, 151, 528, 531

overview, 530 patient-practitioner

communication, 541–543

racial and ethnic disparities, 531

risk factors, 531 role of social workers,

25, 26 treatment regimen,

adherence to, 534– 541, 546, 547

types of, 530

Diagnosis of child, adjustment to, 374–376

Diagnosis Related Groups (DRGs), 102, 104, 105, 119

Diagnostic and Statistical Manual of Mental Disorders, Fourth Edition, Text Revision (DSM- IV-TR)

anxiety and mood disorders, 187, 190, 191

decision trees, 187– 189

depression, 190, 191 diagnostic hierarchy,

191, 192 multiaxial assessment,

178, 179 posttraumatic stress

disorder (PTSD), 180, 181, 191

substance-induced disorders, 128

substance-related disorders, 427–429

substance use disorders, 178, 427–429

Diagnostic-related groups (DRGs), 15

Dialysis, 50, 468–483, 487–492. See also End-stage renal disease (ESRD)

Dialysis centers, 22, 30, 50

Diderot, D., 42 Diet and nutrition. See

also Obesity alternative and

complementary medicine approaches, 300– 302, 308, 309

artifi cial hydration and nutrition, 64, 65, 229, 404, 634

and cancer, 505, 508

Subject Index.indd 684Subject Index.indd 684 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

Subject Index 685

Diet and nutrition. See also Obesity (cont.)

diabetes, 530, 539, 544, 546

dietary adherence, 128, 129

end-stage renal disease, 472, 474–477

National Nutrition and Health Survey (NHANES), 73–75

older adults, 396, 397, 410

religious rules, 273 supplements, 310

Dietitians, 21, 28, 478, 541, 566

Differential assessment, 167, 178, 179, 187–199

Differential diagnosis, 167, 192

Disability adjustment to, 226–

229 advocacy, 230, 231 biopsychosocial

model of treatment, 223

categorizing, 220 defi ning, 219, 220 discrimination, 220,

221, 224, 225, 231 ethical issues, 229, 230 fi nancial

consequences, 230, 231

free and appropriate education, right to, 231

and health-care disparities, 70

historical context, 220, 221

initial counseling, 225, 226

interventions, considerations for, 228, 229

meaning, fi nding, 231–233

Medicaid expenses, 108

medical model of treatment, 221–224

models for social work practice, 221–225

rehabilitation model of treatment, 222, 223

responses to, 226–229 role of social workers,

225–229 social model of, 223,

224 studies, 219 and suicide, 228 U.S. Census statistics,

220 Disaster preparedness

and response, 82–84 Discharge planning, 22,

105, 118, 393, 395, 404, 409–411, 413, 416

Discrimination. See also Health-care disparities

disability, 220, 221, 224, 225, 231, 581

employment, 144 and genetic testing,

581, 582 HIV/AIDS patients, 80 race and ethnicity, 74,

77, 143, 144, 172, 173, 336, 632

real estate and lending practices, 74, 144

Disease management, 15–17, 505, 536, 541

Disease prevention, 66–69, 78–80, 94, 409

Disease-specifi c care centers, 22, 23

Dispensaries, 5, 6 Disruptive disorders,

178, 179 Distraction techniques

for pain management, 604

DNA, 52, 558–563, 569

Domains of care and guidelines for practice, palliative care, 596, 597

Domestic violence, 68 Down syndrome, 225,

226, 562, 573, 574 Drug Abuse Screening

Test (DAST), 456 Dual eligibility

(Medicare and Medicaid), 108

Dual relationships, 50, 53–55

Dumping in Dixie (Bullard), 87

Duties of commission (imperfect duties), 47

Duties of omission (perfect duties), 47

Duty to protect, 47 Duty to warn, 47 Dysthymia, 178, 179,

191, 197, 563

Eating disorders, 22, 127, 284, 536, 544

Ecological systems theory, 34, 70, 167, 169, 171, 172, 174, 175, 187–190

Economic justice, 64, 70, 75, 81, 87

Education collaboration with

schools, 377 free and appropriate

education, right to, 231

Individual Education Programs, 231

patient education (see Counseling and education)

school as health-care setting, 22

social workers (see Education and training for social workers)

student rights, 231, 377, 378

Education and training for social workers

end-of-life care, 638 pain management,

593, 619, 620 public health social

work, 81, 82 social work

education, 244 Elder abuse and neglect,

22, 402–404, 410 Elderly. See Older adults Electroconvulsive

therapy (ECT), 204 Electronic waste

(e-waste), 88, 89 Emergency room

end-of-life care, 383 homeless patients, 158 social workers in, 26,

409 uninsured patients, 116

Emerson, Ruth, 11 Employment

discrimination, 144 and end-stage renal

disease (ESRD), 474

and health-care disparities, 70

health insurance coverage, 103, 104 (see also Insurance coverage)

Empowerment Zones (EZs), 158

End-of-life care. See also Pain management; Palliative care

advance directives, 633–636

anticipating end of life, 629

anticipatory mourning, 636

barriers to, 628 cancer, 517 children, 381–384,

631 communication

issues, 628, 630, 631, 633

Subject Index.indd 685Subject Index.indd 685 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

686 Subject Index

community effects on, 155–156

compassion fatigue, 638, 639

Consumer’s Tool Kit for Health Care Advance Planning, 634

costs, coverage of, 628, 630, 633

cultural issues, 632, 633

education and training for social workers, 638

emergency room, 383 end-stage renal

disease (ESRD), 473, 474, 482

ethical issues, 44–46, 639 (See also Ethics and ethical issues)

grief, disenfranchised, 637

grief, types of, 636, 637

health-care disparities, 632, 633

health-care settings, 627, 629

history of, 504, 594, 628

hospice, 628, 629 interdisciplinary

teamwork, 629, 630

listening skills, 630 loss, understanding,

635, 636 Medicare and

Medicaid, 628, 633 Patient Self-

Determination Act, 633, 634

pediatric intensive care unit, 383

resources, 640, 641 role of social workers,

26, 627, 629, 637, 638

social workers, recognition of, 637, 638

and spirituality, 631, 632 (see also Religion and spirituality)

standards for, 593, 633, 638

End-stage renal disease (ESRD)

adolescents, 474 advocacy role of social

workers, 483–485 anxiety and

depression, 472– 474, 477, 480

and cancer, 469, 509, 591

case examples, 475, 491, 492

case management, 482 caseloads, 488 causes of, 468, 469 challenging patients,

486 children, 474 community-level

intervention, 483 costs of, 468, 469 Council of Nephrology

Social Workers (CNSW), 488–490

counseling and education, 479–481

crisis intervention, 481 demographics, 471 dialysis, 50, 468–483,

487–492 dialysis centers, 22,

30, 50 dietary restrictions,

474, 475, 477 disease-related

psychosocial aspects, 472

effects of psychosocial issues, 477

employment issues, 474

end-of-life care, 473, 474, 482

end-of-life issues, 473, 474, 482

ESRD Network, 486, 487

ethical issues, 50 ethnic groups

affected, 471 family issues, 474 health-care team, 478,

483 hemodialysis, 50,

468–474, 476, 477, 479–481, 483, 491, 492

home hemodialysis, 469, 470

kidney donors, 470, 471, 479, 480

kidney transplants, 468–473, 475–481, 483–485, 490, 491

lifestyle changes, 471 Medicaid coverage,

468, 477, 478, 484, 485, 487

Medicare coverage, 468, 469, 471, 477, 478, 480–484, 486–490

medications, 470, 472, 473, 475–477, 479, 481, 485, 487, 490

national ESRD program (Public Law 92-601), 471

overview, 468–471, 490 pain management,

473, 613, 614 palliative care, 473,

613, 614 patient assessment,

479, 480 peritoneal dialysis,

468–470, 475–477, 479, 481

professional challenges, 485, 487, 488

professional organizations, 488–490

psychosocial aspects of, 471–477

Quality Assessment and Performance Improvement (QAPI), 483

rehabilitation assistance, 482, 483

resources, 492, 493 role of social workers,

472, 477–488 self-management

issues, 474–476 sexual functioning,

473 social work

intervention, 477–487

statistics on, 468 suicde risk, 472

Enterprise Communities, 158

Entitlement programs, 25. See also Medicaid

Environmental factors and genetics, 557– 559, 561–568, 582

Environmental justice, 64, 70, 81, 87, 88, 91

Epidemiology, 64, 94. See also Social epidemiology

Epigenetics, 563, 567 Epilepsy, 30, 38, 127,

128, 178, 181, 238, 242, 434

Erectile dysfunction, 354, 360–362. See also Sexual health/ sexuality

ESRD. See End-stage renal disease (ESRD)

ESRD Network, 486, 487

Ethics and ethical issues bioethics, 50–52 boundary violations,

54, 55 branches of ethics, 44 challenges, 60 cloning, 52 codes of ethics, 42–

44, 46, 49, 50, 57 confl icts, 44, 46, 47 constructivism, 46, 47

Subject Index.indd 686Subject Index.indd 686 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

Subject Index 687

Ethics and ethical issues (cont.)

decision-making, 42, 44, 50–53

disability issues, 229, 230

dual relationships, 50, 53–55

end-of-life care, 44–46, 639

end-stage renal disease (ESRD), 50

ethical dilemmas, 42 ethics of care, 47, 48 ethics of duty

(Kantian ethics), 47 ethics principles, 44,

609, 610 euthanasia (see

Euthanasia) genetics and genetic

testing, 570, 574, 578–581

laws, 43, 44 and managed care,

50, 56, 57 medical ethics, 48, 49 metaethics, 44, 45 morals, 43 normative ethics,

44–49 oncology social work,

512 overview, 41, 42 pain management

and palliative care, 609–611

philosophy, 42–46 positivism, 46 and religious beliefs,

263, 264 research ethics, 47,

57–59 resources, 61, 62 and risk management,

50 social work, 41, 42,

49, 50, 61 standards, 44 terminology, 42–44 values, 43, 45 whistle-blowing

(reporting

violations), 42, 51, 56, 57

Ethics in Social Work Statement of Principles, 61

Ethnicity. See also Race and alternative

medicine/ complementary approaches, 291, 293–295, 302–304, 311

discrimination (see Discrimination)

and end-stage renal disease (ESRD), 471

health-care disparities, 70, 72, 116, 144, 145 (see also Health-care disparities)

and obesity, 73 and pain

management, 615, 616

Ethnogeriatric assessment, 406– 408

Eugenics, 51, 220, 221, 338

Euthanasia, 45, 221, 229, 263, 264, 610, 611, 639. See also Assisted suicide

Evidence-based practice, 75, 89, 94

EX-PLISSIT model of assessment, 351

Expressive arts, use of, 606, 631

Eyberg Child Behavior Inventory, 179

Eye movement desensitization and reprocessing (EMDR), 205

Families assessment, 319,

325–334 and cancer, 321–325,

327, 331, 333–335, 338, 506

caregivers, 337, 396, 405, 416, 506, 511, 513–517, 598, 599

and chronic disease, 238, 318–338

and chronic pain, 598, 599

diagnosis of child, adjustment to, 374–376

and end-stage renal disease (ESRD), 474

family-centered practice method, 64, 318, 407, 504, 505, 511, 513, 516, 518, 592

family history and mapping genetic risk, 577, 578

family meetings, 608–609

family-oriented substance abuse intervention, 448, 449

Family Systems- Illness Model (see Family Systems- Illness Model)

family violence, 22, 26

genograms, 327, 340 (see also Genograms)

health/illness belief system, 320, 331–337

overview, 318, 338 and palliative care,

335 parentifi cation issues,

358, 508 psychoeducation, 319,

324, 326 research challenges,

337 support, 203, 326

Family-centered practice method, 64, 318, 407, 504, 505, 511, 513, 516, 518, 592

Family Systems-Illness Model

clinical and research implications of, 325, 326

developmental phases of individual, family, and illness, 320, 328–331

family system variables (belief systems, culture and ethnicity), 320, 331–337

overview, 319, 320, 338

phases of illness, 320, 322–325, 327, 328

psychosocial types of illness, 320–322

Fears children, 378, 379 older adults, 400, 415

Federal agencies and public health

social work, 14, 23, 68, 81, 82, 100

social workers in, 14 Federal legislation,

timeline, 120–122 Federal programs, health

policy, 105–110, 119

Federally Qualifi ed Health Centers (FQHCs), 103, 116

Fertility issues and cancer, 378,

507–510, 517 children, 378 reproductive genetics

and infertility, 573–575

in vitro fertilization (IVF), 574, 575

Fetal alcohol syndrome, 431

Fetal and Infant Mortality Review (FIMR), 77, 94

FICA questions for spiritual assessment, 280

Subject Index.indd 687Subject Index.indd 687 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

688 Subject Index

Finance and payment for health care services, 102–107, 119. See also Insurance coverage; Medicaid; Medicare

Finding meaning, 231– 233, 598

Flexner, Abraham, 13, 14, 49

Folk medicine, 292, 302–304, 309, 600

Food stamps. See Supplemental Nutrition Assistance Program (SNAP)

FRAMES (Feedback, Responsibility, Advice, Menu, Empathy, and Self- effi cacy), 457

Frankl, Viktor, 232, 598 Franklin, Benjamin, 5 Free and appropriate

education, right to, 231

Funding. See Finance and payment for health-care services

Gay and lesbian issues. See Lesbian, gay, bisexual, and transgender (LGBT) issues

Gehlert, Sarah, 26 Gender issues

communication biases, 247, 248

and health-care disparities, 70, 73

and obesity, 73 pain management, 615 transgender (see

Lesbian, gay, bisexual, and transgender [LGBT] issues)

Generalized anxiety disorder, 178, 179, 182, 191

Genetic counseling, 557, 566–573, 575, 579, 580, 582

Genetic counselors, 566, 568, 570

Genetic Information Non discrimination Act (GINA), 581, 582

Genetics autosomal dominant

mode of inheritance, 560

autosomal recessive mode of inheritance, 560, 569, 575, 580

BRCA gene, 507, 561, 574, 577, 582

chromosomes, 52, 559–562, 569, 573, 574

clinical geneticists, 558, 566

counseling, 507, 557, 566–573, 575, 579, 580, 582

DNA, 52, 558–563, 569

environmental factors, 557–559, 561–568, 582

epigenetics, 563, 567 ethical issues, 570,

574, 578–581 genetic counselors,

566, 568, 570 Genetic Information

Non discrimination Act (GINA), 581, 582

genetic services, demand for, 570, 571

genetic variation, 558–562

genome, 52, 324, 507, 557, 559, 562, 565

genotypes, 566, 579 germline mutations,

561, 562 and health literacy

and numeracy, 572

Human Genome Project (HGP), 52, 61, 557, 565, 585

and mental illness, 565, 566

multifactorial inheritance, 561

mutations, 225, 226, 324, 325, 378, 500, 507, 557, 560–563, 565–569, 572, 574, 575, 577–578, 582

natural selection, 564 overview, 557, 558,

582, 583 pharmacogenomics,

565, 566 phenotypes, 558, 560,

564, 565, 579 policy considerations,

581, 582 polymorphisms, 562,

567, 569 preimplantation

genetic diagnosis (PGD), 574

and race, 564, 565 referrals to genetic

services, 569–571 reproductive genetic

variation, 559, 560 reproductive genetics

and infertility, 573–575

research opportunities, 567, 568

resources, 584, 585 risk, mapping in

family histories, 577, 578

risk information, communicating and interpreting, 571–573

screening, 563, 569, 573–575 (see also Genetic testing)

social work, skills required, 576

somatic mutations, 561, 562

structural genetic

variation, 559–562 and substance use/

abuse, 565, 566 testing. See Genetic

testing transdisciplinary

teams, 566–569 in vitro fertilization,

574 X-linked inheritance,

560, 561, 569, 580 Genetic testing

access to, 570, 571 adult-onset disorders,

575–578 amniocentesis, 574 cancer, 325, 507, 513 carrier testing, 569,

574, 575 chorionic villis

sampling (CVS), 574

diagnostic testing, 569, 570

direct to consumer (DTC) tests, 570, 571

ethical issues, 570, 578–581

family histories, mapping genetic risk in, 577, 578

informed consent, 570, 578–580

microarrays, 562 minors, 580, 581 newborns, 563, 569,

570 predictive testing,

569, 570 prenatal, 569, 570,

573, 574 susceptibility testing,

569 types of, 569

Genograms genetic risk, 577, 578 illness, loss, and

crisis, 327–331, 340

spiritual, 281, 282 Genome, 52, 324, 507,

557, 559, 562, 565

Subject Index.indd 688Subject Index.indd 688 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

Subject Index 689

Genotypes, 566, 579 Gentrifi cation, 74, 75 Geographic information

system (GIS), 75, 77–78, 90, 91

Geriatric evaluation and management (GEM), 395

Geriatrics. See Comprehensive geriatric assessment (CGA); Older adults

Germline mutations, 561, 562

Gestation. See Pregnancy

Gibson, Patricia Ann, 30 Give an Hour, 180 Glenn, John, 6, 11 Glenn, Mary Wilcox, 6 Global Assessment

of Functioning (GAF), 177

Global public health issues, 82–87

Gowan, John Q., 30 Grief

complicated, 636, 637 counseling, 23, 25, 26,

32, 517, 628, 636 disenfranchised, 637 loss, understanding,

635, 636 role of social workers,

29, 32, 637 Grief models of

adjustment to disability, 227

Griffi ths, Martha, 111 Group theory, 245 Guided imagery, 292, 306

Hallucinogens, 436, 437. See also Substance use/ abuse

Hamilton, Alice, 66 Harder, Jeff, 29 Harm reduction

approach, substance use, 446–448

Harmful behaviors, 22 Hastings Center, The,

51, 61 Health behavior theories

Behavioral Model for Vulnerable Populations, 133, 134

Behavioral Model of Health Services Use, 131–135

Health Belief Model, 128, 129, 131, 132, 135

overview, 125, 126, 645

rational choice approaches, 128– 130, 134, 135

Social Action Theory, 131, 132, 135

social network approaches, 131, 132

stages of change, 134 Theory of Planned

Behavior, 128, 130–132, 135

Theory of Reasoned Action, 128–132, 135

Transtheoretical Model (TTM), 134

use of theory in social work practice and research, 126–128

Health Belief Model, 128, 129, 131, 132, 135

Health beliefs and cancer, 241, 506 and communication

issues, 238–243 older adults with

diverse ethnic and cultural backgrounds, 406, 407

supernatural causes of illness, 239

Health Care and Education Reconciliation Act of 2010, 113

Health-care disparities. See also Access to health care

cancer, 26, 70, 500, 501, 512, 515, 517, 519

categories and conditions for, 70

Center for Interdisciplinary Health Disparities Research, 26

diabetes, 531 and disability, 70 end-of-life care, 632,

633 and health policy, 116 heart disease, 529,

530 HIV/AIDS, 533 income, 144, 145, 158 kidney transplants,

471 and public health

social work, 70–72, 89–90

race and ethnicity, 144, 145, 172, 247

research, 89, 90 Health-care

environment, social work challenges and issues, 393, 394, 416, 643

Health-care industry, 102

Health-care proxy (durable power of attorney for health care), 633, 634

Health-care reform cost control, 119, 643 health policy, 102,

107, 110–114, 119, 643, 644

history of, 110–113 key features of, 113,

114 Massachusetts, 112

Health-care safety net, 16, 70, 114, 116–118

Health-care settings

end-of-life care, 627, 629

older adults, 409–416 and social work, 22, 23 transitions, 411, 412 types of, 22–24

Health-care systems alternative, 301–309 structure of, 102

Health-care teams and biopsychosocial

approach to health care, 21. See also Biopsychosocial approach to health care

collaboration, 243– 246

communication issues, 243–246

end-stage renal disease (ESRD), 478, 483

members of, 21 role of social workers,

24–28 types of, 244

Health departments, 14 Health impact

assessment (HIA), 76

Health insurance. See Insurance coverage

Health Insurance Portability and Accountability Act (HIPAA), 59, 377

Health literacy, 572 Health Maintenance

Organization (HMO) Act, 14

Health maintenance organizations (HMOs), 14, 15, 22

Health numeracy, 572 Health outcomes and

communication, 248, 249

Health policy access to health care,

100–102, 119 accountability, 100–

102, 119

Subject Index.indd 689Subject Index.indd 689 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

690 Subject Index

costs of health care, 100–102, 119

defi ned, 100 federal legislation,

timeline, 120–122 federal programs,

105–110, 119 fi nance and payment

process, 102–105, 119

and health care industry, 102

health-care reform, 107, 110–114, 119

health-care safety net, 16, 114, 116–118

health-care system structure, 102

health disparities, 116 and health insurance,

100–116, 119 Medicaid, 100, 102,

103, 105–122 Medicare, 100, 102–

109, 111, 113, 114, 117–122

overview, 100, 101, 119

patient-centered medical home, 117, 118

policy issues for social work, 114–119

quality of health care, 100–102, 119

resources, 120 role of social workers,

17, 100, 118, 119 State Children’s

Health Insurance Program (SCHIP), 100, 101, 105, 107, 109, 110, 113, 118, 119, 121

uninsured, 114–116 Health Resources

Services Administration (HRSA), 82

Health Security Act legislation, 111, 112

Healthy People 2010, 471

Healthy People 2020, 66, 67, 69, 82, 94, 471

Hearing loss, 21, 25, 186, 224, 313, 377, 393, 397, 400, 508, 570, 615. See also Auditory sense

Heart attack. See Myocardial infarction

Heart disease African Americans,

116, 172 congestive heart

failure, 308, 528, 529, 544

coronary artery disease, 153, 174, 181, 308, 528, 529, 544

epidemiology, 528 and gender, 529 health care settings,

528 implications of, 527 and marital status,

155 and mental health,

543–545, 547–549 myocardial infarction,

21, 132, 148, 166, 179, 180, 187, 309, 359, 360, 435, 528–529, 544, 548

overview, 528, 529 patient-practitioner

communication, 541–543

racial and ethnic disparities, 70, 116, 529, 530

and sexual health/ sexuality, 355, 359–360

as top cause of death in U.S., 527

treatment regimen, adherence to, 534– 541, 547

types of, 528, 529

Hemodialysis, 50, 468–474, 476, 477, 479–481, 483, 491, 492

Henry Street Settlement, 66

Herbal medicine, 292–294, 296–298, 300–304, 308–312, 362, 594

Hermann, Joan, 504 Heroin, 435, 436. See

also Substance use/ abuse

Hippocratic Oath, 48, 53, 54

Historical background end-of-life care, 504,

594, 628 health-care reform, 5,

6, 65–67, 110–113 pain management,

593–595 palliative care, 504,

593–595 public health social

work, 65–67 social work in health

care. See History of social work in health care

History of social work in health care

Civil War, impact of, 7, 8

Darwinism, impact of, 8

dispensaries, 5 hospital almoners in

England, 6, 10, 18 hospital social work

departments, growth of, 10, 11

hospitals, evolution of, 4, 5

immigration waves of 1800’s, impact of, 3, 4

Massachusetts General Hospital, 3, 5–13, 17, 592

medical social work, evolution of, 12–14

origins, 3, 4 outpatient and non-

hospital settings, 14–16

professional organizations and training, 10–12

public health reform, 5, 6, 65–67, 110–113

technique and approach, changes in, 16, 17

History of the American Association of Medical Social Workers (Stites), 11

HIV/AIDS deaths from, 527 depression, 166, 167,

179 disease prevention,

79, 80 epidemiology, 528, 532 federal fi nancing, 103 and gender, 532, 533 global issues, 85, 148,

532 HAART (highly

active antiretroviral therapy), 79, 532, 534

and Health Belief Model, 128

health-care disparities, 70, 116

health-care settings, 22, 23, 528

HIV and AIDS distinguished, 531

and homelessness, 146 implications of, 527 and mental health,

543, 545–547 mental health

interventions, 547–549

overview, 531, 532 pain management,

612, 613, 615 patient-practitioner

communication, 541–543

Subject Index.indd 690Subject Index.indd 690 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

Subject Index 691

psychiatric disorders, prevalence of, 179

public health issues, 533

racial and ethnic disparities, 533

and sexual health/ sexuality, 361

and substance use/ abuse, 431–432, 434–436, 444, 448, 452–453

and suicide risk, 193 treatment regimen,

adherence to, 534– 541, 547

Home health-care settings, 395, 409, 410, 412–414

Homelessness, 146, 158, 189, 190

Homeopathy, 292, 296, 297, 301, 302

Homophobia, 175 HOPE questions

for spiritual assessment, 279

Hospice care cancer, 504 children, 381, 382 end-of-life care, 628,

629 Hospital almoners, 6,

10, 18 Hospital Survey and

Construction Act (Hill-Burton Act), 111

Hospitals discharge planning,

393, 395, 404, 409–411, 413, 416

evolution of, 4, 5 health-care settings,

22 historical background,

594 inpatient settings,

394–396, 409–411, 416

nonprofi t and for- profi t, 102

Hull House, 66

Human Genome Project (HGP), 52, 61, 557, 565, 585

Human traffi cking, 85–87

Huntington’s disease, 193, 567, 569, 575, 577, 582

Hutchinson, Marvin R., 29, 30

Hypertension, 145, 146, 152, 153, 172, 183, 360, 393, 396, 414, 468, 471, 472, 529, 545. See also Cardiovascular disease; Heart disease

Hypnosis (hypnotherapy), 292, 306–307, 549, 605

Imagery techniques, 292, 306, 381, 593, 602, 603, 605

Immigration and health-care

issues, 644, 645 and history of social

work in health care, 4, 16

and religions in the U.S., 267

undocumented immigrants, 16, 109, 114, 115

Immigration and Nationality Act of 1965, 267

The Immortal Life of Henrietta Lacks (Skloot), 59

Immune system, 165, 166, 343, 431, 500, 502, 530–532

Immunization, 27, 65, 70, 78, 81, 128, 149, 150, 527

In vitro fertilization (IVF), 574, 575

Income levels and health, 144–146, 173, 174. See also

Socioeconomic status (SES)

Indian Health Services, 103, 581

Individual Education Programs, 231

Individuals with Disabilities Act, 231

Infants. See also Pregnancy

birth defects, 573, 574, 577

fetal alcohol syndrome, 431

genetic testing of newborns, 563, 569, 570

infant mortality (IM), 65, 71, 72, 77, 94, 116, 145, 152, 172

sudden infant death syndrome (SIDS), 77, 78, 433, 436

Infectious diseases, 8, 80, 113, 148, 149, 156, 453, 527. See also HIV/AIDS

Informed consent, 58, 570, 578–580

Inhalants, 433, 437. See also Substance use/ abuse

Injuries, home as source of, 75

Insight and judgment, assessment of as part of mental status exam, 183, 186, 187

Institutional review boards (IRBs), 57, 58

Instrumental activities of daily living (IADLs), 400, 404, 405, 411, 412

Insurance coverage alternative and

complementary medicine approaches, 295, 311

cancer treatment, 500, 501, 505, 508, 509, 513, 514

end-of-life care, 628, 630

and health-care disparities, 70

and health policy, 100–116, 119

Patient Protection and Affordable Care Act (PPACA), 16 (see also Patient Protection and Affordable Care Act of 2010 [PPACA])

and socioeconomic status, 174

uninsured, 114–116 Integrative health care,

295, 297, 298, 309–311

Interdisciplinary and transdisciplinary teams

end-of-life care, 629, 630

genetics, 566–569 pain management,

617, 618 public health social

work, 64, 65, 80, 85, 90

International Federation of Social Workers, 50

Interpersonal therapy (IPT), 203

Interpreters, 70, 185, 253–255, 408, 599

Interventions cancer, 510, 511 children, 378–381 disability, 228, 229 end-stage renal

disease (ESRD), 477–487

evidence-based, 69 multilevel, 30 pain management,

592, 601–609 population-based, 89,

90, 94, 646

Subject Index.indd 691Subject Index.indd 691 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

692 Subject Index

psychiatric disorders, 187

psychological stress, 165

psycho pharmacology, 167

psychosocial, 165, 167, 175, 178, 179, 187, 188, 190, 195–205

psychotherapy, 167, 187, 197, 198, 204, 205, 399, 510, 547, 548

public health social work, 64, 68, 69, 79, 80

role of social workers, 24–26, 30

substance use/abuse, 439–450, 456, 457

suicide risk, 195–198 Intimacy of health social

work, 347–351 Intoxication, 427, 428.

See also Substance use/abuse

Jarrett, Mary, 13 Jehovah’s Witnesses,

239, 240 Jennette, Caroline, 27,

28 Johns Hopkins Hospital,

5, 10, 11, 59 Joint Commission on

Accreditation of Health Care Organizations, 30, 278

Jones, Polly, 30, 31 Jonsen, Albert, 51 Juvenile rheumatoid

arthritis, 374

Kaiser Permanente Health Plan, 14

Kant, Immanuel, 47 Kennedy, Edward, 111,

113 Kidney failure. See End-

stage renal disease (ESRD)

Kidney transplants, 468–473, 475–481, 483–485, 490, 491

Kirk, Douglas, 31 Koro, 241 Kübler-Ross, Elisabeth,

594

Lacks, Henrietta, 58, 59, 571, 579

Language barriers, 70, 174, 242, 253–255. See also Interpreters

Learned helplessness, 127, 128

Legacy building, 383–384, 509, 600, 605–606

Lesbian, gay, bisexual, and transgender (LGBT) issues

access to health care, 73

adolescence, 357, 358 in assisted living

facilities and nursing homes, 355

communication issues, 346, 347, 350

homophobia, 175 older adults, 355, 403 and physical and

mental health, 175 suicidal behavior,

192, 193 terminology, 346

Licensing, 23 Life expectancy, 145,

148, 149, 275, 392, 473, 591, 628

Life review, 382–384, 600, 604–606

Listening skills, 630 Liver disease

liver transplants, 484, 485

and substance use/ abuse, 426, 431, 436, 437

Living wills, 633, 634 Local health

departments and

public health social work, 14, 80–82

Loch, Charles, 6, 18 Logotherapy, 232, 598 Long-term care

Community Living Assistance Services and Supports program, 113, 114

Medicaid coverage for, 107

Loss, understanding, 635, 636

Lou Gehrig’s disease (ALS), 25, 224, 562

Low birth weight (LBW), 31, 71, 72, 94, 116, 152, 153, 433–436

Lung cancer, 69, 193, 431, 432. See also Cancer

Major depressive disorder, 179, 190, 191

Major depressive episode, 178

Malpractice insurance, 50

Mammograms, 70, 79, 150, 151, 241, 253, 273

Managed care, 14, 15, 50, 56, 57, 105, 106, 108, 119, 416

Marijuana (cannabis), 147, 174, 427, 433, 434, 443, 444, 448, 452. See also Substance use/abuse

Marital status heart disease risk, 155 and sexual behavior,

402 and suicide risk, 192

Mass, Sharon, 28, 29 Massachusetts General

Hospital, 3, 5–13, 17, 592

Massachusetts health- care reform, 112, 115

Massage therapy, 292, 296, 300, 301, 303–306

Masturbation, 345, 346, 352–355, 357, 359, 363, 364

Maternal and Child Health Bureau (MCHB), 65, 80, 82, 94

Maternal and Child Health Services Block Grant (Title V), 65

Maternal mortality, 71, 72

Maternity and Infancy Protection Act (Sheppard-Towner Act of 1921), 65

Matrix model intervention, 448

Meaning, fi nding, 231– 233, 598

Medicaid cancer patients, 514 disability expenses,

230 end-of-life care, 628 end-stage renal

disease (ESRD), 468, 477, 478, 484, 485, 487

federal and state fi nancing, 103, 111

and health-care directives, 633, 634

and health-care reform, 87, 112–117

and history of health care social work, 14

home care services, 404, 412, 413

hospice care, 628 interpreters, cost of,

254 medical home model,

108, 117, 118 nursing homes, 415 older adults, 404, 412,

413, 415 overview, 105–112,

119

Subject Index.indd 692Subject Index.indd 692 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

Subject Index 693

Medicaid (cont.) and public policy

advocacy, 75, 87, 118, 119

rural areas, 117 undocumented

immigrants, 16, 115 unenrolled eligible

individuals, 115 Medical approach to

health care, 20–22 Medical crisis

counseling, 548 Medical ethics, 48, 49.

See also Ethics and ethical issues

Medical Ethics (Percival), 48, 49

Medical home, 108, 117, 118

Medical insurance. See Insurance coverage

Medical model of treatment

and alternative and complementary medicine, 296, 297, 310

biopsychosocial approach compared, 20, 21, 319

and cancer treatment, 518

disability, 221–224 and disease treatment

versus prevention, 149

Medical Savings Accounts (MSAs), 104

Medical social work approaches and

technique, changes in, 16, 17

defi ned, 12, 13 evolution of, 12–14

Medical terminology, 256–259

Medicare blank check

Medicare, 104 cancer, 508, 509 cost control, 14

Diagnosis Related Groups (DRGs) payment method, 102

disability coverage, 230

dual eligibles (eligibility for Medicaid), 108, 109

end-of-life care, 628, 633

end-stage renal disease (ESRD), 468, 469, 471, 477, 478, 480–484, 486–490

and geriatric assessment, 395

and health-care directives, 633, 634

and health-care reform, 87, 107, 111–113, 117

and history of health- care social work, 14

home health care, 412–414

hospice care, 628 Medicare Advantage

Plans, 106, 107 nursing homes, 414,

415 overview, 105–107 payroll tax, 103 prescription drug

coverage, 106, 107, 119, 396, 397, 416

Prospective Payment System (PPS), 104, 105, 118

regional variations in spending, 150, 151

undocumented immigrants, 109

Medicare Advantage Plans, 106, 107

Medicare Prospective Payment System (PPS), 104, 105, 118

Medications antidepressants, 197,

198, 203, 204, 310, 361, 362, 428, 439, 545, 547, 616

effects of on sexual health/sexuality, 361, 362

end-stage renal disease (ESRD), 470, 472, 473, 475–477, 479, 481, 485, 487, 490

HIV/AIDS, 532, 533, 545

Medicare prescription drug coverage, 106, 107

nonadherence, 128, 166, 187, 197, 200, 534, 544

posttraumatic stress disorder, 205

side effects, 188, 310, 361, 362, 396, 472, 473, 527, 533, 534, 546

substance use/abuse, 433, 437–439, 453

Meditation, 296, 300, 301, 306, 307, 309, 548, 549

Memorial services, 385 Mental health

case management, 31 health-care

disparities, 70, 89 and physical health

(see Physical and mental health)

public health social workers, role of, 89

Surgeon General’s Report on Mental Health, 89

Mental illness. See also Psychiatric disorders

and cancer, 505 and genetics, 565,

566 Mental status, formal

exam, 182–187,

408. See also Comprehensive geriatric assessment (CGA)

Mesothelioma, 69 Metaethics, 44–45 Methadone treatment,

436, 442, 447, 448. See also Substance use/abuse

Methamphetamine, 438, 439, 443. See also Substance use/abuse

Michigan Alcoholism Screening Test (MAST), 398, 456

Milestones in Sexual Development (Zoldbrod), 344, 345

Military issues disability, 230 female service

members, 180 genetic testing, 581 geriatric assessments,

394, 395 posttraumatic stress

disorder (PTSD), 180 (see also Posttraumatic stress disorder [PTSD])

social work, 14, 22, 31

Millgram’s obedience study, 58, 59

Mills, John Stuart, 47 MIMBRA questions

for spiritual assessment, 283

Mind/body techniques, 295–298, 332, 333

Mindfulness-based stress reduction (MBSR), 200

Miscarriage, 152, 436, 562, 573, 574, 635, 637

Mobile care units, 22 Mood and affect

assessment of as part of mental status exam, 183–185

Subject Index.indd 693Subject Index.indd 693 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

694 Subject Index

Mood disorders. See also specifi c disorders

children, 178 older adults, 178,

398, 415 prevalence, 178, 179 types of, 178

Morals, 43. See also Ethics and ethical issues

Motivation and change theory perspectives, substance use/ abuse, 443–446

Motivational enhancement therapy (MET), 444

Motivational interviewing, 443– 445, 449

Moving to Opportunity (MTO) for Fair Housing Demonstration Program, 147, 148

Multifactorial inheritance, 561

Multiple sclerosis (MS), 38, 127, 193, 321, 360, 361, 434, 612–613

Mutations, 225, 226, 324, 325, 378, 500, 507, 557, 560–563, 565–569, 572, 574, 575, 577–578, 582

Myocardial infarction, 21, 132, 148, 166, 179, 180, 187, 309, 359, 360, 435, 528–529, 544, 548. See also Heart disease

Naprapathy, 305 National Association

of Social Workers (NASW), 12, 30, 36, 38, 43, 49, 61, 75, 278, 279, 344, 387, 483, 520, 578, 619, 633, 638

National Cancer Act, 503

National Cancer Institute (NCI), 118, 503, 504

National Consensus Project for Quality Palliative Care (NCP), 595–597

National health insurance

history of health-care reform, 110–113

Patient Protection and Affordable Care Act of 2010 (see Patient Protection and Affordable Care Act of 2010 [PPACA])

National Hospice and Palliative Care Organization, 29, 38, 382, 504, 593, 634, 641

National Institute of Health (NIH), 17, 28, 82, 244, 245, 1118

National Nutrition and Health Survey (NHANES), 73–75

Natural selection, 564 Naturapathic medicine,

302 Nazi “research,” 47,

57, 58 Needs-based care, 29 Negative attributional

style, 127, 128 Neighborhood

composition in U.S., 143–148

Nephrology social work. See End-stage renal disease (ESRD)

Newborns. See Infants Nixon, Richard, 111 Nonmalfeasance, 45 Nonprofi t organizations,

68, 81, 102, 116, 118, 415

Normative ethics, 44–49

Nuremberg Code, 57, 58 Nurses and nurse

practitioners, 21, 23, 32, 108, 113, 188, 250, 377, 394–397, 410, 412, 414, 478

Nursing homes, 102, 107, 393, 394, 400, 402–405, 409–411, 413–416

Nutrition. See Diet and nutrition

Nutritionists, 566, 596. See also Dietitians

Oath of Hippocrates, 48, 53, 54

Obama, Barack, 52, 112 Obama, Michelle, 74 Obama Health Plan, 112 Obesity. See also Diet

and nutrition and cancer, 500 childhood, 68, 74,

128, 151, 374 and chronic disease,

151, 528, 531, 545, 549

and diabetes, 151, 528, 531

and health-care disparities, 116

and income level, 145, 150

and phenotypes, 564 race/ethnicity and

gender differences, 73, 145

and social networks, 91, 92, 240

as socially created health condition, 73

“thrifty gene” hypothesis, 151

Obsessive-compulsive disorder, 178, 182, 191

Occupational therapy/ therapists, 106, 222, 358, 359, 566, 567, 596

Older adults abuse and neglect, 22,

402–404, 410 activities of daily

living (ADLs), 393, 394, 400, 404, 405, 412, 414

advocacy issues, 394, 396, 397, 409, 411, 414, 416

aging population, characteristics of, 392–394

alcohol use, 396, 398, 430, 431, 439, 452, 454

anxiety disorders, 178, 203, 204, 398, 400, 439

cancer, 393, 396, 398, 401, 411, 500, 508, 509

care transition settings, 411, 412

comprehensive geriatric assessment (CGA), 394–406

dementia, 185, 186, 323, 397–400, 403, 405, 411, 415

demographics, 392, 393, 416

depression, 166, 198, 203, 204, 396–400, 405, 408, 415

discharge planning, 393, 395, 404, 409–411, 413, 416

end-stage renal disease, 471 (see also End-stage renal disease [ESRD])

ethnogeriatric assessment, 406– 408

fears, 400, 415 gay and lesbian, 355,

403 geriatric evaluation

and management (GEM), 395

Subject Index.indd 694Subject Index.indd 694 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

Subject Index 695

Older adults (cont.) health issues, 393 home health-care

settings, 395, 409, 410, 412–414

hospital inpatient settings, 394–396, 409–411, 416

instrumental activities of daily living (IADLs), 400, 404, 405, 411, 412

and managed care, 416

Medicaid, 108, 404, 412, 413, 415

Medicare, 394–397, 412–416 (see also Medicare)

mental status assessment, 182– 187, 408 (see also Comprehensive geriatric assessment [CGA])

Michigan Alcoholism Screening Test, 398

mood disorders, 178, 398, 415

nursing home settings, 393, 394, 400, 402–405, 409–411, 413–416

pain management, 438–439, 614–615 (see also Pain management)

primary health-care settings, 393–396, 399, 408–410, 416

resources, 417, 418 role of social workers,

26, 397, 410–412, 644

screening versus assessment, 408, 409

sexual health/ sexuality, 353–355

social work challenges and issues, 393, 394, 416

spirituality and religion, 273, 274, 276, 404–406 (see also Religion and spirituality)

substance use/abuse, 398, 404, 452, 454, 456

suicide, 192, 194, 198, 399, 410

Omnibus Budget Reconciliation Act of 1989, 75

Oncology social work, 498, 504, 505, 510–519. See also Cancer

Opioids. See Psycho- therapeutics (nonmedical use of prescription drugs)

Oppression, 84–87 Oregon Death with

Dignity Act (ODDA), 611

Organ transplants bone marrow, 352,

363, 484, 485 case management, 26 kidney, 468–473,

475–481, 483–485, 490, 491

liver, 484, 485 organ donation,

264, 470, 471, 479, 480

role of social workers, 26, 29

Society for Transplant Social Workers, 12

The Origin of the Species (Darwin), 7, 8

Orthodox Jews, 240

Pain management. See also End-of-life care

acute versus chronic pain, 591, 592

addiction issues, 428, 616, 617

advocacy, 601, 617

AIDS (acquired immuno defi ciency syndrome), 612, 613, 615

barriers to, 614 biopsychosocial

and spiritual assessment, 597– 600

cancer, 504, 594, 602, 612, 613, 615

challenges and opportunities, 539, 592

children and adolescents, dealing with family member’s chronic pain, 606, 607

chronic incurable illness, 612–614

chronic pain conditions, 612

cognitive-behavioral interventions, 602, 603

cognitive restructuring, 603

compassion fatigue, 619

continuing education for social workers, 593, 619, 620

coping statements, 603, 604

counseling, 601 depression and

anxiety, 598, 615 distraction, 604 education, 601, 602 end-stage renal

disease (ESRD), 473, 613, 614

ethical issues, 609– 611

expressive arts, use of, 606

family meetings, 609 and fi nding meaning,

231–233, 598 gender issues, 615 geriatrics, 438, 439,

614, 615

historical perspective, 593–595

hypnosis, 605 imagery, 605 interdisciplinary and

transdisciplinary teams, 617

interventions, 592, 601–609

minority populations, 615, 616

multiple sclerosis (MS), 612, 613

and opioid medication risks, 438, 439

overview, 591, 592, 611, 612, 619, 620

pain defi ned, 591 policy issues, 617 relaxation techniques,

604, 605 self-monitoring

techniques, 604 social workers, self-

care issues, 618, 619 and substance use/

abuse, 438, 439, 616, 617

suffering, 598 tolerance and

withdrawal issues, 428, 616

undertreatment of pain, 614

vulnerable populations, 614–617

Palliative care. See also Pain management

advocacy, 601, 617 assessment, 600 cancer, 504, 517 challenges and

opportunities, 592, 593

children, 381–383 chronic pain of family

member, dealing with, 606, 607

cognitive restructuring, 603

continuing education for social workers, 593, 619, 620

Subject Index.indd 695Subject Index.indd 695 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

696 Subject Index

coping statements, 603, 604

counseling, 601, 628 domains of care and

guidelines for practice, 596, 597

education and anticipatory guidance, 601

end-stage renal disease (ESRD), 473, 613, 614

ethical issues, 609–611 expressive arts, use

of, 606 family meetings, 608,

609 historical perspective,

504, 593–595 interdisciplinary and

transdisciplinary teams, 617, 618

life review and legacy building, 605, 606

National Consensus Project for Quality Palliative Care (NCP), 595–597

overview, 590, 591, 627, 628

standards for, 593 Panic disorder, 178, 179,

182, 191 Parent–child interaction

therapy (PCIT), 178, 179

Parentifi cation, 358, 508 Parkinson’s disease,

187, 320, 321, 613 Patient-centered medical

home, 117, 118 Patient education. See

Counseling and education

Patient navigation, 118 Patient Protection

and Affordable Care Act of 2010 (PPACA), ix, xv, 3, 16–18, 70, 87, 100, 106–107, 109–110, 113–114, 117, 119, 120

Patient Self- Determination Act, 633, 634

Pay-or-play approach to employer health- care coverage, 111

Payment systems, 102–105

Pediatric intensive care unit, end-of-life care, 383

Peer Standards Review Act, 14

Pelton, Garnet, 3, 6, 7, 9–11, 16–18

Pendleton, Helen B., 11 Pepper, Claude, 111 Pepper Commission, 111 Percival, Thomas, 48 Peritoneal dialysis,

468–470, 475–477, 479, 481

Perlman, Helen Harris, 14

Person-in-environment perspective, 64, 70, 76, 92, 118, 167, 189, 244, 303, 504, 512, 557, 592

Personal Responsibiity and Work Opportunity Reconciliation Act of 1996 (PRWORA), 107, 109

Pharmaceutical industry, 102, 112

Pharmacogenomics, 565, 566

Pharmacotherapy, 197, 205, 442, 447, 451

Phenotypes, 558, 560, 564, 565, 579

Phenylketonuria (PKU), 563, 566

Philosophy and ethics, 42–46

Phobias, 182, 191 Physical and mental

health adherence counseling,

200

adolescents, 166 adults, 166 case example, 174 cultural issues,

169–173 differential

assessment of mental health, 167, 178, 179, 187–199

discrimination, 172, 173

ecological factors, 167, 169

exosystems, 173, 174 family support, 175 information and

psychoeducation, 199, 200

macrosystems, 169–173

mental health symptoms, domains related to, 168

mesosystems, 174, 175 microsystems, 175–

198 overview, 164, 205 physical illness, role

of mental health, 166, 167

psychosocial conditions and increased risk of illness, 164–166

psychosocial conditions in health-care setting, assessing, 167–198

psychosocial interventions, 165, 167, 175, 178, 179, 187, 188, 190, 195–205

resources, 207, 208 role of social workers,

199 routine screenings,

199 and social

relationships, 165, 166

social support, 165, 166, 175

and socioeconomic status, 77, 172–174

stress, 164, 165, 200, 201

women, 166 Physical environment,

148, 149 Physical therapy/

therapists, 108, 222, 238, 357, 394, 397, 414, 566, 567, 596

Physician-assisted suicide. See Euthanasia

Pibloktoq, 241 Play and expressive

therapies, 379, 380, 383

Policy issues. See also Health policy

function of public health agencies, 64

genetics, 581, 582 pain management,

617 policy development,

27 public health social

work, 64, 67, 69, 70, 72, 74–76, 78–81, 85, 87–89, 91, 95

for social work, 114–119

Polymorphisms, 562, 567, 569

Popovich, Rose, 23, 25, 27

Population-based intervention, 89, 90, 94, 646

Positivism, 46 Posttraumatic growth,

377 Posttraumatic stress

disorder (PTSD), 178, 180, 183, 191, 204

Practice settings, public health social work, 22, 23, 80, 81

Subject Index.indd 696Subject Index.indd 696 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

Subject Index 697

Pregnancy. See also Infants

fetal alcohol syndrome, 431

gestation, community effects on, 152, 153

gestational diabetes, 530

gestational hypertension, 152

Maternal and Child Health Bureau (MCHB), 65, 80, 82, 94

Maternal and Child Health Services Block Grant (Title V), 65

maternal mortality, 71, 72

Maternity and Infancy Protection Act (Sheppard-Towner Act of 1921), 65

miscarriage, 152, 436, 562, 573, 574, 635, 637

prenatal genetic testing, 569, 570, 573, 574

substance use/abuse during, 431, 433– 436, 439, 452

Preimplantation genetic diagnosis (PGD), 574

Prenatal genetic testing, 569, 570, 573, 574

Prepaid health care, 105 Prescott, Megan, 478 Prescription drug

benefi ts, Medicare Part D, 106

Prescriptions. See Medications

Presidential Commission for the Study of Bioethical Issues, 51, 52, 62

President’s Council on Bioethics, 52

President’s Emergency Plan for AIDS

Relief (PEPFAR), 85

Preventive health services, role of social workers, 27

Primary care settings, 22–24, 26, 393–396, 399, 408–410, 416

Prisons/prisoners, 22, 51, 58, 80

Privacy issues. See also Confi dentiality

ethics, 47, 49, 50, 53, 58

genetics and genetic testing, 576, 579

and intimacy of health-care settings, 347, 348

in long-term care settings, 404, 415

and sexuality, 347, 348, 355, 363, 364, 402

student rights, 377, 378 and use of

interpreters, 254 Private agencies and

public health social work, 81

Project Camelot, 59 Psychiatric disorders.

See also specifi c disorders

detection, 181, 182 diagnostic criteria,

178, 179 DSM-IV-TR

diagnostic criteria, 178, 179

and homelessness, 189, 190

interventions, 167, 187

mental status exam, formal, 183–187

not otherwise specifi ed (NOS), 177, 191

prevalence, 179 screening instruments,

182, 183 and suicide risk, 193

Psychiatrists, 547, 567 Psychoeducation, 167,

198–201, 203–205, 319, 324, 326, 511, 516, 517

Psychological distress, 145, 146

Psychologists, 567 Psychopharmacology,

167, 187, 198, 199, 204, 513

Psychosocial effects of cancer, 505–510

Psychotherapeutics (nonmedical use of prescription drugs), 433, 437–439, 453. See also Substance use/abuse

Psychotherapy, 167, 177, 187, 197, 198, 204, 205, 399, 510, 547–548, 639

Public health reform, 5, 6, 65–67, 110–113. See also Health- care reform

Public health social work access to health care,

69–71, 75, 87 benefi t model, 88 climate change, 82, 84 clinical social work

contrasted, 68 community

assessment, 68, 76–78

components of prevention, 78, 79

defi ned, 64, 65, 68 determinants of

health, 67–70 disaster preparedness

and response, 82–84

disease prevention, 78, 79, 94

emerging issues, 82, 83

federal agencies, 14, 23, 68, 81, 82, 100

functions of public health agencies, 64

geographic information system (GIS), 75, 77, 78, 90, 91

global issues, 82–87 growth of, 80 health-care

disparities, 70–72, 89, 90

history of, 65–67 impact of, 92, 93 interventions, 64, 68,

69, 79, 80 levels of practice, 70,

78–80 local health

departments, 14, 80–82

mental health services, 89

methodologies for practice, 64, 65, 75–78

not-for-profi t agencies, 68, 81

overview, 64, 65 policies, 64, 67, 69,

70, 72, 74–76, 78–81, 85, 87–89, 91, 95

practice settings, 80, 81

private agencies, 81 research, 89, 90 resources, 82 role of social workers,

27, 29, 30, 68 social, economic,

and environmental justice, 64, 68, 70, 72–75, 81, 87–92

social epidemiology, 64, 68–70, 73, 75–77, 94

standards and competencies, 94

state agencies, 68, 80–82

terrorism, 82, 84 training for, 81, 82 transdisciplinary

teams, 64, 65, 80, 85, 90

Subject Index.indd 697Subject Index.indd 697 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

698 Subject Index

Public Health Social Work Standards and Competencies, 94

Public policy. See Health policy; Public health reform

Pulmonary disease, 181, 360, 361, 432

Quality Assessment and Performance Improvement (QAPI), 483

Quality assurance, 27, 34, 483

Quality of health care, 100–102, 119

Quinlan, Karen, 45

Race. See also Ethnicity discrimination, 172,

173 and genetics, 564,

565 health-care

disparities, 70–72, 116, 144, 145, 172

and obesity, 73 racial segregation,

144 and suicide risk, 192

Radiation therapy, 129, 377, 378, 501–503, 505, 509, 516, 591, 628

Rand Corporation, The, 62

RAND Health Insurance Experiments, 104

Rational choice approaches, health behavior, 128–130, 134, 135

Raymer, Mary, 29 Redlining, 74 Reeve, Christopher, 224 Refl exology, 305 Regulatory standards for

social work, 23 Rehabilitation model of

treatment, 222, 223

Relapse, 441–443, 445–449, 451. See also Substance use/ abuse

Relapse Prevention model, 442, 445

Relaxation techniques, 548, 549, 604, 605

Religion and spirituality children, spiritual

needs of, 383, 384 cultural competence,

170–172, 265 defi ning, 267–272 dimensions of,

269–272 ethical issues, 263,

264 and health, 171, 172,

203, 267, 272–276 intervention,

approaches to, 284, 285

older adults, 266, 273, 274, 276, 404–406

and organ donation, 264

overview, 263–265, 285

prayer and meditation, 171

refusal of medical care, 263

refusal to provide services, 264

religion defi ned, 632 resources, 286, 287 spiritual assessment,

276–284, 597–599 spirituality defi ned,

632 and suicide, 276 U.S. population,

265–267 Renal disease. See End-

stage renal disease (ESRD)

Reproductive genetic variation, 559, 560

Reproductive genetics and infertility, 573–575

Research complementary

and alternative medicine, 309

ethics, 47, 57–59 genetics, 567, 568 National Institute of

Health (NIH), 28 public health social

work, 89, 90 role of social workers,

27 use of theory in,

126–128 Reverby, Susan, 58 Rheumatoid arthritis,

15, 153, 242, 308, 374

Richmond, Mary, 6, 49

Risk management, 50 Role of social workers

administration, 30, 31 advocacy, 356, 364,

483–485, 646–647 case management, 25,

28, 29, 31, 230 child abuse, 31, 32 children, 376, 377,

379, 382, 386 collaboration, 32–35 communication in

health care, 25, 242–246

community-based models of practice, 25, 644, 645

community improvement, 156–159

counseling, 25 diabetes, 25, 26 disability, 225–229 economic reform, 159 end-of-life care, 26,

627, 629, 637–638 end-stage renal

disease (ESRD), 472, 477–488

entitlement programs, 25

grief counseling, 29, 32, 637

health care, 20–35, 41, 643

health-care teams, 24–28

health policy, 17, 100, 118–119, 644

homelessness, 158 interventions, 24–26,

30 mental health, 89 older adults, 26, 397,

410–412, 644 oncology social work,

498, 504, 505, 510–519

patient advocacy, 29 physical and mental

health, 199 preventive health

services, 27 public health social

work, 27, 29–30, 68

research, 27 sexual health/

sexuality, 347, 363, 364

Romano, Dawn, 31, 32 Roosevelt, Franklin, 110 Roosevelt, Theodore,

110 Royal Free Hospital, 6 Rule utilitarianism, 47

Saunders, Cicely, 594, 628

Schiavo, Terri, 44, 45, 229, 230

Schlinger, Jennifer, 28 Schools. See Education Screening

versus assessment, older adults, 408, 409

cancer, 22, 79, 150, 151, 253, 503, 512 (see also Mammograms)

screening, brief intervention, and referral to treatment (SBIRT), 450

Subject Index.indd 698Subject Index.indd 698 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

Subject Index 699

Screening (cont.) substance use/abuse,

449–456 (see also Substance use/ abuse)

Sebelius, Kathleen, 58 Secondary trauma. See

Compassion fatigue Section 8 housing, 147 Segregation, 144 Self-control exercises,

381 Self-determination, 42,

44, 45, 264, 336, 404, 457, 512, 578, 599, 617, 638. See also Patient Self- Determination Act

Self-esteem and body image, 345, 349, 355–357

Self-management issues, end-stage renal disease, 474–476

Self-monitoring techniques, 538, 604

Settlement houses, 65, 66

Sexual abuse, 352, 353 Sexual assault, 22, 26,

68, 179, 180 Sexual health/sexuality

adolescents, 353, 355, 357, 358

advocacy role of social workers, 356, 364

and cancer, 343, 347, 352, 354, 356, 359–362, 500, 505–510

childhood sexual abuse, 352, 353

communication issues, 346, 356, 359

couples, working with, 358, 359

developmental perspective, 354– 358

end-stage renal disease (ESRD), 473

erectile dysfunction, 354, 360–362

and heart disease, 355, 359, 360

and HIV/AIDS, 361 illness and injury,

effect of, 346, 350, 353, 356, 359–364

and income level, 150 intimacy of health

social work, 347–351

lesbian, gay, bisexual, and transgender (LGBT) issues, 346, 347, 350, 355

masturbation, 345, 346, 352–355, 357, 359, 363, 364

medications, side effects of, 361

Milestones in Sexual Development (Zoldbrod), 344, 345

older adults, 353–355 overview, 343, 364,

365 physical intimacy,

institutional obstacles, 343

privacy issues, 347, 348, 355, 363, 364

pulmonary disease, 360, 361

and renal disease, 360 resources, 365, 366 role of social workers,

347, 363, 364 self-esteem and body

image, 345, 349, 355–357

sensuality, 343 sexual development,

344–347 sexual disen-

franchisement by medical establishment, 345, 346

sexual history, obtaining, 348–351

sexual rehabilitation, 353, 354, 362, 363

sexual response, 353, 354

sexuality, 343 and spinal cord

injuries, 353, 358, 360–361

young adults, 355– 357

Sexual relationships, ethical issues, 54, 55

Sickle cell disease, 561, 575, 582

Simple phobia, 178 Skilled nursing

facilities, 22, 106 Smallpox, 65 Smoking. See also

Tobacco use cessation, 68, 134,

135, 201, 432 and income levels,

145, 150 and mental health

symptoms, 188, 189 public health

concerns, 68–70, 92

social network analysis, 92

Social Action Theory, 131, 132, 135

Social capital, 88, 157, 166

Social causation, 173–174

Social determinants of health, 67, 69, 72, 77, 149

Social, economic, and environmental justice, 64, 68, 70, 72–75, 81, 87–92

Social epidemiology, 64, 68–70, 73, 75–77, 94

Social illnesses and problems, 22

Social justice, 43, 44, 49, 64, 68, 70, 72, 81, 82, 87, 88, 90, 101, 118, 447, 512, 590

Social model of disability, 223, 224

Social network analysis (SNA), 91, 92

Social networks, 91, 92, 131, 132, 165, 166

Social norm, 130 Social phobia, 178, 182 Social reform

movements, 65, 66 Social relationships

and community effect on health, 148

and physical and mental health, 165, 166, 175

and sexual practices, 150

Social Security Act of 1935

and social work, 14, 65 Title V, 65, 80, 94

Social selection, 173 Social support

cancer, 21, 504–506, 509, 510, 513, 514

and cancer survival, 187

and chronic pain, 598 and health status, 21,

22, 203 and physical and

mental health, 165, 166, 175, 189, 190, 203

religious groups, 267, 272–274

social work assessment, 24

Social workers autonomous

practitioners, 646 challenges for,

384–386 education and training.

See Education and training for social workers

generalists and specialists, 645, 646

Subject Index.indd 699Subject Index.indd 699 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

700 Subject Index

profi les, 23, 25, 27 recognition of, end-

of-life care, 637, 638

research as part of practice, 646

roles (see Role of social workers)

self-care issues, 618, 619

skills required, 576, 645, 646

transdisciplinary team in genetics, 566–569

Social work ethics, 41, 42, 49, 50. See also Ethics and ethical issues

Social Work Policy Institute, 28

Socioeconomic status (SES)

as barrier to health care, 21, 24

community effects on health, 153, 154

and diabetes, 531 and health care

disparities, 17, 70– 73, 169, 246–248, 471, 500, 616, 617

and insurance coverage, 174

and lung cancer rates, 69

and obesity, 128, 150 and physical and

mental health, 77, 172–174

Somatic mutations, 561, 562

Somatization, 170 Speaker/Listener

Technique, 359 Special needs, 80, 117,

331, 374, 570 Speech and language

assessment of as part of mental status exam, 183, 185

language barriers, 70, 174, 242,

253–255 (see also Interpreters)

Speech therapy/therapists, 21, 566, 567, 630

Speedwell Society, 5 Spinal cord injuries

medical model approach, 223, 224

role of social workers, 225

and sexual health/ sexuality, 353, 358, 360, 361

suicide risk, 193 SPIR questions

for spiritual assessment, 280

Spiritual assessment, 276–284, 597–599. See also Religion and spirituality

Spiritual ecogram, 282 Spiritual ecomaps, 282 Spiritual genograms,

281, 282 Spiritual life maps, 281 Spiritual needs of dying

child, 383, 384 Spirituality. See

Religion and spirituality

Stage models of adjustment to disability, 226, 227

Stages of change, 134, 201, 445, 446

Staging, cancer, 500–502 Standards

cultural competence, 633

end-of-life care, 593, 633, 638

ethics, 44 palliative care, 593 public health social

work, 94 regulatory standards

for social work, 23 State agencies and

public health social work, 68, 80–82

State Children’s Health Insurance Program

(SCHIP), 75, 87, 100, 101, 105, 107, 109, 110, 113, 118, 119, 121

Stearns, Naomi, 504 Stewart, Mary, 6, 16, 18 Stites, M. A., 11 Stress

and increased risk for illness, 164, 165

management, 200, 201 mindfulness-based

stress reduction (MSBR), 200

and socioeconomic status, 174

Stress inoculation, 15 Stroke, 145, 148, 153,

179, 185, 187, 309, 321, 529, 530. See also Cardiovascular disease

Structural genetic variation, 559–562

Substance Abuse and Mental Health Services Administration, 82

Substance dependence, 427–429. See also Substance use/ abuse

Substance-induced disorders, 428. See also Substance use/ abuse

Substance use/abuse abstinence violation

effect, 442, 443 addiction, 426–429,

616, 617 alcohol, 429–431,

450–456 Alcoholics

Anonymous (AA), 429, 439–441, 456

alcoholism, 428, 429 AUDIT (Alcohol

Use Disorders Identifi cation Test), 454, 455

behavioral strategy with use of

vouchers or incentives, 448

brief interventions, 450, 456, 457

CAGE-AID (CAGE Adapted to Include Drugs), 454

CAGE questionnaire, 453, 454

and cancer, 431–434 cannabis (see

Marijuana [cannabis] under this heading)

as cause of end-stage renal disease, 469

co-occurring psychiatric disorders, 168, 189, 197, 449

cocaine, 427, 434, 435, 442, 443, 447, 448, 547

cognitive-behavioral and motivational enhancement therapy, 442

commonly used substances, 429–439

conceptualizing/ addressing problems, approaches for, 439–449

craving, 427, 428 criminal sentencing,

447, 448 defi nitions, 426–428 dependence, 427–429,

616 Diagnostic and

Statistical Manual of Mental Disorders, Fourth Edition, Text Revision (DSM- IV-TR) substance- related disorders, 427–429

diagnostic categories, 428, 429

Substance use/abuse (cont.)

Subject Index.indd 700Subject Index.indd 700 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

Subject Index 701

disease models, 440–442

Drug Abuse Screening Test (DAST), 456

family-oriented intervention, 448, 449

FRAMES (Feedback, Responsibility, Advice, Menu, Empathy, and Self- effi cacy), 457

and genetics, 565–566 hallucinogens, 436, 437 harm reduction

approach, 446–448 heroin, 435, 436 and HIV/AIDS, 431,

432, 434–436, 444, 448, 452, 453

and homelessness, 146 inhalants, 433, 437 interventions, 439–

450, 456, 457 intoxication, 427, 428 and liver disease, 431,

437 marijuana (cannabis),

147, 174, 427, 433, 434, 443, 444, 448, 452

Matrix model intervention, 448

and medical care, 22 and mental health

symptoms, 188, 189

methadone treatment, 436, 442, 447, 448

methamphetamine, 438, 439, 443

Michigan Alcoholism Screening Test (MAST), 456

moral and temperance perspectives, 440

motivation and change theory perspectives, 443–446

motivational enhancement

therapy (MET), 444 motivational

interviewing, 443– 445, 449

older adults, 398, 404, 452, 454, 456

opioids (see Psycho- therapeutics under this heading)

pain management and palliative care, 438, 439

patient placement, 449

pharmacotherapies, 442

in pregnancy, 431, 433–436, 439, 452

pseudoaddiction, 617 psychological models,

442, 443 psychotherapeutics

(nonmedical use of prescription drugs), 433, 437–439, 453

relapse, 441–443, 445–449, 451

Relapse Prevention model, 442, 445

resources, 459, 460 risk factors, 453 screening, 449–456 screening, brief

intervention, and referral to treatment (SBIRT), 450

stereotypes, 429 substance abuse, 428 substance dependence

(see Dependence under this heading)

substance-induced disorders, 428

substance use disorders, 173, 176, 177, 180, 182, 183, 188–190, 193, 197, 205, 428

substance use problems, 427

substance versus drug, 427

and suicide risk, 193 terminology, 426–428 TICS (Two-

Item Conjoint Screening), 455

tobacco, 431–433 tolerance, 427, 428,

616 transtheoretical/stages

of change model, 445, 446

12-step programs, 439, 441, 443, 444

withdrawal, 427–428, 436

Sudden infant death syndrome (SIDS), 77, 78, 433, 436

Suicide and suicidal behavior. See also Assisted suicide

assessment, 194, 195 and disability, 228 end-stage renal

disease patients, 472

ethical issues, 45 interventions, 195–

198 older adults, 194, 198,

399, 410 overview, 192–194 physician-assisted

suicide, 229 and religion, 276 social illness and

problems, 22 and substance use/

abuse, 193 Supernatural causes of

illness, 239 Supplemental Nutrition

Assistance Program (SNAP), 82

Supplemental Security Income (SSI), 107

Support groups, 26, 376, 377, 508, 510, 511

Survivorship issues, 509, 510

Susto, 241 Symptom management,

591. See also Pain

management System dynamics (SD),

91

Tarasoff v. Board of Regents of the University of California, 46, 47

Task-centered case work, 15

Taxes, 103, 106, 107, 111, 119

Tay-Sachs disease, 575 Teenagers, 25. See also

Adolescents; Young adults

Teleontological theory, 46, 47

Temporary Assistance for Needy Families (TANF), 107

Terrorism, 82, 84 Theory of Planned

Behavior, 128, 130–132, 135

Theory of Reasoned Action, 128–132, 135

Therapeutic touch (TT), 305

Thought processes, content, and perception, assessment of, 183, 185, 186

Thrifty gene hypothesis, 151

TICS (Two-Item Conjoint Screening), 455

Title V of the Social Security Act of 1935

Children with Special Health Care Needs, 80

Maternal and Child Health Services Block Grant, 65, 80

Maternal and Child Health Services

Subject Index.indd 701Subject Index.indd 701 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

702 Subject Index

Bureau (MCHB), 94

programs, 94 Tobacco use, 431–433.

See also Smoking; Substance use/ abuse

Traditional Chinese medicine (TCM), 296, 300, 302, 310

Transdisciplinary teams genetics, 566–569 public health social

work, 64, 65, 80, 85, 90

Transgender issues. See Lesbian, gay, bisexual, and transgender (LGBT) issues

Translation. See Interpreters

Transplants. See Organ transplants

Transtheoretical Model (TTM), 134

Transtheoretical/stages of change model, 445, 446

Trauma, 179–181. See also Posttraumatic stress disorder (PTSD)

Trauma-focused cognitive

behavioral treatment (TF- CBT), 205

Traumatic medical experiences, 379

Trisomy 13, 573 Trisomy 18, 573 Trisomy 21, 574 Truman, Harry, 110 Tuberculosis, 10 Turner syndrome

(monosomy X), 574

Tuskegee Study, 58, 571

Tuskegee University National Center for Bioethics in Research & Health Care, 58, 62

12-step programs, 439, 441, 443, 444. See also Substance use/ abuse

Undocumented immigrants, 16, 109, 114, 115

Uninsured, 114–116 Unipolar major

depression, 178 U.S. Department of

Agriculture, 82 U.S. Department of

Health and Human

Services (DHHS), 65, 66, 82

Utilitarianism, 47 Utility doctrine, 47

Vaccinations. See Immunization

Values, 43, 45 Veterans Administration

(VA). See also Military issues

genetic testing policies, 581

geriatric evaluation and management (GEM) approach, 395, 396

and social work, 14 Vicarious

traumatization, 385, 386

Virtue ethics, 48 Voltaire, F., 41

Wagner-Murray-Dingell bill, 110, 111

Wald, Florence, 628 Wald, Lillian, 66 Warren, Marjory, 394 Washburn, Frederic, 10 Whistle-blowing, 42, 51,

56, 57 Williamson, Mildred, 23 Wilson, Woodrow, 110 Winslow, Charles-

Edward Amory, 64

Withdrawal, 427–428, 436. See also Substance use/ abuse

Women and cancer, 175,

498–500 and depression, 166,

167 pregnancy (see

Pregnancy) and suicide, 192

Women, Infants, and Children (WIC), 82

World Health Organization (WHO), 72, 220, 242, 278, 454, 460, 591

World War I, 13 World War II, 14

X-linked inheritance, 560, 561, 569, 580

Young adults, 192, 355–357. See also Adolescents

Zakrzewska, Marie, 5 Zoldbrod’s Milestones

in Sexual Development, 344, 345

Subject Index.indd 702Subject Index.indd 702 9/21/11 7:56 PM9/21/11 7:56 PM

  • HANDBOOK OF HEALTH SOCIAL WORK
    • Contents
    • Foreword
    • Acknowledgments
    • List of Contributors
    • Introduction
    • PART I FOUNDATIONS OF SOCIAL WORK IN HEALTH CARE
      • 1 Conceptual Underpinnings of Social Work in Health Care����������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������
      • 2 Social Work Roles and Health-Care Settings����������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������
      • 3 Ethics and Social Work in Health Care�������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������
      • 4 Public Health and Social Work�������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������
      • 5 Health Policy and Social Work�������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������
      • 6 Theories of Health Behavior�������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������
    • PART II HEALTH SOCIAL WORK PRACTICE: A SPECTRUM OF CRITICAL CONSIDERATIONS
      • 7 Community and Health����������������������������������������������������������������������������������
      • 8 Physical and Mental Health: Interactions, Assessment, and Interventions�������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������
      • 9 Social Work Practice and Disability Issues����������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������
      • 10 Communication in Health Care�������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������
      • 11 Religion, Spirituality, Health, and Social Work����������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������
      • 12 Developing a Shared Understanding: When Medical Patients Use Complementary and Alternative Approaches����������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������
      • 13 Families, Health, and Illness����������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������
      • 14 Human Sexual Health����������������������������������������������������������������������������������
    • PART III HEALTH SOCIAL WORK: SELECTED AREAS OF PRACTICE
      • 15 Social Work With Children and Adolescents With Medical Conditions����������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������
      • 16 Social Work With Older Adults in Health-Care Settings����������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������
      • 17 Substance Use Problems in Health Social Work Practice����������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������
      • 18 Nephrology Social Work�������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������
      • 19 Oncology Social Work�������������������������������������������������������������������������������������
      • 20 Adherence and Mental Health Issues in Chronic Disease: Diabetes, Heart Disease, and HIV/AIDS�������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������
      • 21 Social Work and Genetics�������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������
      • 22 Pain Management and Palliative Care����������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������
      • 23 End-of-Life Care�������������������������������������������������������������������������
    • Afterword
    • About the Editors
    • Author Index
    • Subject Index